summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authornfenwick <nfenwick@pglaf.org>2025-02-07 00:48:23 -0800
committernfenwick <nfenwick@pglaf.org>2025-02-07 00:48:23 -0800
commit6a7f84bc1dc04b48c9df1c9b6558821b779f02eb (patch)
tree2b1c93adbccf96f8111b55b2d6d56e0962efd6f8
parent8c0871efa96095599b94897ab9f94385394ef955 (diff)
NormalizeHEADmain
-rw-r--r--.gitattributes4
-rw-r--r--LICENSE.txt11
-rw-r--r--README.md2
-rw-r--r--old/54499-0.txt11381
-rw-r--r--old/54499-0.zipbin274696 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h.zipbin16521738 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/54499-h.htm12946
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0001.jpgbin48101 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0008.jpgbin275460 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0009.jpgbin319738 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0010.jpgbin448827 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0030.jpgbin269600 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0035.jpgbin244811 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0043.jpgbin288964 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0055.jpgbin147465 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0056.jpgbin212189 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0062.jpgbin291556 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0070.jpgbin300354 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0080.jpgbin316298 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0091.jpgbin393118 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0097.jpgbin381971 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0103.jpgbin254713 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0111.jpgbin306173 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0117.jpgbin342338 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0125.jpgbin312394 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0139.jpgbin441538 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0165.jpgbin407315 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0173.jpgbin285954 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0185.jpgbin371887 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0191.jpgbin375375 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0209.jpgbin436205 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0217.jpgbin246776 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0225.jpgbin220802 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0249.jpgbin226598 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0259.jpgbin372483 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0267.jpgbin332065 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0276.jpgbin325088 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0288.jpgbin246726 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0296.jpgbin445760 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0303.jpgbin367576 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0312.jpgbin76012 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0315.jpgbin371207 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0317.jpgbin270189 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0325.jpgbin313514 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0339.jpgbin344268 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0351.jpgbin319097 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0359.jpgbin167402 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0360.jpgbin181072 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0376.jpgbin391560 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0382.jpgbin322435 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0388.jpgbin253423 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0392.jpgbin341116 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0404.jpgbin185104 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0433.jpgbin304629 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0438.jpgbin391014 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0447.jpgbin291778 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0463.jpgbin255054 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0470.jpgbin282632 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0476.jpgbin264976 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0488.jpgbin238736 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0492.jpgbin364714 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/0501.jpgbin247372 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/cover.jpgbin48101 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54499-h/images/enlarge.jpgbin789 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/old/54499-h.htm.2018-08-2012945
65 files changed, 17 insertions, 37272 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d7b82bc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/.gitattributes
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+*.txt text eol=lf
+*.htm text eol=lf
+*.html text eol=lf
+*.md text eol=lf
diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6312041
--- /dev/null
+++ b/LICENSE.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements,
+metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be
+in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES.
+
+Procedures for determining public domain status are described in
+the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org.
+
+No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in
+jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize
+this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright
+status under the laws that apply to them.
diff --git a/README.md b/README.md
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1f3e6b4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/README.md
@@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
+Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for
+eBook #54499 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/54499)
diff --git a/old/54499-0.txt b/old/54499-0.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index 1d226e3..0000000
--- a/old/54499-0.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,11381 +0,0 @@
-Project Gutenberg's In The Strange South Seas, by Beatrice Grimshaw
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and most
-other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
-whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms of
-the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online at
-www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the United States, you'll have
-to check the laws of the country where you are located before using this ebook.
-
-
-
-Title: In The Strange South Seas
- With Photographs
-
-Author: Beatrice Grimshaw
-
-Release Date: April 7, 2017 [EBook #54499]
-
-Language: English
-
-Character set encoding: UTF-8
-
-*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK IN THE STRANGE SOUTH SEAS ***
-
-
-
-
-Produced by David Widger from page images generously
-provided by the Internet Archive
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-IN THE STRANGE SOUTH SEAS
-
-By Beatrice Grimshaw
-
-Author Of “From Fiji To The Cannibal Islands,” Etc.
-
-London: Hutchinson & Co. Paternoster Row
-
-1907
-
-
-[Illustration: 0001]
-
-
-[Illustration: 0008]
-
-
-[Illustration: 0009]
-
-
-[Illustration: 0010]
-
-
-
-IN THE STRANGE SOUTH SEAS
-
-
- In desire of many marvels over sea,
-
- When the new made tropic city sweats and roars,
-
- I have sailed with young Ulysses from the quay,
-
- Till the anchor rattled down on stranger shores.
-
- Kipling.
-
-
-MOST men have their loves, happy or hopeless, among the countries of
-the earth. There are words in the atlas that ring like trumpet calls
-to the ear of many a stay-at-home in grey northern cities--names of
-mountains, rivers, islands, that tramp across the map to the sound of
-swinging music played by their own gay syllables, that summon, and lure,
-and sadden the man who listens to their fifing, as the music of marching
-regiments grips at the heart of the girl who loves a soldier.
-
-They call, they call, they call--through the long March mornings, when
-the road that leads to everywhere is growing white and dry--through
-restless summer nights, when one sits awake at the window to see the
-stars turn grey with the dawn--in the warm midday, when one hurries
-across the city bridge to a crowded eating-house, and the glittering
-masts far away down the river must never be looked at as one passes. Of
-a misty autumn evening, when steamers creeping up to seaport towns send
-long cries across the water, one here, and another there, will stir
-uneasily in his chair by the fire, and shut his ears against the
-insistent call.... Why should he listen, he who may never answer?
-
-_(Yokohama, the Golden Gate, Cape Horn, the Rio Grande, Agra, Delhi,
-Benares, Bombay, the Amazon, the Andes, the South Sea Islands, Victoria
-Nyanza, the Pyramids, the Nile, Lhassa, Damascus, Singapore, the
-tundras, the prairies, trade-winds, tropics, and the Line--can’t you
-hear us calling?)_
-
-Love is not stronger than that call--let sweetheartless girls left
-alone, and the man of cities who has loved the woman of the wandering
-foot, give bitter witness. Death is not stronger--those who follow the
-call must defy him over and over again. Pride of country, love of home,
-delight in well-known faces and kindly hearts that understand, the
-ease of the old and well-tried ways, the prick of ordinary ambitions
-hungering for the showy prizes that every one may see--these are but as
-dead leaves blown before the wind, when the far-off countries cry across
-the seas. Not one in a hundred may answer the call; yet never think, you
-who suppose that love and avarice and the lust of battle sum up all the
-great passions of the world, that scores out of every hundred Englishmen
-have not heard it, all the same. “In the heart of every man, a poet has
-died young”; and in the heart of almost every Briton, a wanderer once
-has lived. If this were not so, the greatest empire of the world had
-never been.
-
-So, to The Man Who Could Not Go, I address this book--to the elderly,
-white-waistcoated city magnate, grave autocrat of his clerkly kingdom
-(never lie to me, sir--what was your favourite reading in the sixties,
-and why were you a very fair pistol shot, right up to the time when you
-were made junior manager?)--to the serious family solicitor, enjoying
-his father’s good old practice and house, and counting among the
-furnishings of the latter, a shelf of Marryats, Mayne Reids, and Michael
-Scotts, wonderfully free of dust--to the comfortable clergyman, immersed
-in parish cares, who has the oddest fancy at times for standing on
-dock-heads, and sniffing up odours of rope and tar--to all of you, the
-army of the brave, unwilling, more or less resigned Left Behinds, who
-have forgotten years ago, or who will never, forget while spiring masts
-stand thick against blue skies, and keen salt winds wake madness in the
-brain--to all I say: Greeting! and may the tale of another’s happier
-chance send, from the fluttering pages of a book, a breath of the
-far-off lands and the calling sea.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER I
-
-_Fate and Her Parcels--How It All came true--The First South Sea
-Island--Coleridge and the Tropics--The Spell of the Island Scents--What
-happens to Travellers--Days in Dreamland--A Torchlight Market--The
-Enchanted Fei._
-
-LIKE an idle messenger-boy, Fate takes a long while about her rounds,
-but she will get through with them and deliver all her parcels, if you
-give her time enough.
-
-She has so much business that she confuses orders very often, and you
-are never sure of getting what you sent for. Still, you will certainly
-get something, if you wait, and it may even be the thing you demanded.
-
-The morning she called at my door, with a very full basket, she had
-already been to my neighbours, and given them, in a big assortment of
-goods--a failure on the Stock Exchange, a hunting accident, and a broken
-engagement. What they had ordered was a seat in Parliament, and a winter
-at Monte Carlo, with anything good that might come in in the way of
-new-laid motor-cars. But Fate was, as usual, in a hurry, and she never
-changes any goods, once delivered. So they had to take them in.
-
-I had given up expecting her when her knock came to my door, because
-my order had been sent in some years ago, and so far had remained
-unacknowledged. But she fairly emptied her basket into my hands, once
-she was admitted.
-
-“Goods all right, and none the worse for keeping; couldn’t find time to
-see to you before, I’ve been so busy attending to an order from Japan
-for a new army and a gross of assorted victories,” she panted. “Had to
-serve the Czar of Russia with a lot of old defeats I’ve had lying by
-since the Crimea, instead of the new empire he sent for; and can’t get
-time to fill more than half the German Emperor’s order for fireworks.
-You private people are lucky to get anything at all. Count the goods,
-please--one journey round the world, two-and-a-half years of mixed
-adventures, a hundred South Sea Islands, threescore new friends, first
-quality, one large package luck. That’s all, I think--sign the book,
-and let me go; I’ve got seven attacks of appendicitis, a foreclosed
-mortgage, two lawsuits, and a divorce, to deliver in this square before
-lunch.”
-
-So, like the fairy tales, “it all came true,” and one bright winter
-afternoon a Cunard liner bore me away from the streets and shops and
-drab-coloured, huddled houses of Liverpool, down the muddy Mersey--off
-round the world.
-
-There were thousands of people on the quay, come to see the famous boat
-away, for it was Saturday afternoon, and the town took holiday. They had
-a few hours of freedom before them--then, the airless office room,
-the stuffy shop, the ledger and the copying-press, and the clattering
-typewriter, the grim window giving on the dark wet street, for six long
-days again. Next year, and the year after,-just the office, the frowsy
-lodging, the tram car, the pen in the strong young fingers, the desk to
-stoop the broad young shoulders, the life foreseen, eventless, grey for
-ever and for ever. And I was going round the world.
-
-It is three weeks later, and the big “A and A” steamer is ploughing
-along in the midst of a marvellous dazzle of diamond-spangled, pale-blue
-tropic sea and scorching, pale-blue tropic sky. The passengers, in cool
-white suits and dresses, are clustered together on the promenade deck,
-looking eagerly over the port railing, while the captain, telescope in
-hand, points out something lying only a mile away, and says: “That’s
-Tiki-Hau, so now you’ve seen a South Sea Island.”
-
-We are on our way to Tahiti, a twelve-day run from San Francisco, and
-are not stopping anywhere, but as Tiki-Hau is the only glimpse of land
-we shall get until we cast anchor in Papeete, every one wants to look
-at it. Not one of us has ever seen a South Sea Island, and, we are all
-eager to realise this little fragment of our rainbow-coloured childish
-dreams.
-
-Is it as good as we dreamed it? we ask ourselves and each other. The
-verdict, given unanimously, is: “Yes--but not the same.”
-
-Here is no high green palmy peak, overhanging a waveless sea, with
-sparkling waterfalls dashing down from crag to crag, like the coloured
-illustrations in our old school prize books. There are, indeed, just
-such islands in the Pacific, we are told--many hundreds of them--but
-there are still more of the kind we are now looking at, which is not
-half so often mentioned. All South Sea Islands are either high or low;
-the high island, with lofty mountains and dark, rich volcanic soil, is
-the familiar island of the picture book, while the low type, composed
-only of coral, is the variety to which Tiki-Hau belongs.
-
-[Illustration: 0030]
-
-What we can see of the island, however, is enough to set at rest any
-tendency to comparison. None of us want anything better; none of us
-think there can be anything better, among the wonders that the Great
-South Seas yet hold in store.
-
-Tiki-Hau is an island of the atoll or ring-shaped type, a splendid
-circle of seventy and eighty-foot palms, enclosing an inner lagoon clear
-and still as glass. Outside the windy palms, a dazzling beach runs down
-to the open sea all round the island--a beach that is like nothing the
-travellers ever have seen before, for it is made of powdered coral,
-and is as white as salt, as white as starch, as white as the hackneyed
-snow-simile itself can paint it. All the island--the whole great ring,
-many miles in length--is coral too, white, branching, flowering coral
-under water, white, broken-coral gravel above, with here and there a
-thin skin of earth collected by a century or two of falling palm-leaves
-and ocean waste. Outside the magic ring the sea-waves tumble, fresh and
-blue, upon-the cloud-white sand; within, the still lagoon glows like
-a basin of molten emerald. Above, the enormous palm-trees swing their
-twenty-foot plumes of gaudy yellow-green to the rush of warm trade-wind,
-high in the burning sky. A glorious picture indeed--but one before which
-the painter well might tremble.
-
-Here, for the first time, we begin to understand why pictures
-of tropical scenes are so few and so unsatisfactory. Paint! what
-combination of coloured grease that ever came out of a box could hope to
-suggest the pale green fire of those palm-tree plumes, the jewel-blaze
-of the lagoon, the sapphire flame of the sea, the aching, blinding
-whitenesses of spray and sand? Who could paint the sun that is literally
-flashing back from the light dresses of the passengers, making of every
-separate person a distinct conflagration, and darting lightning rays out
-of the officers’ gold shoulder-straps and buttons? Does any dweller in
-the dim grey North really know what light and colour are? did we
-know, with our tinselled April days, and gentle blue-and white August
-afternoons, that we were so proud of once? Well, we know now; and, alas,
-in the dim, prosaic years that are yet to come, we shall remember!
-
-The ship steams on, the atoll fades away in the distance, and once more
-comes the changeless level of long blue empty sea. But we have seen a
-coral island, and the picture is ours for ever.
-
-Flying-fish, skimming and “skittering” over the surface of the waves, we
-have all become used to now. The first day we met them was a memorable
-one, all the same--they were so exactly what one had paid one’s money
-to see. Sharks have disappointed us so far; never a sight of the famous
-“black triangular fin” have we yet enjoyed, and the passengers have an
-idea that something ought to be said to the steamship company about it.
-Nor have the equatorial sunsets quite kept up their stage character.
-Books of travel, and sea literature in general, have led us to expect
-that the sun, in the tropics, should go out at sunset as though Poseidon
-had hold of the switch down below the water line, and turned off the
-light the instant sun and horizon met.
-
- ... The sun’s rim dips, the stars rush out.
-
- At one stride comes the dark.
-
-They don’t, Mr. Coleridge, and it doesn’t, and you never were there to
-see for yourself, or you would not have talked beautiful nonsense
-and misled countless travellers of all ages who did see, but who have
-refused to look, save through your illustrious spectacles, ever since.
-Even on the equator, the sun gives one time to dress for dinner (if the
-toilet is not a very elaborate one) while it is setting, and after it
-has set. So dies one more illusion. Yet it can easily be spared, in the
-midst of a thousand wild dreams and strange imaginings, realised to the
-very utmost, as ours are to be ere long.
-
-Tahiti comes at last. In the pearly light of a sunrise pure as a dawn
-of earliest Eden, we glide into the shadow of a tall, rose-painted peak,
-spiring eight thousand feet up into heaven, and anchor in the midst of
-a glassy mirror of violet sea. Papeëte, the loveliest, sweetest, and
-wickedest town of all the wide South Seas, lies before us--just a
-sparkle of red roofs looking out from under a coverlet of thick foliage,
-a long brown wharf and a many-coloured crowd. Across the water steals
-a faint strange perfume, unlike anything I have ever smelled
-before--heavy, sweet, penetrating, suggestive.... It is cocoanut oil
-scented with the white tieré flower, and never, from Tahiti to Samoa,
-from Raratonga to Fiji, Yavau, Manihiki, or Erromanga, will the South
-Sea traveller lose the odour of it again. Cocoanut oil, and the nutty,
-heavy smell of copra (dried cocoanut kernel) are charms that can raise
-in an instant for any old island wanderer, in the farthest corners of
-the earth, the glowing vision of the wonderful South Sea world.
-
- ... Smells are surer than sounds or sights
-
- To make your heartstrings crack,
-
- They start those awful voices o’ nights
-
- That whisper: “Old man, come back!”
-
-
-_(Old island wanderers in all parts of the world--settled down to
-desks in the E.C. district--tramping through the December glare of Pitt
-Street, Sydney, for “orders”--occupying a tranquil, well-bred billet,
-and a set of red-tape harness, in the Foreign Office--do you smell the
-tierê flower, and hear the crooning of the reef, and feel the rush of
-the warm trade wind, and the touch of the sun-baked sand, under the utu
-trees once more?)_
-
-So I landed in Papeete, and found myself in the South Sea Islands at
-last.
-
-All that afternoon, like “Tommy” in Barrie’s _Thrums_, I kept saying to
-myself: “I’m here, I’m here!”... There was no mistake about Papeëte. It
-was not disappointing or disillusioning, it was only more lifelike
-than life, more fanciful than fancy, infinitely ahead of all past
-imaginations.
-
-There were the waving palms of picture and story, laden with immense
-clusters of nuts; there were the wonderful bananas, with broad green
-leaves ten and twelve feet long, enshrouding bunches of fruit that
-were each a good load for a man; there were the greenhouse flowers of
-home--the costly rare stephanotis, tuberose, gardenia--climbing all over
-the verandahs of the houses, and filling half-cultivated front gardens
-with stacks and bouquets of bloom. And the dug-out canoes, made from a
-single hollowed log supported by an outrigger, flitting about the glassy
-lagoon like long-legged waterflies--and the gorgeous, flamboyant trees,
-ablaze with vermilion flowers, roofing over the grassy roadway in
-a series of gay triumphal arches--and above all, beyond all, the
-fiery-gold sunlight, spilling cataracts of flame through the thickest
-leafage, turning the flowers to white and red-hot coals, painting the
-shadows under the houses in waves of ink, and bleaching the dust to
-dazzling snow--how new, how vivid, how tropical it all was!
-
-The native population was out in full force to see the steamer come
-in. So, indeed, were the white residents, in their freshest suits and
-smartest muslins, but they met with small attention from the little band
-of newcomers.
-
-It was the Tahitians themselves who claimed all our interest--the famous
-race who had been so well liked by Captain Cook, who had seduced the men
-of the _Bounty_ from allegiance to King George of England, a hundred
-and sixteen years ago, who were known all the world over as the most
-beautiful, the most amiable, and the most hospitable of all the South
-Sea Islanders.
-
-Some of the passengers, I fancy, expected to see them coming down to the
-shore clad in necklaces and fringes of leaves, eager to trade with
-the newcomers and exchange large pearls and thick wedges of fine
-tortoiseshell for knives, cloth, and beads.... Most of us were better
-prepared, however, having heard a good deal about Papeëte, the Paris of
-the South Seas, from the people of the steamer, and having realised, on
-our own account, that a great deal of water might run under a bridge in
-a hundred years, even here in the South Pacific.
-
-So the smartness of the native crowd surprised only a few, of whom I was
-not one. On the contrary, I was surprised to find that here, in this
-big island group, with its fortnightly steamer, its large “white” town,
-and its bureaucratic French Government, some kind of a national dress
-did really still exist. The Tahitian men were variously attired, some
-in full suits of white, others in a shirt and a brief cotton kilt. The
-women, however, all wore the same type of dress--a flowing nightdress of
-cotton or muslin, usually pink, pale green, or yellow, and a neat small
-sailor hat made in the islands, and commonly trimmed with a pretty
-wreath of shells. Most of them wore their hair loose, to show off its
-length and fineness--Tahitians have by far the most beautiful hair of
-any island race--and not a few were shoeless, though nearly all had
-smart parasols. The colour of the crowd was extremely various, for
-Tahiti has more half and quarter castes than full-blooded natives--in
-Papeete at all events. The darkest, however, were not more than
-tea-coloured, and in most instances the features were really good.
-
-So much one gathered in the course of landing. Later on, during the few
-days I spent in an hotel waiting for the Cook Island steamer--for, alas!
-I was not staying in Tahiti--there was opportunity for something further
-in the way of observation. But------
-
-But------ It happens to every one in Tahiti, why should I be ashamed of
-it? There was once a scientific man, who came to write a book, and took
-notes and notes and notes--for two days and a half. Then, he thought he
-would take a morning’s rest, and that is five years ago, and he has been
-resting ever since, and they say in the stores that he has not bought so
-much as a sheet of letter paper, or a penny bottle of ink, but that his
-credit for cigars and ice, and things that go with both very well, and
-for pyjamas to lounge about the back verandah in, and very cheap novels,
-and silk-grass hammocks, is nearly run out in Papeete. There was a
-Government official--perhaps it was two, or three, or sixty Government
-officials--who came to Papeete very full of energy and ability, and very
-much determined to work wonders in the sleepy little colony.... He, or
-they, is, or are, never to be seen awake before three in the afternoon,
-and his clerks have to type the signatures to his letters, because he
-will not trouble to write his name; and their people think they died
-years and years ago, because they have never carried out their intention
-of telling some one to find some one else to send a message to say they
-are alive. And there are a dozen or fourteen gentlemen who keep stores
-in Papeete, and if you go in to buy things in the morning or afternoon
-or evening, mayhap you will find the gentleman or his understudy asleep
-behind the counter, but mayhap you will find the door shut, and the
-proprietor away at breakfast, which takes him an hour, or lunch, which
-takes from two hours to three, or dinner, which occupies him from six
-till nine inclusive. After that, he may open again for a little while,
-or he may not.
-
-Must I explain now what happened to me in Papeëte, or why I am not in
-a position to add anything to the scientific or ethnological, or
-geographic knowledge of the world, concerning the Society Islands in
-general?
-
-A duty, obvious, immediate, and unperformed, is perhaps the best of all
-spices to a dish of sweet laziness. And there is not on earth’s round
-ball such a spot to be lazy in as pleasant Papeëte. One is never fairly
-awake. It is dreamland--and what a happy dream! The golden light on
-the still lagoon is surely the “fight that never was on sea nor
-land”--before we sailed in under the purple peaks of Orohena. The
-chanting of the coral reef far out at sea, unceasing, day and night, is
-the song the sirens sang to strong Ulysses, in the dream dreamed for
-all ages by the old Greek poet, long ago. The languorous voices of
-the island women, sweet and low as the “wind of the western sea”--the
-stillness of the island houses, where feet go bare upon the soundless
-floors, and music waxes and wanes so softly now and then in whispering
-songs or lightly swept piano keys, that it only blends with the long
-mysterious murmur of the wind in the rustling palm trees, to lull the
-senses into perfect rest--these, too, are of the world of dream.
-
-Something out of dreamland, also, is the little hotel where most of the
-travellers stay--a rambling bungalow in a grass enclosure, overrun with
-vivid flowers and splendid leafage. That the proprietress should welcome
-her guests in a long lace and muslin nightgown-dress, her pretty brown
-feet bare, and her flowing wavy hair crowned with a wreath of perfumed
-gardenia and tuberose, seems quite a natural part of the dream; that the
-chamber-maids should be beautiful island girls clad in the same garb,
-and that they should sit in the drawing-room playing the piano and
-singing wild melancholy island songs, like the sighing of the surf on
-the shore, when they ought to be making beds or serving dinners, is also
-“in the picture.” That the Chinese cook should do elaborate Parisian
-cookery, and that the coffee and the curry and the bread (or at least
-the bread-fruit) should be picked in the garden as required, and that
-there should be no visible means of shutting the door of the bathroom,
-which is very public, until a carpenter is called in, and that
-L--------, the charming proprietress, should explain with a charming
-smile: “Only the house been using it all this time,” to account
-completely for the deficiency--all this belongs unmistakably to the
-irresponsible dream-country. And when the warm tropic night drops down,
-and one goes wandering in the moonlight, to see for the first time
-the palm-tree plumes all glassy-silver under the radiant sky, flashing
-magically as they tremble in the faint night wind, it is more than ever
-the land of dream that is thus lit up in the soft clear dusk. So vivid
-is the moonlight, that one can even see the scarlet colour of the
-flamboyant flowers fallen in the dust, and distinguish the deep violet
-and hyacinthine hues of the far-off mountain peaks across the bay....
-How, in such a place, can one waste the night in sleep?
-
-It is certainly not like any sort of waking life one has hitherto known,
-to find that the market of Papeëte--one of the principal sights of
-the place--is held on Sunday mornings before sunrise. One might have
-supposed that such a supremely indolent people would scarcely choose the
-most inconvenient hour of all the twenty-four for a general gathering.
-But they do choose it, and the visitor who wants to see the market must
-choose it also.
-
-L-------- calls me, herself, at some unearthly hour, not much after
-four, and I get up and dress in the warm darkness. It is the hot season
-at present and the air, night and day, is very like a hot bath, and not
-far behind it in temperature. I have been loafing about the town during
-the previous day in rather thin shoes, and my feet have been almost
-blistered by the heat of the ground striking up through light soles,
-so that I cannot walk very far, and am glad to find the market close at
-hand.
-
-L--------, in a fresh muslin nightdress (she has something like fifty or
-sixty of them), acts as guide. She has put a new coronet of flowers in
-her hair, and before we reach the market she proceeds to dress me up
-Tahiti fashion, with, long necklaces of sweet white blossoms round my
-neck, falling all over my dress, and a heavy crown of closely woven
-gardenias on my head, instead of my hat, which she removes, and politely
-carries. She wants to pull my hair down as well, but in a temperature of
-eighty degrees the idea does not sound tempting, so I decline to follow
-Tahitian custom further. Besides, there is really no knowing where she
-would stop!
-
-There is not yet a glimmer of daylight when we enter the market-place,
-and flaring lamps and torches cast huge flickering shadows all over the
-gay assembly. Fruit and fish for the most part are the wares--but such
-fish, and such fruit! Where one would look at home for white and grey
-turbot, pallid plaice, zinc-coloured herrings, here one may see the
-most gorgeous shapes of gold and scarlet and green; of iridescent rose,
-silver, orange; of blue, brilliant as a heap of tumbled sapphire, and
-pearl as bright as the lining of a shell. Tahiti is famous for
-its beautiful fish, and indeed these in the market look almost too
-poetically lovely to eat.
-
-Then the fruit! bananas as big as cucumbers, as small as ladies’ fingers
-(after which, indeed, this little sugar-sweet, variety is named), dark
-red bananas, flavoured like a peach, large bloomy ones, tasting and
-looking like custard within; smooth yellow ones, like those exported
-to other countries, whither the daintier fruits will not safely
-go--pineapple in rough-skinned heaps (one learns soon in Tahiti how to
-eat a pineapple, and that is to peel it, cut it into largest possible
-lumps, eat the latter undiminished even if they make you speechless,
-and never, never, shoe the fruit)--oranges of several different kinds,
-custard-apples, rose-apples, paw-paws, melons, avocado pears, guavas,
-mangoes, and other fruits the name of which I have never heard--all
-lying together in masses under the lamplight, costing not as many
-halfpence to buy as at home they would cost shillings.
-
-The native beauties are here in a merry crowd, intent quite as much upon
-enjoyment as on business. Scarcely one but wears a flower behind her
-ear--and if you have ever been in the South Seas, you will know what
-that pretty little signal means, but if you have not, why then I shall
-not tell you--and all are so wreathed, and crowned, and necklaced with
-woven blossoms, that the air is heavy with scent, and the market-place
-looks as though the transformation scene of a pantomine were just about
-to begin, with a full chorus of flower-decked nymphs appearing for the
-dance.
-
-One exceedingly pretty girl, with a perfect cataract of black hair
-overflowing her pale green gown, and a pair of sparkling dark eyes that
-could never be matched outside the magic lines of Cancer and Capricorn,
-is making and frying pancakes with something fruity, nature unknown,
-inside them. She has half a dozen French officers about her, enjoying
-breakfast and flirtation at the same time. Another, who is selling
-a number of the oddest little parcels imaginable, made out of cut-up
-joints of bamboo, carefully sealed, is doing a good trade among the
-coloured and semi-coloured ladies. L-------- says she is selling
-readymade sauces, to be eaten with fish or meat, and adds that she
-herself will show me what Tahitian sauces are like later on, because
-there is no one in the whole group fit to act as scullion to her in that
-important matter--or words to the same effect.
-
-Strange-looking mountain men are here, dressed in shirt and kilt of
-cotton cloth, patterned in flowers and leaves as big as soup-plates. The
-former garment is a concession to Papeete--outside the town, the “pareo”
- or kilt alone forms the Tahitian full-dress suit. These men have come
-in to sell the “fei,” or wild banana, which is only found on the highest
-and most perilous of the mountain precipices. To get it, the Tahitian
-must climb where not even a goat would venture to go, and make his way
-back, having secured the fruit, carrying a bunch that is a heavy load,
-even on level ground. Many are the lives that have been lost gathering
-the “fei,” but the Tahitian, like all islanders, is something of a
-fatalist, and the death of one fruit gatherer never stops another from
-going a-hunting in the very same place next day.
-
-There is something about the same “fei” that is worth noting. It is
-one of the standing dishes of the islands--a cooking banana, large, and
-well-flavoured when baked, but not so attractive on the whole as many
-of the other kinds. The Tahitian, however, ascribes to this variety a
-certain magic property, not unlike that of the fabled lotus. If you eat
-of the “fei,” he says, especially if you eat freely of it, you will fall
-under the spell. For ever, in its working, it binds you to Tahiti. You
-may go away, and without any intention of returning, say goodbye to the
-islands, and place many thousand miles of land and sea between yourself
-and sweet Tahiti, saying to yourself that you and Papeëte have no more
-to do with one another for ever.... Yet by-and-by--some day, one
-knows not when; it may be soon, or it may be late, but it will surely
-come--you will return to Tahiti. The spell of the fei will work, and
-draw you back again.
-
-So the natives said, and I thought the fancy a pretty one, and wondered
-whether it had really any connection with the lotus myth, and then
-forgot all about it.
-
-That is three years ago, and since those days I have travelled the whole
-world over, leaving Tahiti behind as one leaves a station passed long
-ago on a railway journey, upon a line that one never expects to traverse
-again. As I write, the snows of winter Britain lie thick outside my
-window, and a sea of Arctic coldness breaks in freezing green and grey
-upon a desolate shore. Nothing on earth seems farther away than-the
-warm blue waves, and flowers that never fade, and shining coral sands of
-Tahiti. But... there is a steamer running southward before long, and a
-great sunny city on the other side of the world where the island boats
-lie waiting at the quays. And one of those island boats, in a month or
-two, will carry a passenger back to Tahiti--a passenger who ate of the
-fei three years ago, and went away for ever, but on whom the spell of
-the magic fruit has worked--after all.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER II
-
-_The History of Tahiti--Drink and the Native--In the Old Wild Days--The
-Simple and the Civilised Life--What an Island Town is like--The Lotos
-Eaters--Cocoanuts and Courtesy--A Feast of Fat Things--The Orgy on the
-Verandah--Schooners and Pearls--The Land of Tir-n’an-Oge._
-
-ALTHOUGH I certainly did not use the few days of my stay in Tahiti
-to the best advantage--although I saw none of the public buildings of
-Papeëte, never set eyes on any of the officials of the place, and did
-not collect any statistics worth mentioning, I gathered a few crude
-facts of a useful kind, which are herewith offered as a sop to the
-reader, who must be informed and improved, or know the reason why. (If
-he would only go to Tahiti, that dear reader, whom, all travellers know
-so well and fear so much! if he would just spend a week lying on the
-coral beach, and strolling in the moonlight, and listening to native
-songs, and feeding fat on native dainties--he would never want to be
-informed of anything any more, and as to being improved... O Tahiti,
-loveliest and least conventional of the siren countries of the dear
-South Seas, can you lay your hand on your heart, and honestly declare
-you are improving?)
-
-Tahiti was discovered, not by Captain Cook, as is rather commonly
-supposed, but by Captain Wallis of H.M.S. _Dolphin_, in 1767. Captain
-Wallis formally took possession of the group in the name of His Majesty
-King George III., and Captain Cook, in the course of his different
-visits to the islands, laid the foundations of all the civilisation
-they afterwards acquired. Nevertheless, the islands are French property
-to-day. There is nothing in the Pacific better worth owning than the
-Society group, more fertile, more beautiful, more healthy, richer in
-valuable tropical products--and the construction of the Panama Canal,
-an event which has been foreseen for several generations, will obviously
-add much to the importance of the islands. Because of these, and other
-excellent reasons, Great Britain, acting on the principles by which her
-colonial policy is commonly guided, allowed the Society Islands to
-slip gradually into the hands of a power better able than herself to
-appreciate their value, and the group, after thirty-seven years of
-“protection,” was finally taken possession of by France, in the year
-1880. The native Queen, Pômare IV. (Pomare being a dynastic name like
-Cæsar, but, unlike the latter, applied to both sexes), was allowed to
-retain her state and possessions under the French protectorate. Her
-successor, King Pomare V., who succeeded in 1877 and died in 1891, only
-reigned for three years. After the formal annexation he retained his
-title of king, and much of his state, but the power was entirely in
-French hands. Prince Hinoe, his heir, who would in the ordinary course
-have occupied the throne, lives in a handsome European-built house near
-Papeete, and enjoys a good pension, but is otherwise not distinguished
-in any way from the ordinary Tahitian.
-
-Under French rule, the islands have done fairly well. There were at
-first many regrettable disputes and troubles between opposing camps of
-missionaries, but these have long since been made up. Commerce is
-in rather a languishing state. The group exports copra, vanilla,
-pearl-shell, and fruit, but the trade with America was so much on the
-down-grade during the time of my visit, that steamers were leaving the
-port with empty holds. The natives are well treated under the present
-system; the liquor laws, however, are defective, and no Tahitian,
-apparently, has any difficulty in obtaining as much strong spirits as
-he wants and can pay for. The disastrous effects of such carelessness
-as this need no mention to the reader who knows anything of darkskinned
-races. For the benefit of the reader who does not, however, it may
-be remarked that all colonial administrators agree concerning the bad
-effects of intoxicants on coloured races of every kind. It matters not
-at what end or part of the scale of colour the man may be--whether he
-is a woolly-haired, baboon-jawed nigger from Central Africa, a grave,
-intelligent, educated Maori of New Zealand, or a gentle child-like
-native of Tahiti, barely café-au-lait as to colour--all the same, and
-all the time, spirits are sure to convert him, temporarily, into
-a raging beast, and, in the long run, to wipe out him and his kind
-altogether. It is not a question of temperance principles or the
-reverse, but merely a matter of common-sense policy, in dealing with
-races which have shown themselves unable to withstand the effects of
-the liquors that our hardier northern nations can use with comparative
-safety. One may lay it down as a general principle that nothing with a
-coloured skin on it can take, intoxicants in moderation--it is not at
-all, or all in all, with the “native” when it comes to strong drinks.
-Scientific folk would probably set down the comparative immunity of
-the white races to the protection that lies behind them in the shape
-of centuries of drinking ancestors. The coffee-coloured islander’s
-great-grandparents did not know whisky, just as they never experienced
-measles and other diseases, that do not usually kill the white, but
-almost always put an end to the “man and brother.” Therefore, the
-islander’s body has not, by inheritance, acquired those points of
-constitution which enable the white to resist whisky and measles, and
-other dangerous things; and when they touch him, he goes down at once. A
-parallel may be found in the case of opium, which the white man, broadly
-speaking, cannot take in moderation, although most of the yellow races
-can. Europeans who once acquire a liking for the effects of opium will
-generally die as miserable wrecks, in the course of a very few years.
-A Chinaman, under similar circumstances, may, and often does, live to
-a good old age, without taking any harm at all from his constant doses.
-His ancestors have been opium takers, the Englishman’s have not. It is
-the case of the islander and the spirits over again.
-
-After which digression, one has some way to come back to the fact that
-the French Government does not prevent the Tahitian from drinking
-gin nearly so effectively as it should, and that, in consequence, the
-diminution of the native population receives a downward push that it
-does not in the least require. In the Fijis, British rule keeps spirits
-strictly away from all the natives, with the exception of the chiefs,
-and something, at least, is thereby done to slacken the decline that
-afflicts the people of almost every island in the Pacific. The Fijian
-chiefs, as a rule, drink heavily, and do not commonly live long, thus
-providing another argument in favour of restriction.
-
-The population of Tahiti is indeed much less than it should be. Captain
-Cook’s estimates of native populations are now understood to have been
-mistaken in many cases, owing to the fact that he calculated the entire
-numbers from the density of occupation round the shores. As most Pacific
-islands are inhabited about the coasts alone, the interior being often
-unsuitable for cultivation, and too far removed from the fishing-grounds
-to suit an indolent race, it can easily be understood that serious
-errors would arise from such a method of estimate. The diminution,
-therefore, since ancient times, is not quite so alarming as the first
-writers on the Pacific--and, indeed, many who followed them--supposed
-it to be. If the sums worked out by the travellers who visited Honolulu
-in the sixties, or Tahiti a little later, had been correct, both of
-these important groups would long since have been empty of all native
-population. But the Hawaiian group has still a very fair number of
-darkskinned people, while Tahiti, including all its islands, had a
-population, according to the census of 1902, of over thirteen thousand,
-one-eighth of whom are said to be French, and a smaller number Chinese
-and other foreigners.
-
-Still, it cannot be said that this is a large, or even a fair population
-for a group of islands covering 580 square miles, nor can it be denied
-that the numbers of the Tahitians are steadily on the decrease.
-The exact causes of the decline are disputed, as indeed they are in
-connection with every other coloured race in the Pacific. European
-diseases of a serious kind are extremely common in the group, and
-consumption also is frequent. These are two obvious causes. Less easily
-reckoned are the unnamed tendencies towards extinction that follow the
-track of the white man through the lands of primitive peoples, all
-over the world. There can be no doubt that the old life of the
-Pacific--feasting, fighting, making love, and making murder: dressing in
-a bunch of leaves, and living almost as completely without thought for
-the morrow as the twittering parrakeets in the mango trees--suited the
-constitution of the islander better than the life of to-day.
-
-It may have been bad for his spiritual development, and it certainly
-was bad for any wandering white men who came, by necessity or choice, to
-visit his far-away fastnesses. But he lived and flourished in those bad
-days, whereas now he quietly and unostentatiously, and quite without any
-rancour or regret, dies.
-
-Why? Old island residents will tell you that, even if every disease
-brought by the white man were rooted out to-morrow, the native would
-still diminish in numbers. He has done so in islands where the effects
-of European diseases were comparatively slight. He does so in New
-Zealand, where the Maori (the supposed ancestor of most of the island
-peoples) is petted, cherished, and doctored to an amazing extent by the
-ruling race, and yet persists in dying out, although he is not
-affected by consumption or other evils to any serious extent. There are
-undoubtedly other causes, and perhaps among them not the least is
-the fact that, for most Pacific races, life, with the coming of
-civilisation, has greatly lost its savour.
-
-It used to be amazingly lively in Tahiti, in the wild old days. Then,
-the Tahitian did not know of white men’s luxuries--of tea and sugar and
-tinned stuffs, lamps and kerosene, hideous calico shirts and gaudy
-ties, muslin gowns and frilled petticoats for the women, “bits” to make
-patchwork quilts with, and beds to put the quilts on, and matchwood
-bungalows to put the beds in, and quart bottles of fiery gin to drink,
-and coloured silk handkerchiefs to put away on a shelf, and creaking
-shoes to lame oneself with on Sundays. Then, he did not let or sell his
-land to some one in order to get cash to buy these desirable things;
-nor did his womankind, for the same reason, adopt, almost as a national
-profession, a mode of life to which the conventionalities forbid me to
-give a name. Nor did the distractions of unlimited church-going turn
-away his mind from the main business of life, which was undoubtedly that
-of enjoyment. He had no money, and no goods, and did not want either. He
-had no religion (to speak of) and desired that still less. All he had
-to do was to secure a good time, and get up a fight now and then when
-things in general began to turn slow.
-
-It must be said that the existence of the “Areoi,” a certain secret
-society of old Tahiti, went far to minimise the risk of dullness.
-The members formed a species of heathen “Hell-Fire Club,” and
-they cultivated every crime known to civilisation, and a few which
-civilisation has happily forgotten. Murder, theft, human sacrifices,
-cannibalism, were among their usual practices, and the domestic
-relationships of the Society (which was large and influential, and
-included both sexes) are said to have been open to some criticism. They
-were popular, however, for they studied music and the dance as fine
-arts, and gave free entertainments to every one who cared to come. They
-travelled from village to village, island to island, giving “shows”
- wherever they went, and winning welcome and favour everywhere by the
-brilliance and originality of their improprieties. They were as wicked
-as they knew how, and as amusing, and as devilish, and as dazzling....
-How the young Tahitian lad, not yet tattooed, and considered of no
-importance, must have reverenced and envied them! how he must have
-imitated their pranks in the seclusion of the cocoanut groves, and
-hummed over their songs, and longed for the time when he himself should
-be big enough to run away from home, and go off with the delightful,
-demoniacal, fascinating Areois!
-
-Then there was always a native king in Tahiti in those days, and a
-number of big native chiefs, each one of whom had his own little court,
-with all the exciting surroundings of a court which are never missing in
-any part of the world, from Saxe-Niemandhausen to Patagonia. And there
-were tribal fights from time to time, when property changed hands, and
-war-spears were reddened, and a man might hunt his enemy in the dusk,
-stealthy, soft-footed, with heart jumping in his breast, along the
-shadowy borders of the lagoon.... Murder and mischief and fighting and
-greed, pomp of savage courts and stir of savage ambitions, and the other
-world that nobody knew or cared about, shut off by a barrier of seas
-unexplored.... It was a life in which a man undoubtedly did live, a life
-that kept him quick until he was dead. Does the decline of Pacific races
-look less unaccountable now?
-
-In these days, the Tahitian is undoubtedly improved. He never was a
-very “bad lot” all round, in spite of the Areois; but Civilisation,
-of course, had to take him in hand once it was known he was there, for
-Civilisation will not have loose ends or undusted corners in her
-house, if she can help it. So the people of Tahiti were discovered, and
-converted, and clothed, and taught, and they gave up being Areois, and
-worshipping heathen gods, and going about without shirts and skirts,
-and they went frequently to church, and supported their white pastors
-generously, and began to trade with the Europeans, so that the latter
-made much money.
-
-They are quite happy and uncomplaining, and manage to have a reasonably
-good time in a quiet way, but they _will_ die out, and nobody can
-prevent them. You see, they are rather bored, and when you are bored,
-the answer to the question, “Is life worth living?” is, at the least,
-debatable--to a Pacific Islander.
-
-I have written of this at some length, because, _mutatis mutandis_, it
-applies to nearly all the island races.
-
-It is not only the Tahitian who looks back with wistful eyes to the
-faded sunset of the bad old times, with all their savage gaudiness of
-scarlet blood and golden licence, and languishes in the chill pale dawn
-of the white man’s civilisation. It is the whole Pacific world, more or
-less. The Simple Life in the raw original is not, by many a long league,
-as simple and innocent as it is supposed to be, by those new and noisy
-apostles of a return to Nature, who have never got nearer to the things
-of the beginning than a week-end up the Thames--but, unsimple and
-uninnocent as it is, it suits the coloured man better than anything
-else. Would one, therefore, wish to put back the clock of time,
-re-establish heathenism and cannibalism over all the Pacific, and see
-Honolulu, Fiji, Samoa, with their towns and Government Houses, and
-shops and roads and plantations, leap back to the condition of the still
-uncivilised western islands, where no man’s life is safe, and the law of
-might is the only law that is known? Hardly. There is no answer to the
-problem, and no moral to be drawn from it either. But then, you do not
-draw morals in the South Seas--they are not plentiful enough.
-
-The Society Islands--which were so named in compliment to the Royal
-Society--lie between 16° and 18° south latitude, and 148° and 158° west
-longitude. Tahiti itself is much the largest, the driveway round
-this island being about ninety miles long. Huaheine, Raiatea, Murea,
-Bora-Bora, and the small islands Taha’a and Maitea, are much less
-important. The only town of the group is Papeëte.
-
-So much, for the serious-minded reader, already mentioned, who knows
-most things beforehand, and likes his information cut-and-dried. The
-commoner and more ignorant reader, I will assume, knows no more
-about Tahiti than I did before I went, and therefore will be glad of
-amplification.
-
-Sixteen degrees only from the equator is hot--very hot at times--and
-does not allow of a really cool season, though the months between April
-and October are slightly less warm than the others, and at night one may
-sometimes need a blanket. Everything near the equator is a long way from
-England, and everything on the south side of the line is a very long
-way, and anything in the Pacific is so far off that it might almost as
-well be in another star. Tahiti, therefore, is quite, as the Irish say,
-“at the back of God-speed.”
-
-Perhaps that is where much of its charm lies. There is a fascination in
-remoteness, hard to define, but not on that account less powerful. “So
-far away!” is a word-spell that has charmed many a sail across the seas,
-from the days of the seekers after the Golden Fleece till now.
-
-Papeëte was the first of the island towns that I saw, and it is so
-typical an example of all, that one description may serve for many.
-
-Imagine, then, a long, one-sided street, always known in every group as
-“the beach.” The reason is apparent--it really is a beach with
-houses attached, rather than a street with a shore close at hand. The
-stores--roomy, low, wood-built houses, largely composed of verandah--are
-strung loosely down the length of the street. Flamboyant trees, as large
-as English beeches, roof in the greater part of the long roadway with
-a cool canopy of green, spangled by bunches of magnificent scarlet
-flowers. Almost every house stands in a tangle of brilliant tropical
-foliage, and the side streets that run off landwards here and there, are
-more like Botanic Gardens with a few ornamental cottages let loose among
-them, than prosaic pieces of a town--so richly does the flood of riotous
-greenery foam up over low fence tops, and brim into unguarded drains and
-hollows, so gorgeously do the red and white and golden flowers wreathe
-tall verandah posts, and carpet ugly tin roofs with a kindly tapestry of
-leaf, and bloom. Foot to foot and hand to hand with Nature stands man,
-in these islands, let him but relax for a moment, and--there!--she has
-him over the line!... Leave Papeëte alone for a couple of years, and you
-would need an axe to find it, when you came back.
-
-There are a number of hotels in Papeëte--mostly of an indifferent sort,
-and none too cheap--and there are several large cafés and restaurants,
-run on lines entirely Parisian, and a crowd of smaller ones, many owned,
-by Chinese, where the hard-up white may feed at a very small cost,
-pleasantly enough, if he does not ask too many questions about the
-origin and preparation of his food. There are three local newspapers,
-and a military band plays in the afternoons, and there are clubs of all
-kinds’ and not a little society, which--being society--is in its essence
-bound to be uninteresting and flat, even here in the many-coloured South
-Seas. But under all this, the native life flows on in its own way, and
-the Tahitian takes his pleasure after his immemorial fashion, as quietly
-and as lazily as he is allowed. I have spoken hitherto of only one side
-of the main street. The other, which gives directly on the sea, belongs
-to the Tahitian life of Tahiti. Here, a green slope of soft grass
-stretches down to the greener waters of the sparkling lagoon: delicate
-palms lean over the still sea-mirror, like beauties smiling into a
-glass; flamboyant and frangipani trees drop crimson and creamy blooms
-upon the grass; and, among the flowers, facing the sea and the ships and
-the dreamy green lagoon, lie the natives, old and young. They wear the
-lightest of cotton clothing, scarlet and rose and butter-cup yellow, and
-white scented flowers are twisted in their hair. Fruits of many colours,
-and roots and fish, lie beside them. They eat a good part of the day,
-and their dogs, sleeping blissfully in the shade at their feet, wake up
-and eat with them now and then. There is plenty for both--no one ever
-goes short of food in Tahiti, where the pinch of cold and hunger, and
-the burden of hard, unremitting, unholidayed work are alike unknown.
-Sometimes the natives wander away to the river that flows through the
-town, and take a bath in its cool waters; returning later to lounge, and
-laze, and suck fruit, and dream, on the shores of the lagoon again. The
-sound of the surf, droning all day long on the coral reef that bars the
-inner lake of unruffled green from the outer ocean of windy blue, seems
-to charm them into a soft half-sleep, through which, with open but
-unseeing eyes, they watch the far-off creaming of the breakers in the
-sun, and the flutter of huge velvet butterflies among the flowers,
-and the brown canoes gliding like water-beetles about the tall-masted
-schooners in the harbour. With sunset comes a cooling of the heated air,
-and glowworm lights begin to twinkle through the translucent red walls
-of the little native houses scattered here and there. It will soon be
-dark now: after dark, there will be dancing and singing in the house;
-later, the sleeping mats will be laid out, and with the moon and the
-stars glimmering in through the walls upon their still brown faces, the
-Tahitians will sleep.... So, in the sunset, with
-
- Dark faces, pale against the rosy flame,
-
- The mild-eyed melancholy lotus-eaters
-
-wander home.
-
-Only a flash in the long cinematograph of the wonderful track that
-circles the globe, is Tahiti. I cannot tell of Murea, the marvellous
-island that lies opposite Papeete, seven and a half miles away, because,
-during the few days I spent in Tahiti, no boat was going there, and none
-could be induced to go. So I had to look at Murea’s splintered towers
-and spiring pinnacles, and wonderful purple goblin palaces, floating
-high among the clouds, from the tantalising distance of Papeëte harbour.
-Nor could I join some steamer friends in driving round the ninety-mile
-roadway, as we had intended--stopping in native towns, and seeing
-something of the inner life of the island--because no one in the capital
-had any teams for hire just then, and nobody knew when there would be
-any. Some of us went up the river to see Pierre Loti’s bathing pool,
-and came back rather disappointed, and others drove out to the tomb
-of Pômare V., three miles from the town. It was a pile of concrete and
-stone, modelled after European fashions, and not especially interesting.
-
-One of the ladies of the party wandered off with me down the beach,
-neither of us being interested in the resting-place of the defunct
-Pomare--and here we found plenty of food for mind and body both. For was
-not this a pandanus, or screw-pine, which we had read about, overhanging
-the lagoon, with the quaintest mops of palmy foliage, set on long
-broom-handles of boughs, and great fruits like pineapples hanging among
-the leaves, and yellow and scarlet kernels lying thick on the sand
-below--the tree itself perched up on tall bare wooden stilts formed
-by the roots, and looking more like something from a comic scene in a
-pantomime, than a real live piece of vegetation growing on an actual
-shore? And were not these cocoanuts that lay all about the beach under
-the leaning palms--nuts such as we had never seen before, big as a
-horse’s head, and smooth green as to outside, but nuts all the same?
-
-[Illustration: 0055]
-
-
-[Illustration: 0056]
-
-A native slipped silently from among the thick trees beside us--a
-bronze-skinned youth of eighteen or nineteen, dressed only in a light
-pareo or kilt of blue and white cotton. He stood with hands lightly
-crossed on his breast, looking at us with the expression of infinite
-kindliness and good-nature that is so characteristic of the Tahitian
-race. We signed to him that we wanted to drink, and he smiled
-comprehendingly, shook his head at the nuts on the ground, and lightly
-sprang on to the bole of the palm beside us, which slanted a little
-towards the sea. Up the trunk of that tree, which inclined so slightly
-that one would not have thought a squirrel could have kept its footing
-there, walked our native friend, holding on with his feet and hands, and
-going as easily as a sailor on a Jacob’s ladder. Arrived in the crown
-some seventy feet above, he threw down two or three nuts, and then
-descended and husked them for us.
-
-[Illustration: 0062]
-
-Husking a cocoanut is one of the simplest-looking operations in
-the world, but I have not yet seen the white man who could do it
-effectively, though every native is apparently born with the trick. A
-stick is sharply pointed at both ends, and one end is firmly set in the
-ground. The nut is now taken in the hands, and struck with a hitting and
-tearing movement combined, on the point of the stick, so as to split the
-thick, intensely tough covering of dense coir fibre that protects the
-nut, and rip the latter out. It comes forth white as ivory, about the
-same shape and size as the brown old nuts that come by ship to England,
-but much younger and more brittle, for only the smallest of the
-old nuts, which are not wanted in the islands for copra-making, are
-generally exported. A large knife is used to crack the top of the nut
-all round, like an egg-shell, and the drink is ready, a draught of pure
-water, slightly sweet and just a little aerated, if the nut has been
-plucked at the right stage. There is no pleasanter or more refreshing
-draught in the world, and it has not the least likeness to the “milk”
- contained in the cocoanuts of commerce. No native would drink old nuts
-such as the latter, for fear of illness, as they are considered both
-unpleasant and unwholesome. Only half-grown nuts are used for drinking,
-and even these will sometimes hold a couple of pints of liquid. The
-water of the young cocoanut is food and drink in one, having much
-nourishing matter held in solution. On many a long day of hot and
-weary travel, during the years that followed, I had cause to bless the
-refreshing and restoring powers of heaven’s best gift to man in the
-tropics, the never-failing cocoanut.
-
-[Illustration: 0097]
-
-I will not insult the reader by telling him all the uses to which the
-tree and its various products are put, because those are among the
-things we have all learned at our first preparatory school; how the
-natives in the cocoanut countries make hats and mats and houses, and
-silver fish-servers and brocaded dressing-gowns, and glacé kid boots
-with fourteen buttons (I think the list used to run somewhat after that
-fashion--it is the spirit if not the letter)--all out of the simple
-cocoanut tree; a piece of knowledge which, somehow or other, used to
-make us feel vaguely virtuous and deserving, as if we had done it all
-ourselves....
-
-But all this time the youth is standing like a smiling bronze statue,
-holding the great ivory cup in his hands, and waiting for us to drink.
-We do so in turn, Ganymede carefully supporting the cup in his upcurved
-hands, and tilting it with a fine regard for our needs, as the water
-drops down in the nut like the tide on a sandy shore when the moon calls
-back the sea.
-
-[Illustration: 0103]
-
-Then we take out purses, and want to pay Ganymede; but he will not be
-paid, until it becomes plain to him that the greatest politeness lies in
-yielding. He takes our franc, and disappears among the trees, to return
-no more. But in a minute, out from the bush comes running the oddest
-little figure, a very old, grey-bearded man, very gaily dressed in
-a green shirt and a lilac pareo, and laden very heavily with ripe
-pineapples. We guess him to be Ganymede’s father, and see that our guess
-was right, when he drops the whole heap of fruit upon the ground at our
-feet, smiling and bowing and murmuring incomprehensively over it, and
-then begins to vanish like his son.
-
-“Here--stop!” calls my companion. “We don’t want to take your fruit
-without buying it. Come back, please, come back!”
-
-The little old-gentleman trots back on his thin bare legs, recalled more
-by the tone than the words, which he obviously does not understand, and
-takes a hand of each of us in his own brown fingers. He shakes hands
-with us gently and firmly, shaking his head negatively at the same time,
-and then, like the romantic youths of Early Victorian novels, “turns,
-and is immediately lost to view in the surrounding forest,” carrying the
-honours of war, indubitably, with himself.
-
-“Well, they are real generous!” declares my American companion, as we go
-back to the tomb. “By the way, Miss G--------, I guess you’d better not
-sit down on that grass to wait for the rest. I wouldn’t, if I was you.”
-
-“Why not? it’s as dry as dust.”
-
-“Because the natives say it’s somehow or other--they didn’t, explain
-how--infected with leprosy, and I guess they ought to know; there’s
-plenty of it all over the Pacific---- I rather thought that would hit
-you where you lived.”
-
-It did. I got up as quickly as a grasshopper in a hurry. Afterwards, on
-a leper island thousands of miles away from Tahiti---- But that belongs
-to another place.
-
-L--------, the ever-amiable, our half-caste landlady at the little
-bungalow hotel, all overgrown with bougainvillea and stephanotis, was
-grieved because we had seen nothing in the way of “sights,” and declared
-her intention of giving a native dinner for us.
-
-[Illustration: 0070]
-
-It was not very native, but it was very amusing. It took place in the
-verandah of the hotel, under a galaxy of Chinese lanterns, with an
-admiring audience of natives crowding the whole roadway outside, and
-climbing up the trees to look at us. This was principally because the
-word had gone forth in Papeëte (which owns the finest gossip-market in
-the South Seas) that the English and American visitors were going to
-appear in native dress, and nobody knew quite how far they meant to
-go--there being two or three sorts of costume which pass under that
-classification.
-
-The variety which we selected, however, was not very sensational. The
-ladies borrowed from L--------‘s inexhaustible store, draped themselves
-in one or other of her flowing nightdress robes, let loose their hair,
-and crowned themselves with twisted Tahitian corqnets of gardenia and
-tuberose. A scarlet flower behind each ear completed the dress, and drew
-forth delighted squeaks from the handmaidens of the hotel, and digs in
-the ribs from L--------, who was nearly out of her mind with excitement
-and enjoyment. Shoes were retained, contrary to L--------‘s entreaties,
-but corsets she would not permit, nor would she allow a hairpin or
-hair-ribbon among the party. The men guests wore white drill suits
-with a native pareo, scarlet or yellow, tied round the waist. It was
-a gay-looking party, on the whole, and the populace of Tahiti seemed to
-enjoy the sight.
-
-[Illustration: 0080]
-
-The dinner was served at a table, but most of the dishes were on green
-leaves instead of plates, and L-------- begged us, almost with tears in
-her eyes, to eat the native dainties with our fingers, as they tasted
-better that way. Little gold-fish, baked and served with cocoanut sauce,
-were among the items on the menu: sucking-pig, cooked in a hole in the
-ground, fat little river crayfish, breadfruit baked and served hot, with
-(I regret to say) European butter, native puddings made of banana and
-breadfruit, and the famous raw fish. Some of the guests would not touch
-the latter, but the rest of us thought it no worse than raw oysters, and
-sampled it, with much enjoyment. I give the receipt, for the benefit of
-any one who may care to try it. Take any good white fish, cut it up into
-pieces about two inches long, and place the latter, raw, in lime-juice
-squeezed from fresh limes, or lemon-juice, if limes are not to be had.
-Let the fish steep for half a day, and serve it cold, with cocoanut
-sauce, the receipt for which is as follows:--Grate down the meat of a
-large cocoanut, and pour a small cup of sea-water over it. Leave it for
-three or four hours, and then strain several times through muslin (the
-fine brown fibre off young cocoanut shoots is a correct material, but
-the reader may not have a cocoanut in his back garden). The water should
-at last come out as thick and opaque as cream.
-
-This is the true “milk of the cocoanut” about which one so often hears.
-It is of immemorial antiquity in the South Seas.
-
-Captain Cook mentions it in his _Voyages_, and describes the cocoanut
-shells full of it, that were given to every man at a feast, in which to
-dip his food. When used as a sauce for meat or fish, one or two fresh
-red peppers from the nearest pepper bush are cut up and put in. Chili
-pepper, judiciously used, is a fair substitute for the latter. The sauce
-is also used for many native puddings and sweet dishes, in which case it
-is made with fresh water and the pepper is left out. As a fish sauce it
-is unsurpassed, and may be recommended to gourmands as a new sensation.
-It should be served in bowls of brown cocoanut shell.
-
-[Illustration: 0091]
-
-Breadfruit some of us tasted for the first time at this dinner. It was
-universally liked, though a few maintained that it resembled potato more
-than bread. I found it very like the latter, with a suggestion of floury
-cracknel biscuit. It is most satisfying and nourishing. One never,
-in island travels, feels the want of fresh bread when breadfruit is
-available. L-------- had cooked it native fashion, peeled and baked
-on hot stones in a pit in the ground. It is a good-sized fruit in its
-natural state, about as large as a medium hothouse melon, and bright
-green in colour. The skin is divided into lizard-like lozenges, and the
-surface is very rough. Whether it is indigenous to the islands or not,
-I cannot say, but it was there when Cook came, and it grows wild very
-freely, providing an immense store of natural food.
-
-Taro we also had, baked native style. It is a plant in use over almost
-all the Pacific, very easily cultivated and rapidly producing immense
-bluish-coloured roots, which look like mottled soap when cooked and
-served. It is extremely dense and heavy, but pleasant to most tastes.
-The white taro is a less common kind, somewhat lighter.
-
-The mangoes that were served with the meal (among many other fruits)
-were of a variety that is generally supposed to be the finest in the
-world. No mango is so large, so sweet, or so fine in grain, as the mango
-of Tahiti, and none has less of the turpentine flavour that is so much
-disliked by newcomers to tropical countries. It is a commonplace of the
-islands that a mango can only be eaten with comfort in a bath, and many
-of the guests that evening would not have been sorry for a chance to
-put the precept into practice, after struggling with one or two mangoes,
-which were, of course, too solid to be sucked, and much too juicy
-and sticky not to smear the hands and the face of the consumers
-disastrously.
-
-L-------- gave us many French dishes with our native dinner, to suit all
-tastes, and gratify her own love of fine cookery, but these would be
-of little interest to recount. I cannot forget, however, how this
-true artiste of the kitchen described the menu she had planned, on the
-morning of the entertainment. She sat down beside me on a sofa to tell
-the wondrous tale, and, as she recited dish after dish, her voice rose
-higher and higher, and her great black eyes burned, and she seized me
-by the arm and almost hugged me in her excitement. When she came to the
-savouries, tears of genuine emotion rose in her eyes, and at the end
-of the whole long list, her feelings overcame her like a flood, and,
-gasping out--“Beignets d’ananas à la Papeete; glaces. Vénus, en Cythère;
-fromage----” she cast herself bodily into my arms and sobbed with
-delight. She was fully fifteen stone, and the weather was exceedingly
-warm, but I admired her artistic fervour too much to tell her to sit
-up, and stop crying over my clean muslin (as I should have liked to do),
-because it seemed to me that L-------- was really a true artiste in her
-own way, and almost worthy to rank, in the history of the kitchen, with
-Vatel the immortal, who fell upon his sword and died, because the fish
-was late for the royal dinner.
-
-Of the other evening, when half a dozen guests of mixed nationalities
-began, through a temptation of the devil, to talk politics at ten
-o’clock on the verandah--of the fur that, metaphorically speaking,
-commenced to fly when the American cast the Irish question into the
-fray, and the Englishman vilified Erin, and the Irishwoman, following
-the historical precedent, called the Frenchwoman to her aid, and the
-latter in the prettiest manner in the world, got up and closed her
-two small hands round the throat of John Bull, and choked him into
-silence--it would not be necessary to tell, had not the sequel been
-disastrous to the fair name of our steamship party in Papeete. For a big
-banana spider, as big in the body as half a crown, and nearly as hard,
-came suddenly out from the stephanotis boughs, and, like a famous
-ancestor, “sat down beside” a lady of the party. This caused the
-politicians to rush to the aid of the lady, who had of course mounted
-a chair and begun to scream. The spider proved extremely difficult
-to kill, and had to be battered with the legs of chairs for some time
-before he yielded up the ghost--one guest, who found an empty whisky
-bottle, and flattened the creature out with it, carrying off the honours
-of the fray. After which excitement, we all felt ready for bed, and
-went.
-
-“And in the morning, behold” the kindly L-------- smiling upon her
-guests, and remarking: “Dat was a real big drunk you all having on the
-veràndah, after I gone to bed!”
-
-“Good heavens, L--------!” exclaims Mrs. New England, pale with horror,
-“what do you mean?”
-
-“Surely, Mrs. L--------, you do not suppose for an instant any of
-our party were--I can hardly say it!” expostulates a delicate-looking
-minister from the Southern States, here for his lungs, who was very
-prominent last night in arguing Ireland’s right to “secede” if she
-liked.
-
-“That’s a good one, I must say,” remarks John Bull, rather indignantly.
-
-But L-------- only smiles on. She is always smiling.
-
-“Dat don’t go, Mr. ----------” she says pleasantly. “I couldn’t sleep
-last night, for the way you all kicking up, and the girl, she say
-you fighting. Madame ---------- she trying to kill Mr. Bull, all the
-gentlemen smashing the leg of the chairs, the lady scream--and dis
-mornin’, I findin’ a large whisky bottle, all drunk up.”
-
-I am privately choking with laughter in a corner, but I cannot help
-feeling sorry for Mrs. New England, who really looks as if about to
-faint.
-
-“_I_ don’ mind!” declares L-------- delightedly. “Why, I been thinking
-all dis time you haven’t been enjoyin’ yourself at all. I like every
-one here they having a real good time. Every one,” she smiles--and melts
-away into the soft gloom of the drawing-room, where she sits down, and
-begins to play softly thrumming, strangely intoxicating Tahitian dance
-music on the piano.
-
-“_Elle est impayable!_” says the Frenchwoman, shrugging her shoulders.
-“From all I hear of Tahiti, my dear friends, I think you shall find
-yourselves without a chiffon of character to-morrow.... But courage! it
-is a thing here the most superfluous.”
-
-Madame was a true prophet, I have reason to know; for many months after,
-the story of the orgy, held on L--------‘s verandah by the English and
-French and American ladies and gentlemen, reached me in a remote corner
-of the Pacific, as “the latest from Papeete.” What I wanted to know, and
-what I never shall know, for my boat came in next day, and took me away
-to Raratonga--was whether the minister from the South eventually died of
-the shock or not. I do not want to know about the lady from New England,
-because I am quite certain she did--as certain as I am that I should
-have, myself, and did not.
-
-Of the prospects in Tahiti for settlers I cannot say much. It was said,
-while I was in Papeete, that there was practically no money in the
-place, and the traders, like the Scilly Island washerfolk of well-known
-fame, merely existed by trading with each other. This may have been an
-exaggeration, or a temporary state of depression. The vanilla trade,
-owing to a newly invented chemical substitute, was not doing well, but
-judging by what I saw next year in Fiji, the market must have recovered.
-The climate of Tahiti is matchless for vanilla growing, and land is not
-very difficult to get.
-
-Quite a number of small schooners seemed to be engaged in the pearling
-trade with the Paumotus--a group of islands covering over a thousand
-miles of sea, and including some of the richest pearl beds in the
-world--(French property). I never coveted anything more than I coveted
-those dainty little vessels. Built in San Francisco, where people know
-how to build schooners, they were finished like yachts, and their snowy
-spread of cotton-cloth canvas, when they put out to sea, and their
-graceful bird-like lines, would have delighted the soul of Clarke
-Russell. One, a thirty-ton vessel, with the neatest little saloon in
-the world, fitted with shelves for trading; and a captain’s cabin like a
-miniature finer stateroom, and a toy-like galley forward, with a battery
-of shining saucepans, and a spotless stove--snowy paint on hull and
-deckhouses, lightened with fines of turquoise blue--splendid spiring
-masts, varnished till they shone--cool white awning over the poop, and
-sparkling brasses about the compass and the wheel, was so completely a
-craft after my own heart that I longed to run away with her, or take her
-off in my trunk to play with--she seemed quite small enough, though
-her “beat” covered many thousand miles of sea. Poor little _Maid of the
-Islands!_ Her bones are bleaching on a coral reef among the perilous
-pearl atolls, this two years past, and her captain--the cheerful, trim,
-goodnatured X--------, who could squeeze more knots an hour out of his
-little craft than any other master in the port save one, and could tell
-more lies about the Pacific in half an hour, than any one from Chili
-to New Guinea--of his bones are coral made, down where the giant clam
-swings his cruel valves together on wandering fish or streaming weed,
-or limb of luckless diver, and where the dark tentacles of the great
-Polynesian devil-fish
-
- Winnow with giant arms the slumbering green.
-
-The pitcher that goes to the well, and the schooner that goes to
-the pearl islands, are apt to meet with the same fate, in time.
-Nevertheless, tales about the Paumotus are many, and interesting enough
-to attract adventurers from far, if they were known. How the rumour of
-a big pearl gets out; how a schooner sets forth to run down the
-game, pursues it through shifting report after report, from native
-exaggeration to native denial, perhaps for months; how it is found at
-last, and triumphantly secured for a price not a tenth its worth; how
-one shipload of shell, bought on speculation, will have a fortune in
-the first handful, and the next will yield no more than the value of the
-shell itself--this, and much else, make good hearing.
-
-“Look at that pearl,” said a schooner captain to me one day, showing me
-a little globe of light the size of a pea, and as round as a marble. “I
-hunted that for a year, off and on. The native that had it lived way
-off from anywhere, but he knew a thing or two, and he wouldn’t part. I
-offered him goods, I offered him gin, I offered him twenty pounds cash,
-but it was all no go. How d’you think I got it at last? Well, I’ll tell
-you. I went up to his island with the twenty pounds in a sack, all in
-small silver, and when I came into his house, I poured it all out in a
-heap on the mats. ‘Ai, ai, ai!’ he says, and drops down on his knees in
-front of it--it looked like a fortune to him. ‘Will you sell now?’ says
-I, and by Jove, he did, and I carried it off with me. Worth? Can’t say
-yet, but it’ll run well into three figures.”
-
-The pearling in the French islands is strictly preserved, and the terms
-on which it is obtainable are not known to me. Poaching is a crime not
-by any means unheard of.
-
-A glance at the map, and the extent of the Paumotu group, will explain
-better than words why the policing of the pearl bed must necessarily be
-incomplete.
-
-The steamer came in in due course, and carried me away to the Cook
-Islands. Huaheine and Raiatea, in the Society group, were called at
-on the way, but Bora-Bora was left out, as it is not a regular port of
-call. I am glad I did not land on Bora-Bora, and I never shall, if I
-can help it. No place in the world could be so like a fairy dream as
-Bora-Bora looked in the distance. It was literally a castle in the air;
-battlements and turrets, built of vaporous blue clouds, springing steep
-and impregnable from the diamond-dusted sea to the violet vault of
-heaven. Fairy princesses lived there, one could not but know; dragons
-lurked in the dark caves low down on the shore, and “magic casements,
-opening on the foam of perilous seas,” looked down from those far blue
-pinnacles.
-
-Perhaps there is a village on Bora-Bora, with a dozen traders, and
-an ugly concrete house or two, tin-roofed, defacing the beauty of the
-palm-woven native homes, and a whitewashed church with European windows,
-and a school where the pretty native girls are taught to plait back
-their flowing hair, and lay aside their scented wreaths of jessamine and
-orange-blossom.
-
-But if all these things are there, at least I do not know it, and
-Bora-Bora can still remain to me my island of Tir-na’n-Oge--the fabled
-country which the mariners of ancient Ireland sought through long ages
-of wandering, and only saw upon the far horizon, never, through all the
-years, setting foot upon the strand that they knew to be the fairest in
-the world. If they had ever indeed landed there.... But it is best for
-all of us to see our Tir-na’n-Oge only in the far away.
-
- Le seul rêve, intéresse.
-
- Vivre sans rêve, qu’est-ce?
-
- Moi, j’aime la Princesse
-
- Lointaine.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER III
-
-_Is It the Loveliest?--How they deal with the Beachcomber----Cockroaches
-and Local Colour--The Robinson Crusoe-Steamer--Emigrating to the South
-Seas--The Lands of Plenty--How to get an Island._
-
-EVERY ONE has seen Raratonga, though few travellers have looked on it
-with their own mortal eyes.
-
-Close your eyelids, and picture to yourself a South Sea Island, of the
-kind that you used to imagine on holiday afternoons long ago, when you
-wandered off down to the shore alone, to sit in a cave and look
-seaward, and fancy yourself Crusoe or Selkirk, and think the “long, long
-thoughts” of youth. Dagger-shaped peaks, of splendid purple and gorgeous
-green, set in a sky of flaming sapphire--sheer grey precipices, veiled
-with dropping wreaths of flowery vine and creeper--gossamer shreds of
-cloud, garlanding untrodden heights, high above an ocean of stainless
-blue--shadowy gorges, sweeping shoreward from the unseen heart of the
-hills--white foam breaking upon white sand on the beach, and sparkling
-sails afloat in the bay--is not this the picture that wanders ever among
-the gleams and glooms that dart across the schoolboy’s brain?
-
-It is not very like the average South Sea Island on the whole--but it is
-a faithful portrait of Raratonga, the jewel of the Southern Seas.
-
-Nothing is more hotly disputed than the claims of the many beautiful
-islands among the numberless groups of the Pacific to the crown of
-supremest loveliness. Tahiti is awarded the apple of Paris by many,
-Honolulu by a few, Samoa by all who have been there and nowhere else.
-The few who have seen the quaint loveliness of Manahiki, or Humphrey
-Island, uphold its claims among the highest, and for myself, I have
-never been quite certain whether the low atoll islands are not more
-lovely than all else, because of their matchless colouring. But, if
-one pins one’s faith to the high islands, the accepted type of Pacific
-loveliness, there is nothing more beautiful between ’Frisco and Sydney,
-Yokohama and Cape Horn, than Raratonga, chief island of the Cook
-archipelago.
-
-These islands lie some sixteen hundred miles north-east of New Zealand,
-and about six hundred miles to the westward of Tahiti. They are eight in
-number, seven inhabited, and one uninhabited, and cover about a hundred
-and sixty miles of sea. The largest, Atiu, is about thirty miles
-round, Raratonga, which is the principal island, containing the seat of
-government and the only “white” town, is twenty miles in circumference.
-
-The whole group, as well as a number of outlying islands as much as six
-and seven hundred miles away, is under the guardianship of the Resident
-Commissioner appointed by New Zealand, to which colony the islands were
-annexed in 1900. The government, as administered by Colonel Gudgeon, a
-soldier who won much distinction in the days of the New Zealand Maori
-wars, is all that could be desired. The beachcomber element, which is so
-unpleasantly in evidence in other groups, has been sternly discouraged
-in the Cook Islands, the Commissioner having the right to deport any one
-whose presence seems undesirable to the cause of the general good. It
-is a right not infrequently used. During my stay in the island, two
-doubtful characters, recently come, were suspected of having committed
-a robbery that took place in the town. There was practically no one
-else on the island who could have done the deed, or would--but direct
-evidence connecting the strangers with the crime, was not to be had.
-Under these circumstances, the Commissioner simply deported the men
-by the next steamer, giving no reason beyond the fact that they were
-without means of support. There were no more thefts. The colonel might,
-in the same manner, have ordered myself away by the next steamer, and
-compelled it to carry me to New Zealand, if he had had reason to suppose
-that I was likely to disturb the peace of the island in any way,
-or incite it to violence or crime. The doctor--also a Government
-official--was empowered to regulate the amount of liquor consumed by any
-resident, if it appeared to exceed the permitted amount--two bottles of
-spirits a week. Under these circumstances, one would expect Raratonga to
-be a little Arcadia of innocence and virtue. If it was not quite
-that, it was, and is, a credit to British Colonial rule, in all things
-essential.
-
-Before the annexation, the government was chiefly in the hands of the
-Protestant missionaries, who, with the best intentions in the world,
-carried things decidedly too far in the way of grandmotherly laws. Even
-white men were forbidden to be out of doors after eight o’clock in the
-evening, on pain of a heavy fine, and the offences for which the
-natives were fined would be incredible, were they not recorded in the
-Governmental reports of New Zealand.
-
-In Raratonga of the older days (not yet ten years past) a native who
-walked at dusk along the road with his sweetheart, his arm round her
-waist after the manner of sweethearts all the world over, was obliged to
-carry a burning torch in his hand, and was fined if he let it go out.
-If he was found weeping over the grave of a woman to whom he was not
-related (surely the strangest crime in the world) he was again brought
-up and fined. These are only samples of the vagaries of irresponsible
-missionary rule, but they go far to prove that spiritual and temporal
-legislation are better kept apart.
-
-A Government accommodation house had been planned, but not built, when I
-visited Raratonga, so I arranged, on landing, to take an unused house by
-the week, and “do for” myself, as there seemed no other way of living.
-Scarcely had I taken possession of my quarters, however, when the
-residents came down to call, and invite me to stay in their house. I
-did not know any of them, and they did not know me, but that did not
-matter--we were not in chilly England, where a whole country-side must
-discuss your personal history, family connections, probable income, and
-religious views, for a good six months, before deciding whether you are
-likely to be an acquisition or not, and calling accordingly. I began to
-understand, now, the meaning of the term “colonial hospitality,” which
-had formerly fallen on uncomprehending ears. And when I was settled down
-that evening in the most delightful of bungalow houses, with a charming
-host and hostess, and a pretty daughter, all doing their best to make me
-feel at home, I realised that I was about to see something of the true
-island life at last.
-
-[Illustration: 0035]
-
-It began rather sooner than I could have wished. When my new friends had
-gone to bed, and left me sitting up alone in the hall to write letters
-for the morning’s mail, the local colour commenced to lay itself on
-somewhat more rapidly and thickly than I desired. I am not particularly
-nervous about insects, but it is trying, when one is quite new to the
-tropics, to see a horde of cockroaches as large as mice, with fearsome
-waving horns, suddenly appear from nowhere, and proceed to overrun the
-walls and floor, with a hideous ticking noise. And when one has steeled
-oneself to endure this horrid spectacle, it is still more trying to
-be shocked by the silent irruption of dozens of brown hairy
-hunting-spiders, each big enough to straddle over a saucer, which dart
-about the walls on their eight agile legs, and slay and eat the beetles,
-crunching audibly in the silence of the night.... Truly, it was like a
-waking nightmare.
-
-Those cockroaches! What I suffered from them, during the year or two of
-island travel that followed! How they spoiled my tea, and ate my dresses
-(or parts of them), and flew into my hair of moonlight nights, and
-climbed into my berth on shipboard! It was on a liner that shall be
-nameless, very early in the course of my wanderings, that I first
-discovered the tendency of the cockroach to share the voyager’s couch
-unasked, and never again did I know unvexed and trustful sleep aboard
-a tropic ship. It was a moonlight night, and I was lying looking
-peacefully at the brilliantly silvered circle of my port, when suddenly
-a horrid head, with waving feelers, lifted itself over the edge of my
-berth and stared me coldly in the face. I hit out, like the virtuous
-hero in a novel, and struck it straight between the eyes, and it dropped
-to the floor with a dull sickening thud, and lay there very still. I
-thought gloatingly of how the blood would trickle out under my door in
-the morning in a slow hideous stream, and how the stewardess, bringing
-my early tea, would start and stop, and say in an awestruck tone that
-one that night had met his doom--and so thinking, I fell asleep.
-
-I woke, with one cockroach in my hair, chewing a plait, and another
-nibbling my heel. I got up and looked round. It was then that I wished
-I had never come away from home, and that, since I had come, my sex
-forbade me to go and berth in the hold. I was convinced that, if I could
-have done so, I should have had a quiet night, because the hold is
-the part of a ship where the cockroaches come from, and they had all
-_come_--they were on the floor of my cabin, and sitting about the quilt.
-
-The hideous battle raged all night, and in the morning I asked one
-of the mates for an axe, to help me through the coming renewal of
-hostilities. He recommended boracic acid instead, and I may record, for
-the benefit of other travellers, that I really found it of some use.
-
-
-[Illustration: 0043]
-
-To find out, as far as possible, what were the prospects for settlers in
-some of the principal Pacific groups, was the main object of my journey
-to the Islands. It had always seemed to me that the practical side of
-Pacific life received singularly little attention, in most books of
-travel. One could never find out how a living was to be made in the
-island world, what the cost of housekeeping might be, what sort of
-society might be expected, whether the climates were healthy, and so
-forth--matters prosaic enough, but often of more interest to readers
-than the scenic descriptions and historical essays that run naturally
-from the pen of any South Sea traveller.
-
-Certainly, the romantic and picturesque side of the islands is so
-obvious that it takes some determination, and a good deal of actual hard
-work, to obtain any other impressions whatever. But white human beings,
-even in the islands, cannot live on romance alone, and many people, in
-Britain and elsewhere, are always anxious to know how the delightful
-dream of living in the South Seas may be realised. Practical details
-about island life, therefore, will take up the most of the present
-chapter, and readers who prefer the lighter and more romantic vein, must
-turn the pages a little further on. .
-
-The number of those who wish to settle in the Pacific is by no means
-small.
-
-The Pacific Ocean has always had a special interest for the English,
-from the days of Drake s daring circumnavigation, through the times of
-Captain Cook and the somewhat misunderstood Bligh, of the _Bounty_, down
-to the dawn of the twentieth century. The very name of the South Seas
-reeks of adventure and romance. Every boy at school has dreams of coral
-islands and rakish schooners, sharks, and pearls; most men retain a
-shamefaced fancy for stories of peril and adventure in that magical
-South Sea world, of whose charm and beauty every one has heard, although
-very few are fortunate enough to see it with their own bodily eyes. For
-the Pacific Islands are, both in point of time and distance, about the
-remotest spots on the surface of the globe, and they are also among
-the most costly for the ordinary traveller to reach. Thus, for the
-most part, the South Seas dream, which so many hot-blooded young Saxons
-cherish, remains a dream only. The youth who has a fancy for Canadian
-farming life, or for stock-raising in Australasia, may gratify his
-desire with the full approval of parents and guardians in private life,
-and of Empire-builders in high places. But the British possessions in
-the South Seas--and what extensive possession they are let Colonial maps
-prove--may cry out for settlers from the rainy season to the dry, and
-round again to the rainy season once more, without attracting a single
-colonist of the right kind.
-
-What is the reason of this? Where is the broken link? The British
-Pacific Islands need settlers; young Britons at home are only too ready
-to adventure themselves. Why do they not? There are several reasons. The
-first, perhaps, is that neither party can hear the other. In England few
-possess any information about the South Sea Islands. In the Pacific
-the white residents (almost all New Zealand traders and Government
-officials) are possessed with an idea that only wastrels of the worst
-kind drift out from England to the South Seas, and that nothing better
-is to be looked for. The result is that at the present date young
-Englishmen by the hundred are losing their small capital as “pupils” on
-Canadian farms, or are starving on the roads in South Africa, while
-all the time the South Sea Islands hold out hands of peace and plenty,
-begging humbly for a respectable white population. The brown races are
-dying out with fearful rapidity; at their best they never touched the
-limitless capacities of the golden Pacific soil. Its richness has always
-seemed to the original inhabitants an excellent reason for abstaining
-from cultivation. When the earth produced of itself everything that was
-necessary for comfort, why trouble to work it? Now, however, when
-so many groups of fertile islands have fallen into the hands of more
-progressive nations, things are changed. The white man can live happily
-and healthily in the Pacific; he can obtain a good return for a small
-capital at the best, and at the worst cannot possibly suffer from either
-cold or hunger, since neither exists in the South Seas. He can lease or
-buy land from the natives at slight cost, work it with small labour, and
-sell the product to a sure market. Honesty, sobriety, and industry repay
-their possessor as almost nowhere else in the world. Yet, with all this,
-the white settler in the Pacific Islands is generally of a more or less
-undesirable kind.
-
-The “beachcomber” white, without friends, means, or character; the
-“remittance man,” paid to keep as far away from home as possible; the
-travelling ne’er-do-well, with a taste for novelties in dissipation,
-and a fancy for being outside the limit of Press and post--all these are
-familiar figures in the Pacific. Kipling’s Lost Legion musters there by
-the score; the living ghosts of men whose memorial tablets are blinking
-white on the walls of English country churches, walk by daylight along
-the coral beaches. Only the steady man, the young energetic man with a
-future and without a past, the man who can get on without a three-weekly
-spree of the most torrid kind, commonly keeps away. And these are just
-the men that the “Islands” want. Local trading interest, religious
-and otherwise, often does its best to keep them from coming, through
-a natural, if scarcely praiseworthy, desire to retain personal hold of
-everything worth holding. The Governmental party of every group desires
-the respectable settler with a little capital, and expresses its desire,
-as a rule, in gentle wails delivered through Governmental reports--a
-method about as effective as putting one’s head into a cupboard to hail
-a ’bus in the street. The Press does not recognise the existence of
-any habitable land in the Pacific, outside Honolulu and Samoa. So the
-dead lock continues.
-
-I can see the Left Behind in the office raise his head at this, and
-look through the muddy panes of the counting-house window, or across
-the piles of summer goods on the shop counters, out beyond the clanging
-street, and right through the whole round world to the far-away Pacific
-lands. He wants to get away so very badly, that poor Left Behind, and he
-does not quite see his way to do it, because every one discourages him
-if he hints at the subject, and he does not know how one could make a
-living, out in those fairy lands that he wishes so much to see. Well, I
-am on his side in this matter. If it is a crime to long for a glimpse
-of the wonderful island world, to ache for a life spent under the free
-winds of heaven, and a chance of the danger, adventure, and
-excitement, which are as strong wine to the heart of almost every young
-Englishman--then it is a crime shared by the best that the nation has
-ever known, and one which has done more to build up the empire than all
-the parochial virtues ever owned by a million Young Men’s Improvement
-Societies put together.
-
-The Islands are not the place for the ne’er-do-well, and I would also
-warn the exasperating young man, who never did a square day’s work in
-his life, never got into trouble with his employers or his
-superiors, but always found himself misunderstood, unappreciated, and
-incomprehensibly “sacked,” with an excellent character, at the first
-hint of slacking business--that the islands will not suit him either.
-If he comes out, he will not starve or go to the workhouse, because you
-cannot die of hunger where there is always enough vegetable food to keep
-the laziest alive, and you do not need workhouses, under the same happy
-conditions--but he will “go native,” and there are some who would say he
-had better starve, a good deal. There are men who have “gone native”
- in most of the Pacific groups, living in the palm-leaf huts with the
-villagers--but a white man in a waist-cloth and a bush of long hair,
-sleeping on a mat and living on wild fruit and scraps given by the
-generous natives, drunk half the time and infinitely lower, in his
-soberest hours, than the coloured folk who unwisely put up with him, is
-not a happy spectacle.
-
-The Cook Islands, which may be taken as a sample of many other groups,
-are small to look at on the map, and not over large, when one counts up
-the number of square miles. But one cannot fairly estimate the value of
-island land by its extent. Much of it is so rich that every foot has its
-worth, and that is by no means despicable. And, in any case, there is
-plenty available for the small cultivator--the man who has only a few
-hundred pounds, and cannot afford to do things on the colossal scale
-that makes big fortunes.
-
-Among the productions of the group are pineapples, custard apples,
-coffee, tobacco, pepper, mammee-apple or paw-paw, granadilla, cocoa,
-cotton, vanilla, limes, lemons, oranges, bananas, castor-oil, and many
-other useful plants, besides a number of excellent vegetables, not known
-to most Europeans. Many of the fruits above mentioned grow practically
-wild. Bananas come to bearing in fifteen months, cocoanuts in seven
-years, limes in four or five. The water supply is good all round, and
-there is a monthly steamer from Auckland.
-
-The land in all the islands belongs to the natives, and cannot usually
-be bought outright. Leases of any length, can, however, be secured
-at very low rates, with the New Zealand Government laws, administered
-through the Resident, to back up the titles, so that a man who plants
-cocoanuts--the safest of island products--may be sure that his children
-and grandchildren will enjoy the fruits of his labour.
-
-In most of the outer islands the natives cannot use more than a small
-fraction of the land, and are quite willing to let large sections at a
-shilling or two an acre. In Raratonga, the chief island, there has been
-more demand for land, and prices are consequently higher; also, the
-chiefs are not always ready to let, even though they do not use what
-they have. It may be said, however, of the group as a whole, that there
-is land, and a prospect of a good return for capital, ready for any
-reasonable number of settlers, if they bring habits of industry and a
-determination to succeed along with them.
-
-There are two classes of possible settlers to be considered--the man
-with capital, and the man without.
-
-How much does it take to start a man as a planter, and what return can
-he expect?
-
-Taking the Cook Islands as a general example (but by no means suggesting
-that the resources of the Pacific begin and end there) the young
-Englishman wishing to seek his fortune as a planter should have at least
-£500 to start on, exclusive of passage-money. He can do excellently with
-a few hundreds more, but it is as well to put things as low as possible.
-Copra--the dried kernel of the cocoanut--is the usual, and the safest,
-investment. It is always saleable, and the demand increases year by
-year--so much so, that the large soapmaking firms, who are the chief
-users of the product, are of late planting out islands for themselves.
-The cost of clearing and planting the land is about £5 an acre. The
-rent, in the outer islands, should not exceed a couple of shillings an
-acre. In about seven years, the returns begin to come in, and in ten
-years’ time the land should be bringing in £5 net profit for every acre
-of trees. This is, of course, a long time to wait, but bananas can grow
-on the same land meantime, and will generally yield a quick return. Once
-the cocoanuts start bearing, they go on for sixty years or more, so
-that a copra plantation is one of the best investments for a man who has
-others to come after him.
-
-Banana growing may be managed with less capital, but the profits are not
-so sure, since fruit is perishable, and cannot wait for the steamer as
-copra can. Coffee has been grown, but is not of late years doing well,
-because of something like a “ring” formed in New Zealand to lower
-the prices. Cotton used to do excellently, and I have never heard any
-satisfactory reason against its being taken up afresh. It is running
-wild in a good many parts of the group. The plants above mentioned,
-however, by no means exhaust the resources of the islands, which are
-suitable for growing anything that will live in the tropics, and are
-fortunately not subject to the destructive hurricanes that from time
-to time do so much damage in Tahiti and the Fijis. Hurricanes are not
-absolutely unknown, but they are very rare, and not of the worst kind.
-
-The cost of living is not very serious, but it must not be supposed that
-the settlers can live decently and like white men, on nothing a year. A
-house costs something to put up, and furniture to a certain small amount
-is necessary, clothes do not grow on the cocoanut tree, nor do lamps and
-kerosene, or tools and nails, or fishing lines, or flour and bacon and
-tea and tinned butter, and the few groceries that the settler may need.
-Still, with care, a single man can live quite respectably on fifty
-pounds a year, and enjoy, in all probability, better health than he has
-had at home.
-
-What the time of waiting will cost the copra planter, each one must
-work out for himself. He will do best to spend his capital gradually,
-planting as he can afford. The returns will come in only by degrees,
-but he will be saved the mortification of seeing a promising plantation
-leave his possession for a third of its value, simply because he cannot
-afford to wait until the profits begin.
-
-Copra, the chief article of commerce of the Pacific, is very easily
-prepared. The cocoanuts, when ripe, are husked, and emptied, and the
-kernels, as a rule, left to dry in the sun, though some few planters use
-artificial heat. Bagging is the only other operation necessary.
-
-Bananas are often shipped clumsily and carelessly, in unprotected
-bunches. It would be much better to pack them in leaves and crate
-them, as is done in the Canary Islands, where the banana trade is the
-principal support of the country. Oranges are usually shipped in crates.
-They grow wild all over the Cook group, and are not attended to in any
-way, but in spite of this, the orange trade with New Zealand is by no
-means despicable.
-
-Vanilla is not cultivated for market in these islands, but it would
-probably repay the experimenter. It does well in most of the Pacific
-groups, and the returns begin in three years from planting.
-
-Island planters, as a race, seem to be the most conservative of men, and
-very shy of trying anything new and unproved. There are, of course, good
-reasons for this, but there are also excellent arguments in favour of
-exploiting fresh fields. The following brief hints may prove fruitful to
-enterprising minds.
-
-Only one kind of banana--the sort familiar at home--is usually grown
-for trade. There are many varieties, however, and some of the very best
-travel quite as well as the commonplace “China” sort. The large red
-banana, sometimes called the Aitutaki banana, sometimes the peach
-banana, on account of its delicate peach-like flavour, is a fruit that
-would become the fashion at once, if it could be put on the market. One
-or two planters have gone so far as to send consignments down to New
-Zealand, but, finding that these did not sell on account of the unusual
-colour of the fruit, they never made another attempt. At the time of
-my visit, in 1904, the red banana was practically unobtainable in New
-Zealand or Australia. A little intelligent co-operation on the part of
-the buyers would probably get over the difficulty.
-
-The same may be said of limes, a fruit which grows wild very freely. The
-lime is like a small, round-shaped lemon, and is not an attractive fruit
-in appearance. It also suffers under the disadvantage of being very
-badly represented as to flavour by the bottled “shop” lime-juice, with
-which the taste of the fresh lime has hardly anything in common. Where
-it can be obtained fresh, however, no one ever thinks of using lemon as
-a flavouring in food or drink. The lime is incomparably more delicate
-and refreshing than the best lemon ever grown. For some unknown reason,
-however, it is not used in New Zealand, or in the cities of Australia,
-to which it could be easily and profitably exported from many of the
-Pacific groups. Instead, the juice of limes is squeezed out by a very
-rough process, the fruit being run through a wooden hand-press, and is
-shipped away in casks. The lime trade would certainly rival the orange
-trade, if worked up.
-
-Dried bananas have money in them, and the industry is especially adapted
-to some of the lesser Cook Islands, where steamer calls are at present
-irregular. The dried and pressed banana is better than the fig, and is
-considered a great delicacy by the few people in the colonies who have
-tried it. The Cook Islanders peel the fruit, and leave it to dry in
-the sun. When it is shrunk, dark, and sticky with its own sugar, they
-compress it into neat little packets covered with dried banana leaf, and
-tied with banana fibre. These will keep good for many months. Up to the
-present, the trade is extremely small, but there is no reason why it
-should not be increased.
-
-One of the chief troubles of the settler is the guava bush, which runs
-wild all over the islands, and is extremely hard to destroy. It bears
-quantities of excellent fruit, but guavas do not pay for exporting, so
-no one, apparently, has thought of making the island pest profitable.
-And yet, when I went down to New Zealand, which is in direct
-communication with the Cook Islands and less than a week away, I found
-the price of guava jelly in the shops was higher than it is at home.
-Asked why no one in the islands sent jelly for sale, the grocers said it
-was because jampots were not made in New Zealand, and had to be imported
-if wanted. Since most jams in the colonies are sold in tins, this
-did not appear to me an unanswerable argument. Tins are made in the
-colonies, and the process of tinning jam or jelly should not be beyond
-amateur powers. Moreover, common tumblers (which are also made in New
-Zealand) are a good and profitable way of putting up jellies; purchasers
-are always willing to pay extra for the advantage of getting something
-useful along with the dainty itself.
-
-Another item: Dried peppers bring a good price per ounce, and fine Chili
-pepper grows wild everywhere. So far, trade is nil.
-
-Another: One of the commonest plants in the Southern Pacific, a weed
-bearing a bright red flower almost exactly like the pine-cone in shape,
-contains, in the flower, a quantity of white watery liquid, which
-is declared by the natives, and by many of the whites, to be an
-exceptionally fine hair tonic. No one, so far as I know, has tried to
-make anything out of this, or out of the wild castor oil, which is said
-to be of good quality.
-
-If the settler cannot find some useful hint among these, he may be able
-to discover a few on the spot for himself.
-
-The second class of settler--the man without capital, or with only a
-little--is a pariah everywhere. No colony wants him, agents warn him
-away, friends write to him begging him to stay where he is, and not
-tempt fortune by going out unprovided with plenty of cash. No doubt
-there is reason on the side of the discouragers; but there is not a
-colony in the world, all the same, where you shall not find the man who
-came out without capital, who endured a few years of hard work and short
-commons, began to get on, began to save, went on getting on and saving,
-and by-and-by became one of the most successful men in the place.
-Whereupon as a rule he becomes an adviser in his turn, and solemnly
-counsels young men of every kind against the imprudence of tempting
-fortune with an empty purse.
-
-For all that, and all that, young Britons will continue to do what they
-are advised not to, and ships will carry out many a man to the far wild
-countries whose only gold is the gold of youth and health and a brave
-heart. “Sink or swim” is the motto of this kind of colonist, and if he
-often goes under, he very often floats on the top, and comes in on the
-flood-tide of good luck. “Fortune favours the brave”--a proverb none the
-less true because of its age.
-
-To have an island of one’s own, in the beautiful South Seas, to
-live remote from strain and worry, and out of the clash and roar
-of twentieth-century civilization--to pass one’s days in a land of
-perpetual summer; work, but own no master, possess a country (small
-though it may be) yet know none of the troubles of sovereignty--this
-is an ambition of which no one need be ashamed, even though-it appear
-contemptible and even reprehensible to “Samuel Budgett, the Successful
-Merchant.” The planter with a fair amount of capital can realise the
-dream almost any day, for every big group in the Pacific has many small
-unoccupied islands which can be rented for a song, and if the newcomer
-is made of stuff that can stand being totally deprived of theatres,
-clubs, music halls, daily posts and papers, and a good many other charms
-(or burdens) of city life, he has only to pick and choose, secure a good
-title to-his island, decide what he means to grow on it, get his house
-built, and settle down at once.
-
-But people who have very little money cherish the same ambition, often
-enough: There are thousands of men in the United Kingdom to whom a South
-Sea Island of their-own would be heaven--only they see no way of
-getting it. The desire comes, without doubt, of generations of insular
-ancestors. It is the “Englishman’s house is his castle” idea carried a
-step further than usual, that is all; and the boy that never wholly dies
-in the heart of every Briton is always ready to wake up and rejoice at
-the thought.
-
-What is the moneyless man to do?
-
-Well, first of all, he must get out to Sydney or Auckland, each being
-a port from which island vessels constantly sail, and with which island
-trade is closely concerned. It will not cost him so much as he thinks.
-If he goes by Auckland, he can get a third-class ticket from London for
-fifteen pounds, and Sydney is little more. Arrived, he will make use of
-the information he has, of course, obtained in London, from the offices
-of the Agent-General for New Zealand (or Australia, as the case may be)
-and try and get a job to keep him on his feet while he looks about. If
-he can do any kind of manual labour, he will not be at a loss--and if he
-cannot, or will not, he had much better stay at home on an office stool
-within sound of Bow Bells, and leave the far countries to men of tougher
-material.
-
-In Sydney or Auckland he will find a good many firms connected with
-island trading interests, many of whom own trading stores dotted about
-the whole Pacific. It is often possible to obtain a job from one of
-these, if the newcomer is capable and steady. In this case, the way
-of getting up to the islands is clear, and the work of copra trading,
-keeping store for native customers, fruit-buying and shipping on the
-spot, is the best possible training for an independent position. If this
-proves a vain hope (it need not, in the case of a good man, if one may
-judge by the wretched incapables who occupy the trader’s post in many
-islands) our adventurer must try to raise the cost of a passage as best
-he can, and see what he can get to do among the white people of the
-group he has selected, when he arrives. There are so many useless
-wastrels in most of the islands, that character and capability are to a
-certain extent capital in themselves. Some one is generally in want of
-a plantation overseer to replace a drunken employee--some one else would
-be glad of a handy man to help with housebuilding of the simple island
-kind--and in many islands, board and lodging, and a little over, would
-be easily obtainable by any educated man, who would undertake to teach
-the children of the white settlers. There are groups in which no one is
-allowed to land who does not possess a certain minimum of cash, but it
-is not in any case that I know of more than ten pounds, and most islands
-have no such regulation.
-
-Once so far on his journey, the would-be island owner must think out the
-rest for himself. There is sure to be a small island or two for rent,
-and there will probably be means of making money by slow degrees in the
-group itself. Where the will is, the way will be found.
-
-The popular dream of finding and taking possession of an unoccupied
-island somewhere or other, and “squatting” there unopposed, is a dream
-and nothing more. The great European nations have long since parcelled
-out among themselves all the groups worth having, and rent or purchase
-is the only way to acquire land. Far-away separate islands, remote from
-everywhere, are still to be had for nothing in a few instances, but they
-are not desirable-possessions, unless the owner can afford a private
-sailing vessel, and in any case what has not been picked up is little
-worth picking in these days.
-
-So much for the how and where of acquiring islands. I shall have one or
-two definite instances to give in another chapter.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER IV
-
-_Where are the Six Thousand?--Calling on the Queen--A Victoria of the
-Pacific--The Prince sleeps softly--The Mystical Power of the Mana--How
-Islanders can die--A Depressing Palace--Round the Wonderful Roadway--The
-Home of Queen Tinomana--A Princess’s Love Story--Once on Board the
-Schooner!--The Incredible Crabs--Depravity of a Mor Kiri-kiri._
-
-A HUNDRED years ago, Raratonga had six thousand native inhabitants, and
-was a very flourishing heathen country, where cannibalism was all the
-fashion, murder of shipwrecked sailors a common custom, and raids upon
-neighbouring islands the chief diversion. There is no doubt that the
-Raratongan of those days compared none too well with the Tahitian,
-who at the worst never was an habitual cannibal, and was almost always
-friendly to strangers. Williams was the first missionary to arrive in
-the earlier part of the last century, and the complete conversion of the
-island was rapid; the Raratongan in a few years was no longer cannibal,
-no longer warlike, had become hospitable and friendly to travellers, had
-learned to wear clothes (a good deal more than he wanted or should have
-had, but the missionary of the early days really did not know what a
-fatal thing he was doing, when he enforced the wearing of white man’s
-raiment on the unclothed native, and thereby taught him to catch cold,
-and die of chest diseases). The island had (and has) a large school for
-the training of mission teachers, and a church and mission house not to
-be matched in the Pacific for magnificence, and was on the whole a model
-of most of the virtues, compared with what it once had been. There were,
-and are, drawbacks to the missionary rule, but these have been discussed
-so freely in almost every book of Pacific travel ever written, that I
-do not feel it necessary to say over again what has so often been said
-before. The missionaries certainly civilised the islands, and made them
-safe to live in. Concurrently with this desirable result, others not
-so desirable took place, the fruit, in some cases, of irresponsible
-authority exercised by semi-educated men; in others, of the inevitable
-fate that follows the introduction of civilisation to primitive races.
-The Raratongan, like all the other brown folk of the islands, was asked
-to leap, almost at once, the gulf between utter savagery and comparative
-civilisation, that had taken his instructors all the time between
-the Roman Conquest and the end of the Dark Ages to overpass. With the
-docility of the true Polynesian, he did his best to comply. It was not
-his fault--and not, one must fairly say, the fault of the missionary
-either, save in a minor degree--that the effort meant death to him.
-
-There are not nineteen hundred Raratongans living now in the fertile
-little country that used to support six thousand of their ancestors.
-There are not enough babies in the island to carry on the population at
-half its present level, in the future. Not one of the “chief” families,
-of whom there are a dozen or so, has any living children at all.
-Consumption is common, and on the increase; more serious diseases are
-commoner still. A Raratongan seldom lives to be very old, and he almost
-always dies without resistance or regret. The islanders are happy and
-sunny in their own quiet way, but the backbone of life has been broken
-for them, and in the promise of the future, grey or golden, they have no
-share. To-day is theirs, but they have no to-morrow.
-
-The Arikis, or chiefs, to whom the principal power once belonged, and
-who still retain much importance, regret this state of affairs in an
-amiable, fatalistic way, but do not trouble themselves very much over
-it. They are for the most part of the opinion of Sir Boyle Roche about
-the claims of posterity; and anyhow, they have their fruit trading to
-think about, and the next public dancing and singing party, and the last
-illegal beer-brewing up in the hills--so the decadence of their country
-sits lightly on their minds.
-
-These Arikis are one and all inferior to the ruling sovereign, Queen
-Makea, who still contrives to retain a great deal of quiet power in her
-shapely old hands, in spite of the fact that she is nominally deposed,
-and her country owned by New Zealand. I had not been in Raratonga
-more than a day or two, when my hosts took me to call upon the queen,
-intimating that she would feel hurt if the newcomer was not presented to
-her.
-
-[Illustration: 0111]
-
-We walked through the blazing sun of the tropic afternoon, down the
-palm-shaded main street of Avarua town, to the great grassy enclosure
-that surrounds the palace of the queen. One enters through a neat
-white gate; inside are one or two small houses, a number of palms and
-flowering bushes, and at the far end, a stately two-storeyed building
-constructed of whitewashed concrete, with big railed-in verandahs, and
-handsome arched windows. This is Makea’s palace, but her visitors do not
-go there to look for her. In true South Sea Islander fashion, she keeps
-a house for show and one for use. The islander, though he aspires when
-“civilised,” to own a big concrete house, “all same papalangi” (white
-man), does not really like living in a building that shuts out the air.
-He discovered the fresh-air system long before it was thought of by the
-folk who discovered him, and his own houses are always made of small
-poles or saplings, set without any filling, so that the whole building
-is as airy as a birdcage, and almost as transparent. In this he lives,
-while the big concrete house, with its Auckland made tables, chairs, and
-beds, and the red and blue table-cloths, and horrible gilt lamps fringed
-with cut glass lustres, and shrieking oleograph of King Edward in
-his coronation robes, is kept strictly for show, and perhaps for an
-occasional festival, such as a wedding party. It is an odd custom, but
-sensible, on the whole.
-
-[Illustration: 0117]
-
-Makea’s favourite house is a pretty little reed and thatch villa several
-miles out in the country. When she is in town, she makes some concession
-to state by living in a small one-storeyed cottage, with a thatch and a
-verandah, and not much else, close beside her big palace. We found her
-at the cottage when we called, sitting on the verandah upon an ironwood
-couch, and petting a little turtle of which she is very fond. It seems
-a curious sort of creature to adore, but an elderly lady must have her
-little pet of some kind. In other climes, it is a pug, a parrot, or a
-cat. Here, the little turtle is considered chic, so the queen has one,
-the turtle having been always considered a perquisite of royalty in the
-old days, when the chiefs had the best of everything, even down to the
-choicest tit-bits of the roasted enemy, while the commonalty had to put
-up with what they could get.
-
-[Illustration: 0125]
-
-I was introduced to the queen, who shook hands politely, and sent one
-of her handmaids for chairs. These being brought, my hostess and I sat
-down, and the latter conversed with Makea in Raratongan, translating a
-few conventional politenesses from myself, and conveying others to me in
-return. The queen wanted to know how I liked the island, if I had really
-come all the way from England, as she had heard, whether I was not
-afraid to travel so far alone, how long I hoped to stay, and so forth.
-All the time, as we talked, her keen black eyes were scanning me
-silently, rapidly, comprehensively, and making their own judgment, quite
-independently of the conversation and its inevitable formalities. And
-I, on my side, was gazing, I fear with some rudeness, at the very
-remarkable figure before me.
-
-Makea, since the death of her husband, Prince Ngamaru, a few years ago,
-has laid aside all vanities of dress, and wears only the simplest of
-black robes, made loose and flowing from the neck in island fashion. She
-is supposed to be at least seventy years of age, and she is extremely
-stout, even for her height, which is well over six feet. Yet a more
-impressive figure than this aged, deposed, uncrowned sovereign, in her
-robe of shabby black, I have never seen. Wisdom, kindliness, and dignity
-are written large on her fine old face, which has more than a touch
-of resemblance to the late Queen Victoria. And oh, the shrewdness, the
-ability, the keen judgment of men and things, that look out from those
-brown, deep-set eyes, handsome enough, even in old age, to hint at the
-queen-like beauty that once belonged to this island queen!
-
-Makea was always known as a wise, just, and very powerful sovereign. She
-ruled over the whole Cook group, and her word was law everywhere,
-even to the Prince Consort, the warlike Ngamaru, who to the very last
-retained some traces of his heathen upbringing, and used to be seen,
-in the island councils of only a few years ago, making the horrible
-cannibal gesture which signifies in unmistakable pantomime, “I will tear
-the meat from your bones with my teeth!” at any other council member who
-presumed to disagree with him. Their married life was a happy one, in
-spite of the prince’s violent character, and when he died, the widowed
-queen took all her splendid robes of velvet, silk, and satin, gorgeously
-trimmed with gold, tore them in fragments, and cast them into his grave,
-so that he might he soft, as befitted the prince who had been loved so
-well by such a queen.
-
-Makea holds much of the real power in her hands to-day, for all that
-the islands are the property of the British Crown, and administered by a
-Commissioner. The Raratongan is submissive to chiefs by nature, and the
-queen, though uncrowned, is still reverenced and feared almost, as much
-as of old. It is firmly believed that she possesses the mystic power
-known as “mana” among the Maori races, and this, as it gives the
-owner power to slay at will, is greatly feared. The word is almost
-untranslatable, meaning, perhaps, something like “prestige,” “kudos,” or
-the old English “glamour.” It includes, among other gifts, second sight
-to a certain extent, the power to bring good or evil luck, and the
-ability already mentioned to deal death at will.
-
-[Illustration: 0139]
-
-This last may sound like fiction. It is nothing of the sort, it is
-plain, bald fact, as any one who has ever lived in the islands can
-testify. There is nothing more commonly known in the South Seas than
-the weird power possessed by kings and heroes to slay with a word, and
-instances of its exercise could be found in every group.
-
-Makea does not use it now, so they say. She is old: like aged folks
-in other places, she wants to “make her soul,” and it can readily be
-imagined that the mission authorities do not approve of such heathen
-proceedings. Still, there is not a native in Raratonga who does not
-believe that she could strike him dead with a wish, any day in the week,
-if she chose: and there are not a few who can tell you that in the days
-long ago, she exercised the power.
-
-“Makea, she never rude, because she great chief,” said a relation of the
-royal family to me one day. “She never say to any one, ‘You go die!’ I
-think. She only saying, some time, ‘I wish I never seeing you again!’
-and then the people he go away, very sorry, and by-n’-by he die--some
-day, some week, I don’ know--but he dyin’ all right, very quick, you
-bet!”
-
-The power to die at will seems to be a heritage of the island races,
-though the power to live, when a chief bids them set sail on the dark
-seas of the unknown, is not theirs. Suicide, carried out without the
-aid of weapons or poisons of any kind, is not at all uncommon. A man
-or woman who is tired of life, or bitterly offended with any one, will
-often lie down on the mats, turn his face, like David of old; to the
-wall, and simply flicker out like a torch extinguished by the wind.
-There was once a white schooner captain, who had quarrelled with his
-native crew; and the crew, to pay him out, lay down and declared they
-would die to spite him.... But this is about Makea the Queen, not about
-the godless brutal captain, and the measures he took to prevent his men
-from taking passage in a body across the Styx. They didn’t go after all,
-and they were sore and sorry men when they made the island port, and the
-captain, who was a very ill-educated person, boasted far and wide
-for many a day after that, that he would exceedingly well learn any
-exceedingly objectionable nigger who offered to go and die on him
-again--and that is all that I must say about it, for more reasons than
-one.
-
-The queen, after a little conversation, punctuated by intervals of
-fanning and smiling (and a more charming smile than Makea’s, you
-might search the whole South Seas to find), sent a girl up a tree for
-cocoanuts, and offered us the inevitable cocoanut water and bananas,
-without which no island call is complete. Afterwards, when we rose to
-go, she sent a handmaid with us to take us over the palace, of which she
-is, naturally, very proud, though she never enters it except on the rare
-occasion of some great festival.
-
-The palace proved to be as uninteresting as the queen herself was
-interesting and attractive. It had a stuffy, shut-up smell, and it was
-furnished in the worst of European taste, with crude ugly sofas and
-chairs, tables covered with cheap-jack Manchester trinkets, and staring
-mirrors and pictures--partly sacred art, of a kind remarkably well
-calculated to promote the cause of heathenism, and partly portraits,
-nearly as bad as those one sees in the spring exhibitions at home. There
-were two or three saloons or drawing-rooms, all much alike, on the lower
-storey. Upstairs (it is only a very palatial island house that owns
-an upstairs) there were several bedrooms, furnished with large costly
-bedsteads of mahogany and other handsome woods, and big massive
-wardrobes and tables--all unused, and likely to remain so. The place
-was depressing on the whole, and I was glad to get out of it into the
-cheerful sun, although the heat at this hour of the afternoon was really
-outrageous.
-
-[[Illustration: 0165]
-
-Another afternoon, I drove out to see Queen Tinomana, a potentate only
-second to Makea in influence. Tinomana, like Makea, is a dynastic name,
-and is always borne by the high chief, man or woman, who is hereditary
-sovereign of a certain district. The present holder of the title is a
-woman, and therefore queen.
-
-What a drive it was! The roadway round the island is celebrated all
-over the Pacific, and with justice, for nothing more lovely than this
-twenty-mile ribbon of tropic splendour is to be found beneath the
-Southern Cross. One drives in a buggy of colonial pattern, light,
-easy-running, and fast, and the rough little island horse makes short
-work of the miles of dazzling white sandy road that circle the shores
-of the bright lagoon. On one side rises the forest, green and rich and
-gorgeous beyond all that the dwellers of the dark North could possibly
-imagine, and opening now and then to display picture after picture, in
-a long gallery of magnificent mountain views--mountains blue as the sea,
-mountains purple as amethyst, mountains sharp like spear-heads, towered
-and buttressed like grand cathedrals, scarped into grey precipices where
-a bat could scarcely cling, and cloven into green gorges bright with
-falling streams. On the other, the palms and thick undergrowth
-hardly veil the vivid gleam of the emerald lagoon lying within the
-white-toothed barrier reef, where all day long the surf of the great
-Pacific creams and froths and pours. By the verge of the coral beach
-that burns like white fire in the merciless sun, the exquisite ironwood
-tree trails its delicate tresses above the sand, so that, if you leave
-the carriage to follow on the road, and walk down by the beach, you
-shall catch the green glow of the water, and the pearly sparkle of
-the reef, through a drooping veil of leafage fine as a mermaid’s hair.
-Sometimes the buggy runs for a mile or two through thick woods of this
-lovely tree, where the road is carpeted thickly with the fallen needles
-of foliage, so that the wheels run without sound, and you may catch the
-Eolian harp-song of the leaves, sighing ceaselessly and sadly
-
- Of old, unhappy, far-off things,
-
-when the evening wind gets up and the sun drops low on the lagoon.
-
-The myths of the Pacific are marvellous in their way, but they pass
-over unnoticed much that could not have escaped the net of folk-lore and
-poetry in Northern lands. That the lovely ironwood, a tree with
-leaves like mermaid’s locks, and the voice of a mermaid’s song in its
-whispering boughs, should stand bare of legend or romance on the shores
-of a sea that is itself the very home of wonder, strikes the Northern
-mind with a sense of strange incongruity. But the soul of the islands is
-not the soul of the continents, and the poet of the Pacific is still to
-be born.
-
-[Illustration: 0173]
-
-Sometimes, again, the little buggy rattles over white coral sand and
-gravel, on a stretch of road that is fairly buried in the forest. The
-sun is cut off overhead, and only a soft green glow sifts through. The
-palm-tree stems sweep upward, tall and white, the gigantic “maupei”
- rears aloft its hollow buttressed stems, carved out into caverns that
-would delight the soul of a modern Crusoe, and drops big chestnuts,
-floury and sweet, upon the road as we pass. The “utu,” or Barringtonia
-Speciosa, one of the most beautiful of island trees, towers a hundred
-feet into the warm glow above, its brilliant varnished leaves, nearly
-a foot long, and its strange rose and white flowers, shaped like
-feather-dusters, marking it out unmistakably from the general tangle of
-interlacing boughs, and crowding trunks and long liana ropes, green and
-brown, that run from tree to tree. If you were lost in the bush, and
-thirsty, one of those lianas would provide you with waters, were you
-learned enough in wood lore to slash it with your knife, and let the
-pure refreshing juice trickle forth. You might gather wild fruit of many
-kinds, too, and wild roots, mealy and nourishing, or dainty and sweet.
-And at night, you might creep into your hollow tree, or lie down on the
-warm sand of the shore, with nothing worse to fear than a mosquito or
-two.
-
-There are no wild beasts in any of the Pacific Islands, save an
-occasional boar, which always lives remote from men in the hills, and is
-much readier to run away than to annoy. There are no poisonous snakes,
-either, tarantulas, or deadly centipedes and scorpions. I cannot
-honestly say that the two latter creatures do not exist, but they very
-seldom bite or sting any one who does not go barefooted, and their venom
-is not deadly, though painful.
-
-On almost every tree, as we rattle along through the forest, my hostess
-and I can see the beautiful bird’s-nest fern, looking like a hanging
-basket of greenery. We have not time to stop to-day, but we shall have
-to go out some other afternoon and cut down a few of the smaller ones
-for table decoration, for there is a dinner party coming off, and we
-are short of pot plants for the rooms. Young palms, most graceful of all
-green things, shoot up like little fountains in the clearings, some of
-the smaller ones still’ root-bound by the large brown nut from which
-they have sprung. One would never think these dainty ball-room palms
-were related in any way to the stately white columns-spiring high above
-them, for the full-grown palm is all stem and scarcely any top, in
-comparison, while the young palm, a mass of magnificent spreading
-fronds, rises from a short bulb-like trunk that suggests nothing less
-than further growth.
-
-The drive is six good miles, but it seems only too short. In a very
-little while, we have reached Queen Tinomana’s village--a picturesque
-little grassy town, with brown thatched huts, and white concrete
-cottages washed with coral lime, and gay red and yellow leaved ti
-trees standing before almost every door--and the queen’s own palace,
-a handsome two-storeyed house, quite as fine as Makea’s, stands up in
-front of us.
-
-Passing by this piece of European splendour, we go to draw a more likely
-covert, and ere long flush our quarry in a little creeper-wreathed
-cottage, hidden behind bushes of deliciously scented frangipani and
-blazing red hibiscus. The queen is on the verandah, seated, like Makea,
-on an ironwood sofa of state. She sits here most of the day, having
-very little in the way of government to do, and no desire to trouble her
-amiable head with the white woman’s laborious methods of killing time.
-Sometimes she plaits a hat to amuse herself, being accomplished in this
-favourite Raratongan art--a sailor hat with a hard crown and stiff
-brim, and a good deal of neat but lacy fancy work in the twisting of the
-plait. Sometimes she receives friends, and hears gossip. Sometimes, she
-sleeps on the sofa, and wakes up to suck oranges and fall asleep again.
-The strenuous life is not the life beloved of Tinomana, nor (one may
-hint in the smallest of whispers) would her much more strenuous sister
-queen encourage any developments in that direction.
-
-It is well, under the circumstances, that both are suited by their
-respective rôles, otherwise the somewhat difficult lot of the Resident
-Commissioner might be rendered even more trying than it is.
-
-Tinomana is not young, and she is not lovely now, though one can see
-that she has been beautiful, as so many of the soft-eyed island women
-are, long ago. She has had her romance, however, and as we sit on her
-verandah, drinking and eating the cocoanut and banana of ceremony, the
-grey-haired white man who is husband of the queen tells the story to me
-of her love and his, just as it happened, once upon a time.
-
-In 1874 the Cook Islands were an independent group, governed by their
-own chiefs, or Arikis. The Arikis had much more power in those days than
-they are now allowed to exercise. They could order the execution of any
-subject for any cause; they could make war and end it: and no ship dared
-to call at the islands without their permission. They owned, as they
-still own, all the land, and their wealth of various kinds made them, in
-the eyes of the natives, millionaires as well as sovereigns.
-
-“Women’s rights” were a novelty to England thirty years ago, but in the
-Cook Islands they were fully recognised, even at that early period.
-The most powerful of the Arikis was Makea--then a girl, now an elderly
-woman, but always every inch a queen, and always keeping a firm hand on
-the sceptre of Raratonga. Any Cook Islands postage-stamp will show Makea
-as she was some ten years ago. In 1874 Makea and her consort, Ngamaru,
-were making plans for the marrying of Tinomana, a young Raratongan
-princess closely related to Makea. Tinomana would shortly become
-an Ariki, or queen, herself, and her matrimonial affairs were, in
-consequence, of considerable importance.
-
-What the plans of Raratonga’s rulers for Tinomana may have been matters
-little. Tinomana was pretty, with splendid long black hair, large soft
-brown eyes, an excellent profile, and a complexion little darker than a
-Spaniard’s. She was also self-willed, and could keep a secret as close
-as wax when she so desired. She had a secret at that time, and it
-concerned no South Sea Islander, but a certain good-looking young
-Anglo-American named John Salmon (grandson of a Ramsgate sea-captain,
-Thomas Dunnett), who had lately landed at Raratonga from the trading
-schooner _Venus_, and had been enjoying a good deal of the pretty
-princess’s society, unknown to the gossips of the island. It was a case
-of love at first sight; for the two had not been more than a few days
-acquainted when they came privately to James Chalmers, the famous
-missionary, then resident in Raratonga, and begged for a secret
-marriage.
-
-James Chalmers refused promptly to have anything to do with the matter,
-and furthermore told Tinomana that he would never marry her to any white
-man, no matter who it might be. In his opinion such a marriage would be
-certain to cause endless trouble with the other Arikis--apart from
-the fact that Queen Makea was against it. So the lovers went away
-disconsolate. Raratonga was keeping holiday at the time, because a great
-war-canoe was to be launched immediately, and a dance and feast were
-in preparation. But Tinomana and her lover were out of tune with the
-festivities, and no woman in the island prepared her stephanotis and
-hibiscus garlands for the feast, or plaited baskets of green palm leaves
-to carry contributions of baked sucking-pig and pineapples, with as
-heavy a heart as the little princess.
-
-On the day of the feast an idea came to Salmon. There were two schooners
-lying in Avarua harbour. One, the _Coronet_, had for a captain a man
-named Rose, who was as much opposed to Salmon’s marriage as Chalmers
-himself. The _Humboldt_ schooner, on the other hand, had a friend
-of Salmon’s in command. From him some help might be expected. Salmon
-visited him secretly, found that he was willing to assist, and
-arranged for an elopement that very night. Tinomana was willing; nobody
-suspected; and the feast would furnish a capital opportunity.
-
-There was no moon that evening, happily for the lovers, for the smallest
-sign would have awaked the suspicions of the watching _Coronet_. When
-the feast had begun, and all Raratonga was making merry with pig and
-baked banana, raw fish and pineapple beer, Tinomana contrived to slip
-away and get back to her house. Womanlike, she would not go without her
-“things”; and she took so long collecting and packing her treasures--her
-silk and muslin dresses, her feather crowns, her fans and bits of
-cherished European finery from far-away Auckland--that the suspicions of
-a prying girl were aroused. Out she came, accompanied by two others--all
-handmaidens to Tinomana--and charged the princess with an intention to
-elope. Tinomana acknowledged the truth, and ordered the girls to hold
-their tongues, offering them liberal rewards. This was not enough,
-however; the three girls demanded that Tinomana, in addition to buying
-their silence, should shield them from the possible wrath of the great
-Makea by taking them with her. She was forced to consent; and so, when
-the impatient lover, lurking in the darkness near the harbour, saw his
-lady coming at last, she came with three attendants, and almost enough
-luggage to rival Marie Antoinette’s encumbered flight to Varennes.
-
-Eventually, however, the party put off in a canoe, the girls lying flat
-in the bottom, with Tinomana crouching beside them and Salmon holding
-a lighted torch, which he waved in the air as they went. For the boat
-had to pass close by the Coronet, and Captain Rose, somehow or other,
-had become suspicious, and young Salmon knew he would think nothing of
-stopping any boat that could not give an account of itself. So Salmon
-took the torch, to look like a fishing-boat going out with spears and
-torches to the reef, and, paddling with one hand while he held the light
-aloft with the other, he passed the _Coronet_ safely, knowing well that
-his face would be unrecognisable at a distance of fifty yards or so in
-the wavering shadow of the flame.
-
-Beyond the reef lay the _Humboldt_ waiting. Tinomana and her maids and
-her luggage were swung up the side with small ceremony; Salmon hurried
-after, and a small but welcome breeze enabled the schooner to slip out
-to sea unnoticed in the dark. She made for Mangaia, another of the Cook
-Islands, some hundred and fifty miles away, and reached it in a couple
-of days. But the _Humboldt_ had hardly made the land when the dreaded
-_Coronet_ appeared on the horizon, carrying every stitch of sail, and
-with her decks, her “Jacob’s-ladder,” and her very yardarms crowded by
-furious Raratongans. The fugitives were caught!
-
-At first they had not been missed. The islanders were feasting and
-drinking, the Arikis were unsuspicious, and the _Coronet_ had seen only
-a fishing-canoe with a solitary man on board gliding out to the reef.
-But with the morning light came the knowledge that Tinomana was absent
-from her palace, that Salmon had not come home, and that the _Humboldt_
-was gone. Raratonga was enraged, and all the more so because pursuit
-appeared for the moment to be impossible. They knew that the _Humboldt_
-had probably made for Mangaia; but the breeze had died away, and
-the _Coronet_, her sails flapping idly against her rakish masts, lay
-helpless in harbour. Some brilliant spirit, however, proposed that the
-schooner should be towed out, in the hope of catching a breeze beyond
-the reef; and half a dozen great whaleboats, manned by powerful arms,
-were harnessed to the _Coronet’s_ bows. Out she came through the opening
-in the foaming coral reef, with screaming and splashing and tugging
-at oars, into the blue, open sea, and beyond the shelter of the peaky,
-purple hills. The breeze was met at last, the boats cast off and dropped
-astern, and the _Coronet_, carrying half Raratonga on board, set sail
-for Mangaia.
-
-Once within the range of the _Humboldt_ the _Coronet_ lowered a boatful
-of armed men, and the latter made for the schooner lying-to under
-the shelter of the Mangaian hills. Captain Harris, of the _Humboldt_,
-however, ordered his crew to shoot down the first man who attempted to
-board, and the attacking boat thought better of it. Beaten by force they
-tried diplomacy, in which they were more successful. They told Captain
-Harris that all his cargo of valuable cotton, lying on the wharf at
-Raratonga ready for shipment, would be destroyed unless he gave the
-princess back. This meant absolute ruin, and the captain had to submit.
-Salmon told Tinomana that it was best to give in for the present, as
-they were caught; but that the parting would be only for a time. And
-back to Raratonga went the disconsolate princess, bereft of her lover
-and her stolen wedding, and with the anticipation of a good scolding to
-come from the indignant Arikis.
-
-For some months after this disaster Salmon wandered about from island to
-island, living now in Raiatea, now in Flint Island, now in Mauke--always
-restless and always impatient. At last he judged the time had come to
-make a second attempt, and tried to obtain a passage to Raratonga.
-
-Schooner after schooner refused to take him, but finally a little vessel
-called the _Atalanta_ braved the wrath of the Arikis and brought
-him back. During his absence time had worked in his favour, and the
-opposition to the marriage was now much weaker. The Arikis received
-him coolly and fined him twenty pounds’ worth of needles, thread, and
-tobacco for his late excursion, but they no longer refused to let him
-see Tinomana. The missionary, however, still objected to the marriage,
-and as he was the only clergyman available for the ceremony it seemed as
-if things, on the whole, were “getting no forrader.”
-
-At this juncture the great Makea stepped in, and with the charming
-variability common to her sex, took the part of the lovers against all
-Raratonga as strongly as she had before opposed their union. She was not
-then in Raratonga, but in another of the Cook Islands, Atiu. From thence
-she sent the schooner _Venus_ to Raratonga, ordering the captain to
-fetch Tinomana and Salmon to Atiu, where the local missionary would
-marry them, or Makea would know the reason why.
-
-Raratonga--obstinate Raratonga!--still refused to give its princess to
-a foreign adventurer, though it trembled at the thought of defying the
-Elizabethan Makea. A band of warriors came down to the harbour to see
-that Salmon did not get on board the ship. As for Tinomana, they did not
-dare to oppose her departure, when the head of the house had actually
-summoned her. But the princess had no notion whatever of going alone.
-Salmon was smuggled on board in the dusk and hidden under a bunk. A pile
-of mats and native “pareos,” or kilts, was placed over him, and there,
-in the heat of the tropic night, he lay and sweltered, while the _Venus_
-swung to her cable and the warriors hunted the ship and found nothing.
-When they went off, baffled, the schooner put to sea. A Raratongan
-vessel, still suspicious, chased her to Atiu, but Makea informed the
-pursuing crew that it would be bad for their health to land on her
-property unasked; and, as this great Pacific Queen had, and has, the
-reputation of keeping her word when it is passed, the Raratongans did
-not dare to set foot on shore. This time it was they who went home
-disconsolate.
-
-And so the young couple were married “and lived happily ever after.”
- Tinomana and her consort now reside at Arorangi, Raratonga, in their
-long, low house, set among frangipani trees and oranges, and covered
-with flowering tropical creepers, and seldom or never occupy their
-palace. Tinomana’s five children are dead; she herself is growing old,
-but the memory of those long-past years of adventure and romance is
-still with her. Her life glides quietly and dreamily by, within
-the sound of the humming ocean surf, under the shadow of the purple
-Raratongan hills. She has had her day, and there remain the quiet sunset
-and the softened twilight, before the time of dark.
-
-The queen had little to say to us, for she does not speak English,
-nor is she shrewdly curious about men and things outside of sleepy
-Raratonga, like her sister sovereign, Makea. She smiled a good deal, and
-said some polite things about my dress, which illustrated a new fashion,
-and seemed to interest her more than anything else connected with the
-call. I had brought a gift with me for Tinomana, a silk scarf of a
-peculiarly screaming blue, and I presented it before I took my leave
-with some politenesses that the royal consort rapidly translated for me.
-The queen was much pleased with the gift, and began trying its effect on
-several different hats at once. Then we had some more cocoanut water and
-said good-bye, and drove home again in the yellow sunset.
-
-The crabs were getting noisy as we passed along a soft bit of sandy road
-close by the shore. They are fairly active all day, and at night seem to
-wake up a little more completely than before. One can hear them rattling
-and scratching loudly all over the stones and rubbish about the shore;
-the ground is riddled with their holes--as we pass, they dart in at
-their front doors as swiftly as spiders, and stand looking cautiously
-round a comer till the threatening apparition is gone. They are not nice
-things, these crabs--they are tall and spindly and insectlike in build,
-with a scrawny body set on eight spider-like legs, and ugly, sharp, thin
-claws. They live on the land, but haunt the beach a good deal, because
-of the débris to be found there, and they are such nasty feeders that
-not even the natives will eat them, which is saying a good deal.
-
-They have an uncanny fancy for coming into houses. If your residence is
-not raised up on a good Verandah, which they cannot surmount, you may be
-alarmed some night by a ghostly tapping and ticking on the floor, like
-nothing you have ever heard or dreamed of before, and while you are
-wondering fearfully what the sound may be, you will suddenly become
-aware of something clumsy and noisy scrambling among the mosquito
-curtains of your bed. At this, if you are of common human mould, you
-will arise hastily, tangling yourself up in the curtains as you do
-so, and call loudly for a light. And when one is brought, behold the
-offender scuttling hastily away on eight long thin legs into the outer
-dark, without stopping to make an explanation or an apology. You are
-so annoyed that you put on a dressing-gown and follow him out on the
-verandah, a stick in your hand and murder in your heart; but just as you
-reach the steps, there is a loud “flump” on the floor, and a centipede
-as big as a sausage, with a writhing black body and horrible red legs
-and antennae, flashes past the edge of your sweeping draperies. At this
-you give it up, and get back to your mosquito curtains.
-
-You are just falling asleep, when------ Good Heavens! what is it?
-
-Surely nothing but a burglar could have made that fearful noise in the
-outer kitchen!--a burglar, or a madman, or both in one. It sounds as if
-some one were beating somebody else with an iron bucket. Perhaps it
-may be only a native dog chasing a cat. Up go the curtains once more,
-letting half the mosquitoes in the island in, and off the wretched
-traveller sets for the kitchen, accompanied by a brave but pallid
-hostess, who says she is extremely sorry her husband _would_ choose this
-week for going away from home.
-
-There he is! there is the author of the noise--a black, bristly,
-incredibly hideous hermit crab as big as a biscuit--out of his shell,
-and fighting like grim death in an empty kerosene tin, with another crab
-nearly as big, and quite as vicious. Number one has got too big for the
-secondhand univalve shell he lived in, and is touring the country trying
-to replace it. Number two, also out-growing his clothes, has got half a
-broken sardine box in the kerosene tin (which acts as ash-bucket to the
-house), and he thinks it is the loveliest new shell he has ever seen.
-So, unluckily, does the other crab, and they are in the act of putting
-it to ordeal by combat, when we invade the scene of the battle, and
-rudely shake the crabs and the shells and the sardine tin all off the
-end of the verandah together.
-
-“What on earth brings crabs into people’s houses?” you ask amazedly,
-as you go back to bed again. It seems an insane action for any sensible
-crab, considering that we are half a mile from the sea.
-
-“Pure cussedness,” says my friend wrathfully. “They even climb up the
-verandah posts, and sit among the flowers. ‘What for? Spite, I think;
-there isn’t anything more ill-natured in the world than a hermit crab.”
-
-If it is not a moonlight night, now, we get to sleep at last, but if it
-is, and the oranges are ripe------
-
-Well, that is the time the “mor kiri-kiris” choose to perform their
-orisons; and when they are playing the devil with the holy peace and
-calm of midnight on the roof, not even a fourth mate newly come off his
-watch, could sleep below.
-
-“Here, you blank, blank, blank, unspeakable, etcetera, let go that
-orange!”
-
-“I shan’t, blank your double-blank limbs and wings! I got it first!”
-
-“Then just look out, you mangy, fox-faced, clumsy-winged beast, for I’ll
-rip the inside out of your rotten carcase with my claws.”
-
-“Like to see you!” (somewhat muffled with stolen orange).
-
-“You will!”
-
-Shriek, shriek, yell, howl, scream.
-
-“You’ve bitten my toe off, you trebly-blanked vermin!”
-
-“Meant to!”
-
-“Clear off!”
-
-“Won’t!”
-
-“Come on again, then!”
-
-“Pax! pax! here’s the great pig with fur on its head that lives in the
-house, coming out with a gun. I’m off.”
-
-“So am I, but we’ll go back again the moment it goes in.” That is the
-way one sleeps in the orange season, in a place that happens to be
-popular with the “mor kiri-kiri,” or flying-fox--a bat with a furry body
-as big as a cat’s, long sharp white teeth, a head exactly like a fox,
-and the crustiest disposition of anything living on the island.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER V
-
-_Feasting and Fun on Steamer Day--The Brown People of Rara-tonga--Who
-sent back the Teeth?--Divorce made easy--Climbing a Tropical Mountain--A
-Hot-water Swim--Out on the Rainbow Coral Reef--Necklaces for No One._
-
-STEAMER day in Raratonga, as in all the islands that rejoice in the
-privilege of a regular steamer service, is beyond comparison the event
-of the month. Almost before dawn on the day which is expected to see
-the boat arrive, the traders are up and about, seeing to the carting of
-their fruit and copra, and making ready the shelves of the stores for
-the new goods coming in from Auckland. All the residents, men and women,
-white and brown, are getting out the cleanest of muslins and drill
-suits, and looking up the shoe-whitening box, which perhaps has not been
-much in demand since the steamer called on her way back from Tahiti
-last month. The daughters of the white community are making tinned-peach
-pies, and dressing fowls, in case of callers--these are the inevitable
-“company” dishes of the Pacific--and the native women are bringing out
-their newly made straw hats, and, ironing their gayest of pink or yellow
-or scarlet cotton, squatting cross-legged on the floor as they work.
-Cocoanuts for drinking are being husked by the men of the village, and
-laid in neat piles under the verandahs, out of the sun; and in most of
-the little birdcage houses, the children are impounded to grate cocoanut
-meat for cream; while the dying yells of pigs make day hideous from the
-groves beyond the town.
-
-When the tiny trail of smoke, for which every one is looking, first
-rises out of the empty sea, it may be on the day expected, or it may be
-later--there is little time in the Great South Seas--the whole island is
-agape with excitement. The natives shriek with delight, and make haste
-to gather flowers for wreaths and necklaces; the clean suits and frocks
-are put on by brown and white alike, and the populace begins to
-hover about the wharf like a swarm of excited butterflies. The great
-whale-boats are ready to rush out at racing speed to the steamer, long
-before she comes to a stop in the bay--she dares not come into the
-harbour, which is only fit for small craft--passengers from Auckland
-come ashore, anxious to see the island curiosities, and find to
-their embarrassment that they are unmistakably regarded in that light
-themselves; and, as soon as may be, the mail comes after them. Upon
-which events, the whole population makes for the Government buildings,
-and flings itself in one seething breaker against the door of the Post
-Office, demanding its mails. While the letters are being sorted by a
-handful of officials locked and barred out of reach within, it rattles
-at the doors and windows, and as soon as the bolts are withdrawn, the
-mighty host, breathless and ruthless, bursts in like a besieging army.
-But when all are in, nobody has patience to wait and open papers, in
-order to know what has been going on in the outer world all these weeks.
-Purser, passengers, and even sailors are seized upon, and compelled to
-stand and deliver news about “the war,” and other burning questions,
-before any one thinks of opening the envelopes and wrappers in their
-hands.
-
-Minds being satisfied, bodies now assert their claim. Steamer day is
-feast day--beef day, ice day, day for enjoying all the eatables that
-cannot be had in the island itself. There is mutton in Raratonga, but
-not much at the best of times, and of beef there is none at all. So all
-the white folk order beef to come up monthly in the ship’s cold storage,
-and for two happy days--the meat will keep no longer--they enjoy a feast
-that might perhaps more fairly be called a “feed.” About noon on steamer
-day, a savoury smell, to which the island has long been a stranger,
-begins to diffuse itself throughout Avarua. Every one, with true island
-hospitality, is asking every one else to lunch and dinner, to-day and
-to-morrow, so that Mrs. A. and her family may have a taste of Mr. B.’s
-sirloin, and Mr. B. get a bit of the C.’s consignment of steak, and the
-A.’s and B.’s and E.’s enjoy a little bit of Colonel Z.’s roast ribs.
-A sensuous, almost unctuous, happiness shines like a halo about every
-face, and after dusk white dinner coats flit up and down the perfumed
-avenues, thick as night-moths among the orange bloom overhead. Tomorrow
-there will be great doings in the pretty bungalow on the top of the
-hill, for the Resident Commissioner has got a big lump of ice as a
-present from the captain of the steamer, and is hoarding it up in
-blankets to give a dinner-party in its honour. The white man who could
-consume a lump of ice all by himself, in the island world, would be
-considered capable of any crime, and the hospitable Commissioner is the
-last person to shirk his obligations in such a matter.
-
-Once the steamer has come and gone, a dreamy peace settles down upon the
-island. There is seldom much certainty as to clock time, since every one
-goes by his own time-piece, and all vary largely, nor does any one heed
-the day of the month overmuch. This pleasant disregard of time is the
-true secret of the fascination of island life--or perhaps one of
-the secrets, since no one has ever really succeeded in defining the
-unspeakable charm of these lotus lands. Imagine a civilised community,
-where people dine out in evening dress, leave cards and have “At Home”
- days, yet where there is no post except the monthly ship mail, there are
-no telegrams, trains, trams, times, appointments, or engagements of any
-kind! Picture the peace that comes of knowing certainly that, for all
-the time of the steamer’s absence there can be no disturbance of the
-even current of life; no great events at home or abroad, no haste, or
-worry, or responsibility! People keep young long in Raratonga; faces are
-free from weariness and strain; the white man with the “burden” laughs
-as merrily and as often as the brown man who carries nought but his
-flowery necklace and his pareo. Nobody is rich--rich men do not come
-down to the islands to run small plantations, or trading stores, or to
-take up little appointments under a little Government--but every one has
-enough, and extravagance is impossible, since luxuries are unpurchasable
-on the island. There are so social distinctions, save that between white
-and brown--all the seventy or eighty white residents knowing one
-another on a footing of common equality, although in England or even New
-Zealand, they would certainly be split up into half a score of mutually
-contemptuous sets.
-
-As for the natives--the jolly, laughing,-brown-skinned, handsome men and
-women of the island--their life is one long day of peace and leisure and
-plenty. The lands of the six thousand who once inhabited Raratonga are
-now for the most part in the hands of the nineteen hundred survivors,
-and every native has therefore a good deal more than he wants.
-Breadfruit; bananas of many kinds, oranges, mammee-apples, and countless
-other fruits, grow altogether, or almost, without cultivation; taro,
-yam, and sweet potatoes need little, and cocoanuts are always to be had.
-A native house can be put up in a day or two, furniture is superfluous,
-and clothes consist of a few yards of cotton print. The Raratongan,
-therefore, owes no tale of labour to Nature or Society for his existence
-in quiet comfort, if he does not choose to work. But in many cases he
-does choose, for he wants a buggy and a horse, and a bicycle or two, and
-a sewing machine for his wife; shoes with squeaking soles for
-festive wear--deliberately made up with “squeakers” for island trade,
-these--bottles of coarse strong scent, tins of meat and salmon as
-an occasional treat, and, if he is ambitious, one of those concrete,
-iron-roofed houses of which I have already spoken, to enhance his social
-position, and make the neighbours envious, what time he continues to
-live peaceably and comfortably in his palm hut outside--not being quite
-such a fool in this matter as he looks.
-
-Sometimes the Raratongan will go so far as to get his front teeth
-stopped with gold by a travelling dentist, purely for style, since he
-is gifted by nature with grinders that will smash any fruit stone,
-and incisors that will actually tear the close tough husk off a
-huge cocoanut without trouble. It is related of one of the wealthier
-Raratongans that, being stricken in years and short of teeth, he
-purchased a set of false ones from a visiting dentist, and that the
-latter, when he next returned to the island, was astonished to find the
-set thrown on his hands as no good, on the grounds that they would not
-husk cocoanuts!
-
-In order to secure all these more or less desirable luxuries, the
-Raratongan trades in fruit and copra. That is to say, he cuts up
-and dries (strictly at his leisure, and when he feels like it) a few
-thousand cocoanuts, or nails up some hundreds of oranges, and scores of
-banana bunches, from his overflowing acres, in wooden crates, to send
-down to Auckland. This labour, repeated a few times, brings him in good
-British gold by the handful. Copra, sold to the traders in the town,
-fetches about seven pounds a ton, and a family working for a few days
-can prepare as much as that. Other produce is hardly less profitable, to
-a cultivator who has more land than he wants, provides his own labour,
-and need spend nothing on seeds or plants. There is, at most, only light
-work, and that seldom, so that the Raratongan can, and often does, spend
-the greater part of his time singing in choruses on the verandahs of
-the houses, dancing to the thrilling beat of a native drum under the
-cocoanut trees, or fishing lazily off the reef.
-
-The Raratongans are all, to a man, good Christians--good Protestants
-of the Dissenting variety, good Catholics, and, in a few cases,
-enthusiastic Seventh Day Adventists--being readily enough inclined to
-adhere to a cult that makes it sinful to work on the seventh day of
-the week, and impossible to work on the first. It is said that Mormon
-missionaries have visited the group, but failed to make converts.
-Without going into details that might disturb the sensitive mind,
-one feels obliged to remark, in this connection, that the failure was
-probably on all fours, as to cause, with the ill-success of the merchant
-who attempted to sell coals to Newcastle.
-
-And--still concerning this matter--“one word more, and I have done.”
- Some weeks after my arrival, I was going round the group in company with
-the Resident Commissioner and a few more officials, who were
-holding courts and administering justice in the various islands. The
-Commissioner was late getting back to the ship one afternoon, and the
-captain asked him if he had been detained.
-
-“Only a little while,” replied the guardian angel of the group,
-cheerfully rattling his pockets, which gave forth a pleasant chinking
-sound. “Another dozen of divorces. We’ll have a new road round the
-island next year.” And he went to dinner.
-
-Divorce in the Cook Islands is not an expensive luxury. If memory serves
-me right, it costs under thirty shillings, and there is a sixpence
-somewhere in the price--I am unable to say why. But I remember very well
-indeed, after the officials had gone home, when I was travelling round
-about other islands with a captain, who had just taken over the ship and
-did not know the Cook group, that dignitary came to me one day and said:
-
-“I can’t make out these hands of mine. They’re a very decent lot for
-niggers, and don’t give no trouble, but one and another, now that we’re
-going round the islands, keeps coming to me and asking me for an advance
-on their wages, because, says they, they’ve been a long time from home,
-and they wants it--and every blessed one of them he wants the same
-advance!”
-
-“Was it so-and-so?” I asked, mentioning a certain small sum with a
-sixpence in it.
-
-“How on earth did you know?” was the reply.
-
-“Price of a divorce from the Commissioner,” I explained.
-
-“Well!” said the captain, who was a hard-shelled old whaler, with a
-strong religious cast. And again--“Well!”
-
-“That’s what I think myself,” I explained. “But it certainly fills
-the exchequer. I hear the score runs up to ten or twelve apiece, often
-enough.”
-
-“Disgustin’,” said the captain, spitting over the rail.
-
-“Certainly,” I agreed.
-
-But the incident has its own significance, so I have recorded it.
-
-I linger long over the life and ways of Raratonga, for I spent many
-very happy weeks there--studying native customs, and taking notes? Well,
-perhaps--a little, at all events. Raratonga is not quite so lazy a place
-as Tahiti, and the climate is less trying. Still--still------
-
-How impossible it is to explain to the reader who has never spent a
-hot season in the tropics! I think I shall not try. There were missed
-opportunities--there were things I ought to have studied, and did not,
-and things I should have seen, and didn’t see. It is of no use to
-say why. Those who have passed between the magic line of Cancer
-and Capricorn will not need to ‘be told, and the others could not
-understand.
-
-I did something to satisfy my conscience, however, when I climbed the
-highest mountain in Raratonga--a peak something over three thousand feet
-high, so the residents said. It was reported that the Admiralty survey
-did not agree by a hundred feet or so, with the local estimate. I know
-myself that both were wrong; that peak is ten thousand, or perhaps a
-little more. Did it not take myself and two or three others from seven
-a.m. until nine p.m to get up and down, working as hard as white ants
-(there is nothing in the islands really busy except the ants) all the
-time?
-
-We went the wrong way--several wrong ways--we lost our food and our
-water, and got so thirsty that we licked the leaves of the trees, and so
-hungry that it was agony to know ourselves above the zone of the orange
-and banana all day, and see the food we could not reach till night
-hanging in clusters far below. We did most of our climbing by the heroic
-method of swarming up perpendicular rock faces on the ladders of the
-creepers, and a good deal of it by scrambling along in the tops of small
-trees, like monkeys. When we got to the top there was just room for the
-whole party to stand and cheer, and we cheered ourselves vigorously.
-People do not climb mountains--much--in the islands of the Pacific, and
-the peak we were on had been trodden by only one or two white men, and
-no white women.
-
-“There used to be natives up here often enough, some years ago, shooting
-wild fowl,” said one of our guides, letting the smoke of his pipe curl
-out over “half a duchy,” lying blue and green, and far, far down, under
-his elbow. “But they stopped coming. Several of ’em got killed, and
-the others didn’t think it good enough.”
-
-“How did they get killed?” I ask, listening to the wild cocks crowing in
-the sea of green down below, like a farm-yard gone astray.
-
-“Oh, climbing!”
-
-When we had finished admiring the view of the island, we started down
-again. And now, what with our hunger, and our fatigue, and the wild
-adventures in impossible places we had had coming up, we all became
-rather tired, and more than rather reckless. Over and over again,
-slithering down steep descents, we let ourselves go, and tobogganed,
-sitting, we did not care where. The lianas crashed, the red-flowered
-rata snapped and fell on us, the lace-like tree ferns got in our way
-with their damp black trunks, and banged us as we tumbled past. Every
-one knew that if we did not get off the precipice slopes before dark, we
-should have to halt wherever we might be, and wait till morning, holding
-tight to the trunk of a tree to keep from falling down into depths
-unknown. But no one said anything about it.
-
-And in the end, we got back safe--sore and tired and hungry; not
-thirsty, however, for we had found a stream in the interminable dark of
-the valley, and had all put our heads into it like brutes, the moment
-our feet felt the welcome hollow and splashed into the water. The ladies
-of the party had not a whole gown among them, and not very much else,
-so shrewdly had the thorns and creepers of the close-knitted forest
-squeezed and torn us. Still, we had got up where no white women had been
-before, and we were all very proud, though we had to slink homeward in
-the dark, avoiding the lights of the houses, and each slip in unobserved
-at the back doors of our respective homes. But we had done the climb,
-and------ “That was something,” as Hans Andersen would have said.
-
-Picnics we had in plenty, while I stayed. Sometimes they were bathing
-picnics, when the ladies of half a dozen houses went off to spend the
-day down on the shore, and swim in the lagoon. The water, not more than
-five feet deep in any place, was the colour of green grass when the sun
-shines through, and it was as warm as an ordinary hot bath. One could
-spend hour after hour amusing Oneself with swimming tricks, coming out
-now and then to roast for a little on the hot, snow-white coral
-sand, where bits and branches of coral pretty enough for a museum lay
-scattered everywhere, and exquisite flowering creepers spread their long
-green tails of leafage--often thirty or forty, feet in length, and all
-starred with pink or yellow blossoms--right across the broad expanse of
-the beach. Coming out finally, it was customary to find a big rock, and
-stand-with one’s back against it till the wet bathing dress was half
-dried with the blistering heat of the stone. This was supposed to
-prevent chills. I think myself that one would have to hunt a chill very
-hard indeed in the hot season in Raratonga, before catching it. It is
-not a place where one hears of “chill” troubles, and there is no fever
-of any kind. When you find a draught there, you tell every one else in
-the house about it, and they come and sit in it with you. When you give
-tea, to callers, it is correct to serve cold water on the tray to temper
-the beverage, and put a spoon instead of a butter knife, in the butter
-dish.
-
-Nor does it cool down overmuch at night, in the hot months, though in
-the “cold” ones, you may want a blanket now and then. The temperature
-being so equable all round, chills are, naturally, not to be looked for
-and feared at every turn, as in the great tropic continents, where there
-is no surrounding sea to prevent rapid radiation of heat, and sudden
-changes of temperature are frequent and deadly. On the whole, there is
-much to be said in favour of the climate of the Southern Pacific, and
-little against it. It enjoys a long cool season of at least six months,
-when the heat is not at all oppressive. Three months of the year
-are very hot and damp, and three neither hot nor cool. At worst, the
-thermometer seldom goes above ninety in the shade. White children can
-be brought up in the islands without injury to health, and many of the
-older residents have spent the best part of a long life in the South
-Seas, and attained to a venerable age, without ever suffering from
-illness. The Government doctor in Raratonga leads an easy life on the
-whole, and in the other islands of the Cook Group the entire absence of
-medical advice seems to trouble no one.
-
-A reefing picnic was among the many pleasant entertainments to which I
-was invited during my stay. “Reefing” is such a favourite entertainment
-in the islands that nearly every white woman has a reefing skirt and
-shoes in her wardrobe--the former short, like a hockey skirt, the
-latter stout and old. Buggies are gathered together in the town, and the
-picnickers drive to a suitable spot some distance away, where the horses
-are taken out and tethered, and the “reefers” secure a canoe to bring
-them to their destination--the coral barrier reef, lying between the
-lagoon and the sea.
-
-Paddled by some of the native guests (for there are generally a few
-Raratongans included in the party) the canoes glide easily over
-the shallow water towards the reef, flights of the exquisite little
-sapphire-coloured fish that haunt the coral rocks, scattering beneath
-the keel like startled butterflies. Now the water is of the most vivid
-and burning emerald, shooting green lightnings to the sun, now, as we
-near the reef, it begins to change in colour, and-----
-
-Oh!
-
-Why, the canoe is floating on a liquid rainbow--on a casket of jewels
-melted down and poured into the burning sea--on glancing shades of
-rose, and quivering gleams of violet, and gold and blue and amethyst and
-chrysophrase, all trembling and melting one into another in marvels
-of colouring that leave all language far behind. Under the keel, as we
-shoot forward, rise and sink wonderful water-bouquets of purple, pink,
-and pearl; great lacy fans of ivory; frilled and fluted fairy shells,
-streamers of brilliant weed, and under and through all these wonders
-glint, from far below, the dark blue depths of unplumbed caverns
-beneath. It is the coral reef, and we are going to land upon a
-spot exposed by the tide, and see what we can see of these wonders,
-by-and-by. If we were bent on fishing, we might spend a pleasant hour or
-two catching some of these peacock and parrot-coloured fish that flutter
-through these wonderful water-gardens. But reefing proper is more
-amusing, after all.
-
-At a point where the coral juts out above the sea, we leave the canoe,
-and start to walk about. It is very like trying to walk on a gigantic
-petrified hair-brush. The coral is peaked and pointed, and wrought into
-honeycombed sponges of stone, and there is nowhere for the foot to rest
-in security. Besides, the reef is covered with sea urchins possessing
-spines as long and sharp as a big slate-pencil, and these things pierce
-through any but the stoutest shoes. The colours of the sea-urchins are
-fascinating, and we pick up a good many, in spite of difficulties. Then
-there are tiger shells, shiny and spotted, in hues of orange and brown,
-and beautiful scarlet and pinky and lilac and chequered shells, and
-the daintiest of goffered clam shells, pearl white within, ivory white
-without, as large as a pea-pod, or as large as a vegetable dish--you
-may take your choice. And, if you are lucky, there is a varnished brown
-snail shell that you would not think worth picking up, if you did not
-happen to know that it has a “peacock-eye” gem, good to set in brooches,
-inside its plain little front door--like the homely brown toad of fable,
-that carried a jewel in its head. Much other spoil there is to put
-in your basket, and many things that you have no desire to possess at
-all--among them the huge hanks of slimy black string, which are alive,
-and wrigglesome, and not at all pleasant to put your hand on--and the
-wicked-faced great eels that look suddenly out of holes, and vanish,
-bubbling; and the revolting, leprous-spotted fish with the spiny back,
-that one may chance to see lurking at the bottom of a pool, every spine
-charged full of deadly poison for whoever touches it with unwary foot
-or hand. Indeed, the friends who are with you will warn you not to put
-your fingers into any pool, but to hook out shells and other spoil
-with a stick, if you want to be really careful, for there, are as many
-stinging and biting things among the beauties of the coral reef, as
-there thorns in a bed of roses.
-
-I have secured a good many shells, and a Reckitt’s blue star-fish as
-big as a dinner-plate, and one or two other curiosities, and now I want,
-above everything else, one of those miraculous coral bouquets that bloom
-so temptingly just beneath the surface at this point. One of my friends
-asks me which I will have--with a smile, that, somehow or other, seems
-to amuse the rest. I select a pinky-violet one, and with some dragging
-and pounding, it is detached, and held up in the sun.
-
-“Oh!” I exclaim disappointedly, and every one laughs. The beautiful
-bunch of coral flowers is a dirty liver-colour, and the magical hues are
-gone.
-
-“It’s the water that gives the colours,” explains the coral-gatherer.
-“Every one is awfully disappointed about it.”
-
-“Are there no colours at all, then?”
-
-“Oh yes, a little shade of pinkiness, and a touch of green, and that
-purply-brown. But you should see the corals when they are cleaned
-and dried. You’d better have these, you won’t know them when they are
-bleached; they’re like spider’s webs and lace furbelow things, all in
-white.”
-
-“Is there none of the real red stuff?” I ask somewhat ruefully,
-balancing myself with difficulty upon a sort of ornamental sponge-basket
-of spiky coral.
-
-“Not here. All these volcanic islands have a ring of coral reef right
-round, but the coral is always the white kind. There’s a very little red
-coral in Samoa, and about Penrhyn, I believe. But, speaking generally,
-it’s all white in the Pacific.”
-
-I think of the dreams of my childhood, and the delightful pictures of
-palmy islands circled round with a chevaux-de-frise of high spiky red
-coral, which used to flit before my fancy on holiday afternoons. It is
-true that the cold practicalities of the _Voyage of the Challenger_,
-which somebody gave me in my “flapper” days, once and for all, to my
-bitter disappointment, knocked the bottom out of those cherished schemes
-of going away to live on something like a glorified coral necklace, some
-day. But I wonder, as I get into the canoe again, and glide shorewards
-and teawards, paddled by the swift brown arms of native girls, how many
-grown-up people still hold to that delightful fancy, not knowing that it
-is as impossible to realise as a dream of rambling in the moon?
-
-Tea is preparing on the shore when we get back, very wet and dirty, but
-very well pleased. The native girls among the guests immediately offer
-us spare dresses. It is the mode among Raratongans to take two or three
-dresses to a picnic, and retire every now and then into the bush to
-change one smart muslin or cotton “Mother Hubbard” for another--just for
-pure style. So there are plenty of clothes to spare, and in a minute or
-two the damp, sea-weedy “reefers” are fitted out with flowing garments
-of clean cambric and silk, of a mode certainly better adapted to the
-climate than the fitted garments of the “papalangi.”
-
-This question of dress is a burning one among island ladies. The native
-loose robe, hung straight down from a yoke, is very much cooler, and
-the doctors say, healthier, than belted and corseted dresses such as
-European women wear. But there is nevertheless a strong feeling against
-it, because it is supposed to mean a tendency to “go native,” and the
-distinguishing customs of the race acquire, in the island world, a
-significance quite out of proportion to their surface importance,
-because of the greatness of the thing they represent. Therefore, the
-white woman, unless she is suffering from bad health, and needs every
-possible help to withstand the heat of the climate, sticks to her
-blouses and corsets, as a rule, and sometimes “says things” about people
-who do not. For all that, and all that, the native woman is in the
-right, and if the other would agree to adopt the pretty, womanly, and
-essentially graceful robe of the native, no one would be the loser, and
-half of island humanity would be greatly the gainer.
-
-Later, when the dusk is coming down, and the magic moon of the islands
-is creeping, big and round and yellow-gold, out of a purple sea, we
-drive home again through the scented gloom of the forest, the endless
-song of the reef accompanying the voices of the native women, as they
-chant strange island melodies of long ago, that no one in these days,
-not even the singers themselves, can fully translate or understand. The
-moon climbs quickly up as we drive, and the road is as light as day,
-when our wheels roll into the sleeping town.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER VI
-
-_The Simple Life in the South Seas--Servant Problems again--Foods and
-Fruits of the Country--The Tree that digests--Home-made Vanilla--The
-Invaluable Lime--How to cook a Turtle--In an Island Bungalow--The Little
-House on the Coral Shore--Humours of Island Life--Burying a Cycle--A
-Network of Names--Mr. Zebedee-Thunderstorm-Tin-Roof--The Night-dress
-that went to Church--The Extraordinary Wedding--South Sea Musicians--A
-Conductor’s Paradise--Society Journalism in Song._
-
-HOUSEKEEPING in the South Sea Islands demands a section to itself. All
-who are uninterested in such matters may, and doubtless will, begin to
-skip at this point.
-
-Nothing helps the white house-mistress more than the simple standard of
-living set in most of the islands. It is true that if you are the wife
-of an important official in the Government House entourage of Fiji, or
-if you live in civilised, Americanised Honolulu, you will have to “do
-things” much as they are done at home. But, with these two exceptions,
-life in that enormous section of the globe known as the South Seas (much
-of it, by the way,--is north of the Line) is simple and unpretentious.
-In describing the home life of the white settlers in Raratonga,
-I describe what is, with small local variations, the life of settlers
-in almost every group of the Pacific, certainly, the life of all in the
-eight different groups I visited myself, during the years I spent in the
-South Seas. All over the island world, people dine in the middle of the
-day, except when entertaining friends, keep few servants or none, and
-dress and feed simply, because nothing else is possible. The trade
-cottons in the stores form the material of every lady’s dresses, and
-as for the making, common consent, not to speak of climatic conditions,
-votes the simplest style the best. Where every stitch of sewing in dress
-or blouse must be done by the person who is to wear the garment, it is
-astonishing how soon one grows to regard elaborate tuckings, flouncings,
-inlayings, with hostility, and how satisfied the eye becomes with the
-simpler and less “fatigued” lines of the garments fashioned by women
-who cannot hire a dressmaker for love or money. Evening dress is
-almost always of the “blouse” description, and in a climate which works
-universal mischief with delicate white skins, no matter how they are
-protected, this is no matter for regret. Men buy their drill suits
-ready-made from the trading stores at a few shillings apiece, and, with
-a white dinner-jacket and black cummerbund, any one is ready for the
-gayest of evening entertainments.
-
-The great dress question--being thus resolved into the simple elements
-of a few cotton frocks for every day, and a muslin or two for best,
-behold! half the worry of modern life is lifted at a blow. “One must
-look like other people”--the goad of the toiling townswoman--becomes
-in the islands, “One looks like other people because one must,” and the
-words are a lullaby of rest.
-
-After dress, comes servants, in the list of small worries that turn
-a woman’s fair locks grey, and swell the takings of the fashionable
-hairdressers. Well, it cannot be said that there is no servant trouble
-in the islands. White servants simply do not exist; they are far too
-much in demand in America and Australasia to desert either of these
-domestic paradises for the hotter and lonelier islands. Native girls
-cannot be had either, since they marry at thirteen or thereabouts.
-Native boys and men are the only resource. They come to work by the day,
-and are fed in the house; their wages are generally about five shillings
-weekly, in the case of a boy, and ten shillings for a man. So far as
-they go, they are satisfactory enough; they work hard, and are extremely
-honest, and they are amiability and good-nature itself. But their scope
-is decidedly limited. They can garden, under direction; they can
-sweep, fetch wood and water, clean the cooking-stove, husk and open the
-cocoanuts, wash, peel and boil the vegetables, scrub the verandah floor,
-clean the knives, wash up dishes, and whiten the shoes. That is about
-all. The mistress of the house and her daughters, if she is lucky enough
-to have any, must do all the serious cooking, make the beds, dust, tidy,
-and lay the table for meals.
-
-One cannot say, however, that health suffers from the necessity of doing
-a certain amount of housework every day. On the contrary, the white
-women of the islands are strong and handsome, and do not seem to suffer
-from the heat nearly so much as the semi-invalid ladies who have come
-to be regarded as the type of white womanhood in India, that paradise of
-excellent service and servants.
-
-Otherwise, the islands help out the housekeeper considerably. She can
-grow as much excellent coffee as the family are likely to want, on a
-few bushes in the back yard, and peppers only have to be pulled off the
-nearest wild chili tree. Taro, yam, sweet potato, can be bought from
-the natives for a trifle, or grown with very little trouble. There will
-probably be enough breadfruit, mango, orange, lime, and mammee-apple in
-the grounds of the house, to supply all the family needs, and if any
-one likes chestnuts, they can be picked up under the huge maupei trees
-along any road. The mammee-apple or paw-paw, mentioned above, is one of
-the most characteristic fruits of the islands. In Raratonga, it grows
-with extraordinary fertility, springing up of itself wherever scrub is
-cleared away, and coming to maturity in a few months. It is a slender
-palm-like tree, from ten to thirty feet high, with a quaintly scaled
-trunk, very like the skin of some great serpent, and a crown of pointed,
-pinnated leaves, raying out fanwise from the cluster of heavy green and
-yellow fruit that hangs in the centre. The fruit itself is rather like
-a small melon, though wider at one end than the other. It looks likes a
-melon, too, when cut open, and is both refreshing and satisfying, with a
-sweetish, musky flavour, The small, soft black seeds in the centre are
-a sovereign cure for dyspepsia, as is also the fruit itself in a lesser
-degree. The whole of this wonderful tree, indeed, seems to be possessed
-of digestive powers, for the toughest fowl or piece of salt beef will
-become tender in a few hours, if wrapped in its leaves. When boiled in
-the green stage the fruit is undistinguishable from vegetable marrow,
-and if cooked ripe, with a little lime juice, it can be made into a
-mock apple pie, much appreciated by settlers in a land where the typical
-British fruit cannot be grown.
-
-Cooking bananas are much used, and grow wild on the lands of the
-natives, who sell them for a trifle. Every house has its own patch of
-eating bananas of many kinds, and orange-trees are almost sure to be
-there as well. There is always a huge bunch of bananas, and two or three
-great palm-leaf baskets of oranges, on the verandah of every house, and
-the inmates consume them both in uncounted numbers all day. Pineapples
-are easily raised in the little bit of garden, or they can be bought for
-a penny a piece. A vanilla vine will probably spread its beautiful thick
-leaves over the fence, and hang out, in due season, a store of pods for
-flavouring use in the kitchens. Arrowroot may be grown or bought--a big
-basket sells for sixpence, and it has no more to do with the arrowroot
-of the grocer’s shop at home, than a real seal mantle worth three
-figures has to do with a two guinea “electric”. Limes grow wild
-everywhere, and the island housewife makes full use of them. They clean
-her floors, her tables, her enamelled ware, stained table linen, or
-marked clothing; they wash her hair delightfully, and take the sunburn
-off her face and hands; they make the best of “long drinks,” and the
-daintiest of cake flavouring, they are squeezed into every fruit salad,
-and over every stew; they take the place of vinegar, if the island
-stores run low; in truth, they are used for almost every purpose of
-domestic cooking, cleaning, or chemistry.
-
-Cabbage of an excellent kind grows wild in a few islands. Tomatoes,
-small but excellent in flavour, are found on the borders of the
-seashore, in many. Nearly all English vegetables are grown by the white
-settlers with extremely little trouble. The egg-plant, known in England
-as a greenhouse ornament, here thrives splendidly in gardens, and
-instead of the little plum-like fruit of the British plant, produces a
-great purple globe as big as a fine marrow, which resembles fried eggs
-very closely, if sliced and cooked in a pan. But in truth there is no
-limit to the richness and generosity of the island soil. Were it not
-for the troublesome item of butcher’s meat, housekeeping in the
-Pacific would be marvellously cheap and easy. That, however, is the
-housekeeper’s bugbear. Outside of Samoa, Fiji, Tonga, Tahiti, the
-Marquesas, and Honolulu, fresh beef is not be had at all, and fresh
-mutton not often. In very many islands tinned meat and fowls are the
-only resource; and the lady of the house must tax her ingenuity to the
-utmost to find ways of disguising the inevitable “tin.” Curry, stew,
-pie, mince; mince, pie, stew, curry--so runs the monotonous programme in
-most houses; and disguise it as one may, the trail of the tin is over it
-all.
-
-It is a great day in the islands when turtle are caught. They are not
-common in the groups frequented by white people, since they prefer the
-lonely, barren atolls where the soil is dry and infertile; but now and
-then a “school” is found, and a big catch made. Then there is rejoicing
-in the land, and cooking in every house of an uncommonly-liberal and
-elaborate kind. The South Sea turtle are enormous, often weighing as
-much as seven or eight hundred pounds, and occasionally touching the
-thousand. Such a monster as this would easily feed a large household for
-a week--but alas, in tropical climates fresh meat, even when scalded,
-will not keep more than three days; so a good deal is usually wasted.
-The famous turtle soup, is made from the flippers, which are full of
-gelatine; and it may safely be assumed that no London aldermen fed on
-dying creatures carried half across the world has ever tasted soup so
-good as that made from a fine healthy turtle just out of the sea. The
-grass-green fat of the upper shell is used to put in the soup, and to
-fry the thick steaks of turtle beef, also to baste the big roast of
-turtle meat that is generally a feature of a turtle dinner. The eggs (of
-which there will probably be a large bucketful at least) are fried in
-green fat, and eaten as they are, shell-less, crisp and golden, tasting
-rather like roast chestnut. The tripe is cooked like ordinary tripe; the
-liver is fried. An excellent dinner, but surely an indigestible one?
-By no means. It is a curious property of this turtle meat that a much
-larger quantity of it can be eaten than of any ordinary butcher’s meat,
-without any sense of repletion or after ill effects. This is the great
-dainty of the South Sea islands, and if to a turtle dinner be added
-bisque soup made from mountain river crayfish, a real island fruit
-salad, with lime juice and cocoanut cream, a freshly plucked pineapple,
-a dish of mangoes, granadillas, and a cup of island-grown coffee, not
-the Carlton or the Savoy could do better for a travelling prince.
-
-All South Sea Island “white” houses are more or less alike, being
-built of coral concrete (occasionally of wood) and fitted with imported
-windows and doors. The verandah is the great feature of the building;
-for there the family will probably spend most of their time, reading,
-smoking, receiving callers, or simply lounging in long chairs and
-listening to the monotonous singing of the natives in the thatched reed
-houses near at hand. Splendid climbing plants wreathe the pillars
-and sloping roofs of these verandahs--stephanotis, Bougainvillea,
-and countless gay tropical flowers whose ugly Latin names only an
-accomplished botanist could remember. Gardenias, gorgeous white trumpet
-lilies, tall bushes of begonia; pink, yellow and scarlet hibiscus,
-crimson poinsettia, delicate eucharis lilies, run riot about the
-grounds, and orange and lemon flowers fill the air with an exquisite
-perfume.
-
-Within, the high-pitched, deep, church-like roof rises above a range of
-partition walls separating the different rooms, but giving a common air
-supply to all, since the dividing walls are not more than ten or twelve
-feet high. There are no secrets in an island house; what any one says at
-one end can be heard at the other, and a light burning late in anybody’s
-bedroom keeps all the rest awake. In the older houses the roof is of
-“rau” or plaited pandanus thatch, of a soft brown tone, delightfully
-cool and exceedingly picturesque. The rafters, in such a house, will
-be almost black with age, and beautifully latticed and patterned with
-finely plaited “sinnet” (cocoanut fibre). More modern houses have
-corrugated iron roofs, generally painted red. The water supply from
-these roofs is of some importance, and they are less expense and trouble
-than the thatch; but the latter is incomparably the more picturesque,
-and a good deal the cooler as well.
-
-The floor is always covered with native matting (pandanus leaf, split
-and plaited). This is of a pleasant tan colour in tone, and very cool
-and clean. The furniture is generally basket and bamboo, with a native
-“tappa” cloth (of which I shall have more to say later on) on the table.
-There are sure to be groups of old native weapons on the walls--lances
-and spears and clubs and arrows--and a few island fans, arranged in
-trophies, and garlanded with chains of shells. On the steps of
-the verandah one usually finds a fern or two, planted in big white
-clam-shells off the reef, and there may be others in the drawing-room.’
-A piano is a great luxury; the island climate is not kind to pianos.
-Harmoniums are more common.
-
-The bedrooms may have ordinary beds imported from Auckland, or they may
-have (what is quite as good) native bedsteads made of ironwood, laced
-across with sinnet, and covered with soft pandanus leaf mats, over which
-the under sheet is laid. Unless it is the cool season there will not be
-a blanket. Mosquito curtains, of course, protect each bed. All windows
-and doors are wide open, day or night, hot season or cool.
-
-The South Sea housekeeper has a few insect plagues to fight against,
-but not nearly so many as her sister in India or Jamaica. The ants eat
-everything that is not hung or covered up. Enormous hornets, in the cool
-season, lurk about ceilings, bookcases and cupboards, sleepy, cross, and
-ready to dart a fearful sting, if accidentally touched. Cockroaches are
-destructive at all times. Fleas do not trouble much, and flies are only
-annoying in a few islands. Mosquitoes are troublesome in the hot season,
-but give little annoyance at other times. Centipedes and scorpions
-exist, but are not common. They do come into houses occasionally, and
-(being very poisonous, though not deadly) frighten the inmates quite as
-much as the inmates undoubtedly frighten them. It is the rarest possible
-thing, however, to hear of a European being bitten.
-
-Education is not an unsolvable problem in the islands, since quite a
-large number of groups possess convent schools, where even such extras
-as music, languages, and fancy needlework can be taught.
-
-On the whole, the difficulties of housekeeping are somewhat less than at
-home, and the cost certainly much smaller. It is true that a good
-many tinned stuffs are used, and tinned food is always dear; but the
-cheapness of everything that the soil produces makes up that difference,
-and the simple standard of living swings the balance still further to
-the right side. I am of opinion myself that white families would benefit
-both in comfort and in pocket by adopting the native style of house,
-which is, as already mentioned, a structure of small neat sticks or
-poles set very closely and strongly, but not filled in. The roof is
-always thatched. In such a house, the air circulates freely without any
-draught, and there is a pleasant, diffused light during the daytime.
-At night, when native houses are more or less transparent, the
-privacy-loving white can draw thin cotton curtains across his walls
-until the lights are put out.
-
-One such house, built for and used by white people, was conspicuous for
-the simple beauty of the design. The interior was very plainly furnished
-with a few bamboo tables and chairs, and a light stretcher bed or two.
-Its curtains were of printed muslin from the store, and its floor was
-nothing but white coral sand brought from the beach. The house stood
-sheltered, by tall palms, and the sea was so near that all day one could
-watch the soft sparkle of the creaming surf through the half-transparent
-walls, and all night long one slept to the matchless lullaby of the
-humming reef.
-
-_(Windows blurred with beating mud, grey London roaring by in the
-rain; haggard faces, and murky summer, and the snake of custom clipping
-stranglingly about the free man’s throat--O Island wanderer, back in the
-weary North, does your sea-bird’s heart fly swift from these to those,
-and-sicken for the lands where you must go no more?)_
-
-*****
-
-Raratonga is full of funny things, if one knows where to look for them.
-One would not suppose that the tombs of the natives were a likely spot.
-Yet I would defy the most serious of graveyard moralisers to count
-over the list of things that the Raratongan buries in the tombs of his
-departed relatives, without feeling his seriousness badly shaken. Little
-household ornaments belonging to the deceased are pathetic, certainly;
-so, in a lesser degree, are the Sunday clothes that often accompany
-their wearer on the long journey. But what is one to say of bicycles,
-Japanned bedsteads, and even pianos? All these things have been buried
-by Raratongans in the big concreted tombs that crop up sociably along
-the edges of the public road every here and there. The piano, I must
-add, was dug up again, by order of an indignant missionary, who gave the
-disconsolate mourners a good lecture on heathenistic practices, and the
-necessity of drawing the line somewhere.
-
-Native names are sometimes exceedingly funny to the perverted white
-mind, although to the owners they may be dignified, poetic, and even
-beautiful. One young coffee-coloured lady of my acquaintance had
-been named (in Raratongan) “Cup-of-Tea.” Another was
-“Box-with-a-Hole-in-It”--another “Tin-of-Meat.” I should suppose, from
-my knowledge of their religious training, that each of these ladies
-possessed a godly scripture name of her own, properly bestowed on her
-at her proper baptism. But in the Cook Islands, the name a native
-is christened by, and the name he or she goes by, are almost always
-distinct, which is certainly confusing. Worse confusion still is caused
-by the odd habit of changing these commonly accepted names on any
-great occasion that seems to need special commemoration. The natives
-themselves never seem to become puzzled over all these name-changes,
-but so much can hardly be said of the whites. It is, at the least,
-perplexing to employ a gardener called Zebedee by the missionaries,
-Thunderstorm by his friends, and Tin Roof by his relatives--like the
-notable character in _The Hunting of the Snark_,
-
- Whose intimate friends called him Candle-Ends,
-
- And his enemies Toasted Cheese.
-
-But it is even worse to be informed--some day, when you go to look after
-Zebedee-Thunderstorm-Tin Roof down in the village, and ask why he has
-not turned up to weed your pineapples--that his name isn’t any of the
-three, but “Barbed Wire,” because he has just finished putting up a
-fence of barbed wire round the grave of his boy who died last year, and
-has resolved to call himself henceforth, “Barbed Wire,” in memory of his
-son!
-
-Native notions about European clothes often provide a feast of fun for
-the whites, who set the copies in dress.
-
-When a lace-trimmed garment of mine, usually reserved for private wear
-under the shades of night and the shelter of a quilt and sheet, went to
-Sunday morning church as a best dress in full daylight, on the person of
-the laundress who had been entrusted with my clothes for the wash, the
-funny side of the affair was so much the more conspicuous, that the
-borrower never got the reproof she certainly ought to have had. And
-when a certain flower toque, made of poppies (a blossom unknown to
-the Pacific) first drove the women of the island half-distracted
-with excitement, and then led to thirty-six native ladies appearing
-simultaneously at a dance in Makea’s grounds, wearing most excellent
-copies of my Paris model, done in double scarlet hibiscus from the bush,
-the natural outrage to my feelings (which every woman who has ever
-owned a “model” will understand) was quite swallowed up in the intense
-amusement that the incident caused to everybody on the grounds.
-
-I was unfortunate enough to be away on the island schooner when a great
-wedding took place--the nuptials of one of the queen’s nieces--and so
-missed the finest display of native dress and custom that had
-occurred during the whole year. The bride, I heard, wore fourteen silk
-dresses--not all at once, but one after the other, changing her dress
-again and again during the reception that followed the wedding ceremony
-in the mission church, until she almost made the white spectators giddy.
-
-The presents were “numerous and costly” from the guests to the bride,
-and from the bride to the guests, for it is Raratongan custom to give
-presents to the people who come to your wedding; a fashion that would
-considerably alleviate the lot of the weary wedding guest, if only it
-could be introduced over here. The gifts for the bride were carried
-in by the givers, and flung down in a heap one by one, each being duly
-announced by the person making the present, who showed no false modesty
-in describing his contribution. “Here’s twenty yards of the most
-beautiful print for Mata (the bride), from Erri Puno!” “Here’s three
-baskets of arrowroot, the best you ever saw, for Mata, from Taoua.”
-
-“Here’s eighteen-pence for Mata and Tamueli, from Ruru,” flinging the
-coins loudly into a china plate. So the procession went on, until the
-gifts were all bestowed, the bride meanwhile standing behind a kind of
-counter, and rapidly handing out rolls of stuff, tins of food, ribbons,
-gimcracks of various kinds, to her guests as they passed by. When all is
-added up, the amusement seems to be about all that any one really clears
-out of the whole proceeding.
-
-The Cook Islanders are among the most musical of Pacific races. They
-have no musical instruments, unless “trade” mouth-organs, accordions,
-and jew’s harps may be classed as such, but they need none, in their
-choral singing, which is indescribably grand and impressive. Here as
-elsewhere in the islands, one traces distinctly the influence of the two
-dominant sounds of the island world--the low droning of the reef, and
-the high soft murmur of the trade wind in the palms. The boom of the
-breakers finds a marvellously close echo in the splendid volume of
-the men’s voices, which are bass for the most part, and very much more
-powerful and sonorous than anything one hears in the country of the
-“superior” race. The women’s voices are somewhat shrill, but they sound
-well enough as one usually hears them, wandering wildly in and out of
-the massive harmonies of the basses.
-
-A Philharmonic conductor from the isles of the North would surely think
-himself in heaven, if suddenly transported to these southern isles of
-melody and song. The Pacific native is born with harmony in his throat,
-and time in his very pulses. It is as natural to him to sing as to
-breathe; and he simply cannot go out of time if he tries. Solo singing
-does not attract him at all; music is above all things a social
-function, in his opinion, and if he can get a few others--or better
-still, a few score others--to sit down with him on the ground, and begin
-a chorus, he is happy for hours, and so are they.
-
-To the Pacific traveller, this endless chanting is as much a part of the
-island atmosphere as the palms and the reef and the snowy coral strand
-themselves. One comes, in time, to notice it hardly more than the
-choral song of beating breaker and long trade wind, to which it is so
-wonderfully akin. But at the first, wonder is continually awakened
-by the incomparable volume of the voices, and the curious booming
-sound--like the echo that follows the striking of some gigantic
-bell--which characterises the bass register of island men’s singing. The
-swing and entrain of the whole performance are intoxicating--the chorus,
-be it ten or a thousand voices, sweeps onward as resistlessly as a
-cataract, and the beat of the measure is like the pulse of Father Time
-himself. There are several parts as a rule, but they wander in and out
-of one another at will, and every now and then a single voice will break
-away, and embroider a little improvisation upon the melody that is like
-a sudden scatter of spray from the crest of a rolling breaker. Then
-the chorus takes it up and answers it, and the whole mass of the voices
-hurls itself upon the tune like the breaker falling and bursting upon
-the shore.
-
-It is very wonderful, and very lovely; yet there are times--at one in
-the morning, let us say, when the moon has crept round from one side of
-the mosquito curtain to the other since one lay down, and the bats have
-finished quarrelling and gone home, and the comparative chill of the
-small hours is frosting the great green flags of the bananas outside
-the window with glimmering dew--when the white traveller, musical or
-unmusical, may turn over on an uneasy couch, and curse the native love
-of melody, wondering the while if the people in the little brown houses
-down the road ever sleep at all?
-
-What are the subjects of the songs? That is more than the natives
-themselves can tell you, very often, and certainly much more than a
-wandering traveller, here to-day, and gone next month, could say. Many
-of the chants are traditional, so old that the customs they refer to are
-not half remembered, and full of words that have passed out of use. A
-good number now-a-days are religious, consisting of hymns and psalms
-taught by the missionaries, and improved on, as to harmony and setting,
-by the native. The island love of choral singing must be an immense
-assistance to the church services, since it turns these latter into
-a treat, instead of a mere duty, and the native can never get enough
-church, so long as there is plenty of singing for him to do. Some of the
-secular songs are understood to refer to the deeds of ancestors; some
-are amatory; some--and those the most easily understood by white people
-who know the native languages--are in the nature of a kind of society
-journal, recording the important events of the last few days, and making
-comments, often of a very free nature, on friends and enemies, and the
-white people of the island. Most of these latter are not good enough
-scholars to understand the chants, even if they can talk a little
-native, which is just as well, when oratorios of this kind are to be
-heard every evening among the “rau” roofed huts:
-
- “Big-Nose who lives in the white house has got a new
-
- suit of clothes.”
-
- Chorus. “A new suit of clothes, a new suit, suit, suit of
-
- clothes!”
-
- “Big-Nose cannot fasten the coat, he is so fat, ai! ai,
-
- fat like a pig fit for killing!”
-
- Chorus. “Ai, Ai! a pig for killing, like a pig for killing,
-
- Big-Nose is like a pig fit for killing!”
-
- “Big-Nose had a quarrel with his wife to-day, a quarrel,
-
- a great quarrel, Big-Nose drank wisiki, much wisiki.”
-
- (All together, excitedly.) “A quarrel, a great quarrel,
-
- much wisiki Big-Nose drank, Big-Nose!”
-
- “The wife of Big-Nose of the white house has long hair,
-
- though she is very old, long hair that came to her in
-
- a box by the sitima (steamer)!”
-
- Chorus. “Long hair, long hair, long hair, in a box on the
-
- steamer. A box on the steamer, on the steamer,
-
- long hair for the wife of Big-Nose who lives in the
-
- white house.”
-
-
-A resident who really understood the natives and their music once or
-twice translated choruses for me that were quite as personal as the
-above. I have never since then wondered, as I used to wonder, where on
-earth the merry peasants of opera, with their extraordinary knowledge
-of the principals’ affairs, and their tireless energy in singing about
-them, were originally sketched.
-
-(Scholars will probably trace a resemblance to the Greek chorus here. I
-leave it to them to work out the wherefore, which makes me giddy even
-to think of, considering the geographical elements involved in the
-problem.)
-
-But now enough of Raratonga, for the schooner _Duchess_ is waiting
-to carry me away to the other islands of the group, and, after many
-thousands of miles travelled by steamer upon “all the seas of all the
-world,” I am at last to learn what going to sea really is.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER VII
-
-_The Schooner at last--White Wings versus Black Funnels--Not according
-to Clark Russell--The Marvellous White Woman--The Song of the Surf--Why
-not?--Delightful Aitutaki--Into an Atoll--A Night in the House of
-a Chieftainess--The Scarlet Devil--Nothing to wear--How to tickle a
-Shark--The Fairy Islets--A Chance for Robinson Crusoe._
-
-
-THE schooner _Duchess_ was in at last.
-
- Of their bones are coral made.
-
-We were almost growing anxious about her in Raratonga--almost, not
-quite; for after all, she was only a fortnight overdue, and that is not
-much for an island schooner, even when she is run by white officers.
-When the easy-going native runs her, no one ever knows when she will
-leave any port, and no one would venture to predict that she will ever
-arrive at all. There are generally a good many native-owned schooners
-about the South Eastern Pacific, but, though all the numbers keep up,
-the identity varies, and if you return after a few years and ask for the
-ships you used to know, the answer will be, I have not space to tell you
-here of the native schooner that started from one of the Cook Islands,
-not so very long ago, to visit another island less than two hundred
-miles away, but, because of the wild and weird navigation of her owners,
-went instead to somewhere over a thousand miles off; toured half the
-Pacific; stayed away six months; and finally came back to her own little
-island by a happy chance, without ever having reached the place she set
-out for after all. But it has a good deal of local colour in it.
-
-The _Duchess_, however, was not a native schooner, being owned by
-whites, and run by a British captain, mate, and boatswain, assisted
-by eight island seamen. There was, therefore, a reasonable prospect
-of getting somewhere, sometime, if I travelled in her; so I took my
-passage, and, for the first time, literally “sailed away”--to see the
-outer islands of the Cook Group, and later on, solitary Savage Island,
-Penrhyn, Malden, Rakahanga, and Manahiki.
-
-For more than four months afterwards, with a single break, the little
-_Duchess_ of 175 tons was my home. Little she seemed at first, but
-before long she assumed the proportions of quite a majestic vessel.
-There was no schooner in those waters that could touch her, either
-for speed, size, or (alas!) for pitching and rolling, in any and every
-weather. Her ninety-five foot masts made a brave show, when clothed with
-shining canvas; her white hull, with its scarlet encircling band,
-and the sun-coloured copper glimmering at the water-line, stood out
-splendidly on the blazing blue of the great Pacific. “A three-masted
-topsail schooner” was her official designation. The unofficial names she
-was called in a calm, when the great Pacific swell brought out her full
-rolling powers, are best left unreported.
-
-I cannot honestly advise the elderly round-the-world-tourist, doing
-the Pacific in orthodox style, to desert steam for sail, and try the
-experience of voyaging “off the track” among the islands never visited
-by liners. But the true traveller, who wanders for the joy of wandering,
-and is not afraid or unwilling to “rough it” a good deal, will find a
-sailing trip in the Pacific among the most fascinating of experiences.
-Beyond the radius of the belching funnel a great peace reigns; an
-absence of time, a pleasant carelessness about all the weighty and
-tiresome things that may be happening outside the magic circle of still
-blue ocean. There is no “let-her-slide” spirit in the whole world to
-compare with that which blossoms spontaneously on the sun-white decks of
-a Pacific schooner.
-
-Looking back upon all the island boats that I have known, I may say
-that there was not so much discipline among the lot as would have run a
-single cross-channel boat at home, that every one was satisfied if
-the officers refrained from “jamborees” between ports; if some one was
-sometimes at the wheel, and if the native crew knew enough of the ropes
-to work the ship reasonably well, in the intervals of line-fishing and
-chorus-singing. And in one and all, whatever might happen to passengers,
-cargo, ship, or crew, “take things as they come,” was the grand general
-rule.
-
-* * * * *
-
-“This is your cabin,” said the cheerful little pirate of a captain. He
-was celebrated as the “hardest case” in the South Pacific, and looked
-not quite unworthy of his reputation, though he was dressed as if for
-Bond Street in the afternoon, and mannered (on that occasion) as if for
-an evening party.
-
-What I wanted to say, was “Good God!” What I did say was: “Oh, really!
-very nice indeed.” For I saw at once that I must lie, and it seemed as
-well to obtain the fullest possible advantage from the sin. There was no
-use mincing words, or morals, in such a case.
-
-The cabin had a floor exactly the size of my smallest flat box, which
-filled it so neatly that I had to stand on the lid all the time I was in
-my room. It had a bunk about as large as a tight fit in coffins, and a
-small parrot-perch at one side, which was not meant for parrots, but for
-me, to perch on, if I wanted to lace my boots without committing suicide
-when the ship was rolling. On the perch stood a tin basin, to do duty as
-a washstand. There was a biscuit-tin full of water underneath.
-
-This was all that the cabin contained, except smells. The latter,
-however, crowded it to its fullest capacity. It had some mysterious
-communication with the hold, which perfumed it strongly with the
-oppressive, oily stench of ancient copra, and it had also a small door
-leading into the companion that went down to the engine-hole (one
-could not call it a room), in which lived the tiny oil engine that was
-supposed to start instantaneously, and work us out of danger, in case of
-any sudden need. (I say supposed, because---- But that comes after.)
-
-This engine-hole had a smell of its own, a good deal stronger than the
-engine (but that is not saying much)--compounded of dirt, bilge-water,
-and benzolene. The smell joined in a sort of chorus with the copra odour
-of the hold, and both were picked out and accentuated by a sharp note of
-cockroach. It was the most symphonic odour that I had ever encountered.
-As for the port, that, I saw, would be screwed down most of the time
-owing to the position of the cabin, low down on the main deck.
-
-“Very nice,” I repeated, smiling a smile of which I am proud to this
-day. “Such a dear little cabin!”
-
-“I’m glad you like it,” said the captain, evidently relieved. “You see,
-there’s four Government officials coming round this trip, and that takes
-our only other cabin. I chucked the bo’sun out of this; he’s sleeping
-anywhere. Anything else you’d like?” he continued, looking at the
-biscuit-tin and the shiny basin with so much satisfaction that I guessed
-at once they were a startling novelty--the bo’sun having probably
-performed his toilet on deck. “We don’t have lady passengers on these
-trips as we aren’t a Union liner exactly, but we’re always ready to do
-what we can to please every one.”
-
-“I want first of all a new mattress, and sheets that haven’t been washed
-in salt water, and then I want some air and light, and thirty or forty
-cubic feet more space, and I think, a new cabin, and I’m almost sure,
-another ship,” I said to myself. Aloud I added: “Nothing whatever, thank
-you; it is charming,” and then I went in and shut the door, and sat
-down on my bunk, and said things, that would not have passed muster in a
-Sunday-School, for quite ten minutes.
-
-What I had expected I don’t know. Something in the Clark Russell line,
-I fear--a sparkling little sea-parlour, smelling of rope and brine,
-looking out on a deck “as white as a peeled almond,” and fitted with
-stern windows that overhung half the horizon. It was borne in upon me,
-as I sat there among the smells and ants and beetles, that I was in for
-something as un-Clark-Russelly as possible. “Well,” I thought, “it will
-at least be all the newer. And there is certainly no getting out of it.”
-
-So we spread our white wings, and fluttered away like a great
-sea-butterfly, from underneath the green and purple peaks of Raratonga,
-far out on the wide Pacific. And thereupon, because the rollers rolled,
-and the ship was small, I went into my cabin, and for two days, like
-the heroine of an Early Victorian romance, “closed my eyes, and knew no
-more.”
-
-On the third day I was better, and in the afternoon Mitiaro, one of the
-outer Cook Islands, rose on the horizon. By three o’clock our boat had
-landed us--the official party, the captain, and myself--on a beach
-of foam-white coral sand, crowded with laughing, excited natives,
-all intensely eager to see the “wahiné papa,” or foreign woman. White
-men--traders, missionaries, the Resident Commissioner of the group--had
-visited the island now and again, but never a white woman before; and
-though many had been away and seen such wonders, more had not.
-
-The officials went away to hold a court of justice; the captain and
-myself, before we had walked half across the beach, being captured by
-an excited band of jolly brown men and women, all in their Sunday
-best shirts and pareos, and long trailing gowns. They seized us by our
-elbows, and literally ran us up to the house of the principal chief,
-singing triumphantly. Along the neatest of coral sand paths we went,
-among groves of palm and banana, up to a real native house, built with
-a high “rau” roof, and airy birdcage walls. About half the island was
-collected here, drinking cocoanuts, eating bananas, staring, talking,
-laughing. In spite of their excitement, however, they were exceedingly
-courteous, offering me the best seat in the house--a real European
-chair, used as a sort of throne by the chief himself--fanning myself
-and my guide industriously as we sat, pressing everything eatable in
-the house on us, and doing their best, bare-footed brown savages as they
-were, to make us enjoy our visit.
-
-All islanders are not courteous and considerate, but the huge majority
-certainly are. You shall look many a day and many a week among the
-sea-countries of the Pacific, before you meet with as much rudeness,
-selfishness, or unkindness, as you may meet any day without looking at
-all, on any railway platform of any town of civilised white England. And
-not from one end of the South Seas to the other, shall you hear anything
-like the harsh, loud, unmusical voice of the dominant race, in a
-native mouth. Soft and gentle always is the island speech, musical and
-kind--the speech of a race that knows neither hurry nor greed, and for
-whom the days are long and sweet, and “always afternoon.”
-
-When we went out to see the island, it was at the head of a gay
-procession of men, women, and children, singing ceaselessly, in loud
-metallic chants and choruses. Shy of the strange white apparition at
-first, the women grew bolder by degrees, and hung long necklaces of
-flowers and leaves and scented berries round my neck. They took my hat
-away, and returned it covered with feathery reva-reva plumes, made from
-the inner crown of the palm-tree. They produced a native dancing kilt,
-like a little crinoline, made of arrowroot fibre, dyed pink, and tied it
-round my waist, over my tailor skirt, explaining the while (through the
-captain, who interpreted), that the knot of the girdle was fastened in
-such a way as to cast a spell on me, and that I should inevitably be
-obliged to return to the island. (It is perhaps worthy of note that I
-did, though at the time of my first visit there seemed no chance of the
-ship calling again.) Decked out after this fashion, I had a _suces_; on
-my return to the schooner, and was greeted with howls of delight on the
-part of my fellow-passengers, who had managed to escape adornment, being
-less of a novelty. It was of course impossible to remove the ornaments
-without offending the givers.
-
-More houses, and more hosts, standing like Lewis Carroll’s crocodile
-on their thresholds, to welcome me in “with gently smiling jaws.” We
-visited till we were tired of visiting, and then strolled about the
-town. Cool, fresh, and clean are the houses of little Mitiaro, dotted
-about its three miles’ length. Their high deep-gabled roofs of plaited
-pandanus leaf keep out the heat of the staring sun; through their walls
-of smoothed and fitted canes the sea-wind blows and the green lagoon
-gleams dimly: the snowy coral pebbles that carpet all the floor reflect
-a softly pleasant light into the dusk, unwindowed dwelling. Outside, the
-palm-trees rustle endlessly, and the surf sings on the reef the long,
-low, perilous sweet song of the dreamy South Sea world--the song that
-has lured so many away into these lonely coral lands, to remember
-their Northern loves and homes no more--the song that, once heard, will
-whisper through the inmost chambers of the heart, across the years, and
-across the world till death.
-
-Yet--why not?
-
-Why not? The thought followed me as ceaselessly as the trampling of the
-surf (now, in the open, loud and triumphant, like the galloping of a
-victorious army) while I wandered over the little island, up and down
-the coral sand paths that led through groves of feathery ironwood,
-through quaintly regular, low, rich green shrubberies, starred with pale
-pink blossoms among wild grey pinnacles of fantastic rock, clothed in
-trailing vines--always towards the open sky and the limitless blue sea.
-Why not? In England, even yet,
-
- We are not cotton-spinners all,
-
-nor are we all old, blood-chilled by the frost of conventionality, dyed
-ingrain with the conviction that there is nothing but vagabondage and
-ne’er-do-well-ism away from the ring of the professions, or an office
-desk in the E.C. district. For the young and adventurous, the South Seas
-hold as fair prospects as any other semi-civilised portion of the globe.
-For those who have seen and have lived, and are wearied to death of the
-life and cities and competition, the island world offers remoteness,
-beauty, rest, and peace, unmatched in the round of the swinging
-earth. And to all alike it offers that most savoury morsel of life’s
-banquet--freedom. Freedom and a biscuit taste better to many a
-young Anglo-Saxon than stalled ox seasoned with the bitter herbs of
-dependence; but the one is always at hand, and the other very far away.
-
-Well, the gulf can be spanned; but he who cannot do the spanning, and
-must long and dream unsatisfied all his life, had best take comfort:
-it had not been for his good. The Islands are for the man of resource;
-again, of resource; and once more, of resource. Look among the lowest
-huts of the lowest quarters that cling to towns in the big islands, and
-there, gone native, and lost to his race, you shall find the man who was
-an excellent fellow--once--but who in emergency or difficulty, “didn’t
-know what to do.”
-
-If there is a lesson in the above, he who needs it will find it.
-
-*****
-
-Mitiaro is the island, already referred to, where dried bananas are
-prepared. The natives make up their fruit in this way for market,
-because steamers never call, and sailing vessels only come at long and
-irregular intervals. A very small quantity goes down in this way to
-Auckland, and I heard, in a general way, that there were supposed to
-be one or two other islands here and there about the Pacific, where the
-same trade was carried on. One cannot, however, buy preserved bananas in
-the colonies, unless by a special chance, so the purchasing public knows
-nothing of them, and is unaware what it misses. In the opinion of most
-who have tried them, the fruit, dried and compressed in the Mitiaro
-way, is superior to dried figs. It is not only a substitute for fresh
-bananas, but a dainty in itself. The whaling ships pick up an occasional
-consignment in out-of-the-way places, and are therefore familiar with
-them, but one never sees them on a steamer. There may be useful hints,
-for intending settlers, in these stray facts.
-
-We lay over-night at Mitiaro, and got off in the morning. Aitutaki was
-our next place of call, and we reached it in about a day. It is, next
-to Raratonga, the most important island of the group, possessing a large
-mission station, a Government agent, and a post-office. It enjoys a
-call once a month from the Union steamer, and is therefore a much more
-sophisticated place than Mitiaro. In size, it is inferior to Raratonga
-and Atiu, being only seven square miles in extent. Its population is
-officially returned as 1,170. These are almost all natives, the white
-population including only the Government agent, two or three
-missionaries, and a couple of traders.
-
-[Illustration: 0185]
-
-It is bright morning when we make Aitutaki, and the sea is so vividly
-blue, as we push off in the boat, that I wonder my fingers do not come
-out sapphire-coloured when I dip them in. And I think, as the eight
-brown arms pull us vigorously shoreward, that no one in the temperate
-climes knows, or ever can know, what these sea-colours of the tropics
-are like, because the North has no words that express them. How, indeed,
-should it have?
-
-We are rowing, as fast as we can go, towards a great white ruffle of
-foam ruled like a line across the blue, blue sea. Inside this line
-there lies, to all appearance, an immense raised plain of green jade or
-aquamarine, with a palmy, plumy island, cinctured by a pearly beach, far
-away in the middle. Other islands, smaller and farther away, stand
-out upon the surface of this strange green circle here and there, all
-enclosed within the magic ring of tumbling foam, more than five miles
-across, that sets them apart from the wide blue sea. It is only a lagoon
-of atoll formation, but it looks like a piece of enamelled jewel-work,
-done by the hand of some ocean giant, so great that the huge sea-serpent
-itself should be only a bracelet for his arm. The raised appearance of
-the lagoon is one of the strangest things I have yet seen, though it is
-merely an optical delusion, created by contrast in colour.
-
-We are fortunate, too, in seeing what every one does not see--a distinct
-green shade in the few white clouds that overhang the surface of the
-lagoon. Here in Aitutaki a great part of the sky is sometimes coloured
-green by the reflections from the water, and it is a sight worth
-witnessing.
-
-Through an opening in the reef we enter--the boatmen pulling hard
-against the outward rush of the tide, which runs here like a cataract at
-times--and glide easily across the mile or so of shallow water that
-lies between us and the shore. One or two splendid whale-boats pass
-us, manned by native crews, and the other passengers tell me that these
-boats are all made by the Aitutakians themselves, who are excellent
-builders.
-
-There is a very decent little wharf to land on, and of course, the
-usual excited, decorated crowd to receive us, and follow us about. I
-am getting quite used now to going round at the head of a continual
-procession, to being hung over with chains of flowers and berries,
-and ceaselessly fed with bananas and cocoanuts, so the crowd does not
-interfere with my enjoyment of the new island. We are going to stop a
-day or two here, and there will be time to see everything.
-
-When you sleep as a rule in a bunk possessing every attribute of a
-coffin (except the restfulness which one is led to expect in a bed of
-that nature), you do not require much pressing to accept an invitation
-to “dine and sleep” on shore. Tau Ariki (which means Chieftainess, or
-Countess, or Duchess, Tau) lives in Aitutaki, and she had met me in
-Raratonga, so she sent me a hearty invitation to spend the night at her
-house, and I accepted it.
-
-Tau is not by any means as great a personage as Makea, or even as great
-as Tinomana, the lesser queen. She is an Ariki all the same, however,
-and owns a good deal of land in Aitutaki. Also, she is gloriously
-married to a white ex-schooner mate, who can teach even the Aitutakians
-something about boat-building, and she is travelled and finished, having
-been a trip to Auckland--the ambition of every Cook Islander. So Tau
-Ariki is a person of importance in her own small circle, and was
-allowed by the natives of the town to have the undoubted first right to
-entertain the white woman.
-
-Tau’s house, in the middle of the rambling, jungly, green street of the
-little town, proved to be a wooden bungalow with a verandah and a tin
-roof, very ugly, but very fine to native eyes. There were tables and
-chairs in the “parlour”; and the inevitable boiled fowl that takes the
-place of the fatted calf, in Pacific cookery, was served up on a china
-plate. A rich woman, Tau, and one who knew how the “tangata papa” (white
-folk) should be entertained!
-
-She gave me a bedroom all to myself, with a smile that showed complete
-understanding of the foolish fads of the “wahiné papa.” It had a large
-“imported” glass window, giving on the main street of the town, and
-offering, through its lack of blinds, such a fine, free show for the
-interested populace, that I was obliged to go to bed in the dark. There
-was a real bed in the room, covered with a patchwork quilt of a unique
-and striking design, representing a very realistic scarlet devil some
-four feet long. It seemed to me the kind of quilt that would need a good
-conscience and a blameless record, on the part of the sleeper reposing
-under it. To wake in the middle of the night unexpectedly, with the
-moonlight streaming in, forget for the moment where you were, and,
-looking round to find a landmark, drop your startled eyes upon that
-scarlet fiend, sprawling all over your chest---- Well, I had a good
-conscience, or none--I do not know which--so I felt the red devil would
-not disturb my slumbers, and he did not.
-
-[Illustration: 0191]
-
-There was nothing else in the room, except a new, gold-laced, steamship
-officer’s cap, whereto there seemed neither history nor owner, reposing
-on the pillow. If there was any mystery about the cap, I never knew it.
-
-I put it out on the windowsill, and a hen laid an egg in it next
-morning, and no doubt the hen lived happily ever after, and I hope the
-officer did, and that is all. It seems pathetic, but I do not know why.
-
-There was nothing to wash in, but Tau knew her manners, and was quite
-aware that I might have a prejudice against sitting in a washing-tub
-on either the front or the back verandah, to have buckets emptied on my
-head in the morning. So she made haste to leave a kerosene tin full of
-water, before going to her camphorwood chest, and extracting a pink silk
-dress trimmed with yellow lace, for me to sleep in.
-
-“I’m afraid that won’t do; it’s too--too good to sleep in,” I remarked.
-
-“Nothing too good for you, you too much good self!” was the amiable
-reply.
-
-“But I could not sleep in it, Tau. There’s--there’s too much of it,” I
-objected, not knowing how to word my refusal without impoliteness.
-
-“All right,” commented my hostess, throwing a glance at the purple gloom
-of the torrid hot-season night outside. “He plenty hot. I get you pareo,
-all same mine.” And she disinterred a brief cotton kilt of red and
-yellow, considerably smaller than a Highlander’s.
-
-“That’s too little,” objected the exacting guest, rather to poor Tau’s
-perplexity. How was one to please such a visitor? At last, however,
-after refusing a figured muslin robe that was as transparent as a
-dancing-robe of classic Ionia (there are other analogies between those
-robes, if one might go into the subject; but I fear the British public
-must not be told about them), and a pink shirt belonging to the white
-husband, a neat cotton day gown was discovered, offered, and accepted,
-and peace reigned once more in the exceedingly public guest-chamber of
-Tau Ariki’s house.
-
-Concerning quilts, by the way, one may here add a short note. Patchwork
-is the delight of the Cook Island women, and has been so, ever since
-that absorbing pastime was first introduced to them by the missionaries’
-wives. They are extremely clever at it, and often invent their own
-patterns. Sometimes, however, they copy any startling device that
-they may chance to see--the more original, the better. A really good
-patchwork quilt is considered a possession of great value, and (one is
-sorry to say) often preferred to the fine, beautifully hand-woven mats
-in which the islanders used to excel. They still make mats in large
-numbers, but the patchwork quilt has spoilt their taste for the finer
-mats, and these latter are getting scarce.
-
-In the morning, shark-catching was the order of the day. Aitutaki is
-celebrated for this sport all over Australasia, and I was very glad to
-get a chance of joining in it. One does not catch sharks, in Aitutaki,
-after the usual island fashion, which is much like the way familiar to
-all sea-faring folk--hook and line, and a lump of bad pork, and tow the
-monster to the shore when you have got him. No, there is something more
-exciting in store for the visitor-who goes a-fishing in Aitutaki lagoon.
-The water is very shallow for the most part, and heats up quickly with
-the sun, especially when the day is dead calm, and there is not a ripple
-to break the force of the rays. By noon, the lagoon is unbearably warm
-in all the shallow parts, and the sharks which inhabit it in large
-numbers, begin to feel uncomfortable. Some of them make for the opening
-in the reef, and get out into the cooler sea beyond. Others, one will
-suppose, are lazy, and do not want to be troubled to swim so far. So
-they head for the coral patches here and there, and lie on the sand in
-the shelter of the rocks, their bodies thrust as far into the clefts
-and crannies of the coral as they can manage to get. This is the
-Aitutakian’s opportunity. He is perfectly fearless in the water, and he
-knows that the shark is, after all, a stupid brute. So he arms himself
-with a knife, takes a strong rope, noosed in a slip-knot at one end,
-in his hand, and dives from his whale-boat into the warm green water,
-where he has marked the latter end of a shark sticking out from a patch
-of coral, some three or four fathoms underneath the surface.
-
-The shark, being head in, does not see anything, but by-and-by he
-becomes aware of a delicate tickling all along his massive ribs, and
-as he rather likes this, he stays-quite still, and enjoys it. It is the
-Aitutakian, tickling him as boys tickle a trout in a stream at home, and
-for exactly the same reason. He has got the noose in his left hand,
-and his aim is to slip it over the shark’s tail, while he distracts the
-brute’s attention by pleasantly tickling with the other hand. Perhaps he
-manages this at the first attempt--perhaps he is obliged to rise to the
-surface, and take a breath of air, going down again to have a second
-try. But, in any case, he is pretty sure to get the noose on before
-the shark suspects anything. Once that is accomplished, he rises to the
-surface like a shooting air-bubble, swings himself into the boat, and
-gives the order to “haul in!”
-
-The men in the boat lay hold of the rope, tighten with a sharp jerk, and
-tail on. Now the shark begins to realise that something has happened;
-and realises it still more fully in another minute or two, when he finds
-himself fighting for his life on the gunwale of a rocking boat, against
-half a dozen islanders armed with knives and axes. The battle is short
-the great brute is soon disabled by a smashing blow on the tail, and in
-another hour or two the village is feeding fat on his meat, and his fins
-are drying in the sun, to be sold to the trader by-and-by, for export to
-China. No dinner-party in China is complete without a dish of daintily
-dressed shark’s fins, and a good proportion of the supply comes from the
-Pacific.
-
-This is shark-fishing, as practised in Aitutaki. But I was not destined
-to see it at its best, for the day turned out breezy, and there was such
-a ripple, upon the water that the natives declared the sharks would be
-extremely difficult to see or capture. Nevertheless, the captain and
-I decided to go, as there was a chance, though a faint one. We hired a
-boat, and took with us, as well as the rowers, Oki, a diver of renown.
-If Oki could not raise a shark for us, it was certain that no one could.
-
-The captain of the missionary steamer _John Williams_ had told me about
-the fishing some weeks before, and added that he had seen a shark caught
-himself, and tried to photograph it, but the photo was not a success,
-because, as he put it, “the shark moved!”
-
-This story wandered about in my mind as we shot across the lagoon to the
-fishing grounds, and the boat began to look uncomfortably small. “What
-does the shark do when you get it in the boat?” I inquired rather
-anxiously.
-
-“Makes the devil of a row, and the devil of a mess,” said our own
-captain cheerfully. “But don’t you mind him. Let sharks alone, and
-they’ll let you alone; that’s always been my experience.”
-
-Conscious that I was never unkind to animals, not even tigers or sharks,
-I tried to feel at ease. But I did not quite succeed, until we got to
-the coral beds, and Oki put everything else out of my head by going head
-first overboard, and starting out among the rocks below (it was calmer
-here, and we could see him pretty plainly) to look for a shark.
-
-His thin brown body showed up shadowy and wavering, upon the sands
-at the bottom, as he glided like a fish all along the patch of reef,
-inspecting every cave or crack where a shark might hide. He did not
-seem to be incommoded in the least by the three or four fathoms of
-water above him, but moved about as quietly and easily as if he had been
-swimming on the surface. I felt sure he must be at the point of death,
-as the seconds flew by, and he still glided in and out of the rocks
-with nothing but the gleam of his white pareo to show his whereabouts,
-whenever he slipped into the shadow of one of the many clefts in which a
-shark might lie hidden. But Oki knew very well what he was about, and he
-did not seem at all exhausted when he shot to the surface again, after
-rather more than two minutes’ absence, and told us gloomily that “No
-shark stop!”
-
-We tried again, and again. Oki took the slip knot down with him every
-time and every time he brought it up in his hand, unused. Melancholy,
-deep and silent, settled upon the boat. But at last the luck changed;
-our diver came up, and announced with a smile, that there was a shark
-down there, very far into the coral, and if he could only reach the
-animal’s tail, it would be all right.
-
-One of the boatmen at this went to help him, and together they swam down
-to the bottom, and began fumbling interminably in the shadow. It was
-clear that they were making every effort to tempt the shark out, for
-one could see Oki straining wildly with his arm in the cleft, “tickling”
- industriously, while the other hovered head downwards outside, trailing
-the noose like a loop of seaweed in his hand. But all proved vain.
-Exhausted, the men rose at last, and gave it up. The shark was too far
-in, they said, and the noose could not be got on. If we remembered, they
-had told us it was not a good day, and they hoped we thought enough had
-been done. As for themselves, they were very tired doing our pleasure,
-and their lungs were sore, but they thought some plug tobacco--the
-black, sticky kind, and a good deal of it--would set them all right
-again.
-
-This was outside the letter of the agreement, which had included a good
-price for the boat and nothing else; but we promised some tobacco, when
-the stores should be reached, and asked for some more particulars about
-the fishing.
-
-“Do you ever find the shark head out, instead of tail out?” I queried.
-
-“Yes, sometime he come head out,” said Oki, reversing a green cocoanut
-on his nose, and swallowing in great gulps.
-
-I waited till he had finished before I asked: “What happens then?”
-
-“Shark he fight, and we fight too,” said Oki simply.
-
-“And which wins?”
-
-“All the time the Aitutaki boy he win, but sometime the shark he win
-too,” was the cryptic reply.
-
-*****
-
-Shark fins, I was told, sell for about six shillings a pound. Some of
-the traders in the islands further north, where sharks are abundant,
-make a good deal of money taking the fish on a hook and line, and drying
-the fins for sale. It should be a fairly profitable industry, as the
-fins of a medium shark appear to weigh a good deal--not less than three
-or four pounds, at a guess.
-
-It was on my second visit to Aitutaki that I went out to the lesser
-islands of the lagoon; but the tale of that expedition may well come
-here.
-
-These islets are of various sizes, from a mere rock with a couple of
-palms on it, to a fertile piece of land over a mile long, richly grown
-and wooded. They all lie within the great lagoon, and are therefore
-sheltered by a natural breakwater of the reef from the violence of the
-storms that occur in the rainy season. The nearest is about three miles
-from the mainland. All are quite uninhabited, and no particular value is
-set on them by anybody. They belong to the various chief families of the
-big island, but any one who wished to rent one in perpetuity (the New
-Zealand Government laws, which rule here, do not permit outright sale)
-could probably secure it for a few pounds a year.
-
-I was anxious to see them, for it seemed to me that islands suited to
-the realisation of Robinson Crusoe dreams could hardly be found the wide
-Pacific over. A desolate isle five hundred miles from anywhere, sounds
-well in a story, but the romance of such a spot is apt to wear very thin
-indeed after a few months, if one may believe the experiences of those
-who have tried it. Practical details are seldom considered by would-be
-Crusoes; they have, however, a knack of thrusting themselves into the
-foreground just when retreat is impossible. If you elect to live on a
-remote island, how are you going to keep up communication with the outer
-world? You will want at least a few commodities of civilisation from
-time to time, and they cannot swim across half the great South Seas,
-from Auckland or ’Frisco, up to your front verandah unaided. You will
-want mails, newspapers, and letters, unless haply you are a criminal
-flying from the near neighbourhood of the black cap and the drop--and
-how are these to come? Trading schooners will not call at your island
-unless you have plenty of cargo for them, and even then, you may not see
-them twice a year. Steamers, of course, you must not expect. If you keep
-a small vessel of your own, you must be thoroughly sea-trained to run
-and navigate her, and you will need to bring a few island men to your
-kingdom as crew, and they will want to go home again, and make trouble,
-and finally run off with your ship some dark night, and maroon you there
-for good. No, the “desert” island idea is best left to the shelves of
-the school library.
-
-But at Aitutaki, and in some similar collections of atoll islands
-Robinson Crusoe’s way is made easy and pleasant--or so it seemed to me,
-crossing the lagoon that afternoon on my way to the islets that were
-lying waste and uninhabited out on its broad expanse. From three to five
-miles away from the mainland, these islets are sufficiently isolated
-for any one who has not quarrelled with the whole human race. There is a
-steamer once a month, at the little pier near the settlement. There are
-one or two stores on the main island, where common provisions, cotton
-stuffs, spades, and knives, and such simple things, can be purchased.
-The lagoon is usually so calm that a native canoe would serve all
-ordinary needs of communication, for any one living on an islet. A house
-could be built in a few days, of the native type: and a good concrete
-bungalow could be put up with native help, in a very few weeks. Why
-should any one want to live in such a spot? Well, it is not necessary to
-argue out that question, because I have found by experience that quite
-a remarkable number of people do. It was for those people that I crossed
-the lagoon that day, and I know I shall have their thanks.
-
-A whale-boat and a crew were necessary for the trip. I engaged both in
-the village, and went down to the wharf followed by a “tail” of
-seven stalwart islanders, dressed in white and crimson pareos, berry
-necklaces, and a curiously representative collection of steamship caps
-and jerseys. The Aitutakian is an inveterate traveller, and all these
-men had been away in a steamer somewhere as deck hands--or else their
-friends had, and they had begged a steamer cap and jersey or two here
-and there: it was all the same to them. The P. & O.--the Union S.S.
-Co. of New Zealand--the Shaw, Savill, and Albion--the Orient--Burns
-Philp--were all represented (so far as caps and jerseys went) by my
-boat’s crew, and very well pleased with themselves and their poached
-attire they evidently were.
-
-Provisions had to be purchased, they declared, as we should not be back
-before afternoon. So into the big store the whole party went to see me
-victual the ship. I bought biscuits and meat, exactly half what they
-asked, and they were so uplifted with joy at the amount of the supplies
-that they sang all the way down to the boat; and, once in it, treated
-me to an exhibition of rowing, the like of which I never expect to see
-again. The Aitutaki man is the smartest boatman, and the best hand with
-an oar, in the Southern Pacific. Never a man-of-war comes round the Cook
-group that her men do not try conclusions with the Aitutakians, and
-if report speaks truth, the result is not always flattering to British
-pride. Nor is this astonishing, to any one who has seen these islanders
-row. We had six miles of a pull, and every inch was against a strong
-head wind, and through a decidedly choppy sea. Yet, in spite of these
-handicaps, the men rowed the whole way at racing pace, oars springing,
-spray flying, the great whale-boat tearing through the water as though
-a mortal enemy were in pursuit. The coxswain, in the stern, kept slyly
-urging the rowers on to let the foreign woman see what they could do,
-and they pulled “all out”--or what looked extremely like it--from start
-to finish. I do not think any white crew that ever held an oar could
-have lived with that splendid six-mile rush. And when we neared the
-first island and gradually slacked speed, there was not one among those
-seven mighty chests that heaved faster than at the start. Truly, I
-thought, they had earned their picnic.
-
-But the islets! If Raratonga was the realisation of a childish dream,
-this was the embodiment of a vision of fairyland. There can surely be
-nothing on earth more lovely than the islet constellation enclosed by
-Aitutaki reef. The water, shallow, sun-jewelled, and spread out over
-a bed of spotless coral sand, is coloured with a brilliance that is
-simply incredible. Emerald and jade and sapphire--yes, one expects
-these, in the hues of tropic seas. But when it comes to whole tracts of
-glancing heliotrope and hyacinth, shot with unnamable shades of melted
-turquoise and silver, and all a-quiver with pulsations of flashing
-greens, for which there is no name in any language under the pallid
-northern or burning southern sun--then, the thing becomes indescribable,
-and one can only say:
-
-“There is something in that little corner of earth beyond the touch
-of words, so you will never know anything about it, unless you too go
-there, and see it for yourself. And when you have seen, you will come
-away burning to describe, as I was--but you will not be able.”
-
-In the midst of this magical sea, rise the islets themselves--fairyland
-every one. Their little beaches are sparkling white, as only a coral
-beach can be; palm-trees, heavyheaded with their loads of huge green
-nuts, cluster thick along the shores; coral-trees drop their blood-red
-flowers into the glass-like water of the lagoon; ripe oranges swing
-their glowing lamps among the darker green of the woods that rise
-behind. Big white clams with goffered shells, each holding meat enough
-for one man’s dinner, gleam along the edges of the shore; large,
-long-legged crabs wander rustling and rattling among the stones. The
-murmur of the barrier reef is very far away; its thin white line of foam
-gleams out a long way off, under a low horizon, sky shot strangely with
-lilac blue--a lonely, lovely, exquisite place, the like of which one
-might seek the world all over, and never find again.
-
-We landed on the sand, and I set about exploring, while the men knocked
-down cocoanuts, and squatted in the shade to drink them, and suck fresh
-oranges. The island on which we had landed was one of the smaller ones,
-not more than an acre or two in extent. It rose to a high point in the
-centre, and was so thickly wooded all over, that I could hardly make my
-way through. There was no sign of life or habitation, and the ripe fruit
-was everywhere rotting on the ground.
-
-I pictured the little islet with a high brown roof peeping out among its
-palms, a neatly kept pathway cut through the bush, and a snug boathouse
-on the shore, covering a fine whaleboat, while a graceful native canoe
-lay on the sand, ready for any one to lift down into the water at any
-minute. I wonder, will the picture ever body itself out in real, for
-some tired-out soul, weary of cities and competition, or some pair of
-lovers, who find the world well lost in each other, here among the far
-islands of the sweet Southern Seas? I shall never know, for the
-“sea-bird’s feather” was in the pillow on which I slept my first baby
-sleep, and I wander always on. But it may be that these words will be
-read by some to whom they are, or shall be, a part of fife’s own
-history.
-
-We did not get to the other islands that day, partly because I wasted so
-much time looking for shells, and partly because the largest were still
-some miles away, and the wind was stronger than ever. One, I heard,
-had ground enough for a paying plantation, and was already fairly well
-supplied with cocoanuts. All are perfectly healthy and free from fevers
-of any kind, and though mosquitoes are present in rather large numbers,
-careful clearing of their breeding grounds would in time drive them
-away.
-
-*****
-
-In case author, or publishers, should be inundated with inquiries about
-South Sea Islands, it may be as well to say that all over the Pacific,
-the Governors, Commissioners, and Resident Agents of the various groups
-are always ready to furnish information to honest inquirers.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER VIII
-
-_Jumping a Coral Reef--The Great Wall of the Makatea--Makaia’s Wonderful
-Staircases--A Clothing Club of the Pacific--Cool Costumes in Atiu--The
-Lands that lie waste--Mystery of a Vanished Tribe--Fashions in
-Hair-Dressing--The Sign-Language of the Sex--Invited to a Feast._
-
-MANGAIA, where we next stopped, proved quite an exciting place. You
-cannot land upon Mangaia in the ordinary way: the reef that surrounds it
-is unbroken, and girdles the whole island in a fortress moat of its own.
-The only way to land is to get into one of the numberless native canoes
-that crowd about the ship, and let the copper-coloured owner take you
-over the reef in his own way, which is the determined and decisive way
-of a steeplechaser at a fence. It is most excellent fun and a new thing
-in sensations. As the little dug-out--made of nothing more elaborate
-than a hollowed mango log, with an outrigger at one side--rushes
-shoreward on the crest of a foaming roller, you watch with rather
-anxious interest the movements of the dusky boatman, who poises his
-paddle in the air, waits, looks, and strikes the water, always at
-exactly the right moment--usually when you are just beginning to think
-of kicking off your shoes.
-
-There is the reef right in front, a pearly shadow in the blue, with
-up-springing spears of ivory, bared like the teeth of a tiger, when the
-wave rolls back. Are we going to jump that? We are indeed. The boatman
-lifts his paddle--we sweep upwards on the sloping blue satin neck of a
-curling wave. No no, that will not do--not this time. He backs water--we
-hang on the crest of the wave--but we are not going to be drowned, or
-snapped up by the sharks that haunt the reefs, because the boatman is
-a born islander, and what he does not know about canoeing over a reef,
-neither you nor I need attempt to teach him. Another wave, a monster
-this time, swinging us up into the air as if we were a couple of
-grasshoppers out paddling in a walnut shell. That will do: here she
-goes! The wave roars with us; the wicked white fangs gleam on either
-hand: our rough thick keel scrapes agonisingly on the coral, and there
-is a smother of foam and tumbling blue and bursting green all about the
-cranky little craft. Bump! we have struck--we strike again, but it does
-not seem to matter in the least: over we go, and we are in the smooth,
-safe, shallow green water inside, and across the reef. And here are a
-dozen men of Mangaia, splashing’ about in the lagoon, ready to pick up
-the visitor in their powerful arms as soon as the canoe grounds in the
-shallow* water, and carry her ashore.
-
-That is how one lands on Mangaia.
-
-[Illustration: 0209]
-
-This island is of a good size, being some thirty mile» in circumference.
-Its formation is very notable, being indeed rather celebrated among
-geologists. It is supposed to be of volcanic origin, like most of the
-“high” islands. From the sea, it looks much like any other place of
-the same size. But, going inland, one is astonished to find that a mere
-strip of land close round the coast terminates the ground available for
-walking on. A high irregular cliff wall, from fifty to a hundred feet in
-height, encloses the whole interior of the island, which thus resembles
-in shape a very large cup set on a very small saucer. Within the cup lie
-all fertile lands, the taro beds, the yam fields, the pineapple patches,
-the tangled bush, where cotton used to be grown in the days of the
-American war, the low green shrubberies that produce the finest
-coffee in the Cook Islands. To reach them, there is only one way--that
-furnished by a really wonderful rocky staircase, built in prehistoric
-times by the ancestors of the present natives. If one were to find such
-a work in any other of the Cook Islands one might regard it as proof
-positive of the existence of an older and more industrious race, in the
-days before the New Zealand Maori took possession of these lands, and
-grew effeminate and idle in the occupying.
-
-But the people of Mangaia, though identical in descent with incurably
-indolent and sensual Aitutakians and Raratongans, have been moulded by
-their environment to a degree that amounts to an actual difference in
-character. The barrier reef has always prevented the free communication
-enjoyed by other islands, so that they were able to develop along their
-own lines of character, without modification from outside. With an
-island that possessed only a limited amount of fertile land, a matchless
-fortress in the interior, and a complete barrier about the exterior, it
-was a foregone conclusion that the Mangaians should become inhospitable,
-reserved, and hard-working, as compared with the prodigally generous
-and idle folk of the open and fertile islands. They did so. In the
-days before the missions, some sixty years ago, the Mangaians were the
-fiercest cannibals in the group, and determinedly hostile to strangers:
-nor were they ever as pleasure-loving as the other Cook Islanders.
-To-day they are harder in character than the folk of the other islands;
-kindly to strangers, but hardly gushing in their reception of them,
-and so much more industrious than the Aitutakians or Raratongans that
-Mangaian men are sought as servants all over the group.
-
-There is, therefore, no difficulty in understanding how the people of
-Mangaia found energy and time to construct the staircases that span the
-great wall of “Makatea,” enclosing the inner part of the island. Being
-obliged day after day to climb with infinite pains the sharp rocky
-heights of the cliff, in order to get from the fishing grounds to the
-plantations, they would certainly not be long in devising some means of
-lessening this inconvenience. The staircases which are the result
-must have taken many years and much labour in constructing, and it is
-difficult to understand how a people unacquainted with the use of any
-mechanical contrivance could have placed so many large blocks of
-stone in the positions which they occupy. The steps are very high and
-irregular, and on an extremely torrid afternoon it is not exactly the
-walk one would choose for pure enjoyment. However, our time in Mangaia
-was short, so I explained to a native girl that I wanted to see
-the Makatea, and she at once called up half the village to join the
-procession.
-
-Attended, therefore, by my young guide and the inevitable following, I
-went up the mighty stairs, and across the tract of level land lying at
-the top. It is nearly a mile before one comes upon the cup-like valley
-in the centre of the island, so it must be allowed that the rim of the
-cup is a thick one. After a pleasant walk through groves of cocoanut and
-guava, we came upon the inner side of the wall, and stood on the edge
-of a great grey circular cliff, spiked, spired, and towered with
-extraordinary eccentricity, and splendidly garlanded with falling
-masses of sea-green creeper. At one point, a huge split in the rock
-had evidently provided a foundation for the second staircase, which was
-rougher than the first, made of great blocks of stone irregularly laid
-here and there so as to fill up the split in part, and give a foothold
-to the climber. Still, it was a big piece of work, and must have taken
-a good many years--generations, perhaps--to complete. Down in the valley
-below, which seemed to be two or three miles across, were all the native
-plantations and gardens, and as we jumped down from block to block,
-we met hard-faced muscular women toiling upwards with heavy loads of
-vegetables and fruit. In the taro fields, terraced so as to let a little
-stream trickle through and create an artificial swamp, the workers
-seemed to be women only. They dug and scraped in the thick mud under the
-burning sun, leaving off their tasks long enough to stare and question
-a little, and then setting stolidly to work again. The men were probably
-out fishing or pigeon shooting. In spite of Christianity, the island
-woman always carries the heavy end of the load, where there is one
-to carry; the man is the hunter, the woman the labourer and beast of
-burden, as in the cannibal times of long ago.
-
-There are some remarkable caves in the island, and I went into them for
-a mile or so, in company with the local missionary, who kindly offered
-to act as guide.
-
-Caves, however--as most people will allow--are much alike in all parts
-of the earth, and there is nothing to differentiate the long, dark,
-dripping passages, half-glimpsed halls, gloomy crevasses, and dimly
-sparkling stalactite candelabra of a South Sea Island cave, from those
-of a cave near Brighton or the Land’s End. There is no need, therefore,
-to describe the caves of Mangaia further than to say that they were
-quite up to the usual pattern, and that at all events, they gave a touch
-of “Swiss Family Robinson” to the island atmosphere that was pleasing to
-the imagination.
-
-It had, of course, nothing to do with Mangaia, but I wondered as we
-walked back from the caves towards the top of Makatea, how it was that
-the interesting shipwrecked people who live in caves as described in
-fiction, never seem to be troubled with damp? I have, personally, never
-seen a cave--out of a book--that was not first cousin to a showerbath,
-and I should be surprised if any One else had. Who ever saw a genuine
-cave roof that was not covered with stalactites, large or small? and
-what makes stalactites but endless drip? If I were a shipwrecked person,
-I should certainly prefer the temporary house the “useful” character
-always puts up in half an hour with the aid of four growing trees and
-the ship’s mainsail, to the cave that is invariably discovered in
-the second chapter. I should know for certain that the former was the
-driest--even when it rained.
-
-I cannot leave the subject of the strange Makatea, without telling yet a
-little more about it, for it has not often been described or mentioned.
-Geologists say that it is the product of a double volcanic upheaval. The
-first convulsion threw up the island itself, and, in the course of ages,
-the usual encircling reef of coral was built up round it by the busy
-coral insects, working under the water. Then came a second upheaval, and
-the island and reef together were cast up two hundred feet. The Makatea
-is thus the ancient reef that once surrounded the original small island
-which is represented by a crown of heights in the middle of the cup of
-the crater, and by the sunk-down valley about it. The narrow strip of
-land that edges the beach to-day is a later formation.
-
-One cannot mistake the character of the great coral cliff, which is
-quite unlike any kind of stone, or indeed anything but itself. The
-passing ages have turned it to rock, but to rock which is hollowed in
-every direction with caves, small and great, and filled with fossil
-shells as a pudding is filled with plums. No unprotected foot can tread
-the surface of these heights, which are simply a mass of serried grey
-spears, sharp and cruel as the top of a wall protected by broken glass.
-The natives, if convenience leads them to cross any part of the Makatea
-other than the staircases, usually protect their feet with thick sandals
-of woven coir fastened on with cords. One can imagine how much this
-peculiar protection must have added to the safety of the interior of the
-island, in the old predatory days.
-
-The caves were often used for burying places in time gone by, and it is
-only a few years since a “find” of skulls of a type differing in several
-particulars from those of the present day, was made in one of the
-largest caves by a schooner captain. Rumour says that he sold them for a
-good price, but the purchasers were not known.
-
-Another use of the coral caves in the old days (over fifty years ago)
-was a shelter for fugitives of various kinds. The Mangaians were not a
-pleasant people, in those times, either to strangers or each other.
-The outsider was cooked and eaten for the mere offence of presuming to
-exist. The Mangaian was never sure that some one who had a spite against
-him would not murder him--probably by poison, in the use of which
-these people were as expert as the Borgias themselves. Under these
-circumstances, the caves were never without their occupants, living in
-secret, and creeping out at night to pick up a little food. Many and
-romantic are the stories told by the missionaries and traders of these
-stirring times, if I had space to relate them.
-
-Mangaia is a beautiful island, but that goes without saying, in the
-exquisite Cook Group. It has about half a dozen white people, and the
-native population is said to number something under two thousand.
-
-Though a pleasant island and a healthy one, it cannot be recommended
-to planters, as there is not an inch of land available for rent. The
-natives themselves are keen traders and bargainers, and export much
-of their fruit and copra direct to Auckland. Most of what they make is
-spent in trade-finery, for which they have an uncontrollable passion.
-On Sundays, the churches are a very flower-garden of frippery, the men
-turning out in the most brilliant of shirts, ties, and suits, the women
-decking themselves in long loose robes of muslin, sateen, or cheap silk,
-coloured in the most screaming hues--pea-green, royal blue, scarlet, and
-orange being all strong favourites. Their hats, made by themselves out
-of silky arrowroot fibre, are often trimmed with the costliest ribbons
-and artificial flowers, and even with ostrich plumes to the value of
-two or three pounds. It is somewhat puzzling, I was told, to see several
-entire families got up in the same extraordinary style, unless you know
-the reason, which is, that these various households have joined together
-in a club, putting all the money they have made into one purse, and
-sending it down to Auckland on their own account for a bale of gorgeous
-clothing, all alike. Thus you will see twenty or thirty women, on a
-Sunday morning, dressed alike in robes of vermilion satinette, and
-wearing huge hats, crowned by three ostrich feathers, red, yellow, and
-blue, arranged after the fashion of the Prince of Wales’s crest.
-
-This is one of the clubs, and there are sure to be others that vie with
-them in startling attire. Such are the weaknesses--after all, venial
-ones indeed--of the sturdy-souled Mangaian.
-
-Atiu was our next stop, and here the reef-jumping process had to be
-repeated in another form. The ship’s whale-boat, steered by our captain,
-who was the cleverest hand at the big sixteen-foot steer-oar of any
-white man I have ever seen, approached the edge of the reef, and danced
-about in front of it, until the passengers found an opportunity of
-leaping out on to it. Then, rather wetfooted (but no one minded that, in
-a temperature like the hot room of a Turkish bath) we were picked up
-by natives waiting on the shallow side, and carried through the lagoon,
-which was not more than a foot or two deep.
-
-[Illustration: 0217]
-
-On landing, we found a number of the men standing on the shore ready to
-receive the Commissioner. They had been fishing, and were clad simply
-and coolly in a rag and a feather apiece--the latter worn in the hair,
-over one ear. Their dress, however, did not seem to embarrass them
-at all, and they came forward and shook hands with every one,’ quite
-politely. All the Cook islanders are supposed to be Christianised and
-civilised, but in some parts of the group the civilisation, at all
-events, seems to be wearing very thin, and this is notably the case
-in Atiu, an island rather larger than Raratonga, which has no resident
-missionary, save a very conceited and upsetting young native teacher.
-The Atiuans were of old a wilder and fiercer race than even the
-Mangaians, and such determined cannibals that they used to make raids on
-the surrounding islands for the simple purpose of filling their cooking
-ovens, and enjoying a mighty feast. Great war canoes, laden with gory
-corpses, have many a time been’ drawn up on the very stretch of sand
-where we landed, and the grandfathers of the men who greeted us have
-sung and danced in fierce exultation to see the fat limbs and well-fed
-bodies of their enemies laid in ghastly heaps upon the snowy beach,
-ready for the cooking pits that since early morning had been glowing
-with flame in anticipation of the banquet.
-
-“Meek-faced Atiuans” was the nickname bestowed upon these islanders, in
-derision, by those who knew their wiliness and treachery. There is not
-much that is meekfaced about them to-day. They certainly look rougher
-and less amiable than any others of the Cook Islanders, and they are by
-no means so amiable and easy-going as the Raratongans, Aitutakians, and
-people of Mitiaro and Mauke. However, it cannot be said that they are
-in any way dangerous, and the stray white people who have lived in the
-island (there was only one at the time of my visit) have always got on
-well with them. Rough, as I said before, they certainly are. A ring I
-wore on my hand attracted the attention of one or two of the men,
-and they crowded round, fingered it, and actually tried to snatch--an
-attempt very shortly put an end to by the Commissioner, who ordered them
-off peremptorily. The incident, although small, illustrates a standard
-of manners that one would certainly not encounter in any other part
-of the group, or indeed in any one of the Southern or Eastern Pacific
-groups that I afterwards saw.
-
-There was a good deal of native-manufactured lime-juice to be got away
-here, and the people (most of them more completely dressed than the
-party that had received us on the shore) were busy rolling down the
-casks into the water, where the out-going tide took them, and floated
-them across the reef to the schooner. It seemed a strange way of taking
-on cargo, but I learned, afterwards, that it is not uncommon in islands
-surrounded by a dangerous reef.
-
-[Illustration: 0225]
-
-The walk up to the settlement proved to be a good three miles, Atiu
-being one of the very few islands whose natives do not live down on the
-shore. The scenery was fine--wide rich plains covered with low scrub, or
-clothed with thick herbage, alternating with heavy forest. There is no
-better soil in the islands than that of Atiu. Guavas are a common weed;
-pumpkins run wild, trailing their long green vines and heavy fruit
-right across the track, mangoes, chestnuts, Pacific cherries, and othér
-fruits, grow without care or cultivation. Any tropical product can
-be raised, and land is exceedingly cheap. The reef has always been a
-handicap to the island; but I heard that a part had been blown up to
-admit of a boat passage, some time after my visit, also that the Union
-steamers had begun to call for cargoes--an important event in the
-history of any island, and one likely to do much for its future.
-
-The people are few in number--only nine hundred--and do not attempt to
-use more than a very small portion of the thirty-two square miles of
-their territory. Much is available for letting, and every inch of the
-island is worth cultivating, although to a stranger’s eye it is hardly
-as fertile in appearance as other portions of the Cook Group that are
-much less valuable. Coffee, copra, oranges, bananas, sweet potatoes,
-could be profitably grown for export. The climate is good and healthy.
-
-The people have not dwindled down to their present small numbers through
-natural decay. Like another more famous island, Atiu is “swarming with
-absentees.” In the Society Islands, and here and there in other groups,
-whole villages full of Atiuans are to-day to be seen, who emigrated from
-their native country twenty or thirty years ago, owing to difficulties
-with the missionaries, and went to seek an asylum in lands where
-strings were drawn somewhat less tightly than they were at home. They
-never returned, though the island, when I saw it, had no resident white
-missionary at all, and in consequence their lands have lain idle ever
-since. The ill wind has blown good to planters and settlers, however, so
-one need not quarrel with it.
-
-Like Mangaia, Atiu has a cave--only a much larger one, and it has a
-mystery connected with the cave, which no one has yet attempted to
-solve.
-
-Sixty years ago or more (I was told--I do not swear to the truth of
-this or any other island story that I have not had the opportunity of
-investigating in person), an invading tribe came to Atiu, and in the
-course of several battles, defeated and put to rout one of the lesser
-tribes of the island. The vanquished ones, fearing that they would be
-killed and eaten, plucked up courage to try a desperate expedient, and
-hid themselves in the cave, into whose dark recesses no native had ever
-before ventured, for fear of offending the evil spirits that were said
-to live therein. After waiting for a day or two, the enemies gave up the
-contest, and went away again. It was now safe for the hunted tribe to
-come forth, and the other inhabitants of the island looked to see them
-return--for after all, it did not seem likely that the evil spirits
-would destroy so many. They waited in vain. From the unknown depths of
-the cave--unknown, in its innermost recesses, to the present day--no
-sign, no message reached them; no living soul ever came forth of the
-many men, women, and children who had braved the dangers of that dark
-portal. Lost they were, lost they remained.
-
-What happened to them? No one knows. It is not easy to destroy a whole
-tribe, and leave no sign. But the one white man who partly explored the
-cave some years ago, found nothing to hint at the nature of the tragedy.
-It is true that his candles gave out, and the cord that served him for
-a guide back among the endless windings of the place came to an end,
-so that he never knew quite how far the place went, or how many
-ramifications it had. Still, it is strange enough that not so much as a
-single human bone was to be seen. If the tribe had lost their way, and
-perished of hunger, some traces would certainly have been visible--a
-spear, a shell ornament, perhaps a skeleton. If they had fallen in a
-body over some treacherous inner precipice, the dangerous place would
-have been discoverable. Perhaps some new explorer will unravel the
-mystery, one of these days. It will not be a steamer passenger, however,
-for the Union boats on their rare calls do not stay long enough for any
-one to land, and the cave requires two clear days to reach and see.
-
-As we were not even stopping overnight ourselves, I had no opportunity
-of making an exploration on my own account. Thus the mystery rests
-unsolved--unless some one may have come to the island in a stray trading
-schooner since my visit, and found time enough to explore the unknown
-parts of the haunted cavern. The natives of Atiu, needless to say, put
-down the whole thing simply and solely to the revenge of the “local
-demons.”
-
-The people of the settlement, when we reached it, greeted our party
-with boisterous cheerfulness. The officials went to hold their court, as
-usual, and I, being as usual quite uninterested in the details of native
-boundary disputes conducted in an unknown tongue, amused myself with the
-women of the village. It might be more correct to say that they amused
-themselves with me. I do not think any white woman had been up to the
-settlement before I visited it, and the curiosity of the girls was
-uncontrollable. They crowded round me, they slyly felt my hair to see
-if the coils were attached to my head in Nature’s own way (by which I
-conclude that the wearing of false hair is not unknown to themselves),
-they rubbed my dress material in their fingers, they poked me all over
-to see if I was real, and conducted such searching investigations into
-the quantity and style of my clothing, that I was obliged to speak to
-one or two as sharply as I knew how (the tongue was alien, but the tone
-was understood) and make them desist. Withal, they were not ill-natured,
-though certainly a little ill-mannered. They did not forget the duties
-of hospitality, but pressed fruit and cocoanut water on me, and one
-woman insisted on giving me a bottle full of honey to take away--a gift
-that was much appreciated by my fellow-passengers on the schooner, later
-on.
-
-I gratified them extremely by loosening the hair of one or two, and
-putting it up in the latest fashionable style, which proved so popular
-that the whole feminine half of the island set to hair-dressing at once,
-and before I left the island that day, a general and complete revolution
-in coiffure had taken place. We had a good deal of feminine talk among
-ourselves, before the men came out again: the fact that I did not know
-anything of the language, save perhaps half a dozen words, was no bar to
-a certain amount of thought-interchange. How was it done? Signs, for the
-most part: scraps, guesses, hints, stray native words made to do double
-and treble duty. Could I have talked to the husbands and brothers of
-the women in the same way? No, certainly not. All through my wanderings
-among the uncivilised folk of the island world, I was constantly
-interested and amused to see how quick the women were in the language of
-signs and makeshifts, how very uncomprehending the men. If I wanted to
-make a request of any kind, on an island where I did not know any of the
-language, I instinctively sought for a woman to interpret my signs for a
-boat, a guide, a trader’s or missionary’s house, and so forth; and found
-that the women understood, almost as surely as the men, under the same
-circumstances, did not. Psychologists may make what they like of the
-fact. Women, who have talked the “sign-language” to each other, many
-and many a time, over the innocent thick heads of their unsuspecting
-better-halves, friends, or brothers, will never doubt it. We are not as
-clever as men--let the equality brigade shriek if they like, “it’s as
-true as turnips is, as true as taxes”--but neither are we as stupid. God
-forbid!
-
-I had practically the whole day to put in somehow, so, after the
-delights of hair-dressing had palled, and the afternoon was passing on,
-I accepted the invitation of a cheerful, though rather rough-looking
-pair of girls, whom I found crushing limes for lime juice in a very
-primitive sort of hand press, and followed them in to dinner in one of
-the native houses.
-
-There was a distinguished guest to be entertained--a woman of Atiu who
-had been away from the island with her husband for many months, and had
-now returned in the _Duchess_, quite civilised and chic and modern, with
-the up-to-dateness of far-away Auckland. This celebrity, regarded as a
-very Isabella Bird among the island women, scarce any of whom had ever
-seen the other side of their own reef, was seated on the mats when I
-entered, her legs folded under her, native fashion; not without evident
-discomfort, for the heels of very high-heeled, pointed boots are painful
-under such circumstances, and corsets laced to bursting point are
-absolutely deadly. Ritia’s dark face was ominously empurpled, and
-perspiration due as much to agony as to the heat (which was undeniable)
-streamed over her forehead and down, her nose, from under the brim of
-her incredible picture hat. But pride upheld her, for who among the
-other women of the island owned such magnificent clothes?
-
-The people of the house received me with exultation. Now, the feast
-was indeed a gorgeous one, and the sea-green envy sure to be the lot of
-every housewife in settlement with whom I had not dined, shed additional
-lustre on the triumph. The food was just coming in as I entered and
-folded myself up on the mats--roast sucking-pig, smelling very good;
-a fat boiled fowl; some fish from the lagoon, baked like the pig in a
-ground oven, and done to a turn; arrowroot jelly; young green cocoanuts,
-with the meat still unset, clinging to the thin shell like transparent
-blanc-mange; breadfruit, smoking and floury; baked pumpkins; bananas,
-roasted in their skins; sweet potatoes; chestnuts. A large cocoanut,
-picked at the right stage for drinking, stood at each guest’s right
-hand, and in the middle was a big bowl of milky cocoanut cream, into
-which each guest was supposed to dip his food as he ate.
-
-Plates there were none, but I have never thought clean, fresh, green
-leaves, a foot or two across, unpleasant substitutes for delf or china,
-which is handled and used by hundreds of eaters, and must be washed in
-greasy hot water at the end of every meal. There is a good deal to
-be said for the native custom, whether the point of view be that of
-convenience, cleanliness, or simple beauty.
-
-I, as the principal guest, was offered everything first, which obviated
-any unpleasantness that might have arisen from the entire absence of
-knives and forks. There is no hardship in eating with your fingers, if
-yours are the first to plunge into every dish, and you have your nice
-fresh leaf to yourself. The little pig I did not touch, because no one
-who has lived as much as a week in the islands will venture on native
-pork, good as it looks and smells. When an unfortunate beast is killed
-by strangulation, and never bled, and when you know that it has lived at
-its gipsy will, and fed more abominably than a land-crab, you are apt
-to find you are “not hungry” when its crackling little carcase comes to
-table in cerements of green leaves, and you ask for the breadfruit and
-the fish instead.
-
-The feast seemed likely to go on all afternoon, since no native thinks
-he has eaten enough, on such an occasion, until he is as gorged and as
-comatose as a stuffed anaconda. There is no obligation to stay longer
-than one likes, however, so I washed my hands and withdrew, as soon as
-it seemed good to me to do so.
-
-And by the way, if we of the civilised countries think that we invented
-fingerbowls, either in form, or in use, we are mistaken. The South
-Seas invented them, a few hundred years before we found out they were
-necessary to our own delicate refinement. A bowl full of water is handed
-round to every diner in a South Sea house. The water is from the river,
-pure and fresh; the bowl is of a mould more perfect than the most
-exquisite models of ancient Greece, delicately hued with pale brown in
-the inner part, and deep sienna brown outside. It is half a cocoanut
-shell--beautiful, useful, practically unbreakable, yet not of sufficient
-worth to prevent its being thrown away to-morrow and replaced by a fresh
-one from the nearest palm. Fresh plates and cups for one’s food are a
-refinement that our refined civilisation has not attained to yet. You
-must go to savages to look for them.
-
-I thanked my hosts for their entertainment, in good English, when I
-left. They understood the words and tone almost as clearly as if I had
-spoken in their own language, and gave me a ringing salutation that
-followed me down the road. That a number of Atiuan men, coming up from
-the shore, burst out laughing when they saw me, and held on to each
-other in convulsions of merriment at the sight of my absurd white face
-and ridiculous clothes, did not detract from the real kindliness of
-the reception the island had given me. The manners of the Atiuan would
-certainly throw a Tahitian or a courtly Samoan into a fit; but for
-all that, he is not at bottom a bad sort, and could certainly be made
-something of with training.
-
-One of the Arikas of Atiu--a woman again: there seemed to be very few
-male chiefs in the islands--was pointed out to me as I went down to
-the shore, and I photographed her sitting in her chair. She looked
-dignified, and her long descent was visible in the pose of her small
-head, and the delicacy of her hands, but she did not possess much claim
-to beauty.
-
-[Illustration: 0249]
-
-The _Duchess_ was standing off and on outside the reef when I came out
-on the beach again, and the barrels were merrily floating out, rolled
-down into the water by the hands of bu§y brown men and women. It was a
-pretty scene in the low yellow sunlight of the waning afternoon,’ and
-I carried it away with me, long after we had sailed; as a pleasant
-recollection of Atiu.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER IX
-
-_Islands and Adventures--What about the Missionary?--The Lotus
-Eaters--How to hunt the Robber-Crab--The Ship that would not
-sail--Proper Place of a Passenger--One Way to get wrecked--The Pirate
-and the Pearls._
-
-MAUKE, Manuwai, and Takutea still remained to be seen, before the
-_Duchess_ could spread her wings for Raratonga again. We sailed from one
-to another in the course of a few days. There was no hurry, and a day
-wasted here or there troubled none of us.
-
-Sometimes the “trades,” which are very fickle about here, came up and
-caught our towering canvas in a cool embrace; then the great hollows of
-the sails hummed with the music that the ocean wanderer loves, and the
-_Duchess_ skimmed the rolling blue hills like a flying-fish. Sometimes
-the wind fell, and the booms swung and creaked lazily above the burning
-deck; then we trolled for albacore and bonito, shrieking with savage joy
-when our bit of long-desired fresh food came flapping and fighting over
-the rail; or we watched the crew hook devil-faced grey sharks, which,
-“took charge” of the deck when captured, hitting terrible blows with
-their tails, and snapping stout ropes with their savage teeth; or we got
-out boats, and rowed them for miles between the double furnaces of the
-blazing sun and the glowing sea, coming back to the ship scorched into
-cinders, stiff with exertion, but happy. At night the Southern Cross
-burned white in the velvet sky, and the coral rocks about the lagoons
-showed in shimmering pale blue underneath fifty feet or more of clear,
-moonlit water. Lying on the poop, like seals on sand, the little knot
-of passengers, captain, and mate, “yarned” for hour after hour--strange,
-wild tales of frontier life in new lands; of adventures in unknown seas;
-of fights, and more fights, and fights yet again--literature in the
-rough, a very gallery of vivid pictures wasted unseen... and yet, what
-should any man who had the rich reality care about its pale shadow,
-Story? “Do you care much for reading?” “Well, no,” answers the
-bare-footed officer lying with his head in a coil of rope; “books
-aren’t very interesting, are they?”
-
-I, watching the mizzen truck swing among the stars, look back over the
-long, long trail--long both in distance and in time--that separates this
-small heaving deck in the midst of the tropic seas from the rush of the
-wintry Strand, Nights in islands of ill reputation, when I slept with
-“one eye open” and one hand within touch of my revolver (for there are
-incidents of my wanderings that I have not told, and only those who know
-the Eastern Pacific may guess at them); days when only a fifty-to-one
-chance kept the little schooner from piling her bones on a spouting
-coral reef in mid-ocean--rough fare, hard lodging, and long fatigue,
-sometimes, all to be “eaten as helped,” without comment or complaint,
-for that is the rule of island life--the pungent taste of danger, now
-and then, gratefully slaking some deep, half-conscious thirst derived
-from fiercer centuries; the sight of many lands and many peoples--these,
-and other pictures, painted themselves among the little gold stars swept
-by the rocking masts, as I lay^ remembering. I thought of the pile of
-untouched “shockers” in my cabin; of grey London and its pyramids of
-books and armies of writers; of the mirror that they hold up to life,
-and the “magic web of colours gay” they weave, always looking, like
-the Lady of Shalott, in the mirror, and seldom joining the merry
-rout outside, where no one cares a pin for coloured tapestries, and
-looking-glasses are left to half-grown girls. No, truly; “books are not
-interesting,” when you can have life instead.
-
-Upon which some one proposed “Consequences” in the cabin, and I made
-haste to climb down.
-
-Another day, gold and blue as are almost all the days of the “winter”
- season, and another island, burning white and blazing green, and another
-tumbling reef to jump, with the help of a powerful boat-holder, who
-stands in the midst of the surf, and drags the dinghy forward at the
-right moment. This is Mauke: we are getting on with the group, and begin
-to realise that some time or other, even in these timeless regions, will
-actually see us back at Raratonga.
-
-Mauke proves to be a pretty little place, some six miles in
-circumference, “low” in type, but park-like and gardenlike and dainty
-enough to wake covetous desires in the heart of almost any traveller. It
-has the finest oranges in the group--growing completely wild--and we
-are greeted on the shore by the usual crowd of flower-wreathed natives,
-bearing splendid branches of rich yellow fruit, which they present
-to every one with eager generosity. There are only three hundred and
-seventy natives in the island, and much of the land lies waste, though
-it is exceedingly fertile. The Mauke folk take things easy on the whole,
-and are not keen on trading. They export some oranges, some copra, a few
-bunches of dried bananas, and they buy a fair amount of cotton cloth,
-and shirts, and cutlery, from the white trader’s store. But no one, so
-far, has grown fat on what Mauke makes or buys.
-
-There were, at the time of my visit, only one or two whites in the
-place. The greater portion of the land available for planting lay
-unused. Probable rents, on long leases, were quoted to me as a shilling
-or so an acre.
-
-The call at Mauke was short, and I saw little of the island. The natives
-insisted, however, that I should come up to the village and look at
-their church, of which they are very proud, so I headed the inevitable
-procession through the orange and lime and guava groves, to the little
-group of houses, partly thatch and reed, partly whitewashed concrete,
-that made up the settlement. The church was, of course, much the least
-interesting thing in the island. South Sea churches, with one or two
-happy exceptions, are blots in a world of beauty, monuments of bad
-taste, extravagance, and folly, that do very little credit to the
-religions they represent. In the days when most of them were built, the
-one idea of the missionary was the assimilation of the native to
-white men’s ways and customs, as far as was possible, by any means
-conceivable--wise, or otherwise. In building churches for the new
-converts, the pattern followed was that set by Europeans for use in
-a cold climate, on sites that had a distinct money value per yard.
-Consequently, while South Sea houses, for coolness, are made almost all
-window and door, or else built, native fashion, in such a way that
-the air blows through the walls, South Sea churches are almost without
-ventilation, and (because the style of architecture selected is that of
-the whitewashed barn description) quite without beauty of any kind.
-In most cases, they have cost the islands appalling sums to build, and
-continue to demand a good deal to keep them in repair. There are happy
-exceptions here and there. Niué, of which place I have more to say later
-on, possesses a church built with exquisite taste and perfect regard to
-convenience, and the Catholic cathedral in Samoa is designed with much
-consideration as to climate, and appearance as well.
-
-Mauke’s church, however, is not one of the exceptions, being exceedingly
-bald and ugly, and it is furthermore disfigured by the most horrible
-lapse of taste to be seen in almost any island church--the decoration of
-the pulpit and communion rails with silver dollars nailed on in rows. I
-told the crowd of natives, eager to hear the praises of their wonderful
-church, that I had never seen anything like it in my life--which seemed
-to afford them much gratification. I did not add what I thought--that I
-sincerely hoped I might never see anything like it again.
-
-A statement made only once or twice is fairly sure to miss the
-observation of the average reader, so I make no apology for saying here,
-as I have said in other parts of this book, that I am not one of those
-people who are opposed to mission work, or indifferent to religion;
-neither am I inclined to minimise the effects of the work done by
-missionaries in converting and civilising the Pacific generally. That
-the missionaries are infallible and always wise, however, in their
-methods of dealing with the natives, I do deny--which is only equivalent
-to saying that they are human, like the people at home. Nor do I think
-that, in these days, the missionary who takes up work in the Southern
-and Eastern Pacific has any need to wear the martyr aureole which is so
-persistently fitted on to the heads of all who go to “labour” in the
-island world. We are not in the days of Cook: cannibalism, over most of
-the Pacific, is dead and forgotten, violence to white people of any kind
-is unheard of, the climates are usually excellent, the islands
-beautiful, fertile, and happy, and the missionary’s work is much the
-same as that of any country clergyman at home, save for the fact that
-his congregation are infinitely more submissive than whites would be,
-and incline to regard their teacher as a sovereign, not only spiritual,
-but temporal. The mission house is always much the finest building on
-the island, and the best furnished and provided. The missionary’s
-children are usually sent away to be educated at good home or colonial
-boarding schools, and afterwards return to take up their parents’ work,
-or possibly to settle in the islands in other capacities. The life,
-though busy, is devoid of all stress and strain, and there is no
-apparent difficulty in “making both ends meet”--and overlap. In the
-Southern and Eastern Pacific, the missionaries are conveyed from group
-to group in a mission steamer that is little inferior to the yacht of a
-millionaire, for comfort and elegance. They are constantly assisted by
-gifts of all kinds, and treated with consideration wherever they go, and
-in most cases enjoy a social position much better than that originally
-possessed at home. It is hard to see why a profession, which is so
-pleasant and profitable, should be exalted over the work of thousands of
-struggling pastors and clergymen at home, who too often know the pinch
-of actual want, and are in many cases obliged to lead lives of the
-greyest and narrowest monotony.
-
-What is the moral? That one should not give money to missions? Certainly
-not. But if I were a millionaire, and had thousands to give in such
-a cause, I would give them carefully, with inquiry, directed to more
-sources than one, and would distribute them so that they should be used,
-if possible, in adding to the numbers of the Christian Church, rather
-than in teaching geography and English grammar and dressmaking to
-amiable brown people who are, and have been for generations, a good deal
-more Christian than ninety in a hundred whites. I believe firmly that
-most of the older missions in the Pacific could be continued perfectly
-well with the aid of native teachers, at one-twentieth the present
-cost--much as the teaching of outlying far-away islands, where residence
-is unpleasant for white families, is carried on to-day, with the aid
-of a yearly visit or so. That the present system will ever be modified,
-however, I do not believe. The reasons for such a conclusion are too
-obvious to need discussion.
-
-I have wandered a good way from the church at Mauke. But there are many
-points on this subject of island missions, nevertheless, on which I have
-not touched.
-
-Some of the men of Mauke were very busy on the shore, when our party
-passed down again to the boat. They made a bright picture, in their gay
-pareos of scarlet and yellow, and the snowy coronets of scented island
-flowers that they had twined about their heads. But the most picturesque
-thing about them was their occupation, which was neither more nor less
-than sand-castle building! There they sat, those big grown men, with
-never a child among them to make excuse for their play, building up
-churches and houses of the milk-white coral sand, scooping dark windows
-in the edifices, training green creepers up them, and planting out odd
-little gardens of branching coral twigs off the reef, in the surrounding
-pleasances. They had bundles of good things tied up in green leaves,
-lying somewhere in the shade of the guava bushes, and they had brought a
-pile of husked cocoanuts down to the shore with them, to drink when they
-pleased. They may have been waiting for a native boat, or they may have
-been simply making a day of it. In any case, they were sublimely happy.
-
-_(Cold rain on the miry road; faint gold sunset fading to stormy grey;
-wet leaves a-shiver in the dusk--and the long, long way before the tired
-feet. A day of toil, a comfortless night. A handful of coppers in the
-pocket; food and fire that must be bought with silver; freedom, rest,
-enjoyment, that cost unattainable gold. The sacred right of labour;
-a white man’s freedom. O, brown half-naked islanders, playing at
-sand-castles on your sun-bathed shore, with unbought food lying among
-the unpurchased fruits beside you, what would you give to be one of the
-master race?)_
-
-Takutea we did not call at, since it was uninhabited, but the _Duchess_,
-under her daring little pirate of a captain, made no bones about running
-as close to anything, anywhere, as her passengers might desire, so we
-saw the fascinating place at fairly close quarters. In 1904, when I saw
-it, it was a real “desolate island,” being twelve miles out in the open
-sea from the nearest land (Atiu), and totally uninhabited. Its extent
-is four or five hundred acres; it is thickly wooded with cocoanuts-, and
-has a good spring of water. The beautiful “bo’sun bird,” whose long red
-and white tail feathers have a considerable commercial value, is common
-on the island. No one had visited it for a long time when we sailed by;
-the wide white beach was empty, the cocoanut palms dropped their nuts
-unheeded into earth that received them gladly, and set them forth
-again in fountain-like sprays of green. The surf crumbled softly on
-the irregular fringing reef; the ripples of the lagoon laid their ridgy
-footsteps along the empty strand, and no Man Friday came to trample
-them out-with a step of awful significance. I wanted Takutea very badly
-indeed, all for myself; but I shall not have it now, neither will the
-reader, for some one else has bought it, and it is to be turned into a
-cocoanut plantation.
-
-Manuwai, better known as Hervey Island, is not many miles away, but we
-took a day or more to reach it, partly because the winds were contrary,
-partly because (with apologies to the Admiralty Surveys) it was wrongly
-charted, and could not be found, at first, in a slight sea-fog. Manuwai
-has changed its ownership and its use, of late, but in 1904 it was a
-penal settlement and a copra plantation combined, being used as a
-place of punishment for sinful Cook Islanders, who were compulsorily
-let out as labourers to the Company renting the two islets of which this
-so-called group is composed.
-
-The islands between them cover about fifteen hundred acres, according
-to the estimate given me. They have no permanent inhabitants, and when
-first taken up for planting, were quite desolate of life. A far-away,
-melancholy little place looked Manuwai, under the rays of the declining
-sun, as we came up to the reef. The two low islands, with their thick
-pluming of palms, are enclosed in the same lagoon, sheltered by a reef
-of oval form. There were a couple of drying-huts on the beach, and some
-heaps of oily smelling copra, when our boat pulled in. About twenty men,
-some convicts, some hired labourers, were gathered on the shore, fairly
-dancing with excitement, and the rest of the population--one white
-overseer, and one half-caste--were waiting on the very edge of the
-water, hardly less agitated. No ships ever called except the _Duchess_,
-and she was long overdue.
-
-I stepped on shore, and was immediately shaken hands with, and
-congratulated on being the first white woman to set foot on the island.
-Then we all went for a walk, while the native crew fell into the arms of
-the labourers, and with cries of joy began exchanging gossip, tobacco,
-hats, and shirts, bartering oranges from the ship for cocoanut crabs
-from the island, and eagerly discussing the question of who was going
-home in the _Duchess_, and who would have to stop over till her next
-call, perhaps six months hence.
-
-Manuwai is not one of the most beautiful of the islands, but anything
-in the way of solid ground was welcome after the gymnastics of the
-too-lively _Duchess_. The cocoa-nut plantations, and the new clearings,
-where the bush was being burned away, interested the officials from
-Raratonga, and the “boulevard” planted by the overseer--a handsome
-double row of palms, composing an avenue that facetiously began in
-nothing, and led to nowhere, received due admiration. We heard a
-good deal about the depredations of the cocoanut crabs, and as these
-creatures are among the strangest things that ever furnished food for
-travellers’ tales, I shall give their history as I gathered it, both in
-Manuwai and other places.
-
-One must not, by the way, believe all that one hears, or even half,
-among the “sunny isles of Eden.” Flowers of the imagination flourish
-quite as freely as flowers and fruits of the earth, and are much less
-satisfactory in kind. Also, it is a recognised sport to “spin yarns” to
-a newcomer, with the pious object of seeing how much he--or she--will
-swallow; and where so much is strange, bizarre, and almost incredible,
-among undoubted facts, it is hard to sift out the fictions of the
-playful resident.
-
-However, the cocoanut crab is an undeniable fact, with which many a
-planter has had to wrestle, much to his loss. It must be confessed that
-I had expected something very exciting indeed, when I heard in Tahiti
-that cocoanut or robber crabs were still to be found in some parts of
-the Cook Group. One of the most grisly bugbears of my youth had been
-the descriptions of the terrible cocoanut crab that attacked the “Swiss
-Family Robinson” on their wonderful island. It was described, if my
-memory serves me, as “about the size of a turtle.” and was dark blue in
-colour; it descended rapidly backwards down a tree, and immediately went
-to the attack of a Robinson youth, who repulsed it at the peril of his
-life.... On the whole, I thought it would make things interesting, if it
-really was in the Cook Group.
-
-I never was more disappointed in my life than when I really saw one. It
-was dead, and cured in formalin, and only brought down from an island
-house as a show, but that was not the trouble. It was not more than two
-and a half feet long, lobster tail and all; it was not in the least like
-a turtle, and any small boy armed with a good stick could have faced it
-without fear, at its worst. No, decidedly the terrible crab was not up
-to the travellers’ tales that had been told about it.
-
-Still, it was worth seeing, for it was like nothing on the earth or in
-the sea that I had ever encountered. It had been excellently preserved,
-and looked wonderfully alive, when laid on the sand at the foot of a
-cocoanut palm. Its colour, as in life, was a gay mixture of red and
-blue. It had a long body like a colossal lobster, and two claws, one
-slight and thin, the other big enough to crack the ankle-bone of a man.
-It was an ugly and a wicked-looking thing, and I was not surprised to
-hear that it fights fiercely, if caught away from its hole, sitting up
-and threatening man or beast with its formidable claw, and showing no
-fear whatever.
-
-In the daylight, however, it is very seldom seen abroad. We walked
-through groves that were riddled with its holes that afternoon,
-but never even heard the scuffle of a claw. The creature lives in
-rabbit-like burrows at the foot of palm-trees, and the natives can
-always tell the size of the inmate by a glance at the diameter of the
-hole by which it enters its burrow. At night it comes out, climbs the
-nearest palm, and gets in among the raffle of young and old leaves,
-fibre, stalks, and nuts, in the crown, there it selects a good nut, nips
-the stalk in two with its claw, and lets the booty drop with a thump
-to the earth, seventy or eighty feel below. Then the marauder backs
-cautiously down the tree, finds the nut, and proceeds to rip and rend
-the tough husk until the nut as we know it at home is laid bare. A
-cocoanut shell is no easy thing to crack, as most people know, but the
-robber crab with its huge claws makes nothing more of it than we should
-make of an egg, and in a minute the rich oily meat is at the mercy
-of the thief, and another fraction of a ton of copra is lost to the
-planter. It goes without saying that any stray nuts lying on the ground
-have been opened and destroyed, before the crab will trouble itself to
-climb.
-
-Cocoanut crab is very good eating, and as it is mostly found in barren
-coral islands where little or nothing will grow but palms, the natives
-are always keen on hunting the “robber.” Sometimes he is secured by
-thrusting a lighted torch down a hole which possesses two exits--the
-crab hurrying out at the unopposed side as soon as the flame invades his
-dwelling. Sometimes the islanders secure him by the simple process of
-feeling for him in his burrow, and stabbing him at the end of it with
-a knife. This is decidedly risky, however, and may result in a smashed
-hand or wrist for the invader. A favourite plan is the following: Slip
-out in the dark, barefoot and silent, and hide yourself in a cocoanut
-grove till you see or hear a crab making his way up a tree. Wait till
-he is up at the top, and then climb half-way up, and tie a band of grass
-round the trunk. Now hurry down and pile a heap of rough coral stones
-from the beach at the foot of the tree. Slip away into the shadow again,
-and wait. The crab will start to come down presently, backing carefully,
-tail first, for he has a bare and unprotected end to his armoured body,
-and uses it to inform himself of his arrival on the safe ground below.
-Half-way down the tree he touches your cunning band of grass. “Down so
-soon?” he remarks to himself, and lets go. Crack! he has shot down forty
-feet through air, and landed smashingly on the pile of stones that you
-carefully prepared for his reception.
-
-He is badly injured, ten to one, and you will have little trouble in
-finishing him off with your knife, and carrying home a savoury supper
-that is well worth the’ waiting for. That is the native way of hunting
-robber crabs.
-
-When one lives on a cocoanut plantation, on an island that contains
-practically nothing else, one comes in time to know everything that is
-to be known about cocoanuts in general. But even the manager of Manuwai
-could not solve for me a problem that had been perplexing me ever since
-I had first seen a cocoanut palm--a problem, indeed, that after several
-more years of island travel, remains unanswered yet.
-
-Why is no one ever killed by a cocoanut?
-
-The question seems an idle one, if one thinks of cocoa-nuts as they are
-seen in British shops--small brown ovals of little weight or size--and
-if one has never seen them growing, or heard them fall. But when one
-knows that, the smallest nuts alone reach England (since they are sold
-by number, not by weight) and that the ordinary nut, in its husk and on
-its native tree, is as big as one’s own head, and as heavy as a solid
-lump of hard wood--that most trees bear seventy or eighty nuts a year,
-and that every one of those nuts has the height of a four-storey house
-to drop before it reaches the ground--that native houses are usually
-placed in the middle of a palm grove, and that every one in the islands,
-brown or white, walks underneath hundreds of laden cocoanut trees every
-day in the year--it then becomes a miracle of the largest kind that no
-one is ever killed, and very rarely injured, by the fall of the nuts.
-Nor can the reason be sought in the fact that the nuts cannot hurt. One
-is sure to see them fall from time to time, and they shoot down from
-the crown of the palm like flying bomb-shells, making a most portentous
-thump as they reach the earth. So extremely rare are accidents, however,
-that in nearly three years I did not hear of any mishap, past or
-present, save the single case of a man who was struck by a falling nut
-in the Cook Islands, and knocked insensible for an hour or two. This is
-certainly not a bad record for a tour extending over so many thousand
-miles, and including most of the important island groups--every one
-of which grows cocoanut palms by the thousand, in some cases, by the
-hundred thousand.
-
-Travellers are often a little nervous at first, when riding or walking
-all day long through woods of palm, heavily laden with ponderous nuts.
-But the feeling never lasts more than a few days. One does not know
-why one is never hit by these cannon-balls of Nature--but one never is,
-neither is anybody else, so all uneasiness dies out very quickly, and
-one acquiesces placidly in the universal miracle.
-
-Planters say that most of the nuts fall at night, when the dew has
-relaxed the fibres of the stalks. This would be an excellent reason,
-but for the fact that the nuts don’t fall any more at night than in the
-daytime, if one takes the trouble to observe, and that damp, or dew,
-tightens up fibres of all kind, instead of relaxing them. If one asks
-the natives, the usual answer is: “It just happens that way”; and I
-fancy that is as near as any one is likely to get to a solution.
-
-Manuwai, since I saw it, has been purchased outright by a couple of
-adventurous young Englishmen, who are working it as a copra plantation.
-Takutea has, therefore, a neighbour in the Robinson Crusoe business, and
-is not likely to be quite so solitary as in times past.
-
-The tour of the group was now ended, and the Government officials were
-conveyed back to Raratonga with all possible despatch--which is not
-saying very much, after all. There followed a luxurious interval of real
-beds and real meals, and similar Capuan delights, in the pretty island
-bungalow where my lot for the time had been cast. Then the _Duchess_
-began to start again, and peace was over. A sailing vessel does not
-start in the same way as a steamer. She gives out that she will leave
-on such a day, at such an hour, quite like the steamer; but there the
-resemblance ends. When you pack your cabin trunk, and have it taken
-down at 11 a.m., you find there is no wind, so you take it back and call
-again next day. There is a wind now, but from the one quarter that makes
-it practically impossible to get out of port.’ You are told you had
-better leave your trunk, in case of the breeze shifting. You do, and
-go back for the second time to the hostess from whom you have already
-parted twice. The verandah (every one lives on verandahs, in the
-islands) is convulsed to see you come back, and tells you this is the
-way the ship always does “get off.” You spend a quiet evening, and go
-to bed. At twelve o’clock, just as you are in the very heart of your
-soundest sleep, a native boy comes running up to the house to say that
-the captain has sent for the passenger to come down at once, for the
-wind is getting up, and he will sail in a quarter of an hour! You
-scramble into your clothes, run down to the quay, get rowed out to
-the ship, and finish your sleep in your cabin to the accompaniment of
-stamping feet and the flapping sails; and behold, at eight o’clock, the
-bo’sun thunders on your door, and tells you that breakfast is in, but
-the breeze is away again, and the ship still in harbour! After breakfast
-you sneak up the well-known avenue again, feeling very much as if you
-had run away from school, and were coming back in disgrace. This time,
-the verandah shrieks until the natives run to the avenue gate to see
-what is the matter with the man “papalangis,” and then console you with
-the prophecy that the schooner won’t get away for another week.
-
-She does, though. In the middle of the afternoon tea, the captain
-himself arrives, declines to have a cup, and says it is really business
-this time, and he is away. You go down that eternal avenue again,
-followed by cheerful cries of “No goodbye! we’ll keep your place at
-dinner,” and in half an hour the green and purple hills of lovely
-Raratonga are separated from you by a widening plain of wind-ruffled
-blue waves, and the _Duchess_ is fairly away to Savage Island.
-
-“Miss G--------, have you nearly done your book?”
-
-“Pretty nearly--why?” I ask, looking up from the pages of “John
-Herring.”
-
-We are a day or two out from Raratonga, but not even one hundred of the
-six hundred miles that lie between the Cook Group and lonely Niué is
-compassed as yet. The winds have been lightest of the light, and from
-the wrong quarter too, until this morning, when we have “got a slant” at
-last. Now the _Duchess_ is rolling along in her usual tipsy fashion
-at seven or eight knots an hour, and the china-blue sea is ruffled and
-frilled with snow. It is hot, but not oppressively so, and I have
-been enjoying myself most of the morning lounging on a pile of locker
-cushions against the deck-house, alternately reading, and humming to
-myself something from Kipling about:
-
- Sailing south on the old trail, our own trail, the out trail,
-
- Sliding south on the long trail, the trail that is always new.
-
-The pirate captain has been at the wheel for the last two hours, but I
-have not taken much note of the fact. Our only mate left us in the Cook
-Group, for a reason not absolutely new in the history of the world (a
-pretty little reason she was, too); and our bo’sun, who has been giddily
-promoted to a rank that he describes as “chief officer,” is not exactly
-a host in himself, though he is a white man. In consequence, the pirate
-and he have been keeping watch and watch since we sailed--four hours on
-and four hours off--and, as one or two of our best A.B.s declined to go
-down to Niué, and most of the others are bad helmsmen, the two whites
-have been at the wheel during the greater part of their watches.
-
-I have grown quite accustomed to seeing one or other standing aft of
-the little companion that leads down to the cabin, lightly shifting the
-spokes in his hands hour after hour. It never occurred to me, however,
-that I was personally interested in the matter.
-
-But we are in the South Pacific, and I have still a good many things to
-find out about the “way they do things at sea,” here where the ocean is
-the ocean, and no playground for globe-trotting tourists.
-
-“Are you nearly done?” asks the pirate again, shifting half a point, and
-throwing a glance at the clouds on the windward side. They are harmless
-little clouds, and only suggest a steady breeze.
-
-“I have about half an hour’s reading left,” I answer.
-
-“Then you’d better chuck the book into your cabin, for it’s almost eight
-bells, and that begins your trick at the wheel,” says the pirate calmly.
-
-“My _what?_”
-
-“Your trick. Your turn. Time you have to steer, see?”
-
-“But, good heavens! I never had a wheel in my hand in my life--I don’t
-know how!”
-
-“That’s your misfortune, not your fault,” says the pirate kindly.
-“You’ll never have to say that again.. There’s eight bells now--come
-along. J------ and I have had too much of the wheel, and now we’re well
-away from land is your time to learn.”
-
-And from thenceforth until we made the rocky coast of Niué, more than a
-week later, I spent a portion of every day with the polished spokes of
-the wheel in my hands, straining my eyes on the “lubber’s point,” or
-anxiously watching the swelling curves of the sails aloft in the windy
-blue, ready to put the wheel up the instant an ominous wrinkle began
-to flap and writhe upon the marble smoothness of the leaning canvas. At
-night, the smallest slatting of sail upon the mast would start me out of
-my sleep, with an uneasy fear that I was steering, and had let her get
-too, close to the wind; and I deposed most of my prayers in favour of
-an evening litany that began: “North, north by east, nor’-nor’-east,
-nor’-east by north, nor’-east,” and turned round upon itself to go
-backward in the end, like a spell said upside down to raise a storm.
-
-Withal, the good ship left many a wake that would have broken the back
-of a snake, for the first day or two of my lessons, and the native A.B.s
-used to come and stand behind me when an occasional sea made the wheel
-kick, under the evident impression that they would be wanted before
-long. But I learned to steer--somehow--before we got to Niué, and I
-learned to lower away boats, and to manage a sixteen foot steer-oar,
-when we got becalmed, and spent the day rowing about among the
-mountainous swells, out of sheer boredom. And for exercise and sport,
-I learned to go up into the cross-trees and come down again by the
-ratlines or the back-stay, whichever seemed the handiest, wearing the
-flannel gymnasium dress I had brought for mountaineering excursions.
-It was very pleasant up there on a bright, salt-windy morning, when the
-_Duchess_ swung steadily on her way with a light favouring breeze, her
-little white deck lying below me like a tea-tray covered with walking
-dolls, her masts at times leaning to leeward until my airy seat was
-swung far out across the water. Having a good head, I was never troubled
-with giddiness, and used to do a good deal of photographing from
-aloft, when the ship was steady enough to allow of it. That was seldom,
-however, for the _Duchess_ had been built in New Zealand, where the good
-schooners do not come from, and had no more hold on the water than
-a floating egg. More than one sailing vessel turned out by the same
-builders had vanished off the face of the ocean, in ways not explained,
-by reason of the absence of survivors, but dimly guessed at, all the
-same; and I cannot allow that the pirate captain had any just cause
-of annoyance--even allowing for a master’s pride in his ship--when I
-recommended him to have the schooner’s name painted legibly on her keel
-before he should leave Auckland on his next northward journey, just “in
-case.”
-
-We were about a hundred and fifty miles off Niué, when the pirate came
-to me one windy morning, and asked me if I wanted to see something that
-had only been once seen before.
-
-There was, of course, only one reply possible.
-
-“Then keep a look-out, and you’ll see it,” said the pirate. “We’re going
-to run right by Beveridge Reef, and it’s been only once sighted. What’s
-more, it’s wrong charted, and I’m going to set it right. You’ve no idea
-what a lot of wrecks there have been on that d-------- that dangerous
-place. Not a soul ever got away from one of them to tell what happened,
-either. They’d only know when things began drifting down to Niué, weeks
-after--timber and cargo, and so on--why, a lot of the houses in Niué
-are built out of wreckage--and then people would say that there’d been
-another wreck on Beveridge Reef. Some fool reported it as a coral island
-two miles across, once upon a time, but I’ll bet he never saw it. If it
-had been, it wouldn’t have been as destructive as it is.”
-
-Late in the day we sighted it. The pirate was aloft, swinging between
-heaven and earth, with a glass in his hand, calling out observations to
-the chief-officer-boatswain below. The crew were attending exclusively
-to the horizon, and letting the ship look after herself, according to
-the amiable way of Maories when there is anything interesting afoot. The
-weather was darkening down, and heavy squalls of rain swept the sea now
-and then. But there it was, clearly enough to be seen in the intervals
-of the squalls, a circle of white foam enclosing an inner patch of livid
-green, clearly marked off from the grey of the surrounding ocean. Here
-and there a small black tooth of rock projected from the deadly ring of
-surf, and--significant and cruel sight--two ships’ anchors were plainly
-to be seen through the glass, as we neared the reef, lying fixed among
-the rock, so low in the water as only to be visible at intervals.
-
-“A wicked place,” said the captain, who had come down from his eyrie,
-and was giving orders for the preparation of a boat. “Couldn’t see a bit
-of it at night--couldn’t see it in broad daylight, if there was a big
-sea on. And wrong charted too. Think of the last minutes of those poor
-chaps the anchors belonged to!”
-
-The sea and sky were really beginning to look nasty, and I did not want
-to think of it. But the pirate went discoursing pleasantly of deaths and
-wrecks, while the men were putting various things into the whaleboat,
-and getting ready to lower away. He did not often have a passenger, but
-when he did, he evidently thought it his duty to keep her entertained.
-
-We were very near to the reef now--so close that I was able to take a
-photograph of it, a little marred by the rainy weather. Meantime,
-the boat was being swung out, and the men were getting in. And now
-“a strange thing happened.” Out of nowhere at all eight sharks
-appeared--large ones, too--and began to cruise hungrily about the
-_Duchess’s_ hull, their lithe yellowish bodies sharply outlined in the
-dark blue water, their evil eyes fixed on me, as I overhung the rail to
-look at them. “If only!” they said as plainly as possible, with those
-hideously intelligent green orbs. “If only------”
-
-“What has brought those horrible brutes about us?” I asked.
-
-“Those? oh, they’re waiting to be fed, I suppose. Pretty much all the
-ships that came this way before us have given them a good dinner. I bet
-they say grace before meat now every time they see a sail, which isn’t
-often. Here, you Oki, put in that keg of beef.”
-
-“Where are you going?” I demanded with considerable interest, for the
-pirate captain never did things like any one else, and I scented an
-adventure.
-
-“Going to find out what the inside of that lagoon is really like. No
-one ever put a boat into it yet. No, you can’t be in it this time: very
-sorry, but----”
-
-“What?”
-
-“Well, you see, one isn’t absolutely sure of getting back again, in a
-place like this. Didn’t you see me put in grub and water and a compass?
-I don’t think you’d like a boat voyage down to Niué, if we happened to
-miss the train. The mate has the course, and could take her on, if I
-came to grief. No, it isn’t any use asking, I just can’t. Lower away.”
-
-They lowered and------
-
-Well, if the pirate had been a shade less determined about the number in
-the boat, there would have been a pretty little tragedy of the sea, that
-gusty afternoon. One more in the boat had certainly turned the scale.
-For the wind was continually getting up, and the wretched _Duchess_ was
-rolling like a buoy, and the boat as she touched the water, with the
-captain and three men in her, was caught by the top of a wave, and
-dashed against the side of the ship. In a flash she was overturned,
-with a badly damaged thwart, and was washing about helplessly among the
-waves, with the four men clinging to her keel. The sea took her past the
-schooner like a rag. I had only time to run to the stern, before she was
-swept out of hearing, but I heard the pirate call as he disappeared in
-the trough of a wave, “Get out your camera, here’s the chance of your
-life!” Then the boat was gone, and for a moment the mate and I thought
-it was all over. “The sharks will have ’em if they don’t sink!”
- declared that officer, straining over the rail, while the Maori crew ran
-aimlessly about the deck, shouting with excitement.
-
-What happened during the next half-hour has never been very clear in my
-memory. The wind kept rising, and the afternoon grew late and dark. The
-overturned boat, with the four heads visible about her keel, drifted
-helplessly in the trough of the seas, at the mercy of waves and sharks.
-(I heard, afterwards, that the men had all kicked ceaselessly to keep
-them away, and that they expected to be seized any moment.) The wind
-screamed in the rigging, and drifts of foam flew up on deck, and the
-Maories ran about and shouted, and got in each other’s way, and tried
-to heave ropes, and missed, and tried to launch a boat under the mate’s
-direction, and somehow did not--I cannot tell why. And right in the
-middle of the play, when we seemed to be making some attempt to bear
-down upon the drifting wreck, a grey old man who had come on with us
-from the Cook Islands, but had kept to his berth through illness most
-of the time, burst out on deck with an astonishing explosion of sea
-language, and told us that we were nearly on to the reef. Which, it
-seems, every one had forgotten!
-
-After that, things grew so lively on the poop that I got up on the top
-of the deck-house to keep out of the way, and reflect upon my sins. It
-seemed a suitable occasion for devotional exercises. The white teeth
-of the reef were unpleasantly near, the water was growing shoal. “Put a
-leadsman in the chains this minute!” yelled the grizzled passenger (who
-had been at sea in his time, and knew something of what was likely to
-happen when you got a nasty reef on your lee side, with the wind working
-up). The auxiliary engine, meant for use on just such occasions, had
-been sick for some time. There was a very strong tide running, the wind
-had shifted while the ship’s company were intent on the fate of the
-boat, and on the whole it looked very much as if the decorations already
-possessed by the notorious reef were likely to be increased by another
-pair of best quality British made anchors--_ours_.
-
-A good many things happen on sailing ships--Pacific ships
-especially--that one does not describe in detail, unless one happens to
-be writing fiction. This is not fiction, so the occurrences of the next
-quarter of an hour must be passed over lightly. The ancient passenger
-took command of the ship. We got away from the reef by an unpleasantly
-close shave and bore down upon the boat, which the pirate captain had
-impossibly contrived to right by this time, paddling it along with one
-oar, while the men baled constantly. We got the captain and the men
-and the damaged boat on board, and a few “free opinions, freely
-expressed”--as a certain famous lady novelist would put it--were
-exchanged. Then the pirate, who was quite fresh, and very lively,
-demanded the second boat, and said he was bound to get into that place
-anyhow, and wouldn’t leave till he did.
-
-I rather think we mutinied at this juncture. I am sure I did, because
-I had been thinking over my sins for some time, and had come to the
-conclusion that there really were not many of them, and that I wanted a
-chance to accumulate a few more, preferably of an agreeable kind, before
-I faced the probability of decorating any Pacific coral reef with my
-unadorned and unburied skeleton. The grey-haired passenger and the mate
-mutinied too, upon my example, and the pirate, seeing that we were
-three to one, and moreover, that it was growing dusk, made a virtue of
-necessity, and went off for a shift of clothes, giving orders to make
-all sail at once. And so we left the reef in the growing dusk, and no
-man has to this day disturbed the virgin surface of its stormy little
-lagoon with profanely invading oar.
-
-Was there a fortune lying concealed beneath those pale green waves
-within the foaming jaws of the reef? I never heard. But there were some
-among our native crew who came from the far-off island of Penrhyn, where
-the pearl fisheries are, and they were strong in asserting their belief
-that the pirate might have been well paid for his exploration. It was
-just that sort of reef, said the pearl-island men, that most often
-contained good shell, and produced the biggest pearls, the first time
-of looking. An old, undisturbed atoll, where no one had ever thought of
-looking for shell, was the place where big pearls got a chance to grow.
-The first comer scooped in the prizes; afterwards, the shell itself and
-the smaller pearls were all that any one was likely to get.
-
-However that might be, the talk, on the rest of the way down to Niué,
-ran much on pearls and pearl-shell, and I learned a good deal about
-these gold-mines of the Pacific--always making allowance for the
-inevitable Pacific exaggeration. Any man who can live a year among the
-islands, and restrain himself, in the latter part of his stay, from
-lying as naturally and freely as he breathes, deserves a D.S.O.
-
-Stripped of flowers of fiction, the romance of the pearling trade was
-still interesting and fascinating enough. Pearls, in the Pacific, are
-obtained from a large bivalve that has a good deal of value in itself,
-being the material from which mother-o’-pearl is made. Prices,
-of course, fluctuate very much, as the shell is used in so many
-manufactures that depend on the vagaries of fashion; but the value
-may run to £200 a ton or over. When it gets down to £40 or less, it is
-hardly worth the expense of lifting and carrying. For the most part,
-however, it is worth a good deal more than this, and when it is at the
-highest, fortunes can be, and have been, made out of small beginnings,
-in a very short time. The pearls are an “extra,” and not to be relied
-upon. There may be almost none in a big take of shell, there may be a
-few small ones, there may be a number of fine ones that will make the
-fortune of the lucky fisher. It is all a gamble, and perhaps none the
-less fascinating for that. Much of the best shell and the finest pearls
-in the Pacific, come from the Paumotus, which are French. Thursday
-Island, off the north of Queensland, was the great centre of the
-fishery, until lately, but it has been almost fished out. The Solomons
-were reported to have a good deal of shell, and a rush took place to
-that part not long ago, but the yield was much exaggerated. There are
-a good many atolls about the Central Pacific in general, which contain
-more or less shell, and are generally owned and fished by Australian
-syndicates. Outlying reefs and islets, where no one goes, now and then
-turn out to be valuable. The news of a find travels apparently on
-the wings of the seagulls from group to group, for no such place ever
-remains secret for more than a very short time, and then, if the owner’s
-title is not secure (a thing that may easily happen, in the case of an
-island that does not lie within the geographical limits of any of the
-annexed groups) there is sometimes trouble. Pearl-poaching is easy and
-profitable, if not very safe; and who is to tell ugly tales, a thousand
-miles from anywhere, out in the far Pacific?
-
-_(The swift-winged schooner and the racing seas: decks foam-white
-beneath a burning sky: salt wind on the lips, and the fairy-voiced
-enchantress Adventure singing ever from beyond the prow! “O dreamers in
-the man-stifled town,” do you hear the wide world calling?)_
-
-And so the pirate captain brought us up to Niué, and left me there, and
-sailed away with the ship to Auckland, where he gave over the command,
-and went (so it was said) to aid in the instruction of sea-going youth,
-somewhere further south. The Cook Islands shrieked with joyous amusement
-when they heard of the pirate’s new rôle as the guide and mentor of
-tender boyhood--but I do not know, after all. The pirate was as full of
-mischief as an egg is full of meat, as full of fight as a sparrow-hawk,
-gifted with an uncanny faculty for plunging into every kind of risk
-that the wide seas of the earth could hold, and coming out unscathed and
-asking for more. He was assuredly not to be numbered among the company
-of the saints, but neither is the average “glorious human boy”--and on
-the principle of setting a thief to catch a thief, the pirate’s new rôle
-may well have turned out a success.
-
-We came up to Niué graced by a last touch of the piratical spirit.
-There was some blusterous weather as we neared the great island with its
-iron-bound, rocky coasts, towards which we had been making for so many
-days, but we swept up towards the land with every rag of canvas set,
-for that was the pirate captain’s custom, and he would not break
-it. By-and-by, as I was standing on the main deck, holding on to the
-deckhouse, while I looked at the looming mass of blue ahead, the main
-square-sail gave way with a report like a gun, and began to thrash the
-foremast with streamers of tattered canvas. The pirate had it down in a
-twinkling, and got the men to bend on a new sail immediately. It went
-up to the sound of yelling Maori chants (for the crew liked this sort of
-excitement), and once more the ship fled on towards Niué with every
-sail straining against the gusty wind. Half-an-hour, and crack!--the
-new square-sail was gone too, and half of it away to leeward like a huge
-grey bird in a very great hurry. And the pirate, as we began to draw
-inshore, raged up and down the deck, like a lion baulked of its prey. To
-come up to Niué without every sail set was a disgrace that he had never
-yet encountered, and it evidently hit him hard that he had not another
-sail in the locker, and was forced to “carry on” as best he could
-without it.
-
-Niué, or Savage Island, is no joke to approach. It is about forty miles
-round, and almost every yard of the whole forty is unapproachable, by
-reason of the precipitous cliffs, guarded by iron spears of coral rock,
-that surround it on every side. There are one or two places where an
-approach can be made, in suitable weather, with care, but it is quite a
-common thing for sailing vessels to beat on and off as much as a week,
-before they succeed in landing passengers and goods. We came up on a
-very gusty day, with the blow-holes in the cliffs spouting like whales
-as we went by, but the pirate captain ran us into the anchorage below
-Alofi as easily as if it had been perfect weather and an excellent
-harbour, and we put out a boat to land our goods, including myself. The
-pirate had not an ounce of caution in his body, but, as an old Irishman
-on one of the islands declared: “The divil takes care of his own, let
-him alone for that, and it’s not the Pirate that he’s goin’ to let into
-any houle till he lets him into the biggest wan of all--mind that!”
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER X
-
-_How not to see the Islands--Lonely Niué--A Heathen Quarantine
-Board--The King and the Parliament--The Great Question of Gifts--Is
-it Chief-like?--The New Woman in Niué--Devil-fish and Water-Snakes--An
-Island of Ghosts--How the Witch-Doctor died--The Life of a Trader._
-
-LANDINGS on Pacific islands are not usually easy, but there are few
-approaches as bad as that of Niué, the solitary outlier of Polynesia. It
-is a difficult task to get within reasonable distance of the land in the
-first place, and when the ship has succeeded in manoeuvring safely up
-to the neighbourhood of the cruel cliffs, the trouble is only beginning.
-There are no harbours worth the name on the island, although the cliffs
-show an occasional crack through which a boat may be brought down to
-the sea, and the circling reef is broken here and there. The best that a
-ship can do is to lie off at a safe distance, put out a boat, and trust
-to the skill of the crew to effect a landing on the wharf. In anything
-but really calm weather, communication is impossible. However, there are
-very many calm days in this part of the Pacific, so chances are fairly
-frequent.
-
-It was not at all as calm as one could have wished when the _Duchess_
-put out her whaleboat to bring me ashore. But the pirate trusted to his
-luck, and was, as usual, justified. The boat passage proved to be a mere
-crack in the reef, through which the sea rushed with extreme violence,
-dancing us up and down like a cork. It was not difficult for our smart
-Maori crew to fend us off the knife-edged coral walls with their oars,
-as we manoeuvred down towards the spider-legged little iron ladder
-standing up in the surf, and pretending to be a wharf. But when we got
-within an oar’s length of the ladder, and the boat was leaping wildly on
-every swell, things got more exciting. The only way of landing on Niué
-is to watch your time at the foot of the ladder, while the men fend
-the boat off the coral, and jump on to the rungs at the right moment. A
-native standing on the platform at the top takes you by the arms as
-you rise, and snatches you into the air as the eagle snatched Endymion.
-Only, instead of going all the way to heaven, you land on the pier--or
-what passes for it--and find yourselves upon the soil of Niué.
-
-Behind the pier rises a little pathway cut in the face of the rock, and
-leading up to the main street of the capital. Once up the path, we are
-fairly arrived in Savage Island.
-
-It is not a place known to the globe-trotting tourist, as yet. Much
-of the Pacific has been “discovered” by the tripper element of recent
-years, but Niué is still almost inviolate. Once here, if one seeks the
-true spirit of the South Seas, one still may find it.
-
-Travellers go in scores by every steamer to Samoa, to Fiji, to Honolulu,
-which are on the beaten track of “round-the-world.” They drive up to
-Stevenson’s villa, they make excursions to Nuuanu Pali, they see a
-sugar plantation here, and a kava drinking there, and a native dance,
-specially composed to suit tourists’ tastes, somewhere else. They stay
-a week in a fine modern hotel, drink green cocoanuts (and other things
-that are stronger), take photographs of island girls wearing imported
-Parisian or Sydney costumes, and think they have seen the life of the
-islands. Never was there a greater mistake. The sweet South Seas do
-not so easily yield up their secret and their charm. The spell that for
-three hundred years has drawn the wandering hearts of the world across
-the ocean ploughed by the keels of Drake and Hawkins and Cook, of
-Dampier, Bougainville, and Bligh, will not unfold itself save to him who
-will pay the price. And the price to-day is the same in kind, though
-not in degree, as that paid by those old explorers and adventurers--hard
-travel, scanty food, loneliness, loss of money and time, forgetting the
-cities and civilisation. To know the heart of the South Seas, all these
-things must be encountered willingly, with a love of the very hardship
-they may bring, strong as the seabird’s love of the tossing waters and
-thunderwaking storm.
-
-The typical British tourist--yes, even he--hears from far off, at times,
-the mysterious call of the island world, and tells himself that he will
-listen to it a little nearer, and enjoy the siren song sung to so many
-long before him. Hence his visits to the great Pacific ports that can
-be reached by liner; hence, in most cases, his gradually acquired
-conviction that the islands are, after all, very much like any other
-place in the tropics--beautiful, interesting, but---- Well, writer
-fellows always exaggerate: every one knows that.
-
-Hotel dinners, big liners, shops, hired carriages, guides, and picture
-postcards--these things are death to the spirit of the South Seas. This
-is the first lesson that the island wanderer must learn. Where every one
-goes the bloom is off the peach. Leave the great ports and the steamers;
-disregard the advice of every one who knows anything (most people in the
-island towns know everything, but you must not listen to them, for the
-jingling of the trade dollar has long since deafened their ears to the
-song of the mermaids on the coral beaches); take ship on a schooner, it
-does not much matter where; live in a little bungalow under the palms
-for weeks or months; ride and swim and feast with the brown people of
-the coral countries, as one of themselves; learn, if you do not already
-know, how to live on what you can get, and cook what you catch or pick
-or shoot, to sleep on a mat and wash in a stream, do without newspapers
-and posts, forget that there ever was a war anywhere, or an election, or
-that there will ever be a “season” anywhere again; and so perhaps, the
-charm of the island world will whisper itself in your waiting ear. What
-then? What happened to the men who ate the enchanted fruit of the lotus
-long ago? Well, no one ever said that the sweetness of the fruit was not
-worth all that it cost.
-
-There are about five thousand native inhabitants on Niué, and generally
-a score or so of whites--almost all traders. Alofi, the capital,
-possesses a few hundred of the former, and nearly all the latter. It is
-a winsome little spot, and I loved it the moment the wide grassy street
-first broke upon my view, as I climbed the narrow pathway from the
-shore.
-
-The houses stand down one side, as is the invariable custom of South
-Sea towns. They are whitewashed concrete for the most part, built by
-the natives out of materials furnished by the coral reef. The roofs are
-plaited pandanus thatch, high and steep. The doors are mostly windows,
-or the windows doors--it would be hard to say which. They are simply
-long openings filled in with wooden slats, which can be sloped to suit
-the wind and weather. Mats and cooking pots and the inevitable Chinese
-camphor-wood box, for keeping clothes in, are all the furniture.
-Round the doorways grow palms and gay hibiscus, and cerise-flowered
-poinsettia, and here and there a native will have set up an odd
-decoration of glittering stalactites from the caves on the shore, to
-sparkle in the sun by his doorstep. The white men’s houses have grass
-compounds in front for the most part, and many have iron roofs, glass
-windows, and other luxuries.
-
-All these houses look the one way--across the wide, empty grassy street,
-between the stems of the leaning palms, to the sunset and the still blue
-sea. It is a lonely sea, this great empty plain lying below the little
-town. The _Duchess_ calls twice a year, the mission steamer once, a
-trade steamer, ancient and worn out, limps across from Tonga, about
-three hundred miles away, every ten or twelve months. That is all. The
-island itself owns nothing bigger than a whaleboat, and cannot as a rule
-communicate with any other place in case of emergency. Some few months
-before my visit, a trader had very urgent need to send a letter to
-Australia. After waiting in vain for something to call, he sighted
-an American timber brig on her way to Sydney, far out on the horizon.
-Hastily launching a native canoe, and filling it with fruit, he paddled
-three or four miles out to sea, in the hope of being seen by the ship.
-His signals were perceived, and the brig hove to, when the trader
-paddled up to her, offered his fruit as a gift, and begged the captain
-to take his letter. This the sailor willingly did, and still more
-willingly accepted the excellent Niué bananas and oranges that went with
-the missive. And so the post was caught--Niué fashion.
-
-There is no doctor on the island as a rule, and if you want to die
-during the intervals between ships, you may do so unopposed. I am almost
-afraid to state how healthy the people of Niué are as a rule, in spite
-of--or can it be in consequence of?--this deprivation.
-
-The “bush” overflows the town, after the charming way of bush, in this
-island world. Big lilies, bell-shaped, snowy petalled, and as long as
-your hand, spill over into the main street from the bordering scrub. The
-grass on the top of the cliff, the day I landed, was blazing with great
-drifts of fiery salvia, and starred with pink and yellow marigolds.
-About the houses were clumps of wild “foliage plants,” claret and
-crimson leaved, looking like a nurseryman’s bedding-out corner. The coco
-palm that I knew so well had a sister palm here, of a kind new to me--an
-exceedingly graceful tree twenty to thirty feet high, bearing small
-inedible berry-like fruits, and splendid fan-shaped leaves, of the shape
-and size once so familiar in the “artistic type of drawing-room” at
-home. Pinnacles of fantastic grey rock, all spiked and spired, started
-up unexpectedly in the midst of the riotous green, and every pinnacle
-was garlanded cunningly with wreaths and fronds of flowering vines.
-There were mammee-apples and bananas beside most of the houses: yellow
-oranges hung as thickly in the scrub as ornaments on a Christmas tree,
-and one or two verandahs were decorated with the creeping trailers of
-the delicious granadilla. A land of peace and plenty, it looked in the
-golden rays of the declining sun, that windy blue afternoon. It proved
-alas, to be nothing of the kind: its soil is fertile, but so thinly
-scraped over the coral rock for foundation, that very little in the way
-of nutritious food will grow--it has no water save what can be gathered
-from deep clefts in the rocks, the bananas are scanty, the mammee-apples
-unsatisfying, and the “oranges” are for the most part citrons,
-drinkable, as lemons are, but little use for anything else. Indeed,
-Niué is a useless place altogether, and nobody makes fortunes there
-now-a-days, though one or two did well out of the “first skim” of its
-trading, a generation ago. Nor does any one grow fat there, upon a
-diet of tinned meats, biscuit, and fruit. Nor are there any marvellous
-“sights,” like the volcanoes of Hawaii, or the tribe dancing and
-firewalking of Fiji. Still I loved Niué, and love it yet.
-
-It was so very far away, to begin with. In other islands, with regular
-steamers, people concerned themselves to some degree about the doings of
-the outer world, and used to wonder how things were getting on, beyond
-the still blue bar of sea. Newspapers arrived, people came and went,
-things were done at set times, more or less. One was still in touch with
-the world, though out of sight.
-
-But in Niué, the isolation was complete. There was no come and go. We
-were on the road to nowhere. Nobody knew when any communication
-with anywhere would be possible, so nobody troubled, and save for an
-occasional delirious day when a ship really did come in, and waked us
-all from our enchanted slumber for just So long as you might turn round
-and look about you before dropping off into dreams again, we were asleep
-to all that lay beyond the long horizon line below the seaward-leaning
-palms. Niué was the world. The rest was a cloudy dream.
-
-I rented a little cottage in the heart of a palm-grove, when I settled
-down to wait for the problematic return of the _Duchess_, and see the
-life of Niué. It belonged to a native couple, Kuru and Vekia, who were
-well-to-do, and had saved money selling copra. The Niuéan, unlike every
-other Polynesian, is always willing and anxious to make a bargain or do
-a deal of any kind, and Kuru and his wife were as delighted to get the
-chance of a “let” as any seaside landlady. They moved their small goods
-out of the house most readily, and left me in full possession of the
-two rooms and the verandah and the innumerable doors and windows, with
-everything else to find for myself.
-
-A general collection of furniture, taken up by a friendly white
-resident, resulted in the loan of a bed and a box and a table, three
-chairs, some cups and cutlery, and a jug and basin. These, with a
-saucepan lent by my landlady (who, as I have said, was rich, and
-possessed many superfluities of civilisation), made up the whole of my
-household goods. For two months I occupied the little house among the
-palms, and was happy. “Can a man be more than happy?” runs the Irish
-proverb, and answer there is none.
-
-There were never, in all my island wanderings, such shadows or such
-sunsets, as I saw in lonely Niué. The little house was far away from
-others, and the palms stood up round it close to the very door. In the
-white, white moonlight, silver-clear and still as snow, I used to stay
-for half a night on my verandah, sitting crosslegged in the darkness of
-the eaves, and watching the wonderful great stars of shadow drawn out,
-as if in ink, round the foot of every palm-tree. The perfect circle
-of tenderly curving rays lay for the most part still as some wonderful
-drawing about the foot of the tree; but at rare intervals, when the hour
-was very late, and even the whisper of the surf upon the reef seemed to
-have grown tired and dim and far away, the night would turn and sigh in
-its sleep for just a moment, and all the palm-tree fronds would begin to
-sway and shiver up in the sparkling moon-rays, glancing like burnished
-silver in the light. Then the star at the foot would dance and sway as
-well, and weave itself into forms of indescribable beauty, as if the
-spirit of Giotto of the marvellous circles were hovering unseen in the
-warm air of this alien country that he never knew, and pencilling forms
-more lovely than his mortal fingers ever drew on earth.... Yes, it was
-worth losing one’s sleep for, in those magic island nights.
-
-In the daytime, I rode and walked a good deal about the island, which
-is very fairly provided with roads, and tried to find out what I could
-about the people and their ways. There is not a more interesting island
-in the Pacific than Niué, from an ethnological point of view; but my
-scientific knowledge was too contemptibly small to enable me to make use
-of my opportunities. This I regretted, for the place is full of strange
-survivals of ancient customs and characteristics, such as are seldom to
-be found among Christianised natives. The people are somewhat rude
-and rough in character; indeed until about forty years ago, they
-were actually dangerous. Their island is one of the finest of natural
-fortresses, and they used it as such, declining to admit strangers on
-any pretext. Captain Cook attempted to land in 1777, but was beaten
-off before he had succeeded in putting his boat’s crew ashore. Other
-travellers for the most part gave the place a wide berth.
-
-When men of the island wandered away to other places (the Niuéan is a
-gipsy by nature) they received no kindly welcome on attempting to come
-home. The Niuéan had an exceeding fear of imported diseases, and to
-protect himself against them, he thought out a system of sanitary
-precaution, all on his own account, which was surely the completest
-the world has ever seen. There was no weak link in the chain: no break
-through which measles, or cholera, or worse could creep, during the
-absence of an official, or owing to the carelessness of an inspector.
-Every person attempting to land on Niué, be he sick or well, stranger,
-or native, was promptly killed! That was Niué’s rule. You might go away
-from the island freely, but if you did, you had better not attempt to
-come back again, for the “sanitary officers” would knock your brains
-out on the shore. It was without doubt the simplest and best system of
-quarantine conceivable. Possibly as a result of this Draconian law, the
-people of Niué are remarkably strong and hardy to-day, though since the
-relaxation of the ancient rule, a certain amount of disease has crept
-in.
-
-The people, though warlike and fierce, were never cannibals here at the
-worst. They did not even eat their enemies when slain in battle. They
-enjoyed a fight very much, however, when they got the chance of one,
-and still remembered the Waterloo victory of their history, against the
-fierce Tongans, about two hundred years ago. The Tongans, until within
-the last half-century, seem to have been the Danes of the Pacific,
-always hunting and harrying some other maritime people, and always a
-name of terror to weak races. Tonga is the nearest land to Niué, being
-about three hundred miles away, so it was not to be expected that the
-Niuéans would escape invasion, and they were fully prepared for the
-Tongan attack when it did come. They did not attempt to meet force by
-force. There was one place they knew where the Tongans might succeed in
-landing, and near to this they laid a cunning plan for defence.
-
-A trader took me down to see the spot one Sunday afternoon. It is one
-of the numerous caves of Niué, with a top open for the most part to the
-sky. The cave runs underneath the greenery and the creeping flowers
-of the bush--a long black gash just showing here and there among the
-leaves. The drop is forty or fifty feet, and an unwary foot might very
-easily stumble over its edge, even now.
-
-On the day when the Tongan war canoes broke the level line of the sea
-horizon, the Niué men hastened to the shore, and prepared the cave in
-such a way as to set a fatal and most effective trap for their enemies.
-They cut down a mass of slight branches and leafy twigs, and covered
-the gulf completely, so that nothing was to be seen except the ordinary
-surface of the low-growing bush. When the enemies landed, the Niué men
-showed themselves on the farther side of the cave, as if fleeing into
-the woods. The Tongans, with yells of joy, rushed in pursuit, straight
-over the gulf--and in another moment were lying in crushed and dying
-heaps at the foot of the pit, while the men of Niué, dashing out of
-ambush on every side, ran down into the cave from its shallow end and
-butchered their enemies as they lay.
-
-After this, it is said that the Tongans left Niué alone.
-
-Because of the loneliness and inaccessibility of the place, the Savage
-Islanders have always been different from the rest of the Pacific. The
-typical “Kanaka” is straight-haired, light brown in colour, mild and
-gentle and generous in disposition, ready to welcome strangers and feast
-them hospitably. He is aristocratic to the backbone in his ideas, and
-almost always has a native class of nobles and princes, culminating in a
-hereditary king.
-
-The Savage Islander is often frizzy-haired, and generally a darkish
-brown in colour. His manners are rather brusque, and he gives nothing
-without obtaining a heavy price for it. He has no chiefs, nobles, or
-princes, and does not want any. There is always a head of the State, who
-enjoys a certain amount of mild dignity, and may be called the King
-for want of a better name. The office is not hereditary, however, the
-monarch being elected by the natives who form the island Parliament.
-Meetings of this Parliament are held at irregular intervals; and
-the King, together with the British Resident Commissioner, takes an
-important part in the debates.
-
-These are very formal affairs. The brown M.P.s who live, each in his
-own village, in the utmost simplicity of manners and attire, dress
-themselves up for the day in full suits of European clothing, very heavy
-and hot, instead of the light and comfortable cotton kilt they generally
-wear. They travel into Alofi and join the local members on the green
-before the public hall--generally used as a school-house. King Tongia
-joins them, the British Resident comes also, and for hour after hour,
-inside the great, cool hall, with its matted floor and many open
-window-embrasures, the talk goes on. This road is to be made, that
-banyan tree is to be removed, regulation pigsties are to be built in
-such a village, petitions are to be sent up to New Zealand about the tax
-on tobacco--and so on, and so on. The king is a tough old man; he has
-his say on most questions, and it is not considered generally good for
-health or business to oppose him too much; but of royal dignity he has,
-and asks for, none.
-
-There is something quite American in the history of Tongia’s elevation,
-some seven years ago. He had acted as Prime Minister to the late head of
-the State; and when the latter died he calmly assumed the reins without
-going through the formality of an election. This was not the usual
-custom, and some of the members remonstrated. Tongia told them, however,
-that he was in the right, and meant to stay on. When the captain of a
-ship died on a voyage, did not his chief mate take over command? The
-cases were exactly parallel, to his mind. This argument pleased the
-members, who had most of them been to sea, and Tongia was allowed to
-retain his seat, the objectors calming themselves with the thought of
-the sovereign’s age--he was well over eighty at that time. “He is only
-the stump of a torch,” they said; “he will soon burn out.” But the stump
-is burning yet, and shows no symptoms of extinction. Tongia married a
-pretty young girl soon after his “election,” settled down in the royal
-palace--a whitewashed cottage with a palm-thatch roof--and seems likely
-to outlast many of his former opponents.
-
-The powers of the king, limited as they are, have lessened since 1902,
-when New Zealand annexed Niué--a proceeding that had its humorous side,
-if one examines the map, for Niué is something like a thousand miles
-from Auckland. The Resident Commissioner who is responsible for the
-well-being of the island lives in a house much more like a palace than
-Tongia’s modest hut, and is in truth the real ruler of the place. His
-work, however, is not overpowering. He is supposed to be judge and
-lawgiver, among many other duties, but in Niué no one ever seems to do
-anything that requires punishment. There is nothing in the shape of a
-prison, if any one did. Innocent little crimes, such as chicken stealing
-with extenuating circumstances, or allowing pigs to trespass into
-somebody’s garden, occasionally blot the fair pages of the island
-records, but a little weeding, or a day’s work on the road is considered
-sufficient punishment for these. At the time of my stay, which lasted
-nearly two months, such a wave of goodness seemed to be passing over the
-island that the Resident complained he could not find enough crime in
-the place to keep his garden weeded, and declared that he really wished
-somebody would do something, and do it quick, or all his imported
-flowers would be spoiled! Since the forties, missionaries have been busy
-in Savage Island, and there is no doubt that they have done their work
-effectively. The early traders, who arrived near the same time, also
-helped considerably in the civilisation of the natives. Drink has never
-been a trouble on Niué, and at the present date, no native ever tastes
-it, and strict regulations govern importation by the whites, for their
-own use. The natives are healthy, although European diseases are by no
-means unknown. Skin diseases are so troublesome that many of the traders
-wash the money they get from the bush towns, before handling, and the
-new-comer’s first days in the island are sure to be harassed by the
-difficulties of avoiding miscellaneous hand-shaking. Knowing what one
-knows about the prevalence of skin-troubles, one does not care to run
-risks; but the Niuéan, like all islanders, has unfortunately learned the
-habit of continual hand-shaking from his earliest teachers, and is never
-likely to unlearn it. So the visitor who does not want to encounter
-disappointed faces and puzzled inquiries, looks out old gloves to go
-a-walking with, and burns them, once he or she is settled in the place,
-and no longer a novelty.
-
-There are manners in Niué--of a sort. “Fanagé fei!” is the greeting
-to any one met on the road, and it must not be left out, or the Savage
-Islanders will say you have no manners. It means, “Where are you going?”
- and it is not at all an empty inquiry, for you must mention the name
-of your destination in reply, and then repeat the inquiry on your own
-account, and listen for the answer. Riding across the island day by day,
-I used to pass in a perfect whirlwind of “Where-are-you-goings?”
- callings out hastily, as the horse cantered over the grassy road,
-“Avatele,” or “Mutelau,” (names of villages) or “Misi Nicolasi” (Mrs.
-Nicholas, a trader’s wife), and adding as I passed on: “Fanagé fei?” to
-the man or woman who had greeted me. There was generally a long story in
-reply, but I fear I was usually out of hearing before it was ended. My
-manners, out riding, must have struck Niué as decidedly vulgar.
-
-It was during the first few days of my stay that I attained a
-distinction that I had never hoped to see, and that I am not at all
-likely to see again. I was made a headline; in a copybook! If that is
-not fame, what is?
-
-The native school-teacher--a brown, black-eyed and bearded man of middle
-age and dignified presence--had called at my house shortly after my
-arrival, to display his English and his importance, and welcome the
-stranger. He wanted, among a great many other things, to know what my
-name was, and how it was spelt. I wrote it down for him, and he
-carried it away, studying it the while. Next day, the copies set in the
-principal school for the youth of Niué consisted of my name in full,
-heading the following legend: “While this lady is in Niué, we must all
-be very good.” Evidently a case of “Après moi le déluge!”
-
-Sitting on a box in my cool little shady house of a morning, writing
-on my knee, with the whisper of the palms about the door, and the
-empty changeless blue sea lying below, I used to receive visitor after
-visitor, calling on different errands--some to sit on the verandah
-and look at me in silence; some to come in, squat on the floor, and
-discourse fluently for half an hour in a language I did not understand
-(they never seemed distressed by the absence of replies); some to sell
-curios; some to give dinners!
-
-You give dinners in Niué in a strictly literal sense. Instead of
-bringing the guest to the dinner, you take the dinner to the guests and
-then wait to see it eaten. It generally consists of a baked fish wrapped
-in leaves, several lumps of yam, hot and moist, and as heavy as iron, a
-pudding made of mashed pumpkin and breadfruit, another made of bananas,
-sugarcane, and cocoanut, some arrowroot boiled to jelly, and the
-inevitable taro top and cocoanut cream--about which I must confess I was
-rather greedy. The rest of the dinner I used to accept politely, as
-it was set out on the floor, eat a morsel or two here and there, and
-afterwards hand over the remainder to Kuru and his wife, who were always
-ready to dispose of it. At the beginning, I used to offer gifts in
-return, which were always refused. Then, acting on the advice of old
-residents, I reserved the gift for a day or two, and presented it at the
-first suitable opportunity. It was always readily accepted, when offered
-after this fashion, and thus I learned one more lesson as to island
-etiquette.
-
-“You’ll see a lot of stuff in travel books,” said an old resident to
-me, “about the wonderful generosity of the island people, all over the
-Pacific--how they press gifts of every kind on travellers, and won’t
-take any return. Well, that’s true, and it’s not true. All the island
-people love strangers, and are new-fangled with every fresh face, and
-they do come along with presents, but as to not wanting a return, why,
-that isn’t quite the case. They won’t take payment, mostly, and there’s
-very few places where they’ll even take a present, right off. But they
-always expect something back, some time. I know that isn’t what the
-books say, but books are mostly wrong about anything you’ve got to go
-below the top of things to see--and the traveller likes that pretty
-idea, of getting presents for nothing, too much to give it up easily.
-Still, you may take my word for it that the natives _will_ take a return
-for anything and everything they give you, here and everywhere else,
-unless it’s a drink of cocoanut, or a bit of fruit they offer you on
-the road, or maybe a bit of dinner, if you’d drop in on them at meals.
-Set presents you’ve got to pay for, and more than their value too, if
-you take them. I don’t myself, I find native presents too expensive.”
-
-What do you want to give? Oh, well, if a woman brings you in a dinner
-or two, give her a trade silk handkerchief, one of those shilling ones,
-some day. Or if they bring you baskets of fruit, give them a couple of
-sticks of tobacco. They’ll take payment for fruit here, in that way, at
-any time. You’ll need to give some things when you’re going away, to the
-people you’ve seen most of--a few yards of cotton, or something of
-that kind. White people are expected to give presents, all over the
-island--it needn’t be dear things, but it ought to be something.
-
-If the lords and folk who have been round the Pacific in their yachts
-only heard what the natives say of them, because they didn’t know that,
-they’d take care to bring a case or two of cheap stuff for presents next
-time. ‘Not chief-like,’ is what the natives say--and I ask you yourself,
-it isn’t ‘chief-like,’ is it, to take all you can get, and give not a
-stick of niggerhead or an inch of ribbon in return?
-
-I’d think they’d be too proud--but then, I’m not a tourist trotting
-round the globe, I’m only a man who works for his living.
-
-“As for yourself, you take my advice, and say right out you don’t want
-the dinners, when they bring them. Yes, it’ll offend them, but you must
-either do that, or pay for stuff you don’t want three days out of seven,
-or six days, more likely, if they think you’re liberal-minded. You’ll
-get no end of presents when you’re going away, pretty things enough, and
-those will have to be paid for in presents, too. Better make it as cheap
-as you can, meantime.
-
-“But those people who go travelling like princes, and load their cabins
-up with spears and clubs and tappa-cloths and shells the natives have
-given them everywhere they went--and not a farthing, or a farthing’s
-worth, do they let it cost them from end to end--I tell you, they’re a
-disgrace to England,” concluded my informant hotly.
-
-[Illustration: 0259]
-
-“I am quite sure it is simply because they do not know--how should
-they?” I asked, trying to defend the absent globe-trotters.
-
-“Decent feeling ought to teach them!” declared the critic of manners,
-who was evidently not to be pacified.
-
-I had my dinner to cook, so I went away, and left him still revolving
-the iniquities of travelling milords in his memory. But I did not forget
-the conversation, for it seemed to me that the facts about this matter
-of present-giving and taking ought to be known as widely as possible. In
-nearly two years of island travel that followed after those days, I had
-full opportunity of proving the truth of the statements made by my Niué
-acquaintance, and every experience only served to confirm them.
-
-Travellers who visit the islands should note this fact, and lay in a
-stock of suitable goods at Sydney, which is the starting point for most
-Pacific travel. There are various firms who make a speciality of island
-trade, and these will usually sell any reasonable quantity at wholesale
-prices. The natives of the Pacific, in general, are not to be put off
-with worthless trifles as presents, nor do they care for beads, unless
-in the few groups still remaining uncivilised. They like best the sort
-of goods with which they are already familiar, and do not care for
-“imported” novelties. Silk handkerchiefs are liked everywhere, and
-they are easy to carry. Cotton or silk stuff is much valued. Imitation
-jewellery--brooches, pins, etc.--is valued quite as much as real, except
-in Niué, where the natives seem to have a natural craving and liking
-for precious metals. Tinned foods of all kinds, and sweets, are perhaps
-better appreciated than anything else. Tinned salmon in especial, is
-the safest kind of “tip” than can be given to any native, from a lordly
-Samoan chief, down to a wild “bushie” from the Solomons.
-
-Withal, one must not take away the character of the island world for
-hospitality, because of its childlike fancy for presents. Many and many
-a destitute white man can tell of the true generosity and ungrudging
-kindness he has met with at the hands of the gentle brown men and women,
-when luck was hard and the whites would have none of him. They are not
-fair-weather friends, in the European sense of the word. True, when the
-weather is sunny with you, they will come round and bask in the warmth,
-and share your good luck. But when the rainy days come, they will share
-all they have with you, just as freely, and they will not look for
-presents, then.
-
-The industries of the island filled up many a pleasant morning. Niué
-is supposed to be the most hard-working of all the Pacific islands, and
-certainly its people do not seem to eat the bread of idleness. Here,
-there is no lounging and dreaming and lotus-eating on the sounding coral
-shore--perhaps there isn’t much shore anyway; perhaps because the Savage
-Islander is not made that way. The food of the people consists largely
-of yams, and in a country which has hardly any depth of soil, these are
-hard to grow, and need care. The bananas are grown in the most wonderful
-way in the clefts of the coral rocks, so that they actually appear to be
-springing out of the stone. Copra is made in fair quantity, and many
-of the people spend the greater part of their time collecting a certain
-kind of fungus which is exported to Sydney, and used (or so report
-declares) for making an imitation of birds’ nest soup in China.
-
-[Illustration: 0267]
-
-The proportion of women on the island is very large, because there
-are always at least a thousand men, out of a total population of five
-thousand souls, away working elsewhere. The Niuéan is a bit of a miser,
-and will do anything for money. He engages, therefore, as a labourer in
-the plantations of Samoa, where the natives will not do any work they
-can avoid, or goes up to Malden Island to the guano pits, or takes a
-year or two at sea on an island schooner, or goes away as fireman on the
-missionary steamer--anything to make money. Meantime his women-kind stay
-at home and keep themselves. They work about the white people’s houses,
-they act as stevedores to the ships, they fetch and carry all over the
-island. When I wanted two heavy trunks conveyed a distance of six miles
-one day, four sturdy Niué girls came to do the work; slung the trunks
-on two poles, trotted away with them, and reached the end of the journey
-before my lazy horse had managed to carry me to my destination. They do
-an immense amount of plaiting work--mats, fans, baskets, and above all,
-hats, of which the annual export runs into thousands of dozens. These
-hats are made of fine strips of dried and split pandanus leaf; they much
-resemble the coarser kind of Panama, and give excellent shade and wear.
-They are worn over the whole Pacific, and a great part of New Zealand,
-and, I strongly suspect, are exported to England under the name, and at
-the price of second-grade Panamas. A clever worker will finish one in
-a day. Much of the plaiting is done in caves in the hot season, as the
-material must be kept fairly cool and moist.
-
-[Illustration: 0276]
-
-When the Niué folks are not working, they idle a little at times,
-but not very much. They sing in chorus occasionally, but it is not
-an absorbing occupation with them, and they do not dance a great deal
-either, since the advent of missionary rule. Their chief amusement is
-an odd one--walking round the island. You can scarcely take a long ride
-without encountering a stray picnic party of natives, mostly women,
-striding along at a good round pace, and heavily laden with fruit,
-food, and mats. They always complete the journey--forty miles--in a
-day, picknicking on the roadside for meals, and seem to enjoy themselves
-thoroughly. The strenuous life, exemplified after this fashion, is
-certainly the last thing one would expect to find in the Pacific. But
-then, the great fascination of the island world lies in the fact that
-here, as nowhere else, “only the unexpected happens.”
-
-*****
-
-It is a day of molten gold, with a sea coloured like a sheet of sapphire
-glass in a cathedral window. I am busy washing up my breakfast things
-at the door (there is no false shame about the performance of domestic
-duties in the capital city of Niué) when a couple of native girls appear
-on the grass pathway, their wavy hair loose and flowing, their white
-muslin dresses kilted up high over strong brown limbs. Each carries
-a clean “pareo” in her hand. They are going for a swim, one of them
-informs me in broken English: will I come too?
-
-Of course I will. I get out my own bathing dress, and follow the pair
-down the cliff, scrambling perilously from crag to crag, until we reach
-a point where it is possible to get down on to the narrow rocky ledge at
-the verge of the sea. Within the reef here there is a splendid stretch
-of protected water, peacock-blue in colour, immensely deep, and almost
-cold. There are no sharks about here, the girls tell me, and it is an
-excellent place for a swim.
-
-[Illustration: 0288]
-
-Oh, for a Royal Academician to paint the picture made by the younger
-girl, as she stands on the edge of the rocks ready to leap in, dressed
-in a bright blue scarf that is wound round and round her graceful bronze
-body from shoulder to knee, and parting her full wavy hair aside with
-slender dark fingers! Beauty of form did not die out with the ancient
-Greeks: the Diana of the Louvre and the Medici Venus may be seen any day
-of any year, on the shores of the far-away islands, by those who know
-lovely line when they see it, and have not given over their senses,
-bound and blinded, to the traditions of the schools. If there is any man
-in the world to-day who can handle a hammer and chisel as Phidias did,
-let him come to the South Sea Islands and look there for the models
-that made the ancient Greek immortal. The sculptor who can mould a young
-island girl, Tahitian for the Venus type, Samoan for the Diana, or
-a young island chief, like Mercury, in bronze, will give the world
-something as exquisite and as immortal as any marvel from the hand of
-Phidias or Praxiteles.
-
-My beautiful Niué girl was an exception, so far as her own island went.
-Niué women are strong and well made, but not lovely as a rule. Her
-companion was as sturdy as a cart-horse, but as plain as a pig. She
-smoked a huge pipe, chewed plug tobacco, and laughed like a hyena. They
-were truly a well-contrasted pair.
-
-The reef was a good way off, so we all struck out for that, when we
-came up panting and blowing from our dive. The girls gave me a fine
-exhibition of under-water swimming now and then, slipping easily
-underneath the gleaming surface, and disappearing from view below, for
-so long a time that one became quite nervous. My pretty little friend
-persuaded me to accompany her once, and though I did not like it among
-the ugly-looking coral caves, I dived for a short time, and endeavoured
-to follow her flying heels.
-
-Under water among the coral reefs! It sounds romantic, but it was not
-pleasant. Five feet beneath the surface, the light was as clear as day,
-and one could see all about one, far too much, for the things that were
-visible were disquieting. I knew extremely well that coral reefs are the
-haunt of every kind of unpleasant sea-beast, and I fancied Victor Hugo’s
-“pieuvre” at the very least, within the gloomy arch of every cave. There
-were far too many fish also, and they were much too impertinent, and a
-fish in one’s hair, even if harmless, is not nice. I had not gone down
-much over a fathom, when I turned, and began to beat upwards again
-looking eagerly at the light. And then I saw a thing that as nearly as
-possible made me open my mouth and drown myself.
-
-It was merely a bunch of black waving trailers, coming out of the dark
-of the rocks, and spreading between me and the pale-green light of day.
-I did not know what it was, and I do not know, to this day. And, like
-the runaway soldier in the poem, “I don’t know where I went to, for I
-didn’t stop to see.” I was on the top of the water, twenty yards away,
-and swimming at racing speed, when I realised the fact that I was still
-alive, some moments later. And on the surface I stayed, for the rest
-of the swim. The native girls were exceedingly amused, for the islander
-fears nothing that is in the water or under it; but I did not mind their
-laughing.
-
-One of them then, as she swam along, began laying her mouth to the
-surface of the water, and blowing bubbles, laughing all the time. She
-insisted that I should do it too, and I imitated her, at which she
-seemed delighted. “That what we doing, suppose some shark come,” she
-explained, “shark he plenty frighten, no like that.”
-
-We practised this useful accomplishment for some time, and then
-went ashore again. I regret to say that I roused the amusement of my
-companions yet again, before we landed, by making hasty exclamations,
-and dodging rapidly away from the embraces of a black-and-white banded
-snake, about four feet long, that suddenly appeared from nowhere in
-particular, moving very swiftly, and seemed disposed to argue the right
-of way. The lagoon at Raratonga had not prepared me for the Zoological
-Garden in which one had to bathe at Niué.
-
-“Snake he no harm,” said my Venus Anadyomene, as she stood on the rock,
-with her bathing scarf in her hand, wringing it out in the calmest
-manner in the world.
-
-“Plenty-plenty snake stop there.”
-
-There were indeed plenty of snakes. One could see them any fine day from
-the top of the cliffs, gliding through the water below, or lying on
-the rocks in family parties of a score or two, conspicuous at a great
-distance, because of their handsome black-and-white banded skins. As
-to there being no harm--well, I never heard of any one in Niué
-being injured. But a boy in Fiji trod on one of these checkerboarded
-creatures, about that time, and died in half an hour from its bite. I am
-strongly inclined to think that the Niué snake is poisonous, like almost
-all sea-snakes, though it does not seem at all ready to attack.
-
-What was it I saw under water? I never knew, but I guessed as much as
-I wanted, a day or two later, when I saw a native, fishing on the
-reef near my bathing-place, draw up a big devil-fish, with eight limp
-dangling arms’ over six feet long, and carry it away. A trader told me
-that he had once pulled up one himself, while out fishing in a light
-canoe, and that it seized hold of the little boat, and made such a fight
-that he barely escaped with his life. It is the pleasant habit of this
-fish, when attacked by a human being, to fling its hideous tentacles
-over his head and face, and force them up into eyes, nostrils, and
-mouth, so as to suffocate him, if he cannot master the creature.
-
-“Do you think there were any sharks about the day I bathed?” I inquired.
-
-“Well, if the girls were blowing, I should say there must have been.
-They wouldn’t do it for fun altogether,” he replied.
-
-“Surely they wouldn’t bathe, if they knew there were any about?”
-
-“Oh, wouldn’t they, though! _They_ don’t mind them. No native is afraid
-of anything in the sea.”
-
-I believed this with reservations, until a day came in another island,
-when I nearly furnished a dinner for a shark myself, and thenceforth
-gave up bathing in unprotected tropical waters, for good. It was in
-Rakahanga, many hundreds of miles nearer the Line, and I had left the
-schooner to enjoy a walk and a bathe. A native Rakahangan girl, who had
-never seen a white woman before, and was wildly excited at the thought
-of going bathing with this unknown wonder, found a boat for me, and
-allowed me to pick my own place in the inner lagoon of the island. I
-chose a spot where the lagoon narrowed into a bottle-neck communicating
-with the sea, and we-started our swim. The girl, however, much to my
-surprise, would not go more than a few yards from the boat, and declined
-to follow me when I struck out for the open water. I had been assured
-by her, so far as my scanty knowledge of Maori allowed me to understand,
-that there were no sharks, so her conduct seemed incomprehensible until
-a stealthy black fin, shaped like the mainsail of a schooner, rose out
-of the water a few score yards away, and began making for me!
-
-The native girl was first into the boat, but I was assuredly not long
-after her. The back fin did not follow, once I was out of the water. But
-the heat of that burning day far up towards the Line, was hardly enough
-to warm me, for half an hour afterwards.
-
-I found, on asking the question that I should have asked first of all,
-that the bottle-neck entrance of the lagoon was a perfect death-trap of
-sharks, and that more than one native had been eaten there.
-
-“Why on earth did the girl tell me there were none, and why did she
-venture into such a place herself?” I asked.
-
-“Well,” said the only white man on the island, “I should think she knew
-that any shark will take a white person, and leave a native, if there’s
-a choice. And if you had that red bathing-dress on that you’re carrying,
-why, you were simply making bait of yourself!”
-
-“But why should she want to see me killed?”
-
-“Oh, she didn’t. She only wanted to have the fun of a bathe with a white
-woman, and just took the chances!”
-
-So much about bathing, in the “sunny isles of Eden.” One is sorry to
-be obliged to say that it is one of the disappointments of the Pacific.
-Warm, brilliant water, snowy coral sands, and glancing fish of rainbow
-hues, are charming accompaniments to a bath, no doubt, but they are too
-dearly paid for when snakes, sharks, sting-rays, and devil-fish have to
-be counted into the party.
-
-*****
-
-Nothing in curious Niué is quite so curious as the native fancies about
-ghosts and devils. In spite of their Christianity, they still hold fast
-to all their ancient superstitions about the powers of evil.
-
-Every Savage Islander believes, quite as a matter of course, that ghosts
-walk the roads and patrol the lonely bush, all night long. Some are
-harmless spirits, many are malignant devils. After dark has fallen,
-about six o’clock, no one dares to leave his house except for some very
-important errand; and if it is necessary to go out so late as nine
-or ten o’clock, a large party will go together--this even in the town
-itself. Every native has a dog or two, of a good barking watchdog breed,
-not to protect property, for theft is unknown, but to drive away ghosts
-at night! Devil possession is believed in firmly. When a man, takes
-sick, his neighbours try, in a friendly manner, to “drive the devil out
-of him.” Perhaps they hang him up by his thumbs; possibly they put his
-feet in boiling water, causing fearful scalds; or they may drive sharks’
-teeth into him here and there. But the most popular method is plain and
-simple squeezing, to squeeze the devil out! This often results in broken
-ribs, and occasionally in death. It is a curious fact, in connection
-with this “squeezing,” that the natives are remarkably expert
-“masseurs,” and can “drive the devil” out of a sprain, or a headache, or
-an attack of neuralgia, by what seems to be a clever combination of the
-“pétrissage” and “screw” movement of massage. This, they say, annoys
-the devil so much that he goes away. Applied to the trunk, however,
-and carried out with the utmost strength of two or three powerful men,
-Savage Islander massage is-(as above stated) often fatal--and small
-wonder!
-
-When a man has died, from natural or unnatural causes, a great feast
-is held of baked pig and fowl, yams, taro, fish, and cocoanuts. Presents
-are given to the dead man’s relatives, as at a wedding, and other
-presents are returned by them to the men who dig the grave. The corpse
-is placed in a shallow hole, wrapped in costly mats; and then begins
-the ghostly life of the once-loved husband or father, who now becomes a
-haunting terror to those of his own household. Over his grave they erect
-a massive tomb of concrete and lime, meant to discourage him, so far
-as possible, from coming out to revisit the upper world. They gather
-together roots of the splendid scarlet poinsettia, gorgeous hibiscus,
-and graceful wine-coloured foliage plants, and place them about his
-tomb, to make it attractive to him. They collect his most cherished
-possessions--his “papalangi” (white man’s) bowler hat, which he used to
-wear on Sundays at the five long services in the native church; his best
-trousers; his orange-coloured singlet with pink bindings; his tin mug
-and plate--and place them on the grave. Savage Island folk are very
-avaricious and greedy; yet not a soul will dare to touch these valuable
-goods; they lie on the grave, in sun and storm, until rotted or
-broken. If it is a woman’s grave, you may even see her little hand
-sewing-machine (almost every island in the Pacific possesses scores
-of these) placed on the tomb, to amuse the ghost in its leisure hours.
-There will be a bottle of cocoanut hair-oil, too, scented with “tieré”
- flowers, and perhaps a little looking-glass or comb--so that we can
-picture the spirit of the dark-eyed island girls, like mermaids, coming
-forth at night to sit in the moonlight and dress their glossy hair--if
-ghosts indeed have hair like mortal girls!
-
-[Illustration: 0296]
-
-Mosquito-curtains, somewhat tattered by the wind, can be seen on many
-graves, carefully stretched over the tomb on the regulation uprights
-and cross-pieces, as over a bed. This is, no doubt, intended to help the
-ghost to lie quiet, lest the mosquitoes should annoy it so much that it
-be driven to get up and walk about. Certainly, if a Savage Island ghost
-does walk, it is not because every care is not taken to make it (as the
-Americans would say) “stay put.”
-
-There are no graveyards on the island. Every man is buried on his own
-land, very often alongside the road, or close to his house. The thrifty
-islanders plant onions and pumpkins on the earth close about the tomb,
-and enjoy the excellent flavour imparted to these vegetables by the
-essence of dead ancestor which they suck up through the soil. In odd
-contradiction to this economical plan, a “tapu” is placed upon all the
-cocoanut trees owned by the deceased; and for a year or more valuable
-nuts are allowed to lie where they fall, sprouting into young plants,
-and losing many tons of copra annually to the island. Groups of palms
-unhealthily crowded together, bear witness everywhere to the antiquity
-of this strange practice.
-
-The main, and indeed the only good road, across the island, owns a
-spot of fearsome reputation. On a solitary tableland, swept by salt
-sea-winds, stand certain groups of clustered cocoa-palms, sprung from
-tapu’s nuts on dead men’s lands. Here the natives say, the ghosts and
-devils have great power, and it is dangerous to walk there at night
-alone, even for white men, who take little account of native spirits.
-Many of the white traders of the island are shy of the spot; and some
-say that when riding in parties across the island at night, their horses
-shy and bolt passing the place, and exhibit unaccountable fear. Only a
-year or two ago, a terrible thing happened in this desolate spot, as
-if to prove the truth of local traditions. There was one native of the
-island, a “witch-doctor,” learned in charms and spells, who professed
-not to be afraid of the devils. He could manage them, he said; and to
-prove it, he used sometimes to walk alone across the island at night.
-One morning, he did not return from an excursion of this nature. The
-villagers set out in a body to look for him in the broad light of the
-tropical sun. They found him, at the haunted spot, lying on the ground
-dead. His face was black and his body horribly contorted. The devils
-had fought him, and conquered him--so the natives said. And now no gold
-would induce a Savage Islander to pass the fatal spot after dark.
-
-I asked the white missionary doctor resident at the time of my visit on
-the island, if he could account for the death. He said that he had not
-held a post-mortem and therefore could not say what the cause might be;
-but the appearance of the corpse was undoubtedly as described by the
-natives.
-
-Being anxious to investigate the truth of these stories, I determined
-to spend a night on the spot, and see what happened. The natives were
-horrified beyond measure at the idea; and when an accident on a coral
-reef laid me up from walking exercise until just before the schooner
-called again at the island to take me away--thus preventing me from
-carrying out the plan--they were one and all convinced that the fall
-was the work of devils, anxious to prevent me from meddling with their
-doings!
-
-The problem, then, remained unsolved, and rests open to any other
-traveller to investigate. But as Savage Island lies far off the track
-of the wandering tourist, its ghosts are likely to remain undisturbed in
-their happy hunting-grounds for the present.
-
-Mrs. Joe Gargery would certainly have liked Niué, for it is a place
-where there is none of the “pompeying” so obnoxious to her Spartan soul.
-And yet, if you stay there long, you will find out that Savage Island
-practises certain of the early Christian virtues, if it has dropped a
-few of its luxuries manufactured by civilisation. If you want a horse to
-ride across the island--a gentle, native creature that goes off at both
-ends, like a fire-cracker, when you try to mount, biting and kicking
-simultaneously, and, when mounted, converts your ride into a sandwich of
-jibbing and bolting, you will call in at the nearest trader’s, and tell
-him you want his horse and his neighbour’s saddle and whip. All these
-will appear at your door, with a couple of kindly messages, in half an
-hour. You will time your arrival at the different villages so as to hit
-off some one’s meal-hours, walk in, ask for a help of the inevitable
-curried tin, and carry off a loaf of bread or a lump of cake, if your
-host happens to have baked that morning and you have not. When a ship
-comes in--perhaps the bi-yearly steamer from Samoa, with real mutton
-and beef in her ice-chest--and the capital gorges for two days, you,
-the stranger within their gates, will meet hot chops walking up to your
-verandah between two hot plates, and find confectioners’ paper bags full
-of priceless New Zealand potatoes, sitting on your doorstep. You will
-learn to shed tears of genuine emotion at the sight of a rasher of
-bacon, and to accept with modest reluctance the almost too valuable gift
-of one real onion. Hospitality among the white folk of Savage Island
-is hospitality, and no mistake, and its real generosity can only be
-appreciated by those who know the supreme importance assumed by “daily
-bread,” when the latter is dependent upon the rare and irregular calls
-of passing ships.
-
-For, like a good many Pacific Islands, this coral land is more beautiful
-than fertile. Its wild fantastic rocks, which make up the whole surface
-of the island, produce in their clefts and hollows enough yam, taro,
-banana, and papaw to feed the natives; but the white man wants more.
-Tins are his only resource--tins and biscuits, for flour does not keep
-long, and bread is often unattainable. Fowls or eggs can seldom be
-bought, for the reason that some one imported a number of cats many
-years ago; these were allowed to run wild in the bush, and have now
-become wild in earnest, devouring fowls, and even attacking dogs and
-young pigs at times. Why, then, if the island is valueless to Europeans,
-and the life hard, do white men live in Savage Island and many similar
-places? For the reason that fortunes have been piled up, in past years,
-by trading in such isolated spots, and that there is still money to
-be made, though not so much as of old. Trading in the Pacific is a
-double-barrelled sort of business. You settle down on an island where
-there is a good supply of copra (dried cocoa-nut kernel, manufactured
-by the natives). You buy the copra from the islanders at about £8 a
-ton, store it away in your copra-house until the schooner or the steamer
-calls, and then ship it off to Sydney, where it sells at £13 to £14 a
-ton. Freight and labour in storing and getting on board, eat into the
-profits. But, in addition to buying, the trader sells. He has a store,
-where cheap prints, violent perfumes, gaudy jewellery, tapes and buttons
-and pins and needles, tins of beef, shoes, etc., are sold to the
-natives at a price which leaves a very good profit on their cost down in
-Auckland.
-
-The laws of all the Pacific Colonies forbid the white trader to buy from
-the natives, except with cash; but, as the cash comes back to him before
-long over the counter of the store, it comes to much the same in the end
-as the old barter system of the early days, out of which money used to
-be, quickly and easily made. Sometimes the trader, if in a small way
-of business, sells his copra to captains of calling ships at a smaller
-price than the Auckland value. But nowadays so many stores are owned by
-big Auckland and Sydney firms that most of the stuff is shipped off for
-sale in New Zealand or Australia. “Panama” hats, already mentioned,
-are a very important article of commerce here. Every island has some
-speciality of its own besides the inevitable copra; and the trader
-deals in all he can get. The trader’s life is, as a rule, a pleasant
-one enough. Savage Island is one of the worst places where he could find
-himself; and yet the days pass happily enough in that solitary outlier
-of civilisation. There is not much work to do; the climate is never
-inconveniently hot; the scenery, especially among the up-country
-primaeval forests, is very lovely. There is a good deal of riding and
-bathing, a little shooting, and a myriad of wild and fantastic caves to
-explore when the spirit moves one. The native canoes are easy to manage
-and excellent to fish from.
-
-[Illustration: 0303]
-
-It is traditional in Savage Island for the few white people--almost all
-rival traders--to hang together, and live in as friendly a manner as a
-great family party. If the great world is shut out, its cares are shut
-away, and life sits lightly on all. No one can be extravagant; no
-one can “keep up appearances” at the cost of comfort; no one is
-over-anxious, or worried, or excited over anything’--except when the
-rare, the long-expected ship comes in, and the natives rend the air with
-yells of joy, and the girls cocoanut-oil their hair, and the white men
-rush for clean duck suits and fresh hats, and the mails come in, and the
-news is distributed, and cargoes go out, and every one feasts from dawn
-till dusk, and all the island is in a state of frantic ebullition for at
-least three days. Then, indeed, Niué is alive.
-
-We were all getting hungry when the _Duchess_ came in again, after
-nearly two months’ absence, for provisions were short, and most of
-us had come down to eating little green parrots out of the bush, and
-enjoying them, for want of anything better. It was certainly tantalising
-to see the ship off the island beating about for three days and more,
-before she was able to approach, but that is an usual incident in Niué.
-She came up at last, and I got my traps on board, and paid my bills, and
-carried away the model canoes and shell necklaces, and plaited hats and
-baskets, that were brought me as parting presents, and gave-a number of
-yards of cotton cloth, and a good many silk handkerchiefs, in return.
-And so the big sails were hoisted once more with a merry rattling and
-flapping, and away we went, northward a thousand miles, to desolate,
-burning Penrhyn and Malden Island.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XI
-
-_A Life on the Ocean Wave--Where They kept the Dynamite--How far from
-an Iced Drink?--The Peacefulness of a Pacific Calm--A Golden Dust
-Heap--Among the Rookeries--Sailing on the Land--All about Guano._
-
-THE pirate captain was gone when the schooner reappeared off Niué, and
-a certain ancient mariner had taken his place. Things were not quite
-so exciting on the _Duchess_ under the new régime, but the order which
-reigned on board was something awful; for the ancient mariner had been a
-whaling captain in his day, and on whaling ships it is more than on any
-others a case of “Growl you may, but go you must,” for all the crew.
-The ancient mariner was as salty a salt as ever sailed the ocean. He had
-never been on anything with steam in it, he was as tough as ship-yard
-teak, and as strong as a bear, though he was a grandfather of some
-years’ standing, and he was full of strange wild stories about the
-whaling grounds, and odd happenings in out-of-the-way comers of the
-Pacific--most of which he seemed to consider the merest commonplaces of
-a prosaic existence.
-
-We suffered many things from the cook, in the course of that long
-burning voyage towards the Line. The _Duchess’s_ stores were none of
-the best, and the cook dealt with them after a fashion that made me
-understand once for all the sailor saying: “God sends meat, and the
-devil sends cooks.” Pea-soup, salt pork and beef, plum duff, ship’s
-biscuit, sea-pie--this was the sort of food that, in the days before
-I set foot on the _Duchess_, I had supposed to form the usual table of
-sailing vessels. I fear it was a case of sea-story-books, over again.
-What we did get was “tinned rag” of a peculiarly damp and viscous
-quality, tea that usually tasted of cockroaches, biscuit that was so
-full of copra bugs we had to hammer it on the table before eating it, an
-occasional tin of tasteless fruit (it ran out very soon), and bread that
-was a nightmare, for the flour went musty before we were out a week,
-and the unspeakable cook tried to disguise its taste with sugar.
-Board-of-trade limejuice, which is a nauseous dose at best, we were
-obliged, by law to carry, and I think we must have run rather near
-scurvy in the course of that long trip, for the amount of the oily,
-drug-flavoured liquid that the mates and myself used to drink at times,
-seemed to argue a special craving of nature. But _à la guerre comme à
-la guerre_--and one does not take ship on a Pacific windjammer expecting
-the luxuries of a P. and O.
-
-We were not going direct to Malden, having to call first at Samoa and
-Mangaia. Three days of rough rolling weather saw us in Apia, about
-which I have nothing to say at present, since I paid a longer visit to
-Stevenson’s country later on. We had about forty native passengers to
-take on here for the Cook Islands and Malden. There was nowhere to put
-them, but in the South Seas such small inconveniences trouble nobody.
-
-I am very strongly tempted here to tell about the big-gale that caught
-us the first night out, carried away our lifeboat, topsail, topgallant,
-and main gaff, swamped the unlucky passengers’ cabin, and caused
-the Cingalese steward to compose and chant all night long a litany
-containing three mournful versicles: “O my God, this is too much
-terrible! O my#God, why I ever go to sea! O my God, I never go to sea
-again!” But in the Pacific one soon learns that sea etiquette makes
-light of such matters. So the wonderful and terrible sights which I saw
-once or twice that night, clinging precariously to anything solid near
-the door of my cabin, and hoping that the captain would not catch me out
-on deck, must remain undescribed.
-
-Nearly seven weeks were occupied by this northern trip--time for a mail
-steamer to go out from London to New Zealand, and get well started on
-the way home again. We were, of course, entirely isolated from news and
-letters; indeed, the mails and papers that we carried conveyed the very
-latest intelligence to islands that had not had a word from the outer
-world for many months. Our native passengers, who were mostly going up
-to Malden Island guano works as paid labourers, evidently considered
-the trip one wild scene of excitement and luxury. The South Sea Islander
-loves nothing more than change, and every new island we touched at was
-a Paris or an Ostend to these (mostly) untravelled natives. Their
-accommodation on the ship was not unlike that complained of by the
-waiter in “David Copperfield.” They “lived on broken wittles and they
-slept on the coals.” The _Duchess_ carried benzoline tins for the
-feeding of the futile little motor that worked her in and out of port,
-and the native sleeping place was merely the hold, on top of the tins.
-
-[Illustration: 0325]
-
-“Do you mind the dynamite remaining under your bunk?” asked the ancient
-mariner, shortly after we left Samoa.
-
-“_Under my bunk?_”
-
-“Yes--didn’t you know it was there? The explosives safe is let into the
-deck just beneath the deck cabin. I’ll move it if you’re nervous about
-it--I thought I’d tell you, anyways. But it’s the best place for it to
-be, you see, right amidships.” And the ancient mariner, leaning his six
-foot two across the rail, turned his quid, and spat into the deep.
-
-“What do we want with dynamite, anyhow?” asked the bewildered passenger,
-confronted with this new and startling streak of local colour.
-
-“_We_ don’t want none. The Cook Islands wants it for reefs.”
-
-“Oh, leave it where it is--I suppose it’s all the same in the end where
-it starts from, if it did blow up,” says the passenger resignedly. “What
-about the benzoline in the hold, though?”
-
-“Every one’s got to take chances at sea,” says the captain, easily.
-“The mates have orders to keep the natives from smokin’ in the hold at
-night.”
-
-And at midnight, when I slip out of my bunk to look on and see what
-the weather is like (it has been threatening all day), a faint but
-unmistakable odour of island tobacco greets my nose, from the opening
-of the main hatch! Benzoline, dynamite, natives smoking in the hold,
-one big boat smashed, one small one left, forty native passengers, five
-whites, and three hundred miles to the nearest land!
-
-Well, _à la guerre comme à la guerre_, and one must not tell tales at
-sea. So I don’t tell any, though tempted. But I am very glad, a week
-later, to see the Cook Islands rising up out of the empty blue again.
-We have had head winds, we have been allowanced as to water, we are all
-pleased to have a chance of taking in some fruit before we start on the
-thousand miles’ run to Malden--and above all, we leave that dynamite
-here, which is a good thing; for really we have been putting rather too
-much strain on the good nature of the “Sweet little cherub that sits up
-aloft, to keep guard o’er the life of poor Jack,” this last week or two.
-
-If proof were wanted that the cherub’s patience is about at an end, our
-arrival at Mangaia furnishes it--for we do take fire after all, just a
-couple of hundred yards from shore!
-
-It does not matter now, since half the natives of the island are about
-the ship, and the case of explosives has just been rowed off in our only
-boat, and the blaze is put out without much trouble. But, two days ago!
-
-Well, the sweet little cherub certainly deserved a rest.
-
-*****
-
-Now the _Duchess’s_ bowsprit was pointed northwards, and we set out on
-a thousand miles’ unbroken run up to Malden Island, only four degrees
-south of the Line. For nine days we ploughed across the same monotonous
-plain of lonely sea, growing a little duller every day, as our stores of
-reading matter dwindled away, and our fruit and vegetables ran out,
-and the memory of our last fresh mess became only a haunting, far-off
-regret. Squatting or lying about the white-hot poop in the merciless
-sun--which burnt through our duck and cotton clothing, and scorched the
-skin underneath, but was at least a degree better than the choking Hades
-of a cabin below--we used to torture each other with reminiscences
-and speculations, such as “They have real salt beef and sea-pie and
-lobscouse and pea-soup, and things like that, every day on Robinson’s
-schooner; no tinned rag and musty flour”; or “How many thousand miles
-are we now from an iced drink?” This last problem occupied the mates and
-myself for half a morning, and made us all a great deal hotter than we
-were before. Auckland was about 2,300 miles away, San Francisco about
-3,000 as far as we could guess. We decided for Auckland, and discussed
-the best place to buy the drink, being somewhat limited in choice by
-the passenger’s selfish insistence on a place where she could get really
-good iced coffee. By the time this was settled, the captain joined in,
-and informed us that we could get all we wanted, and fresh limes into
-the bargain, only a thousand miles away, at Tahiti, which every one had
-somehow overlooked. Only a thousand! It seemed nothing, and we all felt
-(illogically) cheered up at the thought.
-
-Late in the afternoon we came near attaining our wish for a temperature
-of thirty-two degrees in rather an unexpected way. The bottom of the
-Pacific generally hovers about this figure, some miles below the burning
-surface, which often reaches the temperature of an ordinary warm bath;
-and the _Duchess_ had a fairly narrow escape of going down to look for
-a cool spot without a return ticket. A giant waterspout suddenly formed
-out of the low-hanging, angry sky that had replaced the clear heat of
-the morning. First of all, a black trunk like an elephant’s began to
-feel blindly about in mid-air, hanging from a cloud. It came nearer and
-nearer with uncanny speed, drawing up to itself as it came a colossal
-cone of turbulent sea, until the two joined together in one enormous
-black pillar, some quarter of a mile broad at the base, and probably a
-good thousand feet high, uniting as it did the clouds and the sea
-below. Across the darkening sea, against the threatening, copper-crimson
-sunset, came this gigantic horror, waltzing over leagues of torn-up
-water in a veritable dance of death, like something blind, but mad and
-cruel, trying to find and shatter our fragile little ship. Happily, the
-dark was only coming, not yet come; happily, too, the wind favoured
-us, and we were able to tack about and keep out of the way, dodging the
-strangely human rushes and advances of the water-giant with smartness
-and skill. At one time it came so close that the elephant trunk--now
-separately visible again--seemed feeling about over our heads, although
-the captain afterwards said it had been more than three hundred yards
-away--and the immense maelstrom underneath showed us the great wall of
-whirling spindrift that edged its deadly circle, as plain as the foam
-about our own bows. Every one was quiet, cool, and ready; but no one
-was sorry when the threatening monster finally spun, away to leeward and
-melted into air once more. A waterspout of this enormous size, striking
-a small vessel, would snap off her masts like sticks of candy, kill any
-one who happened to be on deck, and most probably sink the ship with the
-very impact of the terrible shock.
-
-“One doesn’t hear much about ships being sunk by waterspouts,” objected
-the sceptical passenger to this last statement.
-
-“Ships that’s sunk by waterspouts doesn’t come back to tell the
-newspapers about it,” said the captain darkly.
-
-Life on a South Sea schooner is not all romance. For the officers of
-the ship it is a very hard life indeed. Native crews are the rule in
-the South Seas, and native crews make work for every one, including
-themselves. Absolutely fearless is the Kanaka, active as a monkey aloft,
-good-natured and jolly to the last degree, but perfectly unreliable in
-any matter requiring an ounce of thought or a pennyworth of discretion,
-and, moreover, given to shirk work in a variety of ingenious ways
-that pass the wit of the white man to circumvent. Constant and keen
-supervision while at sea, unremitting hurry and drive in port, are the
-duties of a South Sea mate, coupled with plenty of actual hard work on
-his own account. I have known a case where a small schooner was leaking
-badly, many days from port, and almost constant pumping was required.
-The pump broke while in use; and the watch, delighted to be released,
-turned in at eight bells without having done their spell, and without
-reporting the accident. The water gained steadily, but that did not
-trouble them; and when the mate discovered the accident, and set them to
-mend the pump at once, they were both surprised and grieved!
-
-“Watch and watch” is the rule on small sailing-vessels: four hours on
-and four hours off, day and night, except for the “dog watches,” four
-to six and six to eight in the evening, which create a daily shift in
-order that each man may be on watch at a different time on successive
-days. Always provided, of course, that the ship has any watches at all!
-I _have_ sailed in a Pacific schooner where the crew spent most of their
-time playing the accordion and the Jew’s harp, and slept peacefully all
-night. In the daytime there was generally some one at the wheel; but at
-night it was usually lashed, and the ship was let run, with all sails
-set, taking her chances of what might come, every soul on board being
-asleep. One night the cook came out of his bunk to get a drink from the
-tank, and found the vessel taken aback. The whole spirit of South
-Sea life breathes from the sequel. He told nobody! The galley was his
-department, not the sails; so he simply went back to his bunk. In the
-morning we fetched up off the northern side of an island we had intended
-to «approach from the south; having, strange to say, somehow escaped
-piling our bones on the encircling reef, and also avoided the misfortune
-of losing our masts and getting sunk.
-
-If there is a good deal of hard work on most schooners, and something
-of risk on all, there is also plenty of adventure and romance, for those
-who care about it. One seldom meets an island skipper whose life would
-not furnish materials for a dozen exciting books. Being cut off and
-attacked by cannibals down in the dangerous western groups; swimming for
-dear life away from a boat just bitten in two by an infuriated whale;
-driving one native king off his throne, putting another on, and acting
-as prime minister to the nation; hunting up a rumour of a splendid pearl
-among the pearling islands, and tracking down the gem, until found
-and coaxed away from its careless owner at one-tenth Sydney market
-prices--these are incidents that the typical schooner captain regards
-as merely the ordinary kind of break to be expected in his rather
-monotonous life. He does not think them very interesting as a rule, and
-dismisses them somewhat briefly, in a yarn. What does excite him, cause
-him to raise his voice and gesticulate freely, and induce him to “yarn”
- relentlessly for half a watch, is the recital of some thrilling incident
-connected with the price of cargo or the claims made for damaged stuff
-by some abandoned villain of a trader. There is something worth relating
-in a tale like that, to his mind!
-
-The passenger on an island schooner learns very early to cultivate a
-humble frame of mind. On a great steam liner he is all in all. It is for
-him almost entirely that the ships are built and run; his favour is
-life or death to the company. He is handled like eggs, and petted like a
-canary bird. Every one runs to do his bidding; he is one of a small but
-precious aristocracy waited on hand and foot by the humblest of serfs.
-On a schooner, however, he is ousted from his pride of place most
-completely by the cargo, which takes precedence of him at every point;
-so that he rapidly learns he is not of nearly so much value as a fat
-sack of copra, and he becomes lowlier in mind than he ever was before.
-There is no special accommodation for him, as a rule; he must go where
-he can, and take what he gets. If he can make himself useful about the
-ship, so much the better; every one will think more of him, and he will
-get some useful exercise by working his passage in addition to paying
-for it.
-
-Here is a typical day on the _Duchess_.
-
-At eight bells (8 a.m.) breakfast is served in the cabin. The
-passenger’s own cabin is a small deck-house placed amidships on the main
-deck. The deck is filled up with masses of cargo, interposing a perfect
-Himalayan chain of mountains between the main deck and the poop. It is
-pouring with tropical rain, but the big main hatch yawns half open on
-one side, because of the native passengers in the hold. On the other
-side foams a squally sea, unguarded by either rail or bulwark, since the
-cargo is almost overflowing out of the ship. The _Duchess_ is rolling
-like a porpoise, and the passenger’s hands are full of mackintosh and
-hat-brim. It seems impossible to reach the poop alive; but the verb
-“have to” is in constant use on a sailing-ship, and it does not fail
-of its magical effect on this occasion. Clawing like a parrot, the
-passenger reaches the cabin, and finds the bare-armed, barefooted mates
-and the captain engaged on the inevitable “tin” and biscuits. There is
-no tea this morning, because the cockroaches have managed to get into
-and flavour the brew; and the cabin will none of it. The captain has
-sent word by the native steward that he will “learn” the cook--a strange
-threat that usually brings about at least a temporary reform--and is
-now engaged in knocking the copra-bugs out of a piece of biscuit and
-brushing a colony of ants off his plate. Our cargo is copra, and
-in consequence the ship resembles an entomological museum more than
-anything else. No centipedes have been found this trip so far; but the
-mate-stabbed a big scorpion with a sail-needle yesterday, as it was
-walking across the deck; and the cockroaches--as large as mice, and much
-bolder--have fairly “taken charge.” The captain says he does not know
-whether he is sleeping in the cockroaches’ bunk, or they in his, but he
-rather thinks the former, since the brutes made a determined effort to
-throw him out on the deck last night, and nearly succeeded!
-
-It grows very warm after breakfast, for we are far within the tropics,
-and the _Duchess_ has no awnings to protect her deck. The rail is almost
-hot enough to blister an unwary hand, and the great sails cast little
-shade, as the sun climbs higher to the zenith. The pitch does not,
-however, bubble in the seams of the deck, after the well-known fashion
-of stories, because the _Duchess_, like most other tropical ships, has
-her decks caulked with putty. A calm has fallen--a Pacific calm, which
-is not as highly distinguished for calmness as the stay-at-home reader
-might suppose. There is no wind, and the island we are trying to reach
-remains tantalisingly perched on the extreme edge of the horizon, like a
-little blue flower on the rim of a crystal dish. But there is plenty
-of sea--long glittering hills of water, rising and falling, smooth and
-foamless, under the ship, which they fling from side to side with cruel
-violence. The great booms swing and slam, the blocks clatter, the masts
-creak. Everything loose in the cabins toboggans wildly up and down the
-floor. At dinner, the soup which the cook has struggled to produce,
-lest he should be “learned,” has to be drunk out of tin mugs for safety.
-Every one is sad and silent, for the sailor hates a calm even more than
-a gale.
-
-Bonitos come round the ship in a glittering shoal by-and-by, and there
-is a rush for hooks and lines. One of our native A.B.s produces a huge
-pearl hook, unbaited, and begins to skim it lightly along the water at
-the end of its line, mimicking the exact motions of a flying-fish with
-a cleverness that no white man can approach. Hurrah! a catch! A mass of
-sparkling silver, blue, and green, nearly twenty pounds weight, is swung
-through the air, and tumbled on deck. Another and another follows; we
-have over a hundred pounds weight of fish in half an hour. The crew
-shout and sing for delight. There are only seven of them and five of us,
-but there-will not be a scrap of that fish left by to-morrow, for all
-the forecastle hands will turn to and cook and eat without ceasing until
-it is gone; after which they will probably dance for an hour or two.
-
-To every one’s delight, the weather begins to cloud over again after
-this, and we are soon spinning before a ten-knot breeze towards the
-island, within sight of which we have been aimlessly beating about
-for some days, unable to get up. Our crew begin to make preparations.
-Tapitua, who is a great dandy, puts two gold earrings in one ear, and
-fastens a wreath of cock’s feathers about his hat. Koddi (christened
-George) gets into a thick blue woollen jersey (very suitable for
-Antarctic weather), a scarlet and yellow pareo or kilt, and a pair
-of English shoes, which make him limp terribly; but they are splendid
-squeakers, so Koddi is happy. (The Pacific islander always picks out
-squeaking shoes if he can get them, and some manufacturers even put
-special squeakers into goods meant for the island trade.) Ta puts on
-three different singlets--a pink, a blue, and a yellow--turning up the
-edges carefully, so as to present a fine display of layered colours,
-like a Neapolitan ice; and gums the gaudy label off a jam tin about his
-bare brown arm, thus christening himself with the imposing title of “Our
-Real Raspberry.” Neo is wearing two hats and three neck-handkerchiefs;
-Oki has a cap with a “P. & O.” ribbon, and Union Steamship Company’s
-jersey, besides a threepenny-piece in the hollow of each ear. Truly we
-are a gay party, by the time every one is ready to land.
-
-And now after our thousand mile run, we have arrived at Malden.
-
-Malden Island lies on the border of the Southern Pacific, only four
-degrees south of the equator. It is beyond the verge of the great
-Polynesian archipelago, and stands out by itself in a lonely stretch of
-still blue sea, very seldom visited by ships of any kind. Approaching it
-one is struck from far away by the glaring barrenness of the big island,
-which is thirty-three miles in circumference, and does not possess a
-single height or solitary tree, save one small clump of recently planted
-cocoanuts. Nothing more unlike the typical South Sea island could be
-imagined. Instead of the violet mountain peaks, wreathed with flying
-vapour, the lowlands rich with pineapple, banana, orange, and mango, the
-picturesque beach bordered by groves of feathery cocoanuts and quaint
-heavy-fruited pandanus trees, that one finds in such groups as the
-Society, Navigator’s, Hawaiian, and Cook Islands, Malden consists simply
-of an immense white beach, a little settlement fronted by a big wooden
-pier, and a desolate plain of low greyish-green herbage, relieved here
-and there by small bushes bearing insignificant yellow flowers. Water
-is provided by great condensers. Food is all imported, save for pig
-and goat flesh. Shade, coolness, refreshing fruit, pleasant sights and
-sounds, there are none. For those who live on the island, it is the
-scene of an exile which has to be endured somehow or other, but which
-drags away with incredible slowness and soul-deadening monotony.
-
-Why does any one live in such a spot? More especially, why should it
-be tenanted by five or six whites and a couple of hundred Kanakas, when
-many beautiful and fertile islands cannot show nearly so many of either
-race; quite a large number, indeed, being altogether uninhabited? One
-need never look far for an answer in such a case. If there is no
-comfort on Malden Island, there is something that men value more than
-comfort--money. For fifty-six years it has been one of the most valuable
-properties in the Pacific. Out of Malden Island have come horses and
-carriages, fine houses, and gorgeous jewellery, rich eating, delicate
-wines, handsome entertainments, university education and expensive
-finishing governesses, trips to the Continent, swift white schooners,
-high places in Society, and all the other desirables of wealth, for two
-generations of fortunate owners and their families. Half-a-million hard
-cash has been made out of it in the last thirty years, and it is good
-for another thirty. All this from a barren rock in mid-ocean! The
-solution of the problem will at once suggest itself to any reader who
-has ever sailed the Southern Seas--guano!
-
-This is indeed the secret of Malden Island’s riches. Better by far
-than the discovery of a pirate’s treasure-cave, that favourite dream
-of romantic youth, is the discovery of a guano island. There are few
-genuine treasure romances in the Pacific, but many exciting tales that
-deal with the finding and disposing of these unromantic mines of wealth.
-Malden Island itself has had an interesting history enough. In 1848,
-Captain Chapman, an American whaling captain who still lives in
-Honolulu, happened to discover Malden during the course of a long
-cruise. He landed on the island, found nothing for himself and his crew
-in the way of fruit or vegetables, but discovered the guano beds, and
-made up his mind to sell the valuable knowledge as soon as his cruise
-was over. Then he put to sea again, and did not reach San Francisco for
-the best part of a year. Meantime, another American, Captain English,
-had found the island and its treasure. Wiser than Captain Chapman, he
-abandoned his cruise, and hurried at once to Sydney, where he sold the
-island for a big price to the trading firm who have owned it ever since.
-
-This is the history of Malden Island’s discovery. Time, in the island,
-has slipped along since the days of the Crimea with never a change.
-There is a row of little tin-roofed, one-storeyed houses above the
-beach, tenanted by the half-dozen white men who act as managers; there
-are big, barn-like shelters for the native labourers. Every three years
-the managers end their term of service, and joyfully return to
-the Company’s great offices in Sydney, where there is life and
-companionship, pleasant things to see, good things to eat, newspapers
-every day, and no prison bar of blue relentless ocean cutting off all
-the outer world. Once or twice in the year one of the pretty white
-island schooners sails up to Malden, greeted with shrieks and war-dances
-of joy; discharges her freight of forty or fifty newly indentured
-labourers, and takes away as many others whose time of one year on the
-island has expired. On Malden itself nothing changes. Close up to the
-equator, and devoid of mountains or even heights which could attract
-rain, its climate is unaltered by the passing season. No fruits or
-flowers mark the year by their ripening and blossoming, no rainy season
-changes the face of the land. News from the outer world comes rarely;
-and when it does come, it is so old as to have lost its savour. Life on
-Malden Island for managers and labourers alike, is work, work, all day
-long; in the evening, the bare verandah and the copper-crimson sunset,
-and the empty prisoning sea. That is all.
-
-The guano beds cover practically the whole of the island. The surface on
-which one walks is hard, white, and rocky. This must be broken through
-before the guano, which lies a foot or two underneath, is reached. The
-labourers break away the stony crust with picks, and shovel out the
-fine, dry, earth-coloured guano that lies beneath, in a stratum varying
-from one to three feet in thickness. This is piled in great heaps, and
-sifted through large wire, screens. The sifted guano--exactly resembling
-common sand--is now spread out in small heaps, and left to dry
-thoroughly in the fierce sun. There must not be any trace of moisture
-left that can possibly be dispersed; for the price of the guano depends
-on its absolute purity and extreme concentration, and purchasers
-generally make careful chemical tests of the stuff they buy.
-
-When dried, the guano is stored away in an immense shed near the
-settlement. If it has been obtained from the pits at the other side of
-the island, eight miles away, it will be brought down to the storehouse
-by means of one of the oddest little railways in the world. The Malden
-Island railway is worked, not by steam, electricity, or petrol, but by
-sail! The S.E. trade-wind blows practically all the year round on
-this island; so the Company keep a little fleet of land-vessels,
-cross-rigged, with fine large sails, to convey the guano down to
-the settlement. The empty carriages are pushed up to the pits by the
-workmen, and loaded there. At evening, the labourers climb on the top of
-the load, set the great sails, and fly down to the settlement as fast
-as an average train could go. These “land-ships” of Malden are a bit
-unmanageable at times, and have been known to jump the rails when
-travelling at high speed, thus causing unpleasant accidents. But the
-Kanaka labourers do not mind a trifle of that kind, and not even in a
-S.E. gale would they condescend to take a reef in the sails.
-
-As it is necessary to push these railway ships on the outward trip, the
-managers generally travel on a small railway tricycle of the pattern
-familiar at home. This can be driven at a fair speed, by means of arm
-levers. Across the desolate inland plain one clatters, the centre of a
-disk of shadowless grey-green, drenched clear of drawing and colour by
-the merciless flood of white fire from above. The sky is of the very
-thinnest pale blue; the dark, deep sea is out of sight. The world is
-all dead stillness and smiting sun, with only the thin rattle of our
-labouring car, and the vibration of distant dark specks above the
-rookeries, for relief.
-
-The dark specks grow nearer and more numerous, filling the whole sky
-at last with the sweep of rushing wings and the screams of angry bird
-voices. We leave the tricycle on the rails and walk across the
-thin, coarse grass, tangled with barilla plants, and low-growing
-yellow-flowered shrubs, towards the spot where the wings flutter
-thickest, covering many acres of the unlovely, barren land with a
-perfect canopy of feathered life. This is the bird by which the fortunes
-of Malden have been made--the smaller man-o’-war bird. It is about the
-size of a duck, though much lighter in build. The back is black, the
-breast white, the bill long and hooked. The bird has an extraordinarily
-rapid and powerful flight. It might more appropriately be called the
-“pirate” than the “man-o’-war” or “frigate” bird, since it uses, its
-superior speed to deprive other seabirds of the fish they catch, very
-seldom indeed exerting itself to make an honest capture on its own
-account. Strange to say, however, this daring buccaneer is the meekest
-and most long-suffering of birds where human beings are concerned. It
-will allow you to walk all through its rookeries, and even to handle
-the young birds and eggs, without making any remonstrance other than a
-petulant squeal. The parents fly about the visitors’ heads in a perfect
-cloud, sweeping their wings within an inch of our faces, screaming
-harshly, and looking exceedingly fierce, with their ugly hooked bills
-and sparkling black eyes. But that is their ordinary way of occupying
-themselves; they wheel and scream above the rookery all day long,
-visited or let alone. Even if you capture one, by a happy snatch (not
-at all an impossible feat), you will not alarm the others, and your
-prisoner will not show much fight.
-
-The eggs lie all over the ground in a mass of broken shells, feathers,
-and clawed-up earth. Those birds never build nests, and only sit upon
-one egg, which is dirty white, with brown spots. The native labourers
-consider frigate-bird eggs good to eat, and devour large numbers, but
-the white men find them too strong. The birds are also eaten by the
-labourers, but only on the sly, as this practice is strictly forbidden,
-for the reason that illness generally follows. The frigate-bird, it
-seems, is not very wholesome eating.
-
-It is not in the insignificant deposits of these modern rookeries that
-the wealth of the island lies, but in the prehistoric strata underlying
-the stony surface crust already mentioned. There are three strata
-composing the island--first the coral rock, secondly the guano, lastly
-the surface crust. At one time, the island must have been the home of
-innumerable myriads of frigate-birds, nesting all over its circumference
-of thirty-three miles. The birds now nest only in certain places, and,
-though exceedingly thick to an unaccustomed eye, cannot compare with
-their ancestors in number.
-
-The schooner called on a Sunday, and so I could not see the men at work.
-One of the managers, however, showed me over the labourers’ quarters,
-and told me all about their life. There is certainly none of the
-“black-birding” business about Malden. Kidnapping natives for plantation
-work, under conditions which amount to slavery, is unfortunately still
-common enough in some parts of the Pacific. But in the Cook Group,
-and Savage Island, where most of the labourers come from, there is no
-difficulty in obtaining as many genuine volunteers for Malden as its
-owners want. The men sign for a year’s work, at ten shillings a week,
-and board and lodging. Their food consists of rice, biscuits, yams,
-tinned beef, and tea, with a few cocoanuts for those who may fall sick.
-This is “the hoigth of good ’atin” for a Polynesian, who lives when
-at home on yams, taro root, and bananas, with an occasional mouthful of
-fish, and fowl or pig only on high festival days.
-
-The labourers’ quarters are large, bare, shady buildings fitted with
-wide shelves, on which the men spread their mats and pillows to sleep.
-A Polynesian is never to be divorced from his bedding; he always carries
-it with him when travelling, and the Malden labourers each come to the
-island provided with beautifully plaited pandanus mats, and cushions
-stuffed with the down of the silk-cotton tree. The cushions have covers
-of “trade” cottons, rudely embroidered by the owner’s sweetheart or wife
-with decorative designs, and affectionate mottoes.
-
-From 5 a.m. to 5 p.m. are the hours of work, with an hour and
-three-quarters off for meals. There is nothing unpleasant about the
-work, as Malden Island guano is absolutely without odour, and apparently
-so dry and fine when taken from the pits, that one wonders at the
-necessity for further sifting and drying. Occasionally, however, one of
-the workers develops a peculiar intestinal trouble which is said to be
-caused by the fine dust of the pits. It is nearly always fatal, by slow
-degrees. Our schooner carried away one of these unfortunates--a Savage
-Island man who had come up to Malden in full health and strength only
-a few months before. He was the merest shadow or sketch of a human
-being--a bundle of bones clad in loose brown skin, with a skull-like
-face, all teeth and eye-sockets--he could not stand or walk, only creep
-along the deck; and he was very obviously dying. Poor fellow! he longed
-for his own home above everything---the cool green island, sixteen
-hundred miles away, where there were fruit and flowers in the shady
-valleys, and women’s and children’s voices sounding pleasantly about the
-grassy village streets, and his own little pandanus-thatched cottage,
-with his “fafiné” and the babies at the door, among the palms and
-oranges above the sea. But the schooner had a two months’ voyage to
-make yet among the Cook and other groups, before Savage Island could be
-reached; and Death was already lifting his spear to strike. We left
-the poor fellow as a last chance on Penrhyn Island, a couple of hundred
-miles away, hoping that the unlimited cocoanuts he could obtain there
-might do him some good, and that by some fortunate chance he might
-recover sufficiently to take another ship, and reach Niué at last.
-
-The guano of Malden Island is supposed to be the best in the world. It
-is extremely rich in superphosphates, and needs no “doctoring” whatever,
-being ready to apply to the land just as taken from the island. As the
-company are obliged to guarantee the purity of what they sell, and give
-an exact analysis of the constituents of every lot, they keep a skilled
-chemist on the island, and place a fine laboratory at his disposal.
-These analyses are tedious to make, and require great accuracy, as a
-mistake might cause a refusal of payment on the part of the purchaser.
-The post of official chemist, therefore, is no sinecure, especially
-as it includes the duties of dispenser as well, and not a little
-rough-and-ready doctoring at times.
-
-The temperature of the island is not so high as might be expected from
-the latitude. It seldom goes above 90° in the shade, and is generally
-rendered quite endurable, in spite of the merciless glare and total
-absence of shade, by the persistent trade-wind. Mosquitoes are unknown,
-and flies not troublesome. There are no centipedes, scorpions, or other
-venomous creatures, although the neighbouring islands (“neighbouring,”
- in the Pacific, means anything within three or four hundred miles) have
-plenty of these unpleasant inhabitants. The white men live on tinned
-food of various kinds, also bread, rice, fowls, pork, goat, and goat’s
-milk. Vegetables or fruit are a rare and precious luxury, for the
-nearest island producing either lies a thousand miles away. Big yams,
-weighing a stone or two apiece and whitewashed to prevent decay, are
-sent up from the Cook Islands now and then; but the want of really
-fresh, vegetable food is one of the trials of the island. It is not
-astonishing to hear that the salaries of the Malden officials are very
-high. A year or two on the island is a good way of accumulating some
-capital, since it is impossible to spend a penny.
-
-The native labourers generally leave the island with the greatest joy,
-glad beyond expression to return to their sweet do-nothing lives at
-home. Why they undertake the work at all is one of the many puzzles
-presented by the Polynesian character. They have enough to eat and
-enough to wear, without doing any work to speak of, while they are at
-home. Usually the motive for going to Malden is the desire of making
-twenty-five pounds or so in a lump, to buy a bicycle (all South Sea
-Islanders have bicycles, and ride them splendidly) or to build a stone
-house. But in most cases the money is “spreed” away in the first two
-or three days at home, giving presents to everybody, and buying fine
-clothes at the trader’s store.
-
-So the product of the year’s exile and hard work is simply a tour among
-the islands--in itself a strong attraction--a horribly hot suit of
-shoddy serge, with a stiff white shirt, red socks, and red tie, bought
-up in Malden from the company out of the labourer’s wages, and proudly
-worn on the day the schooner brings the wanderer home to his lightly
-clad relatives--a bicycle, perhaps, which soon becomes a scrap-heap;
-or, possibly, a stone house which is never lived in. The company has the
-labour that it wants, and the money that the labour produces. Every one
-is satisfied with the bargain, doubtless; and the faraway British farmer
-and market-gardener are the people who are ultimately benefited.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XII
-
-_Pearl-fishing at Penrhyn--The Beautiful Golden-Edge--Perils of the
-Pearl Diver--A Fight for Life--Visit to a Leper Island--A God-forsaken
-Place--How they kept the Corpses--The Woman who sinned--A Nameless
-Grave--On to Merry Manahiki--The Island of Dance and Song--Story of the
-Leper and his Bird--Good-bye to the Duchess._
-
-A DAY or two after leaving Malden we sighted Penrhyn, lying five
-degrees further south, but for some unexplained reason a very much
-hotter place than Malden. Penrhyn is an island that is famous all over
-the South Sea world, and not unknown even in Europe. Its pearl-shell and
-pearls, its strange, wild, semi-amphibious natives, and its melancholy
-leper station, make it a marked spot upon the Pacific map; and a certain
-rather fictitious value attaching to its stamps has made the name of the
-island familiar to all stamp collectors at home. The general impression
-conveyed to the voyager from kinder and fairer islands is that Penrhyn
-is a place “at the back of God-speed,” a lonely, sultry, windy, eerie
-spot, desolate and remote beyond description.
-
-It is an atoll island, consisting merely of a strip of land some couple
-of hundred yards in width, enclosing a splendid lagoon nine miles long.
-The land is white coral gravel; nothing grows on it but cocoanut and
-pandanus and a few insignificant creepers. Fruit, vegetables, flowers,
-there are none. The natives live entirely on cocoanut and fish. They
-are nominally Christianised, but the veneer of Christianity is wearing
-uncommonly thin in places. They are reckless and daring to a degree,
-notable even among Pacific Islanders. Any Penrhyn man will attack a
-shark single-handed in its own element, and kill it with the big knife
-he usually carries. They are, beyond comparison, the finest swimmers in
-the world; it is almost impossible to drown a Penrhyn Islander. He
-will swim all day as easily as he will walk. You may often meet him out
-fishing, miles from shore, without a boat, pushing in front of him a
-small plank that carries his bait, lines, and catch. Some of the fish
-he most fancies seldom come to the surface. To catch these he baits his
-line, dives, and swims about underneath the water for a minute or two at
-a time, trailing the bait after him, and rising to the surface as often
-as a fish takes it.
-
-[Illustration: 0339]
-
-Of his pearl-diving exploits I shall speak later. The deadly surf that
-breaks upon the outer reef has no terrors for him. Among the small boys
-of the island there is a favourite feat known as “crossing a hundred
-waves,” which consists in diving through ninety-nine great rollers, just
-as they are about to break, and rushing triumphantly to shore on the
-back of the hundredth. The old warlike, quarrelsome character of the
-islanders--no doubt originally due to scarcity of food--still lurks
-concealed under an outward show of civility. Penrhyn was the only South
-Pacific Island I have visited where I did not care to walk alone in the
-bush without my little American revolver. The four or five white traders
-all keep firearms ready to hand in their stores. There has been no
-actual trouble of recent years, but there are narrow escapes from a
-free fight every now and then, and every man must hold himself ready for
-emergencies. It is only eight years since there was such an outbreak of
-hostilities in Penrhyn that a man-of-war had to be sent up to protect
-the traders.
-
-I was kindly offered the use of a house during the week the _Duchess_
-spent in Penrhyn lagoon repairing sails and rigging, and generally
-refitting after the stormy weather that we had experienced on several
-occasions. But Penrhyn is rotten with undeclared leprosy, the water
-is not above suspicion, and flies abound in myriads. So I slept on the
-ship, and by day wandered about the desolate, thin, sun-smitten woods
-of the island, or flew over the green lagoon in one of the marvellously
-speedy pearling sloops of the traders. These boats are about a couple
-of tons each, with a boom as big, in proportion, as a grasshopper’s leg.
-They are as manageable as a motor car, and faster than most yachts.
-It is a wonderful sight to see them taking cargo out to the schooners,
-speeding like gulls over the water, and turning round in their tracks to
-fly back again as easily as any gull might do. Pearling was almost “off”
- at the time of the _Duchess’s_ visit, since a good part of the lagoon
-was tabooed to allow the beds to recover.
-
-The pearls are rather a minor consideration at Penrhyn. The shell is of
-beautiful quality, large and thick, with the much-valued golden edge;
-but pearls are not plentiful in it, and they are generally of moderate
-size. Some very fine ones have been found, however; and gems of ordinary
-value can always be picked up fairly cheaply from the divers. The
-Penrhyn lagoon is the property of the natives themselves, who sell the
-shell and the pearls to white traders. Christmas Island and some other
-Pacific pearling grounds are privately owned, and in these places there
-is a great deal of poaching done by the divers. The great buyers of
-pearls are the schooner captains. There are three or four schooners that
-call at Penrhyn now and then for cargo; and every captain has a nose for
-pearls like that of a trained hound for truffles. In the Paumotus, about
-Penrhyn, Christmas Island, and the Scillies (the Pacific Scillies, not
-those that are so familiarly known to English readers), they flit from
-island to island, following up the vagrant rumours of a fine pearl with
-infinite tact and patience, until they run it to ground at last, and
-(perhaps) clear a year’s income in a day by a lucky deal. San Francisco
-and Sydney are always ready to buy, and the typical Pacific captain, if
-he is just a bit of a buccaneer, is also a very keen man of business in
-the most modern sense of the word, and not at all likely to be cheated.
-Three native divers, famous for their deepwater feats, came out in a
-pearling sloop with us one afternoon, and gave a fine exhibition.
-
-The bed over which we halted was about ninety feet under the surface.
-Our three divers stripped to a “pareo” apiece, and then, squatting down
-on the gunwale of the boat with their hands hanging over their knees,
-appeared to meditate. They were “taking their wind,” the white steersman
-informed me. After about five minutes of perfect stillness they suddenly
-got up and dived off the thwart. The rest of us fidgeted up and down the
-tiny deck, talked, speculated, and passed away the time for what seemed
-an extraordinarily long period. No one, unfortunately, had brought a
-watch; but the traders and schooner captains all agree in saying that
-the Penrhyn diver can stay under water for full three minutes; and it
-was quite evident that our men were showing off for the benefit of that
-almost unknown bird, the “wahiné papa.” At last, one after another, the
-dark heads popped up again, and the divers, each carrying a shell or
-two, swam back to the boat, got on board, and presented their catch to
-me with the easy grace and high-bred courtesy that are the birthright of
-all Pacific islanders--not at all embarrassed by the fact that all the
-clothes they wore would hardly have sufficed to make a Sunday suit for
-an equal number of pigeons.
-
-As a general rule, the divers carry baskets, and fill them before coming
-up. Each man opens his own catch at once, and hunts through the shell
-for pearls. Usually he does not find any; now and then he gets a small
-grey pearl, 01 a decent white one, or a big irregular “baroque” pearl of
-the “new art” variety, and once in a month of Sundays he is rewarded
-by a large gleaming gem worth several hundred pounds, for which he will
-probably get only twenty or thirty.
-
-Diving dresses are sometimes used in Penrhyn; but in such an irregular
-and risky manner that they are really more dangerous than the ordinary
-method. The suit is nothing but a helmet and jumper. No boots are worn,
-no clothing whatever on the legs, and there are no weights to
-preserve the diver’s balance. It sometimes happens--though wonderfully
-seldom--that the diver trips, falls, and turns upside down, the heavy
-helmet keeping him head-downwards until the air all rushes out under
-the jumper, and he is miserably suffocated. The air pump above is often
-carelessly worked in any case, and there is no recognised system of
-signals, except the jerk that means “Pull up.”
-
-“They’re the most reckless devils on the face of the earth,” said a
-local trader. “Once let a man strike a good bed of shell, and he won’t
-leave go of it, not for Father Peter. He’ll stick down there all day,
-grabbin’ away in twenty fathom or more till he feels paralysis cornin’
-on----”
-
-“Paralysis?”
-
-“Yes--they gets it, lots of’em. If you was to go down in twenty
-fathom--they can do five and twenty, but anything over is touch and
-go--and stay ’alf the day, you’d come up ’owling like anything, and
-not able to move. That’s the way it catches them; and then they must get
-some one to come and rub them with sea water all night long, and maybe
-they dies, and maybe they’re all right by morning. So then down they
-goes again, just the same as ever. Sometimes a man’ll be pulled up dead
-at the end of a day. How does that happen? Well, I allow it’s because
-he’s been workin’ at a big depth all day, and feels all right; and then,
-do you see, he’ll find somethin’ a bit extra below of him, in a holler
-like, and down he’ll go after it; and the extra fathom or two does the
-trick.
-
-“Sharks? Well, I’ve seen you poppin’ at them from the deck of the
-_Duchess_, so you know as well as I do how many there are. Didn’t ’it
-them, even when the fin was up? That’s because you ’aven’t greased
-your bullet, I suppose. You want to, if the water isn’t to turn it
-aside. But about the divers? Oh! they don’t mind sharks, none of them,
-when they’ve got the dress on. Sharks is easy scared. You’ve only got to
-pull up your jumper a bit, and the air bubbles out and frightens them
-to fits. If you meet a big sting-ray, it’ll run its spine into you, and
-send the dress all to--I mean, spoil the dress, so’s the water comes
-in, and maybe it’ll stick the diver too. And the big devilfish is nasty;
-he’ll ’old you down to a rock but you can use your knife on him. The
-kara mauaa is the worst; the divers don’t like him. He’s not as big as
-a shark, but he’s downright wicked, and he’s a mouth on him as big as
-’alf his body. If one comes along, he’ll bite an arm or leg off
-the man anyways, and eat ’im outright if he’s big enough to do it.
-Swordfish? Well, they don’t often come into the lagoon; it’s the fishing
-canoes outside they’ll go for. Yes, they’ll run a canoe and a man
-through at a blow easy enough: but they don’t often do it. If you wants
-a canoe, I’ll get you one; and you needn’t mind about the swordfish. As
-like as not they’ll never come near you.
-
-“About the divin’?--well, I think the naked divin’ is very near as safe
-as the machine, takin’ all things. Worst of it is, if a kara mauaa comes
-along, the diver can’t wait his time till it goes. No, he doesn’t stab
-it--not inside the lagoon, because there’s too many of them there, and
-the blood would bring a whole pack about. He gets under a ledge of rock,
-and ’opes it’ll go away before his wind gives out. If he doesn’t, he
-gets eat.”
-
-Did Schiller, or Edgar Allan Poe ever conjure up a picture more ghastly
-than that of a Penrhyn diver, caught like a rat in a trap by some huge,
-man-eating shark, or fierce kara mauaa--crouching in a cleft of the
-overhanging coral, under the dark green gloom of a hundred feet of
-water, with bursting lungs and cracking eyeballs, while the threatening
-bulk of his terrible enemy looms dark and steady, full in the road to
-life and air? A minute or more has been spent in the downward journey;
-another minute has passed in the agonised wait under the rock. Has he
-been seen? Will the creature move away now, while there is still time to
-return? The diver knows to a second how much time has passed; the third
-minute is on its way; but one goes up quicker than one comes down, and
-there is still hope. Two minutes and a half; it is barely possible
-now, but------ The sentinel of death glides forward; his cruel eyes,
-phosphorescent in the gloom, look right into the cleft where the
-wretched creature is crouching, with almost twenty seconds of life still
-left, but now not a shred of hope. A few more beats of the labouring
-pulse, a gasp from the tortured lungs, a sudden rush of silvery air
-bubbles, and the brown limbs collapse down out of the cleft like wreaths
-of seaweed. The shark has his own.
-
-There is a “Molokai,” or Leper Island, some two miles out in the
-lagoon, where natives afflicted with leprosy are confined. The Resident
-Agent--one of the traders--broke the rigid quarantine of the Molokai one
-day so far as to let me land upon the island, although he did not allow
-me to approach nearer than ten or twelve yards to the lepers, or to
-leave the beach and go inland to the houses that were visible in the
-distance. Our boatmen ran the sloop close inshore, and carried the
-captain and myself through the shallow water, carefully setting us down
-on dry stones, but remaining in the sea themselves. A little dog that
-had come with the party sprang overboard, and began swimming to the
-shore. It was hurriedly seized by the scruff of its neck, and flung
-back into the boat. If it had set paw on the beach it could never have
-returned, but would have had to stay on the island for good.
-
-Very lovely is the Molokai of Penrhyn; sadly beautiful this spot where
-so many wretched creatures have passed away from death in life to life
-in death. As we landed, the low golden rays of the afternoon sun were
-slanting through the pillared palm stems and quaintly beautiful pandanus
-fronds, across the snowy beach, and its trailing gold-flowered vines.
-The water of the lagoon, coloured like the gems in the gates of the
-Heavenly City, lapped softly on the shore; the perpetual trade wind
-poured through the swaying trees, shaking silvery gleams from the
-lacquered crests of the palms. In the distance, shadowed by a heavy
-pandanus grove, stood a few low brown huts. From the direction of these
-there came, hurrying down to the beach as we landed, four figures--three
-men and a woman. They had put on their best clothes when they saw the
-sloop making for the island. The woman wore a gaudy scarlet cotton
-frock; two of the men had white shirts and sailor’s trousers of blue
-dungaree--relics of a happier day, these, telling their own melancholy
-tale of bygone years of freedom on the wide Pacific. The third man wore
-a shirt and scarlet “pareo,” or kilt. Every face was lit up with
-delight at the sight of strangers from the schooner; above all, at the
-marvellous view of the wonderful “wahiné papa.” Why, even the men who
-lived free and happy on Penrhyn mainland did not get the chance of
-seeing such a show once in a lifetime! There she was, with two arms, and
-two legs, and a head, and a funny gown fastened in about the middle, and
-the most remarkable yellow shoes, and a ring, and a watch, which showed
-her to be extraordinarily wealthy, and a pale smooth face, not at
-all like a man’s, and hair that was brown, not black--how odd! It was
-evidently as good as a theatre, to the lonely prisoners!
-
-Bright as all the faces of the lepers were at that exciting moment, one
-could not mistake the traces left by a more habitual expression of heavy
-sadness. The terrible disease, too, had set its well-known marks upon
-every countenance. None of those who came out to see us had lost any
-feature; but all the faces had the gross, thickened, unhuman look that
-leprosy stamps upon its victims. The woman kept her arm up over her
-head, to hide some sad disfigurement about her neck. One of the men
-walked slowly and painfully, through an affection of the hip and leg.
-There were nine lepers in all upon the island; but the other five either
-could not, or did not, wish to leave their huts, and the agent refused
-to break the quarantine any further than he had already done. What care
-the wretched creatures are able to give one another, therefore, what
-their homes are like, and how their lives are passed, I cannot tell.
-Three of the lepers were accompanied by their faithful dogs. They are
-all fond of pets, and must have either a dog or a cat. Of course the
-animals never leave the island. We exchanged a few remarks at the top of
-our voices, left a case of oranges (brought up from the Cook Islands, a
-thousand miles away), and returned to our boat. The case of oranges was
-eagerly seized upon, and conveyed into the bush.
-
-“They will eat them up at once,” I said.
-
-“Not they,” said one of our white men. “They’ll make them into orange
-beer to-night, and get jolly well drunk for once in their miserable
-lives. Glad to see the poor devils get a chance, say I.” And so--most
-immorally, no doubt--said the “wahiné papa” as well.
-
-The lepers are fed from stores furnished by a small Government fund;
-and the trader who fulfils the very light duties of Resident Government
-Agent generally sends them over a share of any little luxury, in the way
-of oranges, limes, or yams, that may reach the island. None the less,
-their condition is most miserable, and one cannot but regard it as a
-crying scandal upon the great missionary organisations of the Pacific
-that nothing whatever is done for the lepers of these northern groups.
-The noble example of the late Father Damien, of Hawaii, and of the
-Franciscan Sisters who still live upon the Hawaiian Molokai, courting a
-martyr’s death to serve the victims of this terrible disease, seems to
-find no imitators in the islands evangelised by British missionaries.
-Godless, hopeless, and friendless, the lepers live and die alone. That
-their lives are immoral in the last degree, their religion, in spite of
-early teaching, almost a dead letter, is only to be expected. Penrhyn
-is not alone in this terrible scourge. Rakahanga, Manahiki, and
-Palmerston--all in the same part of the Pacific--are seriously affected
-by the disease. Palmerston I did not see; but I heard that there is one
-whole family of lepers there, and some stray cases as well.
-
-The island belongs to the half-caste descendants (about 150 in number)
-of Masters, a “beachcomber” of the early days, who died a few years ago.
-These people are much alarmed at the appearance of leprosy, and have
-segregated the lepers on an island in the lagoon. They are anxious
-to have them removed to the Molokai at Penrhyn, since the family came
-originally from that island; but no schooner will undertake to carry
-them. In Rakahanga, the lepers are not quarantined in any way, but
-wander about among the people. There are only a few cases as yet; but
-the number will certainly increase. This may also be said of Manahiki,
-for although very serious cases are isolated there, the lepers are
-allowed, in the earlier stages, to mix freely with every one else, and
-even to prepare the food of a whole family. The New Zealand Government,
-it is believed, will shortly pass a law compelling the removal of all
-these cases to the Molokai at Penrhyn. No Government, however, can
-alleviate the wretched condition of these unfortunate prisoners, once
-sent to the island. That remains for private charity and devotion.
-
-A God-forsaken, God-forgotten-looking place is Penrhyn, all in all. When
-sunset falls upon the great desolate lagoon, and the tall cocoanuts
-of the island stand up jet black against the stormy yellow sky in one
-unbroken rampart of tossing spears, and the endless sweep of shadowy
-beach is empty of all human life, and clear of every sound save the
-long, monotonous, never-ceasing cry of the trade wind in the trees, it
-needs but little imagination to fancy strange creatures creeping through
-the gloom of the forest--strange, ghastly stories of murder and despair
-whispering in the gathering night. Death in every form is always near
-to Penrhyn; death in the dark waters of the lagoon, death from the white
-terror of leprosy, and death at the hands of men but quarter civilised,
-whose fingers are always itching for the ready knife. And at the lonely
-sunset hour, when old memories of the life and light of great cities,
-of welcoming windows shining red and warm through grey, cold northern
-gloamings come back to the wanderer’s mind in vivid contrast, the very
-wings of the “Shadow cloaked from head to foot” seem to shake in full
-sight above these desolate shores. Yet, perhaps, the intolerable blaze
-of full noon upon the windward beaches strikes a note of even deeper
-loneliness and distance. The windward side of Penrhyn is uninhabited;
-the sea that breaks in blinding white foam upon the untrodden strand,
-wreathed with trailing vines of vivid green, is never broken by a sail.
-The sun beats down through the palm and pandanus leaves so fiercely that
-the whole of the seaward bush is but a shadeless blaze of green fire.
-Nothing stirs, nothing cries; the earth is silent, the sea empty; and a
-barrier of thousands of long sea miles, steadily built up, day by day,
-through many weeks, and only to be passed again by the slow demolishing,
-brick by brick, of the same great wall, lies between us and the world
-where people live. Here there is no life, only an endless dream; not as
-in the happy southern islands, a gentle sunrise dream of such surpassing
-sweetness that the sleeper asks nothing more than to dream on thus
-forever; but a dark-hour dream of loneliness, desolation, and utter
-remoteness, from which the dreamer cannot awaken, even if he would. Why
-do men--white men, with some ability and some education--live in these
-faraway infertile islands? There is no answer to the problem, even from
-the men themselves. They came, they stayed, they do not go away--why?
-they do not know. That is all.
-
-The land extent of Penrhyn is only three square miles, though the
-enclosed lagoon is a hundred. The population is little over four hundred
-souls; there are three or four white traders, as a rule. There is no
-resident white missionary. The island is one of those that have been
-annexed by New Zealand, and is therefore British property. It is
-governed by the Resident Commissioner of the Cook group, who visits it
-about once a year.
-
-Until two or three years ago, the Penrhyn Islanders used to keep their
-dead in the houses, hanging up the corpse, wrapped in matting, until it
-was completely decayed. This hideous practice was put an end to by the
-Representatives of British Government, much to the grief of the natives,
-who found it hard to part with the bodies of their friends, and leave
-them away in the graveyard they were bidden to choose. As the best
-substitute for the old practice, they now build little houses, some four
-feet high, over the tombs of their friends, and live in these houses for
-many months after a death, sitting and sleeping and even eating on the
-tomb that is covered by the thatch or iron roof of the grave-house. The
-graveyard is in consequence a strange and picturesque sight, almost like
-a village of some pigmy folk. A few plain concrete graves stand above
-the remains of white men who have died in the island, and one headstone
-is carved with the initials--not the name--of a woman. There is a story
-about that lonely grave; it was told to me as I lingered in the little
-“God’s Acre” at sunset, with the light falling low between the palms and
-the lonely evening wind beginning to wail from the sea.
-
-The woman was the wife of a schooner captain, a man of good family and
-connections, who liked the wild roving life of the Pacific, yet managed
-to retain a number of acquaintances of his own class in Auckland and
-Tahiti. His wife was young and handsome, and had many friends of her
-own. On one of the schooner’s visits to Penrhyn, the man was taken
-suddenly ill, and died in a very short time, leaving his wife alone. It
-seems that at first she was bewildered by her loss, and stayed on in the
-island, not knowing what to do, but before many months she had solved
-the problem after a fashion that horrified all the whites--she married a
-Penrhyn native! good-looking and attractive, but three-quarters savage,
-and left the island with him.
-
-Several children were born to the pair, but they were given to the
-husband’s people. At last he took a native partner, and deserted his
-English wife. She left the islands, and went down to Auckland; but her
-story had travelled before her, and Auckland society closed its doors.
-To Tahiti, where morals are easy, and no one frowns upon the union,
-temporary or permanent, of the white man and the brown woman, she went,
-hoping to be received as in former days. But even Papeete, “the sink of
-the Pacific,” would have none of the white woman who had married a brown
-man. Northwards once more, to lonely Penrhyn, the broken-hearted woman
-went, wishing only to die, far from the eyes of her own world that had
-driven her out. A schooner captain, who called there now and then,
-cast eyes upon her--for she was still young and retained much of her
-beauty--and asked her, at last, if she would become his wife, and so
-redeem in some degree her position; but she had neither heart nor wish
-to live longer, so she sent the kindly sailor away, and soon afterwards
-closed her eyes for ever on the blue Pacific and the burning sands, the
-brown lover who had betrayed her, and the white lover who came too late.
-The traders buried her, and kindly left her grave without a name; only
-the initials of that which she had borne in her first marriage, and
-the date of her death. So, quiet and forgotten at last, lies in lonely
-Penrhyn the woman who sinned against her race and found no forgiveness.
-
-It was a relief to leave Penrhyn, with all its gloomy associations, and
-see the schooner’s head set for the open sea and merry Manahiki. But
-we seemed to have brought ill-luck away with us, for there was what the
-captain called “mean weather” before we came within hail of land again,
-and the _Duchess_ got some more knocking about.
-
-It was on account of this that Neo, our native bo’sun, hit an innocent
-A.B. over the head with a belaying-pin one afternoon, and offered to
-perform the same service for any of the rest of the crew who might
-require it. The men had been singing mission hymns as they ran about the
-deck pulling and hauling--not exactly out of sheer piety, but because
-some of the hymns, with good rousing choruses, made excellent chanties.
-They were hauling to the tune of “Pull for the shore, brothers!” when
-a squall hit the ship, and out of the fifteen agitated minutes that
-followed, the _Duchess emerged minus her jib-boom_. When things had
-quieted down, Neo started to work with the belaying-, pin, until he was
-stopped, when he offered, as a sufficient explanation, the following:
-
-“Those men, they sing something made bad luck, I think, jib-boom he
-break. Suppose they sing, ‘Pull for ‘em shore’ some other time, I break
-their head, that I telling them!”
-
-The next time a chanty was wanted, “Hold the Fort!” took the place of
-the obnoxious tune, and Neo’s lessons were not called for.
-
-And so, in a day or two we came to Rakahanga and Manahiki (Reirson and
-Humphrey Islands), and stopped there for another day or two, before we
-spread our wings like the swallows, to fleet southward again.
-
-[Illustration: 0351]
-
-It was certainly globe-trotting, not proper travelling. To flit from
-group to group, taking in cargo, and then hurrying off again, is the way
-not to understand the places one sees, and I was more than half inclined
-to leave the _Duchess_ here, and stop over for a month or two on the
-chance of another schooner turning up. But the dinner that the solitary
-trader ate when he came on board made me change my mind. He looked like
-a man half-famished, and he certainly acted like one. There was hardly
-a thing on the island to eat at present, he said; the natives had only
-enough fish for themselves, and the turtle weren’t coming and his stores
-were almost out, and he had been living on biscuit and cocoanuts for
-weeks. There was leprosy in both islands, and one did not dare to touch
-native pork or fowl. On the whole, I thought I would be contented to
-“globe-trot,” on this occasion, and see what I could in a day or two.
-
-The islands are about twenty-five miles apart, and very much like
-one another. They each own an area of about two square miles, and a
-population of some four hundred natives. And there is nothing in the
-whole Pacific prettier.
-
-Coming up to Manahiki, one sees first of all a snowy shore and a belt
-of green tossing palms, just like any other island. As the ship coasts
-along, however, making for the village, the palm-trees break and open
-out here and there, and through the break one sees--paradise! There is
-a great sheet of turquoise-green water inside, and on the water an
-archipelago of the most exquisite little plumy, palmy islets, each
-ringed round with its own pearly girdle of coral sand. Every gap in the
-trees frames in a picture more lovely than the last--and, as we approach
-the village, the dainty little brown island canoes that all the Pacific
-wanderers know so well, begin to dot the jewel-bright surface of the
-inner lake, and gleams of white and rose and scarlet dresses, worn by
-the rowers of the tiny craft, sparkle on the water like gems. At last
-the vessel comes to anchor before a wide white, sloping beach, with
-brown-roofed huts clustering behind, and we reached merry Manahiki.
-
-The island has long enjoyed a reputation for peculiar innocence and
-simplicity, coupled with piety of a marked description. Well, one
-does not care to destroy any one’s illusions, so the less said about
-Manahiki’s innocence and simplicity the better. The islanders are,
-at all events, a kindly and a cheerful people, and their home is the
-neatest and best kept island in the Pacific. A palm-bordered road of
-finest white sand, beautifully kept, and four miles long, runs without
-a bend or break from one end of the island to the other--this portion of
-the atoll forming a separate island, and containing most of the scanty
-population. The village stands about midway--a collection of quaint
-little houses deeply thatched with plaited pan-danus leaf, and walled
-with small, straight saplings set side by side and admitting a good deal
-of light and air. The houses are unwindowed as a rule. Rakahanga, the
-sister island, is extremely like Manahiki in formation and architecture.
-It, however, enjoys the additional advantage of a jail, which is built
-of crossed saplings, looks much like a huge bird-cage, and certainly
-could not confine any one who made the smallest attempt to get out.
-But, as criminals are unknown in these islands, and petty offences are
-visited by fine instead of imprisonment, the jail is not expected to
-do real service, being merely a bit of “swagger,” like the white-washed
-stone houses possessed by one or two wealthy natives, who, Pacific
-fashion, never think of living in them.
-
-Within, the ordinary houses are extremely simple. The floor of white
-coral gravel reflects and intensifies the soft diffused light that
-enters through the walls. There may be a native bedstead, laced across
-with, “sinnet”--plaited cocoanut fibre--and provided with a gay
-patchwork quilt, and a few large soft mats of pandanus leaf,
-ingeniously split, dried, and plaited. There will certainly be a pile of
-camphor-wood trunks, containing the clothes of the household; a dozen
-or so cocoanut shells, for drinking and eating purposes; a few
-sheath-knives, and a small quantity of much-cherished crockery. In a
-corner, you may find a heap of flying-fish ready cleaned for baking in
-the oven-pit outside, and a number of green, unhusked cocoanuts, for
-drinking. You may possibly see some ship’s biscuits, too, bought from
-the one white resident of the island, a trader and there will also be
-some lumps of white, soft pith, shaped like large buns--the “sponge” or
-kernel of the old cocoanut, which grows and fills up the shell after the
-water has dried away, and the nut commenced to sprout. But there will be
-no bananas, no oranges, no mangoes, granadillas, pineapples, yam, taro
-or ti root, bread-fruit or maupei chestnuts, as in the fertile volcanic
-islands. Manahiki is a coral island, pure and simple, and has no soil at
-all, nothing but sand and white gravel, out of which the cocoa-palm
-and a few small timber trees spring, in a manner that seems almost
-miraculous to those accustomed to the rich, fertile soil of Raratonga or
-Tahiti. Cocoanut and fish are the food of the Manahikian, varied by an
-occasional gorge of turtle-meat, and a feast of pig and fowl on very
-great occasions. There is, therefore, not much work to do in the island,
-and there are few distractions from the outside world, since trading
-schooners only call two or three times a year at best. Some copra-drying
-is done and a few toy canoes, baskets, and other curiosities are made,
-to find a precarious sale when a schooner comes in and the captain is
-inclined to speculate.
-
-But time never hangs heavy on the Manahikian’s hands. He is the most
-accomplished dancer and singer in the whole South Pacific, and the
-island is inordinately vain of this distinction. All South Sea islanders
-sing constantly, but in Manahiki, the tunes are much sweeter and more
-definite than in most other islands; and the impromptu variations of the
-“seconds” are really wonderful. The voices, too, are exceptionally good.
-The women’s are rather hard and piercing, but those of the men are often
-magnificent. The time is as perfect as if beaten out by a metronome, and
-false notes are almost unknown.
-
-[Illustration: 0359]
-
-Men and women alike seem incapable of fatigue when singing. The mere
-white man will feel tired and husky after going through the choruses
-of _The Messiah_ or _The Creation_. A Manahikian, if he were acquainted
-with oratorio music, would run through both, and then “take on”
- _Tannhauser_, following up with another Wagnerian opera, and perhaps a
-cantata thrown in. By this time, it would be dusk, and the chorus would
-probably stop to eat a cartload of cocoanuts before beginning on the
-whole _Nibelungen Ring_ cycle for the night. About midnight the Resident
-Agent, a clever half-caste, who has European ideas about the value of
-sleep, would probably send out the village policeman with a stick to
-induce the singers to go to bed; and, quite unfatigued, they would rise
-up from their cross-legged squatting posture on the ground, and go,
-remonstrant, but compelled.
-
-[Illustration: 0360]
-
-Happily for the Resident Agent and the trader, however, European music
-is not known in Manahiki, and when a singing fit seizes the people, they
-can generally be stopped after about a day, unless somebody has composed
-something very new and very screaming. If the two ends of the village
-have begun one of their musical competitions, there may also be
-difficulty in bringing it to a period; for the rival choruses will sing
-against each other with cracking throats and swelling veins, hour after
-hour, till both sides are completely exhausted.
-
-Dancing, however, is the Manahikian’s chief reason for existing.
-The Manahikian dances are infinitely superior to those of most other
-islands, which consist almost altogether of a wriggle belonging to the
-_danse du ventre_ family, and a little waving of the arms. The Manahiki
-dance has the wriggle for its groundwork, but there are many steps
-and variations. Some of the steps are so rapid that the eye can hardly
-follow them, and a camera shutter which works up to 1/100 of a second
-does not give a sharp result. The men are ranged in a long row, with the
-women opposite; there is a good deal of wheeling and turning about in
-brisk military style, advancing, retreating, and spinning round. The men
-dance very much on the extreme tips of their toes (they are, of course,
-barefooted) and keep up this painful posture for an extraordinary
-length of time. Every muscle in the whole body seems to be worked in the
-“fancy” steps; and there is a remarkable effect of general dislocation,
-due to turning the knees and elbows violently out and in.
-
-The women, like Miss Mercy Pecksniff, seem chiefly to favour the “shape
-and skip” style of locomotion. There is a good deal of both these, a
-great deal of wriggle, and plenty of arm action, about their dancing.
-They manoeuvre their long, loose robes about, not at all ungracefully,
-and do some neat step-dancing, rather inferior, however, to that of the
-men.
-
-Both men and women dress specially for the dance, so the festival that
-was organised to greet our arrivals took some time to get up, as all the
-beaux and belles of the village had to hurry home and dress. The women
-put on fresh cotton loose gowns, of brilliant pink, purple, yellow,
-white and green, oiled their hair with cocoanut oil scented with the
-fragrant white tieré flower, and hung long chains of red and yellow
-berries about their necks. About their waists they tied the dancing
-girdle, never worn except on these occasions, and made of twisted green
-ferns. The men took off their cool, easy everyday costume, of a short
-cotton kilt and gay coloured singlet, and attired themselves in shirts
-and heavy stuff trousers (bought from the trader at enormous expense,
-and considered the acme of smartness). Both sexes crowned themselves
-with the curious dancing headdress, which looks exactly like the
-long-rayed halo of a saint, and is made by splitting a palm frond down
-the middle, and fastening it in a half-circle about the back of the
-head.
-
-The music then struck up and the dancers began to assemble. The
-band consisted of two youths, one of whom clicked a couple of sticks
-together, while the other beat a drum. This does not sound attractive;
-but as a matter of fact, the Manahiki castanet and drum music is
-curiously weird and thrilling, and arouses a desire for dancing even
-in the prosaic European. On board our schooner, lying half a mile from
-shore, the sound of the measured click and throb used to set every foot
-beating time on deck, while the native crew frankly dropped whatever
-they were at, and began to caper wildly. Close at hand, the music
-is even more impressive; no swinging waltz thundered out by a whole
-Hungarian band gets “into the feet” more effectively than the Manahiki
-drum.
-
-A much-cherished possession is this drum. It is carved and ornamented
-with sinnet, and topped with a piece of bladder; it seems to have been
-hollowed out of a big log, with considerable labour. The skill of the
-drummers is really remarkable. No drumsticks are used, only fingers, yet
-the sound carries for miles. While drumming, the hands rise and fall so
-fast as to lose all outline to the eye; the drummer nods and beats with
-his foot in an ecstasy of delight at his own performance; the air is
-full of the throbbing, rhythmical, intensely savage notes. The dancers
-at first hesitate, begin and stop, and begin again, laugh and retreat
-and come forward undecidedly. By-and-by the dancing fervour seizes one
-or two; they commence to twirl and to stamp wildly, winnowing the
-air with their arms. Others join in, the two rows are completed, and
-Manahiki is fairly started for the day. Hour after hour they dance,
-streaming with perspiration in the burning sun, laughing and singing and
-skipping. The green fern girdles wither into shreds of crackling brown,
-the palm haloes droop, the berry necklaces break and scatter, but on
-they go. The children join in the dance now and then, but their small
-frames weary soon; the parents are indefatigable.
-
-Perhaps both ends of the settlement are dancing; if that is so, the
-competitive element is sure to come in sooner or later, for the feeling
-between the two is very like that between the collegers and oppidans at
-Eton, each despising the other heartily, and ready on all occasions
-to find a cause for a fight. They will dance against each other now,
-striving with every muscle to twinkle the feet quicker, stand higher on
-the tips of the toes, wriggle more snakily, than their rivals. Evening
-comes, and they are still dancing. With the night, the dance degenerates
-into something very like an orgy, and before dawn, to avoid scandal, a
-powerful hint from the native pastor and the agent causes the ball to
-break up.
-
-Do the dancers go to bed now, lie down on their piled up sleeping
-mats, and compose themselves to slumber? By no means. Most of them get
-torches, and go out on the reef in the dark to spear fish. Cooking fires
-are lighted, and there is a hurried gorge in the houses; everywhere,
-in the breaking dawn, one hears the chuck-chuck of the husking-stick
-preparing cocoanuts, and smells the savoury odour of cooking fish. The
-dancers have not eaten for at least twenty-four hours, perhaps more. But
-this feast does not last long, for just as the sun begins to shoot long
-scarlet rays up through the palm trees, some one begins to beat the drum
-again. Immediately the whole village pours out into the open, and the
-dance is all on again, as energetic as ever. The trading schooner is
-three weeks over-due, and the copra on which the island income depends
-is not half dried; there is not a fancy basket or a pandanus hat ready
-for the trader; the washing of every house is hopelessly behind, and
-nobody has had a decent meal since the day before yesterday. No matter:
-the Manahikians are dancing, and it would take an earthquake to stop
-them.
-
-Late in the second day, they will probably give out and take a night’s
-rest. But it is about even chances that they begin again the next
-morning. In any case, no day passes in Manahiki or Rakahanga without a
-dance in the evening. Regularly at sunset the drum begins to beat, the
-fern girdles are tied on (relics, these, of heathen days when girdles
-of grass or fern were all that the dancers wore), and palm haloes are
-twisted about the glossy black hair, and the island gives itself up to
-enjoyment for the evening.
-
-There is a dancing-master in Manahiki, a most important potentate, who
-does nothing whatever but invent new dances, and teach the youth of the
-village both the old dances and the new.
-
-We stopped overnight at the island, so I had time for a good walk along
-the beautiful coral avenue, which is indeed one of the loveliest things
-in the island world. It was Sunday, and all the natives were worshipping
-in the exceedingly ugly and stuffy concrete church, under the guidance
-of the native pastor, so I had the place almost to myself. Far away from
-everywhere, sitting in a ruinous little hut under the trees by the inner
-lagoon, I found a lonely old man, crippled and unable to walk. He was
-waiting until the others came back from church, staring solemnly into
-the lagoon the while, and playing with a heap of cocoanut shells.
-By-and-by he would probably rouse up, drag himself into the hut, and
-busy himself getting ready the dinner for the family against their
-return home, for he was an industrious old man, and liked to make
-himself useful so far as he could, and his relatives were very glad of
-what small services he could render in washing and cooking.
-
-What was the matter with the poor old man? He was a leper!
-
-That is the way of the islands, and no white rule can altogether put a
-stop to it. The half-caste who acts as agent for the Government of New
-Zealand had hunted out a very bad case of leprosy a year or two before,
-and insisted on quarantining it in a lonely part of the bush. This was
-all very well, but the leper had a pet cock, which he wanted to take
-with him, and the agent’s heart was not hard enough to refuse. Now the
-leper, being fed without working, and having nothing to do, found the
-time hanging heavy on his hands, so he taught the cock to dance--report
-says, to dance the real Manahiki dances--and the fame of the wondrous
-bird spread all over the island, and as far as Rakahanga, so that
-the natives made continual parties to see the creature perform, and
-quarantine became a dead letter. Still the agent had not the heart
-to take the cock away, but when he saw the leper’s end was near, he
-watched, and as soon as he heard the man was dead, he hurried to the
-quarantined hut, set it on fire, and immediately slaughtered the cock.
-An hour later, half the island was out at the hut, looking for the
-bird--but they came too late.
-
-*****
-
-We have been two days at merry Manahiki, and the cargo is in, and the
-Captain has ordered the _Duchess_--looking shockingly cock-nosed without
-her great jib-boom--to be put under sail again. As the booms begin to
-rattle, and the sails to rise against the splendid rose and daffodil of
-the Pacific sunset, Shalli, our Cingalese steward, leans sadly over the
-rail, listening to the thrilling beat of the drum that is just beginning
-to throb across the still waters of the lagoon, now that evening and its
-merrymaking are coming on once more.
-
-“He plenty good place, that,” says Shalli mournfully. “All the time
-dancing, singing, eating, no working--he all same place as heaven. O my
-God, I plenty wish I stopping there, I no wanting any heaven then!”
-
-With this pious aspiration in our ears, we spread our white wings
-once more--for the last time. Raratonga lies before us now, and from
-Raratonga the steamers go, and the mails and tourists come, and the
-doors of the great world open for us again. So, good-bye to the life of
-the schooner.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XIII
-
-_The Last of the Island Kingdoms--Fashions in Nukualofa--The King
-who was shy--His Majesty’s Love Story--Who got the Wedding-Cake?--The
-Chancellor goes to Jail--Bungalow Housekeeping--The Wood of the
-Sacred Bats--By the Tombs of the Tui-Tongas--A “Chief” Kava-party--The
-Waits!--Mariner’s Cave--The Cave of the Swallows--To Samoa._
-
-SOME weeks afterwards, after a round of three thousand miles, I found
-myself in Tonga, better known as the Friendly Islands. The distance from
-the Cook Group was only one thousand or less, as the crow flies, but
-the steamers flew down to Auckland, and then back again, which naturally
-added to the journey. Pacific travel is a series of compromises. The
-British Resident of Niué, which is only three hundred miles from Tonga,
-wanted to get to the latter place about that time, and when I met him
-at Nukualofa, the Tongan capital, he had had to travel two thousand
-four hundred miles to reach it! But no one is ever in a hurry, under the
-shade of the cocoanut tree.
-
-Who has heard of Tongatabu? who knows where the “Friendly Islands” are?
-You will not find them very readily in the map, but they are to be
-found nevertheless, about one thousand miles to the north-east of New
-Zealand. And if you take the steamer that runs every month from Auckland
-to Sydney, touching at the “Friendly” or Tongan Group, on the way, you
-will find yourself, in four days, set down on the wharf of Nukualofa,
-the capital of the island of Tongatabu, and the seat of the oddest, most
-comic-opera-like monarchy that the world ever knew.
-
-Thirty years ago--even twenty--the Great South Seas were scattered over
-with independent island states, ruled by monarchs who displayed every
-degree of civilisation, from the bloodthirsty monster, Thakomban of Fiji
-and Jibberik, the half-crazy tyrant of Majuro, up to such Elizabeths of
-the Pacific as Liluokalani of Hawaii, and Queen Pomaré of Tahiti. Now
-there is but one island kingdom left; but one native sovereign, who
-still sits on his throne unembarrassed by the presence of a British
-Resident, who is ruler in all but name. Hawaii has fallen to America;
-France has taken the Marquesas and Tahiti; England has annexed the Cook
-Islands and dethroned the famous Queen Makea; Germany and America have
-partitioned Samoa between them; the rich archipelago of Fiji has been
-added to the British Colonies. This accounts for almost all of the
-larger and richer island groups, distinguished by a certain amount
-of original civilisation, and leaves only one unseized--Tonga, or the
-Friendly Islands, over which England has maintained a protectorate since
-1900.
-
-The Tongan Archipelago was discovered by Captain Cook in 1777, and by
-him named the “Friendly Islands,” on account of the apparently friendly
-disposition of the natives. He sailed away from the group unaware that
-beneath their seemingly genial reception, the Tongans had been maturing
-a plot to murder him and seize his ship. Treachery, it is true, has
-never been an essential part of the Tongan character; but they are,
-and always have been, the most warlike of all Pacific races, and it
-is probable that they thought the character of the deed excused by the
-necessities of a military race who feared injury from a superior power.
-
-After Cook’s visit the world heard very little of Tonga until 1816, when
-Mariner’s “Tonga Islands,” the history of a young sailor’s captivity
-among the natives of the group, fairly took the reading world by storm.
-It is still a classic among works of travel and adventure. Since
-the islands were converted to Christianity their history has been
-uneventful. One king--George Tubou I.--reigned for seventy years, and
-only died at last, aged ninety-seven, of a chill contracted from his
-invariable custom of bathing in the sea at dawn! His great-grandson,
-George Tubou II. succeeded, inheriting through his mother’s side, as the
-Tongan succession follows the matriarchal plan. It is this king--aged
-thirty-four, six feet four in height, and about twenty-seven stone
-weight--who now sits upon the last throne of the Island Kings, and rules
-over the only independent state left in the Pacific.
-
-When Britain, assumed a Protectorate over Tonga in 1900, it was done
-simply to prevent any other nation annexing the rich and fertile group,
-with its splendid harbour of Vavau which lay so dangerously near Fiji.
-The Germans, who had maintained a kind of half-and-half Protectorate for
-some time, ceded their rights in exchange for those possessed by England
-in Samoa, and Tonga then became safe from the incursions of any foreign
-nation whose interests, trading and territorial, might be hostile to
-those of Britain.
-
-Perhaps as a consequence of all those negotiations, the Tongans have
-a high opinion of their own importance. When the war between China and
-Japan broke out, Tonga politely sent word to Great Britain that she
-intended to remain neutral, and not take any part in the affair. Great
-Britain’s reply, I regret to say, is not recorded.
-
-The Tongans are a Christianised and partially civilised, if a coloured,
-race, numbering about 20,000. They are of a warm brown in hue, with
-dense black, wiry hair (usually dyed golden red with lime juice), tall,
-well-made frames, and immense muscular development. As a nation, they
-are handsome, with intelligent faces, and a dignity of pose and movement
-that is sometimes unkindly called the “Tongan swagger.” In education,
-many of them would compare favourably with the average white man, so far
-as mere attainments go; although a course of instruction at the local
-schools and colleges, amounting to very nearly the standard of an
-English “matriculations,” does not prevent its recipient from believing
-firmly in the holiness of the sacred Tongan bats, feeding himself with
-his fingers, and walking about his native village naked as Adam, save
-for a cotton kilt. There is not only a King in Tonga, but a real palace,
-guards of honour, a Parliament, a Prime Minister, a Chancellor of the
-Exchequer, and a large number of public officials. All these are
-Tongan natives. The king’s guards are apt to make an especially vivid
-impression upon the newcomer, as he walks up the wharf, and sees the
-scarlet-coated sentry pacing up and down opposite the guard-room, with
-his fellows, also smartly uniformed, lounging inside. If the stranger,
-however, could have witnessed the scene on the wharf as soon as the
-steamer was signalled---the sudden running up of a dozen or two of
-guards who had been amusing themselves about the town in undress uniform
-(navy-blue kilt, red sash, buff singlet), the scrambling and dressing
-_coram publico_ on the grass, getting into trousers, boots, shirt,
-tunic, forage cap, and the hurried scuffle to get ready in time, and
-make a fine appearance to the steamer folk--he might think rather
-less of Tonga’s military discipline. Beyond the wharf lies the town,
-straggling over a good mile of space, and consisting of a few main
-streets and one or two side alleys, bordered by pretty verandahed,
-flowery houses. The pavement is the same throughout--green grass,
-kept short by the constant passing of bare feet. There are a good many
-trading stores, filled with wares suited to native tastes--gaudy prints,
-strong perfumes, cutlery, crockery, Brummagem jewellery. The streets are
-busy to-day--busy for Nukualofa, that is. Every now and then a native
-passes, flying by on a galloping, barebacked horse, or striding along
-the grass with the inimitable Tongan strut; for it is steamer day,
-and the monthly Union steamer boat is the theatre, the newspaper, the
-society entertainment; the luxury-provider of all the archipelago. On
-the other twenty-nine or thirty days of the month, you may stand in the
-middle of a main street for half an hour at a time, and not see a single
-passer-by, but steamer day galvanises the whole island into life.
-
-[Illustration: 0376]
-
-The sand of the beach beside the wharf is as white as snow; it is
-pulverised coral from the reef, nothing else. Great fluted clam-shells,
-a foot long and more, lie about the strand, among the trailing
-pink-flowered convolvulus vines that wreathe the shore of every South
-Sea island. Unkempt pandanus trees, mounted on quaint high wooden
-stilts, overhang the green water; among the taller and more graceful
-cocoa-palms, Norfolk Island pines, odd, formal, and suggestive of
-hairbrushes, stand among feathery ironwoods and spreading-avavas
-about the palace of the king. Quite close to the wharf this latter is
-placed--a handsome two-storeyed building, with wide verandahs and a
-tower. Scarlet-coated sentries march up and down all day at its gates;
-it is surrounded by a wall, and carefully guarded from intruders. George
-Tubou II. is among the shyest of monarchs and hates nothing so much as
-being stared at; so on steamer days there is little sign of life to be
-seen about the palace.
-
-I happened to arrive in Tonga at an interesting historical crisis, and
-was promised an audience with the retiring monarch.
-
-After a week or two, however, the promise was suddenly recalled, and the
-visitor informed that the king declined to see her, then or at any other
-time. A little investigation revealed the cause. The High Commissioner
-of the Western Pacific had recently come over from Fiji; to remonstrate
-with the Tongan monarchy concerning certain unconstitutional behaviour,
-and a British man-of-war had accompanied him. I, being the only other
-person on the island from “Home,” had naturally been seeing a good deal
-of the formidable stranger. This was enough for the king. There was a
-plot to deprive him of his throne, he was certain; and it was obvious
-that I was in it, whatever I might choose to say to the contrary. There
-was no knowing what crime I might not be capable of, once admitted to
-the Royal Palace. George Tubou II. is six feet four, and twenty-seven
-stone weight, but he is distinctly of a nervous temperament; and his
-fears of Guy Fawkesism kept possession of his mind during the whole of
-my stay; so that the carefully averted face of a fat, copper-coloured
-sort of Joe Sedley, driving very fast in a buggy, was all I saw of
-Tonga’s king.
-
-There is no one, surely, in the world who quite comes up to George of
-Tonga for a “guid conceit o’ himsel’.” When he wished to provide himself
-with a queen, some six or seven years ago, he first applied to
-the Emperor of Germany, to know if there was a German Princess of
-marriageable age whom he could have! The Kaiser politely replied in the
-negative. King George then sent proposals to a princess of Hawaii who
-was as well educated as any white lady, and used to diplomatic society
-in Washington. This also failing, he turned his attentions to his own
-country; and then began the most extraordinary love-story ever told
-under the Southern Cross--a story that could have happened nowhere on
-the globe, except in the comic-opera country of Tonga.
-
-There were two eligible princesses of the royal line of Tonga--Princess
-Ofa and Princess Lavinia. The king appears to have proposed to them
-both, and then found himself unable to decide between the two. They were
-both of high rank, both good-looking after the portly Tongan fashion,
-and both very willing to be queen, reign over the fine palace, order
-lots of silk dresses from Auckland, wear the queen’s crown of Tonga
-(supposed to be gold, but rather inclined to suspicious outbreaks of
-verdigris), and see the natives get off their horses and kneel on the
-ground, when the royal state carriage drove by.
-
-But the king kept both princesses in the agonies of suspense ever
-present, and hope constantly deferred for months--until the wedding-day
-was fixed, the wedding-cake (ordered three years before from a New
-Zealand confectioner, for the German Princess who was not to be had)
-patched up and fresh coloured, the wedding-dress provided, at the
-expense of the Government of Tonga (according to custom) and actually
-made! Not till the very night before the wedding did his dilatory
-Majesty at last declare his intentions, and fix upon the princess he
-had last proposed to, whom nobody expected him to take--Lavinia. It is
-a sober fact that the wedding invitation cards, sent out at the last
-minute, were printed with a blank for the bride’s name, which was
-added with a pen! Lavinia, overjoyed at her good luck, got into the
-Governmentally provided wedding dress next day, and (as the fairy tales
-say) “the wedding was celebrated with great pomp!” There is no sense of
-humour in Tonga. If there had been, the king could hardly have selected
-the means of consolation for Ofa’s disappointment that he actually did
-choose, in sending her the bottom half of his wedding cake, as soon as
-the ceremony was over. Princess Ofa was not proud; she had been beating
-her head on the floor-mats all morning and pulling out handfuls of her
-long black hair, but when the consolatory cake arrived, she accepted it
-promptly and ate it.
-
-There are generally illuminations on the night of a royal wedding. Tonga
-was not behind-hand in this matter, but the illuminations were of rather
-an unusual kind, being nothing less than numbers of burning native
-houses, set on fire by the indignant friends of the jilted Princess Ofa.
-The friends of the new queen retaliated in kind; and for nearly a week,
-arson became the recognised sport of the island. This excess of party
-feeling soon died down, however, and the newly married couple were left
-to honeymoon in peace.
-
-An infant princess was born in due time, and not very long after, Queen
-Lavinia died. Here was Princess Ofa’s chance, if Fate had permitted;
-but Ofa herself was dead, leaving no eligible princess to console the
-widowed king.
-
-For more than five years the monarch (who is still only thirty-four) has
-lived alone, a mark for every husband-hunting princess in the Pacific. A
-princess related to an ancient island monarchy, invited herself to stay
-in the palace one recent Christmas. King George received her pleasantly,
-entertained her for some weeks, and then sent her home with a big
-packet of fine tobacco and a barrel of spirits, to console her for the
-non-success of her visit--which may be accounted for by the fact that
-she is rather older than the king himself, and by no means so lovely as
-she was. A favoured candidate is a certain princess of the royal family
-of Tahiti. She has been described to the king as handsome, and at least
-sixteen stone weight, both of which claims are quite correct. King
-George really wants a European princess, but as soon as he has been
-convinced for the second time that this is impossible, it is hoped that
-he will decide on the Tahitian princess, and elevate her to the Tongan
-throne, since he admires fat women exceedingly.
-
-One of the most remarkable things in this remarkable country is the
-Parliament. It would take too long to record the history of this
-assembly’s birth and development; but the chapter has been a notable one
-in Tongan history. The Parliament usually consists of the King and Prime
-Minister, the Chancellor of the Exchequer, the Chief Justice, and a
-score or two of important chiefs, some of whom inherit by birth, while
-others are returned by their native villages. At the time of my visit,
-there were a couple of vacancies in this remarkable assembly, since the
-High Commissioner of the Western Pacific (Governor of Fiji) had just
-deported the Prime Minister and the Chancellor of the Exchequer to Fiji,
-on account of certain proceedings which resulted in emptying Tonga’s
-public treasury and leaving nothing to show for it.
-
-Their absence did not greatly matter, however, as it is a rule of the
-Tongan Constitution, that Parliament shall not meet oftener than once in
-three years. An excellent and practical reason lies at the root of this
-seemingly peculiar law. Tongatabu is a small island, only twenty miles
-long; and when the Members of Parliament,--dressed in new cotton
-kilts, with smart large floor-mats tied round their waists with sinnet
-(cocoanut fibre plait), and violet, sea-green, or lemon silk shirts
-on their brown backs--arrive from the outer villages and islands in
-Nukualofa with all their relatives, for the beginning of the session,
-something very like a famine sets in. The whole Parliament, also its
-sisters, aunts, and grandpapas, has to be fed at public expense, while
-it stays in the capital arranging the affairs of the nation; and as the
-length of its sitting is always regulated by the amount of provisions
-available, and never ends until the last yam, the last skinny chicken,
-the last sack of pineapples, is eaten up, it is easy to understand why
-the capital does not care to undergo such a strain any oftener than it
-can help.
-
-A new Prime Minister and Chancellor of the Exchequer were appointed
-before long, and it was made a condition of the latter office, that the
-Chancellor should understand a reasonable amount of arithmetic.
-There was also a rigid rule made about the keeping of the key of the
-Government safe in some suitable place. A good deal of trouble was
-caused by the last Chancellor’s losing it, one day when he was out
-fishing on the coral reef! There was a duplicate, but the Chancellor had
-carefully locked it up in the safe, to make sure it should not be lost!
-The poor old gentleman nearly get sunstroke hunting about the coral
-reef for the key until he found it. If it had been carried, away by the
-tides, the safe must have remained closed until an expert from Auckland
-could be brought up to open it. As the Chancellor of the Exchequer did
-not know how much he had in it, or how much he had spent in the last
-quarter, it can readily be understood that the public accounts acquired
-an entirely superfluous extra tangle or two during the absence of the
-lost key.
-
-Tonga enjoys one of the finest climates in the Pacific. The heat is
-never excessive, and the air is generally bright and invigorating.
-Fevers are unheard of, and the few white residents of the islands enjoy
-splendid health. As for the Tongans themselves, they dispute with the
-Fijians the palm of being physically the finest and strongest people
-in the whole Pacific; and no one has ever thought of challenging their
-claim to be the most intellectual of all the brown island races. Their
-carriage is superb, though only its extreme _aplomb_ and ease save it
-from degenerating into an actual swagger. Their dress displays the most
-perfect taste in the South Seas. It consists, among the men, of a short
-tunic (“vala”) of fine cashmere or silk, occasionally of cotton, on
-working days--draped with all the grace of an antique statue, and worn
-with a wide sash, and a thin, close-fitting singlet or shirt. The
-Tongan woman generally wears a garment that is suggestive of the Greek
-_chiton_--a loose sleeveless dress reaching to a point midway between
-waist and knee. Underneath is seen a tunic similar to that of the men,
-but a little longer. The colours chosen by both sexes are exquisite. No
-artist could design more beautiful combinations than those I have often
-seen flitting about the grassy streets of Nukualofa, Tonga’s capital. A
-finely made giant strides by, in a navy-blue vala, cream-coloured silk
-shirt, and vivid sea-green sash. Another wears a pale blue vala and
-shirt, and a sash of royal blue. A third is in white and lemon colour
-girdled with orange; another wears a white vala, a pale green shirt, and
-a sash of violet silk. A tall, self-possessed young woman, her hair dyed
-golden red with lime, and worn coiffed high above the forehead, with a
-fall of natural curls down her back, has a scarlet and yellow vala under
-her short brown silk gown, while her companion--smaller and merrier
-faced, with the melting black eyes of “The Islands”--wears and looks
-charming in, a pale-blue gown over a vala of daffodil yellow. These are
-the fashions of Tonga; and they offer a feast for artistic souls and
-pencils, that cannot be matched under the Southern Cross.
-
-Tonga is very seldom visited by travellers, except for an hour or two
-during the steamer’s stay in port, and it is hardly ever seen by British
-tourists. I could not discover that any English lady had ever made a
-stay there, except myself, and the wife of a local Church dignitary.
-There are, of course, a few Colonial residents. But the English
-traveller leaves Tonga out altogether, which is really a pity--for his
-sake. As for the islands, they can do very well without tourists, and
-would not be the better for them.
-
-There was no hotel save a plain and simple public-house, at the time
-of my stay, though I understand this defect has been remedied. I had
-therefore to set up housekeeping on my own account. The tiny bungalow I
-took for my stay of four weeks in the island, was a real South Sea home.
-It stood almost on the white coral sand of the beach, and close to
-the cool green waters of the lagoon; it was shaded by palms and
-scarlet-blossomed “flamboyant” trees, and it was nearly all door and
-window and verandah. Its carpets were plaited pandanus-leaf mats; the
-ornaments in the sitting-room were foot-long fluted clam-shells off
-the beach, filled with wild red and yellow hibiscus flowers, poignantly
-perfumed frangipani stars, and the sweet pink blossoms of the South Sea
-oleander. The back kitchen had generally a bunch of bananas hanging from
-the roof, a pile of green cocoanuts for drinking, under the window, a
-mound of yellow papaws, or tree-melons, in a corner, some custard-apples
-and mangoes, and a big basket of pineapples, bought at the door for
-fourteen a shilling, or picked by myself during a drive through the
-bush.
-
-There was not much else, besides bread and tea. I almost lived on
-fruit, and could not help wondering what the inhabitants of temperate
-latitudes, who fear ill consequences from a dozen plums or a double
-handful of strawberries, would have thought of my uncounted mangoes,
-and bananas, and five or six pineapples a day. Only children, at home
-in England, really know how much fruit can safely be undertaken by the
-human digestive organs. Wise children! and foolish elders, who have
-forgotten so soon.
-
-The transparent waters of the lagoon outside, lapping idly under the
-leaves of overhanging palm and pandanus, were not so cool as they
-looked, under the hot midday sun; and if one did not want a tepid
-sea-bath, it was best to wait till night. Then, what a luxury it was,
-after the heat of the day (for Tonga, though cool for the tropics, is
-nevertheless tropical), to float about in the dim lagoon, under a glow
-of stars that fit up the sky almost as brightly as an English moon, the
-dark shining water bearing one to and fro with the swell from the reef,
-the land growing farther and farther away, the palms on the thin pale
-shoreline standing out small and black, like Indian ink sketches,
-against the lurid purple of the midnight sky! Willingly indeed one would
-have passed the whole night out there, swimming, and floating in a warm
-dark sea of stars--stars above and stars below--if nature had not given
-out after an hour or two, and demanded a return to the solid earth.
-Sharks? Well, they had “hardly ever” been seen inside the reef.
-Stingarees, with their immense ugly bodies buried in the sand at the
-bottom, and their cruel barbed tails ready to strike? Yes, they had been
-seen, but not often; and in tropic waters you learn to take the
-chances like every one else, and enjoy yourself without thinking of the
-“might-be’s.”
-
-[Illustration: 0382]
-
-It was the hot season, but not too hot for riding or driving, and I
-spent many mornings exploring about the island. To the Wood of the
-Bats, about eleven miles from Nukualofa, one drives in a springy little
-colonial buggy, driving over mile after mile of rather uneven grass
-road, along avenues of blossoming orange trees, through groves of
-bananas and breadfruit and tall mango trees, past straggling native
-villages with neat little fancy-work houses made of woven reeds and
-thatch, until, in the distance, one begins to hear a loud screaming,
-squeaking, and chattering noise. This is the Wood of the Bats that we
-are coming to, and that is some of their usual conversation. Under
-the trees--there are over twenty of them, avavas, like great cedars,
-ironwoods, mangoes; all big forest trees, and all covered with bats as
-thick as a currant bush with currants--the squeaking and squealing
-grows almost deafening, Thousands of great flying-foxes, with dark furry
-bodies as big as cats, big spreading wings (now folded tightly up) and
-sharp, keen fox-like heads, hang upside down on every tree, waiting
-for the night to come, and whiling away the time by quarrelling and
-swearing. They are all bad, these bats; they axe ugly, dirty, vicious,
-destructive and greedy--yet they are strictly tabooed by the natives,
-and no one dares to kill a single one. It is believed that the
-prosperity of Tonga is inextricably associated with the bats, and that,
-if they ever deserted the wood, the country would fall. They are sacred,
-and must not be touched.
-
-Every evening, punctually at five o’clock, the bats take wing, and
-rise from the trees like a screaming cloud of evil spirits. The sky is
-blackened with their bodies as they go, and scattered all over with the
-long streaming flights of separate bats that divide away from the main
-body. They are off to feed--to feed all night upon the bananas and
-pineapples and mangoes of the unhappy islanders, who lose thousands
-of pounds’ worth of fruit and trade every year, but dare not revenge
-themselves. Just at dawn, they will return, screaming and shoving rudely
-as they settle down in the trees once more, squabbling for upper
-berths, and trying to push into a nice comfortable place amidships of a
-particular bough, by biting the occupant’s toes until he lets go. They
-may have flown forty or fifty miles in the night, visited islands more
-than twenty miles away, and devastated the plantations of Tonga from end
-to end. They have worked hard for their suppers, and now they will doze
-and squabble all day, once more, until evening.
-
-A few miles from the Wood of Bats, in the midst of exquisite scenery,
-stands a famous avava known as Captain Cook’s Tree. It was under this
-tree that the great explorer called together all the natives, on his
-discovery of the islands in 1777, and addressed them by means of an
-interpreter. The account of this will be found in “Cook’s Voyages.” The
-tree is still in splendid condition, in spite of its age, which must
-amount to many hundred years. Pigs were brought to Tonga by Cook in this
-same year, and a few of the original breed are still to be seen in the
-island--tall, gaunt, hump-backed creatures with immense heads and long
-noses, contrasting oddly with the smaller and fatter kinds introduced by
-later voyagers.
-
-The burial-place of the Tui Tongans made an object for another drive.
-Before the introduction of Christianity, in early Victorian days, the
-Tongans had two kings, an ordinary earthly king, who did all the hard
-work of governing, and a heavenly king, the Tui Tonga, who was
-supposed to be of divine descent, and was worshipped as a god. For many
-centuries, the Tui Tongas were buried in great oblong raised enclosures,
-three-terraced, and built of rough-hewn, closely fitted slabs from the
-coral reef. Two of these great tombs still remain, hidden in tangled
-thickets of low bush, and considerably worn by age. I had no means
-of measurement, but judged the larger one to be about fifty yards by
-thirty, the smaller somewhat less. The state of the coral slabs, and the
-great trees that have grown up rooted among them, suggest that the tombs
-are extremely old. Tradition among the natives takes them back beyond
-the recollection of any of their ancestors; they cannot say when or why
-they were built. The construction--a double terrace, each step about
-five feet high--and the carefully arranged oblong shape, seem to point
-to some special significance long since forgotten. There is also a
-“trilithon” erection of three large blocks of stone, some miles away,
-concerning which island traditions are silent. It could not have been
-constructed by hand labour alone; some mechanical device must have been
-employed to raise the centre stone to its present position. The ancient
-Tongans, however, knew nothing of mechanics, and an interesting problem
-is therefore set for antiquarians to solve. The height of the side
-supports is about twenty feet, and the centre cross-piece, which rests
-in a socket on each side, is a little less in length.
-
-The beautiful and interesting sea-caves--some swarming with birds,
-others celebrated for their lovely colouring and formation--which are
-found in the windward side of the island, I was unable to see, owing to
-the bad weather of the rainy season, during which my visit was made.
-
-A “Chief” kava-party, however, got up for my benefit, consoled me for
-the loss of the caves. Kava is the great national drink of Tonga, as of
-many other South Sea islands. It is made from the hard woody root of
-the Piper methysticum and is exhilarating and cooling, but not actually
-intoxicating. In taste, it is extremely unpleasant till one gets used
-to it, being peppery, soapy, and dish-watery as to flavour. I had
-drunk kava before, however, and learned to recognise its pleasanter
-properties; also, the old custom of chewing the kava-root, before
-infusing it, which still obtains in some parts of Samoa, has been quite
-given up in Tonga, and the pounding is done with stones.
-
-The scene was weird and strange in the last degree. I was the only white
-person present. We all squatted on the mats in the chief’s house, the
-natives in their valas and loose short gowns, with white scented flowers
-in their hair; I in a smart demi-toilette evening dress, because I was
-the special guest, and the chief’s family would expect me to honour them
-by “dressing the part.” The only light was a ship’s hurricane lantern,
-placed on the floor, where it threw the most Rembrandtesque of shadows
-upon the silent circle of brown, glittering-eyed faces, and upon the
-rapt ecstatic countenances of the kava-makers, as they went through all
-the details of what was evidently an ancient religious ceremony, very
-savage, very native, and not at all “missionary,” despite the church
-membership of all the performers. There were loud sonorous chants and
-responses, elaborate gymnastics, with the great twist of hibiscus fibre
-that was used to strain the kava after it was pounded, and water poured
-on; something very like incantations, and finally, a wild religious
-ecstasy on the part of the kava-maker, who worked himself almost into a
-fit, and at last sank back utterly exhausted, with the bowl of prepared
-kava before him. This bowl was a standing vessel as big as a round
-sponge bath, carved, legs and all, from one block of a huge forest
-tree-trunk, and exquisitely polished and enamelled, by many years of
-kava-holding. Its value was beyond price.
-
-The calling of names now began--first the chief’s, then mine, then the
-other guests. There is great ceremony observed at kava-drinkings, and an
-order of precedence as strict as that of a German Court. As my name was
-called, I clapped my hands once, took the cocoanut bowl from the girl
-who was serving it, and swallowed the contents at a draught. The next
-name was then called, and the next drinker drank as I did. It is very
-bad manners to act otherwise. The girl who served the kava walked round
-our squatting circle in a doubled-up posture that must surely have made
-her back ache; but custom forbade her to stand erect while serving.
-
-After the long ceremony was ended, the dignified white-haired chief held
-a conversation with me, by means of an interpreter; and told me that
-there were four ways of kava-drinking, each with its appropriate
-etiquette.
-
-That which I had seen was the most important and elaborate of the four,
-very seldom used, and only permitted to chiefs. We exchanged a good
-many stately compliments through the interpreter, and I then took my
-departure.
-
-It is near the end of my visit, and in a few more days, the steamer
-takes me on to Haapai and Vavau and beautiful, steamy-hot Samoa. But
-this is Christmas morning, and one can think of nothing else.
-
-Nothing? Well, those who know what it is to spend that day of days under
-a burning tropic sky, with palms and poinsettia for Christmas garlandry,
-instead of holly and mistletoe, know just what thoughts fly homewards
-across twelve thousand miles of sea, and how far they are concerned with
-the sunny, lonely Christmas of the present--how far with the dark and
-stormy Christmases of the past, when snow and winter reigned outside,
-but summer, more brilliant than all the splendours of southern world,
-was within, and in the heart. But it is of the Tongan Christmas day that
-I have to tell.
-
-I was awakened very early by--the waits! Whatever one expects under the
-Southern Cross, one certainly does not expect that, and yet there they
-were, a score of boys and youths playing merry tunes under my window,
-and pausing now and then to see if I was not awake to come out and give
-them their Christmas “tip.”
-
-[Illustration: 0388]
-
-I dressed hastily, and came on to the verandah. The music of the band,
-which had puzzled me a good deal, now turned out to be produced solely
-by mouth-organs, blown by a number of youths dressed exactly alike in
-black valas, white linen jackets, and white uniform caps. The soul of
-the Tongan loves a uniform above everything, and all the bands in the
-islands--of whom there are an astonishing number--wear specially made
-costumes of a rather military type.
-
-It was frightfully hot, for Christmas is midsummer here, and the day was
-exceptionally warm in any case.
-
-But the “waits,” standing out in the burning sun, did not seem to feel
-the heat at all. They blew lustily away at their mouth-organs, playing
-English dance music, Tongan songs, missionary hymns, in wonderful time
-and harmony, and with the inimitable Tongan verve and swing, poor though
-the instruments were. The performance was quite worth the gift they
-expected, I listened as long as they cared to play. Then they collected
-their dues, and went off to serenade a white trader, who, I strongly
-suspected, had been celebrating Christmas Eve after a fashion that would
-not tend to make him grateful for an early call.
-
-For me, Christmas had begun on the previous evening when I went to the
-midnight Mass at the church upon the shore, among the palms and
-the feathery ironwood trees. In the crystal-clear moonlight, what a
-brilliant scene it was! Even outside the church, the decorations could
-be seen for miles, since they consisted of thousands and thousands of
-half-cocoanut-shells, filled with cocoanut oil, and provided with a wick
-of twisted fibre, which when lit, burnt with a clear ray like a star,
-illuminating the walls of the churchyard, the outlines of the doors and
-the ridges of the roof--even the winding walks about the building, too,
-and the low-growing trees--with a perfect Milky Way of dancing light.
-
-Within, all the colours of a coral reef (which includes every hue of
-a rainbow, and many more) were in full blaze about the tremendous,
-unbroken floor, where the natives stood or sat cross-legged, dressed in
-all their gayest finery. There was a heavy scent of perfumed cocoanut
-oil, orange-blossom, and frangipani flowers and a rich glow of lights;
-and the waves of gorgeous melody that burst forth now and again with the
-progress of the service were like the billows of Time breaking upon
-the shores of Eternity. Of all the choral singing that I heard in the
-Pacific, that of Tonga was incomparably the fullest, the most splendid,
-and most majestic. The singers of Manahiki are sweeter and stranger,
-those of the Cook Islands more varied and soft, but the Tongan music is,
-for sheer magnificence and volume, unsurpassable.
-
-The women, in their graceful tunics, with their elaborately dressed
-hair, and their fine, dignified presence, were all unlike the soft,
-sensuous, languorous syrens of Tahiti and Raratonga, They do not
-encourage familiarity, even from white women, and their moral character
-is much higher than that of their sisters in the far Eastern Pacific.
-Women are treated with more respect in Tonga than in any part of the
-Pacific. They have little to do in the way of household work, and
-almost no field work. The men save them most of the hard labour, on the
-undeniable ground that hard work makes a woman ugly, and they do not
-care for ugly wives!
-
-Nearly every one wore a mat tied round the waist, partly concealing the
-gay dress--in spite of the extreme heat of the night. Some of the mats
-were new and clean, but most were old, ragged, and dirty. This curious
-custom is a relic of ancient heathen days in Tonga, when a handsome
-dress of any kind, worn by a commoner, was apt to arouse the dangerous
-envy of a chief, and in consequence, a native who was wearing his “best”
- generally tied the dirtiest old mat that he could get over all, so that
-he might not look too rich! The reason has long since vanished, but
-the custom remains in a modified form. A mat, tied round the waist with
-strong sinnet cord, is considered a correct finish to the gayest of
-festival costume in Tonga of to-day, and, as far as I was able to
-ascertain, its absence, on occasions of ceremony, is considered rather
-vulgar.
-
-The service was enlivened by the presence of a very large and extremely
-loud brass band. Brass is a passion with the Tongan musician, and
-he certainly makes the most of it. The effects produced are a little
-monotonous to a European ear, but, none the less, impressive and fine.
-
-After the midnight mass, I went home in the bright moonlight, the gentle
-stir of the trade-wind, the soft rustle of the ironwood trees, falling
-with a pleasantly soothing effect upon ears a little strained and tired
-by the strenuous character of the Tongan music. Next morning came the
-waits, and in the afternoon there were games and sports of a rather too
-familiar Sunday-school pattern, at the various mission stations. I did
-not trouble to attend any of them, as the Pacific native is certainly
-least interesting when most intent on copying the ways and fashions of
-the white man. The cricket matches which came off at various intervals
-during the few weeks of my stay, were well worth seeing, however, for
-the Tongan is a magnificent cricketer, and has often inflicted bitter
-defeat on the best teams that visiting men-of-war could put in the field
-against him.
-
-The politically disturbed state of the island was interesting in one
-way, but a serious disadvantage in another, since it prevented my
-obtaining much information about many interesting native customs that
-I should have been glad to investigate. I am afraid that I deserved the
-worst that scientifically minded travellers could say of me, in Tonga,
-for I merely spent the time enjoying myself after the pleasant island
-fashion, and not in research or geographical note-taking, even so far as
-was possible. Yet, after all, what are the islands, if not a Garden
-of Indolence, a lotus-land, a place where one dreams, and wanders, and
-listens to the murmuring reef-song, and sleeps under the shade of a
-palm, and wakes but to dream again? Does one degenerate, in such a life?
-Why, yes, of course--constantly, surely, and most delightfully.
-
-“_Be good, and you will be happy, but you won’t have a good time_,” says
-“Pudd’nhead Wilson,” one of the wisest of modern philosophers. In the
-islands, one is not good, in the ordinary Dr. Wattian sense of the term,
-and perhaps one is not happy--though if so, one never finds it out. But
-the good time one does have, and it is very good indeed. And if you do
-not believe me, dear sensible reader, never be tempted to go and try,
-for it is very likely that the good time and your own goodness would
-mutually cancel one another, and you would be unvirtuous and bored
-all in one. The islands are not for all, and the gateway to the
-“Tir-na’n-Oge” is now, as ever, hard to find.
-
-The big Union steamer, with her ice, and her “cuisine” (cooking is never
-cooking, on board a passenger vessel), and her dainty little blue and
-white cabins, and her large cool saloon glittering with crystal and
-gilding, came in in due time, and I went away with her to Samoa. The
-three days’ run was broken by two calls in the Tongan group--one at
-Haapai, and one at Vavau.
-
-Of Haapai, a long, low, wooded island, with a few hundred native
-inhabitants, and one or two whites, we saw nothing but the king’s
-palace--a great, square, two-storeyed, verandahed building, which is
-never lived in--and the Wesleyan chapel, which has some of the
-finest sinnet work in the Pacific to show. This sinnet work is quite
-distinctive of the islands, and is very beautiful and artistic. It
-is not one of the “curios” known to the markets and collections of
-civilisation, because it is always done _in situ_, and cannot be
-removed. At first sight, it looks like remarkably, good chip carving,
-done on the capitals of pillars, and about the centres of supports
-and beams, in various shades of red, black, brown, and yellow. Looking
-closer, one sees that it is much more remarkable than carving, being a
-solid mass of interwoven sinnet plait, as fine as very thin twine, wound
-and twisted into raised patterns by the clever fingers of the natives.
-In the church at Haapai, the sinnet plaiting is very fine and elaborate,
-and certainly well worth seeing. The captain of the steamer, who acted
-as our guide, made sure we had all seen it, and then took us a wild,
-hot, hurried walk across the island, to the coral beach at the other
-side, and past the palace, and along an endless cocoanut avenue, which
-was very pretty, but----
-
-We wanted our afternoon tea, and we mutinied at that point, and insisted
-on going back to the ship. This grieved our commander, who conceived
-that his duties to the Company required he should ensure every passenger
-saw everything that was to be seen on the whole voyage, and shirked
-nothing--but we threatened to overpower and maroon him, if he did not
-take us back, so he returned, lecturing learnedly about the cutting off
-of the “Port-au-Prince,” in Haapai, by the natives, in seventeen hundred
-and I-forget-when. We ought to have been listening--but we wanted our
-tea, and we weren’t.
-
-We reached Vavau just before dark, barely in time to admire the
-wonderful windings and fiords, the long blue arms and bright green
-islets, of this Helen among island harbours. Vavau is celebrated for its
-beauty through all the South Sea world, and its loveliness has not been
-one whit exaggerated.
-
-In the early morning--at half-past five, to be precise--the energetic
-captain routed all the passengers out of their bunks, and compelled
-them, by sheer force of character, to follow him, groaning and puffing,
-up a hill five hundred feet high, and exceedingly precipitous--a mere
-crag, in fact--that overlooked the harbour. We did not want to go, but
-none of us were sorry we had been compelled, when we did get to the top
-and saw that matchless harbour lying extended at our feet, mile after
-mile of land-locked fiord and palmy headland and exquisite green island,
-all set in a stainless mirror of flaming blue, and jewelled, where the
-shallows lightened to the shore, with flashes of marvellous colour shot
-up from the coral reef lying underneath. Rose and amethyst and violet,
-and malachite green and tawny yellow--they were all there, painting
-the splendid sweep of the harbour waters with hues that no mortal brush
-could reproduce, or pen describe. We stayed there long, and even the
-thought of breakfast, generally a moving call, did not hurry us away.
-
-In the afternoon, the captain had business to attend to, so he turned
-out one of the officers to act as guide, and sent us all off to see
-the Cave of the Swallows, and Mariner’s Cave, on the other side of the
-harbour.
-
-If the Cave of the Swallows were situated on any European coast, it
-would be as tourist-ridden a spot as the Blue Grotto of Capri, or
-any other of the thousand famous caves through which holiday-making
-travellers are dragged each summer season--and would consequently be
-despoiled of half its loveliness. But it is very far away, in the South
-Sea Islands, and though a passenger steamer does visit Vavau once a
-month there are usually no tourists--only a missionary and a trader or
-two. So the lovely place lies undisturbed almost all the time, and you
-shall not find, when you row across the harbour to see it, that you
-have to wait your turn in a crowd of other boats, full of romping and
-larking trippers, with the guide of every party keeping a sharp look-out
-to see that no one takes longer than he ought going over the “sight”--so
-long as his charges remain outside.
-
-Instead of this, we glide silently under a noble archway some fifty feet
-high, and enter a great, still, ocean sanctuary, that looks as if no
-wandering oar had ever profaned its peace, since first the white man
-came to these far-off isles. Outside, the water is Prussian blue in
-colour, and over a thousand feet deep, but within the arch of the cave
-the bottom shoots up till it is within a hundred feet of the glass-clear
-surface on which we float, hanging above the silver-coloured coral reefs
-of the deep sea-bed, like birds hanging in air. The roof and walls of
-the cave are brilliant verdigris green, the water-floor, that curves so.
-closely in and out of the numerous arches and recesses, where mysterious
-shadows creep, is sapphire shot with fire. At one side of the cave there
-is a dark winding corridor leading to depths unknown. We glide down
-this a little way, and there before us opens out--surely, a temple and
-a shrine! The water-floor spreads and broadens here into the carpet of
-a high, still, secret inner cave, in the centre of which springs up a
-splintered pedestal--shattered, one fancies, by the blow that broke the
-image that must surely once have stood in this strange sea-shrine. From
-an unseen rift in the roof, far above, a white ray of sun strikes down
-into the cave, and falls like a blast from an offended heaven upon the
-broken pedestal.
-
-There is a geological explanation, no doubt, but we shall not look for
-it, for this is a wonder that would have delighted Victor Hugo himself,
-who drew the scenery of the “Toilers of the Sea.” And Victor Hugo’s pen
-would be needed by any one who would adequately describe the spot.
-
-There is a rock in the outer cave, that sounds like a church bell when
-struck with an oar, and this delights the boatmen greatly, though they
-have heard it every time the steamer came up to Vavau. It is, indeed, a
-solemn and beautiful sound, and well suited to the place.
-
-Going back to the ship, we are shown the spot where the famous Mariner’s
-Cave opens out, under water. There is nothing whatever to be seen, since
-the entrance is six feet under water at low tide. The story was first
-told to the world in Mariner’s “Tonga,” published 1802, and was utilised
-by Byron in his poem of “The Island.” A young chief, it was said, was
-chasing a turtle one day, and saw the creature dive. He followed it, and
-was surprised to find that, on rising after his dive, he had reached an
-under-water cave of considerable size, to which there was no outlet save
-the one by which he had come in. Giving up the turtle, he dived again,
-returned to the surface, and did not trouble himself about the cave
-until, some months later, it occurred to him as an excellent place for
-an elopement--the parents of the girl he loved having refused to
-give her to him. So it came about that the young chief’s sweetheart
-disappeared, and no one knew what had become of her until one day a
-boating party, to their intense amazement, saw what appeared to be the
-ghost of the girl rising from the heart of the waves. The apparition
-stared round, saw the intruders, and immediately disappeared. She was
-seen no more, but the story caused so much talk, that in the end the
-true secret came out, and it was discovered that the chief had hidden
-his lady-love in the cave, diving down with food to her day by day,
-and even bringing torches, safely wrapped in leaves. The stem parents,
-touched by so much devotion, relented, and the chief triumphantly
-brought home his bride at last in full day.
-
-Mariner, who was interested in the ancient tale, succeeded in reaching
-the cave himself, and found it as represented. He surmised that there
-was an air supply, passing through invisible cracks in the rock above,
-for the air seemed to keep fresh. There was something like a rough couch
-of stone at one end, where the imprisoned girl had made her bed. No
-light whatever penetrated the cavern.
-
-Since Mariner’s time, very few Europeans have succeeded in entering the
-cave, which is extremely difficult to get into, owing to the length of
-the passage under water, and the currents of the tides. About thirty
-years ago, Captain Luce, of H.M.S. _Esk_, succeeded in entering the
-cave, but rose too soon on going out, and lacerated his back so badly
-against the coral spears under water, that he died in a few days. Since
-then, I heard that one white man had gone safely in and returned, but no
-one seemed to know who, or when. None of our party, at all events, felt
-tempted to make the trial.
-
-The steamer was ready to start when we got back, so we hurried on board,
-and started away for Samoa. There was much more to see in Vavau, but
-the only way of seeing it was to stop over for a month and remain in the
-village. For this no one had time. I was giving a month to each group
-of islands, which is little enough in the Pacific--but I knew very well
-that, unless I had had a vessel of my own, or a year or two extra to
-spend, it was impossible to see all that could be seen.
-
-Tofoa, for instance, one of the Tongan Group, which is an active
-volcano, and, naturally, not inhabited--what could be more interesting
-than a call there? But uninhabited volcanoes do not furnish cargo for
-steamship companies, so all we could see was a smear of smoke in the
-far distance, as we steamed on our way to Apia, the capital of the
-“Navigators” Group, better known, since the days of Stevenson, as Samoa.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XIV
-
-_Stevenson’s Samoa--What happened when it rained--Life in a Native
-Village--The Albino Chief--A Samoan “Bee”--The Tyranny of Time--Fishing
-at Midnight--Throwing the Presents--My Friend Fangati--The Taupo
-Dances--Down the sliding Rock--“Good-bye, my Flennie!”_
-
-WHEN I woke up in the morning, the ship was still, and the familiar
-chatter of island tongues, and splashing of island paddles, audible
-outside the ports, told that we had reached Apia.
-
-Dressing is always a rush, under such circumstances. I hurried out on
-the deck in even quicker time than usual, and hastened to enjoy a good
-look at the little island that has been made famous the wide world over,
-by the genius of the great writer who passed his latest years in exile
-among those palmy hills.
-
-Upolu, Stevenson’s island, is the second largest in the Samoan Group,
-being forty miles by eight. Savaii is a little wider. Tutuila is
-smaller. The six other islands are of little importance.
-
-Apia and Stevenson’s home have been written about and described, by
-almost every tourist who ever passed through on the way to Sydney. There
-is little therefore to say that has not been said before. Every one
-knows that Apia is a fair-sized, highly civilised place, with hotels
-and shops and band promenades, and that Vailima, Stevenson’s villa, is
-a mile or two outside. Every one has heard of the beautiful harbour of
-Apia itself, with the blue overhanging hills, and the dark wooded peak
-rising above all, on the summit of which the famous Scotsman’s tomb
-gleams out like a tiny pearl--“under the wide and starry sky.” Since
-the disturbances of 1899, most people have been aware that England
-has absolutely relinquished any rights she had in Samoa, and that the
-islands are now divided between Germany and America--Upolu being among
-the possessions of the former.
-
-Perhaps some people have forgotten that Samoa is a fairly recent
-discovery, having been first sighted by Bougainville in 1768. It is
-supposed that the natives originally came from Sumatra. During the last
-six hundred years, they were frequently at war with the Tongans
-and Fijians, and from the latter learned the horrible practice of
-cannibalism--which, however, they abandoned of their own accord a good
-while before the coming of the first missionaries in 1833.
-
-They are a singularly beautiful race, and most amiable in character.
-They are all Christianised, and a great number can read and write.
-Tourists have done their best to spoil them, but outside the towns there
-is much of the ancient simplicity and patriarchal character still to be
-found.
-
-About two dozen Samoan gentlemen--I call them gentlemen, because in
-manners and demeanour they really deserved the name, and many were
-actual chiefs--had come on board the steamer, and were walking about the
-deck when I came out. The air was like hot water, and there was not a
-breath of wind. All the same, the Samoan gentlemen were quite cool, for
-they wore nothing at all but a British bath-towel with red edges, tied
-round the waist in the universal kilt style of the Pacific. In the Cook
-Group, the garment is called a pareo, and is made of figured cotton.
-In Tonga, it is a vala, and is usually cashmere. In Samoa the name
-is changed to lava-lava, and the thing may be either a piece of plain
-coloured cotton, or the bath-towel above mentioned, which is considered
-a good deal smarter--but the costume itself is the same all through.
-
-Most of the men had their short-cut hair plastered snow-white with
-lime, because it was Saturday. Almost every Samoan limes his hair on
-Saturdays, partly to keep up the yellow colour produced by previous
-applications, partly for hygienic reasons that had better be left to the
-imagination.
-
-[Illustration: 0404]
-
-All the visitors displayed an incomparable self-possession and dignity
-of bearing, not at all like the “Tongan swagger,” but much more akin to
-the manner of what is known in society as “really good people.” Coupled
-to the almost complete absence of clothes, and the copper skins, it was
-enough to make one perfectly giddy at first. But afterwards, one grew
-used to it, and even came to compare the average white man’s manner
-disadvantageously with the unsurpassable self-possession and calm of the
-unclothed native.
-
-Then came boats and landing and hotels, and the usual one-sided South
-Sea town, with little green parrakeets tweedling cheerfully among the
-scarlet flowers of the flamboyant trees, and looking very much as if
-they had escaped from somewhere. And behold, as we were making our way
-to the hotel, a heavy waterspout of hot-season rain came on, whereupon
-the street immediately became a transformation scene of the most
-startling character.
-
-The roadway had been full of natives in their best clothes, come down
-to see the passengers--some in bath-towels, like the visitors to the
-steamer, but many in the cleanest of shirts and cotton tunics, and
-scores of pretty Samoan girls in civilised gowns of starched and laced
-muslin, trimmed hats, and gay silk ribbons. The rain began to spout, as
-only tropical rain can, and immediately things commenced to happen
-that made me wonder if I were really awake. Under the eaves of houses,
-beneath umbrellas, out in the street without any shelter at all,
-the Samoans rapidly began undressing. Smart white shirts, frilled
-petticoats, lacy dresses, all came off in a twinkling, and were rolled
-up into tight bundles, and stowed away under their owners’ arms, to
-protect the precious garments from the rain. Then down the street, with
-bare brown legs twinkling as they ran, and bodies covered merely by the
-“lava-lava,” scurried the bronze ladies and gentlemen who had looked
-so smart and dressy a few brief seconds before. Some of the girls, who
-could not get an inch of shelter under which to undress, merely pulled
-their fine frocks up under their arms, and ran down the street looking
-like very gay but draggled tulips set on two long brown stalks. It was
-the oddest transformation scene that I had ever been privileged to look
-on at, and it sent the passengers of the ship into such screaming fits
-of laughter that they forgot all about keeping themselves dry, and
-landed in the hotel in the condition of wet seaweed tossed up by the
-waves. So we arrived in Samoa.
-
-There is no use in relating at length how I drove out to see Stevenson’s
-much described villa at Vailima--now in the possession of a wealthy
-German merchant, and much altered and spoiled--and how I did _not_ climb
-the two thousand feet up to his tomb above the harbour, and was sorry
-ever after. Rather let me tell how, tired of the civilised section of
-the island, I took ship one day in an ugly little oil-_launch_, and
-sailed away to see the life of a native village, down at Falepunu.
-There is not much real native life now to be seen in the capital; for,
-although the “faa Samoa” (ancient Samoan custom) is very strong all over
-the islands, in Apia it is at a minimum, and the influence of the white
-man has much increased since Stevenson’s day. Besides, how can one study
-native customs, dining at a _table d’hôte_ and living in a great gilt
-and glass hotel, situated in the midst of a busy street?
-
-So it was very gladly that I saw the wide blue harbour of Apia open out
-before me, and melt into the great Pacific, the “league long rollers”
- tossing our little cockle shell about remorselessly as we headed out
-beyond the reef, and began to slant along the coast, Upolu’s rich blue
-and green mountains unfolding in a splendid panorama of tropic glory,
-as we crept along against the wind towards Falefa, our destined port,
-nearly twenty miles away. Here and there, white threads of falling water
-gleamed out against the dark mountain steeps; and the nearer hills,
-smooth and rich and palmy, and green as a basket of moss, parted now
-and then in unexpected gateways, to show brief glimpses of the wildly
-tumbled lilac peaks of far-away, rugged inner ranges. A day of gold
-and glitter, of steady, smiting heat, of beauty that was almost^ too
-beautiful, as hour after hour went by, and found the glorious panorama
-still unrolling before eyes that were well-nigh wearied, and bodies that
-wanted shelter and food.
-
-But even a little oil-launch cannot take all day to cover twenty miles;
-so it was still early in the afternoon when we glided into the harbour
-of Falefa, and came to a stop in the very heart of Paradise.
-
-How to picture Falefa, to the dwellers in the far grey north! how to
-paint the jewel-green of the water, the snow white of the sand, the
-overhanging palms that lean all day to look at their own loveliness in
-the unruffled mirror below; the emerald peaks above, the hyacinth peaks
-beyond, the strangely fashioned out-rigged canoes, with their merry
-brown rowers, skimming like long-limbed water-flies about the bay;
-the far-away sweetness and stillness and unlikeness of it all! And the
-waterfall, dropping down seventy feet of black precipitous rock right
-into the sea’s blue bosom--and the winding, shady fiords, where the
-water is glass-green with reflections of shimmering leaves--and the
-little secluded brown houses, domed and pillared after the Samoan
-fashion, that ramble about among the long avenues of palm--surely, even
-in all the lovely South Sea Islands, there never was a lovelier spot
-than this harbour of Falefa!
-
-We three--a half-caste Samoan lady, a New Zealand girl, and
-myself--landed on the beach and gave over our things to a native boy, to
-carry up to the great guesthouse at Falepunu, a mile further on. Every
-Samoan village has its guest-house, for the free accommodation of
-passing travellers, but few have anything that can compare with the
-house where we were to stay--my companions for the night only, myself
-for a week.
-
-A Samoan house, owing to the heat of the climate, is a roof and nothing
-more, the walls being omitted, save for the posts necessary to support
-the great dome of the roof. It is worth well looking at and admiring all
-the same. Fine ribs made of strong flexible branches run diagonally from
-eaves to crown, only an inch or two apart, and curved with exquisite
-skill to form the arching dome. Over these, at an acute angle, are laid
-similar ribs in a second layer, forming a strong, flexible ‘lattice. At
-just the right intervals, narrow, curved beams cross behind these, and
-hold them firm. The centre of the house displays three splendid pillars,
-made from the trunks of three tall trees; these support the roof-tree,
-and are connected with the sides of the dome by several tiers of slender
-beams, beautifully graded in size and length. The guest-house of
-Falepunu belongs to a high chief, and is in consequence exceptionally
-handsome. Its roof-tree is fifty feet from the floor, and the width of
-the house, on the floor-level, is the same. Forty wooden pillars, each
-seven feet high, support this handsome dome, every inch of which is
-laced and latticed and tied together with the finest of plaited cocoanut
-fibre, stained black, red, and yellow, and woven into pattern like
-elaborate chip carving.
-
-There is not a nail used in the construction of the house. One wet
-afternoon I attempted to count the number of thousand yards of sinnet
-(plaited cocoanut fibre) that must have been used in this colossal work,
-and gave it up in despair. The number of the mats used in forming
-the blinds was more calculable. Each opening between the pillars was
-surmounted by seven plaited cocoanut-leaf mats, fastened up under the
-eaves into a neat little packet. These could be dropped like a Venetian
-blind, whenever rain or wind proved troublesome. The total number of
-mats was two hundred and seventy-three.
-
-The floor of a Samoan house consists of a circular terrace, raised some
-two feet above the level of the ground. It is surrounded by a shallow
-ditch, and it is made of large and small stones, closely fitted
-together, and covered with a final layer of small white coral pebbles
-from the beach. This forms the carpet of the house, and is known as
-“Samoan feathers,” from the fact that it also forms everybody’s bed at
-night, covered with a mat or two.
-
-The chief, Pula-Ulu, and his wife, Iva, who were in charge of the
-guest-house, in the absence of its owner, received us joyfully, and
-proceeded to make a feast for us at once. Fowls were killed, baked
-bread-fruit and taro brought from the ovens outside (which were simply
-pits dug in the ground, and filled with hot stones), and oranges and
-pineapples plucked from the nearest grove. We sat crosslegged on the
-mats, and ate till we could eat no more; then, “faa Samoa,” we lay down
-where we were to rest and doze away the hot hours, of the afternoon.
-
-In the evening, Iva lit a big ship’s hurricane lamp, and set it on the
-floor; and half Falepunu came in to call. In rows and rows they sat on
-the floor-mats, their brown, handsome faces lit up with interest and
-excitement, fanning themselves ceaselessly as they sat, and asking
-endless questions of the half-caste lady, who interpreted for the
-others. I, as coming from London, was the heroine of the hour, for the
-Samoans are all greatly interested in “Beritania” (Britain) and, in
-spite of the German annexation, still prefer the English to any other
-nation.
-
-The inevitable question: “Where was my husband?” followed by: “Why had I
-not got one?”--in a tone of reproachful astonishment--was put by almost
-every new-comer. The half-caste visitor explained volubly; but the
-villagers still looked a little puzzled. The Samoans have in almost
-every village a “taupo” or “Maid of the Village,” whose office it is to
-receive guests, and take a prominent part in all public ceremonies and
-festivals. But she only holds office for a very few years, until she
-marries, and she is always surrounded, when travelling, by a train of
-elderly attendants. An unmarried woman who had money of her own, who
-wandered about alone, who held office in no village, here or at home,
-this was decidedly a puzzle to the Falepunu folk, whose own women all
-marry at about fourteen. They had seen white women; travelling with
-their husbands, but never one who had ventured from Beritania all alone!
-
-There was evidently some difficulty, at first, in “placing” me according
-to Samoan etiquette, which is both complex and peculiar. A white women
-with her husband presents no difficulty, since the “faa Samoa” always
-gives the superior honour to the man, and therefore the woman must only
-receive second-class ceremony. In my case, the question was solved later
-on, by classing me as a male chief! I was addressed as “Tamaite” (lady),
-but officially considered as a man; therefore I was always offered kava
-(the national drink of Samoa, never given to their own women, and not
-usually to white women), and the young chiefs of the district came
-almost every evening to call upon me in due form, sitting in formal
-rows, and conversing, through an interpreter, in a well-bred, gracious
-manner, that was oddly reminiscent of a London drawing-room. The women
-did not visit me officially, although I had many a pleasant bathing and
-fishing excursion in their company.
-
-On the first evening the callers stayed a long time--so long, that we
-all grew very weary, and yearned for sleep. But they kept on coming, one
-after another; and by-and-by half-a-dozen young men appeared, dressed in
-kilts of coloured bark-strips; adorned with necklaces of scarlet berries
-and red hibiscus flowers, and liberally cocoanut-oiled. In the centre
-of the group was the most extraordinary figure I had ever seen--a white
-man, his skin burned to an unwholesome pink by exposure, his hair pure
-gold, extremely fine and silky, and so thick as to make a huge halo
-round his face when shaken out. His eyes were weak, and half shut, and I
-was not surprised to hear that he was not really of white descent, being
-simply a Samoan albino, born of brown parents. This man, being the son
-of a chief, took the principal figure in the dance that was now got
-up for our amusement. The seven men danced on the floor-mats,
-close together, the albino in the centre, all performing figures of
-extraordinary agility, and not a little grace. The music was furnished
-by the other spectators, who rolled up a mat or two, and beat time on
-these improvised drums, others clapping their hands, and chanting a
-loud, sonorous, measured song.
-
-At the end of the dance the performers, streaming with perspiration (for
-the night was very hot) and all out of breath, paused for our applause.
-We gave it liberally, and added a tin or two of salmon, which was
-joyfully received, and eaten at once. All Samoans love tinned salmon,
-which, by an odd perversion, they call “peasoupo.” No doubt the first
-tinned goods seen in the islands were simply tinned peasoup. This would
-account for the extraordinary confusion of names mentioned above.
-
-By this time we were so utterly weary that we lay down on the mats where
-we were, and almost slept. Iva, seeing this, chased most of the callers
-out with small ceremony, and got up the calico mosquito curtain that was
-to shelter the slumbers of all three travellers. It enclosed a space of
-some eight feet by six. Within, plaited pandanus-leaf mats were laid,
-two thick, upon the white pebble floor, and Samoan pillows offered us.
-
-A Samoan pillow is just like a large fire-dog, being simply a length of
-bamboo supported on two small pairs of legs. If you are a Samoan, you
-lay your cheek on this neck-breaking arrangement, and sleep without
-moving till the daylight. We preferred our cloaks rolled up under our
-heads.
-
-The invaluable little mosquito tent served as dressing-room to all
-of us, and very glad we were of it, for there were still a good many
-visitors, dotted about the floor of the great guest-house, smoking
-and chattering; and none of them had any idea that a white woman
-could object to performing her evening toilet in public, any more than
-a-Samoan girl, who simply takes her “pillow” down from the rafters,
-spreads her mat, and lies down just, as she is.
-
-No-bed-clothes were needed, for the heat was severe. We fidgeted about
-on our stony couch, elbowed each other a good deal, slept occasionally,
-and woke again to hear the eternal chatter still going on outside
-our tent, and see the light still glowing through the calico. It was
-exactly, like going to bed in the-middle of a bazaar, after making a
-couch out of one of the stalls.
-
-At last, however, the light went out; Iva, Pula-Ulu, and their saucy
-little handmaiden and relative, Kafi, got under their mosquito curtains,
-quite, a little walk away, at the other side of the dome, all the guests
-departed, and there was peace.
-
-Next, morning my friends went away and I was left to study the fife of
-a Samoan village alone, with only such aid as old Iva’s very few English
-words could give me, since I did not know above half-a-dozen; sentences
-of the Samoan tongue. There were no great feasts, no ceremonies or
-festivals while I was in Falepunu, only the ordinary, everyday fife of
-the village, which has changed extremely little since the coming of the
-white men, although that event is three generations old.
-
-Perhaps the greatest change is in the native treatment of guests.
-Hospitable, polite and pleasant the Samoans have always been and still
-are; but in these days, when a white visitor stays in a native house, he
-is expected to give presents when parting, that fully cover the value of
-his stay. This is contrary to the original Samoan laws of hospitality,
-which still hold good in the case of natives. No Samoan ever thinks of
-paying for accommodation in another’s house, no matter how long his stay
-may be; nor is there the least hesitation in taking or giving whatever
-food a traveller may want on his way. But the white visitors who have
-stayed in Samoa have been so liberal with their gifts, that the native
-now expects presents as a right. He would still scorn to take money for
-his hospitality, but money’s worth is quite another matter.
-
-Otherwise, the “faa Samoa” holds with astonishing completeness. Natives
-who have boxes full of trade prints, bought from the lonely little
-European store that every island owns, will dress themselves on
-ceremonial occasions in finely plaited mats, or silky brown tappa cloth.
-Houses on the verge of Apia, the European capital, are built precisely
-as houses were in the days of Captain Cook; though perhaps an
-incongruous bicycle or sewing-machine, standing up against the central
-pillars, may strike a jarring note. Men and women who have been to
-school, and can tell you the geographical boundaries of Montenegro, and
-why Charles I.’s head was cut off--who know all about the Russo-Japanese
-war, wear full European dress when you ask them to your house, and sing
-“In the Gloaming” or “Sail away” to your piano--will take part in a
-native “si va” or dancing festival, dressed in a necklace, a kilt, and
-unlimited cocoanut-oil, and may be heard of, when the chiefs are
-out fighting, roaming round the mountains potting their enemies with
-illegally acquired Winchesters, and cutting off the victims’ heads
-afterwards. The “faa Samoa” holds the Samoan, old and young, educated or
-primitive, through life and to death.
-
-[Illustration: 0392]
-
-Uneventful, yet very happy, was the little week that time allowed me
-among the pleasant folk of Falepunu. When the low, yellow rays of
-the rising sun hot under the wide eaves of the great guest-house,
-and striped the white coral floor with gold, and the little green
-parrakeets began to twitter in the trees outside, and the long sleepy
-murmur of the surf on the reef, blown landward by the sunrise wind,
-swelled to a deep-throated choral song--then, I used to slip into my
-clothes, come out from my mosquito tent, and see the beauty of the new
-young day. Dawn on a South Sea Island! The rainbow fancies of childhood
-painted out in real--the
-
- Dreams of youth come back again,
-
- Dropping on the ripened grain
-
- As once upon the flower.
-
-Iva, Pula-Ulu, and Kafi would be awake also, and moving about. No minute
-of daylight is ever wasted in these tropical islands; where all the year
-round the dawn lingers till after five, and the dark comes down long
-before seven. None of my house-mates had much toilet to make. They
-simply got up from their mats, hung up the pillows, put the mosquito
-nets away, and walked forth; clad in the cotton lava-lavas of yesterday,
-which they had not taken off when they lay down. Taking soap and bundles
-of cocoanut fibre off the ever useful rafters they went to bathe in the
-nearest river. Before long they came back, fresh and clean, and wearing
-a new lava-lava, yesterday’s hanging limp and wet from their hands--the
-Samoan generally washes his garments at the same time as himself. Then
-Iva boiled water for my tea, and produced cold baked bread-fruit and
-stewed fish, and I breakfasted, taking care to leave a good share of
-tea, butter, and any tinned food I might open, for the family to enjoy
-afterwards. It is a positive crime in Samoa to eat up any delicacy all
-by yourself--an offence indeed, which produces about the same impression
-on the Samoan mind as cheating at cards does upon the well-bred
-European. The natives themselves usually eat twice a day, about noon,
-and some time in the evening; but a Samoan is always ready to eat at any
-hour, provided there is something nice to be got. Good old Iva enjoyed
-my tea and tinned milk extremely, and so did her pet cronies. They used
-to call in now and then, in the hope of getting some--a hope liberally
-fulfilled by Iva, who distributed my goods among them with charming
-courtesy, and a total innocence of any possible objection on my part,
-which disarmed all criticism. I might have taken anything she had, from
-her Sunday lava-lava to her fattest fowl, and kept it or given it away;
-equally without remonstrance. Such is the “faa Samoa.” That any one
-continues to retain anything worth having; under such circumstances,
-speaks well for the natural unselfishness of the people. They may be a
-little greedy with the whites--much as we ourselves should no doubt be
-greedy if half-a-dozen millionaires were to quarter themselves in
-our modest mansions, or come to stay in our quiet suburbs--but among
-themselves they are wonderfully self-’ restrained, and at the same time
-faultlessly generous.
-
-After my breakfast, following the agreeable Samoan custom, I lay down
-on a mat and dozed a little, to feel the wind blowing over my face from
-the sea, as I wandered half in and half out of the lands of dreams,
-and saw with semi-closed eyes the sun of the hot morning hours turn the
-green of the bush into a girdle of burning emerald-gold, clasped round
-the pleasant gloom of the dark over-circling roof. Pula-Ulu was out on
-“ploys” of his own; Kafi had gone to fish, or to flirt; Iva, pulling a
-fly-cover over her body, slept like a sheeted corpse on her own mat,
-off the other side of the central pillars.
-
-After an hour or two--there was never any time in Falepunu--I would
-rise, and call for Kafi, and we would walk slowly through the smiting
-sun, to a fairylike spot in the lovely bay of Falefa--a terrace of grey
-rock clothed with ferns, and shaded by thick-growing palms and chestnut
-and mango trees. The great white waterfall, cool as nothing else is cool
-in this burning land, thundered within fifty yards of us, turning the
-salt waters of the bay to brackish freshness, and spraying the hot air
-with its own delicious cold. Here we swam and dived for hours at a time,
-getting an old canoe sometimes, and paddling it up under the very spray
-of the fall--upsetting it perhaps, and tumbling out While Kafi yelled as
-if she could not swim a stroke, and anticipated immediate death (being,
-of course, absolutely amphibious). A pretty little minx was Kafi, small
-and black-eyed and piquante, always with a scarlet hibiscus bloom, or a
-yellow and white frangipani flower, stuck behind her ear; always tossing
-her head, and swaying her beautiful olive arms, and patting her small
-arched foot on the ground, when she stood waiting for me under the
-palms, as if she could not keep her elastic little frame, from dancing
-of itself. Pretty, saucy, mischievous little Kafi, she gave me many a
-bad moment wickedly calling out, “S’ark!” when we were swimming far from
-land, in places where it was just conceivable that a shark might be; but
-I forgive her everything, for the sake of that unique and charming small
-personality of hers. Not even Fangati, the languorous sweet-eyed Taupo
-of Apia, can compete with her in my memories of fascinating island girls
-and pleasant companions.
-
-One morning--it must have been somewhere near the middle of the day--Iva
-and Kafi and I were walking back from Falefa, tired out and very hungry
-(at least, I will answer for myself), when we were hailed from the house
-of a chief, and asked to come in. We did so, all saying, as we bowed our
-heads to step under the low eaves: “Talofa!” (my love to you), and being
-answered with a loud chorus: “Talofa, tamaite! (lady); Talofa, I va;
-Talofa, Kafi.” I took my seat cross-legged on the mats, and looked about
-me. All round the house in a Circle were seated a number of men, about
-a dozen, each with a bundle of cleaned and carded cocoanut husk fibre,
-called sinnet, beside him, and a slender plait of sinnet in his hand, to
-which every minute added on an inch or so of length. It was evidently
-a “bee” for making sinnet plait, and it solved a problem that had
-perplexed me a good deal--namely, how all the thousands of sinnet
-used instead of nails in building Samoan houses, were ever obtained.
-Afterwards I learned that Samoan men occupy much of their unlimited
-leisure time in plaiting sinnet. The bundle of husk and the-neat-little
-coil of plait are to a Samoan man what her needle and stockings are to
-a Scotch housewife; he works away mechanically with them in many an odd
-moment, all going to swell the big roll that is gradually widening and
-fattening up among the rafters; Some of the sinnet thus made is as fine
-as fine twine, yet enormously strong....
-
-My hosts, it seemed, were just going to knock, off work for the
-present, and have some kava, and I was not sorry to join them, for kava
-is a wonderfully refreshing drink, among these tropical islands, and
-wholesome besides. It was made Tongan fashion, by pounding the dry
-woody’ root with stones, pouring water over the crushed fragments,
-and straining the latter out with a wisp of hibiscus fibre. A handsome
-wooden bowl was used, circular in form, and supported on; a number of
-legs--the whole being carved out of one solid block of wood. The ancient
-Samoan way of preparation was to chew the kava root, and deposit the
-chewed, lamps in, the bowl, afterwards pouring on the water; but this
-practice has died out, in many parts of Samoa, though in some of the
-islands it is still kept up.
-
-My kava On this occasion was not chewed, and I was thankful, as it is
-unmannerly to refuse it under any circumstances.
-
-The kava made, the highest chief present called the names, according, to
-etiquette, as in Tonga, in a loud resounding voice. I answered to my
-own (which came first, as a foreign, chief) by clapping my hands, in the
-correct fashion, and drained the cocoanut bowl that was handed me. Kava,
-as I had already learned, quenches thirst; removes fatigue, clears the
-brain, and is exceedingly cooling. If drunk in excess it produces a
-temporary paralysis of the legs, without affecting the head; but very
-few natives and hardly any whites do drink more than is good for them.
-
-After the kava, two young men came running in from the bush, carrying
-between them an immense black wooden bowl, spoon-shaped, three-legged,
-and filled with something exactly like bread-and-milk, which they had
-been concocting at the cooking-pits. It was raining now, and the thrifty
-youths had taken off their clothes, for fear of spoiling them, yet
-they were dressed with perfect decency, and much picturesqueness. Their
-attire consisted of thick fringed kilts, made of pieces of green banana
-leaves (a banana leaf is often nine or ten feet long, and two or three
-wide), and something like a feather boa, hung round the neck, of the
-same material. Clad in these rain-proof garments, they ran laughing
-through the downpour, their bowl covered with another leaf, and
-deposited it on the floor, safe and hot.
-
-A section of banana-leaf was now placed on the mat beside each person,
-also a skewer, made from the midrib of the cocoanut leaf. Then the
-servers dipped both hands generously into the food, and filled each leaf
-with the bread-and-milk, or “tafolo,” which turned out to be lumps of
-bread-fruit stewed in thick white cream expressed from the meat of
-the cocoanut. Better eating no epicure could desire; and the food is
-exceedingly nourishing. We ate with the cocoanut skewers, on which
-each creamy lump was speared; and when all was done we folded the
-leaf-plates into a cone, and drank the remaining cream. Afterwards, Iva
-and Kafi and I took our leave, and I hurried back to Falepunu, feeling
-that my hunger and fatigue had been magically removed, and that I
-was ready for anything more in the way of exercise that the day might
-produce.
-
-I had no watch or clock with me, and this was certainly an advantage,
-since it compelled me to measure time in the pleasant island fashion,
-which simply marks out the day vaguely by hot hours and cool hours, and
-the recurring calls of hunger. No one who has not tried it can conceive
-the limitless freedom and leisure that comes of this custom. Time is
-simply wiped out. One discovers-all of a sudden, that one has been
-groaning under an unbearable and unnecessary tyranny all one’s
-life--whence all the hurry-scurry of civilisation? why do people rush
-to catch trains and omnibuses, and hasten to make and keep appointments,
-and have meals at rigidly fixed times, whether they are hungry or not?
-These are the things that make life short. It is inimitably long, and
-curiously sweet and simple, in the island world. At first one finds it
-hard to realise that no one is ever waiting for dinner, or wanting to go
-to bed--that eating and sleeping are the-impulse of a moment, and not a
-set task--but once realised, the sense of emancipation is exquisite and
-complete.
-
-The Samoan does what he wants, when he wishes, and if he does not wish a
-thing, does not do it at all. According, to the theology of our youthful
-days, he ought in consequence to become a fiend in human shape; but he
-does nothing of the kind. He is the most amiable creature on earth’s
-round ball. Angry voices, loud tones even, are never heard in a Samoan
-house. Husbands never come home drunk in the evening and ill-use their
-wives; wives never nag at their husbands; no one screams at children, or
-snaps at house-mates and neighbours. Houses are never dirty; clothes are
-always kept clean; nothing is untidy, nothing superfluous or ugly.
-There is therefore no striking ground for ill-temper or peevishness;
-and amiability and courtesy reign supreme. The Samoan has his
-faults--sensuality, indolence, a certain bluntness of perception as to
-the white man’s laws of property--but they are slight indeed compared
-with the faults of the ordinary European. And, concerning the tendency
-to exploit the latter person, which has been already mentioned, it must
-not be forgotten that if a white man is known to be destitute and in
-want, the very people who would have eagerly sought for presents from
-him while he was thought to be rich, will take him in, feed and-lodge
-him; without a thought of payment, and will never turn him out if he
-does not choose to go.
-
-Sometimes, in the long, lazy, golden afternoons, a woman or two would
-drop in, and bring with her some little dainty as a present for the
-stranger. “Palusani” was the favourite, made, as in Niué, of taro-tops
-and cocoanut; the cook grating down the meat of the nuts, and straining
-water through the oily mass thus produced. The cream is very cleverly
-wrapped up inside the leaves, and these are again enveloped in larger
-and tougher leaves. While baking, the cream thickens and condenses, and
-permeates the taro-tops completely. The resulting dish is a spinachlike
-mixture of dark green and white, odd to look at, but very rich and
-dainty to eat.
-
-Another present was a sort of sweetmeat, also made from cocoanut cream,
-which was baked into small brown balls like chocolates, each containing
-a lump of thickened cream inside. These were generally brought tied up
-in tiny square packets of green banana leaf. Small dumpy round puddings,
-made of native arrowroot, bananas, cocoanut, and sugar-cane juice, used
-also to be brought, tied up in the inevitable banana-leaf; and
-baked wild pigeon, tender and juicy, was another offering not at all
-unacceptable. As a typical millionaire, possessed of several dresses,
-change for some sovereigns, and countless tins of salmon, I was expected
-to give an occasional _quid pro quo_, which usually took the form of
-tinned fish or meat, and was much appreciated.
-
-I do not know how late it was, one night--the moon had been up for many
-hours, but no one seemed to want to go to bed--when I heard a sound of
-splashing and laughing from the brightly silvered lagoon beyond the belt
-of palms. I went out, and saw thirty or forty of the native women wading
-about in the shallow water inside the reef, catching fish. It looked
-interesting, so I shed an outer skirt or two, kilted up what remained,
-and ran down the white shelving beach, all pencilled with the feathery
-shadows of tossing palms, into the glassy knee-deep water. How warm it
-was! as hot as a tepid bath at home--how the gorgeous moonlight flashed
-back from the still lagoon, as from a huge silver shield! The whole
-place was as light as day; not as a Samoan day, which is too like the
-glare from an open furnace to be pleasant at all times, but at least,
-as light as a grey English afternoon.
-
-The girls, wearing only a small lava-lava, were wading in the water,
-some carrying a big, wide net made out of fine fibres beaten from the
-bark of a Samoan tree; others trailing two long fringes of plaited palm
-leaves, about a yard deep, and twenty or thirty yards long. These were
-drawn through the water about twenty yards apart, the girls walking
-along for a few minutes in two parallel rows, and then quickly bringing
-the ends of the palm fringes together in an open V shape. The net was
-placed across the narrow end of the V, and from the wide end two or
-three splashed noisily down the enclosed space, driving before them into
-the net all the little silvery fish who had been gathered together by
-the sudden closing in of the palm-leaf fringes. Then there was laughing
-and crying out,-and the moon shone down on a cluster of beautiful
-gold-bronze figures, graceful as statues, stretching out their small
-pretty hands and wild curly heads, diamond-gemmed with scattered drops
-of water, over the gathered-in net, now sparkling and quivering with
-imprisoned life. The captured fish were dropped into a plaited palm-leaf
-basket; and then the two lines of girls separated once more, and marched
-on through the warm silvery water, singing as they went.
-
-I think, though I do not know, that this simple sport (which was, after
-all, a necessary task as well) went on nearly all the night. The Samoan
-is not easily bored, and no one minds losing a night’s rest, when there
-is all the hot day to doze on the mats. I gave up an hour or so, and
-returned to the guest-house, loaded with presents of fish. It was quite
-absurd, but I wanted to go to bed, silly inferior white person that I
-was! so I crept under my calico tent, and “turned in,” feeling amid the
-stir and chatter, the singing and wandering to and fro, of those moonlit
-small hours, exceedingly like a child that has to follow nurse and go to
-sleep, while all the grown-ups are still enjoying themselves downstairs.
-
-The night before I left for Apia once more, I bought my farewell
-presents at the solitary little store that was marooned away down on
-the beach at Falefa, and bore on its house front the mysterious
-legend--“MISIMOA”--all in one word--translatable as “Mr. Moore!” Advised
-by the trader’s native wife, I got several lava-lavas for the old chief
-and his wife, also a “Sunday frock” piece of white muslin, and some
-lace, for Iva herself. Poor old Iva! she could not afford herself many
-clothes, being only a caretaker in the great house; and I had felt sorry
-for her when I saw her missionary-meeting frock--only an old blue print.
-All the Samoan women love to turn out in trade finery on Sundays, and a
-white muslin, with lace, made exactly like a British nightdress, is the
-height of elegance and good form. I gave Pula-Ulu, furthermore, a yellow
-shirt spotted with red horses; and as a final gift for Iva, I selected a
-large white English bath-towel, with crimson stripes and edge. This last
-I knew would certainly be Iva’s best week-day visiting costume for some
-time to come.
-
-All these splendours I tied up in a brown paper parcel, and left on
-my portmanteau. Samoan etiquette is very strict about the giving and
-receiving of presents, and prescribes absolute ignorance, on the part
-of the recipient, of any such intention being about; but Iva could not
-resist pinching the parcel, and whispering--“Misi! what ‘sat?”
-
-“Ki-ki, Iva,” (food), I answered.
-
-“You lie!” said Iva delightedly, poking me in the ribs. She had no idea
-that she was not expressing herself with the most perfect elegance and
-courtesy; the Samoan tongue has no really rude words, and Samoans often
-do not realise the quality of our verbal unpolitenesses.
-
-Next morning, however, when my “solofanua” (animal that runs along the
-ground-->horse) was standing out under the bread-fruit trees, and all my
-goods had been tied about the saddle, till the venerable animal
-looked like nothing on earth but the White Knight’s own horse--Iva and
-Pula-Ulu, bidding me good-bye with the utmost dignity, did not even
-glance at the parcels which I threw across the house, at their heads,
-narrowly escaping hitting their old grey hair. This was etiquette. In
-Samoa, a formal gift must be thrown high in the air at the recipient, so
-as to fall at his feet; and he must not pick it up at once, but simply
-say “Fafekai” (thank you) with a cold and unmoved accent, waiting until
-the giver is gone to examine the present. The inner meaning of the
-custom is the supposed worthlessness of the gift, when compared with
-the recipient’s merits--it is mere rubbish, to be cast away--and the
-demeanour of the recipient himself is intended to suggest that in any
-case he is not eager for gifts.
-
-A long, hot ride of twenty miles back to Apia and civilisation filled up
-the day. The pendulum of Time, held back for a whole dreamy, lazy week,
-had begun to swing once more; and all day I worried about the hour I
-should get in. I was late for _table d’hote_; I was met by a “little
-bill”; and the mail had come in since I left. Thus Apia welcomed me; and
-thus I “took up the white man’s burden” once again.
-
-*****
-
-“Talofa!” says a gentle yet insistent voice.
-
-It is only half-past six, and I am exceedingly sleepy, so I bury my face
-in the pillow, and try not to hear.
-
-“Talofa!” (How do you do?), repeats the voice, a little louder, and my
-basket armchair creaks to the sudden drop of a substantial weight. I
-open my eyes, and see, through the dim mist of the mosquito-curtains,
-the taupo, Fangati, sitting beside my bed.
-
-Fangati is my “flennie,” and that means a good deal more in Samoa than
-the cold English word “friend,” from which if is derived. She attached
-herself to me upon my arrival in Apia, some weeks ago, and has ever
-since continued to indicate, in the gentle Samoan way, that she prefers
-my company to that of any other white woman on the island. There is
-nothing contrary to Samoan etiquette in her calling upon me at 6.30
-a.m., for Samoa knows not times or seasons, save such as are pleasing to
-itself for the moment. If I were suffering from sleeplessness and went
-to call on Fangati at midnight, she would certainly awake, get up off
-her mat, take a fan in her hands, sit down cross-legged on the floor,
-ready to talk or yarn for the rest of the night--without the smallest
-surprise or discomposure. So, aspiring after the ideal of Samoan
-politeness, I feel bound to shake myself awake, and talk.
-
-Fangati is very much “got up” this morning. She is a chief’s daughter,
-of high rank, and her wardrobe is an extensive one. To-day she has a
-short tunic of tappa (native cloth, beaten out of the bark of a paper
-mulberry tree), satiny brown in colour, and immensely pinked and
-fringed. This is worn over a lava-lava, or kilt, of purple trade print,
-reaching a little below her knees. Her beautiful pale brown arms (all
-Samoan women have exquisitely shaped arms) and small arched brown feet
-are bare. In her thick, wavy hair she has placed one large scarlet
-hibiscus flower, and there are three or four long necklaces round her
-neck, made of the crimson rind of a big scented berry, cut into curly
-strips. One of these, as a matter of common courtesy, she flings over
-my nightdress as we talk, and smiles sweetly at the brilliant effect
-achieved.
-
-“Ni--ice!” says Fangati. She can speak quite a good deal of English, but
-she smooths and trims it prettily to suit her own taste, and the harsh
-language of the black North loses all its roughness on her lips.
-
-She has come to tell me that there will be dancing at the village of
-Mulinuu this afternoon, as it is the German Emperor’s birthday, and a
-great many kegs of salt beef and boxes of biscuit have been given to the
-villages by the Government, to celebrate the day. (Not such a bad method
-of encouraging loyalty in a newly acquired colony, either.) There
-are to be some taupo dances, and Fangati will take a leading part.
-Therefore I must be certain to come and see my “flennie” perform. This
-matter settled, Fangati gets up and drifts to the washstand, tastes my
-cold cream and makes a face over it, points to a jug of cold tea and
-says “You give?” shares the luxury with her ancient chaperon, who is
-sitting on the doormat, and then melts away down the verandah, dreamily
-smoking a native-made cigarette.
-
-It is now time to explain what a taupo is, and why the dances to-day
-will be especially attractive. .
-
-Most Samoan villages possess a taupo, or mistress of the ceremonies,
-who has many duties, and many privileges as well. She is always young,
-pretty, and well-born, being usually the daughter of a high chief. She
-remains unmarried during her term of office, which may last for many
-years, or for only a few months. The propriety of her conduct is
-guaranteed by the constant presence of certain old women, who always
-accompany her on visits or journeys. Sometimes her train is increased by
-the addition of a dwarf or a cripple, who seems to act a part somewhat
-similar to that of a mediaeval court fool. Her duties oblige her to
-receive and entertain all guests or travellers who pass through her
-village; to make kava (the universal drink of the Pacific islands) for
-them, welcome them to the guest-house, which is a part of every Samoan
-settlement, and dance for their amusement. She is treated with royal
-honours by the villagers, always handsomely clothed, and luxuriously fed
-on pig and chicken, and never required to do any hard work, while the
-other girls have to be content with taro-root and bread-fruit, and are
-obliged to work in the fields, carry water, and fish on the reef in the
-burning tropic sun. When there is a festival, she takes the principal
-part in the dances; and when the tribes are at war (as occasionally
-happens even to-day) the taupo, dressed as a warrior, marches out with
-the ceremonial parade of the troops, and acts as a _vivandière_ during
-the fight, carrying water to the soldiers, and bringing ammunition when
-required. This duty is not one of the safest, for, although no Samoan
-warrior knowingly fires on any woman, much less on a taupo, stray
-bullets take no account of persons, and many a beautiful young “Maid of
-the Village,” in times past, has justified her warrior dress by meeting
-with a soldier’s death.
-
-Well-mannered as all Samoan women are, the taupo is especially noted for
-the elegance of her demeanour. My “flennie’s” bearing reminds me oddly
-at times of the manner of a London great lady, accustomed to constant
-receiving, and become in consequence almost mechanically “gracious.”
- She never moves abruptly; her speech is calm and self-possessed, and her
-accent soft and _traînant_. There are, however, taupos and taupos. Vao,
-who lives just across the way, is by way of being an “advanced woman.”
- She plays native cricket in a man’s singlet and a kilt, dances a knife
-dance that tries the nerves of every one that looks on, wears her hair
-short and is exceedingly independent, and a little scornful. Vao does
-not want to marry she says; but I have an idea, all the same, that
-if just the right sort of young chief came along, with just the
-irresistible number of baskets of food (these take the place of bouquets
-and chocolate boxes among Samoan wooers), Vao would renounce her dignity
-of taupo just as readily as other Maids of the Village have done when
-Mr. Right appeared. On her wedding day she would dance her last dance
-for the villagers, according to immemorial custom, and thenceforward
-live the quiet home-life of the Samoan wife and mother, all the
-footlights out, all the admiring audience gone, and only the little
-coral-carpeted, brown-roofed cottage with its small home duties and
-quiet home affections left.
-
-Then there is the taupo Fuamoa--but of her more anon, as the Victorian
-novelist used to say.
-
-Early in the afternoon, when the sun was at its very hottest--and what
-that heat can be, at 130 south, in the height of the hot season, let
-Pacific travellers say--I made my way down to Mulinuu under a big
-umbrella, and took my place on the mats laid to accommodate the
-spectators. The dancing was in full swing. A long row of young men,
-dressed in short kilts of many-coloured bark strips--red, pink, green,
-yellow, purple--and decked out with anklets of green creepers and
-necklaces of big scarlet berries, which looked just like enormous coral
-beads, were twirling and pirouetting, retreating, advancing, and waving
-their arms, in wonderfully perfect time. The Samoan, man or woman, is
-born with a metronome concealed somewhere in his or her works, to all
-appearance. Certainly the exquisite sense of time and movement displayed
-in children’s games, grown-up dances, and all the songs of the people,
-seems almost supernatural, as the result of unaided impulse.
-
-The arms and hands play a remarkable part in the dance. Every finger is
-made a means of expression, and the simultaneous fluttering and waving
-of the arms of an entire _corps-de-ballet_ can be compared to nothing
-but the petals of a bed of flowers, sent hither and thither by a
-capricious wind.
-
-There is no instrumental music, for the Samoans--strange to say, for a
-music-loving people--have no instruments at all, unless one may count
-the occasional British mouth-organ. But the sonorous, full-voiced
-chanting of the chorus that sits cross-legged on the grass at a little
-distance, leaves nothing to be desired in the way of orchestra. A
-favourite tune, which one is sure to hear at every Samoan dance-meeting
-or “siva” is the following, commenced with a loud “Ai, ai!”
-
-It is first sung very slowly, and gradually increased in speed until the
-dancers give up in despair.’ ‘The faster they have danced before giving
-in, the louder is the applause.
-
-[Illustration: 0312]
-
-By-and-by the men conclude their dance, and retire, loudly clapped,
-and followed by cries of “Malo! malo!” (well done). A short interval
-follows. The many-coloured crowd seated on the grass fans itself, smokes
-cigarettes, and chatters; the dry palm-fronds rustle in the burning sky
-overhead, harshly mimicking the cool whisper of forest leaves in gentler
-climes. Suddenly six handsome young men, splendidly decorated, their
-brown skins satiny with’ rubbing of perfumed cocoanut-oil, rush into
-the middle of the green, and in the midst comes a seventh, smaller,
-slighter, and handsomer than the rest. What a beautiful youth! almost
-too young, one would have thought, for the smart black moustache that
-curves above his upper lip--wonderfully active, supple, and alive in
-every movement--a skin like brown Lyons silk, limbs---- Why, it is
-a girl! the taupo Fuâmoa, dressed (or rather undressed) as a Samoan
-warrior, and full to the brim of mischief, sparkle, and fun. She wears
-a fringe of coloured bark-strips round her waist, and a very big kilt
-of scarlet and white striped cotton underneath. The rest of her attire
-consists of a necklace of whale’s teeth inestimably valuable, a
-string of red berries, and a tall helmet, or busby, apparently made of
-brilliant yellow fur. Her exquisitely moulded figure is as Nature made
-it, save for a rubbing of cocoanut-oil, that only serves to bring out
-the full beauty of every curving line. Strange to say, the black-painted
-moustache is wonderfully becoming, so too is the imposing helmet;
-and does not Fuamoa know it? and is not she saucy, and dainty, and
-kitten-like, as she frisks and plays in the centre of the dance, making
-the prettiest of eyes at the audience, and flashing her white teeth
-delightedly under the wicked little black moustache? She is a celebrated
-dancer, being only surpassed on the island by one other taupo--Vao, who
-is not appearing to-day. You would never think, as her little brown feet
-twinkle over the grass, and her statuesque brown arms wave above her
-head, while the merry smile ceaselessly comes and goes, that Fuamoa is
-suffering positive agonies all the time, from the splendid war-helmet
-that adorns her head; yet that is the truth. One must indeed suffer to
-be beautiful, as a Samoan taupo. Before the helmet is put on, the girl’s
-long thick hair is drawn up to the top of her head, and twisted as
-tightly as strong arms can twist it, so that her very eyebrows are
-pulled out of place, and every hair is a separate torture. Then the
-great helmet is fastened on as firmly as a rock, with countless tight
-cords, and the dancer is ready for her part, with a scalp on fire and
-a torturing headache, which will certainly last until she can take the
-cruel decoration off.
-
-[Illustration: 0315]
-
-There are several taupo dances this afternoon, but only two of the
-girls have the courage to wear the helmet. Fangati, my little “flennie,”
- frankly confesses that she cannot stand it. “He made me cly-y-y!
-too much!” she says, and shows me the pretty wreath of crimson berry
-peelings and green leaves that is to adorn her own curly head.
-
-These helmets, it may be noted, are not made of fur, as one might
-suppose at a first glance. The material is human hair, cut from the head
-of a Samoan girl, and dyed bright yellow with lime. In time of war, it
-is a common thing for a girl to offer up her beautiful tresses to make
-a helmet for father, husband, or lover; and the wearer of such a gift is
-as proud as a knight of Arthur’s Round Table may have been, bearing on
-his crest his lady’s little pearl-broidered glove.
-
-It is Fangati’s turn to dance now, and out she trips, wearing a valuable
-mat of the finest plait, her pretty wreath, countless scarlet necklaces,
-and a modest girdle of coloured silk. Fangati has the prettiest foot
-and hand in Apia, and she is a dainty little dancer--not so marvellously
-agile and spirited as Fuamoa, and with much less of “devil” in her
-composition, but a pretty and a pleasant creature to watch. She has
-reached the twenties, and gone nearly half-way through them, so that she
-is in a fair way to become an old maid, according to Samoan ideas; but
-she still retains her maiden state, and declares she will not marry, in
-spite of good offers from several chiefs. It is said in Apia that she is
-proud, and wishes to marry a white man--which is much as if a charming
-English country girl should determine to mate with nothing less than
-a duke. Country lasses do marry dukes, but not often; and there is
-not much more chance of my “flennie’s” attaining her ambition, unless
-Providence is very kind.
-
-[Illustration: 0433]
-
-[Illustration: 0438]
-
-The ordinary Samoan is obliged to do a little work now and then, since
-yam patches must be cultivated, breadfruit plucked and cooked, banana
-and arrowroot puddings made, fish caught, nets woven, houses built and
-repaired. But all in all there is not much to do, and the real business
-of life in Samoa is amusement. _Le monde où l’on s’amuse_, for most
-people means a certain circle of London and Paris; but for all who have
-travelled in the South Seas, it means, once and for all, Samoa.
-
-The taupo is of course at the head and front of every diversion, for,
-little as the other people have to do, she has less, having nothing at
-all. A day at Papaseea is one of her favourite delights. During my stay
-in Samoa one of these pleasant native picnics was organised for me, and
-I set off on a lovely morning for the “Sliding Rock,” accompanied by
-fifteen native and half-caste girls, stowed away in six buggies. It
-was a long drive in the burning sun, and afterwards a long rough
-walk through the bush, among wild pineapples, scarlet hibiscus, tall,
-creamy-flowered, pungent, scented ginger-bushes, red-fruited cacao,
-quaint mammee-apple trees, mangoes, Pacific chestnuts, and countless
-other strange tropic growths. Hot and tired as we all were, the Papaseea
-rock, when we reached it, seemed a perfect Paradise.
-
-Imagine a deep gorge in the heart of green, heavily-wooded hills; at
-the bottom, a narrow channel shaded by overhanging trees, where the pure
-mountain water runs clear and cold and deep, amber-brown pools quiver
-at the foot of white plunging falls--one only some seven feet high, the
-other a good thirty. This last was the Sliding Rock, over which we were
-all going to fling ourselves _à la_ Sappho by-and-by, only with less
-melancholy consequences. It looked formidable enough, and when Pangati
-and the others, with cries of delight, pulled off their dresses, wound
-white and pink and green cotton lava-lavas over one shoulder, and
-round from waist to knee, crowned themselves picturesquely with woven
-fern-leaves, and plunged shrieking over the fall, I began to wish I had
-not come, or coming, had not promised to “slide.” However, there was no
-help for it, so I got into my English bathing-dress, which excited
-peals of merry laughter, because of its “continuations,” waded down the
-stream, and sitting in the rush of the water, held tightly on to a rock
-at each side, and looked over my own toes at the foaming, roaring thirty
-feet drop.
-
-It was all over in a minute. Just an unclasping of unwilling hands
-from the safe black rocks, a fierce tug from the tearing stream, an
-exceedingly unpleasant instant when one realised that there was no going
-back now at any price, and that the solid earth had slipped away as it
-does in the ghastly drop of a nightmare dream; then nothing in the world
-but a long loud roar, and a desperate holding of the breath, while the
-helpless body shot down to the bottom of the deep brown pool and up
-again--and at last, the warm air of heaven filling one’s grateful lungs
-in big gasps, as one reached the surface, and swam across to the other
-side of the pool, firmly resolved on no account to do it again, now that
-it was over.
-
-It was pleasant, afterwards, to sit among the rocks above the fall, and
-watch one after another of the native and half-caste girls--including a
-very charming and highly educated half-American, who had been to college
-in San Francisco, and to smart society dances in Samoa--rush madly over
-the fall, leaving behind them as they went a long, loud yell, like the
-whistle of a train going into a tunnel. One native girl daringly went
-down head first; another, standing incautiously near the edge of the
-fall, lost her balance, and simply sat down on the pool below, dropping
-through the air with arms and legs outspread like a starfish. Fangati
-seized a friend in her arms and tumbled over the verge with her, in
-a perfect Catherine wheel of revolving limbs. It was hours before the
-riotous party grew tired, and even then, only the sight of large green
-leaves being laid out on the stones, and palm-leaf baskets being opened,
-brought them out of the water, and got them into their little
-sleeveless tunics and gracefully draped kilts. By this time, the pretty
-Samoan-American’s mother had laid out the “ki-ki”--baked fowl and pig,
-taro-root, yams, bananas, pineapples, guavas, European delicacies
-such as cake and pies, and native dainties, including the delicious
-_palusami_, of which I have spoken before. The drinking cocoanuts had
-been husked and opened by the boy who brought the food, and there they
-stood among the stones, rows of rough ivory cups, lined with smooth
-ivory jelly of the young soft meat, and filled with fresh sweet water,
-such as is never to be tasted out of the cocoanut-land. Our plates were
-sections of green banana-leaf; our forks were our fingers. And when
-every one had fed, and felt happy and lazy, we all lay among the rocks
-above the fall, in the green shadow of the trees, and did nothing
-whatever till evening. Then we climbed back to the road, and drove
-home, six buggies full of laughing brown and white humanity, crowned
-and wreathed with green ferns, and singing the sweet, sad song of
-Samoa--“Good-bye, my flennie”--the song that was written by a native
-only a few years ago, and has already become famous over the whole
-Pacific. It is the farewell song of every island lover, the melody
-that soars above the melancholy rattling of the anchor chains on every
-outward-bound schooner that spreads her white wings upon the breast
-of the great South Seas. And for those who have known the moonlight
-nights of those enchanted shores, have smelt the frangipani flower, and
-listened to the soft singing girls in the endless, golden afternoons,
-and watched the sun go down upon an empty, sailless sea, behind the
-weird pandanus and drooping palms--the sweet song of the islands will
-ring in the heart for ever. In London rush and rain and gloom, in the
-dust and glitter of fevered Paris, in the dewy cold green woods of
-English country homes, the Samoan air will whisper, calling, calling,
-calling--back to the murmur of the palms, and’ the singing of the coral
-reef, and the purple tropic night once more.
-
-
-“GOOD-BYE, MY FLENNIE.”
-
-(Song, with Samoan words, English beginning to each verse.)
-
-
-[Illustration: 0317]
-
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XV
-
-_Southward to New Zealand--Into the Hot-Water Country--Coaching Days
-come back--The Early Victorian Inn--The Fire and Snow of Ruapehu--A
-Hotel run wild--Hot Lakes and Steaming Rivers--The Devil’s Trumpet--The
-Valley of the Burning Fountains--Waking up the Champagne Lake._
-
-OF the other island groups that I visited during that pleasant year or
-two of wandering--strange Fiji, exquisite Norfolk Island, the wicked,
-unknown New Hebrides--I have told elsewhere. But before the great P. &
-O. liner carried me away from Sydney on the well-known track across the
-seas to England and home, I had a journey through New Zealand that
-was second to nothing in the world, for pure enjoyment, but the
-unsurpassable Islands themselves.
-
-New Zealand is not yet fully opened up--that was what the geography
-books said in my school days. The saying, like most geography-book
-information, slipped through my mind easily, and did not create any
-marked impression. The marked impression came later, when I went half
-round the world to see New Zealand, and discovered that I could not take
-train to just anywhere I chose. It seemed incredible, in a country as
-highly civilised as France or Germany, that coaches--not the ornamental
-tourist brand, run as an accompaniment to railways, but real Early
-Victorian coaches, with “no frills on them” of any sort or kind--were
-the only means of transit, save boats, to a great part of the famous hot
-lake and river district of the North Island. One could go to Rotorua,
-the most remarkable collection of geysers and hot lakes, direct by rail
-from Auckland. But the lovely Wanganui River, the beautiful up-country
-bush, and whole duchies of hot-water and mud-volcano land, could only be
-“done” by coach and boat.
-
-[Illustration: 0447]
-
-This made the journey more interesting, on the whole, though it was a
-little amazing at first to leave the railway far behind, and strike
-out right into the early nineteenth century. One should have worn
-side-curls, a spencer, and a poke bonnet, instead of the ordinary
-tourist coat and skirt and useful straw hat, to feel quite in character
-with the mud-splashed coach, its six insides, two outsides, and four
-struggling, straining horses; the days of wind and shower, the hurried
-meals eaten at lonely little wayside inns, and the nights spent in
-strange barrack-like, barn-like places, where the stable was of more
-importance than the house, and every one always arose and fled like a
-ghost at the early dawn of day.
-
-But first, after the railway town and railway hotel were left behind,
-came Wanganui River, a whole day of it; nearly sixty miles of exquisite
-loveliness, viewed in perfect comfort from the canopied deck of a river
-steamer. The Wanganui has been called New Zealand’s Rhine, but it no
-more resembles the Rhine than it resembles a garden-party or an ostrich
-farm. It has nothing whatever in common with Germany’s great historic
-river but its beauty; and the beauty of the Wanganui is of an order very
-far indeed removed from that of the ancient castle-crowned streams of
-Europe, which are strewn with records of dead and decaying æons of human
-life. Solitude, stillness, absolute, deathly loneliness are the keynotes
-of Wanganui scenery. Shut in by fold on fold of great green mountain
-peaks, scarp on scarp of fern-wreathed precipice, one can almost fancy
-that the swift little paddle-steamer is churning her way for the first
-time into solitudes never seen of man. Now and then a Maori dug-out
-canoe, long and thin and upturned at the ends, may be sighted riding
-under the willows, or gliding down-stream to the swift paddle-strokes
-of its dusky-faced occupant. At rare intervals, too, the spell of silent
-lonelinesses broken by the sight of some tiny river-side settlement
-perched on a great green height--half a dozen wooden houses, and a
-tin-roofed church; the whole being labelled, with some extraordinarily
-pretentious name. One of our passengers that day got in at London, and
-went on to Jerusalem; another was booked from Nazareth to Athens!
-
-All New Zealanders are _not_ Maories, despite the hazy ideas as to
-colour which exist at home. There is a little trifle of nine hundred
-thousand full-blooded white settlers, to compare with the few thousand
-native Maories still left, in the land they once owned from sea, to sea.
-Still, the Maori in New Zealand is an unmistakable fact, and a most
-picturesque fact into the bargain. To see a family taking deck passage
-on the boat--handsome dark-eyed women, with rosy cheeks in spite of
-their olive skins, and beautifully waved black hair; bright elfish
-little children; dogs and cats and a sack or two for luggage--: is
-an interesting spot in the day’s experience, especially when some
-patronising passenger, accustomed to “natives” in other countries, gets
-one of the delightful set-downs the Maori can give so effectively.
-For all their shapeless clothing and heavy blankets, hatless heads and
-tattooed lips and chins, the New Zealand Maories are very much “all
-there”; and when the patronising saloon passenger struts up to one, and
-remarks: “Tenakoe (good-day), Polly! You got ums nicey little fellow
-there, eh?”
-
-“Polly” will probably reply in excellent English: “My name happens to
-be Te Rangi, not Polly; and as for the child you are referring to, I
-believe it belongs to the lady in the yellow plaid sitting aft!”
-
-At the end of the day comes an hotel, standing on a wooded cliff above
-the river, and looking down upon a long lovely stretch of winding water
-and high-piled forest. The night is spent here, and in the morning
-comes the coach, with its team of four fine satin-skinned bays, its
-many-coated driver, its portmanteaux on the roof, mysterious little
-parcels in the “boot,” and confidential letters in coachman’s hat, for
-all the world like something in Charles Dickens. There is no bugle and
-no guard, and the coach itself is a high, long-legged, spidery thing
-enough, not even painted red, and though it is “Merry Christmas” time, it
-is a warm summer day, with some prospect of thundery rain, but not
-the faintest of any typical Dickensesque Christmas weather. Still, the
-sentiment is there, so one may as well make the most of it.
-
-All day, muddy roads and straining horses; all day, a long pull up-hill;
-half the day rain in the wet lovely bush, starring and sparkling the
-exquisite tree ferns, those fine ladies of the forest; crystal-dropping
-the thick coat of ferns that tapestries the tall cliffs, shutting in our
-road. Beneath the wheel curve innumerable black-green gorges, deep
-and dark as Hades, gurgling in their mysterious depths with unseen
-full-throated streams and half-glimpsed waterfalls. About and above
-us rises the impenetrable “bush”--tall green trees, feathery, cedary,
-ferny, flowery, set as close together as the spires of moss on a
-velvet-cushioned stone, shutting out half the sky; marking off an
-unmistakable frontier between the territory of still unconquered Nature
-and the regions wrested from her by toiling Man. Wood-pigeons flash
-their blue-grey wings across the valleys; the merry mournful _tui_
-flutes “piercing sweet by the river,” undisturbed by our rattling
-wheels. There are wild creatures in plenty, further back in the
-bush--wild boars, wild cattle, wild cats, and “dingoes” or dogs--all
-originally escaped from civilisation, but now as wild as their own
-savage ancestors. The feathery bracken, that carpets all the banks by
-the wayside, was, and indeed still is, a staple food of the Maories.
-Its young roots are excellent eating, being rather like asparagus,
-and reasonably nourishing when nothing better can be had--and the
-white-flowered tea-tree--one of the tree-heath family---has often
-furnished a “colourable imitation” of China tea, to the benighted
-bush-wanderer run out of the genuine leaf. This bush about us is all
-Maori land. Maories alone can find their way easily and safely through
-its pathless mysteries. No, there is no avoiding the Maori, anywhere in
-the North Island!
-
-Dinner, warm and grateful and unspeakably comforting, is met with at
-a little inn in a little settlement whose name (of course) begins with
-Wai. The towns in North New Zealand that do not begin with Wai begin
-with Roto. There are a few others, but they hardly count. We are all
-amazingly cheerful when we issue forth warmed and fed; and the cold
-wind that is beginning to blow down from the icy mountain peaks just
-out of sight, is encountered’ without any British-tourist grumbling.
-The driver explains that the wind ought not to be so cold--never is
-in December (the New Zealand June); but somehow, this is “a most
-exceptional season,” and there has been a lot of rain and cold that they
-don’t generally have. Across twelve thousand miles of sea my mind leaps
-back to home; I feel the raspy air of the English spring nipping my
-face, and hear the familiar music of the sweet old English lie about
-the weather. It is a dear home-like lie, and makes me feel that New
-Zealand is indeed what it claims to be--the Britain of the Southern
-Cross.
-
-The effect of dinner is wearing off, and the insides are saying things
-about the weather that make a lonely wanderer like myself long to clasp
-the speakers warmly by the hand--because they sound so English. Now I
-understand what puzzled me a good deal at first--the difference between
-the Americanised, Continentalised Australians and the perfectly British
-New Zealander. The Briton cannot retain his peculiar characteristic in
-a climate like that of Australia; deprived of his natural and national
-grumble about the changeable weather, he is like a dog without a
-bark--an utterly anomalous being, But the New Zealand climate is windy
-and showery, given to casting autumn in the lap of spring and throwing
-winter into the warm, unexpecting arms of summer. So the Briton of the
-South, settled among his familiar weather “samples,” remains like the
-Briton of the North; and the travelling Englishman or Englishwoman,
-visiting New Zealand, feels more entirely at home than in any other
-quarter of the globe. It is only fair to New Zealand, however, to add
-that the average summer, beginning in December, is at worst very much
-warmer and pleasanter than the English spring or winter, and at best, a
-season of real delight.
-
-Late and dark and cold is the evening when we rattle up to the
-accommodation house planted in a strange desert spot, where the night is
-to be passed. Another coach comes in and discharges its load by-and-by.
-The Dickensonian flavour increases, as we of the earlier coach sit round
-the great ingle-nook fire of blazing logs in the coffee-room, silently
-surveying the new comers, while they shed their many wraps and crowd
-about the blaze. To how many Early Victorian tales--Dickens, Bulwer
-Lytton, G. P. R. James--have not the lonely inn and the late arriving
-guest been the familiar commencement!
-
-But the three Maories, man and two women, alighting from the coach
-and taking their place in the warm room, break through the illusion
-of Victorian romance at a touch, as a passing figure breaks through a
-gossamer cobweb stretched across a furzy path. Even G. P. R. could have
-had no dealings with those tall bundled-up, black-eyed, self-possessed
-beings from the bush. He would have turned them out in despair,
-or turned himself out, and gone back to his mysterious,
-Spanish-complexioned gentlemen in furred riding-cloaks.
-
-A nipping early morning sees us off at seven o’clock; the discontented
-innkeeper, with (apparently) a dark crime on his conscience, seeing
-us go with obvious relief. It is too evident that like rather many
-backwoods hotelkeepers, he regards the harmless necessary traveller in
-the unflattering light of “the pig that pays the rint.”
-
-Ruapehu’s giant cone, covered with dazzling snow, soars 3,000 feet into
-heaven above us. We are high up ourselves, for we pass the 4,000 foot
-level later on, rather cold and cross, and inclined to regard the little
-flag of hot smoke creeping out of the crest of Ngaurhoe, a smaller
-volcano ahead, as the most desirable thing in nature. Brumbies (wild
-horses) skim the plains below us, quick-moving little dots of black
-against the buff-colour of river valleys and fiats of sand. “There’s a
-fellow hunting those at present,” volunteers the driver--“catches and
-breaks them, and gets thirty shillings apiece for them for youngsters to
-ride to school. The kids must have something, you know, and the brumbies
-are wiry little brutes.”
-
-No one walks on two legs in New Zealand, apparently. I recollect
-a picture that the coach passed only yesterday evening--a man on
-horseback, and two dogs, fetching home a cow and her calf from a pasture
-a quarter of a mile away from the homestead. In England the whole outfit
-of man, horse, and dogs would have been represented by one small child
-with a pinafore and a stick. Other countries, other manners.
-
-One o’clock, forty-two miles out, with a stop for a fresh team; and we
-now enter a valley where we are met by the strange sight of a puff of
-steam rising from a bushy dell, and a little river that glides along
-with smoky vapours curling up from its surface. We are in the hot-water
-country at last; this is Tokaanu, and from here to Rotorua, ninety miles
-away, the earth is dotted, every now and then, with boiling springs,
-erupting geysers, hot lakes, and warm rivers. In all this country you
-need never light a fire to cook, unless you choose; never heat water to
-wash your pots and pans, or to bath yourself. The Maories, and many of
-the whites, steam all their food instead of boiling or baking it; and as
-for hot baths, an army might enjoy them all day long.
-
-The valley is warm and pleasant; Lake Taupo lies before us, thirty miles
-long, wide and blue and beautiful as the sea, sentinelled by tall peaks
-of dazzling white and purest turquoise, and all embroidered about the
-shores with gold braiding of splendid _Planta Genista_ scattered in
-groves and hedges of surpassing richness. Three hours in a tiny steamer
-brings us, To the othér side; and here, the sights of the hot-water
-country fairly begin.
-
-The Spa Hotel, at Taupo (where one passes the night and as many days as
-one has time for), is a museum; an exhibition, and very-good joke, all
-in itself. One might fairly describe it as hashed hotel, served up with
-excellent sauce. You find bits of it lost in a wilderness of rose and
-rhododendron, at the end of a garden path; half a dozen bedrooms,
-run away all along among the honeysuckles to play hide-and-seek;
-a drawing-room isolated like a lighthouse in a sea of greenery; a
-dining-room that was once a Maori assembly-house, and is a miracle of
-wildly grotesque carvings, representing, the weirdest of six-foot goblin
-figures, eyed and toothed; with pearl-shell, and carved in the highest
-of alto relievo, all down the walls. White sand pathways, run, between,
-the various fragments of the hotel; a hot stream, breathing curly vapour
-as it goes, meanders, about the grounds, captured here and there in deep
-wooden ponds, under rustic roofs, or hemmed in by walls and concealing
-trees, to make the most attractive of baths. There is sulphur, and soda
-and free sulphuric acid in these, waters; one spring, welling up all
-by itself, has iodine. For rheumatism, skin diseases, and many blood
-diseases, these constantly running pools are almost a certain cure. It
-seems a shocking waste of golden opportunities to let this chance go by
-without being healed of something; but I can only collect, a cold in the
-head, a grazed ankle, and a cracked lip, to meet the occasion--of all
-which evils the baths at once relieve me, offering in their place
-an appetite which must seriously impair my popularity with the
-proprietress, though I am bound to say she hides her feelings nobly.
-
-There is a celebrated “porridge pot,” or mud volcano, near this hotel.
-I have not time to see it; therefore I leave it with gentle reproaches
-ringing in my ears, and hints to the effect that I shall be haunted on
-my deathbed by unavailing regret. But I meet the Waikato River directly
-after, and at once forget everything else. Never anywhere on this earth,
-except in the hues of a peacock’s breast shining in the sun, have I
-seen such a marvellous blue-green colour as that of this deep, gem-like,
-splendid stream. And the golden broom on its banks, the golden broom
-on the heights, the golden broom everywhere--bushes eight and ten feet
-high, all one molten flame of burning colour, with never a leaf to be
-seen under the conflagration of riotous blossom--what is the English
-broom, or the English gorse, compared to this?
-
-All the six miles to Wairakei, we follow the Waikato River; watch it
-sink into a deep green gorge; break into splendid foam and spray down
-a magnificent fall, that alone might make the fortune of any hotel in a
-less richly dowered country; wind underneath colossal tree-clad cliffs,
-in coils and streaks of the strange emerald-blue that is the glory of
-the river, and finally bend away towards the Arateatea Rapids. Another
-hotel built after the charming fashion of the Taupo hostelry, receives
-the coach occupants. The style of architecture sets one thinking.
-Where, twenty years ago, did out-of-the-way New Zealand light upon the
-“pavilion” system, that is the very latest fancy of all modern-built
-sanatoria? Has the liability to occasional small earthquake tremors
-anything to do with it? Whatever the cause may be, the result is that
-the fresh-air system is in full swing in nearly all the New Zealand
-thermal resorts; that doors and windows are always open, paths take the
-place of passages, and everybody acquires the complexion of a milkmaid
-and the appetite of a second-mate.
-
-The hot outdoor swimming bath is a toy with which one really cannot stop
-playing. It is something so new and so amusing to dive into a bath 90
-feet long and 102 deg. Fahrenheit as to heat; swim about like marigolds
-in broth, in a temperature that would cook an egg in a few minutes, and
-all the time see the exquisite weeping willows wave overhead, the tall
-grasses stand on the bank, the wild clematis tremble in the trees above
-the pool. After the hot dip, one steps over a partition into another
-bathful of cool spring water, only 68° in heat, to cool down; and then
-comes dressing in a little bath-box (shut off from the grounds, like all
-the bath, by a high board fence), followed by a two minutes’ walk back
-to the house. But again, when night comes on, and the moon silvers the
-weeping willows to the semblance of pale frost-foliage on an icy pane,
-and the dim wraith-like vapours of the pool float up in ghostly shapes
-and shadows about the darkness of the inner boughs, one is tempted to
-come down once more, gliding hurriedly through the chill night air to
-the pool, locking the door, and floating for an hour or more in the
-dim, warm, drowsy waters. Cold? No one ever gets cold from the thermal
-waters, even if the cool dip is left out. That is one of their chiefest
-charms.
-
-With the morning, I am informed that life will not be worth living to me
-any more, if I do not see the Geyser Canon. Some one declares that it
-is the most beautiful sight in New Zealand; some one else says that it
-frightens you most delightfully, in the safest possible way; and “one
-low churl, compact of thankless earth,” says that it is extremely
-instructive. This last calumny I must at once deny. Interesting, to the
-deepest degree, the Wairakei Geysers are; suggestive also beyond any
-other geological phenomena in New Zealand; but instructive, after the
-tedious scientific-evenings fashion of our childhood, they are not. They
-are too beautiful for that, and too fascinating. One ought, no doubt,
-to absorb a great deal of geological information during the tour of the
-valley, but one is so busy having a good time that one doesn’t. Which is
-exactly as it should be.
-
-Coming round the corner of the path that leads to the geysers, one sees
-a column of white steam rising over the shoulder of the hill, among the
-greenery of tea-tree and willow, exactly like the blowing-off steam of
-some railway engine, waiting at a station. It is indeed an engine that
-is blowing off steam; but the engine is rather a big one--nothing less,
-indeed, than that admirable piece of work, Mother Earth herself. Ingle,
-the guide, now comes out of a tin-roofed cottage at the entrance to the
-valley, and starts to show us the wonders of the place.
-
-Now be it known that Mr. Ingle is a very remarkable character, and
-second only to the geysers themselves, as a phenomenon of singular
-interest. He is one of the very few men in the world who know all about
-geysers, and quite the only one who can literally handle and work’ them.
-Ingle knows how to doctor a sick geyser as well as any stableman can
-doctor a horse; he can induce it to erupt, keep it from doing so, or
-make it erupt after his fashion, and not after its own. He is the author
-of at least two scientific discoveries of some importance, combining
-the effects of steam pressure on rocks and the incidence of volcanoes
-along certain thermal lines. In fact, what Ingle does not know about the
-interior of the earth, and the doings down there, is not worth knowing;
-and he tells us much of it as he takes us over the canon. Instructive?
-Certainly not. It is all gossip about volcanoes and geysers--personal,
-interesting, slightly scandalous gossip (because the behaviour of
-some of them, at times, and the tempers they exhibit, _are_ simply
-scandalous); but not “instructive”; assuredly not.
-
-The average tourist likes to have every sight named--romantically or
-comically named, if possible--and his tastes have been fully considered
-in the Geyser Canon. I am not going to quote the guide-book titles of
-the dozen or two thermal wonders exhibited by Ingle. Staircases of
-pink silica, with hot water running down them; boiling pools of white
-fuller’s earth, with miniature volcanoes and geysers pock-marked all
-over them: sapphire-coloured ponds, where one can see fifty feet of
-scalding depths; the great Wairakei Geyser, casting up huge fountains of
-boiling steam and spray every seven minutes; twin geysers living in one
-pool of exquisite creamy stalactites, and erupting every four minutes
-with the punctuality of a watch; geysers that throb exactly like the
-paddles of a steamer, or beat like the pulse of an engine; geysers
-that throw up great white balls of steam through crystal funnels of hot
-water; geysers that cast themselves bodily out of their beds at regular
-intervals, leaving you with exactly nine minutes in which to scramble
-down the hot wet rock of the funnel, stagger through the blinding steam
-that rises from the rents and fissures at the bottom, and climb up the
-other side again, into coolness and safety, to wait and watch the
-roaring water burst up through the rock once more; geysers that make
-blue-green pools oh the lip of milky and ruddy terrace of carven silica;
-that explode like watery cannon, in definite rows, one after another;
-that build themselves nests like birds, send boiling streams under
-rustic bridges, scatter hot spray and steam over’ richly drooping ferns,
-and plant rainbow haloes on a scalding cloud of mist, high above the
-clustering trees of the valley--these are the sights of the canon, and
-they need no childish names to make them interesting. When a visitor
-gets into the Geyser Canon he is like a fly in a spider’s web. He
-cannot get away from this colossal variety entertainment. He runs from a
-nine-minute geyser to see a four-minute geyser do its little “turn,” and
-by this time the number is up for the seven-minute performance of the
-great star, so he hurries there; and after that he must just go back
-and see the twin geysers do another four-minute trick, and then there is
-quite another, which will do a splendid “turn” in twenty-seven minutes’
-time, if he only waits--and so half a day is gone, without any
-one noticing the flight of time, until the sudden occurrence of a
-“passionate vacancy,” not at all connected with the geysers or their
-beds, informs the traveller that another meal-time has, unperceived,
-come round.
-
-The Arateatea Rapids fill in the afternoon. From the high road where the
-open coach stands waiting, down through a pretty woodland of greenery
-and shadow and thick soundless moss, one follows a narrow pathway
-towards an ever-increasing sound of rushing, tumbling, and thundering,
-out, at last, on to a projecting point where one stands right over a
-rocky canon filled almost to the brim with a smother of white rolling
-foam, woven through with surprising lights of clear jade green and
-trembling gold. And here, on the brink of this half-mile of rapids, over
-the roaring water, I give it up. I do not attempt to describe it. When
-you take a great river, exceptionally deep and swift, and throw it
-over half a mile of sloping cliff, things are bound to happen that are
-somewhat beyond the power of pen and ink to render. Who has ever read a
-description of a waterfall, anywhere, written by any one that conveyed
-an impression worth a rotten nut? Every one who goes to see Arateatea
-must manufacture his own sensations on the spot. Sheer fright will
-certainly be one of them; not at anything the innocent rapids are doing
-to the beholder, but at the bare notion of what they might do, one foot
-nearer--one step lower down--one---- Let me have a couple of trees to
-hold on to, please. Thank you, that is better.
-
-Many years ago, a party of twenty Maories had a narrow escape from the
-cruel embraces of snow-white Arateatea. They were canoeing on the upper
-river; and, partly because the trout in the Waikato are the biggest
-trout in the world, partly because some of the rowers had had too much
-fun at a “tangi,” or wailing party, the night before, and were not very
-clear-headed, they forgot to think of the current until it had them
-fairly in its clutch, whirling them along only a mile or two above the
-terrible rapids. They could not reach the shore, and they dared not
-swim. One would have supposed that nothing could save them from being
-beaten to pieces against the cruel rocks in the rapids--yet they escaped
-that fate.
-
-They went over the Huka Falls, which come a mile or two above the rapids
-(the Maories had forgotten all about that) and were decently drowned
-instead.
-
-I am sorry that the above is not a better story; but the fact is, that
-tourists are not very plentiful about Wairakei, and the natives have not
-yet learned to invent the proper tourist tale. That is about the best
-they can do as yet.
-
-It will hardly be credited, but there is not even a Lover’s Leap in the
-whole valley; not a story of an obstinate father who got opportunely
-boiled in a geyser, while his daughter eloped down a scalding river in a
-motor-boat worked by the steam from the surface--nor a tale of a flying
-criminal pursued by executioners, who leaped from side to side of a
-gorge some thirty feet across and got away. This is certainly remiss of
-the authorities; but I have no doubt the Government Tourist Department
-would take the matter up, and supply the necessary fiction, if suitably
-approached.
-
-[Illustration: 0470]
-
-In the meantime travellers must be satisfied with the rather bald and
-uninteresting tale of a Maori maiden named Karapiti, who jumped into the
-steam blow-hole bearing her name, because her _fiancé_ did not meet her
-there on Sunday afternoon as arranged to take her to afternoon tea at
-the Wairakei Hotel. At least, that is one version of the tale, and it is
-quite enough for the Smith family from London, and other representative
-tourists.
-
-“You should have given yourself more time.”
-
-“Whatever you are going to do later on, this place really requires at
-least a week.”
-
-“You cannot possibly miss so-and-so, or this and that!” Such are
-the reproaches that haunt the hasty traveller through the Hot-Water
-Country--reproaches fully deserved in nearly every case, for very few
-tourists who journey to New Zealand realise the amount of time that
-should be spent in seeing the miracles of the volcanic zone, if nothing
-really good is to be omitted.
-
-It results in an unsatisfactory compromise as a rule--some “sights”
- being seen; many passed over. There is always something fascinating just
-ahead, calling the traveller on, and something wonderful close at hand,
-which demands the sacrifice of yet another day, before moving. Such a
-superfluity of beautiful and wonderful sights can assuredly be found
-nowhere else on earth. Iceland is far inferior; the famous Yellowstone
-Park of America has only a stepmother’s helping of what might be New
-Zealand’s “left-overs.” The lovely, lamented Pink and White Terraces
-are by many supposed to have been the only great thermal wonder of the
-country. This is so far from being the truth that only a good-sized
-volume could fairly state the other side of the question. I have never
-met any traveller through the thermal districts who had succeeded in
-seeing everything of interest. All whom I saw were as hard at work as
-the very coach-horses themselves--walking, driving, climbing, scrambling
-each hour of every day, and often thoroughly overdoing themselves,
-in the plucky attempt to carry away as much as possible from this
-over-richly spread banquet of Nature’s wonders.
-
-I squeezed out an afternoon for Karapiti (the “Devil’s Trumpet”) and
-the Valley of the Coloured Lakes. By this time I was a little jaded with
-sight-seeing, disposed to talk in a hold-cheap tone of anything that
-was not absolutely amazing, and to taste all these weirdly impressive
-marvels with a very discriminating palate. Karapiti, however, is cayenne
-to any jaded taste. It is known as the “Safety-Valve of New Zealand,”
- and the term is peculiarly fitting. The whole of the Hot-Water Country
-is only one plank removed from the infernal regions; it almost floats
-upon the scalding brow of molten rock, liquid mineral, and vaporised
-water, that composes the earth interior immediately below. That it
-is perfectly safe to live in (a constant wonder to outsiders) is very
-largely due to just those steam blow-holes and geysers which excite the
-fears of the nervous-minded--and the colossal dragon-throat of Karapiti
-is the most important safety-valve of all.
-
-Walking up the hill’ to the blow-hole, many hundred yards off, one hears
-its loud unvarying roar, like the steam-thunder that comes from an ocean
-liner’s huge funnel, when the ship is ready to cast loose from shore.
-The ground as one gets nearer is jutted and uneven, and perceptibly warm
-in certain spots. Rounding a corner, one comes suddenly upon the Devil’s
-Trumpet, a funnel-shaped opening, ten feet across at the lip, in the
-bottom of a cupshaped hollow. A fierce jet of steam rushes out from the
-Trumpet, thick and white as a great marble column, and roaring horribly
-as it comes forth. The pressure is no less than 180 lb. to one square
-inch, and the rush of this gigantic waste-pipe never slackens or ceases,
-night or day; nor has it done so within the memory of man.
-
-“If it did, I’d look for another situation pretty sharp, for it wouldn’t
-be ’ealthy to stay around Wairakei no more,” observes one guide, who
-is showing off the monster to us by throwing a kerosene can into the
-jet, and catching it as it is violently flung back to him, many yards
-away. “I can throw a penny the same,” he says, and does so, getting back
-the coin promptly, a good deal hotter than it went in.
-
-One of the ladies of our party is nearly reduced to tears by the
-sinister aspect, the menacing horror of the spot. She begs to be taken
-away, because she knows she will dream about it. She does dream about
-it; I know that, because I do myself, that night; and the dreams are
-not nice. Still, I would face them again for another look at roaring
-Karapiti. It is a wonder of wonders, a horror of horrors, unlike
-anything else in the world. On the whole, I am glad of that last fact.
-Too much Karapiti would certainly get on one’s nerves.
-
-There have never been any accidents to travellers here. No one could
-fall down the hole, because the funnel narrows rapidly, and is only
-about two feet across in the inner part. All the same, one cannot safely
-approach very near, for there is an in-rush as well as an out-rush,
-and if any one did fall victim to it, and stumble into the funnel, the
-highly condensed steam would strip the flesh from his bones as quickly
-as a cherry is shelled off its stone.
-
-The Valley of the Coloured Lakes came next. I wonder what the
-inhabitants of Brighton or Bath would do--how they would advertise, how
-they would cry for visitors--if they had a valley at their very
-gates which contained a scalding hot river, tumbling over pink and
-cream-coloured cascades of china-like silica, in clouds of steamy
-spray--a great round pond, set deep in richest forest, and coloured
-vivid orange, with red rocks round the brim; another, crude Reckitt’s
-blue; another, staring verdigris green; another, raspberry pink; others
-still, yellow as custard and white as starch! All these ponds are hot;
-they are coloured by the various minerals they hold In solution, but
-they have not yet been chemically analysed, so it is only possible
-to speculate as to the exact cause of the colours. Seen from a height
-above, the ponds resemble nothing so much as a number of paint-pots;
-and that, indeed, is one of the names by which the valley is generally
-known.
-
-Leaving behind me, unlooked at, still more than I had seen, I took coach
-again next morning for Rotorua. It was an early and a chilly start, for
-we had over thirty miles to do before lunch. The light, springy coach,
-with its leather-curtain sides, was filled with a cheerful party, all
-young, all enjoying themselves heartily, and all full of the genial good
-spirits that come of much open air and a holiday frame of mind. _New_
-New Zealand at its best was represented there, much as Old New Zealand
-was represented by the silent bearded men, with the lonely-looking eyes,
-who travelled in the Pipiriki and Waiouru stages of the journey.
-
-How fast the spanking team swings in along the road! How lovely the
-changing panorama of the encircling hills, now velvet-brown with rich
-green dells and valleys, now far-off pansy-purple, now palest grey,
-seamed with crimson streaks of hematite! The air is very clear to-day,
-with that strange New Zealand clearness that changes every-distance to
-sea-blue crystal, and pencils every shadow sharp and square.
-
-We have left the royal gold broom behind us; but the beautiful manuka
-scrub of the valleys is in full blossom, exquisitely tipped and touched
-with white lace-like blossoms. It is almost as if a heavy hoar-froat had
-misted over every delicate green bough with finest touches of silver.
-Arum lilies bloom in the ditches; the Maori flax, like tall iris leaves,
-wanders wildly over hill and valley; great fields of Pampas grass wave
-their creamy plumes over the shot green satin of thick-growing leaves.
-Wild horses, as the coach goes by, look warily out from behind some
-woody knoll, or canter away across the plains with their long-legged
-foals. Some of them are fine creatures, too, worth catching and
-breaking, and many are taken there from time to time. What a happy land,
-where a man can go out and pick a fine horse in a mountain meadow, much
-as you pick a daisy at home!
-
-Lunch-time befalls at another of the inevitable Wais--Waiotapu, this
-time--and before the coach starts on the last stretch of eighteen
-miles to Rotorua, I go across the road to see the only one of Waiotapu’s
-sights for which I have time--the Champagne Pool and Alum Cliffs.
-
-These are to be found on a most extraordinary milk-coloured plain, which
-looks exactly as if a careless giant had been mixing colours and trying
-brushes on it, and left everything lying about. The rocks and heights,
-the deep dells with boiling pools and grumbling geysers at the bottom,
-the narrow pathways leading here and there, are spotted and streaked
-with carmine, rose madder, scarlet, primrose, bright yellow, and amber.
-The “Cliffs” are a succession of rocky heights composed of something
-very like cream fondant, which is mostly alum. At their feet opens out
-a fascinating succession of bays and inlets full of variously
-coloured water, at which I can only glance as I pass. There are two
-mustard-coloured pools, and one pale green, among them. Close at hand
-the overflow from the Champagne Pool rushes, steaming fiercely, over a
-fall of rocks which appear to have been very newly and stickily painted
-in palest primrose colour. Alum, sulphur, and hematite are responsible,
-I am told, for most of these strange hues. Sulphur and arsenic have
-coloured the Champagne Pool itself--a great green lake, almost boiling,
-and of a most amazing colour--something between the green of a peridot
-and that of Chartreuse. It has never been bottomed; the line ran out at
-900 feet when tried. The edge of all the lake is most delicately wrought
-into a coralline border of ornamental knobs and branches, canary yellow
-in colour. Its name is derived from the curious effect produced in the
-depths of the pond by a handful of sand. The water begins to cream and
-froth at once, like champagne or lemonade, and continues to do so in
-places for at least half an hour.
-
-[Illustration: 0476]
-
-And now we hurry back to the coach once more, and on to Rotorua, wonder
-of wonders, and thermal temple of every healing water known to the
-medical world.
-
-[Illustration: 0488]
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XVI
-
-_From Heaven to Hades--Gay Rotorua--Where One lives on a Pie crust--The
-Birth of a River--Horrible Tikitere--In the Track of the Great
-Eruption--Where are the Pink and White Terraces?--A Fountain fifteen
-hundred feet high--Foolhardy Feat of a Guide--How the Tourists were
-killed--A Maori Village--Soaping a Geyser--The End._
-
-RED roofs and white verandahs; straight sandy streets of immense width,
-planted with green trees, and spindling away into unnaturally bright
-blue distances; omnibuses, phaetons, motor-cars, and four-in-hands
-passing at long intervals towards the shining lakes that lie beside
-the town; puffs of white steam rising up among green gardens and open
-fields; a ring of amethyst-coloured hills surrounding the whole bright
-scene, bathed in such a white, pure, crystalline sun as never shines on
-misty England. That is Rotorua, a half-day’s journey from Auckland, and
-the centre of the wonderful geyser region of New Zealand.
-
-Every one now-a-days knows that New Zealand possesses wonderful geysers,
-but not quite everybody knows what a geyser is; and certainly very
-few are aware of the extraordinary richness and variety of the geyser
-country. Geysers are intermittent fountains of boiling water, in height
-from a couple of feet up to fifteen hundred--the enormous altitude
-reached by Waimangu the Terrible, greatest geyser of the whole world.
-They consist of a shaft reaching down from the surface of the earth to
-deep, very highly heated reservoirs of steam and boiling water below;
-and (usually) of a siliceous basin surrounding the shaft-opening,
-and full of hot water. Some geysers open in the centre of a cone of
-siliceous sinter, built up by the deposits from the water, and have no
-basin.
-
-[Illustration: 0492]
-
-The periodic explosions of active geysers are due to the following
-facts--water under heavy pressure requires a much higher temperature
-to boil than water free from pressure. While the water high up in the
-geyser pipe may be a little under 212 degrees, that in the lower levels
-may be standing at 50 or 60 degrees higher, and only kept from expanding
-into steam by the weight of the column above it. If anything lessens
-that weight or increases the temperature of the lower water, this latter
-will explode into steam, and drive the upper waters high into air with
-the force of its exit from the shaft. This, briefly, is the theory of
-geyser action.
-
-Rotorua itself, the great focus of the healing forces of Nature in the
-geyser district, is simply a crust over a mass of hot springs, charged
-with various minerals. Three feet under earth you will find hot water,
-in nearly any part of the town. There are hundreds of hot springs in the
-neighbourhood that have never been analysed. Of the many that are in use
-in the Government Sanatorium, the “Priest’s Water” and “Rachel Water”
- are the most famous. The former cures rheumatism, gout, and blood
-diseases, while “Rachel” makes her patrons “beautiful for ever” by
-curing all forms of skin trouble, and bestowing a lovely complexion, not
-to speak of the remarkable effects of the spring on nervous affections.
-There are also wonderful hot swimming baths, much patronised by the
-casual tourist; baths of hot volcanic mud, and baths of hot sulphur
-vapour rising direct from the burning caverns under the earth.
-
-But for people who are in good health, it is the “sights” of Rotorua
-that are the chief attractions, and these are very many. One of the
-loveliest, and a welcome change from the countless hot-water springs,
-is Hamurana, surely the most beautiful river source in the world. It is
-reached by a journey across one of the lakes in a steamer. All the way
-the great lake ripples purest turquoise under a high, clear, cloudless
-sky; green islands rise bright and cool from its shining surface,
-sharply peaked and shadowed mountains, on the distant shores, stand out
-in strange hues of crystalline hyacinth unknown to our northern climes.
-By-and-by the little steamer leaves us on a green wooded shore, and we
-take boat up a fairy river to a region of enchanted beauty. Blossoming
-trees line the sun-steeped banks; the water is of the strangest
-colours--jade-green, clear molten sapphire, silver/ emerald, and
-transparent as a great highway of rock crystal. Enormous trout, weighing
-up to twenty pounds, rush from under our keel; grass-green and rose-red
-water weeds quiver far beneath the oar. Wild fuchsias, wild cherries,
-loaded with scarlet fruit, snowy-flowered tea-tree, arum lilies, yellow
-broom, and pink dog-roses, hang out over the water. But a few hundred
-yards, and the big lovely river comes to a sudden end, walled in
-by blossoming bushes, and apparently cut short in the strangest’ of
-culs-de-sac. In reality it is the source we have reached; here the whole
-Hamurana stream springs full-grown from the earth. A great rift in the
-bed of the glassy river is visible, where the water wells up under our
-keel in wavering masses of amber, aquamarine, and deep blue, shot with
-glancing arrows of prismatic light. Five million gallons are poured
-forth from this deep cold cavern every twenty-four hours--each drop as
-clear as a diamond, and as pure. The force of the upspringing stream
-is so great that pennies can be thrown in from the boat without sinking,
-to the bottom of the cavern--the water sends them back, and casts them
-out into the shallows about the edge of the rift. Sometimes a small
-silver coin will slip down into depths, and lie glittering many fathoms
-below, magnified conspicuously by the transparent water. The Maori
-natives, who are marvellous divers, have tried time and again to
-reach-this tempting store of treasure; but no man can stem the uprushing
-torrent of water, and if the coins were gold, they would be as safe
-as they are now from being taken by human hands. The most determined
-suicide could not drown himself in the Hamurana River source, for the
-stream about the source is shallow, and the cavern water itself would
-not permit him to sink, however willing he might be.
-
-The Valley of Tikitere, some ten miles from Rotorua, is the greatest
-contrast that could possibly be conceived to Hamurana’s enchanted
-loveliness. Enchanted indeed this valley also plight be, but by a spell
-of evil. It is the nearest possible approach to the familiar conception
-of hell. A stretch of white siliceous soil, streaked here and there with
-the blood-coloured stains of hematite, or the livid yellow of sulphur,
-is pitted all over with lakes, pools, and small deep pot-holes of
-boiling mud, sometimes thick, sometimes thin, but always scalding,
-bubbling, spirting, and threatening. Chief of all the horrors is the
-well-named lake, “Gates of Hell.” Standing upon a bank of white earth
-that is warm underfoot, and seamed with steaming cracks, one looks down
-upon a ghastly hellhole of a seething cauldron, slimy black in colour,
-and veiled with stinging mists that only now and then lift sufficiently
-to show the hideous surface of the lake. The foul broth of which it is
-composed bubbles and lifts ceaselessly, now and then rising into ominous
-heights and waves that seem about to break upon the banks above. The
-heat reaches our faces, as we stand half-stifled on the pathway. Just
-beside us, a large pool of bubbling mud, which stands constantly at 2120
-Fahrenheit--ordinary boiling point--seems almost cool in comparison.
-Little wonder that is so; for the “Gates of Hell” is largely composed of
-sulphuric acid, and its surface temperature is 232°.
-
-[Illustration: 0463]
-
-Beyond lies a perfect wilderness of boiling mud-holes of every kind.
-Here, there is a pond of mud as thick as porridge; there, one fluid as
-cream. Here, the deadly, scalding surface lies innocently smooth and
-unrippled; there, it leaps and thunders like a young volcano in action.
-
-At one corner we come suddenly upon an ugly black archway, leading to
-no inviting interior; nothing can be seen within; but the loud gurglings
-and chokings of the seething depths inside restrain any desire for
-closer observation, “The Heavenly Twins,” derisively so-named, are two
-boiling mud-lioles not a foot apart, but quite unconnected; one boils
-the thickest of brews, while its twin concocts the thinnest.
-
-One must follow the guide closely and carefully about these ghastly
-wonders. One step off the pathway, and a horrible death awaits the
-careless walker. Even the path itself is only cool and solid on the
-outside skin. The guide stops now and then to dig his stick into the
-whitey-brown earth for a couple of inches, and turn up a clod all
-glittering on the under-side with fresh crystals of sulphur. This
-under-side is so hot that one can hardly touch it with the unprotected
-hand.
-
-From one deep mud-hole, of a comparatively reasonable temperature, mud
-is taken out for medical uses. It is wonderfully effective as a bath,
-for soothing pain and curing sleeplessness. Further on, on safe ground,
-one can see a hot waterfall about twenty feet high, in temperature about
-100°, which is used as a douche bath by invalids of many kinds, with
-remarkable results.
-
-On the edges of the valley, I see for the first time in detail exactly
-how the “fumarole,” or steam blow-hole, is used for cooking purposes.
-Over the opening of a small manageable blow-hole, an inch or two across,
-is placed a box without a bottom. The food to be cooked is placed in the
-box, either in a pot, or wrapped in leaves. The lid is then put on, and
-covered with clay. In an hour or so the meat or stew is done to a
-turn; and even if left too long, it cannot be burned. One blow-hole,
-in constant use by the Maories, is not steam at all, but hot sulphur
-vapour, which deposits a crust of sulphur on everything it touches. This
-does not trouble the Maori, however; he eats his food quite contentedly,
-with a strong sulphurous flavour added to its natural taste, and says
-it does him good. Certainly, the natives living about Tikitere are
-unusually strong and hearty in appearance, and never troubled with any
-kind of illness.
-
-People of middle age will doubtless remember vividly the impression
-created all over the world in 1886 by the eruption of the great volcano
-Tarawera, and the destruction of New Zealand’s most cherished natural
-wonder--the peerless Pink and White Terraces of Rotomahana. Count-, less
-marvels have been left, and one new one that far outstrips the Terraces
-in sheer wonder and magnificence--Waimangu, the greatest geyser in the
-world; but New Zealand still laments her beautiful Terraces, and shows
-the spot where they lie deep, buried under ninety feet of volcanic
-débris, as though pointing out the grave of something loved and lost.
-
-A day of wonderful interest is that spent in seeing the track of the
-great eruption. Leaving Rotorua early in the morning, I saw, as the
-coach wound up the hilly road outside the town, many traces of that
-awful night and day of darkness, thunder, and terror, eighteen years
-ago. Although Rotorua is fifteen miles or more from the site of the
-Terraces, the sky was dark all the day of the eruption, and only three
-or four miles from the town black volcanic dust fell so densely as to
-leave a stratum several inches thick over the country. This is clearly
-visible in the cuttings at the side of the road, where the black stratum
-can be seen underlying the more recent layer of ordinary soil. Where the
-great coach-road to Rotomahana once ran, a chasm some sixty feet deep
-scars the mountain side, caused by the fearful rush of water that took
-place down the road-track. An earthquake crack, thirty feet deep, runs
-close to the road for a long distance. All the way up to the buried
-village of Wairoa, similar traces can be seen. But before the village
-is reached, two gems of scenic loveliness are passed--the Blue and
-Green Lakes, lying side by side, each enclosed by steep rugged hills,
-reflected clearly on its glassy surface. One is of the strangest, most
-delicate Sèvres blue--a colour, not depending on any reflection from
-above, for I saw it on a grey and cloudy day--the other is a bright
-verdigris green. “Chemicals in the water” is the very vague reason given
-by inhabitants of the district for these remarkable beauties of colour.
-
-I must note here that in no case have I succeeded in obtaining any
-satisfactory reason for the remarkable blues and greens so common in
-both the cold and hot waters of the thermal district. The Waikato River,
-a great cold stream, full of immense trout; Taupo Lake (cold); the
-coloured lakes of Wairakei and Waiotapu (hot); Hamurana Springs (cold),
-and many others, display these remarkable tints, under every sky and
-in every depth of water. Varying reasons are given, but none seem
-satisfactory. The beauty of the colouring is, at all events, certain,
-and the cause may safely be left to geologists.
-
-Wairoa Village is now a green, silent waste of young forest and rich
-grass, broken only by the ruins of the old hotel that stood there before
-the eruption, and by a few scattered traces of other human occupation--a
-fragment of wall, the rusty skeleton of an iron bedstead, lying in a
-gully; the remains of a shattered buggy. In 1886 it occupied the place
-now held by Rotorua, and was visited by numbers of tourists, all anxious
-to see the Terraces, which lay not far away at the other end of the
-chain of lakes now united in one, and called Rotomahana. On the day of
-the eruption, the roof of the hotel was broken in by red-hot falling
-stones and mud, and eleven people were killed. Some, who escaped, ran
-out and took refuge in a native “warry” or hut, which, strange to say,
-remained uninjured. Over a hundred people in all--mostly Maories--were
-killed by the eruption, which destroyed millions of acres of good land,
-swept away several native villages, and utterly altered the face of the
-whole country.
-
-Lake Tarawera, which must be crossed to see the site of the lost
-terraces, lies under the shadow of the great volcanic cone of Tarawera,
-8,000 feet high, from which much of the molten rock and burning ashes
-came. It is as lovely, in its own strange way, as the famous lakes of
-Italy and Switzerland. The water is intensely blue, and the high hills
-closing it in are of a colour unknown to most other scenery in the
-world--a strange pale barren grey, so nearly white as to be slightly
-suggestive of snow. Like snow, too, is the distribution of this coloured
-matter; it lies on the crests and projections of the hills, and is
-streaked thinly down the sides. It is ash, volcanic ash, cast out by
-the surrounding craters on that fatal night of June, 1886, and lying
-unchanged on the hills about the lake ever since. Tarawera itself towers
-above the lake, grim and dark and ominous; a mountain hot yet tamed
-by any means, and still hot, though not molten, in the interior of the
-cone.
-
-On the shores of the lake, as the launch carries us past, can be seen,
-at one spot, the whitened bones of some of the natives who perished in
-the eruption. The name and titles of one, who was a great chief, are
-painted on a rock that overhangs the shore.
-
-Rotomahana, the second lake, is also surrounded by ash-whitened hills.
-At the far end, as our second oil-launch starts to cross, we can see
-thick columns of steam rising against the grey of the cliffs. These are
-the gravestones of the lost Pink Terrace; these tall pillars of cloud
-alone mark the spot where one half of the world’s greatest wonder once
-stood. Just where the launch starts, the White Terrace was buried,
-under a hundred feet of earth and mud, deep in the bed of the lake.
-
-What were the Terraces like? New Zealand has many oil paintings of them,
-so that a clear idea of their loveliness can be formed even to-day.
-They consisted of two immense terraced slopes, formed by the action of
-downward dropping hot water heavily loaded with silicon. Every terrace
-was a succession of fairy-like baths and basins, filled with bright blue
-water. One was pure ivory-white, the other, tinged with hematite,
-was bright pink., The exquisite natural carvings and flutings of the
-silicon, the beautiful tints of the terraces, the blue sky above and
-blue lakes below, together formed a picture the like of which does not
-exist on earth to-day.
-
-Our oil-launch, sailing now over water which is actually boiling, close
-in shore, though the main body of the lake is cold, allows us to land on
-the very spot where the Pink Terrace once stood. It is a dangerous task,
-even with the aid of a guide, to pick one’s way about this stretch of
-ground, for it is nothing but a crumbling honey-comb of boiling-water
-ponds, and narrow ridges as brittle as piecrust. Over these latter we
-take our perilous way, planting each footstep slowly and carefully,
-but never standing still, for the ground is so exceedingly hot that the
-soles of one’s boots are scorched, if planted long in one place. The
-earth is choked and clouded with steam, the ponds roar and bubble about
-our feet, the blow-holes rumble. The ground is full of raw cracks, old
-and new, and as our small party steps over one of these, on the way
-back, it is seen to be visibly wider than it was on the previous coming!
-To-morrow the whole of this narrow ridge may have crumbled in and
-disappeared. No one is sorry to reach the launch again, and glide away
-from those threatening shores.
-
-A little further on, where we land for the walk up to Waimangu Geyser,
-there is a hot iodine spring, unique among medical waters, and most
-useful in many diseases. Arrangements are now being made to have the
-water collected and sent to Rotorua; up to the present, it has only been
-used by the Maories.
-
-All the three-mile walk up to the geyser is crowded with tokens of the
-great eruption. Mud cliffs a hundred feet in height were created by the
-terrible outburst, and for miles about the whole country was covered
-yards deep with the boiling slimy mass. Not only Tarawera, but three
-other craters (all visible in the high distance above the lake) were
-erupting together, for a night and a day. The eruptions took place
-without the least warning of any kind, about ten o’clock at night. The
-chain of lakes about Tarawera’s foot suddenly exploded like colossal
-bombs, blowing their entire contents, and all the mud from their
-bottoms, over the whole country-side. Tarawera and the neighbouring
-craters cast out huge jets of flame, and scattered burning masses of
-rock, ashes, and scoriæ, for many miles. The noise was terrible, and the
-sky for twenty miles around was dark at noonday. It is supposed that the
-eruption was caused by the falling in of the lake bottom, which allowed
-the water to drop into the underlying fires, and exploded the lakes
-instantly into steam.
-
-Up a great earthquake chasm, among deep volcano craters that were formed
-at the time of the eruption, we climb towards the Great Geyser. These
-craters are for the most part still in a more or less heated state,
-though grass and ferns grow in the interior of nearly all, and no
-apprehension is felt as to future outbursts. One has a hot mudpool at
-the bottom; a second spits steam from many cracks and blow-holes; a
-third, the largest of all, erupted slightly in August 1904, and threw a
-quantity of hot mud and stones out over the top.
-
-Waimangu Geyser itself, which is really more a volcano than a geyser,
-is supposed to have been formed at the time of the eruption. It did not,
-however, commence its present activity until 1900, when an enormously
-high “shot” was seen by one or two explorers camping in the
-neighbourhood, and the source at once investigated. It became apparent
-that New Zealand, in the place of the lost Terraces, had acquired the
-largest and most magnificent geyser in the whole world. The exchange is
-by no means a bad one. Waimangu attracts hundreds of travellers to the
-pretty little hotel planted on a cliff not far from the crater; and
-those who have been fortunate enough to see the geyser play, one and
-all utterly lose themselves in attempting to express the extraordinary
-majesty, wonder, and terror of the sight.
-
-The geyser is somewhat irregular in action, but generally plays every
-day or so. The water in the huge basin heaves and lifts; then an
-enormous cloud of steam rushes up, and then a column of black water,
-charged with mud and stones, flings itself upward in repeated leaps or
-“shots” through the steam, to an almost incredible height--at times as
-high as fifteen hundred feet. More than a quarter of a mile in sheer
-height is Waimangu’s biggest “shot.” On such occasions, the sky is
-darkened by the tremendous spread of the leaping waters, the earth
-trembles with the concussion, and the watching spectators, perched high
-above the crater by the shelter hut, feel as though the terrors of the
-Last Day itself were falling upon them, unprepared.
-
-In the summer of 1903 two girls and a guide were killed during the
-explosion of the geyser. The girls had been repeatedly warned, even
-entreated, not to stand near the crater, as it was momentarily expected
-to “play”; but they hovered close by the verge, anxious to secure a
-photograph. Without warning, Waimangu suddenly rose and hurled itself
-bodily skyward out of its bed. The enormous backfall of the boiling
-water caught and swept away the luckless three, and they were carried
-down the outflow valley in the flood that succeeds every eruption. When
-found, the bodies were terribly mutilated, and stripped of all clothing.
-The mother of the girls, standing higher up, saw the whole awful
-disaster, and had to be forcibly held back from rushing into the crater,
-in a wild effort to save her children. Since that melancholy day, the
-geyser basin has been railed off, in such a manner that no one can
-approach near enough to incur the slightest danger. Warbrick, the head
-guide of the district, was present, and nearly lost his life in a daring
-attempt to save the girls and the guide, who was his own brother. He
-rushed into the midst of the falling stones and water, to try and drag
-the luckless victims back, but was too late to save them, and narrowly
-escaped being carried away himself.
-
-Warbrick is the best-known guide in New Zealand, and a character
-of considerable interest. He is a halfcaste Maori, decidedly more
-intelligent than the average white man, and speaking English perfectly.
-In company with a sailor, he lately made what was probably the most
-daring boat-trip ever attempted on earth--nothing less than a voyage
-over Waimangu’s boiling basin, undertaken with the object of sounding
-the depths of the geyser. The monster often erupts without the least
-warning, sending the whole contents of its huge basin bodily skyward; so
-that the feat was one likely to shake the strongest nerve. Warbrick took
-a lead line with him, and noted the various depths of the crater basin.
-In the centre, where the great throat of the geyser opens up, no bottom
-could be found. The boat came safely to shore, after some minutes spent,
-in performing one of the most perilous feats ever attempted, even by a
-Maori.
-
-Visitors generally stay at the Government accommodation house near the
-geyser for a day or two, on the chance of seeing a good “shot,” and they
-seldom go away unrewarded. It is well worth while to cut short one’s
-stay in some other place by a couple of days, to have a chance of seeing
-the world’s greatest thermal wonder in full action, for Waimangu, when
-playing, is the sight of a lifetime. I was not fortunate enough to see
-the geyser in action, as it was undergoing a period of “sulks” at the
-time of my visit; but if it had been playing as it played some weeks
-after I left, nothing would have tempted me away from its neighbourhood
-until I had seen an eruption.
-
-One, of the great charms of the geyser country about Rotorua is its
-absolute unlikeness to anything that can be found on the other side of
-the Line. To the much-travelled wanderer, nearly all famous show-places,
-after a time, display a distressing similarity. The two or three leading
-types of peasant to be found on the Continent of Europe, grow familiar
-by-and-by. Giuseppe of Italy is not very novel to the traveller who
-still remembers Ignacio of Spain; German Wilhelm recalls Dutch
-Jan; Belgian Françoise is sister to French Mathilde. As for the
-“sights”--well, one waterfall is very like another, and lakes and ruined
-castles pall, taken in bulk. Even if the traveller wanders further
-away, he does not find much in Egypt, India, or Japan, that has not been
-greatly spoiled for him beforehand, by the countless descriptions he
-has heard and read ever since childhood. It seems almost as though the
-illimitable flood of sight-seers, past and present, rushing through all
-the famous beauty-spots of the old world, had washed away something of
-their charm--as if the air about such places were drained dry of the
-ozone of fresh delight which every lovely and wonderful spot should
-give, leaving only an atmosphere of feeling that is stale and used-up in
-the last degree.
-
-New Zealand’s “sights,” however, are (to vary the metaphor) new gems in
-a new setting. Not even the most experienced traveller can look on the
-wonders of the thermal region with an eye dulled and indifferent by
-other experiences, since there is hardly anything similar the whole
-world over. And the setting of the gems---the strange, unfamiliar
-country, oddly reversed seasons, and wild brown Maori folk, taking the
-place of European peasantry, is perhaps the greatest charm of all.
-
-For myself, the carefully revived native dances of the Maories,
-performed for money, in civilised concert halls the “haka” or war
-dance, done by children on the roads for pennies, and the modern native
-carvings, done with English tools, which are all among the most striking
-features of daily life in Rotorua, were not the real attractions of the
-place. Those lay in the common features of ordinary Maori existence,
-seen here, there, and everywhere, without pose or preparation. When one
-strolls out along the country roads near the town, it is an adventure to
-meet a party of wild-eyed, brown-faced men and women, galloping madly up
-and down hill on their rough “brumbies” (wild-horses, broken in)--both
-sexes alike wrapped in heavy blankets, and sitting astride. Wandering
-about on a bicycle, it pleasantly increases the “go-abroady” feeling
-that most travellers welcome, to coma upon a woman taking a fat fowl out
-of the steam-hole cooker, that Nature has provided just at the door
-of her thatch-roofed, reed-built “warry,” and to stop and talk for an
-interesting quarter of an hour with a barefooted, half-clad savage, who
-speaks English as good as one’s own, reads the daily papers and has his
-opinions on Mr. Seddon’s fiscal policy. The Maori guides and hangers on,
-about the best-known sights, are naturally more or less spoiled by the
-visitors. But the real Maori, of whom one gets an occasional sight, even
-about such a civilised town as Rotorua, is attractive enough to make
-one fully understand the strong regard that most New Zealanders have
-for their native friends. Dignity, pride, and the manners of an exiled
-royalty are his natural heritage. His mind is as keen as the white,
-man’s, though perhaps somewhat narrower in scope; he has a vivid sense
-of humour, strong feelings about honour and faithfulness, the courage of
-a bull-dog, and the reckless daring of an Irish dragoon. Worth knowing,
-and well worth liking when known, are the brown men and women of North
-New Zealand.
-
-The little village of Ohinemutu, less than a mile from Rotorua, is
-astonishingly Maori still, in spite of the development of the district
-for tourist travel. Go down towards the shores of the lake at the back
-of the big hotel, and you step at once into a native “pah,” built in the
-haphazard fashion peculiar to Maori settlements. There are no streets,
-and no definite beginnings or endings. The houses face every way, and
-are of many fashions; here a reed-built warry, there a house with a
-front splendidly carved and painted in old native fashion, further on
-a wooden dwelling about as large as a bathing-box, with a full-sized
-bay-window fastened on to it. Most are wooden huts with iron roofs--a
-compromise between native and European styles.
-
-Everywhere one goes, there are steaming pools with newly washed clothes
-drying on the edge, or small brown bodies happily disporting themselves
-in the water. Cooking-boxes are erected over countless steam-holes;
-and every here and there, one meets a tall brown man or woman, looking
-extremely clean and damp, and wrapped in a big coloured blanket and
-nothing else, stalking house-wards from a refreshing bath. Try to take
-a photograph, and if the Maori is accustomed to tourists, he will ask a
-shilling for the labour of posing; but if he has recently come down from
-the wilds, and is still unspoiled, he will reject an offer of coin with
-quiet dignity. Taken as nature made him, the Maori is not greedy of
-money. It is only a very few months since the Maories of the King
-country (a wild, half-claimed district in the “back blocks”) have
-allowed gold prospectors to pass through their lands. Until recently
-they admitted tourists and sportsmen freely, but refused to allow any
-one to look for gold, giving as a reason their belief, that the finding
-of gold did no country any good.
-
-Whakarewarewa, a couple of miles outside the town of Rotorua, has a very
-interesting model of a typical Maori fortified “pah,” lately completed
-by the Government. The large space of grass enclosed by the fort is
-guarded by high earth breastworks and a deep ditch. Beyond the ditch is
-an open wooden paling, apparently more for ornament than use, on which
-are placed at intervals carved wooden figures of a threatening and
-terrifying character. All of them are native work, but of modern date.
-
-The geysers of Whakarewarewa are many and famous. The most famous of all
-was the great twin geyser Waikite, whose double throat opens at the top
-of a high terraced cone, built up of siliceous sinter, deposited by
-the geyser water during long ages of action. Waikite has ceased to play
-since 1886, when the railway from Auckland to Rotorua was completed. On
-the day when the line was opened for traffic, the geyser ceased playing,
-and its fountains have never ascended since.
-
-Wairoa (Maori, “Long Water”) is now the lion of Whakarewarewa. It
-plays very seldom of its own accord, but on special occasions the local
-authorities permit it to be dosed with soap, which always produces an
-eruption. A geyser constantly physicked in this manner often gives up
-playing altogether in the end; so careful restrictions hedge round
-the operation, in the case of Wairoa. It is first necessary to procure
-consent from the Government Tourist Department in Wellington, and then
-to arrange a day and give notice to the town. The Government authorities
-in Wellington were kind enough to send an order to Rotorua to have
-Wairoa soaped for me during my stay; and I took advantage of the
-opportunity to enjoy the novel sensation of starting the geyser myself.
-
-On a Sunday afternoon of December 1904, all Rotorua assembled in a black
-crowd at “Whaka” to see Wairoa play. Rows of cameras were placed upon
-the hillocks commanding the spot; bets were freely made about the height
-and quality of the coming performance, and every one scuffled politely
-for a front place when the ceremony began. The caretaker of the grounds
-and the head guide solemnly removed the wooden cover (pierced to allow
-the escape of steam) which is padlocked over the geyser’s stony lips,
-and handed me a bag containing three bars of soap, cut up into small
-pieces. I stood on the edge of the geyser-mouth, looking down a great
-black well full of steam, and rumbling with deep, groaning murmurs from
-below, until the guide gave the word, and then emptied the bag down
-Wairoa’s throat.
-
-[Illustration: 501]
-
-Almost immediately, white lather began to form in the depths of the
-well, and rose rapidly to the verge. The guide now ordered me away from
-the geyser; for, although Wairoa generally takes some minutes to play
-after being soaped, one can never be absolutely certain that it will
-not respond with inconvenient swiftness. I went back to a neighbouring
-hillock from which an excellent view could be obtained, and waited with
-the eager crowd. Every now and then a small rush of water lifted over
-the geyser rim, and once or twice the fountain seemed about to start;
-but it was not until seventeen minutes after I had put in the soap
-that Wairoa choked, gurgled, and finally broke into a roar like a
-ten thousand ton liner throwing off steam. In another instant, still
-roaring, the geyser shot up silvery white water, dissolving at the top,
-full 140 feet above ground, into a crest of delicate streamy feathers
-all sparkling in the sun. The display lasted about a couple of minutes,
-and then sank gradually away; but for long afterwards, Wairoa mumbled
-and grumbled and frothed at the mouth, not settling down into quiet for
-at least an hour.
-
-Of Auckland--“last, loneliest, loveliest, exquisite, apart,” as Kipling
-has called it--thus compelling all later travellers to see, or at least
-pretend to see, exquisite loveliness in prosaic Queen Street, and go
-a-hunting for poetic solitudes along the quays--I have nothing to say.
-Great ports are all alike, the wide world over, and hotel is as like
-unto hotel as pebble unto pebble. And when the story is done, why
-linger?
-
-I have set forth to tell something of Britain of the South Seas, and
-such as it is, my say has been said.
-
-
-THE END
-
-
-
-
-
-
-End of Project Gutenberg's In The Strange South Seas, by Beatrice Grimshaw
-
-*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK IN THE STRANGE SOUTH SEAS ***
-
-***** This file should be named 54499-0.txt or 54499-0.zip *****
-This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
- http://www.gutenberg.org/5/4/4/9/54499/
-
-Produced by David Widger from page images generously
-provided by the Internet Archive
-
-
-Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions will
-be renamed.
-
-Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright
-law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works,
-so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United
-States without permission and without paying copyright
-royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part
-of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
-concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark,
-and may not be used if you charge for the eBooks, unless you receive
-specific permission. If you do not charge anything for copies of this
-eBook, complying with the rules is very easy. You may use this eBook
-for nearly any purpose such as creation of derivative works, reports,
-performances and research. They may be modified and printed and given
-away--you may do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks
-not protected by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the
-trademark license, especially commercial redistribution.
-
-START: FULL LICENSE
-
-THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
-PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
-
-To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
-distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
-(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full
-Project Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at
-www.gutenberg.org/license.
-
-Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-
-1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
-and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
-(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
-the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or
-destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your
-possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a
-Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound
-by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the
-person or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph
-1.E.8.
-
-1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
-used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
-agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
-things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
-paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this
-agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below.
-
-1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the
-Foundation" or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection
-of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual
-works in the collection are in the public domain in the United
-States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the
-United States and you are located in the United States, we do not
-claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing,
-displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as
-all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope
-that you will support the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting
-free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm
-works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the
-Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with the work. You can easily
-comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the
-same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg-tm License when
-you share it without charge with others.
-
-1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
-what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are
-in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States,
-check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this
-agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing,
-distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any
-other Project Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no
-representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any
-country outside the United States.
-
-1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
-
-1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other
-immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear
-prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work
-on which the phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the
-phrase "Project Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed,
-performed, viewed, copied or distributed:
-
- This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
- most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no
- restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it
- under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included with this
- eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the
- United States, you'll have to check the laws of the country where you
- are located before using this ebook.
-
-1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is
-derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not
-contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the
-copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in
-the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are
-redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply
-either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or
-obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
-with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
-must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any
-additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms
-will be linked to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works
-posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the
-beginning of this work.
-
-1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
-work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
-
-1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
-electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
-prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
-active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm License.
-
-1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
-compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including
-any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access
-to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format
-other than "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official
-version posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site
-(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense
-to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means
-of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original "Plain
-Vanilla ASCII" or other form. Any alternate format must include the
-full Project Gutenberg-tm License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
-
-1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
-performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
-unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
-access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-provided that
-
-* You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
- the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
- you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed
- to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he has
- agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid
- within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are
- legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty
- payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in
- Section 4, "Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg
- Literary Archive Foundation."
-
-* You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
- you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
- does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
- License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all
- copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue
- all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg-tm
- works.
-
-* You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of
- any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
- electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of
- receipt of the work.
-
-* You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
- distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work or group of works on different terms than
-are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing
-from both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and The
-Project Gutenberg Trademark LLC, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark. Contact the Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
-
-1.F.
-
-1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
-effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
-works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project
-Gutenberg-tm collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may
-contain "Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate
-or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
-intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or
-other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or
-cannot be read by your equipment.
-
-1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
-of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
-liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
-fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
-LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
-PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
-TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
-LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
-INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGE.
-
-1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
-defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
-receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
-written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
-received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium
-with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you
-with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in
-lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person
-or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second
-opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If
-the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing
-without further opportunities to fix the problem.
-
-1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
-in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO
-OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
-LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
-
-1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
-warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of
-damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement
-violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the
-agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or
-limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or
-unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the
-remaining provisions.
-
-1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
-trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
-providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in
-accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the
-production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses,
-including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of
-the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this
-or any Project Gutenberg-tm work, (b) alteration, modification, or
-additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any
-Defect you cause.
-
-Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
-electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of
-computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It
-exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations
-from people in all walks of life.
-
-Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
-assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
-goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
-remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
-and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future
-generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see
-Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at
-www.gutenberg.org Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
-501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
-state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
-Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
-number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by
-U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
-
-The Foundation's principal office is in Fairbanks, Alaska, with the
-mailing address: PO Box 750175, Fairbanks, AK 99775, but its
-volunteers and employees are scattered throughout numerous
-locations. Its business office is located at 809 North 1500 West, Salt
-Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up to
-date contact information can be found at the Foundation's web site and
-official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact
-
-For additional contact information:
-
- Dr. Gregory B. Newby
- Chief Executive and Director
- gbnewby@pglaf.org
-
-Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
-spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
-increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
-freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
-array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
-($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
-status with the IRS.
-
-The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
-charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
-States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
-considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
-with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
-where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND
-DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular
-state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
-have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
-against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
-approach us with offers to donate.
-
-International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
-any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
-outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
-
-Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
-methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
-ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To
-donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works.
-
-Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm concept of a library of electronic works that could be
-freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and
-distributed Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of
-volunteer support.
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
-editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in
-the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not
-necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper
-edition.
-
-Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search
-facility: www.gutenberg.org
-
-This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
-including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
-subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
-
diff --git a/old/54499-0.zip b/old/54499-0.zip
deleted file mode 100644
index 5e5f150..0000000
--- a/old/54499-0.zip
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h.zip b/old/54499-h.zip
deleted file mode 100644
index d68229c..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h.zip
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/54499-h.htm b/old/54499-h/54499-h.htm
deleted file mode 100644
index 2c7b7ec..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/54499-h.htm
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,12946 +0,0 @@
-<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
-<!DOCTYPE html
- PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN"
- "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd" >
-
-<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" lang="en">
- <head>
- <meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html;charset=UTF-8" />
- <title>In The Strange South Seas, by Beatrice Grimshaw</title>
- <meta content="pg2html (binary v0.17)" />
- <link rel="coverpage" href="images/cover.jpg" />
- <style type="text/css" xml:space="preserve">
-
- body { margin:5%; background:#faebd0; text-align:justify}
- P { text-indent: 1em; margin-top: .50em; margin-bottom: .50em; }
- H1,H2,H3,H4,H5,H6 { text-align: center; margin-left: 15%; margin-right: 15%; }
- hr { width: 50%; text-align: center;}
- .foot { margin-left: 5%; margin-right: 5%; text-align: justify; font-size: 80%; font-style: italic;}
- blockquote {font-size: 97%; font-style: italic; margin-left: 10%; margin-right: 10%;}
- .mynote {background-color: #DDE; color: #000; padding: .5em; margin-left: 10%; margin-right: 10%; font-family: sans-serif; font-size: 95%;}
- .toc { margin-left: 10%; margin-bottom: .75em;}
- .toc2 { margin-left: 20%;}
- .xx-small {font-size: 60%;}
- .x-small {font-size: 75%;}
- .small {font-size: 85%;}
- .large {font-size: 115%;}
- .x-large {font-size: 130%;}
- .indent5 { margin-left: 5%;}
- .indent10 { margin-left: 10%;}
- .indent15 { margin-left: 15%;}
- .indent20 { margin-left: 20%;}
- .indent30 { margin-left: 30%;}
- .indent40 { margin-left: 40%;}
- div.fig { display:block; margin:0 auto; text-align:center; }
- div.middle { margin-left: 20%; margin-right: 20%; text-align: justify; }
- .figleft {float: left; margin-left: 0%; margin-right: 1%;}
- .figright {float: right; margin-right: 0%; margin-left: 1%;}
- .pagenum {position: absolute; right: 1%; font-size: 0.6em;
- font-variant: normal; font-style: normal;
- text-align: right; background-color: #FFFACD;
- border: 1px solid; padding: 0.3em;text-indent: 0em;}
- .side { float: left; font-size: 75%; width: 15%; padding-left: 0.8em;
- border-left: dashed thin; text-align: left;
- text-indent: 0; font-weight: bold; font-style: italic;
- font-weight: bold; color: black; background: #eeeeee; border: solid 1px;}
- .head { float: left; font-size: 90%; width: 98%; padding-left: 0.8em;
- border-left: dashed thin; text-align: center;
- text-indent: 0; font-weight: bold; font-style: italic;
- font-weight: bold; color: black; background: #eeeeee; border: solid 1px;}
- p.pfirst, p.noindent {text-indent: 0}
- span.dropcap { float: left; margin: 0 0.1em 0 0; line-height: 0.8 }
- pre { font-style: italic; font-size: 90%; margin-left: 10%;}
-
-</style>
- </head>
- <body>
-
-
-<pre>
-
-Project Gutenberg's In The Strange South Seas, by Beatrice Grimshaw
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and most
-other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
-whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms of
-the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online at
-www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the United States, you'll have
-to check the laws of the country where you are located before using this ebook.
-
-
-
-Title: In The Strange South Seas
- With Photographs
-
-Author: Beatrice Grimshaw
-
-Release Date: April 7, 2017 [EBook #54499]
-
-Language: English
-
-Character set encoding: UTF-8
-
-*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK IN THE STRANGE SOUTH SEAS ***
-
-
-
-
-Produced by David Widger from page images generously
-provided by the Internet Archive
-
-
-
-
-
-
-</pre>
-
- <div style="height: 8em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br /><br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h1>
- IN THE STRANGE SOUTH SEAS
- </h1>
- <h2>
- By Beatrice Grimshaw
- </h2>
- <h3>
- Author Of &ldquo;From Fiji To The Cannibal Islands,&rdquo; Etc.
- </h3>
- <h4>
- London: Hutchinson &amp; Co. Paternoster Row
- </h4>
- <h3>
- 1907
- </h3>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0001" id="linkimage-0001"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0001.jpg" alt="0001 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0001.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0002" id="linkimage-0002"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0008.jpg" alt="0008 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0008.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0003" id="linkimage-0003"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0009.jpg" alt="0009 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0009.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0004" id="linkimage-0004"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0010.jpg" alt="0010 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0010.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <h3>
- IN THE STRANGE SOUTH SEAS
- </h3>
- <p class="indent15">
- In desire of many marvels over sea,
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- When the new made tropic city sweats and roars,
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- I have sailed with young Ulysses from the quay,
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- Till the anchor rattled down on stranger shores.
- </p>
- <p class="indent30">
- Kipling.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">M</span>OST men have their
- loves, happy or hopeless, among the countries of the earth. There are
- words in the atlas that ring like trumpet calls to the ear of many a
- stay-at-home in grey northern cities&mdash;names of mountains, rivers,
- islands, that tramp across the map to the sound of swinging music played
- by their own gay syllables, that summon, and lure, and sadden the man who
- listens to their fifing, as the music of marching regiments grips at the
- heart of the girl who loves a soldier.
- </p>
- <p>
- They call, they call, they call&mdash;through the long March mornings,
- when the road that leads to everywhere is growing white and dry&mdash;through
- restless summer nights, when one sits awake at the window to see the stars
- turn grey with the dawn&mdash;in the warm midday, when one hurries across
- the city bridge to a crowded eating-house, and the glittering masts far
- away down the river must never be looked at as one passes. Of a misty
- autumn evening, when steamers creeping up to seaport towns send long cries
- across the water, one here, and another there, will stir uneasily in his
- chair by the fire, and shut his ears against the insistent call.... Why
- should he listen, he who may never answer?
- </p>
- <p>
- <i>(Yokohama, the Golden Gate, Cape Horn, the Rio Grande, Agra, Delhi,
- Benares, Bombay, the Amazon, the Andes, the South Sea Islands, Victoria
- Nyanza, the Pyramids, the Nile, Lhassa, Damascus, Singapore, the tundras,
- the prairies, trade-winds, tropics, and the Line&mdash;can&rsquo;t you hear us
- calling?)</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">L</span>ove is not
- stronger than that call&mdash;let sweetheartless girls left alone, and the
- man of cities who has loved the woman of the wandering foot, give bitter
- witness. Death is not stronger&mdash;those who follow the call must defy
- him over and over again. Pride of country, love of home, delight in
- well-known faces and kindly hearts that understand, the ease of the old
- and well-tried ways, the prick of ordinary ambitions hungering for the
- showy prizes that every one may see&mdash;these are but as dead leaves
- blown before the wind, when the far-off countries cry across the seas. Not
- one in a hundred may answer the call; yet never think, you who suppose
- that love and avarice and the lust of battle sum up all the great passions
- of the world, that scores out of every hundred Englishmen have not heard
- it, all the same. &ldquo;In the heart of every man, a poet has died young&rdquo;; and
- in the heart of almost every Briton, a wanderer once has lived. If this
- were not so, the greatest empire of the world had never been.
- </p>
- <p>
- So, to The Man Who Could Not Go, I address this book&mdash;to the elderly,
- white-waistcoated city magnate, grave autocrat of his clerkly kingdom
- (never lie to me, sir&mdash;what was your favourite reading in the
- sixties, and why were you a very fair pistol shot, right up to the time
- when you were made junior manager?)&mdash;to the serious family solicitor,
- enjoying his father&rsquo;s good old practice and house, and counting among the
- furnishings of the latter, a shelf of Marryats, Mayne Reids, and Michael
- Scotts, wonderfully free of dust&mdash;to the comfortable clergyman,
- immersed in parish cares, who has the oddest fancy at times for standing
- on dock-heads, and sniffing up odours of rope and tar&mdash;to all of you,
- the army of the brave, unwilling, more or less resigned Left Behinds, who
- have forgotten years ago, or who will never, forget while spiring masts
- stand thick against blue skies, and keen salt winds wake madness in the
- brain&mdash;to all I say: Greeting! and may the tale of another&rsquo;s happier
- chance send, from the fluttering pages of a book, a breath of the far-off
- lands and the calling sea.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <p>
- <b>CONTENTS</b>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0001"> CHAPTER I </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0002"> CHAPTER II </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0003"> CHAPTER III </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0004"> CHAPTER IV </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0005"> CHAPTER V </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0006"> CHAPTER VI </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0007"> CHAPTER VII </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0008"> CHAPTER VIII </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0009"> CHAPTER IX </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0010"> CHAPTER X </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0011"> CHAPTER XI </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0012"> CHAPTER XII </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0013"> CHAPTER XIII </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0014"> CHAPTER XIV </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0015"> CHAPTER XV </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0016"> CHAPTER XVI </a>
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0001" id="link2HCH0001"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER I
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>Fate and Her Parcels&mdash;How It All came true&mdash;The First South
- Sea Island&mdash;Coleridge and the Tropics&mdash;The Spell of the Island
- Scents&mdash;What happens to Travellers&mdash;Days in Dreamland&mdash;A
- Torchlight Market&mdash;The Enchanted Fei.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">L</span>IKE an idle
- messenger-boy, Fate takes a long while about her rounds, but she will get
- through with them and deliver all her parcels, if you give her time
- enough.
- </p>
- <p>
- She has so much business that she confuses orders very often, and you are
- never sure of getting what you sent for. Still, you will certainly get
- something, if you wait, and it may even be the thing you demanded.
- </p>
- <p>
- The morning she called at my door, with a very full basket, she had
- already been to my neighbours, and given them, in a big assortment of
- goods&mdash;a failure on the Stock Exchange, a hunting accident, and a
- broken engagement. What they had ordered was a seat in Parliament, and a
- winter at Monte Carlo, with anything good that might come in in the way of
- new-laid motor-cars. But Fate was, as usual, in a hurry, and she never
- changes any goods, once delivered. So they had to take them in.
- </p>
- <p>
- I had given up expecting her when her knock came to my door, because my
- order had been sent in some years ago, and so far had remained
- unacknowledged. But she fairly emptied her basket into my hands, once she
- was admitted.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Goods all right, and none the worse for keeping; couldn&rsquo;t find time to
- see to you before, I&rsquo;ve been so busy attending to an order from Japan for
- a new army and a gross of assorted victories,&rdquo; she panted. &ldquo;Had to serve
- the Czar of Russia with a lot of old defeats I&rsquo;ve had lying by since the
- Crimea, instead of the new empire he sent for; and can&rsquo;t get time to fill
- more than half the German Emperor&rsquo;s order for fireworks. You private
- people are lucky to get anything at all. Count the goods, please&mdash;one
- journey round the world, two-and-a-half years of mixed adventures, a
- hundred South Sea Islands, threescore new friends, first quality, one
- large package luck. That&rsquo;s all, I think&mdash;sign the book, and let me
- go; I&rsquo;ve got seven attacks of appendicitis, a foreclosed mortgage, two
- lawsuits, and a divorce, to deliver in this square before lunch.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- So, like the fairy tales, &ldquo;it all came true,&rdquo; and one bright winter
- afternoon a Cunard liner bore me away from the streets and shops and
- drab-coloured, huddled houses of Liverpool, down the muddy Mersey&mdash;off
- round the world.
- </p>
- <p>
- There were thousands of people on the quay, come to see the famous boat
- away, for it was Saturday afternoon, and the town took holiday. They had a
- few hours of freedom before them&mdash;then, the airless office room, the
- stuffy shop, the ledger and the copying-press, and the clattering
- typewriter, the grim window giving on the dark wet street, for six long
- days again. Next year, and the year after,-just the office, the frowsy
- lodging, the tram car, the pen in the strong young fingers, the desk to
- stoop the broad young shoulders, the life foreseen, eventless, grey for
- ever and for ever. And I was going round the world.
- </p>
- <p>
- It is three weeks later, and the big &ldquo;A and A&rdquo; steamer is ploughing along
- in the midst of a marvellous dazzle of diamond-spangled, pale-blue tropic
- sea and scorching, pale-blue tropic sky. The passengers, in cool white
- suits and dresses, are clustered together on the promenade deck, looking
- eagerly over the port railing, while the captain, telescope in hand,
- points out something lying only a mile away, and says: &ldquo;That&rsquo;s Tiki-Hau,
- so now you&rsquo;ve seen a South Sea Island.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- We are on our way to Tahiti, a twelve-day run from San Francisco, and are
- not stopping anywhere, but as Tiki-Hau is the only glimpse of land we
- shall get until we cast anchor in Papeete, every one wants to look at it.
- Not one of us has ever seen a South Sea Island, and, we are all eager to
- realise this little fragment of our rainbow-coloured childish dreams.
- </p>
- <p>
- Is it as good as we dreamed it? we ask ourselves and each other. The
- verdict, given unanimously, is: &ldquo;Yes&mdash;but not the same.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- Here is no high green palmy peak, overhanging a waveless sea, with
- sparkling waterfalls dashing down from crag to crag, like the coloured
- illustrations in our old school prize books. There are, indeed, just such
- islands in the Pacific, we are told&mdash;many hundreds of them&mdash;but
- there are still more of the kind we are now looking at, which is not half
- so often mentioned. All South Sea Islands are either high or low; the high
- island, with lofty mountains and dark, rich volcanic soil, is the familiar
- island of the picture book, while the low type, composed only of coral, is
- the variety to which Tiki-Hau belongs.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0005" id="linkimage-0005"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0030.jpg" alt="0030 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0030.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- What we can see of the island, however, is enough to set at rest any
- tendency to comparison. None of us want anything better; none of us think
- there can be anything better, among the wonders that the Great South Seas
- yet hold in store.
- </p>
- <p>
- Tiki-Hau is an island of the atoll or ring-shaped type, a splendid circle
- of seventy and eighty-foot palms, enclosing an inner lagoon clear and
- still as glass. Outside the windy palms, a dazzling beach runs down to the
- open sea all round the island&mdash;a beach that is like nothing the
- travellers ever have seen before, for it is made of powdered coral, and is
- as white as salt, as white as starch, as white as the hackneyed
- snow-simile itself can paint it. All the island&mdash;the whole great
- ring, many miles in length&mdash;is coral too, white, branching, flowering
- coral under water, white, broken-coral gravel above, with here and there a
- thin skin of earth collected by a century or two of falling palm-leaves
- and ocean waste. Outside the magic ring the sea-waves tumble, fresh and
- blue, upon-the cloud-white sand; within, the still lagoon glows like a
- basin of molten emerald. Above, the enormous palm-trees swing their
- twenty-foot plumes of gaudy yellow-green to the rush of warm trade-wind,
- high in the burning sky. A glorious picture indeed&mdash;but one before
- which the painter well might tremble.
- </p>
- <p>
- Here, for the first time, we begin to understand why pictures of tropical
- scenes are so few and so unsatisfactory. Paint! what combination of
- coloured grease that ever came out of a box could hope to suggest the pale
- green fire of those palm-tree plumes, the jewel-blaze of the lagoon, the
- sapphire flame of the sea, the aching, blinding whitenesses of spray and
- sand? Who could paint the sun that is literally flashing back from the
- light dresses of the passengers, making of every separate person a
- distinct conflagration, and darting lightning rays out of the officers&rsquo;
- gold shoulder-straps and buttons? Does any dweller in the dim grey North
- really know what light and colour are? did we know, with our tinselled
- April days, and gentle blue-and white August afternoons, that we were so
- proud of once? Well, we know now; and, alas, in the dim, prosaic years
- that are yet to come, we shall remember!
- </p>
- <p>
- The ship steams on, the atoll fades away in the distance, and once more
- comes the changeless level of long blue empty sea. But we have seen a
- coral island, and the picture is ours for ever.
- </p>
- <p>
- Flying-fish, skimming and &ldquo;skittering&rdquo; over the surface of the waves, we
- have all become used to now. The first day we met them was a memorable
- one, all the same&mdash;they were so exactly what one had paid one&rsquo;s money
- to see. Sharks have disappointed us so far; never a sight of the famous
- &ldquo;black triangular fin&rdquo; have we yet enjoyed, and the passengers have an
- idea that something ought to be said to the steamship company about it.
- Nor have the equatorial sunsets quite kept up their stage character. Books
- of travel, and sea literature in general, have led us to expect that the
- sun, in the tropics, should go out at sunset as though Poseidon had hold
- of the switch down below the water line, and turned off the light the
- instant sun and horizon met.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- ... The sun&rsquo;s rim dips, the stars rush out.
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- At one stride comes the dark.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p>
- They don&rsquo;t, Mr. Coleridge, and it doesn&rsquo;t, and you never were there to see
- for yourself, or you would not have talked beautiful nonsense and misled
- countless travellers of all ages who did see, but who have refused to
- look, save through your illustrious spectacles, ever since. Even on the
- equator, the sun gives one time to dress for dinner (if the toilet is not
- a very elaborate one) while it is setting, and after it has set. So dies
- one more illusion. Yet it can easily be spared, in the midst of a thousand
- wild dreams and strange imaginings, realised to the very utmost, as ours
- are to be ere long.
- </p>
- <p>
- Tahiti comes at last. In the pearly light of a sunrise pure as a dawn of
- earliest Eden, we glide into the shadow of a tall, rose-painted peak,
- spiring eight thousand feet up into heaven, and anchor in the midst of a
- glassy mirror of violet sea. Papeëte, the loveliest, sweetest, and
- wickedest town of all the wide South Seas, lies before us&mdash;just a
- sparkle of red roofs looking out from under a coverlet of thick foliage, a
- long brown wharf and a many-coloured crowd. Across the water steals a
- faint strange perfume, unlike anything I have ever smelled before&mdash;heavy,
- sweet, penetrating, suggestive.... It is cocoanut oil scented with the
- white tieré flower, and never, from Tahiti to Samoa, from Raratonga to
- Fiji, Yavau, Manihiki, or Erromanga, will the South Sea traveller lose the
- odour of it again. Cocoanut oil, and the nutty, heavy smell of copra
- (dried cocoanut kernel) are charms that can raise in an instant for any
- old island wanderer, in the farthest corners of the earth, the glowing
- vision of the wonderful South Sea world.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- ... Smells are surer than sounds or sights
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- To make your heartstrings crack,
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- They start those awful voices o&rsquo; nights
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- That whisper: &ldquo;Old man, come back!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p>
- <i>(Old island wanderers in all parts of the world&mdash;settled down to
- desks in the E.C. district&mdash;tramping through the December glare of
- Pitt Street, Sydney, for &ldquo;orders&rdquo;&mdash;occupying a tranquil, well-bred
- billet, and a set of red-tape harness, in the Foreign Office&mdash;do you
- smell the tierê flower, and hear the crooning of the reef, and feel the
- rush of the warm trade wind, and the touch of the sun-baked sand, under
- the utu trees once more?)</i>
- </p>
- <p>
- So I landed in Papeete, and found myself in the South Sea Islands at last.
- </p>
- <p>
- All that afternoon, like &ldquo;Tommy&rdquo; in Barrie&rsquo;s <i>Thrums</i>, I kept saying
- to myself: &ldquo;I&rsquo;m here, I&rsquo;m here!&rdquo;... There was no mistake about Papeëte. It
- was not disappointing or disillusioning, it was only more lifelike than
- life, more fanciful than fancy, infinitely ahead of all past imaginations.
- </p>
- <p>
- There were the waving palms of picture and story, laden with immense
- clusters of nuts; there were the wonderful bananas, with broad green
- leaves ten and twelve feet long, enshrouding bunches of fruit that were
- each a good load for a man; there were the greenhouse flowers of home&mdash;the
- costly rare stephanotis, tuberose, gardenia&mdash;climbing all over the
- verandahs of the houses, and filling half-cultivated front gardens with
- stacks and bouquets of bloom. And the dug-out canoes, made from a single
- hollowed log supported by an outrigger, flitting about the glassy lagoon
- like long-legged waterflies&mdash;and the gorgeous, flamboyant trees,
- ablaze with vermilion flowers, roofing over the grassy roadway in a series
- of gay triumphal arches&mdash;and above all, beyond all, the fiery-gold
- sunlight, spilling cataracts of flame through the thickest leafage,
- turning the flowers to white and red-hot coals, painting the shadows under
- the houses in waves of ink, and bleaching the dust to dazzling snow&mdash;how
- new, how vivid, how tropical it all was!
- </p>
- <p>
- The native population was out in full force to see the steamer come in.
- So, indeed, were the white residents, in their freshest suits and smartest
- muslins, but they met with small attention from the little band of
- newcomers.
- </p>
- <p>
- It was the Tahitians themselves who claimed all our interest&mdash;the
- famous race who had been so well liked by Captain Cook, who had seduced
- the men of the <i>Bounty</i> from allegiance to King George of England, a
- hundred and sixteen years ago, who were known all the world over as the
- most beautiful, the most amiable, and the most hospitable of all the South
- Sea Islanders.
- </p>
- <p>
- Some of the passengers, I fancy, expected to see them coming down to the
- shore clad in necklaces and fringes of leaves, eager to trade with the
- newcomers and exchange large pearls and thick wedges of fine tortoiseshell
- for knives, cloth, and beads.... Most of us were better prepared, however,
- having heard a good deal about Papeëte, the Paris of the South Seas, from
- the people of the steamer, and having realised, on our own account, that a
- great deal of water might run under a bridge in a hundred years, even here
- in the South Pacific.
- </p>
- <p>
- So the smartness of the native crowd surprised only a few, of whom I was
- not one. On the contrary, I was surprised to find that here, in this big
- island group, with its fortnightly steamer, its large &ldquo;white&rdquo; town, and
- its bureaucratic French Government, some kind of a national dress did
- really still exist. The Tahitian men were variously attired, some in full
- suits of white, others in a shirt and a brief cotton kilt. The women,
- however, all wore the same type of dress&mdash;a flowing nightdress of
- cotton or muslin, usually pink, pale green, or yellow, and a neat small
- sailor hat made in the islands, and commonly trimmed with a pretty wreath
- of shells. Most of them wore their hair loose, to show off its length and
- fineness&mdash;Tahitians have by far the most beautiful hair of any island
- race&mdash;and not a few were shoeless, though nearly all had smart
- parasols. The colour of the crowd was extremely various, for Tahiti has
- more half and quarter castes than full-blooded natives&mdash;in Papeete at
- all events. The darkest, however, were not more than tea-coloured, and in
- most instances the features were really good.
- </p>
- <p>
- So much one gathered in the course of landing. Later on, during the few
- days I spent in an hotel waiting for the Cook Island steamer&mdash;for,
- alas! I was not staying in Tahiti&mdash;there was opportunity for
- something further in the way of observation. But&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;
- </p>
- <p>
- But&mdash;&mdash;&mdash; It happens to every one in Tahiti, why should I
- be ashamed of it? There was once a scientific man, who came to write a
- book, and took notes and notes and notes&mdash;for two days and a half.
- Then, he thought he would take a morning&rsquo;s rest, and that is five years
- ago, and he has been resting ever since, and they say in the stores that
- he has not bought so much as a sheet of letter paper, or a penny bottle of
- ink, but that his credit for cigars and ice, and things that go with both
- very well, and for pyjamas to lounge about the back verandah in, and very
- cheap novels, and silk-grass hammocks, is nearly run out in Papeete. There
- was a Government official&mdash;perhaps it was two, or three, or sixty
- Government officials&mdash;who came to Papeete very full of energy and
- ability, and very much determined to work wonders in the sleepy little
- colony.... He, or they, is, or are, never to be seen awake before three in
- the afternoon, and his clerks have to type the signatures to his letters,
- because he will not trouble to write his name; and their people think they
- died years and years ago, because they have never carried out their
- intention of telling some one to find some one else to send a message to
- say they are alive. And there are a dozen or fourteen gentlemen who keep
- stores in Papeete, and if you go in to buy things in the morning or
- afternoon or evening, mayhap you will find the gentleman or his understudy
- asleep behind the counter, but mayhap you will find the door shut, and the
- proprietor away at breakfast, which takes him an hour, or lunch, which
- takes from two hours to three, or dinner, which occupies him from six till
- nine inclusive. After that, he may open again for a little while, or he
- may not.
- </p>
- <p>
- Must I explain now what happened to me in Papeëte, or why I am not in a
- position to add anything to the scientific or ethnological, or geographic
- knowledge of the world, concerning the Society Islands in general?
- </p>
- <p>
- A duty, obvious, immediate, and unperformed, is perhaps the best of all
- spices to a dish of sweet laziness. And there is not on earth&rsquo;s round ball
- such a spot to be lazy in as pleasant Papeëte. One is never fairly awake.
- It is dreamland&mdash;and what a happy dream! The golden light on the
- still lagoon is surely the &ldquo;fight that never was on sea nor land&rdquo;&mdash;before
- we sailed in under the purple peaks of Orohena. The chanting of the coral
- reef far out at sea, unceasing, day and night, is the song the sirens sang
- to strong Ulysses, in the dream dreamed for all ages by the old Greek
- poet, long ago. The languorous voices of the island women, sweet and low
- as the &ldquo;wind of the western sea&rdquo;&mdash;the stillness of the island houses,
- where feet go bare upon the soundless floors, and music waxes and wanes so
- softly now and then in whispering songs or lightly swept piano keys, that
- it only blends with the long mysterious murmur of the wind in the rustling
- palm trees, to lull the senses into perfect rest&mdash;these, too, are of
- the world of dream.
- </p>
- <p>
- Something out of dreamland, also, is the little hotel where most of the
- travellers stay&mdash;a rambling bungalow in a grass enclosure, overrun
- with vivid flowers and splendid leafage. That the proprietress should
- welcome her guests in a long lace and muslin nightgown-dress, her pretty
- brown feet bare, and her flowing wavy hair crowned with a wreath of
- perfumed gardenia and tuberose, seems quite a natural part of the dream;
- that the chamber-maids should be beautiful island girls clad in the same
- garb, and that they should sit in the drawing-room playing the piano and
- singing wild melancholy island songs, like the sighing of the surf on the
- shore, when they ought to be making beds or serving dinners, is also &ldquo;in
- the picture.&rdquo; That the Chinese cook should do elaborate Parisian cookery,
- and that the coffee and the curry and the bread (or at least the
- bread-fruit) should be picked in the garden as required, and that there
- should be no visible means of shutting the door of the bathroom, which is
- very public, until a carpenter is called in, and that L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;,
- the charming proprietress, should explain with a charming smile: &ldquo;Only the
- house been using it all this time,&rdquo; to account completely for the
- deficiency&mdash;all this belongs unmistakably to the irresponsible
- dream-country. And when the warm tropic night drops down, and one goes
- wandering in the moonlight, to see for the first time the palm-tree plumes
- all glassy-silver under the radiant sky, flashing magically as they
- tremble in the faint night wind, it is more than ever the land of dream
- that is thus lit up in the soft clear dusk. So vivid is the moonlight,
- that one can even see the scarlet colour of the flamboyant flowers fallen
- in the dust, and distinguish the deep violet and hyacinthine hues of the
- far-off mountain peaks across the bay.... How, in such a place, can one
- waste the night in sleep?
- </p>
- <p>
- It is certainly not like any sort of waking life one has hitherto known,
- to find that the market of Papeëte&mdash;one of the principal sights of
- the place&mdash;is held on Sunday mornings before sunrise. One might have
- supposed that such a supremely indolent people would scarcely choose the
- most inconvenient hour of all the twenty-four for a general gathering. But
- they do choose it, and the visitor who wants to see the market must choose
- it also.
- </p>
- <p>
- L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash; calls me, herself, at some unearthly hour,
- not much after four, and I get up and dress in the warm darkness. It is
- the hot season at present and the air, night and day, is very like a hot
- bath, and not far behind it in temperature. I have been loafing about the
- town during the previous day in rather thin shoes, and my feet have been
- almost blistered by the heat of the ground striking up through light
- soles, so that I cannot walk very far, and am glad to find the market
- close at hand.
- </p>
- <p>
- L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;, in a fresh muslin nightdress (she has
- something like fifty or sixty of them), acts as guide. She has put a new
- coronet of flowers in her hair, and before we reach the market she
- proceeds to dress me up Tahiti fashion, with, long necklaces of sweet
- white blossoms round my neck, falling all over my dress, and a heavy crown
- of closely woven gardenias on my head, instead of my hat, which she
- removes, and politely carries. She wants to pull my hair down as well, but
- in a temperature of eighty degrees the idea does not sound tempting, so I
- decline to follow Tahitian custom further. Besides, there is really no
- knowing where she would stop!
- </p>
- <p>
- There is not yet a glimmer of daylight when we enter the market-place, and
- flaring lamps and torches cast huge flickering shadows all over the gay
- assembly. Fruit and fish for the most part are the wares&mdash;but such
- fish, and such fruit! Where one would look at home for white and grey
- turbot, pallid plaice, zinc-coloured herrings, here one may see the most
- gorgeous shapes of gold and scarlet and green; of iridescent rose, silver,
- orange; of blue, brilliant as a heap of tumbled sapphire, and pearl as
- bright as the lining of a shell. Tahiti is famous for its beautiful fish,
- and indeed these in the market look almost too poetically lovely to eat.
- </p>
- <p>
- Then the fruit! bananas as big as cucumbers, as small as ladies&rsquo; fingers
- (after which, indeed, this little sugar-sweet, variety is named), dark red
- bananas, flavoured like a peach, large bloomy ones, tasting and looking
- like custard within; smooth yellow ones, like those exported to other
- countries, whither the daintier fruits will not safely go&mdash;pineapple
- in rough-skinned heaps (one learns soon in Tahiti how to eat a pineapple,
- and that is to peel it, cut it into largest possible lumps, eat the latter
- undiminished even if they make you speechless, and never, never, shoe the
- fruit)&mdash;oranges of several different kinds, custard-apples,
- rose-apples, paw-paws, melons, avocado pears, guavas, mangoes, and other
- fruits the name of which I have never heard&mdash;all lying together in
- masses under the lamplight, costing not as many halfpence to buy as at
- home they would cost shillings.
- </p>
- <p>
- The native beauties are here in a merry crowd, intent quite as much upon
- enjoyment as on business. Scarcely one but wears a flower behind her ear&mdash;and
- if you have ever been in the South Seas, you will know what that pretty
- little signal means, but if you have not, why then I shall not tell you&mdash;and
- all are so wreathed, and crowned, and necklaced with woven blossoms, that
- the air is heavy with scent, and the market-place looks as though the
- transformation scene of a pantomine were just about to begin, with a full
- chorus of flower-decked nymphs appearing for the dance.
- </p>
- <p>
- One exceedingly pretty girl, with a perfect cataract of black hair
- overflowing her pale green gown, and a pair of sparkling dark eyes that
- could never be matched outside the magic lines of Cancer and Capricorn, is
- making and frying pancakes with something fruity, nature unknown, inside
- them. She has half a dozen French officers about her, enjoying breakfast
- and flirtation at the same time. Another, who is selling a number of the
- oddest little parcels imaginable, made out of cut-up joints of bamboo,
- carefully sealed, is doing a good trade among the coloured and
- semi-coloured ladies. L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash; says she is selling
- readymade sauces, to be eaten with fish or meat, and adds that she herself
- will show me what Tahitian sauces are like later on, because there is no
- one in the whole group fit to act as scullion to her in that important
- matter&mdash;or words to the same effect.
- </p>
- <p>
- Strange-looking mountain men are here, dressed in shirt and kilt of cotton
- cloth, patterned in flowers and leaves as big as soup-plates. The former
- garment is a concession to Papeete&mdash;outside the town, the &ldquo;pareo&rdquo; or
- kilt alone forms the Tahitian full-dress suit. These men have come in to
- sell the &ldquo;fei,&rdquo; or wild banana, which is only found on the highest and
- most perilous of the mountain precipices. To get it, the Tahitian must
- climb where not even a goat would venture to go, and make his way back,
- having secured the fruit, carrying a bunch that is a heavy load, even on
- level ground. Many are the lives that have been lost gathering the &ldquo;fei,&rdquo;
- but the Tahitian, like all islanders, is something of a fatalist, and the
- death of one fruit gatherer never stops another from going a-hunting in
- the very same place next day.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is something about the same &ldquo;fei&rdquo; that is worth noting. It is one of
- the standing dishes of the islands&mdash;a cooking banana, large, and
- well-flavoured when baked, but not so attractive on the whole as many of
- the other kinds. The Tahitian, however, ascribes to this variety a certain
- magic property, not unlike that of the fabled lotus. If you eat of the
- &ldquo;fei,&rdquo; he says, especially if you eat freely of it, you will fall under
- the spell. For ever, in its working, it binds you to Tahiti. You may go
- away, and without any intention of returning, say goodbye to the islands,
- and place many thousand miles of land and sea between yourself and sweet
- Tahiti, saying to yourself that you and Papeëte have no more to do with
- one another for ever.... Yet by-and-by&mdash;some day, one knows not when;
- it may be soon, or it may be late, but it will surely come&mdash;you will
- return to Tahiti. The spell of the fei will work, and draw you back again.
- </p>
- <p>
- So the natives said, and I thought the fancy a pretty one, and wondered
- whether it had really any connection with the lotus myth, and then forgot
- all about it.
- </p>
- <p>
- That is three years ago, and since those days I have travelled the whole
- world over, leaving Tahiti behind as one leaves a station passed long ago
- on a railway journey, upon a line that one never expects to traverse
- again. As I write, the snows of winter Britain lie thick outside my
- window, and a sea of Arctic coldness breaks in freezing green and grey
- upon a desolate shore. Nothing on earth seems farther away than-the warm
- blue waves, and flowers that never fade, and shining coral sands of
- Tahiti. But... there is a steamer running southward before long, and a
- great sunny city on the other side of the world where the island boats lie
- waiting at the quays. And one of those island boats, in a month or two,
- will carry a passenger back to Tahiti&mdash;a passenger who ate of the fei
- three years ago, and went away for ever, but on whom the spell of the
- magic fruit has worked&mdash;after all.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0002" id="link2HCH0002"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER II
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>The History of Tahiti&mdash;Drink and the Native&mdash;In the Old Wild
- Days&mdash;The Simple and the Civilised Life&mdash;What an Island Town is
- like&mdash;The Lotos Eaters&mdash;Cocoanuts and Courtesy&mdash;A Feast of
- Fat Things&mdash;The Orgy on the Verandah&mdash;Schooners and Pearls&mdash;The
- Land of Tir-n&rsquo;an-Oge.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">A</span>LTHOUGH I
- certainly did not use the few days of my stay in Tahiti to the best
- advantage&mdash;although I saw none of the public buildings of Papeëte,
- never set eyes on any of the officials of the place, and did not collect
- any statistics worth mentioning, I gathered a few crude facts of a useful
- kind, which are herewith offered as a sop to the reader, who must be
- informed and improved, or know the reason why. (If he would only go to
- Tahiti, that dear reader, whom, all travellers know so well and fear so
- much! if he would just spend a week lying on the coral beach, and
- strolling in the moonlight, and listening to native songs, and feeding fat
- on native dainties&mdash;he would never want to be informed of anything
- any more, and as to being improved... O Tahiti, loveliest and least
- conventional of the siren countries of the dear South Seas, can you lay
- your hand on your heart, and honestly declare you are improving?)
- </p>
- <p>
- Tahiti was discovered, not by Captain Cook, as is rather commonly
- supposed, but by Captain Wallis of H.M.S. <i>Dolphin</i>, in 1767. Captain
- Wallis formally took possession of the group in the name of His Majesty
- King George III., and Captain Cook, in the course of his different visits
- to the islands, laid the foundations of all the civilisation they
- afterwards acquired. Nevertheless, the islands are French property to-day.
- There is nothing in the Pacific better worth owning than the Society
- group, more fertile, more beautiful, more healthy, richer in valuable
- tropical products&mdash;and the construction of the Panama Canal, an event
- which has been foreseen for several generations, will obviously add much
- to the importance of the islands. Because of these, and other excellent
- reasons, Great Britain, acting on the principles by which her colonial
- policy is commonly guided, allowed the Society Islands to slip gradually
- into the hands of a power better able than herself to appreciate their
- value, and the group, after thirty-seven years of &ldquo;protection,&rdquo; was
- finally taken possession of by France, in the year 1880. The native Queen,
- Pômare IV. (Pomare being a dynastic name like Cæsar, but, unlike the
- latter, applied to both sexes), was allowed to retain her state and
- possessions under the French protectorate. Her successor, King Pomare V.,
- who succeeded in 1877 and died in 1891, only reigned for three years.
- After the formal annexation he retained his title of king, and much of his
- state, but the power was entirely in French hands. Prince Hinoe, his heir,
- who would in the ordinary course have occupied the throne, lives in a
- handsome European-built house near Papeete, and enjoys a good pension, but
- is otherwise not distinguished in any way from the ordinary Tahitian.
- </p>
- <p>
- Under French rule, the islands have done fairly well. There were at first
- many regrettable disputes and troubles between opposing camps of
- missionaries, but these have long since been made up. Commerce is in
- rather a languishing state. The group exports copra, vanilla, pearl-shell,
- and fruit, but the trade with America was so much on the down-grade during
- the time of my visit, that steamers were leaving the port with empty
- holds. The natives are well treated under the present system; the liquor
- laws, however, are defective, and no Tahitian, apparently, has any
- difficulty in obtaining as much strong spirits as he wants and can pay
- for. The disastrous effects of such carelessness as this need no mention
- to the reader who knows anything of darkskinned races. For the benefit of
- the reader who does not, however, it may be remarked that all colonial
- administrators agree concerning the bad effects of intoxicants on coloured
- races of every kind. It matters not at what end or part of the scale of
- colour the man may be&mdash;whether he is a woolly-haired, baboon-jawed
- nigger from Central Africa, a grave, intelligent, educated Maori of New
- Zealand, or a gentle child-like native of Tahiti, barely café-au-lait as
- to colour&mdash;all the same, and all the time, spirits are sure to
- convert him, temporarily, into a raging beast, and, in the long run, to
- wipe out him and his kind altogether. It is not a question of temperance
- principles or the reverse, but merely a matter of common-sense policy, in
- dealing with races which have shown themselves unable to withstand the
- effects of the liquors that our hardier northern nations can use with
- comparative safety. One may lay it down as a general principle that
- nothing with a coloured skin on it can take, intoxicants in moderation&mdash;it
- is not at all, or all in all, with the &ldquo;native&rdquo; when it comes to strong
- drinks. Scientific folk would probably set down the comparative immunity
- of the white races to the protection that lies behind them in the shape of
- centuries of drinking ancestors. The coffee-coloured islander&rsquo;s
- great-grandparents did not know whisky, just as they never experienced
- measles and other diseases, that do not usually kill the white, but almost
- always put an end to the &ldquo;man and brother.&rdquo; Therefore, the islander&rsquo;s body
- has not, by inheritance, acquired those points of constitution which
- enable the white to resist whisky and measles, and other dangerous things;
- and when they touch him, he goes down at once. A parallel may be found in
- the case of opium, which the white man, broadly speaking, cannot take in
- moderation, although most of the yellow races can. Europeans who once
- acquire a liking for the effects of opium will generally die as miserable
- wrecks, in the course of a very few years. A Chinaman, under similar
- circumstances, may, and often does, live to a good old age, without taking
- any harm at all from his constant doses. His ancestors have been opium
- takers, the Englishman&rsquo;s have not. It is the case of the islander and the
- spirits over again.
- </p>
- <p>
- After which digression, one has some way to come back to the fact that the
- French Government does not prevent the Tahitian from drinking gin nearly
- so effectively as it should, and that, in consequence, the diminution of
- the native population receives a downward push that it does not in the
- least require. In the Fijis, British rule keeps spirits strictly away from
- all the natives, with the exception of the chiefs, and something, at
- least, is thereby done to slacken the decline that afflicts the people of
- almost every island in the Pacific. The Fijian chiefs, as a rule, drink
- heavily, and do not commonly live long, thus providing another argument in
- favour of restriction.
- </p>
- <p>
- The population of Tahiti is indeed much less than it should be. Captain
- Cook&rsquo;s estimates of native populations are now understood to have been
- mistaken in many cases, owing to the fact that he calculated the entire
- numbers from the density of occupation round the shores. As most Pacific
- islands are inhabited about the coasts alone, the interior being often
- unsuitable for cultivation, and too far removed from the fishing-grounds
- to suit an indolent race, it can easily be understood that serious errors
- would arise from such a method of estimate. The diminution, therefore,
- since ancient times, is not quite so alarming as the first writers on the
- Pacific&mdash;and, indeed, many who followed them&mdash;supposed it to be.
- If the sums worked out by the travellers who visited Honolulu in the
- sixties, or Tahiti a little later, had been correct, both of these
- important groups would long since have been empty of all native
- population. But the Hawaiian group has still a very fair number of
- darkskinned people, while Tahiti, including all its islands, had a
- population, according to the census of 1902, of over thirteen thousand,
- one-eighth of whom are said to be French, and a smaller number Chinese and
- other foreigners.
- </p>
- <p>
- Still, it cannot be said that this is a large, or even a fair population
- for a group of islands covering 580 square miles, nor can it be denied
- that the numbers of the Tahitians are steadily on the decrease. The exact
- causes of the decline are disputed, as indeed they are in connection with
- every other coloured race in the Pacific. European diseases of a serious
- kind are extremely common in the group, and consumption also is frequent.
- These are two obvious causes. Less easily reckoned are the unnamed
- tendencies towards extinction that follow the track of the white man
- through the lands of primitive peoples, all over the world. There can be
- no doubt that the old life of the Pacific&mdash;feasting, fighting, making
- love, and making murder: dressing in a bunch of leaves, and living almost
- as completely without thought for the morrow as the twittering parrakeets
- in the mango trees&mdash;suited the constitution of the islander better
- than the life of to-day.
- </p>
- <p>
- It may have been bad for his spiritual development, and it certainly was
- bad for any wandering white men who came, by necessity or choice, to visit
- his far-away fastnesses. But he lived and flourished in those bad days,
- whereas now he quietly and unostentatiously, and quite without any rancour
- or regret, dies.
- </p>
- <p>
- Why? Old island residents will tell you that, even if every disease
- brought by the white man were rooted out to-morrow, the native would still
- diminish in numbers. He has done so in islands where the effects of
- European diseases were comparatively slight. He does so in New Zealand,
- where the Maori (the supposed ancestor of most of the island peoples) is
- petted, cherished, and doctored to an amazing extent by the ruling race,
- and yet persists in dying out, although he is not affected by consumption
- or other evils to any serious extent. There are undoubtedly other causes,
- and perhaps among them not the least is the fact that, for most Pacific
- races, life, with the coming of civilisation, has greatly lost its savour.
- </p>
- <p>
- It used to be amazingly lively in Tahiti, in the wild old days. Then, the
- Tahitian did not know of white men&rsquo;s luxuries&mdash;of tea and sugar and
- tinned stuffs, lamps and kerosene, hideous calico shirts and gaudy ties,
- muslin gowns and frilled petticoats for the women, &ldquo;bits&rdquo; to make
- patchwork quilts with, and beds to put the quilts on, and matchwood
- bungalows to put the beds in, and quart bottles of fiery gin to drink, and
- coloured silk handkerchiefs to put away on a shelf, and creaking shoes to
- lame oneself with on Sundays. Then, he did not let or sell his land to
- some one in order to get cash to buy these desirable things; nor did his
- womankind, for the same reason, adopt, almost as a national profession, a
- mode of life to which the conventionalities forbid me to give a name. Nor
- did the distractions of unlimited church-going turn away his mind from the
- main business of life, which was undoubtedly that of enjoyment. He had no
- money, and no goods, and did not want either. He had no religion (to speak
- of) and desired that still less. All he had to do was to secure a good
- time, and get up a fight now and then when things in general began to turn
- slow.
- </p>
- <p>
- It must be said that the existence of the &ldquo;Areoi,&rdquo; a certain secret
- society of old Tahiti, went far to minimise the risk of dullness. The
- members formed a species of heathen &ldquo;Hell-Fire Club,&rdquo; and they cultivated
- every crime known to civilisation, and a few which civilisation has
- happily forgotten. Murder, theft, human sacrifices, cannibalism, were
- among their usual practices, and the domestic relationships of the Society
- (which was large and influential, and included both sexes) are said to
- have been open to some criticism. They were popular, however, for they
- studied music and the dance as fine arts, and gave free entertainments to
- every one who cared to come. They travelled from village to village,
- island to island, giving &ldquo;shows&rdquo; wherever they went, and winning welcome
- and favour everywhere by the brilliance and originality of their
- improprieties. They were as wicked as they knew how, and as amusing, and
- as devilish, and as dazzling.... How the young Tahitian lad, not yet
- tattooed, and considered of no importance, must have reverenced and envied
- them! how he must have imitated their pranks in the seclusion of the
- cocoanut groves, and hummed over their songs, and longed for the time when
- he himself should be big enough to run away from home, and go off with the
- delightful, demoniacal, fascinating Areois!
- </p>
- <p>
- Then there was always a native king in Tahiti in those days, and a number
- of big native chiefs, each one of whom had his own little court, with all
- the exciting surroundings of a court which are never missing in any part
- of the world, from Saxe-Niemandhausen to Patagonia. And there were tribal
- fights from time to time, when property changed hands, and war-spears were
- reddened, and a man might hunt his enemy in the dusk, stealthy,
- soft-footed, with heart jumping in his breast, along the shadowy borders
- of the lagoon.... Murder and mischief and fighting and greed, pomp of
- savage courts and stir of savage ambitions, and the other world that
- nobody knew or cared about, shut off by a barrier of seas unexplored....
- It was a life in which a man undoubtedly did live, a life that kept him
- quick until he was dead. Does the decline of Pacific races look less
- unaccountable now?
- </p>
- <p>
- In these days, the Tahitian is undoubtedly improved. He never was a very
- &ldquo;bad lot&rdquo; all round, in spite of the Areois; but Civilisation, of course,
- had to take him in hand once it was known he was there, for Civilisation
- will not have loose ends or undusted corners in her house, if she can help
- it. So the people of Tahiti were discovered, and converted, and clothed,
- and taught, and they gave up being Areois, and worshipping heathen gods,
- and going about without shirts and skirts, and they went frequently to
- church, and supported their white pastors generously, and began to trade
- with the Europeans, so that the latter made much money.
- </p>
- <p>
- They are quite happy and uncomplaining, and manage to have a reasonably
- good time in a quiet way, but they <i>will</i> die out, and nobody can
- prevent them. You see, they are rather bored, and when you are bored, the
- answer to the question, &ldquo;Is life worth living?&rdquo; is, at the least,
- debatable&mdash;to a Pacific Islander.
- </p>
- <p>
- I have written of this at some length, because, <i>mutatis mutandis</i>,
- it applies to nearly all the island races.
- </p>
- <p>
- It is not only the Tahitian who looks back with wistful eyes to the faded
- sunset of the bad old times, with all their savage gaudiness of scarlet
- blood and golden licence, and languishes in the chill pale dawn of the
- white man&rsquo;s civilisation. It is the whole Pacific world, more or less. The
- Simple Life in the raw original is not, by many a long league, as simple
- and innocent as it is supposed to be, by those new and noisy apostles of a
- return to Nature, who have never got nearer to the things of the beginning
- than a week-end up the Thames&mdash;but, unsimple and uninnocent as it is,
- it suits the coloured man better than anything else. Would one, therefore,
- wish to put back the clock of time, re-establish heathenism and
- cannibalism over all the Pacific, and see Honolulu, Fiji, Samoa, with
- their towns and Government Houses, and shops and roads and plantations,
- leap back to the condition of the still uncivilised western islands, where
- no man&rsquo;s life is safe, and the law of might is the only law that is known?
- Hardly. There is no answer to the problem, and no moral to be drawn from
- it either. But then, you do not draw morals in the South Seas&mdash;they
- are not plentiful enough.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Society Islands&mdash;which were so named in compliment to the Royal
- Society&mdash;lie between 16° and 18° south latitude, and 148° and 158°
- west longitude. Tahiti itself is much the largest, the driveway round this
- island being about ninety miles long. Huaheine, Raiatea, Murea, Bora-Bora,
- and the small islands Taha&rsquo;a and Maitea, are much less important. The only
- town of the group is Papeëte.
- </p>
- <p>
- So much, for the serious-minded reader, already mentioned, who knows most
- things beforehand, and likes his information cut-and-dried. The commoner
- and more ignorant reader, I will assume, knows no more about Tahiti than I
- did before I went, and therefore will be glad of amplification.
- </p>
- <p>
- Sixteen degrees only from the equator is hot&mdash;very hot at times&mdash;and
- does not allow of a really cool season, though the months between April
- and October are slightly less warm than the others, and at night one may
- sometimes need a blanket. Everything near the equator is a long way from
- England, and everything on the south side of the line is a very long way,
- and anything in the Pacific is so far off that it might almost as well be
- in another star. Tahiti, therefore, is quite, as the Irish say, &ldquo;at the
- back of God-speed.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- Perhaps that is where much of its charm lies. There is a fascination in
- remoteness, hard to define, but not on that account less powerful. &ldquo;So far
- away!&rdquo; is a word-spell that has charmed many a sail across the seas, from
- the days of the seekers after the Golden Fleece till now.
- </p>
- <p>
- Papeëte was the first of the island towns that I saw, and it is so typical
- an example of all, that one description may serve for many.
- </p>
- <p>
- Imagine, then, a long, one-sided street, always known in every group as
- &ldquo;the beach.&rdquo; The reason is apparent&mdash;it really is a beach with houses
- attached, rather than a street with a shore close at hand. The stores&mdash;roomy,
- low, wood-built houses, largely composed of verandah&mdash;are strung
- loosely down the length of the street. Flamboyant trees, as large as
- English beeches, roof in the greater part of the long roadway with a cool
- canopy of green, spangled by bunches of magnificent scarlet flowers.
- Almost every house stands in a tangle of brilliant tropical foliage, and
- the side streets that run off landwards here and there, are more like
- Botanic Gardens with a few ornamental cottages let loose among them, than
- prosaic pieces of a town&mdash;so richly does the flood of riotous
- greenery foam up over low fence tops, and brim into unguarded drains and
- hollows, so gorgeously do the red and white and golden flowers wreathe
- tall verandah posts, and carpet ugly tin roofs with a kindly tapestry of
- leaf, and bloom. Foot to foot and hand to hand with Nature stands man, in
- these islands, let him but relax for a moment, and&mdash;there!&mdash;she
- has him over the line!... Leave Papeëte alone for a couple of years, and
- you would need an axe to find it, when you came back.
- </p>
- <p>
- There are a number of hotels in Papeëte&mdash;mostly of an indifferent
- sort, and none too cheap&mdash;and there are several large cafés and
- restaurants, run on lines entirely Parisian, and a crowd of smaller ones,
- many owned, by Chinese, where the hard-up white may feed at a very small
- cost, pleasantly enough, if he does not ask too many questions about the
- origin and preparation of his food. There are three local newspapers, and
- a military band plays in the afternoons, and there are clubs of all kinds&rsquo;
- and not a little society, which&mdash;being society&mdash;is in its
- essence bound to be uninteresting and flat, even here in the many-coloured
- South Seas. But under all this, the native life flows on in its own way,
- and the Tahitian takes his pleasure after his immemorial fashion, as
- quietly and as lazily as he is allowed. I have spoken hitherto of only one
- side of the main street. The other, which gives directly on the sea,
- belongs to the Tahitian life of Tahiti. Here, a green slope of soft grass
- stretches down to the greener waters of the sparkling lagoon: delicate
- palms lean over the still sea-mirror, like beauties smiling into a glass;
- flamboyant and frangipani trees drop crimson and creamy blooms upon the
- grass; and, among the flowers, facing the sea and the ships and the dreamy
- green lagoon, lie the natives, old and young. They wear the lightest of
- cotton clothing, scarlet and rose and butter-cup yellow, and white scented
- flowers are twisted in their hair. Fruits of many colours, and roots and
- fish, lie beside them. They eat a good part of the day, and their dogs,
- sleeping blissfully in the shade at their feet, wake up and eat with them
- now and then. There is plenty for both&mdash;no one ever goes short of
- food in Tahiti, where the pinch of cold and hunger, and the burden of
- hard, unremitting, unholidayed work are alike unknown. Sometimes the
- natives wander away to the river that flows through the town, and take a
- bath in its cool waters; returning later to lounge, and laze, and suck
- fruit, and dream, on the shores of the lagoon again. The sound of the
- surf, droning all day long on the coral reef that bars the inner lake of
- unruffled green from the outer ocean of windy blue, seems to charm them
- into a soft half-sleep, through which, with open but unseeing eyes, they
- watch the far-off creaming of the breakers in the sun, and the flutter of
- huge velvet butterflies among the flowers, and the brown canoes gliding
- like water-beetles about the tall-masted schooners in the harbour. With
- sunset comes a cooling of the heated air, and glowworm lights begin to
- twinkle through the translucent red walls of the little native houses
- scattered here and there. It will soon be dark now: after dark, there will
- be dancing and singing in the house; later, the sleeping mats will be laid
- out, and with the moon and the stars glimmering in through the walls upon
- their still brown faces, the Tahitians will sleep.... So, in the sunset,
- with
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- Dark faces, pale against the rosy flame,
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- The mild-eyed melancholy lotus-eaters
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p>
- wander home.
- </p>
- <p>
- Only a flash in the long cinematograph of the wonderful track that circles
- the globe, is Tahiti. I cannot tell of Murea, the marvellous island that
- lies opposite Papeete, seven and a half miles away, because, during the
- few days I spent in Tahiti, no boat was going there, and none could be
- induced to go. So I had to look at Murea&rsquo;s splintered towers and spiring
- pinnacles, and wonderful purple goblin palaces, floating high among the
- clouds, from the tantalising distance of Papeëte harbour. Nor could I join
- some steamer friends in driving round the ninety-mile roadway, as we had
- intended&mdash;stopping in native towns, and seeing something of the inner
- life of the island&mdash;because no one in the capital had any teams for
- hire just then, and nobody knew when there would be any. Some of us went
- up the river to see Pierre Loti&rsquo;s bathing pool, and came back rather
- disappointed, and others drove out to the tomb of Pômare V., three miles
- from the town. It was a pile of concrete and stone, modelled after
- European fashions, and not especially interesting.
- </p>
- <p>
- One of the ladies of the party wandered off with me down the beach,
- neither of us being interested in the resting-place of the defunct Pomare&mdash;and
- here we found plenty of food for mind and body both. For was not this a
- pandanus, or screw-pine, which we had read about, overhanging the lagoon,
- with the quaintest mops of palmy foliage, set on long broom-handles of
- boughs, and great fruits like pineapples hanging among the leaves, and
- yellow and scarlet kernels lying thick on the sand below&mdash;the tree
- itself perched up on tall bare wooden stilts formed by the roots, and
- looking more like something from a comic scene in a pantomime, than a real
- live piece of vegetation growing on an actual shore? And were not these
- cocoanuts that lay all about the beach under the leaning palms&mdash;nuts
- such as we had never seen before, big as a horse&rsquo;s head, and smooth green
- as to outside, but nuts all the same?
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0006" id="linkimage-0006"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0055.jpg" alt="0055 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0055.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0007" id="linkimage-0007"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0056.jpg" alt="0056 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0056.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- A native slipped silently from among the thick trees beside us&mdash;a
- bronze-skinned youth of eighteen or nineteen, dressed only in a light
- pareo or kilt of blue and white cotton. He stood with hands lightly
- crossed on his breast, looking at us with the expression of infinite
- kindliness and good-nature that is so characteristic of the Tahitian race.
- We signed to him that we wanted to drink, and he smiled comprehendingly,
- shook his head at the nuts on the ground, and lightly sprang on to the
- bole of the palm beside us, which slanted a little towards the sea. Up the
- trunk of that tree, which inclined so slightly that one would not have
- thought a squirrel could have kept its footing there, walked our native
- friend, holding on with his feet and hands, and going as easily as a
- sailor on a Jacob&rsquo;s ladder. Arrived in the crown some seventy feet above,
- he threw down two or three nuts, and then descended and husked them for
- us.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0008" id="linkimage-0008"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0062.jpg" alt="0062 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0062.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Husking a cocoanut is one of the simplest-looking operations in the world,
- but I have not yet seen the white man who could do it effectively, though
- every native is apparently born with the trick. A stick is sharply pointed
- at both ends, and one end is firmly set in the ground. The nut is now
- taken in the hands, and struck with a hitting and tearing movement
- combined, on the point of the stick, so as to split the thick, intensely
- tough covering of dense coir fibre that protects the nut, and rip the
- latter out. It comes forth white as ivory, about the same shape and size
- as the brown old nuts that come by ship to England, but much younger and
- more brittle, for only the smallest of the old nuts, which are not wanted
- in the islands for copra-making, are generally exported. A large knife is
- used to crack the top of the nut all round, like an egg-shell, and the
- drink is ready, a draught of pure water, slightly sweet and just a little
- aerated, if the nut has been plucked at the right stage. There is no
- pleasanter or more refreshing draught in the world, and it has not the
- least likeness to the &ldquo;milk&rdquo; contained in the cocoanuts of commerce. No
- native would drink old nuts such as the latter, for fear of illness, as
- they are considered both unpleasant and unwholesome. Only half-grown nuts
- are used for drinking, and even these will sometimes hold a couple of
- pints of liquid. The water of the young cocoanut is food and drink in one,
- having much nourishing matter held in solution. On many a long day of hot
- and weary travel, during the years that followed, I had cause to bless the
- refreshing and restoring powers of heaven&rsquo;s best gift to man in the
- tropics, the never-failing cocoanut.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0009" id="linkimage-0009"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0097.jpg" alt="0097 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0097.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- I will not insult the reader by telling him all the uses to which the tree
- and its various products are put, because those are among the things we
- have all learned at our first preparatory school; how the natives in the
- cocoanut countries make hats and mats and houses, and silver fish-servers
- and brocaded dressing-gowns, and glacé kid boots with fourteen buttons (I
- think the list used to run somewhat after that fashion&mdash;it is the
- spirit if not the letter)&mdash;all out of the simple cocoanut tree; a
- piece of knowledge which, somehow or other, used to make us feel vaguely
- virtuous and deserving, as if we had done it all ourselves....
- </p>
- <p>
- But all this time the youth is standing like a smiling bronze statue,
- holding the great ivory cup in his hands, and waiting for us to drink. We
- do so in turn, Ganymede carefully supporting the cup in his upcurved
- hands, and tilting it with a fine regard for our needs, as the water drops
- down in the nut like the tide on a sandy shore when the moon calls back
- the sea.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0010" id="linkimage-0010"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0103.jpg" alt="0103 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0103.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Then we take out purses, and want to pay Ganymede; but he will not be
- paid, until it becomes plain to him that the greatest politeness lies in
- yielding. He takes our franc, and disappears among the trees, to return no
- more. But in a minute, out from the bush comes running the oddest little
- figure, a very old, grey-bearded man, very gaily dressed in a green shirt
- and a lilac pareo, and laden very heavily with ripe pineapples. We guess
- him to be Ganymede&rsquo;s father, and see that our guess was right, when he
- drops the whole heap of fruit upon the ground at our feet, smiling and
- bowing and murmuring incomprehensively over it, and then begins to vanish
- like his son.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Here&mdash;stop!&rdquo; calls my companion. &ldquo;We don&rsquo;t want to take your fruit
- without buying it. Come back, please, come back!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- The little old-gentleman trots back on his thin bare legs, recalled more
- by the tone than the words, which he obviously does not understand, and
- takes a hand of each of us in his own brown fingers. He shakes hands with
- us gently and firmly, shaking his head negatively at the same time, and
- then, like the romantic youths of Early Victorian novels, &ldquo;turns, and is
- immediately lost to view in the surrounding forest,&rdquo; carrying the honours
- of war, indubitably, with himself.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Well, they are real generous!&rdquo; declares my American companion, as we go
- back to the tomb. &ldquo;By the way, Miss G&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;, I guess
- you&rsquo;d better not sit down on that grass to wait for the rest. I wouldn&rsquo;t,
- if I was you.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Why not? it&rsquo;s as dry as dust.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Because the natives say it&rsquo;s somehow or other&mdash;they didn&rsquo;t, explain
- how&mdash;infected with leprosy, and I guess they ought to know; there&rsquo;s
- plenty of it all over the Pacific&mdash;&mdash; I rather thought that
- would hit you where you lived.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- It did. I got up as quickly as a grasshopper in a hurry. Afterwards, on a
- leper island thousands of miles away from Tahiti&mdash;&mdash; But that
- belongs to another place.
- </p>
- <p>
- L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;, the ever-amiable, our half-caste landlady
- at the little bungalow hotel, all overgrown with bougainvillea and
- stephanotis, was grieved because we had seen nothing in the way of
- &ldquo;sights,&rdquo; and declared her intention of giving a native dinner for us.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0011" id="linkimage-0011"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0070.jpg" alt="0070 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0070.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- It was not very native, but it was very amusing. It took place in the
- verandah of the hotel, under a galaxy of Chinese lanterns, with an
- admiring audience of natives crowding the whole roadway outside, and
- climbing up the trees to look at us. This was principally because the word
- had gone forth in Papeëte (which owns the finest gossip-market in the
- South Seas) that the English and American visitors were going to appear in
- native dress, and nobody knew quite how far they meant to go&mdash;there
- being two or three sorts of costume which pass under that classification.
- </p>
- <p>
- The variety which we selected, however, was not very sensational. The
- ladies borrowed from L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&lsquo;s inexhaustible store,
- draped themselves in one or other of her flowing nightdress robes, let
- loose their hair, and crowned themselves with twisted Tahitian corqnets of
- gardenia and tuberose. A scarlet flower behind each ear completed the
- dress, and drew forth delighted squeaks from the handmaidens of the hotel,
- and digs in the ribs from L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;, who was nearly
- out of her mind with excitement and enjoyment. Shoes were retained,
- contrary to L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&lsquo;s entreaties, but corsets she
- would not permit, nor would she allow a hairpin or hair-ribbon among the
- party. The men guests wore white drill suits with a native pareo, scarlet
- or yellow, tied round the waist. It was a gay-looking party, on the whole,
- and the populace of Tahiti seemed to enjoy the sight.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0012" id="linkimage-0012"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0080.jpg" alt="0080 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0080.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- The dinner was served at a table, but most of the dishes were on green
- leaves instead of plates, and L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash; begged us,
- almost with tears in her eyes, to eat the native dainties with our
- fingers, as they tasted better that way. Little gold-fish, baked and
- served with cocoanut sauce, were among the items on the menu: sucking-pig,
- cooked in a hole in the ground, fat little river crayfish, breadfruit
- baked and served hot, with (I regret to say) European butter, native
- puddings made of banana and breadfruit, and the famous raw fish. Some of
- the guests would not touch the latter, but the rest of us thought it no
- worse than raw oysters, and sampled it, with much enjoyment. I give the
- receipt, for the benefit of any one who may care to try it. Take any good
- white fish, cut it up into pieces about two inches long, and place the
- latter, raw, in lime-juice squeezed from fresh limes, or lemon-juice, if
- limes are not to be had. Let the fish steep for half a day, and serve it
- cold, with cocoanut sauce, the receipt for which is as follows:&mdash;Grate
- down the meat of a large cocoanut, and pour a small cup of sea-water over
- it. Leave it for three or four hours, and then strain several times
- through muslin (the fine brown fibre off young cocoanut shoots is a
- correct material, but the reader may not have a cocoanut in his back
- garden). The water should at last come out as thick and opaque as cream.
- </p>
- <p>
- This is the true &ldquo;milk of the cocoanut&rdquo; about which one so often hears. It
- is of immemorial antiquity in the South Seas.
- </p>
- <p>
- Captain Cook mentions it in his <i>Voyages</i>, and describes the cocoanut
- shells full of it, that were given to every man at a feast, in which to
- dip his food. When used as a sauce for meat or fish, one or two fresh red
- peppers from the nearest pepper bush are cut up and put in. Chili pepper,
- judiciously used, is a fair substitute for the latter. The sauce is also
- used for many native puddings and sweet dishes, in which case it is made
- with fresh water and the pepper is left out. As a fish sauce it is
- unsurpassed, and may be recommended to gourmands as a new sensation. It
- should be served in bowls of brown cocoanut shell.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0013" id="linkimage-0013"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0091.jpg" alt="0091 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0091.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Breadfruit some of us tasted for the first time at this dinner. It was
- universally liked, though a few maintained that it resembled potato more
- than bread. I found it very like the latter, with a suggestion of floury
- cracknel biscuit. It is most satisfying and nourishing. One never, in
- island travels, feels the want of fresh bread when breadfruit is
- available. L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash; had cooked it native fashion,
- peeled and baked on hot stones in a pit in the ground. It is a good-sized
- fruit in its natural state, about as large as a medium hothouse melon, and
- bright green in colour. The skin is divided into lizard-like lozenges, and
- the surface is very rough. Whether it is indigenous to the islands or not,
- I cannot say, but it was there when Cook came, and it grows wild very
- freely, providing an immense store of natural food.
- </p>
- <p>
- Taro we also had, baked native style. It is a plant in use over almost all
- the Pacific, very easily cultivated and rapidly producing immense
- bluish-coloured roots, which look like mottled soap when cooked and
- served. It is extremely dense and heavy, but pleasant to most tastes. The
- white taro is a less common kind, somewhat lighter.
- </p>
- <p>
- The mangoes that were served with the meal (among many other fruits) were
- of a variety that is generally supposed to be the finest in the world. No
- mango is so large, so sweet, or so fine in grain, as the mango of Tahiti,
- and none has less of the turpentine flavour that is so much disliked by
- newcomers to tropical countries. It is a commonplace of the islands that a
- mango can only be eaten with comfort in a bath, and many of the guests
- that evening would not have been sorry for a chance to put the precept
- into practice, after struggling with one or two mangoes, which were, of
- course, too solid to be sucked, and much too juicy and sticky not to smear
- the hands and the face of the consumers disastrously.
- </p>
- <p>
- L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash; gave us many French dishes with our native
- dinner, to suit all tastes, and gratify her own love of fine cookery, but
- these would be of little interest to recount. I cannot forget, however,
- how this true artiste of the kitchen described the menu she had planned,
- on the morning of the entertainment. She sat down beside me on a sofa to
- tell the wondrous tale, and, as she recited dish after dish, her voice
- rose higher and higher, and her great black eyes burned, and she seized me
- by the arm and almost hugged me in her excitement. When she came to the
- savouries, tears of genuine emotion rose in her eyes, and at the end of
- the whole long list, her feelings overcame her like a flood, and, gasping
- out&mdash;&ldquo;Beignets d&rsquo;ananas à la Papeete; glaces. Vénus, en Cythère;
- fromage&mdash;&mdash;&rdquo; she cast herself bodily into my arms and sobbed
- with delight. She was fully fifteen stone, and the weather was exceedingly
- warm, but I admired her artistic fervour too much to tell her to sit up,
- and stop crying over my clean muslin (as I should have liked to do),
- because it seemed to me that L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash; was really a
- true artiste in her own way, and almost worthy to rank, in the history of
- the kitchen, with Vatel the immortal, who fell upon his sword and died,
- because the fish was late for the royal dinner.
- </p>
- <p>
- Of the other evening, when half a dozen guests of mixed nationalities
- began, through a temptation of the devil, to talk politics at ten o&rsquo;clock
- on the verandah&mdash;of the fur that, metaphorically speaking, commenced
- to fly when the American cast the Irish question into the fray, and the
- Englishman vilified Erin, and the Irishwoman, following the historical
- precedent, called the Frenchwoman to her aid, and the latter in the
- prettiest manner in the world, got up and closed her two small hands round
- the throat of John Bull, and choked him into silence&mdash;it would not be
- necessary to tell, had not the sequel been disastrous to the fair name of
- our steamship party in Papeete. For a big banana spider, as big in the
- body as half a crown, and nearly as hard, came suddenly out from the
- stephanotis boughs, and, like a famous ancestor, &ldquo;sat down beside&rdquo; a lady
- of the party. This caused the politicians to rush to the aid of the lady,
- who had of course mounted a chair and begun to scream. The spider proved
- extremely difficult to kill, and had to be battered with the legs of
- chairs for some time before he yielded up the ghost&mdash;one guest, who
- found an empty whisky bottle, and flattened the creature out with it,
- carrying off the honours of the fray. After which excitement, we all felt
- ready for bed, and went.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;And in the morning, behold&rdquo; the kindly L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;
- smiling upon her guests, and remarking: &ldquo;Dat was a real big drunk you all
- having on the veràndah, after I gone to bed!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Good heavens, L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;!&rdquo; exclaims Mrs. New England,
- pale with horror, &ldquo;what do you mean?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Surely, Mrs. L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;, you do not suppose for an
- instant any of our party were&mdash;I can hardly say it!&rdquo; expostulates a
- delicate-looking minister from the Southern States, here for his lungs,
- who was very prominent last night in arguing Ireland&rsquo;s right to &ldquo;secede&rdquo;
- if she liked.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;That&rsquo;s a good one, I must say,&rdquo; remarks John Bull, rather indignantly.
- </p>
- <p>
- But L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash; only smiles on. She is always smiling.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Dat don&rsquo;t go, Mr. &mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&rdquo; she says
- pleasantly. &ldquo;I couldn&rsquo;t sleep last night, for the way you all kicking up,
- and the girl, she say you fighting. Madame &mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;
- she trying to kill Mr. Bull, all the gentlemen smashing the leg of the
- chairs, the lady scream&mdash;and dis mornin&rsquo;, I findin&rsquo; a large whisky
- bottle, all drunk up.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- I am privately choking with laughter in a corner, but I cannot help
- feeling sorry for Mrs. New England, who really looks as if about to faint.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;<i>I</i> don&rsquo; mind!&rdquo; declares L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash; delightedly.
- &ldquo;Why, I been thinking all dis time you haven&rsquo;t been enjoyin&rsquo; yourself at
- all. I like every one here they having a real good time. Every one,&rdquo; she
- smiles&mdash;and melts away into the soft gloom of the drawing-room, where
- she sits down, and begins to play softly thrumming, strangely intoxicating
- Tahitian dance music on the piano.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;<i>Elle est impayable!</i>&rdquo; says the Frenchwoman, shrugging her
- shoulders. &ldquo;From all I hear of Tahiti, my dear friends, I think you shall
- find yourselves without a chiffon of character to-morrow.... But courage!
- it is a thing here the most superfluous.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- Madame was a true prophet, I have reason to know; for many months after,
- the story of the orgy, held on L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&lsquo;s verandah by
- the English and French and American ladies and gentlemen, reached me in a
- remote corner of the Pacific, as &ldquo;the latest from Papeete.&rdquo; What I wanted
- to know, and what I never shall know, for my boat came in next day, and
- took me away to Raratonga&mdash;was whether the minister from the South
- eventually died of the shock or not. I do not want to know about the lady
- from New England, because I am quite certain she did&mdash;as certain as I
- am that I should have, myself, and did not.
- </p>
- <p>
- Of the prospects in Tahiti for settlers I cannot say much. It was said,
- while I was in Papeete, that there was practically no money in the place,
- and the traders, like the Scilly Island washerfolk of well-known fame,
- merely existed by trading with each other. This may have been an
- exaggeration, or a temporary state of depression. The vanilla trade, owing
- to a newly invented chemical substitute, was not doing well, but judging
- by what I saw next year in Fiji, the market must have recovered. The
- climate of Tahiti is matchless for vanilla growing, and land is not very
- difficult to get.
- </p>
- <p>
- Quite a number of small schooners seemed to be engaged in the pearling
- trade with the Paumotus&mdash;a group of islands covering over a thousand
- miles of sea, and including some of the richest pearl beds in the world&mdash;(French
- property). I never coveted anything more than I coveted those dainty
- little vessels. Built in San Francisco, where people know how to build
- schooners, they were finished like yachts, and their snowy spread of
- cotton-cloth canvas, when they put out to sea, and their graceful
- bird-like lines, would have delighted the soul of Clarke Russell. One, a
- thirty-ton vessel, with the neatest little saloon in the world, fitted
- with shelves for trading; and a captain&rsquo;s cabin like a miniature finer
- stateroom, and a toy-like galley forward, with a battery of shining
- saucepans, and a spotless stove&mdash;snowy paint on hull and deckhouses,
- lightened with fines of turquoise blue&mdash;splendid spiring masts,
- varnished till they shone&mdash;cool white awning over the poop, and
- sparkling brasses about the compass and the wheel, was so completely a
- craft after my own heart that I longed to run away with her, or take her
- off in my trunk to play with&mdash;she seemed quite small enough, though
- her &ldquo;beat&rdquo; covered many thousand miles of sea. Poor little <i>Maid of the
- Islands!</i> Her bones are bleaching on a coral reef among the perilous
- pearl atolls, this two years past, and her captain&mdash;the cheerful,
- trim, goodnatured X&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;, who could squeeze more
- knots an hour out of his little craft than any other master in the port
- save one, and could tell more lies about the Pacific in half an hour, than
- any one from Chili to New Guinea&mdash;of his bones are coral made, down
- where the giant clam swings his cruel valves together on wandering fish or
- streaming weed, or limb of luckless diver, and where the dark tentacles of
- the great Polynesian devil-fish
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- Winnow with giant arms the slumbering green.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p>
- The pitcher that goes to the well, and the schooner that goes to the pearl
- islands, are apt to meet with the same fate, in time. Nevertheless, tales
- about the Paumotus are many, and interesting enough to attract adventurers
- from far, if they were known. How the rumour of a big pearl gets out; how
- a schooner sets forth to run down the game, pursues it through shifting
- report after report, from native exaggeration to native denial, perhaps
- for months; how it is found at last, and triumphantly secured for a price
- not a tenth its worth; how one shipload of shell, bought on speculation,
- will have a fortune in the first handful, and the next will yield no more
- than the value of the shell itself&mdash;this, and much else, make good
- hearing.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Look at that pearl,&rdquo; said a schooner captain to me one day, showing me a
- little globe of light the size of a pea, and as round as a marble. &ldquo;I
- hunted that for a year, off and on. The native that had it lived way off
- from anywhere, but he knew a thing or two, and he wouldn&rsquo;t part. I offered
- him goods, I offered him gin, I offered him twenty pounds cash, but it was
- all no go. How d&rsquo;you think I got it at last? Well, I&rsquo;ll tell you. I went
- up to his island with the twenty pounds in a sack, all in small silver,
- and when I came into his house, I poured it all out in a heap on the mats.
- &lsquo;Ai, ai, ai!&rsquo; he says, and drops down on his knees in front of it&mdash;it
- looked like a fortune to him. &lsquo;Will you sell now?&rsquo; says I, and by Jove, he
- did, and I carried it off with me. Worth? Can&rsquo;t say yet, but it&rsquo;ll run
- well into three figures.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- The pearling in the French islands is strictly preserved, and the terms on
- which it is obtainable are not known to me. Poaching is a crime not by any
- means unheard of.
- </p>
- <p>
- A glance at the map, and the extent of the Paumotu group, will explain
- better than words why the policing of the pearl bed must necessarily be
- incomplete.
- </p>
- <p>
- The steamer came in in due course, and carried me away to the Cook
- Islands. Huaheine and Raiatea, in the Society group, were called at on the
- way, but Bora-Bora was left out, as it is not a regular port of call. I am
- glad I did not land on Bora-Bora, and I never shall, if I can help it. No
- place in the world could be so like a fairy dream as Bora-Bora looked in
- the distance. It was literally a castle in the air; battlements and
- turrets, built of vaporous blue clouds, springing steep and impregnable
- from the diamond-dusted sea to the violet vault of heaven. Fairy
- princesses lived there, one could not but know; dragons lurked in the dark
- caves low down on the shore, and &ldquo;magic casements, opening on the foam of
- perilous seas,&rdquo; looked down from those far blue pinnacles.
- </p>
- <p>
- Perhaps there is a village on Bora-Bora, with a dozen traders, and an ugly
- concrete house or two, tin-roofed, defacing the beauty of the palm-woven
- native homes, and a whitewashed church with European windows, and a school
- where the pretty native girls are taught to plait back their flowing hair,
- and lay aside their scented wreaths of jessamine and orange-blossom.
- </p>
- <p>
- But if all these things are there, at least I do not know it, and
- Bora-Bora can still remain to me my island of Tir-na&rsquo;n-Oge&mdash;the
- fabled country which the mariners of ancient Ireland sought through long
- ages of wandering, and only saw upon the far horizon, never, through all
- the years, setting foot upon the strand that they knew to be the fairest
- in the world. If they had ever indeed landed there.... But it is best for
- all of us to see our Tir-na&rsquo;n-Oge only in the far away.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p class="indent20">
- Le seul rêve, intéresse.
- </p>
- <p class="indent20">
- Vivre sans rêve, qu&rsquo;est-ce?
- </p>
- <p class="indent20">
- Moi, j&rsquo;aime la Princesse
- </p>
- <p class="indent30">
- Lointaine.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /> <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0003" id="link2HCH0003"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER III
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>Is It the Loveliest?&mdash;How they deal with the Beachcomber&mdash;&mdash;Cockroaches
- and Local Colour&mdash;The Robinson Crusoe-Steamer&mdash;Emigrating to the
- South Seas&mdash;The Lands of Plenty&mdash;How to get an Island.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">E</span>VERY ONE has seen
- Raratonga, though few travellers have looked on it with their own mortal
- eyes.
- </p>
- <p>
- Close your eyelids, and picture to yourself a South Sea Island, of the
- kind that you used to imagine on holiday afternoons long ago, when you
- wandered off down to the shore alone, to sit in a cave and look seaward,
- and fancy yourself Crusoe or Selkirk, and think the &ldquo;long, long thoughts&rdquo;
- of youth. Dagger-shaped peaks, of splendid purple and gorgeous green, set
- in a sky of flaming sapphire&mdash;sheer grey precipices, veiled with
- dropping wreaths of flowery vine and creeper&mdash;gossamer shreds of
- cloud, garlanding untrodden heights, high above an ocean of stainless blue&mdash;shadowy
- gorges, sweeping shoreward from the unseen heart of the hills&mdash;white
- foam breaking upon white sand on the beach, and sparkling sails afloat in
- the bay&mdash;is not this the picture that wanders ever among the gleams
- and glooms that dart across the schoolboy&rsquo;s brain?
- </p>
- <p>
- It is not very like the average South Sea Island on the whole&mdash;but it
- is a faithful portrait of Raratonga, the jewel of the Southern Seas.
- </p>
- <p>
- Nothing is more hotly disputed than the claims of the many beautiful
- islands among the numberless groups of the Pacific to the crown of
- supremest loveliness. Tahiti is awarded the apple of Paris by many,
- Honolulu by a few, Samoa by all who have been there and nowhere else. The
- few who have seen the quaint loveliness of Manahiki, or Humphrey Island,
- uphold its claims among the highest, and for myself, I have never been
- quite certain whether the low atoll islands are not more lovely than all
- else, because of their matchless colouring. But, if one pins one&rsquo;s faith
- to the high islands, the accepted type of Pacific loveliness, there is
- nothing more beautiful between &rsquo;Frisco and Sydney, Yokohama and
- Cape Horn, than Raratonga, chief island of the Cook archipelago.
- </p>
- <p>
- These islands lie some sixteen hundred miles north-east of New Zealand,
- and about six hundred miles to the westward of Tahiti. They are eight in
- number, seven inhabited, and one uninhabited, and cover about a hundred
- and sixty miles of sea. The largest, Atiu, is about thirty miles round,
- Raratonga, which is the principal island, containing the seat of
- government and the only &ldquo;white&rdquo; town, is twenty miles in circumference.
- </p>
- <p>
- The whole group, as well as a number of outlying islands as much as six
- and seven hundred miles away, is under the guardianship of the Resident
- Commissioner appointed by New Zealand, to which colony the islands were
- annexed in 1900. The government, as administered by Colonel Gudgeon, a
- soldier who won much distinction in the days of the New Zealand Maori
- wars, is all that could be desired. The beachcomber element, which is so
- unpleasantly in evidence in other groups, has been sternly discouraged in
- the Cook Islands, the Commissioner having the right to deport any one
- whose presence seems undesirable to the cause of the general good. It is a
- right not infrequently used. During my stay in the island, two doubtful
- characters, recently come, were suspected of having committed a robbery
- that took place in the town. There was practically no one else on the
- island who could have done the deed, or would&mdash;but direct evidence
- connecting the strangers with the crime, was not to be had. Under these
- circumstances, the Commissioner simply deported the men by the next
- steamer, giving no reason beyond the fact that they were without means of
- support. There were no more thefts. The colonel might, in the same manner,
- have ordered myself away by the next steamer, and compelled it to carry me
- to New Zealand, if he had had reason to suppose that I was likely to
- disturb the peace of the island in any way, or incite it to violence or
- crime. The doctor&mdash;also a Government official&mdash;was empowered to
- regulate the amount of liquor consumed by any resident, if it appeared to
- exceed the permitted amount&mdash;two bottles of spirits a week. Under
- these circumstances, one would expect Raratonga to be a little Arcadia of
- innocence and virtue. If it was not quite that, it was, and is, a credit
- to British Colonial rule, in all things essential.
- </p>
- <p>
- Before the annexation, the government was chiefly in the hands of the
- Protestant missionaries, who, with the best intentions in the world,
- carried things decidedly too far in the way of grandmotherly laws. Even
- white men were forbidden to be out of doors after eight o&rsquo;clock in the
- evening, on pain of a heavy fine, and the offences for which the natives
- were fined would be incredible, were they not recorded in the Governmental
- reports of New Zealand.
- </p>
- <p>
- In Raratonga of the older days (not yet ten years past) a native who
- walked at dusk along the road with his sweetheart, his arm round her waist
- after the manner of sweethearts all the world over, was obliged to carry a
- burning torch in his hand, and was fined if he let it go out. If he was
- found weeping over the grave of a woman to whom he was not related (surely
- the strangest crime in the world) he was again brought up and fined. These
- are only samples of the vagaries of irresponsible missionary rule, but
- they go far to prove that spiritual and temporal legislation are better
- kept apart.
- </p>
- <p>
- A Government accommodation house had been planned, but not built, when I
- visited Raratonga, so I arranged, on landing, to take an unused house by
- the week, and &ldquo;do for&rdquo; myself, as there seemed no other way of living.
- Scarcely had I taken possession of my quarters, however, when the
- residents came down to call, and invite me to stay in their house. I did
- not know any of them, and they did not know me, but that did not matter&mdash;we
- were not in chilly England, where a whole country-side must discuss your
- personal history, family connections, probable income, and religious
- views, for a good six months, before deciding whether you are likely to be
- an acquisition or not, and calling accordingly. I began to understand,
- now, the meaning of the term &ldquo;colonial hospitality,&rdquo; which had formerly
- fallen on uncomprehending ears. And when I was settled down that evening
- in the most delightful of bungalow houses, with a charming host and
- hostess, and a pretty daughter, all doing their best to make me feel at
- home, I realised that I was about to see something of the true island life
- at last.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0014" id="linkimage-0014"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0035.jpg" alt="0035 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0035.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- It began rather sooner than I could have wished. When my new friends had
- gone to bed, and left me sitting up alone in the hall to write letters for
- the morning&rsquo;s mail, the local colour commenced to lay itself on somewhat
- more rapidly and thickly than I desired. I am not particularly nervous
- about insects, but it is trying, when one is quite new to the tropics, to
- see a horde of cockroaches as large as mice, with fearsome waving horns,
- suddenly appear from nowhere, and proceed to overrun the walls and floor,
- with a hideous ticking noise. And when one has steeled oneself to endure
- this horrid spectacle, it is still more trying to be shocked by the silent
- irruption of dozens of brown hairy hunting-spiders, each big enough to
- straddle over a saucer, which dart about the walls on their eight agile
- legs, and slay and eat the beetles, crunching audibly in the silence of
- the night.... Truly, it was like a waking nightmare.
- </p>
- <p>
- Those cockroaches! What I suffered from them, during the year or two of
- island travel that followed! How they spoiled my tea, and ate my dresses
- (or parts of them), and flew into my hair of moonlight nights, and climbed
- into my berth on shipboard! It was on a liner that shall be nameless, very
- early in the course of my wanderings, that I first discovered the tendency
- of the cockroach to share the voyager&rsquo;s couch unasked, and never again did
- I know unvexed and trustful sleep aboard a tropic ship. It was a moonlight
- night, and I was lying looking peacefully at the brilliantly silvered
- circle of my port, when suddenly a horrid head, with waving feelers,
- lifted itself over the edge of my berth and stared me coldly in the face.
- I hit out, like the virtuous hero in a novel, and struck it straight
- between the eyes, and it dropped to the floor with a dull sickening thud,
- and lay there very still. I thought gloatingly of how the blood would
- trickle out under my door in the morning in a slow hideous stream, and how
- the stewardess, bringing my early tea, would start and stop, and say in an
- awestruck tone that one that night had met his doom&mdash;and so thinking,
- I fell asleep.
- </p>
- <p>
- I woke, with one cockroach in my hair, chewing a plait, and another
- nibbling my heel. I got up and looked round. It was then that I wished I
- had never come away from home, and that, since I had come, my sex forbade
- me to go and berth in the hold. I was convinced that, if I could have done
- so, I should have had a quiet night, because the hold is the part of a
- ship where the cockroaches come from, and they had all <i>come</i>&mdash;they
- were on the floor of my cabin, and sitting about the quilt.
- </p>
- <p>
- The hideous battle raged all night, and in the morning I asked one of the
- mates for an axe, to help me through the coming renewal of hostilities. He
- recommended boracic acid instead, and I may record, for the benefit of
- other travellers, that I really found it of some use.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0015" id="linkimage-0015"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0043.jpg" alt="0043 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0043.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- To find out, as far as possible, what were the prospects for settlers in
- some of the principal Pacific groups, was the main object of my journey to
- the Islands. It had always seemed to me that the practical side of Pacific
- life received singularly little attention, in most books of travel. One
- could never find out how a living was to be made in the island world, what
- the cost of housekeeping might be, what sort of society might be expected,
- whether the climates were healthy, and so forth&mdash;matters prosaic
- enough, but often of more interest to readers than the scenic descriptions
- and historical essays that run naturally from the pen of any South Sea
- traveller.
- </p>
- <p>
- Certainly, the romantic and picturesque side of the islands is so obvious
- that it takes some determination, and a good deal of actual hard work, to
- obtain any other impressions whatever. But white human beings, even in the
- islands, cannot live on romance alone, and many people, in Britain and
- elsewhere, are always anxious to know how the delightful dream of living
- in the South Seas may be realised. Practical details about island life,
- therefore, will take up the most of the present chapter, and readers who
- prefer the lighter and more romantic vein, must turn the pages a little
- further on. .
- </p>
- <p>
- The number of those who wish to settle in the Pacific is by no means
- small.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Pacific Ocean has always had a special interest for the English, from
- the days of Drake s daring circumnavigation, through the times of Captain
- Cook and the somewhat misunderstood Bligh, of the <i>Bounty</i>, down to
- the dawn of the twentieth century. The very name of the South Seas reeks
- of adventure and romance. Every boy at school has dreams of coral islands
- and rakish schooners, sharks, and pearls; most men retain a shamefaced
- fancy for stories of peril and adventure in that magical South Sea world,
- of whose charm and beauty every one has heard, although very few are
- fortunate enough to see it with their own bodily eyes. For the Pacific
- Islands are, both in point of time and distance, about the remotest spots
- on the surface of the globe, and they are also among the most costly for
- the ordinary traveller to reach. Thus, for the most part, the South Seas
- dream, which so many hot-blooded young Saxons cherish, remains a dream
- only. The youth who has a fancy for Canadian farming life, or for
- stock-raising in Australasia, may gratify his desire with the full
- approval of parents and guardians in private life, and of Empire-builders
- in high places. But the British possessions in the South Seas&mdash;and
- what extensive possession they are let Colonial maps prove&mdash;may cry
- out for settlers from the rainy season to the dry, and round again to the
- rainy season once more, without attracting a single colonist of the right
- kind.
- </p>
- <p>
- What is the reason of this? Where is the broken link? The British Pacific
- Islands need settlers; young Britons at home are only too ready to
- adventure themselves. Why do they not? There are several reasons. The
- first, perhaps, is that neither party can hear the other. In England few
- possess any information about the South Sea Islands. In the Pacific the
- white residents (almost all New Zealand traders and Government officials)
- are possessed with an idea that only wastrels of the worst kind drift out
- from England to the South Seas, and that nothing better is to be looked
- for. The result is that at the present date young Englishmen by the
- hundred are losing their small capital as &ldquo;pupils&rdquo; on Canadian farms, or
- are starving on the roads in South Africa, while all the time the South
- Sea Islands hold out hands of peace and plenty, begging humbly for a
- respectable white population. The brown races are dying out with fearful
- rapidity; at their best they never touched the limitless capacities of the
- golden Pacific soil. Its richness has always seemed to the original
- inhabitants an excellent reason for abstaining from cultivation. When the
- earth produced of itself everything that was necessary for comfort, why
- trouble to work it? Now, however, when so many groups of fertile islands
- have fallen into the hands of more progressive nations, things are
- changed. The white man can live happily and healthily in the Pacific; he
- can obtain a good return for a small capital at the best, and at the worst
- cannot possibly suffer from either cold or hunger, since neither exists in
- the South Seas. He can lease or buy land from the natives at slight cost,
- work it with small labour, and sell the product to a sure market. Honesty,
- sobriety, and industry repay their possessor as almost nowhere else in the
- world. Yet, with all this, the white settler in the Pacific Islands is
- generally of a more or less undesirable kind.
- </p>
- <p>
- The &ldquo;beachcomber&rdquo; white, without friends, means, or character; the
- &ldquo;remittance man,&rdquo; paid to keep as far away from home as possible; the
- travelling ne&rsquo;er-do-well, with a taste for novelties in dissipation, and a
- fancy for being outside the limit of Press and post&mdash;all these are
- familiar figures in the Pacific. Kipling&rsquo;s Lost Legion musters there by
- the score; the living ghosts of men whose memorial tablets are blinking
- white on the walls of English country churches, walk by daylight along the
- coral beaches. Only the steady man, the young energetic man with a future
- and without a past, the man who can get on without a three-weekly spree of
- the most torrid kind, commonly keeps away. And these are just the men that
- the &ldquo;Islands&rdquo; want. Local trading interest, religious and otherwise, often
- does its best to keep them from coming, through a natural, if scarcely
- praiseworthy, desire to retain personal hold of everything worth holding.
- The Governmental party of every group desires the respectable settler with
- a little capital, and expresses its desire, as a rule, in gentle wails
- delivered through Governmental reports&mdash;a method about as effective
- as putting one&rsquo;s head into a cupboard to hail a &rsquo;bus in the street.
- The Press does not recognise the existence of any habitable land in the
- Pacific, outside Honolulu and Samoa. So the dead lock continues.
- </p>
- <p>
- I can see the Left Behind in the office raise his head at this, and look
- through the muddy panes of the counting-house window, or across the piles
- of summer goods on the shop counters, out beyond the clanging street, and
- right through the whole round world to the far-away Pacific lands. He
- wants to get away so very badly, that poor Left Behind, and he does not
- quite see his way to do it, because every one discourages him if he hints
- at the subject, and he does not know how one could make a living, out in
- those fairy lands that he wishes so much to see. Well, I am on his side in
- this matter. If it is a crime to long for a glimpse of the wonderful
- island world, to ache for a life spent under the free winds of heaven, and
- a chance of the danger, adventure, and excitement, which are as strong
- wine to the heart of almost every young Englishman&mdash;then it is a
- crime shared by the best that the nation has ever known, and one which has
- done more to build up the empire than all the parochial virtues ever owned
- by a million Young Men&rsquo;s Improvement Societies put together.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Islands are not the place for the ne&rsquo;er-do-well, and I would also warn
- the exasperating young man, who never did a square day&rsquo;s work in his life,
- never got into trouble with his employers or his superiors, but always
- found himself misunderstood, unappreciated, and incomprehensibly &ldquo;sacked,&rdquo;
- with an excellent character, at the first hint of slacking business&mdash;that
- the islands will not suit him either. If he comes out, he will not starve
- or go to the workhouse, because you cannot die of hunger where there is
- always enough vegetable food to keep the laziest alive, and you do not
- need workhouses, under the same happy conditions&mdash;but he will &ldquo;go
- native,&rdquo; and there are some who would say he had better starve, a good
- deal. There are men who have &ldquo;gone native&rdquo; in most of the Pacific groups,
- living in the palm-leaf huts with the villagers&mdash;but a white man in a
- waist-cloth and a bush of long hair, sleeping on a mat and living on wild
- fruit and scraps given by the generous natives, drunk half the time and
- infinitely lower, in his soberest hours, than the coloured folk who
- unwisely put up with him, is not a happy spectacle.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Cook Islands, which may be taken as a sample of many other groups, are
- small to look at on the map, and not over large, when one counts up the
- number of square miles. But one cannot fairly estimate the value of island
- land by its extent. Much of it is so rich that every foot has its worth,
- and that is by no means despicable. And, in any case, there is plenty
- available for the small cultivator&mdash;the man who has only a few
- hundred pounds, and cannot afford to do things on the colossal scale that
- makes big fortunes.
- </p>
- <p>
- Among the productions of the group are pineapples, custard apples, coffee,
- tobacco, pepper, mammee-apple or paw-paw, granadilla, cocoa, cotton,
- vanilla, limes, lemons, oranges, bananas, castor-oil, and many other
- useful plants, besides a number of excellent vegetables, not known to most
- Europeans. Many of the fruits above mentioned grow practically wild.
- Bananas come to bearing in fifteen months, cocoanuts in seven years, limes
- in four or five. The water supply is good all round, and there is a
- monthly steamer from Auckland.
- </p>
- <p>
- The land in all the islands belongs to the natives, and cannot usually be
- bought outright. Leases of any length, can, however, be secured at very
- low rates, with the New Zealand Government laws, administered through the
- Resident, to back up the titles, so that a man who plants cocoanuts&mdash;the
- safest of island products&mdash;may be sure that his children and
- grandchildren will enjoy the fruits of his labour.
- </p>
- <p>
- In most of the outer islands the natives cannot use more than a small
- fraction of the land, and are quite willing to let large sections at a
- shilling or two an acre. In Raratonga, the chief island, there has been
- more demand for land, and prices are consequently higher; also, the chiefs
- are not always ready to let, even though they do not use what they have.
- It may be said, however, of the group as a whole, that there is land, and
- a prospect of a good return for capital, ready for any reasonable number
- of settlers, if they bring habits of industry and a determination to
- succeed along with them.
- </p>
- <p>
- There are two classes of possible settlers to be considered&mdash;the man
- with capital, and the man without.
- </p>
- <p>
- How much does it take to start a man as a planter, and what return can he
- expect?
- </p>
- <p>
- Taking the Cook Islands as a general example (but by no means suggesting
- that the resources of the Pacific begin and end there) the young
- Englishman wishing to seek his fortune as a planter should have at least
- £500 to start on, exclusive of passage-money. He can do excellently with a
- few hundreds more, but it is as well to put things as low as possible.
- Copra&mdash;the dried kernel of the cocoanut&mdash;is the usual, and the
- safest, investment. It is always saleable, and the demand increases year
- by year&mdash;so much so, that the large soapmaking firms, who are the
- chief users of the product, are of late planting out islands for
- themselves. The cost of clearing and planting the land is about £5 an
- acre. The rent, in the outer islands, should not exceed a couple of
- shillings an acre. In about seven years, the returns begin to come in, and
- in ten years&rsquo; time the land should be bringing in £5 net profit for every
- acre of trees. This is, of course, a long time to wait, but bananas can
- grow on the same land meantime, and will generally yield a quick return.
- Once the cocoanuts start bearing, they go on for sixty years or more, so
- that a copra plantation is one of the best investments for a man who has
- others to come after him.
- </p>
- <p>
- Banana growing may be managed with less capital, but the profits are not
- so sure, since fruit is perishable, and cannot wait for the steamer as
- copra can. Coffee has been grown, but is not of late years doing well,
- because of something like a &ldquo;ring&rdquo; formed in New Zealand to lower the
- prices. Cotton used to do excellently, and I have never heard any
- satisfactory reason against its being taken up afresh. It is running wild
- in a good many parts of the group. The plants above mentioned, however, by
- no means exhaust the resources of the islands, which are suitable for
- growing anything that will live in the tropics, and are fortunately not
- subject to the destructive hurricanes that from time to time do so much
- damage in Tahiti and the Fijis. Hurricanes are not absolutely unknown, but
- they are very rare, and not of the worst kind.
- </p>
- <p>
- The cost of living is not very serious, but it must not be supposed that
- the settlers can live decently and like white men, on nothing a year. A
- house costs something to put up, and furniture to a certain small amount
- is necessary, clothes do not grow on the cocoanut tree, nor do lamps and
- kerosene, or tools and nails, or fishing lines, or flour and bacon and tea
- and tinned butter, and the few groceries that the settler may need. Still,
- with care, a single man can live quite respectably on fifty pounds a year,
- and enjoy, in all probability, better health than he has had at home.
- </p>
- <p>
- What the time of waiting will cost the copra planter, each one must work
- out for himself. He will do best to spend his capital gradually, planting
- as he can afford. The returns will come in only by degrees, but he will be
- saved the mortification of seeing a promising plantation leave his
- possession for a third of its value, simply because he cannot afford to
- wait until the profits begin.
- </p>
- <p>
- Copra, the chief article of commerce of the Pacific, is very easily
- prepared. The cocoanuts, when ripe, are husked, and emptied, and the
- kernels, as a rule, left to dry in the sun, though some few planters use
- artificial heat. Bagging is the only other operation necessary.
- </p>
- <p>
- Bananas are often shipped clumsily and carelessly, in unprotected bunches.
- It would be much better to pack them in leaves and crate them, as is done
- in the Canary Islands, where the banana trade is the principal support of
- the country. Oranges are usually shipped in crates. They grow wild all
- over the Cook group, and are not attended to in any way, but in spite of
- this, the orange trade with New Zealand is by no means despicable.
- </p>
- <p>
- Vanilla is not cultivated for market in these islands, but it would
- probably repay the experimenter. It does well in most of the Pacific
- groups, and the returns begin in three years from planting.
- </p>
- <p>
- Island planters, as a race, seem to be the most conservative of men, and
- very shy of trying anything new and unproved. There are, of course, good
- reasons for this, but there are also excellent arguments in favour of
- exploiting fresh fields. The following brief hints may prove fruitful to
- enterprising minds.
- </p>
- <p>
- Only one kind of banana&mdash;the sort familiar at home&mdash;is usually
- grown for trade. There are many varieties, however, and some of the very
- best travel quite as well as the commonplace &ldquo;China&rdquo; sort. The large red
- banana, sometimes called the Aitutaki banana, sometimes the peach banana,
- on account of its delicate peach-like flavour, is a fruit that would
- become the fashion at once, if it could be put on the market. One or two
- planters have gone so far as to send consignments down to New Zealand,
- but, finding that these did not sell on account of the unusual colour of
- the fruit, they never made another attempt. At the time of my visit, in
- 1904, the red banana was practically unobtainable in New Zealand or
- Australia. A little intelligent co-operation on the part of the buyers
- would probably get over the difficulty.
- </p>
- <p>
- The same may be said of limes, a fruit which grows wild very freely. The
- lime is like a small, round-shaped lemon, and is not an attractive fruit
- in appearance. It also suffers under the disadvantage of being very badly
- represented as to flavour by the bottled &ldquo;shop&rdquo; lime-juice, with which the
- taste of the fresh lime has hardly anything in common. Where it can be
- obtained fresh, however, no one ever thinks of using lemon as a flavouring
- in food or drink. The lime is incomparably more delicate and refreshing
- than the best lemon ever grown. For some unknown reason, however, it is
- not used in New Zealand, or in the cities of Australia, to which it could
- be easily and profitably exported from many of the Pacific groups.
- Instead, the juice of limes is squeezed out by a very rough process, the
- fruit being run through a wooden hand-press, and is shipped away in casks.
- The lime trade would certainly rival the orange trade, if worked up.
- </p>
- <p>
- Dried bananas have money in them, and the industry is especially adapted
- to some of the lesser Cook Islands, where steamer calls are at present
- irregular. The dried and pressed banana is better than the fig, and is
- considered a great delicacy by the few people in the colonies who have
- tried it. The Cook Islanders peel the fruit, and leave it to dry in the
- sun. When it is shrunk, dark, and sticky with its own sugar, they compress
- it into neat little packets covered with dried banana leaf, and tied with
- banana fibre. These will keep good for many months. Up to the present, the
- trade is extremely small, but there is no reason why it should not be
- increased.
- </p>
- <p>
- One of the chief troubles of the settler is the guava bush, which runs
- wild all over the islands, and is extremely hard to destroy. It bears
- quantities of excellent fruit, but guavas do not pay for exporting, so no
- one, apparently, has thought of making the island pest profitable. And
- yet, when I went down to New Zealand, which is in direct communication
- with the Cook Islands and less than a week away, I found the price of
- guava jelly in the shops was higher than it is at home. Asked why no one
- in the islands sent jelly for sale, the grocers said it was because
- jampots were not made in New Zealand, and had to be imported if wanted.
- Since most jams in the colonies are sold in tins, this did not appear to
- me an unanswerable argument. Tins are made in the colonies, and the
- process of tinning jam or jelly should not be beyond amateur powers.
- Moreover, common tumblers (which are also made in New Zealand) are a good
- and profitable way of putting up jellies; purchasers are always willing to
- pay extra for the advantage of getting something useful along with the
- dainty itself.
- </p>
- <p>
- Another item: Dried peppers bring a good price per ounce, and fine Chili
- pepper grows wild everywhere. So far, trade is nil.
- </p>
- <p>
- Another: One of the commonest plants in the Southern Pacific, a weed
- bearing a bright red flower almost exactly like the pine-cone in shape,
- contains, in the flower, a quantity of white watery liquid, which is
- declared by the natives, and by many of the whites, to be an exceptionally
- fine hair tonic. No one, so far as I know, has tried to make anything out
- of this, or out of the wild castor oil, which is said to be of good
- quality.
- </p>
- <p>
- If the settler cannot find some useful hint among these, he may be able to
- discover a few on the spot for himself.
- </p>
- <p>
- The second class of settler&mdash;the man without capital, or with only a
- little&mdash;is a pariah everywhere. No colony wants him, agents warn him
- away, friends write to him begging him to stay where he is, and not tempt
- fortune by going out unprovided with plenty of cash. No doubt there is
- reason on the side of the discouragers; but there is not a colony in the
- world, all the same, where you shall not find the man who came out without
- capital, who endured a few years of hard work and short commons, began to
- get on, began to save, went on getting on and saving, and by-and-by became
- one of the most successful men in the place. Whereupon as a rule he
- becomes an adviser in his turn, and solemnly counsels young men of every
- kind against the imprudence of tempting fortune with an empty purse.
- </p>
- <p>
- For all that, and all that, young Britons will continue to do what they
- are advised not to, and ships will carry out many a man to the far wild
- countries whose only gold is the gold of youth and health and a brave
- heart. &ldquo;Sink or swim&rdquo; is the motto of this kind of colonist, and if he
- often goes under, he very often floats on the top, and comes in on the
- flood-tide of good luck. &ldquo;Fortune favours the brave&rdquo;&mdash;a proverb none
- the less true because of its age.
- </p>
- <p>
- To have an island of one&rsquo;s own, in the beautiful South Seas, to live
- remote from strain and worry, and out of the clash and roar of
- twentieth-century civilization&mdash;to pass one&rsquo;s days in a land of
- perpetual summer; work, but own no master, possess a country (small though
- it may be) yet know none of the troubles of sovereignty&mdash;this is an
- ambition of which no one need be ashamed, even though-it appear
- contemptible and even reprehensible to &ldquo;Samuel Budgett, the Successful
- Merchant.&rdquo; The planter with a fair amount of capital can realise the dream
- almost any day, for every big group in the Pacific has many small
- unoccupied islands which can be rented for a song, and if the newcomer is
- made of stuff that can stand being totally deprived of theatres, clubs,
- music halls, daily posts and papers, and a good many other charms (or
- burdens) of city life, he has only to pick and choose, secure a good title
- to-his island, decide what he means to grow on it, get his house built,
- and settle down at once.
- </p>
- <p>
- But people who have very little money cherish the same ambition, often
- enough: There are thousands of men in the United Kingdom to whom a South
- Sea Island of their-own would be heaven&mdash;only they see no way of
- getting it. The desire comes, without doubt, of generations of insular
- ancestors. It is the &ldquo;Englishman&rsquo;s house is his castle" idea carried a
- step further than usual, that is all; and the boy that never wholly dies
- in the heart of every Briton is always ready to wake up and rejoice at the
- thought.
- </p>
- <p>
- What is the moneyless man to do?
- </p>
- <p>
- Well, first of all, he must get out to Sydney or Auckland, each being a
- port from which island vessels constantly sail, and with which island
- trade is closely concerned. It will not cost him so much as he thinks. If
- he goes by Auckland, he can get a third-class ticket from London for
- fifteen pounds, and Sydney is little more. Arrived, he will make use of
- the information he has, of course, obtained in London, from the offices of
- the Agent-General for New Zealand (or Australia, as the case may be) and
- try and get a job to keep him on his feet while he looks about. If he can
- do any kind of manual labour, he will not be at a loss&mdash;and if he
- cannot, or will not, he had much better stay at home on an office stool
- within sound of Bow Bells, and leave the far countries to men of tougher
- material.
- </p>
- <p>
- In Sydney or Auckland he will find a good many firms connected with island
- trading interests, many of whom own trading stores dotted about the whole
- Pacific. It is often possible to obtain a job from one of these, if the
- newcomer is capable and steady. In this case, the way of getting up to the
- islands is clear, and the work of copra trading, keeping store for native
- customers, fruit-buying and shipping on the spot, is the best possible
- training for an independent position. If this proves a vain hope (it need
- not, in the case of a good man, if one may judge by the wretched
- incapables who occupy the trader&rsquo;s post in many islands) our adventurer
- must try to raise the cost of a passage as best he can, and see what he
- can get to do among the white people of the group he has selected, when he
- arrives. There are so many useless wastrels in most of the islands, that
- character and capability are to a certain extent capital in themselves.
- Some one is generally in want of a plantation overseer to replace a
- drunken employee&mdash;some one else would be glad of a handy man to help
- with housebuilding of the simple island kind&mdash;and in many islands,
- board and lodging, and a little over, would be easily obtainable by any
- educated man, who would undertake to teach the children of the white
- settlers. There are groups in which no one is allowed to land who does not
- possess a certain minimum of cash, but it is not in any case that I know
- of more than ten pounds, and most islands have no such regulation.
- </p>
- <p>
- Once so far on his journey, the would-be island owner must think out the
- rest for himself. There is sure to be a small island or two for rent, and
- there will probably be means of making money by slow degrees in the group
- itself. Where the will is, the way will be found.
- </p>
- <p>
- The popular dream of finding and taking possession of an unoccupied island
- somewhere or other, and &ldquo;squatting&rdquo; there unopposed, is a dream and
- nothing more. The great European nations have long since parcelled out
- among themselves all the groups worth having, and rent or purchase is the
- only way to acquire land. Far-away separate islands, remote from
- everywhere, are still to be had for nothing in a few instances, but they
- are not desirable-possessions, unless the owner can afford a private
- sailing vessel, and in any case what has not been picked up is little
- worth picking in these days.
- </p>
- <p>
- So much for the how and where of acquiring islands. I shall have one or
- two definite instances to give in another chapter.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0004" id="link2HCH0004"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER IV
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>Where are the Six Thousand?&mdash;Calling on the Queen&mdash;A Victoria
- of the Pacific&mdash;The Prince sleeps softly&mdash;The Mystical Power of
- the Mana&mdash;How Islanders can die&mdash;A Depressing Palace&mdash;Round
- the Wonderful Roadway&mdash;The Home of Queen Tinomana&mdash;A Princess&rsquo;s
- Love Story&mdash;Once on Board the Schooner!&mdash;The Incredible Crabs&mdash;Depravity
- of a Mor Kiri-kiri.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">A</span> HUNDRED years
- ago, Raratonga had six thousand native inhabitants, and was a very
- flourishing heathen country, where cannibalism was all the fashion, murder
- of shipwrecked sailors a common custom, and raids upon neighbouring
- islands the chief diversion. There is no doubt that the Raratongan of
- those days compared none too well with the Tahitian, who at the worst
- never was an habitual cannibal, and was almost always friendly to
- strangers. Williams was the first missionary to arrive in the earlier part
- of the last century, and the complete conversion of the island was rapid;
- the Raratongan in a few years was no longer cannibal, no longer warlike,
- had become hospitable and friendly to travellers, had learned to wear
- clothes (a good deal more than he wanted or should have had, but the
- missionary of the early days really did not know what a fatal thing he was
- doing, when he enforced the wearing of white man&rsquo;s raiment on the
- unclothed native, and thereby taught him to catch cold, and die of chest
- diseases). The island had (and has) a large school for the training of
- mission teachers, and a church and mission house not to be matched in the
- Pacific for magnificence, and was on the whole a model of most of the
- virtues, compared with what it once had been. There were, and are,
- drawbacks to the missionary rule, but these have been discussed so freely
- in almost every book of Pacific travel ever written, that I do not feel it
- necessary to say over again what has so often been said before. The
- missionaries certainly civilised the islands, and made them safe to live
- in. Concurrently with this desirable result, others not so desirable took
- place, the fruit, in some cases, of irresponsible authority exercised by
- semi-educated men; in others, of the inevitable fate that follows the
- introduction of civilisation to primitive races. The Raratongan, like all
- the other brown folk of the islands, was asked to leap, almost at once,
- the gulf between utter savagery and comparative civilisation, that had
- taken his instructors all the time between the Roman Conquest and the end
- of the Dark Ages to overpass. With the docility of the true Polynesian, he
- did his best to comply. It was not his fault&mdash;and not, one must
- fairly say, the fault of the missionary either, save in a minor degree&mdash;that
- the effort meant death to him.
- </p>
- <p>
- There are not nineteen hundred Raratongans living now in the fertile
- little country that used to support six thousand of their ancestors. There
- are not enough babies in the island to carry on the population at half its
- present level, in the future. Not one of the &ldquo;chief&rdquo; families, of whom
- there are a dozen or so, has any living children at all. Consumption is
- common, and on the increase; more serious diseases are commoner still. A
- Raratongan seldom lives to be very old, and he almost always dies without
- resistance or regret. The islanders are happy and sunny in their own quiet
- way, but the backbone of life has been broken for them, and in the promise
- of the future, grey or golden, they have no share. To-day is theirs, but
- they have no to-morrow.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Arikis, or chiefs, to whom the principal power once belonged, and who
- still retain much importance, regret this state of affairs in an amiable,
- fatalistic way, but do not trouble themselves very much over it. They are
- for the most part of the opinion of Sir Boyle Roche about the claims of
- posterity; and anyhow, they have their fruit trading to think about, and
- the next public dancing and singing party, and the last illegal
- beer-brewing up in the hills&mdash;so the decadence of their country sits
- lightly on their minds.
- </p>
- <p>
- These Arikis are one and all inferior to the ruling sovereign, Queen
- Makea, who still contrives to retain a great deal of quiet power in her
- shapely old hands, in spite of the fact that she is nominally deposed, and
- her country owned by New Zealand. I had not been in Raratonga more than a
- day or two, when my hosts took me to call upon the queen, intimating that
- she would feel hurt if the newcomer was not presented to her.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0016" id="linkimage-0016"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0111.jpg" alt="0111 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0111.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- We walked through the blazing sun of the tropic afternoon, down the
- palm-shaded main street of Avarua town, to the great grassy enclosure that
- surrounds the palace of the queen. One enters through a neat white gate;
- inside are one or two small houses, a number of palms and flowering
- bushes, and at the far end, a stately two-storeyed building constructed of
- whitewashed concrete, with big railed-in verandahs, and handsome arched
- windows. This is Makea&rsquo;s palace, but her visitors do not go there to look
- for her. In true South Sea Islander fashion, she keeps a house for show
- and one for use. The islander, though he aspires when &ldquo;civilised,&rdquo; to own
- a big concrete house, &ldquo;all same papalangi&rdquo; (white man), does not really
- like living in a building that shuts out the air. He discovered the
- fresh-air system long before it was thought of by the folk who discovered
- him, and his own houses are always made of small poles or saplings, set
- without any filling, so that the whole building is as airy as a birdcage,
- and almost as transparent. In this he lives, while the big concrete house,
- with its Auckland made tables, chairs, and beds, and the red and blue
- table-cloths, and horrible gilt lamps fringed with cut glass lustres, and
- shrieking oleograph of King Edward in his coronation robes, is kept
- strictly for show, and perhaps for an occasional festival, such as a
- wedding party. It is an odd custom, but sensible, on the whole.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0017" id="linkimage-0017"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0117.jpg" alt="0117 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0117.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Makea&rsquo;s favourite house is a pretty little reed and thatch villa several
- miles out in the country. When she is in town, she makes some concession
- to state by living in a small one-storeyed cottage, with a thatch and a
- verandah, and not much else, close beside her big palace. We found her at
- the cottage when we called, sitting on the verandah upon an ironwood
- couch, and petting a little turtle of which she is very fond. It seems a
- curious sort of creature to adore, but an elderly lady must have her
- little pet of some kind. In other climes, it is a pug, a parrot, or a cat.
- Here, the little turtle is considered chic, so the queen has one, the
- turtle having been always considered a perquisite of royalty in the old
- days, when the chiefs had the best of everything, even down to the
- choicest tit-bits of the roasted enemy, while the commonalty had to put up
- with what they could get.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0018" id="linkimage-0018"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0125.jpg" alt="0125 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0125.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- I was introduced to the queen, who shook hands politely, and sent one of
- her handmaids for chairs. These being brought, my hostess and I sat down,
- and the latter conversed with Makea in Raratongan, translating a few
- conventional politenesses from myself, and conveying others to me in
- return. The queen wanted to know how I liked the island, if I had really
- come all the way from England, as she had heard, whether I was not afraid
- to travel so far alone, how long I hoped to stay, and so forth. All the
- time, as we talked, her keen black eyes were scanning me silently,
- rapidly, comprehensively, and making their own judgment, quite
- independently of the conversation and its inevitable formalities. And I,
- on my side, was gazing, I fear with some rudeness, at the very remarkable
- figure before me.
- </p>
- <p>
- Makea, since the death of her husband, Prince Ngamaru, a few years ago,
- has laid aside all vanities of dress, and wears only the simplest of black
- robes, made loose and flowing from the neck in island fashion. She is
- supposed to be at least seventy years of age, and she is extremely stout,
- even for her height, which is well over six feet. Yet a more impressive
- figure than this aged, deposed, uncrowned sovereign, in her robe of shabby
- black, I have never seen. Wisdom, kindliness, and dignity are written
- large on her fine old face, which has more than a touch of resemblance to
- the late Queen Victoria. And oh, the shrewdness, the ability, the keen
- judgment of men and things, that look out from those brown, deep-set eyes,
- handsome enough, even in old age, to hint at the queen-like beauty that
- once belonged to this island queen!
- </p>
- <p>
- Makea was always known as a wise, just, and very powerful sovereign. She
- ruled over the whole Cook group, and her word was law everywhere, even to
- the Prince Consort, the warlike Ngamaru, who to the very last retained
- some traces of his heathen upbringing, and used to be seen, in the island
- councils of only a few years ago, making the horrible cannibal gesture
- which signifies in unmistakable pantomime, &ldquo;I will tear the meat from your
- bones with my teeth!&rdquo; at any other council member who presumed to disagree
- with him. Their married life was a happy one, in spite of the prince&rsquo;s
- violent character, and when he died, the widowed queen took all her
- splendid robes of velvet, silk, and satin, gorgeously trimmed with gold,
- tore them in fragments, and cast them into his grave, so that he might he
- soft, as befitted the prince who had been loved so well by such a queen.
- </p>
- <p>
- Makea holds much of the real power in her hands to-day, for all that the
- islands are the property of the British Crown, and administered by a
- Commissioner. The Raratongan is submissive to chiefs by nature, and the
- queen, though uncrowned, is still reverenced and feared almost, as much as
- of old. It is firmly believed that she possesses the mystic power known as
- &ldquo;mana&rdquo; among the Maori races, and this, as it gives the owner power to
- slay at will, is greatly feared. The word is almost untranslatable,
- meaning, perhaps, something like &ldquo;prestige,&rdquo; &ldquo;kudos,&rdquo; or the old English
- &ldquo;glamour.&rdquo; It includes, among other gifts, second sight to a certain
- extent, the power to bring good or evil luck, and the ability already
- mentioned to deal death at will.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0019" id="linkimage-0019"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0139.jpg" alt="0139 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0139.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- This last may sound like fiction. It is nothing of the sort, it is plain,
- bald fact, as any one who has ever lived in the islands can testify. There
- is nothing more commonly known in the South Seas than the weird power
- possessed by kings and heroes to slay with a word, and instances of its
- exercise could be found in every group.
- </p>
- <p>
- Makea does not use it now, so they say. She is old: like aged folks in
- other places, she wants to &ldquo;make her soul,&rdquo; and it can readily be imagined
- that the mission authorities do not approve of such heathen proceedings.
- Still, there is not a native in Raratonga who does not believe that she
- could strike him dead with a wish, any day in the week, if she chose: and
- there are not a few who can tell you that in the days long ago, she
- exercised the power.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Makea, she never rude, because she great chief,&rdquo; said a relation of the
- royal family to me one day. &ldquo;She never say to any one, &lsquo;You go die!&rsquo; I
- think. She only saying, some time, &lsquo;I wish I never seeing you again!&rsquo; and
- then the people he go away, very sorry, and by-n&rsquo;-by he die&mdash;some
- day, some week, I don&rsquo; know&mdash;but he dyin&rsquo; all right, very quick, you
- bet!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- The power to die at will seems to be a heritage of the island races,
- though the power to live, when a chief bids them set sail on the dark seas
- of the unknown, is not theirs. Suicide, carried out without the aid of
- weapons or poisons of any kind, is not at all uncommon. A man or woman who
- is tired of life, or bitterly offended with any one, will often lie down
- on the mats, turn his face, like David of old; to the wall, and simply
- flicker out like a torch extinguished by the wind. There was once a white
- schooner captain, who had quarrelled with his native crew; and the crew,
- to pay him out, lay down and declared they would die to spite him.... But
- this is about Makea the Queen, not about the godless brutal captain, and
- the measures he took to prevent his men from taking passage in a body
- across the Styx. They didn&rsquo;t go after all, and they were sore and sorry
- men when they made the island port, and the captain, who was a very
- ill-educated person, boasted far and wide for many a day after that, that
- he would exceedingly well learn any exceedingly objectionable nigger who
- offered to go and die on him again&mdash;and that is all that I must say
- about it, for more reasons than one.
- </p>
- <p>
- The queen, after a little conversation, punctuated by intervals of fanning
- and smiling (and a more charming smile than Makea&rsquo;s, you might search the
- whole South Seas to find), sent a girl up a tree for cocoanuts, and
- offered us the inevitable cocoanut water and bananas, without which no
- island call is complete. Afterwards, when we rose to go, she sent a
- handmaid with us to take us over the palace, of which she is, naturally,
- very proud, though she never enters it except on the rare occasion of some
- great festival.
- </p>
- <p>
- The palace proved to be as uninteresting as the queen herself was
- interesting and attractive. It had a stuffy, shut-up smell, and it was
- furnished in the worst of European taste, with crude ugly sofas and
- chairs, tables covered with cheap-jack Manchester trinkets, and staring
- mirrors and pictures&mdash;partly sacred art, of a kind remarkably well
- calculated to promote the cause of heathenism, and partly portraits,
- nearly as bad as those one sees in the spring exhibitions at home. There
- were two or three saloons or drawing-rooms, all much alike, on the lower
- storey. Upstairs (it is only a very palatial island house that owns an
- upstairs) there were several bedrooms, furnished with large costly
- bedsteads of mahogany and other handsome woods, and big massive wardrobes
- and tables&mdash;all unused, and likely to remain so. The place was
- depressing on the whole, and I was glad to get out of it into the cheerful
- sun, although the heat at this hour of the afternoon was really
- outrageous.
- </p>
- <p>
- [[Illustration: 0165]
- </p>
- <p>
- Another afternoon, I drove out to see Queen Tinomana, a potentate only
- second to Makea in influence. Tinomana, like Makea, is a dynastic name,
- and is always borne by the high chief, man or woman, who is hereditary
- sovereign of a certain district. The present holder of the title is a
- woman, and therefore queen.
- </p>
- <p>
- What a drive it was! The roadway round the island is celebrated all over
- the Pacific, and with justice, for nothing more lovely than this
- twenty-mile ribbon of tropic splendour is to be found beneath the Southern
- Cross. One drives in a buggy of colonial pattern, light, easy-running, and
- fast, and the rough little island horse makes short work of the miles of
- dazzling white sandy road that circle the shores of the bright lagoon. On
- one side rises the forest, green and rich and gorgeous beyond all that the
- dwellers of the dark North could possibly imagine, and opening now and
- then to display picture after picture, in a long gallery of magnificent
- mountain views&mdash;mountains blue as the sea, mountains purple as
- amethyst, mountains sharp like spear-heads, towered and buttressed like
- grand cathedrals, scarped into grey precipices where a bat could scarcely
- cling, and cloven into green gorges bright with falling streams. On the
- other, the palms and thick undergrowth hardly veil the vivid gleam of the
- emerald lagoon lying within the white-toothed barrier reef, where all day
- long the surf of the great Pacific creams and froths and pours. By the
- verge of the coral beach that burns like white fire in the merciless sun,
- the exquisite ironwood tree trails its delicate tresses above the sand, so
- that, if you leave the carriage to follow on the road, and walk down by
- the beach, you shall catch the green glow of the water, and the pearly
- sparkle of the reef, through a drooping veil of leafage fine as a
- mermaid&rsquo;s hair. Sometimes the buggy runs for a mile or two through thick
- woods of this lovely tree, where the road is carpeted thickly with the
- fallen needles of foliage, so that the wheels run without sound, and you
- may catch the Eolian harp-song of the leaves, sighing ceaselessly and
- sadly
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p class="indent20">
- Of old, unhappy, far-off things,
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p>
- when the evening wind gets up and the sun drops low on the lagoon.
- </p>
- <p>
- The myths of the Pacific are marvellous in their way, but they pass over
- unnoticed much that could not have escaped the net of folk-lore and poetry
- in Northern lands. That the lovely ironwood, a tree with leaves like
- mermaid&rsquo;s locks, and the voice of a mermaid&rsquo;s song in its whispering
- boughs, should stand bare of legend or romance on the shores of a sea that
- is itself the very home of wonder, strikes the Northern mind with a sense
- of strange incongruity. But the soul of the islands is not the soul of the
- continents, and the poet of the Pacific is still to be born.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0020" id="linkimage-0020"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0173.jpg" alt="0173 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0173.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Sometimes, again, the little buggy rattles over white coral sand and
- gravel, on a stretch of road that is fairly buried in the forest. The sun
- is cut off overhead, and only a soft green glow sifts through. The
- palm-tree stems sweep upward, tall and white, the gigantic &ldquo;maupei&rdquo; rears
- aloft its hollow buttressed stems, carved out into caverns that would
- delight the soul of a modern Crusoe, and drops big chestnuts, floury and
- sweet, upon the road as we pass. The &ldquo;utu,&rdquo; or Barringtonia Speciosa, one
- of the most beautiful of island trees, towers a hundred feet into the warm
- glow above, its brilliant varnished leaves, nearly a foot long, and its
- strange rose and white flowers, shaped like feather-dusters, marking it
- out unmistakably from the general tangle of interlacing boughs, and
- crowding trunks and long liana ropes, green and brown, that run from tree
- to tree. If you were lost in the bush, and thirsty, one of those lianas
- would provide you with waters, were you learned enough in wood lore to
- slash it with your knife, and let the pure refreshing juice trickle forth.
- You might gather wild fruit of many kinds, too, and wild roots, mealy and
- nourishing, or dainty and sweet. And at night, you might creep into your
- hollow tree, or lie down on the warm sand of the shore, with nothing worse
- to fear than a mosquito or two.
- </p>
- <p>
- There are no wild beasts in any of the Pacific Islands, save an occasional
- boar, which always lives remote from men in the hills, and is much readier
- to run away than to annoy. There are no poisonous snakes, either,
- tarantulas, or deadly centipedes and scorpions. I cannot honestly say that
- the two latter creatures do not exist, but they very seldom bite or sting
- any one who does not go barefooted, and their venom is not deadly, though
- painful.
- </p>
- <p>
- On almost every tree, as we rattle along through the forest, my hostess
- and I can see the beautiful bird&rsquo;s-nest fern, looking like a hanging
- basket of greenery. We have not time to stop to-day, but we shall have to
- go out some other afternoon and cut down a few of the smaller ones for
- table decoration, for there is a dinner party coming off, and we are short
- of pot plants for the rooms. Young palms, most graceful of all green
- things, shoot up like little fountains in the clearings, some of the
- smaller ones still&rsquo; root-bound by the large brown nut from which they have
- sprung. One would never think these dainty ball-room palms were related in
- any way to the stately white columns-spiring high above them, for the
- full-grown palm is all stem and scarcely any top, in comparison, while the
- young palm, a mass of magnificent spreading fronds, rises from a short
- bulb-like trunk that suggests nothing less than further growth.
- </p>
- <p>
- The drive is six good miles, but it seems only too short. In a very little
- while, we have reached Queen Tinomana&rsquo;s village&mdash;a picturesque little
- grassy town, with brown thatched huts, and white concrete cottages washed
- with coral lime, and gay red and yellow leaved ti trees standing before
- almost every door&mdash;and the queen&rsquo;s own palace, a handsome
- two-storeyed house, quite as fine as Makea&rsquo;s, stands up in front of us.
- </p>
- <p>
- Passing by this piece of European splendour, we go to draw a more likely
- covert, and ere long flush our quarry in a little creeper-wreathed
- cottage, hidden behind bushes of deliciously scented frangipani and
- blazing red hibiscus. The queen is on the verandah, seated, like Makea, on
- an ironwood sofa of state. She sits here most of the day, having very
- little in the way of government to do, and no desire to trouble her
- amiable head with the white woman&rsquo;s laborious methods of killing time.
- Sometimes she plaits a hat to amuse herself, being accomplished in this
- favourite Raratongan art&mdash;a sailor hat with a hard crown and stiff
- brim, and a good deal of neat but lacy fancy work in the twisting of the
- plait. Sometimes she receives friends, and hears gossip. Sometimes, she
- sleeps on the sofa, and wakes up to suck oranges and fall asleep again.
- The strenuous life is not the life beloved of Tinomana, nor (one may hint
- in the smallest of whispers) would her much more strenuous sister queen
- encourage any developments in that direction.
- </p>
- <p>
- It is well, under the circumstances, that both are suited by their
- respective rôles, otherwise the somewhat difficult lot of the Resident
- Commissioner might be rendered even more trying than it is.
- </p>
- <p>
- Tinomana is not young, and she is not lovely now, though one can see that
- she has been beautiful, as so many of the soft-eyed island women are, long
- ago. She has had her romance, however, and as we sit on her verandah,
- drinking and eating the cocoanut and banana of ceremony, the grey-haired
- white man who is husband of the queen tells the story to me of her love
- and his, just as it happened, once upon a time.
- </p>
- <p>
- In 1874 the Cook Islands were an independent group, governed by their own
- chiefs, or Arikis. The Arikis had much more power in those days than they
- are now allowed to exercise. They could order the execution of any subject
- for any cause; they could make war and end it: and no ship dared to call
- at the islands without their permission. They owned, as they still own,
- all the land, and their wealth of various kinds made them, in the eyes of
- the natives, millionaires as well as sovereigns.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Women&rsquo;s rights&rdquo; were a novelty to England thirty years ago, but in the
- Cook Islands they were fully recognised, even at that early period. The
- most powerful of the Arikis was Makea&mdash;then a girl, now an elderly
- woman, but always every inch a queen, and always keeping a firm hand on
- the sceptre of Raratonga. Any Cook Islands postage-stamp will show Makea
- as she was some ten years ago. In 1874 Makea and her consort, Ngamaru,
- were making plans for the marrying of Tinomana, a young Raratongan
- princess closely related to Makea. Tinomana would shortly become an Ariki,
- or queen, herself, and her matrimonial affairs were, in consequence, of
- considerable importance.
- </p>
- <p>
- What the plans of Raratonga&rsquo;s rulers for Tinomana may have been matters
- little. Tinomana was pretty, with splendid long black hair, large soft
- brown eyes, an excellent profile, and a complexion little darker than a
- Spaniard&rsquo;s. She was also self-willed, and could keep a secret as close as
- wax when she so desired. She had a secret at that time, and it concerned
- no South Sea Islander, but a certain good-looking young Anglo-American
- named John Salmon (grandson of a Ramsgate sea-captain, Thomas Dunnett),
- who had lately landed at Raratonga from the trading schooner <i>Venus</i>,
- and had been enjoying a good deal of the pretty princess&rsquo;s society,
- unknown to the gossips of the island. It was a case of love at first
- sight; for the two had not been more than a few days acquainted when they
- came privately to James Chalmers, the famous missionary, then resident in
- Raratonga, and begged for a secret marriage.
- </p>
- <p>
- James Chalmers refused promptly to have anything to do with the matter,
- and furthermore told Tinomana that he would never marry her to any white
- man, no matter who it might be. In his opinion such a marriage would be
- certain to cause endless trouble with the other Arikis&mdash;apart from
- the fact that Queen Makea was against it. So the lovers went away
- disconsolate. Raratonga was keeping holiday at the time, because a great
- war-canoe was to be launched immediately, and a dance and feast were in
- preparation. But Tinomana and her lover were out of tune with the
- festivities, and no woman in the island prepared her stephanotis and
- hibiscus garlands for the feast, or plaited baskets of green palm leaves
- to carry contributions of baked sucking-pig and pineapples, with as heavy
- a heart as the little princess.
- </p>
- <p>
- On the day of the feast an idea came to Salmon. There were two schooners
- lying in Avarua harbour. One, the <i>Coronet</i>, had for a captain a man
- named Rose, who was as much opposed to Salmon&rsquo;s marriage as Chalmers
- himself. The <i>Humboldt</i> schooner, on the other hand, had a friend of
- Salmon&rsquo;s in command. From him some help might be expected. Salmon visited
- him secretly, found that he was willing to assist, and arranged for an
- elopement that very night. Tinomana was willing; nobody suspected; and the
- feast would furnish a capital opportunity.
- </p>
- <p>
- There was no moon that evening, happily for the lovers, for the smallest
- sign would have awaked the suspicions of the watching <i>Coronet</i>. When
- the feast had begun, and all Raratonga was making merry with pig and baked
- banana, raw fish and pineapple beer, Tinomana contrived to slip away and
- get back to her house. Womanlike, she would not go without her &ldquo;things&rdquo;;
- and she took so long collecting and packing her treasures&mdash;her silk
- and muslin dresses, her feather crowns, her fans and bits of cherished
- European finery from far-away Auckland&mdash;that the suspicions of a
- prying girl were aroused. Out she came, accompanied by two others&mdash;all
- handmaidens to Tinomana&mdash;and charged the princess with an intention
- to elope. Tinomana acknowledged the truth, and ordered the girls to hold
- their tongues, offering them liberal rewards. This was not enough,
- however; the three girls demanded that Tinomana, in addition to buying
- their silence, should shield them from the possible wrath of the great
- Makea by taking them with her. She was forced to consent; and so, when the
- impatient lover, lurking in the darkness near the harbour, saw his lady
- coming at last, she came with three attendants, and almost enough luggage
- to rival Marie Antoinette&rsquo;s encumbered flight to Varennes.
- </p>
- <p>
- Eventually, however, the party put off in a canoe, the girls lying flat in
- the bottom, with Tinomana crouching beside them and Salmon holding a
- lighted torch, which he waved in the air as they went. For the boat had to
- pass close by the Coronet, and Captain Rose, somehow or other, had become
- suspicious, and young Salmon knew he would think nothing of stopping any
- boat that could not give an account of itself. So Salmon took the torch,
- to look like a fishing-boat going out with spears and torches to the reef,
- and, paddling with one hand while he held the light aloft with the other,
- he passed the <i>Coronet</i> safely, knowing well that his face would be
- unrecognisable at a distance of fifty yards or so in the wavering shadow
- of the flame.
- </p>
- <p>
- Beyond the reef lay the <i>Humboldt</i> waiting. Tinomana and her maids
- and her luggage were swung up the side with small ceremony; Salmon hurried
- after, and a small but welcome breeze enabled the schooner to slip out to
- sea unnoticed in the dark. She made for Mangaia, another of the Cook
- Islands, some hundred and fifty miles away, and reached it in a couple of
- days. But the <i>Humboldt</i> had hardly made the land when the dreaded <i>Coronet</i>
- appeared on the horizon, carrying every stitch of sail, and with her
- decks, her &ldquo;Jacob&rsquo;s-ladder,&rdquo; and her very yardarms crowded by furious
- Raratongans. The fugitives were caught!
- </p>
- <p>
- At first they had not been missed. The islanders were feasting and
- drinking, the Arikis were unsuspicious, and the <i>Coronet</i> had seen
- only a fishing-canoe with a solitary man on board gliding out to the reef.
- But with the morning light came the knowledge that Tinomana was absent
- from her palace, that Salmon had not come home, and that the <i>Humboldt</i>
- was gone. Raratonga was enraged, and all the more so because pursuit
- appeared for the moment to be impossible. They knew that the <i>Humboldt</i>
- had probably made for Mangaia; but the breeze had died away, and the <i>Coronet</i>,
- her sails flapping idly against her rakish masts, lay helpless in harbour.
- Some brilliant spirit, however, proposed that the schooner should be towed
- out, in the hope of catching a breeze beyond the reef; and half a dozen
- great whaleboats, manned by powerful arms, were harnessed to the <i>Coronet&rsquo;s</i>
- bows. Out she came through the opening in the foaming coral reef, with
- screaming and splashing and tugging at oars, into the blue, open sea, and
- beyond the shelter of the peaky, purple hills. The breeze was met at last,
- the boats cast off and dropped astern, and the <i>Coronet</i>, carrying
- half Raratonga on board, set sail for Mangaia.
- </p>
- <p>
- Once within the range of the <i>Humboldt</i> the <i>Coronet</i> lowered a
- boatful of armed men, and the latter made for the schooner lying-to under
- the shelter of the Mangaian hills. Captain Harris, of the <i>Humboldt</i>,
- however, ordered his crew to shoot down the first man who attempted to
- board, and the attacking boat thought better of it. Beaten by force they
- tried diplomacy, in which they were more successful. They told Captain
- Harris that all his cargo of valuable cotton, lying on the wharf at
- Raratonga ready for shipment, would be destroyed unless he gave the
- princess back. This meant absolute ruin, and the captain had to submit.
- Salmon told Tinomana that it was best to give in for the present, as they
- were caught; but that the parting would be only for a time. And back to
- Raratonga went the disconsolate princess, bereft of her lover and her
- stolen wedding, and with the anticipation of a good scolding to come from
- the indignant Arikis.
- </p>
- <p>
- For some months after this disaster Salmon wandered about from island to
- island, living now in Raiatea, now in Flint Island, now in Mauke&mdash;always
- restless and always impatient. At last he judged the time had come to make
- a second attempt, and tried to obtain a passage to Raratonga.
- </p>
- <p>
- Schooner after schooner refused to take him, but finally a little vessel
- called the <i>Atalanta</i> braved the wrath of the Arikis and brought him
- back. During his absence time had worked in his favour, and the opposition
- to the marriage was now much weaker. The Arikis received him coolly and
- fined him twenty pounds&rsquo; worth of needles, thread, and tobacco for his
- late excursion, but they no longer refused to let him see Tinomana. The
- missionary, however, still objected to the marriage, and as he was the
- only clergyman available for the ceremony it seemed as if things, on the
- whole, were &ldquo;getting no forrader.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- At this juncture the great Makea stepped in, and with the charming
- variability common to her sex, took the part of the lovers against all
- Raratonga as strongly as she had before opposed their union. She was not
- then in Raratonga, but in another of the Cook Islands, Atiu. From thence
- she sent the schooner <i>Venus</i> to Raratonga, ordering the captain to
- fetch Tinomana and Salmon to Atiu, where the local missionary would marry
- them, or Makea would know the reason why.
- </p>
- <p>
- Raratonga&mdash;obstinate Raratonga!&mdash;still refused to give its
- princess to a foreign adventurer, though it trembled at the thought of
- defying the Elizabethan Makea. A band of warriors came down to the harbour
- to see that Salmon did not get on board the ship. As for Tinomana, they
- did not dare to oppose her departure, when the head of the house had
- actually summoned her. But the princess had no notion whatever of going
- alone. Salmon was smuggled on board in the dusk and hidden under a bunk. A
- pile of mats and native &ldquo;pareos,&rdquo; or kilts, was placed over him, and
- there, in the heat of the tropic night, he lay and sweltered, while the <i>Venus</i>
- swung to her cable and the warriors hunted the ship and found nothing.
- When they went off, baffled, the schooner put to sea. A Raratongan vessel,
- still suspicious, chased her to Atiu, but Makea informed the pursuing crew
- that it would be bad for their health to land on her property unasked;
- and, as this great Pacific Queen had, and has, the reputation of keeping
- her word when it is passed, the Raratongans did not dare to set foot on
- shore. This time it was they who went home disconsolate.
- </p>
- <p>
- And so the young couple were married &ldquo;and lived happily ever after.&rdquo;
- Tinomana and her consort now reside at Arorangi, Raratonga, in their long,
- low house, set among frangipani trees and oranges, and covered with
- flowering tropical creepers, and seldom or never occupy their palace.
- Tinomana&rsquo;s five children are dead; she herself is growing old, but the
- memory of those long-past years of adventure and romance is still with
- her. Her life glides quietly and dreamily by, within the sound of the
- humming ocean surf, under the shadow of the purple Raratongan hills. She
- has had her day, and there remain the quiet sunset and the softened
- twilight, before the time of dark.
- </p>
- <p>
- The queen had little to say to us, for she does not speak English, nor is
- she shrewdly curious about men and things outside of sleepy Raratonga,
- like her sister sovereign, Makea. She smiled a good deal, and said some
- polite things about my dress, which illustrated a new fashion, and seemed
- to interest her more than anything else connected with the call. I had
- brought a gift with me for Tinomana, a silk scarf of a peculiarly
- screaming blue, and I presented it before I took my leave with some
- politenesses that the royal consort rapidly translated for me. The queen
- was much pleased with the gift, and began trying its effect on several
- different hats at once. Then we had some more cocoanut water and said
- good-bye, and drove home again in the yellow sunset.
- </p>
- <p>
- The crabs were getting noisy as we passed along a soft bit of sandy road
- close by the shore. They are fairly active all day, and at night seem to
- wake up a little more completely than before. One can hear them rattling
- and scratching loudly all over the stones and rubbish about the shore; the
- ground is riddled with their holes&mdash;as we pass, they dart in at their
- front doors as swiftly as spiders, and stand looking cautiously round a
- comer till the threatening apparition is gone. They are not nice things,
- these crabs&mdash;they are tall and spindly and insectlike in build, with
- a scrawny body set on eight spider-like legs, and ugly, sharp, thin claws.
- They live on the land, but haunt the beach a good deal, because of the
- débris to be found there, and they are such nasty feeders that not even
- the natives will eat them, which is saying a good deal.
- </p>
- <p>
- They have an uncanny fancy for coming into houses. If your residence is
- not raised up on a good Verandah, which they cannot surmount, you may be
- alarmed some night by a ghostly tapping and ticking on the floor, like
- nothing you have ever heard or dreamed of before, and while you are
- wondering fearfully what the sound may be, you will suddenly become aware
- of something clumsy and noisy scrambling among the mosquito curtains of
- your bed. At this, if you are of common human mould, you will arise
- hastily, tangling yourself up in the curtains as you do so, and call
- loudly for a light. And when one is brought, behold the offender scuttling
- hastily away on eight long thin legs into the outer dark, without stopping
- to make an explanation or an apology. You are so annoyed that you put on a
- dressing-gown and follow him out on the verandah, a stick in your hand and
- murder in your heart; but just as you reach the steps, there is a loud
- &ldquo;flump&rdquo; on the floor, and a centipede as big as a sausage, with a writhing
- black body and horrible red legs and antennae, flashes past the edge of
- your sweeping draperies. At this you give it up, and get back to your
- mosquito curtains.
- </p>
- <p>
- You are just falling asleep, when&mdash;&mdash;&mdash; Good Heavens! what
- is it?
- </p>
- <p>
- Surely nothing but a burglar could have made that fearful noise in the
- outer kitchen!&mdash;a burglar, or a madman, or both in one. It sounds as
- if some one were beating somebody else with an iron bucket. Perhaps it may
- be only a native dog chasing a cat. Up go the curtains once more, letting
- half the mosquitoes in the island in, and off the wretched traveller sets
- for the kitchen, accompanied by a brave but pallid hostess, who says she
- is extremely sorry her husband <i>would</i> choose this week for going
- away from home.
- </p>
- <p>
- There he is! there is the author of the noise&mdash;a black, bristly,
- incredibly hideous hermit crab as big as a biscuit&mdash;out of his shell,
- and fighting like grim death in an empty kerosene tin, with another crab
- nearly as big, and quite as vicious. Number one has got too big for the
- secondhand univalve shell he lived in, and is touring the country trying
- to replace it. Number two, also out-growing his clothes, has got half a
- broken sardine box in the kerosene tin (which acts as ash-bucket to the
- house), and he thinks it is the loveliest new shell he has ever seen. So,
- unluckily, does the other crab, and they are in the act of putting it to
- ordeal by combat, when we invade the scene of the battle, and rudely shake
- the crabs and the shells and the sardine tin all off the end of the
- verandah together.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;What on earth brings crabs into people&rsquo;s houses?&rdquo; you ask amazedly, as
- you go back to bed again. It seems an insane action for any sensible crab,
- considering that we are half a mile from the sea.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Pure cussedness,&rdquo; says my friend wrathfully. &ldquo;They even climb up the
- verandah posts, and sit among the flowers. &lsquo;What for? Spite, I think;
- there isn&rsquo;t anything more ill-natured in the world than a hermit crab.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- If it is not a moonlight night, now, we get to sleep at last, but if it
- is, and the oranges are ripe&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;
- </p>
- <p>
- Well, that is the time the &ldquo;mor kiri-kiris&rdquo; choose to perform their
- orisons; and when they are playing the devil with the holy peace and calm
- of midnight on the roof, not even a fourth mate newly come off his watch,
- could sleep below.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Here, you blank, blank, blank, unspeakable, etcetera, let go that
- orange!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;I shan&rsquo;t, blank your double-blank limbs and wings! I got it first!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Then just look out, you mangy, fox-faced, clumsy-winged beast, for I&rsquo;ll
- rip the inside out of your rotten carcase with my claws.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Like to see you!&rdquo; (somewhat muffled with stolen orange).
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;You will!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- Shriek, shriek, yell, howl, scream.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;You&rsquo;ve bitten my toe off, you trebly-blanked vermin!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Meant to!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Clear off!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Won&rsquo;t!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Come on again, then!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Pax! pax! here&rsquo;s the great pig with fur on its head that lives in the
- house, coming out with a gun. I&rsquo;m off.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;So am I, but we&rsquo;ll go back again the moment it goes in.&rdquo; That is the way
- one sleeps in the orange season, in a place that happens to be popular
- with the &ldquo;mor kiri-kiri,&rdquo; or flying-fox&mdash;a bat with a furry body as
- big as a cat&rsquo;s, long sharp white teeth, a head exactly like a fox, and the
- crustiest disposition of anything living on the island.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0005" id="link2HCH0005"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER V
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>Feasting and Fun on Steamer Day&mdash;The Brown People of Rara-tonga&mdash;Who
- sent back the Teeth?&mdash;Divorce made easy&mdash;Climbing a Tropical
- Mountain&mdash;A Hot-water Swim&mdash;Out on the Rainbow Coral Reef&mdash;Necklaces
- for No One.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">S</span>TEAMER day in
- Raratonga, as in all the islands that rejoice in the privilege of a
- regular steamer service, is beyond comparison the event of the month.
- Almost before dawn on the day which is expected to see the boat arrive,
- the traders are up and about, seeing to the carting of their fruit and
- copra, and making ready the shelves of the stores for the new goods coming
- in from Auckland. All the residents, men and women, white and brown, are
- getting out the cleanest of muslins and drill suits, and looking up the
- shoe-whitening box, which perhaps has not been much in demand since the
- steamer called on her way back from Tahiti last month. The daughters of
- the white community are making tinned-peach pies, and dressing fowls, in
- case of callers&mdash;these are the inevitable &ldquo;company&rdquo; dishes of the
- Pacific&mdash;and the native women are bringing out their newly made straw
- hats, and, ironing their gayest of pink or yellow or scarlet cotton,
- squatting cross-legged on the floor as they work. Cocoanuts for drinking
- are being husked by the men of the village, and laid in neat piles under
- the verandahs, out of the sun; and in most of the little birdcage houses,
- the children are impounded to grate cocoanut meat for cream; while the
- dying yells of pigs make day hideous from the groves beyond the town.
- </p>
- <p>
- When the tiny trail of smoke, for which every one is looking, first rises
- out of the empty sea, it may be on the day expected, or it may be later&mdash;there
- is little time in the Great South Seas&mdash;the whole island is agape
- with excitement. The natives shriek with delight, and make haste to gather
- flowers for wreaths and necklaces; the clean suits and frocks are put on
- by brown and white alike, and the populace begins to hover about the wharf
- like a swarm of excited butterflies. The great whale-boats are ready to
- rush out at racing speed to the steamer, long before she comes to a stop
- in the bay&mdash;she dares not come into the harbour, which is only fit
- for small craft&mdash;passengers from Auckland come ashore, anxious to see
- the island curiosities, and find to their embarrassment that they are
- unmistakably regarded in that light themselves; and, as soon as may be,
- the mail comes after them. Upon which events, the whole population makes
- for the Government buildings, and flings itself in one seething breaker
- against the door of the Post Office, demanding its mails. While the
- letters are being sorted by a handful of officials locked and barred out
- of reach within, it rattles at the doors and windows, and as soon as the
- bolts are withdrawn, the mighty host, breathless and ruthless, bursts in
- like a besieging army. But when all are in, nobody has patience to wait
- and open papers, in order to know what has been going on in the outer
- world all these weeks. Purser, passengers, and even sailors are seized
- upon, and compelled to stand and deliver news about &ldquo;the war,&rdquo; and other
- burning questions, before any one thinks of opening the envelopes and
- wrappers in their hands.
- </p>
- <p>
- Minds being satisfied, bodies now assert their claim. Steamer day is feast
- day&mdash;beef day, ice day, day for enjoying all the eatables that cannot
- be had in the island itself. There is mutton in Raratonga, but not much at
- the best of times, and of beef there is none at all. So all the white folk
- order beef to come up monthly in the ship&rsquo;s cold storage, and for two
- happy days&mdash;the meat will keep no longer&mdash;they enjoy a feast
- that might perhaps more fairly be called a &ldquo;feed.&rdquo; About noon on steamer
- day, a savoury smell, to which the island has long been a stranger, begins
- to diffuse itself throughout Avarua. Every one, with true island
- hospitality, is asking every one else to lunch and dinner, to-day and
- to-morrow, so that Mrs. A. and her family may have a taste of Mr. B.&lsquo;s
- sirloin, and Mr. B. get a bit of the C.&lsquo;s consignment of steak, and the
- A.&lsquo;s and B.&lsquo;s and E.&lsquo;s enjoy a little bit of Colonel Z.&lsquo;s roast ribs. A
- sensuous, almost unctuous, happiness shines like a halo about every face,
- and after dusk white dinner coats flit up and down the perfumed avenues,
- thick as night-moths among the orange bloom overhead. Tomorrow there will
- be great doings in the pretty bungalow on the top of the hill, for the
- Resident Commissioner has got a big lump of ice as a present from the
- captain of the steamer, and is hoarding it up in blankets to give a
- dinner-party in its honour. The white man who could consume a lump of ice
- all by himself, in the island world, would be considered capable of any
- crime, and the hospitable Commissioner is the last person to shirk his
- obligations in such a matter.
- </p>
- <p>
- Once the steamer has come and gone, a dreamy peace settles down upon the
- island. There is seldom much certainty as to clock time, since every one
- goes by his own time-piece, and all vary largely, nor does any one heed
- the day of the month overmuch. This pleasant disregard of time is the true
- secret of the fascination of island life&mdash;or perhaps one of the
- secrets, since no one has ever really succeeded in defining the
- unspeakable charm of these lotus lands. Imagine a civilised community,
- where people dine out in evening dress, leave cards and have &ldquo;At Home&rdquo;
- days, yet where there is no post except the monthly ship mail, there are
- no telegrams, trains, trams, times, appointments, or engagements of any
- kind! Picture the peace that comes of knowing certainly that, for all the
- time of the steamer&rsquo;s absence there can be no disturbance of the even
- current of life; no great events at home or abroad, no haste, or worry, or
- responsibility! People keep young long in Raratonga; faces are free from
- weariness and strain; the white man with the &ldquo;burden&rdquo; laughs as merrily
- and as often as the brown man who carries nought but his flowery necklace
- and his pareo. Nobody is rich&mdash;rich men do not come down to the
- islands to run small plantations, or trading stores, or to take up little
- appointments under a little Government&mdash;but every one has enough, and
- extravagance is impossible, since luxuries are unpurchasable on the
- island. There are so social distinctions, save that between white and
- brown&mdash;all the seventy or eighty white residents knowing one another
- on a footing of common equality, although in England or even New Zealand,
- they would certainly be split up into half a score of mutually
- contemptuous sets.
- </p>
- <p>
- As for the natives&mdash;the jolly, laughing,-brown-skinned, handsome men
- and women of the island&mdash;their life is one long day of peace and
- leisure and plenty. The lands of the six thousand who once inhabited
- Raratonga are now for the most part in the hands of the nineteen hundred
- survivors, and every native has therefore a good deal more than he wants.
- Breadfruit; bananas of many kinds, oranges, mammee-apples, and countless
- other fruits, grow altogether, or almost, without cultivation; taro, yam,
- and sweet potatoes need little, and cocoanuts are always to be had. A
- native house can be put up in a day or two, furniture is superfluous, and
- clothes consist of a few yards of cotton print. The Raratongan, therefore,
- owes no tale of labour to Nature or Society for his existence in quiet
- comfort, if he does not choose to work. But in many cases he does choose,
- for he wants a buggy and a horse, and a bicycle or two, and a sewing
- machine for his wife; shoes with squeaking soles for festive wear&mdash;deliberately
- made up with &ldquo;squeakers&rdquo; for island trade, these&mdash;bottles of coarse
- strong scent, tins of meat and salmon as an occasional treat, and, if he
- is ambitious, one of those concrete, iron-roofed houses of which I have
- already spoken, to enhance his social position, and make the neighbours
- envious, what time he continues to live peaceably and comfortably in his
- palm hut outside&mdash;not being quite such a fool in this matter as he
- looks.
- </p>
- <p>
- Sometimes the Raratongan will go so far as to get his front teeth stopped
- with gold by a travelling dentist, purely for style, since he is gifted by
- nature with grinders that will smash any fruit stone, and incisors that
- will actually tear the close tough husk off a huge cocoanut without
- trouble. It is related of one of the wealthier Raratongans that, being
- stricken in years and short of teeth, he purchased a set of false ones
- from a visiting dentist, and that the latter, when he next returned to the
- island, was astonished to find the set thrown on his hands as no good, on
- the grounds that they would not husk cocoanuts!
- </p>
- <p>
- In order to secure all these more or less desirable luxuries, the
- Raratongan trades in fruit and copra. That is to say, he cuts up and dries
- (strictly at his leisure, and when he feels like it) a few thousand
- cocoanuts, or nails up some hundreds of oranges, and scores of banana
- bunches, from his overflowing acres, in wooden crates, to send down to
- Auckland. This labour, repeated a few times, brings him in good British
- gold by the handful. Copra, sold to the traders in the town, fetches about
- seven pounds a ton, and a family working for a few days can prepare as
- much as that. Other produce is hardly less profitable, to a cultivator who
- has more land than he wants, provides his own labour, and need spend
- nothing on seeds or plants. There is, at most, only light work, and that
- seldom, so that the Raratongan can, and often does, spend the greater part
- of his time singing in choruses on the verandahs of the houses, dancing to
- the thrilling beat of a native drum under the cocoanut trees, or fishing
- lazily off the reef.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Raratongans are all, to a man, good Christians&mdash;good Protestants
- of the Dissenting variety, good Catholics, and, in a few cases,
- enthusiastic Seventh Day Adventists&mdash;being readily enough inclined to
- adhere to a cult that makes it sinful to work on the seventh day of the
- week, and impossible to work on the first. It is said that Mormon
- missionaries have visited the group, but failed to make converts. Without
- going into details that might disturb the sensitive mind, one feels
- obliged to remark, in this connection, that the failure was probably on
- all fours, as to cause, with the ill-success of the merchant who attempted
- to sell coals to Newcastle.
- </p>
- <p>
- And&mdash;still concerning this matter&mdash;&ldquo;one word more, and I have
- done.&rdquo; Some weeks after my arrival, I was going round the group in company
- with the Resident Commissioner and a few more officials, who were holding
- courts and administering justice in the various islands. The Commissioner
- was late getting back to the ship one afternoon, and the captain asked him
- if he had been detained.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Only a little while,&rdquo; replied the guardian angel of the group, cheerfully
- rattling his pockets, which gave forth a pleasant chinking sound. &ldquo;Another
- dozen of divorces. We&rsquo;ll have a new road round the island next year.&rdquo; And
- he went to dinner.
- </p>
- <p>
- Divorce in the Cook Islands is not an expensive luxury. If memory serves
- me right, it costs under thirty shillings, and there is a sixpence
- somewhere in the price&mdash;I am unable to say why. But I remember very
- well indeed, after the officials had gone home, when I was travelling
- round about other islands with a captain, who had just taken over the ship
- and did not know the Cook group, that dignitary came to me one day and
- said:
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;I can&rsquo;t make out these hands of mine. They&rsquo;re a very decent lot for
- niggers, and don&rsquo;t give no trouble, but one and another, now that we&rsquo;re
- going round the islands, keeps coming to me and asking me for an advance
- on their wages, because, says they, they&rsquo;ve been a long time from home,
- and they wants it&mdash;and every blessed one of them he wants the same
- advance!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Was it so-and-so?&rdquo; I asked, mentioning a certain small sum with a
- sixpence in it.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;How on earth did you know?&rdquo; was the reply.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Price of a divorce from the Commissioner,&rdquo; I explained.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Well!&rdquo; said the captain, who was a hard-shelled old whaler, with a strong
- religious cast. And again&mdash;&ldquo;Well!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;That&rsquo;s what I think myself,&rdquo; I explained. &ldquo;But it certainly fills the
- exchequer. I hear the score runs up to ten or twelve apiece, often
- enough.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Disgustin&rsquo;,&rdquo; said the captain, spitting over the rail.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Certainly,&rdquo; I agreed.
- </p>
- <p>
- But the incident has its own significance, so I have recorded it.
- </p>
- <p>
- I linger long over the life and ways of Raratonga, for I spent many very
- happy weeks there&mdash;studying native customs, and taking notes? Well,
- perhaps&mdash;a little, at all events. Raratonga is not quite so lazy a
- place as Tahiti, and the climate is less trying. Still&mdash;still&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;
- </p>
- <p>
- How impossible it is to explain to the reader who has never spent a hot
- season in the tropics! I think I shall not try. There were missed
- opportunities&mdash;there were things I ought to have studied, and did
- not, and things I should have seen, and didn&rsquo;t see. It is of no use to say
- why. Those who have passed between the magic line of Cancer and Capricorn
- will not need to &lsquo;be told, and the others could not understand.
- </p>
- <p>
- I did something to satisfy my conscience, however, when I climbed the
- highest mountain in Raratonga&mdash;a peak something over three thousand
- feet high, so the residents said. It was reported that the Admiralty
- survey did not agree by a hundred feet or so, with the local estimate. I
- know myself that both were wrong; that peak is ten thousand, or perhaps a
- little more. Did it not take myself and two or three others from seven
- a.m. until nine p.m to get up and down, working as hard as white ants
- (there is nothing in the islands really busy except the ants) all the
- time?
- </p>
- <p>
- We went the wrong way&mdash;several wrong ways&mdash;we lost our food and
- our water, and got so thirsty that we licked the leaves of the trees, and
- so hungry that it was agony to know ourselves above the zone of the orange
- and banana all day, and see the food we could not reach till night hanging
- in clusters far below. We did most of our climbing by the heroic method of
- swarming up perpendicular rock faces on the ladders of the creepers, and a
- good deal of it by scrambling along in the tops of small trees, like
- monkeys. When we got to the top there was just room for the whole party to
- stand and cheer, and we cheered ourselves vigorously. People do not climb
- mountains&mdash;much&mdash;in the islands of the Pacific, and the peak we
- were on had been trodden by only one or two white men, and no white women.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;There used to be natives up here often enough, some years ago, shooting
- wild fowl,&rdquo; said one of our guides, letting the smoke of his pipe curl out
- over &ldquo;half a duchy,&rdquo; lying blue and green, and far, far down, under his
- elbow. &ldquo;But they stopped coming. Several of &rsquo;em got killed, and the
- others didn&rsquo;t think it good enough.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;How did they get killed?&rdquo; I ask, listening to the wild cocks crowing in
- the sea of green down below, like a farm-yard gone astray.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Oh, climbing!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- When we had finished admiring the view of the island, we started down
- again. And now, what with our hunger, and our fatigue, and the wild
- adventures in impossible places we had had coming up, we all became rather
- tired, and more than rather reckless. Over and over again, slithering down
- steep descents, we let ourselves go, and tobogganed, sitting, we did not
- care where. The lianas crashed, the red-flowered rata snapped and fell on
- us, the lace-like tree ferns got in our way with their damp black trunks,
- and banged us as we tumbled past. Every one knew that if we did not get
- off the precipice slopes before dark, we should have to halt wherever we
- might be, and wait till morning, holding tight to the trunk of a tree to
- keep from falling down into depths unknown. But no one said anything about
- it.
- </p>
- <p>
- And in the end, we got back safe&mdash;sore and tired and hungry; not
- thirsty, however, for we had found a stream in the interminable dark of
- the valley, and had all put our heads into it like brutes, the moment our
- feet felt the welcome hollow and splashed into the water. The ladies of
- the party had not a whole gown among them, and not very much else, so
- shrewdly had the thorns and creepers of the close-knitted forest squeezed
- and torn us. Still, we had got up where no white women had been before,
- and we were all very proud, though we had to slink homeward in the dark,
- avoiding the lights of the houses, and each slip in unobserved at the back
- doors of our respective homes. But we had done the climb, and&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;
- &ldquo;That was something,&rdquo; as Hans Andersen would have said.
- </p>
- <p>
- Picnics we had in plenty, while I stayed. Sometimes they were bathing
- picnics, when the ladies of half a dozen houses went off to spend the day
- down on the shore, and swim in the lagoon. The water, not more than five
- feet deep in any place, was the colour of green grass when the sun shines
- through, and it was as warm as an ordinary hot bath. One could spend hour
- after hour amusing Oneself with swimming tricks, coming out now and then
- to roast for a little on the hot, snow-white coral sand, where bits and
- branches of coral pretty enough for a museum lay scattered everywhere, and
- exquisite flowering creepers spread their long green tails of leafage&mdash;often
- thirty or forty, feet in length, and all starred with pink or yellow
- blossoms&mdash;right across the broad expanse of the beach. Coming out
- finally, it was customary to find a big rock, and stand-with one&rsquo;s back
- against it till the wet bathing dress was half dried with the blistering
- heat of the stone. This was supposed to prevent chills. I think myself
- that one would have to hunt a chill very hard indeed in the hot season in
- Raratonga, before catching it. It is not a place where one hears of
- &ldquo;chill&rdquo; troubles, and there is no fever of any kind. When you find a
- draught there, you tell every one else in the house about it, and they
- come and sit in it with you. When you give tea, to callers, it is correct
- to serve cold water on the tray to temper the beverage, and put a spoon
- instead of a butter knife, in the butter dish.
- </p>
- <p>
- Nor does it cool down overmuch at night, in the hot months, though in the
- &ldquo;cold&rdquo; ones, you may want a blanket now and then. The temperature being so
- equable all round, chills are, naturally, not to be looked for and feared
- at every turn, as in the great tropic continents, where there is no
- surrounding sea to prevent rapid radiation of heat, and sudden changes of
- temperature are frequent and deadly. On the whole, there is much to be
- said in favour of the climate of the Southern Pacific, and little against
- it. It enjoys a long cool season of at least six months, when the heat is
- not at all oppressive. Three months of the year are very hot and damp, and
- three neither hot nor cool. At worst, the thermometer seldom goes above
- ninety in the shade. White children can be brought up in the islands
- without injury to health, and many of the older residents have spent the
- best part of a long life in the South Seas, and attained to a venerable
- age, without ever suffering from illness. The Government doctor in
- Raratonga leads an easy life on the whole, and in the other islands of the
- Cook Group the entire absence of medical advice seems to trouble no one.
- </p>
- <p>
- A reefing picnic was among the many pleasant entertainments to which I was
- invited during my stay. &ldquo;Reefing&rdquo; is such a favourite entertainment in the
- islands that nearly every white woman has a reefing skirt and shoes in her
- wardrobe&mdash;the former short, like a hockey skirt, the latter stout and
- old. Buggies are gathered together in the town, and the picnickers drive
- to a suitable spot some distance away, where the horses are taken out and
- tethered, and the &ldquo;reefers&rdquo; secure a canoe to bring them to their
- destination&mdash;the coral barrier reef, lying between the lagoon and the
- sea.
- </p>
- <p>
- Paddled by some of the native guests (for there are generally a few
- Raratongans included in the party) the canoes glide easily over the
- shallow water towards the reef, flights of the exquisite little
- sapphire-coloured fish that haunt the coral rocks, scattering beneath the
- keel like startled butterflies. Now the water is of the most vivid and
- burning emerald, shooting green lightnings to the sun, now, as we near the
- reef, it begins to change in colour, and&mdash;&mdash;-
- </p>
- <p>
- Oh!
- </p>
- <p>
- Why, the canoe is floating on a liquid rainbow&mdash;on a casket of jewels
- melted down and poured into the burning sea&mdash;on glancing shades of
- rose, and quivering gleams of violet, and gold and blue and amethyst and
- chrysophrase, all trembling and melting one into another in marvels of
- colouring that leave all language far behind. Under the keel, as we shoot
- forward, rise and sink wonderful water-bouquets of purple, pink, and
- pearl; great lacy fans of ivory; frilled and fluted fairy shells,
- streamers of brilliant weed, and under and through all these wonders
- glint, from far below, the dark blue depths of unplumbed caverns beneath.
- It is the coral reef, and we are going to land upon a spot exposed by the
- tide, and see what we can see of these wonders, by-and-by. If we were bent
- on fishing, we might spend a pleasant hour or two catching some of these
- peacock and parrot-coloured fish that flutter through these wonderful
- water-gardens. But reefing proper is more amusing, after all.
- </p>
- <p>
- At a point where the coral juts out above the sea, we leave the canoe, and
- start to walk about. It is very like trying to walk on a gigantic
- petrified hair-brush. The coral is peaked and pointed, and wrought into
- honeycombed sponges of stone, and there is nowhere for the foot to rest in
- security. Besides, the reef is covered with sea urchins possessing spines
- as long and sharp as a big slate-pencil, and these things pierce through
- any but the stoutest shoes. The colours of the sea-urchins are
- fascinating, and we pick up a good many, in spite of difficulties. Then
- there are tiger shells, shiny and spotted, in hues of orange and brown,
- and beautiful scarlet and pinky and lilac and chequered shells, and the
- daintiest of goffered clam shells, pearl white within, ivory white
- without, as large as a pea-pod, or as large as a vegetable dish&mdash;you
- may take your choice. And, if you are lucky, there is a varnished brown
- snail shell that you would not think worth picking up, if you did not
- happen to know that it has a &ldquo;peacock-eye&rdquo; gem, good to set in brooches,
- inside its plain little front door&mdash;like the homely brown toad of
- fable, that carried a jewel in its head. Much other spoil there is to put
- in your basket, and many things that you have no desire to possess at all&mdash;among
- them the huge hanks of slimy black string, which are alive, and
- wrigglesome, and not at all pleasant to put your hand on&mdash;and the
- wicked-faced great eels that look suddenly out of holes, and vanish,
- bubbling; and the revolting, leprous-spotted fish with the spiny back,
- that one may chance to see lurking at the bottom of a pool, every spine
- charged full of deadly poison for whoever touches it with unwary foot or
- hand. Indeed, the friends who are with you will warn you not to put your
- fingers into any pool, but to hook out shells and other spoil with a
- stick, if you want to be really careful, for there, are as many stinging
- and biting things among the beauties of the coral reef, as there thorns in
- a bed of roses.
- </p>
- <p>
- I have secured a good many shells, and a Reckitt&rsquo;s blue star-fish as big
- as a dinner-plate, and one or two other curiosities, and now I want, above
- everything else, one of those miraculous coral bouquets that bloom so
- temptingly just beneath the surface at this point. One of my friends asks
- me which I will have&mdash;with a smile, that, somehow or other, seems to
- amuse the rest. I select a pinky-violet one, and with some dragging and
- pounding, it is detached, and held up in the sun.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Oh!&rdquo; I exclaim disappointedly, and every one laughs. The beautiful bunch
- of coral flowers is a dirty liver-colour, and the magical hues are gone.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;It&rsquo;s the water that gives the colours,&rdquo; explains the coral-gatherer.
- &ldquo;Every one is awfully disappointed about it.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Are there no colours at all, then?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Oh yes, a little shade of pinkiness, and a touch of green, and that
- purply-brown. But you should see the corals when they are cleaned and
- dried. You&rsquo;d better have these, you won&rsquo;t know them when they are
- bleached; they&rsquo;re like spider&rsquo;s webs and lace furbelow things, all in
- white.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Is there none of the real red stuff?&rdquo; I ask somewhat ruefully, balancing
- myself with difficulty upon a sort of ornamental sponge-basket of spiky
- coral.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Not here. All these volcanic islands have a ring of coral reef right
- round, but the coral is always the white kind. There&rsquo;s a very little red
- coral in Samoa, and about Penrhyn, I believe. But, speaking generally,
- it&rsquo;s all white in the Pacific.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- I think of the dreams of my childhood, and the delightful pictures of
- palmy islands circled round with a chevaux-de-frise of high spiky red
- coral, which used to flit before my fancy on holiday afternoons. It is
- true that the cold practicalities of the <i>Voyage of the Challenger</i>,
- which somebody gave me in my &ldquo;flapper&rdquo; days, once and for all, to my
- bitter disappointment, knocked the bottom out of those cherished schemes
- of going away to live on something like a glorified coral necklace, some
- day. But I wonder, as I get into the canoe again, and glide shorewards and
- teawards, paddled by the swift brown arms of native girls, how many
- grown-up people still hold to that delightful fancy, not knowing that it
- is as impossible to realise as a dream of rambling in the moon?
- </p>
- <p>
- Tea is preparing on the shore when we get back, very wet and dirty, but
- very well pleased. The native girls among the guests immediately offer us
- spare dresses. It is the mode among Raratongans to take two or three
- dresses to a picnic, and retire every now and then into the bush to change
- one smart muslin or cotton &ldquo;Mother Hubbard&rdquo; for another&mdash;just for
- pure style. So there are plenty of clothes to spare, and in a minute or
- two the damp, sea-weedy &ldquo;reefers&rdquo; are fitted out with flowing garments of
- clean cambric and silk, of a mode certainly better adapted to the climate
- than the fitted garments of the &ldquo;papalangi.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- This question of dress is a burning one among island ladies. The native
- loose robe, hung straight down from a yoke, is very much cooler, and the
- doctors say, healthier, than belted and corseted dresses such as European
- women wear. But there is nevertheless a strong feeling against it, because
- it is supposed to mean a tendency to &ldquo;go native,&rdquo; and the distinguishing
- customs of the race acquire, in the island world, a significance quite out
- of proportion to their surface importance, because of the greatness of the
- thing they represent. Therefore, the white woman, unless she is suffering
- from bad health, and needs every possible help to withstand the heat of
- the climate, sticks to her blouses and corsets, as a rule, and sometimes
- &ldquo;says things&rdquo; about people who do not. For all that, and all that, the
- native woman is in the right, and if the other would agree to adopt the
- pretty, womanly, and essentially graceful robe of the native, no one would
- be the loser, and half of island humanity would be greatly the gainer.
- </p>
- <p>
- Later, when the dusk is coming down, and the magic moon of the islands is
- creeping, big and round and yellow-gold, out of a purple sea, we drive
- home again through the scented gloom of the forest, the endless song of
- the reef accompanying the voices of the native women, as they chant
- strange island melodies of long ago, that no one in these days, not even
- the singers themselves, can fully translate or understand. The moon climbs
- quickly up as we drive, and the road is as light as day, when our wheels
- roll into the sleeping town.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0006" id="link2HCH0006"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER VI
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>The Simple Life in the South Seas&mdash;Servant Problems again&mdash;Foods
- and Fruits of the Country&mdash;The Tree that digests&mdash;Home-made
- Vanilla&mdash;The Invaluable Lime&mdash;How to cook a Turtle&mdash;In an
- Island Bungalow&mdash;The Little House on the Coral Shore&mdash;Humours of
- Island Life&mdash;Burying a Cycle&mdash;A Network of Names&mdash;Mr.
- Zebedee-Thunderstorm-Tin-Roof&mdash;The Night-dress that went to Church&mdash;The
- Extraordinary Wedding&mdash;South Sea Musicians&mdash;A Conductor&rsquo;s
- Paradise&mdash;Society Journalism in Song.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">H</span>OUSEKEEPING in the
- South Sea Islands demands a section to itself. All who are uninterested in
- such matters may, and doubtless will, begin to skip at this point.
- </p>
- <p>
- Nothing helps the white house-mistress more than the simple standard of
- living set in most of the islands. It is true that if you are the wife of
- an important official in the Government House entourage of Fiji, or if you
- live in civilised, Americanised Honolulu, you will have to &ldquo;do things&rdquo;
- much as they are done at home. But, with these two exceptions, life in
- that enormous section of the globe known as the South Seas (much of it, by
- the way,&mdash;is north of the Line) is simple and unpretentious. In
- describing the home life of the white settlers in Raratonga, I describe
- what is, with small local variations, the life of settlers in almost every
- group of the Pacific, certainly, the life of all in the eight different
- groups I visited myself, during the years I spent in the South Seas. All
- over the island world, people dine in the middle of the day, except when
- entertaining friends, keep few servants or none, and dress and feed
- simply, because nothing else is possible. The trade cottons in the stores
- form the material of every lady&rsquo;s dresses, and as for the making, common
- consent, not to speak of climatic conditions, votes the simplest style the
- best. Where every stitch of sewing in dress or blouse must be done by the
- person who is to wear the garment, it is astonishing how soon one grows to
- regard elaborate tuckings, flouncings, inlayings, with hostility, and how
- satisfied the eye becomes with the simpler and less &ldquo;fatigued&rdquo; lines of
- the garments fashioned by women who cannot hire a dressmaker for love or
- money. Evening dress is almost always of the &ldquo;blouse&rdquo; description, and in
- a climate which works universal mischief with delicate white skins, no
- matter how they are protected, this is no matter for regret. Men buy their
- drill suits ready-made from the trading stores at a few shillings apiece,
- and, with a white dinner-jacket and black cummerbund, any one is ready for
- the gayest of evening entertainments.
- </p>
- <p>
- The great dress question&mdash;being thus resolved into the simple
- elements of a few cotton frocks for every day, and a muslin or two for
- best, behold! half the worry of modern life is lifted at a blow. &ldquo;One must
- look like other people&rdquo;&mdash;the goad of the toiling townswoman&mdash;becomes
- in the islands, &ldquo;One looks like other people because one must,&rdquo; and the
- words are a lullaby of rest.
- </p>
- <p>
- After dress, comes servants, in the list of small worries that turn a
- woman&rsquo;s fair locks grey, and swell the takings of the fashionable
- hairdressers. Well, it cannot be said that there is no servant trouble in
- the islands. White servants simply do not exist; they are far too much in
- demand in America and Australasia to desert either of these domestic
- paradises for the hotter and lonelier islands. Native girls cannot be had
- either, since they marry at thirteen or thereabouts. Native boys and men
- are the only resource. They come to work by the day, and are fed in the
- house; their wages are generally about five shillings weekly, in the case
- of a boy, and ten shillings for a man. So far as they go, they are
- satisfactory enough; they work hard, and are extremely honest, and they
- are amiability and good-nature itself. But their scope is decidedly
- limited. They can garden, under direction; they can sweep, fetch wood and
- water, clean the cooking-stove, husk and open the cocoanuts, wash, peel
- and boil the vegetables, scrub the verandah floor, clean the knives, wash
- up dishes, and whiten the shoes. That is about all. The mistress of the
- house and her daughters, if she is lucky enough to have any, must do all
- the serious cooking, make the beds, dust, tidy, and lay the table for
- meals.
- </p>
- <p>
- One cannot say, however, that health suffers from the necessity of doing a
- certain amount of housework every day. On the contrary, the white women of
- the islands are strong and handsome, and do not seem to suffer from the
- heat nearly so much as the semi-invalid ladies who have come to be
- regarded as the type of white womanhood in India, that paradise of
- excellent service and servants.
- </p>
- <p>
- Otherwise, the islands help out the housekeeper considerably. She can grow
- as much excellent coffee as the family are likely to want, on a few bushes
- in the back yard, and peppers only have to be pulled off the nearest wild
- chili tree. Taro, yam, sweet potato, can be bought from the natives for a
- trifle, or grown with very little trouble. There will probably be enough
- breadfruit, mango, orange, lime, and mammee-apple in the grounds of the
- house, to supply all the family needs, and if any one likes chestnuts,
- they can be picked up under the huge maupei trees along any road. The
- mammee-apple or paw-paw, mentioned above, is one of the most
- characteristic fruits of the islands. In Raratonga, it grows with
- extraordinary fertility, springing up of itself wherever scrub is cleared
- away, and coming to maturity in a few months. It is a slender palm-like
- tree, from ten to thirty feet high, with a quaintly scaled trunk, very
- like the skin of some great serpent, and a crown of pointed, pinnated
- leaves, raying out fanwise from the cluster of heavy green and yellow
- fruit that hangs in the centre. The fruit itself is rather like a small
- melon, though wider at one end than the other. It looks likes a melon,
- too, when cut open, and is both refreshing and satisfying, with a
- sweetish, musky flavour, The small, soft black seeds in the centre are a
- sovereign cure for dyspepsia, as is also the fruit itself in a lesser
- degree. The whole of this wonderful tree, indeed, seems to be possessed of
- digestive powers, for the toughest fowl or piece of salt beef will become
- tender in a few hours, if wrapped in its leaves. When boiled in the green
- stage the fruit is undistinguishable from vegetable marrow, and if cooked
- ripe, with a little lime juice, it can be made into a mock apple pie, much
- appreciated by settlers in a land where the typical British fruit cannot
- be grown.
- </p>
- <p>
- Cooking bananas are much used, and grow wild on the lands of the natives,
- who sell them for a trifle. Every house has its own patch of eating
- bananas of many kinds, and orange-trees are almost sure to be there as
- well. There is always a huge bunch of bananas, and two or three great
- palm-leaf baskets of oranges, on the verandah of every house, and the
- inmates consume them both in uncounted numbers all day. Pineapples are
- easily raised in the little bit of garden, or they can be bought for a
- penny a piece. A vanilla vine will probably spread its beautiful thick
- leaves over the fence, and hang out, in due season, a store of pods for
- flavouring use in the kitchens. Arrowroot may be grown or bought&mdash;a
- big basket sells for sixpence, and it has no more to do with the arrowroot
- of the grocer&rsquo;s shop at home, than a real seal mantle worth three figures
- has to do with a two guinea &ldquo;electric&rdquo;. Limes grow wild everywhere, and
- the island housewife makes full use of them. They clean her floors, her
- tables, her enamelled ware, stained table linen, or marked clothing; they
- wash her hair delightfully, and take the sunburn off her face and hands;
- they make the best of &ldquo;long drinks,&rdquo; and the daintiest of cake flavouring,
- they are squeezed into every fruit salad, and over every stew; they take
- the place of vinegar, if the island stores run low; in truth, they are
- used for almost every purpose of domestic cooking, cleaning, or chemistry.
- </p>
- <p>
- Cabbage of an excellent kind grows wild in a few islands. Tomatoes, small
- but excellent in flavour, are found on the borders of the seashore, in
- many. Nearly all English vegetables are grown by the white settlers with
- extremely little trouble. The egg-plant, known in England as a greenhouse
- ornament, here thrives splendidly in gardens, and instead of the little
- plum-like fruit of the British plant, produces a great purple globe as big
- as a fine marrow, which resembles fried eggs very closely, if sliced and
- cooked in a pan. But in truth there is no limit to the richness and
- generosity of the island soil. Were it not for the troublesome item of
- butcher&rsquo;s meat, housekeeping in the Pacific would be marvellously cheap
- and easy. That, however, is the housekeeper&rsquo;s bugbear. Outside of Samoa,
- Fiji, Tonga, Tahiti, the Marquesas, and Honolulu, fresh beef is not be had
- at all, and fresh mutton not often. In very many islands tinned meat and
- fowls are the only resource; and the lady of the house must tax her
- ingenuity to the utmost to find ways of disguising the inevitable &ldquo;tin.&rdquo;
- Curry, stew, pie, mince; mince, pie, stew, curry&mdash;so runs the
- monotonous programme in most houses; and disguise it as one may, the trail
- of the tin is over it all.
- </p>
- <p>
- It is a great day in the islands when turtle are caught. They are not
- common in the groups frequented by white people, since they prefer the
- lonely, barren atolls where the soil is dry and infertile; but now and
- then a &ldquo;school&rdquo; is found, and a big catch made. Then there is rejoicing in
- the land, and cooking in every house of an uncommonly-liberal and
- elaborate kind. The South Sea turtle are enormous, often weighing as much
- as seven or eight hundred pounds, and occasionally touching the thousand.
- Such a monster as this would easily feed a large household for a week&mdash;but
- alas, in tropical climates fresh meat, even when scalded, will not keep
- more than three days; so a good deal is usually wasted. The famous turtle
- soup, is made from the flippers, which are full of gelatine; and it may
- safely be assumed that no London aldermen fed on dying creatures carried
- half across the world has ever tasted soup so good as that made from a
- fine healthy turtle just out of the sea. The grass-green fat of the upper
- shell is used to put in the soup, and to fry the thick steaks of turtle
- beef, also to baste the big roast of turtle meat that is generally a
- feature of a turtle dinner. The eggs (of which there will probably be a
- large bucketful at least) are fried in green fat, and eaten as they are,
- shell-less, crisp and golden, tasting rather like roast chestnut. The
- tripe is cooked like ordinary tripe; the liver is fried. An excellent
- dinner, but surely an indigestible one? By no means. It is a curious
- property of this turtle meat that a much larger quantity of it can be
- eaten than of any ordinary butcher&rsquo;s meat, without any sense of repletion
- or after ill effects. This is the great dainty of the South Sea islands,
- and if to a turtle dinner be added bisque soup made from mountain river
- crayfish, a real island fruit salad, with lime juice and cocoanut cream, a
- freshly plucked pineapple, a dish of mangoes, granadillas, and a cup of
- island-grown coffee, not the Carlton or the Savoy could do better for a
- travelling prince.
- </p>
- <p>
- All South Sea Island &ldquo;white&rdquo; houses are more or less alike, being built of
- coral concrete (occasionally of wood) and fitted with imported windows and
- doors. The verandah is the great feature of the building; for there the
- family will probably spend most of their time, reading, smoking, receiving
- callers, or simply lounging in long chairs and listening to the monotonous
- singing of the natives in the thatched reed houses near at hand. Splendid
- climbing plants wreathe the pillars and sloping roofs of these verandahs&mdash;stephanotis,
- Bougainvillea, and countless gay tropical flowers whose ugly Latin names
- only an accomplished botanist could remember. Gardenias, gorgeous white
- trumpet lilies, tall bushes of begonia; pink, yellow and scarlet hibiscus,
- crimson poinsettia, delicate eucharis lilies, run riot about the grounds,
- and orange and lemon flowers fill the air with an exquisite perfume.
- </p>
- <p>
- Within, the high-pitched, deep, church-like roof rises above a range of
- partition walls separating the different rooms, but giving a common air
- supply to all, since the dividing walls are not more than ten or twelve
- feet high. There are no secrets in an island house; what any one says at
- one end can be heard at the other, and a light burning late in anybody&rsquo;s
- bedroom keeps all the rest awake. In the older houses the roof is of &ldquo;rau&rdquo;
- or plaited pandanus thatch, of a soft brown tone, delightfully cool and
- exceedingly picturesque. The rafters, in such a house, will be almost
- black with age, and beautifully latticed and patterned with finely plaited
- &ldquo;sinnet&rdquo; (cocoanut fibre). More modern houses have corrugated iron roofs,
- generally painted red. The water supply from these roofs is of some
- importance, and they are less expense and trouble than the thatch; but the
- latter is incomparably the more picturesque, and a good deal the cooler as
- well.
- </p>
- <p>
- The floor is always covered with native matting (pandanus leaf, split and
- plaited). This is of a pleasant tan colour in tone, and very cool and
- clean. The furniture is generally basket and bamboo, with a native &ldquo;tappa&rdquo;
- cloth (of which I shall have more to say later on) on the table. There are
- sure to be groups of old native weapons on the walls&mdash;lances and
- spears and clubs and arrows&mdash;and a few island fans, arranged in
- trophies, and garlanded with chains of shells. On the steps of the
- verandah one usually finds a fern or two, planted in big white clam-shells
- off the reef, and there may be others in the drawing-room.&rsquo; A piano is a
- great luxury; the island climate is not kind to pianos. Harmoniums are
- more common.
- </p>
- <p>
- The bedrooms may have ordinary beds imported from Auckland, or they may
- have (what is quite as good) native bedsteads made of ironwood, laced
- across with sinnet, and covered with soft pandanus leaf mats, over which
- the under sheet is laid. Unless it is the cool season there will not be a
- blanket. Mosquito curtains, of course, protect each bed. All windows and
- doors are wide open, day or night, hot season or cool.
- </p>
- <p>
- The South Sea housekeeper has a few insect plagues to fight against, but
- not nearly so many as her sister in India or Jamaica. The ants eat
- everything that is not hung or covered up. Enormous hornets, in the cool
- season, lurk about ceilings, bookcases and cupboards, sleepy, cross, and
- ready to dart a fearful sting, if accidentally touched. Cockroaches are
- destructive at all times. Fleas do not trouble much, and flies are only
- annoying in a few islands. Mosquitoes are troublesome in the hot season,
- but give little annoyance at other times. Centipedes and scorpions exist,
- but are not common. They do come into houses occasionally, and (being very
- poisonous, though not deadly) frighten the inmates quite as much as the
- inmates undoubtedly frighten them. It is the rarest possible thing,
- however, to hear of a European being bitten.
- </p>
- <p>
- Education is not an unsolvable problem in the islands, since quite a large
- number of groups possess convent schools, where even such extras as music,
- languages, and fancy needlework can be taught.
- </p>
- <p>
- On the whole, the difficulties of housekeeping are somewhat less than at
- home, and the cost certainly much smaller. It is true that a good many
- tinned stuffs are used, and tinned food is always dear; but the cheapness
- of everything that the soil produces makes up that difference, and the
- simple standard of living swings the balance still further to the right
- side. I am of opinion myself that white families would benefit both in
- comfort and in pocket by adopting the native style of house, which is, as
- already mentioned, a structure of small neat sticks or poles set very
- closely and strongly, but not filled in. The roof is always thatched. In
- such a house, the air circulates freely without any draught, and there is
- a pleasant, diffused light during the daytime. At night, when native
- houses are more or less transparent, the privacy-loving white can draw
- thin cotton curtains across his walls until the lights are put out.
- </p>
- <p>
- One such house, built for and used by white people, was conspicuous for
- the simple beauty of the design. The interior was very plainly furnished
- with a few bamboo tables and chairs, and a light stretcher bed or two. Its
- curtains were of printed muslin from the store, and its floor was nothing
- but white coral sand brought from the beach. The house stood sheltered, by
- tall palms, and the sea was so near that all day one could watch the soft
- sparkle of the creaming surf through the half-transparent walls, and all
- night long one slept to the matchless lullaby of the humming reef.
- </p>
- <p>
- <i>(Windows blurred with beating mud, grey London roaring by in the rain;
- haggard faces, and murky summer, and the snake of custom clipping
- stranglingly about the free man&rsquo;s throat&mdash;O Island wanderer, back in
- the weary North, does your sea-bird&rsquo;s heart fly swift from these to those,
- and-sicken for the lands where you must go no more?)</i>
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <p>
- Raratonga is full of funny things, if one knows where to look for them.
- One would not suppose that the tombs of the natives were a likely spot.
- Yet I would defy the most serious of graveyard moralisers to count over
- the list of things that the Raratongan buries in the tombs of his departed
- relatives, without feeling his seriousness badly shaken. Little household
- ornaments belonging to the deceased are pathetic, certainly; so, in a
- lesser degree, are the Sunday clothes that often accompany their wearer on
- the long journey. But what is one to say of bicycles, Japanned bedsteads,
- and even pianos? All these things have been buried by Raratongans in the
- big concreted tombs that crop up sociably along the edges of the public
- road every here and there. The piano, I must add, was dug up again, by
- order of an indignant missionary, who gave the disconsolate mourners a
- good lecture on heathenistic practices, and the necessity of drawing the
- line somewhere.
- </p>
- <p>
- Native names are sometimes exceedingly funny to the perverted white mind,
- although to the owners they may be dignified, poetic, and even beautiful.
- One young coffee-coloured lady of my acquaintance had been named (in
- Raratongan) &ldquo;Cup-of-Tea.&rdquo; Another was &ldquo;Box-with-a-Hole-in-It&rdquo;&mdash;another
- &ldquo;Tin-of-Meat.&rdquo; I should suppose, from my knowledge of their religious
- training, that each of these ladies possessed a godly scripture name of
- her own, properly bestowed on her at her proper baptism. But in the Cook
- Islands, the name a native is christened by, and the name he or she goes
- by, are almost always distinct, which is certainly confusing. Worse
- confusion still is caused by the odd habit of changing these commonly
- accepted names on any great occasion that seems to need special
- commemoration. The natives themselves never seem to become puzzled over
- all these name-changes, but so much can hardly be said of the whites. It
- is, at the least, perplexing to employ a gardener called Zebedee by the
- missionaries, Thunderstorm by his friends, and Tin Roof by his relatives&mdash;like
- the notable character in <i>The Hunting of the Snark</i>,
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- Whose intimate friends called him Candle-Ends,
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- And his enemies Toasted Cheese.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p>
- But it is even worse to be informed&mdash;some day, when you go to look
- after Zebedee-Thunderstorm-Tin Roof down in the village, and ask why he
- has not turned up to weed your pineapples&mdash;that his name isn&rsquo;t any of
- the three, but &ldquo;Barbed Wire,&rdquo; because he has just finished putting up a
- fence of barbed wire round the grave of his boy who died last year, and
- has resolved to call himself henceforth, &ldquo;Barbed Wire,&rdquo; in memory of his
- son!
- </p>
- <p>
- Native notions about European clothes often provide a feast of fun for the
- whites, who set the copies in dress.
- </p>
- <p>
- When a lace-trimmed garment of mine, usually reserved for private wear
- under the shades of night and the shelter of a quilt and sheet, went to
- Sunday morning church as a best dress in full daylight, on the person of
- the laundress who had been entrusted with my clothes for the wash, the
- funny side of the affair was so much the more conspicuous, that the
- borrower never got the reproof she certainly ought to have had. And when a
- certain flower toque, made of poppies (a blossom unknown to the Pacific)
- first drove the women of the island half-distracted with excitement, and
- then led to thirty-six native ladies appearing simultaneously at a dance
- in Makea&rsquo;s grounds, wearing most excellent copies of my Paris model, done
- in double scarlet hibiscus from the bush, the natural outrage to my
- feelings (which every woman who has ever owned a &ldquo;model&rdquo; will understand)
- was quite swallowed up in the intense amusement that the incident caused
- to everybody on the grounds.
- </p>
- <p>
- I was unfortunate enough to be away on the island schooner when a great
- wedding took place&mdash;the nuptials of one of the queen&rsquo;s nieces&mdash;and
- so missed the finest display of native dress and custom that had occurred
- during the whole year. The bride, I heard, wore fourteen silk dresses&mdash;not
- all at once, but one after the other, changing her dress again and again
- during the reception that followed the wedding ceremony in the mission
- church, until she almost made the white spectators giddy.
- </p>
- <p>
- The presents were &ldquo;numerous and costly&rdquo; from the guests to the bride, and
- from the bride to the guests, for it is Raratongan custom to give presents
- to the people who come to your wedding; a fashion that would considerably
- alleviate the lot of the weary wedding guest, if only it could be
- introduced over here. The gifts for the bride were carried in by the
- givers, and flung down in a heap one by one, each being duly announced by
- the person making the present, who showed no false modesty in describing
- his contribution. &ldquo;Here&rsquo;s twenty yards of the most beautiful print for
- Mata (the bride), from Erri Puno!&rdquo; &ldquo;Here&rsquo;s three baskets of arrowroot, the
- best you ever saw, for Mata, from Taoua.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Here&rsquo;s eighteen-pence for Mata and Tamueli, from Ruru,&rdquo; flinging the
- coins loudly into a china plate. So the procession went on, until the
- gifts were all bestowed, the bride meanwhile standing behind a kind of
- counter, and rapidly handing out rolls of stuff, tins of food, ribbons,
- gimcracks of various kinds, to her guests as they passed by. When all is
- added up, the amusement seems to be about all that any one really clears
- out of the whole proceeding.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Cook Islanders are among the most musical of Pacific races. They have
- no musical instruments, unless &ldquo;trade&rdquo; mouth-organs, accordions, and jew&rsquo;s
- harps may be classed as such, but they need none, in their choral singing,
- which is indescribably grand and impressive. Here as elsewhere in the
- islands, one traces distinctly the influence of the two dominant sounds of
- the island world&mdash;the low droning of the reef, and the high soft
- murmur of the trade wind in the palms. The boom of the breakers finds a
- marvellously close echo in the splendid volume of the men&rsquo;s voices, which
- are bass for the most part, and very much more powerful and sonorous than
- anything one hears in the country of the &ldquo;superior&rdquo; race. The women&rsquo;s
- voices are somewhat shrill, but they sound well enough as one usually
- hears them, wandering wildly in and out of the massive harmonies of the
- basses.
- </p>
- <p>
- A Philharmonic conductor from the isles of the North would surely think
- himself in heaven, if suddenly transported to these southern isles of
- melody and song. The Pacific native is born with harmony in his throat,
- and time in his very pulses. It is as natural to him to sing as to
- breathe; and he simply cannot go out of time if he tries. Solo singing
- does not attract him at all; music is above all things a social function,
- in his opinion, and if he can get a few others&mdash;or better still, a
- few score others&mdash;to sit down with him on the ground, and begin a
- chorus, he is happy for hours, and so are they.
- </p>
- <p>
- To the Pacific traveller, this endless chanting is as much a part of the
- island atmosphere as the palms and the reef and the snowy coral strand
- themselves. One comes, in time, to notice it hardly more than the choral
- song of beating breaker and long trade wind, to which it is so wonderfully
- akin. But at the first, wonder is continually awakened by the incomparable
- volume of the voices, and the curious booming sound&mdash;like the echo
- that follows the striking of some gigantic bell&mdash;which characterises
- the bass register of island men&rsquo;s singing. The swing and entrain of the
- whole performance are intoxicating&mdash;the chorus, be it ten or a
- thousand voices, sweeps onward as resistlessly as a cataract, and the beat
- of the measure is like the pulse of Father Time himself. There are several
- parts as a rule, but they wander in and out of one another at will, and
- every now and then a single voice will break away, and embroider a little
- improvisation upon the melody that is like a sudden scatter of spray from
- the crest of a rolling breaker. Then the chorus takes it up and answers
- it, and the whole mass of the voices hurls itself upon the tune like the
- breaker falling and bursting upon the shore.
- </p>
- <p>
- It is very wonderful, and very lovely; yet there are times&mdash;at one in
- the morning, let us say, when the moon has crept round from one side of
- the mosquito curtain to the other since one lay down, and the bats have
- finished quarrelling and gone home, and the comparative chill of the small
- hours is frosting the great green flags of the bananas outside the window
- with glimmering dew&mdash;when the white traveller, musical or unmusical,
- may turn over on an uneasy couch, and curse the native love of melody,
- wondering the while if the people in the little brown houses down the road
- ever sleep at all?
- </p>
- <p>
- What are the subjects of the songs? That is more than the natives
- themselves can tell you, very often, and certainly much more than a
- wandering traveller, here to-day, and gone next month, could say. Many of
- the chants are traditional, so old that the customs they refer to are not
- half remembered, and full of words that have passed out of use. A good
- number now-a-days are religious, consisting of hymns and psalms taught by
- the missionaries, and improved on, as to harmony and setting, by the
- native. The island love of choral singing must be an immense assistance to
- the church services, since it turns these latter into a treat, instead of
- a mere duty, and the native can never get enough church, so long as there
- is plenty of singing for him to do. Some of the secular songs are
- understood to refer to the deeds of ancestors; some are amatory; some&mdash;and
- those the most easily understood by white people who know the native
- languages&mdash;are in the nature of a kind of society journal, recording
- the important events of the last few days, and making comments, often of a
- very free nature, on friends and enemies, and the white people of the
- island. Most of these latter are not good enough scholars to understand
- the chants, even if they can talk a little native, which is just as well,
- when oratorios of this kind are to be heard every evening among the &ldquo;rau&rdquo;
- roofed huts:
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- &ldquo;Big-Nose who lives in the white house has got a new
- </p>
- <p class="indent20">
- suit of clothes.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- Chorus. &ldquo;A new suit of clothes, a new suit, suit, suit of
- </p>
- <p class="indent20">
- clothes!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- &ldquo;Big-Nose cannot fasten the coat, he is so fat, ai! ai,
- </p>
- <p class="indent20">
- fat like a pig fit for killing!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- Chorus. &ldquo;Ai, Ai! a pig for killing, like a pig for killing,
- </p>
- <p class="indent20">
- Big-Nose is like a pig fit for killing!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- &ldquo;Big-Nose had a quarrel with his wife to-day, a quarrel,
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- a great quarrel, Big-Nose drank wisiki, much wisiki.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- (All together, excitedly.) &ldquo;A quarrel, a great quarrel,
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- much wisiki Big-Nose drank, Big-Nose!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- &ldquo;The wife of Big-Nose of the white house has long hair,
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- though she is very old, long hair that came to her in
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- a box by the sitima (steamer)!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- Chorus. &ldquo;Long hair, long hair, long hair, in a box on the
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- steamer. A box on the steamer, on the steamer,
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- long hair for the wife of Big-Nose who lives in the
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- white house.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p>
- A resident who really understood the natives and their music once or twice
- translated choruses for me that were quite as personal as the above. I
- have never since then wondered, as I used to wonder, where on earth the
- merry peasants of opera, with their extraordinary knowledge of the
- principals&rsquo; affairs, and their tireless energy in singing about them, were
- originally sketched.
- </p>
- <p>
- (Scholars will probably trace a resemblance to the Greek chorus here. I
- leave it to them to work out the wherefore, which makes me giddy even to
- think of, considering the geographical elements involved in the problem.)
- </p>
- <p>
- But now enough of Raratonga, for the schooner <i>Duchess</i> is waiting to
- carry me away to the other islands of the group, and, after many thousands
- of miles travelled by steamer upon &ldquo;all the seas of all the world,&rdquo; I am
- at last to learn what going to sea really is.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0007" id="link2HCH0007"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER VII
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>The Schooner at last&mdash;White Wings versus Black Funnels&mdash;Not
- according to Clark Russell&mdash;The Marvellous White Woman&mdash;The Song
- of the Surf&mdash;Why not?&mdash;Delightful Aitutaki&mdash;Into an Atoll&mdash;A
- Night in the House of a Chieftainess&mdash;The Scarlet Devil&mdash;Nothing
- to wear&mdash;How to tickle a Shark&mdash;The Fairy Islets&mdash;A Chance
- for Robinson Crusoe.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">T</span>HE schooner <i>Duchess</i>
- was in at last.
- </p>
- <p class="indent20">
- Of their bones are coral made.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p>
- We were almost growing anxious about her in Raratonga&mdash;almost, not
- quite; for after all, she was only a fortnight overdue, and that is not
- much for an island schooner, even when she is run by white officers. When
- the easy-going native runs her, no one ever knows when she will leave any
- port, and no one would venture to predict that she will ever arrive at
- all. There are generally a good many native-owned schooners about the
- South Eastern Pacific, but, though all the numbers keep up, the identity
- varies, and if you return after a few years and ask for the ships you used
- to know, the answer will be, I have not space to tell you here of the
- native schooner that started from one of the Cook Islands, not so very
- long ago, to visit another island less than two hundred miles away, but,
- because of the wild and weird navigation of her owners, went instead to
- somewhere over a thousand miles off; toured half the Pacific; stayed away
- six months; and finally came back to her own little island by a happy
- chance, without ever having reached the place she set out for after all.
- But it has a good deal of local colour in it.
- </p>
- <p>
- The <i>Duchess</i>, however, was not a native schooner, being owned by
- whites, and run by a British captain, mate, and boatswain, assisted by
- eight island seamen. There was, therefore, a reasonable prospect of
- getting somewhere, sometime, if I travelled in her; so I took my passage,
- and, for the first time, literally &ldquo;sailed away&rdquo;&mdash;to see the outer
- islands of the Cook Group, and later on, solitary Savage Island, Penrhyn,
- Malden, Rakahanga, and Manahiki.
- </p>
- <p>
- For more than four months afterwards, with a single break, the little <i>Duchess</i>
- of 175 tons was my home. Little she seemed at first, but before long she
- assumed the proportions of quite a majestic vessel. There was no schooner
- in those waters that could touch her, either for speed, size, or (alas!)
- for pitching and rolling, in any and every weather. Her ninety-five foot
- masts made a brave show, when clothed with shining canvas; her white hull,
- with its scarlet encircling band, and the sun-coloured copper glimmering
- at the water-line, stood out splendidly on the blazing blue of the great
- Pacific. &ldquo;A three-masted topsail schooner&rdquo; was her official designation.
- The unofficial names she was called in a calm, when the great Pacific
- swell brought out her full rolling powers, are best left unreported.
- </p>
- <p>
- I cannot honestly advise the elderly round-the-world-tourist, doing the
- Pacific in orthodox style, to desert steam for sail, and try the
- experience of voyaging &ldquo;off the track&rdquo; among the islands never visited by
- liners. But the true traveller, who wanders for the joy of wandering, and
- is not afraid or unwilling to &ldquo;rough it&rdquo; a good deal, will find a sailing
- trip in the Pacific among the most fascinating of experiences. Beyond the
- radius of the belching funnel a great peace reigns; an absence of time, a
- pleasant carelessness about all the weighty and tiresome things that may
- be happening outside the magic circle of still blue ocean. There is no
- &ldquo;let-her-slide&rdquo; spirit in the whole world to compare with that which
- blossoms spontaneously on the sun-white decks of a Pacific schooner.
- </p>
- <p>
- Looking back upon all the island boats that I have known, I may say that
- there was not so much discipline among the lot as would have run a single
- cross-channel boat at home, that every one was satisfied if the officers
- refrained from &ldquo;jamborees&rdquo; between ports; if some one was sometimes at the
- wheel, and if the native crew knew enough of the ropes to work the ship
- reasonably well, in the intervals of line-fishing and chorus-singing. And
- in one and all, whatever might happen to passengers, cargo, ship, or crew,
- &ldquo;take things as they come,&rdquo; was the grand general rule.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;This is your cabin,&rdquo; said the cheerful little pirate of a captain. He was
- celebrated as the &ldquo;hardest case&rdquo; in the South Pacific, and looked not
- quite unworthy of his reputation, though he was dressed as if for Bond
- Street in the afternoon, and mannered (on that occasion) as if for an
- evening party.
- </p>
- <p>
- What I wanted to say, was &ldquo;Good God!&rdquo; What I did say was: &ldquo;Oh, really!
- very nice indeed.&rdquo; For I saw at once that I must lie, and it seemed as
- well to obtain the fullest possible advantage from the sin. There was no
- use mincing words, or morals, in such a case.
- </p>
- <p>
- The cabin had a floor exactly the size of my smallest flat box, which
- filled it so neatly that I had to stand on the lid all the time I was in
- my room. It had a bunk about as large as a tight fit in coffins, and a
- small parrot-perch at one side, which was not meant for parrots, but for
- me, to perch on, if I wanted to lace my boots without committing suicide
- when the ship was rolling. On the perch stood a tin basin, to do duty as a
- washstand. There was a biscuit-tin full of water underneath.
- </p>
- <p>
- This was all that the cabin contained, except smells. The latter, however,
- crowded it to its fullest capacity. It had some mysterious communication
- with the hold, which perfumed it strongly with the oppressive, oily stench
- of ancient copra, and it had also a small door leading into the companion
- that went down to the engine-hole (one could not call it a room), in which
- lived the tiny oil engine that was supposed to start instantaneously, and
- work us out of danger, in case of any sudden need. (I say supposed,
- because&mdash;&mdash; But that comes after.)
- </p>
- <p>
- This engine-hole had a smell of its own, a good deal stronger than the
- engine (but that is not saying much)&mdash;compounded of dirt,
- bilge-water, and benzolene. The smell joined in a sort of chorus with the
- copra odour of the hold, and both were picked out and accentuated by a
- sharp note of cockroach. It was the most symphonic odour that I had ever
- encountered. As for the port, that, I saw, would be screwed down most of
- the time owing to the position of the cabin, low down on the main deck.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Very nice,&rdquo; I repeated, smiling a smile of which I am proud to this day.
- &ldquo;Such a dear little cabin!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;I&rsquo;m glad you like it,&rdquo; said the captain, evidently relieved. &ldquo;You see,
- there&rsquo;s four Government officials coming round this trip, and that takes
- our only other cabin. I chucked the bo&rsquo;sun out of this; he&rsquo;s sleeping
- anywhere. Anything else you&rsquo;d like?&rdquo; he continued, looking at the
- biscuit-tin and the shiny basin with so much satisfaction that I guessed
- at once they were a startling novelty&mdash;the bo&rsquo;sun having probably
- performed his toilet on deck. &ldquo;We don&rsquo;t have lady passengers on these
- trips as we aren&rsquo;t a Union liner exactly, but we&rsquo;re always ready to do
- what we can to please every one.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;I want first of all a new mattress, and sheets that haven&rsquo;t been washed
- in salt water, and then I want some air and light, and thirty or forty
- cubic feet more space, and I think, a new cabin, and I&rsquo;m almost sure,
- another ship,&rdquo; I said to myself. Aloud I added: &ldquo;Nothing whatever, thank
- you; it is charming,&rdquo; and then I went in and shut the door, and sat down
- on my bunk, and said things, that would not have passed muster in a
- Sunday-School, for quite ten minutes.
- </p>
- <p>
- What I had expected I don&rsquo;t know. Something in the Clark Russell line, I
- fear&mdash;a sparkling little sea-parlour, smelling of rope and brine,
- looking out on a deck &ldquo;as white as a peeled almond,&rdquo; and fitted with stern
- windows that overhung half the horizon. It was borne in upon me, as I sat
- there among the smells and ants and beetles, that I was in for something
- as un-Clark-Russelly as possible. &ldquo;Well,&rdquo; I thought, &ldquo;it will at least be
- all the newer. And there is certainly no getting out of it.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- So we spread our white wings, and fluttered away like a great
- sea-butterfly, from underneath the green and purple peaks of Raratonga,
- far out on the wide Pacific. And thereupon, because the rollers rolled,
- and the ship was small, I went into my cabin, and for two days, like the
- heroine of an Early Victorian romance, &ldquo;closed my eyes, and knew no more.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- On the third day I was better, and in the afternoon Mitiaro, one of the
- outer Cook Islands, rose on the horizon. By three o&rsquo;clock our boat had
- landed us&mdash;the official party, the captain, and myself&mdash;on a
- beach of foam-white coral sand, crowded with laughing, excited natives,
- all intensely eager to see the &ldquo;wahiné papa,&rdquo; or foreign woman. White men&mdash;traders,
- missionaries, the Resident Commissioner of the group&mdash;had visited the
- island now and again, but never a white woman before; and though many had
- been away and seen such wonders, more had not.
- </p>
- <p>
- The officials went away to hold a court of justice; the captain and
- myself, before we had walked half across the beach, being captured by an
- excited band of jolly brown men and women, all in their Sunday best shirts
- and pareos, and long trailing gowns. They seized us by our elbows, and
- literally ran us up to the house of the principal chief, singing
- triumphantly. Along the neatest of coral sand paths we went, among groves
- of palm and banana, up to a real native house, built with a high &ldquo;rau&rdquo;
- roof, and airy birdcage walls. About half the island was collected here,
- drinking cocoanuts, eating bananas, staring, talking, laughing. In spite
- of their excitement, however, they were exceedingly courteous, offering me
- the best seat in the house&mdash;a real European chair, used as a sort of
- throne by the chief himself&mdash;fanning myself and my guide
- industriously as we sat, pressing everything eatable in the house on us,
- and doing their best, bare-footed brown savages as they were, to make us
- enjoy our visit.
- </p>
- <p>
- All islanders are not courteous and considerate, but the huge majority
- certainly are. You shall look many a day and many a week among the
- sea-countries of the Pacific, before you meet with as much rudeness,
- selfishness, or unkindness, as you may meet any day without looking at
- all, on any railway platform of any town of civilised white England. And
- not from one end of the South Seas to the other, shall you hear anything
- like the harsh, loud, unmusical voice of the dominant race, in a native
- mouth. Soft and gentle always is the island speech, musical and kind&mdash;the
- speech of a race that knows neither hurry nor greed, and for whom the days
- are long and sweet, and &ldquo;always afternoon.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- When we went out to see the island, it was at the head of a gay procession
- of men, women, and children, singing ceaselessly, in loud metallic chants
- and choruses. Shy of the strange white apparition at first, the women grew
- bolder by degrees, and hung long necklaces of flowers and leaves and
- scented berries round my neck. They took my hat away, and returned it
- covered with feathery reva-reva plumes, made from the inner crown of the
- palm-tree. They produced a native dancing kilt, like a little crinoline,
- made of arrowroot fibre, dyed pink, and tied it round my waist, over my
- tailor skirt, explaining the while (through the captain, who interpreted),
- that the knot of the girdle was fastened in such a way as to cast a spell
- on me, and that I should inevitably be obliged to return to the island.
- (It is perhaps worthy of note that I did, though at the time of my first
- visit there seemed no chance of the ship calling again.) Decked out after
- this fashion, I had a <i>suces</i>; on my return to the schooner, and was
- greeted with howls of delight on the part of my fellow-passengers, who had
- managed to escape adornment, being less of a novelty. It was of course
- impossible to remove the ornaments without offending the givers.
- </p>
- <p>
- More houses, and more hosts, standing like Lewis Carroll&rsquo;s crocodile on
- their thresholds, to welcome me in &ldquo;with gently smiling jaws.&rdquo; We visited
- till we were tired of visiting, and then strolled about the town. Cool,
- fresh, and clean are the houses of little Mitiaro, dotted about its three
- miles&rsquo; length. Their high deep-gabled roofs of plaited pandanus leaf keep
- out the heat of the staring sun; through their walls of smoothed and
- fitted canes the sea-wind blows and the green lagoon gleams dimly: the
- snowy coral pebbles that carpet all the floor reflect a softly pleasant
- light into the dusk, unwindowed dwelling. Outside, the palm-trees rustle
- endlessly, and the surf sings on the reef the long, low, perilous sweet
- song of the dreamy South Sea world&mdash;the song that has lured so many
- away into these lonely coral lands, to remember their Northern loves and
- homes no more&mdash;the song that, once heard, will whisper through the
- inmost chambers of the heart, across the years, and across the world till
- death.
- </p>
- <p>
- Yet&mdash;why not?
- </p>
- <p>
- Why not? The thought followed me as ceaselessly as the trampling of the
- surf (now, in the open, loud and triumphant, like the galloping of a
- victorious army) while I wandered over the little island, up and down the
- coral sand paths that led through groves of feathery ironwood, through
- quaintly regular, low, rich green shrubberies, starred with pale pink
- blossoms among wild grey pinnacles of fantastic rock, clothed in trailing
- vines&mdash;always towards the open sky and the limitless blue sea. Why
- not? In England, even yet,
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p class="indent20">
- We are not cotton-spinners all,
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p>
- nor are we all old, blood-chilled by the frost of conventionality, dyed
- ingrain with the conviction that there is nothing but vagabondage and
- ne&rsquo;er-do-well-ism away from the ring of the professions, or an office desk
- in the E.C. district. For the young and adventurous, the South Seas hold
- as fair prospects as any other semi-civilised portion of the globe. For
- those who have seen and have lived, and are wearied to death of the life
- and cities and competition, the island world offers remoteness, beauty,
- rest, and peace, unmatched in the round of the swinging earth. And to all
- alike it offers that most savoury morsel of life&rsquo;s banquet&mdash;freedom.
- Freedom and a biscuit taste better to many a young Anglo-Saxon than
- stalled ox seasoned with the bitter herbs of dependence; but the one is
- always at hand, and the other very far away.
- </p>
- <p>
- Well, the gulf can be spanned; but he who cannot do the spanning, and must
- long and dream unsatisfied all his life, had best take comfort: it had not
- been for his good. The Islands are for the man of resource; again, of
- resource; and once more, of resource. Look among the lowest huts of the
- lowest quarters that cling to towns in the big islands, and there, gone
- native, and lost to his race, you shall find the man who was an excellent
- fellow&mdash;once&mdash;but who in emergency or difficulty, &ldquo;didn&rsquo;t know
- what to do.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- If there is a lesson in the above, he who needs it will find it.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <p>
- Mitiaro is the island, already referred to, where dried bananas are
- prepared. The natives make up their fruit in this way for market, because
- steamers never call, and sailing vessels only come at long and irregular
- intervals. A very small quantity goes down in this way to Auckland, and I
- heard, in a general way, that there were supposed to be one or two other
- islands here and there about the Pacific, where the same trade was carried
- on. One cannot, however, buy preserved bananas in the colonies, unless by
- a special chance, so the purchasing public knows nothing of them, and is
- unaware what it misses. In the opinion of most who have tried them, the
- fruit, dried and compressed in the Mitiaro way, is superior to dried figs.
- It is not only a substitute for fresh bananas, but a dainty in itself. The
- whaling ships pick up an occasional consignment in out-of-the-way places,
- and are therefore familiar with them, but one never sees them on a
- steamer. There may be useful hints, for intending settlers, in these stray
- facts.
- </p>
- <p>
- We lay over-night at Mitiaro, and got off in the morning. Aitutaki was our
- next place of call, and we reached it in about a day. It is, next to
- Raratonga, the most important island of the group, possessing a large
- mission station, a Government agent, and a post-office. It enjoys a call
- once a month from the Union steamer, and is therefore a much more
- sophisticated place than Mitiaro. In size, it is inferior to Raratonga and
- Atiu, being only seven square miles in extent. Its population is
- officially returned as 1,170. These are almost all natives, the white
- population including only the Government agent, two or three missionaries,
- and a couple of traders.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0021" id="linkimage-0021"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0185.jpg" alt="0185 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0185.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- It is bright morning when we make Aitutaki, and the sea is so vividly
- blue, as we push off in the boat, that I wonder my fingers do not come out
- sapphire-coloured when I dip them in. And I think, as the eight brown arms
- pull us vigorously shoreward, that no one in the temperate climes knows,
- or ever can know, what these sea-colours of the tropics are like, because
- the North has no words that express them. How, indeed, should it have?
- </p>
- <p>
- We are rowing, as fast as we can go, towards a great white ruffle of foam
- ruled like a line across the blue, blue sea. Inside this line there lies,
- to all appearance, an immense raised plain of green jade or aquamarine,
- with a palmy, plumy island, cinctured by a pearly beach, far away in the
- middle. Other islands, smaller and farther away, stand out upon the
- surface of this strange green circle here and there, all enclosed within
- the magic ring of tumbling foam, more than five miles across, that sets
- them apart from the wide blue sea. It is only a lagoon of atoll formation,
- but it looks like a piece of enamelled jewel-work, done by the hand of
- some ocean giant, so great that the huge sea-serpent itself should be only
- a bracelet for his arm. The raised appearance of the lagoon is one of the
- strangest things I have yet seen, though it is merely an optical delusion,
- created by contrast in colour.
- </p>
- <p>
- We are fortunate, too, in seeing what every one does not see&mdash;a
- distinct green shade in the few white clouds that overhang the surface of
- the lagoon. Here in Aitutaki a great part of the sky is sometimes coloured
- green by the reflections from the water, and it is a sight worth
- witnessing.
- </p>
- <p>
- Through an opening in the reef we enter&mdash;the boatmen pulling hard
- against the outward rush of the tide, which runs here like a cataract at
- times&mdash;and glide easily across the mile or so of shallow water that
- lies between us and the shore. One or two splendid whale-boats pass us,
- manned by native crews, and the other passengers tell me that these boats
- are all made by the Aitutakians themselves, who are excellent builders.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is a very decent little wharf to land on, and of course, the usual
- excited, decorated crowd to receive us, and follow us about. I am getting
- quite used now to going round at the head of a continual procession, to
- being hung over with chains of flowers and berries, and ceaselessly fed
- with bananas and cocoanuts, so the crowd does not interfere with my
- enjoyment of the new island. We are going to stop a day or two here, and
- there will be time to see everything.
- </p>
- <p>
- When you sleep as a rule in a bunk possessing every attribute of a coffin
- (except the restfulness which one is led to expect in a bed of that
- nature), you do not require much pressing to accept an invitation to &ldquo;dine
- and sleep&rdquo; on shore. Tau Ariki (which means Chieftainess, or Countess, or
- Duchess, Tau) lives in Aitutaki, and she had met me in Raratonga, so she
- sent me a hearty invitation to spend the night at her house, and I
- accepted it.
- </p>
- <p>
- Tau is not by any means as great a personage as Makea, or even as great as
- Tinomana, the lesser queen. She is an Ariki all the same, however, and
- owns a good deal of land in Aitutaki. Also, she is gloriously married to a
- white ex-schooner mate, who can teach even the Aitutakians something about
- boat-building, and she is travelled and finished, having been a trip to
- Auckland&mdash;the ambition of every Cook Islander. So Tau Ariki is a
- person of importance in her own small circle, and was allowed by the
- natives of the town to have the undoubted first right to entertain the
- white woman.
- </p>
- <p>
- Tau&rsquo;s house, in the middle of the rambling, jungly, green street of the
- little town, proved to be a wooden bungalow with a verandah and a tin
- roof, very ugly, but very fine to native eyes. There were tables and
- chairs in the &ldquo;parlour&rdquo;; and the inevitable boiled fowl that takes the
- place of the fatted calf, in Pacific cookery, was served up on a china
- plate. A rich woman, Tau, and one who knew how the &ldquo;tangata papa&rdquo; (white
- folk) should be entertained!
- </p>
- <p>
- She gave me a bedroom all to myself, with a smile that showed complete
- understanding of the foolish fads of the &ldquo;wahiné papa.&rdquo; It had a large
- &ldquo;imported&rdquo; glass window, giving on the main street of the town, and
- offering, through its lack of blinds, such a fine, free show for the
- interested populace, that I was obliged to go to bed in the dark. There
- was a real bed in the room, covered with a patchwork quilt of a unique and
- striking design, representing a very realistic scarlet devil some four
- feet long. It seemed to me the kind of quilt that would need a good
- conscience and a blameless record, on the part of the sleeper reposing
- under it. To wake in the middle of the night unexpectedly, with the
- moonlight streaming in, forget for the moment where you were, and, looking
- round to find a landmark, drop your startled eyes upon that scarlet fiend,
- sprawling all over your chest&mdash;&mdash; Well, I had a good conscience,
- or none&mdash;I do not know which&mdash;so I felt the red devil would not
- disturb my slumbers, and he did not.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0022" id="linkimage-0022"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0191.jpg" alt="0191 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0191.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- There was nothing else in the room, except a new, gold-laced, steamship
- officer&rsquo;s cap, whereto there seemed neither history nor owner, reposing on
- the pillow. If there was any mystery about the cap, I never knew it.
- </p>
- <p>
- I put it out on the windowsill, and a hen laid an egg in it next morning,
- and no doubt the hen lived happily ever after, and I hope the officer did,
- and that is all. It seems pathetic, but I do not know why.
- </p>
- <p>
- There was nothing to wash in, but Tau knew her manners, and was quite
- aware that I might have a prejudice against sitting in a washing-tub on
- either the front or the back verandah, to have buckets emptied on my head
- in the morning. So she made haste to leave a kerosene tin full of water,
- before going to her camphorwood chest, and extracting a pink silk dress
- trimmed with yellow lace, for me to sleep in.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;I&rsquo;m afraid that won&rsquo;t do; it&rsquo;s too&mdash;too good to sleep in,&rdquo; I
- remarked.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Nothing too good for you, you too much good self!&rdquo; was the amiable reply.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;But I could not sleep in it, Tau. There&rsquo;s&mdash;there&rsquo;s too much of it,&rdquo;
- I objected, not knowing how to word my refusal without impoliteness.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;All right,&rdquo; commented my hostess, throwing a glance at the purple gloom
- of the torrid hot-season night outside. &ldquo;He plenty hot. I get you pareo,
- all same mine.&rdquo; And she disinterred a brief cotton kilt of red and yellow,
- considerably smaller than a Highlander&rsquo;s.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;That&rsquo;s too little,&rdquo; objected the exacting guest, rather to poor Tau&rsquo;s
- perplexity. How was one to please such a visitor? At last, however, after
- refusing a figured muslin robe that was as transparent as a dancing-robe
- of classic Ionia (there are other analogies between those robes, if one
- might go into the subject; but I fear the British public must not be told
- about them), and a pink shirt belonging to the white husband, a neat
- cotton day gown was discovered, offered, and accepted, and peace reigned
- once more in the exceedingly public guest-chamber of Tau Ariki&rsquo;s house.
- </p>
- <p>
- Concerning quilts, by the way, one may here add a short note. Patchwork is
- the delight of the Cook Island women, and has been so, ever since that
- absorbing pastime was first introduced to them by the missionaries&rsquo; wives.
- They are extremely clever at it, and often invent their own patterns.
- Sometimes, however, they copy any startling device that they may chance to
- see&mdash;the more original, the better. A really good patchwork quilt is
- considered a possession of great value, and (one is sorry to say) often
- preferred to the fine, beautifully hand-woven mats in which the islanders
- used to excel. They still make mats in large numbers, but the patchwork
- quilt has spoilt their taste for the finer mats, and these latter are
- getting scarce.
- </p>
- <p>
- In the morning, shark-catching was the order of the day. Aitutaki is
- celebrated for this sport all over Australasia, and I was very glad to get
- a chance of joining in it. One does not catch sharks, in Aitutaki, after
- the usual island fashion, which is much like the way familiar to all
- sea-faring folk&mdash;hook and line, and a lump of bad pork, and tow the
- monster to the shore when you have got him. No, there is something more
- exciting in store for the visitor-who goes a-fishing in Aitutaki lagoon.
- The water is very shallow for the most part, and heats up quickly with the
- sun, especially when the day is dead calm, and there is not a ripple to
- break the force of the rays. By noon, the lagoon is unbearably warm in all
- the shallow parts, and the sharks which inhabit it in large numbers, begin
- to feel uncomfortable. Some of them make for the opening in the reef, and
- get out into the cooler sea beyond. Others, one will suppose, are lazy,
- and do not want to be troubled to swim so far. So they head for the coral
- patches here and there, and lie on the sand in the shelter of the rocks,
- their bodies thrust as far into the clefts and crannies of the coral as
- they can manage to get. This is the Aitutakian&rsquo;s opportunity. He is
- perfectly fearless in the water, and he knows that the shark is, after
- all, a stupid brute. So he arms himself with a knife, takes a strong rope,
- noosed in a slip-knot at one end, in his hand, and dives from his
- whale-boat into the warm green water, where he has marked the latter end
- of a shark sticking out from a patch of coral, some three or four fathoms
- underneath the surface.
- </p>
- <p>
- The shark, being head in, does not see anything, but by-and-by he becomes
- aware of a delicate tickling all along his massive ribs, and as he rather
- likes this, he stays-quite still, and enjoys it. It is the Aitutakian,
- tickling him as boys tickle a trout in a stream at home, and for exactly
- the same reason. He has got the noose in his left hand, and his aim is to
- slip it over the shark&rsquo;s tail, while he distracts the brute&rsquo;s attention by
- pleasantly tickling with the other hand. Perhaps he manages this at the
- first attempt&mdash;perhaps he is obliged to rise to the surface, and take
- a breath of air, going down again to have a second try. But, in any case,
- he is pretty sure to get the noose on before the shark suspects anything.
- Once that is accomplished, he rises to the surface like a shooting
- air-bubble, swings himself into the boat, and gives the order to &ldquo;haul
- in!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- The men in the boat lay hold of the rope, tighten with a sharp jerk, and
- tail on. Now the shark begins to realise that something has happened; and
- realises it still more fully in another minute or two, when he finds
- himself fighting for his life on the gunwale of a rocking boat, against
- half a dozen islanders armed with knives and axes. The battle is short the
- great brute is soon disabled by a smashing blow on the tail, and in
- another hour or two the village is feeding fat on his meat, and his fins
- are drying in the sun, to be sold to the trader by-and-by, for export to
- China. No dinner-party in China is complete without a dish of daintily
- dressed shark&rsquo;s fins, and a good proportion of the supply comes from the
- Pacific.
- </p>
- <p>
- This is shark-fishing, as practised in Aitutaki. But I was not destined to
- see it at its best, for the day turned out breezy, and there was such a
- ripple, upon the water that the natives declared the sharks would be
- extremely difficult to see or capture. Nevertheless, the captain and I
- decided to go, as there was a chance, though a faint one. We hired a boat,
- and took with us, as well as the rowers, Oki, a diver of renown. If Oki
- could not raise a shark for us, it was certain that no one could.
- </p>
- <p>
- The captain of the missionary steamer <i>John Williams</i> had told me
- about the fishing some weeks before, and added that he had seen a shark
- caught himself, and tried to photograph it, but the photo was not a
- success, because, as he put it, &ldquo;the shark moved!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- This story wandered about in my mind as we shot across the lagoon to the
- fishing grounds, and the boat began to look uncomfortably small. &ldquo;What
- does the shark do when you get it in the boat?&rdquo; I inquired rather
- anxiously.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Makes the devil of a row, and the devil of a mess,&rdquo; said our own captain
- cheerfully. &ldquo;But don&rsquo;t you mind him. Let sharks alone, and they&rsquo;ll let you
- alone; that&rsquo;s always been my experience.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- Conscious that I was never unkind to animals, not even tigers or sharks, I
- tried to feel at ease. But I did not quite succeed, until we got to the
- coral beds, and Oki put everything else out of my head by going head first
- overboard, and starting out among the rocks below (it was calmer here, and
- we could see him pretty plainly) to look for a shark.
- </p>
- <p>
- His thin brown body showed up shadowy and wavering, upon the sands at the
- bottom, as he glided like a fish all along the patch of reef, inspecting
- every cave or crack where a shark might hide. He did not seem to be
- incommoded in the least by the three or four fathoms of water above him,
- but moved about as quietly and easily as if he had been swimming on the
- surface. I felt sure he must be at the point of death, as the seconds flew
- by, and he still glided in and out of the rocks with nothing but the gleam
- of his white pareo to show his whereabouts, whenever he slipped into the
- shadow of one of the many clefts in which a shark might lie hidden. But
- Oki knew very well what he was about, and he did not seem at all exhausted
- when he shot to the surface again, after rather more than two minutes&rsquo;
- absence, and told us gloomily that &ldquo;No shark stop!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- We tried again, and again. Oki took the slip knot down with him every time
- and every time he brought it up in his hand, unused. Melancholy, deep and
- silent, settled upon the boat. But at last the luck changed; our diver
- came up, and announced with a smile, that there was a shark down there,
- very far into the coral, and if he could only reach the animal&rsquo;s tail, it
- would be all right.
- </p>
- <p>
- One of the boatmen at this went to help him, and together they swam down
- to the bottom, and began fumbling interminably in the shadow. It was clear
- that they were making every effort to tempt the shark out, for one could
- see Oki straining wildly with his arm in the cleft, &ldquo;tickling&rdquo;
- industriously, while the other hovered head downwards outside, trailing
- the noose like a loop of seaweed in his hand. But all proved vain.
- Exhausted, the men rose at last, and gave it up. The shark was too far in,
- they said, and the noose could not be got on. If we remembered, they had
- told us it was not a good day, and they hoped we thought enough had been
- done. As for themselves, they were very tired doing our pleasure, and
- their lungs were sore, but they thought some plug tobacco&mdash;the black,
- sticky kind, and a good deal of it&mdash;would set them all right again.
- </p>
- <p>
- This was outside the letter of the agreement, which had included a good
- price for the boat and nothing else; but we promised some tobacco, when
- the stores should be reached, and asked for some more particulars about
- the fishing.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Do you ever find the shark head out, instead of tail out?&rdquo; I queried.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Yes, sometime he come head out,&rdquo; said Oki, reversing a green cocoanut on
- his nose, and swallowing in great gulps.
- </p>
- <p>
- I waited till he had finished before I asked: &ldquo;What happens then?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Shark he fight, and we fight too,&rdquo; said Oki simply.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;And which wins?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;All the time the Aitutaki boy he win, but sometime the shark he win too,&rdquo;
- was the cryptic reply.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <p>
- Shark fins, I was told, sell for about six shillings a pound. Some of the
- traders in the islands further north, where sharks are abundant, make a
- good deal of money taking the fish on a hook and line, and drying the fins
- for sale. It should be a fairly profitable industry, as the fins of a
- medium shark appear to weigh a good deal&mdash;not less than three or four
- pounds, at a guess.
- </p>
- <p>
- It was on my second visit to Aitutaki that I went out to the lesser
- islands of the lagoon; but the tale of that expedition may well come here.
- </p>
- <p>
- These islets are of various sizes, from a mere rock with a couple of palms
- on it, to a fertile piece of land over a mile long, richly grown and
- wooded. They all lie within the great lagoon, and are therefore sheltered
- by a natural breakwater of the reef from the violence of the storms that
- occur in the rainy season. The nearest is about three miles from the
- mainland. All are quite uninhabited, and no particular value is set on
- them by anybody. They belong to the various chief families of the big
- island, but any one who wished to rent one in perpetuity (the New Zealand
- Government laws, which rule here, do not permit outright sale) could
- probably secure it for a few pounds a year.
- </p>
- <p>
- I was anxious to see them, for it seemed to me that islands suited to the
- realisation of Robinson Crusoe dreams could hardly be found the wide
- Pacific over. A desolate isle five hundred miles from anywhere, sounds
- well in a story, but the romance of such a spot is apt to wear very thin
- indeed after a few months, if one may believe the experiences of those who
- have tried it. Practical details are seldom considered by would-be
- Crusoes; they have, however, a knack of thrusting themselves into the
- foreground just when retreat is impossible. If you elect to live on a
- remote island, how are you going to keep up communication with the outer
- world? You will want at least a few commodities of civilisation from time
- to time, and they cannot swim across half the great South Seas, from
- Auckland or &rsquo;Frisco, up to your front verandah unaided. You will
- want mails, newspapers, and letters, unless haply you are a criminal
- flying from the near neighbourhood of the black cap and the drop&mdash;and
- how are these to come? Trading schooners will not call at your island
- unless you have plenty of cargo for them, and even then, you may not see
- them twice a year. Steamers, of course, you must not expect. If you keep a
- small vessel of your own, you must be thoroughly sea-trained to run and
- navigate her, and you will need to bring a few island men to your kingdom
- as crew, and they will want to go home again, and make trouble, and
- finally run off with your ship some dark night, and maroon you there for
- good. No, the &ldquo;desert&rdquo; island idea is best left to the shelves of the
- school library.
- </p>
- <p>
- But at Aitutaki, and in some similar collections of atoll islands Robinson
- Crusoe&rsquo;s way is made easy and pleasant&mdash;or so it seemed to me,
- crossing the lagoon that afternoon on my way to the islets that were lying
- waste and uninhabited out on its broad expanse. From three to five miles
- away from the mainland, these islets are sufficiently isolated for any one
- who has not quarrelled with the whole human race. There is a steamer once
- a month, at the little pier near the settlement. There are one or two
- stores on the main island, where common provisions, cotton stuffs, spades,
- and knives, and such simple things, can be purchased. The lagoon is
- usually so calm that a native canoe would serve all ordinary needs of
- communication, for any one living on an islet. A house could be built in a
- few days, of the native type: and a good concrete bungalow could be put up
- with native help, in a very few weeks. Why should any one want to live in
- such a spot? Well, it is not necessary to argue out that question, because
- I have found by experience that quite a remarkable number of people do. It
- was for those people that I crossed the lagoon that day, and I know I
- shall have their thanks.
- </p>
- <p>
- A whale-boat and a crew were necessary for the trip. I engaged both in the
- village, and went down to the wharf followed by a &ldquo;tail&rdquo; of seven stalwart
- islanders, dressed in white and crimson pareos, berry necklaces, and a
- curiously representative collection of steamship caps and jerseys. The
- Aitutakian is an inveterate traveller, and all these men had been away in
- a steamer somewhere as deck hands&mdash;or else their friends had, and
- they had begged a steamer cap and jersey or two here and there: it was all
- the same to them. The P. &amp; O.&mdash;the Union S.S. Co. of New Zealand&mdash;the
- Shaw, Savill, and Albion&mdash;the Orient&mdash;Burns Philp&mdash;were all
- represented (so far as caps and jerseys went) by my boat&rsquo;s crew, and very
- well pleased with themselves and their poached attire they evidently were.
- </p>
- <p>
- Provisions had to be purchased, they declared, as we should not be back
- before afternoon. So into the big store the whole party went to see me
- victual the ship. I bought biscuits and meat, exactly half what they
- asked, and they were so uplifted with joy at the amount of the supplies
- that they sang all the way down to the boat; and, once in it, treated me
- to an exhibition of rowing, the like of which I never expect to see again.
- The Aitutaki man is the smartest boatman, and the best hand with an oar,
- in the Southern Pacific. Never a man-of-war comes round the Cook group
- that her men do not try conclusions with the Aitutakians, and if report
- speaks truth, the result is not always flattering to British pride. Nor is
- this astonishing, to any one who has seen these islanders row. We had six
- miles of a pull, and every inch was against a strong head wind, and
- through a decidedly choppy sea. Yet, in spite of these handicaps, the men
- rowed the whole way at racing pace, oars springing, spray flying, the
- great whale-boat tearing through the water as though a mortal enemy were
- in pursuit. The coxswain, in the stern, kept slyly urging the rowers on to
- let the foreign woman see what they could do, and they pulled &ldquo;all out&rdquo;&mdash;or
- what looked extremely like it&mdash;from start to finish. I do not think
- any white crew that ever held an oar could have lived with that splendid
- six-mile rush. And when we neared the first island and gradually slacked
- speed, there was not one among those seven mighty chests that heaved
- faster than at the start. Truly, I thought, they had earned their picnic.
- </p>
- <p>
- But the islets! If Raratonga was the realisation of a childish dream, this
- was the embodiment of a vision of fairyland. There can surely be nothing
- on earth more lovely than the islet constellation enclosed by Aitutaki
- reef. The water, shallow, sun-jewelled, and spread out over a bed of
- spotless coral sand, is coloured with a brilliance that is simply
- incredible. Emerald and jade and sapphire&mdash;yes, one expects these, in
- the hues of tropic seas. But when it comes to whole tracts of glancing
- heliotrope and hyacinth, shot with unnamable shades of melted turquoise
- and silver, and all a-quiver with pulsations of flashing greens, for which
- there is no name in any language under the pallid northern or burning
- southern sun&mdash;then, the thing becomes indescribable, and one can only
- say:
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;There is something in that little corner of earth beyond the touch of
- words, so you will never know anything about it, unless you too go there,
- and see it for yourself. And when you have seen, you will come away
- burning to describe, as I was&mdash;but you will not be able.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- In the midst of this magical sea, rise the islets themselves&mdash;fairyland
- every one. Their little beaches are sparkling white, as only a coral beach
- can be; palm-trees, heavyheaded with their loads of huge green nuts,
- cluster thick along the shores; coral-trees drop their blood-red flowers
- into the glass-like water of the lagoon; ripe oranges swing their glowing
- lamps among the darker green of the woods that rise behind. Big white
- clams with goffered shells, each holding meat enough for one man&rsquo;s dinner,
- gleam along the edges of the shore; large, long-legged crabs wander
- rustling and rattling among the stones. The murmur of the barrier reef is
- very far away; its thin white line of foam gleams out a long way off,
- under a low horizon, sky shot strangely with lilac blue&mdash;a lonely,
- lovely, exquisite place, the like of which one might seek the world all
- over, and never find again.
- </p>
- <p>
- We landed on the sand, and I set about exploring, while the men knocked
- down cocoanuts, and squatted in the shade to drink them, and suck fresh
- oranges. The island on which we had landed was one of the smaller ones,
- not more than an acre or two in extent. It rose to a high point in the
- centre, and was so thickly wooded all over, that I could hardly make my
- way through. There was no sign of life or habitation, and the ripe fruit
- was everywhere rotting on the ground.
- </p>
- <p>
- I pictured the little islet with a high brown roof peeping out among its
- palms, a neatly kept pathway cut through the bush, and a snug boathouse on
- the shore, covering a fine whaleboat, while a graceful native canoe lay on
- the sand, ready for any one to lift down into the water at any minute. I
- wonder, will the picture ever body itself out in real, for some tired-out
- soul, weary of cities and competition, or some pair of lovers, who find
- the world well lost in each other, here among the far islands of the sweet
- Southern Seas? I shall never know, for the &ldquo;sea-bird&rsquo;s feather&rdquo; was in the
- pillow on which I slept my first baby sleep, and I wander always on. But
- it may be that these words will be read by some to whom they are, or shall
- be, a part of fife&rsquo;s own history.
- </p>
- <p>
- We did not get to the other islands that day, partly because I wasted so
- much time looking for shells, and partly because the largest were still
- some miles away, and the wind was stronger than ever. One, I heard, had
- ground enough for a paying plantation, and was already fairly well
- supplied with cocoanuts. All are perfectly healthy and free from fevers of
- any kind, and though mosquitoes are present in rather large numbers,
- careful clearing of their breeding grounds would in time drive them away.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <p>
- In case author, or publishers, should be inundated with inquiries about
- South Sea Islands, it may be as well to say that all over the Pacific, the
- Governors, Commissioners, and Resident Agents of the various groups are
- always ready to furnish information to honest inquirers.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0008" id="link2HCH0008"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER VIII
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>Jumping a Coral Reef&mdash;The Great Wall of the Makatea&mdash;Makaia&rsquo;s
- Wonderful Staircases&mdash;A Clothing Club of the Pacific&mdash;Cool
- Costumes in Atiu&mdash;The Lands that lie waste&mdash;Mystery of a
- Vanished Tribe&mdash;Fashions in Hair-Dressing&mdash;The Sign-Language of
- the Sex&mdash;Invited to a Feast.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">M</span>ANGAIA, where we
- next stopped, proved quite an exciting place. You cannot land upon Mangaia
- in the ordinary way: the reef that surrounds it is unbroken, and girdles
- the whole island in a fortress moat of its own. The only way to land is to
- get into one of the numberless native canoes that crowd about the ship,
- and let the copper-coloured owner take you over the reef in his own way,
- which is the determined and decisive way of a steeplechaser at a fence. It
- is most excellent fun and a new thing in sensations. As the little dug-out&mdash;made
- of nothing more elaborate than a hollowed mango log, with an outrigger at
- one side&mdash;rushes shoreward on the crest of a foaming roller, you
- watch with rather anxious interest the movements of the dusky boatman, who
- poises his paddle in the air, waits, looks, and strikes the water, always
- at exactly the right moment&mdash;usually when you are just beginning to
- think of kicking off your shoes.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is the reef right in front, a pearly shadow in the blue, with
- up-springing spears of ivory, bared like the teeth of a tiger, when the
- wave rolls back. Are we going to jump that? We are indeed. The boatman
- lifts his paddle&mdash;we sweep upwards on the sloping blue satin neck of
- a curling wave. No no, that will not do&mdash;not this time. He backs
- water&mdash;we hang on the crest of the wave&mdash;but we are not going to
- be drowned, or snapped up by the sharks that haunt the reefs, because the
- boatman is a born islander, and what he does not know about canoeing over
- a reef, neither you nor I need attempt to teach him. Another wave, a
- monster this time, swinging us up into the air as if we were a couple of
- grasshoppers out paddling in a walnut shell. That will do: here she goes!
- The wave roars with us; the wicked white fangs gleam on either hand: our
- rough thick keel scrapes agonisingly on the coral, and there is a smother
- of foam and tumbling blue and bursting green all about the cranky little
- craft. Bump! we have struck&mdash;we strike again, but it does not seem to
- matter in the least: over we go, and we are in the smooth, safe, shallow
- green water inside, and across the reef. And here are a dozen men of
- Mangaia, splashing&rsquo; about in the lagoon, ready to pick up the visitor in
- their powerful arms as soon as the canoe grounds in the shallow* water,
- and carry her ashore.
- </p>
- <p>
- That is how one lands on Mangaia.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0023" id="linkimage-0023"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0209.jpg" alt="0209 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0209.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- This island is of a good size, being some thirty mile» in circumference.
- Its formation is very notable, being indeed rather celebrated among
- geologists. It is supposed to be of volcanic origin, like most of the
- &ldquo;high&rdquo; islands. From the sea, it looks much like any other place of the
- same size. But, going inland, one is astonished to find that a mere strip
- of land close round the coast terminates the ground available for walking
- on. A high irregular cliff wall, from fifty to a hundred feet in height,
- encloses the whole interior of the island, which thus resembles in shape a
- very large cup set on a very small saucer. Within the cup lie all fertile
- lands, the taro beds, the yam fields, the pineapple patches, the tangled
- bush, where cotton used to be grown in the days of the American war, the
- low green shrubberies that produce the finest coffee in the Cook Islands.
- To reach them, there is only one way&mdash;that furnished by a really
- wonderful rocky staircase, built in prehistoric times by the ancestors of
- the present natives. If one were to find such a work in any other of the
- Cook Islands one might regard it as proof positive of the existence of an
- older and more industrious race, in the days before the New Zealand Maori
- took possession of these lands, and grew effeminate and idle in the
- occupying.
- </p>
- <p>
- But the people of Mangaia, though identical in descent with incurably
- indolent and sensual Aitutakians and Raratongans, have been moulded by
- their environment to a degree that amounts to an actual difference in
- character. The barrier reef has always prevented the free communication
- enjoyed by other islands, so that they were able to develop along their
- own lines of character, without modification from outside. With an island
- that possessed only a limited amount of fertile land, a matchless fortress
- in the interior, and a complete barrier about the exterior, it was a
- foregone conclusion that the Mangaians should become inhospitable,
- reserved, and hard-working, as compared with the prodigally generous and
- idle folk of the open and fertile islands. They did so. In the days before
- the missions, some sixty years ago, the Mangaians were the fiercest
- cannibals in the group, and determinedly hostile to strangers: nor were
- they ever as pleasure-loving as the other Cook Islanders. To-day they are
- harder in character than the folk of the other islands; kindly to
- strangers, but hardly gushing in their reception of them, and so much more
- industrious than the Aitutakians or Raratongans that Mangaian men are
- sought as servants all over the group.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is, therefore, no difficulty in understanding how the people of
- Mangaia found energy and time to construct the staircases that span the
- great wall of &ldquo;Makatea,&rdquo; enclosing the inner part of the island. Being
- obliged day after day to climb with infinite pains the sharp rocky heights
- of the cliff, in order to get from the fishing grounds to the plantations,
- they would certainly not be long in devising some means of lessening this
- inconvenience. The staircases which are the result must have taken many
- years and much labour in constructing, and it is difficult to understand
- how a people unacquainted with the use of any mechanical contrivance could
- have placed so many large blocks of stone in the positions which they
- occupy. The steps are very high and irregular, and on an extremely torrid
- afternoon it is not exactly the walk one would choose for pure enjoyment.
- However, our time in Mangaia was short, so I explained to a native girl
- that I wanted to see the Makatea, and she at once called up half the
- village to join the procession.
- </p>
- <p>
- Attended, therefore, by my young guide and the inevitable following, I
- went up the mighty stairs, and across the tract of level land lying at the
- top. It is nearly a mile before one comes upon the cup-like valley in the
- centre of the island, so it must be allowed that the rim of the cup is a
- thick one. After a pleasant walk through groves of cocoanut and guava, we
- came upon the inner side of the wall, and stood on the edge of a great
- grey circular cliff, spiked, spired, and towered with extraordinary
- eccentricity, and splendidly garlanded with falling masses of sea-green
- creeper. At one point, a huge split in the rock had evidently provided a
- foundation for the second staircase, which was rougher than the first,
- made of great blocks of stone irregularly laid here and there so as to
- fill up the split in part, and give a foothold to the climber. Still, it
- was a big piece of work, and must have taken a good many years&mdash;generations,
- perhaps&mdash;to complete. Down in the valley below, which seemed to be
- two or three miles across, were all the native plantations and gardens,
- and as we jumped down from block to block, we met hard-faced muscular
- women toiling upwards with heavy loads of vegetables and fruit. In the
- taro fields, terraced so as to let a little stream trickle through and
- create an artificial swamp, the workers seemed to be women only. They dug
- and scraped in the thick mud under the burning sun, leaving off their
- tasks long enough to stare and question a little, and then setting
- stolidly to work again. The men were probably out fishing or pigeon
- shooting. In spite of Christianity, the island woman always carries the
- heavy end of the load, where there is one to carry; the man is the hunter,
- the woman the labourer and beast of burden, as in the cannibal times of
- long ago.
- </p>
- <p>
- There are some remarkable caves in the island, and I went into them for a
- mile or so, in company with the local missionary, who kindly offered to
- act as guide.
- </p>
- <p>
- Caves, however&mdash;as most people will allow&mdash;are much alike in all
- parts of the earth, and there is nothing to differentiate the long, dark,
- dripping passages, half-glimpsed halls, gloomy crevasses, and dimly
- sparkling stalactite candelabra of a South Sea Island cave, from those of
- a cave near Brighton or the Land&rsquo;s End. There is no need, therefore, to
- describe the caves of Mangaia further than to say that they were quite up
- to the usual pattern, and that at all events, they gave a touch of &ldquo;Swiss
- Family Robinson&rdquo; to the island atmosphere that was pleasing to the
- imagination.
- </p>
- <p>
- It had, of course, nothing to do with Mangaia, but I wondered as we walked
- back from the caves towards the top of Makatea, how it was that the
- interesting shipwrecked people who live in caves as described in fiction,
- never seem to be troubled with damp? I have, personally, never seen a cave&mdash;out
- of a book&mdash;that was not first cousin to a showerbath, and I should be
- surprised if any One else had. Who ever saw a genuine cave roof that was
- not covered with stalactites, large or small? and what makes stalactites
- but endless drip? If I were a shipwrecked person, I should certainly
- prefer the temporary house the &ldquo;useful&rdquo; character always puts up in half
- an hour with the aid of four growing trees and the ship&rsquo;s mainsail, to the
- cave that is invariably discovered in the second chapter. I should know
- for certain that the former was the driest&mdash;even when it rained.
- </p>
- <p>
- I cannot leave the subject of the strange Makatea, without telling yet a
- little more about it, for it has not often been described or mentioned.
- Geologists say that it is the product of a double volcanic upheaval. The
- first convulsion threw up the island itself, and, in the course of ages,
- the usual encircling reef of coral was built up round it by the busy coral
- insects, working under the water. Then came a second upheaval, and the
- island and reef together were cast up two hundred feet. The Makatea is
- thus the ancient reef that once surrounded the original small island which
- is represented by a crown of heights in the middle of the cup of the
- crater, and by the sunk-down valley about it. The narrow strip of land
- that edges the beach to-day is a later formation.
- </p>
- <p>
- One cannot mistake the character of the great coral cliff, which is quite
- unlike any kind of stone, or indeed anything but itself. The passing ages
- have turned it to rock, but to rock which is hollowed in every direction
- with caves, small and great, and filled with fossil shells as a pudding is
- filled with plums. No unprotected foot can tread the surface of these
- heights, which are simply a mass of serried grey spears, sharp and cruel
- as the top of a wall protected by broken glass. The natives, if
- convenience leads them to cross any part of the Makatea other than the
- staircases, usually protect their feet with thick sandals of woven coir
- fastened on with cords. One can imagine how much this peculiar protection
- must have added to the safety of the interior of the island, in the old
- predatory days.
- </p>
- <p>
- The caves were often used for burying places in time gone by, and it is
- only a few years since a &ldquo;find&rdquo; of skulls of a type differing in several
- particulars from those of the present day, was made in one of the largest
- caves by a schooner captain. Rumour says that he sold them for a good
- price, but the purchasers were not known.
- </p>
- <p>
- Another use of the coral caves in the old days (over fifty years ago) was
- a shelter for fugitives of various kinds. The Mangaians were not a
- pleasant people, in those times, either to strangers or each other. The
- outsider was cooked and eaten for the mere offence of presuming to exist.
- The Mangaian was never sure that some one who had a spite against him
- would not murder him&mdash;probably by poison, in the use of which these
- people were as expert as the Borgias themselves. Under these
- circumstances, the caves were never without their occupants, living in
- secret, and creeping out at night to pick up a little food. Many and
- romantic are the stories told by the missionaries and traders of these
- stirring times, if I had space to relate them.
- </p>
- <p>
- Mangaia is a beautiful island, but that goes without saying, in the
- exquisite Cook Group. It has about half a dozen white people, and the
- native population is said to number something under two thousand.
- </p>
- <p>
- Though a pleasant island and a healthy one, it cannot be recommended to
- planters, as there is not an inch of land available for rent. The natives
- themselves are keen traders and bargainers, and export much of their fruit
- and copra direct to Auckland. Most of what they make is spent in
- trade-finery, for which they have an uncontrollable passion. On Sundays,
- the churches are a very flower-garden of frippery, the men turning out in
- the most brilliant of shirts, ties, and suits, the women decking
- themselves in long loose robes of muslin, sateen, or cheap silk, coloured
- in the most screaming hues&mdash;pea-green, royal blue, scarlet, and
- orange being all strong favourites. Their hats, made by themselves out of
- silky arrowroot fibre, are often trimmed with the costliest ribbons and
- artificial flowers, and even with ostrich plumes to the value of two or
- three pounds. It is somewhat puzzling, I was told, to see several entire
- families got up in the same extraordinary style, unless you know the
- reason, which is, that these various households have joined together in a
- club, putting all the money they have made into one purse, and sending it
- down to Auckland on their own account for a bale of gorgeous clothing, all
- alike. Thus you will see twenty or thirty women, on a Sunday morning,
- dressed alike in robes of vermilion satinette, and wearing huge hats,
- crowned by three ostrich feathers, red, yellow, and blue, arranged after
- the fashion of the Prince of Wales&rsquo;s crest.
- </p>
- <p>
- This is one of the clubs, and there are sure to be others that vie with
- them in startling attire. Such are the weaknesses&mdash;after all, venial
- ones indeed&mdash;of the sturdy-souled Mangaian.
- </p>
- <p>
- Atiu was our next stop, and here the reef-jumping process had to be
- repeated in another form. The ship&rsquo;s whale-boat, steered by our captain,
- who was the cleverest hand at the big sixteen-foot steer-oar of any white
- man I have ever seen, approached the edge of the reef, and danced about in
- front of it, until the passengers found an opportunity of leaping out on
- to it. Then, rather wetfooted (but no one minded that, in a temperature
- like the hot room of a Turkish bath) we were picked up by natives waiting
- on the shallow side, and carried through the lagoon, which was not more
- than a foot or two deep.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0024" id="linkimage-0024"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0217.jpg" alt="0217 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0217.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- On landing, we found a number of the men standing on the shore ready to
- receive the Commissioner. They had been fishing, and were clad simply and
- coolly in a rag and a feather apiece&mdash;the latter worn in the hair,
- over one ear. Their dress, however, did not seem to embarrass them at all,
- and they came forward and shook hands with every one,&rsquo; quite politely. All
- the Cook islanders are supposed to be Christianised and civilised, but in
- some parts of the group the civilisation, at all events, seems to be
- wearing very thin, and this is notably the case in Atiu, an island rather
- larger than Raratonga, which has no resident missionary, save a very
- conceited and upsetting young native teacher. The Atiuans were of old a
- wilder and fiercer race than even the Mangaians, and such determined
- cannibals that they used to make raids on the surrounding islands for the
- simple purpose of filling their cooking ovens, and enjoying a mighty
- feast. Great war canoes, laden with gory corpses, have many a time been&rsquo;
- drawn up on the very stretch of sand where we landed, and the grandfathers
- of the men who greeted us have sung and danced in fierce exultation to see
- the fat limbs and well-fed bodies of their enemies laid in ghastly heaps
- upon the snowy beach, ready for the cooking pits that since early morning
- had been glowing with flame in anticipation of the banquet.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Meek-faced Atiuans&rdquo; was the nickname bestowed upon these islanders, in
- derision, by those who knew their wiliness and treachery. There is not
- much that is meekfaced about them to-day. They certainly look rougher and
- less amiable than any others of the Cook Islanders, and they are by no
- means so amiable and easy-going as the Raratongans, Aitutakians, and
- people of Mitiaro and Mauke. However, it cannot be said that they are in
- any way dangerous, and the stray white people who have lived in the island
- (there was only one at the time of my visit) have always got on well with
- them. Rough, as I said before, they certainly are. A ring I wore on my
- hand attracted the attention of one or two of the men, and they crowded
- round, fingered it, and actually tried to snatch&mdash;an attempt very
- shortly put an end to by the Commissioner, who ordered them off
- peremptorily. The incident, although small, illustrates a standard of
- manners that one would certainly not encounter in any other part of the
- group, or indeed in any one of the Southern or Eastern Pacific groups that
- I afterwards saw.
- </p>
- <p>
- There was a good deal of native-manufactured lime-juice to be got away
- here, and the people (most of them more completely dressed than the party
- that had received us on the shore) were busy rolling down the casks into
- the water, where the out-going tide took them, and floated them across the
- reef to the schooner. It seemed a strange way of taking on cargo, but I
- learned, afterwards, that it is not uncommon in islands surrounded by a
- dangerous reef.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0025" id="linkimage-0025"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0225.jpg" alt="0225 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0225.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- The walk up to the settlement proved to be a good three miles, Atiu being
- one of the very few islands whose natives do not live down on the shore.
- The scenery was fine&mdash;wide rich plains covered with low scrub, or
- clothed with thick herbage, alternating with heavy forest. There is no
- better soil in the islands than that of Atiu. Guavas are a common weed;
- pumpkins run wild, trailing their long green vines and heavy fruit right
- across the track, mangoes, chestnuts, Pacific cherries, and othér fruits,
- grow without care or cultivation. Any tropical product can be raised, and
- land is exceedingly cheap. The reef has always been a handicap to the
- island; but I heard that a part had been blown up to admit of a boat
- passage, some time after my visit, also that the Union steamers had begun
- to call for cargoes&mdash;an important event in the history of any island,
- and one likely to do much for its future.
- </p>
- <p>
- The people are few in number&mdash;only nine hundred&mdash;and do not
- attempt to use more than a very small portion of the thirty-two square
- miles of their territory. Much is available for letting, and every inch of
- the island is worth cultivating, although to a stranger&rsquo;s eye it is hardly
- as fertile in appearance as other portions of the Cook Group that are much
- less valuable. Coffee, copra, oranges, bananas, sweet potatoes, could be
- profitably grown for export. The climate is good and healthy.
- </p>
- <p>
- The people have not dwindled down to their present small numbers through
- natural decay. Like another more famous island, Atiu is &ldquo;swarming with
- absentees.&rdquo; In the Society Islands, and here and there in other groups,
- whole villages full of Atiuans are to-day to be seen, who emigrated from
- their native country twenty or thirty years ago, owing to difficulties
- with the missionaries, and went to seek an asylum in lands where strings
- were drawn somewhat less tightly than they were at home. They never
- returned, though the island, when I saw it, had no resident white
- missionary at all, and in consequence their lands have lain idle ever
- since. The ill wind has blown good to planters and settlers, however, so
- one need not quarrel with it.
- </p>
- <p>
- Like Mangaia, Atiu has a cave&mdash;only a much larger one, and it has a
- mystery connected with the cave, which no one has yet attempted to solve.
- </p>
- <p>
- Sixty years ago or more (I was told&mdash;I do not swear to the truth of
- this or any other island story that I have not had the opportunity of
- investigating in person), an invading tribe came to Atiu, and in the
- course of several battles, defeated and put to rout one of the lesser
- tribes of the island. The vanquished ones, fearing that they would be
- killed and eaten, plucked up courage to try a desperate expedient, and hid
- themselves in the cave, into whose dark recesses no native had ever before
- ventured, for fear of offending the evil spirits that were said to live
- therein. After waiting for a day or two, the enemies gave up the contest,
- and went away again. It was now safe for the hunted tribe to come forth,
- and the other inhabitants of the island looked to see them return&mdash;for
- after all, it did not seem likely that the evil spirits would destroy so
- many. They waited in vain. From the unknown depths of the cave&mdash;unknown,
- in its innermost recesses, to the present day&mdash;no sign, no message
- reached them; no living soul ever came forth of the many men, women, and
- children who had braved the dangers of that dark portal. Lost they were,
- lost they remained.
- </p>
- <p>
- What happened to them? No one knows. It is not easy to destroy a whole
- tribe, and leave no sign. But the one white man who partly explored the
- cave some years ago, found nothing to hint at the nature of the tragedy.
- It is true that his candles gave out, and the cord that served him for a
- guide back among the endless windings of the place came to an end, so that
- he never knew quite how far the place went, or how many ramifications it
- had. Still, it is strange enough that not so much as a single human bone
- was to be seen. If the tribe had lost their way, and perished of hunger,
- some traces would certainly have been visible&mdash;a spear, a shell
- ornament, perhaps a skeleton. If they had fallen in a body over some
- treacherous inner precipice, the dangerous place would have been
- discoverable. Perhaps some new explorer will unravel the mystery, one of
- these days. It will not be a steamer passenger, however, for the Union
- boats on their rare calls do not stay long enough for any one to land, and
- the cave requires two clear days to reach and see.
- </p>
- <p>
- As we were not even stopping overnight ourselves, I had no opportunity of
- making an exploration on my own account. Thus the mystery rests unsolved&mdash;unless
- some one may have come to the island in a stray trading schooner since my
- visit, and found time enough to explore the unknown parts of the haunted
- cavern. The natives of Atiu, needless to say, put down the whole thing
- simply and solely to the revenge of the &ldquo;local demons.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- The people of the settlement, when we reached it, greeted our party with
- boisterous cheerfulness. The officials went to hold their court, as usual,
- and I, being as usual quite uninterested in the details of native boundary
- disputes conducted in an unknown tongue, amused myself with the women of
- the village. It might be more correct to say that they amused themselves
- with me. I do not think any white woman had been up to the settlement
- before I visited it, and the curiosity of the girls was uncontrollable.
- They crowded round me, they slyly felt my hair to see if the coils were
- attached to my head in Nature&rsquo;s own way (by which I conclude that the
- wearing of false hair is not unknown to themselves), they rubbed my dress
- material in their fingers, they poked me all over to see if I was real,
- and conducted such searching investigations into the quantity and style of
- my clothing, that I was obliged to speak to one or two as sharply as I
- knew how (the tongue was alien, but the tone was understood) and make them
- desist. Withal, they were not ill-natured, though certainly a little
- ill-mannered. They did not forget the duties of hospitality, but pressed
- fruit and cocoanut water on me, and one woman insisted on giving me a
- bottle full of honey to take away&mdash;a gift that was much appreciated
- by my fellow-passengers on the schooner, later on.
- </p>
- <p>
- I gratified them extremely by loosening the hair of one or two, and
- putting it up in the latest fashionable style, which proved so popular
- that the whole feminine half of the island set to hair-dressing at once,
- and before I left the island that day, a general and complete revolution
- in coiffure had taken place. We had a good deal of feminine talk among
- ourselves, before the men came out again: the fact that I did not know
- anything of the language, save perhaps half a dozen words, was no bar to a
- certain amount of thought-interchange. How was it done? Signs, for the
- most part: scraps, guesses, hints, stray native words made to do double
- and treble duty. Could I have talked to the husbands and brothers of the
- women in the same way? No, certainly not. All through my wanderings among
- the uncivilised folk of the island world, I was constantly interested and
- amused to see how quick the women were in the language of signs and
- makeshifts, how very uncomprehending the men. If I wanted to make a
- request of any kind, on an island where I did not know any of the
- language, I instinctively sought for a woman to interpret my signs for a
- boat, a guide, a trader&rsquo;s or missionary&rsquo;s house, and so forth; and found
- that the women understood, almost as surely as the men, under the same
- circumstances, did not. Psychologists may make what they like of the fact.
- Women, who have talked the &ldquo;sign-language&rdquo; to each other, many and many a
- time, over the innocent thick heads of their unsuspecting better-halves,
- friends, or brothers, will never doubt it. We are not as clever as men&mdash;let
- the equality brigade shriek if they like, &ldquo;it&rsquo;s as true as turnips is, as
- true as taxes&rdquo;&mdash;but neither are we as stupid. God forbid!
- </p>
- <p>
- I had practically the whole day to put in somehow, so, after the delights
- of hair-dressing had palled, and the afternoon was passing on, I accepted
- the invitation of a cheerful, though rather rough-looking pair of girls,
- whom I found crushing limes for lime juice in a very primitive sort of
- hand press, and followed them in to dinner in one of the native houses.
- </p>
- <p>
- There was a distinguished guest to be entertained&mdash;a woman of Atiu
- who had been away from the island with her husband for many months, and
- had now returned in the <i>Duchess</i>, quite civilised and chic and
- modern, with the up-to-dateness of far-away Auckland. This celebrity,
- regarded as a very Isabella Bird among the island women, scarce any of
- whom had ever seen the other side of their own reef, was seated on the
- mats when I entered, her legs folded under her, native fashion; not
- without evident discomfort, for the heels of very high-heeled, pointed
- boots are painful under such circumstances, and corsets laced to bursting
- point are absolutely deadly. Ritia&rsquo;s dark face was ominously empurpled,
- and perspiration due as much to agony as to the heat (which was
- undeniable) streamed over her forehead and down, her nose, from under the
- brim of her incredible picture hat. But pride upheld her, for who among
- the other women of the island owned such magnificent clothes?
- </p>
- <p>
- The people of the house received me with exultation. Now, the feast was
- indeed a gorgeous one, and the sea-green envy sure to be the lot of every
- housewife in settlement with whom I had not dined, shed additional lustre
- on the triumph. The food was just coming in as I entered and folded myself
- up on the mats&mdash;roast sucking-pig, smelling very good; a fat boiled
- fowl; some fish from the lagoon, baked like the pig in a ground oven, and
- done to a turn; arrowroot jelly; young green cocoanuts, with the meat
- still unset, clinging to the thin shell like transparent blanc-mange;
- breadfruit, smoking and floury; baked pumpkins; bananas, roasted in their
- skins; sweet potatoes; chestnuts. A large cocoanut, picked at the right
- stage for drinking, stood at each guest&rsquo;s right hand, and in the middle
- was a big bowl of milky cocoanut cream, into which each guest was supposed
- to dip his food as he ate.
- </p>
- <p>
- Plates there were none, but I have never thought clean, fresh, green
- leaves, a foot or two across, unpleasant substitutes for delf or china,
- which is handled and used by hundreds of eaters, and must be washed in
- greasy hot water at the end of every meal. There is a good deal to be said
- for the native custom, whether the point of view be that of convenience,
- cleanliness, or simple beauty.
- </p>
- <p>
- I, as the principal guest, was offered everything first, which obviated
- any unpleasantness that might have arisen from the entire absence of
- knives and forks. There is no hardship in eating with your fingers, if
- yours are the first to plunge into every dish, and you have your nice
- fresh leaf to yourself. The little pig I did not touch, because no one who
- has lived as much as a week in the islands will venture on native pork,
- good as it looks and smells. When an unfortunate beast is killed by
- strangulation, and never bled, and when you know that it has lived at its
- gipsy will, and fed more abominably than a land-crab, you are apt to find
- you are &ldquo;not hungry&rdquo; when its crackling little carcase comes to table in
- cerements of green leaves, and you ask for the breadfruit and the fish
- instead.
- </p>
- <p>
- The feast seemed likely to go on all afternoon, since no native thinks he
- has eaten enough, on such an occasion, until he is as gorged and as
- comatose as a stuffed anaconda. There is no obligation to stay longer than
- one likes, however, so I washed my hands and withdrew, as soon as it
- seemed good to me to do so.
- </p>
- <p>
- And by the way, if we of the civilised countries think that we invented
- fingerbowls, either in form, or in use, we are mistaken. The South Seas
- invented them, a few hundred years before we found out they were necessary
- to our own delicate refinement. A bowl full of water is handed round to
- every diner in a South Sea house. The water is from the river, pure and
- fresh; the bowl is of a mould more perfect than the most exquisite models
- of ancient Greece, delicately hued with pale brown in the inner part, and
- deep sienna brown outside. It is half a cocoanut shell&mdash;beautiful,
- useful, practically unbreakable, yet not of sufficient worth to prevent
- its being thrown away to-morrow and replaced by a fresh one from the
- nearest palm. Fresh plates and cups for one&rsquo;s food are a refinement that
- our refined civilisation has not attained to yet. You must go to savages
- to look for them.
- </p>
- <p>
- I thanked my hosts for their entertainment, in good English, when I left.
- They understood the words and tone almost as clearly as if I had spoken in
- their own language, and gave me a ringing salutation that followed me down
- the road. That a number of Atiuan men, coming up from the shore, burst out
- laughing when they saw me, and held on to each other in convulsions of
- merriment at the sight of my absurd white face and ridiculous clothes, did
- not detract from the real kindliness of the reception the island had given
- me. The manners of the Atiuan would certainly throw a Tahitian or a
- courtly Samoan into a fit; but for all that, he is not at bottom a bad
- sort, and could certainly be made something of with training.
- </p>
- <p>
- One of the Arikas of Atiu&mdash;a woman again: there seemed to be very few
- male chiefs in the islands&mdash;was pointed out to me as I went down to
- the shore, and I photographed her sitting in her chair. She looked
- dignified, and her long descent was visible in the pose of her small head,
- and the delicacy of her hands, but she did not possess much claim to
- beauty.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0026" id="linkimage-0026"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0249.jpg" alt="0249 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0249.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- The <i>Duchess</i> was standing off and on outside the reef when I came
- out on the beach again, and the barrels were merrily floating out, rolled
- down into the water by the hands of bu§y brown men and women. It was a
- pretty scene in the low yellow sunlight of the waning afternoon,&rsquo; and I
- carried it away with me, long after we had sailed; as a pleasant
- recollection of Atiu.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0009" id="link2HCH0009"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER IX
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>Islands and Adventures&mdash;What about the Missionary?&mdash;The Lotus
- Eaters&mdash;How to hunt the Robber-Crab&mdash;The Ship that would not
- sail&mdash;Proper Place of a Passenger&mdash;One Way to get wrecked&mdash;The
- Pirate and the Pearls.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">M</span>AUKE, Manuwai, and
- Takutea still remained to be seen, before the <i>Duchess</i> could spread
- her wings for Raratonga again. We sailed from one to another in the course
- of a few days. There was no hurry, and a day wasted here or there troubled
- none of us.
- </p>
- <p>
- Sometimes the &ldquo;trades,&rdquo; which are very fickle about here, came up and
- caught our towering canvas in a cool embrace; then the great hollows of
- the sails hummed with the music that the ocean wanderer loves, and the <i>Duchess</i>
- skimmed the rolling blue hills like a flying-fish. Sometimes the wind
- fell, and the booms swung and creaked lazily above the burning deck; then
- we trolled for albacore and bonito, shrieking with savage joy when our bit
- of long-desired fresh food came flapping and fighting over the rail; or we
- watched the crew hook devil-faced grey sharks, which, &ldquo;took charge&rdquo; of the
- deck when captured, hitting terrible blows with their tails, and snapping
- stout ropes with their savage teeth; or we got out boats, and rowed them
- for miles between the double furnaces of the blazing sun and the glowing
- sea, coming back to the ship scorched into cinders, stiff with exertion,
- but happy. At night the Southern Cross burned white in the velvet sky, and
- the coral rocks about the lagoons showed in shimmering pale blue
- underneath fifty feet or more of clear, moonlit water. Lying on the poop,
- like seals on sand, the little knot of passengers, captain, and mate,
- &ldquo;yarned&rdquo; for hour after hour&mdash;strange, wild tales of frontier life in
- new lands; of adventures in unknown seas; of fights, and more fights, and
- fights yet again&mdash;literature in the rough, a very gallery of vivid
- pictures wasted unseen... and yet, what should any man who had the rich
- reality care about its pale shadow, Story? &ldquo;Do you care much for reading?&rdquo;
- &ldquo;Well, no,&rdquo; answers the bare-footed officer lying with his head in a coil
- of rope; &ldquo;books aren&rsquo;t very interesting, are they?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- I, watching the mizzen truck swing among the stars, look back over the
- long, long trail&mdash;long both in distance and in time&mdash;that
- separates this small heaving deck in the midst of the tropic seas from the
- rush of the wintry Strand, Nights in islands of ill reputation, when I
- slept with &ldquo;one eye open&rdquo; and one hand within touch of my revolver (for
- there are incidents of my wanderings that I have not told, and only those
- who know the Eastern Pacific may guess at them); days when only a
- fifty-to-one chance kept the little schooner from piling her bones on a
- spouting coral reef in mid-ocean&mdash;rough fare, hard lodging, and long
- fatigue, sometimes, all to be &ldquo;eaten as helped,&rdquo; without comment or
- complaint, for that is the rule of island life&mdash;the pungent taste of
- danger, now and then, gratefully slaking some deep, half-conscious thirst
- derived from fiercer centuries; the sight of many lands and many peoples&mdash;these,
- and other pictures, painted themselves among the little gold stars swept
- by the rocking masts, as I lay^ remembering. I thought of the pile of
- untouched &ldquo;shockers&rdquo; in my cabin; of grey London and its pyramids of books
- and armies of writers; of the mirror that they hold up to life, and the
- &ldquo;magic web of colours gay&rdquo; they weave, always looking, like the Lady of
- Shalott, in the mirror, and seldom joining the merry rout outside, where
- no one cares a pin for coloured tapestries, and looking-glasses are left
- to half-grown girls. No, truly; &ldquo;books are not interesting,&rdquo; when you can
- have life instead.
- </p>
- <p>
- Upon which some one proposed &ldquo;Consequences&rdquo; in the cabin, and I made haste
- to climb down.
- </p>
- <p>
- Another day, gold and blue as are almost all the days of the &ldquo;winter&rdquo;
- season, and another island, burning white and blazing green, and another
- tumbling reef to jump, with the help of a powerful boat-holder, who stands
- in the midst of the surf, and drags the dinghy forward at the right
- moment. This is Mauke: we are getting on with the group, and begin to
- realise that some time or other, even in these timeless regions, will
- actually see us back at Raratonga.
- </p>
- <p>
- Mauke proves to be a pretty little place, some six miles in circumference,
- &ldquo;low&rdquo; in type, but park-like and gardenlike and dainty enough to wake
- covetous desires in the heart of almost any traveller. It has the finest
- oranges in the group&mdash;growing completely wild&mdash;and we are
- greeted on the shore by the usual crowd of flower-wreathed natives,
- bearing splendid branches of rich yellow fruit, which they present to
- every one with eager generosity. There are only three hundred and seventy
- natives in the island, and much of the land lies waste, though it is
- exceedingly fertile. The Mauke folk take things easy on the whole, and are
- not keen on trading. They export some oranges, some copra, a few bunches
- of dried bananas, and they buy a fair amount of cotton cloth, and shirts,
- and cutlery, from the white trader&rsquo;s store. But no one, so far, has grown
- fat on what Mauke makes or buys.
- </p>
- <p>
- There were, at the time of my visit, only one or two whites in the place.
- The greater portion of the land available for planting lay unused.
- Probable rents, on long leases, were quoted to me as a shilling or so an
- acre.
- </p>
- <p>
- The call at Mauke was short, and I saw little of the island. The natives
- insisted, however, that I should come up to the village and look at their
- church, of which they are very proud, so I headed the inevitable
- procession through the orange and lime and guava groves, to the little
- group of houses, partly thatch and reed, partly whitewashed concrete, that
- made up the settlement. The church was, of course, much the least
- interesting thing in the island. South Sea churches, with one or two happy
- exceptions, are blots in a world of beauty, monuments of bad taste,
- extravagance, and folly, that do very little credit to the religions they
- represent. In the days when most of them were built, the one idea of the
- missionary was the assimilation of the native to white men&rsquo;s ways and
- customs, as far as was possible, by any means conceivable&mdash;wise, or
- otherwise. In building churches for the new converts, the pattern followed
- was that set by Europeans for use in a cold climate, on sites that had a
- distinct money value per yard. Consequently, while South Sea houses, for
- coolness, are made almost all window and door, or else built, native
- fashion, in such a way that the air blows through the walls, South Sea
- churches are almost without ventilation, and (because the style of
- architecture selected is that of the whitewashed barn description) quite
- without beauty of any kind. In most cases, they have cost the islands
- appalling sums to build, and continue to demand a good deal to keep them
- in repair. There are happy exceptions here and there. Niué, of which place
- I have more to say later on, possesses a church built with exquisite taste
- and perfect regard to convenience, and the Catholic cathedral in Samoa is
- designed with much consideration as to climate, and appearance as well.
- </p>
- <p>
- Mauke&rsquo;s church, however, is not one of the exceptions, being exceedingly
- bald and ugly, and it is furthermore disfigured by the most horrible lapse
- of taste to be seen in almost any island church&mdash;the decoration of
- the pulpit and communion rails with silver dollars nailed on in rows. I
- told the crowd of natives, eager to hear the praises of their wonderful
- church, that I had never seen anything like it in my life&mdash;which
- seemed to afford them much gratification. I did not add what I thought&mdash;that
- I sincerely hoped I might never see anything like it again.
- </p>
- <p>
- A statement made only once or twice is fairly sure to miss the observation
- of the average reader, so I make no apology for saying here, as I have
- said in other parts of this book, that I am not one of those people who
- are opposed to mission work, or indifferent to religion; neither am I
- inclined to minimise the effects of the work done by missionaries in
- converting and civilising the Pacific generally. That the missionaries are
- infallible and always wise, however, in their methods of dealing with the
- natives, I do deny&mdash;which is only equivalent to saying that they are
- human, like the people at home. Nor do I think that, in these days, the
- missionary who takes up work in the Southern and Eastern Pacific has any
- need to wear the martyr aureole which is so persistently fitted on to the
- heads of all who go to &ldquo;labour&rdquo; in the island world. We are not in the
- days of Cook: cannibalism, over most of the Pacific, is dead and
- forgotten, violence to white people of any kind is unheard of, the
- climates are usually excellent, the islands beautiful, fertile, and happy,
- and the missionary&rsquo;s work is much the same as that of any country
- clergyman at home, save for the fact that his congregation are infinitely
- more submissive than whites would be, and incline to regard their teacher
- as a sovereign, not only spiritual, but temporal. The mission house is
- always much the finest building on the island, and the best furnished and
- provided. The missionary&rsquo;s children are usually sent away to be educated
- at good home or colonial boarding schools, and afterwards return to take
- up their parents&rsquo; work, or possibly to settle in the islands in other
- capacities. The life, though busy, is devoid of all stress and strain, and
- there is no apparent difficulty in &ldquo;making both ends meet&rdquo;&mdash;and
- overlap. In the Southern and Eastern Pacific, the missionaries are
- conveyed from group to group in a mission steamer that is little inferior
- to the yacht of a millionaire, for comfort and elegance. They are
- constantly assisted by gifts of all kinds, and treated with consideration
- wherever they go, and in most cases enjoy a social position much better
- than that originally possessed at home. It is hard to see why a
- profession, which is so pleasant and profitable, should be exalted over
- the work of thousands of struggling pastors and clergymen at home, who too
- often know the pinch of actual want, and are in many cases obliged to lead
- lives of the greyest and narrowest monotony.
- </p>
- <p>
- What is the moral? That one should not give money to missions? Certainly
- not. But if I were a millionaire, and had thousands to give in such a
- cause, I would give them carefully, with inquiry, directed to more sources
- than one, and would distribute them so that they should be used, if
- possible, in adding to the numbers of the Christian Church, rather than in
- teaching geography and English grammar and dressmaking to amiable brown
- people who are, and have been for generations, a good deal more Christian
- than ninety in a hundred whites. I believe firmly that most of the older
- missions in the Pacific could be continued perfectly well with the aid of
- native teachers, at one-twentieth the present cost&mdash;much as the
- teaching of outlying far-away islands, where residence is unpleasant for
- white families, is carried on to-day, with the aid of a yearly visit or
- so. That the present system will ever be modified, however, I do not
- believe. The reasons for such a conclusion are too obvious to need
- discussion.
- </p>
- <p>
- I have wandered a good way from the church at Mauke. But there are many
- points on this subject of island missions, nevertheless, on which I have
- not touched.
- </p>
- <p>
- Some of the men of Mauke were very busy on the shore, when our party
- passed down again to the boat. They made a bright picture, in their gay
- pareos of scarlet and yellow, and the snowy coronets of scented island
- flowers that they had twined about their heads. But the most picturesque
- thing about them was their occupation, which was neither more nor less
- than sand-castle building! There they sat, those big grown men, with never
- a child among them to make excuse for their play, building up churches and
- houses of the milk-white coral sand, scooping dark windows in the
- edifices, training green creepers up them, and planting out odd little
- gardens of branching coral twigs off the reef, in the surrounding
- pleasances. They had bundles of good things tied up in green leaves, lying
- somewhere in the shade of the guava bushes, and they had brought a pile of
- husked cocoanuts down to the shore with them, to drink when they pleased.
- They may have been waiting for a native boat, or they may have been simply
- making a day of it. In any case, they were sublimely happy.
- </p>
- <p>
- <i>(Cold rain on the miry road; faint gold sunset fading to stormy grey;
- wet leaves a-shiver in the dusk&mdash;and the long, long way before the
- tired feet. A day of toil, a comfortless night. A handful of coppers in
- the pocket; food and fire that must be bought with silver; freedom, rest,
- enjoyment, that cost unattainable gold. The sacred right of labour; a
- white man&rsquo;s freedom. O, brown half-naked islanders, playing at
- sand-castles on your sun-bathed shore, with unbought food lying among the
- unpurchased fruits beside you, what would you give to be one of the master
- race?)</i>
- </p>
- <p>
- Takutea we did not call at, since it was uninhabited, but the <i>Duchess</i>,
- under her daring little pirate of a captain, made no bones about running
- as close to anything, anywhere, as her passengers might desire, so we saw
- the fascinating place at fairly close quarters. In 1904, when I saw it, it
- was a real &ldquo;desolate island,&rdquo; being twelve miles out in the open sea from
- the nearest land (Atiu), and totally uninhabited. Its extent is four or
- five hundred acres; it is thickly wooded with cocoanuts-, and has a good
- spring of water. The beautiful &ldquo;bo&rsquo;sun bird,&rdquo; whose long red and white
- tail feathers have a considerable commercial value, is common on the
- island. No one had visited it for a long time when we sailed by; the wide
- white beach was empty, the cocoanut palms dropped their nuts unheeded into
- earth that received them gladly, and set them forth again in fountain-like
- sprays of green. The surf crumbled softly on the irregular fringing reef;
- the ripples of the lagoon laid their ridgy footsteps along the empty
- strand, and no Man Friday came to trample them out-with a step of awful
- significance. I wanted Takutea very badly indeed, all for myself; but I
- shall not have it now, neither will the reader, for some one else has
- bought it, and it is to be turned into a cocoanut plantation.
- </p>
- <p>
- Manuwai, better known as Hervey Island, is not many miles away, but we
- took a day or more to reach it, partly because the winds were contrary,
- partly because (with apologies to the Admiralty Surveys) it was wrongly
- charted, and could not be found, at first, in a slight sea-fog. Manuwai
- has changed its ownership and its use, of late, but in 1904 it was a penal
- settlement and a copra plantation combined, being used as a place of
- punishment for sinful Cook Islanders, who were compulsorily let out as
- labourers to the Company renting the two islets of which this so-called
- group is composed.
- </p>
- <p>
- The islands between them cover about fifteen hundred acres, according to
- the estimate given me. They have no permanent inhabitants, and when first
- taken up for planting, were quite desolate of life. A far-away, melancholy
- little place looked Manuwai, under the rays of the declining sun, as we
- came up to the reef. The two low islands, with their thick pluming of
- palms, are enclosed in the same lagoon, sheltered by a reef of oval form.
- There were a couple of drying-huts on the beach, and some heaps of oily
- smelling copra, when our boat pulled in. About twenty men, some convicts,
- some hired labourers, were gathered on the shore, fairly dancing with
- excitement, and the rest of the population&mdash;one white overseer, and
- one half-caste&mdash;were waiting on the very edge of the water, hardly
- less agitated. No ships ever called except the <i>Duchess</i>, and she was
- long overdue.
- </p>
- <p>
- I stepped on shore, and was immediately shaken hands with, and
- congratulated on being the first white woman to set foot on the island.
- Then we all went for a walk, while the native crew fell into the arms of
- the labourers, and with cries of joy began exchanging gossip, tobacco,
- hats, and shirts, bartering oranges from the ship for cocoanut crabs from
- the island, and eagerly discussing the question of who was going home in
- the <i>Duchess</i>, and who would have to stop over till her next call,
- perhaps six months hence.
- </p>
- <p>
- Manuwai is not one of the most beautiful of the islands, but anything in
- the way of solid ground was welcome after the gymnastics of the too-lively
- <i>Duchess</i>. The cocoa-nut plantations, and the new clearings, where
- the bush was being burned away, interested the officials from Raratonga,
- and the &ldquo;boulevard&rdquo; planted by the overseer&mdash;a handsome double row of
- palms, composing an avenue that facetiously began in nothing, and led to
- nowhere, received due admiration. We heard a good deal about the
- depredations of the cocoanut crabs, and as these creatures are among the
- strangest things that ever furnished food for travellers&rsquo; tales, I shall
- give their history as I gathered it, both in Manuwai and other places.
- </p>
- <p>
- One must not, by the way, believe all that one hears, or even half, among
- the &ldquo;sunny isles of Eden.&rdquo; Flowers of the imagination flourish quite as
- freely as flowers and fruits of the earth, and are much less satisfactory
- in kind. Also, it is a recognised sport to &ldquo;spin yarns&rdquo; to a newcomer,
- with the pious object of seeing how much he&mdash;or she&mdash;will
- swallow; and where so much is strange, bizarre, and almost incredible,
- among undoubted facts, it is hard to sift out the fictions of the playful
- resident.
- </p>
- <p>
- However, the cocoanut crab is an undeniable fact, with which many a
- planter has had to wrestle, much to his loss. It must be confessed that I
- had expected something very exciting indeed, when I heard in Tahiti that
- cocoanut or robber crabs were still to be found in some parts of the Cook
- Group. One of the most grisly bugbears of my youth had been the
- descriptions of the terrible cocoanut crab that attacked the &ldquo;Swiss Family
- Robinson&rdquo; on their wonderful island. It was described, if my memory serves
- me, as &ldquo;about the size of a turtle.&rdquo; and was dark blue in colour; it
- descended rapidly backwards down a tree, and immediately went to the
- attack of a Robinson youth, who repulsed it at the peril of his life....
- On the whole, I thought it would make things interesting, if it really was
- in the Cook Group.
- </p>
- <p>
- I never was more disappointed in my life than when I really saw one. It
- was dead, and cured in formalin, and only brought down from an island
- house as a show, but that was not the trouble. It was not more than two
- and a half feet long, lobster tail and all; it was not in the least like a
- turtle, and any small boy armed with a good stick could have faced it
- without fear, at its worst. No, decidedly the terrible crab was not up to
- the travellers&rsquo; tales that had been told about it.
- </p>
- <p>
- Still, it was worth seeing, for it was like nothing on the earth or in the
- sea that I had ever encountered. It had been excellently preserved, and
- looked wonderfully alive, when laid on the sand at the foot of a cocoanut
- palm. Its colour, as in life, was a gay mixture of red and blue. It had a
- long body like a colossal lobster, and two claws, one slight and thin, the
- other big enough to crack the ankle-bone of a man. It was an ugly and a
- wicked-looking thing, and I was not surprised to hear that it fights
- fiercely, if caught away from its hole, sitting up and threatening man or
- beast with its formidable claw, and showing no fear whatever.
- </p>
- <p>
- In the daylight, however, it is very seldom seen abroad. We walked through
- groves that were riddled with its holes that afternoon, but never even
- heard the scuffle of a claw. The creature lives in rabbit-like burrows at
- the foot of palm-trees, and the natives can always tell the size of the
- inmate by a glance at the diameter of the hole by which it enters its
- burrow. At night it comes out, climbs the nearest palm, and gets in among
- the raffle of young and old leaves, fibre, stalks, and nuts, in the crown,
- there it selects a good nut, nips the stalk in two with its claw, and lets
- the booty drop with a thump to the earth, seventy or eighty feel below.
- Then the marauder backs cautiously down the tree, finds the nut, and
- proceeds to rip and rend the tough husk until the nut as we know it at
- home is laid bare. A cocoanut shell is no easy thing to crack, as most
- people know, but the robber crab with its huge claws makes nothing more of
- it than we should make of an egg, and in a minute the rich oily meat is at
- the mercy of the thief, and another fraction of a ton of copra is lost to
- the planter. It goes without saying that any stray nuts lying on the
- ground have been opened and destroyed, before the crab will trouble itself
- to climb.
- </p>
- <p>
- Cocoanut crab is very good eating, and as it is mostly found in barren
- coral islands where little or nothing will grow but palms, the natives are
- always keen on hunting the &ldquo;robber.&rdquo; Sometimes he is secured by thrusting
- a lighted torch down a hole which possesses two exits&mdash;the crab
- hurrying out at the unopposed side as soon as the flame invades his
- dwelling. Sometimes the islanders secure him by the simple process of
- feeling for him in his burrow, and stabbing him at the end of it with a
- knife. This is decidedly risky, however, and may result in a smashed hand
- or wrist for the invader. A favourite plan is the following: Slip out in
- the dark, barefoot and silent, and hide yourself in a cocoanut grove till
- you see or hear a crab making his way up a tree. Wait till he is up at the
- top, and then climb half-way up, and tie a band of grass round the trunk.
- Now hurry down and pile a heap of rough coral stones from the beach at the
- foot of the tree. Slip away into the shadow again, and wait. The crab will
- start to come down presently, backing carefully, tail first, for he has a
- bare and unprotected end to his armoured body, and uses it to inform
- himself of his arrival on the safe ground below. Half-way down the tree he
- touches your cunning band of grass. &ldquo;Down so soon?&rdquo; he remarks to himself,
- and lets go. Crack! he has shot down forty feet through air, and landed
- smashingly on the pile of stones that you carefully prepared for his
- reception.
- </p>
- <p>
- He is badly injured, ten to one, and you will have little trouble in
- finishing him off with your knife, and carrying home a savoury supper that
- is well worth the&rsquo; waiting for. That is the native way of hunting robber
- crabs.
- </p>
- <p>
- When one lives on a cocoanut plantation, on an island that contains
- practically nothing else, one comes in time to know everything that is to
- be known about cocoanuts in general. But even the manager of Manuwai could
- not solve for me a problem that had been perplexing me ever since I had
- first seen a cocoanut palm&mdash;a problem, indeed, that after several
- more years of island travel, remains unanswered yet.
- </p>
- <p>
- Why is no one ever killed by a cocoanut?
- </p>
- <p>
- The question seems an idle one, if one thinks of cocoa-nuts as they are
- seen in British shops&mdash;small brown ovals of little weight or size&mdash;and
- if one has never seen them growing, or heard them fall. But when one knows
- that, the smallest nuts alone reach England (since they are sold by
- number, not by weight) and that the ordinary nut, in its husk and on its
- native tree, is as big as one&rsquo;s own head, and as heavy as a solid lump of
- hard wood&mdash;that most trees bear seventy or eighty nuts a year, and
- that every one of those nuts has the height of a four-storey house to drop
- before it reaches the ground&mdash;that native houses are usually placed
- in the middle of a palm grove, and that every one in the islands, brown or
- white, walks underneath hundreds of laden cocoanut trees every day in the
- year&mdash;it then becomes a miracle of the largest kind that no one is
- ever killed, and very rarely injured, by the fall of the nuts. Nor can the
- reason be sought in the fact that the nuts cannot hurt. One is sure to see
- them fall from time to time, and they shoot down from the crown of the
- palm like flying bomb-shells, making a most portentous thump as they reach
- the earth. So extremely rare are accidents, however, that in nearly three
- years I did not hear of any mishap, past or present, save the single case
- of a man who was struck by a falling nut in the Cook Islands, and knocked
- insensible for an hour or two. This is certainly not a bad record for a
- tour extending over so many thousand miles, and including most of the
- important island groups&mdash;every one of which grows cocoanut palms by
- the thousand, in some cases, by the hundred thousand.
- </p>
- <p>
- Travellers are often a little nervous at first, when riding or walking all
- day long through woods of palm, heavily laden with ponderous nuts. But the
- feeling never lasts more than a few days. One does not know why one is
- never hit by these cannon-balls of Nature&mdash;but one never is, neither
- is anybody else, so all uneasiness dies out very quickly, and one
- acquiesces placidly in the universal miracle.
- </p>
- <p>
- Planters say that most of the nuts fall at night, when the dew has relaxed
- the fibres of the stalks. This would be an excellent reason, but for the
- fact that the nuts don&rsquo;t fall any more at night than in the daytime, if
- one takes the trouble to observe, and that damp, or dew, tightens up
- fibres of all kind, instead of relaxing them. If one asks the natives, the
- usual answer is: &ldquo;It just happens that way&rdquo;; and I fancy that is as near
- as any one is likely to get to a solution.
- </p>
- <p>
- Manuwai, since I saw it, has been purchased outright by a couple of
- adventurous young Englishmen, who are working it as a copra plantation.
- Takutea has, therefore, a neighbour in the Robinson Crusoe business, and
- is not likely to be quite so solitary as in times past.
- </p>
- <p>
- The tour of the group was now ended, and the Government officials were
- conveyed back to Raratonga with all possible despatch&mdash;which is not
- saying very much, after all. There followed a luxurious interval of real
- beds and real meals, and similar Capuan delights, in the pretty island
- bungalow where my lot for the time had been cast. Then the <i>Duchess</i>
- began to start again, and peace was over. A sailing vessel does not start
- in the same way as a steamer. She gives out that she will leave on such a
- day, at such an hour, quite like the steamer; but there the resemblance
- ends. When you pack your cabin trunk, and have it taken down at 11 a.m.,
- you find there is no wind, so you take it back and call again next day.
- There is a wind now, but from the one quarter that makes it practically
- impossible to get out of port.&rsquo; You are told you had better leave your
- trunk, in case of the breeze shifting. You do, and go back for the second
- time to the hostess from whom you have already parted twice. The verandah
- (every one lives on verandahs, in the islands) is convulsed to see you
- come back, and tells you this is the way the ship always does &ldquo;get off.&rdquo;
- You spend a quiet evening, and go to bed. At twelve o&rsquo;clock, just as you
- are in the very heart of your soundest sleep, a native boy comes running
- up to the house to say that the captain has sent for the passenger to come
- down at once, for the wind is getting up, and he will sail in a quarter of
- an hour! You scramble into your clothes, run down to the quay, get rowed
- out to the ship, and finish your sleep in your cabin to the accompaniment
- of stamping feet and the flapping sails; and behold, at eight o&rsquo;clock, the
- bo&rsquo;sun thunders on your door, and tells you that breakfast is in, but the
- breeze is away again, and the ship still in harbour! After breakfast you
- sneak up the well-known avenue again, feeling very much as if you had run
- away from school, and were coming back in disgrace. This time, the
- verandah shrieks until the natives run to the avenue gate to see what is
- the matter with the man &ldquo;papalangis,&rdquo; and then console you with the
- prophecy that the schooner won&rsquo;t get away for another week.
- </p>
- <p>
- She does, though. In the middle of the afternoon tea, the captain himself
- arrives, declines to have a cup, and says it is really business this time,
- and he is away. You go down that eternal avenue again, followed by
- cheerful cries of &ldquo;No goodbye! we&rsquo;ll keep your place at dinner,&rdquo; and in
- half an hour the green and purple hills of lovely Raratonga are separated
- from you by a widening plain of wind-ruffled blue waves, and the <i>Duchess</i>
- is fairly away to Savage Island.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Miss G&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;, have you nearly done your book?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Pretty nearly&mdash;why?&rdquo; I ask, looking up from the pages of &ldquo;John
- Herring.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- We are a day or two out from Raratonga, but not even one hundred of the
- six hundred miles that lie between the Cook Group and lonely Niué is
- compassed as yet. The winds have been lightest of the light, and from the
- wrong quarter too, until this morning, when we have &ldquo;got a slant&rdquo; at last.
- Now the <i>Duchess</i> is rolling along in her usual tipsy fashion at
- seven or eight knots an hour, and the china-blue sea is ruffled and
- frilled with snow. It is hot, but not oppressively so, and I have been
- enjoying myself most of the morning lounging on a pile of locker cushions
- against the deck-house, alternately reading, and humming to myself
- something from Kipling about:
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- Sailing south on the old trail, our own trail, the out trail,
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- Sliding south on the long trail, the trail that is always new.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p>
- The pirate captain has been at the wheel for the last two hours, but I
- have not taken much note of the fact. Our only mate left us in the Cook
- Group, for a reason not absolutely new in the history of the world (a
- pretty little reason she was, too); and our bo&rsquo;sun, who has been giddily
- promoted to a rank that he describes as &ldquo;chief officer,&rdquo; is not exactly a
- host in himself, though he is a white man. In consequence, the pirate and
- he have been keeping watch and watch since we sailed&mdash;four hours on
- and four hours off&mdash;and, as one or two of our best A.B.s declined to
- go down to Niué, and most of the others are bad helmsmen, the two whites
- have been at the wheel during the greater part of their watches.
- </p>
- <p>
- I have grown quite accustomed to seeing one or other standing aft of the
- little companion that leads down to the cabin, lightly shifting the spokes
- in his hands hour after hour. It never occurred to me, however, that I was
- personally interested in the matter.
- </p>
- <p>
- But we are in the South Pacific, and I have still a good many things to
- find out about the &ldquo;way they do things at sea,&rdquo; here where the ocean is
- the ocean, and no playground for globe-trotting tourists.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Are you nearly done?&rdquo; asks the pirate again, shifting half a point, and
- throwing a glance at the clouds on the windward side. They are harmless
- little clouds, and only suggest a steady breeze.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;I have about half an hour&rsquo;s reading left,&rdquo; I answer.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Then you&rsquo;d better chuck the book into your cabin, for it&rsquo;s almost eight
- bells, and that begins your trick at the wheel,&rdquo; says the pirate calmly.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;My <i>what?</i>&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Your trick. Your turn. Time you have to steer, see?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;But, good heavens! I never had a wheel in my hand in my life&mdash;I
- don&rsquo;t know how!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;That&rsquo;s your misfortune, not your fault,&rdquo; says the pirate kindly. &ldquo;You&rsquo;ll
- never have to say that again.. There&rsquo;s eight bells now&mdash;come along. J&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;
- and I have had too much of the wheel, and now we&rsquo;re well away from land is
- your time to learn.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- And from thenceforth until we made the rocky coast of Niué, more than a
- week later, I spent a portion of every day with the polished spokes of the
- wheel in my hands, straining my eyes on the &ldquo;lubber&rsquo;s point,&rdquo; or anxiously
- watching the swelling curves of the sails aloft in the windy blue, ready
- to put the wheel up the instant an ominous wrinkle began to flap and
- writhe upon the marble smoothness of the leaning canvas. At night, the
- smallest slatting of sail upon the mast would start me out of my sleep,
- with an uneasy fear that I was steering, and had let her get too, close to
- the wind; and I deposed most of my prayers in favour of an evening litany
- that began: &ldquo;North, north by east, nor&rsquo;-nor&rsquo;-east, nor&rsquo;-east by north,
- nor&rsquo;-east,&rdquo; and turned round upon itself to go backward in the end, like a
- spell said upside down to raise a storm.
- </p>
- <p>
- Withal, the good ship left many a wake that would have broken the back of
- a snake, for the first day or two of my lessons, and the native A.B.s used
- to come and stand behind me when an occasional sea made the wheel kick,
- under the evident impression that they would be wanted before long. But I
- learned to steer&mdash;somehow&mdash;before we got to Niué, and I learned
- to lower away boats, and to manage a sixteen foot steer-oar, when we got
- becalmed, and spent the day rowing about among the mountainous swells, out
- of sheer boredom. And for exercise and sport, I learned to go up into the
- cross-trees and come down again by the ratlines or the back-stay,
- whichever seemed the handiest, wearing the flannel gymnasium dress I had
- brought for mountaineering excursions. It was very pleasant up there on a
- bright, salt-windy morning, when the <i>Duchess</i> swung steadily on her
- way with a light favouring breeze, her little white deck lying below me
- like a tea-tray covered with walking dolls, her masts at times leaning to
- leeward until my airy seat was swung far out across the water. Having a
- good head, I was never troubled with giddiness, and used to do a good deal
- of photographing from aloft, when the ship was steady enough to allow of
- it. That was seldom, however, for the <i>Duchess</i> had been built in New
- Zealand, where the good schooners do not come from, and had no more hold
- on the water than a floating egg. More than one sailing vessel turned out
- by the same builders had vanished off the face of the ocean, in ways not
- explained, by reason of the absence of survivors, but dimly guessed at,
- all the same; and I cannot allow that the pirate captain had any just
- cause of annoyance&mdash;even allowing for a master&rsquo;s pride in his ship&mdash;when
- I recommended him to have the schooner&rsquo;s name painted legibly on her keel
- before he should leave Auckland on his next northward journey, just &ldquo;in
- case.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- We were about a hundred and fifty miles off Niué, when the pirate came to
- me one windy morning, and asked me if I wanted to see something that had
- only been once seen before.
- </p>
- <p>
- There was, of course, only one reply possible.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Then keep a look-out, and you&rsquo;ll see it,&rdquo; said the pirate. &ldquo;We&rsquo;re going
- to run right by Beveridge Reef, and it&rsquo;s been only once sighted. What&rsquo;s
- more, it&rsquo;s wrong charted, and I&rsquo;m going to set it right. You&rsquo;ve no idea
- what a lot of wrecks there have been on that d&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;
- that dangerous place. Not a soul ever got away from one of them to tell
- what happened, either. They&rsquo;d only know when things began drifting down to
- Niué, weeks after&mdash;timber and cargo, and so on&mdash;why, a lot of
- the houses in Niué are built out of wreckage&mdash;and then people would
- say that there&rsquo;d been another wreck on Beveridge Reef. Some fool reported
- it as a coral island two miles across, once upon a time, but I&rsquo;ll bet he
- never saw it. If it had been, it wouldn&rsquo;t have been as destructive as it
- is.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- Late in the day we sighted it. The pirate was aloft, swinging between
- heaven and earth, with a glass in his hand, calling out observations to
- the chief-officer-boatswain below. The crew were attending exclusively to
- the horizon, and letting the ship look after herself, according to the
- amiable way of Maories when there is anything interesting afoot. The
- weather was darkening down, and heavy squalls of rain swept the sea now
- and then. But there it was, clearly enough to be seen in the intervals of
- the squalls, a circle of white foam enclosing an inner patch of livid
- green, clearly marked off from the grey of the surrounding ocean. Here and
- there a small black tooth of rock projected from the deadly ring of surf,
- and&mdash;significant and cruel sight&mdash;two ships&rsquo; anchors were
- plainly to be seen through the glass, as we neared the reef, lying fixed
- among the rock, so low in the water as only to be visible at intervals.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;A wicked place,&rdquo; said the captain, who had come down from his eyrie, and
- was giving orders for the preparation of a boat. &ldquo;Couldn&rsquo;t see a bit of it
- at night&mdash;couldn&rsquo;t see it in broad daylight, if there was a big sea
- on. And wrong charted too. Think of the last minutes of those poor chaps
- the anchors belonged to!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- The sea and sky were really beginning to look nasty, and I did not want to
- think of it. But the pirate went discoursing pleasantly of deaths and
- wrecks, while the men were putting various things into the whaleboat, and
- getting ready to lower away. He did not often have a passenger, but when
- he did, he evidently thought it his duty to keep her entertained.
- </p>
- <p>
- We were very near to the reef now&mdash;so close that I was able to take a
- photograph of it, a little marred by the rainy weather. Meantime, the boat
- was being swung out, and the men were getting in. And now &ldquo;a strange thing
- happened.&rdquo; Out of nowhere at all eight sharks appeared&mdash;large ones,
- too&mdash;and began to cruise hungrily about the <i>Duchess&rsquo;s</i> hull,
- their lithe yellowish bodies sharply outlined in the dark blue water,
- their evil eyes fixed on me, as I overhung the rail to look at them. &ldquo;If
- only!&rdquo; they said as plainly as possible, with those hideously intelligent
- green orbs. &ldquo;If only&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;What has brought those horrible brutes about us?&rdquo; I asked.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Those? oh, they&rsquo;re waiting to be fed, I suppose. Pretty much all the
- ships that came this way before us have given them a good dinner. I bet
- they say grace before meat now every time they see a sail, which isn&rsquo;t
- often. Here, you Oki, put in that keg of beef.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Where are you going?&rdquo; I demanded with considerable interest, for the
- pirate captain never did things like any one else, and I scented an
- adventure.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Going to find out what the inside of that lagoon is really like. No one
- ever put a boat into it yet. No, you can&rsquo;t be in it this time: very sorry,
- but&mdash;&mdash;&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;What?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Well, you see, one isn&rsquo;t absolutely sure of getting back again, in a
- place like this. Didn&rsquo;t you see me put in grub and water and a compass? I
- don&rsquo;t think you&rsquo;d like a boat voyage down to Niué, if we happened to miss
- the train. The mate has the course, and could take her on, if I came to
- grief. No, it isn&rsquo;t any use asking, I just can&rsquo;t. Lower away.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- They lowered and&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;
- </p>
- <p>
- Well, if the pirate had been a shade less determined about the number in
- the boat, there would have been a pretty little tragedy of the sea, that
- gusty afternoon. One more in the boat had certainly turned the scale. For
- the wind was continually getting up, and the wretched <i>Duchess</i> was
- rolling like a buoy, and the boat as she touched the water, with the
- captain and three men in her, was caught by the top of a wave, and dashed
- against the side of the ship. In a flash she was overturned, with a badly
- damaged thwart, and was washing about helplessly among the waves, with the
- four men clinging to her keel. The sea took her past the schooner like a
- rag. I had only time to run to the stern, before she was swept out of
- hearing, but I heard the pirate call as he disappeared in the trough of a
- wave, &ldquo;Get out your camera, here&rsquo;s the chance of your life!&rdquo; Then the boat
- was gone, and for a moment the mate and I thought it was all over. &ldquo;The
- sharks will have &rsquo;em if they don&rsquo;t sink!&rdquo; declared that officer,
- straining over the rail, while the Maori crew ran aimlessly about the
- deck, shouting with excitement.
- </p>
- <p>
- What happened during the next half-hour has never been very clear in my
- memory. The wind kept rising, and the afternoon grew late and dark. The
- overturned boat, with the four heads visible about her keel, drifted
- helplessly in the trough of the seas, at the mercy of waves and sharks. (I
- heard, afterwards, that the men had all kicked ceaselessly to keep them
- away, and that they expected to be seized any moment.) The wind screamed
- in the rigging, and drifts of foam flew up on deck, and the Maories ran
- about and shouted, and got in each other&rsquo;s way, and tried to heave ropes,
- and missed, and tried to launch a boat under the mate&rsquo;s direction, and
- somehow did not&mdash;I cannot tell why. And right in the middle of the
- play, when we seemed to be making some attempt to bear down upon the
- drifting wreck, a grey old man who had come on with us from the Cook
- Islands, but had kept to his berth through illness most of the time, burst
- out on deck with an astonishing explosion of sea language, and told us
- that we were nearly on to the reef. Which, it seems, every one had
- forgotten!
- </p>
- <p>
- After that, things grew so lively on the poop that I got up on the top of
- the deck-house to keep out of the way, and reflect upon my sins. It seemed
- a suitable occasion for devotional exercises. The white teeth of the reef
- were unpleasantly near, the water was growing shoal. &ldquo;Put a leadsman in
- the chains this minute!&rdquo; yelled the grizzled passenger (who had been at
- sea in his time, and knew something of what was likely to happen when you
- got a nasty reef on your lee side, with the wind working up). The
- auxiliary engine, meant for use on just such occasions, had been sick for
- some time. There was a very strong tide running, the wind had shifted
- while the ship&rsquo;s company were intent on the fate of the boat, and on the
- whole it looked very much as if the decorations already possessed by the
- notorious reef were likely to be increased by another pair of best quality
- British made anchors&mdash;<i>ours</i>.
- </p>
- <p>
- A good many things happen on sailing ships&mdash;Pacific ships especially&mdash;that
- one does not describe in detail, unless one happens to be writing fiction.
- This is not fiction, so the occurrences of the next quarter of an hour
- must be passed over lightly. The ancient passenger took command of the
- ship. We got away from the reef by an unpleasantly close shave and bore
- down upon the boat, which the pirate captain had impossibly contrived to
- right by this time, paddling it along with one oar, while the men baled
- constantly. We got the captain and the men and the damaged boat on board,
- and a few &ldquo;free opinions, freely expressed&rdquo;&mdash;as a certain famous lady
- novelist would put it&mdash;were exchanged. Then the pirate, who was quite
- fresh, and very lively, demanded the second boat, and said he was bound to
- get into that place anyhow, and wouldn&rsquo;t leave till he did.
- </p>
- <p>
- I rather think we mutinied at this juncture. I am sure I did, because I
- had been thinking over my sins for some time, and had come to the
- conclusion that there really were not many of them, and that I wanted a
- chance to accumulate a few more, preferably of an agreeable kind, before I
- faced the probability of decorating any Pacific coral reef with my
- unadorned and unburied skeleton. The grey-haired passenger and the mate
- mutinied too, upon my example, and the pirate, seeing that we were three
- to one, and moreover, that it was growing dusk, made a virtue of
- necessity, and went off for a shift of clothes, giving orders to make all
- sail at once. And so we left the reef in the growing dusk, and no man has
- to this day disturbed the virgin surface of its stormy little lagoon with
- profanely invading oar.
- </p>
- <p>
- Was there a fortune lying concealed beneath those pale green waves within
- the foaming jaws of the reef? I never heard. But there were some among our
- native crew who came from the far-off island of Penrhyn, where the pearl
- fisheries are, and they were strong in asserting their belief that the
- pirate might have been well paid for his exploration. It was just that
- sort of reef, said the pearl-island men, that most often contained good
- shell, and produced the biggest pearls, the first time of looking. An old,
- undisturbed atoll, where no one had ever thought of looking for shell, was
- the place where big pearls got a chance to grow. The first comer scooped
- in the prizes; afterwards, the shell itself and the smaller pearls were
- all that any one was likely to get.
- </p>
- <p>
- However that might be, the talk, on the rest of the way down to Niué, ran
- much on pearls and pearl-shell, and I learned a good deal about these
- gold-mines of the Pacific&mdash;always making allowance for the inevitable
- Pacific exaggeration. Any man who can live a year among the islands, and
- restrain himself, in the latter part of his stay, from lying as naturally
- and freely as he breathes, deserves a D.S.O.
- </p>
- <p>
- Stripped of flowers of fiction, the romance of the pearling trade was
- still interesting and fascinating enough. Pearls, in the Pacific, are
- obtained from a large bivalve that has a good deal of value in itself,
- being the material from which mother-o&rsquo;-pearl is made. Prices, of course,
- fluctuate very much, as the shell is used in so many manufactures that
- depend on the vagaries of fashion; but the value may run to £200 a ton or
- over. When it gets down to £40 or less, it is hardly worth the expense of
- lifting and carrying. For the most part, however, it is worth a good deal
- more than this, and when it is at the highest, fortunes can be, and have
- been, made out of small beginnings, in a very short time. The pearls are
- an &ldquo;extra,&rdquo; and not to be relied upon. There may be almost none in a big
- take of shell, there may be a few small ones, there may be a number of
- fine ones that will make the fortune of the lucky fisher. It is all a
- gamble, and perhaps none the less fascinating for that. Much of the best
- shell and the finest pearls in the Pacific, come from the Paumotus, which
- are French. Thursday Island, off the north of Queensland, was the great
- centre of the fishery, until lately, but it has been almost fished out.
- The Solomons were reported to have a good deal of shell, and a rush took
- place to that part not long ago, but the yield was much exaggerated. There
- are a good many atolls about the Central Pacific in general, which contain
- more or less shell, and are generally owned and fished by Australian
- syndicates. Outlying reefs and islets, where no one goes, now and then
- turn out to be valuable. The news of a find travels apparently on the
- wings of the seagulls from group to group, for no such place ever remains
- secret for more than a very short time, and then, if the owner&rsquo;s title is
- not secure (a thing that may easily happen, in the case of an island that
- does not lie within the geographical limits of any of the annexed groups)
- there is sometimes trouble. Pearl-poaching is easy and profitable, if not
- very safe; and who is to tell ugly tales, a thousand miles from anywhere,
- out in the far Pacific?
- </p>
- <p>
- <i>(The swift-winged schooner and the racing seas: decks foam-white
- beneath a burning sky: salt wind on the lips, and the fairy-voiced
- enchantress Adventure singing ever from beyond the prow! &ldquo;O dreamers in
- the man-stifled town,&rdquo; do you hear the wide world calling?)</i>
- </p>
- <p>
- And so the pirate captain brought us up to Niué, and left me there, and
- sailed away with the ship to Auckland, where he gave over the command, and
- went (so it was said) to aid in the instruction of sea-going youth,
- somewhere further south. The Cook Islands shrieked with joyous amusement
- when they heard of the pirate&rsquo;s new rôle as the guide and mentor of tender
- boyhood&mdash;but I do not know, after all. The pirate was as full of
- mischief as an egg is full of meat, as full of fight as a sparrow-hawk,
- gifted with an uncanny faculty for plunging into every kind of risk that
- the wide seas of the earth could hold, and coming out unscathed and asking
- for more. He was assuredly not to be numbered among the company of the
- saints, but neither is the average &ldquo;glorious human boy&rdquo;&mdash;and on the
- principle of setting a thief to catch a thief, the pirate&rsquo;s new rôle may
- well have turned out a success.
- </p>
- <p>
- We came up to Niué graced by a last touch of the piratical spirit. There
- was some blusterous weather as we neared the great island with its
- iron-bound, rocky coasts, towards which we had been making for so many
- days, but we swept up towards the land with every rag of canvas set, for
- that was the pirate captain&rsquo;s custom, and he would not break it.
- By-and-by, as I was standing on the main deck, holding on to the
- deckhouse, while I looked at the looming mass of blue ahead, the main
- square-sail gave way with a report like a gun, and began to thrash the
- foremast with streamers of tattered canvas. The pirate had it down in a
- twinkling, and got the men to bend on a new sail immediately. It went up
- to the sound of yelling Maori chants (for the crew liked this sort of
- excitement), and once more the ship fled on towards Niué with every sail
- straining against the gusty wind. Half-an-hour, and crack!&mdash;the new
- square-sail was gone too, and half of it away to leeward like a huge grey
- bird in a very great hurry. And the pirate, as we began to draw inshore,
- raged up and down the deck, like a lion baulked of its prey. To come up to
- Niué without every sail set was a disgrace that he had never yet
- encountered, and it evidently hit him hard that he had not another sail in
- the locker, and was forced to &ldquo;carry on&rdquo; as best he could without it.
- </p>
- <p>
- Niué, or Savage Island, is no joke to approach. It is about forty miles
- round, and almost every yard of the whole forty is unapproachable, by
- reason of the precipitous cliffs, guarded by iron spears of coral rock,
- that surround it on every side. There are one or two places where an
- approach can be made, in suitable weather, with care, but it is quite a
- common thing for sailing vessels to beat on and off as much as a week,
- before they succeed in landing passengers and goods. We came up on a very
- gusty day, with the blow-holes in the cliffs spouting like whales as we
- went by, but the pirate captain ran us into the anchorage below Alofi as
- easily as if it had been perfect weather and an excellent harbour, and we
- put out a boat to land our goods, including myself. The pirate had not an
- ounce of caution in his body, but, as an old Irishman on one of the
- islands declared: &ldquo;The divil takes care of his own, let him alone for
- that, and it&rsquo;s not the Pirate that he&rsquo;s goin&rsquo; to let into any houle till
- he lets him into the biggest wan of all&mdash;mind that!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0010" id="link2HCH0010"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER X
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>How not to see the Islands&mdash;Lonely Niué&mdash;A Heathen Quarantine
- Board&mdash;The King and the Parliament&mdash;The Great Question of Gifts&mdash;Is
- it Chief-like?&mdash;The New Woman in Niué&mdash;Devil-fish and
- Water-Snakes&mdash;An Island of Ghosts&mdash;How the Witch-Doctor died&mdash;The
- Life of a Trader.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">L</span>ANDINGS on Pacific
- islands are not usually easy, but there are few approaches as bad as that
- of Niué, the solitary outlier of Polynesia. It is a difficult task to get
- within reasonable distance of the land in the first place, and when the
- ship has succeeded in manoeuvring safely up to the neighbourhood of the
- cruel cliffs, the trouble is only beginning. There are no harbours worth
- the name on the island, although the cliffs show an occasional crack
- through which a boat may be brought down to the sea, and the circling reef
- is broken here and there. The best that a ship can do is to lie off at a
- safe distance, put out a boat, and trust to the skill of the crew to
- effect a landing on the wharf. In anything but really calm weather,
- communication is impossible. However, there are very many calm days in
- this part of the Pacific, so chances are fairly frequent.
- </p>
- <p>
- It was not at all as calm as one could have wished when the <i>Duchess</i>
- put out her whaleboat to bring me ashore. But the pirate trusted to his
- luck, and was, as usual, justified. The boat passage proved to be a mere
- crack in the reef, through which the sea rushed with extreme violence,
- dancing us up and down like a cork. It was not difficult for our smart
- Maori crew to fend us off the knife-edged coral walls with their oars, as
- we manoeuvred down towards the spider-legged little iron ladder standing
- up in the surf, and pretending to be a wharf. But when we got within an
- oar&rsquo;s length of the ladder, and the boat was leaping wildly on every
- swell, things got more exciting. The only way of landing on Niué is to
- watch your time at the foot of the ladder, while the men fend the boat off
- the coral, and jump on to the rungs at the right moment. A native standing
- on the platform at the top takes you by the arms as you rise, and snatches
- you into the air as the eagle snatched Endymion. Only, instead of going
- all the way to heaven, you land on the pier&mdash;or what passes for it&mdash;and
- find yourselves upon the soil of Niué.
- </p>
- <p>
- Behind the pier rises a little pathway cut in the face of the rock, and
- leading up to the main street of the capital. Once up the path, we are
- fairly arrived in Savage Island.
- </p>
- <p>
- It is not a place known to the globe-trotting tourist, as yet. Much of the
- Pacific has been &ldquo;discovered&rdquo; by the tripper element of recent years, but
- Niué is still almost inviolate. Once here, if one seeks the true spirit of
- the South Seas, one still may find it.
- </p>
- <p>
- Travellers go in scores by every steamer to Samoa, to Fiji, to Honolulu,
- which are on the beaten track of &ldquo;round-the-world.&rdquo; They drive up to
- Stevenson&rsquo;s villa, they make excursions to Nuuanu Pali, they see a sugar
- plantation here, and a kava drinking there, and a native dance, specially
- composed to suit tourists&rsquo; tastes, somewhere else. They stay a week in a
- fine modern hotel, drink green cocoanuts (and other things that are
- stronger), take photographs of island girls wearing imported Parisian or
- Sydney costumes, and think they have seen the life of the islands. Never
- was there a greater mistake. The sweet South Seas do not so easily yield
- up their secret and their charm. The spell that for three hundred years
- has drawn the wandering hearts of the world across the ocean ploughed by
- the keels of Drake and Hawkins and Cook, of Dampier, Bougainville, and
- Bligh, will not unfold itself save to him who will pay the price. And the
- price to-day is the same in kind, though not in degree, as that paid by
- those old explorers and adventurers&mdash;hard travel, scanty food,
- loneliness, loss of money and time, forgetting the cities and
- civilisation. To know the heart of the South Seas, all these things must
- be encountered willingly, with a love of the very hardship they may bring,
- strong as the seabird&rsquo;s love of the tossing waters and thunderwaking
- storm.
- </p>
- <p>
- The typical British tourist&mdash;yes, even he&mdash;hears from far off,
- at times, the mysterious call of the island world, and tells himself that
- he will listen to it a little nearer, and enjoy the siren song sung to so
- many long before him. Hence his visits to the great Pacific ports that can
- be reached by liner; hence, in most cases, his gradually acquired
- conviction that the islands are, after all, very much like any other place
- in the tropics&mdash;beautiful, interesting, but&mdash;&mdash; Well,
- writer fellows always exaggerate: every one knows that.
- </p>
- <p>
- Hotel dinners, big liners, shops, hired carriages, guides, and picture
- postcards&mdash;these things are death to the spirit of the South Seas.
- This is the first lesson that the island wanderer must learn. Where every
- one goes the bloom is off the peach. Leave the great ports and the
- steamers; disregard the advice of every one who knows anything (most
- people in the island towns know everything, but you must not listen to
- them, for the jingling of the trade dollar has long since deafened their
- ears to the song of the mermaids on the coral beaches); take ship on a
- schooner, it does not much matter where; live in a little bungalow under
- the palms for weeks or months; ride and swim and feast with the brown
- people of the coral countries, as one of themselves; learn, if you do not
- already know, how to live on what you can get, and cook what you catch or
- pick or shoot, to sleep on a mat and wash in a stream, do without
- newspapers and posts, forget that there ever was a war anywhere, or an
- election, or that there will ever be a &ldquo;season&rdquo; anywhere again; and so
- perhaps, the charm of the island world will whisper itself in your waiting
- ear. What then? What happened to the men who ate the enchanted fruit of
- the lotus long ago? Well, no one ever said that the sweetness of the fruit
- was not worth all that it cost.
- </p>
- <p>
- There are about five thousand native inhabitants on Niué, and generally a
- score or so of whites&mdash;almost all traders. Alofi, the capital,
- possesses a few hundred of the former, and nearly all the latter. It is a
- winsome little spot, and I loved it the moment the wide grassy street
- first broke upon my view, as I climbed the narrow pathway from the shore.
- </p>
- <p>
- The houses stand down one side, as is the invariable custom of South Sea
- towns. They are whitewashed concrete for the most part, built by the
- natives out of materials furnished by the coral reef. The roofs are
- plaited pandanus thatch, high and steep. The doors are mostly windows, or
- the windows doors&mdash;it would be hard to say which. They are simply
- long openings filled in with wooden slats, which can be sloped to suit the
- wind and weather. Mats and cooking pots and the inevitable Chinese
- camphor-wood box, for keeping clothes in, are all the furniture. Round the
- doorways grow palms and gay hibiscus, and cerise-flowered poinsettia, and
- here and there a native will have set up an odd decoration of glittering
- stalactites from the caves on the shore, to sparkle in the sun by his
- doorstep. The white men&rsquo;s houses have grass compounds in front for the
- most part, and many have iron roofs, glass windows, and other luxuries.
- </p>
- <p>
- All these houses look the one way&mdash;across the wide, empty grassy
- street, between the stems of the leaning palms, to the sunset and the
- still blue sea. It is a lonely sea, this great empty plain lying below the
- little town. The <i>Duchess</i> calls twice a year, the mission steamer
- once, a trade steamer, ancient and worn out, limps across from Tonga,
- about three hundred miles away, every ten or twelve months. That is all.
- The island itself owns nothing bigger than a whaleboat, and cannot as a
- rule communicate with any other place in case of emergency. Some few
- months before my visit, a trader had very urgent need to send a letter to
- Australia. After waiting in vain for something to call, he sighted an
- American timber brig on her way to Sydney, far out on the horizon. Hastily
- launching a native canoe, and filling it with fruit, he paddled three or
- four miles out to sea, in the hope of being seen by the ship. His signals
- were perceived, and the brig hove to, when the trader paddled up to her,
- offered his fruit as a gift, and begged the captain to take his letter.
- This the sailor willingly did, and still more willingly accepted the
- excellent Niué bananas and oranges that went with the missive. And so the
- post was caught&mdash;Niué fashion.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is no doctor on the island as a rule, and if you want to die during
- the intervals between ships, you may do so unopposed. I am almost afraid
- to state how healthy the people of Niué are as a rule, in spite of&mdash;or
- can it be in consequence of?&mdash;this deprivation.
- </p>
- <p>
- The &ldquo;bush&rdquo; overflows the town, after the charming way of bush, in this
- island world. Big lilies, bell-shaped, snowy petalled, and as long as your
- hand, spill over into the main street from the bordering scrub. The grass
- on the top of the cliff, the day I landed, was blazing with great drifts
- of fiery salvia, and starred with pink and yellow marigolds. About the
- houses were clumps of wild &ldquo;foliage plants,&rdquo; claret and crimson leaved,
- looking like a nurseryman&rsquo;s bedding-out corner. The coco palm that I knew
- so well had a sister palm here, of a kind new to me&mdash;an exceedingly
- graceful tree twenty to thirty feet high, bearing small inedible
- berry-like fruits, and splendid fan-shaped leaves, of the shape and size
- once so familiar in the &ldquo;artistic type of drawing-room&rdquo; at home. Pinnacles
- of fantastic grey rock, all spiked and spired, started up unexpectedly in
- the midst of the riotous green, and every pinnacle was garlanded cunningly
- with wreaths and fronds of flowering vines. There were mammee-apples and
- bananas beside most of the houses: yellow oranges hung as thickly in the
- scrub as ornaments on a Christmas tree, and one or two verandahs were
- decorated with the creeping trailers of the delicious granadilla. A land
- of peace and plenty, it looked in the golden rays of the declining sun,
- that windy blue afternoon. It proved alas, to be nothing of the kind: its
- soil is fertile, but so thinly scraped over the coral rock for foundation,
- that very little in the way of nutritious food will grow&mdash;it has no
- water save what can be gathered from deep clefts in the rocks, the bananas
- are scanty, the mammee-apples unsatisfying, and the &ldquo;oranges&rdquo; are for the
- most part citrons, drinkable, as lemons are, but little use for anything
- else. Indeed, Niué is a useless place altogether, and nobody makes
- fortunes there now-a-days, though one or two did well out of the &ldquo;first
- skim&rdquo; of its trading, a generation ago. Nor does any one grow fat there,
- upon a diet of tinned meats, biscuit, and fruit. Nor are there any
- marvellous &ldquo;sights,&rdquo; like the volcanoes of Hawaii, or the tribe dancing
- and firewalking of Fiji. Still I loved Niué, and love it yet.
- </p>
- <p>
- It was so very far away, to begin with. In other islands, with regular
- steamers, people concerned themselves to some degree about the doings of
- the outer world, and used to wonder how things were getting on, beyond the
- still blue bar of sea. Newspapers arrived, people came and went, things
- were done at set times, more or less. One was still in touch with the
- world, though out of sight.
- </p>
- <p>
- But in Niué, the isolation was complete. There was no come and go. We were
- on the road to nowhere. Nobody knew when any communication with anywhere
- would be possible, so nobody troubled, and save for an occasional
- delirious day when a ship really did come in, and waked us all from our
- enchanted slumber for just So long as you might turn round and look about
- you before dropping off into dreams again, we were asleep to all that lay
- beyond the long horizon line below the seaward-leaning palms. Niué was the
- world. The rest was a cloudy dream.
- </p>
- <p>
- I rented a little cottage in the heart of a palm-grove, when I settled
- down to wait for the problematic return of the <i>Duchess</i>, and see the
- life of Niué. It belonged to a native couple, Kuru and Vekia, who were
- well-to-do, and had saved money selling copra. The Niuéan, unlike every
- other Polynesian, is always willing and anxious to make a bargain or do a
- deal of any kind, and Kuru and his wife were as delighted to get the
- chance of a &ldquo;let&rdquo; as any seaside landlady. They moved their small goods
- out of the house most readily, and left me in full possession of the two
- rooms and the verandah and the innumerable doors and windows, with
- everything else to find for myself.
- </p>
- <p>
- A general collection of furniture, taken up by a friendly white resident,
- resulted in the loan of a bed and a box and a table, three chairs, some
- cups and cutlery, and a jug and basin. These, with a saucepan lent by my
- landlady (who, as I have said, was rich, and possessed many superfluities
- of civilisation), made up the whole of my household goods. For two months
- I occupied the little house among the palms, and was happy. &ldquo;Can a man be
- more than happy?&rdquo; runs the Irish proverb, and answer there is none.
- </p>
- <p>
- There were never, in all my island wanderings, such shadows or such
- sunsets, as I saw in lonely Niué. The little house was far away from
- others, and the palms stood up round it close to the very door. In the
- white, white moonlight, silver-clear and still as snow, I used to stay for
- half a night on my verandah, sitting crosslegged in the darkness of the
- eaves, and watching the wonderful great stars of shadow drawn out, as if
- in ink, round the foot of every palm-tree. The perfect circle of tenderly
- curving rays lay for the most part still as some wonderful drawing about
- the foot of the tree; but at rare intervals, when the hour was very late,
- and even the whisper of the surf upon the reef seemed to have grown tired
- and dim and far away, the night would turn and sigh in its sleep for just
- a moment, and all the palm-tree fronds would begin to sway and shiver up
- in the sparkling moon-rays, glancing like burnished silver in the light.
- Then the star at the foot would dance and sway as well, and weave itself
- into forms of indescribable beauty, as if the spirit of Giotto of the
- marvellous circles were hovering unseen in the warm air of this alien
- country that he never knew, and pencilling forms more lovely than his
- mortal fingers ever drew on earth.... Yes, it was worth losing one&rsquo;s sleep
- for, in those magic island nights.
- </p>
- <p>
- In the daytime, I rode and walked a good deal about the island, which is
- very fairly provided with roads, and tried to find out what I could about
- the people and their ways. There is not a more interesting island in the
- Pacific than Niué, from an ethnological point of view; but my scientific
- knowledge was too contemptibly small to enable me to make use of my
- opportunities. This I regretted, for the place is full of strange
- survivals of ancient customs and characteristics, such as are seldom to be
- found among Christianised natives. The people are somewhat rude and rough
- in character; indeed until about forty years ago, they were actually
- dangerous. Their island is one of the finest of natural fortresses, and
- they used it as such, declining to admit strangers on any pretext. Captain
- Cook attempted to land in 1777, but was beaten off before he had succeeded
- in putting his boat&rsquo;s crew ashore. Other travellers for the most part gave
- the place a wide berth.
- </p>
- <p>
- When men of the island wandered away to other places (the Niuéan is a
- gipsy by nature) they received no kindly welcome on attempting to come
- home. The Niuéan had an exceeding fear of imported diseases, and to
- protect himself against them, he thought out a system of sanitary
- precaution, all on his own account, which was surely the completest the
- world has ever seen. There was no weak link in the chain: no break through
- which measles, or cholera, or worse could creep, during the absence of an
- official, or owing to the carelessness of an inspector. Every person
- attempting to land on Niué, be he sick or well, stranger, or native, was
- promptly killed! That was Niué&rsquo;s rule. You might go away from the island
- freely, but if you did, you had better not attempt to come back again, for
- the &ldquo;sanitary officers&rdquo; would knock your brains out on the shore. It was
- without doubt the simplest and best system of quarantine conceivable.
- Possibly as a result of this Draconian law, the people of Niué are
- remarkably strong and hardy to-day, though since the relaxation of the
- ancient rule, a certain amount of disease has crept in.
- </p>
- <p>
- The people, though warlike and fierce, were never cannibals here at the
- worst. They did not even eat their enemies when slain in battle. They
- enjoyed a fight very much, however, when they got the chance of one, and
- still remembered the Waterloo victory of their history, against the fierce
- Tongans, about two hundred years ago. The Tongans, until within the last
- half-century, seem to have been the Danes of the Pacific, always hunting
- and harrying some other maritime people, and always a name of terror to
- weak races. Tonga is the nearest land to Niué, being about three hundred
- miles away, so it was not to be expected that the Niuéans would escape
- invasion, and they were fully prepared for the Tongan attack when it did
- come. They did not attempt to meet force by force. There was one place
- they knew where the Tongans might succeed in landing, and near to this
- they laid a cunning plan for defence.
- </p>
- <p>
- A trader took me down to see the spot one Sunday afternoon. It is one of
- the numerous caves of Niué, with a top open for the most part to the sky.
- The cave runs underneath the greenery and the creeping flowers of the bush&mdash;a
- long black gash just showing here and there among the leaves. The drop is
- forty or fifty feet, and an unwary foot might very easily stumble over its
- edge, even now.
- </p>
- <p>
- On the day when the Tongan war canoes broke the level line of the sea
- horizon, the Niué men hastened to the shore, and prepared the cave in such
- a way as to set a fatal and most effective trap for their enemies. They
- cut down a mass of slight branches and leafy twigs, and covered the gulf
- completely, so that nothing was to be seen except the ordinary surface of
- the low-growing bush. When the enemies landed, the Niué men showed
- themselves on the farther side of the cave, as if fleeing into the woods.
- The Tongans, with yells of joy, rushed in pursuit, straight over the gulf&mdash;and
- in another moment were lying in crushed and dying heaps at the foot of the
- pit, while the men of Niué, dashing out of ambush on every side, ran down
- into the cave from its shallow end and butchered their enemies as they
- lay.
- </p>
- <p>
- After this, it is said that the Tongans left Niué alone.
- </p>
- <p>
- Because of the loneliness and inaccessibility of the place, the Savage
- Islanders have always been different from the rest of the Pacific. The
- typical &ldquo;Kanaka&rdquo; is straight-haired, light brown in colour, mild and
- gentle and generous in disposition, ready to welcome strangers and feast
- them hospitably. He is aristocratic to the backbone in his ideas, and
- almost always has a native class of nobles and princes, culminating in a
- hereditary king.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Savage Islander is often frizzy-haired, and generally a darkish brown
- in colour. His manners are rather brusque, and he gives nothing without
- obtaining a heavy price for it. He has no chiefs, nobles, or princes, and
- does not want any. There is always a head of the State, who enjoys a
- certain amount of mild dignity, and may be called the King for want of a
- better name. The office is not hereditary, however, the monarch being
- elected by the natives who form the island Parliament. Meetings of this
- Parliament are held at irregular intervals; and the King, together with
- the British Resident Commissioner, takes an important part in the debates.
- </p>
- <p>
- These are very formal affairs. The brown M.P.s who live, each in his own
- village, in the utmost simplicity of manners and attire, dress themselves
- up for the day in full suits of European clothing, very heavy and hot,
- instead of the light and comfortable cotton kilt they generally wear. They
- travel into Alofi and join the local members on the green before the
- public hall&mdash;generally used as a school-house. King Tongia joins
- them, the British Resident comes also, and for hour after hour, inside the
- great, cool hall, with its matted floor and many open window-embrasures,
- the talk goes on. This road is to be made, that banyan tree is to be
- removed, regulation pigsties are to be built in such a village, petitions
- are to be sent up to New Zealand about the tax on tobacco&mdash;and so on,
- and so on. The king is a tough old man; he has his say on most questions,
- and it is not considered generally good for health or business to oppose
- him too much; but of royal dignity he has, and asks for, none.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is something quite American in the history of Tongia&rsquo;s elevation,
- some seven years ago. He had acted as Prime Minister to the late head of
- the State; and when the latter died he calmly assumed the reins without
- going through the formality of an election. This was not the usual custom,
- and some of the members remonstrated. Tongia told them, however, that he
- was in the right, and meant to stay on. When the captain of a ship died on
- a voyage, did not his chief mate take over command? The cases were exactly
- parallel, to his mind. This argument pleased the members, who had most of
- them been to sea, and Tongia was allowed to retain his seat, the objectors
- calming themselves with the thought of the sovereign&rsquo;s age&mdash;he was
- well over eighty at that time. &ldquo;He is only the stump of a torch,&rdquo; they
- said; &ldquo;he will soon burn out.&rdquo; But the stump is burning yet, and shows no
- symptoms of extinction. Tongia married a pretty young girl soon after his
- &ldquo;election,&rdquo; settled down in the royal palace&mdash;a whitewashed cottage
- with a palm-thatch roof&mdash;and seems likely to outlast many of his
- former opponents.
- </p>
- <p>
- The powers of the king, limited as they are, have lessened since 1902,
- when New Zealand annexed Niué&mdash;a proceeding that had its humorous
- side, if one examines the map, for Niué is something like a thousand miles
- from Auckland. The Resident Commissioner who is responsible for the
- well-being of the island lives in a house much more like a palace than
- Tongia&rsquo;s modest hut, and is in truth the real ruler of the place. His
- work, however, is not overpowering. He is supposed to be judge and
- lawgiver, among many other duties, but in Niué no one ever seems to do
- anything that requires punishment. There is nothing in the shape of a
- prison, if any one did. Innocent little crimes, such as chicken stealing
- with extenuating circumstances, or allowing pigs to trespass into
- somebody&rsquo;s garden, occasionally blot the fair pages of the island records,
- but a little weeding, or a day&rsquo;s work on the road is considered sufficient
- punishment for these. At the time of my stay, which lasted nearly two
- months, such a wave of goodness seemed to be passing over the island that
- the Resident complained he could not find enough crime in the place to
- keep his garden weeded, and declared that he really wished somebody would
- do something, and do it quick, or all his imported flowers would be
- spoiled! Since the forties, missionaries have been busy in Savage Island,
- and there is no doubt that they have done their work effectively. The
- early traders, who arrived near the same time, also helped considerably in
- the civilisation of the natives. Drink has never been a trouble on Niué,
- and at the present date, no native ever tastes it, and strict regulations
- govern importation by the whites, for their own use. The natives are
- healthy, although European diseases are by no means unknown. Skin diseases
- are so troublesome that many of the traders wash the money they get from
- the bush towns, before handling, and the new-comer&rsquo;s first days in the
- island are sure to be harassed by the difficulties of avoiding
- miscellaneous hand-shaking. Knowing what one knows about the prevalence of
- skin-troubles, one does not care to run risks; but the Niuéan, like all
- islanders, has unfortunately learned the habit of continual hand-shaking
- from his earliest teachers, and is never likely to unlearn it. So the
- visitor who does not want to encounter disappointed faces and puzzled
- inquiries, looks out old gloves to go a-walking with, and burns them, once
- he or she is settled in the place, and no longer a novelty.
- </p>
- <p>
- There are manners in Niué&mdash;of a sort. &ldquo;Fanagé fei!&rdquo; is the greeting
- to any one met on the road, and it must not be left out, or the Savage
- Islanders will say you have no manners. It means, &ldquo;Where are you going?&rdquo;
- and it is not at all an empty inquiry, for you must mention the name of
- your destination in reply, and then repeat the inquiry on your own
- account, and listen for the answer. Riding across the island day by day, I
- used to pass in a perfect whirlwind of &ldquo;Where-are-you-goings?&rdquo; callings
- out hastily, as the horse cantered over the grassy road, &ldquo;Avatele,&rdquo; or
- &ldquo;Mutelau,&rdquo; (names of villages) or &ldquo;Misi Nicolasi&rdquo; (Mrs. Nicholas, a
- trader&rsquo;s wife), and adding as I passed on: &ldquo;Fanagé fei?&rdquo; to the man or
- woman who had greeted me. There was generally a long story in reply, but I
- fear I was usually out of hearing before it was ended. My manners, out
- riding, must have struck Niué as decidedly vulgar.
- </p>
- <p>
- It was during the first few days of my stay that I attained a distinction
- that I had never hoped to see, and that I am not at all likely to see
- again. I was made a headline; in a copybook! If that is not fame, what is?
- </p>
- <p>
- The native school-teacher&mdash;a brown, black-eyed and bearded man of
- middle age and dignified presence&mdash;had called at my house shortly
- after my arrival, to display his English and his importance, and welcome
- the stranger. He wanted, among a great many other things, to know what my
- name was, and how it was spelt. I wrote it down for him, and he carried it
- away, studying it the while. Next day, the copies set in the principal
- school for the youth of Niué consisted of my name in full, heading the
- following legend: &ldquo;While this lady is in Niué, we must all be very good.&rdquo;
- Evidently a case of &ldquo;Après moi le déluge!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- Sitting on a box in my cool little shady house of a morning, writing on my
- knee, with the whisper of the palms about the door, and the empty
- changeless blue sea lying below, I used to receive visitor after visitor,
- calling on different errands&mdash;some to sit on the verandah and look at
- me in silence; some to come in, squat on the floor, and discourse fluently
- for half an hour in a language I did not understand (they never seemed
- distressed by the absence of replies); some to sell curios; some to give
- dinners!
- </p>
- <p>
- You give dinners in Niué in a strictly literal sense. Instead of bringing
- the guest to the dinner, you take the dinner to the guests and then wait
- to see it eaten. It generally consists of a baked fish wrapped in leaves,
- several lumps of yam, hot and moist, and as heavy as iron, a pudding made
- of mashed pumpkin and breadfruit, another made of bananas, sugarcane, and
- cocoanut, some arrowroot boiled to jelly, and the inevitable taro top and
- cocoanut cream&mdash;about which I must confess I was rather greedy. The
- rest of the dinner I used to accept politely, as it was set out on the
- floor, eat a morsel or two here and there, and afterwards hand over the
- remainder to Kuru and his wife, who were always ready to dispose of it. At
- the beginning, I used to offer gifts in return, which were always refused.
- Then, acting on the advice of old residents, I reserved the gift for a day
- or two, and presented it at the first suitable opportunity. It was always
- readily accepted, when offered after this fashion, and thus I learned one
- more lesson as to island etiquette.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;You&rsquo;ll see a lot of stuff in travel books,&rdquo; said an old resident to me,
- &ldquo;about the wonderful generosity of the island people, all over the Pacific&mdash;how
- they press gifts of every kind on travellers, and won&rsquo;t take any return.
- Well, that&rsquo;s true, and it&rsquo;s not true. All the island people love
- strangers, and are new-fangled with every fresh face, and they do come
- along with presents, but as to not wanting a return, why, that isn&rsquo;t quite
- the case. They won&rsquo;t take payment, mostly, and there&rsquo;s very few places
- where they&rsquo;ll even take a present, right off. But they always expect
- something back, some time. I know that isn&rsquo;t what the books say, but books
- are mostly wrong about anything you&rsquo;ve got to go below the top of things
- to see&mdash;and the traveller likes that pretty idea, of getting presents
- for nothing, too much to give it up easily. Still, you may take my word
- for it that the natives <i>will</i> take a return for anything and
- everything they give you, here and everywhere else, unless it&rsquo;s a drink of
- cocoanut, or a bit of fruit they offer you on the road, or maybe a bit of
- dinner, if you&rsquo;d drop in on them at meals. Set presents you&rsquo;ve got to pay
- for, and more than their value too, if you take them. I don&rsquo;t myself, I
- find native presents too expensive.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- What do you want to give? Oh, well, if a woman brings you in a dinner or
- two, give her a trade silk handkerchief, one of those shilling ones, some
- day. Or if they bring you baskets of fruit, give them a couple of sticks
- of tobacco. They&rsquo;ll take payment for fruit here, in that way, at any time.
- You&rsquo;ll need to give some things when you&rsquo;re going away, to the people
- you&rsquo;ve seen most of&mdash;a few yards of cotton, or something of that
- kind. White people are expected to give presents, all over the island&mdash;it
- needn&rsquo;t be dear things, but it ought to be something.
- </p>
- <p>
- If the lords and folk who have been round the Pacific in their yachts only
- heard what the natives say of them, because they didn&rsquo;t know that, they&rsquo;d
- take care to bring a case or two of cheap stuff for presents next time.
- &lsquo;Not chief-like,&rsquo; is what the natives say&mdash;and I ask you yourself, it
- isn&rsquo;t &lsquo;chief-like,&rsquo; is it, to take all you can get, and give not a stick
- of niggerhead or an inch of ribbon in return?
- </p>
- <p>
- I&rsquo;d think they&rsquo;d be too proud&mdash;but then, I&rsquo;m not a tourist trotting
- round the globe, I&rsquo;m only a man who works for his living.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;As for yourself, you take my advice, and say right out you don&rsquo;t want the
- dinners, when they bring them. Yes, it&rsquo;ll offend them, but you must either
- do that, or pay for stuff you don&rsquo;t want three days out of seven, or six
- days, more likely, if they think you&rsquo;re liberal-minded. You&rsquo;ll get no end
- of presents when you&rsquo;re going away, pretty things enough, and those will
- have to be paid for in presents, too. Better make it as cheap as you can,
- meantime.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;But those people who go travelling like princes, and load their cabins up
- with spears and clubs and tappa-cloths and shells the natives have given
- them everywhere they went&mdash;and not a farthing, or a farthing&rsquo;s worth,
- do they let it cost them from end to end&mdash;I tell you, they&rsquo;re a
- disgrace to England,&rdquo; concluded my informant hotly.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0027" id="linkimage-0027"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0259.jpg" alt="0259 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0259.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- &ldquo;I am quite sure it is simply because they do not know&mdash;how should
- they?&rdquo; I asked, trying to defend the absent globe-trotters.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Decent feeling ought to teach them!&rdquo; declared the critic of manners, who
- was evidently not to be pacified.
- </p>
- <p>
- I had my dinner to cook, so I went away, and left him still revolving the
- iniquities of travelling milords in his memory. But I did not forget the
- conversation, for it seemed to me that the facts about this matter of
- present-giving and taking ought to be known as widely as possible. In
- nearly two years of island travel that followed after those days, I had
- full opportunity of proving the truth of the statements made by my Niué
- acquaintance, and every experience only served to confirm them.
- </p>
- <p>
- Travellers who visit the islands should note this fact, and lay in a stock
- of suitable goods at Sydney, which is the starting point for most Pacific
- travel. There are various firms who make a speciality of island trade, and
- these will usually sell any reasonable quantity at wholesale prices. The
- natives of the Pacific, in general, are not to be put off with worthless
- trifles as presents, nor do they care for beads, unless in the few groups
- still remaining uncivilised. They like best the sort of goods with which
- they are already familiar, and do not care for &ldquo;imported&rdquo; novelties. Silk
- handkerchiefs are liked everywhere, and they are easy to carry. Cotton or
- silk stuff is much valued. Imitation jewellery&mdash;brooches, pins, etc.&mdash;is
- valued quite as much as real, except in Niué, where the natives seem to
- have a natural craving and liking for precious metals. Tinned foods of all
- kinds, and sweets, are perhaps better appreciated than anything else.
- Tinned salmon in especial, is the safest kind of &ldquo;tip&rdquo; than can be given
- to any native, from a lordly Samoan chief, down to a wild &ldquo;bushie&rdquo; from
- the Solomons.
- </p>
- <p>
- Withal, one must not take away the character of the island world for
- hospitality, because of its childlike fancy for presents. Many and many a
- destitute white man can tell of the true generosity and ungrudging
- kindness he has met with at the hands of the gentle brown men and women,
- when luck was hard and the whites would have none of him. They are not
- fair-weather friends, in the European sense of the word. True, when the
- weather is sunny with you, they will come round and bask in the warmth,
- and share your good luck. But when the rainy days come, they will share
- all they have with you, just as freely, and they will not look for
- presents, then.
- </p>
- <p>
- The industries of the island filled up many a pleasant morning. Niué is
- supposed to be the most hard-working of all the Pacific islands, and
- certainly its people do not seem to eat the bread of idleness. Here, there
- is no lounging and dreaming and lotus-eating on the sounding coral shore&mdash;perhaps
- there isn&rsquo;t much shore anyway; perhaps because the Savage Islander is not
- made that way. The food of the people consists largely of yams, and in a
- country which has hardly any depth of soil, these are hard to grow, and
- need care. The bananas are grown in the most wonderful way in the clefts
- of the coral rocks, so that they actually appear to be springing out of
- the stone. Copra is made in fair quantity, and many of the people spend
- the greater part of their time collecting a certain kind of fungus which
- is exported to Sydney, and used (or so report declares) for making an
- imitation of birds&rsquo; nest soup in China.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0028" id="linkimage-0028"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0267.jpg" alt="0267 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0267.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- The proportion of women on the island is very large, because there are
- always at least a thousand men, out of a total population of five thousand
- souls, away working elsewhere. The Niuéan is a bit of a miser, and will do
- anything for money. He engages, therefore, as a labourer in the
- plantations of Samoa, where the natives will not do any work they can
- avoid, or goes up to Malden Island to the guano pits, or takes a year or
- two at sea on an island schooner, or goes away as fireman on the
- missionary steamer&mdash;anything to make money. Meantime his women-kind
- stay at home and keep themselves. They work about the white people&rsquo;s
- houses, they act as stevedores to the ships, they fetch and carry all over
- the island. When I wanted two heavy trunks conveyed a distance of six
- miles one day, four sturdy Niué girls came to do the work; slung the
- trunks on two poles, trotted away with them, and reached the end of the
- journey before my lazy horse had managed to carry me to my destination.
- They do an immense amount of plaiting work&mdash;mats, fans, baskets, and
- above all, hats, of which the annual export runs into thousands of dozens.
- These hats are made of fine strips of dried and split pandanus leaf; they
- much resemble the coarser kind of Panama, and give excellent shade and
- wear. They are worn over the whole Pacific, and a great part of New
- Zealand, and, I strongly suspect, are exported to England under the name,
- and at the price of second-grade Panamas. A clever worker will finish one
- in a day. Much of the plaiting is done in caves in the hot season, as the
- material must be kept fairly cool and moist.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0029" id="linkimage-0029"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0276.jpg" alt="0276 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0276.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- When the Niué folks are not working, they idle a little at times, but not
- very much. They sing in chorus occasionally, but it is not an absorbing
- occupation with them, and they do not dance a great deal either, since the
- advent of missionary rule. Their chief amusement is an odd one&mdash;walking
- round the island. You can scarcely take a long ride without encountering a
- stray picnic party of natives, mostly women, striding along at a good
- round pace, and heavily laden with fruit, food, and mats. They always
- complete the journey&mdash;forty miles&mdash;in a day, picknicking on the
- roadside for meals, and seem to enjoy themselves thoroughly. The strenuous
- life, exemplified after this fashion, is certainly the last thing one
- would expect to find in the Pacific. But then, the great fascination of
- the island world lies in the fact that here, as nowhere else, &ldquo;only the
- unexpected happens.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <p>
- It is a day of molten gold, with a sea coloured like a sheet of sapphire
- glass in a cathedral window. I am busy washing up my breakfast things at
- the door (there is no false shame about the performance of domestic duties
- in the capital city of Niué) when a couple of native girls appear on the
- grass pathway, their wavy hair loose and flowing, their white muslin
- dresses kilted up high over strong brown limbs. Each carries a clean
- &ldquo;pareo&rdquo; in her hand. They are going for a swim, one of them informs me in
- broken English: will I come too?
- </p>
- <p>
- Of course I will. I get out my own bathing dress, and follow the pair down
- the cliff, scrambling perilously from crag to crag, until we reach a point
- where it is possible to get down on to the narrow rocky ledge at the verge
- of the sea. Within the reef here there is a splendid stretch of protected
- water, peacock-blue in colour, immensely deep, and almost cold. There are
- no sharks about here, the girls tell me, and it is an excellent place for
- a swim.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0030" id="linkimage-0030"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0288.jpg" alt="0288 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0288.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Oh, for a Royal Academician to paint the picture made by the younger girl,
- as she stands on the edge of the rocks ready to leap in, dressed in a
- bright blue scarf that is wound round and round her graceful bronze body
- from shoulder to knee, and parting her full wavy hair aside with slender
- dark fingers! Beauty of form did not die out with the ancient Greeks: the
- Diana of the Louvre and the Medici Venus may be seen any day of any year,
- on the shores of the far-away islands, by those who know lovely line when
- they see it, and have not given over their senses, bound and blinded, to
- the traditions of the schools. If there is any man in the world to-day who
- can handle a hammer and chisel as Phidias did, let him come to the South
- Sea Islands and look there for the models that made the ancient Greek
- immortal. The sculptor who can mould a young island girl, Tahitian for the
- Venus type, Samoan for the Diana, or a young island chief, like Mercury,
- in bronze, will give the world something as exquisite and as immortal as
- any marvel from the hand of Phidias or Praxiteles.
- </p>
- <p>
- My beautiful Niué girl was an exception, so far as her own island went.
- Niué women are strong and well made, but not lovely as a rule. Her
- companion was as sturdy as a cart-horse, but as plain as a pig. She smoked
- a huge pipe, chewed plug tobacco, and laughed like a hyena. They were
- truly a well-contrasted pair.
- </p>
- <p>
- The reef was a good way off, so we all struck out for that, when we came
- up panting and blowing from our dive. The girls gave me a fine exhibition
- of under-water swimming now and then, slipping easily underneath the
- gleaming surface, and disappearing from view below, for so long a time
- that one became quite nervous. My pretty little friend persuaded me to
- accompany her once, and though I did not like it among the ugly-looking
- coral caves, I dived for a short time, and endeavoured to follow her
- flying heels.
- </p>
- <p>
- Under water among the coral reefs! It sounds romantic, but it was not
- pleasant. Five feet beneath the surface, the light was as clear as day,
- and one could see all about one, far too much, for the things that were
- visible were disquieting. I knew extremely well that coral reefs are the
- haunt of every kind of unpleasant sea-beast, and I fancied Victor Hugo&rsquo;s
- &ldquo;pieuvre&rdquo; at the very least, within the gloomy arch of every cave. There
- were far too many fish also, and they were much too impertinent, and a
- fish in one&rsquo;s hair, even if harmless, is not nice. I had not gone down
- much over a fathom, when I turned, and began to beat upwards again looking
- eagerly at the light. And then I saw a thing that as nearly as possible
- made me open my mouth and drown myself.
- </p>
- <p>
- It was merely a bunch of black waving trailers, coming out of the dark of
- the rocks, and spreading between me and the pale-green light of day. I did
- not know what it was, and I do not know, to this day. And, like the
- runaway soldier in the poem, &ldquo;I don&rsquo;t know where I went to, for I didn&rsquo;t
- stop to see.&rdquo; I was on the top of the water, twenty yards away, and
- swimming at racing speed, when I realised the fact that I was still alive,
- some moments later. And on the surface I stayed, for the rest of the swim.
- The native girls were exceedingly amused, for the islander fears nothing
- that is in the water or under it; but I did not mind their laughing.
- </p>
- <p>
- One of them then, as she swam along, began laying her mouth to the surface
- of the water, and blowing bubbles, laughing all the time. She insisted
- that I should do it too, and I imitated her, at which she seemed
- delighted. &ldquo;That what we doing, suppose some shark come,&rdquo; she explained,
- &ldquo;shark he plenty frighten, no like that.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- We practised this useful accomplishment for some time, and then went
- ashore again. I regret to say that I roused the amusement of my companions
- yet again, before we landed, by making hasty exclamations, and dodging
- rapidly away from the embraces of a black-and-white banded snake, about
- four feet long, that suddenly appeared from nowhere in particular, moving
- very swiftly, and seemed disposed to argue the right of way. The lagoon at
- Raratonga had not prepared me for the Zoological Garden in which one had
- to bathe at Niué.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Snake he no harm,&rdquo; said my Venus Anadyomene, as she stood on the rock,
- with her bathing scarf in her hand, wringing it out in the calmest manner
- in the world.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Plenty-plenty snake stop there.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- There were indeed plenty of snakes. One could see them any fine day from
- the top of the cliffs, gliding through the water below, or lying on the
- rocks in family parties of a score or two, conspicuous at a great
- distance, because of their handsome black-and-white banded skins. As to
- there being no harm&mdash;well, I never heard of any one in Niué being
- injured. But a boy in Fiji trod on one of these checkerboarded creatures,
- about that time, and died in half an hour from its bite. I am strongly
- inclined to think that the Niué snake is poisonous, like almost all
- sea-snakes, though it does not seem at all ready to attack.
- </p>
- <p>
- What was it I saw under water? I never knew, but I guessed as much as I
- wanted, a day or two later, when I saw a native, fishing on the reef near
- my bathing-place, draw up a big devil-fish, with eight limp dangling arms&rsquo;
- over six feet long, and carry it away. A trader told me that he had once
- pulled up one himself, while out fishing in a light canoe, and that it
- seized hold of the little boat, and made such a fight that he barely
- escaped with his life. It is the pleasant habit of this fish, when
- attacked by a human being, to fling its hideous tentacles over his head
- and face, and force them up into eyes, nostrils, and mouth, so as to
- suffocate him, if he cannot master the creature.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Do you think there were any sharks about the day I bathed?&rdquo; I inquired.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Well, if the girls were blowing, I should say there must have been. They
- wouldn&rsquo;t do it for fun altogether,&rdquo; he replied.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Surely they wouldn&rsquo;t bathe, if they knew there were any about?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Oh, wouldn&rsquo;t they, though! <i>They</i> don&rsquo;t mind them. No native is
- afraid of anything in the sea.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- I believed this with reservations, until a day came in another island,
- when I nearly furnished a dinner for a shark myself, and thenceforth gave
- up bathing in unprotected tropical waters, for good. It was in Rakahanga,
- many hundreds of miles nearer the Line, and I had left the schooner to
- enjoy a walk and a bathe. A native Rakahangan girl, who had never seen a
- white woman before, and was wildly excited at the thought of going bathing
- with this unknown wonder, found a boat for me, and allowed me to pick my
- own place in the inner lagoon of the island. I chose a spot where the
- lagoon narrowed into a bottle-neck communicating with the sea, and
- we-started our swim. The girl, however, much to my surprise, would not go
- more than a few yards from the boat, and declined to follow me when I
- struck out for the open water. I had been assured by her, so far as my
- scanty knowledge of Maori allowed me to understand, that there were no
- sharks, so her conduct seemed incomprehensible until a stealthy black fin,
- shaped like the mainsail of a schooner, rose out of the water a few score
- yards away, and began making for me!
- </p>
- <p>
- The native girl was first into the boat, but I was assuredly not long
- after her. The back fin did not follow, once I was out of the water. But
- the heat of that burning day far up towards the Line, was hardly enough to
- warm me, for half an hour afterwards.
- </p>
- <p>
- I found, on asking the question that I should have asked first of all,
- that the bottle-neck entrance of the lagoon was a perfect death-trap of
- sharks, and that more than one native had been eaten there.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Why on earth did the girl tell me there were none, and why did she
- venture into such a place herself?&rdquo; I asked.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Well,&rdquo; said the only white man on the island, &ldquo;I should think she knew
- that any shark will take a white person, and leave a native, if there&rsquo;s a
- choice. And if you had that red bathing-dress on that you&rsquo;re carrying,
- why, you were simply making bait of yourself!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;But why should she want to see me killed?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Oh, she didn&rsquo;t. She only wanted to have the fun of a bathe with a white
- woman, and just took the chances!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- So much about bathing, in the &ldquo;sunny isles of Eden.&rdquo; One is sorry to be
- obliged to say that it is one of the disappointments of the Pacific. Warm,
- brilliant water, snowy coral sands, and glancing fish of rainbow hues, are
- charming accompaniments to a bath, no doubt, but they are too dearly paid
- for when snakes, sharks, sting-rays, and devil-fish have to be counted
- into the party.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <p>
- Nothing in curious Niué is quite so curious as the native fancies about
- ghosts and devils. In spite of their Christianity, they still hold fast to
- all their ancient superstitions about the powers of evil.
- </p>
- <p>
- Every Savage Islander believes, quite as a matter of course, that ghosts
- walk the roads and patrol the lonely bush, all night long. Some are
- harmless spirits, many are malignant devils. After dark has fallen, about
- six o&rsquo;clock, no one dares to leave his house except for some very
- important errand; and if it is necessary to go out so late as nine or ten
- o&rsquo;clock, a large party will go together&mdash;this even in the town
- itself. Every native has a dog or two, of a good barking watchdog breed,
- not to protect property, for theft is unknown, but to drive away ghosts at
- night! Devil possession is believed in firmly. When a man, takes sick, his
- neighbours try, in a friendly manner, to &ldquo;drive the devil out of him.&rdquo;
- Perhaps they hang him up by his thumbs; possibly they put his feet in
- boiling water, causing fearful scalds; or they may drive sharks&rsquo; teeth
- into him here and there. But the most popular method is plain and simple
- squeezing, to squeeze the devil out! This often results in broken ribs,
- and occasionally in death. It is a curious fact, in connection with this
- &ldquo;squeezing,&rdquo; that the natives are remarkably expert &ldquo;masseurs,&rdquo; and can
- &ldquo;drive the devil&rdquo; out of a sprain, or a headache, or an attack of
- neuralgia, by what seems to be a clever combination of the &ldquo;pétrissage&rdquo;
- and &ldquo;screw&rdquo; movement of massage. This, they say, annoys the devil so much
- that he goes away. Applied to the trunk, however, and carried out with the
- utmost strength of two or three powerful men, Savage Islander massage
- is-(as above stated) often fatal&mdash;and small wonder!
- </p>
- <p>
- When a man has died, from natural or unnatural causes, a great feast is
- held of baked pig and fowl, yams, taro, fish, and cocoanuts. Presents are
- given to the dead man&rsquo;s relatives, as at a wedding, and other presents are
- returned by them to the men who dig the grave. The corpse is placed in a
- shallow hole, wrapped in costly mats; and then begins the ghostly life of
- the once-loved husband or father, who now becomes a haunting terror to
- those of his own household. Over his grave they erect a massive tomb of
- concrete and lime, meant to discourage him, so far as possible, from
- coming out to revisit the upper world. They gather together roots of the
- splendid scarlet poinsettia, gorgeous hibiscus, and graceful wine-coloured
- foliage plants, and place them about his tomb, to make it attractive to
- him. They collect his most cherished possessions&mdash;his &ldquo;papalangi&rdquo;
- (white man&rsquo;s) bowler hat, which he used to wear on Sundays at the five
- long services in the native church; his best trousers; his orange-coloured
- singlet with pink bindings; his tin mug and plate&mdash;and place them on
- the grave. Savage Island folk are very avaricious and greedy; yet not a
- soul will dare to touch these valuable goods; they lie on the grave, in
- sun and storm, until rotted or broken. If it is a woman&rsquo;s grave, you may
- even see her little hand sewing-machine (almost every island in the
- Pacific possesses scores of these) placed on the tomb, to amuse the ghost
- in its leisure hours. There will be a bottle of cocoanut hair-oil, too,
- scented with &ldquo;tieré&rdquo; flowers, and perhaps a little looking-glass or comb&mdash;so
- that we can picture the spirit of the dark-eyed island girls, like
- mermaids, coming forth at night to sit in the moonlight and dress their
- glossy hair&mdash;if ghosts indeed have hair like mortal girls!
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0031" id="linkimage-0031"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0296.jpg" alt="0296 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0296.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Mosquito-curtains, somewhat tattered by the wind, can be seen on many
- graves, carefully stretched over the tomb on the regulation uprights and
- cross-pieces, as over a bed. This is, no doubt, intended to help the ghost
- to lie quiet, lest the mosquitoes should annoy it so much that it be
- driven to get up and walk about. Certainly, if a Savage Island ghost does
- walk, it is not because every care is not taken to make it (as the
- Americans would say) &ldquo;stay put.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- There are no graveyards on the island. Every man is buried on his own
- land, very often alongside the road, or close to his house. The thrifty
- islanders plant onions and pumpkins on the earth close about the tomb, and
- enjoy the excellent flavour imparted to these vegetables by the essence of
- dead ancestor which they suck up through the soil. In odd contradiction to
- this economical plan, a &ldquo;tapu&rdquo; is placed upon all the cocoanut trees owned
- by the deceased; and for a year or more valuable nuts are allowed to lie
- where they fall, sprouting into young plants, and losing many tons of
- copra annually to the island. Groups of palms unhealthily crowded
- together, bear witness everywhere to the antiquity of this strange
- practice.
- </p>
- <p>
- The main, and indeed the only good road, across the island, owns a spot of
- fearsome reputation. On a solitary tableland, swept by salt sea-winds,
- stand certain groups of clustered cocoa-palms, sprung from tapu&rsquo;s nuts on
- dead men&rsquo;s lands. Here the natives say, the ghosts and devils have great
- power, and it is dangerous to walk there at night alone, even for white
- men, who take little account of native spirits. Many of the white traders
- of the island are shy of the spot; and some say that when riding in
- parties across the island at night, their horses shy and bolt passing the
- place, and exhibit unaccountable fear. Only a year or two ago, a terrible
- thing happened in this desolate spot, as if to prove the truth of local
- traditions. There was one native of the island, a &ldquo;witch-doctor,&rdquo; learned
- in charms and spells, who professed not to be afraid of the devils. He
- could manage them, he said; and to prove it, he used sometimes to walk
- alone across the island at night. One morning, he did not return from an
- excursion of this nature. The villagers set out in a body to look for him
- in the broad light of the tropical sun. They found him, at the haunted
- spot, lying on the ground dead. His face was black and his body horribly
- contorted. The devils had fought him, and conquered him&mdash;so the
- natives said. And now no gold would induce a Savage Islander to pass the
- fatal spot after dark.
- </p>
- <p>
- I asked the white missionary doctor resident at the time of my visit on
- the island, if he could account for the death. He said that he had not
- held a post-mortem and therefore could not say what the cause might be;
- but the appearance of the corpse was undoubtedly as described by the
- natives.
- </p>
- <p>
- Being anxious to investigate the truth of these stories, I determined to
- spend a night on the spot, and see what happened. The natives were
- horrified beyond measure at the idea; and when an accident on a coral reef
- laid me up from walking exercise until just before the schooner called
- again at the island to take me away&mdash;thus preventing me from carrying
- out the plan&mdash;they were one and all convinced that the fall was the
- work of devils, anxious to prevent me from meddling with their doings!
- </p>
- <p>
- The problem, then, remained unsolved, and rests open to any other
- traveller to investigate. But as Savage Island lies far off the track of
- the wandering tourist, its ghosts are likely to remain undisturbed in
- their happy hunting-grounds for the present.
- </p>
- <p>
- Mrs. Joe Gargery would certainly have liked Niué, for it is a place where
- there is none of the &ldquo;pompeying&rdquo; so obnoxious to her Spartan soul. And
- yet, if you stay there long, you will find out that Savage Island
- practises certain of the early Christian virtues, if it has dropped a few
- of its luxuries manufactured by civilisation. If you want a horse to ride
- across the island&mdash;a gentle, native creature that goes off at both
- ends, like a fire-cracker, when you try to mount, biting and kicking
- simultaneously, and, when mounted, converts your ride into a sandwich of
- jibbing and bolting, you will call in at the nearest trader&rsquo;s, and tell
- him you want his horse and his neighbour&rsquo;s saddle and whip. All these will
- appear at your door, with a couple of kindly messages, in half an hour.
- You will time your arrival at the different villages so as to hit off some
- one&rsquo;s meal-hours, walk in, ask for a help of the inevitable curried tin,
- and carry off a loaf of bread or a lump of cake, if your host happens to
- have baked that morning and you have not. When a ship comes in&mdash;perhaps
- the bi-yearly steamer from Samoa, with real mutton and beef in her
- ice-chest&mdash;and the capital gorges for two days, you, the stranger
- within their gates, will meet hot chops walking up to your verandah
- between two hot plates, and find confectioners&rsquo; paper bags full of
- priceless New Zealand potatoes, sitting on your doorstep. You will learn
- to shed tears of genuine emotion at the sight of a rasher of bacon, and to
- accept with modest reluctance the almost too valuable gift of one real
- onion. Hospitality among the white folk of Savage Island is hospitality,
- and no mistake, and its real generosity can only be appreciated by those
- who know the supreme importance assumed by &ldquo;daily bread,&rdquo; when the latter
- is dependent upon the rare and irregular calls of passing ships.
- </p>
- <p>
- For, like a good many Pacific Islands, this coral land is more beautiful
- than fertile. Its wild fantastic rocks, which make up the whole surface of
- the island, produce in their clefts and hollows enough yam, taro, banana,
- and papaw to feed the natives; but the white man wants more. Tins are his
- only resource&mdash;tins and biscuits, for flour does not keep long, and
- bread is often unattainable. Fowls or eggs can seldom be bought, for the
- reason that some one imported a number of cats many years ago; these were
- allowed to run wild in the bush, and have now become wild in earnest,
- devouring fowls, and even attacking dogs and young pigs at times. Why,
- then, if the island is valueless to Europeans, and the life hard, do white
- men live in Savage Island and many similar places? For the reason that
- fortunes have been piled up, in past years, by trading in such isolated
- spots, and that there is still money to be made, though not so much as of
- old. Trading in the Pacific is a double-barrelled sort of business. You
- settle down on an island where there is a good supply of copra (dried
- cocoa-nut kernel, manufactured by the natives). You buy the copra from the
- islanders at about £8 a ton, store it away in your copra-house until the
- schooner or the steamer calls, and then ship it off to Sydney, where it
- sells at £13 to £14 a ton. Freight and labour in storing and getting on
- board, eat into the profits. But, in addition to buying, the trader sells.
- He has a store, where cheap prints, violent perfumes, gaudy jewellery,
- tapes and buttons and pins and needles, tins of beef, shoes, etc., are
- sold to the natives at a price which leaves a very good profit on their
- cost down in Auckland.
- </p>
- <p>
- The laws of all the Pacific Colonies forbid the white trader to buy from
- the natives, except with cash; but, as the cash comes back to him before
- long over the counter of the store, it comes to much the same in the end
- as the old barter system of the early days, out of which money used to be,
- quickly and easily made. Sometimes the trader, if in a small way of
- business, sells his copra to captains of calling ships at a smaller price
- than the Auckland value. But nowadays so many stores are owned by big Auckland
- and Sydney firms that most of the stuff is shipped off for sale in New
- Zealand or Australia. &ldquo;Panama&rdquo; hats, already mentioned, are a very
- important article of commerce here. Every island has some speciality of
- its own besides the inevitable copra; and the trader deals in all he can
- get. The trader&rsquo;s life is, as a rule, a pleasant one enough. Savage Island
- is one of the worst places where he could find himself; and yet the days
- pass happily enough in that solitary outlier of civilisation. There is not
- much work to do; the climate is never inconveniently hot; the scenery,
- especially among the up-country primaeval forests, is very lovely. There
- is a good deal of riding and bathing, a little shooting, and a myriad of
- wild and fantastic caves to explore when the spirit moves one. The native
- canoes are easy to manage and excellent to fish from.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0032" id="linkimage-0032"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0303.jpg" alt="0303 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0303.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- It is traditional in Savage Island for the few white people&mdash;almost
- all rival traders&mdash;to hang together, and live in as friendly a manner
- as a great family party. If the great world is shut out, its cares are
- shut away, and life sits lightly on all. No one can be extravagant; no one
- can &ldquo;keep up appearances&rdquo; at the cost of comfort; no one is over-anxious,
- or worried, or excited over anything&rsquo;&mdash;except when the rare, the
- long-expected ship comes in, and the natives rend the air with yells of
- joy, and the girls cocoanut-oil their hair, and the white men rush for
- clean duck suits and fresh hats, and the mails come in, and the news is
- distributed, and cargoes go out, and every one feasts from dawn till dusk,
- and all the island is in a state of frantic ebullition for at least three
- days. Then, indeed, Niué is alive.
- </p>
- <p>
- We were all getting hungry when the <i>Duchess</i> came in again, after
- nearly two months&rsquo; absence, for provisions were short, and most of us had
- come down to eating little green parrots out of the bush, and enjoying
- them, for want of anything better. It was certainly tantalising to see the
- ship off the island beating about for three days and more, before she was
- able to approach, but that is an usual incident in Niué. She came up at
- last, and I got my traps on board, and paid my bills, and carried away the
- model canoes and shell necklaces, and plaited hats and baskets, that were
- brought me as parting presents, and gave-a number of yards of cotton
- cloth, and a good many silk handkerchiefs, in return. And so the big sails
- were hoisted once more with a merry rattling and flapping, and away we
- went, northward a thousand miles, to desolate, burning Penrhyn and Malden
- Island.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0011" id="link2HCH0011"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER XI
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>A Life on the Ocean Wave&mdash;Where They kept the Dynamite&mdash;How
- far from an Iced Drink?&mdash;The Peacefulness of a Pacific Calm&mdash;A
- Golden Dust Heap&mdash;Among the Rookeries&mdash;Sailing on the Land&mdash;All
- about Guano.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">T</span>HE pirate captain
- was gone when the schooner reappeared off Niué, and a certain ancient
- mariner had taken his place. Things were not quite so exciting on the <i>Duchess</i>
- under the new régime, but the order which reigned on board was something
- awful; for the ancient mariner had been a whaling captain in his day, and
- on whaling ships it is more than on any others a case of &ldquo;Growl you may,
- but go you must,&rdquo; for all the crew. The ancient mariner was as salty a
- salt as ever sailed the ocean. He had never been on anything with steam in
- it, he was as tough as ship-yard teak, and as strong as a bear, though he
- was a grandfather of some years&rsquo; standing, and he was full of strange wild
- stories about the whaling grounds, and odd happenings in out-of-the-way
- comers of the Pacific&mdash;most of which he seemed to consider the merest
- commonplaces of a prosaic existence.
- </p>
- <p>
- We suffered many things from the cook, in the course of that long burning
- voyage towards the Line. The <i>Duchess&rsquo;s</i> stores were none of the
- best, and the cook dealt with them after a fashion that made me understand
- once for all the sailor saying: &ldquo;God sends meat, and the devil sends
- cooks.&rdquo; Pea-soup, salt pork and beef, plum duff, ship&rsquo;s biscuit, sea-pie&mdash;this
- was the sort of food that, in the days before I set foot on the <i>Duchess</i>,
- I had supposed to form the usual table of sailing vessels. I fear it was a
- case of sea-story-books, over again. What we did get was &ldquo;tinned rag&rdquo; of a
- peculiarly damp and viscous quality, tea that usually tasted of
- cockroaches, biscuit that was so full of copra bugs we had to hammer it on
- the table before eating it, an occasional tin of tasteless fruit (it ran
- out very soon), and bread that was a nightmare, for the flour went musty
- before we were out a week, and the unspeakable cook tried to disguise its
- taste with sugar. Board-of-trade limejuice, which is a nauseous dose at
- best, we were obliged, by law to carry, and I think we must have run
- rather near scurvy in the course of that long trip, for the amount of the
- oily, drug-flavoured liquid that the mates and myself used to drink at
- times, seemed to argue a special craving of nature. But <i>à la guerre
- comme à la guerre</i>&mdash;and one does not take ship on a Pacific
- windjammer expecting the luxuries of a P. and O.
- </p>
- <p>
- We were not going direct to Malden, having to call first at Samoa and
- Mangaia. Three days of rough rolling weather saw us in Apia, about which I
- have nothing to say at present, since I paid a longer visit to Stevenson&rsquo;s
- country later on. We had about forty native passengers to take on here for
- the Cook Islands and Malden. There was nowhere to put them, but in the
- South Seas such small inconveniences trouble nobody.
- </p>
- <p>
- I am very strongly tempted here to tell about the big-gale that caught us
- the first night out, carried away our lifeboat, topsail, topgallant, and
- main gaff, swamped the unlucky passengers&rsquo; cabin, and caused the Cingalese
- steward to compose and chant all night long a litany containing three
- mournful versicles: &ldquo;O my God, this is too much terrible! O my#God, why I
- ever go to sea! O my God, I never go to sea again!&rdquo; But in the Pacific one
- soon learns that sea etiquette makes light of such matters. So the
- wonderful and terrible sights which I saw once or twice that night,
- clinging precariously to anything solid near the door of my cabin, and
- hoping that the captain would not catch me out on deck, must remain
- undescribed.
- </p>
- <p>
- Nearly seven weeks were occupied by this northern trip&mdash;time for a
- mail steamer to go out from London to New Zealand, and get well started on
- the way home again. We were, of course, entirely isolated from news and
- letters; indeed, the mails and papers that we carried conveyed the very
- latest intelligence to islands that had not had a word from the outer
- world for many months. Our native passengers, who were mostly going up to
- Malden Island guano works as paid labourers, evidently considered the trip
- one wild scene of excitement and luxury. The South Sea Islander loves
- nothing more than change, and every new island we touched at was a Paris
- or an Ostend to these (mostly) untravelled natives. Their accommodation on
- the ship was not unlike that complained of by the waiter in &ldquo;David
- Copperfield.&rdquo; They &ldquo;lived on broken wittles and they slept on the coals.&rdquo;
- The <i>Duchess</i> carried benzoline tins for the feeding of the futile
- little motor that worked her in and out of port, and the native sleeping
- place was merely the hold, on top of the tins.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0033" id="linkimage-0033"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0325.jpg" alt="0325 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0325.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Do you mind the dynamite remaining under your bunk?&rdquo; asked the ancient
- mariner, shortly after we left Samoa.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;<i>Under my bunk?</i>&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Yes&mdash;didn&rsquo;t you know it was there? The explosives safe is let into
- the deck just beneath the deck cabin. I&rsquo;ll move it if you&rsquo;re nervous about
- it&mdash;I thought I&rsquo;d tell you, anyways. But it&rsquo;s the best place for it
- to be, you see, right amidships.&rdquo; And the ancient mariner, leaning his six
- foot two across the rail, turned his quid, and spat into the deep.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;What do we want with dynamite, anyhow?&rdquo; asked the bewildered passenger,
- confronted with this new and startling streak of local colour.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;<i>We</i> don&rsquo;t want none. The Cook Islands wants it for reefs.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Oh, leave it where it is&mdash;I suppose it&rsquo;s all the same in the end
- where it starts from, if it did blow up,&rdquo; says the passenger resignedly.
- &ldquo;What about the benzoline in the hold, though?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Every one&rsquo;s got to take chances at sea,&rdquo; says the captain, easily. &ldquo;The
- mates have orders to keep the natives from smokin&rsquo; in the hold at night.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- And at midnight, when I slip out of my bunk to look on and see what the
- weather is like (it has been threatening all day), a faint but
- unmistakable odour of island tobacco greets my nose, from the opening of
- the main hatch! Benzoline, dynamite, natives smoking in the hold, one big
- boat smashed, one small one left, forty native passengers, five whites,
- and three hundred miles to the nearest land!
- </p>
- <p>
- Well, <i>à la guerre comme à la guerre</i>, and one must not tell tales at
- sea. So I don&rsquo;t tell any, though tempted. But I am very glad, a week
- later, to see the Cook Islands rising up out of the empty blue again. We
- have had head winds, we have been allowanced as to water, we are all
- pleased to have a chance of taking in some fruit before we start on the
- thousand miles&rsquo; run to Malden&mdash;and above all, we leave that dynamite
- here, which is a good thing; for really we have been putting rather too
- much strain on the good nature of the &ldquo;Sweet little cherub that sits up
- aloft, to keep guard o&rsquo;er the life of poor Jack,&rdquo; this last week or two.
- </p>
- <p>
- If proof were wanted that the cherub&rsquo;s patience is about at an end, our
- arrival at Mangaia furnishes it&mdash;for we do take fire after all, just
- a couple of hundred yards from shore!
- </p>
- <p>
- It does not matter now, since half the natives of the island are about the
- ship, and the case of explosives has just been rowed off in our only boat,
- and the blaze is put out without much trouble. But, two days ago!
- </p>
- <p>
- Well, the sweet little cherub certainly deserved a rest.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <p>
- Now the <i>Duchess&rsquo;s</i> bowsprit was pointed northwards, and we set out
- on a thousand miles&rsquo; unbroken run up to Malden Island, only four degrees
- south of the Line. For nine days we ploughed across the same monotonous
- plain of lonely sea, growing a little duller every day, as our stores of
- reading matter dwindled away, and our fruit and vegetables ran out, and
- the memory of our last fresh mess became only a haunting, far-off regret.
- Squatting or lying about the white-hot poop in the merciless sun&mdash;which
- burnt through our duck and cotton clothing, and scorched the skin
- underneath, but was at least a degree better than the choking Hades of a
- cabin below&mdash;we used to torture each other with reminiscences and
- speculations, such as &ldquo;They have real salt beef and sea-pie and lobscouse
- and pea-soup, and things like that, every day on Robinson&rsquo;s schooner; no
- tinned rag and musty flour&rdquo;; or &ldquo;How many thousand miles are we now from
- an iced drink?&rdquo; This last problem occupied the mates and myself for half a
- morning, and made us all a great deal hotter than we were before. Auckland
- was about 2,300 miles away, San Francisco about 3,000 as far as we could
- guess. We decided for Auckland, and discussed the best place to buy the
- drink, being somewhat limited in choice by the passenger&rsquo;s selfish
- insistence on a place where she could get really good iced coffee. By the
- time this was settled, the captain joined in, and informed us that we
- could get all we wanted, and fresh limes into the bargain, only a thousand
- miles away, at Tahiti, which every one had somehow overlooked. Only a
- thousand! It seemed nothing, and we all felt (illogically) cheered up at
- the thought.
- </p>
- <p>
- Late in the afternoon we came near attaining our wish for a temperature of
- thirty-two degrees in rather an unexpected way. The bottom of the Pacific
- generally hovers about this figure, some miles below the burning surface,
- which often reaches the temperature of an ordinary warm bath; and the <i>Duchess</i>
- had a fairly narrow escape of going down to look for a cool spot without a
- return ticket. A giant waterspout suddenly formed out of the low-hanging,
- angry sky that had replaced the clear heat of the morning. First of all, a
- black trunk like an elephant&rsquo;s began to feel blindly about in mid-air,
- hanging from a cloud. It came nearer and nearer with uncanny speed,
- drawing up to itself as it came a colossal cone of turbulent sea, until
- the two joined together in one enormous black pillar, some quarter of a
- mile broad at the base, and probably a good thousand feet high, uniting as
- it did the clouds and the sea below. Across the darkening sea, against the
- threatening, copper-crimson sunset, came this gigantic horror, waltzing
- over leagues of torn-up water in a veritable dance of death, like
- something blind, but mad and cruel, trying to find and shatter our fragile
- little ship. Happily, the dark was only coming, not yet come; happily,
- too, the wind favoured us, and we were able to tack about and keep out of
- the way, dodging the strangely human rushes and advances of the
- water-giant with smartness and skill. At one time it came so close that
- the elephant trunk&mdash;now separately visible again&mdash;seemed feeling
- about over our heads, although the captain afterwards said it had been
- more than three hundred yards away&mdash;and the immense maelstrom
- underneath showed us the great wall of whirling spindrift that edged its
- deadly circle, as plain as the foam about our own bows. Every one was
- quiet, cool, and ready; but no one was sorry when the threatening monster
- finally spun, away to leeward and melted into air once more. A waterspout
- of this enormous size, striking a small vessel, would snap off her masts
- like sticks of candy, kill any one who happened to be on deck, and most
- probably sink the ship with the very impact of the terrible shock.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;One doesn&rsquo;t hear much about ships being sunk by waterspouts,&rdquo; objected
- the sceptical passenger to this last statement.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Ships that&rsquo;s sunk by waterspouts doesn&rsquo;t come back to tell the newspapers
- about it,&rdquo; said the captain darkly.
- </p>
- <p>
- Life on a South Sea schooner is not all romance. For the officers of the
- ship it is a very hard life indeed. Native crews are the rule in the South
- Seas, and native crews make work for every one, including themselves.
- Absolutely fearless is the Kanaka, active as a monkey aloft, good-natured
- and jolly to the last degree, but perfectly unreliable in any matter
- requiring an ounce of thought or a pennyworth of discretion, and,
- moreover, given to shirk work in a variety of ingenious ways that pass the
- wit of the white man to circumvent. Constant and keen supervision while at
- sea, unremitting hurry and drive in port, are the duties of a South Sea
- mate, coupled with plenty of actual hard work on his own account. I have
- known a case where a small schooner was leaking badly, many days from
- port, and almost constant pumping was required. The pump broke while in
- use; and the watch, delighted to be released, turned in at eight bells
- without having done their spell, and without reporting the accident. The
- water gained steadily, but that did not trouble them; and when the mate
- discovered the accident, and set them to mend the pump at once, they were
- both surprised and grieved!
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Watch and watch&rdquo; is the rule on small sailing-vessels: four hours on and
- four hours off, day and night, except for the &ldquo;dog watches,&rdquo; four to six
- and six to eight in the evening, which create a daily shift in order that
- each man may be on watch at a different time on successive days. Always
- provided, of course, that the ship has any watches at all! I <i>have</i>
- sailed in a Pacific schooner where the crew spent most of their time
- playing the accordion and the Jew&rsquo;s harp, and slept peacefully all night.
- In the daytime there was generally some one at the wheel; but at night it
- was usually lashed, and the ship was let run, with all sails set, taking
- her chances of what might come, every soul on board being asleep. One
- night the cook came out of his bunk to get a drink from the tank, and
- found the vessel taken aback. The whole spirit of South Sea life breathes
- from the sequel. He told nobody! The galley was his department, not the
- sails; so he simply went back to his bunk. In the morning we fetched up
- off the northern side of an island we had intended to «approach from the
- south; having, strange to say, somehow escaped piling our bones on the
- encircling reef, and also avoided the misfortune of losing our masts and
- getting sunk.
- </p>
- <p>
- If there is a good deal of hard work on most schooners, and something of
- risk on all, there is also plenty of adventure and romance, for those who
- care about it. One seldom meets an island skipper whose life would not
- furnish materials for a dozen exciting books. Being cut off and attacked
- by cannibals down in the dangerous western groups; swimming for dear life
- away from a boat just bitten in two by an infuriated whale; driving one
- native king off his throne, putting another on, and acting as prime
- minister to the nation; hunting up a rumour of a splendid pearl among the
- pearling islands, and tracking down the gem, until found and coaxed away
- from its careless owner at one-tenth Sydney market prices&mdash;these are
- incidents that the typical schooner captain regards as merely the ordinary
- kind of break to be expected in his rather monotonous life. He does not
- think them very interesting as a rule, and dismisses them somewhat
- briefly, in a yarn. What does excite him, cause him to raise his voice and
- gesticulate freely, and induce him to &ldquo;yarn&rdquo; relentlessly for half a
- watch, is the recital of some thrilling incident connected with the price
- of cargo or the claims made for damaged stuff by some abandoned villain of
- a trader. There is something worth relating in a tale like that, to his
- mind!
- </p>
- <p>
- The passenger on an island schooner learns very early to cultivate a
- humble frame of mind. On a great steam liner he is all in all. It is for
- him almost entirely that the ships are built and run; his favour is life
- or death to the company. He is handled like eggs, and petted like a canary
- bird. Every one runs to do his bidding; he is one of a small but precious
- aristocracy waited on hand and foot by the humblest of serfs. On a
- schooner, however, he is ousted from his pride of place most completely by
- the cargo, which takes precedence of him at every point; so that he
- rapidly learns he is not of nearly so much value as a fat sack of copra,
- and he becomes lowlier in mind than he ever was before. There is no
- special accommodation for him, as a rule; he must go where he can, and
- take what he gets. If he can make himself useful about the ship, so much
- the better; every one will think more of him, and he will get some useful
- exercise by working his passage in addition to paying for it.
- </p>
- <p>
- Here is a typical day on the <i>Duchess</i>.
- </p>
- <p>
- At eight bells (8 a.m.) breakfast is served in the cabin. The passenger&rsquo;s
- own cabin is a small deck-house placed amidships on the main deck. The
- deck is filled up with masses of cargo, interposing a perfect Himalayan
- chain of mountains between the main deck and the poop. It is pouring with
- tropical rain, but the big main hatch yawns half open on one side, because
- of the native passengers in the hold. On the other side foams a squally
- sea, unguarded by either rail or bulwark, since the cargo is almost
- overflowing out of the ship. The <i>Duchess</i> is rolling like a
- porpoise, and the passenger&rsquo;s hands are full of mackintosh and hat-brim.
- It seems impossible to reach the poop alive; but the verb &ldquo;have to&rdquo; is in
- constant use on a sailing-ship, and it does not fail of its magical effect
- on this occasion. Clawing like a parrot, the passenger reaches the cabin,
- and finds the bare-armed, barefooted mates and the captain engaged on the
- inevitable &ldquo;tin&rdquo; and biscuits. There is no tea this morning, because the
- cockroaches have managed to get into and flavour the brew; and the cabin
- will none of it. The captain has sent word by the native steward that he
- will &ldquo;learn&rdquo; the cook&mdash;a strange threat that usually brings about at
- least a temporary reform&mdash;and is now engaged in knocking the
- copra-bugs out of a piece of biscuit and brushing a colony of ants off his
- plate. Our cargo is copra, and in consequence the ship resembles an
- entomological museum more than anything else. No centipedes have been
- found this trip so far; but the mate-stabbed a big scorpion with a
- sail-needle yesterday, as it was walking across the deck; and the
- cockroaches&mdash;as large as mice, and much bolder&mdash;have fairly
- &ldquo;taken charge.&rdquo; The captain says he does not know whether he is sleeping
- in the cockroaches&rsquo; bunk, or they in his, but he rather thinks the former,
- since the brutes made a determined effort to throw him out on the deck
- last night, and nearly succeeded!
- </p>
- <p>
- It grows very warm after breakfast, for we are far within the tropics, and
- the <i>Duchess</i> has no awnings to protect her deck. The rail is almost
- hot enough to blister an unwary hand, and the great sails cast little
- shade, as the sun climbs higher to the zenith. The pitch does not,
- however, bubble in the seams of the deck, after the well-known fashion of
- stories, because the <i>Duchess</i>, like most other tropical ships, has
- her decks caulked with putty. A calm has fallen&mdash;a Pacific calm,
- which is not as highly distinguished for calmness as the stay-at-home
- reader might suppose. There is no wind, and the island we are trying to
- reach remains tantalisingly perched on the extreme edge of the horizon,
- like a little blue flower on the rim of a crystal dish. But there is
- plenty of sea&mdash;long glittering hills of water, rising and falling,
- smooth and foamless, under the ship, which they fling from side to side
- with cruel violence. The great booms swing and slam, the blocks clatter,
- the masts creak. Everything loose in the cabins toboggans wildly up and
- down the floor. At dinner, the soup which the cook has struggled to
- produce, lest he should be &ldquo;learned,&rdquo; has to be drunk out of tin mugs for
- safety. Every one is sad and silent, for the sailor hates a calm even more
- than a gale.
- </p>
- <p>
- Bonitos come round the ship in a glittering shoal by-and-by, and there is
- a rush for hooks and lines. One of our native A.B.s produces a huge pearl
- hook, unbaited, and begins to skim it lightly along the water at the end
- of its line, mimicking the exact motions of a flying-fish with a
- cleverness that no white man can approach. Hurrah! a catch! A mass of
- sparkling silver, blue, and green, nearly twenty pounds weight, is swung
- through the air, and tumbled on deck. Another and another follows; we have
- over a hundred pounds weight of fish in half an hour. The crew shout and
- sing for delight. There are only seven of them and five of us, but
- there-will not be a scrap of that fish left by to-morrow, for all the
- forecastle hands will turn to and cook and eat without ceasing until it is
- gone; after which they will probably dance for an hour or two.
- </p>
- <p>
- To every one&rsquo;s delight, the weather begins to cloud over again after this,
- and we are soon spinning before a ten-knot breeze towards the island,
- within sight of which we have been aimlessly beating about for some days,
- unable to get up. Our crew begin to make preparations. Tapitua, who is a
- great dandy, puts two gold earrings in one ear, and fastens a wreath of
- cock&rsquo;s feathers about his hat. Koddi (christened George) gets into a thick
- blue woollen jersey (very suitable for Antarctic weather), a scarlet and
- yellow pareo or kilt, and a pair of English shoes, which make him limp
- terribly; but they are splendid squeakers, so Koddi is happy. (The Pacific
- islander always picks out squeaking shoes if he can get them, and some
- manufacturers even put special squeakers into goods meant for the island
- trade.) Ta puts on three different singlets&mdash;a pink, a blue, and a
- yellow&mdash;turning up the edges carefully, so as to present a fine
- display of layered colours, like a Neapolitan ice; and gums the gaudy
- label off a jam tin about his bare brown arm, thus christening himself
- with the imposing title of &ldquo;Our Real Raspberry.&rdquo; Neo is wearing two hats
- and three neck-handkerchiefs; Oki has a cap with a &ldquo;P. &amp; O.&rdquo; ribbon,
- and Union Steamship Company&rsquo;s jersey, besides a threepenny-piece in the
- hollow of each ear. Truly we are a gay party, by the time every one is
- ready to land.
- </p>
- <p>
- And now after our thousand mile run, we have arrived at Malden.
- </p>
- <p>
- Malden Island lies on the border of the Southern Pacific, only four
- degrees south of the equator. It is beyond the verge of the great
- Polynesian archipelago, and stands out by itself in a lonely stretch of
- still blue sea, very seldom visited by ships of any kind. Approaching it
- one is struck from far away by the glaring barrenness of the big island,
- which is thirty-three miles in circumference, and does not possess a
- single height or solitary tree, save one small clump of recently planted
- cocoanuts. Nothing more unlike the typical South Sea island could be
- imagined. Instead of the violet mountain peaks, wreathed with flying
- vapour, the lowlands rich with pineapple, banana, orange, and mango, the
- picturesque beach bordered by groves of feathery cocoanuts and quaint
- heavy-fruited pandanus trees, that one finds in such groups as the
- Society, Navigator&rsquo;s, Hawaiian, and Cook Islands, Malden consists simply
- of an immense white beach, a little settlement fronted by a big wooden
- pier, and a desolate plain of low greyish-green herbage, relieved here and
- there by small bushes bearing insignificant yellow flowers. Water is
- provided by great condensers. Food is all imported, save for pig and goat
- flesh. Shade, coolness, refreshing fruit, pleasant sights and sounds,
- there are none. For those who live on the island, it is the scene of an
- exile which has to be endured somehow or other, but which drags away with
- incredible slowness and soul-deadening monotony.
- </p>
- <p>
- Why does any one live in such a spot? More especially, why should it be
- tenanted by five or six whites and a couple of hundred Kanakas, when many
- beautiful and fertile islands cannot show nearly so many of either race;
- quite a large number, indeed, being altogether uninhabited? One need never
- look far for an answer in such a case. If there is no comfort on Malden
- Island, there is something that men value more than comfort&mdash;money.
- For fifty-six years it has been one of the most valuable properties in the
- Pacific. Out of Malden Island have come horses and carriages, fine houses,
- and gorgeous jewellery, rich eating, delicate wines, handsome
- entertainments, university education and expensive finishing governesses,
- trips to the Continent, swift white schooners, high places in Society, and
- all the other desirables of wealth, for two generations of fortunate
- owners and their families. Half-a-million hard cash has been made out of
- it in the last thirty years, and it is good for another thirty. All this
- from a barren rock in mid-ocean! The solution of the problem will at once
- suggest itself to any reader who has ever sailed the Southern Seas&mdash;guano!
- </p>
- <p>
- This is indeed the secret of Malden Island&rsquo;s riches. Better by far than
- the discovery of a pirate&rsquo;s treasure-cave, that favourite dream of
- romantic youth, is the discovery of a guano island. There are few genuine
- treasure romances in the Pacific, but many exciting tales that deal with
- the finding and disposing of these unromantic mines of wealth. Malden
- Island itself has had an interesting history enough. In 1848, Captain
- Chapman, an American whaling captain who still lives in Honolulu, happened
- to discover Malden during the course of a long cruise. He landed on the
- island, found nothing for himself and his crew in the way of fruit or
- vegetables, but discovered the guano beds, and made up his mind to sell
- the valuable knowledge as soon as his cruise was over. Then he put to sea
- again, and did not reach San Francisco for the best part of a year.
- Meantime, another American, Captain English, had found the island and its
- treasure. Wiser than Captain Chapman, he abandoned his cruise, and hurried
- at once to Sydney, where he sold the island for a big price to the trading
- firm who have owned it ever since.
- </p>
- <p>
- This is the history of Malden Island&rsquo;s discovery. Time, in the island, has
- slipped along since the days of the Crimea with never a change. There is a
- row of little tin-roofed, one-storeyed houses above the beach, tenanted by
- the half-dozen white men who act as managers; there are big, barn-like
- shelters for the native labourers. Every three years the managers end
- their term of service, and joyfully return to the Company&rsquo;s great offices
- in Sydney, where there is life and companionship, pleasant things to see,
- good things to eat, newspapers every day, and no prison bar of blue
- relentless ocean cutting off all the outer world. Once or twice in the
- year one of the pretty white island schooners sails up to Malden, greeted
- with shrieks and war-dances of joy; discharges her freight of forty or
- fifty newly indentured labourers, and takes away as many others whose time
- of one year on the island has expired. On Malden itself nothing changes.
- Close up to the equator, and devoid of mountains or even heights which
- could attract rain, its climate is unaltered by the passing season. No
- fruits or flowers mark the year by their ripening and blossoming, no rainy
- season changes the face of the land. News from the outer world comes
- rarely; and when it does come, it is so old as to have lost its savour.
- Life on Malden Island for managers and labourers alike, is work, work, all
- day long; in the evening, the bare verandah and the copper-crimson sunset,
- and the empty prisoning sea. That is all.
- </p>
- <p>
- The guano beds cover practically the whole of the island. The surface on
- which one walks is hard, white, and rocky. This must be broken through
- before the guano, which lies a foot or two underneath, is reached. The
- labourers break away the stony crust with picks, and shovel out the fine,
- dry, earth-coloured guano that lies beneath, in a stratum varying from one
- to three feet in thickness. This is piled in great heaps, and sifted
- through large wire, screens. The sifted guano&mdash;exactly resembling
- common sand&mdash;is now spread out in small heaps, and left to dry
- thoroughly in the fierce sun. There must not be any trace of moisture left
- that can possibly be dispersed; for the price of the guano depends on its
- absolute purity and extreme concentration, and purchasers generally make
- careful chemical tests of the stuff they buy.
- </p>
- <p>
- When dried, the guano is stored away in an immense shed near the
- settlement. If it has been obtained from the pits at the other side of the
- island, eight miles away, it will be brought down to the storehouse by
- means of one of the oddest little railways in the world. The Malden Island
- railway is worked, not by steam, electricity, or petrol, but by sail! The
- S.E. trade-wind blows practically all the year round on this island; so
- the Company keep a little fleet of land-vessels, cross-rigged, with fine
- large sails, to convey the guano down to the settlement. The empty
- carriages are pushed up to the pits by the workmen, and loaded there. At
- evening, the labourers climb on the top of the load, set the great sails,
- and fly down to the settlement as fast as an average train could go. These
- &ldquo;land-ships&rdquo; of Malden are a bit unmanageable at times, and have been
- known to jump the rails when travelling at high speed, thus causing
- unpleasant accidents. But the Kanaka labourers do not mind a trifle of
- that kind, and not even in a S.E. gale would they condescend to take a
- reef in the sails.
- </p>
- <p>
- As it is necessary to push these railway ships on the outward trip, the
- managers generally travel on a small railway tricycle of the pattern
- familiar at home. This can be driven at a fair speed, by means of arm
- levers. Across the desolate inland plain one clatters, the centre of a
- disk of shadowless grey-green, drenched clear of drawing and colour by the
- merciless flood of white fire from above. The sky is of the very thinnest
- pale blue; the dark, deep sea is out of sight. The world is all dead
- stillness and smiting sun, with only the thin rattle of our labouring car,
- and the vibration of distant dark specks above the rookeries, for relief.
- </p>
- <p>
- The dark specks grow nearer and more numerous, filling the whole sky at
- last with the sweep of rushing wings and the screams of angry bird voices.
- We leave the tricycle on the rails and walk across the thin, coarse grass,
- tangled with barilla plants, and low-growing yellow-flowered shrubs,
- towards the spot where the wings flutter thickest, covering many acres of
- the unlovely, barren land with a perfect canopy of feathered life. This is
- the bird by which the fortunes of Malden have been made&mdash;the smaller
- man-o&rsquo;-war bird. It is about the size of a duck, though much lighter in
- build. The back is black, the breast white, the bill long and hooked. The
- bird has an extraordinarily rapid and powerful flight. It might more
- appropriately be called the &ldquo;pirate&rdquo; than the &ldquo;man-o&rsquo;-war&rdquo; or &ldquo;frigate&rdquo;
- bird, since it uses, its superior speed to deprive other seabirds of the
- fish they catch, very seldom indeed exerting itself to make an honest
- capture on its own account. Strange to say, however, this daring buccaneer
- is the meekest and most long-suffering of birds where human beings are
- concerned. It will allow you to walk all through its rookeries, and even
- to handle the young birds and eggs, without making any remonstrance other
- than a petulant squeal. The parents fly about the visitors&rsquo; heads in a
- perfect cloud, sweeping their wings within an inch of our faces, screaming
- harshly, and looking exceedingly fierce, with their ugly hooked bills and
- sparkling black eyes. But that is their ordinary way of occupying
- themselves; they wheel and scream above the rookery all day long, visited
- or let alone. Even if you capture one, by a happy snatch (not at all an
- impossible feat), you will not alarm the others, and your prisoner will
- not show much fight.
- </p>
- <p>
- The eggs lie all over the ground in a mass of broken shells, feathers, and
- clawed-up earth. Those birds never build nests, and only sit upon one egg,
- which is dirty white, with brown spots. The native labourers consider
- frigate-bird eggs good to eat, and devour large numbers, but the white men
- find them too strong. The birds are also eaten by the labourers, but only
- on the sly, as this practice is strictly forbidden, for the reason that
- illness generally follows. The frigate-bird, it seems, is not very
- wholesome eating.
- </p>
- <p>
- It is not in the insignificant deposits of these modern rookeries that the
- wealth of the island lies, but in the prehistoric strata underlying the
- stony surface crust already mentioned. There are three strata composing
- the island&mdash;first the coral rock, secondly the guano, lastly the
- surface crust. At one time, the island must have been the home of
- innumerable myriads of frigate-birds, nesting all over its circumference
- of thirty-three miles. The birds now nest only in certain places, and,
- though exceedingly thick to an unaccustomed eye, cannot compare with their
- ancestors in number.
- </p>
- <p>
- The schooner called on a Sunday, and so I could not see the men at work.
- One of the managers, however, showed me over the labourers&rsquo; quarters, and
- told me all about their life. There is certainly none of the
- &ldquo;black-birding&rdquo; business about Malden. Kidnapping natives for plantation
- work, under conditions which amount to slavery, is unfortunately still
- common enough in some parts of the Pacific. But in the Cook Group, and
- Savage Island, where most of the labourers come from, there is no
- difficulty in obtaining as many genuine volunteers for Malden as its
- owners want. The men sign for a year&rsquo;s work, at ten shillings a week, and
- board and lodging. Their food consists of rice, biscuits, yams, tinned
- beef, and tea, with a few cocoanuts for those who may fall sick. This is
- &ldquo;the hoigth of good &rsquo;atin&rdquo; for a Polynesian, who lives when at home
- on yams, taro root, and bananas, with an occasional mouthful of fish, and
- fowl or pig only on high festival days.
- </p>
- <p>
- The labourers&rsquo; quarters are large, bare, shady buildings fitted with wide
- shelves, on which the men spread their mats and pillows to sleep. A
- Polynesian is never to be divorced from his bedding; he always carries it
- with him when travelling, and the Malden labourers each come to the island
- provided with beautifully plaited pandanus mats, and cushions stuffed with
- the down of the silk-cotton tree. The cushions have covers of &ldquo;trade&rdquo;
- cottons, rudely embroidered by the owner&rsquo;s sweetheart or wife with
- decorative designs, and affectionate mottoes.
- </p>
- <p>
- From 5 a.m. to 5 p.m. are the hours of work, with an hour and
- three-quarters off for meals. There is nothing unpleasant about the work,
- as Malden Island guano is absolutely without odour, and apparently so dry
- and fine when taken from the pits, that one wonders at the necessity for
- further sifting and drying. Occasionally, however, one of the workers
- develops a peculiar intestinal trouble which is said to be caused by the
- fine dust of the pits. It is nearly always fatal, by slow degrees. Our
- schooner carried away one of these unfortunates&mdash;a Savage Island man
- who had come up to Malden in full health and strength only a few months
- before. He was the merest shadow or sketch of a human being&mdash;a bundle
- of bones clad in loose brown skin, with a skull-like face, all teeth and
- eye-sockets&mdash;he could not stand or walk, only creep along the deck;
- and he was very obviously dying. Poor fellow! he longed for his own home
- above everything&mdash;-the cool green island, sixteen hundred miles away,
- where there were fruit and flowers in the shady valleys, and women&rsquo;s and
- children&rsquo;s voices sounding pleasantly about the grassy village streets,
- and his own little pandanus-thatched cottage, with his &ldquo;fafiné&rdquo; and the
- babies at the door, among the palms and oranges above the sea. But the
- schooner had a two months&rsquo; voyage to make yet among the Cook and other
- groups, before Savage Island could be reached; and Death was already
- lifting his spear to strike. We left the poor fellow as a last chance on
- Penrhyn Island, a couple of hundred miles away, hoping that the unlimited
- cocoanuts he could obtain there might do him some good, and that by some
- fortunate chance he might recover sufficiently to take another ship, and
- reach Niué at last.
- </p>
- <p>
- The guano of Malden Island is supposed to be the best in the world. It is
- extremely rich in superphosphates, and needs no &ldquo;doctoring&rdquo; whatever,
- being ready to apply to the land just as taken from the island. As the
- company are obliged to guarantee the purity of what they sell, and give an
- exact analysis of the constituents of every lot, they keep a skilled
- chemist on the island, and place a fine laboratory at his disposal. These
- analyses are tedious to make, and require great accuracy, as a mistake
- might cause a refusal of payment on the part of the purchaser. The post of
- official chemist, therefore, is no sinecure, especially as it includes the
- duties of dispenser as well, and not a little rough-and-ready doctoring at
- times.
- </p>
- <p>
- The temperature of the island is not so high as might be expected from the
- latitude. It seldom goes above 90° in the shade, and is generally rendered
- quite endurable, in spite of the merciless glare and total absence of
- shade, by the persistent trade-wind. Mosquitoes are unknown, and flies not
- troublesome. There are no centipedes, scorpions, or other venomous
- creatures, although the neighbouring islands (&ldquo;neighbouring,&rdquo; in the
- Pacific, means anything within three or four hundred miles) have plenty of
- these unpleasant inhabitants. The white men live on tinned food of various
- kinds, also bread, rice, fowls, pork, goat, and goat&rsquo;s milk. Vegetables or
- fruit are a rare and precious luxury, for the nearest island producing
- either lies a thousand miles away. Big yams, weighing a stone or two
- apiece and whitewashed to prevent decay, are sent up from the Cook Islands
- now and then; but the want of really fresh, vegetable food is one of the
- trials of the island. It is not astonishing to hear that the salaries of
- the Malden officials are very high. A year or two on the island is a good
- way of accumulating some capital, since it is impossible to spend a penny.
- </p>
- <p>
- The native labourers generally leave the island with the greatest joy,
- glad beyond expression to return to their sweet do-nothing lives at home.
- Why they undertake the work at all is one of the many puzzles presented by
- the Polynesian character. They have enough to eat and enough to wear,
- without doing any work to speak of, while they are at home. Usually the
- motive for going to Malden is the desire of making twenty-five pounds or
- so in a lump, to buy a bicycle (all South Sea Islanders have bicycles, and
- ride them splendidly) or to build a stone house. But in most cases the
- money is &ldquo;spreed&rdquo; away in the first two or three days at home, giving
- presents to everybody, and buying fine clothes at the trader&rsquo;s store.
- </p>
- <p>
- So the product of the year&rsquo;s exile and hard work is simply a tour among
- the islands&mdash;in itself a strong attraction&mdash;a horribly hot suit
- of shoddy serge, with a stiff white shirt, red socks, and red tie, bought
- up in Malden from the company out of the labourer&rsquo;s wages, and proudly
- worn on the day the schooner brings the wanderer home to his lightly clad
- relatives&mdash;a bicycle, perhaps, which soon becomes a scrap-heap; or,
- possibly, a stone house which is never lived in. The company has the
- labour that it wants, and the money that the labour produces. Every one is
- satisfied with the bargain, doubtless; and the faraway British farmer and
- market-gardener are the people who are ultimately benefited.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0012" id="link2HCH0012"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER XII
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>Pearl-fishing at Penrhyn&mdash;The Beautiful Golden-Edge&mdash;Perils
- of the Pearl Diver&mdash;A Fight for Life&mdash;Visit to a Leper Island&mdash;A
- God-forsaken Place&mdash;How they kept the Corpses&mdash;The Woman who
- sinned&mdash;A Nameless Grave&mdash;On to Merry Manahiki&mdash;The Island
- of Dance and Song&mdash;Story of the Leper and his Bird&mdash;Good-bye to
- the Duchess.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">A</span> DAY or two after
- leaving Malden we sighted Penrhyn, lying five degrees further south, but
- for some unexplained reason a very much hotter place than Malden. Penrhyn
- is an island that is famous all over the South Sea world, and not unknown
- even in Europe. Its pearl-shell and pearls, its strange, wild,
- semi-amphibious natives, and its melancholy leper station, make it a
- marked spot upon the Pacific map; and a certain rather fictitious value
- attaching to its stamps has made the name of the island familiar to all
- stamp collectors at home. The general impression conveyed to the voyager
- from kinder and fairer islands is that Penrhyn is a place &ldquo;at the back of
- God-speed,&rdquo; a lonely, sultry, windy, eerie spot, desolate and remote
- beyond description.
- </p>
- <p>
- It is an atoll island, consisting merely of a strip of land some couple of
- hundred yards in width, enclosing a splendid lagoon nine miles long. The
- land is white coral gravel; nothing grows on it but cocoanut and pandanus
- and a few insignificant creepers. Fruit, vegetables, flowers, there are
- none. The natives live entirely on cocoanut and fish. They are nominally
- Christianised, but the veneer of Christianity is wearing uncommonly thin
- in places. They are reckless and daring to a degree, notable even among
- Pacific Islanders. Any Penrhyn man will attack a shark single-handed in
- its own element, and kill it with the big knife he usually carries. They
- are, beyond comparison, the finest swimmers in the world; it is almost
- impossible to drown a Penrhyn Islander. He will swim all day as easily as
- he will walk. You may often meet him out fishing, miles from shore,
- without a boat, pushing in front of him a small plank that carries his
- bait, lines, and catch. Some of the fish he most fancies seldom come to
- the surface. To catch these he baits his line, dives, and swims about
- underneath the water for a minute or two at a time, trailing the bait
- after him, and rising to the surface as often as a fish takes it.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0034" id="linkimage-0034"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0339.jpg" alt="0339 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0339.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Of his pearl-diving exploits I shall speak later. The deadly surf that
- breaks upon the outer reef has no terrors for him. Among the small boys of
- the island there is a favourite feat known as &ldquo;crossing a hundred waves,&rdquo;
- which consists in diving through ninety-nine great rollers, just as they
- are about to break, and rushing triumphantly to shore on the back of the
- hundredth. The old warlike, quarrelsome character of the islanders&mdash;no
- doubt originally due to scarcity of food&mdash;still lurks concealed under
- an outward show of civility. Penrhyn was the only South Pacific Island I
- have visited where I did not care to walk alone in the bush without my
- little American revolver. The four or five white traders all keep firearms
- ready to hand in their stores. There has been no actual trouble of recent
- years, but there are narrow escapes from a free fight every now and then,
- and every man must hold himself ready for emergencies. It is only eight
- years since there was such an outbreak of hostilities in Penrhyn that a
- man-of-war had to be sent up to protect the traders.
- </p>
- <p>
- I was kindly offered the use of a house during the week the <i>Duchess</i>
- spent in Penrhyn lagoon repairing sails and rigging, and generally
- refitting after the stormy weather that we had experienced on several
- occasions. But Penrhyn is rotten with undeclared leprosy, the water is not
- above suspicion, and flies abound in myriads. So I slept on the ship, and
- by day wandered about the desolate, thin, sun-smitten woods of the island,
- or flew over the green lagoon in one of the marvellously speedy pearling
- sloops of the traders. These boats are about a couple of tons each, with a
- boom as big, in proportion, as a grasshopper&rsquo;s leg. They are as manageable
- as a motor car, and faster than most yachts. It is a wonderful sight to
- see them taking cargo out to the schooners, speeding like gulls over the
- water, and turning round in their tracks to fly back again as easily as
- any gull might do. Pearling was almost &ldquo;off&rdquo; at the time of the <i>Duchess&rsquo;s</i>
- visit, since a good part of the lagoon was tabooed to allow the beds to
- recover.
- </p>
- <p>
- The pearls are rather a minor consideration at Penrhyn. The shell is of
- beautiful quality, large and thick, with the much-valued golden edge; but
- pearls are not plentiful in it, and they are generally of moderate size.
- Some very fine ones have been found, however; and gems of ordinary value
- can always be picked up fairly cheaply from the divers. The Penrhyn lagoon
- is the property of the natives themselves, who sell the shell and the
- pearls to white traders. Christmas Island and some other Pacific pearling
- grounds are privately owned, and in these places there is a great deal of
- poaching done by the divers. The great buyers of pearls are the schooner
- captains. There are three or four schooners that call at Penrhyn now and
- then for cargo; and every captain has a nose for pearls like that of a
- trained hound for truffles. In the Paumotus, about Penrhyn, Christmas
- Island, and the Scillies (the Pacific Scillies, not those that are so
- familiarly known to English readers), they flit from island to island,
- following up the vagrant rumours of a fine pearl with infinite tact and
- patience, until they run it to ground at last, and (perhaps) clear a
- year&rsquo;s income in a day by a lucky deal. San Francisco and Sydney are
- always ready to buy, and the typical Pacific captain, if he is just a bit
- of a buccaneer, is also a very keen man of business in the most modern
- sense of the word, and not at all likely to be cheated. Three native
- divers, famous for their deepwater feats, came out in a pearling sloop
- with us one afternoon, and gave a fine exhibition.
- </p>
- <p>
- The bed over which we halted was about ninety feet under the surface. Our
- three divers stripped to a &ldquo;pareo&rdquo; apiece, and then, squatting down on the
- gunwale of the boat with their hands hanging over their knees, appeared to
- meditate. They were &ldquo;taking their wind,&rdquo; the white steersman informed me.
- After about five minutes of perfect stillness they suddenly got up and
- dived off the thwart. The rest of us fidgeted up and down the tiny deck,
- talked, speculated, and passed away the time for what seemed an
- extraordinarily long period. No one, unfortunately, had brought a watch;
- but the traders and schooner captains all agree in saying that the Penrhyn
- diver can stay under water for full three minutes; and it was quite
- evident that our men were showing off for the benefit of that almost
- unknown bird, the &ldquo;wahiné papa.&rdquo; At last, one after another, the dark
- heads popped up again, and the divers, each carrying a shell or two, swam
- back to the boat, got on board, and presented their catch to me with the
- easy grace and high-bred courtesy that are the birthright of all Pacific
- islanders&mdash;not at all embarrassed by the fact that all the clothes
- they wore would hardly have sufficed to make a Sunday suit for an equal
- number of pigeons.
- </p>
- <p>
- As a general rule, the divers carry baskets, and fill them before coming
- up. Each man opens his own catch at once, and hunts through the shell for
- pearls. Usually he does not find any; now and then he gets a small grey
- pearl, 01 a decent white one, or a big irregular &ldquo;baroque&rdquo; pearl of the
- &ldquo;new art&rdquo; variety, and once in a month of Sundays he is rewarded by a
- large gleaming gem worth several hundred pounds, for which he will
- probably get only twenty or thirty.
- </p>
- <p>
- Diving dresses are sometimes used in Penrhyn; but in such an irregular and
- risky manner that they are really more dangerous than the ordinary method.
- The suit is nothing but a helmet and jumper. No boots are worn, no
- clothing whatever on the legs, and there are no weights to preserve the
- diver&rsquo;s balance. It sometimes happens&mdash;though wonderfully seldom&mdash;that
- the diver trips, falls, and turns upside down, the heavy helmet keeping
- him head-downwards until the air all rushes out under the jumper, and he
- is miserably suffocated. The air pump above is often carelessly worked in
- any case, and there is no recognised system of signals, except the jerk
- that means &ldquo;Pull up.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;They&rsquo;re the most reckless devils on the face of the earth,&rdquo; said a local
- trader. &ldquo;Once let a man strike a good bed of shell, and he won&rsquo;t leave go
- of it, not for Father Peter. He&rsquo;ll stick down there all day, grabbin&rsquo; away
- in twenty fathom or more till he feels paralysis cornin&rsquo; on&mdash;&mdash;&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Paralysis?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Yes&mdash;they gets it, lots of&rsquo;em. If you was to go down in twenty
- fathom&mdash;they can do five and twenty, but anything over is touch and
- go&mdash;and stay &rsquo;alf the day, you&rsquo;d come up &rsquo;owling like
- anything, and not able to move. That&rsquo;s the way it catches them; and then
- they must get some one to come and rub them with sea water all night long,
- and maybe they dies, and maybe they&rsquo;re all right by morning. So then down
- they goes again, just the same as ever. Sometimes a man&rsquo;ll be pulled up
- dead at the end of a day. How does that happen? Well, I allow it&rsquo;s because
- he&rsquo;s been workin&rsquo; at a big depth all day, and feels all right; and then,
- do you see, he&rsquo;ll find somethin&rsquo; a bit extra below of him, in a holler
- like, and down he&rsquo;ll go after it; and the extra fathom or two does the
- trick.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Sharks? Well, I&rsquo;ve seen you poppin&rsquo; at them from the deck of the <i>Duchess</i>,
- so you know as well as I do how many there are. Didn&rsquo;t &rsquo;it them,
- even when the fin was up? That&rsquo;s because you &rsquo;aven&rsquo;t greased your
- bullet, I suppose. You want to, if the water isn&rsquo;t to turn it aside. But
- about the divers? Oh! they don&rsquo;t mind sharks, none of them, when they&rsquo;ve
- got the dress on. Sharks is easy scared. You&rsquo;ve only got to pull up your
- jumper a bit, and the air bubbles out and frightens them to fits. If you
- meet a big sting-ray, it&rsquo;ll run its spine into you, and send the dress all
- to&mdash;I mean, spoil the dress, so&rsquo;s the water comes in, and maybe it&rsquo;ll
- stick the diver too. And the big devilfish is nasty; he&rsquo;ll &rsquo;old you
- down to a rock but you can use your knife on him. The kara mauaa is the
- worst; the divers don&rsquo;t like him. He&rsquo;s not as big as a shark, but he&rsquo;s
- downright wicked, and he&rsquo;s a mouth on him as big as &rsquo;alf his body.
- If one comes along, he&rsquo;ll bite an arm or leg off the man anyways, and eat
- &rsquo;im outright if he&rsquo;s big enough to do it. Swordfish? Well, they
- don&rsquo;t often come into the lagoon; it&rsquo;s the fishing canoes outside they&rsquo;ll
- go for. Yes, they&rsquo;ll run a canoe and a man through at a blow easy enough:
- but they don&rsquo;t often do it. If you wants a canoe, I&rsquo;ll get you one; and
- you needn&rsquo;t mind about the swordfish. As like as not they&rsquo;ll never come
- near you.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;About the divin&rsquo;?&mdash;well, I think the naked divin&rsquo; is very near as
- safe as the machine, takin&rsquo; all things. Worst of it is, if a kara mauaa
- comes along, the diver can&rsquo;t wait his time till it goes. No, he doesn&rsquo;t
- stab it&mdash;not inside the lagoon, because there&rsquo;s too many of them
- there, and the blood would bring a whole pack about. He gets under a ledge
- of rock, and &rsquo;opes it&rsquo;ll go away before his wind gives out. If he
- doesn&rsquo;t, he gets eat.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- Did Schiller, or Edgar Allan Poe ever conjure up a picture more ghastly
- than that of a Penrhyn diver, caught like a rat in a trap by some huge,
- man-eating shark, or fierce kara mauaa&mdash;crouching in a cleft of the
- overhanging coral, under the dark green gloom of a hundred feet of water,
- with bursting lungs and cracking eyeballs, while the threatening bulk of
- his terrible enemy looms dark and steady, full in the road to life and
- air? A minute or more has been spent in the downward journey; another
- minute has passed in the agonised wait under the rock. Has he been seen?
- Will the creature move away now, while there is still time to return? The
- diver knows to a second how much time has passed; the third minute is on
- its way; but one goes up quicker than one comes down, and there is still
- hope. Two minutes and a half; it is barely possible now, but&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;
- The sentinel of death glides forward; his cruel eyes, phosphorescent in
- the gloom, look right into the cleft where the wretched creature is
- crouching, with almost twenty seconds of life still left, but now not a
- shred of hope. A few more beats of the labouring pulse, a gasp from the
- tortured lungs, a sudden rush of silvery air bubbles, and the brown limbs
- collapse down out of the cleft like wreaths of seaweed. The shark has his
- own.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is a &ldquo;Molokai,&rdquo; or Leper Island, some two miles out in the lagoon,
- where natives afflicted with leprosy are confined. The Resident Agent&mdash;one
- of the traders&mdash;broke the rigid quarantine of the Molokai one day so
- far as to let me land upon the island, although he did not allow me to
- approach nearer than ten or twelve yards to the lepers, or to leave the
- beach and go inland to the houses that were visible in the distance. Our
- boatmen ran the sloop close inshore, and carried the captain and myself
- through the shallow water, carefully setting us down on dry stones, but
- remaining in the sea themselves. A little dog that had come with the party
- sprang overboard, and began swimming to the shore. It was hurriedly seized
- by the scruff of its neck, and flung back into the boat. If it had set paw
- on the beach it could never have returned, but would have had to stay on
- the island for good.
- </p>
- <p>
- Very lovely is the Molokai of Penrhyn; sadly beautiful this spot where so
- many wretched creatures have passed away from death in life to life in
- death. As we landed, the low golden rays of the afternoon sun were
- slanting through the pillared palm stems and quaintly beautiful pandanus
- fronds, across the snowy beach, and its trailing gold-flowered vines. The
- water of the lagoon, coloured like the gems in the gates of the Heavenly
- City, lapped softly on the shore; the perpetual trade wind poured through
- the swaying trees, shaking silvery gleams from the lacquered crests of the
- palms. In the distance, shadowed by a heavy pandanus grove, stood a few
- low brown huts. From the direction of these there came, hurrying down to
- the beach as we landed, four figures&mdash;three men and a woman. They had
- put on their best clothes when they saw the sloop making for the island.
- The woman wore a gaudy scarlet cotton frock; two of the men had white
- shirts and sailor&rsquo;s trousers of blue dungaree&mdash;relics of a happier
- day, these, telling their own melancholy tale of bygone years of freedom
- on the wide Pacific. The third man wore a shirt and scarlet &ldquo;pareo,&rdquo; or
- kilt. Every face was lit up with delight at the sight of strangers from
- the schooner; above all, at the marvellous view of the wonderful &ldquo;wahiné
- papa.&rdquo; Why, even the men who lived free and happy on Penrhyn mainland did
- not get the chance of seeing such a show once in a lifetime! There she
- was, with two arms, and two legs, and a head, and a funny gown fastened in
- about the middle, and the most remarkable yellow shoes, and a ring, and a
- watch, which showed her to be extraordinarily wealthy, and a pale smooth
- face, not at all like a man&rsquo;s, and hair that was brown, not black&mdash;how
- odd! It was evidently as good as a theatre, to the lonely prisoners!
- </p>
- <p>
- Bright as all the faces of the lepers were at that exciting moment, one
- could not mistake the traces left by a more habitual expression of heavy
- sadness. The terrible disease, too, had set its well-known marks upon
- every countenance. None of those who came out to see us had lost any
- feature; but all the faces had the gross, thickened, unhuman look that
- leprosy stamps upon its victims. The woman kept her arm up over her head,
- to hide some sad disfigurement about her neck. One of the men walked
- slowly and painfully, through an affection of the hip and leg. There were
- nine lepers in all upon the island; but the other five either could not,
- or did not, wish to leave their huts, and the agent refused to break the
- quarantine any further than he had already done. What care the wretched
- creatures are able to give one another, therefore, what their homes are
- like, and how their lives are passed, I cannot tell. Three of the lepers
- were accompanied by their faithful dogs. They are all fond of pets, and
- must have either a dog or a cat. Of course the animals never leave the
- island. We exchanged a few remarks at the top of our voices, left a case
- of oranges (brought up from the Cook Islands, a thousand miles away), and
- returned to our boat. The case of oranges was eagerly seized upon, and
- conveyed into the bush.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;They will eat them up at once,&rdquo; I said.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Not they,&rdquo; said one of our white men. &ldquo;They&rsquo;ll make them into orange beer
- to-night, and get jolly well drunk for once in their miserable lives. Glad
- to see the poor devils get a chance, say I.&rdquo; And so&mdash;most immorally,
- no doubt&mdash;said the &ldquo;wahiné papa&rdquo; as well.
- </p>
- <p>
- The lepers are fed from stores furnished by a small Government fund; and
- the trader who fulfils the very light duties of Resident Government Agent
- generally sends them over a share of any little luxury, in the way of
- oranges, limes, or yams, that may reach the island. None the less, their
- condition is most miserable, and one cannot but regard it as a crying
- scandal upon the great missionary organisations of the Pacific that
- nothing whatever is done for the lepers of these northern groups. The
- noble example of the late Father Damien, of Hawaii, and of the Franciscan
- Sisters who still live upon the Hawaiian Molokai, courting a martyr&rsquo;s
- death to serve the victims of this terrible disease, seems to find no
- imitators in the islands evangelised by British missionaries. Godless,
- hopeless, and friendless, the lepers live and die alone. That their lives
- are immoral in the last degree, their religion, in spite of early
- teaching, almost a dead letter, is only to be expected. Penrhyn is not
- alone in this terrible scourge. Rakahanga, Manahiki, and Palmerston&mdash;all
- in the same part of the Pacific&mdash;are seriously affected by the
- disease. Palmerston I did not see; but I heard that there is one whole
- family of lepers there, and some stray cases as well.
- </p>
- <p>
- The island belongs to the half-caste descendants (about 150 in number) of
- Masters, a &ldquo;beachcomber&rdquo; of the early days, who died a few years ago.
- These people are much alarmed at the appearance of leprosy, and have
- segregated the lepers on an island in the lagoon. They are anxious to have
- them removed to the Molokai at Penrhyn, since the family came originally
- from that island; but no schooner will undertake to carry them. In
- Rakahanga, the lepers are not quarantined in any way, but wander about
- among the people. There are only a few cases as yet; but the number will
- certainly increase. This may also be said of Manahiki, for although very
- serious cases are isolated there, the lepers are allowed, in the earlier
- stages, to mix freely with every one else, and even to prepare the food of
- a whole family. The New Zealand Government, it is believed, will shortly
- pass a law compelling the removal of all these cases to the Molokai at
- Penrhyn. No Government, however, can alleviate the wretched condition of
- these unfortunate prisoners, once sent to the island. That remains for
- private charity and devotion.
- </p>
- <p>
- A God-forsaken, God-forgotten-looking place is Penrhyn, all in all. When
- sunset falls upon the great desolate lagoon, and the tall cocoanuts of the
- island stand up jet black against the stormy yellow sky in one unbroken
- rampart of tossing spears, and the endless sweep of shadowy beach is empty
- of all human life, and clear of every sound save the long, monotonous,
- never-ceasing cry of the trade wind in the trees, it needs but little
- imagination to fancy strange creatures creeping through the gloom of the
- forest&mdash;strange, ghastly stories of murder and despair whispering in
- the gathering night. Death in every form is always near to Penrhyn; death
- in the dark waters of the lagoon, death from the white terror of leprosy,
- and death at the hands of men but quarter civilised, whose fingers are
- always itching for the ready knife. And at the lonely sunset hour, when
- old memories of the life and light of great cities, of welcoming windows
- shining red and warm through grey, cold northern gloamings come back to
- the wanderer&rsquo;s mind in vivid contrast, the very wings of the &ldquo;Shadow
- cloaked from head to foot&rdquo; seem to shake in full sight above these
- desolate shores. Yet, perhaps, the intolerable blaze of full noon upon the
- windward beaches strikes a note of even deeper loneliness and distance.
- The windward side of Penrhyn is uninhabited; the sea that breaks in
- blinding white foam upon the untrodden strand, wreathed with trailing
- vines of vivid green, is never broken by a sail. The sun beats down
- through the palm and pandanus leaves so fiercely that the whole of the
- seaward bush is but a shadeless blaze of green fire. Nothing stirs,
- nothing cries; the earth is silent, the sea empty; and a barrier of
- thousands of long sea miles, steadily built up, day by day, through many
- weeks, and only to be passed again by the slow demolishing, brick by
- brick, of the same great wall, lies between us and the world where people
- live. Here there is no life, only an endless dream; not as in the happy
- southern islands, a gentle sunrise dream of such surpassing sweetness that
- the sleeper asks nothing more than to dream on thus forever; but a
- dark-hour dream of loneliness, desolation, and utter remoteness, from
- which the dreamer cannot awaken, even if he would. Why do men&mdash;white
- men, with some ability and some education&mdash;live in these faraway
- infertile islands? There is no answer to the problem, even from the men
- themselves. They came, they stayed, they do not go away&mdash;why? they do
- not know. That is all.
- </p>
- <p>
- The land extent of Penrhyn is only three square miles, though the enclosed
- lagoon is a hundred. The population is little over four hundred souls;
- there are three or four white traders, as a rule. There is no resident
- white missionary. The island is one of those that have been annexed by New
- Zealand, and is therefore British property. It is governed by the Resident
- Commissioner of the Cook group, who visits it about once a year.
- </p>
- <p>
- Until two or three years ago, the Penrhyn Islanders used to keep their
- dead in the houses, hanging up the corpse, wrapped in matting, until it
- was completely decayed. This hideous practice was put an end to by the
- Representatives of British Government, much to the grief of the natives,
- who found it hard to part with the bodies of their friends, and leave them
- away in the graveyard they were bidden to choose. As the best substitute
- for the old practice, they now build little houses, some four feet high,
- over the tombs of their friends, and live in these houses for many months
- after a death, sitting and sleeping and even eating on the tomb that is
- covered by the thatch or iron roof of the grave-house. The graveyard is in
- consequence a strange and picturesque sight, almost like a village of some
- pigmy folk. A few plain concrete graves stand above the remains of white
- men who have died in the island, and one headstone is carved with the
- initials&mdash;not the name&mdash;of a woman. There is a story about that
- lonely grave; it was told to me as I lingered in the little &ldquo;God&rsquo;s Acre&rdquo;
- at sunset, with the light falling low between the palms and the lonely
- evening wind beginning to wail from the sea.
- </p>
- <p>
- The woman was the wife of a schooner captain, a man of good family and
- connections, who liked the wild roving life of the Pacific, yet managed to
- retain a number of acquaintances of his own class in Auckland and Tahiti.
- His wife was young and handsome, and had many friends of her own. On one
- of the schooner&rsquo;s visits to Penrhyn, the man was taken suddenly ill, and
- died in a very short time, leaving his wife alone. It seems that at first
- she was bewildered by her loss, and stayed on in the island, not knowing
- what to do, but before many months she had solved the problem after a
- fashion that horrified all the whites&mdash;she married a Penrhyn native!
- good-looking and attractive, but three-quarters savage, and left the
- island with him.
- </p>
- <p>
- Several children were born to the pair, but they were given to the
- husband&rsquo;s people. At last he took a native partner, and deserted his
- English wife. She left the islands, and went down to Auckland; but her
- story had travelled before her, and Auckland society closed its doors. To
- Tahiti, where morals are easy, and no one frowns upon the union, temporary
- or permanent, of the white man and the brown woman, she went, hoping to be
- received as in former days. But even Papeete, &ldquo;the sink of the Pacific,&rdquo;
- would have none of the white woman who had married a brown man. Northwards
- once more, to lonely Penrhyn, the broken-hearted woman went, wishing only
- to die, far from the eyes of her own world that had driven her out. A
- schooner captain, who called there now and then, cast eyes upon her&mdash;for
- she was still young and retained much of her beauty&mdash;and asked her,
- at last, if she would become his wife, and so redeem in some degree her
- position; but she had neither heart nor wish to live longer, so she sent
- the kindly sailor away, and soon afterwards closed her eyes for ever on
- the blue Pacific and the burning sands, the brown lover who had betrayed
- her, and the white lover who came too late. The traders buried her, and
- kindly left her grave without a name; only the initials of that which she
- had borne in her first marriage, and the date of her death. So, quiet and
- forgotten at last, lies in lonely Penrhyn the woman who sinned against her
- race and found no forgiveness.
- </p>
- <p>
- It was a relief to leave Penrhyn, with all its gloomy associations, and
- see the schooner&rsquo;s head set for the open sea and merry Manahiki. But we
- seemed to have brought ill-luck away with us, for there was what the
- captain called &ldquo;mean weather&rdquo; before we came within hail of land again,
- and the <i>Duchess</i> got some more knocking about.
- </p>
- <p>
- It was on account of this that Neo, our native bo&rsquo;sun, hit an innocent
- A.B. over the head with a belaying-pin one afternoon, and offered to
- perform the same service for any of the rest of the crew who might require
- it. The men had been singing mission hymns as they ran about the deck
- pulling and hauling&mdash;not exactly out of sheer piety, but because some
- of the hymns, with good rousing choruses, made excellent chanties. They
- were hauling to the tune of &ldquo;Pull for the shore, brothers!&rdquo; when a squall
- hit the ship, and out of the fifteen agitated minutes that followed, the
- <i>Duchess emerged minus her jib-boom</i>. When things had quieted down,
- Neo started to work with the belaying-, pin, until he was stopped, when he
- offered, as a sufficient explanation, the following:
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Those men, they sing something made bad luck, I think, jib-boom he break.
- Suppose they sing, &lsquo;Pull for &lsquo;em shore&rsquo; some other time, I break their
- head, that I telling them!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- The next time a chanty was wanted, &ldquo;Hold the Fort!&rdquo; took the place of the
- obnoxious tune, and Neo&rsquo;s lessons were not called for.
- </p>
- <p>
- And so, in a day or two we came to Rakahanga and Manahiki (Reirson and
- Humphrey Islands), and stopped there for another day or two, before we
- spread our wings like the swallows, to fleet southward again.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0035" id="linkimage-0035"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0351.jpg" alt="0351 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0351.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- It was certainly globe-trotting, not proper travelling. To flit from group
- to group, taking in cargo, and then hurrying off again, is the way not to
- understand the places one sees, and I was more than half inclined to leave
- the <i>Duchess</i> here, and stop over for a month or two on the chance of
- another schooner turning up. But the dinner that the solitary trader ate
- when he came on board made me change my mind. He looked like a man
- half-famished, and he certainly acted like one. There was hardly a thing
- on the island to eat at present, he said; the natives had only enough fish
- for themselves, and the turtle weren&rsquo;t coming and his stores were almost
- out, and he had been living on biscuit and cocoanuts for weeks. There was
- leprosy in both islands, and one did not dare to touch native pork or
- fowl. On the whole, I thought I would be contented to &ldquo;globe-trot,&rdquo; on
- this occasion, and see what I could in a day or two.
- </p>
- <p>
- The islands are about twenty-five miles apart, and very much like one
- another. They each own an area of about two square miles, and a population
- of some four hundred natives. And there is nothing in the whole Pacific
- prettier.
- </p>
- <p>
- Coming up to Manahiki, one sees first of all a snowy shore and a belt of
- green tossing palms, just like any other island. As the ship coasts along,
- however, making for the village, the palm-trees break and open out here
- and there, and through the break one sees&mdash;paradise! There is a great
- sheet of turquoise-green water inside, and on the water an archipelago of
- the most exquisite little plumy, palmy islets, each ringed round with its
- own pearly girdle of coral sand. Every gap in the trees frames in a
- picture more lovely than the last&mdash;and, as we approach the village,
- the dainty little brown island canoes that all the Pacific wanderers know
- so well, begin to dot the jewel-bright surface of the inner lake, and
- gleams of white and rose and scarlet dresses, worn by the rowers of the
- tiny craft, sparkle on the water like gems. At last the vessel comes to
- anchor before a wide white, sloping beach, with brown-roofed huts
- clustering behind, and we reached merry Manahiki.
- </p>
- <p>
- The island has long enjoyed a reputation for peculiar innocence and
- simplicity, coupled with piety of a marked description. Well, one does not
- care to destroy any one&rsquo;s illusions, so the less said about Manahiki&rsquo;s
- innocence and simplicity the better. The islanders are, at all events, a
- kindly and a cheerful people, and their home is the neatest and best kept
- island in the Pacific. A palm-bordered road of finest white sand,
- beautifully kept, and four miles long, runs without a bend or break from
- one end of the island to the other&mdash;this portion of the atoll forming
- a separate island, and containing most of the scanty population. The
- village stands about midway&mdash;a collection of quaint little houses
- deeply thatched with plaited pan-danus leaf, and walled with small,
- straight saplings set side by side and admitting a good deal of light and
- air. The houses are unwindowed as a rule. Rakahanga, the sister island, is
- extremely like Manahiki in formation and architecture. It, however, enjoys
- the additional advantage of a jail, which is built of crossed saplings,
- looks much like a huge bird-cage, and certainly could not confine any one
- who made the smallest attempt to get out. But, as criminals are unknown in
- these islands, and petty offences are visited by fine instead of
- imprisonment, the jail is not expected to do real service, being merely a
- bit of &ldquo;swagger,&rdquo; like the white-washed stone houses possessed by one or
- two wealthy natives, who, Pacific fashion, never think of living in them.
- </p>
- <p>
- Within, the ordinary houses are extremely simple. The floor of white coral
- gravel reflects and intensifies the soft diffused light that enters
- through the walls. There may be a native bedstead, laced across with,
- &ldquo;sinnet&rdquo;&mdash;plaited cocoanut fibre&mdash;and provided with a gay
- patchwork quilt, and a few large soft mats of pandanus leaf, ingeniously
- split, dried, and plaited. There will certainly be a pile of camphor-wood
- trunks, containing the clothes of the household; a dozen or so cocoanut
- shells, for drinking and eating purposes; a few sheath-knives, and a small
- quantity of much-cherished crockery. In a corner, you may find a heap of
- flying-fish ready cleaned for baking in the oven-pit outside, and a number
- of green, unhusked cocoanuts, for drinking. You may possibly see some
- ship&rsquo;s biscuits, too, bought from the one white resident of the island, a
- trader and there will also be some lumps of white, soft pith, shaped like
- large buns&mdash;the &ldquo;sponge&rdquo; or kernel of the old cocoanut, which grows
- and fills up the shell after the water has dried away, and the nut
- commenced to sprout. But there will be no bananas, no oranges, no mangoes,
- granadillas, pineapples, yam, taro or ti root, bread-fruit or maupei
- chestnuts, as in the fertile volcanic islands. Manahiki is a coral island,
- pure and simple, and has no soil at all, nothing but sand and white
- gravel, out of which the cocoa-palm and a few small timber trees spring,
- in a manner that seems almost miraculous to those accustomed to the rich,
- fertile soil of Raratonga or Tahiti. Cocoanut and fish are the food of the
- Manahikian, varied by an occasional gorge of turtle-meat, and a feast of
- pig and fowl on very great occasions. There is, therefore, not much work
- to do in the island, and there are few distractions from the outside
- world, since trading schooners only call two or three times a year at
- best. Some copra-drying is done and a few toy canoes, baskets, and other
- curiosities are made, to find a precarious sale when a schooner comes in
- and the captain is inclined to speculate.
- </p>
- <p>
- But time never hangs heavy on the Manahikian&rsquo;s hands. He is the most
- accomplished dancer and singer in the whole South Pacific, and the island
- is inordinately vain of this distinction. All South Sea islanders sing
- constantly, but in Manahiki, the tunes are much sweeter and more definite
- than in most other islands; and the impromptu variations of the &ldquo;seconds&rdquo;
- are really wonderful. The voices, too, are exceptionally good. The women&rsquo;s
- are rather hard and piercing, but those of the men are often magnificent.
- The time is as perfect as if beaten out by a metronome, and false notes
- are almost unknown.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0036" id="linkimage-0036"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0359.jpg" alt="0359 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0359.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Men and women alike seem incapable of fatigue when singing. The mere white
- man will feel tired and husky after going through the choruses of <i>The
- Messiah</i> or <i>The Creation</i>. A Manahikian, if he were acquainted
- with oratorio music, would run through both, and then &ldquo;take on&rdquo; <i>Tannhauser</i>,
- following up with another Wagnerian opera, and perhaps a cantata thrown
- in. By this time, it would be dusk, and the chorus would probably stop to
- eat a cartload of cocoanuts before beginning on the whole <i>Nibelungen
- Ring</i> cycle for the night. About midnight the Resident Agent, a clever
- half-caste, who has European ideas about the value of sleep, would
- probably send out the village policeman with a stick to induce the singers
- to go to bed; and, quite unfatigued, they would rise up from their
- cross-legged squatting posture on the ground, and go, remonstrant, but
- compelled.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0037" id="linkimage-0037"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0360.jpg" alt="0360 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0360.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Happily for the Resident Agent and the trader, however, European music is
- not known in Manahiki, and when a singing fit seizes the people, they can
- generally be stopped after about a day, unless somebody has composed
- something very new and very screaming. If the two ends of the village have
- begun one of their musical competitions, there may also be difficulty in
- bringing it to a period; for the rival choruses will sing against each
- other with cracking throats and swelling veins, hour after hour, till both
- sides are completely exhausted.
- </p>
- <p>
- Dancing, however, is the Manahikian&rsquo;s chief reason for existing. The
- Manahikian dances are infinitely superior to those of most other islands,
- which consist almost altogether of a wriggle belonging to the <i>danse du
- ventre</i> family, and a little waving of the arms. The Manahiki dance has
- the wriggle for its groundwork, but there are many steps and variations.
- Some of the steps are so rapid that the eye can hardly follow them, and a
- camera shutter which works up to 1/100 of a second does not give a sharp
- result. The men are ranged in a long row, with the women opposite; there
- is a good deal of wheeling and turning about in brisk military style,
- advancing, retreating, and spinning round. The men dance very much on the
- extreme tips of their toes (they are, of course, barefooted) and keep up
- this painful posture for an extraordinary length of time. Every muscle in
- the whole body seems to be worked in the &ldquo;fancy&rdquo; steps; and there is a
- remarkable effect of general dislocation, due to turning the knees and
- elbows violently out and in.
- </p>
- <p>
- The women, like Miss Mercy Pecksniff, seem chiefly to favour the &ldquo;shape
- and skip&rdquo; style of locomotion. There is a good deal of both these, a great
- deal of wriggle, and plenty of arm action, about their dancing. They
- manoeuvre their long, loose robes about, not at all ungracefully, and do
- some neat step-dancing, rather inferior, however, to that of the men.
- </p>
- <p>
- Both men and women dress specially for the dance, so the festival that was
- organised to greet our arrivals took some time to get up, as all the beaux
- and belles of the village had to hurry home and dress. The women put on
- fresh cotton loose gowns, of brilliant pink, purple, yellow, white and
- green, oiled their hair with cocoanut oil scented with the fragrant white
- tieré flower, and hung long chains of red and yellow berries about their
- necks. About their waists they tied the dancing girdle, never worn except
- on these occasions, and made of twisted green ferns. The men took off
- their cool, easy everyday costume, of a short cotton kilt and gay coloured
- singlet, and attired themselves in shirts and heavy stuff trousers (bought
- from the trader at enormous expense, and considered the acme of
- smartness). Both sexes crowned themselves with the curious dancing
- headdress, which looks exactly like the long-rayed halo of a saint, and is
- made by splitting a palm frond down the middle, and fastening it in a
- half-circle about the back of the head.
- </p>
- <p>
- The music then struck up and the dancers began to assemble. The band
- consisted of two youths, one of whom clicked a couple of sticks together,
- while the other beat a drum. This does not sound attractive; but as a
- matter of fact, the Manahiki castanet and drum music is curiously weird
- and thrilling, and arouses a desire for dancing even in the prosaic
- European. On board our schooner, lying half a mile from shore, the sound
- of the measured click and throb used to set every foot beating time on
- deck, while the native crew frankly dropped whatever they were at, and
- began to caper wildly. Close at hand, the music is even more impressive;
- no swinging waltz thundered out by a whole Hungarian band gets &ldquo;into the
- feet&rdquo; more effectively than the Manahiki drum.
- </p>
- <p>
- A much-cherished possession is this drum. It is carved and ornamented with
- sinnet, and topped with a piece of bladder; it seems to have been hollowed
- out of a big log, with considerable labour. The skill of the drummers is
- really remarkable. No drumsticks are used, only fingers, yet the sound
- carries for miles. While drumming, the hands rise and fall so fast as to
- lose all outline to the eye; the drummer nods and beats with his foot in
- an ecstasy of delight at his own performance; the air is full of the
- throbbing, rhythmical, intensely savage notes. The dancers at first
- hesitate, begin and stop, and begin again, laugh and retreat and come
- forward undecidedly. By-and-by the dancing fervour seizes one or two; they
- commence to twirl and to stamp wildly, winnowing the air with their arms.
- Others join in, the two rows are completed, and Manahiki is fairly started
- for the day. Hour after hour they dance, streaming with perspiration in
- the burning sun, laughing and singing and skipping. The green fern girdles
- wither into shreds of crackling brown, the palm haloes droop, the berry
- necklaces break and scatter, but on they go. The children join in the
- dance now and then, but their small frames weary soon; the parents are
- indefatigable.
- </p>
- <p>
- Perhaps both ends of the settlement are dancing; if that is so, the
- competitive element is sure to come in sooner or later, for the feeling
- between the two is very like that between the collegers and oppidans at
- Eton, each despising the other heartily, and ready on all occasions to
- find a cause for a fight. They will dance against each other now, striving
- with every muscle to twinkle the feet quicker, stand higher on the tips of
- the toes, wriggle more snakily, than their rivals. Evening comes, and they
- are still dancing. With the night, the dance degenerates into something
- very like an orgy, and before dawn, to avoid scandal, a powerful hint from
- the native pastor and the agent causes the ball to break up.
- </p>
- <p>
- Do the dancers go to bed now, lie down on their piled up sleeping mats,
- and compose themselves to slumber? By no means. Most of them get torches,
- and go out on the reef in the dark to spear fish. Cooking fires are
- lighted, and there is a hurried gorge in the houses; everywhere, in the
- breaking dawn, one hears the chuck-chuck of the husking-stick preparing
- cocoanuts, and smells the savoury odour of cooking fish. The dancers have
- not eaten for at least twenty-four hours, perhaps more. But this feast
- does not last long, for just as the sun begins to shoot long scarlet rays
- up through the palm trees, some one begins to beat the drum again.
- Immediately the whole village pours out into the open, and the dance is
- all on again, as energetic as ever. The trading schooner is three weeks
- over-due, and the copra on which the island income depends is not half
- dried; there is not a fancy basket or a pandanus hat ready for the trader;
- the washing of every house is hopelessly behind, and nobody has had a
- decent meal since the day before yesterday. No matter: the Manahikians are
- dancing, and it would take an earthquake to stop them.
- </p>
- <p>
- Late in the second day, they will probably give out and take a night&rsquo;s
- rest. But it is about even chances that they begin again the next morning.
- In any case, no day passes in Manahiki or Rakahanga without a dance in the
- evening. Regularly at sunset the drum begins to beat, the fern girdles are
- tied on (relics, these, of heathen days when girdles of grass or fern were
- all that the dancers wore), and palm haloes are twisted about the glossy
- black hair, and the island gives itself up to enjoyment for the evening.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is a dancing-master in Manahiki, a most important potentate, who
- does nothing whatever but invent new dances, and teach the youth of the
- village both the old dances and the new.
- </p>
- <p>
- We stopped overnight at the island, so I had time for a good walk along
- the beautiful coral avenue, which is indeed one of the loveliest things in
- the island world. It was Sunday, and all the natives were worshipping in
- the exceedingly ugly and stuffy concrete church, under the guidance of the
- native pastor, so I had the place almost to myself. Far away from
- everywhere, sitting in a ruinous little hut under the trees by the inner
- lagoon, I found a lonely old man, crippled and unable to walk. He was
- waiting until the others came back from church, staring solemnly into the
- lagoon the while, and playing with a heap of cocoanut shells. By-and-by he
- would probably rouse up, drag himself into the hut, and busy himself
- getting ready the dinner for the family against their return home, for he
- was an industrious old man, and liked to make himself useful so far as he
- could, and his relatives were very glad of what small services he could
- render in washing and cooking.
- </p>
- <p>
- What was the matter with the poor old man? He was a leper!
- </p>
- <p>
- That is the way of the islands, and no white rule can altogether put a
- stop to it. The half-caste who acts as agent for the Government of New
- Zealand had hunted out a very bad case of leprosy a year or two before,
- and insisted on quarantining it in a lonely part of the bush. This was all
- very well, but the leper had a pet cock, which he wanted to take with him,
- and the agent&rsquo;s heart was not hard enough to refuse. Now the leper, being
- fed without working, and having nothing to do, found the time hanging
- heavy on his hands, so he taught the cock to dance&mdash;report says, to
- dance the real Manahiki dances&mdash;and the fame of the wondrous bird
- spread all over the island, and as far as Rakahanga, so that the natives
- made continual parties to see the creature perform, and quarantine became
- a dead letter. Still the agent had not the heart to take the cock away,
- but when he saw the leper&rsquo;s end was near, he watched, and as soon as he
- heard the man was dead, he hurried to the quarantined hut, set it on fire,
- and immediately slaughtered the cock. An hour later, half the island was
- out at the hut, looking for the bird&mdash;but they came too late.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <p>
- We have been two days at merry Manahiki, and the cargo is in, and the
- Captain has ordered the <i>Duchess</i>&mdash;looking shockingly cock-nosed
- without her great jib-boom&mdash;to be put under sail again. As the booms
- begin to rattle, and the sails to rise against the splendid rose and
- daffodil of the Pacific sunset, Shalli, our Cingalese steward, leans sadly
- over the rail, listening to the thrilling beat of the drum that is just
- beginning to throb across the still waters of the lagoon, now that evening
- and its merrymaking are coming on once more.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;He plenty good place, that,&rdquo; says Shalli mournfully. &ldquo;All the time
- dancing, singing, eating, no working&mdash;he all same place as heaven. O
- my God, I plenty wish I stopping there, I no wanting any heaven then!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- With this pious aspiration in our ears, we spread our white wings once
- more&mdash;for the last time. Raratonga lies before us now, and from
- Raratonga the steamers go, and the mails and tourists come, and the doors
- of the great world open for us again. So, good-bye to the life of the
- schooner.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0013" id="link2HCH0013"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER XIII
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>The Last of the Island Kingdoms&mdash;Fashions in Nukualofa&mdash;The
- King who was shy&mdash;His Majesty&rsquo;s Love Story&mdash;Who got the
- Wedding-Cake?&mdash;The Chancellor goes to Jail&mdash;Bungalow
- Housekeeping&mdash;The Wood of the Sacred Bats&mdash;By the Tombs of the
- Tui-Tongas&mdash;A &ldquo;Chief&rdquo; Kava-party&mdash;The Waits!&mdash;Mariner&rsquo;s
- Cave&mdash;The Cave of the Swallows&mdash;To Samoa.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">S</span>OME weeks
- afterwards, after a round of three thousand miles, I found myself in
- Tonga, better known as the Friendly Islands. The distance from the Cook
- Group was only one thousand or less, as the crow flies, but the steamers
- flew down to Auckland, and then back again, which naturally added to the
- journey. Pacific travel is a series of compromises. The British Resident
- of Niué, which is only three hundred miles from Tonga, wanted to get to
- the latter place about that time, and when I met him at Nukualofa, the
- Tongan capital, he had had to travel two thousand four hundred miles to
- reach it! But no one is ever in a hurry, under the shade of the cocoanut
- tree.
- </p>
- <p>
- Who has heard of Tongatabu? who knows where the &ldquo;Friendly Islands&rdquo; are?
- You will not find them very readily in the map, but they are to be found
- nevertheless, about one thousand miles to the north-east of New Zealand.
- And if you take the steamer that runs every month from Auckland to Sydney,
- touching at the &ldquo;Friendly&rdquo; or Tongan Group, on the way, you will find
- yourself, in four days, set down on the wharf of Nukualofa, the capital of
- the island of Tongatabu, and the seat of the oddest, most comic-opera-like
- monarchy that the world ever knew.
- </p>
- <p>
- Thirty years ago&mdash;even twenty&mdash;the Great South Seas were
- scattered over with independent island states, ruled by monarchs who
- displayed every degree of civilisation, from the bloodthirsty monster,
- Thakomban of Fiji and Jibberik, the half-crazy tyrant of Majuro, up to
- such Elizabeths of the Pacific as Liluokalani of Hawaii, and Queen Pomaré
- of Tahiti. Now there is but one island kingdom left; but one native
- sovereign, who still sits on his throne unembarrassed by the presence of a
- British Resident, who is ruler in all but name. Hawaii has fallen to
- America; France has taken the Marquesas and Tahiti; England has annexed
- the Cook Islands and dethroned the famous Queen Makea; Germany and America
- have partitioned Samoa between them; the rich archipelago of Fiji has been
- added to the British Colonies. This accounts for almost all of the larger
- and richer island groups, distinguished by a certain amount of original
- civilisation, and leaves only one unseized&mdash;Tonga, or the Friendly
- Islands, over which England has maintained a protectorate since 1900.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Tongan Archipelago was discovered by Captain Cook in 1777, and by him
- named the &ldquo;Friendly Islands,&rdquo; on account of the apparently friendly
- disposition of the natives. He sailed away from the group unaware that
- beneath their seemingly genial reception, the Tongans had been maturing a
- plot to murder him and seize his ship. Treachery, it is true, has never
- been an essential part of the Tongan character; but they are, and always
- have been, the most warlike of all Pacific races, and it is probable that
- they thought the character of the deed excused by the necessities of a
- military race who feared injury from a superior power.
- </p>
- <p>
- After Cook&rsquo;s visit the world heard very little of Tonga until 1816, when
- Mariner&rsquo;s &ldquo;Tonga Islands,&rdquo; the history of a young sailor&rsquo;s captivity among
- the natives of the group, fairly took the reading world by storm. It is
- still a classic among works of travel and adventure. Since the islands
- were converted to Christianity their history has been uneventful. One king&mdash;George
- Tubou I.&mdash;reigned for seventy years, and only died at last, aged
- ninety-seven, of a chill contracted from his invariable custom of bathing
- in the sea at dawn! His great-grandson, George Tubou II. succeeded,
- inheriting through his mother&rsquo;s side, as the Tongan succession follows the
- matriarchal plan. It is this king&mdash;aged thirty-four, six feet four in
- height, and about twenty-seven stone weight&mdash;who now sits upon the
- last throne of the Island Kings, and rules over the only independent state
- left in the Pacific.
- </p>
- <p>
- When Britain, assumed a Protectorate over Tonga in 1900, it was done
- simply to prevent any other nation annexing the rich and fertile group,
- with its splendid harbour of Vavau which lay so dangerously near Fiji. The
- Germans, who had maintained a kind of half-and-half Protectorate for some
- time, ceded their rights in exchange for those possessed by England in
- Samoa, and Tonga then became safe from the incursions of any foreign
- nation whose interests, trading and territorial, might be hostile to those
- of Britain.
- </p>
- <p>
- Perhaps as a consequence of all those negotiations, the Tongans have a
- high opinion of their own importance. When the war between China and Japan
- broke out, Tonga politely sent word to Great Britain that she intended to
- remain neutral, and not take any part in the affair. Great Britain&rsquo;s
- reply, I regret to say, is not recorded.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Tongans are a Christianised and partially civilised, if a coloured,
- race, numbering about 20,000. They are of a warm brown in hue, with dense
- black, wiry hair (usually dyed golden red with lime juice), tall,
- well-made frames, and immense muscular development. As a nation, they are
- handsome, with intelligent faces, and a dignity of pose and movement that
- is sometimes unkindly called the &ldquo;Tongan swagger.&rdquo; In education, many of
- them would compare favourably with the average white man, so far as mere
- attainments go; although a course of instruction at the local schools and
- colleges, amounting to very nearly the standard of an English
- &ldquo;matriculations,&rdquo; does not prevent its recipient from believing firmly in
- the holiness of the sacred Tongan bats, feeding himself with his fingers,
- and walking about his native village naked as Adam, save for a cotton
- kilt. There is not only a King in Tonga, but a real palace, guards of
- honour, a Parliament, a Prime Minister, a Chancellor of the Exchequer, and
- a large number of public officials. All these are Tongan natives. The
- king&rsquo;s guards are apt to make an especially vivid impression upon the
- newcomer, as he walks up the wharf, and sees the scarlet-coated sentry
- pacing up and down opposite the guard-room, with his fellows, also smartly
- uniformed, lounging inside. If the stranger, however, could have witnessed
- the scene on the wharf as soon as the steamer was signalled&mdash;-the
- sudden running up of a dozen or two of guards who had been amusing
- themselves about the town in undress uniform (navy-blue kilt, red sash,
- buff singlet), the scrambling and dressing <i>coram publico</i> on the
- grass, getting into trousers, boots, shirt, tunic, forage cap, and the
- hurried scuffle to get ready in time, and make a fine appearance to the
- steamer folk&mdash;he might think rather less of Tonga&rsquo;s military
- discipline. Beyond the wharf lies the town, straggling over a good mile of
- space, and consisting of a few main streets and one or two side alleys,
- bordered by pretty verandahed, flowery houses. The pavement is the same
- throughout&mdash;green grass, kept short by the constant passing of bare
- feet. There are a good many trading stores, filled with wares suited to
- native tastes&mdash;gaudy prints, strong perfumes, cutlery, crockery,
- Brummagem jewellery. The streets are busy to-day&mdash;busy for Nukualofa,
- that is. Every now and then a native passes, flying by on a galloping,
- barebacked horse, or striding along the grass with the inimitable Tongan
- strut; for it is steamer day, and the monthly Union steamer boat is the
- theatre, the newspaper, the society entertainment; the luxury-provider of
- all the archipelago. On the other twenty-nine or thirty days of the month,
- you may stand in the middle of a main street for half an hour at a time,
- and not see a single passer-by, but steamer day galvanises the whole
- island into life.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0038" id="linkimage-0038"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0376.jpg" alt="0376 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0376.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- The sand of the beach beside the wharf is as white as snow; it is
- pulverised coral from the reef, nothing else. Great fluted clam-shells, a
- foot long and more, lie about the strand, among the trailing pink-flowered
- convolvulus vines that wreathe the shore of every South Sea island.
- Unkempt pandanus trees, mounted on quaint high wooden stilts, overhang the
- green water; among the taller and more graceful cocoa-palms, Norfolk
- Island pines, odd, formal, and suggestive of hairbrushes, stand among
- feathery ironwoods and spreading-avavas about the palace of the king.
- Quite close to the wharf this latter is placed&mdash;a handsome
- two-storeyed building, with wide verandahs and a tower. Scarlet-coated
- sentries march up and down all day at its gates; it is surrounded by a
- wall, and carefully guarded from intruders. George Tubou II. is among the
- shyest of monarchs and hates nothing so much as being stared at; so on
- steamer days there is little sign of life to be seen about the palace.
- </p>
- <p>
- I happened to arrive in Tonga at an interesting historical crisis, and was
- promised an audience with the retiring monarch.
- </p>
- <p>
- After a week or two, however, the promise was suddenly recalled, and the
- visitor informed that the king declined to see her, then or at any other
- time. A little investigation revealed the cause. The High Commissioner of
- the Western Pacific had recently come over from Fiji; to remonstrate with
- the Tongan monarchy concerning certain unconstitutional behaviour, and a
- British man-of-war had accompanied him. I, being the only other person on
- the island from &ldquo;Home,&rdquo; had naturally been seeing a good deal of the
- formidable stranger. This was enough for the king. There was a plot to
- deprive him of his throne, he was certain; and it was obvious that I was
- in it, whatever I might choose to say to the contrary. There was no
- knowing what crime I might not be capable of, once admitted to the Royal
- Palace. George Tubou II. is six feet four, and twenty-seven stone weight,
- but he is distinctly of a nervous temperament; and his fears of Guy
- Fawkesism kept possession of his mind during the whole of my stay; so that
- the carefully averted face of a fat, copper-coloured sort of Joe Sedley,
- driving very fast in a buggy, was all I saw of Tonga&rsquo;s king.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is no one, surely, in the world who quite comes up to George of
- Tonga for a &ldquo;guid conceit o&rsquo; himsel&rsquo;.&rdquo; When he wished to provide himself
- with a queen, some six or seven years ago, he first applied to the Emperor
- of Germany, to know if there was a German Princess of marriageable age
- whom he could have! The Kaiser politely replied in the negative. King
- George then sent proposals to a princess of Hawaii who was as well
- educated as any white lady, and used to diplomatic society in Washington.
- This also failing, he turned his attentions to his own country; and then
- began the most extraordinary love-story ever told under the Southern Cross&mdash;a
- story that could have happened nowhere on the globe, except in the
- comic-opera country of Tonga.
- </p>
- <p>
- There were two eligible princesses of the royal line of Tonga&mdash;Princess
- Ofa and Princess Lavinia. The king appears to have proposed to them both,
- and then found himself unable to decide between the two. They were both of
- high rank, both good-looking after the portly Tongan fashion, and both
- very willing to be queen, reign over the fine palace, order lots of silk
- dresses from Auckland, wear the queen&rsquo;s crown of Tonga (supposed to be
- gold, but rather inclined to suspicious outbreaks of verdigris), and see
- the natives get off their horses and kneel on the ground, when the royal
- state carriage drove by.
- </p>
- <p>
- But the king kept both princesses in the agonies of suspense ever present,
- and hope constantly deferred for months&mdash;until the wedding-day was
- fixed, the wedding-cake (ordered three years before from a New Zealand
- confectioner, for the German Princess who was not to be had) patched up
- and fresh coloured, the wedding-dress provided, at the expense of the
- Government of Tonga (according to custom) and actually made! Not till the
- very night before the wedding did his dilatory Majesty at last declare his
- intentions, and fix upon the princess he had last proposed to, whom nobody
- expected him to take&mdash;Lavinia. It is a sober fact that the wedding
- invitation cards, sent out at the last minute, were printed with a blank
- for the bride&rsquo;s name, which was added with a pen! Lavinia, overjoyed at
- her good luck, got into the Governmentally provided wedding dress next
- day, and (as the fairy tales say) &ldquo;the wedding was celebrated with great
- pomp!&rdquo; There is no sense of humour in Tonga. If there had been, the king
- could hardly have selected the means of consolation for Ofa&rsquo;s
- disappointment that he actually did choose, in sending her the bottom half
- of his wedding cake, as soon as the ceremony was over. Princess Ofa was
- not proud; she had been beating her head on the floor-mats all morning and
- pulling out handfuls of her long black hair, but when the consolatory cake
- arrived, she accepted it promptly and ate it.
- </p>
- <p>
- There are generally illuminations on the night of a royal wedding. Tonga
- was not behind-hand in this matter, but the illuminations were of rather
- an unusual kind, being nothing less than numbers of burning native houses,
- set on fire by the indignant friends of the jilted Princess Ofa. The
- friends of the new queen retaliated in kind; and for nearly a week, arson
- became the recognised sport of the island. This excess of party feeling
- soon died down, however, and the newly married couple were left to
- honeymoon in peace.
- </p>
- <p>
- An infant princess was born in due time, and not very long after, Queen
- Lavinia died. Here was Princess Ofa&rsquo;s chance, if Fate had permitted; but
- Ofa herself was dead, leaving no eligible princess to console the widowed
- king.
- </p>
- <p>
- For more than five years the monarch (who is still only thirty-four) has
- lived alone, a mark for every husband-hunting princess in the Pacific. A
- princess related to an ancient island monarchy, invited herself to stay in
- the palace one recent Christmas. King George received her pleasantly,
- entertained her for some weeks, and then sent her home with a big packet
- of fine tobacco and a barrel of spirits, to console her for the
- non-success of her visit&mdash;which may be accounted for by the fact that
- she is rather older than the king himself, and by no means so lovely as
- she was. A favoured candidate is a certain princess of the royal family of
- Tahiti. She has been described to the king as handsome, and at least
- sixteen stone weight, both of which claims are quite correct. King George
- really wants a European princess, but as soon as he has been convinced for
- the second time that this is impossible, it is hoped that he will decide
- on the Tahitian princess, and elevate her to the Tongan throne, since he
- admires fat women exceedingly.
- </p>
- <p>
- One of the most remarkable things in this remarkable country is the
- Parliament. It would take too long to record the history of this
- assembly&rsquo;s birth and development; but the chapter has been a notable one
- in Tongan history. The Parliament usually consists of the King and Prime
- Minister, the Chancellor of the Exchequer, the Chief Justice, and a score
- or two of important chiefs, some of whom inherit by birth, while others
- are returned by their native villages. At the time of my visit, there were
- a couple of vacancies in this remarkable assembly, since the High
- Commissioner of the Western Pacific (Governor of Fiji) had just deported
- the Prime Minister and the Chancellor of the Exchequer to Fiji, on account
- of certain proceedings which resulted in emptying Tonga&rsquo;s public treasury
- and leaving nothing to show for it.
- </p>
- <p>
- Their absence did not greatly matter, however, as it is a rule of the
- Tongan Constitution, that Parliament shall not meet oftener than once in
- three years. An excellent and practical reason lies at the root of this
- seemingly peculiar law. Tongatabu is a small island, only twenty miles
- long; and when the Members of Parliament,&mdash;dressed in new cotton
- kilts, with smart large floor-mats tied round their waists with sinnet
- (cocoanut fibre plait), and violet, sea-green, or lemon silk shirts on
- their brown backs&mdash;arrive from the outer villages and islands in
- Nukualofa with all their relatives, for the beginning of the session,
- something very like a famine sets in. The whole Parliament, also its
- sisters, aunts, and grandpapas, has to be fed at public expense, while it
- stays in the capital arranging the affairs of the nation; and as the
- length of its sitting is always regulated by the amount of provisions
- available, and never ends until the last yam, the last skinny chicken, the
- last sack of pineapples, is eaten up, it is easy to understand why the
- capital does not care to undergo such a strain any oftener than it can
- help.
- </p>
- <p>
- A new Prime Minister and Chancellor of the Exchequer were appointed before
- long, and it was made a condition of the latter office, that the
- Chancellor should understand a reasonable amount of arithmetic. There was
- also a rigid rule made about the keeping of the key of the Government safe
- in some suitable place. A good deal of trouble was caused by the last
- Chancellor&rsquo;s losing it, one day when he was out fishing on the coral reef!
- There was a duplicate, but the Chancellor had carefully locked it up in
- the safe, to make sure it should not be lost! The poor old gentleman
- nearly get sunstroke hunting about the coral reef for the key until he
- found it. If it had been carried, away by the tides, the safe must have
- remained closed until an expert from Auckland could be brought up to open
- it. As the Chancellor of the Exchequer did not know how much he had in it,
- or how much he had spent in the last quarter, it can readily be understood
- that the public accounts acquired an entirely superfluous extra tangle or
- two during the absence of the lost key.
- </p>
- <p>
- Tonga enjoys one of the finest climates in the Pacific. The heat is never
- excessive, and the air is generally bright and invigorating. Fevers are
- unheard of, and the few white residents of the islands enjoy splendid
- health. As for the Tongans themselves, they dispute with the Fijians the
- palm of being physically the finest and strongest people in the whole
- Pacific; and no one has ever thought of challenging their claim to be the
- most intellectual of all the brown island races. Their carriage is superb,
- though only its extreme <i>aplomb</i> and ease save it from degenerating
- into an actual swagger. Their dress displays the most perfect taste in the
- South Seas. It consists, among the men, of a short tunic (&ldquo;vala&rdquo;) of fine
- cashmere or silk, occasionally of cotton, on working days&mdash;draped
- with all the grace of an antique statue, and worn with a wide sash, and a
- thin, close-fitting singlet or shirt. The Tongan woman generally wears a
- garment that is suggestive of the Greek <i>chiton</i>&mdash;a loose
- sleeveless dress reaching to a point midway between waist and knee.
- Underneath is seen a tunic similar to that of the men, but a little
- longer. The colours chosen by both sexes are exquisite. No artist could
- design more beautiful combinations than those I have often seen flitting
- about the grassy streets of Nukualofa, Tonga&rsquo;s capital. A finely made
- giant strides by, in a navy-blue vala, cream-coloured silk shirt, and
- vivid sea-green sash. Another wears a pale blue vala and shirt, and a sash
- of royal blue. A third is in white and lemon colour girdled with orange;
- another wears a white vala, a pale green shirt, and a sash of violet silk.
- A tall, self-possessed young woman, her hair dyed golden red with lime,
- and worn coiffed high above the forehead, with a fall of natural curls
- down her back, has a scarlet and yellow vala under her short brown silk
- gown, while her companion&mdash;smaller and merrier faced, with the
- melting black eyes of &ldquo;The Islands&rdquo;&mdash;wears and looks charming in, a
- pale-blue gown over a vala of daffodil yellow. These are the fashions of
- Tonga; and they offer a feast for artistic souls and pencils, that cannot
- be matched under the Southern Cross.
- </p>
- <p>
- Tonga is very seldom visited by travellers, except for an hour or two
- during the steamer&rsquo;s stay in port, and it is hardly ever seen by British
- tourists. I could not discover that any English lady had ever made a stay
- there, except myself, and the wife of a local Church dignitary. There are,
- of course, a few Colonial residents. But the English traveller leaves
- Tonga out altogether, which is really a pity&mdash;for his sake. As for
- the islands, they can do very well without tourists, and would not be the
- better for them.
- </p>
- <p>
- There was no hotel save a plain and simple public-house, at the time of my
- stay, though I understand this defect has been remedied. I had therefore
- to set up housekeeping on my own account. The tiny bungalow I took for my
- stay of four weeks in the island, was a real South Sea home. It stood
- almost on the white coral sand of the beach, and close to the cool green
- waters of the lagoon; it was shaded by palms and scarlet-blossomed
- &ldquo;flamboyant&rdquo; trees, and it was nearly all door and window and verandah.
- Its carpets were plaited pandanus-leaf mats; the ornaments in the
- sitting-room were foot-long fluted clam-shells off the beach, filled with
- wild red and yellow hibiscus flowers, poignantly perfumed frangipani
- stars, and the sweet pink blossoms of the South Sea oleander. The back
- kitchen had generally a bunch of bananas hanging from the roof, a pile of
- green cocoanuts for drinking, under the window, a mound of yellow papaws,
- or tree-melons, in a corner, some custard-apples and mangoes, and a big
- basket of pineapples, bought at the door for fourteen a shilling, or
- picked by myself during a drive through the bush.
- </p>
- <p>
- There was not much else, besides bread and tea. I almost lived on fruit,
- and could not help wondering what the inhabitants of temperate latitudes,
- who fear ill consequences from a dozen plums or a double handful of
- strawberries, would have thought of my uncounted mangoes, and bananas, and
- five or six pineapples a day. Only children, at home in England, really
- know how much fruit can safely be undertaken by the human digestive
- organs. Wise children! and foolish elders, who have forgotten so soon.
- </p>
- <p>
- The transparent waters of the lagoon outside, lapping idly under the
- leaves of overhanging palm and pandanus, were not so cool as they looked,
- under the hot midday sun; and if one did not want a tepid sea-bath, it was
- best to wait till night. Then, what a luxury it was, after the heat of the
- day (for Tonga, though cool for the tropics, is nevertheless tropical), to
- float about in the dim lagoon, under a glow of stars that fit up the sky
- almost as brightly as an English moon, the dark shining water bearing one
- to and fro with the swell from the reef, the land growing farther and
- farther away, the palms on the thin pale shoreline standing out small and
- black, like Indian ink sketches, against the lurid purple of the midnight
- sky! Willingly indeed one would have passed the whole night out there,
- swimming, and floating in a warm dark sea of stars&mdash;stars above and
- stars below&mdash;if nature had not given out after an hour or two, and
- demanded a return to the solid earth. Sharks? Well, they had &ldquo;hardly ever&rdquo;
- been seen inside the reef. Stingarees, with their immense ugly bodies
- buried in the sand at the bottom, and their cruel barbed tails ready to
- strike? Yes, they had been seen, but not often; and in tropic waters you
- learn to take the chances like every one else, and enjoy yourself without
- thinking of the &ldquo;might-be&rsquo;s.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0039" id="linkimage-0039"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0382.jpg" alt="0382 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0382.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- It was the hot season, but not too hot for riding or driving, and I spent
- many mornings exploring about the island. To the Wood of the Bats, about
- eleven miles from Nukualofa, one drives in a springy little colonial
- buggy, driving over mile after mile of rather uneven grass road, along
- avenues of blossoming orange trees, through groves of bananas and
- breadfruit and tall mango trees, past straggling native villages with neat
- little fancy-work houses made of woven reeds and thatch, until, in the
- distance, one begins to hear a loud screaming, squeaking, and chattering
- noise. This is the Wood of the Bats that we are coming to, and that is
- some of their usual conversation. Under the trees&mdash;there are over
- twenty of them, avavas, like great cedars, ironwoods, mangoes; all big
- forest trees, and all covered with bats as thick as a currant bush with
- currants&mdash;the squeaking and squealing grows almost deafening,
- Thousands of great flying-foxes, with dark furry bodies as big as cats,
- big spreading wings (now folded tightly up) and sharp, keen fox-like
- heads, hang upside down on every tree, waiting for the night to come, and
- whiling away the time by quarrelling and swearing. They are all bad, these
- bats; they axe ugly, dirty, vicious, destructive and greedy&mdash;yet they
- are strictly tabooed by the natives, and no one dares to kill a single
- one. It is believed that the prosperity of Tonga is inextricably
- associated with the bats, and that, if they ever deserted the wood, the
- country would fall. They are sacred, and must not be touched.
- </p>
- <p>
- Every evening, punctually at five o&rsquo;clock, the bats take wing, and rise
- from the trees like a screaming cloud of evil spirits. The sky is
- blackened with their bodies as they go, and scattered all over with the
- long streaming flights of separate bats that divide away from the main
- body. They are off to feed&mdash;to feed all night upon the bananas and
- pineapples and mangoes of the unhappy islanders, who lose thousands of
- pounds&rsquo; worth of fruit and trade every year, but dare not revenge
- themselves. Just at dawn, they will return, screaming and shoving rudely
- as they settle down in the trees once more, squabbling for upper berths,
- and trying to push into a nice comfortable place amidships of a particular
- bough, by biting the occupant&rsquo;s toes until he lets go. They may have flown
- forty or fifty miles in the night, visited islands more than twenty miles
- away, and devastated the plantations of Tonga from end to end. They have
- worked hard for their suppers, and now they will doze and squabble all
- day, once more, until evening.
- </p>
- <p>
- A few miles from the Wood of Bats, in the midst of exquisite scenery,
- stands a famous avava known as Captain Cook&rsquo;s Tree. It was under this tree
- that the great explorer called together all the natives, on his discovery
- of the islands in 1777, and addressed them by means of an interpreter. The
- account of this will be found in &ldquo;Cook&rsquo;s Voyages.&rdquo; The tree is still in
- splendid condition, in spite of its age, which must amount to many hundred
- years. Pigs were brought to Tonga by Cook in this same year, and a few of
- the original breed are still to be seen in the island&mdash;tall, gaunt,
- hump-backed creatures with immense heads and long noses, contrasting oddly
- with the smaller and fatter kinds introduced by later voyagers.
- </p>
- <p>
- The burial-place of the Tui Tongans made an object for another drive.
- Before the introduction of Christianity, in early Victorian days, the
- Tongans had two kings, an ordinary earthly king, who did all the hard work
- of governing, and a heavenly king, the Tui Tonga, who was supposed to be
- of divine descent, and was worshipped as a god. For many centuries, the
- Tui Tongas were buried in great oblong raised enclosures, three-terraced,
- and built of rough-hewn, closely fitted slabs from the coral reef. Two of
- these great tombs still remain, hidden in tangled thickets of low bush,
- and considerably worn by age. I had no means of measurement, but judged
- the larger one to be about fifty yards by thirty, the smaller somewhat
- less. The state of the coral slabs, and the great trees that have grown up
- rooted among them, suggest that the tombs are extremely old. Tradition
- among the natives takes them back beyond the recollection of any of their
- ancestors; they cannot say when or why they were built. The construction&mdash;a
- double terrace, each step about five feet high&mdash;and the carefully
- arranged oblong shape, seem to point to some special significance long
- since forgotten. There is also a &ldquo;trilithon&rdquo; erection of three large
- blocks of stone, some miles away, concerning which island traditions are
- silent. It could not have been constructed by hand labour alone; some
- mechanical device must have been employed to raise the centre stone to its
- present position. The ancient Tongans, however, knew nothing of mechanics,
- and an interesting problem is therefore set for antiquarians to solve. The
- height of the side supports is about twenty feet, and the centre
- cross-piece, which rests in a socket on each side, is a little less in
- length.
- </p>
- <p>
- The beautiful and interesting sea-caves&mdash;some swarming with birds,
- others celebrated for their lovely colouring and formation&mdash;which are
- found in the windward side of the island, I was unable to see, owing to
- the bad weather of the rainy season, during which my visit was made.
- </p>
- <p>
- A &ldquo;Chief&rdquo; kava-party, however, got up for my benefit, consoled me for the
- loss of the caves. Kava is the great national drink of Tonga, as of many
- other South Sea islands. It is made from the hard woody root of the Piper
- methysticum and is exhilarating and cooling, but not actually
- intoxicating. In taste, it is extremely unpleasant till one gets used to
- it, being peppery, soapy, and dish-watery as to flavour. I had drunk kava
- before, however, and learned to recognise its pleasanter properties; also,
- the old custom of chewing the kava-root, before infusing it, which still
- obtains in some parts of Samoa, has been quite given up in Tonga, and the
- pounding is done with stones.
- </p>
- <p>
- The scene was weird and strange in the last degree. I was the only white
- person present. We all squatted on the mats in the chief&rsquo;s house, the
- natives in their valas and loose short gowns, with white scented flowers
- in their hair; I in a smart demi-toilette evening dress, because I was the
- special guest, and the chief&rsquo;s family would expect me to honour them by
- &ldquo;dressing the part.&rdquo; The only light was a ship&rsquo;s hurricane lantern, placed
- on the floor, where it threw the most Rembrandtesque of shadows upon the
- silent circle of brown, glittering-eyed faces, and upon the rapt ecstatic
- countenances of the kava-makers, as they went through all the details of
- what was evidently an ancient religious ceremony, very savage, very
- native, and not at all &ldquo;missionary,&rdquo; despite the church membership of all
- the performers. There were loud sonorous chants and responses, elaborate
- gymnastics, with the great twist of hibiscus fibre that was used to strain
- the kava after it was pounded, and water poured on; something very like
- incantations, and finally, a wild religious ecstasy on the part of the
- kava-maker, who worked himself almost into a fit, and at last sank back
- utterly exhausted, with the bowl of prepared kava before him. This bowl
- was a standing vessel as big as a round sponge bath, carved, legs and all,
- from one block of a huge forest tree-trunk, and exquisitely polished and
- enamelled, by many years of kava-holding. Its value was beyond price.
- </p>
- <p>
- The calling of names now began&mdash;first the chief&rsquo;s, then mine, then
- the other guests. There is great ceremony observed at kava-drinkings, and
- an order of precedence as strict as that of a German Court. As my name was
- called, I clapped my hands once, took the cocoanut bowl from the girl who
- was serving it, and swallowed the contents at a draught. The next name was
- then called, and the next drinker drank as I did. It is very bad manners
- to act otherwise. The girl who served the kava walked round our squatting
- circle in a doubled-up posture that must surely have made her back ache;
- but custom forbade her to stand erect while serving.
- </p>
- <p>
- After the long ceremony was ended, the dignified white-haired chief held a
- conversation with me, by means of an interpreter; and told me that there
- were four ways of kava-drinking, each with its appropriate etiquette.
- </p>
- <p>
- That which I had seen was the most important and elaborate of the four,
- very seldom used, and only permitted to chiefs. We exchanged a good many
- stately compliments through the interpreter, and I then took my departure.
- </p>
- <p>
- It is near the end of my visit, and in a few more days, the steamer takes
- me on to Haapai and Vavau and beautiful, steamy-hot Samoa. But this is
- Christmas morning, and one can think of nothing else.
- </p>
- <p>
- Nothing? Well, those who know what it is to spend that day of days under a
- burning tropic sky, with palms and poinsettia for Christmas garlandry,
- instead of holly and mistletoe, know just what thoughts fly homewards
- across twelve thousand miles of sea, and how far they are concerned with
- the sunny, lonely Christmas of the present&mdash;how far with the dark and
- stormy Christmases of the past, when snow and winter reigned outside, but
- summer, more brilliant than all the splendours of southern world, was
- within, and in the heart. But it is of the Tongan Christmas day that I
- have to tell.
- </p>
- <p>
- I was awakened very early by&mdash;the waits! Whatever one expects under
- the Southern Cross, one certainly does not expect that, and yet there they
- were, a score of boys and youths playing merry tunes under my window, and
- pausing now and then to see if I was not awake to come out and give them
- their Christmas &ldquo;tip.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0040" id="linkimage-0040"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0388.jpg" alt="0388 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0388.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- I dressed hastily, and came on to the verandah. The music of the band,
- which had puzzled me a good deal, now turned out to be produced solely by
- mouth-organs, blown by a number of youths dressed exactly alike in black
- valas, white linen jackets, and white uniform caps. The soul of the Tongan
- loves a uniform above everything, and all the bands in the islands&mdash;of
- whom there are an astonishing number&mdash;wear specially made costumes of
- a rather military type.
- </p>
- <p>
- It was frightfully hot, for Christmas is midsummer here, and the day was
- exceptionally warm in any case.
- </p>
- <p>
- But the &ldquo;waits,&rdquo; standing out in the burning sun, did not seem to feel the
- heat at all. They blew lustily away at their mouth-organs, playing English
- dance music, Tongan songs, missionary hymns, in wonderful time and
- harmony, and with the inimitable Tongan verve and swing, poor though the
- instruments were. The performance was quite worth the gift they expected,
- I listened as long as they cared to play. Then they collected their dues,
- and went off to serenade a white trader, who, I strongly suspected, had
- been celebrating Christmas Eve after a fashion that would not tend to make
- him grateful for an early call.
- </p>
- <p>
- For me, Christmas had begun on the previous evening when I went to the
- midnight Mass at the church upon the shore, among the palms and the
- feathery ironwood trees. In the crystal-clear moonlight, what a brilliant
- scene it was! Even outside the church, the decorations could be seen for
- miles, since they consisted of thousands and thousands of
- half-cocoanut-shells, filled with cocoanut oil, and provided with a wick
- of twisted fibre, which when lit, burnt with a clear ray like a star,
- illuminating the walls of the churchyard, the outlines of the doors and
- the ridges of the roof&mdash;even the winding walks about the building,
- too, and the low-growing trees&mdash;with a perfect Milky Way of dancing
- light.
- </p>
- <p>
- Within, all the colours of a coral reef (which includes every hue of a
- rainbow, and many more) were in full blaze about the tremendous, unbroken
- floor, where the natives stood or sat cross-legged, dressed in all their
- gayest finery. There was a heavy scent of perfumed cocoanut oil,
- orange-blossom, and frangipani flowers and a rich glow of lights; and the
- waves of gorgeous melody that burst forth now and again with the progress
- of the service were like the billows of Time breaking upon the shores of
- Eternity. Of all the choral singing that I heard in the Pacific, that of
- Tonga was incomparably the fullest, the most splendid, and most majestic.
- The singers of Manahiki are sweeter and stranger, those of the Cook
- Islands more varied and soft, but the Tongan music is, for sheer
- magnificence and volume, unsurpassable.
- </p>
- <p>
- The women, in their graceful tunics, with their elaborately dressed hair,
- and their fine, dignified presence, were all unlike the soft, sensuous,
- languorous syrens of Tahiti and Raratonga, They do not encourage
- familiarity, even from white women, and their moral character is much
- higher than that of their sisters in the far Eastern Pacific. Women are
- treated with more respect in Tonga than in any part of the Pacific. They
- have little to do in the way of household work, and almost no field work.
- The men save them most of the hard labour, on the undeniable ground that
- hard work makes a woman ugly, and they do not care for ugly wives!
- </p>
- <p>
- Nearly every one wore a mat tied round the waist, partly concealing the
- gay dress&mdash;in spite of the extreme heat of the night. Some of the
- mats were new and clean, but most were old, ragged, and dirty. This
- curious custom is a relic of ancient heathen days in Tonga, when a
- handsome dress of any kind, worn by a commoner, was apt to arouse the
- dangerous envy of a chief, and in consequence, a native who was wearing
- his &ldquo;best&rdquo; generally tied the dirtiest old mat that he could get over all,
- so that he might not look too rich! The reason has long since vanished,
- but the custom remains in a modified form. A mat, tied round the waist
- with strong sinnet cord, is considered a correct finish to the gayest of
- festival costume in Tonga of to-day, and, as far as I was able to
- ascertain, its absence, on occasions of ceremony, is considered rather
- vulgar.
- </p>
- <p>
- The service was enlivened by the presence of a very large and extremely
- loud brass band. Brass is a passion with the Tongan musician, and he
- certainly makes the most of it. The effects produced are a little
- monotonous to a European ear, but, none the less, impressive and fine.
- </p>
- <p>
- After the midnight mass, I went home in the bright moonlight, the gentle
- stir of the trade-wind, the soft rustle of the ironwood trees, falling
- with a pleasantly soothing effect upon ears a little strained and tired by
- the strenuous character of the Tongan music. Next morning came the waits,
- and in the afternoon there were games and sports of a rather too familiar
- Sunday-school pattern, at the various mission stations. I did not trouble
- to attend any of them, as the Pacific native is certainly least
- interesting when most intent on copying the ways and fashions of the white
- man. The cricket matches which came off at various intervals during the
- few weeks of my stay, were well worth seeing, however, for the Tongan is a
- magnificent cricketer, and has often inflicted bitter defeat on the best
- teams that visiting men-of-war could put in the field against him.
- </p>
- <p>
- The politically disturbed state of the island was interesting in one way,
- but a serious disadvantage in another, since it prevented my obtaining
- much information about many interesting native customs that I should have
- been glad to investigate. I am afraid that I deserved the worst that
- scientifically minded travellers could say of me, in Tonga, for I merely
- spent the time enjoying myself after the pleasant island fashion, and not
- in research or geographical note-taking, even so far as was possible. Yet,
- after all, what are the islands, if not a Garden of Indolence, a
- lotus-land, a place where one dreams, and wanders, and listens to the
- murmuring reef-song, and sleeps under the shade of a palm, and wakes but
- to dream again? Does one degenerate, in such a life? Why, yes, of course&mdash;constantly,
- surely, and most delightfully.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;<i>Be good, and you will be happy, but you won&rsquo;t have a good time</i>,&rdquo;
- says &ldquo;Pudd&rsquo;nhead Wilson,&rdquo; one of the wisest of modern philosophers. In the
- islands, one is not good, in the ordinary Dr. Wattian sense of the term,
- and perhaps one is not happy&mdash;though if so, one never finds it out.
- But the good time one does have, and it is very good indeed. And if you do
- not believe me, dear sensible reader, never be tempted to go and try, for
- it is very likely that the good time and your own goodness would mutually
- cancel one another, and you would be unvirtuous and bored all in one. The
- islands are not for all, and the gateway to the &ldquo;Tir-na&rsquo;n-Oge&rdquo; is now, as
- ever, hard to find.
- </p>
- <p>
- The big Union steamer, with her ice, and her &ldquo;cuisine&rdquo; (cooking is never
- cooking, on board a passenger vessel), and her dainty little blue and
- white cabins, and her large cool saloon glittering with crystal and
- gilding, came in in due time, and I went away with her to Samoa. The three
- days&rsquo; run was broken by two calls in the Tongan group&mdash;one at Haapai,
- and one at Vavau.
- </p>
- <p>
- Of Haapai, a long, low, wooded island, with a few hundred native
- inhabitants, and one or two whites, we saw nothing but the king&rsquo;s palace&mdash;a
- great, square, two-storeyed, verandahed building, which is never lived in&mdash;and
- the Wesleyan chapel, which has some of the finest sinnet work in the
- Pacific to show. This sinnet work is quite distinctive of the islands, and
- is very beautiful and artistic. It is not one of the &ldquo;curios&rdquo; known to the
- markets and collections of civilisation, because it is always done <i>in
- situ</i>, and cannot be removed. At first sight, it looks like remarkably,
- good chip carving, done on the capitals of pillars, and about the centres
- of supports and beams, in various shades of red, black, brown, and yellow.
- Looking closer, one sees that it is much more remarkable than carving,
- being a solid mass of interwoven sinnet plait, as fine as very thin twine,
- wound and twisted into raised patterns by the clever fingers of the
- natives. In the church at Haapai, the sinnet plaiting is very fine and
- elaborate, and certainly well worth seeing. The captain of the steamer,
- who acted as our guide, made sure we had all seen it, and then took us a
- wild, hot, hurried walk across the island, to the coral beach at the other
- side, and past the palace, and along an endless cocoanut avenue, which was
- very pretty, but&mdash;&mdash;
- </p>
- <p>
- We wanted our afternoon tea, and we mutinied at that point, and insisted
- on going back to the ship. This grieved our commander, who conceived that
- his duties to the Company required he should ensure every passenger saw
- everything that was to be seen on the whole voyage, and shirked nothing&mdash;but
- we threatened to overpower and maroon him, if he did not take us back, so
- he returned, lecturing learnedly about the cutting off of the
- &ldquo;Port-au-Prince,&rdquo; in Haapai, by the natives, in seventeen hundred and
- I-forget-when. We ought to have been listening&mdash;but we wanted our
- tea, and we weren&rsquo;t.
- </p>
- <p>
- We reached Vavau just before dark, barely in time to admire the wonderful
- windings and fiords, the long blue arms and bright green islets, of this
- Helen among island harbours. Vavau is celebrated for its beauty through
- all the South Sea world, and its loveliness has not been one whit
- exaggerated.
- </p>
- <p>
- In the early morning&mdash;at half-past five, to be precise&mdash;the
- energetic captain routed all the passengers out of their bunks, and
- compelled them, by sheer force of character, to follow him, groaning and
- puffing, up a hill five hundred feet high, and exceedingly precipitous&mdash;a
- mere crag, in fact&mdash;that overlooked the harbour. We did not want to
- go, but none of us were sorry we had been compelled, when we did get to
- the top and saw that matchless harbour lying extended at our feet, mile
- after mile of land-locked fiord and palmy headland and exquisite green
- island, all set in a stainless mirror of flaming blue, and jewelled, where
- the shallows lightened to the shore, with flashes of marvellous colour
- shot up from the coral reef lying underneath. Rose and amethyst and
- violet, and malachite green and tawny yellow&mdash;they were all there,
- painting the splendid sweep of the harbour waters with hues that no mortal
- brush could reproduce, or pen describe. We stayed there long, and even the
- thought of breakfast, generally a moving call, did not hurry us away.
- </p>
- <p>
- In the afternoon, the captain had business to attend to, so he turned out
- one of the officers to act as guide, and sent us all off to see the Cave
- of the Swallows, and Mariner&rsquo;s Cave, on the other side of the harbour.
- </p>
- <p>
- If the Cave of the Swallows were situated on any European coast, it would
- be as tourist-ridden a spot as the Blue Grotto of Capri, or any other of
- the thousand famous caves through which holiday-making travellers are
- dragged each summer season&mdash;and would consequently be despoiled of
- half its loveliness. But it is very far away, in the South Sea Islands,
- and though a passenger steamer does visit Vavau once a month there are
- usually no tourists&mdash;only a missionary and a trader or two. So the
- lovely place lies undisturbed almost all the time, and you shall not find,
- when you row across the harbour to see it, that you have to wait your turn
- in a crowd of other boats, full of romping and larking trippers, with the
- guide of every party keeping a sharp look-out to see that no one takes
- longer than he ought going over the &ldquo;sight&rdquo;&mdash;so long as his charges
- remain outside.
- </p>
- <p>
- Instead of this, we glide silently under a noble archway some fifty feet
- high, and enter a great, still, ocean sanctuary, that looks as if no
- wandering oar had ever profaned its peace, since first the white man came
- to these far-off isles. Outside, the water is Prussian blue in colour, and
- over a thousand feet deep, but within the arch of the cave the bottom
- shoots up till it is within a hundred feet of the glass-clear surface on
- which we float, hanging above the silver-coloured coral reefs of the deep
- sea-bed, like birds hanging in air. The roof and walls of the cave are
- brilliant verdigris green, the water-floor, that curves so. closely in and
- out of the numerous arches and recesses, where mysterious shadows creep,
- is sapphire shot with fire. At one side of the cave there is a dark
- winding corridor leading to depths unknown. We glide down this a little
- way, and there before us opens out&mdash;surely, a temple and a shrine!
- The water-floor spreads and broadens here into the carpet of a high,
- still, secret inner cave, in the centre of which springs up a splintered
- pedestal&mdash;shattered, one fancies, by the blow that broke the image
- that must surely once have stood in this strange sea-shrine. From an
- unseen rift in the roof, far above, a white ray of sun strikes down into
- the cave, and falls like a blast from an offended heaven upon the broken
- pedestal.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is a geological explanation, no doubt, but we shall not look for it,
- for this is a wonder that would have delighted Victor Hugo himself, who
- drew the scenery of the &ldquo;Toilers of the Sea.&rdquo; And Victor Hugo&rsquo;s pen would
- be needed by any one who would adequately describe the spot.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is a rock in the outer cave, that sounds like a church bell when
- struck with an oar, and this delights the boatmen greatly, though they
- have heard it every time the steamer came up to Vavau. It is, indeed, a
- solemn and beautiful sound, and well suited to the place.
- </p>
- <p>
- Going back to the ship, we are shown the spot where the famous Mariner&rsquo;s
- Cave opens out, under water. There is nothing whatever to be seen, since
- the entrance is six feet under water at low tide. The story was first told
- to the world in Mariner&rsquo;s &ldquo;Tonga,&rdquo; published 1802, and was utilised by
- Byron in his poem of &ldquo;The Island.&rdquo; A young chief, it was said, was chasing
- a turtle one day, and saw the creature dive. He followed it, and was
- surprised to find that, on rising after his dive, he had reached an
- under-water cave of considerable size, to which there was no outlet save
- the one by which he had come in. Giving up the turtle, he dived again,
- returned to the surface, and did not trouble himself about the cave until,
- some months later, it occurred to him as an excellent place for an
- elopement&mdash;the parents of the girl he loved having refused to give
- her to him. So it came about that the young chief&rsquo;s sweetheart
- disappeared, and no one knew what had become of her until one day a
- boating party, to their intense amazement, saw what appeared to be the
- ghost of the girl rising from the heart of the waves. The apparition
- stared round, saw the intruders, and immediately disappeared. She was seen
- no more, but the story caused so much talk, that in the end the true
- secret came out, and it was discovered that the chief had hidden his
- lady-love in the cave, diving down with food to her day by day, and even
- bringing torches, safely wrapped in leaves. The stem parents, touched by
- so much devotion, relented, and the chief triumphantly brought home his
- bride at last in full day.
- </p>
- <p>
- Mariner, who was interested in the ancient tale, succeeded in reaching the
- cave himself, and found it as represented. He surmised that there was an
- air supply, passing through invisible cracks in the rock above, for the
- air seemed to keep fresh. There was something like a rough couch of stone
- at one end, where the imprisoned girl had made her bed. No light whatever
- penetrated the cavern.
- </p>
- <p>
- Since Mariner&rsquo;s time, very few Europeans have succeeded in entering the
- cave, which is extremely difficult to get into, owing to the length of the
- passage under water, and the currents of the tides. About thirty years
- ago, Captain Luce, of H.M.S. <i>Esk</i>, succeeded in entering the cave,
- but rose too soon on going out, and lacerated his back so badly against
- the coral spears under water, that he died in a few days. Since then, I
- heard that one white man had gone safely in and returned, but no one
- seemed to know who, or when. None of our party, at all events, felt
- tempted to make the trial.
- </p>
- <p>
- The steamer was ready to start when we got back, so we hurried on board,
- and started away for Samoa. There was much more to see in Vavau, but the
- only way of seeing it was to stop over for a month and remain in the
- village. For this no one had time. I was giving a month to each group of
- islands, which is little enough in the Pacific&mdash;but I knew very well
- that, unless I had had a vessel of my own, or a year or two extra to
- spend, it was impossible to see all that could be seen.
- </p>
- <p>
- Tofoa, for instance, one of the Tongan Group, which is an active volcano,
- and, naturally, not inhabited&mdash;what could be more interesting than a
- call there? But uninhabited volcanoes do not furnish cargo for steamship
- companies, so all we could see was a smear of smoke in the far distance,
- as we steamed on our way to Apia, the capital of the &ldquo;Navigators&rdquo; Group,
- better known, since the days of Stevenson, as Samoa.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0014" id="link2HCH0014"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER XIV
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>Stevenson&rsquo;s Samoa&mdash;What happened when it rained&mdash;Life in a
- Native Village&mdash;The Albino Chief&mdash;A Samoan &ldquo;Bee&rdquo;&mdash;The
- Tyranny of Time&mdash;Fishing at Midnight&mdash;Throwing the Presents&mdash;My
- Friend Fangati&mdash;The Taupo Dances&mdash;Down the sliding Rock&mdash;&ldquo;Good-bye,
- my Flennie!&rdquo;</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">W</span>HEN I woke up in
- the morning, the ship was still, and the familiar chatter of island
- tongues, and splashing of island paddles, audible outside the ports, told
- that we had reached Apia.
- </p>
- <p>
- Dressing is always a rush, under such circumstances. I hurried out on the
- deck in even quicker time than usual, and hastened to enjoy a good look at
- the little island that has been made famous the wide world over, by the
- genius of the great writer who passed his latest years in exile among
- those palmy hills.
- </p>
- <p>
- Upolu, Stevenson&rsquo;s island, is the second largest in the Samoan Group,
- being forty miles by eight. Savaii is a little wider. Tutuila is smaller.
- The six other islands are of little importance.
- </p>
- <p>
- Apia and Stevenson&rsquo;s home have been written about and described, by almost
- every tourist who ever passed through on the way to Sydney. There is
- little therefore to say that has not been said before. Every one knows
- that Apia is a fair-sized, highly civilised place, with hotels and shops
- and band promenades, and that Vailima, Stevenson&rsquo;s villa, is a mile or two
- outside. Every one has heard of the beautiful harbour of Apia itself, with
- the blue overhanging hills, and the dark wooded peak rising above all, on
- the summit of which the famous Scotsman&rsquo;s tomb gleams out like a tiny
- pearl&mdash;&ldquo;under the wide and starry sky.&rdquo; Since the disturbances of
- 1899, most people have been aware that England has absolutely relinquished
- any rights she had in Samoa, and that the islands are now divided between
- Germany and America&mdash;Upolu being among the possessions of the former.
- </p>
- <p>
- Perhaps some people have forgotten that Samoa is a fairly recent
- discovery, having been first sighted by Bougainville in 1768. It is
- supposed that the natives originally came from Sumatra. During the last
- six hundred years, they were frequently at war with the Tongans and
- Fijians, and from the latter learned the horrible practice of cannibalism&mdash;which,
- however, they abandoned of their own accord a good while before the coming
- of the first missionaries in 1833.
- </p>
- <p>
- They are a singularly beautiful race, and most amiable in character. They
- are all Christianised, and a great number can read and write. Tourists
- have done their best to spoil them, but outside the towns there is much of
- the ancient simplicity and patriarchal character still to be found.
- </p>
- <p>
- About two dozen Samoan gentlemen&mdash;I call them gentlemen, because in
- manners and demeanour they really deserved the name, and many were actual
- chiefs&mdash;had come on board the steamer, and were walking about the
- deck when I came out. The air was like hot water, and there was not a
- breath of wind. All the same, the Samoan gentlemen were quite cool, for
- they wore nothing at all but a British bath-towel with red edges, tied
- round the waist in the universal kilt style of the Pacific. In the Cook
- Group, the garment is called a pareo, and is made of figured cotton. In
- Tonga, it is a vala, and is usually cashmere. In Samoa the name is changed
- to lava-lava, and the thing may be either a piece of plain coloured
- cotton, or the bath-towel above mentioned, which is considered a good deal
- smarter&mdash;but the costume itself is the same all through.
- </p>
- <p>
- Most of the men had their short-cut hair plastered snow-white with lime,
- because it was Saturday. Almost every Samoan limes his hair on Saturdays,
- partly to keep up the yellow colour produced by previous applications,
- partly for hygienic reasons that had better be left to the imagination.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0041" id="linkimage-0041"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0404.jpg" alt="0404 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0404.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- All the visitors displayed an incomparable self-possession and dignity of
- bearing, not at all like the &ldquo;Tongan swagger,&rdquo; but much more akin to the
- manner of what is known in society as &ldquo;really good people.&rdquo; Coupled to the
- almost complete absence of clothes, and the copper skins, it was enough to
- make one perfectly giddy at first. But afterwards, one grew used to it,
- and even came to compare the average white man&rsquo;s manner disadvantageously
- with the unsurpassable self-possession and calm of the unclothed native.
- </p>
- <p>
- Then came boats and landing and hotels, and the usual one-sided South Sea
- town, with little green parrakeets tweedling cheerfully among the scarlet
- flowers of the flamboyant trees, and looking very much as if they had
- escaped from somewhere. And behold, as we were making our way to the
- hotel, a heavy waterspout of hot-season rain came on, whereupon the street
- immediately became a transformation scene of the most startling character.
- </p>
- <p>
- The roadway had been full of natives in their best clothes, come down to
- see the passengers&mdash;some in bath-towels, like the visitors to the
- steamer, but many in the cleanest of shirts and cotton tunics, and scores
- of pretty Samoan girls in civilised gowns of starched and laced muslin,
- trimmed hats, and gay silk ribbons. The rain began to spout, as only
- tropical rain can, and immediately things commenced to happen that made me
- wonder if I were really awake. Under the eaves of houses, beneath
- umbrellas, out in the street without any shelter at all, the Samoans
- rapidly began undressing. Smart white shirts, frilled petticoats, lacy
- dresses, all came off in a twinkling, and were rolled up into tight
- bundles, and stowed away under their owners&rsquo; arms, to protect the precious
- garments from the rain. Then down the street, with bare brown legs
- twinkling as they ran, and bodies covered merely by the &ldquo;lava-lava,&rdquo;
- scurried the bronze ladies and gentlemen who had looked so smart and
- dressy a few brief seconds before. Some of the girls, who could not get an
- inch of shelter under which to undress, merely pulled their fine frocks up
- under their arms, and ran down the street looking like very gay but
- draggled tulips set on two long brown stalks. It was the oddest
- transformation scene that I had ever been privileged to look on at, and it
- sent the passengers of the ship into such screaming fits of laughter that
- they forgot all about keeping themselves dry, and landed in the hotel in
- the condition of wet seaweed tossed up by the waves. So we arrived in
- Samoa.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is no use in relating at length how I drove out to see Stevenson&rsquo;s
- much described villa at Vailima&mdash;now in the possession of a wealthy
- German merchant, and much altered and spoiled&mdash;and how I did <i>not</i>
- climb the two thousand feet up to his tomb above the harbour, and was
- sorry ever after. Rather let me tell how, tired of the civilised section
- of the island, I took ship one day in an ugly little oil-<i>launch</i>,
- and sailed away to see the life of a native village, down at Falepunu.
- There is not much real native life now to be seen in the capital; for,
- although the &ldquo;faa Samoa&rdquo; (ancient Samoan custom) is very strong all over
- the islands, in Apia it is at a minimum, and the influence of the white
- man has much increased since Stevenson&rsquo;s day. Besides, how can one study
- native customs, dining at a <i>table d&rsquo;hôte</i> and living in a great gilt
- and glass hotel, situated in the midst of a busy street?
- </p>
- <p>
- So it was very gladly that I saw the wide blue harbour of Apia open out
- before me, and melt into the great Pacific, the &ldquo;league long rollers&rdquo;
- tossing our little cockle shell about remorselessly as we headed out
- beyond the reef, and began to slant along the coast, Upolu&rsquo;s rich blue and
- green mountains unfolding in a splendid panorama of tropic glory, as we
- crept along against the wind towards Falefa, our destined port, nearly
- twenty miles away. Here and there, white threads of falling water gleamed
- out against the dark mountain steeps; and the nearer hills, smooth and
- rich and palmy, and green as a basket of moss, parted now and then in
- unexpected gateways, to show brief glimpses of the wildly tumbled lilac
- peaks of far-away, rugged inner ranges. A day of gold and glitter, of
- steady, smiting heat, of beauty that was almost^ too beautiful, as hour
- after hour went by, and found the glorious panorama still unrolling before
- eyes that were well-nigh wearied, and bodies that wanted shelter and food.
- </p>
- <p>
- But even a little oil-launch cannot take all day to cover twenty miles; so
- it was still early in the afternoon when we glided into the harbour of
- Falefa, and came to a stop in the very heart of Paradise.
- </p>
- <p>
- How to picture Falefa, to the dwellers in the far grey north! how to paint
- the jewel-green of the water, the snow white of the sand, the overhanging
- palms that lean all day to look at their own loveliness in the unruffled
- mirror below; the emerald peaks above, the hyacinth peaks beyond, the
- strangely fashioned out-rigged canoes, with their merry brown rowers,
- skimming like long-limbed water-flies about the bay; the far-away
- sweetness and stillness and unlikeness of it all! And the waterfall,
- dropping down seventy feet of black precipitous rock right into the sea&rsquo;s
- blue bosom&mdash;and the winding, shady fiords, where the water is
- glass-green with reflections of shimmering leaves&mdash;and the little
- secluded brown houses, domed and pillared after the Samoan fashion, that
- ramble about among the long avenues of palm&mdash;surely, even in all the
- lovely South Sea Islands, there never was a lovelier spot than this
- harbour of Falefa!
- </p>
- <p>
- We three&mdash;a half-caste Samoan lady, a New Zealand girl, and myself&mdash;landed
- on the beach and gave over our things to a native boy, to carry up to the
- great guesthouse at Falepunu, a mile further on. Every Samoan village has
- its guest-house, for the free accommodation of passing travellers, but few
- have anything that can compare with the house where we were to stay&mdash;my
- companions for the night only, myself for a week.
- </p>
- <p>
- A Samoan house, owing to the heat of the climate, is a roof and nothing
- more, the walls being omitted, save for the posts necessary to support the
- great dome of the roof. It is worth well looking at and admiring all the
- same. Fine ribs made of strong flexible branches run diagonally from eaves
- to crown, only an inch or two apart, and curved with exquisite skill to
- form the arching dome. Over these, at an acute angle, are laid similar
- ribs in a second layer, forming a strong, flexible &lsquo;lattice. At just the
- right intervals, narrow, curved beams cross behind these, and hold them
- firm. The centre of the house displays three splendid pillars, made from
- the trunks of three tall trees; these support the roof-tree, and are
- connected with the sides of the dome by several tiers of slender beams,
- beautifully graded in size and length. The guest-house of Falepunu belongs
- to a high chief, and is in consequence exceptionally handsome. Its
- roof-tree is fifty feet from the floor, and the width of the house, on the
- floor-level, is the same. Forty wooden pillars, each seven feet high,
- support this handsome dome, every inch of which is laced and latticed and
- tied together with the finest of plaited cocoanut fibre, stained black,
- red, and yellow, and woven into pattern like elaborate chip carving.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is not a nail used in the construction of the house. One wet
- afternoon I attempted to count the number of thousand yards of sinnet
- (plaited cocoanut fibre) that must have been used in this colossal work,
- and gave it up in despair. The number of the mats used in forming the
- blinds was more calculable. Each opening between the pillars was
- surmounted by seven plaited cocoanut-leaf mats, fastened up under the
- eaves into a neat little packet. These could be dropped like a Venetian
- blind, whenever rain or wind proved troublesome. The total number of mats
- was two hundred and seventy-three.
- </p>
- <p>
- The floor of a Samoan house consists of a circular terrace, raised some
- two feet above the level of the ground. It is surrounded by a shallow
- ditch, and it is made of large and small stones, closely fitted together,
- and covered with a final layer of small white coral pebbles from the
- beach. This forms the carpet of the house, and is known as &ldquo;Samoan
- feathers,&rdquo; from the fact that it also forms everybody&rsquo;s bed at night,
- covered with a mat or two.
- </p>
- <p>
- The chief, Pula-Ulu, and his wife, Iva, who were in charge of the
- guest-house, in the absence of its owner, received us joyfully, and
- proceeded to make a feast for us at once. Fowls were killed, baked
- bread-fruit and taro brought from the ovens outside (which were simply
- pits dug in the ground, and filled with hot stones), and oranges and
- pineapples plucked from the nearest grove. We sat crosslegged on the mats,
- and ate till we could eat no more; then, &ldquo;faa Samoa,&rdquo; we lay down where we
- were to rest and doze away the hot hours, of the afternoon.
- </p>
- <p>
- In the evening, Iva lit a big ship&rsquo;s hurricane lamp, and set it on the
- floor; and half Falepunu came in to call. In rows and rows they sat on the
- floor-mats, their brown, handsome faces lit up with interest and
- excitement, fanning themselves ceaselessly as they sat, and asking endless
- questions of the half-caste lady, who interpreted for the others. I, as
- coming from London, was the heroine of the hour, for the Samoans are all
- greatly interested in &ldquo;Beritania&rdquo; (Britain) and, in spite of the German
- annexation, still prefer the English to any other nation.
- </p>
- <p>
- The inevitable question: &ldquo;Where was my husband?&rdquo; followed by: &ldquo;Why had I
- not got one?&rdquo;&mdash;in a tone of reproachful astonishment&mdash;was put by
- almost every new-comer. The half-caste visitor explained volubly; but the
- villagers still looked a little puzzled. The Samoans have in almost every
- village a &ldquo;taupo&rdquo; or &ldquo;Maid of the Village,&rdquo; whose office it is to receive
- guests, and take a prominent part in all public ceremonies and festivals.
- But she only holds office for a very few years, until she marries, and she
- is always surrounded, when travelling, by a train of elderly attendants.
- An unmarried woman who had money of her own, who wandered about alone, who
- held office in no village, here or at home, this was decidedly a puzzle to
- the Falepunu folk, whose own women all marry at about fourteen. They had
- seen white women; travelling with their husbands, but never one who had
- ventured from Beritania all alone!
- </p>
- <p>
- There was evidently some difficulty, at first, in &ldquo;placing&rdquo; me according
- to Samoan etiquette, which is both complex and peculiar. A white women
- with her husband presents no difficulty, since the &ldquo;faa Samoa&rdquo; always
- gives the superior honour to the man, and therefore the woman must only
- receive second-class ceremony. In my case, the question was solved later
- on, by classing me as a male chief! I was addressed as &ldquo;Tamaite&rdquo; (lady),
- but officially considered as a man; therefore I was always offered kava
- (the national drink of Samoa, never given to their own women, and not
- usually to white women), and the young chiefs of the district came almost
- every evening to call upon me in due form, sitting in formal rows, and
- conversing, through an interpreter, in a well-bred, gracious manner, that
- was oddly reminiscent of a London drawing-room. The women did not visit me
- officially, although I had many a pleasant bathing and fishing excursion
- in their company.
- </p>
- <p>
- On the first evening the callers stayed a long time&mdash;so long, that we
- all grew very weary, and yearned for sleep. But they kept on coming, one
- after another; and by-and-by half-a-dozen young men appeared, dressed in
- kilts of coloured bark-strips; adorned with necklaces of scarlet berries
- and red hibiscus flowers, and liberally cocoanut-oiled. In the centre of
- the group was the most extraordinary figure I had ever seen&mdash;a white
- man, his skin burned to an unwholesome pink by exposure, his hair pure
- gold, extremely fine and silky, and so thick as to make a huge halo round
- his face when shaken out. His eyes were weak, and half shut, and I was not
- surprised to hear that he was not really of white descent, being simply a
- Samoan albino, born of brown parents. This man, being the son of a chief,
- took the principal figure in the dance that was now got up for our
- amusement. The seven men danced on the floor-mats, close together, the
- albino in the centre, all performing figures of extraordinary agility, and
- not a little grace. The music was furnished by the other spectators, who
- rolled up a mat or two, and beat time on these improvised drums, others
- clapping their hands, and chanting a loud, sonorous, measured song.
- </p>
- <p>
- At the end of the dance the performers, streaming with perspiration (for
- the night was very hot) and all out of breath, paused for our applause. We
- gave it liberally, and added a tin or two of salmon, which was joyfully
- received, and eaten at once. All Samoans love tinned salmon, which, by an
- odd perversion, they call &ldquo;peasoupo.&rdquo; No doubt the first tinned goods seen
- in the islands were simply tinned peasoup. This would account for the
- extraordinary confusion of names mentioned above.
- </p>
- <p>
- By this time we were so utterly weary that we lay down on the mats where
- we were, and almost slept. Iva, seeing this, chased most of the callers
- out with small ceremony, and got up the calico mosquito curtain that was
- to shelter the slumbers of all three travellers. It enclosed a space of
- some eight feet by six. Within, plaited pandanus-leaf mats were laid, two
- thick, upon the white pebble floor, and Samoan pillows offered us.
- </p>
- <p>
- A Samoan pillow is just like a large fire-dog, being simply a length of
- bamboo supported on two small pairs of legs. If you are a Samoan, you lay
- your cheek on this neck-breaking arrangement, and sleep without moving
- till the daylight. We preferred our cloaks rolled up under our heads.
- </p>
- <p>
- The invaluable little mosquito tent served as dressing-room to all of us,
- and very glad we were of it, for there were still a good many visitors,
- dotted about the floor of the great guest-house, smoking and chattering;
- and none of them had any idea that a white woman could object to
- performing her evening toilet in public, any more than a-Samoan girl, who
- simply takes her &ldquo;pillow&rdquo; down from the rafters, spreads her mat, and lies
- down just, as she is.
- </p>
- <p>
- No-bed-clothes were needed, for the heat was severe. We fidgeted about on
- our stony couch, elbowed each other a good deal, slept occasionally, and
- woke again to hear the eternal chatter still going on outside our tent,
- and see the light still glowing through the calico. It was exactly, like
- going to bed in the-middle of a bazaar, after making a couch out of one of
- the stalls.
- </p>
- <p>
- At last, however, the light went out; Iva, Pula-Ulu, and their saucy
- little handmaiden and relative, Kafi, got under their mosquito curtains,
- quite, a little walk away, at the other side of the dome, all the guests
- departed, and there was peace.
- </p>
- <p>
- Next, morning my friends went away and I was left to study the fife of a
- Samoan village alone, with only such aid as old Iva&rsquo;s very few English
- words could give me, since I did not know above half-a-dozen; sentences of
- the Samoan tongue. There were no great feasts, no ceremonies or festivals
- while I was in Falepunu, only the ordinary, everyday fife of the village,
- which has changed extremely little since the coming of the white men,
- although that event is three generations old.
- </p>
- <p>
- Perhaps the greatest change is in the native treatment of guests.
- Hospitable, polite and pleasant the Samoans have always been and still
- are; but in these days, when a white visitor stays in a native house, he
- is expected to give presents when parting, that fully cover the value of
- his stay. This is contrary to the original Samoan laws of hospitality,
- which still hold good in the case of natives. No Samoan ever thinks of
- paying for accommodation in another&rsquo;s house, no matter how long his stay
- may be; nor is there the least hesitation in taking or giving whatever
- food a traveller may want on his way. But the white visitors who have
- stayed in Samoa have been so liberal with their gifts, that the native now
- expects presents as a right. He would still scorn to take money for his
- hospitality, but money&rsquo;s worth is quite another matter.
- </p>
- <p>
- Otherwise, the &ldquo;faa Samoa&rdquo; holds with astonishing completeness. Natives
- who have boxes full of trade prints, bought from the lonely little
- European store that every island owns, will dress themselves on ceremonial
- occasions in finely plaited mats, or silky brown tappa cloth. Houses on
- the verge of Apia, the European capital, are built precisely as houses
- were in the days of Captain Cook; though perhaps an incongruous bicycle or
- sewing-machine, standing up against the central pillars, may strike a
- jarring note. Men and women who have been to school, and can tell you the
- geographical boundaries of Montenegro, and why Charles I.&lsquo;s head was cut
- off&mdash;who know all about the Russo-Japanese war, wear full European
- dress when you ask them to your house, and sing &ldquo;In the Gloaming&rdquo; or &ldquo;Sail
- away&rdquo; to your piano&mdash;will take part in a native &ldquo;si va&rdquo; or dancing
- festival, dressed in a necklace, a kilt, and unlimited cocoanut-oil, and
- may be heard of, when the chiefs are out fighting, roaming round the
- mountains potting their enemies with illegally acquired Winchesters, and
- cutting off the victims&rsquo; heads afterwards. The &ldquo;faa Samoa&rdquo; holds the
- Samoan, old and young, educated or primitive, through life and to death.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0042" id="linkimage-0042"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0392.jpg" alt="0392 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0392.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Uneventful, yet very happy, was the little week that time allowed me among
- the pleasant folk of Falepunu. When the low, yellow rays of the rising sun
- hot under the wide eaves of the great guest-house, and striped the white
- coral floor with gold, and the little green parrakeets began to twitter in
- the trees outside, and the long sleepy murmur of the surf on the reef,
- blown landward by the sunrise wind, swelled to a deep-throated choral song&mdash;then,
- I used to slip into my clothes, come out from my mosquito tent, and see
- the beauty of the new young day. Dawn on a South Sea Island! The rainbow
- fancies of childhood painted out in real&mdash;the
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- Dreams of youth come back again,
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- Dropping on the ripened grain
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- As once upon the flower.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p>
- Iva, Pula-Ulu, and Kafi would be awake also, and moving about. No minute
- of daylight is ever wasted in these tropical islands; where all the year
- round the dawn lingers till after five, and the dark comes down long
- before seven. None of my house-mates had much toilet to make. They simply
- got up from their mats, hung up the pillows, put the mosquito nets away,
- and walked forth; clad in the cotton lava-lavas of yesterday, which they
- had not taken off when they lay down. Taking soap and bundles of cocoanut
- fibre off the ever useful rafters they went to bathe in the nearest river.
- Before long they came back, fresh and clean, and wearing a new lava-lava,
- yesterday&rsquo;s hanging limp and wet from their hands&mdash;the Samoan
- generally washes his garments at the same time as himself. Then Iva boiled
- water for my tea, and produced cold baked bread-fruit and stewed fish, and
- I breakfasted, taking care to leave a good share of tea, butter, and any
- tinned food I might open, for the family to enjoy afterwards. It is a
- positive crime in Samoa to eat up any delicacy all by yourself&mdash;an
- offence indeed, which produces about the same impression on the Samoan
- mind as cheating at cards does upon the well-bred European. The natives
- themselves usually eat twice a day, about noon, and some time in the
- evening; but a Samoan is always ready to eat at any hour, provided there
- is something nice to be got. Good old Iva enjoyed my tea and tinned milk
- extremely, and so did her pet cronies. They used to call in now and then,
- in the hope of getting some&mdash;a hope liberally fulfilled by Iva, who
- distributed my goods among them with charming courtesy, and a total
- innocence of any possible objection on my part, which disarmed all
- criticism. I might have taken anything she had, from her Sunday lava-lava
- to her fattest fowl, and kept it or given it away; equally without
- remonstrance. Such is the &ldquo;faa Samoa.&rdquo; That any one continues to retain
- anything worth having; under such circumstances, speaks well for the
- natural unselfishness of the people. They may be a little greedy with the
- whites&mdash;much as we ourselves should no doubt be greedy if
- half-a-dozen millionaires were to quarter themselves in our modest
- mansions, or come to stay in our quiet suburbs&mdash;but among themselves
- they are wonderfully self-&rsquo; restrained, and at the same time faultlessly
- generous.
- </p>
- <p>
- After my breakfast, following the agreeable Samoan custom, I lay down on a
- mat and dozed a little, to feel the wind blowing over my face from the
- sea, as I wandered half in and half out of the lands of dreams, and saw
- with semi-closed eyes the sun of the hot morning hours turn the green of
- the bush into a girdle of burning emerald-gold, clasped round the pleasant
- gloom of the dark over-circling roof. Pula-Ulu was out on &ldquo;ploys&rdquo; of his
- own; Kafi had gone to fish, or to flirt; Iva, pulling a fly-cover over her
- body, slept like a sheeted corpse on her own mat, off the other side of
- the central pillars.
- </p>
- <p>
- After an hour or two&mdash;there was never any time in Falepunu&mdash;I
- would rise, and call for Kafi, and we would walk slowly through the
- smiting sun, to a fairylike spot in the lovely bay of Falefa&mdash;a
- terrace of grey rock clothed with ferns, and shaded by thick-growing palms
- and chestnut and mango trees. The great white waterfall, cool as nothing
- else is cool in this burning land, thundered within fifty yards of us,
- turning the salt waters of the bay to brackish freshness, and spraying the
- hot air with its own delicious cold. Here we swam and dived for hours at a
- time, getting an old canoe sometimes, and paddling it up under the very
- spray of the fall&mdash;upsetting it perhaps, and tumbling out While Kafi
- yelled as if she could not swim a stroke, and anticipated immediate death
- (being, of course, absolutely amphibious). A pretty little minx was Kafi,
- small and black-eyed and piquante, always with a scarlet hibiscus bloom,
- or a yellow and white frangipani flower, stuck behind her ear; always
- tossing her head, and swaying her beautiful olive arms, and patting her
- small arched foot on the ground, when she stood waiting for me under the
- palms, as if she could not keep her elastic little frame, from dancing of
- itself. Pretty, saucy, mischievous little Kafi, she gave me many a bad
- moment wickedly calling out, &ldquo;S&rsquo;ark!&rdquo; when we were swimming far from land,
- in places where it was just conceivable that a shark might be; but I
- forgive her everything, for the sake of that unique and charming small
- personality of hers. Not even Fangati, the languorous sweet-eyed Taupo of
- Apia, can compete with her in my memories of fascinating island girls and
- pleasant companions.
- </p>
- <p>
- One morning&mdash;it must have been somewhere near the middle of the day&mdash;Iva
- and Kafi and I were walking back from Falefa, tired out and very hungry
- (at least, I will answer for myself), when we were hailed from the house
- of a chief, and asked to come in. We did so, all saying, as we bowed our
- heads to step under the low eaves: &ldquo;Talofa!&rdquo; (my love to you), and being
- answered with a loud chorus: &ldquo;Talofa, tamaite! (lady); Talofa, I va;
- Talofa, Kafi.&rdquo; I took my seat cross-legged on the mats, and looked about
- me. All round the house in a Circle were seated a number of men, about a
- dozen, each with a bundle of cleaned and carded cocoanut husk fibre,
- called sinnet, beside him, and a slender plait of sinnet in his hand, to
- which every minute added on an inch or so of length. It was evidently a
- &ldquo;bee&rdquo; for making sinnet plait, and it solved a problem that had perplexed
- me a good deal&mdash;namely, how all the thousands of sinnet used instead
- of nails in building Samoan houses, were ever obtained. Afterwards I
- learned that Samoan men occupy much of their unlimited leisure time in
- plaiting sinnet. The bundle of husk and the-neat-little coil of plait are
- to a Samoan man what her needle and stockings are to a Scotch housewife;
- he works away mechanically with them in many an odd moment, all going to
- swell the big roll that is gradually widening and fattening up among the
- rafters; Some of the sinnet thus made is as fine as fine twine, yet
- enormously strong....
- </p>
- <p>
- My hosts, it seemed, were just going to knock, off work for the present,
- and have some kava, and I was not sorry to join them, for kava is a
- wonderfully refreshing drink, among these tropical islands, and wholesome
- besides. It was made Tongan fashion, by pounding the dry woody&rsquo; root with
- stones, pouring water over the crushed fragments, and straining the latter
- out with a wisp of hibiscus fibre. A handsome wooden bowl was used,
- circular in form, and supported on; a number of legs&mdash;the whole being
- carved out of one solid block of wood. The ancient Samoan way of
- preparation was to chew the kava root, and deposit the chewed, lamps in,
- the bowl, afterwards pouring on the water; but this practice has died out,
- in many parts of Samoa, though in some of the islands it is still kept up.
- </p>
- <p>
- My kava On this occasion was not chewed, and I was thankful, as it is
- unmannerly to refuse it under any circumstances.
- </p>
- <p>
- The kava made, the highest chief present called the names, according, to
- etiquette, as in Tonga, in a loud resounding voice. I answered to my own
- (which came first, as a foreign, chief) by clapping my hands, in the
- correct fashion, and drained the cocoanut bowl that was handed me. Kava,
- as I had already learned, quenches thirst; removes fatigue, clears the
- brain, and is exceedingly cooling. If drunk in excess it produces a
- temporary paralysis of the legs, without affecting the head; but very few
- natives and hardly any whites do drink more than is good for them.
- </p>
- <p>
- After the kava, two young men came running in from the bush, carrying
- between them an immense black wooden bowl, spoon-shaped, three-legged, and
- filled with something exactly like bread-and-milk, which they had been
- concocting at the cooking-pits. It was raining now, and the thrifty youths
- had taken off their clothes, for fear of spoiling them, yet they were
- dressed with perfect decency, and much picturesqueness. Their attire
- consisted of thick fringed kilts, made of pieces of green banana leaves (a
- banana leaf is often nine or ten feet long, and two or three wide), and
- something like a feather boa, hung round the neck, of the same material.
- Clad in these rain-proof garments, they ran laughing through the downpour,
- their bowl covered with another leaf, and deposited it on the floor, safe
- and hot.
- </p>
- <p>
- A section of banana-leaf was now placed on the mat beside each person,
- also a skewer, made from the midrib of the cocoanut leaf. Then the servers
- dipped both hands generously into the food, and filled each leaf with the
- bread-and-milk, or &ldquo;tafolo,&rdquo; which turned out to be lumps of bread-fruit
- stewed in thick white cream expressed from the meat of the cocoanut.
- Better eating no epicure could desire; and the food is exceedingly
- nourishing. We ate with the cocoanut skewers, on which each creamy lump
- was speared; and when all was done we folded the leaf-plates into a cone,
- and drank the remaining cream. Afterwards, Iva and Kafi and I took our
- leave, and I hurried back to Falepunu, feeling that my hunger and fatigue
- had been magically removed, and that I was ready for anything more in the
- way of exercise that the day might produce.
- </p>
- <p>
- I had no watch or clock with me, and this was certainly an advantage,
- since it compelled me to measure time in the pleasant island fashion,
- which simply marks out the day vaguely by hot hours and cool hours, and
- the recurring calls of hunger. No one who has not tried it can conceive
- the limitless freedom and leisure that comes of this custom. Time is
- simply wiped out. One discovers-all of a sudden, that one has been
- groaning under an unbearable and unnecessary tyranny all one&rsquo;s life&mdash;whence
- all the hurry-scurry of civilisation? why do people rush to catch trains
- and omnibuses, and hasten to make and keep appointments, and have meals at
- rigidly fixed times, whether they are hungry or not? These are the things
- that make life short. It is inimitably long, and curiously sweet and
- simple, in the island world. At first one finds it hard to realise that no
- one is ever waiting for dinner, or wanting to go to bed&mdash;that eating
- and sleeping are the-impulse of a moment, and not a set task&mdash;but
- once realised, the sense of emancipation is exquisite and complete.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Samoan does what he wants, when he wishes, and if he does not wish a
- thing, does not do it at all. According, to the theology of our youthful
- days, he ought in consequence to become a fiend in human shape; but he
- does nothing of the kind. He is the most amiable creature on earth&rsquo;s round
- ball. Angry voices, loud tones even, are never heard in a Samoan house.
- Husbands never come home drunk in the evening and ill-use their wives;
- wives never nag at their husbands; no one screams at children, or snaps at
- house-mates and neighbours. Houses are never dirty; clothes are always
- kept clean; nothing is untidy, nothing superfluous or ugly. There is
- therefore no striking ground for ill-temper or peevishness; and amiability
- and courtesy reign supreme. The Samoan has his faults&mdash;sensuality,
- indolence, a certain bluntness of perception as to the white man&rsquo;s laws of
- property&mdash;but they are slight indeed compared with the faults of the
- ordinary European. And, concerning the tendency to exploit the latter
- person, which has been already mentioned, it must not be forgotten that if
- a white man is known to be destitute and in want, the very people who
- would have eagerly sought for presents from him while he was thought to be
- rich, will take him in, feed and-lodge him; without a thought of payment,
- and will never turn him out if he does not choose to go.
- </p>
- <p>
- Sometimes, in the long, lazy, golden afternoons, a woman or two would drop
- in, and bring with her some little dainty as a present for the stranger.
- &ldquo;Palusani&rdquo; was the favourite, made, as in Niué, of taro-tops and cocoanut;
- the cook grating down the meat of the nuts, and straining water through
- the oily mass thus produced. The cream is very cleverly wrapped up inside
- the leaves, and these are again enveloped in larger and tougher leaves.
- While baking, the cream thickens and condenses, and permeates the
- taro-tops completely. The resulting dish is a spinachlike mixture of dark
- green and white, odd to look at, but very rich and dainty to eat.
- </p>
- <p>
- Another present was a sort of sweetmeat, also made from cocoanut cream,
- which was baked into small brown balls like chocolates, each containing a
- lump of thickened cream inside. These were generally brought tied up in
- tiny square packets of green banana leaf. Small dumpy round puddings, made
- of native arrowroot, bananas, cocoanut, and sugar-cane juice, used also to
- be brought, tied up in the inevitable banana-leaf; and baked wild pigeon,
- tender and juicy, was another offering not at all unacceptable. As a
- typical millionaire, possessed of several dresses, change for some
- sovereigns, and countless tins of salmon, I was expected to give an
- occasional <i>quid pro quo</i>, which usually took the form of tinned fish
- or meat, and was much appreciated.
- </p>
- <p>
- I do not know how late it was, one night&mdash;the moon had been up for
- many hours, but no one seemed to want to go to bed&mdash;when I heard a
- sound of splashing and laughing from the brightly silvered lagoon beyond
- the belt of palms. I went out, and saw thirty or forty of the native women
- wading about in the shallow water inside the reef, catching fish. It
- looked interesting, so I shed an outer skirt or two, kilted up what
- remained, and ran down the white shelving beach, all pencilled with the
- feathery shadows of tossing palms, into the glassy knee-deep water. How
- warm it was! as hot as a tepid bath at home&mdash;how the gorgeous
- moonlight flashed back from the still lagoon, as from a huge silver
- shield! The whole place was as light as day; not as a Samoan day, which is
- too like the glare from an open furnace to be pleasant at all times, but
- at least, as light as a grey English afternoon.
- </p>
- <p>
- The girls, wearing only a small lava-lava, were wading in the water, some
- carrying a big, wide net made out of fine fibres beaten from the bark of a
- Samoan tree; others trailing two long fringes of plaited palm leaves,
- about a yard deep, and twenty or thirty yards long. These were drawn
- through the water about twenty yards apart, the girls walking along for a
- few minutes in two parallel rows, and then quickly bringing the ends of
- the palm fringes together in an open V shape. The net was placed across
- the narrow end of the V, and from the wide end two or three splashed
- noisily down the enclosed space, driving before them into the net all the
- little silvery fish who had been gathered together by the sudden closing
- in of the palm-leaf fringes. Then there was laughing and crying out,-and
- the moon shone down on a cluster of beautiful gold-bronze figures,
- graceful as statues, stretching out their small pretty hands and wild
- curly heads, diamond-gemmed with scattered drops of water, over the
- gathered-in net, now sparkling and quivering with imprisoned life. The
- captured fish were dropped into a plaited palm-leaf basket; and then the
- two lines of girls separated once more, and marched on through the warm
- silvery water, singing as they went.
- </p>
- <p>
- I think, though I do not know, that this simple sport (which was, after
- all, a necessary task as well) went on nearly all the night. The Samoan is
- not easily bored, and no one minds losing a night&rsquo;s rest, when there is
- all the hot day to doze on the mats. I gave up an hour or so, and returned
- to the guest-house, loaded with presents of fish. It was quite absurd, but
- I wanted to go to bed, silly inferior white person that I was! so I crept
- under my calico tent, and &ldquo;turned in,&rdquo; feeling amid the stir and chatter,
- the singing and wandering to and fro, of those moonlit small hours,
- exceedingly like a child that has to follow nurse and go to sleep, while
- all the grown-ups are still enjoying themselves downstairs.
- </p>
- <p>
- The night before I left for Apia once more, I bought my farewell presents
- at the solitary little store that was marooned away down on the beach at
- Falefa, and bore on its house front the mysterious legend&mdash;&ldquo;MISIMOA&rdquo;&mdash;all
- in one word&mdash;translatable as &ldquo;Mr. Moore!&rdquo; Advised by the trader&rsquo;s
- native wife, I got several lava-lavas for the old chief and his wife, also
- a &ldquo;Sunday frock&rdquo; piece of white muslin, and some lace, for Iva herself.
- Poor old Iva! she could not afford herself many clothes, being only a
- caretaker in the great house; and I had felt sorry for her when I saw her
- missionary-meeting frock&mdash;only an old blue print. All the Samoan
- women love to turn out in trade finery on Sundays, and a white muslin,
- with lace, made exactly like a British nightdress, is the height of
- elegance and good form. I gave Pula-Ulu, furthermore, a yellow shirt
- spotted with red horses; and as a final gift for Iva, I selected a large
- white English bath-towel, with crimson stripes and edge. This last I knew
- would certainly be Iva&rsquo;s best week-day visiting costume for some time to
- come.
- </p>
- <p>
- All these splendours I tied up in a brown paper parcel, and left on my
- portmanteau. Samoan etiquette is very strict about the giving and
- receiving of presents, and prescribes absolute ignorance, on the part of
- the recipient, of any such intention being about; but Iva could not resist
- pinching the parcel, and whispering&mdash;&ldquo;Misi! what &lsquo;sat?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Ki-ki, Iva,&rdquo; (food), I answered.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;You lie!&rdquo; said Iva delightedly, poking me in the ribs. She had no idea
- that she was not expressing herself with the most perfect elegance and
- courtesy; the Samoan tongue has no really rude words, and Samoans often do
- not realise the quality of our verbal unpolitenesses.
- </p>
- <p>
- Next morning, however, when my &ldquo;solofanua&rdquo; (animal that runs along the
- ground&mdash;>horse) was standing out under the bread-fruit trees, and all
- my goods had been tied about the saddle, till the venerable animal looked
- like nothing on earth but the White Knight&rsquo;s own horse&mdash;Iva and
- Pula-Ulu, bidding me good-bye with the utmost dignity, did not even glance
- at the parcels which I threw across the house, at their heads, narrowly
- escaping hitting their old grey hair. This was etiquette. In Samoa, a
- formal gift must be thrown high in the air at the recipient, so as to fall
- at his feet; and he must not pick it up at once, but simply say &ldquo;Fafekai&rdquo;
- (thank you) with a cold and unmoved accent, waiting until the giver is
- gone to examine the present. The inner meaning of the custom is the
- supposed worthlessness of the gift, when compared with the recipient&rsquo;s
- merits&mdash;it is mere rubbish, to be cast away&mdash;and the demeanour
- of the recipient himself is intended to suggest that in any case he is not
- eager for gifts.
- </p>
- <p>
- A long, hot ride of twenty miles back to Apia and civilisation filled up
- the day. The pendulum of Time, held back for a whole dreamy, lazy week,
- had begun to swing once more; and all day I worried about the hour I
- should get in. I was late for <i>table d&rsquo;hote</i>; I was met by a &ldquo;little
- bill&rdquo;; and the mail had come in since I left. Thus Apia welcomed me; and
- thus I &ldquo;took up the white man&rsquo;s burden&rdquo; once again.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Talofa!&rdquo; says a gentle yet insistent voice.
- </p>
- <p>
- It is only half-past six, and I am exceedingly sleepy, so I bury my face
- in the pillow, and try not to hear.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Talofa!&rdquo; (How do you do?), repeats the voice, a little louder, and my
- basket armchair creaks to the sudden drop of a substantial weight. I open
- my eyes, and see, through the dim mist of the mosquito-curtains, the
- taupo, Fangati, sitting beside my bed.
- </p>
- <p>
- Fangati is my &ldquo;flennie,&rdquo; and that means a good deal more in Samoa than the
- cold English word &ldquo;friend,&rdquo; from which if is derived. She attached herself
- to me upon my arrival in Apia, some weeks ago, and has ever since
- continued to indicate, in the gentle Samoan way, that she prefers my
- company to that of any other white woman on the island. There is nothing
- contrary to Samoan etiquette in her calling upon me at 6.30 a.m., for
- Samoa knows not times or seasons, save such as are pleasing to itself for
- the moment. If I were suffering from sleeplessness and went to call on
- Fangati at midnight, she would certainly awake, get up off her mat, take a
- fan in her hands, sit down cross-legged on the floor, ready to talk or
- yarn for the rest of the night&mdash;without the smallest surprise or
- discomposure. So, aspiring after the ideal of Samoan politeness, I feel
- bound to shake myself awake, and talk.
- </p>
- <p>
- Fangati is very much &ldquo;got up&rdquo; this morning. She is a chief&rsquo;s daughter, of
- high rank, and her wardrobe is an extensive one. To-day she has a short
- tunic of tappa (native cloth, beaten out of the bark of a paper mulberry
- tree), satiny brown in colour, and immensely pinked and fringed. This is
- worn over a lava-lava, or kilt, of purple trade print, reaching a little
- below her knees. Her beautiful pale brown arms (all Samoan women have
- exquisitely shaped arms) and small arched brown feet are bare. In her
- thick, wavy hair she has placed one large scarlet hibiscus flower, and
- there are three or four long necklaces round her neck, made of the crimson
- rind of a big scented berry, cut into curly strips. One of these, as a
- matter of common courtesy, she flings over my nightdress as we talk, and
- smiles sweetly at the brilliant effect achieved.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Ni&mdash;ice!&rdquo; says Fangati. She can speak quite a good deal of English,
- but she smooths and trims it prettily to suit her own taste, and the harsh
- language of the black North loses all its roughness on her lips.
- </p>
- <p>
- She has come to tell me that there will be dancing at the village of
- Mulinuu this afternoon, as it is the German Emperor&rsquo;s birthday, and a
- great many kegs of salt beef and boxes of biscuit have been given to the
- villages by the Government, to celebrate the day. (Not such a bad method
- of encouraging loyalty in a newly acquired colony, either.) There are to
- be some taupo dances, and Fangati will take a leading part. Therefore I
- must be certain to come and see my &ldquo;flennie&rdquo; perform. This matter settled,
- Fangati gets up and drifts to the washstand, tastes my cold cream and
- makes a face over it, points to a jug of cold tea and says &ldquo;You give?&rdquo;
- shares the luxury with her ancient chaperon, who is sitting on the
- doormat, and then melts away down the verandah, dreamily smoking a
- native-made cigarette.
- </p>
- <p>
- It is now time to explain what a taupo is, and why the dances to-day will
- be especially attractive. .
- </p>
- <p>
- Most Samoan villages possess a taupo, or mistress of the ceremonies, who
- has many duties, and many privileges as well. She is always young, pretty,
- and well-born, being usually the daughter of a high chief. She remains
- unmarried during her term of office, which may last for many years, or for
- only a few months. The propriety of her conduct is guaranteed by the
- constant presence of certain old women, who always accompany her on visits
- or journeys. Sometimes her train is increased by the addition of a dwarf
- or a cripple, who seems to act a part somewhat similar to that of a
- mediaeval court fool. Her duties oblige her to receive and entertain all
- guests or travellers who pass through her village; to make kava (the
- universal drink of the Pacific islands) for them, welcome them to the
- guest-house, which is a part of every Samoan settlement, and dance for
- their amusement. She is treated with royal honours by the villagers,
- always handsomely clothed, and luxuriously fed on pig and chicken, and
- never required to do any hard work, while the other girls have to be
- content with taro-root and bread-fruit, and are obliged to work in the
- fields, carry water, and fish on the reef in the burning tropic sun. When
- there is a festival, she takes the principal part in the dances; and when
- the tribes are at war (as occasionally happens even to-day) the taupo,
- dressed as a warrior, marches out with the ceremonial parade of the
- troops, and acts as a <i>vivandière</i> during the fight, carrying water
- to the soldiers, and bringing ammunition when required. This duty is not
- one of the safest, for, although no Samoan warrior knowingly fires on any
- woman, much less on a taupo, stray bullets take no account of persons, and
- many a beautiful young &ldquo;Maid of the Village,&rdquo; in times past, has justified
- her warrior dress by meeting with a soldier&rsquo;s death.
- </p>
- <p>
- Well-mannered as all Samoan women are, the taupo is especially noted for
- the elegance of her demeanour. My &ldquo;flennie&rsquo;s&rdquo; bearing reminds me oddly at
- times of the manner of a London great lady, accustomed to constant
- receiving, and become in consequence almost mechanically &ldquo;gracious.&rdquo; She
- never moves abruptly; her speech is calm and self-possessed, and her
- accent soft and <i>traînant</i>. There are, however, taupos and taupos.
- Vao, who lives just across the way, is by way of being an &ldquo;advanced
- woman.&rdquo; She plays native cricket in a man&rsquo;s singlet and a kilt, dances a
- knife dance that tries the nerves of every one that looks on, wears her
- hair short and is exceedingly independent, and a little scornful. Vao does
- not want to marry she says; but I have an idea, all the same, that if just
- the right sort of young chief came along, with just the irresistible
- number of baskets of food (these take the place of bouquets and chocolate
- boxes among Samoan wooers), Vao would renounce her dignity of taupo just
- as readily as other Maids of the Village have done when Mr. Right
- appeared. On her wedding day she would dance her last dance for the
- villagers, according to immemorial custom, and thenceforward live the
- quiet home-life of the Samoan wife and mother, all the footlights out, all
- the admiring audience gone, and only the little coral-carpeted,
- brown-roofed cottage with its small home duties and quiet home affections
- left.
- </p>
- <p>
- Then there is the taupo Fuamoa&mdash;but of her more anon, as the
- Victorian novelist used to say.
- </p>
- <p>
- Early in the afternoon, when the sun was at its very hottest&mdash;and
- what that heat can be, at 130 south, in the height of the hot season, let
- Pacific travellers say&mdash;I made my way down to Mulinuu under a big
- umbrella, and took my place on the mats laid to accommodate the
- spectators. The dancing was in full swing. A long row of young men,
- dressed in short kilts of many-coloured bark strips&mdash;red, pink,
- green, yellow, purple&mdash;and decked out with anklets of green creepers
- and necklaces of big scarlet berries, which looked just like enormous
- coral beads, were twirling and pirouetting, retreating, advancing, and
- waving their arms, in wonderfully perfect time. The Samoan, man or woman,
- is born with a metronome concealed somewhere in his or her works, to all
- appearance. Certainly the exquisite sense of time and movement displayed
- in children&rsquo;s games, grown-up dances, and all the songs of the people,
- seems almost supernatural, as the result of unaided impulse.
- </p>
- <p>
- The arms and hands play a remarkable part in the dance. Every finger is
- made a means of expression, and the simultaneous fluttering and waving of
- the arms of an entire <i>corps-de-ballet</i> can be compared to nothing
- but the petals of a bed of flowers, sent hither and thither by a
- capricious wind.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is no instrumental music, for the Samoans&mdash;strange to say, for
- a music-loving people&mdash;have no instruments at all, unless one may
- count the occasional British mouth-organ. But the sonorous, full-voiced
- chanting of the chorus that sits cross-legged on the grass at a little
- distance, leaves nothing to be desired in the way of orchestra. A
- favourite tune, which one is sure to hear at every Samoan dance-meeting or
- &ldquo;siva&rdquo; is the following, commenced with a loud &ldquo;Ai, ai!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- It is first sung very slowly, and gradually increased in speed until the
- dancers give up in despair.&rsquo; &lsquo;The faster they have danced before giving
- in, the louder is the applause.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0043" id="linkimage-0043"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0312.jpg" alt="0312 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0312.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- By-and-by the men conclude their dance, and retire, loudly clapped, and
- followed by cries of &ldquo;Malo! malo!&rdquo; (well done). A short interval follows.
- The many-coloured crowd seated on the grass fans itself, smokes
- cigarettes, and chatters; the dry palm-fronds rustle in the burning sky
- overhead, harshly mimicking the cool whisper of forest leaves in gentler
- climes. Suddenly six handsome young men, splendidly decorated, their brown
- skins satiny with&rsquo; rubbing of perfumed cocoanut-oil, rush into the middle
- of the green, and in the midst comes a seventh, smaller, slighter, and
- handsomer than the rest. What a beautiful youth! almost too young, one
- would have thought, for the smart black moustache that curves above his
- upper lip&mdash;wonderfully active, supple, and alive in every movement&mdash;a
- skin like brown Lyons silk, limbs&mdash;&mdash; Why, it is a girl! the
- taupo Fuâmoa, dressed (or rather undressed) as a Samoan warrior, and full
- to the brim of mischief, sparkle, and fun. She wears a fringe of coloured
- bark-strips round her waist, and a very big kilt of scarlet and white
- striped cotton underneath. The rest of her attire consists of a necklace
- of whale&rsquo;s teeth inestimably valuable, a string of red berries, and a tall
- helmet, or busby, apparently made of brilliant yellow fur. Her exquisitely
- moulded figure is as Nature made it, save for a rubbing of cocoanut-oil,
- that only serves to bring out the full beauty of every curving line.
- Strange to say, the black-painted moustache is wonderfully becoming, so
- too is the imposing helmet; and does not Fuamoa know it? and is not she
- saucy, and dainty, and kitten-like, as she frisks and plays in the centre
- of the dance, making the prettiest of eyes at the audience, and flashing
- her white teeth delightedly under the wicked little black moustache? She
- is a celebrated dancer, being only surpassed on the island by one other
- taupo&mdash;Vao, who is not appearing to-day. You would never think, as
- her little brown feet twinkle over the grass, and her statuesque brown
- arms wave above her head, while the merry smile ceaselessly comes and
- goes, that Fuamoa is suffering positive agonies all the time, from the
- splendid war-helmet that adorns her head; yet that is the truth. One must
- indeed suffer to be beautiful, as a Samoan taupo. Before the helmet is put
- on, the girl&rsquo;s long thick hair is drawn up to the top of her head, and
- twisted as tightly as strong arms can twist it, so that her very eyebrows
- are pulled out of place, and every hair is a separate torture. Then the
- great helmet is fastened on as firmly as a rock, with countless tight
- cords, and the dancer is ready for her part, with a scalp on fire and a
- torturing headache, which will certainly last until she can take the cruel
- decoration off.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0044" id="linkimage-0044"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0315.jpg" alt="0315 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0315.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- There are several taupo dances this afternoon, but only two of the girls
- have the courage to wear the helmet. Fangati, my little &ldquo;flennie,&rdquo; frankly
- confesses that she cannot stand it. &ldquo;He made me cly-y-y! too much!&rdquo; she
- says, and shows me the pretty wreath of crimson berry peelings and green
- leaves that is to adorn her own curly head.
- </p>
- <p>
- These helmets, it may be noted, are not made of fur, as one might suppose
- at a first glance. The material is human hair, cut from the head of a
- Samoan girl, and dyed bright yellow with lime. In time of war, it is a
- common thing for a girl to offer up her beautiful tresses to make a helmet
- for father, husband, or lover; and the wearer of such a gift is as proud
- as a knight of Arthur&rsquo;s Round Table may have been, bearing on his crest
- his lady&rsquo;s little pearl-broidered glove.
- </p>
- <p>
- It is Fangati&rsquo;s turn to dance now, and out she trips, wearing a valuable
- mat of the finest plait, her pretty wreath, countless scarlet necklaces,
- and a modest girdle of coloured silk. Fangati has the prettiest foot and
- hand in Apia, and she is a dainty little dancer&mdash;not so marvellously
- agile and spirited as Fuamoa, and with much less of &ldquo;devil&rdquo; in her
- composition, but a pretty and a pleasant creature to watch. She has
- reached the twenties, and gone nearly half-way through them, so that she
- is in a fair way to become an old maid, according to Samoan ideas; but she
- still retains her maiden state, and declares she will not marry, in spite
- of good offers from several chiefs. It is said in Apia that she is proud,
- and wishes to marry a white man&mdash;which is much as if a charming
- English country girl should determine to mate with nothing less than a
- duke. Country lasses do marry dukes, but not often; and there is not much
- more chance of my &ldquo;flennie&rsquo;s&rdquo; attaining her ambition, unless Providence is
- very kind.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0045" id="linkimage-0045"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0433.jpg" alt="0433 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0433.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0046" id="linkimage-0046"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0438.jpg" alt="0438 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0438.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- The ordinary Samoan is obliged to do a little work now and then, since yam
- patches must be cultivated, breadfruit plucked and cooked, banana and
- arrowroot puddings made, fish caught, nets woven, houses built and
- repaired. But all in all there is not much to do, and the real business of
- life in Samoa is amusement. <i>Le monde où l&rsquo;on s&rsquo;amuse</i>, for most
- people means a certain circle of London and Paris; but for all who have
- travelled in the South Seas, it means, once and for all, Samoa.
- </p>
- <p>
- The taupo is of course at the head and front of every diversion, for,
- little as the other people have to do, she has less, having nothing at
- all. A day at Papaseea is one of her favourite delights. During my stay in
- Samoa one of these pleasant native picnics was organised for me, and I set
- off on a lovely morning for the &ldquo;Sliding Rock,&rdquo; accompanied by fifteen
- native and half-caste girls, stowed away in six buggies. It was a long
- drive in the burning sun, and afterwards a long rough walk through the
- bush, among wild pineapples, scarlet hibiscus, tall, creamy-flowered,
- pungent, scented ginger-bushes, red-fruited cacao, quaint mammee-apple
- trees, mangoes, Pacific chestnuts, and countless other strange tropic
- growths. Hot and tired as we all were, the Papaseea rock, when we reached
- it, seemed a perfect Paradise.
- </p>
- <p>
- Imagine a deep gorge in the heart of green, heavily-wooded hills; at the
- bottom, a narrow channel shaded by overhanging trees, where the pure
- mountain water runs clear and cold and deep, amber-brown pools quiver at
- the foot of white plunging falls&mdash;one only some seven feet high, the
- other a good thirty. This last was the Sliding Rock, over which we were
- all going to fling ourselves <i>à la</i> Sappho by-and-by, only with less
- melancholy consequences. It looked formidable enough, and when Pangati and
- the others, with cries of delight, pulled off their dresses, wound white
- and pink and green cotton lava-lavas over one shoulder, and round from
- waist to knee, crowned themselves picturesquely with woven fern-leaves,
- and plunged shrieking over the fall, I began to wish I had not come, or
- coming, had not promised to &ldquo;slide.&rdquo; However, there was no help for it, so
- I got into my English bathing-dress, which excited peals of merry
- laughter, because of its &ldquo;continuations,&rdquo; waded down the stream, and
- sitting in the rush of the water, held tightly on to a rock at each side,
- and looked over my own toes at the foaming, roaring thirty feet drop.
- </p>
- <p>
- It was all over in a minute. Just an unclasping of unwilling hands from
- the safe black rocks, a fierce tug from the tearing stream, an exceedingly
- unpleasant instant when one realised that there was no going back now at
- any price, and that the solid earth had slipped away as it does in the
- ghastly drop of a nightmare dream; then nothing in the world but a long
- loud roar, and a desperate holding of the breath, while the helpless body
- shot down to the bottom of the deep brown pool and up again&mdash;and at
- last, the warm air of heaven filling one&rsquo;s grateful lungs in big gasps, as
- one reached the surface, and swam across to the other side of the pool,
- firmly resolved on no account to do it again, now that it was over.
- </p>
- <p>
- It was pleasant, afterwards, to sit among the rocks above the fall, and
- watch one after another of the native and half-caste girls&mdash;including
- a very charming and highly educated half-American, who had been to college
- in San Francisco, and to smart society dances in Samoa&mdash;rush madly
- over the fall, leaving behind them as they went a long, loud yell, like
- the whistle of a train going into a tunnel. One native girl daringly went
- down head first; another, standing incautiously near the edge of the fall,
- lost her balance, and simply sat down on the pool below, dropping through
- the air with arms and legs outspread like a starfish. Fangati seized a
- friend in her arms and tumbled over the verge with her, in a perfect
- Catherine wheel of revolving limbs. It was hours before the riotous party
- grew tired, and even then, only the sight of large green leaves being laid
- out on the stones, and palm-leaf baskets being opened, brought them out of
- the water, and got them into their little sleeveless tunics and gracefully
- draped kilts. By this time, the pretty Samoan-American&rsquo;s mother had laid
- out the &ldquo;ki-ki&rdquo;&mdash;baked fowl and pig, taro-root, yams, bananas,
- pineapples, guavas, European delicacies such as cake and pies, and native
- dainties, including the delicious <i>palusami</i>, of which I have spoken
- before. The drinking cocoanuts had been husked and opened by the boy who
- brought the food, and there they stood among the stones, rows of rough
- ivory cups, lined with smooth ivory jelly of the young soft meat, and
- filled with fresh sweet water, such as is never to be tasted out of the
- cocoanut-land. Our plates were sections of green banana-leaf; our forks
- were our fingers. And when every one had fed, and felt happy and lazy, we
- all lay among the rocks above the fall, in the green shadow of the trees,
- and did nothing whatever till evening. Then we climbed back to the road,
- and drove home, six buggies full of laughing brown and white humanity,
- crowned and wreathed with green ferns, and singing the sweet, sad song of
- Samoa&mdash;&ldquo;Good-bye, my flennie&rdquo;&mdash;the song that was written by a
- native only a few years ago, and has already become famous over the whole
- Pacific. It is the farewell song of every island lover, the melody that
- soars above the melancholy rattling of the anchor chains on every
- outward-bound schooner that spreads her white wings upon the breast of the
- great South Seas. And for those who have known the moonlight nights of
- those enchanted shores, have smelt the frangipani flower, and listened to
- the soft singing girls in the endless, golden afternoons, and watched the
- sun go down upon an empty, sailless sea, behind the weird pandanus and
- drooping palms&mdash;the sweet song of the islands will ring in the heart
- for ever. In London rush and rain and gloom, in the dust and glitter of
- fevered Paris, in the dewy cold green woods of English country homes, the
- Samoan air will whisper, calling, calling, calling&mdash;back to the
- murmur of the palms, and&rsquo; the singing of the coral reef, and the purple
- tropic night once more.
- </p>
- <h3>
- &ldquo;GOOD-BYE, MY FLENNIE.&rdquo;
- </h3>
- <p>
- (Song, with Samoan words, English beginning to each verse.)
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0047" id="linkimage-0047"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0317.jpg" alt="0317 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0317.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0015" id="link2HCH0015"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER XV
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>Southward to New Zealand&mdash;Into the Hot-Water Country&mdash;Coaching
- Days come back&mdash;The Early Victorian Inn&mdash;The Fire and Snow of
- Ruapehu&mdash;A Hotel run wild&mdash;Hot Lakes and Steaming Rivers&mdash;The
- Devil&rsquo;s Trumpet&mdash;The Valley of the Burning Fountains&mdash;Waking up
- the Champagne Lake.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">O</span>F the other island
- groups that I visited during that pleasant year or two of wandering&mdash;strange
- Fiji, exquisite Norfolk Island, the wicked, unknown New Hebrides&mdash;I
- have told elsewhere. But before the great P. &amp; O. liner carried me
- away from Sydney on the well-known track across the seas to England and
- home, I had a journey through New Zealand that was second to nothing in
- the world, for pure enjoyment, but the unsurpassable Islands themselves.
- </p>
- <p>
- New Zealand is not yet fully opened up&mdash;that was what the geography
- books said in my school days. The saying, like most geography-book
- information, slipped through my mind easily, and did not create any marked
- impression. The marked impression came later, when I went half round the
- world to see New Zealand, and discovered that I could not take train to
- just anywhere I chose. It seemed incredible, in a country as highly
- civilised as France or Germany, that coaches&mdash;not the ornamental
- tourist brand, run as an accompaniment to railways, but real Early
- Victorian coaches, with &ldquo;no frills on them&rdquo; of any sort or kind&mdash;were
- the only means of transit, save boats, to a great part of the famous hot
- lake and river district of the North Island. One could go to Rotorua, the
- most remarkable collection of geysers and hot lakes, direct by rail from
- Auckland. But the lovely Wanganui River, the beautiful up-country bush,
- and whole duchies of hot-water and mud-volcano land, could only be &ldquo;done&rdquo;
- by coach and boat.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0048" id="linkimage-0048"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0447.jpg" alt="0447 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0447.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- This made the journey more interesting, on the whole, though it was a
- little amazing at first to leave the railway far behind, and strike out
- right into the early nineteenth century. One should have worn side-curls,
- a spencer, and a poke bonnet, instead of the ordinary tourist coat and
- skirt and useful straw hat, to feel quite in character with the
- mud-splashed coach, its six insides, two outsides, and four struggling,
- straining horses; the days of wind and shower, the hurried meals eaten at
- lonely little wayside inns, and the nights spent in strange barrack-like,
- barn-like places, where the stable was of more importance than the house,
- and every one always arose and fled like a ghost at the early dawn of day.
- </p>
- <p>
- But first, after the railway town and railway hotel were left behind, came
- Wanganui River, a whole day of it; nearly sixty miles of exquisite
- loveliness, viewed in perfect comfort from the canopied deck of a river
- steamer. The Wanganui has been called New Zealand&rsquo;s Rhine, but it no more
- resembles the Rhine than it resembles a garden-party or an ostrich farm.
- It has nothing whatever in common with Germany&rsquo;s great historic river but
- its beauty; and the beauty of the Wanganui is of an order very far indeed
- removed from that of the ancient castle-crowned streams of Europe, which
- are strewn with records of dead and decaying æons of human life. Solitude,
- stillness, absolute, deathly loneliness are the keynotes of Wanganui
- scenery. Shut in by fold on fold of great green mountain peaks, scarp on
- scarp of fern-wreathed precipice, one can almost fancy that the swift
- little paddle-steamer is churning her way for the first time into
- solitudes never seen of man. Now and then a Maori dug-out canoe, long and
- thin and upturned at the ends, may be sighted riding under the willows, or
- gliding down-stream to the swift paddle-strokes of its dusky-faced
- occupant. At rare intervals, too, the spell of silent lonelinesses broken
- by the sight of some tiny river-side settlement perched on a great green
- height&mdash;half a dozen wooden houses, and a tin-roofed church; the
- whole being labelled, with some extraordinarily pretentious name. One of
- our passengers that day got in at London, and went on to Jerusalem;
- another was booked from Nazareth to Athens!
- </p>
- <p>
- All New Zealanders are <i>not</i> Maories, despite the hazy ideas as to
- colour which exist at home. There is a little trifle of nine hundred
- thousand full-blooded white settlers, to compare with the few thousand
- native Maories still left, in the land they once owned from sea, to sea.
- Still, the Maori in New Zealand is an unmistakable fact, and a most
- picturesque fact into the bargain. To see a family taking deck passage on
- the boat&mdash;handsome dark-eyed women, with rosy cheeks in spite of
- their olive skins, and beautifully waved black hair; bright elfish little
- children; dogs and cats and a sack or two for luggage&mdash;: is an
- interesting spot in the day&rsquo;s experience, especially when some patronising
- passenger, accustomed to &ldquo;natives&rdquo; in other countries, gets one of the
- delightful set-downs the Maori can give so effectively. For all their
- shapeless clothing and heavy blankets, hatless heads and tattooed lips and
- chins, the New Zealand Maories are very much &ldquo;all there&rdquo;; and when the
- patronising saloon passenger struts up to one, and remarks: &ldquo;Tenakoe
- (good-day), Polly! You got ums nicey little fellow there, eh?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Polly&rdquo; will probably reply in excellent English: &ldquo;My name happens to be
- Te Rangi, not Polly; and as for the child you are referring to, I believe
- it belongs to the lady in the yellow plaid sitting aft!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- At the end of the day comes an hotel, standing on a wooded cliff above the
- river, and looking down upon a long lovely stretch of winding water and
- high-piled forest. The night is spent here, and in the morning comes the
- coach, with its team of four fine satin-skinned bays, its many-coated
- driver, its portmanteaux on the roof, mysterious little parcels in the
- &ldquo;boot,&rdquo; and confidential letters in coachman&rsquo;s hat, for all the world like
- something in Charles Dickens. There is no bugle and no guard, and the
- coach itself is a high, long-legged, spidery thing enough, not even
- painted red, and though it is &ldquo;Merry Christmas&rdquo; time, it is a warm summer
- day, with some prospect of thundery rain, but not the faintest of any
- typical Dickensesque Christmas weather. Still, the sentiment is there, so
- one may as well make the most of it.
- </p>
- <p>
- All day, muddy roads and straining horses; all day, a long pull up-hill;
- half the day rain in the wet lovely bush, starring and sparkling the
- exquisite tree ferns, those fine ladies of the forest; crystal-dropping
- the thick coat of ferns that tapestries the tall cliffs, shutting in our
- road. Beneath the wheel curve innumerable black-green gorges, deep and
- dark as Hades, gurgling in their mysterious depths with unseen
- full-throated streams and half-glimpsed waterfalls. About and above us
- rises the impenetrable &ldquo;bush&rdquo;&mdash;tall green trees, feathery, cedary,
- ferny, flowery, set as close together as the spires of moss on a
- velvet-cushioned stone, shutting out half the sky; marking off an
- unmistakable frontier between the territory of still unconquered Nature
- and the regions wrested from her by toiling Man. Wood-pigeons flash their
- blue-grey wings across the valleys; the merry mournful <i>tui</i> flutes
- &ldquo;piercing sweet by the river,&rdquo; undisturbed by our rattling wheels. There
- are wild creatures in plenty, further back in the bush&mdash;wild boars,
- wild cattle, wild cats, and &ldquo;dingoes&rdquo; or dogs&mdash;all originally escaped
- from civilisation, but now as wild as their own savage ancestors. The
- feathery bracken, that carpets all the banks by the wayside, was, and
- indeed still is, a staple food of the Maories. Its young roots are
- excellent eating, being rather like asparagus, and reasonably nourishing
- when nothing better can be had&mdash;and the white-flowered tea-tree&mdash;one
- of the tree-heath family&mdash;-has often furnished a &ldquo;colourable
- imitation&rdquo; of China tea, to the benighted bush-wanderer run out of the
- genuine leaf. This bush about us is all Maori land. Maories alone can find
- their way easily and safely through its pathless mysteries. No, there is
- no avoiding the Maori, anywhere in the North Island!
- </p>
- <p>
- Dinner, warm and grateful and unspeakably comforting, is met with at a
- little inn in a little settlement whose name (of course) begins with Wai.
- The towns in North New Zealand that do not begin with Wai begin with Roto.
- There are a few others, but they hardly count. We are all amazingly
- cheerful when we issue forth warmed and fed; and the cold wind that is
- beginning to blow down from the icy mountain peaks just out of sight, is
- encountered&rsquo; without any British-tourist grumbling. The driver explains
- that the wind ought not to be so cold&mdash;never is in December (the New
- Zealand June); but somehow, this is &ldquo;a most exceptional season,&rdquo; and there
- has been a lot of rain and cold that they don&rsquo;t generally have. Across
- twelve thousand miles of sea my mind leaps back to home; I feel the raspy
- air of the English spring nipping my face, and hear the familiar music of
- the sweet old English lie about the weather. It is a dear home-like lie,
- and makes me feel that New Zealand is indeed what it claims to be&mdash;the
- Britain of the Southern Cross.
- </p>
- <p>
- The effect of dinner is wearing off, and the insides are saying things
- about the weather that make a lonely wanderer like myself long to clasp
- the speakers warmly by the hand&mdash;because they sound so English. Now I
- understand what puzzled me a good deal at first&mdash;the difference
- between the Americanised, Continentalised Australians and the perfectly
- British New Zealander. The Briton cannot retain his peculiar
- characteristic in a climate like that of Australia; deprived of his
- natural and national grumble about the changeable weather, he is like a
- dog without a bark&mdash;an utterly anomalous being, But the New Zealand
- climate is windy and showery, given to casting autumn in the lap of spring
- and throwing winter into the warm, unexpecting arms of summer. So the
- Briton of the South, settled among his familiar weather &ldquo;samples,&rdquo; remains
- like the Briton of the North; and the travelling Englishman or
- Englishwoman, visiting New Zealand, feels more entirely at home than in
- any other quarter of the globe. It is only fair to New Zealand, however,
- to add that the average summer, beginning in December, is at worst very
- much warmer and pleasanter than the English spring or winter, and at best,
- a season of real delight.
- </p>
- <p>
- Late and dark and cold is the evening when we rattle up to the
- accommodation house planted in a strange desert spot, where the night is
- to be passed. Another coach comes in and discharges its load by-and-by.
- The Dickensonian flavour increases, as we of the earlier coach sit round
- the great ingle-nook fire of blazing logs in the coffee-room, silently
- surveying the new comers, while they shed their many wraps and crowd about
- the blaze. To how many Early Victorian tales&mdash;Dickens, Bulwer Lytton,
- G. P. R. James&mdash;have not the lonely inn and the late arriving guest
- been the familiar commencement!
- </p>
- <p>
- But the three Maories, man and two women, alighting from the coach and
- taking their place in the warm room, break through the illusion of
- Victorian romance at a touch, as a passing figure breaks through a
- gossamer cobweb stretched across a furzy path. Even G. P. R. could have
- had no dealings with those tall bundled-up, black-eyed, self-possessed
- beings from the bush. He would have turned them out in despair, or turned
- himself out, and gone back to his mysterious, Spanish-complexioned
- gentlemen in furred riding-cloaks.
- </p>
- <p>
- A nipping early morning sees us off at seven o&rsquo;clock; the discontented
- innkeeper, with (apparently) a dark crime on his conscience, seeing us go
- with obvious relief. It is too evident that like rather many backwoods
- hotelkeepers, he regards the harmless necessary traveller in the
- unflattering light of &ldquo;the pig that pays the rint.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- Ruapehu&rsquo;s giant cone, covered with dazzling snow, soars 3,000 feet into
- heaven above us. We are high up ourselves, for we pass the 4,000 foot
- level later on, rather cold and cross, and inclined to regard the little
- flag of hot smoke creeping out of the crest of Ngaurhoe, a smaller volcano
- ahead, as the most desirable thing in nature. Brumbies (wild horses) skim
- the plains below us, quick-moving little dots of black against the
- buff-colour of river valleys and fiats of sand. &ldquo;There&rsquo;s a fellow hunting
- those at present,&rdquo; volunteers the driver&mdash;&ldquo;catches and breaks them,
- and gets thirty shillings apiece for them for youngsters to ride to
- school. The kids must have something, you know, and the brumbies are wiry
- little brutes.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- No one walks on two legs in New Zealand, apparently. I recollect a picture
- that the coach passed only yesterday evening&mdash;a man on horseback, and
- two dogs, fetching home a cow and her calf from a pasture a quarter of a
- mile away from the homestead. In England the whole outfit of man, horse,
- and dogs would have been represented by one small child with a pinafore
- and a stick. Other countries, other manners.
- </p>
- <p>
- One o&rsquo;clock, forty-two miles out, with a stop for a fresh team; and we now
- enter a valley where we are met by the strange sight of a puff of steam
- rising from a bushy dell, and a little river that glides along with smoky
- vapours curling up from its surface. We are in the hot-water country at
- last; this is Tokaanu, and from here to Rotorua, ninety miles away, the
- earth is dotted, every now and then, with boiling springs, erupting
- geysers, hot lakes, and warm rivers. In all this country you need never
- light a fire to cook, unless you choose; never heat water to wash your
- pots and pans, or to bath yourself. The Maories, and many of the whites,
- steam all their food instead of boiling or baking it; and as for hot
- baths, an army might enjoy them all day long.
- </p>
- <p>
- The valley is warm and pleasant; Lake Taupo lies before us, thirty miles
- long, wide and blue and beautiful as the sea, sentinelled by tall peaks of
- dazzling white and purest turquoise, and all embroidered about the shores
- with gold braiding of splendid <i>Planta Genista</i> scattered in groves
- and hedges of surpassing richness. Three hours in a tiny steamer brings
- us, To the othér side; and here, the sights of the hot-water country
- fairly begin.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Spa Hotel, at Taupo (where one passes the night and as many days as
- one has time for), is a museum; an exhibition, and very-good joke, all in
- itself. One might fairly describe it as hashed hotel, served up with
- excellent sauce. You find bits of it lost in a wilderness of rose and
- rhododendron, at the end of a garden path; half a dozen bedrooms, run away
- all along among the honeysuckles to play hide-and-seek; a drawing-room
- isolated like a lighthouse in a sea of greenery; a dining-room that was
- once a Maori assembly-house, and is a miracle of wildly grotesque
- carvings, representing, the weirdest of six-foot goblin figures, eyed and
- toothed; with pearl-shell, and carved in the highest of alto relievo, all
- down the walls. White sand pathways, run, between, the various fragments
- of the hotel; a hot stream, breathing curly vapour as it goes, meanders,
- about the grounds, captured here and there in deep wooden ponds, under
- rustic roofs, or hemmed in by walls and concealing trees, to make the most
- attractive of baths. There is sulphur, and soda and free sulphuric acid in
- these, waters; one spring, welling up all by itself, has iodine. For
- rheumatism, skin diseases, and many blood diseases, these constantly
- running pools are almost a certain cure. It seems a shocking waste of
- golden opportunities to let this chance go by without being healed of
- something; but I can only collect, a cold in the head, a grazed ankle, and
- a cracked lip, to meet the occasion&mdash;of all which evils the baths at
- once relieve me, offering in their place an appetite which must seriously
- impair my popularity with the proprietress, though I am bound to say she
- hides her feelings nobly.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is a celebrated &ldquo;porridge pot,&rdquo; or mud volcano, near this hotel. I
- have not time to see it; therefore I leave it with gentle reproaches
- ringing in my ears, and hints to the effect that I shall be haunted on my
- deathbed by unavailing regret. But I meet the Waikato River directly
- after, and at once forget everything else. Never anywhere on this earth,
- except in the hues of a peacock&rsquo;s breast shining in the sun, have I seen
- such a marvellous blue-green colour as that of this deep, gem-like,
- splendid stream. And the golden broom on its banks, the golden broom on
- the heights, the golden broom everywhere&mdash;bushes eight and ten feet
- high, all one molten flame of burning colour, with never a leaf to be seen
- under the conflagration of riotous blossom&mdash;what is the English
- broom, or the English gorse, compared to this?
- </p>
- <p>
- All the six miles to Wairakei, we follow the Waikato River; watch it sink
- into a deep green gorge; break into splendid foam and spray down a
- magnificent fall, that alone might make the fortune of any hotel in a less
- richly dowered country; wind underneath colossal tree-clad cliffs, in
- coils and streaks of the strange emerald-blue that is the glory of the
- river, and finally bend away towards the Arateatea Rapids. Another hotel
- built after the charming fashion of the Taupo hostelry, receives the coach
- occupants. The style of architecture sets one thinking. Where, twenty
- years ago, did out-of-the-way New Zealand light upon the &ldquo;pavilion&rdquo;
- system, that is the very latest fancy of all modern-built sanatoria? Has
- the liability to occasional small earthquake tremors anything to do with
- it? Whatever the cause may be, the result is that the fresh-air system is
- in full swing in nearly all the New Zealand thermal resorts; that doors
- and windows are always open, paths take the place of passages, and
- everybody acquires the complexion of a milkmaid and the appetite of a
- second-mate.
- </p>
- <p>
- The hot outdoor swimming bath is a toy with which one really cannot stop
- playing. It is something so new and so amusing to dive into a bath 90 feet
- long and 102 deg. Fahrenheit as to heat; swim about like marigolds in
- broth, in a temperature that would cook an egg in a few minutes, and all
- the time see the exquisite weeping willows wave overhead, the tall grasses
- stand on the bank, the wild clematis tremble in the trees above the pool.
- After the hot dip, one steps over a partition into another bathful of cool
- spring water, only 68° in heat, to cool down; and then comes dressing in a
- little bath-box (shut off from the grounds, like all the bath, by a high
- board fence), followed by a two minutes&rsquo; walk back to the house. But
- again, when night comes on, and the moon silvers the weeping willows to
- the semblance of pale frost-foliage on an icy pane, and the dim
- wraith-like vapours of the pool float up in ghostly shapes and shadows
- about the darkness of the inner boughs, one is tempted to come down once
- more, gliding hurriedly through the chill night air to the pool, locking
- the door, and floating for an hour or more in the dim, warm, drowsy
- waters. Cold? No one ever gets cold from the thermal waters, even if the
- cool dip is left out. That is one of their chiefest charms.
- </p>
- <p>
- With the morning, I am informed that life will not be worth living to me
- any more, if I do not see the Geyser Canon. Some one declares that it is
- the most beautiful sight in New Zealand; some one else says that it
- frightens you most delightfully, in the safest possible way; and &ldquo;one low
- churl, compact of thankless earth,&rdquo; says that it is extremely instructive.
- This last calumny I must at once deny. Interesting, to the deepest degree,
- the Wairakei Geysers are; suggestive also beyond any other geological
- phenomena in New Zealand; but instructive, after the tedious
- scientific-evenings fashion of our childhood, they are not. They are too
- beautiful for that, and too fascinating. One ought, no doubt, to absorb a
- great deal of geological information during the tour of the valley, but
- one is so busy having a good time that one doesn&rsquo;t. Which is exactly as it
- should be.
- </p>
- <p>
- Coming round the corner of the path that leads to the geysers, one sees a
- column of white steam rising over the shoulder of the hill, among the
- greenery of tea-tree and willow, exactly like the blowing-off steam of
- some railway engine, waiting at a station. It is indeed an engine that is
- blowing off steam; but the engine is rather a big one&mdash;nothing less,
- indeed, than that admirable piece of work, Mother Earth herself. Ingle,
- the guide, now comes out of a tin-roofed cottage at the entrance to the
- valley, and starts to show us the wonders of the place.
- </p>
- <p>
- Now be it known that Mr. Ingle is a very remarkable character, and second
- only to the geysers themselves, as a phenomenon of singular interest. He
- is one of the very few men in the world who know all about geysers, and
- quite the only one who can literally handle and work&rsquo; them. Ingle knows
- how to doctor a sick geyser as well as any stableman can doctor a horse;
- he can induce it to erupt, keep it from doing so, or make it erupt after
- his fashion, and not after its own. He is the author of at least two
- scientific discoveries of some importance, combining the effects of steam
- pressure on rocks and the incidence of volcanoes along certain thermal
- lines. In fact, what Ingle does not know about the interior of the earth,
- and the doings down there, is not worth knowing; and he tells us much of
- it as he takes us over the canon. Instructive? Certainly not. It is all
- gossip about volcanoes and geysers&mdash;personal, interesting, slightly
- scandalous gossip (because the behaviour of some of them, at times, and
- the tempers they exhibit, <i>are</i> simply scandalous); but not
- &ldquo;instructive&rdquo;; assuredly not.
- </p>
- <p>
- The average tourist likes to have every sight named&mdash;romantically or
- comically named, if possible&mdash;and his tastes have been fully
- considered in the Geyser Canon. I am not going to quote the guide-book
- titles of the dozen or two thermal wonders exhibited by Ingle. Staircases
- of pink silica, with hot water running down them; boiling pools of white
- fuller&rsquo;s earth, with miniature volcanoes and geysers pock-marked all over
- them: sapphire-coloured ponds, where one can see fifty feet of scalding
- depths; the great Wairakei Geyser, casting up huge fountains of boiling
- steam and spray every seven minutes; twin geysers living in one pool of
- exquisite creamy stalactites, and erupting every four minutes with the
- punctuality of a watch; geysers that throb exactly like the paddles of a
- steamer, or beat like the pulse of an engine; geysers that throw up great
- white balls of steam through crystal funnels of hot water; geysers that
- cast themselves bodily out of their beds at regular intervals, leaving you
- with exactly nine minutes in which to scramble down the hot wet rock of
- the funnel, stagger through the blinding steam that rises from the rents
- and fissures at the bottom, and climb up the other side again, into
- coolness and safety, to wait and watch the roaring water burst up through
- the rock once more; geysers that make blue-green pools oh the lip of milky
- and ruddy terrace of carven silica; that explode like watery cannon, in
- definite rows, one after another; that build themselves nests like birds,
- send boiling streams under rustic bridges, scatter hot spray and steam
- over&rsquo; richly drooping ferns, and plant rainbow haloes on a scalding cloud
- of mist, high above the clustering trees of the valley&mdash;these are the
- sights of the canon, and they need no childish names to make them
- interesting. When a visitor gets into the Geyser Canon he is like a fly in
- a spider&rsquo;s web. He cannot get away from this colossal variety
- entertainment. He runs from a nine-minute geyser to see a four-minute
- geyser do its little &ldquo;turn,&rdquo; and by this time the number is up for the
- seven-minute performance of the great star, so he hurries there; and after
- that he must just go back and see the twin geysers do another four-minute
- trick, and then there is quite another, which will do a splendid &ldquo;turn&rdquo; in
- twenty-seven minutes&rsquo; time, if he only waits&mdash;and so half a day is
- gone, without any one noticing the flight of time, until the sudden
- occurrence of a &ldquo;passionate vacancy,&rdquo; not at all connected with the
- geysers or their beds, informs the traveller that another meal-time has,
- unperceived, come round.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Arateatea Rapids fill in the afternoon. From the high road where the
- open coach stands waiting, down through a pretty woodland of greenery and
- shadow and thick soundless moss, one follows a narrow pathway towards an
- ever-increasing sound of rushing, tumbling, and thundering, out, at last,
- on to a projecting point where one stands right over a rocky canon filled
- almost to the brim with a smother of white rolling foam, woven through
- with surprising lights of clear jade green and trembling gold. And here,
- on the brink of this half-mile of rapids, over the roaring water, I give
- it up. I do not attempt to describe it. When you take a great river,
- exceptionally deep and swift, and throw it over half a mile of sloping
- cliff, things are bound to happen that are somewhat beyond the power of
- pen and ink to render. Who has ever read a description of a waterfall,
- anywhere, written by any one that conveyed an impression worth a rotten
- nut? Every one who goes to see Arateatea must manufacture his own
- sensations on the spot. Sheer fright will certainly be one of them; not at
- anything the innocent rapids are doing to the beholder, but at the bare
- notion of what they might do, one foot nearer&mdash;one step lower down&mdash;one&mdash;&mdash;
- Let me have a couple of trees to hold on to, please. Thank you, that is
- better.
- </p>
- <p>
- Many years ago, a party of twenty Maories had a narrow escape from the
- cruel embraces of snow-white Arateatea. They were canoeing on the upper
- river; and, partly because the trout in the Waikato are the biggest trout
- in the world, partly because some of the rowers had had too much fun at a
- &ldquo;tangi,&rdquo; or wailing party, the night before, and were not very
- clear-headed, they forgot to think of the current until it had them fairly
- in its clutch, whirling them along only a mile or two above the terrible
- rapids. They could not reach the shore, and they dared not swim. One would
- have supposed that nothing could save them from being beaten to pieces
- against the cruel rocks in the rapids&mdash;yet they escaped that fate.
- </p>
- <p>
- They went over the Huka Falls, which come a mile or two above the rapids
- (the Maories had forgotten all about that) and were decently drowned
- instead.
- </p>
- <p>
- I am sorry that the above is not a better story; but the fact is, that
- tourists are not very plentiful about Wairakei, and the natives have not
- yet learned to invent the proper tourist tale. That is about the best they
- can do as yet.
- </p>
- <p>
- It will hardly be credited, but there is not even a Lover&rsquo;s Leap in the
- whole valley; not a story of an obstinate father who got opportunely
- boiled in a geyser, while his daughter eloped down a scalding river in a
- motor-boat worked by the steam from the surface&mdash;nor a tale of a
- flying criminal pursued by executioners, who leaped from side to side of a
- gorge some thirty feet across and got away. This is certainly remiss of
- the authorities; but I have no doubt the Government Tourist Department
- would take the matter up, and supply the necessary fiction, if suitably
- approached.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0049" id="linkimage-0049"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0470.jpg" alt="0470 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0470.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- In the meantime travellers must be satisfied with the rather bald and
- uninteresting tale of a Maori maiden named Karapiti, who jumped into the
- steam blow-hole bearing her name, because her <i>fiancé</i> did not meet
- her there on Sunday afternoon as arranged to take her to afternoon tea at
- the Wairakei Hotel. At least, that is one version of the tale, and it is
- quite enough for the Smith family from London, and other representative
- tourists.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;You should have given yourself more time.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Whatever you are going to do later on, this place really requires at
- least a week.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;You cannot possibly miss so-and-so, or this and that!&rdquo; Such are the
- reproaches that haunt the hasty traveller through the Hot-Water Country&mdash;reproaches
- fully deserved in nearly every case, for very few tourists who journey to
- New Zealand realise the amount of time that should be spent in seeing the
- miracles of the volcanic zone, if nothing really good is to be omitted.
- </p>
- <p>
- It results in an unsatisfactory compromise as a rule&mdash;some &ldquo;sights&rdquo;
- being seen; many passed over. There is always something fascinating just
- ahead, calling the traveller on, and something wonderful close at hand,
- which demands the sacrifice of yet another day, before moving. Such a
- superfluity of beautiful and wonderful sights can assuredly be found
- nowhere else on earth. Iceland is far inferior; the famous Yellowstone
- Park of America has only a stepmother&rsquo;s helping of what might be New
- Zealand&rsquo;s &ldquo;left-overs.&rdquo; The lovely, lamented Pink and White Terraces are
- by many supposed to have been the only great thermal wonder of the
- country. This is so far from being the truth that only a good-sized volume
- could fairly state the other side of the question. I have never met any
- traveller through the thermal districts who had succeeded in seeing
- everything of interest. All whom I saw were as hard at work as the very
- coach-horses themselves&mdash;walking, driving, climbing, scrambling each
- hour of every day, and often thoroughly overdoing themselves, in the
- plucky attempt to carry away as much as possible from this over-richly
- spread banquet of Nature&rsquo;s wonders.
- </p>
- <p>
- I squeezed out an afternoon for Karapiti (the &ldquo;Devil&rsquo;s Trumpet&rdquo;) and the
- Valley of the Coloured Lakes. By this time I was a little jaded with
- sight-seeing, disposed to talk in a hold-cheap tone of anything that was
- not absolutely amazing, and to taste all these weirdly impressive marvels
- with a very discriminating palate. Karapiti, however, is cayenne to any
- jaded taste. It is known as the &ldquo;Safety-Valve of New Zealand,&rdquo; and the
- term is peculiarly fitting. The whole of the Hot-Water Country is only one
- plank removed from the infernal regions; it almost floats upon the
- scalding brow of molten rock, liquid mineral, and vaporised water, that
- composes the earth interior immediately below. That it is perfectly safe
- to live in (a constant wonder to outsiders) is very largely due to just
- those steam blow-holes and geysers which excite the fears of the
- nervous-minded&mdash;and the colossal dragon-throat of Karapiti is the
- most important safety-valve of all.
- </p>
- <p>
- Walking up the hill&rsquo; to the blow-hole, many hundred yards off, one hears
- its loud unvarying roar, like the steam-thunder that comes from an ocean
- liner&rsquo;s huge funnel, when the ship is ready to cast loose from shore. The
- ground as one gets nearer is jutted and uneven, and perceptibly warm in
- certain spots. Rounding a corner, one comes suddenly upon the Devil&rsquo;s
- Trumpet, a funnel-shaped opening, ten feet across at the lip, in the
- bottom of a cupshaped hollow. A fierce jet of steam rushes out from the
- Trumpet, thick and white as a great marble column, and roaring horribly as
- it comes forth. The pressure is no less than 180 lb. to one square inch,
- and the rush of this gigantic waste-pipe never slackens or ceases, night
- or day; nor has it done so within the memory of man.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;If it did, I&rsquo;d look for another situation pretty sharp, for it wouldn&rsquo;t
- be &rsquo;ealthy to stay around Wairakei no more,&rdquo; observes one guide,
- who is showing off the monster to us by throwing a kerosene can into the
- jet, and catching it as it is violently flung back to him, many yards
- away. &ldquo;I can throw a penny the same,&rdquo; he says, and does so, getting back
- the coin promptly, a good deal hotter than it went in.
- </p>
- <p>
- One of the ladies of our party is nearly reduced to tears by the sinister
- aspect, the menacing horror of the spot. She begs to be taken away,
- because she knows she will dream about it. She does dream about it; I know
- that, because I do myself, that night; and the dreams are not nice. Still,
- I would face them again for another look at roaring Karapiti. It is a
- wonder of wonders, a horror of horrors, unlike anything else in the world.
- On the whole, I am glad of that last fact. Too much Karapiti would
- certainly get on one&rsquo;s nerves.
- </p>
- <p>
- There have never been any accidents to travellers here. No one could fall
- down the hole, because the funnel narrows rapidly, and is only about two
- feet across in the inner part. All the same, one cannot safely approach
- very near, for there is an in-rush as well as an out-rush, and if any one
- did fall victim to it, and stumble into the funnel, the highly condensed
- steam would strip the flesh from his bones as quickly as a cherry is
- shelled off its stone.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Valley of the Coloured Lakes came next. I wonder what the inhabitants
- of Brighton or Bath would do&mdash;how they would advertise, how they
- would cry for visitors&mdash;if they had a valley at their very gates
- which contained a scalding hot river, tumbling over pink and
- cream-coloured cascades of china-like silica, in clouds of steamy spray&mdash;a
- great round pond, set deep in richest forest, and coloured vivid orange,
- with red rocks round the brim; another, crude Reckitt&rsquo;s blue; another,
- staring verdigris green; another, raspberry pink; others still, yellow as
- custard and white as starch! All these ponds are hot; they are coloured by
- the various minerals they hold In solution, but they have not yet been
- chemically analysed, so it is only possible to speculate as to the exact
- cause of the colours. Seen from a height above, the ponds resemble nothing
- so much as a number of paint-pots; and that, indeed, is one of the names
- by which the valley is generally known.
- </p>
- <p>
- Leaving behind me, unlooked at, still more than I had seen, I took coach
- again next morning for Rotorua. It was an early and a chilly start, for we
- had over thirty miles to do before lunch. The light, springy coach, with
- its leather-curtain sides, was filled with a cheerful party, all young,
- all enjoying themselves heartily, and all full of the genial good spirits
- that come of much open air and a holiday frame of mind. <i>New</i> New
- Zealand at its best was represented there, much as Old New Zealand was
- represented by the silent bearded men, with the lonely-looking eyes, who
- travelled in the Pipiriki and Waiouru stages of the journey.
- </p>
- <p>
- How fast the spanking team swings in along the road! How lovely the
- changing panorama of the encircling hills, now velvet-brown with rich
- green dells and valleys, now far-off pansy-purple, now palest grey, seamed
- with crimson streaks of hematite! The air is very clear to-day, with that
- strange New Zealand clearness that changes every-distance to sea-blue
- crystal, and pencils every shadow sharp and square.
- </p>
- <p>
- We have left the royal gold broom behind us; but the beautiful manuka
- scrub of the valleys is in full blossom, exquisitely tipped and touched
- with white lace-like blossoms. It is almost as if a heavy hoar-froat had
- misted over every delicate green bough with finest touches of silver. Arum
- lilies bloom in the ditches; the Maori flax, like tall iris leaves,
- wanders wildly over hill and valley; great fields of Pampas grass wave
- their creamy plumes over the shot green satin of thick-growing leaves.
- Wild horses, as the coach goes by, look warily out from behind some woody
- knoll, or canter away across the plains with their long-legged foals. Some
- of them are fine creatures, too, worth catching and breaking, and many are
- taken there from time to time. What a happy land, where a man can go out
- and pick a fine horse in a mountain meadow, much as you pick a daisy at
- home!
- </p>
- <p>
- Lunch-time befalls at another of the inevitable Wais&mdash;Waiotapu, this
- time&mdash;and before the coach starts on the last stretch of eighteen
- miles to Rotorua, I go across the road to see the only one of Waiotapu&rsquo;s
- sights for which I have time&mdash;the Champagne Pool and Alum Cliffs.
- </p>
- <p>
- These are to be found on a most extraordinary milk-coloured plain, which
- looks exactly as if a careless giant had been mixing colours and trying
- brushes on it, and left everything lying about. The rocks and heights, the
- deep dells with boiling pools and grumbling geysers at the bottom, the
- narrow pathways leading here and there, are spotted and streaked with
- carmine, rose madder, scarlet, primrose, bright yellow, and amber. The
- &ldquo;Cliffs&rdquo; are a succession of rocky heights composed of something very like
- cream fondant, which is mostly alum. At their feet opens out a fascinating
- succession of bays and inlets full of variously coloured water, at which I
- can only glance as I pass. There are two mustard-coloured pools, and one
- pale green, among them. Close at hand the overflow from the Champagne Pool
- rushes, steaming fiercely, over a fall of rocks which appear to have been
- very newly and stickily painted in palest primrose colour. Alum, sulphur,
- and hematite are responsible, I am told, for most of these strange hues.
- Sulphur and arsenic have coloured the Champagne Pool itself&mdash;a great
- green lake, almost boiling, and of a most amazing colour&mdash;something
- between the green of a peridot and that of Chartreuse. It has never been
- bottomed; the line ran out at 900 feet when tried. The edge of all the
- lake is most delicately wrought into a coralline border of ornamental
- knobs and branches, canary yellow in colour. Its name is derived from the
- curious effect produced in the depths of the pond by a handful of sand.
- The water begins to cream and froth at once, like champagne or lemonade,
- and continues to do so in places for at least half an hour.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0050" id="linkimage-0050"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0476.jpg" alt="0476 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0476.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- And now we hurry back to the coach once more, and on to Rotorua, wonder of
- wonders, and thermal temple of every healing water known to the medical
- world.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0051" id="linkimage-0051"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0488.jpg" alt="0488 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0488.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0016" id="link2HCH0016"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER XVI
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>From Heaven to Hades&mdash;Gay Rotorua&mdash;Where One lives on a Pie
- crust&mdash;The Birth of a River&mdash;Horrible Tikitere&mdash;In the
- Track of the Great Eruption&mdash;Where are the Pink and White Terraces?&mdash;A
- Fountain fifteen hundred feet high&mdash;Foolhardy Feat of a Guide&mdash;How
- the Tourists were killed&mdash;A Maori Village&mdash;Soaping a Geyser&mdash;The
- End.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">R</span>ED roofs and white
- verandahs; straight sandy streets of immense width, planted with green
- trees, and spindling away into unnaturally bright blue distances;
- omnibuses, phaetons, motor-cars, and four-in-hands passing at long
- intervals towards the shining lakes that lie beside the town; puffs of
- white steam rising up among green gardens and open fields; a ring of
- amethyst-coloured hills surrounding the whole bright scene, bathed in such
- a white, pure, crystalline sun as never shines on misty England. That is
- Rotorua, a half-day&rsquo;s journey from Auckland, and the centre of the
- wonderful geyser region of New Zealand.
- </p>
- <p>
- Every one now-a-days knows that New Zealand possesses wonderful geysers,
- but not quite everybody knows what a geyser is; and certainly very few are
- aware of the extraordinary richness and variety of the geyser country.
- Geysers are intermittent fountains of boiling water, in height from a
- couple of feet up to fifteen hundred&mdash;the enormous altitude reached
- by Waimangu the Terrible, greatest geyser of the whole world. They consist
- of a shaft reaching down from the surface of the earth to deep, very
- highly heated reservoirs of steam and boiling water below; and (usually)
- of a siliceous basin surrounding the shaft-opening, and full of hot water.
- Some geysers open in the centre of a cone of siliceous sinter, built up by
- the deposits from the water, and have no basin.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0052" id="linkimage-0052"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0492.jpg" alt="0492 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0492.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- The periodic explosions of active geysers are due to the following facts&mdash;water
- under heavy pressure requires a much higher temperature to boil than water
- free from pressure. While the water high up in the geyser pipe may be a
- little under 212 degrees, that in the lower levels may be standing at 50
- or 60 degrees higher, and only kept from expanding into steam by the
- weight of the column above it. If anything lessens that weight or
- increases the temperature of the lower water, this latter will explode
- into steam, and drive the upper waters high into air with the force of its
- exit from the shaft. This, briefly, is the theory of geyser action.
- </p>
- <p>
- Rotorua itself, the great focus of the healing forces of Nature in the
- geyser district, is simply a crust over a mass of hot springs, charged
- with various minerals. Three feet under earth you will find hot water, in
- nearly any part of the town. There are hundreds of hot springs in the
- neighbourhood that have never been analysed. Of the many that are in use
- in the Government Sanatorium, the &ldquo;Priest&rsquo;s Water&rdquo; and &ldquo;Rachel Water&rdquo; are
- the most famous. The former cures rheumatism, gout, and blood diseases,
- while &ldquo;Rachel&rdquo; makes her patrons &ldquo;beautiful for ever&rdquo; by curing all forms
- of skin trouble, and bestowing a lovely complexion, not to speak of the
- remarkable effects of the spring on nervous affections. There are also
- wonderful hot swimming baths, much patronised by the casual tourist; baths
- of hot volcanic mud, and baths of hot sulphur vapour rising direct from
- the burning caverns under the earth.
- </p>
- <p>
- But for people who are in good health, it is the &ldquo;sights&rdquo; of Rotorua that
- are the chief attractions, and these are very many. One of the loveliest,
- and a welcome change from the countless hot-water springs, is Hamurana,
- surely the most beautiful river source in the world. It is reached by a
- journey across one of the lakes in a steamer. All the way the great lake
- ripples purest turquoise under a high, clear, cloudless sky; green islands
- rise bright and cool from its shining surface, sharply peaked and shadowed
- mountains, on the distant shores, stand out in strange hues of crystalline
- hyacinth unknown to our northern climes. By-and-by the little steamer
- leaves us on a green wooded shore, and we take boat up a fairy river to a
- region of enchanted beauty. Blossoming trees line the sun-steeped banks;
- the water is of the strangest colours&mdash;jade-green, clear molten
- sapphire, silver/ emerald, and transparent as a great highway of rock
- crystal. Enormous trout, weighing up to twenty pounds, rush from under our
- keel; grass-green and rose-red water weeds quiver far beneath the oar.
- Wild fuchsias, wild cherries, loaded with scarlet fruit, snowy-flowered
- tea-tree, arum lilies, yellow broom, and pink dog-roses, hang out over the
- water. But a few hundred yards, and the big lovely river comes to a sudden
- end, walled in by blossoming bushes, and apparently cut short in the
- strangest&rsquo; of culs-de-sac. In reality it is the source we have reached;
- here the whole Hamurana stream springs full-grown from the earth. A great
- rift in the bed of the glassy river is visible, where the water wells up
- under our keel in wavering masses of amber, aquamarine, and deep blue,
- shot with glancing arrows of prismatic light. Five million gallons are
- poured forth from this deep cold cavern every twenty-four hours&mdash;each
- drop as clear as a diamond, and as pure. The force of the upspringing
- stream is so great that pennies can be thrown in from the boat without
- sinking, to the bottom of the cavern&mdash;the water sends them back, and
- casts them out into the shallows about the edge of the rift. Sometimes a
- small silver coin will slip down into depths, and lie glittering many
- fathoms below, magnified conspicuously by the transparent water. The Maori
- natives, who are marvellous divers, have tried time and again to
- reach-this tempting store of treasure; but no man can stem the uprushing
- torrent of water, and if the coins were gold, they would be as safe as
- they are now from being taken by human hands. The most determined suicide
- could not drown himself in the Hamurana River source, for the stream about
- the source is shallow, and the cavern water itself would not permit him to
- sink, however willing he might be.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Valley of Tikitere, some ten miles from Rotorua, is the greatest
- contrast that could possibly be conceived to Hamurana&rsquo;s enchanted
- loveliness. Enchanted indeed this valley also plight be, but by a spell of
- evil. It is the nearest possible approach to the familiar conception of
- hell. A stretch of white siliceous soil, streaked here and there with the
- blood-coloured stains of hematite, or the livid yellow of sulphur, is
- pitted all over with lakes, pools, and small deep pot-holes of boiling
- mud, sometimes thick, sometimes thin, but always scalding, bubbling,
- spirting, and threatening. Chief of all the horrors is the well-named
- lake, &ldquo;Gates of Hell.&rdquo; Standing upon a bank of white earth that is warm
- underfoot, and seamed with steaming cracks, one looks down upon a ghastly
- hellhole of a seething cauldron, slimy black in colour, and veiled with
- stinging mists that only now and then lift sufficiently to show the
- hideous surface of the lake. The foul broth of which it is composed
- bubbles and lifts ceaselessly, now and then rising into ominous heights
- and waves that seem about to break upon the banks above. The heat reaches
- our faces, as we stand half-stifled on the pathway. Just beside us, a
- large pool of bubbling mud, which stands constantly at 2120 Fahrenheit&mdash;ordinary
- boiling point&mdash;seems almost cool in comparison. Little wonder that is
- so; for the &ldquo;Gates of Hell&rdquo; is largely composed of sulphuric acid, and its
- surface temperature is 232°.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0053" id="linkimage-0053"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0463.jpg" alt="0463 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0463.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Beyond lies a perfect wilderness of boiling mud-holes of every kind. Here,
- there is a pond of mud as thick as porridge; there, one fluid as cream.
- Here, the deadly, scalding surface lies innocently smooth and unrippled;
- there, it leaps and thunders like a young volcano in action.
- </p>
- <p>
- At one corner we come suddenly upon an ugly black archway, leading to no
- inviting interior; nothing can be seen within; but the loud gurglings and
- chokings of the seething depths inside restrain any desire for closer
- observation, &ldquo;The Heavenly Twins,&rdquo; derisively so-named, are two boiling
- mud-lioles not a foot apart, but quite unconnected; one boils the thickest
- of brews, while its twin concocts the thinnest.
- </p>
- <p>
- One must follow the guide closely and carefully about these ghastly
- wonders. One step off the pathway, and a horrible death awaits the
- careless walker. Even the path itself is only cool and solid on the
- outside skin. The guide stops now and then to dig his stick into the
- whitey-brown earth for a couple of inches, and turn up a clod all
- glittering on the under-side with fresh crystals of sulphur. This
- under-side is so hot that one can hardly touch it with the unprotected
- hand.
- </p>
- <p>
- From one deep mud-hole, of a comparatively reasonable temperature, mud is
- taken out for medical uses. It is wonderfully effective as a bath, for
- soothing pain and curing sleeplessness. Further on, on safe ground, one
- can see a hot waterfall about twenty feet high, in temperature about 100°,
- which is used as a douche bath by invalids of many kinds, with remarkable
- results.
- </p>
- <p>
- On the edges of the valley, I see for the first time in detail exactly how
- the &ldquo;fumarole,&rdquo; or steam blow-hole, is used for cooking purposes. Over the
- opening of a small manageable blow-hole, an inch or two across, is placed
- a box without a bottom. The food to be cooked is placed in the box, either
- in a pot, or wrapped in leaves. The lid is then put on, and covered with
- clay. In an hour or so the meat or stew is done to a turn; and even if
- left too long, it cannot be burned. One blow-hole, in constant use by the
- Maories, is not steam at all, but hot sulphur vapour, which deposits a
- crust of sulphur on everything it touches. This does not trouble the
- Maori, however; he eats his food quite contentedly, with a strong
- sulphurous flavour added to its natural taste, and says it does him good.
- Certainly, the natives living about Tikitere are unusually strong and
- hearty in appearance, and never troubled with any kind of illness.
- </p>
- <p>
- People of middle age will doubtless remember vividly the impression
- created all over the world in 1886 by the eruption of the great volcano
- Tarawera, and the destruction of New Zealand&rsquo;s most cherished natural
- wonder&mdash;the peerless Pink and White Terraces of Rotomahana. Count-,
- less marvels have been left, and one new one that far outstrips the
- Terraces in sheer wonder and magnificence&mdash;Waimangu, the greatest
- geyser in the world; but New Zealand still laments her beautiful Terraces,
- and shows the spot where they lie deep, buried under ninety feet of
- volcanic débris, as though pointing out the grave of something loved and
- lost.
- </p>
- <p>
- A day of wonderful interest is that spent in seeing the track of the great
- eruption. Leaving Rotorua early in the morning, I saw, as the coach wound
- up the hilly road outside the town, many traces of that awful night and
- day of darkness, thunder, and terror, eighteen years ago. Although Rotorua
- is fifteen miles or more from the site of the Terraces, the sky was dark
- all the day of the eruption, and only three or four miles from the town
- black volcanic dust fell so densely as to leave a stratum several inches
- thick over the country. This is clearly visible in the cuttings at the
- side of the road, where the black stratum can be seen underlying the more
- recent layer of ordinary soil. Where the great coach-road to Rotomahana
- once ran, a chasm some sixty feet deep scars the mountain side, caused by
- the fearful rush of water that took place down the road-track. An
- earthquake crack, thirty feet deep, runs close to the road for a long
- distance. All the way up to the buried village of Wairoa, similar traces
- can be seen. But before the village is reached, two gems of scenic
- loveliness are passed&mdash;the Blue and Green Lakes, lying side by side,
- each enclosed by steep rugged hills, reflected clearly on its glassy
- surface. One is of the strangest, most delicate Sèvres blue&mdash;a
- colour, not depending on any reflection from above, for I saw it on a grey
- and cloudy day&mdash;the other is a bright verdigris green. &ldquo;Chemicals in
- the water&rdquo; is the very vague reason given by inhabitants of the district
- for these remarkable beauties of colour.
- </p>
- <p>
- I must note here that in no case have I succeeded in obtaining any
- satisfactory reason for the remarkable blues and greens so common in both
- the cold and hot waters of the thermal district. The Waikato River, a
- great cold stream, full of immense trout; Taupo Lake (cold); the coloured
- lakes of Wairakei and Waiotapu (hot); Hamurana Springs (cold), and many
- others, display these remarkable tints, under every sky and in every depth
- of water. Varying reasons are given, but none seem satisfactory. The
- beauty of the colouring is, at all events, certain, and the cause may
- safely be left to geologists.
- </p>
- <p>
- Wairoa Village is now a green, silent waste of young forest and rich
- grass, broken only by the ruins of the old hotel that stood there before
- the eruption, and by a few scattered traces of other human occupation&mdash;a
- fragment of wall, the rusty skeleton of an iron bedstead, lying in a
- gully; the remains of a shattered buggy. In 1886 it occupied the place now
- held by Rotorua, and was visited by numbers of tourists, all anxious to
- see the Terraces, which lay not far away at the other end of the chain of
- lakes now united in one, and called Rotomahana. On the day of the
- eruption, the roof of the hotel was broken in by red-hot falling stones
- and mud, and eleven people were killed. Some, who escaped, ran out and
- took refuge in a native &ldquo;warry&rdquo; or hut, which, strange to say, remained
- uninjured. Over a hundred people in all&mdash;mostly Maories&mdash;were
- killed by the eruption, which destroyed millions of acres of good land,
- swept away several native villages, and utterly altered the face of the
- whole country.
- </p>
- <p>
- Lake Tarawera, which must be crossed to see the site of the lost terraces,
- lies under the shadow of the great volcanic cone of Tarawera, 8,000 feet
- high, from which much of the molten rock and burning ashes came. It is as
- lovely, in its own strange way, as the famous lakes of Italy and
- Switzerland. The water is intensely blue, and the high hills closing it in
- are of a colour unknown to most other scenery in the world&mdash;a strange
- pale barren grey, so nearly white as to be slightly suggestive of snow.
- Like snow, too, is the distribution of this coloured matter; it lies on
- the crests and projections of the hills, and is streaked thinly down the
- sides. It is ash, volcanic ash, cast out by the surrounding craters on
- that fatal night of June, 1886, and lying unchanged on the hills about the
- lake ever since. Tarawera itself towers above the lake, grim and dark and
- ominous; a mountain hot yet tamed by any means, and still hot, though not
- molten, in the interior of the cone.
- </p>
- <p>
- On the shores of the lake, as the launch carries us past, can be seen, at
- one spot, the whitened bones of some of the natives who perished in the
- eruption. The name and titles of one, who was a great chief, are painted
- on a rock that overhangs the shore.
- </p>
- <p>
- Rotomahana, the second lake, is also surrounded by ash-whitened hills. At
- the far end, as our second oil-launch starts to cross, we can see thick
- columns of steam rising against the grey of the cliffs. These are the
- gravestones of the lost Pink Terrace; these tall pillars of cloud alone
- mark the spot where one half of the world&rsquo;s greatest wonder once stood.
- Just where the launch starts, the White Terrace was buried, under a
- hundred feet of earth and mud, deep in the bed of the lake.
- </p>
- <p>
- What were the Terraces like? New Zealand has many oil paintings of them,
- so that a clear idea of their loveliness can be formed even to-day. They
- consisted of two immense terraced slopes, formed by the action of downward
- dropping hot water heavily loaded with silicon. Every terrace was a
- succession of fairy-like baths and basins, filled with bright blue water.
- One was pure ivory-white, the other, tinged with hematite, was bright
- pink., The exquisite natural carvings and flutings of the silicon, the
- beautiful tints of the terraces, the blue sky above and blue lakes below,
- together formed a picture the like of which does not exist on earth
- to-day.
- </p>
- <p>
- Our oil-launch, sailing now over water which is actually boiling, close in
- shore, though the main body of the lake is cold, allows us to land on the
- very spot where the Pink Terrace once stood. It is a dangerous task, even
- with the aid of a guide, to pick one&rsquo;s way about this stretch of ground,
- for it is nothing but a crumbling honey-comb of boiling-water ponds, and
- narrow ridges as brittle as piecrust. Over these latter we take our
- perilous way, planting each footstep slowly and carefully, but never
- standing still, for the ground is so exceedingly hot that the soles of
- one&rsquo;s boots are scorched, if planted long in one place. The earth is
- choked and clouded with steam, the ponds roar and bubble about our feet,
- the blow-holes rumble. The ground is full of raw cracks, old and new, and
- as our small party steps over one of these, on the way back, it is seen to
- be visibly wider than it was on the previous coming! To-morrow the whole
- of this narrow ridge may have crumbled in and disappeared. No one is sorry
- to reach the launch again, and glide away from those threatening shores.
- </p>
- <p>
- A little further on, where we land for the walk up to Waimangu Geyser,
- there is a hot iodine spring, unique among medical waters, and most useful
- in many diseases. Arrangements are now being made to have the water
- collected and sent to Rotorua; up to the present, it has only been used by
- the Maories.
- </p>
- <p>
- All the three-mile walk up to the geyser is crowded with tokens of the
- great eruption. Mud cliffs a hundred feet in height were created by the
- terrible outburst, and for miles about the whole country was covered yards
- deep with the boiling slimy mass. Not only Tarawera, but three other
- craters (all visible in the high distance above the lake) were erupting
- together, for a night and a day. The eruptions took place without the
- least warning of any kind, about ten o&rsquo;clock at night. The chain of lakes
- about Tarawera&rsquo;s foot suddenly exploded like colossal bombs, blowing their
- entire contents, and all the mud from their bottoms, over the whole
- country-side. Tarawera and the neighbouring craters cast out huge jets of
- flame, and scattered burning masses of rock, ashes, and scoriæ, for many
- miles. The noise was terrible, and the sky for twenty miles around was
- dark at noonday. It is supposed that the eruption was caused by the
- falling in of the lake bottom, which allowed the water to drop into the
- underlying fires, and exploded the lakes instantly into steam.
- </p>
- <p>
- Up a great earthquake chasm, among deep volcano craters that were formed
- at the time of the eruption, we climb towards the Great Geyser. These
- craters are for the most part still in a more or less heated state, though
- grass and ferns grow in the interior of nearly all, and no apprehension is
- felt as to future outbursts. One has a hot mudpool at the bottom; a second
- spits steam from many cracks and blow-holes; a third, the largest of all,
- erupted slightly in August 1904, and threw a quantity of hot mud and
- stones out over the top.
- </p>
- <p>
- Waimangu Geyser itself, which is really more a volcano than a geyser, is
- supposed to have been formed at the time of the eruption. It did not,
- however, commence its present activity until 1900, when an enormously high
- &ldquo;shot&rdquo; was seen by one or two explorers camping in the neighbourhood, and
- the source at once investigated. It became apparent that New Zealand, in
- the place of the lost Terraces, had acquired the largest and most
- magnificent geyser in the whole world. The exchange is by no means a bad
- one. Waimangu attracts hundreds of travellers to the pretty little hotel
- planted on a cliff not far from the crater; and those who have been
- fortunate enough to see the geyser play, one and all utterly lose
- themselves in attempting to express the extraordinary majesty, wonder, and
- terror of the sight.
- </p>
- <p>
- The geyser is somewhat irregular in action, but generally plays every day
- or so. The water in the huge basin heaves and lifts; then an enormous
- cloud of steam rushes up, and then a column of black water, charged with
- mud and stones, flings itself upward in repeated leaps or &ldquo;shots&rdquo; through
- the steam, to an almost incredible height&mdash;at times as high as
- fifteen hundred feet. More than a quarter of a mile in sheer height is
- Waimangu&rsquo;s biggest &ldquo;shot.&rdquo; On such occasions, the sky is darkened by the
- tremendous spread of the leaping waters, the earth trembles with the
- concussion, and the watching spectators, perched high above the crater by
- the shelter hut, feel as though the terrors of the Last Day itself were
- falling upon them, unprepared.
- </p>
- <p>
- In the summer of 1903 two girls and a guide were killed during the
- explosion of the geyser. The girls had been repeatedly warned, even
- entreated, not to stand near the crater, as it was momentarily expected to
- &ldquo;play&rdquo;; but they hovered close by the verge, anxious to secure a
- photograph. Without warning, Waimangu suddenly rose and hurled itself
- bodily skyward out of its bed. The enormous backfall of the boiling water
- caught and swept away the luckless three, and they were carried down the
- outflow valley in the flood that succeeds every eruption. When found, the
- bodies were terribly mutilated, and stripped of all clothing. The mother
- of the girls, standing higher up, saw the whole awful disaster, and had to
- be forcibly held back from rushing into the crater, in a wild effort to
- save her children. Since that melancholy day, the geyser basin has been
- railed off, in such a manner that no one can approach near enough to incur
- the slightest danger. Warbrick, the head guide of the district, was
- present, and nearly lost his life in a daring attempt to save the girls
- and the guide, who was his own brother. He rushed into the midst of the
- falling stones and water, to try and drag the luckless victims back, but
- was too late to save them, and narrowly escaped being carried away
- himself.
- </p>
- <p>
- Warbrick is the best-known guide in New Zealand, and a character of
- considerable interest. He is a halfcaste Maori, decidedly more intelligent
- than the average white man, and speaking English perfectly. In company
- with a sailor, he lately made what was probably the most daring boat-trip
- ever attempted on earth&mdash;nothing less than a voyage over Waimangu&rsquo;s
- boiling basin, undertaken with the object of sounding the depths of the
- geyser. The monster often erupts without the least warning, sending the
- whole contents of its huge basin bodily skyward; so that the feat was one
- likely to shake the strongest nerve. Warbrick took a lead line with him,
- and noted the various depths of the crater basin. In the centre, where the
- great throat of the geyser opens up, no bottom could be found. The boat
- came safely to shore, after some minutes spent, in performing one of the
- most perilous feats ever attempted, even by a Maori.
- </p>
- <p>
- Visitors generally stay at the Government accommodation house near the
- geyser for a day or two, on the chance of seeing a good &ldquo;shot,&rdquo; and they
- seldom go away unrewarded. It is well worth while to cut short one&rsquo;s stay
- in some other place by a couple of days, to have a chance of seeing the
- world&rsquo;s greatest thermal wonder in full action, for Waimangu, when
- playing, is the sight of a lifetime. I was not fortunate enough to see the
- geyser in action, as it was undergoing a period of &ldquo;sulks&rdquo; at the time of
- my visit; but if it had been playing as it played some weeks after I left,
- nothing would have tempted me away from its neighbourhood until I had seen
- an eruption.
- </p>
- <p>
- One, of the great charms of the geyser country about Rotorua is its
- absolute unlikeness to anything that can be found on the other side of the
- Line. To the much-travelled wanderer, nearly all famous show-places, after
- a time, display a distressing similarity. The two or three leading types
- of peasant to be found on the Continent of Europe, grow familiar
- by-and-by. Giuseppe of Italy is not very novel to the traveller who still
- remembers Ignacio of Spain; German Wilhelm recalls Dutch Jan; Belgian
- Françoise is sister to French Mathilde. As for the &ldquo;sights&rdquo;&mdash;well,
- one waterfall is very like another, and lakes and ruined castles pall,
- taken in bulk. Even if the traveller wanders further away, he does not
- find much in Egypt, India, or Japan, that has not been greatly spoiled for
- him beforehand, by the countless descriptions he has heard and read ever
- since childhood. It seems almost as though the illimitable flood of
- sight-seers, past and present, rushing through all the famous beauty-spots
- of the old world, had washed away something of their charm&mdash;as if the
- air about such places were drained dry of the ozone of fresh delight which
- every lovely and wonderful spot should give, leaving only an atmosphere of
- feeling that is stale and used-up in the last degree.
- </p>
- <p>
- New Zealand&rsquo;s &ldquo;sights,&rdquo; however, are (to vary the metaphor) new gems in a
- new setting. Not even the most experienced traveller can look on the
- wonders of the thermal region with an eye dulled and indifferent by other
- experiences, since there is hardly anything similar the whole world over.
- And the setting of the gems&mdash;-the strange, unfamiliar country, oddly
- reversed seasons, and wild brown Maori folk, taking the place of European
- peasantry, is perhaps the greatest charm of all.
- </p>
- <p>
- For myself, the carefully revived native dances of the Maories, performed
- for money, in civilised concert halls the &ldquo;haka&rdquo; or war dance, done by
- children on the roads for pennies, and the modern native carvings, done
- with English tools, which are all among the most striking features of
- daily life in Rotorua, were not the real attractions of the place. Those
- lay in the common features of ordinary Maori existence, seen here, there,
- and everywhere, without pose or preparation. When one strolls out along
- the country roads near the town, it is an adventure to meet a party of
- wild-eyed, brown-faced men and women, galloping madly up and down hill on
- their rough &ldquo;brumbies&rdquo; (wild-horses, broken in)&mdash;both sexes alike
- wrapped in heavy blankets, and sitting astride. Wandering about on a
- bicycle, it pleasantly increases the &ldquo;go-abroady&rdquo; feeling that most
- travellers welcome, to coma upon a woman taking a fat fowl out of the
- steam-hole cooker, that Nature has provided just at the door of her
- thatch-roofed, reed-built &ldquo;warry,&rdquo; and to stop and talk for an interesting
- quarter of an hour with a barefooted, half-clad savage, who speaks English
- as good as one&rsquo;s own, reads the daily papers and has his opinions on Mr.
- Seddon&rsquo;s fiscal policy. The Maori guides and hangers on, about the
- best-known sights, are naturally more or less spoiled by the visitors. But
- the real Maori, of whom one gets an occasional sight, even about such a
- civilised town as Rotorua, is attractive enough to make one fully
- understand the strong regard that most New Zealanders have for their
- native friends. Dignity, pride, and the manners of an exiled royalty are
- his natural heritage. His mind is as keen as the white, man&rsquo;s, though
- perhaps somewhat narrower in scope; he has a vivid sense of humour, strong
- feelings about honour and faithfulness, the courage of a bull-dog, and the
- reckless daring of an Irish dragoon. Worth knowing, and well worth liking
- when known, are the brown men and women of North New Zealand.
- </p>
- <p>
- The little village of Ohinemutu, less than a mile from Rotorua, is
- astonishingly Maori still, in spite of the development of the district for
- tourist travel. Go down towards the shores of the lake at the back of the
- big hotel, and you step at once into a native &ldquo;pah,&rdquo; built in the
- haphazard fashion peculiar to Maori settlements. There are no streets, and
- no definite beginnings or endings. The houses face every way, and are of
- many fashions; here a reed-built warry, there a house with a front
- splendidly carved and painted in old native fashion, further on a wooden
- dwelling about as large as a bathing-box, with a full-sized bay-window
- fastened on to it. Most are wooden huts with iron roofs&mdash;a compromise
- between native and European styles.
- </p>
- <p>
- Everywhere one goes, there are steaming pools with newly washed clothes
- drying on the edge, or small brown bodies happily disporting themselves in
- the water. Cooking-boxes are erected over countless steam-holes; and every
- here and there, one meets a tall brown man or woman, looking extremely
- clean and damp, and wrapped in a big coloured blanket and nothing else,
- stalking house-wards from a refreshing bath. Try to take a photograph, and
- if the Maori is accustomed to tourists, he will ask a shilling for the
- labour of posing; but if he has recently come down from the wilds, and is
- still unspoiled, he will reject an offer of coin with quiet dignity. Taken
- as nature made him, the Maori is not greedy of money. It is only a very
- few months since the Maories of the King country (a wild, half-claimed
- district in the &ldquo;back blocks&rdquo;) have allowed gold prospectors to pass
- through their lands. Until recently they admitted tourists and sportsmen
- freely, but refused to allow any one to look for gold, giving as a reason
- their belief, that the finding of gold did no country any good.
- </p>
- <p>
- Whakarewarewa, a couple of miles outside the town of Rotorua, has a very
- interesting model of a typical Maori fortified &ldquo;pah,&rdquo; lately completed by
- the Government. The large space of grass enclosed by the fort is guarded
- by high earth breastworks and a deep ditch. Beyond the ditch is an open
- wooden paling, apparently more for ornament than use, on which are placed
- at intervals carved wooden figures of a threatening and terrifying
- character. All of them are native work, but of modern date.
- </p>
- <p>
- The geysers of Whakarewarewa are many and famous. The most famous of all
- was the great twin geyser Waikite, whose double throat opens at the top of
- a high terraced cone, built up of siliceous sinter, deposited by the
- geyser water during long ages of action. Waikite has ceased to play since
- 1886, when the railway from Auckland to Rotorua was completed. On the day
- when the line was opened for traffic, the geyser ceased playing, and its
- fountains have never ascended since.
- </p>
- <p>
- Wairoa (Maori, &ldquo;Long Water&rdquo;) is now the lion of Whakarewarewa. It plays
- very seldom of its own accord, but on special occasions the local
- authorities permit it to be dosed with soap, which always produces an
- eruption. A geyser constantly physicked in this manner often gives up
- playing altogether in the end; so careful restrictions hedge round the
- operation, in the case of Wairoa. It is first necessary to procure consent
- from the Government Tourist Department in Wellington, and then to arrange
- a day and give notice to the town. The Government authorities in
- Wellington were kind enough to send an order to Rotorua to have Wairoa
- soaped for me during my stay; and I took advantage of the opportunity to
- enjoy the novel sensation of starting the geyser myself.
- </p>
- <p>
- On a Sunday afternoon of December 1904, all Rotorua assembled in a black
- crowd at &ldquo;Whaka&rdquo; to see Wairoa play. Rows of cameras were placed upon the
- hillocks commanding the spot; bets were freely made about the height and
- quality of the coming performance, and every one scuffled politely for a
- front place when the ceremony began. The caretaker of the grounds and the
- head guide solemnly removed the wooden cover (pierced to allow the escape
- of steam) which is padlocked over the geyser&rsquo;s stony lips, and handed me a
- bag containing three bars of soap, cut up into small pieces. I stood on
- the edge of the geyser-mouth, looking down a great black well full of
- steam, and rumbling with deep, groaning murmurs from below, until the
- guide gave the word, and then emptied the bag down Wairoa&rsquo;s throat.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0054" id="linkimage-0054"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0501.jpg" alt="0501 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0501.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Almost immediately, white lather began to form in the depths of the well,
- and rose rapidly to the verge. The guide now ordered me away from the
- geyser; for, although Wairoa generally takes some minutes to play after
- being soaped, one can never be absolutely certain that it will not respond
- with inconvenient swiftness. I went back to a neighbouring hillock from
- which an excellent view could be obtained, and waited with the eager
- crowd. Every now and then a small rush of water lifted over the geyser
- rim, and once or twice the fountain seemed about to start; but it was not
- until seventeen minutes after I had put in the soap that Wairoa choked,
- gurgled, and finally broke into a roar like a ten thousand ton liner
- throwing off steam. In another instant, still roaring, the geyser shot up
- silvery white water, dissolving at the top, full 140 feet above ground,
- into a crest of delicate streamy feathers all sparkling in the sun. The
- display lasted about a couple of minutes, and then sank gradually away;
- but for long afterwards, Wairoa mumbled and grumbled and frothed at the
- mouth, not settling down into quiet for at least an hour.
- </p>
- <p>
- Of Auckland&mdash;&ldquo;last, loneliest, loveliest, exquisite, apart,&rdquo; as
- Kipling has called it&mdash;thus compelling all later travellers to see,
- or at least pretend to see, exquisite loveliness in prosaic Queen Street,
- and go a-hunting for poetic solitudes along the quays&mdash;I have nothing
- to say. Great ports are all alike, the wide world over, and hotel is as
- like unto hotel as pebble unto pebble. And when the story is done, why
- linger?
- </p>
- <p>
- I have set forth to tell something of Britain of the South Seas, and such
- as it is, my say has been said.
- </p>
- <h3>
- THE END
- </h3>
- <div style="height: 6em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-<pre>
-
-
-
-
-
-End of Project Gutenberg's In The Strange South Seas, by Beatrice Grimshaw
-
-*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK IN THE STRANGE SOUTH SEAS ***
-
-***** This file should be named 54499-h.htm or 54499-h.zip *****
-This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
- http://www.gutenberg.org/5/4/4/9/54499/
-
-Produced by David Widger from page images generously
-provided by the Internet Archive
-
-
-Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions will
-be renamed.
-
-Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright
-law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works,
-so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United
-States without permission and without paying copyright
-royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part
-of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
-concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark,
-and may not be used if you charge for the eBooks, unless you receive
-specific permission. If you do not charge anything for copies of this
-eBook, complying with the rules is very easy. You may use this eBook
-for nearly any purpose such as creation of derivative works, reports,
-performances and research. They may be modified and printed and given
-away--you may do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks
-not protected by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the
-trademark license, especially commercial redistribution.
-
-START: FULL LICENSE
-
-THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
-PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
-
-To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
-distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
-(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full
-Project Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at
-www.gutenberg.org/license.
-
-Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-
-1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
-and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
-(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
-the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or
-destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your
-possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a
-Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound
-by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the
-person or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph
-1.E.8.
-
-1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
-used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
-agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
-things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
-paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this
-agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below.
-
-1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the
-Foundation" or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection
-of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual
-works in the collection are in the public domain in the United
-States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the
-United States and you are located in the United States, we do not
-claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing,
-displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as
-all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope
-that you will support the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting
-free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm
-works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the
-Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with the work. You can easily
-comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the
-same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg-tm License when
-you share it without charge with others.
-
-1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
-what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are
-in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States,
-check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this
-agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing,
-distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any
-other Project Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no
-representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any
-country outside the United States.
-
-1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
-
-1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other
-immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear
-prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work
-on which the phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the
-phrase "Project Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed,
-performed, viewed, copied or distributed:
-
- This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
- most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no
- restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it
- under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included with this
- eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the
- United States, you'll have to check the laws of the country where you
- are located before using this ebook.
-
-1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is
-derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not
-contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the
-copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in
-the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are
-redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply
-either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or
-obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
-with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
-must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any
-additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms
-will be linked to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works
-posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the
-beginning of this work.
-
-1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
-work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
-
-1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
-electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
-prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
-active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm License.
-
-1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
-compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including
-any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access
-to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format
-other than "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official
-version posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site
-(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense
-to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means
-of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original "Plain
-Vanilla ASCII" or other form. Any alternate format must include the
-full Project Gutenberg-tm License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
-
-1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
-performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
-unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
-access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-provided that
-
-* You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
- the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
- you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed
- to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he has
- agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid
- within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are
- legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty
- payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in
- Section 4, "Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg
- Literary Archive Foundation."
-
-* You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
- you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
- does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
- License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all
- copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue
- all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg-tm
- works.
-
-* You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of
- any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
- electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of
- receipt of the work.
-
-* You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
- distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work or group of works on different terms than
-are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing
-from both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and The
-Project Gutenberg Trademark LLC, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark. Contact the Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
-
-1.F.
-
-1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
-effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
-works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project
-Gutenberg-tm collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may
-contain "Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate
-or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
-intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or
-other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or
-cannot be read by your equipment.
-
-1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
-of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
-liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
-fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
-LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
-PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
-TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
-LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
-INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGE.
-
-1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
-defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
-receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
-written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
-received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium
-with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you
-with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in
-lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person
-or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second
-opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If
-the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing
-without further opportunities to fix the problem.
-
-1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
-in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO
-OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
-LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
-
-1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
-warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of
-damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement
-violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the
-agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or
-limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or
-unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the
-remaining provisions.
-
-1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
-trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
-providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in
-accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the
-production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses,
-including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of
-the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this
-or any Project Gutenberg-tm work, (b) alteration, modification, or
-additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any
-Defect you cause.
-
-Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
-electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of
-computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It
-exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations
-from people in all walks of life.
-
-Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
-assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
-goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
-remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
-and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future
-generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see
-Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at
-www.gutenberg.org Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
-501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
-state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
-Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
-number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by
-U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
-
-The Foundation's principal office is in Fairbanks, Alaska, with the
-mailing address: PO Box 750175, Fairbanks, AK 99775, but its
-volunteers and employees are scattered throughout numerous
-locations. Its business office is located at 809 North 1500 West, Salt
-Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up to
-date contact information can be found at the Foundation's web site and
-official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact
-
-For additional contact information:
-
- Dr. Gregory B. Newby
- Chief Executive and Director
- gbnewby@pglaf.org
-
-Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
-spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
-increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
-freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
-array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
-($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
-status with the IRS.
-
-The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
-charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
-States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
-considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
-with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
-where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND
-DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular
-state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
-have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
-against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
-approach us with offers to donate.
-
-International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
-any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
-outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
-
-Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
-methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
-ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To
-donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works.
-
-Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm concept of a library of electronic works that could be
-freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and
-distributed Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of
-volunteer support.
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
-editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in
-the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not
-necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper
-edition.
-
-Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search
-facility: www.gutenberg.org
-
-This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
-including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
-subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
-
-
-
-</pre>
-
- </body>
-</html>
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0001.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0001.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 1e0fa12..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0001.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0008.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0008.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index ffe98cd..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0008.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0009.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0009.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 9754918..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0009.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0010.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0010.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 970b1e8..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0010.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0030.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0030.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index d97620b..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0030.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0035.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0035.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index fe49db3..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0035.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0043.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0043.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index ceaa094..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0043.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0055.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0055.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index b352e4a..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0055.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0056.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0056.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 08ade17..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0056.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0062.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0062.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 662d098..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0062.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0070.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0070.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 9c17415..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0070.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0080.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0080.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 3d2c482..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0080.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0091.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0091.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 758b41e..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0091.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0097.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0097.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 0f3a48a..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0097.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0103.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0103.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 322b772..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0103.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0111.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0111.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index f1e974c..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0111.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0117.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0117.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 926778e..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0117.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0125.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0125.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 0759614..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0125.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0139.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0139.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index f9a3442..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0139.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0165.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0165.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index dc3a25f..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0165.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0173.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0173.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 7429323..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0173.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0185.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0185.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index e7edc8a..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0185.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0191.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0191.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index cf2e7b7..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0191.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0209.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0209.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index da2d417..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0209.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0217.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0217.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index a273282..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0217.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0225.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0225.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 76b2038..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0225.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0249.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0249.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 3b12659..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0249.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0259.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0259.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index a10ec93..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0259.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0267.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0267.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 838c101..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0267.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0276.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0276.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index b9694e8..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0276.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0288.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0288.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 693fc76..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0288.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0296.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0296.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index f6e3bf7..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0296.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0303.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0303.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 46e3c9a..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0303.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0312.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0312.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 8eb39b2..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0312.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0315.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0315.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index d177547..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0315.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0317.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0317.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 3587bcf..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0317.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0325.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0325.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 0a3ee7f..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0325.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0339.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0339.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 7472f5d..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0339.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0351.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0351.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 0600279..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0351.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0359.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0359.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index eee4460..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0359.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0360.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0360.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 2a7cbbf..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0360.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0376.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0376.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index fd3bd35..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0376.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0382.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0382.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index b4d6b76..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0382.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0388.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0388.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index ffd0057..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0388.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0392.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0392.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 82ba252..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0392.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0404.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0404.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index f21c5f9..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0404.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0433.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0433.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index d6bf716..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0433.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0438.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0438.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index d7873ce..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0438.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0447.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0447.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 51ea3dd..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0447.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0463.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0463.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 98ba745..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0463.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0470.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0470.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 390b6c6..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0470.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0476.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0476.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 33c87b9..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0476.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0488.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0488.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 71c5a37..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0488.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0492.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0492.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index b237b95..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0492.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/0501.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/0501.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 408b706..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/0501.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/cover.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/cover.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 1e0fa12..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/cover.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54499-h/images/enlarge.jpg b/old/54499-h/images/enlarge.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 5a9bcf3..0000000
--- a/old/54499-h/images/enlarge.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/old/54499-h.htm.2018-08-20 b/old/old/54499-h.htm.2018-08-20
deleted file mode 100644
index dd40fc2..0000000
--- a/old/old/54499-h.htm.2018-08-20
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,12945 +0,0 @@
-<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
-<!DOCTYPE html
- PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN"
- "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd" >
-
-<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" lang="en">
- <head>
- <title>In The Strange South Seas, by Beatrice Grimshaw</title>
- <meta content="pg2html (binary v0.17)" />
- <link rel="coverpage" href="images/cover.jpg" />
- <style type="text/css" xml:space="preserve">
-
- body { margin:5%; background:#faebd0; text-align:justify}
- P { text-indent: 1em; margin-top: .50em; margin-bottom: .50em; }
- H1,H2,H3,H4,H5,H6 { text-align: center; margin-left: 15%; margin-right: 15%; }
- hr { width: 50%; text-align: center;}
- .foot { margin-left: 5%; margin-right: 5%; text-align: justify; font-size: 80%; font-style: italic;}
- blockquote {font-size: 97%; font-style: italic; margin-left: 10%; margin-right: 10%;}
- .mynote {background-color: #DDE; color: #000; padding: .5em; margin-left: 10%; margin-right: 10%; font-family: sans-serif; font-size: 95%;}
- .toc { margin-left: 10%; margin-bottom: .75em;}
- .toc2 { margin-left: 20%;}
- .xx-small {font-size: 60%;}
- .x-small {font-size: 75%;}
- .small {font-size: 85%;}
- .large {font-size: 115%;}
- .x-large {font-size: 130%;}
- .indent5 { margin-left: 5%;}
- .indent10 { margin-left: 10%;}
- .indent15 { margin-left: 15%;}
- .indent20 { margin-left: 20%;}
- .indent30 { margin-left: 30%;}
- .indent40 { margin-left: 40%;}
- div.fig { display:block; margin:0 auto; text-align:center; }
- div.middle { margin-left: 20%; margin-right: 20%; text-align: justify; }
- .figleft {float: left; margin-left: 0%; margin-right: 1%;}
- .figright {float: right; margin-right: 0%; margin-left: 1%;}
- .pagenum {position: absolute; right: 1%; font-size: 0.6em;
- font-variant: normal; font-style: normal;
- text-align: right; background-color: #FFFACD;
- border: 1px solid; padding: 0.3em;text-indent: 0em;}
- .side { float: left; font-size: 75%; width: 15%; padding-left: 0.8em;
- border-left: dashed thin; text-align: left;
- text-indent: 0; font-weight: bold; font-style: italic;
- font-weight: bold; color: black; background: #eeeeee; border: solid 1px;}
- .head { float: left; font-size: 90%; width: 98%; padding-left: 0.8em;
- border-left: dashed thin; text-align: center;
- text-indent: 0; font-weight: bold; font-style: italic;
- font-weight: bold; color: black; background: #eeeeee; border: solid 1px;}
- p.pfirst, p.noindent {text-indent: 0}
- span.dropcap { float: left; margin: 0 0.1em 0 0; line-height: 0.8 }
- pre { font-style: italic; font-size: 90%; margin-left: 10%;}
-
-</style>
- </head>
- <body>
-
-
-<pre>
-
-Project Gutenberg's In The Strange South Seas, by Beatrice Grimshaw
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and most
-other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
-whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms of
-the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online at
-www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the United States, you'll have
-to check the laws of the country where you are located before using this ebook.
-
-
-
-Title: In The Strange South Seas
- With Photographs
-
-Author: Beatrice Grimshaw
-
-Release Date: April 7, 2017 [EBook #54499]
-
-Language: English
-
-Character set encoding: UTF-8
-
-*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK IN THE STRANGE SOUTH SEAS ***
-
-
-
-
-Produced by David Widger from page images generously
-provided by the Internet Archive
-
-
-
-
-
-
-</pre>
-
- <div style="height: 8em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br /><br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h1>
- IN THE STRANGE SOUTH SEAS
- </h1>
- <h2>
- By Beatrice Grimshaw
- </h2>
- <h3>
- Author Of &ldquo;From Fiji To The Cannibal Islands,&rdquo; Etc.
- </h3>
- <h4>
- London: Hutchinson &amp; Co. Paternoster Row
- </h4>
- <h3>
- 1907
- </h3>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0001" id="linkimage-0001"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0001.jpg" alt="0001 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0001.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0002" id="linkimage-0002"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0008.jpg" alt="0008 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0008.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0003" id="linkimage-0003"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0009.jpg" alt="0009 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0009.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0004" id="linkimage-0004"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0010.jpg" alt="0010 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0010.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <h3>
- IN THE STRANGE SOUTH SEAS
- </h3>
- <p class="indent15">
- In desire of many marvels over sea,
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- When the new made tropic city sweats and roars,
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- I have sailed with young Ulysses from the quay,
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- Till the anchor rattled down on stranger shores.
- </p>
- <p class="indent30">
- Kipling.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">M</span>OST men have their
- loves, happy or hopeless, among the countries of the earth. There are
- words in the atlas that ring like trumpet calls to the ear of many a
- stay-at-home in grey northern cities&mdash;names of mountains, rivers,
- islands, that tramp across the map to the sound of swinging music played
- by their own gay syllables, that summon, and lure, and sadden the man who
- listens to their fifing, as the music of marching regiments grips at the
- heart of the girl who loves a soldier.
- </p>
- <p>
- They call, they call, they call&mdash;through the long March mornings,
- when the road that leads to everywhere is growing white and dry&mdash;through
- restless summer nights, when one sits awake at the window to see the stars
- turn grey with the dawn&mdash;in the warm midday, when one hurries across
- the city bridge to a crowded eating-house, and the glittering masts far
- away down the river must never be looked at as one passes. Of a misty
- autumn evening, when steamers creeping up to seaport towns send long cries
- across the water, one here, and another there, will stir uneasily in his
- chair by the fire, and shut his ears against the insistent call.... Why
- should he listen, he who may never answer?
- </p>
- <p>
- <i>(Yokohama, the Golden Gate, Cape Horn, the Rio Grande, Agra, Delhi,
- Benares, Bombay, the Amazon, the Andes, the South Sea Islands, Victoria
- Nyanza, the Pyramids, the Nile, Lhassa, Damascus, Singapore, the tundras,
- the prairies, trade-winds, tropics, and the Line&mdash;can&rsquo;t you hear us
- calling?)</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">L</span>ove is not
- stronger than that call&mdash;let sweetheartless girls left alone, and the
- man of cities who has loved the woman of the wandering foot, give bitter
- witness. Death is not stronger&mdash;those who follow the call must defy
- him over and over again. Pride of country, love of home, delight in
- well-known faces and kindly hearts that understand, the ease of the old
- and well-tried ways, the prick of ordinary ambitions hungering for the
- showy prizes that every one may see&mdash;these are but as dead leaves
- blown before the wind, when the far-off countries cry across the seas. Not
- one in a hundred may answer the call; yet never think, you who suppose
- that love and avarice and the lust of battle sum up all the great passions
- of the world, that scores out of every hundred Englishmen have not heard
- it, all the same. &ldquo;In the heart of every man, a poet has died young&rdquo;; and
- in the heart of almost every Briton, a wanderer once has lived. If this
- were not so, the greatest empire of the world had never been.
- </p>
- <p>
- So, to The Man Who Could Not Go, I address this book&mdash;to the elderly,
- white-waistcoated city magnate, grave autocrat of his clerkly kingdom
- (never lie to me, sir&mdash;what was your favourite reading in the
- sixties, and why were you a very fair pistol shot, right up to the time
- when you were made junior manager?)&mdash;to the serious family solicitor,
- enjoying his father&rsquo;s good old practice and house, and counting among the
- furnishings of the latter, a shelf of Marryats, Mayne Reids, and Michael
- Scotts, wonderfully free of dust&mdash;to the comfortable clergyman,
- immersed in parish cares, who has the oddest fancy at times for standing
- on dock-heads, and sniffing up odours of rope and tar&mdash;to all of you,
- the army of the brave, unwilling, more or less resigned Left Behinds, who
- have forgotten years ago, or who will never, forget while spiring masts
- stand thick against blue skies, and keen salt winds wake madness in the
- brain&mdash;to all I say: Greeting! and may the tale of another&rsquo;s happier
- chance send, from the fluttering pages of a book, a breath of the far-off
- lands and the calling sea.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <p>
- <b>CONTENTS</b>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0001"> CHAPTER I </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0002"> CHAPTER II </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0003"> CHAPTER III </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0004"> CHAPTER IV </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0005"> CHAPTER V </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0006"> CHAPTER VI </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0007"> CHAPTER VII </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0008"> CHAPTER VIII </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0009"> CHAPTER IX </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0010"> CHAPTER X </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0011"> CHAPTER XI </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0012"> CHAPTER XII </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0013"> CHAPTER XIII </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0014"> CHAPTER XIV </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0015"> CHAPTER XV </a>
- </p>
- <p class="toc">
- <a href="#link2HCH0016"> CHAPTER XVI </a>
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0001" id="link2HCH0001"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER I
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>Fate and Her Parcels&mdash;How It All came true&mdash;The First South
- Sea Island&mdash;Coleridge and the Tropics&mdash;The Spell of the Island
- Scents&mdash;What happens to Travellers&mdash;Days in Dreamland&mdash;A
- Torchlight Market&mdash;The Enchanted Fei.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">L</span>IKE an idle
- messenger-boy, Fate takes a long while about her rounds, but she will get
- through with them and deliver all her parcels, if you give her time
- enough.
- </p>
- <p>
- She has so much business that she confuses orders very often, and you are
- never sure of getting what you sent for. Still, you will certainly get
- something, if you wait, and it may even be the thing you demanded.
- </p>
- <p>
- The morning she called at my door, with a very full basket, she had
- already been to my neighbours, and given them, in a big assortment of
- goods&mdash;a failure on the Stock Exchange, a hunting accident, and a
- broken engagement. What they had ordered was a seat in Parliament, and a
- winter at Monte Carlo, with anything good that might come in in the way of
- new-laid motor-cars. But Fate was, as usual, in a hurry, and she never
- changes any goods, once delivered. So they had to take them in.
- </p>
- <p>
- I had given up expecting her when her knock came to my door, because my
- order had been sent in some years ago, and so far had remained
- unacknowledged. But she fairly emptied her basket into my hands, once she
- was admitted.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Goods all right, and none the worse for keeping; couldn&rsquo;t find time to
- see to you before, I&rsquo;ve been so busy attending to an order from Japan for
- a new army and a gross of assorted victories,&rdquo; she panted. &ldquo;Had to serve
- the Czar of Russia with a lot of old defeats I&rsquo;ve had lying by since the
- Crimea, instead of the new empire he sent for; and can&rsquo;t get time to fill
- more than half the German Emperor&rsquo;s order for fireworks. You private
- people are lucky to get anything at all. Count the goods, please&mdash;one
- journey round the world, two-and-a-half years of mixed adventures, a
- hundred South Sea Islands, threescore new friends, first quality, one
- large package luck. That&rsquo;s all, I think&mdash;sign the book, and let me
- go; I&rsquo;ve got seven attacks of appendicitis, a foreclosed mortgage, two
- lawsuits, and a divorce, to deliver in this square before lunch.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- So, like the fairy tales, &ldquo;it all came true,&rdquo; and one bright winter
- afternoon a Cunard liner bore me away from the streets and shops and
- drab-coloured, huddled houses of Liverpool, down the muddy Mersey&mdash;off
- round the world.
- </p>
- <p>
- There were thousands of people on the quay, come to see the famous boat
- away, for it was Saturday afternoon, and the town took holiday. They had a
- few hours of freedom before them&mdash;then, the airless office room, the
- stuffy shop, the ledger and the copying-press, and the clattering
- typewriter, the grim window giving on the dark wet street, for six long
- days again. Next year, and the year after,-just the office, the frowsy
- lodging, the tram car, the pen in the strong young fingers, the desk to
- stoop the broad young shoulders, the life foreseen, eventless, grey for
- ever and for ever. And I was going round the world.
- </p>
- <p>
- It is three weeks later, and the big &ldquo;A and A&rdquo; steamer is ploughing along
- in the midst of a marvellous dazzle of diamond-spangled, pale-blue tropic
- sea and scorching, pale-blue tropic sky. The passengers, in cool white
- suits and dresses, are clustered together on the promenade deck, looking
- eagerly over the port railing, while the captain, telescope in hand,
- points out something lying only a mile away, and says: &ldquo;That&rsquo;s Tiki-Hau,
- so now you&rsquo;ve seen a South Sea Island.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- We are on our way to Tahiti, a twelve-day run from San Francisco, and are
- not stopping anywhere, but as Tiki-Hau is the only glimpse of land we
- shall get until we cast anchor in Papeete, every one wants to look at it.
- Not one of us has ever seen a South Sea Island, and, we are all eager to
- realise this little fragment of our rainbow-coloured childish dreams.
- </p>
- <p>
- Is it as good as we dreamed it? we ask ourselves and each other. The
- verdict, given unanimously, is: &ldquo;Yes&mdash;but not the same.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- Here is no high green palmy peak, overhanging a waveless sea, with
- sparkling waterfalls dashing down from crag to crag, like the coloured
- illustrations in our old school prize books. There are, indeed, just such
- islands in the Pacific, we are told&mdash;many hundreds of them&mdash;but
- there are still more of the kind we are now looking at, which is not half
- so often mentioned. All South Sea Islands are either high or low; the high
- island, with lofty mountains and dark, rich volcanic soil, is the familiar
- island of the picture book, while the low type, composed only of coral, is
- the variety to which Tiki-Hau belongs.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0005" id="linkimage-0005"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0030.jpg" alt="0030 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0030.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- What we can see of the island, however, is enough to set at rest any
- tendency to comparison. None of us want anything better; none of us think
- there can be anything better, among the wonders that the Great South Seas
- yet hold in store.
- </p>
- <p>
- Tiki-Hau is an island of the atoll or ring-shaped type, a splendid circle
- of seventy and eighty-foot palms, enclosing an inner lagoon clear and
- still as glass. Outside the windy palms, a dazzling beach runs down to the
- open sea all round the island&mdash;a beach that is like nothing the
- travellers ever have seen before, for it is made of powdered coral, and is
- as white as salt, as white as starch, as white as the hackneyed
- snow-simile itself can paint it. All the island&mdash;the whole great
- ring, many miles in length&mdash;is coral too, white, branching, flowering
- coral under water, white, broken-coral gravel above, with here and there a
- thin skin of earth collected by a century or two of falling palm-leaves
- and ocean waste. Outside the magic ring the sea-waves tumble, fresh and
- blue, upon-the cloud-white sand; within, the still lagoon glows like a
- basin of molten emerald. Above, the enormous palm-trees swing their
- twenty-foot plumes of gaudy yellow-green to the rush of warm trade-wind,
- high in the burning sky. A glorious picture indeed&mdash;but one before
- which the painter well might tremble.
- </p>
- <p>
- Here, for the first time, we begin to understand why pictures of tropical
- scenes are so few and so unsatisfactory. Paint! what combination of
- coloured grease that ever came out of a box could hope to suggest the pale
- green fire of those palm-tree plumes, the jewel-blaze of the lagoon, the
- sapphire flame of the sea, the aching, blinding whitenesses of spray and
- sand? Who could paint the sun that is literally flashing back from the
- light dresses of the passengers, making of every separate person a
- distinct conflagration, and darting lightning rays out of the officers&rsquo;
- gold shoulder-straps and buttons? Does any dweller in the dim grey North
- really know what light and colour are? did we know, with our tinselled
- April days, and gentle blue-and white August afternoons, that we were so
- proud of once? Well, we know now; and, alas, in the dim, prosaic years
- that are yet to come, we shall remember!
- </p>
- <p>
- The ship steams on, the atoll fades away in the distance, and once more
- comes the changeless level of long blue empty sea. But we have seen a
- coral island, and the picture is ours for ever.
- </p>
- <p>
- Flying-fish, skimming and &ldquo;skittering&rdquo; over the surface of the waves, we
- have all become used to now. The first day we met them was a memorable
- one, all the same&mdash;they were so exactly what one had paid one&rsquo;s money
- to see. Sharks have disappointed us so far; never a sight of the famous
- &ldquo;black triangular fin&rdquo; have we yet enjoyed, and the passengers have an
- idea that something ought to be said to the steamship company about it.
- Nor have the equatorial sunsets quite kept up their stage character. Books
- of travel, and sea literature in general, have led us to expect that the
- sun, in the tropics, should go out at sunset as though Poseidon had hold
- of the switch down below the water line, and turned off the light the
- instant sun and horizon met.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- ... The sun&rsquo;s rim dips, the stars rush out.
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- At one stride comes the dark.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p>
- They don&rsquo;t, Mr. Coleridge, and it doesn&rsquo;t, and you never were there to see
- for yourself, or you would not have talked beautiful nonsense and misled
- countless travellers of all ages who did see, but who have refused to
- look, save through your illustrious spectacles, ever since. Even on the
- equator, the sun gives one time to dress for dinner (if the toilet is not
- a very elaborate one) while it is setting, and after it has set. So dies
- one more illusion. Yet it can easily be spared, in the midst of a thousand
- wild dreams and strange imaginings, realised to the very utmost, as ours
- are to be ere long.
- </p>
- <p>
- Tahiti comes at last. In the pearly light of a sunrise pure as a dawn of
- earliest Eden, we glide into the shadow of a tall, rose-painted peak,
- spiring eight thousand feet up into heaven, and anchor in the midst of a
- glassy mirror of violet sea. Papeëte, the loveliest, sweetest, and
- wickedest town of all the wide South Seas, lies before us&mdash;just a
- sparkle of red roofs looking out from under a coverlet of thick foliage, a
- long brown wharf and a many-coloured crowd. Across the water steals a
- faint strange perfume, unlike anything I have ever smelled before&mdash;heavy,
- sweet, penetrating, suggestive.... It is cocoanut oil scented with the
- white tieré flower, and never, from Tahiti to Samoa, from Raratonga to
- Fiji, Yavau, Manihiki, or Erromanga, will the South Sea traveller lose the
- odour of it again. Cocoanut oil, and the nutty, heavy smell of copra
- (dried cocoanut kernel) are charms that can raise in an instant for any
- old island wanderer, in the farthest corners of the earth, the glowing
- vision of the wonderful South Sea world.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- ... Smells are surer than sounds or sights
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- To make your heartstrings crack,
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- They start those awful voices o&rsquo; nights
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- That whisper: &ldquo;Old man, come back!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p>
- <i>(Old island wanderers in all parts of the world&mdash;settled down to
- desks in the E.C. district&mdash;tramping through the December glare of
- Pitt Street, Sydney, for &ldquo;orders&rdquo;&mdash;occupying a tranquil, well-bred
- billet, and a set of red-tape harness, in the Foreign Office&mdash;do you
- smell the tierê flower, and hear the crooning of the reef, and feel the
- rush of the warm trade wind, and the touch of the sun-baked sand, under
- the utu trees once more?)</i>
- </p>
- <p>
- So I landed in Papeete, and found myself in the South Sea Islands at last.
- </p>
- <p>
- All that afternoon, like &ldquo;Tommy&rdquo; in Barrie&rsquo;s <i>Thrums</i>, I kept saying
- to myself: &ldquo;I&rsquo;m here, I&rsquo;m here!&rdquo;... There was no mistake about Papeëte. It
- was not disappointing or disillusioning, it was only more lifelike than
- life, more fanciful than fancy, infinitely ahead of all past imaginations.
- </p>
- <p>
- There were the waving palms of picture and story, laden with immense
- clusters of nuts; there were the wonderful bananas, with broad green
- leaves ten and twelve feet long, enshrouding bunches of fruit that were
- each a good load for a man; there were the greenhouse flowers of home&mdash;the
- costly rare stephanotis, tuberose, gardenia&mdash;climbing all over the
- verandahs of the houses, and filling half-cultivated front gardens with
- stacks and bouquets of bloom. And the dug-out canoes, made from a single
- hollowed log supported by an outrigger, flitting about the glassy lagoon
- like long-legged waterflies&mdash;and the gorgeous, flamboyant trees,
- ablaze with vermilion flowers, roofing over the grassy roadway in a series
- of gay triumphal arches&mdash;and above all, beyond all, the fiery-gold
- sunlight, spilling cataracts of flame through the thickest leafage,
- turning the flowers to white and red-hot coals, painting the shadows under
- the houses in waves of ink, and bleaching the dust to dazzling snow&mdash;how
- new, how vivid, how tropical it all was!
- </p>
- <p>
- The native population was out in full force to see the steamer come in.
- So, indeed, were the white residents, in their freshest suits and smartest
- muslins, but they met with small attention from the little band of
- newcomers.
- </p>
- <p>
- It was the Tahitians themselves who claimed all our interest&mdash;the
- famous race who had been so well liked by Captain Cook, who had seduced
- the men of the <i>Bounty</i> from allegiance to King George of England, a
- hundred and sixteen years ago, who were known all the world over as the
- most beautiful, the most amiable, and the most hospitable of all the South
- Sea Islanders.
- </p>
- <p>
- Some of the passengers, I fancy, expected to see them coming down to the
- shore clad in necklaces and fringes of leaves, eager to trade with the
- newcomers and exchange large pearls and thick wedges of fine tortoiseshell
- for knives, cloth, and beads.... Most of us were better prepared, however,
- having heard a good deal about Papeëte, the Paris of the South Seas, from
- the people of the steamer, and having realised, on our own account, that a
- great deal of water might run under a bridge in a hundred years, even here
- in the South Pacific.
- </p>
- <p>
- So the smartness of the native crowd surprised only a few, of whom I was
- not one. On the contrary, I was surprised to find that here, in this big
- island group, with its fortnightly steamer, its large &ldquo;white&rdquo; town, and
- its bureaucratic French Government, some kind of a national dress did
- really still exist. The Tahitian men were variously attired, some in full
- suits of white, others in a shirt and a brief cotton kilt. The women,
- however, all wore the same type of dress&mdash;a flowing nightdress of
- cotton or muslin, usually pink, pale green, or yellow, and a neat small
- sailor hat made in the islands, and commonly trimmed with a pretty wreath
- of shells. Most of them wore their hair loose, to show off its length and
- fineness&mdash;Tahitians have by far the most beautiful hair of any island
- race&mdash;and not a few were shoeless, though nearly all had smart
- parasols. The colour of the crowd was extremely various, for Tahiti has
- more half and quarter castes than full-blooded natives&mdash;in Papeete at
- all events. The darkest, however, were not more than tea-coloured, and in
- most instances the features were really good.
- </p>
- <p>
- So much one gathered in the course of landing. Later on, during the few
- days I spent in an hotel waiting for the Cook Island steamer&mdash;for,
- alas! I was not staying in Tahiti&mdash;there was opportunity for
- something further in the way of observation. But&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;
- </p>
- <p>
- But&mdash;&mdash;&mdash; It happens to every one in Tahiti, why should I
- be ashamed of it? There was once a scientific man, who came to write a
- book, and took notes and notes and notes&mdash;for two days and a half.
- Then, he thought he would take a morning&rsquo;s rest, and that is five years
- ago, and he has been resting ever since, and they say in the stores that
- he has not bought so much as a sheet of letter paper, or a penny bottle of
- ink, but that his credit for cigars and ice, and things that go with both
- very well, and for pyjamas to lounge about the back verandah in, and very
- cheap novels, and silk-grass hammocks, is nearly run out in Papeete. There
- was a Government official&mdash;perhaps it was two, or three, or sixty
- Government officials&mdash;who came to Papeete very full of energy and
- ability, and very much determined to work wonders in the sleepy little
- colony.... He, or they, is, or are, never to be seen awake before three in
- the afternoon, and his clerks have to type the signatures to his letters,
- because he will not trouble to write his name; and their people think they
- died years and years ago, because they have never carried out their
- intention of telling some one to find some one else to send a message to
- say they are alive. And there are a dozen or fourteen gentlemen who keep
- stores in Papeete, and if you go in to buy things in the morning or
- afternoon or evening, mayhap you will find the gentleman or his understudy
- asleep behind the counter, but mayhap you will find the door shut, and the
- proprietor away at breakfast, which takes him an hour, or lunch, which
- takes from two hours to three, or dinner, which occupies him from six till
- nine inclusive. After that, he may open again for a little while, or he
- may not.
- </p>
- <p>
- Must I explain now what happened to me in Papeëte, or why I am not in a
- position to add anything to the scientific or ethnological, or geographic
- knowledge of the world, concerning the Society Islands in general?
- </p>
- <p>
- A duty, obvious, immediate, and unperformed, is perhaps the best of all
- spices to a dish of sweet laziness. And there is not on earth&rsquo;s round ball
- such a spot to be lazy in as pleasant Papeëte. One is never fairly awake.
- It is dreamland&mdash;and what a happy dream! The golden light on the
- still lagoon is surely the &ldquo;fight that never was on sea nor land&rdquo;&mdash;before
- we sailed in under the purple peaks of Orohena. The chanting of the coral
- reef far out at sea, unceasing, day and night, is the song the sirens sang
- to strong Ulysses, in the dream dreamed for all ages by the old Greek
- poet, long ago. The languorous voices of the island women, sweet and low
- as the &ldquo;wind of the western sea&rdquo;&mdash;the stillness of the island houses,
- where feet go bare upon the soundless floors, and music waxes and wanes so
- softly now and then in whispering songs or lightly swept piano keys, that
- it only blends with the long mysterious murmur of the wind in the rustling
- palm trees, to lull the senses into perfect rest&mdash;these, too, are of
- the world of dream.
- </p>
- <p>
- Something out of dreamland, also, is the little hotel where most of the
- travellers stay&mdash;a rambling bungalow in a grass enclosure, overrun
- with vivid flowers and splendid leafage. That the proprietress should
- welcome her guests in a long lace and muslin nightgown-dress, her pretty
- brown feet bare, and her flowing wavy hair crowned with a wreath of
- perfumed gardenia and tuberose, seems quite a natural part of the dream;
- that the chamber-maids should be beautiful island girls clad in the same
- garb, and that they should sit in the drawing-room playing the piano and
- singing wild melancholy island songs, like the sighing of the surf on the
- shore, when they ought to be making beds or serving dinners, is also &ldquo;in
- the picture.&rdquo; That the Chinese cook should do elaborate Parisian cookery,
- and that the coffee and the curry and the bread (or at least the
- bread-fruit) should be picked in the garden as required, and that there
- should be no visible means of shutting the door of the bathroom, which is
- very public, until a carpenter is called in, and that L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;,
- the charming proprietress, should explain with a charming smile: &ldquo;Only the
- house been using it all this time,&rdquo; to account completely for the
- deficiency&mdash;all this belongs unmistakably to the irresponsible
- dream-country. And when the warm tropic night drops down, and one goes
- wandering in the moonlight, to see for the first time the palm-tree plumes
- all glassy-silver under the radiant sky, flashing magically as they
- tremble in the faint night wind, it is more than ever the land of dream
- that is thus lit up in the soft clear dusk. So vivid is the moonlight,
- that one can even see the scarlet colour of the flamboyant flowers fallen
- in the dust, and distinguish the deep violet and hyacinthine hues of the
- far-off mountain peaks across the bay.... How, in such a place, can one
- waste the night in sleep?
- </p>
- <p>
- It is certainly not like any sort of waking life one has hitherto known,
- to find that the market of Papeëte&mdash;one of the principal sights of
- the place&mdash;is held on Sunday mornings before sunrise. One might have
- supposed that such a supremely indolent people would scarcely choose the
- most inconvenient hour of all the twenty-four for a general gathering. But
- they do choose it, and the visitor who wants to see the market must choose
- it also.
- </p>
- <p>
- L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash; calls me, herself, at some unearthly hour,
- not much after four, and I get up and dress in the warm darkness. It is
- the hot season at present and the air, night and day, is very like a hot
- bath, and not far behind it in temperature. I have been loafing about the
- town during the previous day in rather thin shoes, and my feet have been
- almost blistered by the heat of the ground striking up through light
- soles, so that I cannot walk very far, and am glad to find the market
- close at hand.
- </p>
- <p>
- L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;, in a fresh muslin nightdress (she has
- something like fifty or sixty of them), acts as guide. She has put a new
- coronet of flowers in her hair, and before we reach the market she
- proceeds to dress me up Tahiti fashion, with, long necklaces of sweet
- white blossoms round my neck, falling all over my dress, and a heavy crown
- of closely woven gardenias on my head, instead of my hat, which she
- removes, and politely carries. She wants to pull my hair down as well, but
- in a temperature of eighty degrees the idea does not sound tempting, so I
- decline to follow Tahitian custom further. Besides, there is really no
- knowing where she would stop!
- </p>
- <p>
- There is not yet a glimmer of daylight when we enter the market-place, and
- flaring lamps and torches cast huge flickering shadows all over the gay
- assembly. Fruit and fish for the most part are the wares&mdash;but such
- fish, and such fruit! Where one would look at home for white and grey
- turbot, pallid plaice, zinc-coloured herrings, here one may see the most
- gorgeous shapes of gold and scarlet and green; of iridescent rose, silver,
- orange; of blue, brilliant as a heap of tumbled sapphire, and pearl as
- bright as the lining of a shell. Tahiti is famous for its beautiful fish,
- and indeed these in the market look almost too poetically lovely to eat.
- </p>
- <p>
- Then the fruit! bananas as big as cucumbers, as small as ladies&rsquo; fingers
- (after which, indeed, this little sugar-sweet, variety is named), dark red
- bananas, flavoured like a peach, large bloomy ones, tasting and looking
- like custard within; smooth yellow ones, like those exported to other
- countries, whither the daintier fruits will not safely go&mdash;pineapple
- in rough-skinned heaps (one learns soon in Tahiti how to eat a pineapple,
- and that is to peel it, cut it into largest possible lumps, eat the latter
- undiminished even if they make you speechless, and never, never, shoe the
- fruit)&mdash;oranges of several different kinds, custard-apples,
- rose-apples, paw-paws, melons, avocado pears, guavas, mangoes, and other
- fruits the name of which I have never heard&mdash;all lying together in
- masses under the lamplight, costing not as many halfpence to buy as at
- home they would cost shillings.
- </p>
- <p>
- The native beauties are here in a merry crowd, intent quite as much upon
- enjoyment as on business. Scarcely one but wears a flower behind her ear&mdash;and
- if you have ever been in the South Seas, you will know what that pretty
- little signal means, but if you have not, why then I shall not tell you&mdash;and
- all are so wreathed, and crowned, and necklaced with woven blossoms, that
- the air is heavy with scent, and the market-place looks as though the
- transformation scene of a pantomine were just about to begin, with a full
- chorus of flower-decked nymphs appearing for the dance.
- </p>
- <p>
- One exceedingly pretty girl, with a perfect cataract of black hair
- overflowing her pale green gown, and a pair of sparkling dark eyes that
- could never be matched outside the magic lines of Cancer and Capricorn, is
- making and frying pancakes with something fruity, nature unknown, inside
- them. She has half a dozen French officers about her, enjoying breakfast
- and flirtation at the same time. Another, who is selling a number of the
- oddest little parcels imaginable, made out of cut-up joints of bamboo,
- carefully sealed, is doing a good trade among the coloured and
- semi-coloured ladies. L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash; says she is selling
- readymade sauces, to be eaten with fish or meat, and adds that she herself
- will show me what Tahitian sauces are like later on, because there is no
- one in the whole group fit to act as scullion to her in that important
- matter&mdash;or words to the same effect.
- </p>
- <p>
- Strange-looking mountain men are here, dressed in shirt and kilt of cotton
- cloth, patterned in flowers and leaves as big as soup-plates. The former
- garment is a concession to Papeete&mdash;outside the town, the &ldquo;pareo&rdquo; or
- kilt alone forms the Tahitian full-dress suit. These men have come in to
- sell the &ldquo;fei,&rdquo; or wild banana, which is only found on the highest and
- most perilous of the mountain precipices. To get it, the Tahitian must
- climb where not even a goat would venture to go, and make his way back,
- having secured the fruit, carrying a bunch that is a heavy load, even on
- level ground. Many are the lives that have been lost gathering the &ldquo;fei,&rdquo;
- but the Tahitian, like all islanders, is something of a fatalist, and the
- death of one fruit gatherer never stops another from going a-hunting in
- the very same place next day.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is something about the same &ldquo;fei&rdquo; that is worth noting. It is one of
- the standing dishes of the islands&mdash;a cooking banana, large, and
- well-flavoured when baked, but not so attractive on the whole as many of
- the other kinds. The Tahitian, however, ascribes to this variety a certain
- magic property, not unlike that of the fabled lotus. If you eat of the
- &ldquo;fei,&rdquo; he says, especially if you eat freely of it, you will fall under
- the spell. For ever, in its working, it binds you to Tahiti. You may go
- away, and without any intention of returning, say goodbye to the islands,
- and place many thousand miles of land and sea between yourself and sweet
- Tahiti, saying to yourself that you and Papeëte have no more to do with
- one another for ever.... Yet by-and-by&mdash;some day, one knows not when;
- it may be soon, or it may be late, but it will surely come&mdash;you will
- return to Tahiti. The spell of the fei will work, and draw you back again.
- </p>
- <p>
- So the natives said, and I thought the fancy a pretty one, and wondered
- whether it had really any connection with the lotus myth, and then forgot
- all about it.
- </p>
- <p>
- That is three years ago, and since those days I have travelled the whole
- world over, leaving Tahiti behind as one leaves a station passed long ago
- on a railway journey, upon a line that one never expects to traverse
- again. As I write, the snows of winter Britain lie thick outside my
- window, and a sea of Arctic coldness breaks in freezing green and grey
- upon a desolate shore. Nothing on earth seems farther away than-the warm
- blue waves, and flowers that never fade, and shining coral sands of
- Tahiti. But... there is a steamer running southward before long, and a
- great sunny city on the other side of the world where the island boats lie
- waiting at the quays. And one of those island boats, in a month or two,
- will carry a passenger back to Tahiti&mdash;a passenger who ate of the fei
- three years ago, and went away for ever, but on whom the spell of the
- magic fruit has worked&mdash;after all.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0002" id="link2HCH0002"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER II
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>The History of Tahiti&mdash;Drink and the Native&mdash;In the Old Wild
- Days&mdash;The Simple and the Civilised Life&mdash;What an Island Town is
- like&mdash;The Lotos Eaters&mdash;Cocoanuts and Courtesy&mdash;A Feast of
- Fat Things&mdash;The Orgy on the Verandah&mdash;Schooners and Pearls&mdash;The
- Land of Tir-n&rsquo;an-Oge.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">A</span>LTHOUGH I
- certainly did not use the few days of my stay in Tahiti to the best
- advantage&mdash;although I saw none of the public buildings of Papeëte,
- never set eyes on any of the officials of the place, and did not collect
- any statistics worth mentioning, I gathered a few crude facts of a useful
- kind, which are herewith offered as a sop to the reader, who must be
- informed and improved, or know the reason why. (If he would only go to
- Tahiti, that dear reader, whom, all travellers know so well and fear so
- much! if he would just spend a week lying on the coral beach, and
- strolling in the moonlight, and listening to native songs, and feeding fat
- on native dainties&mdash;he would never want to be informed of anything
- any more, and as to being improved... O Tahiti, loveliest and least
- conventional of the siren countries of the dear South Seas, can you lay
- your hand on your heart, and honestly declare you are improving?)
- </p>
- <p>
- Tahiti was discovered, not by Captain Cook, as is rather commonly
- supposed, but by Captain Wallis of H.M.S. <i>Dolphin</i>, in 1767. Captain
- Wallis formally took possession of the group in the name of His Majesty
- King George III., and Captain Cook, in the course of his different visits
- to the islands, laid the foundations of all the civilisation they
- afterwards acquired. Nevertheless, the islands are French property to-day.
- There is nothing in the Pacific better worth owning than the Society
- group, more fertile, more beautiful, more healthy, richer in valuable
- tropical products&mdash;and the construction of the Panama Canal, an event
- which has been foreseen for several generations, will obviously add much
- to the importance of the islands. Because of these, and other excellent
- reasons, Great Britain, acting on the principles by which her colonial
- policy is commonly guided, allowed the Society Islands to slip gradually
- into the hands of a power better able than herself to appreciate their
- value, and the group, after thirty-seven years of &ldquo;protection,&rdquo; was
- finally taken possession of by France, in the year 1880. The native Queen,
- Pômare IV. (Pomare being a dynastic name like Cæsar, but, unlike the
- latter, applied to both sexes), was allowed to retain her state and
- possessions under the French protectorate. Her successor, King Pomare V.,
- who succeeded in 1877 and died in 1891, only reigned for three years.
- After the formal annexation he retained his title of king, and much of his
- state, but the power was entirely in French hands. Prince Hinoe, his heir,
- who would in the ordinary course have occupied the throne, lives in a
- handsome European-built house near Papeete, and enjoys a good pension, but
- is otherwise not distinguished in any way from the ordinary Tahitian.
- </p>
- <p>
- Under French rule, the islands have done fairly well. There were at first
- many regrettable disputes and troubles between opposing camps of
- missionaries, but these have long since been made up. Commerce is in
- rather a languishing state. The group exports copra, vanilla, pearl-shell,
- and fruit, but the trade with America was so much on the down-grade during
- the time of my visit, that steamers were leaving the port with empty
- holds. The natives are well treated under the present system; the liquor
- laws, however, are defective, and no Tahitian, apparently, has any
- difficulty in obtaining as much strong spirits as he wants and can pay
- for. The disastrous effects of such carelessness as this need no mention
- to the reader who knows anything of darkskinned races. For the benefit of
- the reader who does not, however, it may be remarked that all colonial
- administrators agree concerning the bad effects of intoxicants on coloured
- races of every kind. It matters not at what end or part of the scale of
- colour the man may be&mdash;whether he is a woolly-haired, baboon-jawed
- nigger from Central Africa, a grave, intelligent, educated Maori of New
- Zealand, or a gentle child-like native of Tahiti, barely café-au-lait as
- to colour&mdash;all the same, and all the time, spirits are sure to
- convert him, temporarily, into a raging beast, and, in the long run, to
- wipe out him and his kind altogether. It is not a question of temperance
- principles or the reverse, but merely a matter of common-sense policy, in
- dealing with races which have shown themselves unable to withstand the
- effects of the liquors that our hardier northern nations can use with
- comparative safety. One may lay it down as a general principle that
- nothing with a coloured skin on it can take, intoxicants in moderation&mdash;it
- is not at all, or all in all, with the &ldquo;native&rdquo; when it comes to strong
- drinks. Scientific folk would probably set down the comparative immunity
- of the white races to the protection that lies behind them in the shape of
- centuries of drinking ancestors. The coffee-coloured islander&rsquo;s
- great-grandparents did not know whisky, just as they never experienced
- measles and other diseases, that do not usually kill the white, but almost
- always put an end to the &ldquo;man and brother.&rdquo; Therefore, the islander&rsquo;s body
- has not, by inheritance, acquired those points of constitution which
- enable the white to resist whisky and measles, and other dangerous things;
- and when they touch him, he goes down at once. A parallel may be found in
- the case of opium, which the white man, broadly speaking, cannot take in
- moderation, although most of the yellow races can. Europeans who once
- acquire a liking for the effects of opium will generally die as miserable
- wrecks, in the course of a very few years. A Chinaman, under similar
- circumstances, may, and often does, live to a good old age, without taking
- any harm at all from his constant doses. His ancestors have been opium
- takers, the Englishman&rsquo;s have not. It is the case of the islander and the
- spirits over again.
- </p>
- <p>
- After which digression, one has some way to come back to the fact that the
- French Government does not prevent the Tahitian from drinking gin nearly
- so effectively as it should, and that, in consequence, the diminution of
- the native population receives a downward push that it does not in the
- least require. In the Fijis, British rule keeps spirits strictly away from
- all the natives, with the exception of the chiefs, and something, at
- least, is thereby done to slacken the decline that afflicts the people of
- almost every island in the Pacific. The Fijian chiefs, as a rule, drink
- heavily, and do not commonly live long, thus providing another argument in
- favour of restriction.
- </p>
- <p>
- The population of Tahiti is indeed much less than it should be. Captain
- Cook&rsquo;s estimates of native populations are now understood to have been
- mistaken in many cases, owing to the fact that he calculated the entire
- numbers from the density of occupation round the shores. As most Pacific
- islands are inhabited about the coasts alone, the interior being often
- unsuitable for cultivation, and too far removed from the fishing-grounds
- to suit an indolent race, it can easily be understood that serious errors
- would arise from such a method of estimate. The diminution, therefore,
- since ancient times, is not quite so alarming as the first writers on the
- Pacific&mdash;and, indeed, many who followed them&mdash;supposed it to be.
- If the sums worked out by the travellers who visited Honolulu in the
- sixties, or Tahiti a little later, had been correct, both of these
- important groups would long since have been empty of all native
- population. But the Hawaiian group has still a very fair number of
- darkskinned people, while Tahiti, including all its islands, had a
- population, according to the census of 1902, of over thirteen thousand,
- one-eighth of whom are said to be French, and a smaller number Chinese and
- other foreigners.
- </p>
- <p>
- Still, it cannot be said that this is a large, or even a fair population
- for a group of islands covering 580 square miles, nor can it be denied
- that the numbers of the Tahitians are steadily on the decrease. The exact
- causes of the decline are disputed, as indeed they are in connection with
- every other coloured race in the Pacific. European diseases of a serious
- kind are extremely common in the group, and consumption also is frequent.
- These are two obvious causes. Less easily reckoned are the unnamed
- tendencies towards extinction that follow the track of the white man
- through the lands of primitive peoples, all over the world. There can be
- no doubt that the old life of the Pacific&mdash;feasting, fighting, making
- love, and making murder: dressing in a bunch of leaves, and living almost
- as completely without thought for the morrow as the twittering parrakeets
- in the mango trees&mdash;suited the constitution of the islander better
- than the life of to-day.
- </p>
- <p>
- It may have been bad for his spiritual development, and it certainly was
- bad for any wandering white men who came, by necessity or choice, to visit
- his far-away fastnesses. But he lived and flourished in those bad days,
- whereas now he quietly and unostentatiously, and quite without any rancour
- or regret, dies.
- </p>
- <p>
- Why? Old island residents will tell you that, even if every disease
- brought by the white man were rooted out to-morrow, the native would still
- diminish in numbers. He has done so in islands where the effects of
- European diseases were comparatively slight. He does so in New Zealand,
- where the Maori (the supposed ancestor of most of the island peoples) is
- petted, cherished, and doctored to an amazing extent by the ruling race,
- and yet persists in dying out, although he is not affected by consumption
- or other evils to any serious extent. There are undoubtedly other causes,
- and perhaps among them not the least is the fact that, for most Pacific
- races, life, with the coming of civilisation, has greatly lost its savour.
- </p>
- <p>
- It used to be amazingly lively in Tahiti, in the wild old days. Then, the
- Tahitian did not know of white men&rsquo;s luxuries&mdash;of tea and sugar and
- tinned stuffs, lamps and kerosene, hideous calico shirts and gaudy ties,
- muslin gowns and frilled petticoats for the women, &ldquo;bits&rdquo; to make
- patchwork quilts with, and beds to put the quilts on, and matchwood
- bungalows to put the beds in, and quart bottles of fiery gin to drink, and
- coloured silk handkerchiefs to put away on a shelf, and creaking shoes to
- lame oneself with on Sundays. Then, he did not let or sell his land to
- some one in order to get cash to buy these desirable things; nor did his
- womankind, for the same reason, adopt, almost as a national profession, a
- mode of life to which the conventionalities forbid me to give a name. Nor
- did the distractions of unlimited church-going turn away his mind from the
- main business of life, which was undoubtedly that of enjoyment. He had no
- money, and no goods, and did not want either. He had no religion (to speak
- of) and desired that still less. All he had to do was to secure a good
- time, and get up a fight now and then when things in general began to turn
- slow.
- </p>
- <p>
- It must be said that the existence of the &ldquo;Areoi,&rdquo; a certain secret
- society of old Tahiti, went far to minimise the risk of dullness. The
- members formed a species of heathen &ldquo;Hell-Fire Club,&rdquo; and they cultivated
- every crime known to civilisation, and a few which civilisation has
- happily forgotten. Murder, theft, human sacrifices, cannibalism, were
- among their usual practices, and the domestic relationships of the Society
- (which was large and influential, and included both sexes) are said to
- have been open to some criticism. They were popular, however, for they
- studied music and the dance as fine arts, and gave free entertainments to
- every one who cared to come. They travelled from village to village,
- island to island, giving &ldquo;shows&rdquo; wherever they went, and winning welcome
- and favour everywhere by the brilliance and originality of their
- improprieties. They were as wicked as they knew how, and as amusing, and
- as devilish, and as dazzling.... How the young Tahitian lad, not yet
- tattooed, and considered of no importance, must have reverenced and envied
- them! how he must have imitated their pranks in the seclusion of the
- cocoanut groves, and hummed over their songs, and longed for the time when
- he himself should be big enough to run away from home, and go off with the
- delightful, demoniacal, fascinating Areois!
- </p>
- <p>
- Then there was always a native king in Tahiti in those days, and a number
- of big native chiefs, each one of whom had his own little court, with all
- the exciting surroundings of a court which are never missing in any part
- of the world, from Saxe-Niemandhausen to Patagonia. And there were tribal
- fights from time to time, when property changed hands, and war-spears were
- reddened, and a man might hunt his enemy in the dusk, stealthy,
- soft-footed, with heart jumping in his breast, along the shadowy borders
- of the lagoon.... Murder and mischief and fighting and greed, pomp of
- savage courts and stir of savage ambitions, and the other world that
- nobody knew or cared about, shut off by a barrier of seas unexplored....
- It was a life in which a man undoubtedly did live, a life that kept him
- quick until he was dead. Does the decline of Pacific races look less
- unaccountable now?
- </p>
- <p>
- In these days, the Tahitian is undoubtedly improved. He never was a very
- &ldquo;bad lot&rdquo; all round, in spite of the Areois; but Civilisation, of course,
- had to take him in hand once it was known he was there, for Civilisation
- will not have loose ends or undusted corners in her house, if she can help
- it. So the people of Tahiti were discovered, and converted, and clothed,
- and taught, and they gave up being Areois, and worshipping heathen gods,
- and going about without shirts and skirts, and they went frequently to
- church, and supported their white pastors generously, and began to trade
- with the Europeans, so that the latter made much money.
- </p>
- <p>
- They are quite happy and uncomplaining, and manage to have a reasonably
- good time in a quiet way, but they <i>will</i> die out, and nobody can
- prevent them. You see, they are rather bored, and when you are bored, the
- answer to the question, &ldquo;Is life worth living?&rdquo; is, at the least,
- debatable&mdash;to a Pacific Islander.
- </p>
- <p>
- I have written of this at some length, because, <i>mutatis mutandis</i>,
- it applies to nearly all the island races.
- </p>
- <p>
- It is not only the Tahitian who looks back with wistful eyes to the faded
- sunset of the bad old times, with all their savage gaudiness of scarlet
- blood and golden licence, and languishes in the chill pale dawn of the
- white man&rsquo;s civilisation. It is the whole Pacific world, more or less. The
- Simple Life in the raw original is not, by many a long league, as simple
- and innocent as it is supposed to be, by those new and noisy apostles of a
- return to Nature, who have never got nearer to the things of the beginning
- than a week-end up the Thames&mdash;but, unsimple and uninnocent as it is,
- it suits the coloured man better than anything else. Would one, therefore,
- wish to put back the clock of time, re-establish heathenism and
- cannibalism over all the Pacific, and see Honolulu, Fiji, Samoa, with
- their towns and Government Houses, and shops and roads and plantations,
- leap back to the condition of the still uncivilised western islands, where
- no man&rsquo;s life is safe, and the law of might is the only law that is known?
- Hardly. There is no answer to the problem, and no moral to be drawn from
- it either. But then, you do not draw morals in the South Seas&mdash;they
- are not plentiful enough.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Society Islands&mdash;which were so named in compliment to the Royal
- Society&mdash;lie between 16° and 18° south latitude, and 148° and 158°
- west longitude. Tahiti itself is much the largest, the driveway round this
- island being about ninety miles long. Huaheine, Raiatea, Murea, Bora-Bora,
- and the small islands Taha&rsquo;a and Maitea, are much less important. The only
- town of the group is Papeëte.
- </p>
- <p>
- So much, for the serious-minded reader, already mentioned, who knows most
- things beforehand, and likes his information cut-and-dried. The commoner
- and more ignorant reader, I will assume, knows no more about Tahiti than I
- did before I went, and therefore will be glad of amplification.
- </p>
- <p>
- Sixteen degrees only from the equator is hot&mdash;very hot at times&mdash;and
- does not allow of a really cool season, though the months between April
- and October are slightly less warm than the others, and at night one may
- sometimes need a blanket. Everything near the equator is a long way from
- England, and everything on the south side of the line is a very long way,
- and anything in the Pacific is so far off that it might almost as well be
- in another star. Tahiti, therefore, is quite, as the Irish say, &ldquo;at the
- back of God-speed.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- Perhaps that is where much of its charm lies. There is a fascination in
- remoteness, hard to define, but not on that account less powerful. &ldquo;So far
- away!&rdquo; is a word-spell that has charmed many a sail across the seas, from
- the days of the seekers after the Golden Fleece till now.
- </p>
- <p>
- Papeëte was the first of the island towns that I saw, and it is so typical
- an example of all, that one description may serve for many.
- </p>
- <p>
- Imagine, then, a long, one-sided street, always known in every group as
- &ldquo;the beach.&rdquo; The reason is apparent&mdash;it really is a beach with houses
- attached, rather than a street with a shore close at hand. The stores&mdash;roomy,
- low, wood-built houses, largely composed of verandah&mdash;are strung
- loosely down the length of the street. Flamboyant trees, as large as
- English beeches, roof in the greater part of the long roadway with a cool
- canopy of green, spangled by bunches of magnificent scarlet flowers.
- Almost every house stands in a tangle of brilliant tropical foliage, and
- the side streets that run off landwards here and there, are more like
- Botanic Gardens with a few ornamental cottages let loose among them, than
- prosaic pieces of a town&mdash;so richly does the flood of riotous
- greenery foam up over low fence tops, and brim into unguarded drains and
- hollows, so gorgeously do the red and white and golden flowers wreathe
- tall verandah posts, and carpet ugly tin roofs with a kindly tapestry of
- leaf, and bloom. Foot to foot and hand to hand with Nature stands man, in
- these islands, let him but relax for a moment, and&mdash;there!&mdash;she
- has him over the line!... Leave Papeëte alone for a couple of years, and
- you would need an axe to find it, when you came back.
- </p>
- <p>
- There are a number of hotels in Papeëte&mdash;mostly of an indifferent
- sort, and none too cheap&mdash;and there are several large cafés and
- restaurants, run on lines entirely Parisian, and a crowd of smaller ones,
- many owned, by Chinese, where the hard-up white may feed at a very small
- cost, pleasantly enough, if he does not ask too many questions about the
- origin and preparation of his food. There are three local newspapers, and
- a military band plays in the afternoons, and there are clubs of all kinds&rsquo;
- and not a little society, which&mdash;being society&mdash;is in its
- essence bound to be uninteresting and flat, even here in the many-coloured
- South Seas. But under all this, the native life flows on in its own way,
- and the Tahitian takes his pleasure after his immemorial fashion, as
- quietly and as lazily as he is allowed. I have spoken hitherto of only one
- side of the main street. The other, which gives directly on the sea,
- belongs to the Tahitian life of Tahiti. Here, a green slope of soft grass
- stretches down to the greener waters of the sparkling lagoon: delicate
- palms lean over the still sea-mirror, like beauties smiling into a glass;
- flamboyant and frangipani trees drop crimson and creamy blooms upon the
- grass; and, among the flowers, facing the sea and the ships and the dreamy
- green lagoon, lie the natives, old and young. They wear the lightest of
- cotton clothing, scarlet and rose and butter-cup yellow, and white scented
- flowers are twisted in their hair. Fruits of many colours, and roots and
- fish, lie beside them. They eat a good part of the day, and their dogs,
- sleeping blissfully in the shade at their feet, wake up and eat with them
- now and then. There is plenty for both&mdash;no one ever goes short of
- food in Tahiti, where the pinch of cold and hunger, and the burden of
- hard, unremitting, unholidayed work are alike unknown. Sometimes the
- natives wander away to the river that flows through the town, and take a
- bath in its cool waters; returning later to lounge, and laze, and suck
- fruit, and dream, on the shores of the lagoon again. The sound of the
- surf, droning all day long on the coral reef that bars the inner lake of
- unruffled green from the outer ocean of windy blue, seems to charm them
- into a soft half-sleep, through which, with open but unseeing eyes, they
- watch the far-off creaming of the breakers in the sun, and the flutter of
- huge velvet butterflies among the flowers, and the brown canoes gliding
- like water-beetles about the tall-masted schooners in the harbour. With
- sunset comes a cooling of the heated air, and glowworm lights begin to
- twinkle through the translucent red walls of the little native houses
- scattered here and there. It will soon be dark now: after dark, there will
- be dancing and singing in the house; later, the sleeping mats will be laid
- out, and with the moon and the stars glimmering in through the walls upon
- their still brown faces, the Tahitians will sleep.... So, in the sunset,
- with
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- Dark faces, pale against the rosy flame,
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- The mild-eyed melancholy lotus-eaters
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p>
- wander home.
- </p>
- <p>
- Only a flash in the long cinematograph of the wonderful track that circles
- the globe, is Tahiti. I cannot tell of Murea, the marvellous island that
- lies opposite Papeete, seven and a half miles away, because, during the
- few days I spent in Tahiti, no boat was going there, and none could be
- induced to go. So I had to look at Murea&rsquo;s splintered towers and spiring
- pinnacles, and wonderful purple goblin palaces, floating high among the
- clouds, from the tantalising distance of Papeëte harbour. Nor could I join
- some steamer friends in driving round the ninety-mile roadway, as we had
- intended&mdash;stopping in native towns, and seeing something of the inner
- life of the island&mdash;because no one in the capital had any teams for
- hire just then, and nobody knew when there would be any. Some of us went
- up the river to see Pierre Loti&rsquo;s bathing pool, and came back rather
- disappointed, and others drove out to the tomb of Pômare V., three miles
- from the town. It was a pile of concrete and stone, modelled after
- European fashions, and not especially interesting.
- </p>
- <p>
- One of the ladies of the party wandered off with me down the beach,
- neither of us being interested in the resting-place of the defunct Pomare&mdash;and
- here we found plenty of food for mind and body both. For was not this a
- pandanus, or screw-pine, which we had read about, overhanging the lagoon,
- with the quaintest mops of palmy foliage, set on long broom-handles of
- boughs, and great fruits like pineapples hanging among the leaves, and
- yellow and scarlet kernels lying thick on the sand below&mdash;the tree
- itself perched up on tall bare wooden stilts formed by the roots, and
- looking more like something from a comic scene in a pantomime, than a real
- live piece of vegetation growing on an actual shore? And were not these
- cocoanuts that lay all about the beach under the leaning palms&mdash;nuts
- such as we had never seen before, big as a horse&rsquo;s head, and smooth green
- as to outside, but nuts all the same?
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0006" id="linkimage-0006"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0055.jpg" alt="0055 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0055.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0007" id="linkimage-0007"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0056.jpg" alt="0056 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0056.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- A native slipped silently from among the thick trees beside us&mdash;a
- bronze-skinned youth of eighteen or nineteen, dressed only in a light
- pareo or kilt of blue and white cotton. He stood with hands lightly
- crossed on his breast, looking at us with the expression of infinite
- kindliness and good-nature that is so characteristic of the Tahitian race.
- We signed to him that we wanted to drink, and he smiled comprehendingly,
- shook his head at the nuts on the ground, and lightly sprang on to the
- bole of the palm beside us, which slanted a little towards the sea. Up the
- trunk of that tree, which inclined so slightly that one would not have
- thought a squirrel could have kept its footing there, walked our native
- friend, holding on with his feet and hands, and going as easily as a
- sailor on a Jacob&rsquo;s ladder. Arrived in the crown some seventy feet above,
- he threw down two or three nuts, and then descended and husked them for
- us.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0008" id="linkimage-0008"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0062.jpg" alt="0062 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0062.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Husking a cocoanut is one of the simplest-looking operations in the world,
- but I have not yet seen the white man who could do it effectively, though
- every native is apparently born with the trick. A stick is sharply pointed
- at both ends, and one end is firmly set in the ground. The nut is now
- taken in the hands, and struck with a hitting and tearing movement
- combined, on the point of the stick, so as to split the thick, intensely
- tough covering of dense coir fibre that protects the nut, and rip the
- latter out. It comes forth white as ivory, about the same shape and size
- as the brown old nuts that come by ship to England, but much younger and
- more brittle, for only the smallest of the old nuts, which are not wanted
- in the islands for copra-making, are generally exported. A large knife is
- used to crack the top of the nut all round, like an egg-shell, and the
- drink is ready, a draught of pure water, slightly sweet and just a little
- aerated, if the nut has been plucked at the right stage. There is no
- pleasanter or more refreshing draught in the world, and it has not the
- least likeness to the &ldquo;milk&rdquo; contained in the cocoanuts of commerce. No
- native would drink old nuts such as the latter, for fear of illness, as
- they are considered both unpleasant and unwholesome. Only half-grown nuts
- are used for drinking, and even these will sometimes hold a couple of
- pints of liquid. The water of the young cocoanut is food and drink in one,
- having much nourishing matter held in solution. On many a long day of hot
- and weary travel, during the years that followed, I had cause to bless the
- refreshing and restoring powers of heaven&rsquo;s best gift to man in the
- tropics, the never-failing cocoanut.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0009" id="linkimage-0009"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0097.jpg" alt="0097 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0097.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- I will not insult the reader by telling him all the uses to which the tree
- and its various products are put, because those are among the things we
- have all learned at our first preparatory school; how the natives in the
- cocoanut countries make hats and mats and houses, and silver fish-servers
- and brocaded dressing-gowns, and glacé kid boots with fourteen buttons (I
- think the list used to run somewhat after that fashion&mdash;it is the
- spirit if not the letter)&mdash;all out of the simple cocoanut tree; a
- piece of knowledge which, somehow or other, used to make us feel vaguely
- virtuous and deserving, as if we had done it all ourselves....
- </p>
- <p>
- But all this time the youth is standing like a smiling bronze statue,
- holding the great ivory cup in his hands, and waiting for us to drink. We
- do so in turn, Ganymede carefully supporting the cup in his upcurved
- hands, and tilting it with a fine regard for our needs, as the water drops
- down in the nut like the tide on a sandy shore when the moon calls back
- the sea.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0010" id="linkimage-0010"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0103.jpg" alt="0103 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0103.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Then we take out purses, and want to pay Ganymede; but he will not be
- paid, until it becomes plain to him that the greatest politeness lies in
- yielding. He takes our franc, and disappears among the trees, to return no
- more. But in a minute, out from the bush comes running the oddest little
- figure, a very old, grey-bearded man, very gaily dressed in a green shirt
- and a lilac pareo, and laden very heavily with ripe pineapples. We guess
- him to be Ganymede&rsquo;s father, and see that our guess was right, when he
- drops the whole heap of fruit upon the ground at our feet, smiling and
- bowing and murmuring incomprehensively over it, and then begins to vanish
- like his son.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Here&mdash;stop!&rdquo; calls my companion. &ldquo;We don&rsquo;t want to take your fruit
- without buying it. Come back, please, come back!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- The little old-gentleman trots back on his thin bare legs, recalled more
- by the tone than the words, which he obviously does not understand, and
- takes a hand of each of us in his own brown fingers. He shakes hands with
- us gently and firmly, shaking his head negatively at the same time, and
- then, like the romantic youths of Early Victorian novels, &ldquo;turns, and is
- immediately lost to view in the surrounding forest,&rdquo; carrying the honours
- of war, indubitably, with himself.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Well, they are real generous!&rdquo; declares my American companion, as we go
- back to the tomb. &ldquo;By the way, Miss G&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;, I guess
- you&rsquo;d better not sit down on that grass to wait for the rest. I wouldn&rsquo;t,
- if I was you.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Why not? it&rsquo;s as dry as dust.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Because the natives say it&rsquo;s somehow or other&mdash;they didn&rsquo;t, explain
- how&mdash;infected with leprosy, and I guess they ought to know; there&rsquo;s
- plenty of it all over the Pacific&mdash;&mdash; I rather thought that
- would hit you where you lived.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- It did. I got up as quickly as a grasshopper in a hurry. Afterwards, on a
- leper island thousands of miles away from Tahiti&mdash;&mdash; But that
- belongs to another place.
- </p>
- <p>
- L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;, the ever-amiable, our half-caste landlady
- at the little bungalow hotel, all overgrown with bougainvillea and
- stephanotis, was grieved because we had seen nothing in the way of
- &ldquo;sights,&rdquo; and declared her intention of giving a native dinner for us.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0011" id="linkimage-0011"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0070.jpg" alt="0070 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0070.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- It was not very native, but it was very amusing. It took place in the
- verandah of the hotel, under a galaxy of Chinese lanterns, with an
- admiring audience of natives crowding the whole roadway outside, and
- climbing up the trees to look at us. This was principally because the word
- had gone forth in Papeëte (which owns the finest gossip-market in the
- South Seas) that the English and American visitors were going to appear in
- native dress, and nobody knew quite how far they meant to go&mdash;there
- being two or three sorts of costume which pass under that classification.
- </p>
- <p>
- The variety which we selected, however, was not very sensational. The
- ladies borrowed from L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&lsquo;s inexhaustible store,
- draped themselves in one or other of her flowing nightdress robes, let
- loose their hair, and crowned themselves with twisted Tahitian corqnets of
- gardenia and tuberose. A scarlet flower behind each ear completed the
- dress, and drew forth delighted squeaks from the handmaidens of the hotel,
- and digs in the ribs from L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;, who was nearly
- out of her mind with excitement and enjoyment. Shoes were retained,
- contrary to L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&lsquo;s entreaties, but corsets she
- would not permit, nor would she allow a hairpin or hair-ribbon among the
- party. The men guests wore white drill suits with a native pareo, scarlet
- or yellow, tied round the waist. It was a gay-looking party, on the whole,
- and the populace of Tahiti seemed to enjoy the sight.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0012" id="linkimage-0012"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0080.jpg" alt="0080 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0080.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- The dinner was served at a table, but most of the dishes were on green
- leaves instead of plates, and L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash; begged us,
- almost with tears in her eyes, to eat the native dainties with our
- fingers, as they tasted better that way. Little gold-fish, baked and
- served with cocoanut sauce, were among the items on the menu: sucking-pig,
- cooked in a hole in the ground, fat little river crayfish, breadfruit
- baked and served hot, with (I regret to say) European butter, native
- puddings made of banana and breadfruit, and the famous raw fish. Some of
- the guests would not touch the latter, but the rest of us thought it no
- worse than raw oysters, and sampled it, with much enjoyment. I give the
- receipt, for the benefit of any one who may care to try it. Take any good
- white fish, cut it up into pieces about two inches long, and place the
- latter, raw, in lime-juice squeezed from fresh limes, or lemon-juice, if
- limes are not to be had. Let the fish steep for half a day, and serve it
- cold, with cocoanut sauce, the receipt for which is as follows:&mdash;Grate
- down the meat of a large cocoanut, and pour a small cup of sea-water over
- it. Leave it for three or four hours, and then strain several times
- through muslin (the fine brown fibre off young cocoanut shoots is a
- correct material, but the reader may not have a cocoanut in his back
- garden). The water should at last come out as thick and opaque as cream.
- </p>
- <p>
- This is the true &ldquo;milk of the cocoanut&rdquo; about which one so often hears. It
- is of immemorial antiquity in the South Seas.
- </p>
- <p>
- Captain Cook mentions it in his <i>Voyages</i>, and describes the cocoanut
- shells full of it, that were given to every man at a feast, in which to
- dip his food. When used as a sauce for meat or fish, one or two fresh red
- peppers from the nearest pepper bush are cut up and put in. Chili pepper,
- judiciously used, is a fair substitute for the latter. The sauce is also
- used for many native puddings and sweet dishes, in which case it is made
- with fresh water and the pepper is left out. As a fish sauce it is
- unsurpassed, and may be recommended to gourmands as a new sensation. It
- should be served in bowls of brown cocoanut shell.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0013" id="linkimage-0013"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0091.jpg" alt="0091 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0091.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Breadfruit some of us tasted for the first time at this dinner. It was
- universally liked, though a few maintained that it resembled potato more
- than bread. I found it very like the latter, with a suggestion of floury
- cracknel biscuit. It is most satisfying and nourishing. One never, in
- island travels, feels the want of fresh bread when breadfruit is
- available. L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash; had cooked it native fashion,
- peeled and baked on hot stones in a pit in the ground. It is a good-sized
- fruit in its natural state, about as large as a medium hothouse melon, and
- bright green in colour. The skin is divided into lizard-like lozenges, and
- the surface is very rough. Whether it is indigenous to the islands or not,
- I cannot say, but it was there when Cook came, and it grows wild very
- freely, providing an immense store of natural food.
- </p>
- <p>
- Taro we also had, baked native style. It is a plant in use over almost all
- the Pacific, very easily cultivated and rapidly producing immense
- bluish-coloured roots, which look like mottled soap when cooked and
- served. It is extremely dense and heavy, but pleasant to most tastes. The
- white taro is a less common kind, somewhat lighter.
- </p>
- <p>
- The mangoes that were served with the meal (among many other fruits) were
- of a variety that is generally supposed to be the finest in the world. No
- mango is so large, so sweet, or so fine in grain, as the mango of Tahiti,
- and none has less of the turpentine flavour that is so much disliked by
- newcomers to tropical countries. It is a commonplace of the islands that a
- mango can only be eaten with comfort in a bath, and many of the guests
- that evening would not have been sorry for a chance to put the precept
- into practice, after struggling with one or two mangoes, which were, of
- course, too solid to be sucked, and much too juicy and sticky not to smear
- the hands and the face of the consumers disastrously.
- </p>
- <p>
- L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash; gave us many French dishes with our native
- dinner, to suit all tastes, and gratify her own love of fine cookery, but
- these would be of little interest to recount. I cannot forget, however,
- how this true artiste of the kitchen described the menu she had planned,
- on the morning of the entertainment. She sat down beside me on a sofa to
- tell the wondrous tale, and, as she recited dish after dish, her voice
- rose higher and higher, and her great black eyes burned, and she seized me
- by the arm and almost hugged me in her excitement. When she came to the
- savouries, tears of genuine emotion rose in her eyes, and at the end of
- the whole long list, her feelings overcame her like a flood, and, gasping
- out&mdash;&ldquo;Beignets d&rsquo;ananas à la Papeete; glaces. Vénus, en Cythère;
- fromage&mdash;&mdash;&rdquo; she cast herself bodily into my arms and sobbed
- with delight. She was fully fifteen stone, and the weather was exceedingly
- warm, but I admired her artistic fervour too much to tell her to sit up,
- and stop crying over my clean muslin (as I should have liked to do),
- because it seemed to me that L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash; was really a
- true artiste in her own way, and almost worthy to rank, in the history of
- the kitchen, with Vatel the immortal, who fell upon his sword and died,
- because the fish was late for the royal dinner.
- </p>
- <p>
- Of the other evening, when half a dozen guests of mixed nationalities
- began, through a temptation of the devil, to talk politics at ten o&rsquo;clock
- on the verandah&mdash;of the fur that, metaphorically speaking, commenced
- to fly when the American cast the Irish question into the fray, and the
- Englishman vilified Erin, and the Irishwoman, following the historical
- precedent, called the Frenchwoman to her aid, and the latter in the
- prettiest manner in the world, got up and closed her two small hands round
- the throat of John Bull, and choked him into silence&mdash;it would not be
- necessary to tell, had not the sequel been disastrous to the fair name of
- our steamship party in Papeete. For a big banana spider, as big in the
- body as half a crown, and nearly as hard, came suddenly out from the
- stephanotis boughs, and, like a famous ancestor, &ldquo;sat down beside&rdquo; a lady
- of the party. This caused the politicians to rush to the aid of the lady,
- who had of course mounted a chair and begun to scream. The spider proved
- extremely difficult to kill, and had to be battered with the legs of
- chairs for some time before he yielded up the ghost&mdash;one guest, who
- found an empty whisky bottle, and flattened the creature out with it,
- carrying off the honours of the fray. After which excitement, we all felt
- ready for bed, and went.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;And in the morning, behold&rdquo; the kindly L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;
- smiling upon her guests, and remarking: &ldquo;Dat was a real big drunk you all
- having on the veràndah, after I gone to bed!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Good heavens, L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;!&rdquo; exclaims Mrs. New England,
- pale with horror, &ldquo;what do you mean?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Surely, Mrs. L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;, you do not suppose for an
- instant any of our party were&mdash;I can hardly say it!&rdquo; expostulates a
- delicate-looking minister from the Southern States, here for his lungs,
- who was very prominent last night in arguing Ireland&rsquo;s right to &ldquo;secede&rdquo;
- if she liked.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;That&rsquo;s a good one, I must say,&rdquo; remarks John Bull, rather indignantly.
- </p>
- <p>
- But L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash; only smiles on. She is always smiling.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Dat don&rsquo;t go, Mr. &mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&rdquo; she says
- pleasantly. &ldquo;I couldn&rsquo;t sleep last night, for the way you all kicking up,
- and the girl, she say you fighting. Madame &mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;
- she trying to kill Mr. Bull, all the gentlemen smashing the leg of the
- chairs, the lady scream&mdash;and dis mornin&rsquo;, I findin&rsquo; a large whisky
- bottle, all drunk up.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- I am privately choking with laughter in a corner, but I cannot help
- feeling sorry for Mrs. New England, who really looks as if about to faint.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;<i>I</i> don&rsquo; mind!&rdquo; declares L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash; delightedly.
- &ldquo;Why, I been thinking all dis time you haven&rsquo;t been enjoyin&rsquo; yourself at
- all. I like every one here they having a real good time. Every one,&rdquo; she
- smiles&mdash;and melts away into the soft gloom of the drawing-room, where
- she sits down, and begins to play softly thrumming, strangely intoxicating
- Tahitian dance music on the piano.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;<i>Elle est impayable!</i>&rdquo; says the Frenchwoman, shrugging her
- shoulders. &ldquo;From all I hear of Tahiti, my dear friends, I think you shall
- find yourselves without a chiffon of character to-morrow.... But courage!
- it is a thing here the most superfluous.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- Madame was a true prophet, I have reason to know; for many months after,
- the story of the orgy, held on L&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&lsquo;s verandah by
- the English and French and American ladies and gentlemen, reached me in a
- remote corner of the Pacific, as &ldquo;the latest from Papeete.&rdquo; What I wanted
- to know, and what I never shall know, for my boat came in next day, and
- took me away to Raratonga&mdash;was whether the minister from the South
- eventually died of the shock or not. I do not want to know about the lady
- from New England, because I am quite certain she did&mdash;as certain as I
- am that I should have, myself, and did not.
- </p>
- <p>
- Of the prospects in Tahiti for settlers I cannot say much. It was said,
- while I was in Papeete, that there was practically no money in the place,
- and the traders, like the Scilly Island washerfolk of well-known fame,
- merely existed by trading with each other. This may have been an
- exaggeration, or a temporary state of depression. The vanilla trade, owing
- to a newly invented chemical substitute, was not doing well, but judging
- by what I saw next year in Fiji, the market must have recovered. The
- climate of Tahiti is matchless for vanilla growing, and land is not very
- difficult to get.
- </p>
- <p>
- Quite a number of small schooners seemed to be engaged in the pearling
- trade with the Paumotus&mdash;a group of islands covering over a thousand
- miles of sea, and including some of the richest pearl beds in the world&mdash;(French
- property). I never coveted anything more than I coveted those dainty
- little vessels. Built in San Francisco, where people know how to build
- schooners, they were finished like yachts, and their snowy spread of
- cotton-cloth canvas, when they put out to sea, and their graceful
- bird-like lines, would have delighted the soul of Clarke Russell. One, a
- thirty-ton vessel, with the neatest little saloon in the world, fitted
- with shelves for trading; and a captain&rsquo;s cabin like a miniature finer
- stateroom, and a toy-like galley forward, with a battery of shining
- saucepans, and a spotless stove&mdash;snowy paint on hull and deckhouses,
- lightened with fines of turquoise blue&mdash;splendid spiring masts,
- varnished till they shone&mdash;cool white awning over the poop, and
- sparkling brasses about the compass and the wheel, was so completely a
- craft after my own heart that I longed to run away with her, or take her
- off in my trunk to play with&mdash;she seemed quite small enough, though
- her &ldquo;beat&rdquo; covered many thousand miles of sea. Poor little <i>Maid of the
- Islands!</i> Her bones are bleaching on a coral reef among the perilous
- pearl atolls, this two years past, and her captain&mdash;the cheerful,
- trim, goodnatured X&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;, who could squeeze more
- knots an hour out of his little craft than any other master in the port
- save one, and could tell more lies about the Pacific in half an hour, than
- any one from Chili to New Guinea&mdash;of his bones are coral made, down
- where the giant clam swings his cruel valves together on wandering fish or
- streaming weed, or limb of luckless diver, and where the dark tentacles of
- the great Polynesian devil-fish
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- Winnow with giant arms the slumbering green.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p>
- The pitcher that goes to the well, and the schooner that goes to the pearl
- islands, are apt to meet with the same fate, in time. Nevertheless, tales
- about the Paumotus are many, and interesting enough to attract adventurers
- from far, if they were known. How the rumour of a big pearl gets out; how
- a schooner sets forth to run down the game, pursues it through shifting
- report after report, from native exaggeration to native denial, perhaps
- for months; how it is found at last, and triumphantly secured for a price
- not a tenth its worth; how one shipload of shell, bought on speculation,
- will have a fortune in the first handful, and the next will yield no more
- than the value of the shell itself&mdash;this, and much else, make good
- hearing.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Look at that pearl,&rdquo; said a schooner captain to me one day, showing me a
- little globe of light the size of a pea, and as round as a marble. &ldquo;I
- hunted that for a year, off and on. The native that had it lived way off
- from anywhere, but he knew a thing or two, and he wouldn&rsquo;t part. I offered
- him goods, I offered him gin, I offered him twenty pounds cash, but it was
- all no go. How d&rsquo;you think I got it at last? Well, I&rsquo;ll tell you. I went
- up to his island with the twenty pounds in a sack, all in small silver,
- and when I came into his house, I poured it all out in a heap on the mats.
- &lsquo;Ai, ai, ai!&rsquo; he says, and drops down on his knees in front of it&mdash;it
- looked like a fortune to him. &lsquo;Will you sell now?&rsquo; says I, and by Jove, he
- did, and I carried it off with me. Worth? Can&rsquo;t say yet, but it&rsquo;ll run
- well into three figures.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- The pearling in the French islands is strictly preserved, and the terms on
- which it is obtainable are not known to me. Poaching is a crime not by any
- means unheard of.
- </p>
- <p>
- A glance at the map, and the extent of the Paumotu group, will explain
- better than words why the policing of the pearl bed must necessarily be
- incomplete.
- </p>
- <p>
- The steamer came in in due course, and carried me away to the Cook
- Islands. Huaheine and Raiatea, in the Society group, were called at on the
- way, but Bora-Bora was left out, as it is not a regular port of call. I am
- glad I did not land on Bora-Bora, and I never shall, if I can help it. No
- place in the world could be so like a fairy dream as Bora-Bora looked in
- the distance. It was literally a castle in the air; battlements and
- turrets, built of vaporous blue clouds, springing steep and impregnable
- from the diamond-dusted sea to the violet vault of heaven. Fairy
- princesses lived there, one could not but know; dragons lurked in the dark
- caves low down on the shore, and &ldquo;magic casements, opening on the foam of
- perilous seas,&rdquo; looked down from those far blue pinnacles.
- </p>
- <p>
- Perhaps there is a village on Bora-Bora, with a dozen traders, and an ugly
- concrete house or two, tin-roofed, defacing the beauty of the palm-woven
- native homes, and a whitewashed church with European windows, and a school
- where the pretty native girls are taught to plait back their flowing hair,
- and lay aside their scented wreaths of jessamine and orange-blossom.
- </p>
- <p>
- But if all these things are there, at least I do not know it, and
- Bora-Bora can still remain to me my island of Tir-na&rsquo;n-Oge&mdash;the
- fabled country which the mariners of ancient Ireland sought through long
- ages of wandering, and only saw upon the far horizon, never, through all
- the years, setting foot upon the strand that they knew to be the fairest
- in the world. If they had ever indeed landed there.... But it is best for
- all of us to see our Tir-na&rsquo;n-Oge only in the far away.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p class="indent20">
- Le seul rêve, intéresse.
- </p>
- <p class="indent20">
- Vivre sans rêve, qu&rsquo;est-ce?
- </p>
- <p class="indent20">
- Moi, j&rsquo;aime la Princesse
- </p>
- <p class="indent30">
- Lointaine.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /> <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0003" id="link2HCH0003"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER III
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>Is It the Loveliest?&mdash;How they deal with the Beachcomber&mdash;&mdash;Cockroaches
- and Local Colour&mdash;The Robinson Crusoe-Steamer&mdash;Emigrating to the
- South Seas&mdash;The Lands of Plenty&mdash;How to get an Island.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">E</span>VERY ONE has seen
- Raratonga, though few travellers have looked on it with their own mortal
- eyes.
- </p>
- <p>
- Close your eyelids, and picture to yourself a South Sea Island, of the
- kind that you used to imagine on holiday afternoons long ago, when you
- wandered off down to the shore alone, to sit in a cave and look seaward,
- and fancy yourself Crusoe or Selkirk, and think the &ldquo;long, long thoughts&rdquo;
- of youth. Dagger-shaped peaks, of splendid purple and gorgeous green, set
- in a sky of flaming sapphire&mdash;sheer grey precipices, veiled with
- dropping wreaths of flowery vine and creeper&mdash;gossamer shreds of
- cloud, garlanding untrodden heights, high above an ocean of stainless blue&mdash;shadowy
- gorges, sweeping shoreward from the unseen heart of the hills&mdash;white
- foam breaking upon white sand on the beach, and sparkling sails afloat in
- the bay&mdash;is not this the picture that wanders ever among the gleams
- and glooms that dart across the schoolboy&rsquo;s brain?
- </p>
- <p>
- It is not very like the average South Sea Island on the whole&mdash;but it
- is a faithful portrait of Raratonga, the jewel of the Southern Seas.
- </p>
- <p>
- Nothing is more hotly disputed than the claims of the many beautiful
- islands among the numberless groups of the Pacific to the crown of
- supremest loveliness. Tahiti is awarded the apple of Paris by many,
- Honolulu by a few, Samoa by all who have been there and nowhere else. The
- few who have seen the quaint loveliness of Manahiki, or Humphrey Island,
- uphold its claims among the highest, and for myself, I have never been
- quite certain whether the low atoll islands are not more lovely than all
- else, because of their matchless colouring. But, if one pins one&rsquo;s faith
- to the high islands, the accepted type of Pacific loveliness, there is
- nothing more beautiful between &rsquo;Frisco and Sydney, Yokohama and
- Cape Horn, than Raratonga, chief island of the Cook archipelago.
- </p>
- <p>
- These islands lie some sixteen hundred miles north-east of New Zealand,
- and about six hundred miles to the westward of Tahiti. They are eight in
- number, seven inhabited, and one uninhabited, and cover about a hundred
- and sixty miles of sea. The largest, Atiu, is about thirty miles round,
- Raratonga, which is the principal island, containing the seat of
- government and the only &ldquo;white&rdquo; town, is twenty miles in circumference.
- </p>
- <p>
- The whole group, as well as a number of outlying islands as much as six
- and seven hundred miles away, is under the guardianship of the Resident
- Commissioner appointed by New Zealand, to which colony the islands were
- annexed in 1900. The government, as administered by Colonel Gudgeon, a
- soldier who won much distinction in the days of the New Zealand Maori
- wars, is all that could be desired. The beachcomber element, which is so
- unpleasantly in evidence in other groups, has been sternly discouraged in
- the Cook Islands, the Commissioner having the right to deport any one
- whose presence seems undesirable to the cause of the general good. It is a
- right not infrequently used. During my stay in the island, two doubtful
- characters, recently come, were suspected of having committed a robbery
- that took place in the town. There was practically no one else on the
- island who could have done the deed, or would&mdash;but direct evidence
- connecting the strangers with the crime, was not to be had. Under these
- circumstances, the Commissioner simply deported the men by the next
- steamer, giving no reason beyond the fact that they were without means of
- support. There were no more thefts. The colonel might, in the same manner,
- have ordered myself away by the next steamer, and compelled it to carry me
- to New Zealand, if he had had reason to suppose that I was likely to
- disturb the peace of the island in any way, or incite it to violence or
- crime. The doctor&mdash;also a Government official&mdash;was empowered to
- regulate the amount of liquor consumed by any resident, if it appeared to
- exceed the permitted amount&mdash;two bottles of spirits a week. Under
- these circumstances, one would expect Raratonga to be a little Arcadia of
- innocence and virtue. If it was not quite that, it was, and is, a credit
- to British Colonial rule, in all things essential.
- </p>
- <p>
- Before the annexation, the government was chiefly in the hands of the
- Protestant missionaries, who, with the best intentions in the world,
- carried things decidedly too far in the way of grandmotherly laws. Even
- white men were forbidden to be out of doors after eight o&rsquo;clock in the
- evening, on pain of a heavy fine, and the offences for which the natives
- were fined would be incredible, were they not recorded in the Governmental
- reports of New Zealand.
- </p>
- <p>
- In Raratonga of the older days (not yet ten years past) a native who
- walked at dusk along the road with his sweetheart, his arm round her waist
- after the manner of sweethearts all the world over, was obliged to carry a
- burning torch in his hand, and was fined if he let it go out. If he was
- found weeping over the grave of a woman to whom he was not related (surely
- the strangest crime in the world) he was again brought up and fined. These
- are only samples of the vagaries of irresponsible missionary rule, but
- they go far to prove that spiritual and temporal legislation are better
- kept apart.
- </p>
- <p>
- A Government accommodation house had been planned, but not built, when I
- visited Raratonga, so I arranged, on landing, to take an unused house by
- the week, and &ldquo;do for&rdquo; myself, as there seemed no other way of living.
- Scarcely had I taken possession of my quarters, however, when the
- residents came down to call, and invite me to stay in their house. I did
- not know any of them, and they did not know me, but that did not matter&mdash;we
- were not in chilly England, where a whole country-side must discuss your
- personal history, family connections, probable income, and religious
- views, for a good six months, before deciding whether you are likely to be
- an acquisition or not, and calling accordingly. I began to understand,
- now, the meaning of the term &ldquo;colonial hospitality,&rdquo; which had formerly
- fallen on uncomprehending ears. And when I was settled down that evening
- in the most delightful of bungalow houses, with a charming host and
- hostess, and a pretty daughter, all doing their best to make me feel at
- home, I realised that I was about to see something of the true island life
- at last.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0014" id="linkimage-0014"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0035.jpg" alt="0035 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0035.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- It began rather sooner than I could have wished. When my new friends had
- gone to bed, and left me sitting up alone in the hall to write letters for
- the morning&rsquo;s mail, the local colour commenced to lay itself on somewhat
- more rapidly and thickly than I desired. I am not particularly nervous
- about insects, but it is trying, when one is quite new to the tropics, to
- see a horde of cockroaches as large as mice, with fearsome waving horns,
- suddenly appear from nowhere, and proceed to overrun the walls and floor,
- with a hideous ticking noise. And when one has steeled oneself to endure
- this horrid spectacle, it is still more trying to be shocked by the silent
- irruption of dozens of brown hairy hunting-spiders, each big enough to
- straddle over a saucer, which dart about the walls on their eight agile
- legs, and slay and eat the beetles, crunching audibly in the silence of
- the night.... Truly, it was like a waking nightmare.
- </p>
- <p>
- Those cockroaches! What I suffered from them, during the year or two of
- island travel that followed! How they spoiled my tea, and ate my dresses
- (or parts of them), and flew into my hair of moonlight nights, and climbed
- into my berth on shipboard! It was on a liner that shall be nameless, very
- early in the course of my wanderings, that I first discovered the tendency
- of the cockroach to share the voyager&rsquo;s couch unasked, and never again did
- I know unvexed and trustful sleep aboard a tropic ship. It was a moonlight
- night, and I was lying looking peacefully at the brilliantly silvered
- circle of my port, when suddenly a horrid head, with waving feelers,
- lifted itself over the edge of my berth and stared me coldly in the face.
- I hit out, like the virtuous hero in a novel, and struck it straight
- between the eyes, and it dropped to the floor with a dull sickening thud,
- and lay there very still. I thought gloatingly of how the blood would
- trickle out under my door in the morning in a slow hideous stream, and how
- the stewardess, bringing my early tea, would start and stop, and say in an
- awestruck tone that one that night had met his doom&mdash;and so thinking,
- I fell asleep.
- </p>
- <p>
- I woke, with one cockroach in my hair, chewing a plait, and another
- nibbling my heel. I got up and looked round. It was then that I wished I
- had never come away from home, and that, since I had come, my sex forbade
- me to go and berth in the hold. I was convinced that, if I could have done
- so, I should have had a quiet night, because the hold is the part of a
- ship where the cockroaches come from, and they had all <i>come</i>&mdash;they
- were on the floor of my cabin, and sitting about the quilt.
- </p>
- <p>
- The hideous battle raged all night, and in the morning I asked one of the
- mates for an axe, to help me through the coming renewal of hostilities. He
- recommended boracic acid instead, and I may record, for the benefit of
- other travellers, that I really found it of some use.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0015" id="linkimage-0015"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0043.jpg" alt="0043 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0043.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- To find out, as far as possible, what were the prospects for settlers in
- some of the principal Pacific groups, was the main object of my journey to
- the Islands. It had always seemed to me that the practical side of Pacific
- life received singularly little attention, in most books of travel. One
- could never find out how a living was to be made in the island world, what
- the cost of housekeeping might be, what sort of society might be expected,
- whether the climates were healthy, and so forth&mdash;matters prosaic
- enough, but often of more interest to readers than the scenic descriptions
- and historical essays that run naturally from the pen of any South Sea
- traveller.
- </p>
- <p>
- Certainly, the romantic and picturesque side of the islands is so obvious
- that it takes some determination, and a good deal of actual hard work, to
- obtain any other impressions whatever. But white human beings, even in the
- islands, cannot live on romance alone, and many people, in Britain and
- elsewhere, are always anxious to know how the delightful dream of living
- in the South Seas may be realised. Practical details about island life,
- therefore, will take up the most of the present chapter, and readers who
- prefer the lighter and more romantic vein, must turn the pages a little
- further on. .
- </p>
- <p>
- The number of those who wish to settle in the Pacific is by no means
- small.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Pacific Ocean has always had a special interest for the English, from
- the days of Drake s daring circumnavigation, through the times of Captain
- Cook and the somewhat misunderstood Bligh, of the <i>Bounty</i>, down to
- the dawn of the twentieth century. The very name of the South Seas reeks
- of adventure and romance. Every boy at school has dreams of coral islands
- and rakish schooners, sharks, and pearls; most men retain a shamefaced
- fancy for stories of peril and adventure in that magical South Sea world,
- of whose charm and beauty every one has heard, although very few are
- fortunate enough to see it with their own bodily eyes. For the Pacific
- Islands are, both in point of time and distance, about the remotest spots
- on the surface of the globe, and they are also among the most costly for
- the ordinary traveller to reach. Thus, for the most part, the South Seas
- dream, which so many hot-blooded young Saxons cherish, remains a dream
- only. The youth who has a fancy for Canadian farming life, or for
- stock-raising in Australasia, may gratify his desire with the full
- approval of parents and guardians in private life, and of Empire-builders
- in high places. But the British possessions in the South Seas&mdash;and
- what extensive possession they are let Colonial maps prove&mdash;may cry
- out for settlers from the rainy season to the dry, and round again to the
- rainy season once more, without attracting a single colonist of the right
- kind.
- </p>
- <p>
- What is the reason of this? Where is the broken link? The British Pacific
- Islands need settlers; young Britons at home are only too ready to
- adventure themselves. Why do they not? There are several reasons. The
- first, perhaps, is that neither party can hear the other. In England few
- possess any information about the South Sea Islands. In the Pacific the
- white residents (almost all New Zealand traders and Government officials)
- are possessed with an idea that only wastrels of the worst kind drift out
- from England to the South Seas, and that nothing better is to be looked
- for. The result is that at the present date young Englishmen by the
- hundred are losing their small capital as &ldquo;pupils&rdquo; on Canadian farms, or
- are starving on the roads in South Africa, while all the time the South
- Sea Islands hold out hands of peace and plenty, begging humbly for a
- respectable white population. The brown races are dying out with fearful
- rapidity; at their best they never touched the limitless capacities of the
- golden Pacific soil. Its richness has always seemed to the original
- inhabitants an excellent reason for abstaining from cultivation. When the
- earth produced of itself everything that was necessary for comfort, why
- trouble to work it? Now, however, when so many groups of fertile islands
- have fallen into the hands of more progressive nations, things are
- changed. The white man can live happily and healthily in the Pacific; he
- can obtain a good return for a small capital at the best, and at the worst
- cannot possibly suffer from either cold or hunger, since neither exists in
- the South Seas. He can lease or buy land from the natives at slight cost,
- work it with small labour, and sell the product to a sure market. Honesty,
- sobriety, and industry repay their possessor as almost nowhere else in the
- world. Yet, with all this, the white settler in the Pacific Islands is
- generally of a more or less undesirable kind.
- </p>
- <p>
- The &ldquo;beachcomber&rdquo; white, without friends, means, or character; the
- &ldquo;remittance man,&rdquo; paid to keep as far away from home as possible; the
- travelling ne&rsquo;er-do-well, with a taste for novelties in dissipation, and a
- fancy for being outside the limit of Press and post&mdash;all these are
- familiar figures in the Pacific. Kipling&rsquo;s Lost Legion musters there by
- the score; the living ghosts of men whose memorial tablets are blinking
- white on the walls of English country churches, walk by daylight along the
- coral beaches. Only the steady man, the young energetic man with a future
- and without a past, the man who can get on without a three-weekly spree of
- the most torrid kind, commonly keeps away. And these are just the men that
- the &ldquo;Islands&rdquo; want. Local trading interest, religious and otherwise, often
- does its best to keep them from coming, through a natural, if scarcely
- praiseworthy, desire to retain personal hold of everything worth holding.
- The Governmental party of every group desires the respectable settler with
- a little capital, and expresses its desire, as a rule, in gentle wails
- delivered through Governmental reports&mdash;a method about as effective
- as putting one&rsquo;s head into a cupboard to hail a &rsquo;bus in the street.
- The Press does not recognise the existence of any habitable land in the
- Pacific, outside Honolulu and Samoa. So the dead lock continues.
- </p>
- <p>
- I can see the Left Behind in the office raise his head at this, and look
- through the muddy panes of the counting-house window, or across the piles
- of summer goods on the shop counters, out beyond the clanging street, and
- right through the whole round world to the far-away Pacific lands. He
- wants to get away so very badly, that poor Left Behind, and he does not
- quite see his way to do it, because every one discourages him if he hints
- at the subject, and he does not know how one could make a living, out in
- those fairy lands that he wishes so much to see. Well, I am on his side in
- this matter. If it is a crime to long for a glimpse of the wonderful
- island world, to ache for a life spent under the free winds of heaven, and
- a chance of the danger, adventure, and excitement, which are as strong
- wine to the heart of almost every young Englishman&mdash;then it is a
- crime shared by the best that the nation has ever known, and one which has
- done more to build up the empire than all the parochial virtues ever owned
- by a million Young Men&rsquo;s Improvement Societies put together.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Islands are not the place for the ne&rsquo;er-do-well, and I would also warn
- the exasperating young man, who never did a square day&rsquo;s work in his life,
- never got into trouble with his employers or his superiors, but always
- found himself misunderstood, unappreciated, and incomprehensibly &ldquo;sacked,&rdquo;
- with an excellent character, at the first hint of slacking business&mdash;that
- the islands will not suit him either. If he comes out, he will not starve
- or go to the workhouse, because you cannot die of hunger where there is
- always enough vegetable food to keep the laziest alive, and you do not
- need workhouses, under the same happy conditions&mdash;but he will &ldquo;go
- native,&rdquo; and there are some who would say he had better starve, a good
- deal. There are men who have &ldquo;gone native&rdquo; in most of the Pacific groups,
- living in the palm-leaf huts with the villagers&mdash;but a white man in a
- waist-cloth and a bush of long hair, sleeping on a mat and living on wild
- fruit and scraps given by the generous natives, drunk half the time and
- infinitely lower, in his soberest hours, than the coloured folk who
- unwisely put up with him, is not a happy spectacle.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Cook Islands, which may be taken as a sample of many other groups, are
- small to look at on the map, and not over large, when one counts up the
- number of square miles. But one cannot fairly estimate the value of island
- land by its extent. Much of it is so rich that every foot has its worth,
- and that is by no means despicable. And, in any case, there is plenty
- available for the small cultivator&mdash;the man who has only a few
- hundred pounds, and cannot afford to do things on the colossal scale that
- makes big fortunes.
- </p>
- <p>
- Among the productions of the group are pineapples, custard apples, coffee,
- tobacco, pepper, mammee-apple or paw-paw, granadilla, cocoa, cotton,
- vanilla, limes, lemons, oranges, bananas, castor-oil, and many other
- useful plants, besides a number of excellent vegetables, not known to most
- Europeans. Many of the fruits above mentioned grow practically wild.
- Bananas come to bearing in fifteen months, cocoanuts in seven years, limes
- in four or five. The water supply is good all round, and there is a
- monthly steamer from Auckland.
- </p>
- <p>
- The land in all the islands belongs to the natives, and cannot usually be
- bought outright. Leases of any length, can, however, be secured at very
- low rates, with the New Zealand Government laws, administered through the
- Resident, to back up the titles, so that a man who plants cocoanuts&mdash;the
- safest of island products&mdash;may be sure that his children and
- grandchildren will enjoy the fruits of his labour.
- </p>
- <p>
- In most of the outer islands the natives cannot use more than a small
- fraction of the land, and are quite willing to let large sections at a
- shilling or two an acre. In Raratonga, the chief island, there has been
- more demand for land, and prices are consequently higher; also, the chiefs
- are not always ready to let, even though they do not use what they have.
- It may be said, however, of the group as a whole, that there is land, and
- a prospect of a good return for capital, ready for any reasonable number
- of settlers, if they bring habits of industry and a determination to
- succeed along with them.
- </p>
- <p>
- There are two classes of possible settlers to be considered&mdash;the man
- with capital, and the man without.
- </p>
- <p>
- How much does it take to start a man as a planter, and what return can he
- expect?
- </p>
- <p>
- Taking the Cook Islands as a general example (but by no means suggesting
- that the resources of the Pacific begin and end there) the young
- Englishman wishing to seek his fortune as a planter should have at least
- £500 to start on, exclusive of passage-money. He can do excellently with a
- few hundreds more, but it is as well to put things as low as possible.
- Copra&mdash;the dried kernel of the cocoanut&mdash;is the usual, and the
- safest, investment. It is always saleable, and the demand increases year
- by year&mdash;so much so, that the large soapmaking firms, who are the
- chief users of the product, are of late planting out islands for
- themselves. The cost of clearing and planting the land is about £5 an
- acre. The rent, in the outer islands, should not exceed a couple of
- shillings an acre. In about seven years, the returns begin to come in, and
- in ten years&rsquo; time the land should be bringing in £5 net profit for every
- acre of trees. This is, of course, a long time to wait, but bananas can
- grow on the same land meantime, and will generally yield a quick return.
- Once the cocoanuts start bearing, they go on for sixty years or more, so
- that a copra plantation is one of the best investments for a man who has
- others to come after him.
- </p>
- <p>
- Banana growing may be managed with less capital, but the profits are not
- so sure, since fruit is perishable, and cannot wait for the steamer as
- copra can. Coffee has been grown, but is not of late years doing well,
- because of something like a &ldquo;ring&rdquo; formed in New Zealand to lower the
- prices. Cotton used to do excellently, and I have never heard any
- satisfactory reason against its being taken up afresh. It is running wild
- in a good many parts of the group. The plants above mentioned, however, by
- no means exhaust the resources of the islands, which are suitable for
- growing anything that will live in the tropics, and are fortunately not
- subject to the destructive hurricanes that from time to time do so much
- damage in Tahiti and the Fijis. Hurricanes are not absolutely unknown, but
- they are very rare, and not of the worst kind.
- </p>
- <p>
- The cost of living is not very serious, but it must not be supposed that
- the settlers can live decently and like white men, on nothing a year. A
- house costs something to put up, and furniture to a certain small amount
- is necessary, clothes do not grow on the cocoanut tree, nor do lamps and
- kerosene, or tools and nails, or fishing lines, or flour and bacon and tea
- and tinned butter, and the few groceries that the settler may need. Still,
- with care, a single man can live quite respectably on fifty pounds a year,
- and enjoy, in all probability, better health than he has had at home.
- </p>
- <p>
- What the time of waiting will cost the copra planter, each one must work
- out for himself. He will do best to spend his capital gradually, planting
- as he can afford. The returns will come in only by degrees, but he will be
- saved the mortification of seeing a promising plantation leave his
- possession for a third of its value, simply because he cannot afford to
- wait until the profits begin.
- </p>
- <p>
- Copra, the chief article of commerce of the Pacific, is very easily
- prepared. The cocoanuts, when ripe, are husked, and emptied, and the
- kernels, as a rule, left to dry in the sun, though some few planters use
- artificial heat. Bagging is the only other operation necessary.
- </p>
- <p>
- Bananas are often shipped clumsily and carelessly, in unprotected bunches.
- It would be much better to pack them in leaves and crate them, as is done
- in the Canary Islands, where the banana trade is the principal support of
- the country. Oranges are usually shipped in crates. They grow wild all
- over the Cook group, and are not attended to in any way, but in spite of
- this, the orange trade with New Zealand is by no means despicable.
- </p>
- <p>
- Vanilla is not cultivated for market in these islands, but it would
- probably repay the experimenter. It does well in most of the Pacific
- groups, and the returns begin in three years from planting.
- </p>
- <p>
- Island planters, as a race, seem to be the most conservative of men, and
- very shy of trying anything new and unproved. There are, of course, good
- reasons for this, but there are also excellent arguments in favour of
- exploiting fresh fields. The following brief hints may prove fruitful to
- enterprising minds.
- </p>
- <p>
- Only one kind of banana&mdash;the sort familiar at home&mdash;is usually
- grown for trade. There are many varieties, however, and some of the very
- best travel quite as well as the commonplace &ldquo;China&rdquo; sort. The large red
- banana, sometimes called the Aitutaki banana, sometimes the peach banana,
- on account of its delicate peach-like flavour, is a fruit that would
- become the fashion at once, if it could be put on the market. One or two
- planters have gone so far as to send consignments down to New Zealand,
- but, finding that these did not sell on account of the unusual colour of
- the fruit, they never made another attempt. At the time of my visit, in
- 1904, the red banana was practically unobtainable in New Zealand or
- Australia. A little intelligent co-operation on the part of the buyers
- would probably get over the difficulty.
- </p>
- <p>
- The same may be said of limes, a fruit which grows wild very freely. The
- lime is like a small, round-shaped lemon, and is not an attractive fruit
- in appearance. It also suffers under the disadvantage of being very badly
- represented as to flavour by the bottled &ldquo;shop&rdquo; lime-juice, with which the
- taste of the fresh lime has hardly anything in common. Where it can be
- obtained fresh, however, no one ever thinks of using lemon as a flavouring
- in food or drink. The lime is incomparably more delicate and refreshing
- than the best lemon ever grown. For some unknown reason, however, it is
- not used in New Zealand, or in the cities of Australia, to which it could
- be easily and profitably exported from many of the Pacific groups.
- Instead, the juice of limes is squeezed out by a very rough process, the
- fruit being run through a wooden hand-press, and is shipped away in casks.
- The lime trade would certainly rival the orange trade, if worked up.
- </p>
- <p>
- Dried bananas have money in them, and the industry is especially adapted
- to some of the lesser Cook Islands, where steamer calls are at present
- irregular. The dried and pressed banana is better than the fig, and is
- considered a great delicacy by the few people in the colonies who have
- tried it. The Cook Islanders peel the fruit, and leave it to dry in the
- sun. When it is shrunk, dark, and sticky with its own sugar, they compress
- it into neat little packets covered with dried banana leaf, and tied with
- banana fibre. These will keep good for many months. Up to the present, the
- trade is extremely small, but there is no reason why it should not be
- increased.
- </p>
- <p>
- One of the chief troubles of the settler is the guava bush, which runs
- wild all over the islands, and is extremely hard to destroy. It bears
- quantities of excellent fruit, but guavas do not pay for exporting, so no
- one, apparently, has thought of making the island pest profitable. And
- yet, when I went down to New Zealand, which is in direct communication
- with the Cook Islands and less than a week away, I found the price of
- guava jelly in the shops was higher than it is at home. Asked why no one
- in the islands sent jelly for sale, the grocers said it was because
- jampots were not made in New Zealand, and had to be imported if wanted.
- Since most jams in the colonies are sold in tins, this did not appear to
- me an unanswerable argument. Tins are made in the colonies, and the
- process of tinning jam or jelly should not be beyond amateur powers.
- Moreover, common tumblers (which are also made in New Zealand) are a good
- and profitable way of putting up jellies; purchasers are always willing to
- pay extra for the advantage of getting something useful along with the
- dainty itself.
- </p>
- <p>
- Another item: Dried peppers bring a good price per ounce, and fine Chili
- pepper grows wild everywhere. So far, trade is nil.
- </p>
- <p>
- Another: One of the commonest plants in the Southern Pacific, a weed
- bearing a bright red flower almost exactly like the pine-cone in shape,
- contains, in the flower, a quantity of white watery liquid, which is
- declared by the natives, and by many of the whites, to be an exceptionally
- fine hair tonic. No one, so far as I know, has tried to make anything out
- of this, or out of the wild castor oil, which is said to be of good
- quality.
- </p>
- <p>
- If the settler cannot find some useful hint among these, he may be able to
- discover a few on the spot for himself.
- </p>
- <p>
- The second class of settler&mdash;the man without capital, or with only a
- little&mdash;is a pariah everywhere. No colony wants him, agents warn him
- away, friends write to him begging him to stay where he is, and not tempt
- fortune by going out unprovided with plenty of cash. No doubt there is
- reason on the side of the discouragers; but there is not a colony in the
- world, all the same, where you shall not find the man who came out without
- capital, who endured a few years of hard work and short commons, began to
- get on, began to save, went on getting on and saving, and by-and-by became
- one of the most successful men in the place. Whereupon as a rule he
- becomes an adviser in his turn, and solemnly counsels young men of every
- kind against the imprudence of tempting fortune with an empty purse.
- </p>
- <p>
- For all that, and all that, young Britons will continue to do what they
- are advised not to, and ships will carry out many a man to the far wild
- countries whose only gold is the gold of youth and health and a brave
- heart. &ldquo;Sink or swim&rdquo; is the motto of this kind of colonist, and if he
- often goes under, he very often floats on the top, and comes in on the
- flood-tide of good luck. &ldquo;Fortune favours the brave&rdquo;&mdash;a proverb none
- the less true because of its age.
- </p>
- <p>
- To have an island of one&rsquo;s own, in the beautiful South Seas, to live
- remote from strain and worry, and out of the clash and roar of
- twentieth-century civilization&mdash;to pass one&rsquo;s days in a land of
- perpetual summer; work, but own no master, possess a country (small though
- it may be) yet know none of the troubles of sovereignty&mdash;this is an
- ambition of which no one need be ashamed, even though-it appear
- contemptible and even reprehensible to &ldquo;Samuel Budgett, the Successful
- Merchant.&rdquo; The planter with a fair amount of capital can realise the dream
- almost any day, for every big group in the Pacific has many small
- unoccupied islands which can be rented for a song, and if the newcomer is
- made of stuff that can stand being totally deprived of theatres, clubs,
- music halls, daily posts and papers, and a good many other charms (or
- burdens) of city life, he has only to pick and choose, secure a good title
- to-his island, decide what he means to grow on it, get his house built,
- and settle down at once.
- </p>
- <p>
- But people who have very little money cherish the same ambition, often
- enough: There are thousands of men in the United Kingdom to whom a South
- Sea Island of their-own would be heaven&mdash;only they see no way of
- getting it. The desire comes, without doubt, of generations of insular
- ancestors. It is the &ldquo;Englishman&rsquo;s house is his castle" idea carried a
- step further than usual, that is all; and the boy that never wholly dies
- in the heart of every Briton is always ready to wake up and rejoice at the
- thought.
- </p>
- <p>
- What is the moneyless man to do?
- </p>
- <p>
- Well, first of all, he must get out to Sydney or Auckland, each being a
- port from which island vessels constantly sail, and with which island
- trade is closely concerned. It will not cost him so much as he thinks. If
- he goes by Auckland, he can get a third-class ticket from London for
- fifteen pounds, and Sydney is little more. Arrived, he will make use of
- the information he has, of course, obtained in London, from the offices of
- the Agent-General for New Zealand (or Australia, as the case may be) and
- try and get a job to keep him on his feet while he looks about. If he can
- do any kind of manual labour, he will not be at a loss&mdash;and if he
- cannot, or will not, he had much better stay at home on an office stool
- within sound of Bow Bells, and leave the far countries to men of tougher
- material.
- </p>
- <p>
- In Sydney or Auckland he will find a good many firms connected with island
- trading interests, many of whom own trading stores dotted about the whole
- Pacific. It is often possible to obtain a job from one of these, if the
- newcomer is capable and steady. In this case, the way of getting up to the
- islands is clear, and the work of copra trading, keeping store for native
- customers, fruit-buying and shipping on the spot, is the best possible
- training for an independent position. If this proves a vain hope (it need
- not, in the case of a good man, if one may judge by the wretched
- incapables who occupy the trader&rsquo;s post in many islands) our adventurer
- must try to raise the cost of a passage as best he can, and see what he
- can get to do among the white people of the group he has selected, when he
- arrives. There are so many useless wastrels in most of the islands, that
- character and capability are to a certain extent capital in themselves.
- Some one is generally in want of a plantation overseer to replace a
- drunken employee&mdash;some one else would be glad of a handy man to help
- with housebuilding of the simple island kind&mdash;and in many islands,
- board and lodging, and a little over, would be easily obtainable by any
- educated man, who would undertake to teach the children of the white
- settlers. There are groups in which no one is allowed to land who does not
- possess a certain minimum of cash, but it is not in any case that I know
- of more than ten pounds, and most islands have no such regulation.
- </p>
- <p>
- Once so far on his journey, the would-be island owner must think out the
- rest for himself. There is sure to be a small island or two for rent, and
- there will probably be means of making money by slow degrees in the group
- itself. Where the will is, the way will be found.
- </p>
- <p>
- The popular dream of finding and taking possession of an unoccupied island
- somewhere or other, and &ldquo;squatting&rdquo; there unopposed, is a dream and
- nothing more. The great European nations have long since parcelled out
- among themselves all the groups worth having, and rent or purchase is the
- only way to acquire land. Far-away separate islands, remote from
- everywhere, are still to be had for nothing in a few instances, but they
- are not desirable-possessions, unless the owner can afford a private
- sailing vessel, and in any case what has not been picked up is little
- worth picking in these days.
- </p>
- <p>
- So much for the how and where of acquiring islands. I shall have one or
- two definite instances to give in another chapter.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0004" id="link2HCH0004"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER IV
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>Where are the Six Thousand?&mdash;Calling on the Queen&mdash;A Victoria
- of the Pacific&mdash;The Prince sleeps softly&mdash;The Mystical Power of
- the Mana&mdash;How Islanders can die&mdash;A Depressing Palace&mdash;Round
- the Wonderful Roadway&mdash;The Home of Queen Tinomana&mdash;A Princess&rsquo;s
- Love Story&mdash;Once on Board the Schooner!&mdash;The Incredible Crabs&mdash;Depravity
- of a Mor Kiri-kiri.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">A</span> HUNDRED years
- ago, Raratonga had six thousand native inhabitants, and was a very
- flourishing heathen country, where cannibalism was all the fashion, murder
- of shipwrecked sailors a common custom, and raids upon neighbouring
- islands the chief diversion. There is no doubt that the Raratongan of
- those days compared none too well with the Tahitian, who at the worst
- never was an habitual cannibal, and was almost always friendly to
- strangers. Williams was the first missionary to arrive in the earlier part
- of the last century, and the complete conversion of the island was rapid;
- the Raratongan in a few years was no longer cannibal, no longer warlike,
- had become hospitable and friendly to travellers, had learned to wear
- clothes (a good deal more than he wanted or should have had, but the
- missionary of the early days really did not know what a fatal thing he was
- doing, when he enforced the wearing of white man&rsquo;s raiment on the
- unclothed native, and thereby taught him to catch cold, and die of chest
- diseases). The island had (and has) a large school for the training of
- mission teachers, and a church and mission house not to be matched in the
- Pacific for magnificence, and was on the whole a model of most of the
- virtues, compared with what it once had been. There were, and are,
- drawbacks to the missionary rule, but these have been discussed so freely
- in almost every book of Pacific travel ever written, that I do not feel it
- necessary to say over again what has so often been said before. The
- missionaries certainly civilised the islands, and made them safe to live
- in. Concurrently with this desirable result, others not so desirable took
- place, the fruit, in some cases, of irresponsible authority exercised by
- semi-educated men; in others, of the inevitable fate that follows the
- introduction of civilisation to primitive races. The Raratongan, like all
- the other brown folk of the islands, was asked to leap, almost at once,
- the gulf between utter savagery and comparative civilisation, that had
- taken his instructors all the time between the Roman Conquest and the end
- of the Dark Ages to overpass. With the docility of the true Polynesian, he
- did his best to comply. It was not his fault&mdash;and not, one must
- fairly say, the fault of the missionary either, save in a minor degree&mdash;that
- the effort meant death to him.
- </p>
- <p>
- There are not nineteen hundred Raratongans living now in the fertile
- little country that used to support six thousand of their ancestors. There
- are not enough babies in the island to carry on the population at half its
- present level, in the future. Not one of the &ldquo;chief&rdquo; families, of whom
- there are a dozen or so, has any living children at all. Consumption is
- common, and on the increase; more serious diseases are commoner still. A
- Raratongan seldom lives to be very old, and he almost always dies without
- resistance or regret. The islanders are happy and sunny in their own quiet
- way, but the backbone of life has been broken for them, and in the promise
- of the future, grey or golden, they have no share. To-day is theirs, but
- they have no to-morrow.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Arikis, or chiefs, to whom the principal power once belonged, and who
- still retain much importance, regret this state of affairs in an amiable,
- fatalistic way, but do not trouble themselves very much over it. They are
- for the most part of the opinion of Sir Boyle Roche about the claims of
- posterity; and anyhow, they have their fruit trading to think about, and
- the next public dancing and singing party, and the last illegal
- beer-brewing up in the hills&mdash;so the decadence of their country sits
- lightly on their minds.
- </p>
- <p>
- These Arikis are one and all inferior to the ruling sovereign, Queen
- Makea, who still contrives to retain a great deal of quiet power in her
- shapely old hands, in spite of the fact that she is nominally deposed, and
- her country owned by New Zealand. I had not been in Raratonga more than a
- day or two, when my hosts took me to call upon the queen, intimating that
- she would feel hurt if the newcomer was not presented to her.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0016" id="linkimage-0016"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0111.jpg" alt="0111 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0111.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- We walked through the blazing sun of the tropic afternoon, down the
- palm-shaded main street of Avarua town, to the great grassy enclosure that
- surrounds the palace of the queen. One enters through a neat white gate;
- inside are one or two small houses, a number of palms and flowering
- bushes, and at the far end, a stately two-storeyed building constructed of
- whitewashed concrete, with big railed-in verandahs, and handsome arched
- windows. This is Makea&rsquo;s palace, but her visitors do not go there to look
- for her. In true South Sea Islander fashion, she keeps a house for show
- and one for use. The islander, though he aspires when &ldquo;civilised,&rdquo; to own
- a big concrete house, &ldquo;all same papalangi&rdquo; (white man), does not really
- like living in a building that shuts out the air. He discovered the
- fresh-air system long before it was thought of by the folk who discovered
- him, and his own houses are always made of small poles or saplings, set
- without any filling, so that the whole building is as airy as a birdcage,
- and almost as transparent. In this he lives, while the big concrete house,
- with its Auckland made tables, chairs, and beds, and the red and blue
- table-cloths, and horrible gilt lamps fringed with cut glass lustres, and
- shrieking oleograph of King Edward in his coronation robes, is kept
- strictly for show, and perhaps for an occasional festival, such as a
- wedding party. It is an odd custom, but sensible, on the whole.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0017" id="linkimage-0017"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0117.jpg" alt="0117 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0117.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Makea&rsquo;s favourite house is a pretty little reed and thatch villa several
- miles out in the country. When she is in town, she makes some concession
- to state by living in a small one-storeyed cottage, with a thatch and a
- verandah, and not much else, close beside her big palace. We found her at
- the cottage when we called, sitting on the verandah upon an ironwood
- couch, and petting a little turtle of which she is very fond. It seems a
- curious sort of creature to adore, but an elderly lady must have her
- little pet of some kind. In other climes, it is a pug, a parrot, or a cat.
- Here, the little turtle is considered chic, so the queen has one, the
- turtle having been always considered a perquisite of royalty in the old
- days, when the chiefs had the best of everything, even down to the
- choicest tit-bits of the roasted enemy, while the commonalty had to put up
- with what they could get.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0018" id="linkimage-0018"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0125.jpg" alt="0125 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0125.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- I was introduced to the queen, who shook hands politely, and sent one of
- her handmaids for chairs. These being brought, my hostess and I sat down,
- and the latter conversed with Makea in Raratongan, translating a few
- conventional politenesses from myself, and conveying others to me in
- return. The queen wanted to know how I liked the island, if I had really
- come all the way from England, as she had heard, whether I was not afraid
- to travel so far alone, how long I hoped to stay, and so forth. All the
- time, as we talked, her keen black eyes were scanning me silently,
- rapidly, comprehensively, and making their own judgment, quite
- independently of the conversation and its inevitable formalities. And I,
- on my side, was gazing, I fear with some rudeness, at the very remarkable
- figure before me.
- </p>
- <p>
- Makea, since the death of her husband, Prince Ngamaru, a few years ago,
- has laid aside all vanities of dress, and wears only the simplest of black
- robes, made loose and flowing from the neck in island fashion. She is
- supposed to be at least seventy years of age, and she is extremely stout,
- even for her height, which is well over six feet. Yet a more impressive
- figure than this aged, deposed, uncrowned sovereign, in her robe of shabby
- black, I have never seen. Wisdom, kindliness, and dignity are written
- large on her fine old face, which has more than a touch of resemblance to
- the late Queen Victoria. And oh, the shrewdness, the ability, the keen
- judgment of men and things, that look out from those brown, deep-set eyes,
- handsome enough, even in old age, to hint at the queen-like beauty that
- once belonged to this island queen!
- </p>
- <p>
- Makea was always known as a wise, just, and very powerful sovereign. She
- ruled over the whole Cook group, and her word was law everywhere, even to
- the Prince Consort, the warlike Ngamaru, who to the very last retained
- some traces of his heathen upbringing, and used to be seen, in the island
- councils of only a few years ago, making the horrible cannibal gesture
- which signifies in unmistakable pantomime, &ldquo;I will tear the meat from your
- bones with my teeth!&rdquo; at any other council member who presumed to disagree
- with him. Their married life was a happy one, in spite of the prince&rsquo;s
- violent character, and when he died, the widowed queen took all her
- splendid robes of velvet, silk, and satin, gorgeously trimmed with gold,
- tore them in fragments, and cast them into his grave, so that he might he
- soft, as befitted the prince who had been loved so well by such a queen.
- </p>
- <p>
- Makea holds much of the real power in her hands to-day, for all that the
- islands are the property of the British Crown, and administered by a
- Commissioner. The Raratongan is submissive to chiefs by nature, and the
- queen, though uncrowned, is still reverenced and feared almost, as much as
- of old. It is firmly believed that she possesses the mystic power known as
- &ldquo;mana&rdquo; among the Maori races, and this, as it gives the owner power to
- slay at will, is greatly feared. The word is almost untranslatable,
- meaning, perhaps, something like &ldquo;prestige,&rdquo; &ldquo;kudos,&rdquo; or the old English
- &ldquo;glamour.&rdquo; It includes, among other gifts, second sight to a certain
- extent, the power to bring good or evil luck, and the ability already
- mentioned to deal death at will.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0019" id="linkimage-0019"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0139.jpg" alt="0139 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0139.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- This last may sound like fiction. It is nothing of the sort, it is plain,
- bald fact, as any one who has ever lived in the islands can testify. There
- is nothing more commonly known in the South Seas than the weird power
- possessed by kings and heroes to slay with a word, and instances of its
- exercise could be found in every group.
- </p>
- <p>
- Makea does not use it now, so they say. She is old: like aged folks in
- other places, she wants to &ldquo;make her soul,&rdquo; and it can readily be imagined
- that the mission authorities do not approve of such heathen proceedings.
- Still, there is not a native in Raratonga who does not believe that she
- could strike him dead with a wish, any day in the week, if she chose: and
- there are not a few who can tell you that in the days long ago, she
- exercised the power.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Makea, she never rude, because she great chief,&rdquo; said a relation of the
- royal family to me one day. &ldquo;She never say to any one, &lsquo;You go die!&rsquo; I
- think. She only saying, some time, &lsquo;I wish I never seeing you again!&rsquo; and
- then the people he go away, very sorry, and by-n&rsquo;-by he die&mdash;some
- day, some week, I don&rsquo; know&mdash;but he dyin&rsquo; all right, very quick, you
- bet!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- The power to die at will seems to be a heritage of the island races,
- though the power to live, when a chief bids them set sail on the dark seas
- of the unknown, is not theirs. Suicide, carried out without the aid of
- weapons or poisons of any kind, is not at all uncommon. A man or woman who
- is tired of life, or bitterly offended with any one, will often lie down
- on the mats, turn his face, like David of old; to the wall, and simply
- flicker out like a torch extinguished by the wind. There was once a white
- schooner captain, who had quarrelled with his native crew; and the crew,
- to pay him out, lay down and declared they would die to spite him.... But
- this is about Makea the Queen, not about the godless brutal captain, and
- the measures he took to prevent his men from taking passage in a body
- across the Styx. They didn&rsquo;t go after all, and they were sore and sorry
- men when they made the island port, and the captain, who was a very
- ill-educated person, boasted far and wide for many a day after that, that
- he would exceedingly well learn any exceedingly objectionable nigger who
- offered to go and die on him again&mdash;and that is all that I must say
- about it, for more reasons than one.
- </p>
- <p>
- The queen, after a little conversation, punctuated by intervals of fanning
- and smiling (and a more charming smile than Makea&rsquo;s, you might search the
- whole South Seas to find), sent a girl up a tree for cocoanuts, and
- offered us the inevitable cocoanut water and bananas, without which no
- island call is complete. Afterwards, when we rose to go, she sent a
- handmaid with us to take us over the palace, of which she is, naturally,
- very proud, though she never enters it except on the rare occasion of some
- great festival.
- </p>
- <p>
- The palace proved to be as uninteresting as the queen herself was
- interesting and attractive. It had a stuffy, shut-up smell, and it was
- furnished in the worst of European taste, with crude ugly sofas and
- chairs, tables covered with cheap-jack Manchester trinkets, and staring
- mirrors and pictures&mdash;partly sacred art, of a kind remarkably well
- calculated to promote the cause of heathenism, and partly portraits,
- nearly as bad as those one sees in the spring exhibitions at home. There
- were two or three saloons or drawing-rooms, all much alike, on the lower
- storey. Upstairs (it is only a very palatial island house that owns an
- upstairs) there were several bedrooms, furnished with large costly
- bedsteads of mahogany and other handsome woods, and big massive wardrobes
- and tables&mdash;all unused, and likely to remain so. The place was
- depressing on the whole, and I was glad to get out of it into the cheerful
- sun, although the heat at this hour of the afternoon was really
- outrageous.
- </p>
- <p>
- [[Illustration: 0165]
- </p>
- <p>
- Another afternoon, I drove out to see Queen Tinomana, a potentate only
- second to Makea in influence. Tinomana, like Makea, is a dynastic name,
- and is always borne by the high chief, man or woman, who is hereditary
- sovereign of a certain district. The present holder of the title is a
- woman, and therefore queen.
- </p>
- <p>
- What a drive it was! The roadway round the island is celebrated all over
- the Pacific, and with justice, for nothing more lovely than this
- twenty-mile ribbon of tropic splendour is to be found beneath the Southern
- Cross. One drives in a buggy of colonial pattern, light, easy-running, and
- fast, and the rough little island horse makes short work of the miles of
- dazzling white sandy road that circle the shores of the bright lagoon. On
- one side rises the forest, green and rich and gorgeous beyond all that the
- dwellers of the dark North could possibly imagine, and opening now and
- then to display picture after picture, in a long gallery of magnificent
- mountain views&mdash;mountains blue as the sea, mountains purple as
- amethyst, mountains sharp like spear-heads, towered and buttressed like
- grand cathedrals, scarped into grey precipices where a bat could scarcely
- cling, and cloven into green gorges bright with falling streams. On the
- other, the palms and thick undergrowth hardly veil the vivid gleam of the
- emerald lagoon lying within the white-toothed barrier reef, where all day
- long the surf of the great Pacific creams and froths and pours. By the
- verge of the coral beach that burns like white fire in the merciless sun,
- the exquisite ironwood tree trails its delicate tresses above the sand, so
- that, if you leave the carriage to follow on the road, and walk down by
- the beach, you shall catch the green glow of the water, and the pearly
- sparkle of the reef, through a drooping veil of leafage fine as a
- mermaid&rsquo;s hair. Sometimes the buggy runs for a mile or two through thick
- woods of this lovely tree, where the road is carpeted thickly with the
- fallen needles of foliage, so that the wheels run without sound, and you
- may catch the Eolian harp-song of the leaves, sighing ceaselessly and
- sadly
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p class="indent20">
- Of old, unhappy, far-off things,
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p>
- when the evening wind gets up and the sun drops low on the lagoon.
- </p>
- <p>
- The myths of the Pacific are marvellous in their way, but they pass over
- unnoticed much that could not have escaped the net of folk-lore and poetry
- in Northern lands. That the lovely ironwood, a tree with leaves like
- mermaid&rsquo;s locks, and the voice of a mermaid&rsquo;s song in its whispering
- boughs, should stand bare of legend or romance on the shores of a sea that
- is itself the very home of wonder, strikes the Northern mind with a sense
- of strange incongruity. But the soul of the islands is not the soul of the
- continents, and the poet of the Pacific is still to be born.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0020" id="linkimage-0020"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0173.jpg" alt="0173 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0173.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Sometimes, again, the little buggy rattles over white coral sand and
- gravel, on a stretch of road that is fairly buried in the forest. The sun
- is cut off overhead, and only a soft green glow sifts through. The
- palm-tree stems sweep upward, tall and white, the gigantic &ldquo;maupei&rdquo; rears
- aloft its hollow buttressed stems, carved out into caverns that would
- delight the soul of a modern Crusoe, and drops big chestnuts, floury and
- sweet, upon the road as we pass. The &ldquo;utu,&rdquo; or Barringtonia Speciosa, one
- of the most beautiful of island trees, towers a hundred feet into the warm
- glow above, its brilliant varnished leaves, nearly a foot long, and its
- strange rose and white flowers, shaped like feather-dusters, marking it
- out unmistakably from the general tangle of interlacing boughs, and
- crowding trunks and long liana ropes, green and brown, that run from tree
- to tree. If you were lost in the bush, and thirsty, one of those lianas
- would provide you with waters, were you learned enough in wood lore to
- slash it with your knife, and let the pure refreshing juice trickle forth.
- You might gather wild fruit of many kinds, too, and wild roots, mealy and
- nourishing, or dainty and sweet. And at night, you might creep into your
- hollow tree, or lie down on the warm sand of the shore, with nothing worse
- to fear than a mosquito or two.
- </p>
- <p>
- There are no wild beasts in any of the Pacific Islands, save an occasional
- boar, which always lives remote from men in the hills, and is much readier
- to run away than to annoy. There are no poisonous snakes, either,
- tarantulas, or deadly centipedes and scorpions. I cannot honestly say that
- the two latter creatures do not exist, but they very seldom bite or sting
- any one who does not go barefooted, and their venom is not deadly, though
- painful.
- </p>
- <p>
- On almost every tree, as we rattle along through the forest, my hostess
- and I can see the beautiful bird&rsquo;s-nest fern, looking like a hanging
- basket of greenery. We have not time to stop to-day, but we shall have to
- go out some other afternoon and cut down a few of the smaller ones for
- table decoration, for there is a dinner party coming off, and we are short
- of pot plants for the rooms. Young palms, most graceful of all green
- things, shoot up like little fountains in the clearings, some of the
- smaller ones still&rsquo; root-bound by the large brown nut from which they have
- sprung. One would never think these dainty ball-room palms were related in
- any way to the stately white columns-spiring high above them, for the
- full-grown palm is all stem and scarcely any top, in comparison, while the
- young palm, a mass of magnificent spreading fronds, rises from a short
- bulb-like trunk that suggests nothing less than further growth.
- </p>
- <p>
- The drive is six good miles, but it seems only too short. In a very little
- while, we have reached Queen Tinomana&rsquo;s village&mdash;a picturesque little
- grassy town, with brown thatched huts, and white concrete cottages washed
- with coral lime, and gay red and yellow leaved ti trees standing before
- almost every door&mdash;and the queen&rsquo;s own palace, a handsome
- two-storeyed house, quite as fine as Makea&rsquo;s, stands up in front of us.
- </p>
- <p>
- Passing by this piece of European splendour, we go to draw a more likely
- covert, and ere long flush our quarry in a little creeper-wreathed
- cottage, hidden behind bushes of deliciously scented frangipani and
- blazing red hibiscus. The queen is on the verandah, seated, like Makea, on
- an ironwood sofa of state. She sits here most of the day, having very
- little in the way of government to do, and no desire to trouble her
- amiable head with the white woman&rsquo;s laborious methods of killing time.
- Sometimes she plaits a hat to amuse herself, being accomplished in this
- favourite Raratongan art&mdash;a sailor hat with a hard crown and stiff
- brim, and a good deal of neat but lacy fancy work in the twisting of the
- plait. Sometimes she receives friends, and hears gossip. Sometimes, she
- sleeps on the sofa, and wakes up to suck oranges and fall asleep again.
- The strenuous life is not the life beloved of Tinomana, nor (one may hint
- in the smallest of whispers) would her much more strenuous sister queen
- encourage any developments in that direction.
- </p>
- <p>
- It is well, under the circumstances, that both are suited by their
- respective rôles, otherwise the somewhat difficult lot of the Resident
- Commissioner might be rendered even more trying than it is.
- </p>
- <p>
- Tinomana is not young, and she is not lovely now, though one can see that
- she has been beautiful, as so many of the soft-eyed island women are, long
- ago. She has had her romance, however, and as we sit on her verandah,
- drinking and eating the cocoanut and banana of ceremony, the grey-haired
- white man who is husband of the queen tells the story to me of her love
- and his, just as it happened, once upon a time.
- </p>
- <p>
- In 1874 the Cook Islands were an independent group, governed by their own
- chiefs, or Arikis. The Arikis had much more power in those days than they
- are now allowed to exercise. They could order the execution of any subject
- for any cause; they could make war and end it: and no ship dared to call
- at the islands without their permission. They owned, as they still own,
- all the land, and their wealth of various kinds made them, in the eyes of
- the natives, millionaires as well as sovereigns.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Women&rsquo;s rights&rdquo; were a novelty to England thirty years ago, but in the
- Cook Islands they were fully recognised, even at that early period. The
- most powerful of the Arikis was Makea&mdash;then a girl, now an elderly
- woman, but always every inch a queen, and always keeping a firm hand on
- the sceptre of Raratonga. Any Cook Islands postage-stamp will show Makea
- as she was some ten years ago. In 1874 Makea and her consort, Ngamaru,
- were making plans for the marrying of Tinomana, a young Raratongan
- princess closely related to Makea. Tinomana would shortly become an Ariki,
- or queen, herself, and her matrimonial affairs were, in consequence, of
- considerable importance.
- </p>
- <p>
- What the plans of Raratonga&rsquo;s rulers for Tinomana may have been matters
- little. Tinomana was pretty, with splendid long black hair, large soft
- brown eyes, an excellent profile, and a complexion little darker than a
- Spaniard&rsquo;s. She was also self-willed, and could keep a secret as close as
- wax when she so desired. She had a secret at that time, and it concerned
- no South Sea Islander, but a certain good-looking young Anglo-American
- named John Salmon (grandson of a Ramsgate sea-captain, Thomas Dunnett),
- who had lately landed at Raratonga from the trading schooner <i>Venus</i>,
- and had been enjoying a good deal of the pretty princess&rsquo;s society,
- unknown to the gossips of the island. It was a case of love at first
- sight; for the two had not been more than a few days acquainted when they
- came privately to James Chalmers, the famous missionary, then resident in
- Raratonga, and begged for a secret marriage.
- </p>
- <p>
- James Chalmers refused promptly to have anything to do with the matter,
- and furthermore told Tinomana that he would never marry her to any white
- man, no matter who it might be. In his opinion such a marriage would be
- certain to cause endless trouble with the other Arikis&mdash;apart from
- the fact that Queen Makea was against it. So the lovers went away
- disconsolate. Raratonga was keeping holiday at the time, because a great
- war-canoe was to be launched immediately, and a dance and feast were in
- preparation. But Tinomana and her lover were out of tune with the
- festivities, and no woman in the island prepared her stephanotis and
- hibiscus garlands for the feast, or plaited baskets of green palm leaves
- to carry contributions of baked sucking-pig and pineapples, with as heavy
- a heart as the little princess.
- </p>
- <p>
- On the day of the feast an idea came to Salmon. There were two schooners
- lying in Avarua harbour. One, the <i>Coronet</i>, had for a captain a man
- named Rose, who was as much opposed to Salmon&rsquo;s marriage as Chalmers
- himself. The <i>Humboldt</i> schooner, on the other hand, had a friend of
- Salmon&rsquo;s in command. From him some help might be expected. Salmon visited
- him secretly, found that he was willing to assist, and arranged for an
- elopement that very night. Tinomana was willing; nobody suspected; and the
- feast would furnish a capital opportunity.
- </p>
- <p>
- There was no moon that evening, happily for the lovers, for the smallest
- sign would have awaked the suspicions of the watching <i>Coronet</i>. When
- the feast had begun, and all Raratonga was making merry with pig and baked
- banana, raw fish and pineapple beer, Tinomana contrived to slip away and
- get back to her house. Womanlike, she would not go without her &ldquo;things&rdquo;;
- and she took so long collecting and packing her treasures&mdash;her silk
- and muslin dresses, her feather crowns, her fans and bits of cherished
- European finery from far-away Auckland&mdash;that the suspicions of a
- prying girl were aroused. Out she came, accompanied by two others&mdash;all
- handmaidens to Tinomana&mdash;and charged the princess with an intention
- to elope. Tinomana acknowledged the truth, and ordered the girls to hold
- their tongues, offering them liberal rewards. This was not enough,
- however; the three girls demanded that Tinomana, in addition to buying
- their silence, should shield them from the possible wrath of the great
- Makea by taking them with her. She was forced to consent; and so, when the
- impatient lover, lurking in the darkness near the harbour, saw his lady
- coming at last, she came with three attendants, and almost enough luggage
- to rival Marie Antoinette&rsquo;s encumbered flight to Varennes.
- </p>
- <p>
- Eventually, however, the party put off in a canoe, the girls lying flat in
- the bottom, with Tinomana crouching beside them and Salmon holding a
- lighted torch, which he waved in the air as they went. For the boat had to
- pass close by the Coronet, and Captain Rose, somehow or other, had become
- suspicious, and young Salmon knew he would think nothing of stopping any
- boat that could not give an account of itself. So Salmon took the torch,
- to look like a fishing-boat going out with spears and torches to the reef,
- and, paddling with one hand while he held the light aloft with the other,
- he passed the <i>Coronet</i> safely, knowing well that his face would be
- unrecognisable at a distance of fifty yards or so in the wavering shadow
- of the flame.
- </p>
- <p>
- Beyond the reef lay the <i>Humboldt</i> waiting. Tinomana and her maids
- and her luggage were swung up the side with small ceremony; Salmon hurried
- after, and a small but welcome breeze enabled the schooner to slip out to
- sea unnoticed in the dark. She made for Mangaia, another of the Cook
- Islands, some hundred and fifty miles away, and reached it in a couple of
- days. But the <i>Humboldt</i> had hardly made the land when the dreaded <i>Coronet</i>
- appeared on the horizon, carrying every stitch of sail, and with her
- decks, her &ldquo;Jacob&rsquo;s-ladder,&rdquo; and her very yardarms crowded by furious
- Raratongans. The fugitives were caught!
- </p>
- <p>
- At first they had not been missed. The islanders were feasting and
- drinking, the Arikis were unsuspicious, and the <i>Coronet</i> had seen
- only a fishing-canoe with a solitary man on board gliding out to the reef.
- But with the morning light came the knowledge that Tinomana was absent
- from her palace, that Salmon had not come home, and that the <i>Humboldt</i>
- was gone. Raratonga was enraged, and all the more so because pursuit
- appeared for the moment to be impossible. They knew that the <i>Humboldt</i>
- had probably made for Mangaia; but the breeze had died away, and the <i>Coronet</i>,
- her sails flapping idly against her rakish masts, lay helpless in harbour.
- Some brilliant spirit, however, proposed that the schooner should be towed
- out, in the hope of catching a breeze beyond the reef; and half a dozen
- great whaleboats, manned by powerful arms, were harnessed to the <i>Coronet&rsquo;s</i>
- bows. Out she came through the opening in the foaming coral reef, with
- screaming and splashing and tugging at oars, into the blue, open sea, and
- beyond the shelter of the peaky, purple hills. The breeze was met at last,
- the boats cast off and dropped astern, and the <i>Coronet</i>, carrying
- half Raratonga on board, set sail for Mangaia.
- </p>
- <p>
- Once within the range of the <i>Humboldt</i> the <i>Coronet</i> lowered a
- boatful of armed men, and the latter made for the schooner lying-to under
- the shelter of the Mangaian hills. Captain Harris, of the <i>Humboldt</i>,
- however, ordered his crew to shoot down the first man who attempted to
- board, and the attacking boat thought better of it. Beaten by force they
- tried diplomacy, in which they were more successful. They told Captain
- Harris that all his cargo of valuable cotton, lying on the wharf at
- Raratonga ready for shipment, would be destroyed unless he gave the
- princess back. This meant absolute ruin, and the captain had to submit.
- Salmon told Tinomana that it was best to give in for the present, as they
- were caught; but that the parting would be only for a time. And back to
- Raratonga went the disconsolate princess, bereft of her lover and her
- stolen wedding, and with the anticipation of a good scolding to come from
- the indignant Arikis.
- </p>
- <p>
- For some months after this disaster Salmon wandered about from island to
- island, living now in Raiatea, now in Flint Island, now in Mauke&mdash;always
- restless and always impatient. At last he judged the time had come to make
- a second attempt, and tried to obtain a passage to Raratonga.
- </p>
- <p>
- Schooner after schooner refused to take him, but finally a little vessel
- called the <i>Atalanta</i> braved the wrath of the Arikis and brought him
- back. During his absence time had worked in his favour, and the opposition
- to the marriage was now much weaker. The Arikis received him coolly and
- fined him twenty pounds&rsquo; worth of needles, thread, and tobacco for his
- late excursion, but they no longer refused to let him see Tinomana. The
- missionary, however, still objected to the marriage, and as he was the
- only clergyman available for the ceremony it seemed as if things, on the
- whole, were &ldquo;getting no forrader.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- At this juncture the great Makea stepped in, and with the charming
- variability common to her sex, took the part of the lovers against all
- Raratonga as strongly as she had before opposed their union. She was not
- then in Raratonga, but in another of the Cook Islands, Atiu. From thence
- she sent the schooner <i>Venus</i> to Raratonga, ordering the captain to
- fetch Tinomana and Salmon to Atiu, where the local missionary would marry
- them, or Makea would know the reason why.
- </p>
- <p>
- Raratonga&mdash;obstinate Raratonga!&mdash;still refused to give its
- princess to a foreign adventurer, though it trembled at the thought of
- defying the Elizabethan Makea. A band of warriors came down to the harbour
- to see that Salmon did not get on board the ship. As for Tinomana, they
- did not dare to oppose her departure, when the head of the house had
- actually summoned her. But the princess had no notion whatever of going
- alone. Salmon was smuggled on board in the dusk and hidden under a bunk. A
- pile of mats and native &ldquo;pareos,&rdquo; or kilts, was placed over him, and
- there, in the heat of the tropic night, he lay and sweltered, while the <i>Venus</i>
- swung to her cable and the warriors hunted the ship and found nothing.
- When they went off, baffled, the schooner put to sea. A Raratongan vessel,
- still suspicious, chased her to Atiu, but Makea informed the pursuing crew
- that it would be bad for their health to land on her property unasked;
- and, as this great Pacific Queen had, and has, the reputation of keeping
- her word when it is passed, the Raratongans did not dare to set foot on
- shore. This time it was they who went home disconsolate.
- </p>
- <p>
- And so the young couple were married &ldquo;and lived happily ever after.&rdquo;
- Tinomana and her consort now reside at Arorangi, Raratonga, in their long,
- low house, set among frangipani trees and oranges, and covered with
- flowering tropical creepers, and seldom or never occupy their palace.
- Tinomana&rsquo;s five children are dead; she herself is growing old, but the
- memory of those long-past years of adventure and romance is still with
- her. Her life glides quietly and dreamily by, within the sound of the
- humming ocean surf, under the shadow of the purple Raratongan hills. She
- has had her day, and there remain the quiet sunset and the softened
- twilight, before the time of dark.
- </p>
- <p>
- The queen had little to say to us, for she does not speak English, nor is
- she shrewdly curious about men and things outside of sleepy Raratonga,
- like her sister sovereign, Makea. She smiled a good deal, and said some
- polite things about my dress, which illustrated a new fashion, and seemed
- to interest her more than anything else connected with the call. I had
- brought a gift with me for Tinomana, a silk scarf of a peculiarly
- screaming blue, and I presented it before I took my leave with some
- politenesses that the royal consort rapidly translated for me. The queen
- was much pleased with the gift, and began trying its effect on several
- different hats at once. Then we had some more cocoanut water and said
- good-bye, and drove home again in the yellow sunset.
- </p>
- <p>
- The crabs were getting noisy as we passed along a soft bit of sandy road
- close by the shore. They are fairly active all day, and at night seem to
- wake up a little more completely than before. One can hear them rattling
- and scratching loudly all over the stones and rubbish about the shore; the
- ground is riddled with their holes&mdash;as we pass, they dart in at their
- front doors as swiftly as spiders, and stand looking cautiously round a
- comer till the threatening apparition is gone. They are not nice things,
- these crabs&mdash;they are tall and spindly and insectlike in build, with
- a scrawny body set on eight spider-like legs, and ugly, sharp, thin claws.
- They live on the land, but haunt the beach a good deal, because of the
- débris to be found there, and they are such nasty feeders that not even
- the natives will eat them, which is saying a good deal.
- </p>
- <p>
- They have an uncanny fancy for coming into houses. If your residence is
- not raised up on a good Verandah, which they cannot surmount, you may be
- alarmed some night by a ghostly tapping and ticking on the floor, like
- nothing you have ever heard or dreamed of before, and while you are
- wondering fearfully what the sound may be, you will suddenly become aware
- of something clumsy and noisy scrambling among the mosquito curtains of
- your bed. At this, if you are of common human mould, you will arise
- hastily, tangling yourself up in the curtains as you do so, and call
- loudly for a light. And when one is brought, behold the offender scuttling
- hastily away on eight long thin legs into the outer dark, without stopping
- to make an explanation or an apology. You are so annoyed that you put on a
- dressing-gown and follow him out on the verandah, a stick in your hand and
- murder in your heart; but just as you reach the steps, there is a loud
- &ldquo;flump&rdquo; on the floor, and a centipede as big as a sausage, with a writhing
- black body and horrible red legs and antennae, flashes past the edge of
- your sweeping draperies. At this you give it up, and get back to your
- mosquito curtains.
- </p>
- <p>
- You are just falling asleep, when&mdash;&mdash;&mdash; Good Heavens! what
- is it?
- </p>
- <p>
- Surely nothing but a burglar could have made that fearful noise in the
- outer kitchen!&mdash;a burglar, or a madman, or both in one. It sounds as
- if some one were beating somebody else with an iron bucket. Perhaps it may
- be only a native dog chasing a cat. Up go the curtains once more, letting
- half the mosquitoes in the island in, and off the wretched traveller sets
- for the kitchen, accompanied by a brave but pallid hostess, who says she
- is extremely sorry her husband <i>would</i> choose this week for going
- away from home.
- </p>
- <p>
- There he is! there is the author of the noise&mdash;a black, bristly,
- incredibly hideous hermit crab as big as a biscuit&mdash;out of his shell,
- and fighting like grim death in an empty kerosene tin, with another crab
- nearly as big, and quite as vicious. Number one has got too big for the
- secondhand univalve shell he lived in, and is touring the country trying
- to replace it. Number two, also out-growing his clothes, has got half a
- broken sardine box in the kerosene tin (which acts as ash-bucket to the
- house), and he thinks it is the loveliest new shell he has ever seen. So,
- unluckily, does the other crab, and they are in the act of putting it to
- ordeal by combat, when we invade the scene of the battle, and rudely shake
- the crabs and the shells and the sardine tin all off the end of the
- verandah together.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;What on earth brings crabs into people&rsquo;s houses?&rdquo; you ask amazedly, as
- you go back to bed again. It seems an insane action for any sensible crab,
- considering that we are half a mile from the sea.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Pure cussedness,&rdquo; says my friend wrathfully. &ldquo;They even climb up the
- verandah posts, and sit among the flowers. &lsquo;What for? Spite, I think;
- there isn&rsquo;t anything more ill-natured in the world than a hermit crab.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- If it is not a moonlight night, now, we get to sleep at last, but if it
- is, and the oranges are ripe&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;
- </p>
- <p>
- Well, that is the time the &ldquo;mor kiri-kiris&rdquo; choose to perform their
- orisons; and when they are playing the devil with the holy peace and calm
- of midnight on the roof, not even a fourth mate newly come off his watch,
- could sleep below.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Here, you blank, blank, blank, unspeakable, etcetera, let go that
- orange!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;I shan&rsquo;t, blank your double-blank limbs and wings! I got it first!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Then just look out, you mangy, fox-faced, clumsy-winged beast, for I&rsquo;ll
- rip the inside out of your rotten carcase with my claws.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Like to see you!&rdquo; (somewhat muffled with stolen orange).
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;You will!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- Shriek, shriek, yell, howl, scream.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;You&rsquo;ve bitten my toe off, you trebly-blanked vermin!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Meant to!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Clear off!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Won&rsquo;t!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Come on again, then!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Pax! pax! here&rsquo;s the great pig with fur on its head that lives in the
- house, coming out with a gun. I&rsquo;m off.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;So am I, but we&rsquo;ll go back again the moment it goes in.&rdquo; That is the way
- one sleeps in the orange season, in a place that happens to be popular
- with the &ldquo;mor kiri-kiri,&rdquo; or flying-fox&mdash;a bat with a furry body as
- big as a cat&rsquo;s, long sharp white teeth, a head exactly like a fox, and the
- crustiest disposition of anything living on the island.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0005" id="link2HCH0005"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER V
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>Feasting and Fun on Steamer Day&mdash;The Brown People of Rara-tonga&mdash;Who
- sent back the Teeth?&mdash;Divorce made easy&mdash;Climbing a Tropical
- Mountain&mdash;A Hot-water Swim&mdash;Out on the Rainbow Coral Reef&mdash;Necklaces
- for No One.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">S</span>TEAMER day in
- Raratonga, as in all the islands that rejoice in the privilege of a
- regular steamer service, is beyond comparison the event of the month.
- Almost before dawn on the day which is expected to see the boat arrive,
- the traders are up and about, seeing to the carting of their fruit and
- copra, and making ready the shelves of the stores for the new goods coming
- in from Auckland. All the residents, men and women, white and brown, are
- getting out the cleanest of muslins and drill suits, and looking up the
- shoe-whitening box, which perhaps has not been much in demand since the
- steamer called on her way back from Tahiti last month. The daughters of
- the white community are making tinned-peach pies, and dressing fowls, in
- case of callers&mdash;these are the inevitable &ldquo;company&rdquo; dishes of the
- Pacific&mdash;and the native women are bringing out their newly made straw
- hats, and, ironing their gayest of pink or yellow or scarlet cotton,
- squatting cross-legged on the floor as they work. Cocoanuts for drinking
- are being husked by the men of the village, and laid in neat piles under
- the verandahs, out of the sun; and in most of the little birdcage houses,
- the children are impounded to grate cocoanut meat for cream; while the
- dying yells of pigs make day hideous from the groves beyond the town.
- </p>
- <p>
- When the tiny trail of smoke, for which every one is looking, first rises
- out of the empty sea, it may be on the day expected, or it may be later&mdash;there
- is little time in the Great South Seas&mdash;the whole island is agape
- with excitement. The natives shriek with delight, and make haste to gather
- flowers for wreaths and necklaces; the clean suits and frocks are put on
- by brown and white alike, and the populace begins to hover about the wharf
- like a swarm of excited butterflies. The great whale-boats are ready to
- rush out at racing speed to the steamer, long before she comes to a stop
- in the bay&mdash;she dares not come into the harbour, which is only fit
- for small craft&mdash;passengers from Auckland come ashore, anxious to see
- the island curiosities, and find to their embarrassment that they are
- unmistakably regarded in that light themselves; and, as soon as may be,
- the mail comes after them. Upon which events, the whole population makes
- for the Government buildings, and flings itself in one seething breaker
- against the door of the Post Office, demanding its mails. While the
- letters are being sorted by a handful of officials locked and barred out
- of reach within, it rattles at the doors and windows, and as soon as the
- bolts are withdrawn, the mighty host, breathless and ruthless, bursts in
- like a besieging army. But when all are in, nobody has patience to wait
- and open papers, in order to know what has been going on in the outer
- world all these weeks. Purser, passengers, and even sailors are seized
- upon, and compelled to stand and deliver news about &ldquo;the war,&rdquo; and other
- burning questions, before any one thinks of opening the envelopes and
- wrappers in their hands.
- </p>
- <p>
- Minds being satisfied, bodies now assert their claim. Steamer day is feast
- day&mdash;beef day, ice day, day for enjoying all the eatables that cannot
- be had in the island itself. There is mutton in Raratonga, but not much at
- the best of times, and of beef there is none at all. So all the white folk
- order beef to come up monthly in the ship&rsquo;s cold storage, and for two
- happy days&mdash;the meat will keep no longer&mdash;they enjoy a feast
- that might perhaps more fairly be called a &ldquo;feed.&rdquo; About noon on steamer
- day, a savoury smell, to which the island has long been a stranger, begins
- to diffuse itself throughout Avarua. Every one, with true island
- hospitality, is asking every one else to lunch and dinner, to-day and
- to-morrow, so that Mrs. A. and her family may have a taste of Mr. B.&lsquo;s
- sirloin, and Mr. B. get a bit of the C.&lsquo;s consignment of steak, and the
- A.&lsquo;s and B.&lsquo;s and E.&lsquo;s enjoy a little bit of Colonel Z.&lsquo;s roast ribs. A
- sensuous, almost unctuous, happiness shines like a halo about every face,
- and after dusk white dinner coats flit up and down the perfumed avenues,
- thick as night-moths among the orange bloom overhead. Tomorrow there will
- be great doings in the pretty bungalow on the top of the hill, for the
- Resident Commissioner has got a big lump of ice as a present from the
- captain of the steamer, and is hoarding it up in blankets to give a
- dinner-party in its honour. The white man who could consume a lump of ice
- all by himself, in the island world, would be considered capable of any
- crime, and the hospitable Commissioner is the last person to shirk his
- obligations in such a matter.
- </p>
- <p>
- Once the steamer has come and gone, a dreamy peace settles down upon the
- island. There is seldom much certainty as to clock time, since every one
- goes by his own time-piece, and all vary largely, nor does any one heed
- the day of the month overmuch. This pleasant disregard of time is the true
- secret of the fascination of island life&mdash;or perhaps one of the
- secrets, since no one has ever really succeeded in defining the
- unspeakable charm of these lotus lands. Imagine a civilised community,
- where people dine out in evening dress, leave cards and have &ldquo;At Home&rdquo;
- days, yet where there is no post except the monthly ship mail, there are
- no telegrams, trains, trams, times, appointments, or engagements of any
- kind! Picture the peace that comes of knowing certainly that, for all the
- time of the steamer&rsquo;s absence there can be no disturbance of the even
- current of life; no great events at home or abroad, no haste, or worry, or
- responsibility! People keep young long in Raratonga; faces are free from
- weariness and strain; the white man with the &ldquo;burden&rdquo; laughs as merrily
- and as often as the brown man who carries nought but his flowery necklace
- and his pareo. Nobody is rich&mdash;rich men do not come down to the
- islands to run small plantations, or trading stores, or to take up little
- appointments under a little Government&mdash;but every one has enough, and
- extravagance is impossible, since luxuries are unpurchasable on the
- island. There are so social distinctions, save that between white and
- brown&mdash;all the seventy or eighty white residents knowing one another
- on a footing of common equality, although in England or even New Zealand,
- they would certainly be split up into half a score of mutually
- contemptuous sets.
- </p>
- <p>
- As for the natives&mdash;the jolly, laughing,-brown-skinned, handsome men
- and women of the island&mdash;their life is one long day of peace and
- leisure and plenty. The lands of the six thousand who once inhabited
- Raratonga are now for the most part in the hands of the nineteen hundred
- survivors, and every native has therefore a good deal more than he wants.
- Breadfruit; bananas of many kinds, oranges, mammee-apples, and countless
- other fruits, grow altogether, or almost, without cultivation; taro, yam,
- and sweet potatoes need little, and cocoanuts are always to be had. A
- native house can be put up in a day or two, furniture is superfluous, and
- clothes consist of a few yards of cotton print. The Raratongan, therefore,
- owes no tale of labour to Nature or Society for his existence in quiet
- comfort, if he does not choose to work. But in many cases he does choose,
- for he wants a buggy and a horse, and a bicycle or two, and a sewing
- machine for his wife; shoes with squeaking soles for festive wear&mdash;deliberately
- made up with &ldquo;squeakers&rdquo; for island trade, these&mdash;bottles of coarse
- strong scent, tins of meat and salmon as an occasional treat, and, if he
- is ambitious, one of those concrete, iron-roofed houses of which I have
- already spoken, to enhance his social position, and make the neighbours
- envious, what time he continues to live peaceably and comfortably in his
- palm hut outside&mdash;not being quite such a fool in this matter as he
- looks.
- </p>
- <p>
- Sometimes the Raratongan will go so far as to get his front teeth stopped
- with gold by a travelling dentist, purely for style, since he is gifted by
- nature with grinders that will smash any fruit stone, and incisors that
- will actually tear the close tough husk off a huge cocoanut without
- trouble. It is related of one of the wealthier Raratongans that, being
- stricken in years and short of teeth, he purchased a set of false ones
- from a visiting dentist, and that the latter, when he next returned to the
- island, was astonished to find the set thrown on his hands as no good, on
- the grounds that they would not husk cocoanuts!
- </p>
- <p>
- In order to secure all these more or less desirable luxuries, the
- Raratongan trades in fruit and copra. That is to say, he cuts up and dries
- (strictly at his leisure, and when he feels like it) a few thousand
- cocoanuts, or nails up some hundreds of oranges, and scores of banana
- bunches, from his overflowing acres, in wooden crates, to send down to
- Auckland. This labour, repeated a few times, brings him in good British
- gold by the handful. Copra, sold to the traders in the town, fetches about
- seven pounds a ton, and a family working for a few days can prepare as
- much as that. Other produce is hardly less profitable, to a cultivator who
- has more land than he wants, provides his own labour, and need spend
- nothing on seeds or plants. There is, at most, only light work, and that
- seldom, so that the Raratongan can, and often does, spend the greater part
- of his time singing in choruses on the verandahs of the houses, dancing to
- the thrilling beat of a native drum under the cocoanut trees, or fishing
- lazily off the reef.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Raratongans are all, to a man, good Christians&mdash;good Protestants
- of the Dissenting variety, good Catholics, and, in a few cases,
- enthusiastic Seventh Day Adventists&mdash;being readily enough inclined to
- adhere to a cult that makes it sinful to work on the seventh day of the
- week, and impossible to work on the first. It is said that Mormon
- missionaries have visited the group, but failed to make converts. Without
- going into details that might disturb the sensitive mind, one feels
- obliged to remark, in this connection, that the failure was probably on
- all fours, as to cause, with the ill-success of the merchant who attempted
- to sell coals to Newcastle.
- </p>
- <p>
- And&mdash;still concerning this matter&mdash;&ldquo;one word more, and I have
- done.&rdquo; Some weeks after my arrival, I was going round the group in company
- with the Resident Commissioner and a few more officials, who were holding
- courts and administering justice in the various islands. The Commissioner
- was late getting back to the ship one afternoon, and the captain asked him
- if he had been detained.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Only a little while,&rdquo; replied the guardian angel of the group, cheerfully
- rattling his pockets, which gave forth a pleasant chinking sound. &ldquo;Another
- dozen of divorces. We&rsquo;ll have a new road round the island next year.&rdquo; And
- he went to dinner.
- </p>
- <p>
- Divorce in the Cook Islands is not an expensive luxury. If memory serves
- me right, it costs under thirty shillings, and there is a sixpence
- somewhere in the price&mdash;I am unable to say why. But I remember very
- well indeed, after the officials had gone home, when I was travelling
- round about other islands with a captain, who had just taken over the ship
- and did not know the Cook group, that dignitary came to me one day and
- said:
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;I can&rsquo;t make out these hands of mine. They&rsquo;re a very decent lot for
- niggers, and don&rsquo;t give no trouble, but one and another, now that we&rsquo;re
- going round the islands, keeps coming to me and asking me for an advance
- on their wages, because, says they, they&rsquo;ve been a long time from home,
- and they wants it&mdash;and every blessed one of them he wants the same
- advance!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Was it so-and-so?&rdquo; I asked, mentioning a certain small sum with a
- sixpence in it.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;How on earth did you know?&rdquo; was the reply.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Price of a divorce from the Commissioner,&rdquo; I explained.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Well!&rdquo; said the captain, who was a hard-shelled old whaler, with a strong
- religious cast. And again&mdash;&ldquo;Well!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;That&rsquo;s what I think myself,&rdquo; I explained. &ldquo;But it certainly fills the
- exchequer. I hear the score runs up to ten or twelve apiece, often
- enough.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Disgustin&rsquo;,&rdquo; said the captain, spitting over the rail.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Certainly,&rdquo; I agreed.
- </p>
- <p>
- But the incident has its own significance, so I have recorded it.
- </p>
- <p>
- I linger long over the life and ways of Raratonga, for I spent many very
- happy weeks there&mdash;studying native customs, and taking notes? Well,
- perhaps&mdash;a little, at all events. Raratonga is not quite so lazy a
- place as Tahiti, and the climate is less trying. Still&mdash;still&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;
- </p>
- <p>
- How impossible it is to explain to the reader who has never spent a hot
- season in the tropics! I think I shall not try. There were missed
- opportunities&mdash;there were things I ought to have studied, and did
- not, and things I should have seen, and didn&rsquo;t see. It is of no use to say
- why. Those who have passed between the magic line of Cancer and Capricorn
- will not need to &lsquo;be told, and the others could not understand.
- </p>
- <p>
- I did something to satisfy my conscience, however, when I climbed the
- highest mountain in Raratonga&mdash;a peak something over three thousand
- feet high, so the residents said. It was reported that the Admiralty
- survey did not agree by a hundred feet or so, with the local estimate. I
- know myself that both were wrong; that peak is ten thousand, or perhaps a
- little more. Did it not take myself and two or three others from seven
- a.m. until nine p.m to get up and down, working as hard as white ants
- (there is nothing in the islands really busy except the ants) all the
- time?
- </p>
- <p>
- We went the wrong way&mdash;several wrong ways&mdash;we lost our food and
- our water, and got so thirsty that we licked the leaves of the trees, and
- so hungry that it was agony to know ourselves above the zone of the orange
- and banana all day, and see the food we could not reach till night hanging
- in clusters far below. We did most of our climbing by the heroic method of
- swarming up perpendicular rock faces on the ladders of the creepers, and a
- good deal of it by scrambling along in the tops of small trees, like
- monkeys. When we got to the top there was just room for the whole party to
- stand and cheer, and we cheered ourselves vigorously. People do not climb
- mountains&mdash;much&mdash;in the islands of the Pacific, and the peak we
- were on had been trodden by only one or two white men, and no white women.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;There used to be natives up here often enough, some years ago, shooting
- wild fowl,&rdquo; said one of our guides, letting the smoke of his pipe curl out
- over &ldquo;half a duchy,&rdquo; lying blue and green, and far, far down, under his
- elbow. &ldquo;But they stopped coming. Several of &rsquo;em got killed, and the
- others didn&rsquo;t think it good enough.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;How did they get killed?&rdquo; I ask, listening to the wild cocks crowing in
- the sea of green down below, like a farm-yard gone astray.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Oh, climbing!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- When we had finished admiring the view of the island, we started down
- again. And now, what with our hunger, and our fatigue, and the wild
- adventures in impossible places we had had coming up, we all became rather
- tired, and more than rather reckless. Over and over again, slithering down
- steep descents, we let ourselves go, and tobogganed, sitting, we did not
- care where. The lianas crashed, the red-flowered rata snapped and fell on
- us, the lace-like tree ferns got in our way with their damp black trunks,
- and banged us as we tumbled past. Every one knew that if we did not get
- off the precipice slopes before dark, we should have to halt wherever we
- might be, and wait till morning, holding tight to the trunk of a tree to
- keep from falling down into depths unknown. But no one said anything about
- it.
- </p>
- <p>
- And in the end, we got back safe&mdash;sore and tired and hungry; not
- thirsty, however, for we had found a stream in the interminable dark of
- the valley, and had all put our heads into it like brutes, the moment our
- feet felt the welcome hollow and splashed into the water. The ladies of
- the party had not a whole gown among them, and not very much else, so
- shrewdly had the thorns and creepers of the close-knitted forest squeezed
- and torn us. Still, we had got up where no white women had been before,
- and we were all very proud, though we had to slink homeward in the dark,
- avoiding the lights of the houses, and each slip in unobserved at the back
- doors of our respective homes. But we had done the climb, and&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;
- &ldquo;That was something,&rdquo; as Hans Andersen would have said.
- </p>
- <p>
- Picnics we had in plenty, while I stayed. Sometimes they were bathing
- picnics, when the ladies of half a dozen houses went off to spend the day
- down on the shore, and swim in the lagoon. The water, not more than five
- feet deep in any place, was the colour of green grass when the sun shines
- through, and it was as warm as an ordinary hot bath. One could spend hour
- after hour amusing Oneself with swimming tricks, coming out now and then
- to roast for a little on the hot, snow-white coral sand, where bits and
- branches of coral pretty enough for a museum lay scattered everywhere, and
- exquisite flowering creepers spread their long green tails of leafage&mdash;often
- thirty or forty, feet in length, and all starred with pink or yellow
- blossoms&mdash;right across the broad expanse of the beach. Coming out
- finally, it was customary to find a big rock, and stand-with one&rsquo;s back
- against it till the wet bathing dress was half dried with the blistering
- heat of the stone. This was supposed to prevent chills. I think myself
- that one would have to hunt a chill very hard indeed in the hot season in
- Raratonga, before catching it. It is not a place where one hears of
- &ldquo;chill&rdquo; troubles, and there is no fever of any kind. When you find a
- draught there, you tell every one else in the house about it, and they
- come and sit in it with you. When you give tea, to callers, it is correct
- to serve cold water on the tray to temper the beverage, and put a spoon
- instead of a butter knife, in the butter dish.
- </p>
- <p>
- Nor does it cool down overmuch at night, in the hot months, though in the
- &ldquo;cold&rdquo; ones, you may want a blanket now and then. The temperature being so
- equable all round, chills are, naturally, not to be looked for and feared
- at every turn, as in the great tropic continents, where there is no
- surrounding sea to prevent rapid radiation of heat, and sudden changes of
- temperature are frequent and deadly. On the whole, there is much to be
- said in favour of the climate of the Southern Pacific, and little against
- it. It enjoys a long cool season of at least six months, when the heat is
- not at all oppressive. Three months of the year are very hot and damp, and
- three neither hot nor cool. At worst, the thermometer seldom goes above
- ninety in the shade. White children can be brought up in the islands
- without injury to health, and many of the older residents have spent the
- best part of a long life in the South Seas, and attained to a venerable
- age, without ever suffering from illness. The Government doctor in
- Raratonga leads an easy life on the whole, and in the other islands of the
- Cook Group the entire absence of medical advice seems to trouble no one.
- </p>
- <p>
- A reefing picnic was among the many pleasant entertainments to which I was
- invited during my stay. &ldquo;Reefing&rdquo; is such a favourite entertainment in the
- islands that nearly every white woman has a reefing skirt and shoes in her
- wardrobe&mdash;the former short, like a hockey skirt, the latter stout and
- old. Buggies are gathered together in the town, and the picnickers drive
- to a suitable spot some distance away, where the horses are taken out and
- tethered, and the &ldquo;reefers&rdquo; secure a canoe to bring them to their
- destination&mdash;the coral barrier reef, lying between the lagoon and the
- sea.
- </p>
- <p>
- Paddled by some of the native guests (for there are generally a few
- Raratongans included in the party) the canoes glide easily over the
- shallow water towards the reef, flights of the exquisite little
- sapphire-coloured fish that haunt the coral rocks, scattering beneath the
- keel like startled butterflies. Now the water is of the most vivid and
- burning emerald, shooting green lightnings to the sun, now, as we near the
- reef, it begins to change in colour, and&mdash;&mdash;-
- </p>
- <p>
- Oh!
- </p>
- <p>
- Why, the canoe is floating on a liquid rainbow&mdash;on a casket of jewels
- melted down and poured into the burning sea&mdash;on glancing shades of
- rose, and quivering gleams of violet, and gold and blue and amethyst and
- chrysophrase, all trembling and melting one into another in marvels of
- colouring that leave all language far behind. Under the keel, as we shoot
- forward, rise and sink wonderful water-bouquets of purple, pink, and
- pearl; great lacy fans of ivory; frilled and fluted fairy shells,
- streamers of brilliant weed, and under and through all these wonders
- glint, from far below, the dark blue depths of unplumbed caverns beneath.
- It is the coral reef, and we are going to land upon a spot exposed by the
- tide, and see what we can see of these wonders, by-and-by. If we were bent
- on fishing, we might spend a pleasant hour or two catching some of these
- peacock and parrot-coloured fish that flutter through these wonderful
- water-gardens. But reefing proper is more amusing, after all.
- </p>
- <p>
- At a point where the coral juts out above the sea, we leave the canoe, and
- start to walk about. It is very like trying to walk on a gigantic
- petrified hair-brush. The coral is peaked and pointed, and wrought into
- honeycombed sponges of stone, and there is nowhere for the foot to rest in
- security. Besides, the reef is covered with sea urchins possessing spines
- as long and sharp as a big slate-pencil, and these things pierce through
- any but the stoutest shoes. The colours of the sea-urchins are
- fascinating, and we pick up a good many, in spite of difficulties. Then
- there are tiger shells, shiny and spotted, in hues of orange and brown,
- and beautiful scarlet and pinky and lilac and chequered shells, and the
- daintiest of goffered clam shells, pearl white within, ivory white
- without, as large as a pea-pod, or as large as a vegetable dish&mdash;you
- may take your choice. And, if you are lucky, there is a varnished brown
- snail shell that you would not think worth picking up, if you did not
- happen to know that it has a &ldquo;peacock-eye&rdquo; gem, good to set in brooches,
- inside its plain little front door&mdash;like the homely brown toad of
- fable, that carried a jewel in its head. Much other spoil there is to put
- in your basket, and many things that you have no desire to possess at all&mdash;among
- them the huge hanks of slimy black string, which are alive, and
- wrigglesome, and not at all pleasant to put your hand on&mdash;and the
- wicked-faced great eels that look suddenly out of holes, and vanish,
- bubbling; and the revolting, leprous-spotted fish with the spiny back,
- that one may chance to see lurking at the bottom of a pool, every spine
- charged full of deadly poison for whoever touches it with unwary foot or
- hand. Indeed, the friends who are with you will warn you not to put your
- fingers into any pool, but to hook out shells and other spoil with a
- stick, if you want to be really careful, for there, are as many stinging
- and biting things among the beauties of the coral reef, as there thorns in
- a bed of roses.
- </p>
- <p>
- I have secured a good many shells, and a Reckitt&rsquo;s blue star-fish as big
- as a dinner-plate, and one or two other curiosities, and now I want, above
- everything else, one of those miraculous coral bouquets that bloom so
- temptingly just beneath the surface at this point. One of my friends asks
- me which I will have&mdash;with a smile, that, somehow or other, seems to
- amuse the rest. I select a pinky-violet one, and with some dragging and
- pounding, it is detached, and held up in the sun.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Oh!&rdquo; I exclaim disappointedly, and every one laughs. The beautiful bunch
- of coral flowers is a dirty liver-colour, and the magical hues are gone.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;It&rsquo;s the water that gives the colours,&rdquo; explains the coral-gatherer.
- &ldquo;Every one is awfully disappointed about it.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Are there no colours at all, then?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Oh yes, a little shade of pinkiness, and a touch of green, and that
- purply-brown. But you should see the corals when they are cleaned and
- dried. You&rsquo;d better have these, you won&rsquo;t know them when they are
- bleached; they&rsquo;re like spider&rsquo;s webs and lace furbelow things, all in
- white.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Is there none of the real red stuff?&rdquo; I ask somewhat ruefully, balancing
- myself with difficulty upon a sort of ornamental sponge-basket of spiky
- coral.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Not here. All these volcanic islands have a ring of coral reef right
- round, but the coral is always the white kind. There&rsquo;s a very little red
- coral in Samoa, and about Penrhyn, I believe. But, speaking generally,
- it&rsquo;s all white in the Pacific.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- I think of the dreams of my childhood, and the delightful pictures of
- palmy islands circled round with a chevaux-de-frise of high spiky red
- coral, which used to flit before my fancy on holiday afternoons. It is
- true that the cold practicalities of the <i>Voyage of the Challenger</i>,
- which somebody gave me in my &ldquo;flapper&rdquo; days, once and for all, to my
- bitter disappointment, knocked the bottom out of those cherished schemes
- of going away to live on something like a glorified coral necklace, some
- day. But I wonder, as I get into the canoe again, and glide shorewards and
- teawards, paddled by the swift brown arms of native girls, how many
- grown-up people still hold to that delightful fancy, not knowing that it
- is as impossible to realise as a dream of rambling in the moon?
- </p>
- <p>
- Tea is preparing on the shore when we get back, very wet and dirty, but
- very well pleased. The native girls among the guests immediately offer us
- spare dresses. It is the mode among Raratongans to take two or three
- dresses to a picnic, and retire every now and then into the bush to change
- one smart muslin or cotton &ldquo;Mother Hubbard&rdquo; for another&mdash;just for
- pure style. So there are plenty of clothes to spare, and in a minute or
- two the damp, sea-weedy &ldquo;reefers&rdquo; are fitted out with flowing garments of
- clean cambric and silk, of a mode certainly better adapted to the climate
- than the fitted garments of the &ldquo;papalangi.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- This question of dress is a burning one among island ladies. The native
- loose robe, hung straight down from a yoke, is very much cooler, and the
- doctors say, healthier, than belted and corseted dresses such as European
- women wear. But there is nevertheless a strong feeling against it, because
- it is supposed to mean a tendency to &ldquo;go native,&rdquo; and the distinguishing
- customs of the race acquire, in the island world, a significance quite out
- of proportion to their surface importance, because of the greatness of the
- thing they represent. Therefore, the white woman, unless she is suffering
- from bad health, and needs every possible help to withstand the heat of
- the climate, sticks to her blouses and corsets, as a rule, and sometimes
- &ldquo;says things&rdquo; about people who do not. For all that, and all that, the
- native woman is in the right, and if the other would agree to adopt the
- pretty, womanly, and essentially graceful robe of the native, no one would
- be the loser, and half of island humanity would be greatly the gainer.
- </p>
- <p>
- Later, when the dusk is coming down, and the magic moon of the islands is
- creeping, big and round and yellow-gold, out of a purple sea, we drive
- home again through the scented gloom of the forest, the endless song of
- the reef accompanying the voices of the native women, as they chant
- strange island melodies of long ago, that no one in these days, not even
- the singers themselves, can fully translate or understand. The moon climbs
- quickly up as we drive, and the road is as light as day, when our wheels
- roll into the sleeping town.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0006" id="link2HCH0006"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER VI
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>The Simple Life in the South Seas&mdash;Servant Problems again&mdash;Foods
- and Fruits of the Country&mdash;The Tree that digests&mdash;Home-made
- Vanilla&mdash;The Invaluable Lime&mdash;How to cook a Turtle&mdash;In an
- Island Bungalow&mdash;The Little House on the Coral Shore&mdash;Humours of
- Island Life&mdash;Burying a Cycle&mdash;A Network of Names&mdash;Mr.
- Zebedee-Thunderstorm-Tin-Roof&mdash;The Night-dress that went to Church&mdash;The
- Extraordinary Wedding&mdash;South Sea Musicians&mdash;A Conductor&rsquo;s
- Paradise&mdash;Society Journalism in Song.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">H</span>OUSEKEEPING in the
- South Sea Islands demands a section to itself. All who are uninterested in
- such matters may, and doubtless will, begin to skip at this point.
- </p>
- <p>
- Nothing helps the white house-mistress more than the simple standard of
- living set in most of the islands. It is true that if you are the wife of
- an important official in the Government House entourage of Fiji, or if you
- live in civilised, Americanised Honolulu, you will have to &ldquo;do things&rdquo;
- much as they are done at home. But, with these two exceptions, life in
- that enormous section of the globe known as the South Seas (much of it, by
- the way,&mdash;is north of the Line) is simple and unpretentious. In
- describing the home life of the white settlers in Raratonga, I describe
- what is, with small local variations, the life of settlers in almost every
- group of the Pacific, certainly, the life of all in the eight different
- groups I visited myself, during the years I spent in the South Seas. All
- over the island world, people dine in the middle of the day, except when
- entertaining friends, keep few servants or none, and dress and feed
- simply, because nothing else is possible. The trade cottons in the stores
- form the material of every lady&rsquo;s dresses, and as for the making, common
- consent, not to speak of climatic conditions, votes the simplest style the
- best. Where every stitch of sewing in dress or blouse must be done by the
- person who is to wear the garment, it is astonishing how soon one grows to
- regard elaborate tuckings, flouncings, inlayings, with hostility, and how
- satisfied the eye becomes with the simpler and less &ldquo;fatigued&rdquo; lines of
- the garments fashioned by women who cannot hire a dressmaker for love or
- money. Evening dress is almost always of the &ldquo;blouse&rdquo; description, and in
- a climate which works universal mischief with delicate white skins, no
- matter how they are protected, this is no matter for regret. Men buy their
- drill suits ready-made from the trading stores at a few shillings apiece,
- and, with a white dinner-jacket and black cummerbund, any one is ready for
- the gayest of evening entertainments.
- </p>
- <p>
- The great dress question&mdash;being thus resolved into the simple
- elements of a few cotton frocks for every day, and a muslin or two for
- best, behold! half the worry of modern life is lifted at a blow. &ldquo;One must
- look like other people&rdquo;&mdash;the goad of the toiling townswoman&mdash;becomes
- in the islands, &ldquo;One looks like other people because one must,&rdquo; and the
- words are a lullaby of rest.
- </p>
- <p>
- After dress, comes servants, in the list of small worries that turn a
- woman&rsquo;s fair locks grey, and swell the takings of the fashionable
- hairdressers. Well, it cannot be said that there is no servant trouble in
- the islands. White servants simply do not exist; they are far too much in
- demand in America and Australasia to desert either of these domestic
- paradises for the hotter and lonelier islands. Native girls cannot be had
- either, since they marry at thirteen or thereabouts. Native boys and men
- are the only resource. They come to work by the day, and are fed in the
- house; their wages are generally about five shillings weekly, in the case
- of a boy, and ten shillings for a man. So far as they go, they are
- satisfactory enough; they work hard, and are extremely honest, and they
- are amiability and good-nature itself. But their scope is decidedly
- limited. They can garden, under direction; they can sweep, fetch wood and
- water, clean the cooking-stove, husk and open the cocoanuts, wash, peel
- and boil the vegetables, scrub the verandah floor, clean the knives, wash
- up dishes, and whiten the shoes. That is about all. The mistress of the
- house and her daughters, if she is lucky enough to have any, must do all
- the serious cooking, make the beds, dust, tidy, and lay the table for
- meals.
- </p>
- <p>
- One cannot say, however, that health suffers from the necessity of doing a
- certain amount of housework every day. On the contrary, the white women of
- the islands are strong and handsome, and do not seem to suffer from the
- heat nearly so much as the semi-invalid ladies who have come to be
- regarded as the type of white womanhood in India, that paradise of
- excellent service and servants.
- </p>
- <p>
- Otherwise, the islands help out the housekeeper considerably. She can grow
- as much excellent coffee as the family are likely to want, on a few bushes
- in the back yard, and peppers only have to be pulled off the nearest wild
- chili tree. Taro, yam, sweet potato, can be bought from the natives for a
- trifle, or grown with very little trouble. There will probably be enough
- breadfruit, mango, orange, lime, and mammee-apple in the grounds of the
- house, to supply all the family needs, and if any one likes chestnuts,
- they can be picked up under the huge maupei trees along any road. The
- mammee-apple or paw-paw, mentioned above, is one of the most
- characteristic fruits of the islands. In Raratonga, it grows with
- extraordinary fertility, springing up of itself wherever scrub is cleared
- away, and coming to maturity in a few months. It is a slender palm-like
- tree, from ten to thirty feet high, with a quaintly scaled trunk, very
- like the skin of some great serpent, and a crown of pointed, pinnated
- leaves, raying out fanwise from the cluster of heavy green and yellow
- fruit that hangs in the centre. The fruit itself is rather like a small
- melon, though wider at one end than the other. It looks likes a melon,
- too, when cut open, and is both refreshing and satisfying, with a
- sweetish, musky flavour, The small, soft black seeds in the centre are a
- sovereign cure for dyspepsia, as is also the fruit itself in a lesser
- degree. The whole of this wonderful tree, indeed, seems to be possessed of
- digestive powers, for the toughest fowl or piece of salt beef will become
- tender in a few hours, if wrapped in its leaves. When boiled in the green
- stage the fruit is undistinguishable from vegetable marrow, and if cooked
- ripe, with a little lime juice, it can be made into a mock apple pie, much
- appreciated by settlers in a land where the typical British fruit cannot
- be grown.
- </p>
- <p>
- Cooking bananas are much used, and grow wild on the lands of the natives,
- who sell them for a trifle. Every house has its own patch of eating
- bananas of many kinds, and orange-trees are almost sure to be there as
- well. There is always a huge bunch of bananas, and two or three great
- palm-leaf baskets of oranges, on the verandah of every house, and the
- inmates consume them both in uncounted numbers all day. Pineapples are
- easily raised in the little bit of garden, or they can be bought for a
- penny a piece. A vanilla vine will probably spread its beautiful thick
- leaves over the fence, and hang out, in due season, a store of pods for
- flavouring use in the kitchens. Arrowroot may be grown or bought&mdash;a
- big basket sells for sixpence, and it has no more to do with the arrowroot
- of the grocer&rsquo;s shop at home, than a real seal mantle worth three figures
- has to do with a two guinea &ldquo;electric&rdquo;. Limes grow wild everywhere, and
- the island housewife makes full use of them. They clean her floors, her
- tables, her enamelled ware, stained table linen, or marked clothing; they
- wash her hair delightfully, and take the sunburn off her face and hands;
- they make the best of &ldquo;long drinks,&rdquo; and the daintiest of cake flavouring,
- they are squeezed into every fruit salad, and over every stew; they take
- the place of vinegar, if the island stores run low; in truth, they are
- used for almost every purpose of domestic cooking, cleaning, or chemistry.
- </p>
- <p>
- Cabbage of an excellent kind grows wild in a few islands. Tomatoes, small
- but excellent in flavour, are found on the borders of the seashore, in
- many. Nearly all English vegetables are grown by the white settlers with
- extremely little trouble. The egg-plant, known in England as a greenhouse
- ornament, here thrives splendidly in gardens, and instead of the little
- plum-like fruit of the British plant, produces a great purple globe as big
- as a fine marrow, which resembles fried eggs very closely, if sliced and
- cooked in a pan. But in truth there is no limit to the richness and
- generosity of the island soil. Were it not for the troublesome item of
- butcher&rsquo;s meat, housekeeping in the Pacific would be marvellously cheap
- and easy. That, however, is the housekeeper&rsquo;s bugbear. Outside of Samoa,
- Fiji, Tonga, Tahiti, the Marquesas, and Honolulu, fresh beef is not be had
- at all, and fresh mutton not often. In very many islands tinned meat and
- fowls are the only resource; and the lady of the house must tax her
- ingenuity to the utmost to find ways of disguising the inevitable &ldquo;tin.&rdquo;
- Curry, stew, pie, mince; mince, pie, stew, curry&mdash;so runs the
- monotonous programme in most houses; and disguise it as one may, the trail
- of the tin is over it all.
- </p>
- <p>
- It is a great day in the islands when turtle are caught. They are not
- common in the groups frequented by white people, since they prefer the
- lonely, barren atolls where the soil is dry and infertile; but now and
- then a &ldquo;school&rdquo; is found, and a big catch made. Then there is rejoicing in
- the land, and cooking in every house of an uncommonly-liberal and
- elaborate kind. The South Sea turtle are enormous, often weighing as much
- as seven or eight hundred pounds, and occasionally touching the thousand.
- Such a monster as this would easily feed a large household for a week&mdash;but
- alas, in tropical climates fresh meat, even when scalded, will not keep
- more than three days; so a good deal is usually wasted. The famous turtle
- soup, is made from the flippers, which are full of gelatine; and it may
- safely be assumed that no London aldermen fed on dying creatures carried
- half across the world has ever tasted soup so good as that made from a
- fine healthy turtle just out of the sea. The grass-green fat of the upper
- shell is used to put in the soup, and to fry the thick steaks of turtle
- beef, also to baste the big roast of turtle meat that is generally a
- feature of a turtle dinner. The eggs (of which there will probably be a
- large bucketful at least) are fried in green fat, and eaten as they are,
- shell-less, crisp and golden, tasting rather like roast chestnut. The
- tripe is cooked like ordinary tripe; the liver is fried. An excellent
- dinner, but surely an indigestible one? By no means. It is a curious
- property of this turtle meat that a much larger quantity of it can be
- eaten than of any ordinary butcher&rsquo;s meat, without any sense of repletion
- or after ill effects. This is the great dainty of the South Sea islands,
- and if to a turtle dinner be added bisque soup made from mountain river
- crayfish, a real island fruit salad, with lime juice and cocoanut cream, a
- freshly plucked pineapple, a dish of mangoes, granadillas, and a cup of
- island-grown coffee, not the Carlton or the Savoy could do better for a
- travelling prince.
- </p>
- <p>
- All South Sea Island &ldquo;white&rdquo; houses are more or less alike, being built of
- coral concrete (occasionally of wood) and fitted with imported windows and
- doors. The verandah is the great feature of the building; for there the
- family will probably spend most of their time, reading, smoking, receiving
- callers, or simply lounging in long chairs and listening to the monotonous
- singing of the natives in the thatched reed houses near at hand. Splendid
- climbing plants wreathe the pillars and sloping roofs of these verandahs&mdash;stephanotis,
- Bougainvillea, and countless gay tropical flowers whose ugly Latin names
- only an accomplished botanist could remember. Gardenias, gorgeous white
- trumpet lilies, tall bushes of begonia; pink, yellow and scarlet hibiscus,
- crimson poinsettia, delicate eucharis lilies, run riot about the grounds,
- and orange and lemon flowers fill the air with an exquisite perfume.
- </p>
- <p>
- Within, the high-pitched, deep, church-like roof rises above a range of
- partition walls separating the different rooms, but giving a common air
- supply to all, since the dividing walls are not more than ten or twelve
- feet high. There are no secrets in an island house; what any one says at
- one end can be heard at the other, and a light burning late in anybody&rsquo;s
- bedroom keeps all the rest awake. In the older houses the roof is of &ldquo;rau&rdquo;
- or plaited pandanus thatch, of a soft brown tone, delightfully cool and
- exceedingly picturesque. The rafters, in such a house, will be almost
- black with age, and beautifully latticed and patterned with finely plaited
- &ldquo;sinnet&rdquo; (cocoanut fibre). More modern houses have corrugated iron roofs,
- generally painted red. The water supply from these roofs is of some
- importance, and they are less expense and trouble than the thatch; but the
- latter is incomparably the more picturesque, and a good deal the cooler as
- well.
- </p>
- <p>
- The floor is always covered with native matting (pandanus leaf, split and
- plaited). This is of a pleasant tan colour in tone, and very cool and
- clean. The furniture is generally basket and bamboo, with a native &ldquo;tappa&rdquo;
- cloth (of which I shall have more to say later on) on the table. There are
- sure to be groups of old native weapons on the walls&mdash;lances and
- spears and clubs and arrows&mdash;and a few island fans, arranged in
- trophies, and garlanded with chains of shells. On the steps of the
- verandah one usually finds a fern or two, planted in big white clam-shells
- off the reef, and there may be others in the drawing-room.&rsquo; A piano is a
- great luxury; the island climate is not kind to pianos. Harmoniums are
- more common.
- </p>
- <p>
- The bedrooms may have ordinary beds imported from Auckland, or they may
- have (what is quite as good) native bedsteads made of ironwood, laced
- across with sinnet, and covered with soft pandanus leaf mats, over which
- the under sheet is laid. Unless it is the cool season there will not be a
- blanket. Mosquito curtains, of course, protect each bed. All windows and
- doors are wide open, day or night, hot season or cool.
- </p>
- <p>
- The South Sea housekeeper has a few insect plagues to fight against, but
- not nearly so many as her sister in India or Jamaica. The ants eat
- everything that is not hung or covered up. Enormous hornets, in the cool
- season, lurk about ceilings, bookcases and cupboards, sleepy, cross, and
- ready to dart a fearful sting, if accidentally touched. Cockroaches are
- destructive at all times. Fleas do not trouble much, and flies are only
- annoying in a few islands. Mosquitoes are troublesome in the hot season,
- but give little annoyance at other times. Centipedes and scorpions exist,
- but are not common. They do come into houses occasionally, and (being very
- poisonous, though not deadly) frighten the inmates quite as much as the
- inmates undoubtedly frighten them. It is the rarest possible thing,
- however, to hear of a European being bitten.
- </p>
- <p>
- Education is not an unsolvable problem in the islands, since quite a large
- number of groups possess convent schools, where even such extras as music,
- languages, and fancy needlework can be taught.
- </p>
- <p>
- On the whole, the difficulties of housekeeping are somewhat less than at
- home, and the cost certainly much smaller. It is true that a good many
- tinned stuffs are used, and tinned food is always dear; but the cheapness
- of everything that the soil produces makes up that difference, and the
- simple standard of living swings the balance still further to the right
- side. I am of opinion myself that white families would benefit both in
- comfort and in pocket by adopting the native style of house, which is, as
- already mentioned, a structure of small neat sticks or poles set very
- closely and strongly, but not filled in. The roof is always thatched. In
- such a house, the air circulates freely without any draught, and there is
- a pleasant, diffused light during the daytime. At night, when native
- houses are more or less transparent, the privacy-loving white can draw
- thin cotton curtains across his walls until the lights are put out.
- </p>
- <p>
- One such house, built for and used by white people, was conspicuous for
- the simple beauty of the design. The interior was very plainly furnished
- with a few bamboo tables and chairs, and a light stretcher bed or two. Its
- curtains were of printed muslin from the store, and its floor was nothing
- but white coral sand brought from the beach. The house stood sheltered, by
- tall palms, and the sea was so near that all day one could watch the soft
- sparkle of the creaming surf through the half-transparent walls, and all
- night long one slept to the matchless lullaby of the humming reef.
- </p>
- <p>
- <i>(Windows blurred with beating mud, grey London roaring by in the rain;
- haggard faces, and murky summer, and the snake of custom clipping
- stranglingly about the free man&rsquo;s throat&mdash;O Island wanderer, back in
- the weary North, does your sea-bird&rsquo;s heart fly swift from these to those,
- and-sicken for the lands where you must go no more?)</i>
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <p>
- Raratonga is full of funny things, if one knows where to look for them.
- One would not suppose that the tombs of the natives were a likely spot.
- Yet I would defy the most serious of graveyard moralisers to count over
- the list of things that the Raratongan buries in the tombs of his departed
- relatives, without feeling his seriousness badly shaken. Little household
- ornaments belonging to the deceased are pathetic, certainly; so, in a
- lesser degree, are the Sunday clothes that often accompany their wearer on
- the long journey. But what is one to say of bicycles, Japanned bedsteads,
- and even pianos? All these things have been buried by Raratongans in the
- big concreted tombs that crop up sociably along the edges of the public
- road every here and there. The piano, I must add, was dug up again, by
- order of an indignant missionary, who gave the disconsolate mourners a
- good lecture on heathenistic practices, and the necessity of drawing the
- line somewhere.
- </p>
- <p>
- Native names are sometimes exceedingly funny to the perverted white mind,
- although to the owners they may be dignified, poetic, and even beautiful.
- One young coffee-coloured lady of my acquaintance had been named (in
- Raratongan) &ldquo;Cup-of-Tea.&rdquo; Another was &ldquo;Box-with-a-Hole-in-It&rdquo;&mdash;another
- &ldquo;Tin-of-Meat.&rdquo; I should suppose, from my knowledge of their religious
- training, that each of these ladies possessed a godly scripture name of
- her own, properly bestowed on her at her proper baptism. But in the Cook
- Islands, the name a native is christened by, and the name he or she goes
- by, are almost always distinct, which is certainly confusing. Worse
- confusion still is caused by the odd habit of changing these commonly
- accepted names on any great occasion that seems to need special
- commemoration. The natives themselves never seem to become puzzled over
- all these name-changes, but so much can hardly be said of the whites. It
- is, at the least, perplexing to employ a gardener called Zebedee by the
- missionaries, Thunderstorm by his friends, and Tin Roof by his relatives&mdash;like
- the notable character in <i>The Hunting of the Snark</i>,
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- Whose intimate friends called him Candle-Ends,
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- And his enemies Toasted Cheese.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p>
- But it is even worse to be informed&mdash;some day, when you go to look
- after Zebedee-Thunderstorm-Tin Roof down in the village, and ask why he
- has not turned up to weed your pineapples&mdash;that his name isn&rsquo;t any of
- the three, but &ldquo;Barbed Wire,&rdquo; because he has just finished putting up a
- fence of barbed wire round the grave of his boy who died last year, and
- has resolved to call himself henceforth, &ldquo;Barbed Wire,&rdquo; in memory of his
- son!
- </p>
- <p>
- Native notions about European clothes often provide a feast of fun for the
- whites, who set the copies in dress.
- </p>
- <p>
- When a lace-trimmed garment of mine, usually reserved for private wear
- under the shades of night and the shelter of a quilt and sheet, went to
- Sunday morning church as a best dress in full daylight, on the person of
- the laundress who had been entrusted with my clothes for the wash, the
- funny side of the affair was so much the more conspicuous, that the
- borrower never got the reproof she certainly ought to have had. And when a
- certain flower toque, made of poppies (a blossom unknown to the Pacific)
- first drove the women of the island half-distracted with excitement, and
- then led to thirty-six native ladies appearing simultaneously at a dance
- in Makea&rsquo;s grounds, wearing most excellent copies of my Paris model, done
- in double scarlet hibiscus from the bush, the natural outrage to my
- feelings (which every woman who has ever owned a &ldquo;model&rdquo; will understand)
- was quite swallowed up in the intense amusement that the incident caused
- to everybody on the grounds.
- </p>
- <p>
- I was unfortunate enough to be away on the island schooner when a great
- wedding took place&mdash;the nuptials of one of the queen&rsquo;s nieces&mdash;and
- so missed the finest display of native dress and custom that had occurred
- during the whole year. The bride, I heard, wore fourteen silk dresses&mdash;not
- all at once, but one after the other, changing her dress again and again
- during the reception that followed the wedding ceremony in the mission
- church, until she almost made the white spectators giddy.
- </p>
- <p>
- The presents were &ldquo;numerous and costly&rdquo; from the guests to the bride, and
- from the bride to the guests, for it is Raratongan custom to give presents
- to the people who come to your wedding; a fashion that would considerably
- alleviate the lot of the weary wedding guest, if only it could be
- introduced over here. The gifts for the bride were carried in by the
- givers, and flung down in a heap one by one, each being duly announced by
- the person making the present, who showed no false modesty in describing
- his contribution. &ldquo;Here&rsquo;s twenty yards of the most beautiful print for
- Mata (the bride), from Erri Puno!&rdquo; &ldquo;Here&rsquo;s three baskets of arrowroot, the
- best you ever saw, for Mata, from Taoua.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Here&rsquo;s eighteen-pence for Mata and Tamueli, from Ruru,&rdquo; flinging the
- coins loudly into a china plate. So the procession went on, until the
- gifts were all bestowed, the bride meanwhile standing behind a kind of
- counter, and rapidly handing out rolls of stuff, tins of food, ribbons,
- gimcracks of various kinds, to her guests as they passed by. When all is
- added up, the amusement seems to be about all that any one really clears
- out of the whole proceeding.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Cook Islanders are among the most musical of Pacific races. They have
- no musical instruments, unless &ldquo;trade&rdquo; mouth-organs, accordions, and jew&rsquo;s
- harps may be classed as such, but they need none, in their choral singing,
- which is indescribably grand and impressive. Here as elsewhere in the
- islands, one traces distinctly the influence of the two dominant sounds of
- the island world&mdash;the low droning of the reef, and the high soft
- murmur of the trade wind in the palms. The boom of the breakers finds a
- marvellously close echo in the splendid volume of the men&rsquo;s voices, which
- are bass for the most part, and very much more powerful and sonorous than
- anything one hears in the country of the &ldquo;superior&rdquo; race. The women&rsquo;s
- voices are somewhat shrill, but they sound well enough as one usually
- hears them, wandering wildly in and out of the massive harmonies of the
- basses.
- </p>
- <p>
- A Philharmonic conductor from the isles of the North would surely think
- himself in heaven, if suddenly transported to these southern isles of
- melody and song. The Pacific native is born with harmony in his throat,
- and time in his very pulses. It is as natural to him to sing as to
- breathe; and he simply cannot go out of time if he tries. Solo singing
- does not attract him at all; music is above all things a social function,
- in his opinion, and if he can get a few others&mdash;or better still, a
- few score others&mdash;to sit down with him on the ground, and begin a
- chorus, he is happy for hours, and so are they.
- </p>
- <p>
- To the Pacific traveller, this endless chanting is as much a part of the
- island atmosphere as the palms and the reef and the snowy coral strand
- themselves. One comes, in time, to notice it hardly more than the choral
- song of beating breaker and long trade wind, to which it is so wonderfully
- akin. But at the first, wonder is continually awakened by the incomparable
- volume of the voices, and the curious booming sound&mdash;like the echo
- that follows the striking of some gigantic bell&mdash;which characterises
- the bass register of island men&rsquo;s singing. The swing and entrain of the
- whole performance are intoxicating&mdash;the chorus, be it ten or a
- thousand voices, sweeps onward as resistlessly as a cataract, and the beat
- of the measure is like the pulse of Father Time himself. There are several
- parts as a rule, but they wander in and out of one another at will, and
- every now and then a single voice will break away, and embroider a little
- improvisation upon the melody that is like a sudden scatter of spray from
- the crest of a rolling breaker. Then the chorus takes it up and answers
- it, and the whole mass of the voices hurls itself upon the tune like the
- breaker falling and bursting upon the shore.
- </p>
- <p>
- It is very wonderful, and very lovely; yet there are times&mdash;at one in
- the morning, let us say, when the moon has crept round from one side of
- the mosquito curtain to the other since one lay down, and the bats have
- finished quarrelling and gone home, and the comparative chill of the small
- hours is frosting the great green flags of the bananas outside the window
- with glimmering dew&mdash;when the white traveller, musical or unmusical,
- may turn over on an uneasy couch, and curse the native love of melody,
- wondering the while if the people in the little brown houses down the road
- ever sleep at all?
- </p>
- <p>
- What are the subjects of the songs? That is more than the natives
- themselves can tell you, very often, and certainly much more than a
- wandering traveller, here to-day, and gone next month, could say. Many of
- the chants are traditional, so old that the customs they refer to are not
- half remembered, and full of words that have passed out of use. A good
- number now-a-days are religious, consisting of hymns and psalms taught by
- the missionaries, and improved on, as to harmony and setting, by the
- native. The island love of choral singing must be an immense assistance to
- the church services, since it turns these latter into a treat, instead of
- a mere duty, and the native can never get enough church, so long as there
- is plenty of singing for him to do. Some of the secular songs are
- understood to refer to the deeds of ancestors; some are amatory; some&mdash;and
- those the most easily understood by white people who know the native
- languages&mdash;are in the nature of a kind of society journal, recording
- the important events of the last few days, and making comments, often of a
- very free nature, on friends and enemies, and the white people of the
- island. Most of these latter are not good enough scholars to understand
- the chants, even if they can talk a little native, which is just as well,
- when oratorios of this kind are to be heard every evening among the &ldquo;rau&rdquo;
- roofed huts:
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- &ldquo;Big-Nose who lives in the white house has got a new
- </p>
- <p class="indent20">
- suit of clothes.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- Chorus. &ldquo;A new suit of clothes, a new suit, suit, suit of
- </p>
- <p class="indent20">
- clothes!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- &ldquo;Big-Nose cannot fasten the coat, he is so fat, ai! ai,
- </p>
- <p class="indent20">
- fat like a pig fit for killing!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- Chorus. &ldquo;Ai, Ai! a pig for killing, like a pig for killing,
- </p>
- <p class="indent20">
- Big-Nose is like a pig fit for killing!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- &ldquo;Big-Nose had a quarrel with his wife to-day, a quarrel,
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- a great quarrel, Big-Nose drank wisiki, much wisiki.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- (All together, excitedly.) &ldquo;A quarrel, a great quarrel,
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- much wisiki Big-Nose drank, Big-Nose!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- &ldquo;The wife of Big-Nose of the white house has long hair,
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- though she is very old, long hair that came to her in
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- a box by the sitima (steamer)!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- Chorus. &ldquo;Long hair, long hair, long hair, in a box on the
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- steamer. A box on the steamer, on the steamer,
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- long hair for the wife of Big-Nose who lives in the
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- white house.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p>
- A resident who really understood the natives and their music once or twice
- translated choruses for me that were quite as personal as the above. I
- have never since then wondered, as I used to wonder, where on earth the
- merry peasants of opera, with their extraordinary knowledge of the
- principals&rsquo; affairs, and their tireless energy in singing about them, were
- originally sketched.
- </p>
- <p>
- (Scholars will probably trace a resemblance to the Greek chorus here. I
- leave it to them to work out the wherefore, which makes me giddy even to
- think of, considering the geographical elements involved in the problem.)
- </p>
- <p>
- But now enough of Raratonga, for the schooner <i>Duchess</i> is waiting to
- carry me away to the other islands of the group, and, after many thousands
- of miles travelled by steamer upon &ldquo;all the seas of all the world,&rdquo; I am
- at last to learn what going to sea really is.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0007" id="link2HCH0007"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER VII
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>The Schooner at last&mdash;White Wings versus Black Funnels&mdash;Not
- according to Clark Russell&mdash;The Marvellous White Woman&mdash;The Song
- of the Surf&mdash;Why not?&mdash;Delightful Aitutaki&mdash;Into an Atoll&mdash;A
- Night in the House of a Chieftainess&mdash;The Scarlet Devil&mdash;Nothing
- to wear&mdash;How to tickle a Shark&mdash;The Fairy Islets&mdash;A Chance
- for Robinson Crusoe.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">T</span>HE schooner <i>Duchess</i>
- was in at last.
- </p>
- <p class="indent20">
- Of their bones are coral made.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p>
- We were almost growing anxious about her in Raratonga&mdash;almost, not
- quite; for after all, she was only a fortnight overdue, and that is not
- much for an island schooner, even when she is run by white officers. When
- the easy-going native runs her, no one ever knows when she will leave any
- port, and no one would venture to predict that she will ever arrive at
- all. There are generally a good many native-owned schooners about the
- South Eastern Pacific, but, though all the numbers keep up, the identity
- varies, and if you return after a few years and ask for the ships you used
- to know, the answer will be, I have not space to tell you here of the
- native schooner that started from one of the Cook Islands, not so very
- long ago, to visit another island less than two hundred miles away, but,
- because of the wild and weird navigation of her owners, went instead to
- somewhere over a thousand miles off; toured half the Pacific; stayed away
- six months; and finally came back to her own little island by a happy
- chance, without ever having reached the place she set out for after all.
- But it has a good deal of local colour in it.
- </p>
- <p>
- The <i>Duchess</i>, however, was not a native schooner, being owned by
- whites, and run by a British captain, mate, and boatswain, assisted by
- eight island seamen. There was, therefore, a reasonable prospect of
- getting somewhere, sometime, if I travelled in her; so I took my passage,
- and, for the first time, literally &ldquo;sailed away&rdquo;&mdash;to see the outer
- islands of the Cook Group, and later on, solitary Savage Island, Penrhyn,
- Malden, Rakahanga, and Manahiki.
- </p>
- <p>
- For more than four months afterwards, with a single break, the little <i>Duchess</i>
- of 175 tons was my home. Little she seemed at first, but before long she
- assumed the proportions of quite a majestic vessel. There was no schooner
- in those waters that could touch her, either for speed, size, or (alas!)
- for pitching and rolling, in any and every weather. Her ninety-five foot
- masts made a brave show, when clothed with shining canvas; her white hull,
- with its scarlet encircling band, and the sun-coloured copper glimmering
- at the water-line, stood out splendidly on the blazing blue of the great
- Pacific. &ldquo;A three-masted topsail schooner&rdquo; was her official designation.
- The unofficial names she was called in a calm, when the great Pacific
- swell brought out her full rolling powers, are best left unreported.
- </p>
- <p>
- I cannot honestly advise the elderly round-the-world-tourist, doing the
- Pacific in orthodox style, to desert steam for sail, and try the
- experience of voyaging &ldquo;off the track&rdquo; among the islands never visited by
- liners. But the true traveller, who wanders for the joy of wandering, and
- is not afraid or unwilling to &ldquo;rough it&rdquo; a good deal, will find a sailing
- trip in the Pacific among the most fascinating of experiences. Beyond the
- radius of the belching funnel a great peace reigns; an absence of time, a
- pleasant carelessness about all the weighty and tiresome things that may
- be happening outside the magic circle of still blue ocean. There is no
- &ldquo;let-her-slide&rdquo; spirit in the whole world to compare with that which
- blossoms spontaneously on the sun-white decks of a Pacific schooner.
- </p>
- <p>
- Looking back upon all the island boats that I have known, I may say that
- there was not so much discipline among the lot as would have run a single
- cross-channel boat at home, that every one was satisfied if the officers
- refrained from &ldquo;jamborees&rdquo; between ports; if some one was sometimes at the
- wheel, and if the native crew knew enough of the ropes to work the ship
- reasonably well, in the intervals of line-fishing and chorus-singing. And
- in one and all, whatever might happen to passengers, cargo, ship, or crew,
- &ldquo;take things as they come,&rdquo; was the grand general rule.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;This is your cabin,&rdquo; said the cheerful little pirate of a captain. He was
- celebrated as the &ldquo;hardest case&rdquo; in the South Pacific, and looked not
- quite unworthy of his reputation, though he was dressed as if for Bond
- Street in the afternoon, and mannered (on that occasion) as if for an
- evening party.
- </p>
- <p>
- What I wanted to say, was &ldquo;Good God!&rdquo; What I did say was: &ldquo;Oh, really!
- very nice indeed.&rdquo; For I saw at once that I must lie, and it seemed as
- well to obtain the fullest possible advantage from the sin. There was no
- use mincing words, or morals, in such a case.
- </p>
- <p>
- The cabin had a floor exactly the size of my smallest flat box, which
- filled it so neatly that I had to stand on the lid all the time I was in
- my room. It had a bunk about as large as a tight fit in coffins, and a
- small parrot-perch at one side, which was not meant for parrots, but for
- me, to perch on, if I wanted to lace my boots without committing suicide
- when the ship was rolling. On the perch stood a tin basin, to do duty as a
- washstand. There was a biscuit-tin full of water underneath.
- </p>
- <p>
- This was all that the cabin contained, except smells. The latter, however,
- crowded it to its fullest capacity. It had some mysterious communication
- with the hold, which perfumed it strongly with the oppressive, oily stench
- of ancient copra, and it had also a small door leading into the companion
- that went down to the engine-hole (one could not call it a room), in which
- lived the tiny oil engine that was supposed to start instantaneously, and
- work us out of danger, in case of any sudden need. (I say supposed,
- because&mdash;&mdash; But that comes after.)
- </p>
- <p>
- This engine-hole had a smell of its own, a good deal stronger than the
- engine (but that is not saying much)&mdash;compounded of dirt,
- bilge-water, and benzolene. The smell joined in a sort of chorus with the
- copra odour of the hold, and both were picked out and accentuated by a
- sharp note of cockroach. It was the most symphonic odour that I had ever
- encountered. As for the port, that, I saw, would be screwed down most of
- the time owing to the position of the cabin, low down on the main deck.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Very nice,&rdquo; I repeated, smiling a smile of which I am proud to this day.
- &ldquo;Such a dear little cabin!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;I&rsquo;m glad you like it,&rdquo; said the captain, evidently relieved. &ldquo;You see,
- there&rsquo;s four Government officials coming round this trip, and that takes
- our only other cabin. I chucked the bo&rsquo;sun out of this; he&rsquo;s sleeping
- anywhere. Anything else you&rsquo;d like?&rdquo; he continued, looking at the
- biscuit-tin and the shiny basin with so much satisfaction that I guessed
- at once they were a startling novelty&mdash;the bo&rsquo;sun having probably
- performed his toilet on deck. &ldquo;We don&rsquo;t have lady passengers on these
- trips as we aren&rsquo;t a Union liner exactly, but we&rsquo;re always ready to do
- what we can to please every one.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;I want first of all a new mattress, and sheets that haven&rsquo;t been washed
- in salt water, and then I want some air and light, and thirty or forty
- cubic feet more space, and I think, a new cabin, and I&rsquo;m almost sure,
- another ship,&rdquo; I said to myself. Aloud I added: &ldquo;Nothing whatever, thank
- you; it is charming,&rdquo; and then I went in and shut the door, and sat down
- on my bunk, and said things, that would not have passed muster in a
- Sunday-School, for quite ten minutes.
- </p>
- <p>
- What I had expected I don&rsquo;t know. Something in the Clark Russell line, I
- fear&mdash;a sparkling little sea-parlour, smelling of rope and brine,
- looking out on a deck &ldquo;as white as a peeled almond,&rdquo; and fitted with stern
- windows that overhung half the horizon. It was borne in upon me, as I sat
- there among the smells and ants and beetles, that I was in for something
- as un-Clark-Russelly as possible. &ldquo;Well,&rdquo; I thought, &ldquo;it will at least be
- all the newer. And there is certainly no getting out of it.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- So we spread our white wings, and fluttered away like a great
- sea-butterfly, from underneath the green and purple peaks of Raratonga,
- far out on the wide Pacific. And thereupon, because the rollers rolled,
- and the ship was small, I went into my cabin, and for two days, like the
- heroine of an Early Victorian romance, &ldquo;closed my eyes, and knew no more.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- On the third day I was better, and in the afternoon Mitiaro, one of the
- outer Cook Islands, rose on the horizon. By three o&rsquo;clock our boat had
- landed us&mdash;the official party, the captain, and myself&mdash;on a
- beach of foam-white coral sand, crowded with laughing, excited natives,
- all intensely eager to see the &ldquo;wahiné papa,&rdquo; or foreign woman. White men&mdash;traders,
- missionaries, the Resident Commissioner of the group&mdash;had visited the
- island now and again, but never a white woman before; and though many had
- been away and seen such wonders, more had not.
- </p>
- <p>
- The officials went away to hold a court of justice; the captain and
- myself, before we had walked half across the beach, being captured by an
- excited band of jolly brown men and women, all in their Sunday best shirts
- and pareos, and long trailing gowns. They seized us by our elbows, and
- literally ran us up to the house of the principal chief, singing
- triumphantly. Along the neatest of coral sand paths we went, among groves
- of palm and banana, up to a real native house, built with a high &ldquo;rau&rdquo;
- roof, and airy birdcage walls. About half the island was collected here,
- drinking cocoanuts, eating bananas, staring, talking, laughing. In spite
- of their excitement, however, they were exceedingly courteous, offering me
- the best seat in the house&mdash;a real European chair, used as a sort of
- throne by the chief himself&mdash;fanning myself and my guide
- industriously as we sat, pressing everything eatable in the house on us,
- and doing their best, bare-footed brown savages as they were, to make us
- enjoy our visit.
- </p>
- <p>
- All islanders are not courteous and considerate, but the huge majority
- certainly are. You shall look many a day and many a week among the
- sea-countries of the Pacific, before you meet with as much rudeness,
- selfishness, or unkindness, as you may meet any day without looking at
- all, on any railway platform of any town of civilised white England. And
- not from one end of the South Seas to the other, shall you hear anything
- like the harsh, loud, unmusical voice of the dominant race, in a native
- mouth. Soft and gentle always is the island speech, musical and kind&mdash;the
- speech of a race that knows neither hurry nor greed, and for whom the days
- are long and sweet, and &ldquo;always afternoon.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- When we went out to see the island, it was at the head of a gay procession
- of men, women, and children, singing ceaselessly, in loud metallic chants
- and choruses. Shy of the strange white apparition at first, the women grew
- bolder by degrees, and hung long necklaces of flowers and leaves and
- scented berries round my neck. They took my hat away, and returned it
- covered with feathery reva-reva plumes, made from the inner crown of the
- palm-tree. They produced a native dancing kilt, like a little crinoline,
- made of arrowroot fibre, dyed pink, and tied it round my waist, over my
- tailor skirt, explaining the while (through the captain, who interpreted),
- that the knot of the girdle was fastened in such a way as to cast a spell
- on me, and that I should inevitably be obliged to return to the island.
- (It is perhaps worthy of note that I did, though at the time of my first
- visit there seemed no chance of the ship calling again.) Decked out after
- this fashion, I had a <i>suces</i>; on my return to the schooner, and was
- greeted with howls of delight on the part of my fellow-passengers, who had
- managed to escape adornment, being less of a novelty. It was of course
- impossible to remove the ornaments without offending the givers.
- </p>
- <p>
- More houses, and more hosts, standing like Lewis Carroll&rsquo;s crocodile on
- their thresholds, to welcome me in &ldquo;with gently smiling jaws.&rdquo; We visited
- till we were tired of visiting, and then strolled about the town. Cool,
- fresh, and clean are the houses of little Mitiaro, dotted about its three
- miles&rsquo; length. Their high deep-gabled roofs of plaited pandanus leaf keep
- out the heat of the staring sun; through their walls of smoothed and
- fitted canes the sea-wind blows and the green lagoon gleams dimly: the
- snowy coral pebbles that carpet all the floor reflect a softly pleasant
- light into the dusk, unwindowed dwelling. Outside, the palm-trees rustle
- endlessly, and the surf sings on the reef the long, low, perilous sweet
- song of the dreamy South Sea world&mdash;the song that has lured so many
- away into these lonely coral lands, to remember their Northern loves and
- homes no more&mdash;the song that, once heard, will whisper through the
- inmost chambers of the heart, across the years, and across the world till
- death.
- </p>
- <p>
- Yet&mdash;why not?
- </p>
- <p>
- Why not? The thought followed me as ceaselessly as the trampling of the
- surf (now, in the open, loud and triumphant, like the galloping of a
- victorious army) while I wandered over the little island, up and down the
- coral sand paths that led through groves of feathery ironwood, through
- quaintly regular, low, rich green shrubberies, starred with pale pink
- blossoms among wild grey pinnacles of fantastic rock, clothed in trailing
- vines&mdash;always towards the open sky and the limitless blue sea. Why
- not? In England, even yet,
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p class="indent20">
- We are not cotton-spinners all,
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p>
- nor are we all old, blood-chilled by the frost of conventionality, dyed
- ingrain with the conviction that there is nothing but vagabondage and
- ne&rsquo;er-do-well-ism away from the ring of the professions, or an office desk
- in the E.C. district. For the young and adventurous, the South Seas hold
- as fair prospects as any other semi-civilised portion of the globe. For
- those who have seen and have lived, and are wearied to death of the life
- and cities and competition, the island world offers remoteness, beauty,
- rest, and peace, unmatched in the round of the swinging earth. And to all
- alike it offers that most savoury morsel of life&rsquo;s banquet&mdash;freedom.
- Freedom and a biscuit taste better to many a young Anglo-Saxon than
- stalled ox seasoned with the bitter herbs of dependence; but the one is
- always at hand, and the other very far away.
- </p>
- <p>
- Well, the gulf can be spanned; but he who cannot do the spanning, and must
- long and dream unsatisfied all his life, had best take comfort: it had not
- been for his good. The Islands are for the man of resource; again, of
- resource; and once more, of resource. Look among the lowest huts of the
- lowest quarters that cling to towns in the big islands, and there, gone
- native, and lost to his race, you shall find the man who was an excellent
- fellow&mdash;once&mdash;but who in emergency or difficulty, &ldquo;didn&rsquo;t know
- what to do.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- If there is a lesson in the above, he who needs it will find it.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <p>
- Mitiaro is the island, already referred to, where dried bananas are
- prepared. The natives make up their fruit in this way for market, because
- steamers never call, and sailing vessels only come at long and irregular
- intervals. A very small quantity goes down in this way to Auckland, and I
- heard, in a general way, that there were supposed to be one or two other
- islands here and there about the Pacific, where the same trade was carried
- on. One cannot, however, buy preserved bananas in the colonies, unless by
- a special chance, so the purchasing public knows nothing of them, and is
- unaware what it misses. In the opinion of most who have tried them, the
- fruit, dried and compressed in the Mitiaro way, is superior to dried figs.
- It is not only a substitute for fresh bananas, but a dainty in itself. The
- whaling ships pick up an occasional consignment in out-of-the-way places,
- and are therefore familiar with them, but one never sees them on a
- steamer. There may be useful hints, for intending settlers, in these stray
- facts.
- </p>
- <p>
- We lay over-night at Mitiaro, and got off in the morning. Aitutaki was our
- next place of call, and we reached it in about a day. It is, next to
- Raratonga, the most important island of the group, possessing a large
- mission station, a Government agent, and a post-office. It enjoys a call
- once a month from the Union steamer, and is therefore a much more
- sophisticated place than Mitiaro. In size, it is inferior to Raratonga and
- Atiu, being only seven square miles in extent. Its population is
- officially returned as 1,170. These are almost all natives, the white
- population including only the Government agent, two or three missionaries,
- and a couple of traders.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0021" id="linkimage-0021"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0185.jpg" alt="0185 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0185.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- It is bright morning when we make Aitutaki, and the sea is so vividly
- blue, as we push off in the boat, that I wonder my fingers do not come out
- sapphire-coloured when I dip them in. And I think, as the eight brown arms
- pull us vigorously shoreward, that no one in the temperate climes knows,
- or ever can know, what these sea-colours of the tropics are like, because
- the North has no words that express them. How, indeed, should it have?
- </p>
- <p>
- We are rowing, as fast as we can go, towards a great white ruffle of foam
- ruled like a line across the blue, blue sea. Inside this line there lies,
- to all appearance, an immense raised plain of green jade or aquamarine,
- with a palmy, plumy island, cinctured by a pearly beach, far away in the
- middle. Other islands, smaller and farther away, stand out upon the
- surface of this strange green circle here and there, all enclosed within
- the magic ring of tumbling foam, more than five miles across, that sets
- them apart from the wide blue sea. It is only a lagoon of atoll formation,
- but it looks like a piece of enamelled jewel-work, done by the hand of
- some ocean giant, so great that the huge sea-serpent itself should be only
- a bracelet for his arm. The raised appearance of the lagoon is one of the
- strangest things I have yet seen, though it is merely an optical delusion,
- created by contrast in colour.
- </p>
- <p>
- We are fortunate, too, in seeing what every one does not see&mdash;a
- distinct green shade in the few white clouds that overhang the surface of
- the lagoon. Here in Aitutaki a great part of the sky is sometimes coloured
- green by the reflections from the water, and it is a sight worth
- witnessing.
- </p>
- <p>
- Through an opening in the reef we enter&mdash;the boatmen pulling hard
- against the outward rush of the tide, which runs here like a cataract at
- times&mdash;and glide easily across the mile or so of shallow water that
- lies between us and the shore. One or two splendid whale-boats pass us,
- manned by native crews, and the other passengers tell me that these boats
- are all made by the Aitutakians themselves, who are excellent builders.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is a very decent little wharf to land on, and of course, the usual
- excited, decorated crowd to receive us, and follow us about. I am getting
- quite used now to going round at the head of a continual procession, to
- being hung over with chains of flowers and berries, and ceaselessly fed
- with bananas and cocoanuts, so the crowd does not interfere with my
- enjoyment of the new island. We are going to stop a day or two here, and
- there will be time to see everything.
- </p>
- <p>
- When you sleep as a rule in a bunk possessing every attribute of a coffin
- (except the restfulness which one is led to expect in a bed of that
- nature), you do not require much pressing to accept an invitation to &ldquo;dine
- and sleep&rdquo; on shore. Tau Ariki (which means Chieftainess, or Countess, or
- Duchess, Tau) lives in Aitutaki, and she had met me in Raratonga, so she
- sent me a hearty invitation to spend the night at her house, and I
- accepted it.
- </p>
- <p>
- Tau is not by any means as great a personage as Makea, or even as great as
- Tinomana, the lesser queen. She is an Ariki all the same, however, and
- owns a good deal of land in Aitutaki. Also, she is gloriously married to a
- white ex-schooner mate, who can teach even the Aitutakians something about
- boat-building, and she is travelled and finished, having been a trip to
- Auckland&mdash;the ambition of every Cook Islander. So Tau Ariki is a
- person of importance in her own small circle, and was allowed by the
- natives of the town to have the undoubted first right to entertain the
- white woman.
- </p>
- <p>
- Tau&rsquo;s house, in the middle of the rambling, jungly, green street of the
- little town, proved to be a wooden bungalow with a verandah and a tin
- roof, very ugly, but very fine to native eyes. There were tables and
- chairs in the &ldquo;parlour&rdquo;; and the inevitable boiled fowl that takes the
- place of the fatted calf, in Pacific cookery, was served up on a china
- plate. A rich woman, Tau, and one who knew how the &ldquo;tangata papa&rdquo; (white
- folk) should be entertained!
- </p>
- <p>
- She gave me a bedroom all to myself, with a smile that showed complete
- understanding of the foolish fads of the &ldquo;wahiné papa.&rdquo; It had a large
- &ldquo;imported&rdquo; glass window, giving on the main street of the town, and
- offering, through its lack of blinds, such a fine, free show for the
- interested populace, that I was obliged to go to bed in the dark. There
- was a real bed in the room, covered with a patchwork quilt of a unique and
- striking design, representing a very realistic scarlet devil some four
- feet long. It seemed to me the kind of quilt that would need a good
- conscience and a blameless record, on the part of the sleeper reposing
- under it. To wake in the middle of the night unexpectedly, with the
- moonlight streaming in, forget for the moment where you were, and, looking
- round to find a landmark, drop your startled eyes upon that scarlet fiend,
- sprawling all over your chest&mdash;&mdash; Well, I had a good conscience,
- or none&mdash;I do not know which&mdash;so I felt the red devil would not
- disturb my slumbers, and he did not.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0022" id="linkimage-0022"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0191.jpg" alt="0191 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0191.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- There was nothing else in the room, except a new, gold-laced, steamship
- officer&rsquo;s cap, whereto there seemed neither history nor owner, reposing on
- the pillow. If there was any mystery about the cap, I never knew it.
- </p>
- <p>
- I put it out on the windowsill, and a hen laid an egg in it next morning,
- and no doubt the hen lived happily ever after, and I hope the officer did,
- and that is all. It seems pathetic, but I do not know why.
- </p>
- <p>
- There was nothing to wash in, but Tau knew her manners, and was quite
- aware that I might have a prejudice against sitting in a washing-tub on
- either the front or the back verandah, to have buckets emptied on my head
- in the morning. So she made haste to leave a kerosene tin full of water,
- before going to her camphorwood chest, and extracting a pink silk dress
- trimmed with yellow lace, for me to sleep in.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;I&rsquo;m afraid that won&rsquo;t do; it&rsquo;s too&mdash;too good to sleep in,&rdquo; I
- remarked.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Nothing too good for you, you too much good self!&rdquo; was the amiable reply.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;But I could not sleep in it, Tau. There&rsquo;s&mdash;there&rsquo;s too much of it,&rdquo;
- I objected, not knowing how to word my refusal without impoliteness.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;All right,&rdquo; commented my hostess, throwing a glance at the purple gloom
- of the torrid hot-season night outside. &ldquo;He plenty hot. I get you pareo,
- all same mine.&rdquo; And she disinterred a brief cotton kilt of red and yellow,
- considerably smaller than a Highlander&rsquo;s.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;That&rsquo;s too little,&rdquo; objected the exacting guest, rather to poor Tau&rsquo;s
- perplexity. How was one to please such a visitor? At last, however, after
- refusing a figured muslin robe that was as transparent as a dancing-robe
- of classic Ionia (there are other analogies between those robes, if one
- might go into the subject; but I fear the British public must not be told
- about them), and a pink shirt belonging to the white husband, a neat
- cotton day gown was discovered, offered, and accepted, and peace reigned
- once more in the exceedingly public guest-chamber of Tau Ariki&rsquo;s house.
- </p>
- <p>
- Concerning quilts, by the way, one may here add a short note. Patchwork is
- the delight of the Cook Island women, and has been so, ever since that
- absorbing pastime was first introduced to them by the missionaries&rsquo; wives.
- They are extremely clever at it, and often invent their own patterns.
- Sometimes, however, they copy any startling device that they may chance to
- see&mdash;the more original, the better. A really good patchwork quilt is
- considered a possession of great value, and (one is sorry to say) often
- preferred to the fine, beautifully hand-woven mats in which the islanders
- used to excel. They still make mats in large numbers, but the patchwork
- quilt has spoilt their taste for the finer mats, and these latter are
- getting scarce.
- </p>
- <p>
- In the morning, shark-catching was the order of the day. Aitutaki is
- celebrated for this sport all over Australasia, and I was very glad to get
- a chance of joining in it. One does not catch sharks, in Aitutaki, after
- the usual island fashion, which is much like the way familiar to all
- sea-faring folk&mdash;hook and line, and a lump of bad pork, and tow the
- monster to the shore when you have got him. No, there is something more
- exciting in store for the visitor-who goes a-fishing in Aitutaki lagoon.
- The water is very shallow for the most part, and heats up quickly with the
- sun, especially when the day is dead calm, and there is not a ripple to
- break the force of the rays. By noon, the lagoon is unbearably warm in all
- the shallow parts, and the sharks which inhabit it in large numbers, begin
- to feel uncomfortable. Some of them make for the opening in the reef, and
- get out into the cooler sea beyond. Others, one will suppose, are lazy,
- and do not want to be troubled to swim so far. So they head for the coral
- patches here and there, and lie on the sand in the shelter of the rocks,
- their bodies thrust as far into the clefts and crannies of the coral as
- they can manage to get. This is the Aitutakian&rsquo;s opportunity. He is
- perfectly fearless in the water, and he knows that the shark is, after
- all, a stupid brute. So he arms himself with a knife, takes a strong rope,
- noosed in a slip-knot at one end, in his hand, and dives from his
- whale-boat into the warm green water, where he has marked the latter end
- of a shark sticking out from a patch of coral, some three or four fathoms
- underneath the surface.
- </p>
- <p>
- The shark, being head in, does not see anything, but by-and-by he becomes
- aware of a delicate tickling all along his massive ribs, and as he rather
- likes this, he stays-quite still, and enjoys it. It is the Aitutakian,
- tickling him as boys tickle a trout in a stream at home, and for exactly
- the same reason. He has got the noose in his left hand, and his aim is to
- slip it over the shark&rsquo;s tail, while he distracts the brute&rsquo;s attention by
- pleasantly tickling with the other hand. Perhaps he manages this at the
- first attempt&mdash;perhaps he is obliged to rise to the surface, and take
- a breath of air, going down again to have a second try. But, in any case,
- he is pretty sure to get the noose on before the shark suspects anything.
- Once that is accomplished, he rises to the surface like a shooting
- air-bubble, swings himself into the boat, and gives the order to &ldquo;haul
- in!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- The men in the boat lay hold of the rope, tighten with a sharp jerk, and
- tail on. Now the shark begins to realise that something has happened; and
- realises it still more fully in another minute or two, when he finds
- himself fighting for his life on the gunwale of a rocking boat, against
- half a dozen islanders armed with knives and axes. The battle is short the
- great brute is soon disabled by a smashing blow on the tail, and in
- another hour or two the village is feeding fat on his meat, and his fins
- are drying in the sun, to be sold to the trader by-and-by, for export to
- China. No dinner-party in China is complete without a dish of daintily
- dressed shark&rsquo;s fins, and a good proportion of the supply comes from the
- Pacific.
- </p>
- <p>
- This is shark-fishing, as practised in Aitutaki. But I was not destined to
- see it at its best, for the day turned out breezy, and there was such a
- ripple, upon the water that the natives declared the sharks would be
- extremely difficult to see or capture. Nevertheless, the captain and I
- decided to go, as there was a chance, though a faint one. We hired a boat,
- and took with us, as well as the rowers, Oki, a diver of renown. If Oki
- could not raise a shark for us, it was certain that no one could.
- </p>
- <p>
- The captain of the missionary steamer <i>John Williams</i> had told me
- about the fishing some weeks before, and added that he had seen a shark
- caught himself, and tried to photograph it, but the photo was not a
- success, because, as he put it, &ldquo;the shark moved!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- This story wandered about in my mind as we shot across the lagoon to the
- fishing grounds, and the boat began to look uncomfortably small. &ldquo;What
- does the shark do when you get it in the boat?&rdquo; I inquired rather
- anxiously.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Makes the devil of a row, and the devil of a mess,&rdquo; said our own captain
- cheerfully. &ldquo;But don&rsquo;t you mind him. Let sharks alone, and they&rsquo;ll let you
- alone; that&rsquo;s always been my experience.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- Conscious that I was never unkind to animals, not even tigers or sharks, I
- tried to feel at ease. But I did not quite succeed, until we got to the
- coral beds, and Oki put everything else out of my head by going head first
- overboard, and starting out among the rocks below (it was calmer here, and
- we could see him pretty plainly) to look for a shark.
- </p>
- <p>
- His thin brown body showed up shadowy and wavering, upon the sands at the
- bottom, as he glided like a fish all along the patch of reef, inspecting
- every cave or crack where a shark might hide. He did not seem to be
- incommoded in the least by the three or four fathoms of water above him,
- but moved about as quietly and easily as if he had been swimming on the
- surface. I felt sure he must be at the point of death, as the seconds flew
- by, and he still glided in and out of the rocks with nothing but the gleam
- of his white pareo to show his whereabouts, whenever he slipped into the
- shadow of one of the many clefts in which a shark might lie hidden. But
- Oki knew very well what he was about, and he did not seem at all exhausted
- when he shot to the surface again, after rather more than two minutes&rsquo;
- absence, and told us gloomily that &ldquo;No shark stop!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- We tried again, and again. Oki took the slip knot down with him every time
- and every time he brought it up in his hand, unused. Melancholy, deep and
- silent, settled upon the boat. But at last the luck changed; our diver
- came up, and announced with a smile, that there was a shark down there,
- very far into the coral, and if he could only reach the animal&rsquo;s tail, it
- would be all right.
- </p>
- <p>
- One of the boatmen at this went to help him, and together they swam down
- to the bottom, and began fumbling interminably in the shadow. It was clear
- that they were making every effort to tempt the shark out, for one could
- see Oki straining wildly with his arm in the cleft, &ldquo;tickling&rdquo;
- industriously, while the other hovered head downwards outside, trailing
- the noose like a loop of seaweed in his hand. But all proved vain.
- Exhausted, the men rose at last, and gave it up. The shark was too far in,
- they said, and the noose could not be got on. If we remembered, they had
- told us it was not a good day, and they hoped we thought enough had been
- done. As for themselves, they were very tired doing our pleasure, and
- their lungs were sore, but they thought some plug tobacco&mdash;the black,
- sticky kind, and a good deal of it&mdash;would set them all right again.
- </p>
- <p>
- This was outside the letter of the agreement, which had included a good
- price for the boat and nothing else; but we promised some tobacco, when
- the stores should be reached, and asked for some more particulars about
- the fishing.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Do you ever find the shark head out, instead of tail out?&rdquo; I queried.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Yes, sometime he come head out,&rdquo; said Oki, reversing a green cocoanut on
- his nose, and swallowing in great gulps.
- </p>
- <p>
- I waited till he had finished before I asked: &ldquo;What happens then?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Shark he fight, and we fight too,&rdquo; said Oki simply.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;And which wins?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;All the time the Aitutaki boy he win, but sometime the shark he win too,&rdquo;
- was the cryptic reply.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <p>
- Shark fins, I was told, sell for about six shillings a pound. Some of the
- traders in the islands further north, where sharks are abundant, make a
- good deal of money taking the fish on a hook and line, and drying the fins
- for sale. It should be a fairly profitable industry, as the fins of a
- medium shark appear to weigh a good deal&mdash;not less than three or four
- pounds, at a guess.
- </p>
- <p>
- It was on my second visit to Aitutaki that I went out to the lesser
- islands of the lagoon; but the tale of that expedition may well come here.
- </p>
- <p>
- These islets are of various sizes, from a mere rock with a couple of palms
- on it, to a fertile piece of land over a mile long, richly grown and
- wooded. They all lie within the great lagoon, and are therefore sheltered
- by a natural breakwater of the reef from the violence of the storms that
- occur in the rainy season. The nearest is about three miles from the
- mainland. All are quite uninhabited, and no particular value is set on
- them by anybody. They belong to the various chief families of the big
- island, but any one who wished to rent one in perpetuity (the New Zealand
- Government laws, which rule here, do not permit outright sale) could
- probably secure it for a few pounds a year.
- </p>
- <p>
- I was anxious to see them, for it seemed to me that islands suited to the
- realisation of Robinson Crusoe dreams could hardly be found the wide
- Pacific over. A desolate isle five hundred miles from anywhere, sounds
- well in a story, but the romance of such a spot is apt to wear very thin
- indeed after a few months, if one may believe the experiences of those who
- have tried it. Practical details are seldom considered by would-be
- Crusoes; they have, however, a knack of thrusting themselves into the
- foreground just when retreat is impossible. If you elect to live on a
- remote island, how are you going to keep up communication with the outer
- world? You will want at least a few commodities of civilisation from time
- to time, and they cannot swim across half the great South Seas, from
- Auckland or &rsquo;Frisco, up to your front verandah unaided. You will
- want mails, newspapers, and letters, unless haply you are a criminal
- flying from the near neighbourhood of the black cap and the drop&mdash;and
- how are these to come? Trading schooners will not call at your island
- unless you have plenty of cargo for them, and even then, you may not see
- them twice a year. Steamers, of course, you must not expect. If you keep a
- small vessel of your own, you must be thoroughly sea-trained to run and
- navigate her, and you will need to bring a few island men to your kingdom
- as crew, and they will want to go home again, and make trouble, and
- finally run off with your ship some dark night, and maroon you there for
- good. No, the &ldquo;desert&rdquo; island idea is best left to the shelves of the
- school library.
- </p>
- <p>
- But at Aitutaki, and in some similar collections of atoll islands Robinson
- Crusoe&rsquo;s way is made easy and pleasant&mdash;or so it seemed to me,
- crossing the lagoon that afternoon on my way to the islets that were lying
- waste and uninhabited out on its broad expanse. From three to five miles
- away from the mainland, these islets are sufficiently isolated for any one
- who has not quarrelled with the whole human race. There is a steamer once
- a month, at the little pier near the settlement. There are one or two
- stores on the main island, where common provisions, cotton stuffs, spades,
- and knives, and such simple things, can be purchased. The lagoon is
- usually so calm that a native canoe would serve all ordinary needs of
- communication, for any one living on an islet. A house could be built in a
- few days, of the native type: and a good concrete bungalow could be put up
- with native help, in a very few weeks. Why should any one want to live in
- such a spot? Well, it is not necessary to argue out that question, because
- I have found by experience that quite a remarkable number of people do. It
- was for those people that I crossed the lagoon that day, and I know I
- shall have their thanks.
- </p>
- <p>
- A whale-boat and a crew were necessary for the trip. I engaged both in the
- village, and went down to the wharf followed by a &ldquo;tail&rdquo; of seven stalwart
- islanders, dressed in white and crimson pareos, berry necklaces, and a
- curiously representative collection of steamship caps and jerseys. The
- Aitutakian is an inveterate traveller, and all these men had been away in
- a steamer somewhere as deck hands&mdash;or else their friends had, and
- they had begged a steamer cap and jersey or two here and there: it was all
- the same to them. The P. &amp; O.&mdash;the Union S.S. Co. of New Zealand&mdash;the
- Shaw, Savill, and Albion&mdash;the Orient&mdash;Burns Philp&mdash;were all
- represented (so far as caps and jerseys went) by my boat&rsquo;s crew, and very
- well pleased with themselves and their poached attire they evidently were.
- </p>
- <p>
- Provisions had to be purchased, they declared, as we should not be back
- before afternoon. So into the big store the whole party went to see me
- victual the ship. I bought biscuits and meat, exactly half what they
- asked, and they were so uplifted with joy at the amount of the supplies
- that they sang all the way down to the boat; and, once in it, treated me
- to an exhibition of rowing, the like of which I never expect to see again.
- The Aitutaki man is the smartest boatman, and the best hand with an oar,
- in the Southern Pacific. Never a man-of-war comes round the Cook group
- that her men do not try conclusions with the Aitutakians, and if report
- speaks truth, the result is not always flattering to British pride. Nor is
- this astonishing, to any one who has seen these islanders row. We had six
- miles of a pull, and every inch was against a strong head wind, and
- through a decidedly choppy sea. Yet, in spite of these handicaps, the men
- rowed the whole way at racing pace, oars springing, spray flying, the
- great whale-boat tearing through the water as though a mortal enemy were
- in pursuit. The coxswain, in the stern, kept slyly urging the rowers on to
- let the foreign woman see what they could do, and they pulled &ldquo;all out&rdquo;&mdash;or
- what looked extremely like it&mdash;from start to finish. I do not think
- any white crew that ever held an oar could have lived with that splendid
- six-mile rush. And when we neared the first island and gradually slacked
- speed, there was not one among those seven mighty chests that heaved
- faster than at the start. Truly, I thought, they had earned their picnic.
- </p>
- <p>
- But the islets! If Raratonga was the realisation of a childish dream, this
- was the embodiment of a vision of fairyland. There can surely be nothing
- on earth more lovely than the islet constellation enclosed by Aitutaki
- reef. The water, shallow, sun-jewelled, and spread out over a bed of
- spotless coral sand, is coloured with a brilliance that is simply
- incredible. Emerald and jade and sapphire&mdash;yes, one expects these, in
- the hues of tropic seas. But when it comes to whole tracts of glancing
- heliotrope and hyacinth, shot with unnamable shades of melted turquoise
- and silver, and all a-quiver with pulsations of flashing greens, for which
- there is no name in any language under the pallid northern or burning
- southern sun&mdash;then, the thing becomes indescribable, and one can only
- say:
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;There is something in that little corner of earth beyond the touch of
- words, so you will never know anything about it, unless you too go there,
- and see it for yourself. And when you have seen, you will come away
- burning to describe, as I was&mdash;but you will not be able.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- In the midst of this magical sea, rise the islets themselves&mdash;fairyland
- every one. Their little beaches are sparkling white, as only a coral beach
- can be; palm-trees, heavyheaded with their loads of huge green nuts,
- cluster thick along the shores; coral-trees drop their blood-red flowers
- into the glass-like water of the lagoon; ripe oranges swing their glowing
- lamps among the darker green of the woods that rise behind. Big white
- clams with goffered shells, each holding meat enough for one man&rsquo;s dinner,
- gleam along the edges of the shore; large, long-legged crabs wander
- rustling and rattling among the stones. The murmur of the barrier reef is
- very far away; its thin white line of foam gleams out a long way off,
- under a low horizon, sky shot strangely with lilac blue&mdash;a lonely,
- lovely, exquisite place, the like of which one might seek the world all
- over, and never find again.
- </p>
- <p>
- We landed on the sand, and I set about exploring, while the men knocked
- down cocoanuts, and squatted in the shade to drink them, and suck fresh
- oranges. The island on which we had landed was one of the smaller ones,
- not more than an acre or two in extent. It rose to a high point in the
- centre, and was so thickly wooded all over, that I could hardly make my
- way through. There was no sign of life or habitation, and the ripe fruit
- was everywhere rotting on the ground.
- </p>
- <p>
- I pictured the little islet with a high brown roof peeping out among its
- palms, a neatly kept pathway cut through the bush, and a snug boathouse on
- the shore, covering a fine whaleboat, while a graceful native canoe lay on
- the sand, ready for any one to lift down into the water at any minute. I
- wonder, will the picture ever body itself out in real, for some tired-out
- soul, weary of cities and competition, or some pair of lovers, who find
- the world well lost in each other, here among the far islands of the sweet
- Southern Seas? I shall never know, for the &ldquo;sea-bird&rsquo;s feather&rdquo; was in the
- pillow on which I slept my first baby sleep, and I wander always on. But
- it may be that these words will be read by some to whom they are, or shall
- be, a part of fife&rsquo;s own history.
- </p>
- <p>
- We did not get to the other islands that day, partly because I wasted so
- much time looking for shells, and partly because the largest were still
- some miles away, and the wind was stronger than ever. One, I heard, had
- ground enough for a paying plantation, and was already fairly well
- supplied with cocoanuts. All are perfectly healthy and free from fevers of
- any kind, and though mosquitoes are present in rather large numbers,
- careful clearing of their breeding grounds would in time drive them away.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <p>
- In case author, or publishers, should be inundated with inquiries about
- South Sea Islands, it may be as well to say that all over the Pacific, the
- Governors, Commissioners, and Resident Agents of the various groups are
- always ready to furnish information to honest inquirers.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0008" id="link2HCH0008"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER VIII
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>Jumping a Coral Reef&mdash;The Great Wall of the Makatea&mdash;Makaia&rsquo;s
- Wonderful Staircases&mdash;A Clothing Club of the Pacific&mdash;Cool
- Costumes in Atiu&mdash;The Lands that lie waste&mdash;Mystery of a
- Vanished Tribe&mdash;Fashions in Hair-Dressing&mdash;The Sign-Language of
- the Sex&mdash;Invited to a Feast.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">M</span>ANGAIA, where we
- next stopped, proved quite an exciting place. You cannot land upon Mangaia
- in the ordinary way: the reef that surrounds it is unbroken, and girdles
- the whole island in a fortress moat of its own. The only way to land is to
- get into one of the numberless native canoes that crowd about the ship,
- and let the copper-coloured owner take you over the reef in his own way,
- which is the determined and decisive way of a steeplechaser at a fence. It
- is most excellent fun and a new thing in sensations. As the little dug-out&mdash;made
- of nothing more elaborate than a hollowed mango log, with an outrigger at
- one side&mdash;rushes shoreward on the crest of a foaming roller, you
- watch with rather anxious interest the movements of the dusky boatman, who
- poises his paddle in the air, waits, looks, and strikes the water, always
- at exactly the right moment&mdash;usually when you are just beginning to
- think of kicking off your shoes.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is the reef right in front, a pearly shadow in the blue, with
- up-springing spears of ivory, bared like the teeth of a tiger, when the
- wave rolls back. Are we going to jump that? We are indeed. The boatman
- lifts his paddle&mdash;we sweep upwards on the sloping blue satin neck of
- a curling wave. No no, that will not do&mdash;not this time. He backs
- water&mdash;we hang on the crest of the wave&mdash;but we are not going to
- be drowned, or snapped up by the sharks that haunt the reefs, because the
- boatman is a born islander, and what he does not know about canoeing over
- a reef, neither you nor I need attempt to teach him. Another wave, a
- monster this time, swinging us up into the air as if we were a couple of
- grasshoppers out paddling in a walnut shell. That will do: here she goes!
- The wave roars with us; the wicked white fangs gleam on either hand: our
- rough thick keel scrapes agonisingly on the coral, and there is a smother
- of foam and tumbling blue and bursting green all about the cranky little
- craft. Bump! we have struck&mdash;we strike again, but it does not seem to
- matter in the least: over we go, and we are in the smooth, safe, shallow
- green water inside, and across the reef. And here are a dozen men of
- Mangaia, splashing&rsquo; about in the lagoon, ready to pick up the visitor in
- their powerful arms as soon as the canoe grounds in the shallow* water,
- and carry her ashore.
- </p>
- <p>
- That is how one lands on Mangaia.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0023" id="linkimage-0023"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0209.jpg" alt="0209 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0209.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- This island is of a good size, being some thirty mile» in circumference.
- Its formation is very notable, being indeed rather celebrated among
- geologists. It is supposed to be of volcanic origin, like most of the
- &ldquo;high&rdquo; islands. From the sea, it looks much like any other place of the
- same size. But, going inland, one is astonished to find that a mere strip
- of land close round the coast terminates the ground available for walking
- on. A high irregular cliff wall, from fifty to a hundred feet in height,
- encloses the whole interior of the island, which thus resembles in shape a
- very large cup set on a very small saucer. Within the cup lie all fertile
- lands, the taro beds, the yam fields, the pineapple patches, the tangled
- bush, where cotton used to be grown in the days of the American war, the
- low green shrubberies that produce the finest coffee in the Cook Islands.
- To reach them, there is only one way&mdash;that furnished by a really
- wonderful rocky staircase, built in prehistoric times by the ancestors of
- the present natives. If one were to find such a work in any other of the
- Cook Islands one might regard it as proof positive of the existence of an
- older and more industrious race, in the days before the New Zealand Maori
- took possession of these lands, and grew effeminate and idle in the
- occupying.
- </p>
- <p>
- But the people of Mangaia, though identical in descent with incurably
- indolent and sensual Aitutakians and Raratongans, have been moulded by
- their environment to a degree that amounts to an actual difference in
- character. The barrier reef has always prevented the free communication
- enjoyed by other islands, so that they were able to develop along their
- own lines of character, without modification from outside. With an island
- that possessed only a limited amount of fertile land, a matchless fortress
- in the interior, and a complete barrier about the exterior, it was a
- foregone conclusion that the Mangaians should become inhospitable,
- reserved, and hard-working, as compared with the prodigally generous and
- idle folk of the open and fertile islands. They did so. In the days before
- the missions, some sixty years ago, the Mangaians were the fiercest
- cannibals in the group, and determinedly hostile to strangers: nor were
- they ever as pleasure-loving as the other Cook Islanders. To-day they are
- harder in character than the folk of the other islands; kindly to
- strangers, but hardly gushing in their reception of them, and so much more
- industrious than the Aitutakians or Raratongans that Mangaian men are
- sought as servants all over the group.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is, therefore, no difficulty in understanding how the people of
- Mangaia found energy and time to construct the staircases that span the
- great wall of &ldquo;Makatea,&rdquo; enclosing the inner part of the island. Being
- obliged day after day to climb with infinite pains the sharp rocky heights
- of the cliff, in order to get from the fishing grounds to the plantations,
- they would certainly not be long in devising some means of lessening this
- inconvenience. The staircases which are the result must have taken many
- years and much labour in constructing, and it is difficult to understand
- how a people unacquainted with the use of any mechanical contrivance could
- have placed so many large blocks of stone in the positions which they
- occupy. The steps are very high and irregular, and on an extremely torrid
- afternoon it is not exactly the walk one would choose for pure enjoyment.
- However, our time in Mangaia was short, so I explained to a native girl
- that I wanted to see the Makatea, and she at once called up half the
- village to join the procession.
- </p>
- <p>
- Attended, therefore, by my young guide and the inevitable following, I
- went up the mighty stairs, and across the tract of level land lying at the
- top. It is nearly a mile before one comes upon the cup-like valley in the
- centre of the island, so it must be allowed that the rim of the cup is a
- thick one. After a pleasant walk through groves of cocoanut and guava, we
- came upon the inner side of the wall, and stood on the edge of a great
- grey circular cliff, spiked, spired, and towered with extraordinary
- eccentricity, and splendidly garlanded with falling masses of sea-green
- creeper. At one point, a huge split in the rock had evidently provided a
- foundation for the second staircase, which was rougher than the first,
- made of great blocks of stone irregularly laid here and there so as to
- fill up the split in part, and give a foothold to the climber. Still, it
- was a big piece of work, and must have taken a good many years&mdash;generations,
- perhaps&mdash;to complete. Down in the valley below, which seemed to be
- two or three miles across, were all the native plantations and gardens,
- and as we jumped down from block to block, we met hard-faced muscular
- women toiling upwards with heavy loads of vegetables and fruit. In the
- taro fields, terraced so as to let a little stream trickle through and
- create an artificial swamp, the workers seemed to be women only. They dug
- and scraped in the thick mud under the burning sun, leaving off their
- tasks long enough to stare and question a little, and then setting
- stolidly to work again. The men were probably out fishing or pigeon
- shooting. In spite of Christianity, the island woman always carries the
- heavy end of the load, where there is one to carry; the man is the hunter,
- the woman the labourer and beast of burden, as in the cannibal times of
- long ago.
- </p>
- <p>
- There are some remarkable caves in the island, and I went into them for a
- mile or so, in company with the local missionary, who kindly offered to
- act as guide.
- </p>
- <p>
- Caves, however&mdash;as most people will allow&mdash;are much alike in all
- parts of the earth, and there is nothing to differentiate the long, dark,
- dripping passages, half-glimpsed halls, gloomy crevasses, and dimly
- sparkling stalactite candelabra of a South Sea Island cave, from those of
- a cave near Brighton or the Land&rsquo;s End. There is no need, therefore, to
- describe the caves of Mangaia further than to say that they were quite up
- to the usual pattern, and that at all events, they gave a touch of &ldquo;Swiss
- Family Robinson&rdquo; to the island atmosphere that was pleasing to the
- imagination.
- </p>
- <p>
- It had, of course, nothing to do with Mangaia, but I wondered as we walked
- back from the caves towards the top of Makatea, how it was that the
- interesting shipwrecked people who live in caves as described in fiction,
- never seem to be troubled with damp? I have, personally, never seen a cave&mdash;out
- of a book&mdash;that was not first cousin to a showerbath, and I should be
- surprised if any One else had. Who ever saw a genuine cave roof that was
- not covered with stalactites, large or small? and what makes stalactites
- but endless drip? If I were a shipwrecked person, I should certainly
- prefer the temporary house the &ldquo;useful&rdquo; character always puts up in half
- an hour with the aid of four growing trees and the ship&rsquo;s mainsail, to the
- cave that is invariably discovered in the second chapter. I should know
- for certain that the former was the driest&mdash;even when it rained.
- </p>
- <p>
- I cannot leave the subject of the strange Makatea, without telling yet a
- little more about it, for it has not often been described or mentioned.
- Geologists say that it is the product of a double volcanic upheaval. The
- first convulsion threw up the island itself, and, in the course of ages,
- the usual encircling reef of coral was built up round it by the busy coral
- insects, working under the water. Then came a second upheaval, and the
- island and reef together were cast up two hundred feet. The Makatea is
- thus the ancient reef that once surrounded the original small island which
- is represented by a crown of heights in the middle of the cup of the
- crater, and by the sunk-down valley about it. The narrow strip of land
- that edges the beach to-day is a later formation.
- </p>
- <p>
- One cannot mistake the character of the great coral cliff, which is quite
- unlike any kind of stone, or indeed anything but itself. The passing ages
- have turned it to rock, but to rock which is hollowed in every direction
- with caves, small and great, and filled with fossil shells as a pudding is
- filled with plums. No unprotected foot can tread the surface of these
- heights, which are simply a mass of serried grey spears, sharp and cruel
- as the top of a wall protected by broken glass. The natives, if
- convenience leads them to cross any part of the Makatea other than the
- staircases, usually protect their feet with thick sandals of woven coir
- fastened on with cords. One can imagine how much this peculiar protection
- must have added to the safety of the interior of the island, in the old
- predatory days.
- </p>
- <p>
- The caves were often used for burying places in time gone by, and it is
- only a few years since a &ldquo;find&rdquo; of skulls of a type differing in several
- particulars from those of the present day, was made in one of the largest
- caves by a schooner captain. Rumour says that he sold them for a good
- price, but the purchasers were not known.
- </p>
- <p>
- Another use of the coral caves in the old days (over fifty years ago) was
- a shelter for fugitives of various kinds. The Mangaians were not a
- pleasant people, in those times, either to strangers or each other. The
- outsider was cooked and eaten for the mere offence of presuming to exist.
- The Mangaian was never sure that some one who had a spite against him
- would not murder him&mdash;probably by poison, in the use of which these
- people were as expert as the Borgias themselves. Under these
- circumstances, the caves were never without their occupants, living in
- secret, and creeping out at night to pick up a little food. Many and
- romantic are the stories told by the missionaries and traders of these
- stirring times, if I had space to relate them.
- </p>
- <p>
- Mangaia is a beautiful island, but that goes without saying, in the
- exquisite Cook Group. It has about half a dozen white people, and the
- native population is said to number something under two thousand.
- </p>
- <p>
- Though a pleasant island and a healthy one, it cannot be recommended to
- planters, as there is not an inch of land available for rent. The natives
- themselves are keen traders and bargainers, and export much of their fruit
- and copra direct to Auckland. Most of what they make is spent in
- trade-finery, for which they have an uncontrollable passion. On Sundays,
- the churches are a very flower-garden of frippery, the men turning out in
- the most brilliant of shirts, ties, and suits, the women decking
- themselves in long loose robes of muslin, sateen, or cheap silk, coloured
- in the most screaming hues&mdash;pea-green, royal blue, scarlet, and
- orange being all strong favourites. Their hats, made by themselves out of
- silky arrowroot fibre, are often trimmed with the costliest ribbons and
- artificial flowers, and even with ostrich plumes to the value of two or
- three pounds. It is somewhat puzzling, I was told, to see several entire
- families got up in the same extraordinary style, unless you know the
- reason, which is, that these various households have joined together in a
- club, putting all the money they have made into one purse, and sending it
- down to Auckland on their own account for a bale of gorgeous clothing, all
- alike. Thus you will see twenty or thirty women, on a Sunday morning,
- dressed alike in robes of vermilion satinette, and wearing huge hats,
- crowned by three ostrich feathers, red, yellow, and blue, arranged after
- the fashion of the Prince of Wales&rsquo;s crest.
- </p>
- <p>
- This is one of the clubs, and there are sure to be others that vie with
- them in startling attire. Such are the weaknesses&mdash;after all, venial
- ones indeed&mdash;of the sturdy-souled Mangaian.
- </p>
- <p>
- Atiu was our next stop, and here the reef-jumping process had to be
- repeated in another form. The ship&rsquo;s whale-boat, steered by our captain,
- who was the cleverest hand at the big sixteen-foot steer-oar of any white
- man I have ever seen, approached the edge of the reef, and danced about in
- front of it, until the passengers found an opportunity of leaping out on
- to it. Then, rather wetfooted (but no one minded that, in a temperature
- like the hot room of a Turkish bath) we were picked up by natives waiting
- on the shallow side, and carried through the lagoon, which was not more
- than a foot or two deep.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0024" id="linkimage-0024"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0217.jpg" alt="0217 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0217.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- On landing, we found a number of the men standing on the shore ready to
- receive the Commissioner. They had been fishing, and were clad simply and
- coolly in a rag and a feather apiece&mdash;the latter worn in the hair,
- over one ear. Their dress, however, did not seem to embarrass them at all,
- and they came forward and shook hands with every one,&rsquo; quite politely. All
- the Cook islanders are supposed to be Christianised and civilised, but in
- some parts of the group the civilisation, at all events, seems to be
- wearing very thin, and this is notably the case in Atiu, an island rather
- larger than Raratonga, which has no resident missionary, save a very
- conceited and upsetting young native teacher. The Atiuans were of old a
- wilder and fiercer race than even the Mangaians, and such determined
- cannibals that they used to make raids on the surrounding islands for the
- simple purpose of filling their cooking ovens, and enjoying a mighty
- feast. Great war canoes, laden with gory corpses, have many a time been&rsquo;
- drawn up on the very stretch of sand where we landed, and the grandfathers
- of the men who greeted us have sung and danced in fierce exultation to see
- the fat limbs and well-fed bodies of their enemies laid in ghastly heaps
- upon the snowy beach, ready for the cooking pits that since early morning
- had been glowing with flame in anticipation of the banquet.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Meek-faced Atiuans&rdquo; was the nickname bestowed upon these islanders, in
- derision, by those who knew their wiliness and treachery. There is not
- much that is meekfaced about them to-day. They certainly look rougher and
- less amiable than any others of the Cook Islanders, and they are by no
- means so amiable and easy-going as the Raratongans, Aitutakians, and
- people of Mitiaro and Mauke. However, it cannot be said that they are in
- any way dangerous, and the stray white people who have lived in the island
- (there was only one at the time of my visit) have always got on well with
- them. Rough, as I said before, they certainly are. A ring I wore on my
- hand attracted the attention of one or two of the men, and they crowded
- round, fingered it, and actually tried to snatch&mdash;an attempt very
- shortly put an end to by the Commissioner, who ordered them off
- peremptorily. The incident, although small, illustrates a standard of
- manners that one would certainly not encounter in any other part of the
- group, or indeed in any one of the Southern or Eastern Pacific groups that
- I afterwards saw.
- </p>
- <p>
- There was a good deal of native-manufactured lime-juice to be got away
- here, and the people (most of them more completely dressed than the party
- that had received us on the shore) were busy rolling down the casks into
- the water, where the out-going tide took them, and floated them across the
- reef to the schooner. It seemed a strange way of taking on cargo, but I
- learned, afterwards, that it is not uncommon in islands surrounded by a
- dangerous reef.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0025" id="linkimage-0025"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0225.jpg" alt="0225 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0225.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- The walk up to the settlement proved to be a good three miles, Atiu being
- one of the very few islands whose natives do not live down on the shore.
- The scenery was fine&mdash;wide rich plains covered with low scrub, or
- clothed with thick herbage, alternating with heavy forest. There is no
- better soil in the islands than that of Atiu. Guavas are a common weed;
- pumpkins run wild, trailing their long green vines and heavy fruit right
- across the track, mangoes, chestnuts, Pacific cherries, and othér fruits,
- grow without care or cultivation. Any tropical product can be raised, and
- land is exceedingly cheap. The reef has always been a handicap to the
- island; but I heard that a part had been blown up to admit of a boat
- passage, some time after my visit, also that the Union steamers had begun
- to call for cargoes&mdash;an important event in the history of any island,
- and one likely to do much for its future.
- </p>
- <p>
- The people are few in number&mdash;only nine hundred&mdash;and do not
- attempt to use more than a very small portion of the thirty-two square
- miles of their territory. Much is available for letting, and every inch of
- the island is worth cultivating, although to a stranger&rsquo;s eye it is hardly
- as fertile in appearance as other portions of the Cook Group that are much
- less valuable. Coffee, copra, oranges, bananas, sweet potatoes, could be
- profitably grown for export. The climate is good and healthy.
- </p>
- <p>
- The people have not dwindled down to their present small numbers through
- natural decay. Like another more famous island, Atiu is &ldquo;swarming with
- absentees.&rdquo; In the Society Islands, and here and there in other groups,
- whole villages full of Atiuans are to-day to be seen, who emigrated from
- their native country twenty or thirty years ago, owing to difficulties
- with the missionaries, and went to seek an asylum in lands where strings
- were drawn somewhat less tightly than they were at home. They never
- returned, though the island, when I saw it, had no resident white
- missionary at all, and in consequence their lands have lain idle ever
- since. The ill wind has blown good to planters and settlers, however, so
- one need not quarrel with it.
- </p>
- <p>
- Like Mangaia, Atiu has a cave&mdash;only a much larger one, and it has a
- mystery connected with the cave, which no one has yet attempted to solve.
- </p>
- <p>
- Sixty years ago or more (I was told&mdash;I do not swear to the truth of
- this or any other island story that I have not had the opportunity of
- investigating in person), an invading tribe came to Atiu, and in the
- course of several battles, defeated and put to rout one of the lesser
- tribes of the island. The vanquished ones, fearing that they would be
- killed and eaten, plucked up courage to try a desperate expedient, and hid
- themselves in the cave, into whose dark recesses no native had ever before
- ventured, for fear of offending the evil spirits that were said to live
- therein. After waiting for a day or two, the enemies gave up the contest,
- and went away again. It was now safe for the hunted tribe to come forth,
- and the other inhabitants of the island looked to see them return&mdash;for
- after all, it did not seem likely that the evil spirits would destroy so
- many. They waited in vain. From the unknown depths of the cave&mdash;unknown,
- in its innermost recesses, to the present day&mdash;no sign, no message
- reached them; no living soul ever came forth of the many men, women, and
- children who had braved the dangers of that dark portal. Lost they were,
- lost they remained.
- </p>
- <p>
- What happened to them? No one knows. It is not easy to destroy a whole
- tribe, and leave no sign. But the one white man who partly explored the
- cave some years ago, found nothing to hint at the nature of the tragedy.
- It is true that his candles gave out, and the cord that served him for a
- guide back among the endless windings of the place came to an end, so that
- he never knew quite how far the place went, or how many ramifications it
- had. Still, it is strange enough that not so much as a single human bone
- was to be seen. If the tribe had lost their way, and perished of hunger,
- some traces would certainly have been visible&mdash;a spear, a shell
- ornament, perhaps a skeleton. If they had fallen in a body over some
- treacherous inner precipice, the dangerous place would have been
- discoverable. Perhaps some new explorer will unravel the mystery, one of
- these days. It will not be a steamer passenger, however, for the Union
- boats on their rare calls do not stay long enough for any one to land, and
- the cave requires two clear days to reach and see.
- </p>
- <p>
- As we were not even stopping overnight ourselves, I had no opportunity of
- making an exploration on my own account. Thus the mystery rests unsolved&mdash;unless
- some one may have come to the island in a stray trading schooner since my
- visit, and found time enough to explore the unknown parts of the haunted
- cavern. The natives of Atiu, needless to say, put down the whole thing
- simply and solely to the revenge of the &ldquo;local demons.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- The people of the settlement, when we reached it, greeted our party with
- boisterous cheerfulness. The officials went to hold their court, as usual,
- and I, being as usual quite uninterested in the details of native boundary
- disputes conducted in an unknown tongue, amused myself with the women of
- the village. It might be more correct to say that they amused themselves
- with me. I do not think any white woman had been up to the settlement
- before I visited it, and the curiosity of the girls was uncontrollable.
- They crowded round me, they slyly felt my hair to see if the coils were
- attached to my head in Nature&rsquo;s own way (by which I conclude that the
- wearing of false hair is not unknown to themselves), they rubbed my dress
- material in their fingers, they poked me all over to see if I was real,
- and conducted such searching investigations into the quantity and style of
- my clothing, that I was obliged to speak to one or two as sharply as I
- knew how (the tongue was alien, but the tone was understood) and make them
- desist. Withal, they were not ill-natured, though certainly a little
- ill-mannered. They did not forget the duties of hospitality, but pressed
- fruit and cocoanut water on me, and one woman insisted on giving me a
- bottle full of honey to take away&mdash;a gift that was much appreciated
- by my fellow-passengers on the schooner, later on.
- </p>
- <p>
- I gratified them extremely by loosening the hair of one or two, and
- putting it up in the latest fashionable style, which proved so popular
- that the whole feminine half of the island set to hair-dressing at once,
- and before I left the island that day, a general and complete revolution
- in coiffure had taken place. We had a good deal of feminine talk among
- ourselves, before the men came out again: the fact that I did not know
- anything of the language, save perhaps half a dozen words, was no bar to a
- certain amount of thought-interchange. How was it done? Signs, for the
- most part: scraps, guesses, hints, stray native words made to do double
- and treble duty. Could I have talked to the husbands and brothers of the
- women in the same way? No, certainly not. All through my wanderings among
- the uncivilised folk of the island world, I was constantly interested and
- amused to see how quick the women were in the language of signs and
- makeshifts, how very uncomprehending the men. If I wanted to make a
- request of any kind, on an island where I did not know any of the
- language, I instinctively sought for a woman to interpret my signs for a
- boat, a guide, a trader&rsquo;s or missionary&rsquo;s house, and so forth; and found
- that the women understood, almost as surely as the men, under the same
- circumstances, did not. Psychologists may make what they like of the fact.
- Women, who have talked the &ldquo;sign-language&rdquo; to each other, many and many a
- time, over the innocent thick heads of their unsuspecting better-halves,
- friends, or brothers, will never doubt it. We are not as clever as men&mdash;let
- the equality brigade shriek if they like, &ldquo;it&rsquo;s as true as turnips is, as
- true as taxes&rdquo;&mdash;but neither are we as stupid. God forbid!
- </p>
- <p>
- I had practically the whole day to put in somehow, so, after the delights
- of hair-dressing had palled, and the afternoon was passing on, I accepted
- the invitation of a cheerful, though rather rough-looking pair of girls,
- whom I found crushing limes for lime juice in a very primitive sort of
- hand press, and followed them in to dinner in one of the native houses.
- </p>
- <p>
- There was a distinguished guest to be entertained&mdash;a woman of Atiu
- who had been away from the island with her husband for many months, and
- had now returned in the <i>Duchess</i>, quite civilised and chic and
- modern, with the up-to-dateness of far-away Auckland. This celebrity,
- regarded as a very Isabella Bird among the island women, scarce any of
- whom had ever seen the other side of their own reef, was seated on the
- mats when I entered, her legs folded under her, native fashion; not
- without evident discomfort, for the heels of very high-heeled, pointed
- boots are painful under such circumstances, and corsets laced to bursting
- point are absolutely deadly. Ritia&rsquo;s dark face was ominously empurpled,
- and perspiration due as much to agony as to the heat (which was
- undeniable) streamed over her forehead and down, her nose, from under the
- brim of her incredible picture hat. But pride upheld her, for who among
- the other women of the island owned such magnificent clothes?
- </p>
- <p>
- The people of the house received me with exultation. Now, the feast was
- indeed a gorgeous one, and the sea-green envy sure to be the lot of every
- housewife in settlement with whom I had not dined, shed additional lustre
- on the triumph. The food was just coming in as I entered and folded myself
- up on the mats&mdash;roast sucking-pig, smelling very good; a fat boiled
- fowl; some fish from the lagoon, baked like the pig in a ground oven, and
- done to a turn; arrowroot jelly; young green cocoanuts, with the meat
- still unset, clinging to the thin shell like transparent blanc-mange;
- breadfruit, smoking and floury; baked pumpkins; bananas, roasted in their
- skins; sweet potatoes; chestnuts. A large cocoanut, picked at the right
- stage for drinking, stood at each guest&rsquo;s right hand, and in the middle
- was a big bowl of milky cocoanut cream, into which each guest was supposed
- to dip his food as he ate.
- </p>
- <p>
- Plates there were none, but I have never thought clean, fresh, green
- leaves, a foot or two across, unpleasant substitutes for delf or china,
- which is handled and used by hundreds of eaters, and must be washed in
- greasy hot water at the end of every meal. There is a good deal to be said
- for the native custom, whether the point of view be that of convenience,
- cleanliness, or simple beauty.
- </p>
- <p>
- I, as the principal guest, was offered everything first, which obviated
- any unpleasantness that might have arisen from the entire absence of
- knives and forks. There is no hardship in eating with your fingers, if
- yours are the first to plunge into every dish, and you have your nice
- fresh leaf to yourself. The little pig I did not touch, because no one who
- has lived as much as a week in the islands will venture on native pork,
- good as it looks and smells. When an unfortunate beast is killed by
- strangulation, and never bled, and when you know that it has lived at its
- gipsy will, and fed more abominably than a land-crab, you are apt to find
- you are &ldquo;not hungry&rdquo; when its crackling little carcase comes to table in
- cerements of green leaves, and you ask for the breadfruit and the fish
- instead.
- </p>
- <p>
- The feast seemed likely to go on all afternoon, since no native thinks he
- has eaten enough, on such an occasion, until he is as gorged and as
- comatose as a stuffed anaconda. There is no obligation to stay longer than
- one likes, however, so I washed my hands and withdrew, as soon as it
- seemed good to me to do so.
- </p>
- <p>
- And by the way, if we of the civilised countries think that we invented
- fingerbowls, either in form, or in use, we are mistaken. The South Seas
- invented them, a few hundred years before we found out they were necessary
- to our own delicate refinement. A bowl full of water is handed round to
- every diner in a South Sea house. The water is from the river, pure and
- fresh; the bowl is of a mould more perfect than the most exquisite models
- of ancient Greece, delicately hued with pale brown in the inner part, and
- deep sienna brown outside. It is half a cocoanut shell&mdash;beautiful,
- useful, practically unbreakable, yet not of sufficient worth to prevent
- its being thrown away to-morrow and replaced by a fresh one from the
- nearest palm. Fresh plates and cups for one&rsquo;s food are a refinement that
- our refined civilisation has not attained to yet. You must go to savages
- to look for them.
- </p>
- <p>
- I thanked my hosts for their entertainment, in good English, when I left.
- They understood the words and tone almost as clearly as if I had spoken in
- their own language, and gave me a ringing salutation that followed me down
- the road. That a number of Atiuan men, coming up from the shore, burst out
- laughing when they saw me, and held on to each other in convulsions of
- merriment at the sight of my absurd white face and ridiculous clothes, did
- not detract from the real kindliness of the reception the island had given
- me. The manners of the Atiuan would certainly throw a Tahitian or a
- courtly Samoan into a fit; but for all that, he is not at bottom a bad
- sort, and could certainly be made something of with training.
- </p>
- <p>
- One of the Arikas of Atiu&mdash;a woman again: there seemed to be very few
- male chiefs in the islands&mdash;was pointed out to me as I went down to
- the shore, and I photographed her sitting in her chair. She looked
- dignified, and her long descent was visible in the pose of her small head,
- and the delicacy of her hands, but she did not possess much claim to
- beauty.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0026" id="linkimage-0026"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0249.jpg" alt="0249 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0249.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- The <i>Duchess</i> was standing off and on outside the reef when I came
- out on the beach again, and the barrels were merrily floating out, rolled
- down into the water by the hands of bu§y brown men and women. It was a
- pretty scene in the low yellow sunlight of the waning afternoon,&rsquo; and I
- carried it away with me, long after we had sailed; as a pleasant
- recollection of Atiu.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0009" id="link2HCH0009"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER IX
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>Islands and Adventures&mdash;What about the Missionary?&mdash;The Lotus
- Eaters&mdash;How to hunt the Robber-Crab&mdash;The Ship that would not
- sail&mdash;Proper Place of a Passenger&mdash;One Way to get wrecked&mdash;The
- Pirate and the Pearls.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">M</span>AUKE, Manuwai, and
- Takutea still remained to be seen, before the <i>Duchess</i> could spread
- her wings for Raratonga again. We sailed from one to another in the course
- of a few days. There was no hurry, and a day wasted here or there troubled
- none of us.
- </p>
- <p>
- Sometimes the &ldquo;trades,&rdquo; which are very fickle about here, came up and
- caught our towering canvas in a cool embrace; then the great hollows of
- the sails hummed with the music that the ocean wanderer loves, and the <i>Duchess</i>
- skimmed the rolling blue hills like a flying-fish. Sometimes the wind
- fell, and the booms swung and creaked lazily above the burning deck; then
- we trolled for albacore and bonito, shrieking with savage joy when our bit
- of long-desired fresh food came flapping and fighting over the rail; or we
- watched the crew hook devil-faced grey sharks, which, &ldquo;took charge&rdquo; of the
- deck when captured, hitting terrible blows with their tails, and snapping
- stout ropes with their savage teeth; or we got out boats, and rowed them
- for miles between the double furnaces of the blazing sun and the glowing
- sea, coming back to the ship scorched into cinders, stiff with exertion,
- but happy. At night the Southern Cross burned white in the velvet sky, and
- the coral rocks about the lagoons showed in shimmering pale blue
- underneath fifty feet or more of clear, moonlit water. Lying on the poop,
- like seals on sand, the little knot of passengers, captain, and mate,
- &ldquo;yarned&rdquo; for hour after hour&mdash;strange, wild tales of frontier life in
- new lands; of adventures in unknown seas; of fights, and more fights, and
- fights yet again&mdash;literature in the rough, a very gallery of vivid
- pictures wasted unseen... and yet, what should any man who had the rich
- reality care about its pale shadow, Story? &ldquo;Do you care much for reading?&rdquo;
- &ldquo;Well, no,&rdquo; answers the bare-footed officer lying with his head in a coil
- of rope; &ldquo;books aren&rsquo;t very interesting, are they?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- I, watching the mizzen truck swing among the stars, look back over the
- long, long trail&mdash;long both in distance and in time&mdash;that
- separates this small heaving deck in the midst of the tropic seas from the
- rush of the wintry Strand, Nights in islands of ill reputation, when I
- slept with &ldquo;one eye open&rdquo; and one hand within touch of my revolver (for
- there are incidents of my wanderings that I have not told, and only those
- who know the Eastern Pacific may guess at them); days when only a
- fifty-to-one chance kept the little schooner from piling her bones on a
- spouting coral reef in mid-ocean&mdash;rough fare, hard lodging, and long
- fatigue, sometimes, all to be &ldquo;eaten as helped,&rdquo; without comment or
- complaint, for that is the rule of island life&mdash;the pungent taste of
- danger, now and then, gratefully slaking some deep, half-conscious thirst
- derived from fiercer centuries; the sight of many lands and many peoples&mdash;these,
- and other pictures, painted themselves among the little gold stars swept
- by the rocking masts, as I lay^ remembering. I thought of the pile of
- untouched &ldquo;shockers&rdquo; in my cabin; of grey London and its pyramids of books
- and armies of writers; of the mirror that they hold up to life, and the
- &ldquo;magic web of colours gay&rdquo; they weave, always looking, like the Lady of
- Shalott, in the mirror, and seldom joining the merry rout outside, where
- no one cares a pin for coloured tapestries, and looking-glasses are left
- to half-grown girls. No, truly; &ldquo;books are not interesting,&rdquo; when you can
- have life instead.
- </p>
- <p>
- Upon which some one proposed &ldquo;Consequences&rdquo; in the cabin, and I made haste
- to climb down.
- </p>
- <p>
- Another day, gold and blue as are almost all the days of the &ldquo;winter&rdquo;
- season, and another island, burning white and blazing green, and another
- tumbling reef to jump, with the help of a powerful boat-holder, who stands
- in the midst of the surf, and drags the dinghy forward at the right
- moment. This is Mauke: we are getting on with the group, and begin to
- realise that some time or other, even in these timeless regions, will
- actually see us back at Raratonga.
- </p>
- <p>
- Mauke proves to be a pretty little place, some six miles in circumference,
- &ldquo;low&rdquo; in type, but park-like and gardenlike and dainty enough to wake
- covetous desires in the heart of almost any traveller. It has the finest
- oranges in the group&mdash;growing completely wild&mdash;and we are
- greeted on the shore by the usual crowd of flower-wreathed natives,
- bearing splendid branches of rich yellow fruit, which they present to
- every one with eager generosity. There are only three hundred and seventy
- natives in the island, and much of the land lies waste, though it is
- exceedingly fertile. The Mauke folk take things easy on the whole, and are
- not keen on trading. They export some oranges, some copra, a few bunches
- of dried bananas, and they buy a fair amount of cotton cloth, and shirts,
- and cutlery, from the white trader&rsquo;s store. But no one, so far, has grown
- fat on what Mauke makes or buys.
- </p>
- <p>
- There were, at the time of my visit, only one or two whites in the place.
- The greater portion of the land available for planting lay unused.
- Probable rents, on long leases, were quoted to me as a shilling or so an
- acre.
- </p>
- <p>
- The call at Mauke was short, and I saw little of the island. The natives
- insisted, however, that I should come up to the village and look at their
- church, of which they are very proud, so I headed the inevitable
- procession through the orange and lime and guava groves, to the little
- group of houses, partly thatch and reed, partly whitewashed concrete, that
- made up the settlement. The church was, of course, much the least
- interesting thing in the island. South Sea churches, with one or two happy
- exceptions, are blots in a world of beauty, monuments of bad taste,
- extravagance, and folly, that do very little credit to the religions they
- represent. In the days when most of them were built, the one idea of the
- missionary was the assimilation of the native to white men&rsquo;s ways and
- customs, as far as was possible, by any means conceivable&mdash;wise, or
- otherwise. In building churches for the new converts, the pattern followed
- was that set by Europeans for use in a cold climate, on sites that had a
- distinct money value per yard. Consequently, while South Sea houses, for
- coolness, are made almost all window and door, or else built, native
- fashion, in such a way that the air blows through the walls, South Sea
- churches are almost without ventilation, and (because the style of
- architecture selected is that of the whitewashed barn description) quite
- without beauty of any kind. In most cases, they have cost the islands
- appalling sums to build, and continue to demand a good deal to keep them
- in repair. There are happy exceptions here and there. Niué, of which place
- I have more to say later on, possesses a church built with exquisite taste
- and perfect regard to convenience, and the Catholic cathedral in Samoa is
- designed with much consideration as to climate, and appearance as well.
- </p>
- <p>
- Mauke&rsquo;s church, however, is not one of the exceptions, being exceedingly
- bald and ugly, and it is furthermore disfigured by the most horrible lapse
- of taste to be seen in almost any island church&mdash;the decoration of
- the pulpit and communion rails with silver dollars nailed on in rows. I
- told the crowd of natives, eager to hear the praises of their wonderful
- church, that I had never seen anything like it in my life&mdash;which
- seemed to afford them much gratification. I did not add what I thought&mdash;that
- I sincerely hoped I might never see anything like it again.
- </p>
- <p>
- A statement made only once or twice is fairly sure to miss the observation
- of the average reader, so I make no apology for saying here, as I have
- said in other parts of this book, that I am not one of those people who
- are opposed to mission work, or indifferent to religion; neither am I
- inclined to minimise the effects of the work done by missionaries in
- converting and civilising the Pacific generally. That the missionaries are
- infallible and always wise, however, in their methods of dealing with the
- natives, I do deny&mdash;which is only equivalent to saying that they are
- human, like the people at home. Nor do I think that, in these days, the
- missionary who takes up work in the Southern and Eastern Pacific has any
- need to wear the martyr aureole which is so persistently fitted on to the
- heads of all who go to &ldquo;labour&rdquo; in the island world. We are not in the
- days of Cook: cannibalism, over most of the Pacific, is dead and
- forgotten, violence to white people of any kind is unheard of, the
- climates are usually excellent, the islands beautiful, fertile, and happy,
- and the missionary&rsquo;s work is much the same as that of any country
- clergyman at home, save for the fact that his congregation are infinitely
- more submissive than whites would be, and incline to regard their teacher
- as a sovereign, not only spiritual, but temporal. The mission house is
- always much the finest building on the island, and the best furnished and
- provided. The missionary&rsquo;s children are usually sent away to be educated
- at good home or colonial boarding schools, and afterwards return to take
- up their parents&rsquo; work, or possibly to settle in the islands in other
- capacities. The life, though busy, is devoid of all stress and strain, and
- there is no apparent difficulty in &ldquo;making both ends meet&rdquo;&mdash;and
- overlap. In the Southern and Eastern Pacific, the missionaries are
- conveyed from group to group in a mission steamer that is little inferior
- to the yacht of a millionaire, for comfort and elegance. They are
- constantly assisted by gifts of all kinds, and treated with consideration
- wherever they go, and in most cases enjoy a social position much better
- than that originally possessed at home. It is hard to see why a
- profession, which is so pleasant and profitable, should be exalted over
- the work of thousands of struggling pastors and clergymen at home, who too
- often know the pinch of actual want, and are in many cases obliged to lead
- lives of the greyest and narrowest monotony.
- </p>
- <p>
- What is the moral? That one should not give money to missions? Certainly
- not. But if I were a millionaire, and had thousands to give in such a
- cause, I would give them carefully, with inquiry, directed to more sources
- than one, and would distribute them so that they should be used, if
- possible, in adding to the numbers of the Christian Church, rather than in
- teaching geography and English grammar and dressmaking to amiable brown
- people who are, and have been for generations, a good deal more Christian
- than ninety in a hundred whites. I believe firmly that most of the older
- missions in the Pacific could be continued perfectly well with the aid of
- native teachers, at one-twentieth the present cost&mdash;much as the
- teaching of outlying far-away islands, where residence is unpleasant for
- white families, is carried on to-day, with the aid of a yearly visit or
- so. That the present system will ever be modified, however, I do not
- believe. The reasons for such a conclusion are too obvious to need
- discussion.
- </p>
- <p>
- I have wandered a good way from the church at Mauke. But there are many
- points on this subject of island missions, nevertheless, on which I have
- not touched.
- </p>
- <p>
- Some of the men of Mauke were very busy on the shore, when our party
- passed down again to the boat. They made a bright picture, in their gay
- pareos of scarlet and yellow, and the snowy coronets of scented island
- flowers that they had twined about their heads. But the most picturesque
- thing about them was their occupation, which was neither more nor less
- than sand-castle building! There they sat, those big grown men, with never
- a child among them to make excuse for their play, building up churches and
- houses of the milk-white coral sand, scooping dark windows in the
- edifices, training green creepers up them, and planting out odd little
- gardens of branching coral twigs off the reef, in the surrounding
- pleasances. They had bundles of good things tied up in green leaves, lying
- somewhere in the shade of the guava bushes, and they had brought a pile of
- husked cocoanuts down to the shore with them, to drink when they pleased.
- They may have been waiting for a native boat, or they may have been simply
- making a day of it. In any case, they were sublimely happy.
- </p>
- <p>
- <i>(Cold rain on the miry road; faint gold sunset fading to stormy grey;
- wet leaves a-shiver in the dusk&mdash;and the long, long way before the
- tired feet. A day of toil, a comfortless night. A handful of coppers in
- the pocket; food and fire that must be bought with silver; freedom, rest,
- enjoyment, that cost unattainable gold. The sacred right of labour; a
- white man&rsquo;s freedom. O, brown half-naked islanders, playing at
- sand-castles on your sun-bathed shore, with unbought food lying among the
- unpurchased fruits beside you, what would you give to be one of the master
- race?)</i>
- </p>
- <p>
- Takutea we did not call at, since it was uninhabited, but the <i>Duchess</i>,
- under her daring little pirate of a captain, made no bones about running
- as close to anything, anywhere, as her passengers might desire, so we saw
- the fascinating place at fairly close quarters. In 1904, when I saw it, it
- was a real &ldquo;desolate island,&rdquo; being twelve miles out in the open sea from
- the nearest land (Atiu), and totally uninhabited. Its extent is four or
- five hundred acres; it is thickly wooded with cocoanuts-, and has a good
- spring of water. The beautiful &ldquo;bo&rsquo;sun bird,&rdquo; whose long red and white
- tail feathers have a considerable commercial value, is common on the
- island. No one had visited it for a long time when we sailed by; the wide
- white beach was empty, the cocoanut palms dropped their nuts unheeded into
- earth that received them gladly, and set them forth again in fountain-like
- sprays of green. The surf crumbled softly on the irregular fringing reef;
- the ripples of the lagoon laid their ridgy footsteps along the empty
- strand, and no Man Friday came to trample them out-with a step of awful
- significance. I wanted Takutea very badly indeed, all for myself; but I
- shall not have it now, neither will the reader, for some one else has
- bought it, and it is to be turned into a cocoanut plantation.
- </p>
- <p>
- Manuwai, better known as Hervey Island, is not many miles away, but we
- took a day or more to reach it, partly because the winds were contrary,
- partly because (with apologies to the Admiralty Surveys) it was wrongly
- charted, and could not be found, at first, in a slight sea-fog. Manuwai
- has changed its ownership and its use, of late, but in 1904 it was a penal
- settlement and a copra plantation combined, being used as a place of
- punishment for sinful Cook Islanders, who were compulsorily let out as
- labourers to the Company renting the two islets of which this so-called
- group is composed.
- </p>
- <p>
- The islands between them cover about fifteen hundred acres, according to
- the estimate given me. They have no permanent inhabitants, and when first
- taken up for planting, were quite desolate of life. A far-away, melancholy
- little place looked Manuwai, under the rays of the declining sun, as we
- came up to the reef. The two low islands, with their thick pluming of
- palms, are enclosed in the same lagoon, sheltered by a reef of oval form.
- There were a couple of drying-huts on the beach, and some heaps of oily
- smelling copra, when our boat pulled in. About twenty men, some convicts,
- some hired labourers, were gathered on the shore, fairly dancing with
- excitement, and the rest of the population&mdash;one white overseer, and
- one half-caste&mdash;were waiting on the very edge of the water, hardly
- less agitated. No ships ever called except the <i>Duchess</i>, and she was
- long overdue.
- </p>
- <p>
- I stepped on shore, and was immediately shaken hands with, and
- congratulated on being the first white woman to set foot on the island.
- Then we all went for a walk, while the native crew fell into the arms of
- the labourers, and with cries of joy began exchanging gossip, tobacco,
- hats, and shirts, bartering oranges from the ship for cocoanut crabs from
- the island, and eagerly discussing the question of who was going home in
- the <i>Duchess</i>, and who would have to stop over till her next call,
- perhaps six months hence.
- </p>
- <p>
- Manuwai is not one of the most beautiful of the islands, but anything in
- the way of solid ground was welcome after the gymnastics of the too-lively
- <i>Duchess</i>. The cocoa-nut plantations, and the new clearings, where
- the bush was being burned away, interested the officials from Raratonga,
- and the &ldquo;boulevard&rdquo; planted by the overseer&mdash;a handsome double row of
- palms, composing an avenue that facetiously began in nothing, and led to
- nowhere, received due admiration. We heard a good deal about the
- depredations of the cocoanut crabs, and as these creatures are among the
- strangest things that ever furnished food for travellers&rsquo; tales, I shall
- give their history as I gathered it, both in Manuwai and other places.
- </p>
- <p>
- One must not, by the way, believe all that one hears, or even half, among
- the &ldquo;sunny isles of Eden.&rdquo; Flowers of the imagination flourish quite as
- freely as flowers and fruits of the earth, and are much less satisfactory
- in kind. Also, it is a recognised sport to &ldquo;spin yarns&rdquo; to a newcomer,
- with the pious object of seeing how much he&mdash;or she&mdash;will
- swallow; and where so much is strange, bizarre, and almost incredible,
- among undoubted facts, it is hard to sift out the fictions of the playful
- resident.
- </p>
- <p>
- However, the cocoanut crab is an undeniable fact, with which many a
- planter has had to wrestle, much to his loss. It must be confessed that I
- had expected something very exciting indeed, when I heard in Tahiti that
- cocoanut or robber crabs were still to be found in some parts of the Cook
- Group. One of the most grisly bugbears of my youth had been the
- descriptions of the terrible cocoanut crab that attacked the &ldquo;Swiss Family
- Robinson&rdquo; on their wonderful island. It was described, if my memory serves
- me, as &ldquo;about the size of a turtle.&rdquo; and was dark blue in colour; it
- descended rapidly backwards down a tree, and immediately went to the
- attack of a Robinson youth, who repulsed it at the peril of his life....
- On the whole, I thought it would make things interesting, if it really was
- in the Cook Group.
- </p>
- <p>
- I never was more disappointed in my life than when I really saw one. It
- was dead, and cured in formalin, and only brought down from an island
- house as a show, but that was not the trouble. It was not more than two
- and a half feet long, lobster tail and all; it was not in the least like a
- turtle, and any small boy armed with a good stick could have faced it
- without fear, at its worst. No, decidedly the terrible crab was not up to
- the travellers&rsquo; tales that had been told about it.
- </p>
- <p>
- Still, it was worth seeing, for it was like nothing on the earth or in the
- sea that I had ever encountered. It had been excellently preserved, and
- looked wonderfully alive, when laid on the sand at the foot of a cocoanut
- palm. Its colour, as in life, was a gay mixture of red and blue. It had a
- long body like a colossal lobster, and two claws, one slight and thin, the
- other big enough to crack the ankle-bone of a man. It was an ugly and a
- wicked-looking thing, and I was not surprised to hear that it fights
- fiercely, if caught away from its hole, sitting up and threatening man or
- beast with its formidable claw, and showing no fear whatever.
- </p>
- <p>
- In the daylight, however, it is very seldom seen abroad. We walked through
- groves that were riddled with its holes that afternoon, but never even
- heard the scuffle of a claw. The creature lives in rabbit-like burrows at
- the foot of palm-trees, and the natives can always tell the size of the
- inmate by a glance at the diameter of the hole by which it enters its
- burrow. At night it comes out, climbs the nearest palm, and gets in among
- the raffle of young and old leaves, fibre, stalks, and nuts, in the crown,
- there it selects a good nut, nips the stalk in two with its claw, and lets
- the booty drop with a thump to the earth, seventy or eighty feel below.
- Then the marauder backs cautiously down the tree, finds the nut, and
- proceeds to rip and rend the tough husk until the nut as we know it at
- home is laid bare. A cocoanut shell is no easy thing to crack, as most
- people know, but the robber crab with its huge claws makes nothing more of
- it than we should make of an egg, and in a minute the rich oily meat is at
- the mercy of the thief, and another fraction of a ton of copra is lost to
- the planter. It goes without saying that any stray nuts lying on the
- ground have been opened and destroyed, before the crab will trouble itself
- to climb.
- </p>
- <p>
- Cocoanut crab is very good eating, and as it is mostly found in barren
- coral islands where little or nothing will grow but palms, the natives are
- always keen on hunting the &ldquo;robber.&rdquo; Sometimes he is secured by thrusting
- a lighted torch down a hole which possesses two exits&mdash;the crab
- hurrying out at the unopposed side as soon as the flame invades his
- dwelling. Sometimes the islanders secure him by the simple process of
- feeling for him in his burrow, and stabbing him at the end of it with a
- knife. This is decidedly risky, however, and may result in a smashed hand
- or wrist for the invader. A favourite plan is the following: Slip out in
- the dark, barefoot and silent, and hide yourself in a cocoanut grove till
- you see or hear a crab making his way up a tree. Wait till he is up at the
- top, and then climb half-way up, and tie a band of grass round the trunk.
- Now hurry down and pile a heap of rough coral stones from the beach at the
- foot of the tree. Slip away into the shadow again, and wait. The crab will
- start to come down presently, backing carefully, tail first, for he has a
- bare and unprotected end to his armoured body, and uses it to inform
- himself of his arrival on the safe ground below. Half-way down the tree he
- touches your cunning band of grass. &ldquo;Down so soon?&rdquo; he remarks to himself,
- and lets go. Crack! he has shot down forty feet through air, and landed
- smashingly on the pile of stones that you carefully prepared for his
- reception.
- </p>
- <p>
- He is badly injured, ten to one, and you will have little trouble in
- finishing him off with your knife, and carrying home a savoury supper that
- is well worth the&rsquo; waiting for. That is the native way of hunting robber
- crabs.
- </p>
- <p>
- When one lives on a cocoanut plantation, on an island that contains
- practically nothing else, one comes in time to know everything that is to
- be known about cocoanuts in general. But even the manager of Manuwai could
- not solve for me a problem that had been perplexing me ever since I had
- first seen a cocoanut palm&mdash;a problem, indeed, that after several
- more years of island travel, remains unanswered yet.
- </p>
- <p>
- Why is no one ever killed by a cocoanut?
- </p>
- <p>
- The question seems an idle one, if one thinks of cocoa-nuts as they are
- seen in British shops&mdash;small brown ovals of little weight or size&mdash;and
- if one has never seen them growing, or heard them fall. But when one knows
- that, the smallest nuts alone reach England (since they are sold by
- number, not by weight) and that the ordinary nut, in its husk and on its
- native tree, is as big as one&rsquo;s own head, and as heavy as a solid lump of
- hard wood&mdash;that most trees bear seventy or eighty nuts a year, and
- that every one of those nuts has the height of a four-storey house to drop
- before it reaches the ground&mdash;that native houses are usually placed
- in the middle of a palm grove, and that every one in the islands, brown or
- white, walks underneath hundreds of laden cocoanut trees every day in the
- year&mdash;it then becomes a miracle of the largest kind that no one is
- ever killed, and very rarely injured, by the fall of the nuts. Nor can the
- reason be sought in the fact that the nuts cannot hurt. One is sure to see
- them fall from time to time, and they shoot down from the crown of the
- palm like flying bomb-shells, making a most portentous thump as they reach
- the earth. So extremely rare are accidents, however, that in nearly three
- years I did not hear of any mishap, past or present, save the single case
- of a man who was struck by a falling nut in the Cook Islands, and knocked
- insensible for an hour or two. This is certainly not a bad record for a
- tour extending over so many thousand miles, and including most of the
- important island groups&mdash;every one of which grows cocoanut palms by
- the thousand, in some cases, by the hundred thousand.
- </p>
- <p>
- Travellers are often a little nervous at first, when riding or walking all
- day long through woods of palm, heavily laden with ponderous nuts. But the
- feeling never lasts more than a few days. One does not know why one is
- never hit by these cannon-balls of Nature&mdash;but one never is, neither
- is anybody else, so all uneasiness dies out very quickly, and one
- acquiesces placidly in the universal miracle.
- </p>
- <p>
- Planters say that most of the nuts fall at night, when the dew has relaxed
- the fibres of the stalks. This would be an excellent reason, but for the
- fact that the nuts don&rsquo;t fall any more at night than in the daytime, if
- one takes the trouble to observe, and that damp, or dew, tightens up
- fibres of all kind, instead of relaxing them. If one asks the natives, the
- usual answer is: &ldquo;It just happens that way&rdquo;; and I fancy that is as near
- as any one is likely to get to a solution.
- </p>
- <p>
- Manuwai, since I saw it, has been purchased outright by a couple of
- adventurous young Englishmen, who are working it as a copra plantation.
- Takutea has, therefore, a neighbour in the Robinson Crusoe business, and
- is not likely to be quite so solitary as in times past.
- </p>
- <p>
- The tour of the group was now ended, and the Government officials were
- conveyed back to Raratonga with all possible despatch&mdash;which is not
- saying very much, after all. There followed a luxurious interval of real
- beds and real meals, and similar Capuan delights, in the pretty island
- bungalow where my lot for the time had been cast. Then the <i>Duchess</i>
- began to start again, and peace was over. A sailing vessel does not start
- in the same way as a steamer. She gives out that she will leave on such a
- day, at such an hour, quite like the steamer; but there the resemblance
- ends. When you pack your cabin trunk, and have it taken down at 11 a.m.,
- you find there is no wind, so you take it back and call again next day.
- There is a wind now, but from the one quarter that makes it practically
- impossible to get out of port.&rsquo; You are told you had better leave your
- trunk, in case of the breeze shifting. You do, and go back for the second
- time to the hostess from whom you have already parted twice. The verandah
- (every one lives on verandahs, in the islands) is convulsed to see you
- come back, and tells you this is the way the ship always does &ldquo;get off.&rdquo;
- You spend a quiet evening, and go to bed. At twelve o&rsquo;clock, just as you
- are in the very heart of your soundest sleep, a native boy comes running
- up to the house to say that the captain has sent for the passenger to come
- down at once, for the wind is getting up, and he will sail in a quarter of
- an hour! You scramble into your clothes, run down to the quay, get rowed
- out to the ship, and finish your sleep in your cabin to the accompaniment
- of stamping feet and the flapping sails; and behold, at eight o&rsquo;clock, the
- bo&rsquo;sun thunders on your door, and tells you that breakfast is in, but the
- breeze is away again, and the ship still in harbour! After breakfast you
- sneak up the well-known avenue again, feeling very much as if you had run
- away from school, and were coming back in disgrace. This time, the
- verandah shrieks until the natives run to the avenue gate to see what is
- the matter with the man &ldquo;papalangis,&rdquo; and then console you with the
- prophecy that the schooner won&rsquo;t get away for another week.
- </p>
- <p>
- She does, though. In the middle of the afternoon tea, the captain himself
- arrives, declines to have a cup, and says it is really business this time,
- and he is away. You go down that eternal avenue again, followed by
- cheerful cries of &ldquo;No goodbye! we&rsquo;ll keep your place at dinner,&rdquo; and in
- half an hour the green and purple hills of lovely Raratonga are separated
- from you by a widening plain of wind-ruffled blue waves, and the <i>Duchess</i>
- is fairly away to Savage Island.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Miss G&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;, have you nearly done your book?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Pretty nearly&mdash;why?&rdquo; I ask, looking up from the pages of &ldquo;John
- Herring.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- We are a day or two out from Raratonga, but not even one hundred of the
- six hundred miles that lie between the Cook Group and lonely Niué is
- compassed as yet. The winds have been lightest of the light, and from the
- wrong quarter too, until this morning, when we have &ldquo;got a slant&rdquo; at last.
- Now the <i>Duchess</i> is rolling along in her usual tipsy fashion at
- seven or eight knots an hour, and the china-blue sea is ruffled and
- frilled with snow. It is hot, but not oppressively so, and I have been
- enjoying myself most of the morning lounging on a pile of locker cushions
- against the deck-house, alternately reading, and humming to myself
- something from Kipling about:
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- Sailing south on the old trail, our own trail, the out trail,
- </p>
- <p class="indent10">
- Sliding south on the long trail, the trail that is always new.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p>
- The pirate captain has been at the wheel for the last two hours, but I
- have not taken much note of the fact. Our only mate left us in the Cook
- Group, for a reason not absolutely new in the history of the world (a
- pretty little reason she was, too); and our bo&rsquo;sun, who has been giddily
- promoted to a rank that he describes as &ldquo;chief officer,&rdquo; is not exactly a
- host in himself, though he is a white man. In consequence, the pirate and
- he have been keeping watch and watch since we sailed&mdash;four hours on
- and four hours off&mdash;and, as one or two of our best A.B.s declined to
- go down to Niué, and most of the others are bad helmsmen, the two whites
- have been at the wheel during the greater part of their watches.
- </p>
- <p>
- I have grown quite accustomed to seeing one or other standing aft of the
- little companion that leads down to the cabin, lightly shifting the spokes
- in his hands hour after hour. It never occurred to me, however, that I was
- personally interested in the matter.
- </p>
- <p>
- But we are in the South Pacific, and I have still a good many things to
- find out about the &ldquo;way they do things at sea,&rdquo; here where the ocean is
- the ocean, and no playground for globe-trotting tourists.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Are you nearly done?&rdquo; asks the pirate again, shifting half a point, and
- throwing a glance at the clouds on the windward side. They are harmless
- little clouds, and only suggest a steady breeze.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;I have about half an hour&rsquo;s reading left,&rdquo; I answer.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Then you&rsquo;d better chuck the book into your cabin, for it&rsquo;s almost eight
- bells, and that begins your trick at the wheel,&rdquo; says the pirate calmly.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;My <i>what?</i>&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Your trick. Your turn. Time you have to steer, see?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;But, good heavens! I never had a wheel in my hand in my life&mdash;I
- don&rsquo;t know how!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;That&rsquo;s your misfortune, not your fault,&rdquo; says the pirate kindly. &ldquo;You&rsquo;ll
- never have to say that again.. There&rsquo;s eight bells now&mdash;come along. J&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;
- and I have had too much of the wheel, and now we&rsquo;re well away from land is
- your time to learn.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- And from thenceforth until we made the rocky coast of Niué, more than a
- week later, I spent a portion of every day with the polished spokes of the
- wheel in my hands, straining my eyes on the &ldquo;lubber&rsquo;s point,&rdquo; or anxiously
- watching the swelling curves of the sails aloft in the windy blue, ready
- to put the wheel up the instant an ominous wrinkle began to flap and
- writhe upon the marble smoothness of the leaning canvas. At night, the
- smallest slatting of sail upon the mast would start me out of my sleep,
- with an uneasy fear that I was steering, and had let her get too, close to
- the wind; and I deposed most of my prayers in favour of an evening litany
- that began: &ldquo;North, north by east, nor&rsquo;-nor&rsquo;-east, nor&rsquo;-east by north,
- nor&rsquo;-east,&rdquo; and turned round upon itself to go backward in the end, like a
- spell said upside down to raise a storm.
- </p>
- <p>
- Withal, the good ship left many a wake that would have broken the back of
- a snake, for the first day or two of my lessons, and the native A.B.s used
- to come and stand behind me when an occasional sea made the wheel kick,
- under the evident impression that they would be wanted before long. But I
- learned to steer&mdash;somehow&mdash;before we got to Niué, and I learned
- to lower away boats, and to manage a sixteen foot steer-oar, when we got
- becalmed, and spent the day rowing about among the mountainous swells, out
- of sheer boredom. And for exercise and sport, I learned to go up into the
- cross-trees and come down again by the ratlines or the back-stay,
- whichever seemed the handiest, wearing the flannel gymnasium dress I had
- brought for mountaineering excursions. It was very pleasant up there on a
- bright, salt-windy morning, when the <i>Duchess</i> swung steadily on her
- way with a light favouring breeze, her little white deck lying below me
- like a tea-tray covered with walking dolls, her masts at times leaning to
- leeward until my airy seat was swung far out across the water. Having a
- good head, I was never troubled with giddiness, and used to do a good deal
- of photographing from aloft, when the ship was steady enough to allow of
- it. That was seldom, however, for the <i>Duchess</i> had been built in New
- Zealand, where the good schooners do not come from, and had no more hold
- on the water than a floating egg. More than one sailing vessel turned out
- by the same builders had vanished off the face of the ocean, in ways not
- explained, by reason of the absence of survivors, but dimly guessed at,
- all the same; and I cannot allow that the pirate captain had any just
- cause of annoyance&mdash;even allowing for a master&rsquo;s pride in his ship&mdash;when
- I recommended him to have the schooner&rsquo;s name painted legibly on her keel
- before he should leave Auckland on his next northward journey, just &ldquo;in
- case.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- We were about a hundred and fifty miles off Niué, when the pirate came to
- me one windy morning, and asked me if I wanted to see something that had
- only been once seen before.
- </p>
- <p>
- There was, of course, only one reply possible.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Then keep a look-out, and you&rsquo;ll see it,&rdquo; said the pirate. &ldquo;We&rsquo;re going
- to run right by Beveridge Reef, and it&rsquo;s been only once sighted. What&rsquo;s
- more, it&rsquo;s wrong charted, and I&rsquo;m going to set it right. You&rsquo;ve no idea
- what a lot of wrecks there have been on that d&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;
- that dangerous place. Not a soul ever got away from one of them to tell
- what happened, either. They&rsquo;d only know when things began drifting down to
- Niué, weeks after&mdash;timber and cargo, and so on&mdash;why, a lot of
- the houses in Niué are built out of wreckage&mdash;and then people would
- say that there&rsquo;d been another wreck on Beveridge Reef. Some fool reported
- it as a coral island two miles across, once upon a time, but I&rsquo;ll bet he
- never saw it. If it had been, it wouldn&rsquo;t have been as destructive as it
- is.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- Late in the day we sighted it. The pirate was aloft, swinging between
- heaven and earth, with a glass in his hand, calling out observations to
- the chief-officer-boatswain below. The crew were attending exclusively to
- the horizon, and letting the ship look after herself, according to the
- amiable way of Maories when there is anything interesting afoot. The
- weather was darkening down, and heavy squalls of rain swept the sea now
- and then. But there it was, clearly enough to be seen in the intervals of
- the squalls, a circle of white foam enclosing an inner patch of livid
- green, clearly marked off from the grey of the surrounding ocean. Here and
- there a small black tooth of rock projected from the deadly ring of surf,
- and&mdash;significant and cruel sight&mdash;two ships&rsquo; anchors were
- plainly to be seen through the glass, as we neared the reef, lying fixed
- among the rock, so low in the water as only to be visible at intervals.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;A wicked place,&rdquo; said the captain, who had come down from his eyrie, and
- was giving orders for the preparation of a boat. &ldquo;Couldn&rsquo;t see a bit of it
- at night&mdash;couldn&rsquo;t see it in broad daylight, if there was a big sea
- on. And wrong charted too. Think of the last minutes of those poor chaps
- the anchors belonged to!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- The sea and sky were really beginning to look nasty, and I did not want to
- think of it. But the pirate went discoursing pleasantly of deaths and
- wrecks, while the men were putting various things into the whaleboat, and
- getting ready to lower away. He did not often have a passenger, but when
- he did, he evidently thought it his duty to keep her entertained.
- </p>
- <p>
- We were very near to the reef now&mdash;so close that I was able to take a
- photograph of it, a little marred by the rainy weather. Meantime, the boat
- was being swung out, and the men were getting in. And now &ldquo;a strange thing
- happened.&rdquo; Out of nowhere at all eight sharks appeared&mdash;large ones,
- too&mdash;and began to cruise hungrily about the <i>Duchess&rsquo;s</i> hull,
- their lithe yellowish bodies sharply outlined in the dark blue water,
- their evil eyes fixed on me, as I overhung the rail to look at them. &ldquo;If
- only!&rdquo; they said as plainly as possible, with those hideously intelligent
- green orbs. &ldquo;If only&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;What has brought those horrible brutes about us?&rdquo; I asked.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Those? oh, they&rsquo;re waiting to be fed, I suppose. Pretty much all the
- ships that came this way before us have given them a good dinner. I bet
- they say grace before meat now every time they see a sail, which isn&rsquo;t
- often. Here, you Oki, put in that keg of beef.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Where are you going?&rdquo; I demanded with considerable interest, for the
- pirate captain never did things like any one else, and I scented an
- adventure.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Going to find out what the inside of that lagoon is really like. No one
- ever put a boat into it yet. No, you can&rsquo;t be in it this time: very sorry,
- but&mdash;&mdash;&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;What?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Well, you see, one isn&rsquo;t absolutely sure of getting back again, in a
- place like this. Didn&rsquo;t you see me put in grub and water and a compass? I
- don&rsquo;t think you&rsquo;d like a boat voyage down to Niué, if we happened to miss
- the train. The mate has the course, and could take her on, if I came to
- grief. No, it isn&rsquo;t any use asking, I just can&rsquo;t. Lower away.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- They lowered and&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;
- </p>
- <p>
- Well, if the pirate had been a shade less determined about the number in
- the boat, there would have been a pretty little tragedy of the sea, that
- gusty afternoon. One more in the boat had certainly turned the scale. For
- the wind was continually getting up, and the wretched <i>Duchess</i> was
- rolling like a buoy, and the boat as she touched the water, with the
- captain and three men in her, was caught by the top of a wave, and dashed
- against the side of the ship. In a flash she was overturned, with a badly
- damaged thwart, and was washing about helplessly among the waves, with the
- four men clinging to her keel. The sea took her past the schooner like a
- rag. I had only time to run to the stern, before she was swept out of
- hearing, but I heard the pirate call as he disappeared in the trough of a
- wave, &ldquo;Get out your camera, here&rsquo;s the chance of your life!&rdquo; Then the boat
- was gone, and for a moment the mate and I thought it was all over. &ldquo;The
- sharks will have &rsquo;em if they don&rsquo;t sink!&rdquo; declared that officer,
- straining over the rail, while the Maori crew ran aimlessly about the
- deck, shouting with excitement.
- </p>
- <p>
- What happened during the next half-hour has never been very clear in my
- memory. The wind kept rising, and the afternoon grew late and dark. The
- overturned boat, with the four heads visible about her keel, drifted
- helplessly in the trough of the seas, at the mercy of waves and sharks. (I
- heard, afterwards, that the men had all kicked ceaselessly to keep them
- away, and that they expected to be seized any moment.) The wind screamed
- in the rigging, and drifts of foam flew up on deck, and the Maories ran
- about and shouted, and got in each other&rsquo;s way, and tried to heave ropes,
- and missed, and tried to launch a boat under the mate&rsquo;s direction, and
- somehow did not&mdash;I cannot tell why. And right in the middle of the
- play, when we seemed to be making some attempt to bear down upon the
- drifting wreck, a grey old man who had come on with us from the Cook
- Islands, but had kept to his berth through illness most of the time, burst
- out on deck with an astonishing explosion of sea language, and told us
- that we were nearly on to the reef. Which, it seems, every one had
- forgotten!
- </p>
- <p>
- After that, things grew so lively on the poop that I got up on the top of
- the deck-house to keep out of the way, and reflect upon my sins. It seemed
- a suitable occasion for devotional exercises. The white teeth of the reef
- were unpleasantly near, the water was growing shoal. &ldquo;Put a leadsman in
- the chains this minute!&rdquo; yelled the grizzled passenger (who had been at
- sea in his time, and knew something of what was likely to happen when you
- got a nasty reef on your lee side, with the wind working up). The
- auxiliary engine, meant for use on just such occasions, had been sick for
- some time. There was a very strong tide running, the wind had shifted
- while the ship&rsquo;s company were intent on the fate of the boat, and on the
- whole it looked very much as if the decorations already possessed by the
- notorious reef were likely to be increased by another pair of best quality
- British made anchors&mdash;<i>ours</i>.
- </p>
- <p>
- A good many things happen on sailing ships&mdash;Pacific ships especially&mdash;that
- one does not describe in detail, unless one happens to be writing fiction.
- This is not fiction, so the occurrences of the next quarter of an hour
- must be passed over lightly. The ancient passenger took command of the
- ship. We got away from the reef by an unpleasantly close shave and bore
- down upon the boat, which the pirate captain had impossibly contrived to
- right by this time, paddling it along with one oar, while the men baled
- constantly. We got the captain and the men and the damaged boat on board,
- and a few &ldquo;free opinions, freely expressed&rdquo;&mdash;as a certain famous lady
- novelist would put it&mdash;were exchanged. Then the pirate, who was quite
- fresh, and very lively, demanded the second boat, and said he was bound to
- get into that place anyhow, and wouldn&rsquo;t leave till he did.
- </p>
- <p>
- I rather think we mutinied at this juncture. I am sure I did, because I
- had been thinking over my sins for some time, and had come to the
- conclusion that there really were not many of them, and that I wanted a
- chance to accumulate a few more, preferably of an agreeable kind, before I
- faced the probability of decorating any Pacific coral reef with my
- unadorned and unburied skeleton. The grey-haired passenger and the mate
- mutinied too, upon my example, and the pirate, seeing that we were three
- to one, and moreover, that it was growing dusk, made a virtue of
- necessity, and went off for a shift of clothes, giving orders to make all
- sail at once. And so we left the reef in the growing dusk, and no man has
- to this day disturbed the virgin surface of its stormy little lagoon with
- profanely invading oar.
- </p>
- <p>
- Was there a fortune lying concealed beneath those pale green waves within
- the foaming jaws of the reef? I never heard. But there were some among our
- native crew who came from the far-off island of Penrhyn, where the pearl
- fisheries are, and they were strong in asserting their belief that the
- pirate might have been well paid for his exploration. It was just that
- sort of reef, said the pearl-island men, that most often contained good
- shell, and produced the biggest pearls, the first time of looking. An old,
- undisturbed atoll, where no one had ever thought of looking for shell, was
- the place where big pearls got a chance to grow. The first comer scooped
- in the prizes; afterwards, the shell itself and the smaller pearls were
- all that any one was likely to get.
- </p>
- <p>
- However that might be, the talk, on the rest of the way down to Niué, ran
- much on pearls and pearl-shell, and I learned a good deal about these
- gold-mines of the Pacific&mdash;always making allowance for the inevitable
- Pacific exaggeration. Any man who can live a year among the islands, and
- restrain himself, in the latter part of his stay, from lying as naturally
- and freely as he breathes, deserves a D.S.O.
- </p>
- <p>
- Stripped of flowers of fiction, the romance of the pearling trade was
- still interesting and fascinating enough. Pearls, in the Pacific, are
- obtained from a large bivalve that has a good deal of value in itself,
- being the material from which mother-o&rsquo;-pearl is made. Prices, of course,
- fluctuate very much, as the shell is used in so many manufactures that
- depend on the vagaries of fashion; but the value may run to £200 a ton or
- over. When it gets down to £40 or less, it is hardly worth the expense of
- lifting and carrying. For the most part, however, it is worth a good deal
- more than this, and when it is at the highest, fortunes can be, and have
- been, made out of small beginnings, in a very short time. The pearls are
- an &ldquo;extra,&rdquo; and not to be relied upon. There may be almost none in a big
- take of shell, there may be a few small ones, there may be a number of
- fine ones that will make the fortune of the lucky fisher. It is all a
- gamble, and perhaps none the less fascinating for that. Much of the best
- shell and the finest pearls in the Pacific, come from the Paumotus, which
- are French. Thursday Island, off the north of Queensland, was the great
- centre of the fishery, until lately, but it has been almost fished out.
- The Solomons were reported to have a good deal of shell, and a rush took
- place to that part not long ago, but the yield was much exaggerated. There
- are a good many atolls about the Central Pacific in general, which contain
- more or less shell, and are generally owned and fished by Australian
- syndicates. Outlying reefs and islets, where no one goes, now and then
- turn out to be valuable. The news of a find travels apparently on the
- wings of the seagulls from group to group, for no such place ever remains
- secret for more than a very short time, and then, if the owner&rsquo;s title is
- not secure (a thing that may easily happen, in the case of an island that
- does not lie within the geographical limits of any of the annexed groups)
- there is sometimes trouble. Pearl-poaching is easy and profitable, if not
- very safe; and who is to tell ugly tales, a thousand miles from anywhere,
- out in the far Pacific?
- </p>
- <p>
- <i>(The swift-winged schooner and the racing seas: decks foam-white
- beneath a burning sky: salt wind on the lips, and the fairy-voiced
- enchantress Adventure singing ever from beyond the prow! &ldquo;O dreamers in
- the man-stifled town,&rdquo; do you hear the wide world calling?)</i>
- </p>
- <p>
- And so the pirate captain brought us up to Niué, and left me there, and
- sailed away with the ship to Auckland, where he gave over the command, and
- went (so it was said) to aid in the instruction of sea-going youth,
- somewhere further south. The Cook Islands shrieked with joyous amusement
- when they heard of the pirate&rsquo;s new rôle as the guide and mentor of tender
- boyhood&mdash;but I do not know, after all. The pirate was as full of
- mischief as an egg is full of meat, as full of fight as a sparrow-hawk,
- gifted with an uncanny faculty for plunging into every kind of risk that
- the wide seas of the earth could hold, and coming out unscathed and asking
- for more. He was assuredly not to be numbered among the company of the
- saints, but neither is the average &ldquo;glorious human boy&rdquo;&mdash;and on the
- principle of setting a thief to catch a thief, the pirate&rsquo;s new rôle may
- well have turned out a success.
- </p>
- <p>
- We came up to Niué graced by a last touch of the piratical spirit. There
- was some blusterous weather as we neared the great island with its
- iron-bound, rocky coasts, towards which we had been making for so many
- days, but we swept up towards the land with every rag of canvas set, for
- that was the pirate captain&rsquo;s custom, and he would not break it.
- By-and-by, as I was standing on the main deck, holding on to the
- deckhouse, while I looked at the looming mass of blue ahead, the main
- square-sail gave way with a report like a gun, and began to thrash the
- foremast with streamers of tattered canvas. The pirate had it down in a
- twinkling, and got the men to bend on a new sail immediately. It went up
- to the sound of yelling Maori chants (for the crew liked this sort of
- excitement), and once more the ship fled on towards Niué with every sail
- straining against the gusty wind. Half-an-hour, and crack!&mdash;the new
- square-sail was gone too, and half of it away to leeward like a huge grey
- bird in a very great hurry. And the pirate, as we began to draw inshore,
- raged up and down the deck, like a lion baulked of its prey. To come up to
- Niué without every sail set was a disgrace that he had never yet
- encountered, and it evidently hit him hard that he had not another sail in
- the locker, and was forced to &ldquo;carry on&rdquo; as best he could without it.
- </p>
- <p>
- Niué, or Savage Island, is no joke to approach. It is about forty miles
- round, and almost every yard of the whole forty is unapproachable, by
- reason of the precipitous cliffs, guarded by iron spears of coral rock,
- that surround it on every side. There are one or two places where an
- approach can be made, in suitable weather, with care, but it is quite a
- common thing for sailing vessels to beat on and off as much as a week,
- before they succeed in landing passengers and goods. We came up on a very
- gusty day, with the blow-holes in the cliffs spouting like whales as we
- went by, but the pirate captain ran us into the anchorage below Alofi as
- easily as if it had been perfect weather and an excellent harbour, and we
- put out a boat to land our goods, including myself. The pirate had not an
- ounce of caution in his body, but, as an old Irishman on one of the
- islands declared: &ldquo;The divil takes care of his own, let him alone for
- that, and it&rsquo;s not the Pirate that he&rsquo;s goin&rsquo; to let into any houle till
- he lets him into the biggest wan of all&mdash;mind that!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0010" id="link2HCH0010"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER X
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>How not to see the Islands&mdash;Lonely Niué&mdash;A Heathen Quarantine
- Board&mdash;The King and the Parliament&mdash;The Great Question of Gifts&mdash;Is
- it Chief-like?&mdash;The New Woman in Niué&mdash;Devil-fish and
- Water-Snakes&mdash;An Island of Ghosts&mdash;How the Witch-Doctor died&mdash;The
- Life of a Trader.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">L</span>ANDINGS on Pacific
- islands are not usually easy, but there are few approaches as bad as that
- of Niué, the solitary outlier of Polynesia. It is a difficult task to get
- within reasonable distance of the land in the first place, and when the
- ship has succeeded in manoeuvring safely up to the neighbourhood of the
- cruel cliffs, the trouble is only beginning. There are no harbours worth
- the name on the island, although the cliffs show an occasional crack
- through which a boat may be brought down to the sea, and the circling reef
- is broken here and there. The best that a ship can do is to lie off at a
- safe distance, put out a boat, and trust to the skill of the crew to
- effect a landing on the wharf. In anything but really calm weather,
- communication is impossible. However, there are very many calm days in
- this part of the Pacific, so chances are fairly frequent.
- </p>
- <p>
- It was not at all as calm as one could have wished when the <i>Duchess</i>
- put out her whaleboat to bring me ashore. But the pirate trusted to his
- luck, and was, as usual, justified. The boat passage proved to be a mere
- crack in the reef, through which the sea rushed with extreme violence,
- dancing us up and down like a cork. It was not difficult for our smart
- Maori crew to fend us off the knife-edged coral walls with their oars, as
- we manoeuvred down towards the spider-legged little iron ladder standing
- up in the surf, and pretending to be a wharf. But when we got within an
- oar&rsquo;s length of the ladder, and the boat was leaping wildly on every
- swell, things got more exciting. The only way of landing on Niué is to
- watch your time at the foot of the ladder, while the men fend the boat off
- the coral, and jump on to the rungs at the right moment. A native standing
- on the platform at the top takes you by the arms as you rise, and snatches
- you into the air as the eagle snatched Endymion. Only, instead of going
- all the way to heaven, you land on the pier&mdash;or what passes for it&mdash;and
- find yourselves upon the soil of Niué.
- </p>
- <p>
- Behind the pier rises a little pathway cut in the face of the rock, and
- leading up to the main street of the capital. Once up the path, we are
- fairly arrived in Savage Island.
- </p>
- <p>
- It is not a place known to the globe-trotting tourist, as yet. Much of the
- Pacific has been &ldquo;discovered&rdquo; by the tripper element of recent years, but
- Niué is still almost inviolate. Once here, if one seeks the true spirit of
- the South Seas, one still may find it.
- </p>
- <p>
- Travellers go in scores by every steamer to Samoa, to Fiji, to Honolulu,
- which are on the beaten track of &ldquo;round-the-world.&rdquo; They drive up to
- Stevenson&rsquo;s villa, they make excursions to Nuuanu Pali, they see a sugar
- plantation here, and a kava drinking there, and a native dance, specially
- composed to suit tourists&rsquo; tastes, somewhere else. They stay a week in a
- fine modern hotel, drink green cocoanuts (and other things that are
- stronger), take photographs of island girls wearing imported Parisian or
- Sydney costumes, and think they have seen the life of the islands. Never
- was there a greater mistake. The sweet South Seas do not so easily yield
- up their secret and their charm. The spell that for three hundred years
- has drawn the wandering hearts of the world across the ocean ploughed by
- the keels of Drake and Hawkins and Cook, of Dampier, Bougainville, and
- Bligh, will not unfold itself save to him who will pay the price. And the
- price to-day is the same in kind, though not in degree, as that paid by
- those old explorers and adventurers&mdash;hard travel, scanty food,
- loneliness, loss of money and time, forgetting the cities and
- civilisation. To know the heart of the South Seas, all these things must
- be encountered willingly, with a love of the very hardship they may bring,
- strong as the seabird&rsquo;s love of the tossing waters and thunderwaking
- storm.
- </p>
- <p>
- The typical British tourist&mdash;yes, even he&mdash;hears from far off,
- at times, the mysterious call of the island world, and tells himself that
- he will listen to it a little nearer, and enjoy the siren song sung to so
- many long before him. Hence his visits to the great Pacific ports that can
- be reached by liner; hence, in most cases, his gradually acquired
- conviction that the islands are, after all, very much like any other place
- in the tropics&mdash;beautiful, interesting, but&mdash;&mdash; Well,
- writer fellows always exaggerate: every one knows that.
- </p>
- <p>
- Hotel dinners, big liners, shops, hired carriages, guides, and picture
- postcards&mdash;these things are death to the spirit of the South Seas.
- This is the first lesson that the island wanderer must learn. Where every
- one goes the bloom is off the peach. Leave the great ports and the
- steamers; disregard the advice of every one who knows anything (most
- people in the island towns know everything, but you must not listen to
- them, for the jingling of the trade dollar has long since deafened their
- ears to the song of the mermaids on the coral beaches); take ship on a
- schooner, it does not much matter where; live in a little bungalow under
- the palms for weeks or months; ride and swim and feast with the brown
- people of the coral countries, as one of themselves; learn, if you do not
- already know, how to live on what you can get, and cook what you catch or
- pick or shoot, to sleep on a mat and wash in a stream, do without
- newspapers and posts, forget that there ever was a war anywhere, or an
- election, or that there will ever be a &ldquo;season&rdquo; anywhere again; and so
- perhaps, the charm of the island world will whisper itself in your waiting
- ear. What then? What happened to the men who ate the enchanted fruit of
- the lotus long ago? Well, no one ever said that the sweetness of the fruit
- was not worth all that it cost.
- </p>
- <p>
- There are about five thousand native inhabitants on Niué, and generally a
- score or so of whites&mdash;almost all traders. Alofi, the capital,
- possesses a few hundred of the former, and nearly all the latter. It is a
- winsome little spot, and I loved it the moment the wide grassy street
- first broke upon my view, as I climbed the narrow pathway from the shore.
- </p>
- <p>
- The houses stand down one side, as is the invariable custom of South Sea
- towns. They are whitewashed concrete for the most part, built by the
- natives out of materials furnished by the coral reef. The roofs are
- plaited pandanus thatch, high and steep. The doors are mostly windows, or
- the windows doors&mdash;it would be hard to say which. They are simply
- long openings filled in with wooden slats, which can be sloped to suit the
- wind and weather. Mats and cooking pots and the inevitable Chinese
- camphor-wood box, for keeping clothes in, are all the furniture. Round the
- doorways grow palms and gay hibiscus, and cerise-flowered poinsettia, and
- here and there a native will have set up an odd decoration of glittering
- stalactites from the caves on the shore, to sparkle in the sun by his
- doorstep. The white men&rsquo;s houses have grass compounds in front for the
- most part, and many have iron roofs, glass windows, and other luxuries.
- </p>
- <p>
- All these houses look the one way&mdash;across the wide, empty grassy
- street, between the stems of the leaning palms, to the sunset and the
- still blue sea. It is a lonely sea, this great empty plain lying below the
- little town. The <i>Duchess</i> calls twice a year, the mission steamer
- once, a trade steamer, ancient and worn out, limps across from Tonga,
- about three hundred miles away, every ten or twelve months. That is all.
- The island itself owns nothing bigger than a whaleboat, and cannot as a
- rule communicate with any other place in case of emergency. Some few
- months before my visit, a trader had very urgent need to send a letter to
- Australia. After waiting in vain for something to call, he sighted an
- American timber brig on her way to Sydney, far out on the horizon. Hastily
- launching a native canoe, and filling it with fruit, he paddled three or
- four miles out to sea, in the hope of being seen by the ship. His signals
- were perceived, and the brig hove to, when the trader paddled up to her,
- offered his fruit as a gift, and begged the captain to take his letter.
- This the sailor willingly did, and still more willingly accepted the
- excellent Niué bananas and oranges that went with the missive. And so the
- post was caught&mdash;Niué fashion.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is no doctor on the island as a rule, and if you want to die during
- the intervals between ships, you may do so unopposed. I am almost afraid
- to state how healthy the people of Niué are as a rule, in spite of&mdash;or
- can it be in consequence of?&mdash;this deprivation.
- </p>
- <p>
- The &ldquo;bush&rdquo; overflows the town, after the charming way of bush, in this
- island world. Big lilies, bell-shaped, snowy petalled, and as long as your
- hand, spill over into the main street from the bordering scrub. The grass
- on the top of the cliff, the day I landed, was blazing with great drifts
- of fiery salvia, and starred with pink and yellow marigolds. About the
- houses were clumps of wild &ldquo;foliage plants,&rdquo; claret and crimson leaved,
- looking like a nurseryman&rsquo;s bedding-out corner. The coco palm that I knew
- so well had a sister palm here, of a kind new to me&mdash;an exceedingly
- graceful tree twenty to thirty feet high, bearing small inedible
- berry-like fruits, and splendid fan-shaped leaves, of the shape and size
- once so familiar in the &ldquo;artistic type of drawing-room&rdquo; at home. Pinnacles
- of fantastic grey rock, all spiked and spired, started up unexpectedly in
- the midst of the riotous green, and every pinnacle was garlanded cunningly
- with wreaths and fronds of flowering vines. There were mammee-apples and
- bananas beside most of the houses: yellow oranges hung as thickly in the
- scrub as ornaments on a Christmas tree, and one or two verandahs were
- decorated with the creeping trailers of the delicious granadilla. A land
- of peace and plenty, it looked in the golden rays of the declining sun,
- that windy blue afternoon. It proved alas, to be nothing of the kind: its
- soil is fertile, but so thinly scraped over the coral rock for foundation,
- that very little in the way of nutritious food will grow&mdash;it has no
- water save what can be gathered from deep clefts in the rocks, the bananas
- are scanty, the mammee-apples unsatisfying, and the &ldquo;oranges&rdquo; are for the
- most part citrons, drinkable, as lemons are, but little use for anything
- else. Indeed, Niué is a useless place altogether, and nobody makes
- fortunes there now-a-days, though one or two did well out of the &ldquo;first
- skim&rdquo; of its trading, a generation ago. Nor does any one grow fat there,
- upon a diet of tinned meats, biscuit, and fruit. Nor are there any
- marvellous &ldquo;sights,&rdquo; like the volcanoes of Hawaii, or the tribe dancing
- and firewalking of Fiji. Still I loved Niué, and love it yet.
- </p>
- <p>
- It was so very far away, to begin with. In other islands, with regular
- steamers, people concerned themselves to some degree about the doings of
- the outer world, and used to wonder how things were getting on, beyond the
- still blue bar of sea. Newspapers arrived, people came and went, things
- were done at set times, more or less. One was still in touch with the
- world, though out of sight.
- </p>
- <p>
- But in Niué, the isolation was complete. There was no come and go. We were
- on the road to nowhere. Nobody knew when any communication with anywhere
- would be possible, so nobody troubled, and save for an occasional
- delirious day when a ship really did come in, and waked us all from our
- enchanted slumber for just So long as you might turn round and look about
- you before dropping off into dreams again, we were asleep to all that lay
- beyond the long horizon line below the seaward-leaning palms. Niué was the
- world. The rest was a cloudy dream.
- </p>
- <p>
- I rented a little cottage in the heart of a palm-grove, when I settled
- down to wait for the problematic return of the <i>Duchess</i>, and see the
- life of Niué. It belonged to a native couple, Kuru and Vekia, who were
- well-to-do, and had saved money selling copra. The Niuéan, unlike every
- other Polynesian, is always willing and anxious to make a bargain or do a
- deal of any kind, and Kuru and his wife were as delighted to get the
- chance of a &ldquo;let&rdquo; as any seaside landlady. They moved their small goods
- out of the house most readily, and left me in full possession of the two
- rooms and the verandah and the innumerable doors and windows, with
- everything else to find for myself.
- </p>
- <p>
- A general collection of furniture, taken up by a friendly white resident,
- resulted in the loan of a bed and a box and a table, three chairs, some
- cups and cutlery, and a jug and basin. These, with a saucepan lent by my
- landlady (who, as I have said, was rich, and possessed many superfluities
- of civilisation), made up the whole of my household goods. For two months
- I occupied the little house among the palms, and was happy. &ldquo;Can a man be
- more than happy?&rdquo; runs the Irish proverb, and answer there is none.
- </p>
- <p>
- There were never, in all my island wanderings, such shadows or such
- sunsets, as I saw in lonely Niué. The little house was far away from
- others, and the palms stood up round it close to the very door. In the
- white, white moonlight, silver-clear and still as snow, I used to stay for
- half a night on my verandah, sitting crosslegged in the darkness of the
- eaves, and watching the wonderful great stars of shadow drawn out, as if
- in ink, round the foot of every palm-tree. The perfect circle of tenderly
- curving rays lay for the most part still as some wonderful drawing about
- the foot of the tree; but at rare intervals, when the hour was very late,
- and even the whisper of the surf upon the reef seemed to have grown tired
- and dim and far away, the night would turn and sigh in its sleep for just
- a moment, and all the palm-tree fronds would begin to sway and shiver up
- in the sparkling moon-rays, glancing like burnished silver in the light.
- Then the star at the foot would dance and sway as well, and weave itself
- into forms of indescribable beauty, as if the spirit of Giotto of the
- marvellous circles were hovering unseen in the warm air of this alien
- country that he never knew, and pencilling forms more lovely than his
- mortal fingers ever drew on earth.... Yes, it was worth losing one&rsquo;s sleep
- for, in those magic island nights.
- </p>
- <p>
- In the daytime, I rode and walked a good deal about the island, which is
- very fairly provided with roads, and tried to find out what I could about
- the people and their ways. There is not a more interesting island in the
- Pacific than Niué, from an ethnological point of view; but my scientific
- knowledge was too contemptibly small to enable me to make use of my
- opportunities. This I regretted, for the place is full of strange
- survivals of ancient customs and characteristics, such as are seldom to be
- found among Christianised natives. The people are somewhat rude and rough
- in character; indeed until about forty years ago, they were actually
- dangerous. Their island is one of the finest of natural fortresses, and
- they used it as such, declining to admit strangers on any pretext. Captain
- Cook attempted to land in 1777, but was beaten off before he had succeeded
- in putting his boat&rsquo;s crew ashore. Other travellers for the most part gave
- the place a wide berth.
- </p>
- <p>
- When men of the island wandered away to other places (the Niuéan is a
- gipsy by nature) they received no kindly welcome on attempting to come
- home. The Niuéan had an exceeding fear of imported diseases, and to
- protect himself against them, he thought out a system of sanitary
- precaution, all on his own account, which was surely the completest the
- world has ever seen. There was no weak link in the chain: no break through
- which measles, or cholera, or worse could creep, during the absence of an
- official, or owing to the carelessness of an inspector. Every person
- attempting to land on Niué, be he sick or well, stranger, or native, was
- promptly killed! That was Niué&rsquo;s rule. You might go away from the island
- freely, but if you did, you had better not attempt to come back again, for
- the &ldquo;sanitary officers&rdquo; would knock your brains out on the shore. It was
- without doubt the simplest and best system of quarantine conceivable.
- Possibly as a result of this Draconian law, the people of Niué are
- remarkably strong and hardy to-day, though since the relaxation of the
- ancient rule, a certain amount of disease has crept in.
- </p>
- <p>
- The people, though warlike and fierce, were never cannibals here at the
- worst. They did not even eat their enemies when slain in battle. They
- enjoyed a fight very much, however, when they got the chance of one, and
- still remembered the Waterloo victory of their history, against the fierce
- Tongans, about two hundred years ago. The Tongans, until within the last
- half-century, seem to have been the Danes of the Pacific, always hunting
- and harrying some other maritime people, and always a name of terror to
- weak races. Tonga is the nearest land to Niué, being about three hundred
- miles away, so it was not to be expected that the Niuéans would escape
- invasion, and they were fully prepared for the Tongan attack when it did
- come. They did not attempt to meet force by force. There was one place
- they knew where the Tongans might succeed in landing, and near to this
- they laid a cunning plan for defence.
- </p>
- <p>
- A trader took me down to see the spot one Sunday afternoon. It is one of
- the numerous caves of Niué, with a top open for the most part to the sky.
- The cave runs underneath the greenery and the creeping flowers of the bush&mdash;a
- long black gash just showing here and there among the leaves. The drop is
- forty or fifty feet, and an unwary foot might very easily stumble over its
- edge, even now.
- </p>
- <p>
- On the day when the Tongan war canoes broke the level line of the sea
- horizon, the Niué men hastened to the shore, and prepared the cave in such
- a way as to set a fatal and most effective trap for their enemies. They
- cut down a mass of slight branches and leafy twigs, and covered the gulf
- completely, so that nothing was to be seen except the ordinary surface of
- the low-growing bush. When the enemies landed, the Niué men showed
- themselves on the farther side of the cave, as if fleeing into the woods.
- The Tongans, with yells of joy, rushed in pursuit, straight over the gulf&mdash;and
- in another moment were lying in crushed and dying heaps at the foot of the
- pit, while the men of Niué, dashing out of ambush on every side, ran down
- into the cave from its shallow end and butchered their enemies as they
- lay.
- </p>
- <p>
- After this, it is said that the Tongans left Niué alone.
- </p>
- <p>
- Because of the loneliness and inaccessibility of the place, the Savage
- Islanders have always been different from the rest of the Pacific. The
- typical &ldquo;Kanaka&rdquo; is straight-haired, light brown in colour, mild and
- gentle and generous in disposition, ready to welcome strangers and feast
- them hospitably. He is aristocratic to the backbone in his ideas, and
- almost always has a native class of nobles and princes, culminating in a
- hereditary king.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Savage Islander is often frizzy-haired, and generally a darkish brown
- in colour. His manners are rather brusque, and he gives nothing without
- obtaining a heavy price for it. He has no chiefs, nobles, or princes, and
- does not want any. There is always a head of the State, who enjoys a
- certain amount of mild dignity, and may be called the King for want of a
- better name. The office is not hereditary, however, the monarch being
- elected by the natives who form the island Parliament. Meetings of this
- Parliament are held at irregular intervals; and the King, together with
- the British Resident Commissioner, takes an important part in the debates.
- </p>
- <p>
- These are very formal affairs. The brown M.P.s who live, each in his own
- village, in the utmost simplicity of manners and attire, dress themselves
- up for the day in full suits of European clothing, very heavy and hot,
- instead of the light and comfortable cotton kilt they generally wear. They
- travel into Alofi and join the local members on the green before the
- public hall&mdash;generally used as a school-house. King Tongia joins
- them, the British Resident comes also, and for hour after hour, inside the
- great, cool hall, with its matted floor and many open window-embrasures,
- the talk goes on. This road is to be made, that banyan tree is to be
- removed, regulation pigsties are to be built in such a village, petitions
- are to be sent up to New Zealand about the tax on tobacco&mdash;and so on,
- and so on. The king is a tough old man; he has his say on most questions,
- and it is not considered generally good for health or business to oppose
- him too much; but of royal dignity he has, and asks for, none.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is something quite American in the history of Tongia&rsquo;s elevation,
- some seven years ago. He had acted as Prime Minister to the late head of
- the State; and when the latter died he calmly assumed the reins without
- going through the formality of an election. This was not the usual custom,
- and some of the members remonstrated. Tongia told them, however, that he
- was in the right, and meant to stay on. When the captain of a ship died on
- a voyage, did not his chief mate take over command? The cases were exactly
- parallel, to his mind. This argument pleased the members, who had most of
- them been to sea, and Tongia was allowed to retain his seat, the objectors
- calming themselves with the thought of the sovereign&rsquo;s age&mdash;he was
- well over eighty at that time. &ldquo;He is only the stump of a torch,&rdquo; they
- said; &ldquo;he will soon burn out.&rdquo; But the stump is burning yet, and shows no
- symptoms of extinction. Tongia married a pretty young girl soon after his
- &ldquo;election,&rdquo; settled down in the royal palace&mdash;a whitewashed cottage
- with a palm-thatch roof&mdash;and seems likely to outlast many of his
- former opponents.
- </p>
- <p>
- The powers of the king, limited as they are, have lessened since 1902,
- when New Zealand annexed Niué&mdash;a proceeding that had its humorous
- side, if one examines the map, for Niué is something like a thousand miles
- from Auckland. The Resident Commissioner who is responsible for the
- well-being of the island lives in a house much more like a palace than
- Tongia&rsquo;s modest hut, and is in truth the real ruler of the place. His
- work, however, is not overpowering. He is supposed to be judge and
- lawgiver, among many other duties, but in Niué no one ever seems to do
- anything that requires punishment. There is nothing in the shape of a
- prison, if any one did. Innocent little crimes, such as chicken stealing
- with extenuating circumstances, or allowing pigs to trespass into
- somebody&rsquo;s garden, occasionally blot the fair pages of the island records,
- but a little weeding, or a day&rsquo;s work on the road is considered sufficient
- punishment for these. At the time of my stay, which lasted nearly two
- months, such a wave of goodness seemed to be passing over the island that
- the Resident complained he could not find enough crime in the place to
- keep his garden weeded, and declared that he really wished somebody would
- do something, and do it quick, or all his imported flowers would be
- spoiled! Since the forties, missionaries have been busy in Savage Island,
- and there is no doubt that they have done their work effectively. The
- early traders, who arrived near the same time, also helped considerably in
- the civilisation of the natives. Drink has never been a trouble on Niué,
- and at the present date, no native ever tastes it, and strict regulations
- govern importation by the whites, for their own use. The natives are
- healthy, although European diseases are by no means unknown. Skin diseases
- are so troublesome that many of the traders wash the money they get from
- the bush towns, before handling, and the new-comer&rsquo;s first days in the
- island are sure to be harassed by the difficulties of avoiding
- miscellaneous hand-shaking. Knowing what one knows about the prevalence of
- skin-troubles, one does not care to run risks; but the Niuéan, like all
- islanders, has unfortunately learned the habit of continual hand-shaking
- from his earliest teachers, and is never likely to unlearn it. So the
- visitor who does not want to encounter disappointed faces and puzzled
- inquiries, looks out old gloves to go a-walking with, and burns them, once
- he or she is settled in the place, and no longer a novelty.
- </p>
- <p>
- There are manners in Niué&mdash;of a sort. &ldquo;Fanagé fei!&rdquo; is the greeting
- to any one met on the road, and it must not be left out, or the Savage
- Islanders will say you have no manners. It means, &ldquo;Where are you going?&rdquo;
- and it is not at all an empty inquiry, for you must mention the name of
- your destination in reply, and then repeat the inquiry on your own
- account, and listen for the answer. Riding across the island day by day, I
- used to pass in a perfect whirlwind of &ldquo;Where-are-you-goings?&rdquo; callings
- out hastily, as the horse cantered over the grassy road, &ldquo;Avatele,&rdquo; or
- &ldquo;Mutelau,&rdquo; (names of villages) or &ldquo;Misi Nicolasi&rdquo; (Mrs. Nicholas, a
- trader&rsquo;s wife), and adding as I passed on: &ldquo;Fanagé fei?&rdquo; to the man or
- woman who had greeted me. There was generally a long story in reply, but I
- fear I was usually out of hearing before it was ended. My manners, out
- riding, must have struck Niué as decidedly vulgar.
- </p>
- <p>
- It was during the first few days of my stay that I attained a distinction
- that I had never hoped to see, and that I am not at all likely to see
- again. I was made a headline; in a copybook! If that is not fame, what is?
- </p>
- <p>
- The native school-teacher&mdash;a brown, black-eyed and bearded man of
- middle age and dignified presence&mdash;had called at my house shortly
- after my arrival, to display his English and his importance, and welcome
- the stranger. He wanted, among a great many other things, to know what my
- name was, and how it was spelt. I wrote it down for him, and he carried it
- away, studying it the while. Next day, the copies set in the principal
- school for the youth of Niué consisted of my name in full, heading the
- following legend: &ldquo;While this lady is in Niué, we must all be very good.&rdquo;
- Evidently a case of &ldquo;Après moi le déluge!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- Sitting on a box in my cool little shady house of a morning, writing on my
- knee, with the whisper of the palms about the door, and the empty
- changeless blue sea lying below, I used to receive visitor after visitor,
- calling on different errands&mdash;some to sit on the verandah and look at
- me in silence; some to come in, squat on the floor, and discourse fluently
- for half an hour in a language I did not understand (they never seemed
- distressed by the absence of replies); some to sell curios; some to give
- dinners!
- </p>
- <p>
- You give dinners in Niué in a strictly literal sense. Instead of bringing
- the guest to the dinner, you take the dinner to the guests and then wait
- to see it eaten. It generally consists of a baked fish wrapped in leaves,
- several lumps of yam, hot and moist, and as heavy as iron, a pudding made
- of mashed pumpkin and breadfruit, another made of bananas, sugarcane, and
- cocoanut, some arrowroot boiled to jelly, and the inevitable taro top and
- cocoanut cream&mdash;about which I must confess I was rather greedy. The
- rest of the dinner I used to accept politely, as it was set out on the
- floor, eat a morsel or two here and there, and afterwards hand over the
- remainder to Kuru and his wife, who were always ready to dispose of it. At
- the beginning, I used to offer gifts in return, which were always refused.
- Then, acting on the advice of old residents, I reserved the gift for a day
- or two, and presented it at the first suitable opportunity. It was always
- readily accepted, when offered after this fashion, and thus I learned one
- more lesson as to island etiquette.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;You&rsquo;ll see a lot of stuff in travel books,&rdquo; said an old resident to me,
- &ldquo;about the wonderful generosity of the island people, all over the Pacific&mdash;how
- they press gifts of every kind on travellers, and won&rsquo;t take any return.
- Well, that&rsquo;s true, and it&rsquo;s not true. All the island people love
- strangers, and are new-fangled with every fresh face, and they do come
- along with presents, but as to not wanting a return, why, that isn&rsquo;t quite
- the case. They won&rsquo;t take payment, mostly, and there&rsquo;s very few places
- where they&rsquo;ll even take a present, right off. But they always expect
- something back, some time. I know that isn&rsquo;t what the books say, but books
- are mostly wrong about anything you&rsquo;ve got to go below the top of things
- to see&mdash;and the traveller likes that pretty idea, of getting presents
- for nothing, too much to give it up easily. Still, you may take my word
- for it that the natives <i>will</i> take a return for anything and
- everything they give you, here and everywhere else, unless it&rsquo;s a drink of
- cocoanut, or a bit of fruit they offer you on the road, or maybe a bit of
- dinner, if you&rsquo;d drop in on them at meals. Set presents you&rsquo;ve got to pay
- for, and more than their value too, if you take them. I don&rsquo;t myself, I
- find native presents too expensive.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- What do you want to give? Oh, well, if a woman brings you in a dinner or
- two, give her a trade silk handkerchief, one of those shilling ones, some
- day. Or if they bring you baskets of fruit, give them a couple of sticks
- of tobacco. They&rsquo;ll take payment for fruit here, in that way, at any time.
- You&rsquo;ll need to give some things when you&rsquo;re going away, to the people
- you&rsquo;ve seen most of&mdash;a few yards of cotton, or something of that
- kind. White people are expected to give presents, all over the island&mdash;it
- needn&rsquo;t be dear things, but it ought to be something.
- </p>
- <p>
- If the lords and folk who have been round the Pacific in their yachts only
- heard what the natives say of them, because they didn&rsquo;t know that, they&rsquo;d
- take care to bring a case or two of cheap stuff for presents next time.
- &lsquo;Not chief-like,&rsquo; is what the natives say&mdash;and I ask you yourself, it
- isn&rsquo;t &lsquo;chief-like,&rsquo; is it, to take all you can get, and give not a stick
- of niggerhead or an inch of ribbon in return?
- </p>
- <p>
- I&rsquo;d think they&rsquo;d be too proud&mdash;but then, I&rsquo;m not a tourist trotting
- round the globe, I&rsquo;m only a man who works for his living.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;As for yourself, you take my advice, and say right out you don&rsquo;t want the
- dinners, when they bring them. Yes, it&rsquo;ll offend them, but you must either
- do that, or pay for stuff you don&rsquo;t want three days out of seven, or six
- days, more likely, if they think you&rsquo;re liberal-minded. You&rsquo;ll get no end
- of presents when you&rsquo;re going away, pretty things enough, and those will
- have to be paid for in presents, too. Better make it as cheap as you can,
- meantime.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;But those people who go travelling like princes, and load their cabins up
- with spears and clubs and tappa-cloths and shells the natives have given
- them everywhere they went&mdash;and not a farthing, or a farthing&rsquo;s worth,
- do they let it cost them from end to end&mdash;I tell you, they&rsquo;re a
- disgrace to England,&rdquo; concluded my informant hotly.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0027" id="linkimage-0027"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0259.jpg" alt="0259 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0259.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- &ldquo;I am quite sure it is simply because they do not know&mdash;how should
- they?&rdquo; I asked, trying to defend the absent globe-trotters.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Decent feeling ought to teach them!&rdquo; declared the critic of manners, who
- was evidently not to be pacified.
- </p>
- <p>
- I had my dinner to cook, so I went away, and left him still revolving the
- iniquities of travelling milords in his memory. But I did not forget the
- conversation, for it seemed to me that the facts about this matter of
- present-giving and taking ought to be known as widely as possible. In
- nearly two years of island travel that followed after those days, I had
- full opportunity of proving the truth of the statements made by my Niué
- acquaintance, and every experience only served to confirm them.
- </p>
- <p>
- Travellers who visit the islands should note this fact, and lay in a stock
- of suitable goods at Sydney, which is the starting point for most Pacific
- travel. There are various firms who make a speciality of island trade, and
- these will usually sell any reasonable quantity at wholesale prices. The
- natives of the Pacific, in general, are not to be put off with worthless
- trifles as presents, nor do they care for beads, unless in the few groups
- still remaining uncivilised. They like best the sort of goods with which
- they are already familiar, and do not care for &ldquo;imported&rdquo; novelties. Silk
- handkerchiefs are liked everywhere, and they are easy to carry. Cotton or
- silk stuff is much valued. Imitation jewellery&mdash;brooches, pins, etc.&mdash;is
- valued quite as much as real, except in Niué, where the natives seem to
- have a natural craving and liking for precious metals. Tinned foods of all
- kinds, and sweets, are perhaps better appreciated than anything else.
- Tinned salmon in especial, is the safest kind of &ldquo;tip&rdquo; than can be given
- to any native, from a lordly Samoan chief, down to a wild &ldquo;bushie&rdquo; from
- the Solomons.
- </p>
- <p>
- Withal, one must not take away the character of the island world for
- hospitality, because of its childlike fancy for presents. Many and many a
- destitute white man can tell of the true generosity and ungrudging
- kindness he has met with at the hands of the gentle brown men and women,
- when luck was hard and the whites would have none of him. They are not
- fair-weather friends, in the European sense of the word. True, when the
- weather is sunny with you, they will come round and bask in the warmth,
- and share your good luck. But when the rainy days come, they will share
- all they have with you, just as freely, and they will not look for
- presents, then.
- </p>
- <p>
- The industries of the island filled up many a pleasant morning. Niué is
- supposed to be the most hard-working of all the Pacific islands, and
- certainly its people do not seem to eat the bread of idleness. Here, there
- is no lounging and dreaming and lotus-eating on the sounding coral shore&mdash;perhaps
- there isn&rsquo;t much shore anyway; perhaps because the Savage Islander is not
- made that way. The food of the people consists largely of yams, and in a
- country which has hardly any depth of soil, these are hard to grow, and
- need care. The bananas are grown in the most wonderful way in the clefts
- of the coral rocks, so that they actually appear to be springing out of
- the stone. Copra is made in fair quantity, and many of the people spend
- the greater part of their time collecting a certain kind of fungus which
- is exported to Sydney, and used (or so report declares) for making an
- imitation of birds&rsquo; nest soup in China.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0028" id="linkimage-0028"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0267.jpg" alt="0267 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0267.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- The proportion of women on the island is very large, because there are
- always at least a thousand men, out of a total population of five thousand
- souls, away working elsewhere. The Niuéan is a bit of a miser, and will do
- anything for money. He engages, therefore, as a labourer in the
- plantations of Samoa, where the natives will not do any work they can
- avoid, or goes up to Malden Island to the guano pits, or takes a year or
- two at sea on an island schooner, or goes away as fireman on the
- missionary steamer&mdash;anything to make money. Meantime his women-kind
- stay at home and keep themselves. They work about the white people&rsquo;s
- houses, they act as stevedores to the ships, they fetch and carry all over
- the island. When I wanted two heavy trunks conveyed a distance of six
- miles one day, four sturdy Niué girls came to do the work; slung the
- trunks on two poles, trotted away with them, and reached the end of the
- journey before my lazy horse had managed to carry me to my destination.
- They do an immense amount of plaiting work&mdash;mats, fans, baskets, and
- above all, hats, of which the annual export runs into thousands of dozens.
- These hats are made of fine strips of dried and split pandanus leaf; they
- much resemble the coarser kind of Panama, and give excellent shade and
- wear. They are worn over the whole Pacific, and a great part of New
- Zealand, and, I strongly suspect, are exported to England under the name,
- and at the price of second-grade Panamas. A clever worker will finish one
- in a day. Much of the plaiting is done in caves in the hot season, as the
- material must be kept fairly cool and moist.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0029" id="linkimage-0029"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0276.jpg" alt="0276 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0276.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- When the Niué folks are not working, they idle a little at times, but not
- very much. They sing in chorus occasionally, but it is not an absorbing
- occupation with them, and they do not dance a great deal either, since the
- advent of missionary rule. Their chief amusement is an odd one&mdash;walking
- round the island. You can scarcely take a long ride without encountering a
- stray picnic party of natives, mostly women, striding along at a good
- round pace, and heavily laden with fruit, food, and mats. They always
- complete the journey&mdash;forty miles&mdash;in a day, picknicking on the
- roadside for meals, and seem to enjoy themselves thoroughly. The strenuous
- life, exemplified after this fashion, is certainly the last thing one
- would expect to find in the Pacific. But then, the great fascination of
- the island world lies in the fact that here, as nowhere else, &ldquo;only the
- unexpected happens.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <p>
- It is a day of molten gold, with a sea coloured like a sheet of sapphire
- glass in a cathedral window. I am busy washing up my breakfast things at
- the door (there is no false shame about the performance of domestic duties
- in the capital city of Niué) when a couple of native girls appear on the
- grass pathway, their wavy hair loose and flowing, their white muslin
- dresses kilted up high over strong brown limbs. Each carries a clean
- &ldquo;pareo&rdquo; in her hand. They are going for a swim, one of them informs me in
- broken English: will I come too?
- </p>
- <p>
- Of course I will. I get out my own bathing dress, and follow the pair down
- the cliff, scrambling perilously from crag to crag, until we reach a point
- where it is possible to get down on to the narrow rocky ledge at the verge
- of the sea. Within the reef here there is a splendid stretch of protected
- water, peacock-blue in colour, immensely deep, and almost cold. There are
- no sharks about here, the girls tell me, and it is an excellent place for
- a swim.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0030" id="linkimage-0030"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0288.jpg" alt="0288 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0288.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Oh, for a Royal Academician to paint the picture made by the younger girl,
- as she stands on the edge of the rocks ready to leap in, dressed in a
- bright blue scarf that is wound round and round her graceful bronze body
- from shoulder to knee, and parting her full wavy hair aside with slender
- dark fingers! Beauty of form did not die out with the ancient Greeks: the
- Diana of the Louvre and the Medici Venus may be seen any day of any year,
- on the shores of the far-away islands, by those who know lovely line when
- they see it, and have not given over their senses, bound and blinded, to
- the traditions of the schools. If there is any man in the world to-day who
- can handle a hammer and chisel as Phidias did, let him come to the South
- Sea Islands and look there for the models that made the ancient Greek
- immortal. The sculptor who can mould a young island girl, Tahitian for the
- Venus type, Samoan for the Diana, or a young island chief, like Mercury,
- in bronze, will give the world something as exquisite and as immortal as
- any marvel from the hand of Phidias or Praxiteles.
- </p>
- <p>
- My beautiful Niué girl was an exception, so far as her own island went.
- Niué women are strong and well made, but not lovely as a rule. Her
- companion was as sturdy as a cart-horse, but as plain as a pig. She smoked
- a huge pipe, chewed plug tobacco, and laughed like a hyena. They were
- truly a well-contrasted pair.
- </p>
- <p>
- The reef was a good way off, so we all struck out for that, when we came
- up panting and blowing from our dive. The girls gave me a fine exhibition
- of under-water swimming now and then, slipping easily underneath the
- gleaming surface, and disappearing from view below, for so long a time
- that one became quite nervous. My pretty little friend persuaded me to
- accompany her once, and though I did not like it among the ugly-looking
- coral caves, I dived for a short time, and endeavoured to follow her
- flying heels.
- </p>
- <p>
- Under water among the coral reefs! It sounds romantic, but it was not
- pleasant. Five feet beneath the surface, the light was as clear as day,
- and one could see all about one, far too much, for the things that were
- visible were disquieting. I knew extremely well that coral reefs are the
- haunt of every kind of unpleasant sea-beast, and I fancied Victor Hugo&rsquo;s
- &ldquo;pieuvre&rdquo; at the very least, within the gloomy arch of every cave. There
- were far too many fish also, and they were much too impertinent, and a
- fish in one&rsquo;s hair, even if harmless, is not nice. I had not gone down
- much over a fathom, when I turned, and began to beat upwards again looking
- eagerly at the light. And then I saw a thing that as nearly as possible
- made me open my mouth and drown myself.
- </p>
- <p>
- It was merely a bunch of black waving trailers, coming out of the dark of
- the rocks, and spreading between me and the pale-green light of day. I did
- not know what it was, and I do not know, to this day. And, like the
- runaway soldier in the poem, &ldquo;I don&rsquo;t know where I went to, for I didn&rsquo;t
- stop to see.&rdquo; I was on the top of the water, twenty yards away, and
- swimming at racing speed, when I realised the fact that I was still alive,
- some moments later. And on the surface I stayed, for the rest of the swim.
- The native girls were exceedingly amused, for the islander fears nothing
- that is in the water or under it; but I did not mind their laughing.
- </p>
- <p>
- One of them then, as she swam along, began laying her mouth to the surface
- of the water, and blowing bubbles, laughing all the time. She insisted
- that I should do it too, and I imitated her, at which she seemed
- delighted. &ldquo;That what we doing, suppose some shark come,&rdquo; she explained,
- &ldquo;shark he plenty frighten, no like that.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- We practised this useful accomplishment for some time, and then went
- ashore again. I regret to say that I roused the amusement of my companions
- yet again, before we landed, by making hasty exclamations, and dodging
- rapidly away from the embraces of a black-and-white banded snake, about
- four feet long, that suddenly appeared from nowhere in particular, moving
- very swiftly, and seemed disposed to argue the right of way. The lagoon at
- Raratonga had not prepared me for the Zoological Garden in which one had
- to bathe at Niué.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Snake he no harm,&rdquo; said my Venus Anadyomene, as she stood on the rock,
- with her bathing scarf in her hand, wringing it out in the calmest manner
- in the world.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Plenty-plenty snake stop there.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- There were indeed plenty of snakes. One could see them any fine day from
- the top of the cliffs, gliding through the water below, or lying on the
- rocks in family parties of a score or two, conspicuous at a great
- distance, because of their handsome black-and-white banded skins. As to
- there being no harm&mdash;well, I never heard of any one in Niué being
- injured. But a boy in Fiji trod on one of these checkerboarded creatures,
- about that time, and died in half an hour from its bite. I am strongly
- inclined to think that the Niué snake is poisonous, like almost all
- sea-snakes, though it does not seem at all ready to attack.
- </p>
- <p>
- What was it I saw under water? I never knew, but I guessed as much as I
- wanted, a day or two later, when I saw a native, fishing on the reef near
- my bathing-place, draw up a big devil-fish, with eight limp dangling arms&rsquo;
- over six feet long, and carry it away. A trader told me that he had once
- pulled up one himself, while out fishing in a light canoe, and that it
- seized hold of the little boat, and made such a fight that he barely
- escaped with his life. It is the pleasant habit of this fish, when
- attacked by a human being, to fling its hideous tentacles over his head
- and face, and force them up into eyes, nostrils, and mouth, so as to
- suffocate him, if he cannot master the creature.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Do you think there were any sharks about the day I bathed?&rdquo; I inquired.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Well, if the girls were blowing, I should say there must have been. They
- wouldn&rsquo;t do it for fun altogether,&rdquo; he replied.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Surely they wouldn&rsquo;t bathe, if they knew there were any about?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Oh, wouldn&rsquo;t they, though! <i>They</i> don&rsquo;t mind them. No native is
- afraid of anything in the sea.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- I believed this with reservations, until a day came in another island,
- when I nearly furnished a dinner for a shark myself, and thenceforth gave
- up bathing in unprotected tropical waters, for good. It was in Rakahanga,
- many hundreds of miles nearer the Line, and I had left the schooner to
- enjoy a walk and a bathe. A native Rakahangan girl, who had never seen a
- white woman before, and was wildly excited at the thought of going bathing
- with this unknown wonder, found a boat for me, and allowed me to pick my
- own place in the inner lagoon of the island. I chose a spot where the
- lagoon narrowed into a bottle-neck communicating with the sea, and
- we-started our swim. The girl, however, much to my surprise, would not go
- more than a few yards from the boat, and declined to follow me when I
- struck out for the open water. I had been assured by her, so far as my
- scanty knowledge of Maori allowed me to understand, that there were no
- sharks, so her conduct seemed incomprehensible until a stealthy black fin,
- shaped like the mainsail of a schooner, rose out of the water a few score
- yards away, and began making for me!
- </p>
- <p>
- The native girl was first into the boat, but I was assuredly not long
- after her. The back fin did not follow, once I was out of the water. But
- the heat of that burning day far up towards the Line, was hardly enough to
- warm me, for half an hour afterwards.
- </p>
- <p>
- I found, on asking the question that I should have asked first of all,
- that the bottle-neck entrance of the lagoon was a perfect death-trap of
- sharks, and that more than one native had been eaten there.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Why on earth did the girl tell me there were none, and why did she
- venture into such a place herself?&rdquo; I asked.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Well,&rdquo; said the only white man on the island, &ldquo;I should think she knew
- that any shark will take a white person, and leave a native, if there&rsquo;s a
- choice. And if you had that red bathing-dress on that you&rsquo;re carrying,
- why, you were simply making bait of yourself!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;But why should she want to see me killed?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Oh, she didn&rsquo;t. She only wanted to have the fun of a bathe with a white
- woman, and just took the chances!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- So much about bathing, in the &ldquo;sunny isles of Eden.&rdquo; One is sorry to be
- obliged to say that it is one of the disappointments of the Pacific. Warm,
- brilliant water, snowy coral sands, and glancing fish of rainbow hues, are
- charming accompaniments to a bath, no doubt, but they are too dearly paid
- for when snakes, sharks, sting-rays, and devil-fish have to be counted
- into the party.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <p>
- Nothing in curious Niué is quite so curious as the native fancies about
- ghosts and devils. In spite of their Christianity, they still hold fast to
- all their ancient superstitions about the powers of evil.
- </p>
- <p>
- Every Savage Islander believes, quite as a matter of course, that ghosts
- walk the roads and patrol the lonely bush, all night long. Some are
- harmless spirits, many are malignant devils. After dark has fallen, about
- six o&rsquo;clock, no one dares to leave his house except for some very
- important errand; and if it is necessary to go out so late as nine or ten
- o&rsquo;clock, a large party will go together&mdash;this even in the town
- itself. Every native has a dog or two, of a good barking watchdog breed,
- not to protect property, for theft is unknown, but to drive away ghosts at
- night! Devil possession is believed in firmly. When a man, takes sick, his
- neighbours try, in a friendly manner, to &ldquo;drive the devil out of him.&rdquo;
- Perhaps they hang him up by his thumbs; possibly they put his feet in
- boiling water, causing fearful scalds; or they may drive sharks&rsquo; teeth
- into him here and there. But the most popular method is plain and simple
- squeezing, to squeeze the devil out! This often results in broken ribs,
- and occasionally in death. It is a curious fact, in connection with this
- &ldquo;squeezing,&rdquo; that the natives are remarkably expert &ldquo;masseurs,&rdquo; and can
- &ldquo;drive the devil&rdquo; out of a sprain, or a headache, or an attack of
- neuralgia, by what seems to be a clever combination of the &ldquo;pétrissage&rdquo;
- and &ldquo;screw&rdquo; movement of massage. This, they say, annoys the devil so much
- that he goes away. Applied to the trunk, however, and carried out with the
- utmost strength of two or three powerful men, Savage Islander massage
- is-(as above stated) often fatal&mdash;and small wonder!
- </p>
- <p>
- When a man has died, from natural or unnatural causes, a great feast is
- held of baked pig and fowl, yams, taro, fish, and cocoanuts. Presents are
- given to the dead man&rsquo;s relatives, as at a wedding, and other presents are
- returned by them to the men who dig the grave. The corpse is placed in a
- shallow hole, wrapped in costly mats; and then begins the ghostly life of
- the once-loved husband or father, who now becomes a haunting terror to
- those of his own household. Over his grave they erect a massive tomb of
- concrete and lime, meant to discourage him, so far as possible, from
- coming out to revisit the upper world. They gather together roots of the
- splendid scarlet poinsettia, gorgeous hibiscus, and graceful wine-coloured
- foliage plants, and place them about his tomb, to make it attractive to
- him. They collect his most cherished possessions&mdash;his &ldquo;papalangi&rdquo;
- (white man&rsquo;s) bowler hat, which he used to wear on Sundays at the five
- long services in the native church; his best trousers; his orange-coloured
- singlet with pink bindings; his tin mug and plate&mdash;and place them on
- the grave. Savage Island folk are very avaricious and greedy; yet not a
- soul will dare to touch these valuable goods; they lie on the grave, in
- sun and storm, until rotted or broken. If it is a woman&rsquo;s grave, you may
- even see her little hand sewing-machine (almost every island in the
- Pacific possesses scores of these) placed on the tomb, to amuse the ghost
- in its leisure hours. There will be a bottle of cocoanut hair-oil, too,
- scented with &ldquo;tieré&rdquo; flowers, and perhaps a little looking-glass or comb&mdash;so
- that we can picture the spirit of the dark-eyed island girls, like
- mermaids, coming forth at night to sit in the moonlight and dress their
- glossy hair&mdash;if ghosts indeed have hair like mortal girls!
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0031" id="linkimage-0031"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0296.jpg" alt="0296 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0296.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Mosquito-curtains, somewhat tattered by the wind, can be seen on many
- graves, carefully stretched over the tomb on the regulation uprights and
- cross-pieces, as over a bed. This is, no doubt, intended to help the ghost
- to lie quiet, lest the mosquitoes should annoy it so much that it be
- driven to get up and walk about. Certainly, if a Savage Island ghost does
- walk, it is not because every care is not taken to make it (as the
- Americans would say) &ldquo;stay put.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- There are no graveyards on the island. Every man is buried on his own
- land, very often alongside the road, or close to his house. The thrifty
- islanders plant onions and pumpkins on the earth close about the tomb, and
- enjoy the excellent flavour imparted to these vegetables by the essence of
- dead ancestor which they suck up through the soil. In odd contradiction to
- this economical plan, a &ldquo;tapu&rdquo; is placed upon all the cocoanut trees owned
- by the deceased; and for a year or more valuable nuts are allowed to lie
- where they fall, sprouting into young plants, and losing many tons of
- copra annually to the island. Groups of palms unhealthily crowded
- together, bear witness everywhere to the antiquity of this strange
- practice.
- </p>
- <p>
- The main, and indeed the only good road, across the island, owns a spot of
- fearsome reputation. On a solitary tableland, swept by salt sea-winds,
- stand certain groups of clustered cocoa-palms, sprung from tapu&rsquo;s nuts on
- dead men&rsquo;s lands. Here the natives say, the ghosts and devils have great
- power, and it is dangerous to walk there at night alone, even for white
- men, who take little account of native spirits. Many of the white traders
- of the island are shy of the spot; and some say that when riding in
- parties across the island at night, their horses shy and bolt passing the
- place, and exhibit unaccountable fear. Only a year or two ago, a terrible
- thing happened in this desolate spot, as if to prove the truth of local
- traditions. There was one native of the island, a &ldquo;witch-doctor,&rdquo; learned
- in charms and spells, who professed not to be afraid of the devils. He
- could manage them, he said; and to prove it, he used sometimes to walk
- alone across the island at night. One morning, he did not return from an
- excursion of this nature. The villagers set out in a body to look for him
- in the broad light of the tropical sun. They found him, at the haunted
- spot, lying on the ground dead. His face was black and his body horribly
- contorted. The devils had fought him, and conquered him&mdash;so the
- natives said. And now no gold would induce a Savage Islander to pass the
- fatal spot after dark.
- </p>
- <p>
- I asked the white missionary doctor resident at the time of my visit on
- the island, if he could account for the death. He said that he had not
- held a post-mortem and therefore could not say what the cause might be;
- but the appearance of the corpse was undoubtedly as described by the
- natives.
- </p>
- <p>
- Being anxious to investigate the truth of these stories, I determined to
- spend a night on the spot, and see what happened. The natives were
- horrified beyond measure at the idea; and when an accident on a coral reef
- laid me up from walking exercise until just before the schooner called
- again at the island to take me away&mdash;thus preventing me from carrying
- out the plan&mdash;they were one and all convinced that the fall was the
- work of devils, anxious to prevent me from meddling with their doings!
- </p>
- <p>
- The problem, then, remained unsolved, and rests open to any other
- traveller to investigate. But as Savage Island lies far off the track of
- the wandering tourist, its ghosts are likely to remain undisturbed in
- their happy hunting-grounds for the present.
- </p>
- <p>
- Mrs. Joe Gargery would certainly have liked Niué, for it is a place where
- there is none of the &ldquo;pompeying&rdquo; so obnoxious to her Spartan soul. And
- yet, if you stay there long, you will find out that Savage Island
- practises certain of the early Christian virtues, if it has dropped a few
- of its luxuries manufactured by civilisation. If you want a horse to ride
- across the island&mdash;a gentle, native creature that goes off at both
- ends, like a fire-cracker, when you try to mount, biting and kicking
- simultaneously, and, when mounted, converts your ride into a sandwich of
- jibbing and bolting, you will call in at the nearest trader&rsquo;s, and tell
- him you want his horse and his neighbour&rsquo;s saddle and whip. All these will
- appear at your door, with a couple of kindly messages, in half an hour.
- You will time your arrival at the different villages so as to hit off some
- one&rsquo;s meal-hours, walk in, ask for a help of the inevitable curried tin,
- and carry off a loaf of bread or a lump of cake, if your host happens to
- have baked that morning and you have not. When a ship comes in&mdash;perhaps
- the bi-yearly steamer from Samoa, with real mutton and beef in her
- ice-chest&mdash;and the capital gorges for two days, you, the stranger
- within their gates, will meet hot chops walking up to your verandah
- between two hot plates, and find confectioners&rsquo; paper bags full of
- priceless New Zealand potatoes, sitting on your doorstep. You will learn
- to shed tears of genuine emotion at the sight of a rasher of bacon, and to
- accept with modest reluctance the almost too valuable gift of one real
- onion. Hospitality among the white folk of Savage Island is hospitality,
- and no mistake, and its real generosity can only be appreciated by those
- who know the supreme importance assumed by &ldquo;daily bread,&rdquo; when the latter
- is dependent upon the rare and irregular calls of passing ships.
- </p>
- <p>
- For, like a good many Pacific Islands, this coral land is more beautiful
- than fertile. Its wild fantastic rocks, which make up the whole surface of
- the island, produce in their clefts and hollows enough yam, taro, banana,
- and papaw to feed the natives; but the white man wants more. Tins are his
- only resource&mdash;tins and biscuits, for flour does not keep long, and
- bread is often unattainable. Fowls or eggs can seldom be bought, for the
- reason that some one imported a number of cats many years ago; these were
- allowed to run wild in the bush, and have now become wild in earnest,
- devouring fowls, and even attacking dogs and young pigs at times. Why,
- then, if the island is valueless to Europeans, and the life hard, do white
- men live in Savage Island and many similar places? For the reason that
- fortunes have been piled up, in past years, by trading in such isolated
- spots, and that there is still money to be made, though not so much as of
- old. Trading in the Pacific is a double-barrelled sort of business. You
- settle down on an island where there is a good supply of copra (dried
- cocoa-nut kernel, manufactured by the natives). You buy the copra from the
- islanders at about £8 a ton, store it away in your copra-house until the
- schooner or the steamer calls, and then ship it off to Sydney, where it
- sells at £13 to £14 a ton. Freight and labour in storing and getting on
- board, eat into the profits. But, in addition to buying, the trader sells.
- He has a store, where cheap prints, violent perfumes, gaudy jewellery,
- tapes and buttons and pins and needles, tins of beef, shoes, etc., are
- sold to the natives at a price which leaves a very good profit on their
- cost down in Auckland.
- </p>
- <p>
- The laws of all the Pacific Colonies forbid the white trader to buy from
- the natives, except with cash; but, as the cash comes back to him before
- long over the counter of the store, it comes to much the same in the end
- as the old barter system of the early days, out of which money used to be,
- quickly and easily made. Sometimes the trader, if in a small way of
- business, sells his copra to captains of calling ships at a smaller price
- than the Auckland value. But nowadays so many stores are owned by big Auckland
- and Sydney firms that most of the stuff is shipped off for sale in New
- Zealand or Australia. &ldquo;Panama&rdquo; hats, already mentioned, are a very
- important article of commerce here. Every island has some speciality of
- its own besides the inevitable copra; and the trader deals in all he can
- get. The trader&rsquo;s life is, as a rule, a pleasant one enough. Savage Island
- is one of the worst places where he could find himself; and yet the days
- pass happily enough in that solitary outlier of civilisation. There is not
- much work to do; the climate is never inconveniently hot; the scenery,
- especially among the up-country primaeval forests, is very lovely. There
- is a good deal of riding and bathing, a little shooting, and a myriad of
- wild and fantastic caves to explore when the spirit moves one. The native
- canoes are easy to manage and excellent to fish from.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0032" id="linkimage-0032"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0303.jpg" alt="0303 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0303.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- It is traditional in Savage Island for the few white people&mdash;almost
- all rival traders&mdash;to hang together, and live in as friendly a manner
- as a great family party. If the great world is shut out, its cares are
- shut away, and life sits lightly on all. No one can be extravagant; no one
- can &ldquo;keep up appearances&rdquo; at the cost of comfort; no one is over-anxious,
- or worried, or excited over anything&rsquo;&mdash;except when the rare, the
- long-expected ship comes in, and the natives rend the air with yells of
- joy, and the girls cocoanut-oil their hair, and the white men rush for
- clean duck suits and fresh hats, and the mails come in, and the news is
- distributed, and cargoes go out, and every one feasts from dawn till dusk,
- and all the island is in a state of frantic ebullition for at least three
- days. Then, indeed, Niué is alive.
- </p>
- <p>
- We were all getting hungry when the <i>Duchess</i> came in again, after
- nearly two months&rsquo; absence, for provisions were short, and most of us had
- come down to eating little green parrots out of the bush, and enjoying
- them, for want of anything better. It was certainly tantalising to see the
- ship off the island beating about for three days and more, before she was
- able to approach, but that is an usual incident in Niué. She came up at
- last, and I got my traps on board, and paid my bills, and carried away the
- model canoes and shell necklaces, and plaited hats and baskets, that were
- brought me as parting presents, and gave-a number of yards of cotton
- cloth, and a good many silk handkerchiefs, in return. And so the big sails
- were hoisted once more with a merry rattling and flapping, and away we
- went, northward a thousand miles, to desolate, burning Penrhyn and Malden
- Island.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0011" id="link2HCH0011"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER XI
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>A Life on the Ocean Wave&mdash;Where They kept the Dynamite&mdash;How
- far from an Iced Drink?&mdash;The Peacefulness of a Pacific Calm&mdash;A
- Golden Dust Heap&mdash;Among the Rookeries&mdash;Sailing on the Land&mdash;All
- about Guano.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">T</span>HE pirate captain
- was gone when the schooner reappeared off Niué, and a certain ancient
- mariner had taken his place. Things were not quite so exciting on the <i>Duchess</i>
- under the new régime, but the order which reigned on board was something
- awful; for the ancient mariner had been a whaling captain in his day, and
- on whaling ships it is more than on any others a case of &ldquo;Growl you may,
- but go you must,&rdquo; for all the crew. The ancient mariner was as salty a
- salt as ever sailed the ocean. He had never been on anything with steam in
- it, he was as tough as ship-yard teak, and as strong as a bear, though he
- was a grandfather of some years&rsquo; standing, and he was full of strange wild
- stories about the whaling grounds, and odd happenings in out-of-the-way
- comers of the Pacific&mdash;most of which he seemed to consider the merest
- commonplaces of a prosaic existence.
- </p>
- <p>
- We suffered many things from the cook, in the course of that long burning
- voyage towards the Line. The <i>Duchess&rsquo;s</i> stores were none of the
- best, and the cook dealt with them after a fashion that made me understand
- once for all the sailor saying: &ldquo;God sends meat, and the devil sends
- cooks.&rdquo; Pea-soup, salt pork and beef, plum duff, ship&rsquo;s biscuit, sea-pie&mdash;this
- was the sort of food that, in the days before I set foot on the <i>Duchess</i>,
- I had supposed to form the usual table of sailing vessels. I fear it was a
- case of sea-story-books, over again. What we did get was &ldquo;tinned rag&rdquo; of a
- peculiarly damp and viscous quality, tea that usually tasted of
- cockroaches, biscuit that was so full of copra bugs we had to hammer it on
- the table before eating it, an occasional tin of tasteless fruit (it ran
- out very soon), and bread that was a nightmare, for the flour went musty
- before we were out a week, and the unspeakable cook tried to disguise its
- taste with sugar. Board-of-trade limejuice, which is a nauseous dose at
- best, we were obliged, by law to carry, and I think we must have run
- rather near scurvy in the course of that long trip, for the amount of the
- oily, drug-flavoured liquid that the mates and myself used to drink at
- times, seemed to argue a special craving of nature. But <i>à la guerre
- comme à la guerre</i>&mdash;and one does not take ship on a Pacific
- windjammer expecting the luxuries of a P. and O.
- </p>
- <p>
- We were not going direct to Malden, having to call first at Samoa and
- Mangaia. Three days of rough rolling weather saw us in Apia, about which I
- have nothing to say at present, since I paid a longer visit to Stevenson&rsquo;s
- country later on. We had about forty native passengers to take on here for
- the Cook Islands and Malden. There was nowhere to put them, but in the
- South Seas such small inconveniences trouble nobody.
- </p>
- <p>
- I am very strongly tempted here to tell about the big-gale that caught us
- the first night out, carried away our lifeboat, topsail, topgallant, and
- main gaff, swamped the unlucky passengers&rsquo; cabin, and caused the Cingalese
- steward to compose and chant all night long a litany containing three
- mournful versicles: &ldquo;O my God, this is too much terrible! O my#God, why I
- ever go to sea! O my God, I never go to sea again!&rdquo; But in the Pacific one
- soon learns that sea etiquette makes light of such matters. So the
- wonderful and terrible sights which I saw once or twice that night,
- clinging precariously to anything solid near the door of my cabin, and
- hoping that the captain would not catch me out on deck, must remain
- undescribed.
- </p>
- <p>
- Nearly seven weeks were occupied by this northern trip&mdash;time for a
- mail steamer to go out from London to New Zealand, and get well started on
- the way home again. We were, of course, entirely isolated from news and
- letters; indeed, the mails and papers that we carried conveyed the very
- latest intelligence to islands that had not had a word from the outer
- world for many months. Our native passengers, who were mostly going up to
- Malden Island guano works as paid labourers, evidently considered the trip
- one wild scene of excitement and luxury. The South Sea Islander loves
- nothing more than change, and every new island we touched at was a Paris
- or an Ostend to these (mostly) untravelled natives. Their accommodation on
- the ship was not unlike that complained of by the waiter in &ldquo;David
- Copperfield.&rdquo; They &ldquo;lived on broken wittles and they slept on the coals.&rdquo;
- The <i>Duchess</i> carried benzoline tins for the feeding of the futile
- little motor that worked her in and out of port, and the native sleeping
- place was merely the hold, on top of the tins.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0033" id="linkimage-0033"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0325.jpg" alt="0325 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0325.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Do you mind the dynamite remaining under your bunk?&rdquo; asked the ancient
- mariner, shortly after we left Samoa.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;<i>Under my bunk?</i>&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Yes&mdash;didn&rsquo;t you know it was there? The explosives safe is let into
- the deck just beneath the deck cabin. I&rsquo;ll move it if you&rsquo;re nervous about
- it&mdash;I thought I&rsquo;d tell you, anyways. But it&rsquo;s the best place for it
- to be, you see, right amidships.&rdquo; And the ancient mariner, leaning his six
- foot two across the rail, turned his quid, and spat into the deep.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;What do we want with dynamite, anyhow?&rdquo; asked the bewildered passenger,
- confronted with this new and startling streak of local colour.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;<i>We</i> don&rsquo;t want none. The Cook Islands wants it for reefs.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Oh, leave it where it is&mdash;I suppose it&rsquo;s all the same in the end
- where it starts from, if it did blow up,&rdquo; says the passenger resignedly.
- &ldquo;What about the benzoline in the hold, though?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Every one&rsquo;s got to take chances at sea,&rdquo; says the captain, easily. &ldquo;The
- mates have orders to keep the natives from smokin&rsquo; in the hold at night.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- And at midnight, when I slip out of my bunk to look on and see what the
- weather is like (it has been threatening all day), a faint but
- unmistakable odour of island tobacco greets my nose, from the opening of
- the main hatch! Benzoline, dynamite, natives smoking in the hold, one big
- boat smashed, one small one left, forty native passengers, five whites,
- and three hundred miles to the nearest land!
- </p>
- <p>
- Well, <i>à la guerre comme à la guerre</i>, and one must not tell tales at
- sea. So I don&rsquo;t tell any, though tempted. But I am very glad, a week
- later, to see the Cook Islands rising up out of the empty blue again. We
- have had head winds, we have been allowanced as to water, we are all
- pleased to have a chance of taking in some fruit before we start on the
- thousand miles&rsquo; run to Malden&mdash;and above all, we leave that dynamite
- here, which is a good thing; for really we have been putting rather too
- much strain on the good nature of the &ldquo;Sweet little cherub that sits up
- aloft, to keep guard o&rsquo;er the life of poor Jack,&rdquo; this last week or two.
- </p>
- <p>
- If proof were wanted that the cherub&rsquo;s patience is about at an end, our
- arrival at Mangaia furnishes it&mdash;for we do take fire after all, just
- a couple of hundred yards from shore!
- </p>
- <p>
- It does not matter now, since half the natives of the island are about the
- ship, and the case of explosives has just been rowed off in our only boat,
- and the blaze is put out without much trouble. But, two days ago!
- </p>
- <p>
- Well, the sweet little cherub certainly deserved a rest.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <p>
- Now the <i>Duchess&rsquo;s</i> bowsprit was pointed northwards, and we set out
- on a thousand miles&rsquo; unbroken run up to Malden Island, only four degrees
- south of the Line. For nine days we ploughed across the same monotonous
- plain of lonely sea, growing a little duller every day, as our stores of
- reading matter dwindled away, and our fruit and vegetables ran out, and
- the memory of our last fresh mess became only a haunting, far-off regret.
- Squatting or lying about the white-hot poop in the merciless sun&mdash;which
- burnt through our duck and cotton clothing, and scorched the skin
- underneath, but was at least a degree better than the choking Hades of a
- cabin below&mdash;we used to torture each other with reminiscences and
- speculations, such as &ldquo;They have real salt beef and sea-pie and lobscouse
- and pea-soup, and things like that, every day on Robinson&rsquo;s schooner; no
- tinned rag and musty flour&rdquo;; or &ldquo;How many thousand miles are we now from
- an iced drink?&rdquo; This last problem occupied the mates and myself for half a
- morning, and made us all a great deal hotter than we were before. Auckland
- was about 2,300 miles away, San Francisco about 3,000 as far as we could
- guess. We decided for Auckland, and discussed the best place to buy the
- drink, being somewhat limited in choice by the passenger&rsquo;s selfish
- insistence on a place where she could get really good iced coffee. By the
- time this was settled, the captain joined in, and informed us that we
- could get all we wanted, and fresh limes into the bargain, only a thousand
- miles away, at Tahiti, which every one had somehow overlooked. Only a
- thousand! It seemed nothing, and we all felt (illogically) cheered up at
- the thought.
- </p>
- <p>
- Late in the afternoon we came near attaining our wish for a temperature of
- thirty-two degrees in rather an unexpected way. The bottom of the Pacific
- generally hovers about this figure, some miles below the burning surface,
- which often reaches the temperature of an ordinary warm bath; and the <i>Duchess</i>
- had a fairly narrow escape of going down to look for a cool spot without a
- return ticket. A giant waterspout suddenly formed out of the low-hanging,
- angry sky that had replaced the clear heat of the morning. First of all, a
- black trunk like an elephant&rsquo;s began to feel blindly about in mid-air,
- hanging from a cloud. It came nearer and nearer with uncanny speed,
- drawing up to itself as it came a colossal cone of turbulent sea, until
- the two joined together in one enormous black pillar, some quarter of a
- mile broad at the base, and probably a good thousand feet high, uniting as
- it did the clouds and the sea below. Across the darkening sea, against the
- threatening, copper-crimson sunset, came this gigantic horror, waltzing
- over leagues of torn-up water in a veritable dance of death, like
- something blind, but mad and cruel, trying to find and shatter our fragile
- little ship. Happily, the dark was only coming, not yet come; happily,
- too, the wind favoured us, and we were able to tack about and keep out of
- the way, dodging the strangely human rushes and advances of the
- water-giant with smartness and skill. At one time it came so close that
- the elephant trunk&mdash;now separately visible again&mdash;seemed feeling
- about over our heads, although the captain afterwards said it had been
- more than three hundred yards away&mdash;and the immense maelstrom
- underneath showed us the great wall of whirling spindrift that edged its
- deadly circle, as plain as the foam about our own bows. Every one was
- quiet, cool, and ready; but no one was sorry when the threatening monster
- finally spun, away to leeward and melted into air once more. A waterspout
- of this enormous size, striking a small vessel, would snap off her masts
- like sticks of candy, kill any one who happened to be on deck, and most
- probably sink the ship with the very impact of the terrible shock.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;One doesn&rsquo;t hear much about ships being sunk by waterspouts,&rdquo; objected
- the sceptical passenger to this last statement.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Ships that&rsquo;s sunk by waterspouts doesn&rsquo;t come back to tell the newspapers
- about it,&rdquo; said the captain darkly.
- </p>
- <p>
- Life on a South Sea schooner is not all romance. For the officers of the
- ship it is a very hard life indeed. Native crews are the rule in the South
- Seas, and native crews make work for every one, including themselves.
- Absolutely fearless is the Kanaka, active as a monkey aloft, good-natured
- and jolly to the last degree, but perfectly unreliable in any matter
- requiring an ounce of thought or a pennyworth of discretion, and,
- moreover, given to shirk work in a variety of ingenious ways that pass the
- wit of the white man to circumvent. Constant and keen supervision while at
- sea, unremitting hurry and drive in port, are the duties of a South Sea
- mate, coupled with plenty of actual hard work on his own account. I have
- known a case where a small schooner was leaking badly, many days from
- port, and almost constant pumping was required. The pump broke while in
- use; and the watch, delighted to be released, turned in at eight bells
- without having done their spell, and without reporting the accident. The
- water gained steadily, but that did not trouble them; and when the mate
- discovered the accident, and set them to mend the pump at once, they were
- both surprised and grieved!
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Watch and watch&rdquo; is the rule on small sailing-vessels: four hours on and
- four hours off, day and night, except for the &ldquo;dog watches,&rdquo; four to six
- and six to eight in the evening, which create a daily shift in order that
- each man may be on watch at a different time on successive days. Always
- provided, of course, that the ship has any watches at all! I <i>have</i>
- sailed in a Pacific schooner where the crew spent most of their time
- playing the accordion and the Jew&rsquo;s harp, and slept peacefully all night.
- In the daytime there was generally some one at the wheel; but at night it
- was usually lashed, and the ship was let run, with all sails set, taking
- her chances of what might come, every soul on board being asleep. One
- night the cook came out of his bunk to get a drink from the tank, and
- found the vessel taken aback. The whole spirit of South Sea life breathes
- from the sequel. He told nobody! The galley was his department, not the
- sails; so he simply went back to his bunk. In the morning we fetched up
- off the northern side of an island we had intended to «approach from the
- south; having, strange to say, somehow escaped piling our bones on the
- encircling reef, and also avoided the misfortune of losing our masts and
- getting sunk.
- </p>
- <p>
- If there is a good deal of hard work on most schooners, and something of
- risk on all, there is also plenty of adventure and romance, for those who
- care about it. One seldom meets an island skipper whose life would not
- furnish materials for a dozen exciting books. Being cut off and attacked
- by cannibals down in the dangerous western groups; swimming for dear life
- away from a boat just bitten in two by an infuriated whale; driving one
- native king off his throne, putting another on, and acting as prime
- minister to the nation; hunting up a rumour of a splendid pearl among the
- pearling islands, and tracking down the gem, until found and coaxed away
- from its careless owner at one-tenth Sydney market prices&mdash;these are
- incidents that the typical schooner captain regards as merely the ordinary
- kind of break to be expected in his rather monotonous life. He does not
- think them very interesting as a rule, and dismisses them somewhat
- briefly, in a yarn. What does excite him, cause him to raise his voice and
- gesticulate freely, and induce him to &ldquo;yarn&rdquo; relentlessly for half a
- watch, is the recital of some thrilling incident connected with the price
- of cargo or the claims made for damaged stuff by some abandoned villain of
- a trader. There is something worth relating in a tale like that, to his
- mind!
- </p>
- <p>
- The passenger on an island schooner learns very early to cultivate a
- humble frame of mind. On a great steam liner he is all in all. It is for
- him almost entirely that the ships are built and run; his favour is life
- or death to the company. He is handled like eggs, and petted like a canary
- bird. Every one runs to do his bidding; he is one of a small but precious
- aristocracy waited on hand and foot by the humblest of serfs. On a
- schooner, however, he is ousted from his pride of place most completely by
- the cargo, which takes precedence of him at every point; so that he
- rapidly learns he is not of nearly so much value as a fat sack of copra,
- and he becomes lowlier in mind than he ever was before. There is no
- special accommodation for him, as a rule; he must go where he can, and
- take what he gets. If he can make himself useful about the ship, so much
- the better; every one will think more of him, and he will get some useful
- exercise by working his passage in addition to paying for it.
- </p>
- <p>
- Here is a typical day on the <i>Duchess</i>.
- </p>
- <p>
- At eight bells (8 a.m.) breakfast is served in the cabin. The passenger&rsquo;s
- own cabin is a small deck-house placed amidships on the main deck. The
- deck is filled up with masses of cargo, interposing a perfect Himalayan
- chain of mountains between the main deck and the poop. It is pouring with
- tropical rain, but the big main hatch yawns half open on one side, because
- of the native passengers in the hold. On the other side foams a squally
- sea, unguarded by either rail or bulwark, since the cargo is almost
- overflowing out of the ship. The <i>Duchess</i> is rolling like a
- porpoise, and the passenger&rsquo;s hands are full of mackintosh and hat-brim.
- It seems impossible to reach the poop alive; but the verb &ldquo;have to&rdquo; is in
- constant use on a sailing-ship, and it does not fail of its magical effect
- on this occasion. Clawing like a parrot, the passenger reaches the cabin,
- and finds the bare-armed, barefooted mates and the captain engaged on the
- inevitable &ldquo;tin&rdquo; and biscuits. There is no tea this morning, because the
- cockroaches have managed to get into and flavour the brew; and the cabin
- will none of it. The captain has sent word by the native steward that he
- will &ldquo;learn&rdquo; the cook&mdash;a strange threat that usually brings about at
- least a temporary reform&mdash;and is now engaged in knocking the
- copra-bugs out of a piece of biscuit and brushing a colony of ants off his
- plate. Our cargo is copra, and in consequence the ship resembles an
- entomological museum more than anything else. No centipedes have been
- found this trip so far; but the mate-stabbed a big scorpion with a
- sail-needle yesterday, as it was walking across the deck; and the
- cockroaches&mdash;as large as mice, and much bolder&mdash;have fairly
- &ldquo;taken charge.&rdquo; The captain says he does not know whether he is sleeping
- in the cockroaches&rsquo; bunk, or they in his, but he rather thinks the former,
- since the brutes made a determined effort to throw him out on the deck
- last night, and nearly succeeded!
- </p>
- <p>
- It grows very warm after breakfast, for we are far within the tropics, and
- the <i>Duchess</i> has no awnings to protect her deck. The rail is almost
- hot enough to blister an unwary hand, and the great sails cast little
- shade, as the sun climbs higher to the zenith. The pitch does not,
- however, bubble in the seams of the deck, after the well-known fashion of
- stories, because the <i>Duchess</i>, like most other tropical ships, has
- her decks caulked with putty. A calm has fallen&mdash;a Pacific calm,
- which is not as highly distinguished for calmness as the stay-at-home
- reader might suppose. There is no wind, and the island we are trying to
- reach remains tantalisingly perched on the extreme edge of the horizon,
- like a little blue flower on the rim of a crystal dish. But there is
- plenty of sea&mdash;long glittering hills of water, rising and falling,
- smooth and foamless, under the ship, which they fling from side to side
- with cruel violence. The great booms swing and slam, the blocks clatter,
- the masts creak. Everything loose in the cabins toboggans wildly up and
- down the floor. At dinner, the soup which the cook has struggled to
- produce, lest he should be &ldquo;learned,&rdquo; has to be drunk out of tin mugs for
- safety. Every one is sad and silent, for the sailor hates a calm even more
- than a gale.
- </p>
- <p>
- Bonitos come round the ship in a glittering shoal by-and-by, and there is
- a rush for hooks and lines. One of our native A.B.s produces a huge pearl
- hook, unbaited, and begins to skim it lightly along the water at the end
- of its line, mimicking the exact motions of a flying-fish with a
- cleverness that no white man can approach. Hurrah! a catch! A mass of
- sparkling silver, blue, and green, nearly twenty pounds weight, is swung
- through the air, and tumbled on deck. Another and another follows; we have
- over a hundred pounds weight of fish in half an hour. The crew shout and
- sing for delight. There are only seven of them and five of us, but
- there-will not be a scrap of that fish left by to-morrow, for all the
- forecastle hands will turn to and cook and eat without ceasing until it is
- gone; after which they will probably dance for an hour or two.
- </p>
- <p>
- To every one&rsquo;s delight, the weather begins to cloud over again after this,
- and we are soon spinning before a ten-knot breeze towards the island,
- within sight of which we have been aimlessly beating about for some days,
- unable to get up. Our crew begin to make preparations. Tapitua, who is a
- great dandy, puts two gold earrings in one ear, and fastens a wreath of
- cock&rsquo;s feathers about his hat. Koddi (christened George) gets into a thick
- blue woollen jersey (very suitable for Antarctic weather), a scarlet and
- yellow pareo or kilt, and a pair of English shoes, which make him limp
- terribly; but they are splendid squeakers, so Koddi is happy. (The Pacific
- islander always picks out squeaking shoes if he can get them, and some
- manufacturers even put special squeakers into goods meant for the island
- trade.) Ta puts on three different singlets&mdash;a pink, a blue, and a
- yellow&mdash;turning up the edges carefully, so as to present a fine
- display of layered colours, like a Neapolitan ice; and gums the gaudy
- label off a jam tin about his bare brown arm, thus christening himself
- with the imposing title of &ldquo;Our Real Raspberry.&rdquo; Neo is wearing two hats
- and three neck-handkerchiefs; Oki has a cap with a &ldquo;P. &amp; O.&rdquo; ribbon,
- and Union Steamship Company&rsquo;s jersey, besides a threepenny-piece in the
- hollow of each ear. Truly we are a gay party, by the time every one is
- ready to land.
- </p>
- <p>
- And now after our thousand mile run, we have arrived at Malden.
- </p>
- <p>
- Malden Island lies on the border of the Southern Pacific, only four
- degrees south of the equator. It is beyond the verge of the great
- Polynesian archipelago, and stands out by itself in a lonely stretch of
- still blue sea, very seldom visited by ships of any kind. Approaching it
- one is struck from far away by the glaring barrenness of the big island,
- which is thirty-three miles in circumference, and does not possess a
- single height or solitary tree, save one small clump of recently planted
- cocoanuts. Nothing more unlike the typical South Sea island could be
- imagined. Instead of the violet mountain peaks, wreathed with flying
- vapour, the lowlands rich with pineapple, banana, orange, and mango, the
- picturesque beach bordered by groves of feathery cocoanuts and quaint
- heavy-fruited pandanus trees, that one finds in such groups as the
- Society, Navigator&rsquo;s, Hawaiian, and Cook Islands, Malden consists simply
- of an immense white beach, a little settlement fronted by a big wooden
- pier, and a desolate plain of low greyish-green herbage, relieved here and
- there by small bushes bearing insignificant yellow flowers. Water is
- provided by great condensers. Food is all imported, save for pig and goat
- flesh. Shade, coolness, refreshing fruit, pleasant sights and sounds,
- there are none. For those who live on the island, it is the scene of an
- exile which has to be endured somehow or other, but which drags away with
- incredible slowness and soul-deadening monotony.
- </p>
- <p>
- Why does any one live in such a spot? More especially, why should it be
- tenanted by five or six whites and a couple of hundred Kanakas, when many
- beautiful and fertile islands cannot show nearly so many of either race;
- quite a large number, indeed, being altogether uninhabited? One need never
- look far for an answer in such a case. If there is no comfort on Malden
- Island, there is something that men value more than comfort&mdash;money.
- For fifty-six years it has been one of the most valuable properties in the
- Pacific. Out of Malden Island have come horses and carriages, fine houses,
- and gorgeous jewellery, rich eating, delicate wines, handsome
- entertainments, university education and expensive finishing governesses,
- trips to the Continent, swift white schooners, high places in Society, and
- all the other desirables of wealth, for two generations of fortunate
- owners and their families. Half-a-million hard cash has been made out of
- it in the last thirty years, and it is good for another thirty. All this
- from a barren rock in mid-ocean! The solution of the problem will at once
- suggest itself to any reader who has ever sailed the Southern Seas&mdash;guano!
- </p>
- <p>
- This is indeed the secret of Malden Island&rsquo;s riches. Better by far than
- the discovery of a pirate&rsquo;s treasure-cave, that favourite dream of
- romantic youth, is the discovery of a guano island. There are few genuine
- treasure romances in the Pacific, but many exciting tales that deal with
- the finding and disposing of these unromantic mines of wealth. Malden
- Island itself has had an interesting history enough. In 1848, Captain
- Chapman, an American whaling captain who still lives in Honolulu, happened
- to discover Malden during the course of a long cruise. He landed on the
- island, found nothing for himself and his crew in the way of fruit or
- vegetables, but discovered the guano beds, and made up his mind to sell
- the valuable knowledge as soon as his cruise was over. Then he put to sea
- again, and did not reach San Francisco for the best part of a year.
- Meantime, another American, Captain English, had found the island and its
- treasure. Wiser than Captain Chapman, he abandoned his cruise, and hurried
- at once to Sydney, where he sold the island for a big price to the trading
- firm who have owned it ever since.
- </p>
- <p>
- This is the history of Malden Island&rsquo;s discovery. Time, in the island, has
- slipped along since the days of the Crimea with never a change. There is a
- row of little tin-roofed, one-storeyed houses above the beach, tenanted by
- the half-dozen white men who act as managers; there are big, barn-like
- shelters for the native labourers. Every three years the managers end
- their term of service, and joyfully return to the Company&rsquo;s great offices
- in Sydney, where there is life and companionship, pleasant things to see,
- good things to eat, newspapers every day, and no prison bar of blue
- relentless ocean cutting off all the outer world. Once or twice in the
- year one of the pretty white island schooners sails up to Malden, greeted
- with shrieks and war-dances of joy; discharges her freight of forty or
- fifty newly indentured labourers, and takes away as many others whose time
- of one year on the island has expired. On Malden itself nothing changes.
- Close up to the equator, and devoid of mountains or even heights which
- could attract rain, its climate is unaltered by the passing season. No
- fruits or flowers mark the year by their ripening and blossoming, no rainy
- season changes the face of the land. News from the outer world comes
- rarely; and when it does come, it is so old as to have lost its savour.
- Life on Malden Island for managers and labourers alike, is work, work, all
- day long; in the evening, the bare verandah and the copper-crimson sunset,
- and the empty prisoning sea. That is all.
- </p>
- <p>
- The guano beds cover practically the whole of the island. The surface on
- which one walks is hard, white, and rocky. This must be broken through
- before the guano, which lies a foot or two underneath, is reached. The
- labourers break away the stony crust with picks, and shovel out the fine,
- dry, earth-coloured guano that lies beneath, in a stratum varying from one
- to three feet in thickness. This is piled in great heaps, and sifted
- through large wire, screens. The sifted guano&mdash;exactly resembling
- common sand&mdash;is now spread out in small heaps, and left to dry
- thoroughly in the fierce sun. There must not be any trace of moisture left
- that can possibly be dispersed; for the price of the guano depends on its
- absolute purity and extreme concentration, and purchasers generally make
- careful chemical tests of the stuff they buy.
- </p>
- <p>
- When dried, the guano is stored away in an immense shed near the
- settlement. If it has been obtained from the pits at the other side of the
- island, eight miles away, it will be brought down to the storehouse by
- means of one of the oddest little railways in the world. The Malden Island
- railway is worked, not by steam, electricity, or petrol, but by sail! The
- S.E. trade-wind blows practically all the year round on this island; so
- the Company keep a little fleet of land-vessels, cross-rigged, with fine
- large sails, to convey the guano down to the settlement. The empty
- carriages are pushed up to the pits by the workmen, and loaded there. At
- evening, the labourers climb on the top of the load, set the great sails,
- and fly down to the settlement as fast as an average train could go. These
- &ldquo;land-ships&rdquo; of Malden are a bit unmanageable at times, and have been
- known to jump the rails when travelling at high speed, thus causing
- unpleasant accidents. But the Kanaka labourers do not mind a trifle of
- that kind, and not even in a S.E. gale would they condescend to take a
- reef in the sails.
- </p>
- <p>
- As it is necessary to push these railway ships on the outward trip, the
- managers generally travel on a small railway tricycle of the pattern
- familiar at home. This can be driven at a fair speed, by means of arm
- levers. Across the desolate inland plain one clatters, the centre of a
- disk of shadowless grey-green, drenched clear of drawing and colour by the
- merciless flood of white fire from above. The sky is of the very thinnest
- pale blue; the dark, deep sea is out of sight. The world is all dead
- stillness and smiting sun, with only the thin rattle of our labouring car,
- and the vibration of distant dark specks above the rookeries, for relief.
- </p>
- <p>
- The dark specks grow nearer and more numerous, filling the whole sky at
- last with the sweep of rushing wings and the screams of angry bird voices.
- We leave the tricycle on the rails and walk across the thin, coarse grass,
- tangled with barilla plants, and low-growing yellow-flowered shrubs,
- towards the spot where the wings flutter thickest, covering many acres of
- the unlovely, barren land with a perfect canopy of feathered life. This is
- the bird by which the fortunes of Malden have been made&mdash;the smaller
- man-o&rsquo;-war bird. It is about the size of a duck, though much lighter in
- build. The back is black, the breast white, the bill long and hooked. The
- bird has an extraordinarily rapid and powerful flight. It might more
- appropriately be called the &ldquo;pirate&rdquo; than the &ldquo;man-o&rsquo;-war&rdquo; or &ldquo;frigate&rdquo;
- bird, since it uses, its superior speed to deprive other seabirds of the
- fish they catch, very seldom indeed exerting itself to make an honest
- capture on its own account. Strange to say, however, this daring buccaneer
- is the meekest and most long-suffering of birds where human beings are
- concerned. It will allow you to walk all through its rookeries, and even
- to handle the young birds and eggs, without making any remonstrance other
- than a petulant squeal. The parents fly about the visitors&rsquo; heads in a
- perfect cloud, sweeping their wings within an inch of our faces, screaming
- harshly, and looking exceedingly fierce, with their ugly hooked bills and
- sparkling black eyes. But that is their ordinary way of occupying
- themselves; they wheel and scream above the rookery all day long, visited
- or let alone. Even if you capture one, by a happy snatch (not at all an
- impossible feat), you will not alarm the others, and your prisoner will
- not show much fight.
- </p>
- <p>
- The eggs lie all over the ground in a mass of broken shells, feathers, and
- clawed-up earth. Those birds never build nests, and only sit upon one egg,
- which is dirty white, with brown spots. The native labourers consider
- frigate-bird eggs good to eat, and devour large numbers, but the white men
- find them too strong. The birds are also eaten by the labourers, but only
- on the sly, as this practice is strictly forbidden, for the reason that
- illness generally follows. The frigate-bird, it seems, is not very
- wholesome eating.
- </p>
- <p>
- It is not in the insignificant deposits of these modern rookeries that the
- wealth of the island lies, but in the prehistoric strata underlying the
- stony surface crust already mentioned. There are three strata composing
- the island&mdash;first the coral rock, secondly the guano, lastly the
- surface crust. At one time, the island must have been the home of
- innumerable myriads of frigate-birds, nesting all over its circumference
- of thirty-three miles. The birds now nest only in certain places, and,
- though exceedingly thick to an unaccustomed eye, cannot compare with their
- ancestors in number.
- </p>
- <p>
- The schooner called on a Sunday, and so I could not see the men at work.
- One of the managers, however, showed me over the labourers&rsquo; quarters, and
- told me all about their life. There is certainly none of the
- &ldquo;black-birding&rdquo; business about Malden. Kidnapping natives for plantation
- work, under conditions which amount to slavery, is unfortunately still
- common enough in some parts of the Pacific. But in the Cook Group, and
- Savage Island, where most of the labourers come from, there is no
- difficulty in obtaining as many genuine volunteers for Malden as its
- owners want. The men sign for a year&rsquo;s work, at ten shillings a week, and
- board and lodging. Their food consists of rice, biscuits, yams, tinned
- beef, and tea, with a few cocoanuts for those who may fall sick. This is
- &ldquo;the hoigth of good &rsquo;atin&rdquo; for a Polynesian, who lives when at home
- on yams, taro root, and bananas, with an occasional mouthful of fish, and
- fowl or pig only on high festival days.
- </p>
- <p>
- The labourers&rsquo; quarters are large, bare, shady buildings fitted with wide
- shelves, on which the men spread their mats and pillows to sleep. A
- Polynesian is never to be divorced from his bedding; he always carries it
- with him when travelling, and the Malden labourers each come to the island
- provided with beautifully plaited pandanus mats, and cushions stuffed with
- the down of the silk-cotton tree. The cushions have covers of &ldquo;trade&rdquo;
- cottons, rudely embroidered by the owner&rsquo;s sweetheart or wife with
- decorative designs, and affectionate mottoes.
- </p>
- <p>
- From 5 a.m. to 5 p.m. are the hours of work, with an hour and
- three-quarters off for meals. There is nothing unpleasant about the work,
- as Malden Island guano is absolutely without odour, and apparently so dry
- and fine when taken from the pits, that one wonders at the necessity for
- further sifting and drying. Occasionally, however, one of the workers
- develops a peculiar intestinal trouble which is said to be caused by the
- fine dust of the pits. It is nearly always fatal, by slow degrees. Our
- schooner carried away one of these unfortunates&mdash;a Savage Island man
- who had come up to Malden in full health and strength only a few months
- before. He was the merest shadow or sketch of a human being&mdash;a bundle
- of bones clad in loose brown skin, with a skull-like face, all teeth and
- eye-sockets&mdash;he could not stand or walk, only creep along the deck;
- and he was very obviously dying. Poor fellow! he longed for his own home
- above everything&mdash;-the cool green island, sixteen hundred miles away,
- where there were fruit and flowers in the shady valleys, and women&rsquo;s and
- children&rsquo;s voices sounding pleasantly about the grassy village streets,
- and his own little pandanus-thatched cottage, with his &ldquo;fafiné&rdquo; and the
- babies at the door, among the palms and oranges above the sea. But the
- schooner had a two months&rsquo; voyage to make yet among the Cook and other
- groups, before Savage Island could be reached; and Death was already
- lifting his spear to strike. We left the poor fellow as a last chance on
- Penrhyn Island, a couple of hundred miles away, hoping that the unlimited
- cocoanuts he could obtain there might do him some good, and that by some
- fortunate chance he might recover sufficiently to take another ship, and
- reach Niué at last.
- </p>
- <p>
- The guano of Malden Island is supposed to be the best in the world. It is
- extremely rich in superphosphates, and needs no &ldquo;doctoring&rdquo; whatever,
- being ready to apply to the land just as taken from the island. As the
- company are obliged to guarantee the purity of what they sell, and give an
- exact analysis of the constituents of every lot, they keep a skilled
- chemist on the island, and place a fine laboratory at his disposal. These
- analyses are tedious to make, and require great accuracy, as a mistake
- might cause a refusal of payment on the part of the purchaser. The post of
- official chemist, therefore, is no sinecure, especially as it includes the
- duties of dispenser as well, and not a little rough-and-ready doctoring at
- times.
- </p>
- <p>
- The temperature of the island is not so high as might be expected from the
- latitude. It seldom goes above 90° in the shade, and is generally rendered
- quite endurable, in spite of the merciless glare and total absence of
- shade, by the persistent trade-wind. Mosquitoes are unknown, and flies not
- troublesome. There are no centipedes, scorpions, or other venomous
- creatures, although the neighbouring islands (&ldquo;neighbouring,&rdquo; in the
- Pacific, means anything within three or four hundred miles) have plenty of
- these unpleasant inhabitants. The white men live on tinned food of various
- kinds, also bread, rice, fowls, pork, goat, and goat&rsquo;s milk. Vegetables or
- fruit are a rare and precious luxury, for the nearest island producing
- either lies a thousand miles away. Big yams, weighing a stone or two
- apiece and whitewashed to prevent decay, are sent up from the Cook Islands
- now and then; but the want of really fresh, vegetable food is one of the
- trials of the island. It is not astonishing to hear that the salaries of
- the Malden officials are very high. A year or two on the island is a good
- way of accumulating some capital, since it is impossible to spend a penny.
- </p>
- <p>
- The native labourers generally leave the island with the greatest joy,
- glad beyond expression to return to their sweet do-nothing lives at home.
- Why they undertake the work at all is one of the many puzzles presented by
- the Polynesian character. They have enough to eat and enough to wear,
- without doing any work to speak of, while they are at home. Usually the
- motive for going to Malden is the desire of making twenty-five pounds or
- so in a lump, to buy a bicycle (all South Sea Islanders have bicycles, and
- ride them splendidly) or to build a stone house. But in most cases the
- money is &ldquo;spreed&rdquo; away in the first two or three days at home, giving
- presents to everybody, and buying fine clothes at the trader&rsquo;s store.
- </p>
- <p>
- So the product of the year&rsquo;s exile and hard work is simply a tour among
- the islands&mdash;in itself a strong attraction&mdash;a horribly hot suit
- of shoddy serge, with a stiff white shirt, red socks, and red tie, bought
- up in Malden from the company out of the labourer&rsquo;s wages, and proudly
- worn on the day the schooner brings the wanderer home to his lightly clad
- relatives&mdash;a bicycle, perhaps, which soon becomes a scrap-heap; or,
- possibly, a stone house which is never lived in. The company has the
- labour that it wants, and the money that the labour produces. Every one is
- satisfied with the bargain, doubtless; and the faraway British farmer and
- market-gardener are the people who are ultimately benefited.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0012" id="link2HCH0012"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER XII
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>Pearl-fishing at Penrhyn&mdash;The Beautiful Golden-Edge&mdash;Perils
- of the Pearl Diver&mdash;A Fight for Life&mdash;Visit to a Leper Island&mdash;A
- God-forsaken Place&mdash;How they kept the Corpses&mdash;The Woman who
- sinned&mdash;A Nameless Grave&mdash;On to Merry Manahiki&mdash;The Island
- of Dance and Song&mdash;Story of the Leper and his Bird&mdash;Good-bye to
- the Duchess.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">A</span> DAY or two after
- leaving Malden we sighted Penrhyn, lying five degrees further south, but
- for some unexplained reason a very much hotter place than Malden. Penrhyn
- is an island that is famous all over the South Sea world, and not unknown
- even in Europe. Its pearl-shell and pearls, its strange, wild,
- semi-amphibious natives, and its melancholy leper station, make it a
- marked spot upon the Pacific map; and a certain rather fictitious value
- attaching to its stamps has made the name of the island familiar to all
- stamp collectors at home. The general impression conveyed to the voyager
- from kinder and fairer islands is that Penrhyn is a place &ldquo;at the back of
- God-speed,&rdquo; a lonely, sultry, windy, eerie spot, desolate and remote
- beyond description.
- </p>
- <p>
- It is an atoll island, consisting merely of a strip of land some couple of
- hundred yards in width, enclosing a splendid lagoon nine miles long. The
- land is white coral gravel; nothing grows on it but cocoanut and pandanus
- and a few insignificant creepers. Fruit, vegetables, flowers, there are
- none. The natives live entirely on cocoanut and fish. They are nominally
- Christianised, but the veneer of Christianity is wearing uncommonly thin
- in places. They are reckless and daring to a degree, notable even among
- Pacific Islanders. Any Penrhyn man will attack a shark single-handed in
- its own element, and kill it with the big knife he usually carries. They
- are, beyond comparison, the finest swimmers in the world; it is almost
- impossible to drown a Penrhyn Islander. He will swim all day as easily as
- he will walk. You may often meet him out fishing, miles from shore,
- without a boat, pushing in front of him a small plank that carries his
- bait, lines, and catch. Some of the fish he most fancies seldom come to
- the surface. To catch these he baits his line, dives, and swims about
- underneath the water for a minute or two at a time, trailing the bait
- after him, and rising to the surface as often as a fish takes it.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0034" id="linkimage-0034"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0339.jpg" alt="0339 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0339.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Of his pearl-diving exploits I shall speak later. The deadly surf that
- breaks upon the outer reef has no terrors for him. Among the small boys of
- the island there is a favourite feat known as &ldquo;crossing a hundred waves,&rdquo;
- which consists in diving through ninety-nine great rollers, just as they
- are about to break, and rushing triumphantly to shore on the back of the
- hundredth. The old warlike, quarrelsome character of the islanders&mdash;no
- doubt originally due to scarcity of food&mdash;still lurks concealed under
- an outward show of civility. Penrhyn was the only South Pacific Island I
- have visited where I did not care to walk alone in the bush without my
- little American revolver. The four or five white traders all keep firearms
- ready to hand in their stores. There has been no actual trouble of recent
- years, but there are narrow escapes from a free fight every now and then,
- and every man must hold himself ready for emergencies. It is only eight
- years since there was such an outbreak of hostilities in Penrhyn that a
- man-of-war had to be sent up to protect the traders.
- </p>
- <p>
- I was kindly offered the use of a house during the week the <i>Duchess</i>
- spent in Penrhyn lagoon repairing sails and rigging, and generally
- refitting after the stormy weather that we had experienced on several
- occasions. But Penrhyn is rotten with undeclared leprosy, the water is not
- above suspicion, and flies abound in myriads. So I slept on the ship, and
- by day wandered about the desolate, thin, sun-smitten woods of the island,
- or flew over the green lagoon in one of the marvellously speedy pearling
- sloops of the traders. These boats are about a couple of tons each, with a
- boom as big, in proportion, as a grasshopper&rsquo;s leg. They are as manageable
- as a motor car, and faster than most yachts. It is a wonderful sight to
- see them taking cargo out to the schooners, speeding like gulls over the
- water, and turning round in their tracks to fly back again as easily as
- any gull might do. Pearling was almost &ldquo;off&rdquo; at the time of the <i>Duchess&rsquo;s</i>
- visit, since a good part of the lagoon was tabooed to allow the beds to
- recover.
- </p>
- <p>
- The pearls are rather a minor consideration at Penrhyn. The shell is of
- beautiful quality, large and thick, with the much-valued golden edge; but
- pearls are not plentiful in it, and they are generally of moderate size.
- Some very fine ones have been found, however; and gems of ordinary value
- can always be picked up fairly cheaply from the divers. The Penrhyn lagoon
- is the property of the natives themselves, who sell the shell and the
- pearls to white traders. Christmas Island and some other Pacific pearling
- grounds are privately owned, and in these places there is a great deal of
- poaching done by the divers. The great buyers of pearls are the schooner
- captains. There are three or four schooners that call at Penrhyn now and
- then for cargo; and every captain has a nose for pearls like that of a
- trained hound for truffles. In the Paumotus, about Penrhyn, Christmas
- Island, and the Scillies (the Pacific Scillies, not those that are so
- familiarly known to English readers), they flit from island to island,
- following up the vagrant rumours of a fine pearl with infinite tact and
- patience, until they run it to ground at last, and (perhaps) clear a
- year&rsquo;s income in a day by a lucky deal. San Francisco and Sydney are
- always ready to buy, and the typical Pacific captain, if he is just a bit
- of a buccaneer, is also a very keen man of business in the most modern
- sense of the word, and not at all likely to be cheated. Three native
- divers, famous for their deepwater feats, came out in a pearling sloop
- with us one afternoon, and gave a fine exhibition.
- </p>
- <p>
- The bed over which we halted was about ninety feet under the surface. Our
- three divers stripped to a &ldquo;pareo&rdquo; apiece, and then, squatting down on the
- gunwale of the boat with their hands hanging over their knees, appeared to
- meditate. They were &ldquo;taking their wind,&rdquo; the white steersman informed me.
- After about five minutes of perfect stillness they suddenly got up and
- dived off the thwart. The rest of us fidgeted up and down the tiny deck,
- talked, speculated, and passed away the time for what seemed an
- extraordinarily long period. No one, unfortunately, had brought a watch;
- but the traders and schooner captains all agree in saying that the Penrhyn
- diver can stay under water for full three minutes; and it was quite
- evident that our men were showing off for the benefit of that almost
- unknown bird, the &ldquo;wahiné papa.&rdquo; At last, one after another, the dark
- heads popped up again, and the divers, each carrying a shell or two, swam
- back to the boat, got on board, and presented their catch to me with the
- easy grace and high-bred courtesy that are the birthright of all Pacific
- islanders&mdash;not at all embarrassed by the fact that all the clothes
- they wore would hardly have sufficed to make a Sunday suit for an equal
- number of pigeons.
- </p>
- <p>
- As a general rule, the divers carry baskets, and fill them before coming
- up. Each man opens his own catch at once, and hunts through the shell for
- pearls. Usually he does not find any; now and then he gets a small grey
- pearl, 01 a decent white one, or a big irregular &ldquo;baroque&rdquo; pearl of the
- &ldquo;new art&rdquo; variety, and once in a month of Sundays he is rewarded by a
- large gleaming gem worth several hundred pounds, for which he will
- probably get only twenty or thirty.
- </p>
- <p>
- Diving dresses are sometimes used in Penrhyn; but in such an irregular and
- risky manner that they are really more dangerous than the ordinary method.
- The suit is nothing but a helmet and jumper. No boots are worn, no
- clothing whatever on the legs, and there are no weights to preserve the
- diver&rsquo;s balance. It sometimes happens&mdash;though wonderfully seldom&mdash;that
- the diver trips, falls, and turns upside down, the heavy helmet keeping
- him head-downwards until the air all rushes out under the jumper, and he
- is miserably suffocated. The air pump above is often carelessly worked in
- any case, and there is no recognised system of signals, except the jerk
- that means &ldquo;Pull up.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;They&rsquo;re the most reckless devils on the face of the earth,&rdquo; said a local
- trader. &ldquo;Once let a man strike a good bed of shell, and he won&rsquo;t leave go
- of it, not for Father Peter. He&rsquo;ll stick down there all day, grabbin&rsquo; away
- in twenty fathom or more till he feels paralysis cornin&rsquo; on&mdash;&mdash;&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Paralysis?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Yes&mdash;they gets it, lots of&rsquo;em. If you was to go down in twenty
- fathom&mdash;they can do five and twenty, but anything over is touch and
- go&mdash;and stay &rsquo;alf the day, you&rsquo;d come up &rsquo;owling like
- anything, and not able to move. That&rsquo;s the way it catches them; and then
- they must get some one to come and rub them with sea water all night long,
- and maybe they dies, and maybe they&rsquo;re all right by morning. So then down
- they goes again, just the same as ever. Sometimes a man&rsquo;ll be pulled up
- dead at the end of a day. How does that happen? Well, I allow it&rsquo;s because
- he&rsquo;s been workin&rsquo; at a big depth all day, and feels all right; and then,
- do you see, he&rsquo;ll find somethin&rsquo; a bit extra below of him, in a holler
- like, and down he&rsquo;ll go after it; and the extra fathom or two does the
- trick.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Sharks? Well, I&rsquo;ve seen you poppin&rsquo; at them from the deck of the <i>Duchess</i>,
- so you know as well as I do how many there are. Didn&rsquo;t &rsquo;it them,
- even when the fin was up? That&rsquo;s because you &rsquo;aven&rsquo;t greased your
- bullet, I suppose. You want to, if the water isn&rsquo;t to turn it aside. But
- about the divers? Oh! they don&rsquo;t mind sharks, none of them, when they&rsquo;ve
- got the dress on. Sharks is easy scared. You&rsquo;ve only got to pull up your
- jumper a bit, and the air bubbles out and frightens them to fits. If you
- meet a big sting-ray, it&rsquo;ll run its spine into you, and send the dress all
- to&mdash;I mean, spoil the dress, so&rsquo;s the water comes in, and maybe it&rsquo;ll
- stick the diver too. And the big devilfish is nasty; he&rsquo;ll &rsquo;old you
- down to a rock but you can use your knife on him. The kara mauaa is the
- worst; the divers don&rsquo;t like him. He&rsquo;s not as big as a shark, but he&rsquo;s
- downright wicked, and he&rsquo;s a mouth on him as big as &rsquo;alf his body.
- If one comes along, he&rsquo;ll bite an arm or leg off the man anyways, and eat
- &rsquo;im outright if he&rsquo;s big enough to do it. Swordfish? Well, they
- don&rsquo;t often come into the lagoon; it&rsquo;s the fishing canoes outside they&rsquo;ll
- go for. Yes, they&rsquo;ll run a canoe and a man through at a blow easy enough:
- but they don&rsquo;t often do it. If you wants a canoe, I&rsquo;ll get you one; and
- you needn&rsquo;t mind about the swordfish. As like as not they&rsquo;ll never come
- near you.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;About the divin&rsquo;?&mdash;well, I think the naked divin&rsquo; is very near as
- safe as the machine, takin&rsquo; all things. Worst of it is, if a kara mauaa
- comes along, the diver can&rsquo;t wait his time till it goes. No, he doesn&rsquo;t
- stab it&mdash;not inside the lagoon, because there&rsquo;s too many of them
- there, and the blood would bring a whole pack about. He gets under a ledge
- of rock, and &rsquo;opes it&rsquo;ll go away before his wind gives out. If he
- doesn&rsquo;t, he gets eat.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- Did Schiller, or Edgar Allan Poe ever conjure up a picture more ghastly
- than that of a Penrhyn diver, caught like a rat in a trap by some huge,
- man-eating shark, or fierce kara mauaa&mdash;crouching in a cleft of the
- overhanging coral, under the dark green gloom of a hundred feet of water,
- with bursting lungs and cracking eyeballs, while the threatening bulk of
- his terrible enemy looms dark and steady, full in the road to life and
- air? A minute or more has been spent in the downward journey; another
- minute has passed in the agonised wait under the rock. Has he been seen?
- Will the creature move away now, while there is still time to return? The
- diver knows to a second how much time has passed; the third minute is on
- its way; but one goes up quicker than one comes down, and there is still
- hope. Two minutes and a half; it is barely possible now, but&mdash;&mdash;&mdash;
- The sentinel of death glides forward; his cruel eyes, phosphorescent in
- the gloom, look right into the cleft where the wretched creature is
- crouching, with almost twenty seconds of life still left, but now not a
- shred of hope. A few more beats of the labouring pulse, a gasp from the
- tortured lungs, a sudden rush of silvery air bubbles, and the brown limbs
- collapse down out of the cleft like wreaths of seaweed. The shark has his
- own.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is a &ldquo;Molokai,&rdquo; or Leper Island, some two miles out in the lagoon,
- where natives afflicted with leprosy are confined. The Resident Agent&mdash;one
- of the traders&mdash;broke the rigid quarantine of the Molokai one day so
- far as to let me land upon the island, although he did not allow me to
- approach nearer than ten or twelve yards to the lepers, or to leave the
- beach and go inland to the houses that were visible in the distance. Our
- boatmen ran the sloop close inshore, and carried the captain and myself
- through the shallow water, carefully setting us down on dry stones, but
- remaining in the sea themselves. A little dog that had come with the party
- sprang overboard, and began swimming to the shore. It was hurriedly seized
- by the scruff of its neck, and flung back into the boat. If it had set paw
- on the beach it could never have returned, but would have had to stay on
- the island for good.
- </p>
- <p>
- Very lovely is the Molokai of Penrhyn; sadly beautiful this spot where so
- many wretched creatures have passed away from death in life to life in
- death. As we landed, the low golden rays of the afternoon sun were
- slanting through the pillared palm stems and quaintly beautiful pandanus
- fronds, across the snowy beach, and its trailing gold-flowered vines. The
- water of the lagoon, coloured like the gems in the gates of the Heavenly
- City, lapped softly on the shore; the perpetual trade wind poured through
- the swaying trees, shaking silvery gleams from the lacquered crests of the
- palms. In the distance, shadowed by a heavy pandanus grove, stood a few
- low brown huts. From the direction of these there came, hurrying down to
- the beach as we landed, four figures&mdash;three men and a woman. They had
- put on their best clothes when they saw the sloop making for the island.
- The woman wore a gaudy scarlet cotton frock; two of the men had white
- shirts and sailor&rsquo;s trousers of blue dungaree&mdash;relics of a happier
- day, these, telling their own melancholy tale of bygone years of freedom
- on the wide Pacific. The third man wore a shirt and scarlet &ldquo;pareo,&rdquo; or
- kilt. Every face was lit up with delight at the sight of strangers from
- the schooner; above all, at the marvellous view of the wonderful &ldquo;wahiné
- papa.&rdquo; Why, even the men who lived free and happy on Penrhyn mainland did
- not get the chance of seeing such a show once in a lifetime! There she
- was, with two arms, and two legs, and a head, and a funny gown fastened in
- about the middle, and the most remarkable yellow shoes, and a ring, and a
- watch, which showed her to be extraordinarily wealthy, and a pale smooth
- face, not at all like a man&rsquo;s, and hair that was brown, not black&mdash;how
- odd! It was evidently as good as a theatre, to the lonely prisoners!
- </p>
- <p>
- Bright as all the faces of the lepers were at that exciting moment, one
- could not mistake the traces left by a more habitual expression of heavy
- sadness. The terrible disease, too, had set its well-known marks upon
- every countenance. None of those who came out to see us had lost any
- feature; but all the faces had the gross, thickened, unhuman look that
- leprosy stamps upon its victims. The woman kept her arm up over her head,
- to hide some sad disfigurement about her neck. One of the men walked
- slowly and painfully, through an affection of the hip and leg. There were
- nine lepers in all upon the island; but the other five either could not,
- or did not, wish to leave their huts, and the agent refused to break the
- quarantine any further than he had already done. What care the wretched
- creatures are able to give one another, therefore, what their homes are
- like, and how their lives are passed, I cannot tell. Three of the lepers
- were accompanied by their faithful dogs. They are all fond of pets, and
- must have either a dog or a cat. Of course the animals never leave the
- island. We exchanged a few remarks at the top of our voices, left a case
- of oranges (brought up from the Cook Islands, a thousand miles away), and
- returned to our boat. The case of oranges was eagerly seized upon, and
- conveyed into the bush.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;They will eat them up at once,&rdquo; I said.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Not they,&rdquo; said one of our white men. &ldquo;They&rsquo;ll make them into orange beer
- to-night, and get jolly well drunk for once in their miserable lives. Glad
- to see the poor devils get a chance, say I.&rdquo; And so&mdash;most immorally,
- no doubt&mdash;said the &ldquo;wahiné papa&rdquo; as well.
- </p>
- <p>
- The lepers are fed from stores furnished by a small Government fund; and
- the trader who fulfils the very light duties of Resident Government Agent
- generally sends them over a share of any little luxury, in the way of
- oranges, limes, or yams, that may reach the island. None the less, their
- condition is most miserable, and one cannot but regard it as a crying
- scandal upon the great missionary organisations of the Pacific that
- nothing whatever is done for the lepers of these northern groups. The
- noble example of the late Father Damien, of Hawaii, and of the Franciscan
- Sisters who still live upon the Hawaiian Molokai, courting a martyr&rsquo;s
- death to serve the victims of this terrible disease, seems to find no
- imitators in the islands evangelised by British missionaries. Godless,
- hopeless, and friendless, the lepers live and die alone. That their lives
- are immoral in the last degree, their religion, in spite of early
- teaching, almost a dead letter, is only to be expected. Penrhyn is not
- alone in this terrible scourge. Rakahanga, Manahiki, and Palmerston&mdash;all
- in the same part of the Pacific&mdash;are seriously affected by the
- disease. Palmerston I did not see; but I heard that there is one whole
- family of lepers there, and some stray cases as well.
- </p>
- <p>
- The island belongs to the half-caste descendants (about 150 in number) of
- Masters, a &ldquo;beachcomber&rdquo; of the early days, who died a few years ago.
- These people are much alarmed at the appearance of leprosy, and have
- segregated the lepers on an island in the lagoon. They are anxious to have
- them removed to the Molokai at Penrhyn, since the family came originally
- from that island; but no schooner will undertake to carry them. In
- Rakahanga, the lepers are not quarantined in any way, but wander about
- among the people. There are only a few cases as yet; but the number will
- certainly increase. This may also be said of Manahiki, for although very
- serious cases are isolated there, the lepers are allowed, in the earlier
- stages, to mix freely with every one else, and even to prepare the food of
- a whole family. The New Zealand Government, it is believed, will shortly
- pass a law compelling the removal of all these cases to the Molokai at
- Penrhyn. No Government, however, can alleviate the wretched condition of
- these unfortunate prisoners, once sent to the island. That remains for
- private charity and devotion.
- </p>
- <p>
- A God-forsaken, God-forgotten-looking place is Penrhyn, all in all. When
- sunset falls upon the great desolate lagoon, and the tall cocoanuts of the
- island stand up jet black against the stormy yellow sky in one unbroken
- rampart of tossing spears, and the endless sweep of shadowy beach is empty
- of all human life, and clear of every sound save the long, monotonous,
- never-ceasing cry of the trade wind in the trees, it needs but little
- imagination to fancy strange creatures creeping through the gloom of the
- forest&mdash;strange, ghastly stories of murder and despair whispering in
- the gathering night. Death in every form is always near to Penrhyn; death
- in the dark waters of the lagoon, death from the white terror of leprosy,
- and death at the hands of men but quarter civilised, whose fingers are
- always itching for the ready knife. And at the lonely sunset hour, when
- old memories of the life and light of great cities, of welcoming windows
- shining red and warm through grey, cold northern gloamings come back to
- the wanderer&rsquo;s mind in vivid contrast, the very wings of the &ldquo;Shadow
- cloaked from head to foot&rdquo; seem to shake in full sight above these
- desolate shores. Yet, perhaps, the intolerable blaze of full noon upon the
- windward beaches strikes a note of even deeper loneliness and distance.
- The windward side of Penrhyn is uninhabited; the sea that breaks in
- blinding white foam upon the untrodden strand, wreathed with trailing
- vines of vivid green, is never broken by a sail. The sun beats down
- through the palm and pandanus leaves so fiercely that the whole of the
- seaward bush is but a shadeless blaze of green fire. Nothing stirs,
- nothing cries; the earth is silent, the sea empty; and a barrier of
- thousands of long sea miles, steadily built up, day by day, through many
- weeks, and only to be passed again by the slow demolishing, brick by
- brick, of the same great wall, lies between us and the world where people
- live. Here there is no life, only an endless dream; not as in the happy
- southern islands, a gentle sunrise dream of such surpassing sweetness that
- the sleeper asks nothing more than to dream on thus forever; but a
- dark-hour dream of loneliness, desolation, and utter remoteness, from
- which the dreamer cannot awaken, even if he would. Why do men&mdash;white
- men, with some ability and some education&mdash;live in these faraway
- infertile islands? There is no answer to the problem, even from the men
- themselves. They came, they stayed, they do not go away&mdash;why? they do
- not know. That is all.
- </p>
- <p>
- The land extent of Penrhyn is only three square miles, though the enclosed
- lagoon is a hundred. The population is little over four hundred souls;
- there are three or four white traders, as a rule. There is no resident
- white missionary. The island is one of those that have been annexed by New
- Zealand, and is therefore British property. It is governed by the Resident
- Commissioner of the Cook group, who visits it about once a year.
- </p>
- <p>
- Until two or three years ago, the Penrhyn Islanders used to keep their
- dead in the houses, hanging up the corpse, wrapped in matting, until it
- was completely decayed. This hideous practice was put an end to by the
- Representatives of British Government, much to the grief of the natives,
- who found it hard to part with the bodies of their friends, and leave them
- away in the graveyard they were bidden to choose. As the best substitute
- for the old practice, they now build little houses, some four feet high,
- over the tombs of their friends, and live in these houses for many months
- after a death, sitting and sleeping and even eating on the tomb that is
- covered by the thatch or iron roof of the grave-house. The graveyard is in
- consequence a strange and picturesque sight, almost like a village of some
- pigmy folk. A few plain concrete graves stand above the remains of white
- men who have died in the island, and one headstone is carved with the
- initials&mdash;not the name&mdash;of a woman. There is a story about that
- lonely grave; it was told to me as I lingered in the little &ldquo;God&rsquo;s Acre&rdquo;
- at sunset, with the light falling low between the palms and the lonely
- evening wind beginning to wail from the sea.
- </p>
- <p>
- The woman was the wife of a schooner captain, a man of good family and
- connections, who liked the wild roving life of the Pacific, yet managed to
- retain a number of acquaintances of his own class in Auckland and Tahiti.
- His wife was young and handsome, and had many friends of her own. On one
- of the schooner&rsquo;s visits to Penrhyn, the man was taken suddenly ill, and
- died in a very short time, leaving his wife alone. It seems that at first
- she was bewildered by her loss, and stayed on in the island, not knowing
- what to do, but before many months she had solved the problem after a
- fashion that horrified all the whites&mdash;she married a Penrhyn native!
- good-looking and attractive, but three-quarters savage, and left the
- island with him.
- </p>
- <p>
- Several children were born to the pair, but they were given to the
- husband&rsquo;s people. At last he took a native partner, and deserted his
- English wife. She left the islands, and went down to Auckland; but her
- story had travelled before her, and Auckland society closed its doors. To
- Tahiti, where morals are easy, and no one frowns upon the union, temporary
- or permanent, of the white man and the brown woman, she went, hoping to be
- received as in former days. But even Papeete, &ldquo;the sink of the Pacific,&rdquo;
- would have none of the white woman who had married a brown man. Northwards
- once more, to lonely Penrhyn, the broken-hearted woman went, wishing only
- to die, far from the eyes of her own world that had driven her out. A
- schooner captain, who called there now and then, cast eyes upon her&mdash;for
- she was still young and retained much of her beauty&mdash;and asked her,
- at last, if she would become his wife, and so redeem in some degree her
- position; but she had neither heart nor wish to live longer, so she sent
- the kindly sailor away, and soon afterwards closed her eyes for ever on
- the blue Pacific and the burning sands, the brown lover who had betrayed
- her, and the white lover who came too late. The traders buried her, and
- kindly left her grave without a name; only the initials of that which she
- had borne in her first marriage, and the date of her death. So, quiet and
- forgotten at last, lies in lonely Penrhyn the woman who sinned against her
- race and found no forgiveness.
- </p>
- <p>
- It was a relief to leave Penrhyn, with all its gloomy associations, and
- see the schooner&rsquo;s head set for the open sea and merry Manahiki. But we
- seemed to have brought ill-luck away with us, for there was what the
- captain called &ldquo;mean weather&rdquo; before we came within hail of land again,
- and the <i>Duchess</i> got some more knocking about.
- </p>
- <p>
- It was on account of this that Neo, our native bo&rsquo;sun, hit an innocent
- A.B. over the head with a belaying-pin one afternoon, and offered to
- perform the same service for any of the rest of the crew who might require
- it. The men had been singing mission hymns as they ran about the deck
- pulling and hauling&mdash;not exactly out of sheer piety, but because some
- of the hymns, with good rousing choruses, made excellent chanties. They
- were hauling to the tune of &ldquo;Pull for the shore, brothers!&rdquo; when a squall
- hit the ship, and out of the fifteen agitated minutes that followed, the
- <i>Duchess emerged minus her jib-boom</i>. When things had quieted down,
- Neo started to work with the belaying-, pin, until he was stopped, when he
- offered, as a sufficient explanation, the following:
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Those men, they sing something made bad luck, I think, jib-boom he break.
- Suppose they sing, &lsquo;Pull for &lsquo;em shore&rsquo; some other time, I break their
- head, that I telling them!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- The next time a chanty was wanted, &ldquo;Hold the Fort!&rdquo; took the place of the
- obnoxious tune, and Neo&rsquo;s lessons were not called for.
- </p>
- <p>
- And so, in a day or two we came to Rakahanga and Manahiki (Reirson and
- Humphrey Islands), and stopped there for another day or two, before we
- spread our wings like the swallows, to fleet southward again.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0035" id="linkimage-0035"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0351.jpg" alt="0351 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0351.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- It was certainly globe-trotting, not proper travelling. To flit from group
- to group, taking in cargo, and then hurrying off again, is the way not to
- understand the places one sees, and I was more than half inclined to leave
- the <i>Duchess</i> here, and stop over for a month or two on the chance of
- another schooner turning up. But the dinner that the solitary trader ate
- when he came on board made me change my mind. He looked like a man
- half-famished, and he certainly acted like one. There was hardly a thing
- on the island to eat at present, he said; the natives had only enough fish
- for themselves, and the turtle weren&rsquo;t coming and his stores were almost
- out, and he had been living on biscuit and cocoanuts for weeks. There was
- leprosy in both islands, and one did not dare to touch native pork or
- fowl. On the whole, I thought I would be contented to &ldquo;globe-trot,&rdquo; on
- this occasion, and see what I could in a day or two.
- </p>
- <p>
- The islands are about twenty-five miles apart, and very much like one
- another. They each own an area of about two square miles, and a population
- of some four hundred natives. And there is nothing in the whole Pacific
- prettier.
- </p>
- <p>
- Coming up to Manahiki, one sees first of all a snowy shore and a belt of
- green tossing palms, just like any other island. As the ship coasts along,
- however, making for the village, the palm-trees break and open out here
- and there, and through the break one sees&mdash;paradise! There is a great
- sheet of turquoise-green water inside, and on the water an archipelago of
- the most exquisite little plumy, palmy islets, each ringed round with its
- own pearly girdle of coral sand. Every gap in the trees frames in a
- picture more lovely than the last&mdash;and, as we approach the village,
- the dainty little brown island canoes that all the Pacific wanderers know
- so well, begin to dot the jewel-bright surface of the inner lake, and
- gleams of white and rose and scarlet dresses, worn by the rowers of the
- tiny craft, sparkle on the water like gems. At last the vessel comes to
- anchor before a wide white, sloping beach, with brown-roofed huts
- clustering behind, and we reached merry Manahiki.
- </p>
- <p>
- The island has long enjoyed a reputation for peculiar innocence and
- simplicity, coupled with piety of a marked description. Well, one does not
- care to destroy any one&rsquo;s illusions, so the less said about Manahiki&rsquo;s
- innocence and simplicity the better. The islanders are, at all events, a
- kindly and a cheerful people, and their home is the neatest and best kept
- island in the Pacific. A palm-bordered road of finest white sand,
- beautifully kept, and four miles long, runs without a bend or break from
- one end of the island to the other&mdash;this portion of the atoll forming
- a separate island, and containing most of the scanty population. The
- village stands about midway&mdash;a collection of quaint little houses
- deeply thatched with plaited pan-danus leaf, and walled with small,
- straight saplings set side by side and admitting a good deal of light and
- air. The houses are unwindowed as a rule. Rakahanga, the sister island, is
- extremely like Manahiki in formation and architecture. It, however, enjoys
- the additional advantage of a jail, which is built of crossed saplings,
- looks much like a huge bird-cage, and certainly could not confine any one
- who made the smallest attempt to get out. But, as criminals are unknown in
- these islands, and petty offences are visited by fine instead of
- imprisonment, the jail is not expected to do real service, being merely a
- bit of &ldquo;swagger,&rdquo; like the white-washed stone houses possessed by one or
- two wealthy natives, who, Pacific fashion, never think of living in them.
- </p>
- <p>
- Within, the ordinary houses are extremely simple. The floor of white coral
- gravel reflects and intensifies the soft diffused light that enters
- through the walls. There may be a native bedstead, laced across with,
- &ldquo;sinnet&rdquo;&mdash;plaited cocoanut fibre&mdash;and provided with a gay
- patchwork quilt, and a few large soft mats of pandanus leaf, ingeniously
- split, dried, and plaited. There will certainly be a pile of camphor-wood
- trunks, containing the clothes of the household; a dozen or so cocoanut
- shells, for drinking and eating purposes; a few sheath-knives, and a small
- quantity of much-cherished crockery. In a corner, you may find a heap of
- flying-fish ready cleaned for baking in the oven-pit outside, and a number
- of green, unhusked cocoanuts, for drinking. You may possibly see some
- ship&rsquo;s biscuits, too, bought from the one white resident of the island, a
- trader and there will also be some lumps of white, soft pith, shaped like
- large buns&mdash;the &ldquo;sponge&rdquo; or kernel of the old cocoanut, which grows
- and fills up the shell after the water has dried away, and the nut
- commenced to sprout. But there will be no bananas, no oranges, no mangoes,
- granadillas, pineapples, yam, taro or ti root, bread-fruit or maupei
- chestnuts, as in the fertile volcanic islands. Manahiki is a coral island,
- pure and simple, and has no soil at all, nothing but sand and white
- gravel, out of which the cocoa-palm and a few small timber trees spring,
- in a manner that seems almost miraculous to those accustomed to the rich,
- fertile soil of Raratonga or Tahiti. Cocoanut and fish are the food of the
- Manahikian, varied by an occasional gorge of turtle-meat, and a feast of
- pig and fowl on very great occasions. There is, therefore, not much work
- to do in the island, and there are few distractions from the outside
- world, since trading schooners only call two or three times a year at
- best. Some copra-drying is done and a few toy canoes, baskets, and other
- curiosities are made, to find a precarious sale when a schooner comes in
- and the captain is inclined to speculate.
- </p>
- <p>
- But time never hangs heavy on the Manahikian&rsquo;s hands. He is the most
- accomplished dancer and singer in the whole South Pacific, and the island
- is inordinately vain of this distinction. All South Sea islanders sing
- constantly, but in Manahiki, the tunes are much sweeter and more definite
- than in most other islands; and the impromptu variations of the &ldquo;seconds&rdquo;
- are really wonderful. The voices, too, are exceptionally good. The women&rsquo;s
- are rather hard and piercing, but those of the men are often magnificent.
- The time is as perfect as if beaten out by a metronome, and false notes
- are almost unknown.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0036" id="linkimage-0036"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0359.jpg" alt="0359 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0359.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Men and women alike seem incapable of fatigue when singing. The mere white
- man will feel tired and husky after going through the choruses of <i>The
- Messiah</i> or <i>The Creation</i>. A Manahikian, if he were acquainted
- with oratorio music, would run through both, and then &ldquo;take on&rdquo; <i>Tannhauser</i>,
- following up with another Wagnerian opera, and perhaps a cantata thrown
- in. By this time, it would be dusk, and the chorus would probably stop to
- eat a cartload of cocoanuts before beginning on the whole <i>Nibelungen
- Ring</i> cycle for the night. About midnight the Resident Agent, a clever
- half-caste, who has European ideas about the value of sleep, would
- probably send out the village policeman with a stick to induce the singers
- to go to bed; and, quite unfatigued, they would rise up from their
- cross-legged squatting posture on the ground, and go, remonstrant, but
- compelled.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0037" id="linkimage-0037"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0360.jpg" alt="0360 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0360.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Happily for the Resident Agent and the trader, however, European music is
- not known in Manahiki, and when a singing fit seizes the people, they can
- generally be stopped after about a day, unless somebody has composed
- something very new and very screaming. If the two ends of the village have
- begun one of their musical competitions, there may also be difficulty in
- bringing it to a period; for the rival choruses will sing against each
- other with cracking throats and swelling veins, hour after hour, till both
- sides are completely exhausted.
- </p>
- <p>
- Dancing, however, is the Manahikian&rsquo;s chief reason for existing. The
- Manahikian dances are infinitely superior to those of most other islands,
- which consist almost altogether of a wriggle belonging to the <i>danse du
- ventre</i> family, and a little waving of the arms. The Manahiki dance has
- the wriggle for its groundwork, but there are many steps and variations.
- Some of the steps are so rapid that the eye can hardly follow them, and a
- camera shutter which works up to 1/100 of a second does not give a sharp
- result. The men are ranged in a long row, with the women opposite; there
- is a good deal of wheeling and turning about in brisk military style,
- advancing, retreating, and spinning round. The men dance very much on the
- extreme tips of their toes (they are, of course, barefooted) and keep up
- this painful posture for an extraordinary length of time. Every muscle in
- the whole body seems to be worked in the &ldquo;fancy&rdquo; steps; and there is a
- remarkable effect of general dislocation, due to turning the knees and
- elbows violently out and in.
- </p>
- <p>
- The women, like Miss Mercy Pecksniff, seem chiefly to favour the &ldquo;shape
- and skip&rdquo; style of locomotion. There is a good deal of both these, a great
- deal of wriggle, and plenty of arm action, about their dancing. They
- manoeuvre their long, loose robes about, not at all ungracefully, and do
- some neat step-dancing, rather inferior, however, to that of the men.
- </p>
- <p>
- Both men and women dress specially for the dance, so the festival that was
- organised to greet our arrivals took some time to get up, as all the beaux
- and belles of the village had to hurry home and dress. The women put on
- fresh cotton loose gowns, of brilliant pink, purple, yellow, white and
- green, oiled their hair with cocoanut oil scented with the fragrant white
- tieré flower, and hung long chains of red and yellow berries about their
- necks. About their waists they tied the dancing girdle, never worn except
- on these occasions, and made of twisted green ferns. The men took off
- their cool, easy everyday costume, of a short cotton kilt and gay coloured
- singlet, and attired themselves in shirts and heavy stuff trousers (bought
- from the trader at enormous expense, and considered the acme of
- smartness). Both sexes crowned themselves with the curious dancing
- headdress, which looks exactly like the long-rayed halo of a saint, and is
- made by splitting a palm frond down the middle, and fastening it in a
- half-circle about the back of the head.
- </p>
- <p>
- The music then struck up and the dancers began to assemble. The band
- consisted of two youths, one of whom clicked a couple of sticks together,
- while the other beat a drum. This does not sound attractive; but as a
- matter of fact, the Manahiki castanet and drum music is curiously weird
- and thrilling, and arouses a desire for dancing even in the prosaic
- European. On board our schooner, lying half a mile from shore, the sound
- of the measured click and throb used to set every foot beating time on
- deck, while the native crew frankly dropped whatever they were at, and
- began to caper wildly. Close at hand, the music is even more impressive;
- no swinging waltz thundered out by a whole Hungarian band gets &ldquo;into the
- feet&rdquo; more effectively than the Manahiki drum.
- </p>
- <p>
- A much-cherished possession is this drum. It is carved and ornamented with
- sinnet, and topped with a piece of bladder; it seems to have been hollowed
- out of a big log, with considerable labour. The skill of the drummers is
- really remarkable. No drumsticks are used, only fingers, yet the sound
- carries for miles. While drumming, the hands rise and fall so fast as to
- lose all outline to the eye; the drummer nods and beats with his foot in
- an ecstasy of delight at his own performance; the air is full of the
- throbbing, rhythmical, intensely savage notes. The dancers at first
- hesitate, begin and stop, and begin again, laugh and retreat and come
- forward undecidedly. By-and-by the dancing fervour seizes one or two; they
- commence to twirl and to stamp wildly, winnowing the air with their arms.
- Others join in, the two rows are completed, and Manahiki is fairly started
- for the day. Hour after hour they dance, streaming with perspiration in
- the burning sun, laughing and singing and skipping. The green fern girdles
- wither into shreds of crackling brown, the palm haloes droop, the berry
- necklaces break and scatter, but on they go. The children join in the
- dance now and then, but their small frames weary soon; the parents are
- indefatigable.
- </p>
- <p>
- Perhaps both ends of the settlement are dancing; if that is so, the
- competitive element is sure to come in sooner or later, for the feeling
- between the two is very like that between the collegers and oppidans at
- Eton, each despising the other heartily, and ready on all occasions to
- find a cause for a fight. They will dance against each other now, striving
- with every muscle to twinkle the feet quicker, stand higher on the tips of
- the toes, wriggle more snakily, than their rivals. Evening comes, and they
- are still dancing. With the night, the dance degenerates into something
- very like an orgy, and before dawn, to avoid scandal, a powerful hint from
- the native pastor and the agent causes the ball to break up.
- </p>
- <p>
- Do the dancers go to bed now, lie down on their piled up sleeping mats,
- and compose themselves to slumber? By no means. Most of them get torches,
- and go out on the reef in the dark to spear fish. Cooking fires are
- lighted, and there is a hurried gorge in the houses; everywhere, in the
- breaking dawn, one hears the chuck-chuck of the husking-stick preparing
- cocoanuts, and smells the savoury odour of cooking fish. The dancers have
- not eaten for at least twenty-four hours, perhaps more. But this feast
- does not last long, for just as the sun begins to shoot long scarlet rays
- up through the palm trees, some one begins to beat the drum again.
- Immediately the whole village pours out into the open, and the dance is
- all on again, as energetic as ever. The trading schooner is three weeks
- over-due, and the copra on which the island income depends is not half
- dried; there is not a fancy basket or a pandanus hat ready for the trader;
- the washing of every house is hopelessly behind, and nobody has had a
- decent meal since the day before yesterday. No matter: the Manahikians are
- dancing, and it would take an earthquake to stop them.
- </p>
- <p>
- Late in the second day, they will probably give out and take a night&rsquo;s
- rest. But it is about even chances that they begin again the next morning.
- In any case, no day passes in Manahiki or Rakahanga without a dance in the
- evening. Regularly at sunset the drum begins to beat, the fern girdles are
- tied on (relics, these, of heathen days when girdles of grass or fern were
- all that the dancers wore), and palm haloes are twisted about the glossy
- black hair, and the island gives itself up to enjoyment for the evening.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is a dancing-master in Manahiki, a most important potentate, who
- does nothing whatever but invent new dances, and teach the youth of the
- village both the old dances and the new.
- </p>
- <p>
- We stopped overnight at the island, so I had time for a good walk along
- the beautiful coral avenue, which is indeed one of the loveliest things in
- the island world. It was Sunday, and all the natives were worshipping in
- the exceedingly ugly and stuffy concrete church, under the guidance of the
- native pastor, so I had the place almost to myself. Far away from
- everywhere, sitting in a ruinous little hut under the trees by the inner
- lagoon, I found a lonely old man, crippled and unable to walk. He was
- waiting until the others came back from church, staring solemnly into the
- lagoon the while, and playing with a heap of cocoanut shells. By-and-by he
- would probably rouse up, drag himself into the hut, and busy himself
- getting ready the dinner for the family against their return home, for he
- was an industrious old man, and liked to make himself useful so far as he
- could, and his relatives were very glad of what small services he could
- render in washing and cooking.
- </p>
- <p>
- What was the matter with the poor old man? He was a leper!
- </p>
- <p>
- That is the way of the islands, and no white rule can altogether put a
- stop to it. The half-caste who acts as agent for the Government of New
- Zealand had hunted out a very bad case of leprosy a year or two before,
- and insisted on quarantining it in a lonely part of the bush. This was all
- very well, but the leper had a pet cock, which he wanted to take with him,
- and the agent&rsquo;s heart was not hard enough to refuse. Now the leper, being
- fed without working, and having nothing to do, found the time hanging
- heavy on his hands, so he taught the cock to dance&mdash;report says, to
- dance the real Manahiki dances&mdash;and the fame of the wondrous bird
- spread all over the island, and as far as Rakahanga, so that the natives
- made continual parties to see the creature perform, and quarantine became
- a dead letter. Still the agent had not the heart to take the cock away,
- but when he saw the leper&rsquo;s end was near, he watched, and as soon as he
- heard the man was dead, he hurried to the quarantined hut, set it on fire,
- and immediately slaughtered the cock. An hour later, half the island was
- out at the hut, looking for the bird&mdash;but they came too late.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <p>
- We have been two days at merry Manahiki, and the cargo is in, and the
- Captain has ordered the <i>Duchess</i>&mdash;looking shockingly cock-nosed
- without her great jib-boom&mdash;to be put under sail again. As the booms
- begin to rattle, and the sails to rise against the splendid rose and
- daffodil of the Pacific sunset, Shalli, our Cingalese steward, leans sadly
- over the rail, listening to the thrilling beat of the drum that is just
- beginning to throb across the still waters of the lagoon, now that evening
- and its merrymaking are coming on once more.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;He plenty good place, that,&rdquo; says Shalli mournfully. &ldquo;All the time
- dancing, singing, eating, no working&mdash;he all same place as heaven. O
- my God, I plenty wish I stopping there, I no wanting any heaven then!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- With this pious aspiration in our ears, we spread our white wings once
- more&mdash;for the last time. Raratonga lies before us now, and from
- Raratonga the steamers go, and the mails and tourists come, and the doors
- of the great world open for us again. So, good-bye to the life of the
- schooner.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0013" id="link2HCH0013"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER XIII
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>The Last of the Island Kingdoms&mdash;Fashions in Nukualofa&mdash;The
- King who was shy&mdash;His Majesty&rsquo;s Love Story&mdash;Who got the
- Wedding-Cake?&mdash;The Chancellor goes to Jail&mdash;Bungalow
- Housekeeping&mdash;The Wood of the Sacred Bats&mdash;By the Tombs of the
- Tui-Tongas&mdash;A &ldquo;Chief&rdquo; Kava-party&mdash;The Waits!&mdash;Mariner&rsquo;s
- Cave&mdash;The Cave of the Swallows&mdash;To Samoa.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">S</span>OME weeks
- afterwards, after a round of three thousand miles, I found myself in
- Tonga, better known as the Friendly Islands. The distance from the Cook
- Group was only one thousand or less, as the crow flies, but the steamers
- flew down to Auckland, and then back again, which naturally added to the
- journey. Pacific travel is a series of compromises. The British Resident
- of Niué, which is only three hundred miles from Tonga, wanted to get to
- the latter place about that time, and when I met him at Nukualofa, the
- Tongan capital, he had had to travel two thousand four hundred miles to
- reach it! But no one is ever in a hurry, under the shade of the cocoanut
- tree.
- </p>
- <p>
- Who has heard of Tongatabu? who knows where the &ldquo;Friendly Islands&rdquo; are?
- You will not find them very readily in the map, but they are to be found
- nevertheless, about one thousand miles to the north-east of New Zealand.
- And if you take the steamer that runs every month from Auckland to Sydney,
- touching at the &ldquo;Friendly&rdquo; or Tongan Group, on the way, you will find
- yourself, in four days, set down on the wharf of Nukualofa, the capital of
- the island of Tongatabu, and the seat of the oddest, most comic-opera-like
- monarchy that the world ever knew.
- </p>
- <p>
- Thirty years ago&mdash;even twenty&mdash;the Great South Seas were
- scattered over with independent island states, ruled by monarchs who
- displayed every degree of civilisation, from the bloodthirsty monster,
- Thakomban of Fiji and Jibberik, the half-crazy tyrant of Majuro, up to
- such Elizabeths of the Pacific as Liluokalani of Hawaii, and Queen Pomaré
- of Tahiti. Now there is but one island kingdom left; but one native
- sovereign, who still sits on his throne unembarrassed by the presence of a
- British Resident, who is ruler in all but name. Hawaii has fallen to
- America; France has taken the Marquesas and Tahiti; England has annexed
- the Cook Islands and dethroned the famous Queen Makea; Germany and America
- have partitioned Samoa between them; the rich archipelago of Fiji has been
- added to the British Colonies. This accounts for almost all of the larger
- and richer island groups, distinguished by a certain amount of original
- civilisation, and leaves only one unseized&mdash;Tonga, or the Friendly
- Islands, over which England has maintained a protectorate since 1900.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Tongan Archipelago was discovered by Captain Cook in 1777, and by him
- named the &ldquo;Friendly Islands,&rdquo; on account of the apparently friendly
- disposition of the natives. He sailed away from the group unaware that
- beneath their seemingly genial reception, the Tongans had been maturing a
- plot to murder him and seize his ship. Treachery, it is true, has never
- been an essential part of the Tongan character; but they are, and always
- have been, the most warlike of all Pacific races, and it is probable that
- they thought the character of the deed excused by the necessities of a
- military race who feared injury from a superior power.
- </p>
- <p>
- After Cook&rsquo;s visit the world heard very little of Tonga until 1816, when
- Mariner&rsquo;s &ldquo;Tonga Islands,&rdquo; the history of a young sailor&rsquo;s captivity among
- the natives of the group, fairly took the reading world by storm. It is
- still a classic among works of travel and adventure. Since the islands
- were converted to Christianity their history has been uneventful. One king&mdash;George
- Tubou I.&mdash;reigned for seventy years, and only died at last, aged
- ninety-seven, of a chill contracted from his invariable custom of bathing
- in the sea at dawn! His great-grandson, George Tubou II. succeeded,
- inheriting through his mother&rsquo;s side, as the Tongan succession follows the
- matriarchal plan. It is this king&mdash;aged thirty-four, six feet four in
- height, and about twenty-seven stone weight&mdash;who now sits upon the
- last throne of the Island Kings, and rules over the only independent state
- left in the Pacific.
- </p>
- <p>
- When Britain, assumed a Protectorate over Tonga in 1900, it was done
- simply to prevent any other nation annexing the rich and fertile group,
- with its splendid harbour of Vavau which lay so dangerously near Fiji. The
- Germans, who had maintained a kind of half-and-half Protectorate for some
- time, ceded their rights in exchange for those possessed by England in
- Samoa, and Tonga then became safe from the incursions of any foreign
- nation whose interests, trading and territorial, might be hostile to those
- of Britain.
- </p>
- <p>
- Perhaps as a consequence of all those negotiations, the Tongans have a
- high opinion of their own importance. When the war between China and Japan
- broke out, Tonga politely sent word to Great Britain that she intended to
- remain neutral, and not take any part in the affair. Great Britain&rsquo;s
- reply, I regret to say, is not recorded.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Tongans are a Christianised and partially civilised, if a coloured,
- race, numbering about 20,000. They are of a warm brown in hue, with dense
- black, wiry hair (usually dyed golden red with lime juice), tall,
- well-made frames, and immense muscular development. As a nation, they are
- handsome, with intelligent faces, and a dignity of pose and movement that
- is sometimes unkindly called the &ldquo;Tongan swagger.&rdquo; In education, many of
- them would compare favourably with the average white man, so far as mere
- attainments go; although a course of instruction at the local schools and
- colleges, amounting to very nearly the standard of an English
- &ldquo;matriculations,&rdquo; does not prevent its recipient from believing firmly in
- the holiness of the sacred Tongan bats, feeding himself with his fingers,
- and walking about his native village naked as Adam, save for a cotton
- kilt. There is not only a King in Tonga, but a real palace, guards of
- honour, a Parliament, a Prime Minister, a Chancellor of the Exchequer, and
- a large number of public officials. All these are Tongan natives. The
- king&rsquo;s guards are apt to make an especially vivid impression upon the
- newcomer, as he walks up the wharf, and sees the scarlet-coated sentry
- pacing up and down opposite the guard-room, with his fellows, also smartly
- uniformed, lounging inside. If the stranger, however, could have witnessed
- the scene on the wharf as soon as the steamer was signalled&mdash;-the
- sudden running up of a dozen or two of guards who had been amusing
- themselves about the town in undress uniform (navy-blue kilt, red sash,
- buff singlet), the scrambling and dressing <i>coram publico</i> on the
- grass, getting into trousers, boots, shirt, tunic, forage cap, and the
- hurried scuffle to get ready in time, and make a fine appearance to the
- steamer folk&mdash;he might think rather less of Tonga&rsquo;s military
- discipline. Beyond the wharf lies the town, straggling over a good mile of
- space, and consisting of a few main streets and one or two side alleys,
- bordered by pretty verandahed, flowery houses. The pavement is the same
- throughout&mdash;green grass, kept short by the constant passing of bare
- feet. There are a good many trading stores, filled with wares suited to
- native tastes&mdash;gaudy prints, strong perfumes, cutlery, crockery,
- Brummagem jewellery. The streets are busy to-day&mdash;busy for Nukualofa,
- that is. Every now and then a native passes, flying by on a galloping,
- barebacked horse, or striding along the grass with the inimitable Tongan
- strut; for it is steamer day, and the monthly Union steamer boat is the
- theatre, the newspaper, the society entertainment; the luxury-provider of
- all the archipelago. On the other twenty-nine or thirty days of the month,
- you may stand in the middle of a main street for half an hour at a time,
- and not see a single passer-by, but steamer day galvanises the whole
- island into life.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0038" id="linkimage-0038"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0376.jpg" alt="0376 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0376.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- The sand of the beach beside the wharf is as white as snow; it is
- pulverised coral from the reef, nothing else. Great fluted clam-shells, a
- foot long and more, lie about the strand, among the trailing pink-flowered
- convolvulus vines that wreathe the shore of every South Sea island.
- Unkempt pandanus trees, mounted on quaint high wooden stilts, overhang the
- green water; among the taller and more graceful cocoa-palms, Norfolk
- Island pines, odd, formal, and suggestive of hairbrushes, stand among
- feathery ironwoods and spreading-avavas about the palace of the king.
- Quite close to the wharf this latter is placed&mdash;a handsome
- two-storeyed building, with wide verandahs and a tower. Scarlet-coated
- sentries march up and down all day at its gates; it is surrounded by a
- wall, and carefully guarded from intruders. George Tubou II. is among the
- shyest of monarchs and hates nothing so much as being stared at; so on
- steamer days there is little sign of life to be seen about the palace.
- </p>
- <p>
- I happened to arrive in Tonga at an interesting historical crisis, and was
- promised an audience with the retiring monarch.
- </p>
- <p>
- After a week or two, however, the promise was suddenly recalled, and the
- visitor informed that the king declined to see her, then or at any other
- time. A little investigation revealed the cause. The High Commissioner of
- the Western Pacific had recently come over from Fiji; to remonstrate with
- the Tongan monarchy concerning certain unconstitutional behaviour, and a
- British man-of-war had accompanied him. I, being the only other person on
- the island from &ldquo;Home,&rdquo; had naturally been seeing a good deal of the
- formidable stranger. This was enough for the king. There was a plot to
- deprive him of his throne, he was certain; and it was obvious that I was
- in it, whatever I might choose to say to the contrary. There was no
- knowing what crime I might not be capable of, once admitted to the Royal
- Palace. George Tubou II. is six feet four, and twenty-seven stone weight,
- but he is distinctly of a nervous temperament; and his fears of Guy
- Fawkesism kept possession of his mind during the whole of my stay; so that
- the carefully averted face of a fat, copper-coloured sort of Joe Sedley,
- driving very fast in a buggy, was all I saw of Tonga&rsquo;s king.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is no one, surely, in the world who quite comes up to George of
- Tonga for a &ldquo;guid conceit o&rsquo; himsel&rsquo;.&rdquo; When he wished to provide himself
- with a queen, some six or seven years ago, he first applied to the Emperor
- of Germany, to know if there was a German Princess of marriageable age
- whom he could have! The Kaiser politely replied in the negative. King
- George then sent proposals to a princess of Hawaii who was as well
- educated as any white lady, and used to diplomatic society in Washington.
- This also failing, he turned his attentions to his own country; and then
- began the most extraordinary love-story ever told under the Southern Cross&mdash;a
- story that could have happened nowhere on the globe, except in the
- comic-opera country of Tonga.
- </p>
- <p>
- There were two eligible princesses of the royal line of Tonga&mdash;Princess
- Ofa and Princess Lavinia. The king appears to have proposed to them both,
- and then found himself unable to decide between the two. They were both of
- high rank, both good-looking after the portly Tongan fashion, and both
- very willing to be queen, reign over the fine palace, order lots of silk
- dresses from Auckland, wear the queen&rsquo;s crown of Tonga (supposed to be
- gold, but rather inclined to suspicious outbreaks of verdigris), and see
- the natives get off their horses and kneel on the ground, when the royal
- state carriage drove by.
- </p>
- <p>
- But the king kept both princesses in the agonies of suspense ever present,
- and hope constantly deferred for months&mdash;until the wedding-day was
- fixed, the wedding-cake (ordered three years before from a New Zealand
- confectioner, for the German Princess who was not to be had) patched up
- and fresh coloured, the wedding-dress provided, at the expense of the
- Government of Tonga (according to custom) and actually made! Not till the
- very night before the wedding did his dilatory Majesty at last declare his
- intentions, and fix upon the princess he had last proposed to, whom nobody
- expected him to take&mdash;Lavinia. It is a sober fact that the wedding
- invitation cards, sent out at the last minute, were printed with a blank
- for the bride&rsquo;s name, which was added with a pen! Lavinia, overjoyed at
- her good luck, got into the Governmentally provided wedding dress next
- day, and (as the fairy tales say) &ldquo;the wedding was celebrated with great
- pomp!&rdquo; There is no sense of humour in Tonga. If there had been, the king
- could hardly have selected the means of consolation for Ofa&rsquo;s
- disappointment that he actually did choose, in sending her the bottom half
- of his wedding cake, as soon as the ceremony was over. Princess Ofa was
- not proud; she had been beating her head on the floor-mats all morning and
- pulling out handfuls of her long black hair, but when the consolatory cake
- arrived, she accepted it promptly and ate it.
- </p>
- <p>
- There are generally illuminations on the night of a royal wedding. Tonga
- was not behind-hand in this matter, but the illuminations were of rather
- an unusual kind, being nothing less than numbers of burning native houses,
- set on fire by the indignant friends of the jilted Princess Ofa. The
- friends of the new queen retaliated in kind; and for nearly a week, arson
- became the recognised sport of the island. This excess of party feeling
- soon died down, however, and the newly married couple were left to
- honeymoon in peace.
- </p>
- <p>
- An infant princess was born in due time, and not very long after, Queen
- Lavinia died. Here was Princess Ofa&rsquo;s chance, if Fate had permitted; but
- Ofa herself was dead, leaving no eligible princess to console the widowed
- king.
- </p>
- <p>
- For more than five years the monarch (who is still only thirty-four) has
- lived alone, a mark for every husband-hunting princess in the Pacific. A
- princess related to an ancient island monarchy, invited herself to stay in
- the palace one recent Christmas. King George received her pleasantly,
- entertained her for some weeks, and then sent her home with a big packet
- of fine tobacco and a barrel of spirits, to console her for the
- non-success of her visit&mdash;which may be accounted for by the fact that
- she is rather older than the king himself, and by no means so lovely as
- she was. A favoured candidate is a certain princess of the royal family of
- Tahiti. She has been described to the king as handsome, and at least
- sixteen stone weight, both of which claims are quite correct. King George
- really wants a European princess, but as soon as he has been convinced for
- the second time that this is impossible, it is hoped that he will decide
- on the Tahitian princess, and elevate her to the Tongan throne, since he
- admires fat women exceedingly.
- </p>
- <p>
- One of the most remarkable things in this remarkable country is the
- Parliament. It would take too long to record the history of this
- assembly&rsquo;s birth and development; but the chapter has been a notable one
- in Tongan history. The Parliament usually consists of the King and Prime
- Minister, the Chancellor of the Exchequer, the Chief Justice, and a score
- or two of important chiefs, some of whom inherit by birth, while others
- are returned by their native villages. At the time of my visit, there were
- a couple of vacancies in this remarkable assembly, since the High
- Commissioner of the Western Pacific (Governor of Fiji) had just deported
- the Prime Minister and the Chancellor of the Exchequer to Fiji, on account
- of certain proceedings which resulted in emptying Tonga&rsquo;s public treasury
- and leaving nothing to show for it.
- </p>
- <p>
- Their absence did not greatly matter, however, as it is a rule of the
- Tongan Constitution, that Parliament shall not meet oftener than once in
- three years. An excellent and practical reason lies at the root of this
- seemingly peculiar law. Tongatabu is a small island, only twenty miles
- long; and when the Members of Parliament,&mdash;dressed in new cotton
- kilts, with smart large floor-mats tied round their waists with sinnet
- (cocoanut fibre plait), and violet, sea-green, or lemon silk shirts on
- their brown backs&mdash;arrive from the outer villages and islands in
- Nukualofa with all their relatives, for the beginning of the session,
- something very like a famine sets in. The whole Parliament, also its
- sisters, aunts, and grandpapas, has to be fed at public expense, while it
- stays in the capital arranging the affairs of the nation; and as the
- length of its sitting is always regulated by the amount of provisions
- available, and never ends until the last yam, the last skinny chicken, the
- last sack of pineapples, is eaten up, it is easy to understand why the
- capital does not care to undergo such a strain any oftener than it can
- help.
- </p>
- <p>
- A new Prime Minister and Chancellor of the Exchequer were appointed before
- long, and it was made a condition of the latter office, that the
- Chancellor should understand a reasonable amount of arithmetic. There was
- also a rigid rule made about the keeping of the key of the Government safe
- in some suitable place. A good deal of trouble was caused by the last
- Chancellor&rsquo;s losing it, one day when he was out fishing on the coral reef!
- There was a duplicate, but the Chancellor had carefully locked it up in
- the safe, to make sure it should not be lost! The poor old gentleman
- nearly get sunstroke hunting about the coral reef for the key until he
- found it. If it had been carried, away by the tides, the safe must have
- remained closed until an expert from Auckland could be brought up to open
- it. As the Chancellor of the Exchequer did not know how much he had in it,
- or how much he had spent in the last quarter, it can readily be understood
- that the public accounts acquired an entirely superfluous extra tangle or
- two during the absence of the lost key.
- </p>
- <p>
- Tonga enjoys one of the finest climates in the Pacific. The heat is never
- excessive, and the air is generally bright and invigorating. Fevers are
- unheard of, and the few white residents of the islands enjoy splendid
- health. As for the Tongans themselves, they dispute with the Fijians the
- palm of being physically the finest and strongest people in the whole
- Pacific; and no one has ever thought of challenging their claim to be the
- most intellectual of all the brown island races. Their carriage is superb,
- though only its extreme <i>aplomb</i> and ease save it from degenerating
- into an actual swagger. Their dress displays the most perfect taste in the
- South Seas. It consists, among the men, of a short tunic (&ldquo;vala&rdquo;) of fine
- cashmere or silk, occasionally of cotton, on working days&mdash;draped
- with all the grace of an antique statue, and worn with a wide sash, and a
- thin, close-fitting singlet or shirt. The Tongan woman generally wears a
- garment that is suggestive of the Greek <i>chiton</i>&mdash;a loose
- sleeveless dress reaching to a point midway between waist and knee.
- Underneath is seen a tunic similar to that of the men, but a little
- longer. The colours chosen by both sexes are exquisite. No artist could
- design more beautiful combinations than those I have often seen flitting
- about the grassy streets of Nukualofa, Tonga&rsquo;s capital. A finely made
- giant strides by, in a navy-blue vala, cream-coloured silk shirt, and
- vivid sea-green sash. Another wears a pale blue vala and shirt, and a sash
- of royal blue. A third is in white and lemon colour girdled with orange;
- another wears a white vala, a pale green shirt, and a sash of violet silk.
- A tall, self-possessed young woman, her hair dyed golden red with lime,
- and worn coiffed high above the forehead, with a fall of natural curls
- down her back, has a scarlet and yellow vala under her short brown silk
- gown, while her companion&mdash;smaller and merrier faced, with the
- melting black eyes of &ldquo;The Islands&rdquo;&mdash;wears and looks charming in, a
- pale-blue gown over a vala of daffodil yellow. These are the fashions of
- Tonga; and they offer a feast for artistic souls and pencils, that cannot
- be matched under the Southern Cross.
- </p>
- <p>
- Tonga is very seldom visited by travellers, except for an hour or two
- during the steamer&rsquo;s stay in port, and it is hardly ever seen by British
- tourists. I could not discover that any English lady had ever made a stay
- there, except myself, and the wife of a local Church dignitary. There are,
- of course, a few Colonial residents. But the English traveller leaves
- Tonga out altogether, which is really a pity&mdash;for his sake. As for
- the islands, they can do very well without tourists, and would not be the
- better for them.
- </p>
- <p>
- There was no hotel save a plain and simple public-house, at the time of my
- stay, though I understand this defect has been remedied. I had therefore
- to set up housekeeping on my own account. The tiny bungalow I took for my
- stay of four weeks in the island, was a real South Sea home. It stood
- almost on the white coral sand of the beach, and close to the cool green
- waters of the lagoon; it was shaded by palms and scarlet-blossomed
- &ldquo;flamboyant&rdquo; trees, and it was nearly all door and window and verandah.
- Its carpets were plaited pandanus-leaf mats; the ornaments in the
- sitting-room were foot-long fluted clam-shells off the beach, filled with
- wild red and yellow hibiscus flowers, poignantly perfumed frangipani
- stars, and the sweet pink blossoms of the South Sea oleander. The back
- kitchen had generally a bunch of bananas hanging from the roof, a pile of
- green cocoanuts for drinking, under the window, a mound of yellow papaws,
- or tree-melons, in a corner, some custard-apples and mangoes, and a big
- basket of pineapples, bought at the door for fourteen a shilling, or
- picked by myself during a drive through the bush.
- </p>
- <p>
- There was not much else, besides bread and tea. I almost lived on fruit,
- and could not help wondering what the inhabitants of temperate latitudes,
- who fear ill consequences from a dozen plums or a double handful of
- strawberries, would have thought of my uncounted mangoes, and bananas, and
- five or six pineapples a day. Only children, at home in England, really
- know how much fruit can safely be undertaken by the human digestive
- organs. Wise children! and foolish elders, who have forgotten so soon.
- </p>
- <p>
- The transparent waters of the lagoon outside, lapping idly under the
- leaves of overhanging palm and pandanus, were not so cool as they looked,
- under the hot midday sun; and if one did not want a tepid sea-bath, it was
- best to wait till night. Then, what a luxury it was, after the heat of the
- day (for Tonga, though cool for the tropics, is nevertheless tropical), to
- float about in the dim lagoon, under a glow of stars that fit up the sky
- almost as brightly as an English moon, the dark shining water bearing one
- to and fro with the swell from the reef, the land growing farther and
- farther away, the palms on the thin pale shoreline standing out small and
- black, like Indian ink sketches, against the lurid purple of the midnight
- sky! Willingly indeed one would have passed the whole night out there,
- swimming, and floating in a warm dark sea of stars&mdash;stars above and
- stars below&mdash;if nature had not given out after an hour or two, and
- demanded a return to the solid earth. Sharks? Well, they had &ldquo;hardly ever&rdquo;
- been seen inside the reef. Stingarees, with their immense ugly bodies
- buried in the sand at the bottom, and their cruel barbed tails ready to
- strike? Yes, they had been seen, but not often; and in tropic waters you
- learn to take the chances like every one else, and enjoy yourself without
- thinking of the &ldquo;might-be&rsquo;s.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0039" id="linkimage-0039"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0382.jpg" alt="0382 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0382.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- It was the hot season, but not too hot for riding or driving, and I spent
- many mornings exploring about the island. To the Wood of the Bats, about
- eleven miles from Nukualofa, one drives in a springy little colonial
- buggy, driving over mile after mile of rather uneven grass road, along
- avenues of blossoming orange trees, through groves of bananas and
- breadfruit and tall mango trees, past straggling native villages with neat
- little fancy-work houses made of woven reeds and thatch, until, in the
- distance, one begins to hear a loud screaming, squeaking, and chattering
- noise. This is the Wood of the Bats that we are coming to, and that is
- some of their usual conversation. Under the trees&mdash;there are over
- twenty of them, avavas, like great cedars, ironwoods, mangoes; all big
- forest trees, and all covered with bats as thick as a currant bush with
- currants&mdash;the squeaking and squealing grows almost deafening,
- Thousands of great flying-foxes, with dark furry bodies as big as cats,
- big spreading wings (now folded tightly up) and sharp, keen fox-like
- heads, hang upside down on every tree, waiting for the night to come, and
- whiling away the time by quarrelling and swearing. They are all bad, these
- bats; they axe ugly, dirty, vicious, destructive and greedy&mdash;yet they
- are strictly tabooed by the natives, and no one dares to kill a single
- one. It is believed that the prosperity of Tonga is inextricably
- associated with the bats, and that, if they ever deserted the wood, the
- country would fall. They are sacred, and must not be touched.
- </p>
- <p>
- Every evening, punctually at five o&rsquo;clock, the bats take wing, and rise
- from the trees like a screaming cloud of evil spirits. The sky is
- blackened with their bodies as they go, and scattered all over with the
- long streaming flights of separate bats that divide away from the main
- body. They are off to feed&mdash;to feed all night upon the bananas and
- pineapples and mangoes of the unhappy islanders, who lose thousands of
- pounds&rsquo; worth of fruit and trade every year, but dare not revenge
- themselves. Just at dawn, they will return, screaming and shoving rudely
- as they settle down in the trees once more, squabbling for upper berths,
- and trying to push into a nice comfortable place amidships of a particular
- bough, by biting the occupant&rsquo;s toes until he lets go. They may have flown
- forty or fifty miles in the night, visited islands more than twenty miles
- away, and devastated the plantations of Tonga from end to end. They have
- worked hard for their suppers, and now they will doze and squabble all
- day, once more, until evening.
- </p>
- <p>
- A few miles from the Wood of Bats, in the midst of exquisite scenery,
- stands a famous avava known as Captain Cook&rsquo;s Tree. It was under this tree
- that the great explorer called together all the natives, on his discovery
- of the islands in 1777, and addressed them by means of an interpreter. The
- account of this will be found in &ldquo;Cook&rsquo;s Voyages.&rdquo; The tree is still in
- splendid condition, in spite of its age, which must amount to many hundred
- years. Pigs were brought to Tonga by Cook in this same year, and a few of
- the original breed are still to be seen in the island&mdash;tall, gaunt,
- hump-backed creatures with immense heads and long noses, contrasting oddly
- with the smaller and fatter kinds introduced by later voyagers.
- </p>
- <p>
- The burial-place of the Tui Tongans made an object for another drive.
- Before the introduction of Christianity, in early Victorian days, the
- Tongans had two kings, an ordinary earthly king, who did all the hard work
- of governing, and a heavenly king, the Tui Tonga, who was supposed to be
- of divine descent, and was worshipped as a god. For many centuries, the
- Tui Tongas were buried in great oblong raised enclosures, three-terraced,
- and built of rough-hewn, closely fitted slabs from the coral reef. Two of
- these great tombs still remain, hidden in tangled thickets of low bush,
- and considerably worn by age. I had no means of measurement, but judged
- the larger one to be about fifty yards by thirty, the smaller somewhat
- less. The state of the coral slabs, and the great trees that have grown up
- rooted among them, suggest that the tombs are extremely old. Tradition
- among the natives takes them back beyond the recollection of any of their
- ancestors; they cannot say when or why they were built. The construction&mdash;a
- double terrace, each step about five feet high&mdash;and the carefully
- arranged oblong shape, seem to point to some special significance long
- since forgotten. There is also a &ldquo;trilithon&rdquo; erection of three large
- blocks of stone, some miles away, concerning which island traditions are
- silent. It could not have been constructed by hand labour alone; some
- mechanical device must have been employed to raise the centre stone to its
- present position. The ancient Tongans, however, knew nothing of mechanics,
- and an interesting problem is therefore set for antiquarians to solve. The
- height of the side supports is about twenty feet, and the centre
- cross-piece, which rests in a socket on each side, is a little less in
- length.
- </p>
- <p>
- The beautiful and interesting sea-caves&mdash;some swarming with birds,
- others celebrated for their lovely colouring and formation&mdash;which are
- found in the windward side of the island, I was unable to see, owing to
- the bad weather of the rainy season, during which my visit was made.
- </p>
- <p>
- A &ldquo;Chief&rdquo; kava-party, however, got up for my benefit, consoled me for the
- loss of the caves. Kava is the great national drink of Tonga, as of many
- other South Sea islands. It is made from the hard woody root of the Piper
- methysticum and is exhilarating and cooling, but not actually
- intoxicating. In taste, it is extremely unpleasant till one gets used to
- it, being peppery, soapy, and dish-watery as to flavour. I had drunk kava
- before, however, and learned to recognise its pleasanter properties; also,
- the old custom of chewing the kava-root, before infusing it, which still
- obtains in some parts of Samoa, has been quite given up in Tonga, and the
- pounding is done with stones.
- </p>
- <p>
- The scene was weird and strange in the last degree. I was the only white
- person present. We all squatted on the mats in the chief&rsquo;s house, the
- natives in their valas and loose short gowns, with white scented flowers
- in their hair; I in a smart demi-toilette evening dress, because I was the
- special guest, and the chief&rsquo;s family would expect me to honour them by
- &ldquo;dressing the part.&rdquo; The only light was a ship&rsquo;s hurricane lantern, placed
- on the floor, where it threw the most Rembrandtesque of shadows upon the
- silent circle of brown, glittering-eyed faces, and upon the rapt ecstatic
- countenances of the kava-makers, as they went through all the details of
- what was evidently an ancient religious ceremony, very savage, very
- native, and not at all &ldquo;missionary,&rdquo; despite the church membership of all
- the performers. There were loud sonorous chants and responses, elaborate
- gymnastics, with the great twist of hibiscus fibre that was used to strain
- the kava after it was pounded, and water poured on; something very like
- incantations, and finally, a wild religious ecstasy on the part of the
- kava-maker, who worked himself almost into a fit, and at last sank back
- utterly exhausted, with the bowl of prepared kava before him. This bowl
- was a standing vessel as big as a round sponge bath, carved, legs and all,
- from one block of a huge forest tree-trunk, and exquisitely polished and
- enamelled, by many years of kava-holding. Its value was beyond price.
- </p>
- <p>
- The calling of names now began&mdash;first the chief&rsquo;s, then mine, then
- the other guests. There is great ceremony observed at kava-drinkings, and
- an order of precedence as strict as that of a German Court. As my name was
- called, I clapped my hands once, took the cocoanut bowl from the girl who
- was serving it, and swallowed the contents at a draught. The next name was
- then called, and the next drinker drank as I did. It is very bad manners
- to act otherwise. The girl who served the kava walked round our squatting
- circle in a doubled-up posture that must surely have made her back ache;
- but custom forbade her to stand erect while serving.
- </p>
- <p>
- After the long ceremony was ended, the dignified white-haired chief held a
- conversation with me, by means of an interpreter; and told me that there
- were four ways of kava-drinking, each with its appropriate etiquette.
- </p>
- <p>
- That which I had seen was the most important and elaborate of the four,
- very seldom used, and only permitted to chiefs. We exchanged a good many
- stately compliments through the interpreter, and I then took my departure.
- </p>
- <p>
- It is near the end of my visit, and in a few more days, the steamer takes
- me on to Haapai and Vavau and beautiful, steamy-hot Samoa. But this is
- Christmas morning, and one can think of nothing else.
- </p>
- <p>
- Nothing? Well, those who know what it is to spend that day of days under a
- burning tropic sky, with palms and poinsettia for Christmas garlandry,
- instead of holly and mistletoe, know just what thoughts fly homewards
- across twelve thousand miles of sea, and how far they are concerned with
- the sunny, lonely Christmas of the present&mdash;how far with the dark and
- stormy Christmases of the past, when snow and winter reigned outside, but
- summer, more brilliant than all the splendours of southern world, was
- within, and in the heart. But it is of the Tongan Christmas day that I
- have to tell.
- </p>
- <p>
- I was awakened very early by&mdash;the waits! Whatever one expects under
- the Southern Cross, one certainly does not expect that, and yet there they
- were, a score of boys and youths playing merry tunes under my window, and
- pausing now and then to see if I was not awake to come out and give them
- their Christmas &ldquo;tip.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0040" id="linkimage-0040"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0388.jpg" alt="0388 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0388.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- I dressed hastily, and came on to the verandah. The music of the band,
- which had puzzled me a good deal, now turned out to be produced solely by
- mouth-organs, blown by a number of youths dressed exactly alike in black
- valas, white linen jackets, and white uniform caps. The soul of the Tongan
- loves a uniform above everything, and all the bands in the islands&mdash;of
- whom there are an astonishing number&mdash;wear specially made costumes of
- a rather military type.
- </p>
- <p>
- It was frightfully hot, for Christmas is midsummer here, and the day was
- exceptionally warm in any case.
- </p>
- <p>
- But the &ldquo;waits,&rdquo; standing out in the burning sun, did not seem to feel the
- heat at all. They blew lustily away at their mouth-organs, playing English
- dance music, Tongan songs, missionary hymns, in wonderful time and
- harmony, and with the inimitable Tongan verve and swing, poor though the
- instruments were. The performance was quite worth the gift they expected,
- I listened as long as they cared to play. Then they collected their dues,
- and went off to serenade a white trader, who, I strongly suspected, had
- been celebrating Christmas Eve after a fashion that would not tend to make
- him grateful for an early call.
- </p>
- <p>
- For me, Christmas had begun on the previous evening when I went to the
- midnight Mass at the church upon the shore, among the palms and the
- feathery ironwood trees. In the crystal-clear moonlight, what a brilliant
- scene it was! Even outside the church, the decorations could be seen for
- miles, since they consisted of thousands and thousands of
- half-cocoanut-shells, filled with cocoanut oil, and provided with a wick
- of twisted fibre, which when lit, burnt with a clear ray like a star,
- illuminating the walls of the churchyard, the outlines of the doors and
- the ridges of the roof&mdash;even the winding walks about the building,
- too, and the low-growing trees&mdash;with a perfect Milky Way of dancing
- light.
- </p>
- <p>
- Within, all the colours of a coral reef (which includes every hue of a
- rainbow, and many more) were in full blaze about the tremendous, unbroken
- floor, where the natives stood or sat cross-legged, dressed in all their
- gayest finery. There was a heavy scent of perfumed cocoanut oil,
- orange-blossom, and frangipani flowers and a rich glow of lights; and the
- waves of gorgeous melody that burst forth now and again with the progress
- of the service were like the billows of Time breaking upon the shores of
- Eternity. Of all the choral singing that I heard in the Pacific, that of
- Tonga was incomparably the fullest, the most splendid, and most majestic.
- The singers of Manahiki are sweeter and stranger, those of the Cook
- Islands more varied and soft, but the Tongan music is, for sheer
- magnificence and volume, unsurpassable.
- </p>
- <p>
- The women, in their graceful tunics, with their elaborately dressed hair,
- and their fine, dignified presence, were all unlike the soft, sensuous,
- languorous syrens of Tahiti and Raratonga, They do not encourage
- familiarity, even from white women, and their moral character is much
- higher than that of their sisters in the far Eastern Pacific. Women are
- treated with more respect in Tonga than in any part of the Pacific. They
- have little to do in the way of household work, and almost no field work.
- The men save them most of the hard labour, on the undeniable ground that
- hard work makes a woman ugly, and they do not care for ugly wives!
- </p>
- <p>
- Nearly every one wore a mat tied round the waist, partly concealing the
- gay dress&mdash;in spite of the extreme heat of the night. Some of the
- mats were new and clean, but most were old, ragged, and dirty. This
- curious custom is a relic of ancient heathen days in Tonga, when a
- handsome dress of any kind, worn by a commoner, was apt to arouse the
- dangerous envy of a chief, and in consequence, a native who was wearing
- his &ldquo;best&rdquo; generally tied the dirtiest old mat that he could get over all,
- so that he might not look too rich! The reason has long since vanished,
- but the custom remains in a modified form. A mat, tied round the waist
- with strong sinnet cord, is considered a correct finish to the gayest of
- festival costume in Tonga of to-day, and, as far as I was able to
- ascertain, its absence, on occasions of ceremony, is considered rather
- vulgar.
- </p>
- <p>
- The service was enlivened by the presence of a very large and extremely
- loud brass band. Brass is a passion with the Tongan musician, and he
- certainly makes the most of it. The effects produced are a little
- monotonous to a European ear, but, none the less, impressive and fine.
- </p>
- <p>
- After the midnight mass, I went home in the bright moonlight, the gentle
- stir of the trade-wind, the soft rustle of the ironwood trees, falling
- with a pleasantly soothing effect upon ears a little strained and tired by
- the strenuous character of the Tongan music. Next morning came the waits,
- and in the afternoon there were games and sports of a rather too familiar
- Sunday-school pattern, at the various mission stations. I did not trouble
- to attend any of them, as the Pacific native is certainly least
- interesting when most intent on copying the ways and fashions of the white
- man. The cricket matches which came off at various intervals during the
- few weeks of my stay, were well worth seeing, however, for the Tongan is a
- magnificent cricketer, and has often inflicted bitter defeat on the best
- teams that visiting men-of-war could put in the field against him.
- </p>
- <p>
- The politically disturbed state of the island was interesting in one way,
- but a serious disadvantage in another, since it prevented my obtaining
- much information about many interesting native customs that I should have
- been glad to investigate. I am afraid that I deserved the worst that
- scientifically minded travellers could say of me, in Tonga, for I merely
- spent the time enjoying myself after the pleasant island fashion, and not
- in research or geographical note-taking, even so far as was possible. Yet,
- after all, what are the islands, if not a Garden of Indolence, a
- lotus-land, a place where one dreams, and wanders, and listens to the
- murmuring reef-song, and sleeps under the shade of a palm, and wakes but
- to dream again? Does one degenerate, in such a life? Why, yes, of course&mdash;constantly,
- surely, and most delightfully.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;<i>Be good, and you will be happy, but you won&rsquo;t have a good time</i>,&rdquo;
- says &ldquo;Pudd&rsquo;nhead Wilson,&rdquo; one of the wisest of modern philosophers. In the
- islands, one is not good, in the ordinary Dr. Wattian sense of the term,
- and perhaps one is not happy&mdash;though if so, one never finds it out.
- But the good time one does have, and it is very good indeed. And if you do
- not believe me, dear sensible reader, never be tempted to go and try, for
- it is very likely that the good time and your own goodness would mutually
- cancel one another, and you would be unvirtuous and bored all in one. The
- islands are not for all, and the gateway to the &ldquo;Tir-na&rsquo;n-Oge&rdquo; is now, as
- ever, hard to find.
- </p>
- <p>
- The big Union steamer, with her ice, and her &ldquo;cuisine&rdquo; (cooking is never
- cooking, on board a passenger vessel), and her dainty little blue and
- white cabins, and her large cool saloon glittering with crystal and
- gilding, came in in due time, and I went away with her to Samoa. The three
- days&rsquo; run was broken by two calls in the Tongan group&mdash;one at Haapai,
- and one at Vavau.
- </p>
- <p>
- Of Haapai, a long, low, wooded island, with a few hundred native
- inhabitants, and one or two whites, we saw nothing but the king&rsquo;s palace&mdash;a
- great, square, two-storeyed, verandahed building, which is never lived in&mdash;and
- the Wesleyan chapel, which has some of the finest sinnet work in the
- Pacific to show. This sinnet work is quite distinctive of the islands, and
- is very beautiful and artistic. It is not one of the &ldquo;curios&rdquo; known to the
- markets and collections of civilisation, because it is always done <i>in
- situ</i>, and cannot be removed. At first sight, it looks like remarkably,
- good chip carving, done on the capitals of pillars, and about the centres
- of supports and beams, in various shades of red, black, brown, and yellow.
- Looking closer, one sees that it is much more remarkable than carving,
- being a solid mass of interwoven sinnet plait, as fine as very thin twine,
- wound and twisted into raised patterns by the clever fingers of the
- natives. In the church at Haapai, the sinnet plaiting is very fine and
- elaborate, and certainly well worth seeing. The captain of the steamer,
- who acted as our guide, made sure we had all seen it, and then took us a
- wild, hot, hurried walk across the island, to the coral beach at the other
- side, and past the palace, and along an endless cocoanut avenue, which was
- very pretty, but&mdash;&mdash;
- </p>
- <p>
- We wanted our afternoon tea, and we mutinied at that point, and insisted
- on going back to the ship. This grieved our commander, who conceived that
- his duties to the Company required he should ensure every passenger saw
- everything that was to be seen on the whole voyage, and shirked nothing&mdash;but
- we threatened to overpower and maroon him, if he did not take us back, so
- he returned, lecturing learnedly about the cutting off of the
- &ldquo;Port-au-Prince,&rdquo; in Haapai, by the natives, in seventeen hundred and
- I-forget-when. We ought to have been listening&mdash;but we wanted our
- tea, and we weren&rsquo;t.
- </p>
- <p>
- We reached Vavau just before dark, barely in time to admire the wonderful
- windings and fiords, the long blue arms and bright green islets, of this
- Helen among island harbours. Vavau is celebrated for its beauty through
- all the South Sea world, and its loveliness has not been one whit
- exaggerated.
- </p>
- <p>
- In the early morning&mdash;at half-past five, to be precise&mdash;the
- energetic captain routed all the passengers out of their bunks, and
- compelled them, by sheer force of character, to follow him, groaning and
- puffing, up a hill five hundred feet high, and exceedingly precipitous&mdash;a
- mere crag, in fact&mdash;that overlooked the harbour. We did not want to
- go, but none of us were sorry we had been compelled, when we did get to
- the top and saw that matchless harbour lying extended at our feet, mile
- after mile of land-locked fiord and palmy headland and exquisite green
- island, all set in a stainless mirror of flaming blue, and jewelled, where
- the shallows lightened to the shore, with flashes of marvellous colour
- shot up from the coral reef lying underneath. Rose and amethyst and
- violet, and malachite green and tawny yellow&mdash;they were all there,
- painting the splendid sweep of the harbour waters with hues that no mortal
- brush could reproduce, or pen describe. We stayed there long, and even the
- thought of breakfast, generally a moving call, did not hurry us away.
- </p>
- <p>
- In the afternoon, the captain had business to attend to, so he turned out
- one of the officers to act as guide, and sent us all off to see the Cave
- of the Swallows, and Mariner&rsquo;s Cave, on the other side of the harbour.
- </p>
- <p>
- If the Cave of the Swallows were situated on any European coast, it would
- be as tourist-ridden a spot as the Blue Grotto of Capri, or any other of
- the thousand famous caves through which holiday-making travellers are
- dragged each summer season&mdash;and would consequently be despoiled of
- half its loveliness. But it is very far away, in the South Sea Islands,
- and though a passenger steamer does visit Vavau once a month there are
- usually no tourists&mdash;only a missionary and a trader or two. So the
- lovely place lies undisturbed almost all the time, and you shall not find,
- when you row across the harbour to see it, that you have to wait your turn
- in a crowd of other boats, full of romping and larking trippers, with the
- guide of every party keeping a sharp look-out to see that no one takes
- longer than he ought going over the &ldquo;sight&rdquo;&mdash;so long as his charges
- remain outside.
- </p>
- <p>
- Instead of this, we glide silently under a noble archway some fifty feet
- high, and enter a great, still, ocean sanctuary, that looks as if no
- wandering oar had ever profaned its peace, since first the white man came
- to these far-off isles. Outside, the water is Prussian blue in colour, and
- over a thousand feet deep, but within the arch of the cave the bottom
- shoots up till it is within a hundred feet of the glass-clear surface on
- which we float, hanging above the silver-coloured coral reefs of the deep
- sea-bed, like birds hanging in air. The roof and walls of the cave are
- brilliant verdigris green, the water-floor, that curves so. closely in and
- out of the numerous arches and recesses, where mysterious shadows creep,
- is sapphire shot with fire. At one side of the cave there is a dark
- winding corridor leading to depths unknown. We glide down this a little
- way, and there before us opens out&mdash;surely, a temple and a shrine!
- The water-floor spreads and broadens here into the carpet of a high,
- still, secret inner cave, in the centre of which springs up a splintered
- pedestal&mdash;shattered, one fancies, by the blow that broke the image
- that must surely once have stood in this strange sea-shrine. From an
- unseen rift in the roof, far above, a white ray of sun strikes down into
- the cave, and falls like a blast from an offended heaven upon the broken
- pedestal.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is a geological explanation, no doubt, but we shall not look for it,
- for this is a wonder that would have delighted Victor Hugo himself, who
- drew the scenery of the &ldquo;Toilers of the Sea.&rdquo; And Victor Hugo&rsquo;s pen would
- be needed by any one who would adequately describe the spot.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is a rock in the outer cave, that sounds like a church bell when
- struck with an oar, and this delights the boatmen greatly, though they
- have heard it every time the steamer came up to Vavau. It is, indeed, a
- solemn and beautiful sound, and well suited to the place.
- </p>
- <p>
- Going back to the ship, we are shown the spot where the famous Mariner&rsquo;s
- Cave opens out, under water. There is nothing whatever to be seen, since
- the entrance is six feet under water at low tide. The story was first told
- to the world in Mariner&rsquo;s &ldquo;Tonga,&rdquo; published 1802, and was utilised by
- Byron in his poem of &ldquo;The Island.&rdquo; A young chief, it was said, was chasing
- a turtle one day, and saw the creature dive. He followed it, and was
- surprised to find that, on rising after his dive, he had reached an
- under-water cave of considerable size, to which there was no outlet save
- the one by which he had come in. Giving up the turtle, he dived again,
- returned to the surface, and did not trouble himself about the cave until,
- some months later, it occurred to him as an excellent place for an
- elopement&mdash;the parents of the girl he loved having refused to give
- her to him. So it came about that the young chief&rsquo;s sweetheart
- disappeared, and no one knew what had become of her until one day a
- boating party, to their intense amazement, saw what appeared to be the
- ghost of the girl rising from the heart of the waves. The apparition
- stared round, saw the intruders, and immediately disappeared. She was seen
- no more, but the story caused so much talk, that in the end the true
- secret came out, and it was discovered that the chief had hidden his
- lady-love in the cave, diving down with food to her day by day, and even
- bringing torches, safely wrapped in leaves. The stem parents, touched by
- so much devotion, relented, and the chief triumphantly brought home his
- bride at last in full day.
- </p>
- <p>
- Mariner, who was interested in the ancient tale, succeeded in reaching the
- cave himself, and found it as represented. He surmised that there was an
- air supply, passing through invisible cracks in the rock above, for the
- air seemed to keep fresh. There was something like a rough couch of stone
- at one end, where the imprisoned girl had made her bed. No light whatever
- penetrated the cavern.
- </p>
- <p>
- Since Mariner&rsquo;s time, very few Europeans have succeeded in entering the
- cave, which is extremely difficult to get into, owing to the length of the
- passage under water, and the currents of the tides. About thirty years
- ago, Captain Luce, of H.M.S. <i>Esk</i>, succeeded in entering the cave,
- but rose too soon on going out, and lacerated his back so badly against
- the coral spears under water, that he died in a few days. Since then, I
- heard that one white man had gone safely in and returned, but no one
- seemed to know who, or when. None of our party, at all events, felt
- tempted to make the trial.
- </p>
- <p>
- The steamer was ready to start when we got back, so we hurried on board,
- and started away for Samoa. There was much more to see in Vavau, but the
- only way of seeing it was to stop over for a month and remain in the
- village. For this no one had time. I was giving a month to each group of
- islands, which is little enough in the Pacific&mdash;but I knew very well
- that, unless I had had a vessel of my own, or a year or two extra to
- spend, it was impossible to see all that could be seen.
- </p>
- <p>
- Tofoa, for instance, one of the Tongan Group, which is an active volcano,
- and, naturally, not inhabited&mdash;what could be more interesting than a
- call there? But uninhabited volcanoes do not furnish cargo for steamship
- companies, so all we could see was a smear of smoke in the far distance,
- as we steamed on our way to Apia, the capital of the &ldquo;Navigators&rdquo; Group,
- better known, since the days of Stevenson, as Samoa.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0014" id="link2HCH0014"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER XIV
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>Stevenson&rsquo;s Samoa&mdash;What happened when it rained&mdash;Life in a
- Native Village&mdash;The Albino Chief&mdash;A Samoan &ldquo;Bee&rdquo;&mdash;The
- Tyranny of Time&mdash;Fishing at Midnight&mdash;Throwing the Presents&mdash;My
- Friend Fangati&mdash;The Taupo Dances&mdash;Down the sliding Rock&mdash;&ldquo;Good-bye,
- my Flennie!&rdquo;</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">W</span>HEN I woke up in
- the morning, the ship was still, and the familiar chatter of island
- tongues, and splashing of island paddles, audible outside the ports, told
- that we had reached Apia.
- </p>
- <p>
- Dressing is always a rush, under such circumstances. I hurried out on the
- deck in even quicker time than usual, and hastened to enjoy a good look at
- the little island that has been made famous the wide world over, by the
- genius of the great writer who passed his latest years in exile among
- those palmy hills.
- </p>
- <p>
- Upolu, Stevenson&rsquo;s island, is the second largest in the Samoan Group,
- being forty miles by eight. Savaii is a little wider. Tutuila is smaller.
- The six other islands are of little importance.
- </p>
- <p>
- Apia and Stevenson&rsquo;s home have been written about and described, by almost
- every tourist who ever passed through on the way to Sydney. There is
- little therefore to say that has not been said before. Every one knows
- that Apia is a fair-sized, highly civilised place, with hotels and shops
- and band promenades, and that Vailima, Stevenson&rsquo;s villa, is a mile or two
- outside. Every one has heard of the beautiful harbour of Apia itself, with
- the blue overhanging hills, and the dark wooded peak rising above all, on
- the summit of which the famous Scotsman&rsquo;s tomb gleams out like a tiny
- pearl&mdash;&ldquo;under the wide and starry sky.&rdquo; Since the disturbances of
- 1899, most people have been aware that England has absolutely relinquished
- any rights she had in Samoa, and that the islands are now divided between
- Germany and America&mdash;Upolu being among the possessions of the former.
- </p>
- <p>
- Perhaps some people have forgotten that Samoa is a fairly recent
- discovery, having been first sighted by Bougainville in 1768. It is
- supposed that the natives originally came from Sumatra. During the last
- six hundred years, they were frequently at war with the Tongans and
- Fijians, and from the latter learned the horrible practice of cannibalism&mdash;which,
- however, they abandoned of their own accord a good while before the coming
- of the first missionaries in 1833.
- </p>
- <p>
- They are a singularly beautiful race, and most amiable in character. They
- are all Christianised, and a great number can read and write. Tourists
- have done their best to spoil them, but outside the towns there is much of
- the ancient simplicity and patriarchal character still to be found.
- </p>
- <p>
- About two dozen Samoan gentlemen&mdash;I call them gentlemen, because in
- manners and demeanour they really deserved the name, and many were actual
- chiefs&mdash;had come on board the steamer, and were walking about the
- deck when I came out. The air was like hot water, and there was not a
- breath of wind. All the same, the Samoan gentlemen were quite cool, for
- they wore nothing at all but a British bath-towel with red edges, tied
- round the waist in the universal kilt style of the Pacific. In the Cook
- Group, the garment is called a pareo, and is made of figured cotton. In
- Tonga, it is a vala, and is usually cashmere. In Samoa the name is changed
- to lava-lava, and the thing may be either a piece of plain coloured
- cotton, or the bath-towel above mentioned, which is considered a good deal
- smarter&mdash;but the costume itself is the same all through.
- </p>
- <p>
- Most of the men had their short-cut hair plastered snow-white with lime,
- because it was Saturday. Almost every Samoan limes his hair on Saturdays,
- partly to keep up the yellow colour produced by previous applications,
- partly for hygienic reasons that had better be left to the imagination.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0041" id="linkimage-0041"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0404.jpg" alt="0404 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0404.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- All the visitors displayed an incomparable self-possession and dignity of
- bearing, not at all like the &ldquo;Tongan swagger,&rdquo; but much more akin to the
- manner of what is known in society as &ldquo;really good people.&rdquo; Coupled to the
- almost complete absence of clothes, and the copper skins, it was enough to
- make one perfectly giddy at first. But afterwards, one grew used to it,
- and even came to compare the average white man&rsquo;s manner disadvantageously
- with the unsurpassable self-possession and calm of the unclothed native.
- </p>
- <p>
- Then came boats and landing and hotels, and the usual one-sided South Sea
- town, with little green parrakeets tweedling cheerfully among the scarlet
- flowers of the flamboyant trees, and looking very much as if they had
- escaped from somewhere. And behold, as we were making our way to the
- hotel, a heavy waterspout of hot-season rain came on, whereupon the street
- immediately became a transformation scene of the most startling character.
- </p>
- <p>
- The roadway had been full of natives in their best clothes, come down to
- see the passengers&mdash;some in bath-towels, like the visitors to the
- steamer, but many in the cleanest of shirts and cotton tunics, and scores
- of pretty Samoan girls in civilised gowns of starched and laced muslin,
- trimmed hats, and gay silk ribbons. The rain began to spout, as only
- tropical rain can, and immediately things commenced to happen that made me
- wonder if I were really awake. Under the eaves of houses, beneath
- umbrellas, out in the street without any shelter at all, the Samoans
- rapidly began undressing. Smart white shirts, frilled petticoats, lacy
- dresses, all came off in a twinkling, and were rolled up into tight
- bundles, and stowed away under their owners&rsquo; arms, to protect the precious
- garments from the rain. Then down the street, with bare brown legs
- twinkling as they ran, and bodies covered merely by the &ldquo;lava-lava,&rdquo;
- scurried the bronze ladies and gentlemen who had looked so smart and
- dressy a few brief seconds before. Some of the girls, who could not get an
- inch of shelter under which to undress, merely pulled their fine frocks up
- under their arms, and ran down the street looking like very gay but
- draggled tulips set on two long brown stalks. It was the oddest
- transformation scene that I had ever been privileged to look on at, and it
- sent the passengers of the ship into such screaming fits of laughter that
- they forgot all about keeping themselves dry, and landed in the hotel in
- the condition of wet seaweed tossed up by the waves. So we arrived in
- Samoa.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is no use in relating at length how I drove out to see Stevenson&rsquo;s
- much described villa at Vailima&mdash;now in the possession of a wealthy
- German merchant, and much altered and spoiled&mdash;and how I did <i>not</i>
- climb the two thousand feet up to his tomb above the harbour, and was
- sorry ever after. Rather let me tell how, tired of the civilised section
- of the island, I took ship one day in an ugly little oil-<i>launch</i>,
- and sailed away to see the life of a native village, down at Falepunu.
- There is not much real native life now to be seen in the capital; for,
- although the &ldquo;faa Samoa&rdquo; (ancient Samoan custom) is very strong all over
- the islands, in Apia it is at a minimum, and the influence of the white
- man has much increased since Stevenson&rsquo;s day. Besides, how can one study
- native customs, dining at a <i>table d&rsquo;hôte</i> and living in a great gilt
- and glass hotel, situated in the midst of a busy street?
- </p>
- <p>
- So it was very gladly that I saw the wide blue harbour of Apia open out
- before me, and melt into the great Pacific, the &ldquo;league long rollers&rdquo;
- tossing our little cockle shell about remorselessly as we headed out
- beyond the reef, and began to slant along the coast, Upolu&rsquo;s rich blue and
- green mountains unfolding in a splendid panorama of tropic glory, as we
- crept along against the wind towards Falefa, our destined port, nearly
- twenty miles away. Here and there, white threads of falling water gleamed
- out against the dark mountain steeps; and the nearer hills, smooth and
- rich and palmy, and green as a basket of moss, parted now and then in
- unexpected gateways, to show brief glimpses of the wildly tumbled lilac
- peaks of far-away, rugged inner ranges. A day of gold and glitter, of
- steady, smiting heat, of beauty that was almost^ too beautiful, as hour
- after hour went by, and found the glorious panorama still unrolling before
- eyes that were well-nigh wearied, and bodies that wanted shelter and food.
- </p>
- <p>
- But even a little oil-launch cannot take all day to cover twenty miles; so
- it was still early in the afternoon when we glided into the harbour of
- Falefa, and came to a stop in the very heart of Paradise.
- </p>
- <p>
- How to picture Falefa, to the dwellers in the far grey north! how to paint
- the jewel-green of the water, the snow white of the sand, the overhanging
- palms that lean all day to look at their own loveliness in the unruffled
- mirror below; the emerald peaks above, the hyacinth peaks beyond, the
- strangely fashioned out-rigged canoes, with their merry brown rowers,
- skimming like long-limbed water-flies about the bay; the far-away
- sweetness and stillness and unlikeness of it all! And the waterfall,
- dropping down seventy feet of black precipitous rock right into the sea&rsquo;s
- blue bosom&mdash;and the winding, shady fiords, where the water is
- glass-green with reflections of shimmering leaves&mdash;and the little
- secluded brown houses, domed and pillared after the Samoan fashion, that
- ramble about among the long avenues of palm&mdash;surely, even in all the
- lovely South Sea Islands, there never was a lovelier spot than this
- harbour of Falefa!
- </p>
- <p>
- We three&mdash;a half-caste Samoan lady, a New Zealand girl, and myself&mdash;landed
- on the beach and gave over our things to a native boy, to carry up to the
- great guesthouse at Falepunu, a mile further on. Every Samoan village has
- its guest-house, for the free accommodation of passing travellers, but few
- have anything that can compare with the house where we were to stay&mdash;my
- companions for the night only, myself for a week.
- </p>
- <p>
- A Samoan house, owing to the heat of the climate, is a roof and nothing
- more, the walls being omitted, save for the posts necessary to support the
- great dome of the roof. It is worth well looking at and admiring all the
- same. Fine ribs made of strong flexible branches run diagonally from eaves
- to crown, only an inch or two apart, and curved with exquisite skill to
- form the arching dome. Over these, at an acute angle, are laid similar
- ribs in a second layer, forming a strong, flexible &lsquo;lattice. At just the
- right intervals, narrow, curved beams cross behind these, and hold them
- firm. The centre of the house displays three splendid pillars, made from
- the trunks of three tall trees; these support the roof-tree, and are
- connected with the sides of the dome by several tiers of slender beams,
- beautifully graded in size and length. The guest-house of Falepunu belongs
- to a high chief, and is in consequence exceptionally handsome. Its
- roof-tree is fifty feet from the floor, and the width of the house, on the
- floor-level, is the same. Forty wooden pillars, each seven feet high,
- support this handsome dome, every inch of which is laced and latticed and
- tied together with the finest of plaited cocoanut fibre, stained black,
- red, and yellow, and woven into pattern like elaborate chip carving.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is not a nail used in the construction of the house. One wet
- afternoon I attempted to count the number of thousand yards of sinnet
- (plaited cocoanut fibre) that must have been used in this colossal work,
- and gave it up in despair. The number of the mats used in forming the
- blinds was more calculable. Each opening between the pillars was
- surmounted by seven plaited cocoanut-leaf mats, fastened up under the
- eaves into a neat little packet. These could be dropped like a Venetian
- blind, whenever rain or wind proved troublesome. The total number of mats
- was two hundred and seventy-three.
- </p>
- <p>
- The floor of a Samoan house consists of a circular terrace, raised some
- two feet above the level of the ground. It is surrounded by a shallow
- ditch, and it is made of large and small stones, closely fitted together,
- and covered with a final layer of small white coral pebbles from the
- beach. This forms the carpet of the house, and is known as &ldquo;Samoan
- feathers,&rdquo; from the fact that it also forms everybody&rsquo;s bed at night,
- covered with a mat or two.
- </p>
- <p>
- The chief, Pula-Ulu, and his wife, Iva, who were in charge of the
- guest-house, in the absence of its owner, received us joyfully, and
- proceeded to make a feast for us at once. Fowls were killed, baked
- bread-fruit and taro brought from the ovens outside (which were simply
- pits dug in the ground, and filled with hot stones), and oranges and
- pineapples plucked from the nearest grove. We sat crosslegged on the mats,
- and ate till we could eat no more; then, &ldquo;faa Samoa,&rdquo; we lay down where we
- were to rest and doze away the hot hours, of the afternoon.
- </p>
- <p>
- In the evening, Iva lit a big ship&rsquo;s hurricane lamp, and set it on the
- floor; and half Falepunu came in to call. In rows and rows they sat on the
- floor-mats, their brown, handsome faces lit up with interest and
- excitement, fanning themselves ceaselessly as they sat, and asking endless
- questions of the half-caste lady, who interpreted for the others. I, as
- coming from London, was the heroine of the hour, for the Samoans are all
- greatly interested in &ldquo;Beritania&rdquo; (Britain) and, in spite of the German
- annexation, still prefer the English to any other nation.
- </p>
- <p>
- The inevitable question: &ldquo;Where was my husband?&rdquo; followed by: &ldquo;Why had I
- not got one?&rdquo;&mdash;in a tone of reproachful astonishment&mdash;was put by
- almost every new-comer. The half-caste visitor explained volubly; but the
- villagers still looked a little puzzled. The Samoans have in almost every
- village a &ldquo;taupo&rdquo; or &ldquo;Maid of the Village,&rdquo; whose office it is to receive
- guests, and take a prominent part in all public ceremonies and festivals.
- But she only holds office for a very few years, until she marries, and she
- is always surrounded, when travelling, by a train of elderly attendants.
- An unmarried woman who had money of her own, who wandered about alone, who
- held office in no village, here or at home, this was decidedly a puzzle to
- the Falepunu folk, whose own women all marry at about fourteen. They had
- seen white women; travelling with their husbands, but never one who had
- ventured from Beritania all alone!
- </p>
- <p>
- There was evidently some difficulty, at first, in &ldquo;placing&rdquo; me according
- to Samoan etiquette, which is both complex and peculiar. A white women
- with her husband presents no difficulty, since the &ldquo;faa Samoa&rdquo; always
- gives the superior honour to the man, and therefore the woman must only
- receive second-class ceremony. In my case, the question was solved later
- on, by classing me as a male chief! I was addressed as &ldquo;Tamaite&rdquo; (lady),
- but officially considered as a man; therefore I was always offered kava
- (the national drink of Samoa, never given to their own women, and not
- usually to white women), and the young chiefs of the district came almost
- every evening to call upon me in due form, sitting in formal rows, and
- conversing, through an interpreter, in a well-bred, gracious manner, that
- was oddly reminiscent of a London drawing-room. The women did not visit me
- officially, although I had many a pleasant bathing and fishing excursion
- in their company.
- </p>
- <p>
- On the first evening the callers stayed a long time&mdash;so long, that we
- all grew very weary, and yearned for sleep. But they kept on coming, one
- after another; and by-and-by half-a-dozen young men appeared, dressed in
- kilts of coloured bark-strips; adorned with necklaces of scarlet berries
- and red hibiscus flowers, and liberally cocoanut-oiled. In the centre of
- the group was the most extraordinary figure I had ever seen&mdash;a white
- man, his skin burned to an unwholesome pink by exposure, his hair pure
- gold, extremely fine and silky, and so thick as to make a huge halo round
- his face when shaken out. His eyes were weak, and half shut, and I was not
- surprised to hear that he was not really of white descent, being simply a
- Samoan albino, born of brown parents. This man, being the son of a chief,
- took the principal figure in the dance that was now got up for our
- amusement. The seven men danced on the floor-mats, close together, the
- albino in the centre, all performing figures of extraordinary agility, and
- not a little grace. The music was furnished by the other spectators, who
- rolled up a mat or two, and beat time on these improvised drums, others
- clapping their hands, and chanting a loud, sonorous, measured song.
- </p>
- <p>
- At the end of the dance the performers, streaming with perspiration (for
- the night was very hot) and all out of breath, paused for our applause. We
- gave it liberally, and added a tin or two of salmon, which was joyfully
- received, and eaten at once. All Samoans love tinned salmon, which, by an
- odd perversion, they call &ldquo;peasoupo.&rdquo; No doubt the first tinned goods seen
- in the islands were simply tinned peasoup. This would account for the
- extraordinary confusion of names mentioned above.
- </p>
- <p>
- By this time we were so utterly weary that we lay down on the mats where
- we were, and almost slept. Iva, seeing this, chased most of the callers
- out with small ceremony, and got up the calico mosquito curtain that was
- to shelter the slumbers of all three travellers. It enclosed a space of
- some eight feet by six. Within, plaited pandanus-leaf mats were laid, two
- thick, upon the white pebble floor, and Samoan pillows offered us.
- </p>
- <p>
- A Samoan pillow is just like a large fire-dog, being simply a length of
- bamboo supported on two small pairs of legs. If you are a Samoan, you lay
- your cheek on this neck-breaking arrangement, and sleep without moving
- till the daylight. We preferred our cloaks rolled up under our heads.
- </p>
- <p>
- The invaluable little mosquito tent served as dressing-room to all of us,
- and very glad we were of it, for there were still a good many visitors,
- dotted about the floor of the great guest-house, smoking and chattering;
- and none of them had any idea that a white woman could object to
- performing her evening toilet in public, any more than a-Samoan girl, who
- simply takes her &ldquo;pillow&rdquo; down from the rafters, spreads her mat, and lies
- down just, as she is.
- </p>
- <p>
- No-bed-clothes were needed, for the heat was severe. We fidgeted about on
- our stony couch, elbowed each other a good deal, slept occasionally, and
- woke again to hear the eternal chatter still going on outside our tent,
- and see the light still glowing through the calico. It was exactly, like
- going to bed in the-middle of a bazaar, after making a couch out of one of
- the stalls.
- </p>
- <p>
- At last, however, the light went out; Iva, Pula-Ulu, and their saucy
- little handmaiden and relative, Kafi, got under their mosquito curtains,
- quite, a little walk away, at the other side of the dome, all the guests
- departed, and there was peace.
- </p>
- <p>
- Next, morning my friends went away and I was left to study the fife of a
- Samoan village alone, with only such aid as old Iva&rsquo;s very few English
- words could give me, since I did not know above half-a-dozen; sentences of
- the Samoan tongue. There were no great feasts, no ceremonies or festivals
- while I was in Falepunu, only the ordinary, everyday fife of the village,
- which has changed extremely little since the coming of the white men,
- although that event is three generations old.
- </p>
- <p>
- Perhaps the greatest change is in the native treatment of guests.
- Hospitable, polite and pleasant the Samoans have always been and still
- are; but in these days, when a white visitor stays in a native house, he
- is expected to give presents when parting, that fully cover the value of
- his stay. This is contrary to the original Samoan laws of hospitality,
- which still hold good in the case of natives. No Samoan ever thinks of
- paying for accommodation in another&rsquo;s house, no matter how long his stay
- may be; nor is there the least hesitation in taking or giving whatever
- food a traveller may want on his way. But the white visitors who have
- stayed in Samoa have been so liberal with their gifts, that the native now
- expects presents as a right. He would still scorn to take money for his
- hospitality, but money&rsquo;s worth is quite another matter.
- </p>
- <p>
- Otherwise, the &ldquo;faa Samoa&rdquo; holds with astonishing completeness. Natives
- who have boxes full of trade prints, bought from the lonely little
- European store that every island owns, will dress themselves on ceremonial
- occasions in finely plaited mats, or silky brown tappa cloth. Houses on
- the verge of Apia, the European capital, are built precisely as houses
- were in the days of Captain Cook; though perhaps an incongruous bicycle or
- sewing-machine, standing up against the central pillars, may strike a
- jarring note. Men and women who have been to school, and can tell you the
- geographical boundaries of Montenegro, and why Charles I.&lsquo;s head was cut
- off&mdash;who know all about the Russo-Japanese war, wear full European
- dress when you ask them to your house, and sing &ldquo;In the Gloaming&rdquo; or &ldquo;Sail
- away&rdquo; to your piano&mdash;will take part in a native &ldquo;si va&rdquo; or dancing
- festival, dressed in a necklace, a kilt, and unlimited cocoanut-oil, and
- may be heard of, when the chiefs are out fighting, roaming round the
- mountains potting their enemies with illegally acquired Winchesters, and
- cutting off the victims&rsquo; heads afterwards. The &ldquo;faa Samoa&rdquo; holds the
- Samoan, old and young, educated or primitive, through life and to death.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0042" id="linkimage-0042"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0392.jpg" alt="0392 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0392.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Uneventful, yet very happy, was the little week that time allowed me among
- the pleasant folk of Falepunu. When the low, yellow rays of the rising sun
- hot under the wide eaves of the great guest-house, and striped the white
- coral floor with gold, and the little green parrakeets began to twitter in
- the trees outside, and the long sleepy murmur of the surf on the reef,
- blown landward by the sunrise wind, swelled to a deep-throated choral song&mdash;then,
- I used to slip into my clothes, come out from my mosquito tent, and see
- the beauty of the new young day. Dawn on a South Sea Island! The rainbow
- fancies of childhood painted out in real&mdash;the
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- Dreams of youth come back again,
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- Dropping on the ripened grain
- </p>
- <p class="indent15">
- As once upon the flower.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br />
- </p>
- <p>
- Iva, Pula-Ulu, and Kafi would be awake also, and moving about. No minute
- of daylight is ever wasted in these tropical islands; where all the year
- round the dawn lingers till after five, and the dark comes down long
- before seven. None of my house-mates had much toilet to make. They simply
- got up from their mats, hung up the pillows, put the mosquito nets away,
- and walked forth; clad in the cotton lava-lavas of yesterday, which they
- had not taken off when they lay down. Taking soap and bundles of cocoanut
- fibre off the ever useful rafters they went to bathe in the nearest river.
- Before long they came back, fresh and clean, and wearing a new lava-lava,
- yesterday&rsquo;s hanging limp and wet from their hands&mdash;the Samoan
- generally washes his garments at the same time as himself. Then Iva boiled
- water for my tea, and produced cold baked bread-fruit and stewed fish, and
- I breakfasted, taking care to leave a good share of tea, butter, and any
- tinned food I might open, for the family to enjoy afterwards. It is a
- positive crime in Samoa to eat up any delicacy all by yourself&mdash;an
- offence indeed, which produces about the same impression on the Samoan
- mind as cheating at cards does upon the well-bred European. The natives
- themselves usually eat twice a day, about noon, and some time in the
- evening; but a Samoan is always ready to eat at any hour, provided there
- is something nice to be got. Good old Iva enjoyed my tea and tinned milk
- extremely, and so did her pet cronies. They used to call in now and then,
- in the hope of getting some&mdash;a hope liberally fulfilled by Iva, who
- distributed my goods among them with charming courtesy, and a total
- innocence of any possible objection on my part, which disarmed all
- criticism. I might have taken anything she had, from her Sunday lava-lava
- to her fattest fowl, and kept it or given it away; equally without
- remonstrance. Such is the &ldquo;faa Samoa.&rdquo; That any one continues to retain
- anything worth having; under such circumstances, speaks well for the
- natural unselfishness of the people. They may be a little greedy with the
- whites&mdash;much as we ourselves should no doubt be greedy if
- half-a-dozen millionaires were to quarter themselves in our modest
- mansions, or come to stay in our quiet suburbs&mdash;but among themselves
- they are wonderfully self-&rsquo; restrained, and at the same time faultlessly
- generous.
- </p>
- <p>
- After my breakfast, following the agreeable Samoan custom, I lay down on a
- mat and dozed a little, to feel the wind blowing over my face from the
- sea, as I wandered half in and half out of the lands of dreams, and saw
- with semi-closed eyes the sun of the hot morning hours turn the green of
- the bush into a girdle of burning emerald-gold, clasped round the pleasant
- gloom of the dark over-circling roof. Pula-Ulu was out on &ldquo;ploys&rdquo; of his
- own; Kafi had gone to fish, or to flirt; Iva, pulling a fly-cover over her
- body, slept like a sheeted corpse on her own mat, off the other side of
- the central pillars.
- </p>
- <p>
- After an hour or two&mdash;there was never any time in Falepunu&mdash;I
- would rise, and call for Kafi, and we would walk slowly through the
- smiting sun, to a fairylike spot in the lovely bay of Falefa&mdash;a
- terrace of grey rock clothed with ferns, and shaded by thick-growing palms
- and chestnut and mango trees. The great white waterfall, cool as nothing
- else is cool in this burning land, thundered within fifty yards of us,
- turning the salt waters of the bay to brackish freshness, and spraying the
- hot air with its own delicious cold. Here we swam and dived for hours at a
- time, getting an old canoe sometimes, and paddling it up under the very
- spray of the fall&mdash;upsetting it perhaps, and tumbling out While Kafi
- yelled as if she could not swim a stroke, and anticipated immediate death
- (being, of course, absolutely amphibious). A pretty little minx was Kafi,
- small and black-eyed and piquante, always with a scarlet hibiscus bloom,
- or a yellow and white frangipani flower, stuck behind her ear; always
- tossing her head, and swaying her beautiful olive arms, and patting her
- small arched foot on the ground, when she stood waiting for me under the
- palms, as if she could not keep her elastic little frame, from dancing of
- itself. Pretty, saucy, mischievous little Kafi, she gave me many a bad
- moment wickedly calling out, &ldquo;S&rsquo;ark!&rdquo; when we were swimming far from land,
- in places where it was just conceivable that a shark might be; but I
- forgive her everything, for the sake of that unique and charming small
- personality of hers. Not even Fangati, the languorous sweet-eyed Taupo of
- Apia, can compete with her in my memories of fascinating island girls and
- pleasant companions.
- </p>
- <p>
- One morning&mdash;it must have been somewhere near the middle of the day&mdash;Iva
- and Kafi and I were walking back from Falefa, tired out and very hungry
- (at least, I will answer for myself), when we were hailed from the house
- of a chief, and asked to come in. We did so, all saying, as we bowed our
- heads to step under the low eaves: &ldquo;Talofa!&rdquo; (my love to you), and being
- answered with a loud chorus: &ldquo;Talofa, tamaite! (lady); Talofa, I va;
- Talofa, Kafi.&rdquo; I took my seat cross-legged on the mats, and looked about
- me. All round the house in a Circle were seated a number of men, about a
- dozen, each with a bundle of cleaned and carded cocoanut husk fibre,
- called sinnet, beside him, and a slender plait of sinnet in his hand, to
- which every minute added on an inch or so of length. It was evidently a
- &ldquo;bee&rdquo; for making sinnet plait, and it solved a problem that had perplexed
- me a good deal&mdash;namely, how all the thousands of sinnet used instead
- of nails in building Samoan houses, were ever obtained. Afterwards I
- learned that Samoan men occupy much of their unlimited leisure time in
- plaiting sinnet. The bundle of husk and the-neat-little coil of plait are
- to a Samoan man what her needle and stockings are to a Scotch housewife;
- he works away mechanically with them in many an odd moment, all going to
- swell the big roll that is gradually widening and fattening up among the
- rafters; Some of the sinnet thus made is as fine as fine twine, yet
- enormously strong....
- </p>
- <p>
- My hosts, it seemed, were just going to knock, off work for the present,
- and have some kava, and I was not sorry to join them, for kava is a
- wonderfully refreshing drink, among these tropical islands, and wholesome
- besides. It was made Tongan fashion, by pounding the dry woody&rsquo; root with
- stones, pouring water over the crushed fragments, and straining the latter
- out with a wisp of hibiscus fibre. A handsome wooden bowl was used,
- circular in form, and supported on; a number of legs&mdash;the whole being
- carved out of one solid block of wood. The ancient Samoan way of
- preparation was to chew the kava root, and deposit the chewed, lamps in,
- the bowl, afterwards pouring on the water; but this practice has died out,
- in many parts of Samoa, though in some of the islands it is still kept up.
- </p>
- <p>
- My kava On this occasion was not chewed, and I was thankful, as it is
- unmannerly to refuse it under any circumstances.
- </p>
- <p>
- The kava made, the highest chief present called the names, according, to
- etiquette, as in Tonga, in a loud resounding voice. I answered to my own
- (which came first, as a foreign, chief) by clapping my hands, in the
- correct fashion, and drained the cocoanut bowl that was handed me. Kava,
- as I had already learned, quenches thirst; removes fatigue, clears the
- brain, and is exceedingly cooling. If drunk in excess it produces a
- temporary paralysis of the legs, without affecting the head; but very few
- natives and hardly any whites do drink more than is good for them.
- </p>
- <p>
- After the kava, two young men came running in from the bush, carrying
- between them an immense black wooden bowl, spoon-shaped, three-legged, and
- filled with something exactly like bread-and-milk, which they had been
- concocting at the cooking-pits. It was raining now, and the thrifty youths
- had taken off their clothes, for fear of spoiling them, yet they were
- dressed with perfect decency, and much picturesqueness. Their attire
- consisted of thick fringed kilts, made of pieces of green banana leaves (a
- banana leaf is often nine or ten feet long, and two or three wide), and
- something like a feather boa, hung round the neck, of the same material.
- Clad in these rain-proof garments, they ran laughing through the downpour,
- their bowl covered with another leaf, and deposited it on the floor, safe
- and hot.
- </p>
- <p>
- A section of banana-leaf was now placed on the mat beside each person,
- also a skewer, made from the midrib of the cocoanut leaf. Then the servers
- dipped both hands generously into the food, and filled each leaf with the
- bread-and-milk, or &ldquo;tafolo,&rdquo; which turned out to be lumps of bread-fruit
- stewed in thick white cream expressed from the meat of the cocoanut.
- Better eating no epicure could desire; and the food is exceedingly
- nourishing. We ate with the cocoanut skewers, on which each creamy lump
- was speared; and when all was done we folded the leaf-plates into a cone,
- and drank the remaining cream. Afterwards, Iva and Kafi and I took our
- leave, and I hurried back to Falepunu, feeling that my hunger and fatigue
- had been magically removed, and that I was ready for anything more in the
- way of exercise that the day might produce.
- </p>
- <p>
- I had no watch or clock with me, and this was certainly an advantage,
- since it compelled me to measure time in the pleasant island fashion,
- which simply marks out the day vaguely by hot hours and cool hours, and
- the recurring calls of hunger. No one who has not tried it can conceive
- the limitless freedom and leisure that comes of this custom. Time is
- simply wiped out. One discovers-all of a sudden, that one has been
- groaning under an unbearable and unnecessary tyranny all one&rsquo;s life&mdash;whence
- all the hurry-scurry of civilisation? why do people rush to catch trains
- and omnibuses, and hasten to make and keep appointments, and have meals at
- rigidly fixed times, whether they are hungry or not? These are the things
- that make life short. It is inimitably long, and curiously sweet and
- simple, in the island world. At first one finds it hard to realise that no
- one is ever waiting for dinner, or wanting to go to bed&mdash;that eating
- and sleeping are the-impulse of a moment, and not a set task&mdash;but
- once realised, the sense of emancipation is exquisite and complete.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Samoan does what he wants, when he wishes, and if he does not wish a
- thing, does not do it at all. According, to the theology of our youthful
- days, he ought in consequence to become a fiend in human shape; but he
- does nothing of the kind. He is the most amiable creature on earth&rsquo;s round
- ball. Angry voices, loud tones even, are never heard in a Samoan house.
- Husbands never come home drunk in the evening and ill-use their wives;
- wives never nag at their husbands; no one screams at children, or snaps at
- house-mates and neighbours. Houses are never dirty; clothes are always
- kept clean; nothing is untidy, nothing superfluous or ugly. There is
- therefore no striking ground for ill-temper or peevishness; and amiability
- and courtesy reign supreme. The Samoan has his faults&mdash;sensuality,
- indolence, a certain bluntness of perception as to the white man&rsquo;s laws of
- property&mdash;but they are slight indeed compared with the faults of the
- ordinary European. And, concerning the tendency to exploit the latter
- person, which has been already mentioned, it must not be forgotten that if
- a white man is known to be destitute and in want, the very people who
- would have eagerly sought for presents from him while he was thought to be
- rich, will take him in, feed and-lodge him; without a thought of payment,
- and will never turn him out if he does not choose to go.
- </p>
- <p>
- Sometimes, in the long, lazy, golden afternoons, a woman or two would drop
- in, and bring with her some little dainty as a present for the stranger.
- &ldquo;Palusani&rdquo; was the favourite, made, as in Niué, of taro-tops and cocoanut;
- the cook grating down the meat of the nuts, and straining water through
- the oily mass thus produced. The cream is very cleverly wrapped up inside
- the leaves, and these are again enveloped in larger and tougher leaves.
- While baking, the cream thickens and condenses, and permeates the
- taro-tops completely. The resulting dish is a spinachlike mixture of dark
- green and white, odd to look at, but very rich and dainty to eat.
- </p>
- <p>
- Another present was a sort of sweetmeat, also made from cocoanut cream,
- which was baked into small brown balls like chocolates, each containing a
- lump of thickened cream inside. These were generally brought tied up in
- tiny square packets of green banana leaf. Small dumpy round puddings, made
- of native arrowroot, bananas, cocoanut, and sugar-cane juice, used also to
- be brought, tied up in the inevitable banana-leaf; and baked wild pigeon,
- tender and juicy, was another offering not at all unacceptable. As a
- typical millionaire, possessed of several dresses, change for some
- sovereigns, and countless tins of salmon, I was expected to give an
- occasional <i>quid pro quo</i>, which usually took the form of tinned fish
- or meat, and was much appreciated.
- </p>
- <p>
- I do not know how late it was, one night&mdash;the moon had been up for
- many hours, but no one seemed to want to go to bed&mdash;when I heard a
- sound of splashing and laughing from the brightly silvered lagoon beyond
- the belt of palms. I went out, and saw thirty or forty of the native women
- wading about in the shallow water inside the reef, catching fish. It
- looked interesting, so I shed an outer skirt or two, kilted up what
- remained, and ran down the white shelving beach, all pencilled with the
- feathery shadows of tossing palms, into the glassy knee-deep water. How
- warm it was! as hot as a tepid bath at home&mdash;how the gorgeous
- moonlight flashed back from the still lagoon, as from a huge silver
- shield! The whole place was as light as day; not as a Samoan day, which is
- too like the glare from an open furnace to be pleasant at all times, but
- at least, as light as a grey English afternoon.
- </p>
- <p>
- The girls, wearing only a small lava-lava, were wading in the water, some
- carrying a big, wide net made out of fine fibres beaten from the bark of a
- Samoan tree; others trailing two long fringes of plaited palm leaves,
- about a yard deep, and twenty or thirty yards long. These were drawn
- through the water about twenty yards apart, the girls walking along for a
- few minutes in two parallel rows, and then quickly bringing the ends of
- the palm fringes together in an open V shape. The net was placed across
- the narrow end of the V, and from the wide end two or three splashed
- noisily down the enclosed space, driving before them into the net all the
- little silvery fish who had been gathered together by the sudden closing
- in of the palm-leaf fringes. Then there was laughing and crying out,-and
- the moon shone down on a cluster of beautiful gold-bronze figures,
- graceful as statues, stretching out their small pretty hands and wild
- curly heads, diamond-gemmed with scattered drops of water, over the
- gathered-in net, now sparkling and quivering with imprisoned life. The
- captured fish were dropped into a plaited palm-leaf basket; and then the
- two lines of girls separated once more, and marched on through the warm
- silvery water, singing as they went.
- </p>
- <p>
- I think, though I do not know, that this simple sport (which was, after
- all, a necessary task as well) went on nearly all the night. The Samoan is
- not easily bored, and no one minds losing a night&rsquo;s rest, when there is
- all the hot day to doze on the mats. I gave up an hour or so, and returned
- to the guest-house, loaded with presents of fish. It was quite absurd, but
- I wanted to go to bed, silly inferior white person that I was! so I crept
- under my calico tent, and &ldquo;turned in,&rdquo; feeling amid the stir and chatter,
- the singing and wandering to and fro, of those moonlit small hours,
- exceedingly like a child that has to follow nurse and go to sleep, while
- all the grown-ups are still enjoying themselves downstairs.
- </p>
- <p>
- The night before I left for Apia once more, I bought my farewell presents
- at the solitary little store that was marooned away down on the beach at
- Falefa, and bore on its house front the mysterious legend&mdash;&ldquo;MISIMOA&rdquo;&mdash;all
- in one word&mdash;translatable as &ldquo;Mr. Moore!&rdquo; Advised by the trader&rsquo;s
- native wife, I got several lava-lavas for the old chief and his wife, also
- a &ldquo;Sunday frock&rdquo; piece of white muslin, and some lace, for Iva herself.
- Poor old Iva! she could not afford herself many clothes, being only a
- caretaker in the great house; and I had felt sorry for her when I saw her
- missionary-meeting frock&mdash;only an old blue print. All the Samoan
- women love to turn out in trade finery on Sundays, and a white muslin,
- with lace, made exactly like a British nightdress, is the height of
- elegance and good form. I gave Pula-Ulu, furthermore, a yellow shirt
- spotted with red horses; and as a final gift for Iva, I selected a large
- white English bath-towel, with crimson stripes and edge. This last I knew
- would certainly be Iva&rsquo;s best week-day visiting costume for some time to
- come.
- </p>
- <p>
- All these splendours I tied up in a brown paper parcel, and left on my
- portmanteau. Samoan etiquette is very strict about the giving and
- receiving of presents, and prescribes absolute ignorance, on the part of
- the recipient, of any such intention being about; but Iva could not resist
- pinching the parcel, and whispering&mdash;&ldquo;Misi! what &lsquo;sat?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Ki-ki, Iva,&rdquo; (food), I answered.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;You lie!&rdquo; said Iva delightedly, poking me in the ribs. She had no idea
- that she was not expressing herself with the most perfect elegance and
- courtesy; the Samoan tongue has no really rude words, and Samoans often do
- not realise the quality of our verbal unpolitenesses.
- </p>
- <p>
- Next morning, however, when my &ldquo;solofanua&rdquo; (animal that runs along the
- ground&mdash;>horse) was standing out under the bread-fruit trees, and all
- my goods had been tied about the saddle, till the venerable animal looked
- like nothing on earth but the White Knight&rsquo;s own horse&mdash;Iva and
- Pula-Ulu, bidding me good-bye with the utmost dignity, did not even glance
- at the parcels which I threw across the house, at their heads, narrowly
- escaping hitting their old grey hair. This was etiquette. In Samoa, a
- formal gift must be thrown high in the air at the recipient, so as to fall
- at his feet; and he must not pick it up at once, but simply say &ldquo;Fafekai&rdquo;
- (thank you) with a cold and unmoved accent, waiting until the giver is
- gone to examine the present. The inner meaning of the custom is the
- supposed worthlessness of the gift, when compared with the recipient&rsquo;s
- merits&mdash;it is mere rubbish, to be cast away&mdash;and the demeanour
- of the recipient himself is intended to suggest that in any case he is not
- eager for gifts.
- </p>
- <p>
- A long, hot ride of twenty miles back to Apia and civilisation filled up
- the day. The pendulum of Time, held back for a whole dreamy, lazy week,
- had begun to swing once more; and all day I worried about the hour I
- should get in. I was late for <i>table d&rsquo;hote</i>; I was met by a &ldquo;little
- bill&rdquo;; and the mail had come in since I left. Thus Apia welcomed me; and
- thus I &ldquo;took up the white man&rsquo;s burden&rdquo; once again.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Talofa!&rdquo; says a gentle yet insistent voice.
- </p>
- <p>
- It is only half-past six, and I am exceedingly sleepy, so I bury my face
- in the pillow, and try not to hear.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Talofa!&rdquo; (How do you do?), repeats the voice, a little louder, and my
- basket armchair creaks to the sudden drop of a substantial weight. I open
- my eyes, and see, through the dim mist of the mosquito-curtains, the
- taupo, Fangati, sitting beside my bed.
- </p>
- <p>
- Fangati is my &ldquo;flennie,&rdquo; and that means a good deal more in Samoa than the
- cold English word &ldquo;friend,&rdquo; from which if is derived. She attached herself
- to me upon my arrival in Apia, some weeks ago, and has ever since
- continued to indicate, in the gentle Samoan way, that she prefers my
- company to that of any other white woman on the island. There is nothing
- contrary to Samoan etiquette in her calling upon me at 6.30 a.m., for
- Samoa knows not times or seasons, save such as are pleasing to itself for
- the moment. If I were suffering from sleeplessness and went to call on
- Fangati at midnight, she would certainly awake, get up off her mat, take a
- fan in her hands, sit down cross-legged on the floor, ready to talk or
- yarn for the rest of the night&mdash;without the smallest surprise or
- discomposure. So, aspiring after the ideal of Samoan politeness, I feel
- bound to shake myself awake, and talk.
- </p>
- <p>
- Fangati is very much &ldquo;got up&rdquo; this morning. She is a chief&rsquo;s daughter, of
- high rank, and her wardrobe is an extensive one. To-day she has a short
- tunic of tappa (native cloth, beaten out of the bark of a paper mulberry
- tree), satiny brown in colour, and immensely pinked and fringed. This is
- worn over a lava-lava, or kilt, of purple trade print, reaching a little
- below her knees. Her beautiful pale brown arms (all Samoan women have
- exquisitely shaped arms) and small arched brown feet are bare. In her
- thick, wavy hair she has placed one large scarlet hibiscus flower, and
- there are three or four long necklaces round her neck, made of the crimson
- rind of a big scented berry, cut into curly strips. One of these, as a
- matter of common courtesy, she flings over my nightdress as we talk, and
- smiles sweetly at the brilliant effect achieved.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Ni&mdash;ice!&rdquo; says Fangati. She can speak quite a good deal of English,
- but she smooths and trims it prettily to suit her own taste, and the harsh
- language of the black North loses all its roughness on her lips.
- </p>
- <p>
- She has come to tell me that there will be dancing at the village of
- Mulinuu this afternoon, as it is the German Emperor&rsquo;s birthday, and a
- great many kegs of salt beef and boxes of biscuit have been given to the
- villages by the Government, to celebrate the day. (Not such a bad method
- of encouraging loyalty in a newly acquired colony, either.) There are to
- be some taupo dances, and Fangati will take a leading part. Therefore I
- must be certain to come and see my &ldquo;flennie&rdquo; perform. This matter settled,
- Fangati gets up and drifts to the washstand, tastes my cold cream and
- makes a face over it, points to a jug of cold tea and says &ldquo;You give?&rdquo;
- shares the luxury with her ancient chaperon, who is sitting on the
- doormat, and then melts away down the verandah, dreamily smoking a
- native-made cigarette.
- </p>
- <p>
- It is now time to explain what a taupo is, and why the dances to-day will
- be especially attractive. .
- </p>
- <p>
- Most Samoan villages possess a taupo, or mistress of the ceremonies, who
- has many duties, and many privileges as well. She is always young, pretty,
- and well-born, being usually the daughter of a high chief. She remains
- unmarried during her term of office, which may last for many years, or for
- only a few months. The propriety of her conduct is guaranteed by the
- constant presence of certain old women, who always accompany her on visits
- or journeys. Sometimes her train is increased by the addition of a dwarf
- or a cripple, who seems to act a part somewhat similar to that of a
- mediaeval court fool. Her duties oblige her to receive and entertain all
- guests or travellers who pass through her village; to make kava (the
- universal drink of the Pacific islands) for them, welcome them to the
- guest-house, which is a part of every Samoan settlement, and dance for
- their amusement. She is treated with royal honours by the villagers,
- always handsomely clothed, and luxuriously fed on pig and chicken, and
- never required to do any hard work, while the other girls have to be
- content with taro-root and bread-fruit, and are obliged to work in the
- fields, carry water, and fish on the reef in the burning tropic sun. When
- there is a festival, she takes the principal part in the dances; and when
- the tribes are at war (as occasionally happens even to-day) the taupo,
- dressed as a warrior, marches out with the ceremonial parade of the
- troops, and acts as a <i>vivandière</i> during the fight, carrying water
- to the soldiers, and bringing ammunition when required. This duty is not
- one of the safest, for, although no Samoan warrior knowingly fires on any
- woman, much less on a taupo, stray bullets take no account of persons, and
- many a beautiful young &ldquo;Maid of the Village,&rdquo; in times past, has justified
- her warrior dress by meeting with a soldier&rsquo;s death.
- </p>
- <p>
- Well-mannered as all Samoan women are, the taupo is especially noted for
- the elegance of her demeanour. My &ldquo;flennie&rsquo;s&rdquo; bearing reminds me oddly at
- times of the manner of a London great lady, accustomed to constant
- receiving, and become in consequence almost mechanically &ldquo;gracious.&rdquo; She
- never moves abruptly; her speech is calm and self-possessed, and her
- accent soft and <i>traînant</i>. There are, however, taupos and taupos.
- Vao, who lives just across the way, is by way of being an &ldquo;advanced
- woman.&rdquo; She plays native cricket in a man&rsquo;s singlet and a kilt, dances a
- knife dance that tries the nerves of every one that looks on, wears her
- hair short and is exceedingly independent, and a little scornful. Vao does
- not want to marry she says; but I have an idea, all the same, that if just
- the right sort of young chief came along, with just the irresistible
- number of baskets of food (these take the place of bouquets and chocolate
- boxes among Samoan wooers), Vao would renounce her dignity of taupo just
- as readily as other Maids of the Village have done when Mr. Right
- appeared. On her wedding day she would dance her last dance for the
- villagers, according to immemorial custom, and thenceforward live the
- quiet home-life of the Samoan wife and mother, all the footlights out, all
- the admiring audience gone, and only the little coral-carpeted,
- brown-roofed cottage with its small home duties and quiet home affections
- left.
- </p>
- <p>
- Then there is the taupo Fuamoa&mdash;but of her more anon, as the
- Victorian novelist used to say.
- </p>
- <p>
- Early in the afternoon, when the sun was at its very hottest&mdash;and
- what that heat can be, at 130 south, in the height of the hot season, let
- Pacific travellers say&mdash;I made my way down to Mulinuu under a big
- umbrella, and took my place on the mats laid to accommodate the
- spectators. The dancing was in full swing. A long row of young men,
- dressed in short kilts of many-coloured bark strips&mdash;red, pink,
- green, yellow, purple&mdash;and decked out with anklets of green creepers
- and necklaces of big scarlet berries, which looked just like enormous
- coral beads, were twirling and pirouetting, retreating, advancing, and
- waving their arms, in wonderfully perfect time. The Samoan, man or woman,
- is born with a metronome concealed somewhere in his or her works, to all
- appearance. Certainly the exquisite sense of time and movement displayed
- in children&rsquo;s games, grown-up dances, and all the songs of the people,
- seems almost supernatural, as the result of unaided impulse.
- </p>
- <p>
- The arms and hands play a remarkable part in the dance. Every finger is
- made a means of expression, and the simultaneous fluttering and waving of
- the arms of an entire <i>corps-de-ballet</i> can be compared to nothing
- but the petals of a bed of flowers, sent hither and thither by a
- capricious wind.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is no instrumental music, for the Samoans&mdash;strange to say, for
- a music-loving people&mdash;have no instruments at all, unless one may
- count the occasional British mouth-organ. But the sonorous, full-voiced
- chanting of the chorus that sits cross-legged on the grass at a little
- distance, leaves nothing to be desired in the way of orchestra. A
- favourite tune, which one is sure to hear at every Samoan dance-meeting or
- &ldquo;siva&rdquo; is the following, commenced with a loud &ldquo;Ai, ai!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- It is first sung very slowly, and gradually increased in speed until the
- dancers give up in despair.&rsquo; &lsquo;The faster they have danced before giving
- in, the louder is the applause.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0043" id="linkimage-0043"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0312.jpg" alt="0312 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0312.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- By-and-by the men conclude their dance, and retire, loudly clapped, and
- followed by cries of &ldquo;Malo! malo!&rdquo; (well done). A short interval follows.
- The many-coloured crowd seated on the grass fans itself, smokes
- cigarettes, and chatters; the dry palm-fronds rustle in the burning sky
- overhead, harshly mimicking the cool whisper of forest leaves in gentler
- climes. Suddenly six handsome young men, splendidly decorated, their brown
- skins satiny with&rsquo; rubbing of perfumed cocoanut-oil, rush into the middle
- of the green, and in the midst comes a seventh, smaller, slighter, and
- handsomer than the rest. What a beautiful youth! almost too young, one
- would have thought, for the smart black moustache that curves above his
- upper lip&mdash;wonderfully active, supple, and alive in every movement&mdash;a
- skin like brown Lyons silk, limbs&mdash;&mdash; Why, it is a girl! the
- taupo Fuâmoa, dressed (or rather undressed) as a Samoan warrior, and full
- to the brim of mischief, sparkle, and fun. She wears a fringe of coloured
- bark-strips round her waist, and a very big kilt of scarlet and white
- striped cotton underneath. The rest of her attire consists of a necklace
- of whale&rsquo;s teeth inestimably valuable, a string of red berries, and a tall
- helmet, or busby, apparently made of brilliant yellow fur. Her exquisitely
- moulded figure is as Nature made it, save for a rubbing of cocoanut-oil,
- that only serves to bring out the full beauty of every curving line.
- Strange to say, the black-painted moustache is wonderfully becoming, so
- too is the imposing helmet; and does not Fuamoa know it? and is not she
- saucy, and dainty, and kitten-like, as she frisks and plays in the centre
- of the dance, making the prettiest of eyes at the audience, and flashing
- her white teeth delightedly under the wicked little black moustache? She
- is a celebrated dancer, being only surpassed on the island by one other
- taupo&mdash;Vao, who is not appearing to-day. You would never think, as
- her little brown feet twinkle over the grass, and her statuesque brown
- arms wave above her head, while the merry smile ceaselessly comes and
- goes, that Fuamoa is suffering positive agonies all the time, from the
- splendid war-helmet that adorns her head; yet that is the truth. One must
- indeed suffer to be beautiful, as a Samoan taupo. Before the helmet is put
- on, the girl&rsquo;s long thick hair is drawn up to the top of her head, and
- twisted as tightly as strong arms can twist it, so that her very eyebrows
- are pulled out of place, and every hair is a separate torture. Then the
- great helmet is fastened on as firmly as a rock, with countless tight
- cords, and the dancer is ready for her part, with a scalp on fire and a
- torturing headache, which will certainly last until she can take the cruel
- decoration off.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0044" id="linkimage-0044"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0315.jpg" alt="0315 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0315.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- There are several taupo dances this afternoon, but only two of the girls
- have the courage to wear the helmet. Fangati, my little &ldquo;flennie,&rdquo; frankly
- confesses that she cannot stand it. &ldquo;He made me cly-y-y! too much!&rdquo; she
- says, and shows me the pretty wreath of crimson berry peelings and green
- leaves that is to adorn her own curly head.
- </p>
- <p>
- These helmets, it may be noted, are not made of fur, as one might suppose
- at a first glance. The material is human hair, cut from the head of a
- Samoan girl, and dyed bright yellow with lime. In time of war, it is a
- common thing for a girl to offer up her beautiful tresses to make a helmet
- for father, husband, or lover; and the wearer of such a gift is as proud
- as a knight of Arthur&rsquo;s Round Table may have been, bearing on his crest
- his lady&rsquo;s little pearl-broidered glove.
- </p>
- <p>
- It is Fangati&rsquo;s turn to dance now, and out she trips, wearing a valuable
- mat of the finest plait, her pretty wreath, countless scarlet necklaces,
- and a modest girdle of coloured silk. Fangati has the prettiest foot and
- hand in Apia, and she is a dainty little dancer&mdash;not so marvellously
- agile and spirited as Fuamoa, and with much less of &ldquo;devil&rdquo; in her
- composition, but a pretty and a pleasant creature to watch. She has
- reached the twenties, and gone nearly half-way through them, so that she
- is in a fair way to become an old maid, according to Samoan ideas; but she
- still retains her maiden state, and declares she will not marry, in spite
- of good offers from several chiefs. It is said in Apia that she is proud,
- and wishes to marry a white man&mdash;which is much as if a charming
- English country girl should determine to mate with nothing less than a
- duke. Country lasses do marry dukes, but not often; and there is not much
- more chance of my &ldquo;flennie&rsquo;s&rdquo; attaining her ambition, unless Providence is
- very kind.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0045" id="linkimage-0045"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0433.jpg" alt="0433 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0433.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0046" id="linkimage-0046"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0438.jpg" alt="0438 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0438.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- The ordinary Samoan is obliged to do a little work now and then, since yam
- patches must be cultivated, breadfruit plucked and cooked, banana and
- arrowroot puddings made, fish caught, nets woven, houses built and
- repaired. But all in all there is not much to do, and the real business of
- life in Samoa is amusement. <i>Le monde où l&rsquo;on s&rsquo;amuse</i>, for most
- people means a certain circle of London and Paris; but for all who have
- travelled in the South Seas, it means, once and for all, Samoa.
- </p>
- <p>
- The taupo is of course at the head and front of every diversion, for,
- little as the other people have to do, she has less, having nothing at
- all. A day at Papaseea is one of her favourite delights. During my stay in
- Samoa one of these pleasant native picnics was organised for me, and I set
- off on a lovely morning for the &ldquo;Sliding Rock,&rdquo; accompanied by fifteen
- native and half-caste girls, stowed away in six buggies. It was a long
- drive in the burning sun, and afterwards a long rough walk through the
- bush, among wild pineapples, scarlet hibiscus, tall, creamy-flowered,
- pungent, scented ginger-bushes, red-fruited cacao, quaint mammee-apple
- trees, mangoes, Pacific chestnuts, and countless other strange tropic
- growths. Hot and tired as we all were, the Papaseea rock, when we reached
- it, seemed a perfect Paradise.
- </p>
- <p>
- Imagine a deep gorge in the heart of green, heavily-wooded hills; at the
- bottom, a narrow channel shaded by overhanging trees, where the pure
- mountain water runs clear and cold and deep, amber-brown pools quiver at
- the foot of white plunging falls&mdash;one only some seven feet high, the
- other a good thirty. This last was the Sliding Rock, over which we were
- all going to fling ourselves <i>à la</i> Sappho by-and-by, only with less
- melancholy consequences. It looked formidable enough, and when Pangati and
- the others, with cries of delight, pulled off their dresses, wound white
- and pink and green cotton lava-lavas over one shoulder, and round from
- waist to knee, crowned themselves picturesquely with woven fern-leaves,
- and plunged shrieking over the fall, I began to wish I had not come, or
- coming, had not promised to &ldquo;slide.&rdquo; However, there was no help for it, so
- I got into my English bathing-dress, which excited peals of merry
- laughter, because of its &ldquo;continuations,&rdquo; waded down the stream, and
- sitting in the rush of the water, held tightly on to a rock at each side,
- and looked over my own toes at the foaming, roaring thirty feet drop.
- </p>
- <p>
- It was all over in a minute. Just an unclasping of unwilling hands from
- the safe black rocks, a fierce tug from the tearing stream, an exceedingly
- unpleasant instant when one realised that there was no going back now at
- any price, and that the solid earth had slipped away as it does in the
- ghastly drop of a nightmare dream; then nothing in the world but a long
- loud roar, and a desperate holding of the breath, while the helpless body
- shot down to the bottom of the deep brown pool and up again&mdash;and at
- last, the warm air of heaven filling one&rsquo;s grateful lungs in big gasps, as
- one reached the surface, and swam across to the other side of the pool,
- firmly resolved on no account to do it again, now that it was over.
- </p>
- <p>
- It was pleasant, afterwards, to sit among the rocks above the fall, and
- watch one after another of the native and half-caste girls&mdash;including
- a very charming and highly educated half-American, who had been to college
- in San Francisco, and to smart society dances in Samoa&mdash;rush madly
- over the fall, leaving behind them as they went a long, loud yell, like
- the whistle of a train going into a tunnel. One native girl daringly went
- down head first; another, standing incautiously near the edge of the fall,
- lost her balance, and simply sat down on the pool below, dropping through
- the air with arms and legs outspread like a starfish. Fangati seized a
- friend in her arms and tumbled over the verge with her, in a perfect
- Catherine wheel of revolving limbs. It was hours before the riotous party
- grew tired, and even then, only the sight of large green leaves being laid
- out on the stones, and palm-leaf baskets being opened, brought them out of
- the water, and got them into their little sleeveless tunics and gracefully
- draped kilts. By this time, the pretty Samoan-American&rsquo;s mother had laid
- out the &ldquo;ki-ki&rdquo;&mdash;baked fowl and pig, taro-root, yams, bananas,
- pineapples, guavas, European delicacies such as cake and pies, and native
- dainties, including the delicious <i>palusami</i>, of which I have spoken
- before. The drinking cocoanuts had been husked and opened by the boy who
- brought the food, and there they stood among the stones, rows of rough
- ivory cups, lined with smooth ivory jelly of the young soft meat, and
- filled with fresh sweet water, such as is never to be tasted out of the
- cocoanut-land. Our plates were sections of green banana-leaf; our forks
- were our fingers. And when every one had fed, and felt happy and lazy, we
- all lay among the rocks above the fall, in the green shadow of the trees,
- and did nothing whatever till evening. Then we climbed back to the road,
- and drove home, six buggies full of laughing brown and white humanity,
- crowned and wreathed with green ferns, and singing the sweet, sad song of
- Samoa&mdash;&ldquo;Good-bye, my flennie&rdquo;&mdash;the song that was written by a
- native only a few years ago, and has already become famous over the whole
- Pacific. It is the farewell song of every island lover, the melody that
- soars above the melancholy rattling of the anchor chains on every
- outward-bound schooner that spreads her white wings upon the breast of the
- great South Seas. And for those who have known the moonlight nights of
- those enchanted shores, have smelt the frangipani flower, and listened to
- the soft singing girls in the endless, golden afternoons, and watched the
- sun go down upon an empty, sailless sea, behind the weird pandanus and
- drooping palms&mdash;the sweet song of the islands will ring in the heart
- for ever. In London rush and rain and gloom, in the dust and glitter of
- fevered Paris, in the dewy cold green woods of English country homes, the
- Samoan air will whisper, calling, calling, calling&mdash;back to the
- murmur of the palms, and&rsquo; the singing of the coral reef, and the purple
- tropic night once more.
- </p>
- <h3>
- &ldquo;GOOD-BYE, MY FLENNIE.&rdquo;
- </h3>
- <p>
- (Song, with Samoan words, English beginning to each verse.)
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0047" id="linkimage-0047"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0317.jpg" alt="0317 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0317.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0015" id="link2HCH0015"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER XV
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>Southward to New Zealand&mdash;Into the Hot-Water Country&mdash;Coaching
- Days come back&mdash;The Early Victorian Inn&mdash;The Fire and Snow of
- Ruapehu&mdash;A Hotel run wild&mdash;Hot Lakes and Steaming Rivers&mdash;The
- Devil&rsquo;s Trumpet&mdash;The Valley of the Burning Fountains&mdash;Waking up
- the Champagne Lake.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">O</span>F the other island
- groups that I visited during that pleasant year or two of wandering&mdash;strange
- Fiji, exquisite Norfolk Island, the wicked, unknown New Hebrides&mdash;I
- have told elsewhere. But before the great P. &amp; O. liner carried me
- away from Sydney on the well-known track across the seas to England and
- home, I had a journey through New Zealand that was second to nothing in
- the world, for pure enjoyment, but the unsurpassable Islands themselves.
- </p>
- <p>
- New Zealand is not yet fully opened up&mdash;that was what the geography
- books said in my school days. The saying, like most geography-book
- information, slipped through my mind easily, and did not create any marked
- impression. The marked impression came later, when I went half round the
- world to see New Zealand, and discovered that I could not take train to
- just anywhere I chose. It seemed incredible, in a country as highly
- civilised as France or Germany, that coaches&mdash;not the ornamental
- tourist brand, run as an accompaniment to railways, but real Early
- Victorian coaches, with &ldquo;no frills on them&rdquo; of any sort or kind&mdash;were
- the only means of transit, save boats, to a great part of the famous hot
- lake and river district of the North Island. One could go to Rotorua, the
- most remarkable collection of geysers and hot lakes, direct by rail from
- Auckland. But the lovely Wanganui River, the beautiful up-country bush,
- and whole duchies of hot-water and mud-volcano land, could only be &ldquo;done&rdquo;
- by coach and boat.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0048" id="linkimage-0048"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0447.jpg" alt="0447 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0447.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- This made the journey more interesting, on the whole, though it was a
- little amazing at first to leave the railway far behind, and strike out
- right into the early nineteenth century. One should have worn side-curls,
- a spencer, and a poke bonnet, instead of the ordinary tourist coat and
- skirt and useful straw hat, to feel quite in character with the
- mud-splashed coach, its six insides, two outsides, and four struggling,
- straining horses; the days of wind and shower, the hurried meals eaten at
- lonely little wayside inns, and the nights spent in strange barrack-like,
- barn-like places, where the stable was of more importance than the house,
- and every one always arose and fled like a ghost at the early dawn of day.
- </p>
- <p>
- But first, after the railway town and railway hotel were left behind, came
- Wanganui River, a whole day of it; nearly sixty miles of exquisite
- loveliness, viewed in perfect comfort from the canopied deck of a river
- steamer. The Wanganui has been called New Zealand&rsquo;s Rhine, but it no more
- resembles the Rhine than it resembles a garden-party or an ostrich farm.
- It has nothing whatever in common with Germany&rsquo;s great historic river but
- its beauty; and the beauty of the Wanganui is of an order very far indeed
- removed from that of the ancient castle-crowned streams of Europe, which
- are strewn with records of dead and decaying æons of human life. Solitude,
- stillness, absolute, deathly loneliness are the keynotes of Wanganui
- scenery. Shut in by fold on fold of great green mountain peaks, scarp on
- scarp of fern-wreathed precipice, one can almost fancy that the swift
- little paddle-steamer is churning her way for the first time into
- solitudes never seen of man. Now and then a Maori dug-out canoe, long and
- thin and upturned at the ends, may be sighted riding under the willows, or
- gliding down-stream to the swift paddle-strokes of its dusky-faced
- occupant. At rare intervals, too, the spell of silent lonelinesses broken
- by the sight of some tiny river-side settlement perched on a great green
- height&mdash;half a dozen wooden houses, and a tin-roofed church; the
- whole being labelled, with some extraordinarily pretentious name. One of
- our passengers that day got in at London, and went on to Jerusalem;
- another was booked from Nazareth to Athens!
- </p>
- <p>
- All New Zealanders are <i>not</i> Maories, despite the hazy ideas as to
- colour which exist at home. There is a little trifle of nine hundred
- thousand full-blooded white settlers, to compare with the few thousand
- native Maories still left, in the land they once owned from sea, to sea.
- Still, the Maori in New Zealand is an unmistakable fact, and a most
- picturesque fact into the bargain. To see a family taking deck passage on
- the boat&mdash;handsome dark-eyed women, with rosy cheeks in spite of
- their olive skins, and beautifully waved black hair; bright elfish little
- children; dogs and cats and a sack or two for luggage&mdash;: is an
- interesting spot in the day&rsquo;s experience, especially when some patronising
- passenger, accustomed to &ldquo;natives&rdquo; in other countries, gets one of the
- delightful set-downs the Maori can give so effectively. For all their
- shapeless clothing and heavy blankets, hatless heads and tattooed lips and
- chins, the New Zealand Maories are very much &ldquo;all there&rdquo;; and when the
- patronising saloon passenger struts up to one, and remarks: &ldquo;Tenakoe
- (good-day), Polly! You got ums nicey little fellow there, eh?&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Polly&rdquo; will probably reply in excellent English: &ldquo;My name happens to be
- Te Rangi, not Polly; and as for the child you are referring to, I believe
- it belongs to the lady in the yellow plaid sitting aft!&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- At the end of the day comes an hotel, standing on a wooded cliff above the
- river, and looking down upon a long lovely stretch of winding water and
- high-piled forest. The night is spent here, and in the morning comes the
- coach, with its team of four fine satin-skinned bays, its many-coated
- driver, its portmanteaux on the roof, mysterious little parcels in the
- &ldquo;boot,&rdquo; and confidential letters in coachman&rsquo;s hat, for all the world like
- something in Charles Dickens. There is no bugle and no guard, and the
- coach itself is a high, long-legged, spidery thing enough, not even
- painted red, and though it is &ldquo;Merry Christmas&rdquo; time, it is a warm summer
- day, with some prospect of thundery rain, but not the faintest of any
- typical Dickensesque Christmas weather. Still, the sentiment is there, so
- one may as well make the most of it.
- </p>
- <p>
- All day, muddy roads and straining horses; all day, a long pull up-hill;
- half the day rain in the wet lovely bush, starring and sparkling the
- exquisite tree ferns, those fine ladies of the forest; crystal-dropping
- the thick coat of ferns that tapestries the tall cliffs, shutting in our
- road. Beneath the wheel curve innumerable black-green gorges, deep and
- dark as Hades, gurgling in their mysterious depths with unseen
- full-throated streams and half-glimpsed waterfalls. About and above us
- rises the impenetrable &ldquo;bush&rdquo;&mdash;tall green trees, feathery, cedary,
- ferny, flowery, set as close together as the spires of moss on a
- velvet-cushioned stone, shutting out half the sky; marking off an
- unmistakable frontier between the territory of still unconquered Nature
- and the regions wrested from her by toiling Man. Wood-pigeons flash their
- blue-grey wings across the valleys; the merry mournful <i>tui</i> flutes
- &ldquo;piercing sweet by the river,&rdquo; undisturbed by our rattling wheels. There
- are wild creatures in plenty, further back in the bush&mdash;wild boars,
- wild cattle, wild cats, and &ldquo;dingoes&rdquo; or dogs&mdash;all originally escaped
- from civilisation, but now as wild as their own savage ancestors. The
- feathery bracken, that carpets all the banks by the wayside, was, and
- indeed still is, a staple food of the Maories. Its young roots are
- excellent eating, being rather like asparagus, and reasonably nourishing
- when nothing better can be had&mdash;and the white-flowered tea-tree&mdash;one
- of the tree-heath family&mdash;-has often furnished a &ldquo;colourable
- imitation&rdquo; of China tea, to the benighted bush-wanderer run out of the
- genuine leaf. This bush about us is all Maori land. Maories alone can find
- their way easily and safely through its pathless mysteries. No, there is
- no avoiding the Maori, anywhere in the North Island!
- </p>
- <p>
- Dinner, warm and grateful and unspeakably comforting, is met with at a
- little inn in a little settlement whose name (of course) begins with Wai.
- The towns in North New Zealand that do not begin with Wai begin with Roto.
- There are a few others, but they hardly count. We are all amazingly
- cheerful when we issue forth warmed and fed; and the cold wind that is
- beginning to blow down from the icy mountain peaks just out of sight, is
- encountered&rsquo; without any British-tourist grumbling. The driver explains
- that the wind ought not to be so cold&mdash;never is in December (the New
- Zealand June); but somehow, this is &ldquo;a most exceptional season,&rdquo; and there
- has been a lot of rain and cold that they don&rsquo;t generally have. Across
- twelve thousand miles of sea my mind leaps back to home; I feel the raspy
- air of the English spring nipping my face, and hear the familiar music of
- the sweet old English lie about the weather. It is a dear home-like lie,
- and makes me feel that New Zealand is indeed what it claims to be&mdash;the
- Britain of the Southern Cross.
- </p>
- <p>
- The effect of dinner is wearing off, and the insides are saying things
- about the weather that make a lonely wanderer like myself long to clasp
- the speakers warmly by the hand&mdash;because they sound so English. Now I
- understand what puzzled me a good deal at first&mdash;the difference
- between the Americanised, Continentalised Australians and the perfectly
- British New Zealander. The Briton cannot retain his peculiar
- characteristic in a climate like that of Australia; deprived of his
- natural and national grumble about the changeable weather, he is like a
- dog without a bark&mdash;an utterly anomalous being, But the New Zealand
- climate is windy and showery, given to casting autumn in the lap of spring
- and throwing winter into the warm, unexpecting arms of summer. So the
- Briton of the South, settled among his familiar weather &ldquo;samples,&rdquo; remains
- like the Briton of the North; and the travelling Englishman or
- Englishwoman, visiting New Zealand, feels more entirely at home than in
- any other quarter of the globe. It is only fair to New Zealand, however,
- to add that the average summer, beginning in December, is at worst very
- much warmer and pleasanter than the English spring or winter, and at best,
- a season of real delight.
- </p>
- <p>
- Late and dark and cold is the evening when we rattle up to the
- accommodation house planted in a strange desert spot, where the night is
- to be passed. Another coach comes in and discharges its load by-and-by.
- The Dickensonian flavour increases, as we of the earlier coach sit round
- the great ingle-nook fire of blazing logs in the coffee-room, silently
- surveying the new comers, while they shed their many wraps and crowd about
- the blaze. To how many Early Victorian tales&mdash;Dickens, Bulwer Lytton,
- G. P. R. James&mdash;have not the lonely inn and the late arriving guest
- been the familiar commencement!
- </p>
- <p>
- But the three Maories, man and two women, alighting from the coach and
- taking their place in the warm room, break through the illusion of
- Victorian romance at a touch, as a passing figure breaks through a
- gossamer cobweb stretched across a furzy path. Even G. P. R. could have
- had no dealings with those tall bundled-up, black-eyed, self-possessed
- beings from the bush. He would have turned them out in despair, or turned
- himself out, and gone back to his mysterious, Spanish-complexioned
- gentlemen in furred riding-cloaks.
- </p>
- <p>
- A nipping early morning sees us off at seven o&rsquo;clock; the discontented
- innkeeper, with (apparently) a dark crime on his conscience, seeing us go
- with obvious relief. It is too evident that like rather many backwoods
- hotelkeepers, he regards the harmless necessary traveller in the
- unflattering light of &ldquo;the pig that pays the rint.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- Ruapehu&rsquo;s giant cone, covered with dazzling snow, soars 3,000 feet into
- heaven above us. We are high up ourselves, for we pass the 4,000 foot
- level later on, rather cold and cross, and inclined to regard the little
- flag of hot smoke creeping out of the crest of Ngaurhoe, a smaller volcano
- ahead, as the most desirable thing in nature. Brumbies (wild horses) skim
- the plains below us, quick-moving little dots of black against the
- buff-colour of river valleys and fiats of sand. &ldquo;There&rsquo;s a fellow hunting
- those at present,&rdquo; volunteers the driver&mdash;&ldquo;catches and breaks them,
- and gets thirty shillings apiece for them for youngsters to ride to
- school. The kids must have something, you know, and the brumbies are wiry
- little brutes.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- No one walks on two legs in New Zealand, apparently. I recollect a picture
- that the coach passed only yesterday evening&mdash;a man on horseback, and
- two dogs, fetching home a cow and her calf from a pasture a quarter of a
- mile away from the homestead. In England the whole outfit of man, horse,
- and dogs would have been represented by one small child with a pinafore
- and a stick. Other countries, other manners.
- </p>
- <p>
- One o&rsquo;clock, forty-two miles out, with a stop for a fresh team; and we now
- enter a valley where we are met by the strange sight of a puff of steam
- rising from a bushy dell, and a little river that glides along with smoky
- vapours curling up from its surface. We are in the hot-water country at
- last; this is Tokaanu, and from here to Rotorua, ninety miles away, the
- earth is dotted, every now and then, with boiling springs, erupting
- geysers, hot lakes, and warm rivers. In all this country you need never
- light a fire to cook, unless you choose; never heat water to wash your
- pots and pans, or to bath yourself. The Maories, and many of the whites,
- steam all their food instead of boiling or baking it; and as for hot
- baths, an army might enjoy them all day long.
- </p>
- <p>
- The valley is warm and pleasant; Lake Taupo lies before us, thirty miles
- long, wide and blue and beautiful as the sea, sentinelled by tall peaks of
- dazzling white and purest turquoise, and all embroidered about the shores
- with gold braiding of splendid <i>Planta Genista</i> scattered in groves
- and hedges of surpassing richness. Three hours in a tiny steamer brings
- us, To the othér side; and here, the sights of the hot-water country
- fairly begin.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Spa Hotel, at Taupo (where one passes the night and as many days as
- one has time for), is a museum; an exhibition, and very-good joke, all in
- itself. One might fairly describe it as hashed hotel, served up with
- excellent sauce. You find bits of it lost in a wilderness of rose and
- rhododendron, at the end of a garden path; half a dozen bedrooms, run away
- all along among the honeysuckles to play hide-and-seek; a drawing-room
- isolated like a lighthouse in a sea of greenery; a dining-room that was
- once a Maori assembly-house, and is a miracle of wildly grotesque
- carvings, representing, the weirdest of six-foot goblin figures, eyed and
- toothed; with pearl-shell, and carved in the highest of alto relievo, all
- down the walls. White sand pathways, run, between, the various fragments
- of the hotel; a hot stream, breathing curly vapour as it goes, meanders,
- about the grounds, captured here and there in deep wooden ponds, under
- rustic roofs, or hemmed in by walls and concealing trees, to make the most
- attractive of baths. There is sulphur, and soda and free sulphuric acid in
- these, waters; one spring, welling up all by itself, has iodine. For
- rheumatism, skin diseases, and many blood diseases, these constantly
- running pools are almost a certain cure. It seems a shocking waste of
- golden opportunities to let this chance go by without being healed of
- something; but I can only collect, a cold in the head, a grazed ankle, and
- a cracked lip, to meet the occasion&mdash;of all which evils the baths at
- once relieve me, offering in their place an appetite which must seriously
- impair my popularity with the proprietress, though I am bound to say she
- hides her feelings nobly.
- </p>
- <p>
- There is a celebrated &ldquo;porridge pot,&rdquo; or mud volcano, near this hotel. I
- have not time to see it; therefore I leave it with gentle reproaches
- ringing in my ears, and hints to the effect that I shall be haunted on my
- deathbed by unavailing regret. But I meet the Waikato River directly
- after, and at once forget everything else. Never anywhere on this earth,
- except in the hues of a peacock&rsquo;s breast shining in the sun, have I seen
- such a marvellous blue-green colour as that of this deep, gem-like,
- splendid stream. And the golden broom on its banks, the golden broom on
- the heights, the golden broom everywhere&mdash;bushes eight and ten feet
- high, all one molten flame of burning colour, with never a leaf to be seen
- under the conflagration of riotous blossom&mdash;what is the English
- broom, or the English gorse, compared to this?
- </p>
- <p>
- All the six miles to Wairakei, we follow the Waikato River; watch it sink
- into a deep green gorge; break into splendid foam and spray down a
- magnificent fall, that alone might make the fortune of any hotel in a less
- richly dowered country; wind underneath colossal tree-clad cliffs, in
- coils and streaks of the strange emerald-blue that is the glory of the
- river, and finally bend away towards the Arateatea Rapids. Another hotel
- built after the charming fashion of the Taupo hostelry, receives the coach
- occupants. The style of architecture sets one thinking. Where, twenty
- years ago, did out-of-the-way New Zealand light upon the &ldquo;pavilion&rdquo;
- system, that is the very latest fancy of all modern-built sanatoria? Has
- the liability to occasional small earthquake tremors anything to do with
- it? Whatever the cause may be, the result is that the fresh-air system is
- in full swing in nearly all the New Zealand thermal resorts; that doors
- and windows are always open, paths take the place of passages, and
- everybody acquires the complexion of a milkmaid and the appetite of a
- second-mate.
- </p>
- <p>
- The hot outdoor swimming bath is a toy with which one really cannot stop
- playing. It is something so new and so amusing to dive into a bath 90 feet
- long and 102 deg. Fahrenheit as to heat; swim about like marigolds in
- broth, in a temperature that would cook an egg in a few minutes, and all
- the time see the exquisite weeping willows wave overhead, the tall grasses
- stand on the bank, the wild clematis tremble in the trees above the pool.
- After the hot dip, one steps over a partition into another bathful of cool
- spring water, only 68° in heat, to cool down; and then comes dressing in a
- little bath-box (shut off from the grounds, like all the bath, by a high
- board fence), followed by a two minutes&rsquo; walk back to the house. But
- again, when night comes on, and the moon silvers the weeping willows to
- the semblance of pale frost-foliage on an icy pane, and the dim
- wraith-like vapours of the pool float up in ghostly shapes and shadows
- about the darkness of the inner boughs, one is tempted to come down once
- more, gliding hurriedly through the chill night air to the pool, locking
- the door, and floating for an hour or more in the dim, warm, drowsy
- waters. Cold? No one ever gets cold from the thermal waters, even if the
- cool dip is left out. That is one of their chiefest charms.
- </p>
- <p>
- With the morning, I am informed that life will not be worth living to me
- any more, if I do not see the Geyser Canon. Some one declares that it is
- the most beautiful sight in New Zealand; some one else says that it
- frightens you most delightfully, in the safest possible way; and &ldquo;one low
- churl, compact of thankless earth,&rdquo; says that it is extremely instructive.
- This last calumny I must at once deny. Interesting, to the deepest degree,
- the Wairakei Geysers are; suggestive also beyond any other geological
- phenomena in New Zealand; but instructive, after the tedious
- scientific-evenings fashion of our childhood, they are not. They are too
- beautiful for that, and too fascinating. One ought, no doubt, to absorb a
- great deal of geological information during the tour of the valley, but
- one is so busy having a good time that one doesn&rsquo;t. Which is exactly as it
- should be.
- </p>
- <p>
- Coming round the corner of the path that leads to the geysers, one sees a
- column of white steam rising over the shoulder of the hill, among the
- greenery of tea-tree and willow, exactly like the blowing-off steam of
- some railway engine, waiting at a station. It is indeed an engine that is
- blowing off steam; but the engine is rather a big one&mdash;nothing less,
- indeed, than that admirable piece of work, Mother Earth herself. Ingle,
- the guide, now comes out of a tin-roofed cottage at the entrance to the
- valley, and starts to show us the wonders of the place.
- </p>
- <p>
- Now be it known that Mr. Ingle is a very remarkable character, and second
- only to the geysers themselves, as a phenomenon of singular interest. He
- is one of the very few men in the world who know all about geysers, and
- quite the only one who can literally handle and work&rsquo; them. Ingle knows
- how to doctor a sick geyser as well as any stableman can doctor a horse;
- he can induce it to erupt, keep it from doing so, or make it erupt after
- his fashion, and not after its own. He is the author of at least two
- scientific discoveries of some importance, combining the effects of steam
- pressure on rocks and the incidence of volcanoes along certain thermal
- lines. In fact, what Ingle does not know about the interior of the earth,
- and the doings down there, is not worth knowing; and he tells us much of
- it as he takes us over the canon. Instructive? Certainly not. It is all
- gossip about volcanoes and geysers&mdash;personal, interesting, slightly
- scandalous gossip (because the behaviour of some of them, at times, and
- the tempers they exhibit, <i>are</i> simply scandalous); but not
- &ldquo;instructive&rdquo;; assuredly not.
- </p>
- <p>
- The average tourist likes to have every sight named&mdash;romantically or
- comically named, if possible&mdash;and his tastes have been fully
- considered in the Geyser Canon. I am not going to quote the guide-book
- titles of the dozen or two thermal wonders exhibited by Ingle. Staircases
- of pink silica, with hot water running down them; boiling pools of white
- fuller&rsquo;s earth, with miniature volcanoes and geysers pock-marked all over
- them: sapphire-coloured ponds, where one can see fifty feet of scalding
- depths; the great Wairakei Geyser, casting up huge fountains of boiling
- steam and spray every seven minutes; twin geysers living in one pool of
- exquisite creamy stalactites, and erupting every four minutes with the
- punctuality of a watch; geysers that throb exactly like the paddles of a
- steamer, or beat like the pulse of an engine; geysers that throw up great
- white balls of steam through crystal funnels of hot water; geysers that
- cast themselves bodily out of their beds at regular intervals, leaving you
- with exactly nine minutes in which to scramble down the hot wet rock of
- the funnel, stagger through the blinding steam that rises from the rents
- and fissures at the bottom, and climb up the other side again, into
- coolness and safety, to wait and watch the roaring water burst up through
- the rock once more; geysers that make blue-green pools oh the lip of milky
- and ruddy terrace of carven silica; that explode like watery cannon, in
- definite rows, one after another; that build themselves nests like birds,
- send boiling streams under rustic bridges, scatter hot spray and steam
- over&rsquo; richly drooping ferns, and plant rainbow haloes on a scalding cloud
- of mist, high above the clustering trees of the valley&mdash;these are the
- sights of the canon, and they need no childish names to make them
- interesting. When a visitor gets into the Geyser Canon he is like a fly in
- a spider&rsquo;s web. He cannot get away from this colossal variety
- entertainment. He runs from a nine-minute geyser to see a four-minute
- geyser do its little &ldquo;turn,&rdquo; and by this time the number is up for the
- seven-minute performance of the great star, so he hurries there; and after
- that he must just go back and see the twin geysers do another four-minute
- trick, and then there is quite another, which will do a splendid &ldquo;turn&rdquo; in
- twenty-seven minutes&rsquo; time, if he only waits&mdash;and so half a day is
- gone, without any one noticing the flight of time, until the sudden
- occurrence of a &ldquo;passionate vacancy,&rdquo; not at all connected with the
- geysers or their beds, informs the traveller that another meal-time has,
- unperceived, come round.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Arateatea Rapids fill in the afternoon. From the high road where the
- open coach stands waiting, down through a pretty woodland of greenery and
- shadow and thick soundless moss, one follows a narrow pathway towards an
- ever-increasing sound of rushing, tumbling, and thundering, out, at last,
- on to a projecting point where one stands right over a rocky canon filled
- almost to the brim with a smother of white rolling foam, woven through
- with surprising lights of clear jade green and trembling gold. And here,
- on the brink of this half-mile of rapids, over the roaring water, I give
- it up. I do not attempt to describe it. When you take a great river,
- exceptionally deep and swift, and throw it over half a mile of sloping
- cliff, things are bound to happen that are somewhat beyond the power of
- pen and ink to render. Who has ever read a description of a waterfall,
- anywhere, written by any one that conveyed an impression worth a rotten
- nut? Every one who goes to see Arateatea must manufacture his own
- sensations on the spot. Sheer fright will certainly be one of them; not at
- anything the innocent rapids are doing to the beholder, but at the bare
- notion of what they might do, one foot nearer&mdash;one step lower down&mdash;one&mdash;&mdash;
- Let me have a couple of trees to hold on to, please. Thank you, that is
- better.
- </p>
- <p>
- Many years ago, a party of twenty Maories had a narrow escape from the
- cruel embraces of snow-white Arateatea. They were canoeing on the upper
- river; and, partly because the trout in the Waikato are the biggest trout
- in the world, partly because some of the rowers had had too much fun at a
- &ldquo;tangi,&rdquo; or wailing party, the night before, and were not very
- clear-headed, they forgot to think of the current until it had them fairly
- in its clutch, whirling them along only a mile or two above the terrible
- rapids. They could not reach the shore, and they dared not swim. One would
- have supposed that nothing could save them from being beaten to pieces
- against the cruel rocks in the rapids&mdash;yet they escaped that fate.
- </p>
- <p>
- They went over the Huka Falls, which come a mile or two above the rapids
- (the Maories had forgotten all about that) and were decently drowned
- instead.
- </p>
- <p>
- I am sorry that the above is not a better story; but the fact is, that
- tourists are not very plentiful about Wairakei, and the natives have not
- yet learned to invent the proper tourist tale. That is about the best they
- can do as yet.
- </p>
- <p>
- It will hardly be credited, but there is not even a Lover&rsquo;s Leap in the
- whole valley; not a story of an obstinate father who got opportunely
- boiled in a geyser, while his daughter eloped down a scalding river in a
- motor-boat worked by the steam from the surface&mdash;nor a tale of a
- flying criminal pursued by executioners, who leaped from side to side of a
- gorge some thirty feet across and got away. This is certainly remiss of
- the authorities; but I have no doubt the Government Tourist Department
- would take the matter up, and supply the necessary fiction, if suitably
- approached.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0049" id="linkimage-0049"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0470.jpg" alt="0470 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0470.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- In the meantime travellers must be satisfied with the rather bald and
- uninteresting tale of a Maori maiden named Karapiti, who jumped into the
- steam blow-hole bearing her name, because her <i>fiancé</i> did not meet
- her there on Sunday afternoon as arranged to take her to afternoon tea at
- the Wairakei Hotel. At least, that is one version of the tale, and it is
- quite enough for the Smith family from London, and other representative
- tourists.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;You should have given yourself more time.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;Whatever you are going to do later on, this place really requires at
- least a week.&rdquo;
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;You cannot possibly miss so-and-so, or this and that!&rdquo; Such are the
- reproaches that haunt the hasty traveller through the Hot-Water Country&mdash;reproaches
- fully deserved in nearly every case, for very few tourists who journey to
- New Zealand realise the amount of time that should be spent in seeing the
- miracles of the volcanic zone, if nothing really good is to be omitted.
- </p>
- <p>
- It results in an unsatisfactory compromise as a rule&mdash;some &ldquo;sights&rdquo;
- being seen; many passed over. There is always something fascinating just
- ahead, calling the traveller on, and something wonderful close at hand,
- which demands the sacrifice of yet another day, before moving. Such a
- superfluity of beautiful and wonderful sights can assuredly be found
- nowhere else on earth. Iceland is far inferior; the famous Yellowstone
- Park of America has only a stepmother&rsquo;s helping of what might be New
- Zealand&rsquo;s &ldquo;left-overs.&rdquo; The lovely, lamented Pink and White Terraces are
- by many supposed to have been the only great thermal wonder of the
- country. This is so far from being the truth that only a good-sized volume
- could fairly state the other side of the question. I have never met any
- traveller through the thermal districts who had succeeded in seeing
- everything of interest. All whom I saw were as hard at work as the very
- coach-horses themselves&mdash;walking, driving, climbing, scrambling each
- hour of every day, and often thoroughly overdoing themselves, in the
- plucky attempt to carry away as much as possible from this over-richly
- spread banquet of Nature&rsquo;s wonders.
- </p>
- <p>
- I squeezed out an afternoon for Karapiti (the &ldquo;Devil&rsquo;s Trumpet&rdquo;) and the
- Valley of the Coloured Lakes. By this time I was a little jaded with
- sight-seeing, disposed to talk in a hold-cheap tone of anything that was
- not absolutely amazing, and to taste all these weirdly impressive marvels
- with a very discriminating palate. Karapiti, however, is cayenne to any
- jaded taste. It is known as the &ldquo;Safety-Valve of New Zealand,&rdquo; and the
- term is peculiarly fitting. The whole of the Hot-Water Country is only one
- plank removed from the infernal regions; it almost floats upon the
- scalding brow of molten rock, liquid mineral, and vaporised water, that
- composes the earth interior immediately below. That it is perfectly safe
- to live in (a constant wonder to outsiders) is very largely due to just
- those steam blow-holes and geysers which excite the fears of the
- nervous-minded&mdash;and the colossal dragon-throat of Karapiti is the
- most important safety-valve of all.
- </p>
- <p>
- Walking up the hill&rsquo; to the blow-hole, many hundred yards off, one hears
- its loud unvarying roar, like the steam-thunder that comes from an ocean
- liner&rsquo;s huge funnel, when the ship is ready to cast loose from shore. The
- ground as one gets nearer is jutted and uneven, and perceptibly warm in
- certain spots. Rounding a corner, one comes suddenly upon the Devil&rsquo;s
- Trumpet, a funnel-shaped opening, ten feet across at the lip, in the
- bottom of a cupshaped hollow. A fierce jet of steam rushes out from the
- Trumpet, thick and white as a great marble column, and roaring horribly as
- it comes forth. The pressure is no less than 180 lb. to one square inch,
- and the rush of this gigantic waste-pipe never slackens or ceases, night
- or day; nor has it done so within the memory of man.
- </p>
- <p>
- &ldquo;If it did, I&rsquo;d look for another situation pretty sharp, for it wouldn&rsquo;t
- be &rsquo;ealthy to stay around Wairakei no more,&rdquo; observes one guide,
- who is showing off the monster to us by throwing a kerosene can into the
- jet, and catching it as it is violently flung back to him, many yards
- away. &ldquo;I can throw a penny the same,&rdquo; he says, and does so, getting back
- the coin promptly, a good deal hotter than it went in.
- </p>
- <p>
- One of the ladies of our party is nearly reduced to tears by the sinister
- aspect, the menacing horror of the spot. She begs to be taken away,
- because she knows she will dream about it. She does dream about it; I know
- that, because I do myself, that night; and the dreams are not nice. Still,
- I would face them again for another look at roaring Karapiti. It is a
- wonder of wonders, a horror of horrors, unlike anything else in the world.
- On the whole, I am glad of that last fact. Too much Karapiti would
- certainly get on one&rsquo;s nerves.
- </p>
- <p>
- There have never been any accidents to travellers here. No one could fall
- down the hole, because the funnel narrows rapidly, and is only about two
- feet across in the inner part. All the same, one cannot safely approach
- very near, for there is an in-rush as well as an out-rush, and if any one
- did fall victim to it, and stumble into the funnel, the highly condensed
- steam would strip the flesh from his bones as quickly as a cherry is
- shelled off its stone.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Valley of the Coloured Lakes came next. I wonder what the inhabitants
- of Brighton or Bath would do&mdash;how they would advertise, how they
- would cry for visitors&mdash;if they had a valley at their very gates
- which contained a scalding hot river, tumbling over pink and
- cream-coloured cascades of china-like silica, in clouds of steamy spray&mdash;a
- great round pond, set deep in richest forest, and coloured vivid orange,
- with red rocks round the brim; another, crude Reckitt&rsquo;s blue; another,
- staring verdigris green; another, raspberry pink; others still, yellow as
- custard and white as starch! All these ponds are hot; they are coloured by
- the various minerals they hold In solution, but they have not yet been
- chemically analysed, so it is only possible to speculate as to the exact
- cause of the colours. Seen from a height above, the ponds resemble nothing
- so much as a number of paint-pots; and that, indeed, is one of the names
- by which the valley is generally known.
- </p>
- <p>
- Leaving behind me, unlooked at, still more than I had seen, I took coach
- again next morning for Rotorua. It was an early and a chilly start, for we
- had over thirty miles to do before lunch. The light, springy coach, with
- its leather-curtain sides, was filled with a cheerful party, all young,
- all enjoying themselves heartily, and all full of the genial good spirits
- that come of much open air and a holiday frame of mind. <i>New</i> New
- Zealand at its best was represented there, much as Old New Zealand was
- represented by the silent bearded men, with the lonely-looking eyes, who
- travelled in the Pipiriki and Waiouru stages of the journey.
- </p>
- <p>
- How fast the spanking team swings in along the road! How lovely the
- changing panorama of the encircling hills, now velvet-brown with rich
- green dells and valleys, now far-off pansy-purple, now palest grey, seamed
- with crimson streaks of hematite! The air is very clear to-day, with that
- strange New Zealand clearness that changes every-distance to sea-blue
- crystal, and pencils every shadow sharp and square.
- </p>
- <p>
- We have left the royal gold broom behind us; but the beautiful manuka
- scrub of the valleys is in full blossom, exquisitely tipped and touched
- with white lace-like blossoms. It is almost as if a heavy hoar-froat had
- misted over every delicate green bough with finest touches of silver. Arum
- lilies bloom in the ditches; the Maori flax, like tall iris leaves,
- wanders wildly over hill and valley; great fields of Pampas grass wave
- their creamy plumes over the shot green satin of thick-growing leaves.
- Wild horses, as the coach goes by, look warily out from behind some woody
- knoll, or canter away across the plains with their long-legged foals. Some
- of them are fine creatures, too, worth catching and breaking, and many are
- taken there from time to time. What a happy land, where a man can go out
- and pick a fine horse in a mountain meadow, much as you pick a daisy at
- home!
- </p>
- <p>
- Lunch-time befalls at another of the inevitable Wais&mdash;Waiotapu, this
- time&mdash;and before the coach starts on the last stretch of eighteen
- miles to Rotorua, I go across the road to see the only one of Waiotapu&rsquo;s
- sights for which I have time&mdash;the Champagne Pool and Alum Cliffs.
- </p>
- <p>
- These are to be found on a most extraordinary milk-coloured plain, which
- looks exactly as if a careless giant had been mixing colours and trying
- brushes on it, and left everything lying about. The rocks and heights, the
- deep dells with boiling pools and grumbling geysers at the bottom, the
- narrow pathways leading here and there, are spotted and streaked with
- carmine, rose madder, scarlet, primrose, bright yellow, and amber. The
- &ldquo;Cliffs&rdquo; are a succession of rocky heights composed of something very like
- cream fondant, which is mostly alum. At their feet opens out a fascinating
- succession of bays and inlets full of variously coloured water, at which I
- can only glance as I pass. There are two mustard-coloured pools, and one
- pale green, among them. Close at hand the overflow from the Champagne Pool
- rushes, steaming fiercely, over a fall of rocks which appear to have been
- very newly and stickily painted in palest primrose colour. Alum, sulphur,
- and hematite are responsible, I am told, for most of these strange hues.
- Sulphur and arsenic have coloured the Champagne Pool itself&mdash;a great
- green lake, almost boiling, and of a most amazing colour&mdash;something
- between the green of a peridot and that of Chartreuse. It has never been
- bottomed; the line ran out at 900 feet when tried. The edge of all the
- lake is most delicately wrought into a coralline border of ornamental
- knobs and branches, canary yellow in colour. Its name is derived from the
- curious effect produced in the depths of the pond by a handful of sand.
- The water begins to cream and froth at once, like champagne or lemonade,
- and continues to do so in places for at least half an hour.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0050" id="linkimage-0050"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0476.jpg" alt="0476 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0476.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- And now we hurry back to the coach once more, and on to Rotorua, wonder of
- wonders, and thermal temple of every healing water known to the medical
- world.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0051" id="linkimage-0051"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0488.jpg" alt="0488 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0488.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- <br /><br />
- </p>
- <hr />
- <p>
- <a name="link2HCH0016" id="link2HCH0016"> </a>
- </p>
- <div style="height: 4em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
- <h2>
- CHAPTER XVI
- </h2>
- <p>
- <i>From Heaven to Hades&mdash;Gay Rotorua&mdash;Where One lives on a Pie
- crust&mdash;The Birth of a River&mdash;Horrible Tikitere&mdash;In the
- Track of the Great Eruption&mdash;Where are the Pink and White Terraces?&mdash;A
- Fountain fifteen hundred feet high&mdash;Foolhardy Feat of a Guide&mdash;How
- the Tourists were killed&mdash;A Maori Village&mdash;Soaping a Geyser&mdash;The
- End.</i>
- </p>
- <p class="pfirst">
- <span class="dropcap" style="font-size: 4.00em">R</span>ED roofs and white
- verandahs; straight sandy streets of immense width, planted with green
- trees, and spindling away into unnaturally bright blue distances;
- omnibuses, phaetons, motor-cars, and four-in-hands passing at long
- intervals towards the shining lakes that lie beside the town; puffs of
- white steam rising up among green gardens and open fields; a ring of
- amethyst-coloured hills surrounding the whole bright scene, bathed in such
- a white, pure, crystalline sun as never shines on misty England. That is
- Rotorua, a half-day&rsquo;s journey from Auckland, and the centre of the
- wonderful geyser region of New Zealand.
- </p>
- <p>
- Every one now-a-days knows that New Zealand possesses wonderful geysers,
- but not quite everybody knows what a geyser is; and certainly very few are
- aware of the extraordinary richness and variety of the geyser country.
- Geysers are intermittent fountains of boiling water, in height from a
- couple of feet up to fifteen hundred&mdash;the enormous altitude reached
- by Waimangu the Terrible, greatest geyser of the whole world. They consist
- of a shaft reaching down from the surface of the earth to deep, very
- highly heated reservoirs of steam and boiling water below; and (usually)
- of a siliceous basin surrounding the shaft-opening, and full of hot water.
- Some geysers open in the centre of a cone of siliceous sinter, built up by
- the deposits from the water, and have no basin.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0052" id="linkimage-0052"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0492.jpg" alt="0492 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0492.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- The periodic explosions of active geysers are due to the following facts&mdash;water
- under heavy pressure requires a much higher temperature to boil than water
- free from pressure. While the water high up in the geyser pipe may be a
- little under 212 degrees, that in the lower levels may be standing at 50
- or 60 degrees higher, and only kept from expanding into steam by the
- weight of the column above it. If anything lessens that weight or
- increases the temperature of the lower water, this latter will explode
- into steam, and drive the upper waters high into air with the force of its
- exit from the shaft. This, briefly, is the theory of geyser action.
- </p>
- <p>
- Rotorua itself, the great focus of the healing forces of Nature in the
- geyser district, is simply a crust over a mass of hot springs, charged
- with various minerals. Three feet under earth you will find hot water, in
- nearly any part of the town. There are hundreds of hot springs in the
- neighbourhood that have never been analysed. Of the many that are in use
- in the Government Sanatorium, the &ldquo;Priest&rsquo;s Water&rdquo; and &ldquo;Rachel Water&rdquo; are
- the most famous. The former cures rheumatism, gout, and blood diseases,
- while &ldquo;Rachel&rdquo; makes her patrons &ldquo;beautiful for ever&rdquo; by curing all forms
- of skin trouble, and bestowing a lovely complexion, not to speak of the
- remarkable effects of the spring on nervous affections. There are also
- wonderful hot swimming baths, much patronised by the casual tourist; baths
- of hot volcanic mud, and baths of hot sulphur vapour rising direct from
- the burning caverns under the earth.
- </p>
- <p>
- But for people who are in good health, it is the &ldquo;sights&rdquo; of Rotorua that
- are the chief attractions, and these are very many. One of the loveliest,
- and a welcome change from the countless hot-water springs, is Hamurana,
- surely the most beautiful river source in the world. It is reached by a
- journey across one of the lakes in a steamer. All the way the great lake
- ripples purest turquoise under a high, clear, cloudless sky; green islands
- rise bright and cool from its shining surface, sharply peaked and shadowed
- mountains, on the distant shores, stand out in strange hues of crystalline
- hyacinth unknown to our northern climes. By-and-by the little steamer
- leaves us on a green wooded shore, and we take boat up a fairy river to a
- region of enchanted beauty. Blossoming trees line the sun-steeped banks;
- the water is of the strangest colours&mdash;jade-green, clear molten
- sapphire, silver/ emerald, and transparent as a great highway of rock
- crystal. Enormous trout, weighing up to twenty pounds, rush from under our
- keel; grass-green and rose-red water weeds quiver far beneath the oar.
- Wild fuchsias, wild cherries, loaded with scarlet fruit, snowy-flowered
- tea-tree, arum lilies, yellow broom, and pink dog-roses, hang out over the
- water. But a few hundred yards, and the big lovely river comes to a sudden
- end, walled in by blossoming bushes, and apparently cut short in the
- strangest&rsquo; of culs-de-sac. In reality it is the source we have reached;
- here the whole Hamurana stream springs full-grown from the earth. A great
- rift in the bed of the glassy river is visible, where the water wells up
- under our keel in wavering masses of amber, aquamarine, and deep blue,
- shot with glancing arrows of prismatic light. Five million gallons are
- poured forth from this deep cold cavern every twenty-four hours&mdash;each
- drop as clear as a diamond, and as pure. The force of the upspringing
- stream is so great that pennies can be thrown in from the boat without
- sinking, to the bottom of the cavern&mdash;the water sends them back, and
- casts them out into the shallows about the edge of the rift. Sometimes a
- small silver coin will slip down into depths, and lie glittering many
- fathoms below, magnified conspicuously by the transparent water. The Maori
- natives, who are marvellous divers, have tried time and again to
- reach-this tempting store of treasure; but no man can stem the uprushing
- torrent of water, and if the coins were gold, they would be as safe as
- they are now from being taken by human hands. The most determined suicide
- could not drown himself in the Hamurana River source, for the stream about
- the source is shallow, and the cavern water itself would not permit him to
- sink, however willing he might be.
- </p>
- <p>
- The Valley of Tikitere, some ten miles from Rotorua, is the greatest
- contrast that could possibly be conceived to Hamurana&rsquo;s enchanted
- loveliness. Enchanted indeed this valley also plight be, but by a spell of
- evil. It is the nearest possible approach to the familiar conception of
- hell. A stretch of white siliceous soil, streaked here and there with the
- blood-coloured stains of hematite, or the livid yellow of sulphur, is
- pitted all over with lakes, pools, and small deep pot-holes of boiling
- mud, sometimes thick, sometimes thin, but always scalding, bubbling,
- spirting, and threatening. Chief of all the horrors is the well-named
- lake, &ldquo;Gates of Hell.&rdquo; Standing upon a bank of white earth that is warm
- underfoot, and seamed with steaming cracks, one looks down upon a ghastly
- hellhole of a seething cauldron, slimy black in colour, and veiled with
- stinging mists that only now and then lift sufficiently to show the
- hideous surface of the lake. The foul broth of which it is composed
- bubbles and lifts ceaselessly, now and then rising into ominous heights
- and waves that seem about to break upon the banks above. The heat reaches
- our faces, as we stand half-stifled on the pathway. Just beside us, a
- large pool of bubbling mud, which stands constantly at 2120 Fahrenheit&mdash;ordinary
- boiling point&mdash;seems almost cool in comparison. Little wonder that is
- so; for the &ldquo;Gates of Hell&rdquo; is largely composed of sulphuric acid, and its
- surface temperature is 232°.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0053" id="linkimage-0053"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0463.jpg" alt="0463 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0463.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Beyond lies a perfect wilderness of boiling mud-holes of every kind. Here,
- there is a pond of mud as thick as porridge; there, one fluid as cream.
- Here, the deadly, scalding surface lies innocently smooth and unrippled;
- there, it leaps and thunders like a young volcano in action.
- </p>
- <p>
- At one corner we come suddenly upon an ugly black archway, leading to no
- inviting interior; nothing can be seen within; but the loud gurglings and
- chokings of the seething depths inside restrain any desire for closer
- observation, &ldquo;The Heavenly Twins,&rdquo; derisively so-named, are two boiling
- mud-lioles not a foot apart, but quite unconnected; one boils the thickest
- of brews, while its twin concocts the thinnest.
- </p>
- <p>
- One must follow the guide closely and carefully about these ghastly
- wonders. One step off the pathway, and a horrible death awaits the
- careless walker. Even the path itself is only cool and solid on the
- outside skin. The guide stops now and then to dig his stick into the
- whitey-brown earth for a couple of inches, and turn up a clod all
- glittering on the under-side with fresh crystals of sulphur. This
- under-side is so hot that one can hardly touch it with the unprotected
- hand.
- </p>
- <p>
- From one deep mud-hole, of a comparatively reasonable temperature, mud is
- taken out for medical uses. It is wonderfully effective as a bath, for
- soothing pain and curing sleeplessness. Further on, on safe ground, one
- can see a hot waterfall about twenty feet high, in temperature about 100°,
- which is used as a douche bath by invalids of many kinds, with remarkable
- results.
- </p>
- <p>
- On the edges of the valley, I see for the first time in detail exactly how
- the &ldquo;fumarole,&rdquo; or steam blow-hole, is used for cooking purposes. Over the
- opening of a small manageable blow-hole, an inch or two across, is placed
- a box without a bottom. The food to be cooked is placed in the box, either
- in a pot, or wrapped in leaves. The lid is then put on, and covered with
- clay. In an hour or so the meat or stew is done to a turn; and even if
- left too long, it cannot be burned. One blow-hole, in constant use by the
- Maories, is not steam at all, but hot sulphur vapour, which deposits a
- crust of sulphur on everything it touches. This does not trouble the
- Maori, however; he eats his food quite contentedly, with a strong
- sulphurous flavour added to its natural taste, and says it does him good.
- Certainly, the natives living about Tikitere are unusually strong and
- hearty in appearance, and never troubled with any kind of illness.
- </p>
- <p>
- People of middle age will doubtless remember vividly the impression
- created all over the world in 1886 by the eruption of the great volcano
- Tarawera, and the destruction of New Zealand&rsquo;s most cherished natural
- wonder&mdash;the peerless Pink and White Terraces of Rotomahana. Count-,
- less marvels have been left, and one new one that far outstrips the
- Terraces in sheer wonder and magnificence&mdash;Waimangu, the greatest
- geyser in the world; but New Zealand still laments her beautiful Terraces,
- and shows the spot where they lie deep, buried under ninety feet of
- volcanic débris, as though pointing out the grave of something loved and
- lost.
- </p>
- <p>
- A day of wonderful interest is that spent in seeing the track of the great
- eruption. Leaving Rotorua early in the morning, I saw, as the coach wound
- up the hilly road outside the town, many traces of that awful night and
- day of darkness, thunder, and terror, eighteen years ago. Although Rotorua
- is fifteen miles or more from the site of the Terraces, the sky was dark
- all the day of the eruption, and only three or four miles from the town
- black volcanic dust fell so densely as to leave a stratum several inches
- thick over the country. This is clearly visible in the cuttings at the
- side of the road, where the black stratum can be seen underlying the more
- recent layer of ordinary soil. Where the great coach-road to Rotomahana
- once ran, a chasm some sixty feet deep scars the mountain side, caused by
- the fearful rush of water that took place down the road-track. An
- earthquake crack, thirty feet deep, runs close to the road for a long
- distance. All the way up to the buried village of Wairoa, similar traces
- can be seen. But before the village is reached, two gems of scenic
- loveliness are passed&mdash;the Blue and Green Lakes, lying side by side,
- each enclosed by steep rugged hills, reflected clearly on its glassy
- surface. One is of the strangest, most delicate Sèvres blue&mdash;a
- colour, not depending on any reflection from above, for I saw it on a grey
- and cloudy day&mdash;the other is a bright verdigris green. &ldquo;Chemicals in
- the water&rdquo; is the very vague reason given by inhabitants of the district
- for these remarkable beauties of colour.
- </p>
- <p>
- I must note here that in no case have I succeeded in obtaining any
- satisfactory reason for the remarkable blues and greens so common in both
- the cold and hot waters of the thermal district. The Waikato River, a
- great cold stream, full of immense trout; Taupo Lake (cold); the coloured
- lakes of Wairakei and Waiotapu (hot); Hamurana Springs (cold), and many
- others, display these remarkable tints, under every sky and in every depth
- of water. Varying reasons are given, but none seem satisfactory. The
- beauty of the colouring is, at all events, certain, and the cause may
- safely be left to geologists.
- </p>
- <p>
- Wairoa Village is now a green, silent waste of young forest and rich
- grass, broken only by the ruins of the old hotel that stood there before
- the eruption, and by a few scattered traces of other human occupation&mdash;a
- fragment of wall, the rusty skeleton of an iron bedstead, lying in a
- gully; the remains of a shattered buggy. In 1886 it occupied the place now
- held by Rotorua, and was visited by numbers of tourists, all anxious to
- see the Terraces, which lay not far away at the other end of the chain of
- lakes now united in one, and called Rotomahana. On the day of the
- eruption, the roof of the hotel was broken in by red-hot falling stones
- and mud, and eleven people were killed. Some, who escaped, ran out and
- took refuge in a native &ldquo;warry&rdquo; or hut, which, strange to say, remained
- uninjured. Over a hundred people in all&mdash;mostly Maories&mdash;were
- killed by the eruption, which destroyed millions of acres of good land,
- swept away several native villages, and utterly altered the face of the
- whole country.
- </p>
- <p>
- Lake Tarawera, which must be crossed to see the site of the lost terraces,
- lies under the shadow of the great volcanic cone of Tarawera, 8,000 feet
- high, from which much of the molten rock and burning ashes came. It is as
- lovely, in its own strange way, as the famous lakes of Italy and
- Switzerland. The water is intensely blue, and the high hills closing it in
- are of a colour unknown to most other scenery in the world&mdash;a strange
- pale barren grey, so nearly white as to be slightly suggestive of snow.
- Like snow, too, is the distribution of this coloured matter; it lies on
- the crests and projections of the hills, and is streaked thinly down the
- sides. It is ash, volcanic ash, cast out by the surrounding craters on
- that fatal night of June, 1886, and lying unchanged on the hills about the
- lake ever since. Tarawera itself towers above the lake, grim and dark and
- ominous; a mountain hot yet tamed by any means, and still hot, though not
- molten, in the interior of the cone.
- </p>
- <p>
- On the shores of the lake, as the launch carries us past, can be seen, at
- one spot, the whitened bones of some of the natives who perished in the
- eruption. The name and titles of one, who was a great chief, are painted
- on a rock that overhangs the shore.
- </p>
- <p>
- Rotomahana, the second lake, is also surrounded by ash-whitened hills. At
- the far end, as our second oil-launch starts to cross, we can see thick
- columns of steam rising against the grey of the cliffs. These are the
- gravestones of the lost Pink Terrace; these tall pillars of cloud alone
- mark the spot where one half of the world&rsquo;s greatest wonder once stood.
- Just where the launch starts, the White Terrace was buried, under a
- hundred feet of earth and mud, deep in the bed of the lake.
- </p>
- <p>
- What were the Terraces like? New Zealand has many oil paintings of them,
- so that a clear idea of their loveliness can be formed even to-day. They
- consisted of two immense terraced slopes, formed by the action of downward
- dropping hot water heavily loaded with silicon. Every terrace was a
- succession of fairy-like baths and basins, filled with bright blue water.
- One was pure ivory-white, the other, tinged with hematite, was bright
- pink., The exquisite natural carvings and flutings of the silicon, the
- beautiful tints of the terraces, the blue sky above and blue lakes below,
- together formed a picture the like of which does not exist on earth
- to-day.
- </p>
- <p>
- Our oil-launch, sailing now over water which is actually boiling, close in
- shore, though the main body of the lake is cold, allows us to land on the
- very spot where the Pink Terrace once stood. It is a dangerous task, even
- with the aid of a guide, to pick one&rsquo;s way about this stretch of ground,
- for it is nothing but a crumbling honey-comb of boiling-water ponds, and
- narrow ridges as brittle as piecrust. Over these latter we take our
- perilous way, planting each footstep slowly and carefully, but never
- standing still, for the ground is so exceedingly hot that the soles of
- one&rsquo;s boots are scorched, if planted long in one place. The earth is
- choked and clouded with steam, the ponds roar and bubble about our feet,
- the blow-holes rumble. The ground is full of raw cracks, old and new, and
- as our small party steps over one of these, on the way back, it is seen to
- be visibly wider than it was on the previous coming! To-morrow the whole
- of this narrow ridge may have crumbled in and disappeared. No one is sorry
- to reach the launch again, and glide away from those threatening shores.
- </p>
- <p>
- A little further on, where we land for the walk up to Waimangu Geyser,
- there is a hot iodine spring, unique among medical waters, and most useful
- in many diseases. Arrangements are now being made to have the water
- collected and sent to Rotorua; up to the present, it has only been used by
- the Maories.
- </p>
- <p>
- All the three-mile walk up to the geyser is crowded with tokens of the
- great eruption. Mud cliffs a hundred feet in height were created by the
- terrible outburst, and for miles about the whole country was covered yards
- deep with the boiling slimy mass. Not only Tarawera, but three other
- craters (all visible in the high distance above the lake) were erupting
- together, for a night and a day. The eruptions took place without the
- least warning of any kind, about ten o&rsquo;clock at night. The chain of lakes
- about Tarawera&rsquo;s foot suddenly exploded like colossal bombs, blowing their
- entire contents, and all the mud from their bottoms, over the whole
- country-side. Tarawera and the neighbouring craters cast out huge jets of
- flame, and scattered burning masses of rock, ashes, and scoriæ, for many
- miles. The noise was terrible, and the sky for twenty miles around was
- dark at noonday. It is supposed that the eruption was caused by the
- falling in of the lake bottom, which allowed the water to drop into the
- underlying fires, and exploded the lakes instantly into steam.
- </p>
- <p>
- Up a great earthquake chasm, among deep volcano craters that were formed
- at the time of the eruption, we climb towards the Great Geyser. These
- craters are for the most part still in a more or less heated state, though
- grass and ferns grow in the interior of nearly all, and no apprehension is
- felt as to future outbursts. One has a hot mudpool at the bottom; a second
- spits steam from many cracks and blow-holes; a third, the largest of all,
- erupted slightly in August 1904, and threw a quantity of hot mud and
- stones out over the top.
- </p>
- <p>
- Waimangu Geyser itself, which is really more a volcano than a geyser, is
- supposed to have been formed at the time of the eruption. It did not,
- however, commence its present activity until 1900, when an enormously high
- &ldquo;shot&rdquo; was seen by one or two explorers camping in the neighbourhood, and
- the source at once investigated. It became apparent that New Zealand, in
- the place of the lost Terraces, had acquired the largest and most
- magnificent geyser in the whole world. The exchange is by no means a bad
- one. Waimangu attracts hundreds of travellers to the pretty little hotel
- planted on a cliff not far from the crater; and those who have been
- fortunate enough to see the geyser play, one and all utterly lose
- themselves in attempting to express the extraordinary majesty, wonder, and
- terror of the sight.
- </p>
- <p>
- The geyser is somewhat irregular in action, but generally plays every day
- or so. The water in the huge basin heaves and lifts; then an enormous
- cloud of steam rushes up, and then a column of black water, charged with
- mud and stones, flings itself upward in repeated leaps or &ldquo;shots&rdquo; through
- the steam, to an almost incredible height&mdash;at times as high as
- fifteen hundred feet. More than a quarter of a mile in sheer height is
- Waimangu&rsquo;s biggest &ldquo;shot.&rdquo; On such occasions, the sky is darkened by the
- tremendous spread of the leaping waters, the earth trembles with the
- concussion, and the watching spectators, perched high above the crater by
- the shelter hut, feel as though the terrors of the Last Day itself were
- falling upon them, unprepared.
- </p>
- <p>
- In the summer of 1903 two girls and a guide were killed during the
- explosion of the geyser. The girls had been repeatedly warned, even
- entreated, not to stand near the crater, as it was momentarily expected to
- &ldquo;play&rdquo;; but they hovered close by the verge, anxious to secure a
- photograph. Without warning, Waimangu suddenly rose and hurled itself
- bodily skyward out of its bed. The enormous backfall of the boiling water
- caught and swept away the luckless three, and they were carried down the
- outflow valley in the flood that succeeds every eruption. When found, the
- bodies were terribly mutilated, and stripped of all clothing. The mother
- of the girls, standing higher up, saw the whole awful disaster, and had to
- be forcibly held back from rushing into the crater, in a wild effort to
- save her children. Since that melancholy day, the geyser basin has been
- railed off, in such a manner that no one can approach near enough to incur
- the slightest danger. Warbrick, the head guide of the district, was
- present, and nearly lost his life in a daring attempt to save the girls
- and the guide, who was his own brother. He rushed into the midst of the
- falling stones and water, to try and drag the luckless victims back, but
- was too late to save them, and narrowly escaped being carried away
- himself.
- </p>
- <p>
- Warbrick is the best-known guide in New Zealand, and a character of
- considerable interest. He is a halfcaste Maori, decidedly more intelligent
- than the average white man, and speaking English perfectly. In company
- with a sailor, he lately made what was probably the most daring boat-trip
- ever attempted on earth&mdash;nothing less than a voyage over Waimangu&rsquo;s
- boiling basin, undertaken with the object of sounding the depths of the
- geyser. The monster often erupts without the least warning, sending the
- whole contents of its huge basin bodily skyward; so that the feat was one
- likely to shake the strongest nerve. Warbrick took a lead line with him,
- and noted the various depths of the crater basin. In the centre, where the
- great throat of the geyser opens up, no bottom could be found. The boat
- came safely to shore, after some minutes spent, in performing one of the
- most perilous feats ever attempted, even by a Maori.
- </p>
- <p>
- Visitors generally stay at the Government accommodation house near the
- geyser for a day or two, on the chance of seeing a good &ldquo;shot,&rdquo; and they
- seldom go away unrewarded. It is well worth while to cut short one&rsquo;s stay
- in some other place by a couple of days, to have a chance of seeing the
- world&rsquo;s greatest thermal wonder in full action, for Waimangu, when
- playing, is the sight of a lifetime. I was not fortunate enough to see the
- geyser in action, as it was undergoing a period of &ldquo;sulks&rdquo; at the time of
- my visit; but if it had been playing as it played some weeks after I left,
- nothing would have tempted me away from its neighbourhood until I had seen
- an eruption.
- </p>
- <p>
- One, of the great charms of the geyser country about Rotorua is its
- absolute unlikeness to anything that can be found on the other side of the
- Line. To the much-travelled wanderer, nearly all famous show-places, after
- a time, display a distressing similarity. The two or three leading types
- of peasant to be found on the Continent of Europe, grow familiar
- by-and-by. Giuseppe of Italy is not very novel to the traveller who still
- remembers Ignacio of Spain; German Wilhelm recalls Dutch Jan; Belgian
- Françoise is sister to French Mathilde. As for the &ldquo;sights&rdquo;&mdash;well,
- one waterfall is very like another, and lakes and ruined castles pall,
- taken in bulk. Even if the traveller wanders further away, he does not
- find much in Egypt, India, or Japan, that has not been greatly spoiled for
- him beforehand, by the countless descriptions he has heard and read ever
- since childhood. It seems almost as though the illimitable flood of
- sight-seers, past and present, rushing through all the famous beauty-spots
- of the old world, had washed away something of their charm&mdash;as if the
- air about such places were drained dry of the ozone of fresh delight which
- every lovely and wonderful spot should give, leaving only an atmosphere of
- feeling that is stale and used-up in the last degree.
- </p>
- <p>
- New Zealand&rsquo;s &ldquo;sights,&rdquo; however, are (to vary the metaphor) new gems in a
- new setting. Not even the most experienced traveller can look on the
- wonders of the thermal region with an eye dulled and indifferent by other
- experiences, since there is hardly anything similar the whole world over.
- And the setting of the gems&mdash;-the strange, unfamiliar country, oddly
- reversed seasons, and wild brown Maori folk, taking the place of European
- peasantry, is perhaps the greatest charm of all.
- </p>
- <p>
- For myself, the carefully revived native dances of the Maories, performed
- for money, in civilised concert halls the &ldquo;haka&rdquo; or war dance, done by
- children on the roads for pennies, and the modern native carvings, done
- with English tools, which are all among the most striking features of
- daily life in Rotorua, were not the real attractions of the place. Those
- lay in the common features of ordinary Maori existence, seen here, there,
- and everywhere, without pose or preparation. When one strolls out along
- the country roads near the town, it is an adventure to meet a party of
- wild-eyed, brown-faced men and women, galloping madly up and down hill on
- their rough &ldquo;brumbies&rdquo; (wild-horses, broken in)&mdash;both sexes alike
- wrapped in heavy blankets, and sitting astride. Wandering about on a
- bicycle, it pleasantly increases the &ldquo;go-abroady&rdquo; feeling that most
- travellers welcome, to coma upon a woman taking a fat fowl out of the
- steam-hole cooker, that Nature has provided just at the door of her
- thatch-roofed, reed-built &ldquo;warry,&rdquo; and to stop and talk for an interesting
- quarter of an hour with a barefooted, half-clad savage, who speaks English
- as good as one&rsquo;s own, reads the daily papers and has his opinions on Mr.
- Seddon&rsquo;s fiscal policy. The Maori guides and hangers on, about the
- best-known sights, are naturally more or less spoiled by the visitors. But
- the real Maori, of whom one gets an occasional sight, even about such a
- civilised town as Rotorua, is attractive enough to make one fully
- understand the strong regard that most New Zealanders have for their
- native friends. Dignity, pride, and the manners of an exiled royalty are
- his natural heritage. His mind is as keen as the white, man&rsquo;s, though
- perhaps somewhat narrower in scope; he has a vivid sense of humour, strong
- feelings about honour and faithfulness, the courage of a bull-dog, and the
- reckless daring of an Irish dragoon. Worth knowing, and well worth liking
- when known, are the brown men and women of North New Zealand.
- </p>
- <p>
- The little village of Ohinemutu, less than a mile from Rotorua, is
- astonishingly Maori still, in spite of the development of the district for
- tourist travel. Go down towards the shores of the lake at the back of the
- big hotel, and you step at once into a native &ldquo;pah,&rdquo; built in the
- haphazard fashion peculiar to Maori settlements. There are no streets, and
- no definite beginnings or endings. The houses face every way, and are of
- many fashions; here a reed-built warry, there a house with a front
- splendidly carved and painted in old native fashion, further on a wooden
- dwelling about as large as a bathing-box, with a full-sized bay-window
- fastened on to it. Most are wooden huts with iron roofs&mdash;a compromise
- between native and European styles.
- </p>
- <p>
- Everywhere one goes, there are steaming pools with newly washed clothes
- drying on the edge, or small brown bodies happily disporting themselves in
- the water. Cooking-boxes are erected over countless steam-holes; and every
- here and there, one meets a tall brown man or woman, looking extremely
- clean and damp, and wrapped in a big coloured blanket and nothing else,
- stalking house-wards from a refreshing bath. Try to take a photograph, and
- if the Maori is accustomed to tourists, he will ask a shilling for the
- labour of posing; but if he has recently come down from the wilds, and is
- still unspoiled, he will reject an offer of coin with quiet dignity. Taken
- as nature made him, the Maori is not greedy of money. It is only a very
- few months since the Maories of the King country (a wild, half-claimed
- district in the &ldquo;back blocks&rdquo;) have allowed gold prospectors to pass
- through their lands. Until recently they admitted tourists and sportsmen
- freely, but refused to allow any one to look for gold, giving as a reason
- their belief, that the finding of gold did no country any good.
- </p>
- <p>
- Whakarewarewa, a couple of miles outside the town of Rotorua, has a very
- interesting model of a typical Maori fortified &ldquo;pah,&rdquo; lately completed by
- the Government. The large space of grass enclosed by the fort is guarded
- by high earth breastworks and a deep ditch. Beyond the ditch is an open
- wooden paling, apparently more for ornament than use, on which are placed
- at intervals carved wooden figures of a threatening and terrifying
- character. All of them are native work, but of modern date.
- </p>
- <p>
- The geysers of Whakarewarewa are many and famous. The most famous of all
- was the great twin geyser Waikite, whose double throat opens at the top of
- a high terraced cone, built up of siliceous sinter, deposited by the
- geyser water during long ages of action. Waikite has ceased to play since
- 1886, when the railway from Auckland to Rotorua was completed. On the day
- when the line was opened for traffic, the geyser ceased playing, and its
- fountains have never ascended since.
- </p>
- <p>
- Wairoa (Maori, &ldquo;Long Water&rdquo;) is now the lion of Whakarewarewa. It plays
- very seldom of its own accord, but on special occasions the local
- authorities permit it to be dosed with soap, which always produces an
- eruption. A geyser constantly physicked in this manner often gives up
- playing altogether in the end; so careful restrictions hedge round the
- operation, in the case of Wairoa. It is first necessary to procure consent
- from the Government Tourist Department in Wellington, and then to arrange
- a day and give notice to the town. The Government authorities in
- Wellington were kind enough to send an order to Rotorua to have Wairoa
- soaped for me during my stay; and I took advantage of the opportunity to
- enjoy the novel sensation of starting the geyser myself.
- </p>
- <p>
- On a Sunday afternoon of December 1904, all Rotorua assembled in a black
- crowd at &ldquo;Whaka&rdquo; to see Wairoa play. Rows of cameras were placed upon the
- hillocks commanding the spot; bets were freely made about the height and
- quality of the coming performance, and every one scuffled politely for a
- front place when the ceremony began. The caretaker of the grounds and the
- head guide solemnly removed the wooden cover (pierced to allow the escape
- of steam) which is padlocked over the geyser&rsquo;s stony lips, and handed me a
- bag containing three bars of soap, cut up into small pieces. I stood on
- the edge of the geyser-mouth, looking down a great black well full of
- steam, and rumbling with deep, groaning murmurs from below, until the
- guide gave the word, and then emptied the bag down Wairoa&rsquo;s throat.
- </p>
- <p>
- <br /><br /><a name="linkimage-0054" id="linkimage-0054"> </a>
- </p>
- <div class="fig" style="width:50%;">
- <img src="images/0501.jpg" alt="0501 " width="100%" /><br />
- </div>
- <h5>
- <a href="images/0501.jpg"><img src="images/enlarge.jpg" alt="" /> </a>
- </h5>
- <p>
- Almost immediately, white lather began to form in the depths of the well,
- and rose rapidly to the verge. The guide now ordered me away from the
- geyser; for, although Wairoa generally takes some minutes to play after
- being soaped, one can never be absolutely certain that it will not respond
- with inconvenient swiftness. I went back to a neighbouring hillock from
- which an excellent view could be obtained, and waited with the eager
- crowd. Every now and then a small rush of water lifted over the geyser
- rim, and once or twice the fountain seemed about to start; but it was not
- until seventeen minutes after I had put in the soap that Wairoa choked,
- gurgled, and finally broke into a roar like a ten thousand ton liner
- throwing off steam. In another instant, still roaring, the geyser shot up
- silvery white water, dissolving at the top, full 140 feet above ground,
- into a crest of delicate streamy feathers all sparkling in the sun. The
- display lasted about a couple of minutes, and then sank gradually away;
- but for long afterwards, Wairoa mumbled and grumbled and frothed at the
- mouth, not settling down into quiet for at least an hour.
- </p>
- <p>
- Of Auckland&mdash;&ldquo;last, loneliest, loveliest, exquisite, apart,&rdquo; as
- Kipling has called it&mdash;thus compelling all later travellers to see,
- or at least pretend to see, exquisite loveliness in prosaic Queen Street,
- and go a-hunting for poetic solitudes along the quays&mdash;I have nothing
- to say. Great ports are all alike, the wide world over, and hotel is as
- like unto hotel as pebble unto pebble. And when the story is done, why
- linger?
- </p>
- <p>
- I have set forth to tell something of Britain of the South Seas, and such
- as it is, my say has been said.
- </p>
- <h3>
- THE END
- </h3>
- <div style="height: 6em;">
- <br /><br /><br /><br /><br /><br />
- </div>
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-<pre>
-
-
-
-
-
-End of Project Gutenberg's In The Strange South Seas, by Beatrice Grimshaw
-
-*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK IN THE STRANGE SOUTH SEAS ***
-
-***** This file should be named 54499-h.htm or 54499-h.zip *****
-This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
- http://www.gutenberg.org/5/4/4/9/54499/
-
-Produced by David Widger from page images generously
-provided by the Internet Archive
-
-
-Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions will
-be renamed.
-
-Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright
-law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works,
-so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United
-States without permission and without paying copyright
-royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part
-of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
-concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark,
-and may not be used if you charge for the eBooks, unless you receive
-specific permission. If you do not charge anything for copies of this
-eBook, complying with the rules is very easy. You may use this eBook
-for nearly any purpose such as creation of derivative works, reports,
-performances and research. They may be modified and printed and given
-away--you may do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks
-not protected by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the
-trademark license, especially commercial redistribution.
-
-START: FULL LICENSE
-
-THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
-PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
-
-To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
-distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
-(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full
-Project Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at
-www.gutenberg.org/license.
-
-Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-
-1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
-and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
-(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
-the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or
-destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your
-possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a
-Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound
-by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the
-person or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph
-1.E.8.
-
-1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
-used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
-agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
-things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
-paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this
-agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below.
-
-1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the
-Foundation" or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection
-of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual
-works in the collection are in the public domain in the United
-States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the
-United States and you are located in the United States, we do not
-claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing,
-displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as
-all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope
-that you will support the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting
-free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm
-works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the
-Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with the work. You can easily
-comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the
-same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg-tm License when
-you share it without charge with others.
-
-1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
-what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are
-in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States,
-check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this
-agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing,
-distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any
-other Project Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no
-representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any
-country outside the United States.
-
-1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
-
-1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other
-immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear
-prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work
-on which the phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the
-phrase "Project Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed,
-performed, viewed, copied or distributed:
-
- This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
- most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no
- restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it
- under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included with this
- eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the
- United States, you'll have to check the laws of the country where you
- are located before using this ebook.
-
-1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is
-derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not
-contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the
-copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in
-the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are
-redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply
-either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or
-obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
-with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
-must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any
-additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms
-will be linked to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works
-posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the
-beginning of this work.
-
-1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
-work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
-
-1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
-electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
-prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
-active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm License.
-
-1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
-compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including
-any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access
-to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format
-other than "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official
-version posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site
-(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense
-to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means
-of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original "Plain
-Vanilla ASCII" or other form. Any alternate format must include the
-full Project Gutenberg-tm License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
-
-1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
-performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
-unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
-access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-provided that
-
-* You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
- the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
- you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed
- to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he has
- agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid
- within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are
- legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty
- payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in
- Section 4, "Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg
- Literary Archive Foundation."
-
-* You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
- you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
- does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
- License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all
- copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue
- all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg-tm
- works.
-
-* You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of
- any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
- electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of
- receipt of the work.
-
-* You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
- distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work or group of works on different terms than
-are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing
-from both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and The
-Project Gutenberg Trademark LLC, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark. Contact the Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
-
-1.F.
-
-1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
-effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
-works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project
-Gutenberg-tm collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may
-contain "Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate
-or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
-intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or
-other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or
-cannot be read by your equipment.
-
-1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
-of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
-liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
-fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
-LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
-PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
-TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
-LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
-INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGE.
-
-1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
-defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
-receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
-written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
-received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium
-with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you
-with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in
-lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person
-or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second
-opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If
-the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing
-without further opportunities to fix the problem.
-
-1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
-in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO
-OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
-LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
-
-1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
-warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of
-damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement
-violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the
-agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or
-limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or
-unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the
-remaining provisions.
-
-1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
-trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
-providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in
-accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the
-production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses,
-including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of
-the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this
-or any Project Gutenberg-tm work, (b) alteration, modification, or
-additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any
-Defect you cause.
-
-Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
-electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of
-computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It
-exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations
-from people in all walks of life.
-
-Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
-assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
-goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
-remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
-and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future
-generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see
-Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at
-www.gutenberg.org Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
-501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
-state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
-Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
-number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by
-U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
-
-The Foundation's principal office is in Fairbanks, Alaska, with the
-mailing address: PO Box 750175, Fairbanks, AK 99775, but its
-volunteers and employees are scattered throughout numerous
-locations. Its business office is located at 809 North 1500 West, Salt
-Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up to
-date contact information can be found at the Foundation's web site and
-official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact
-
-For additional contact information:
-
- Dr. Gregory B. Newby
- Chief Executive and Director
- gbnewby@pglaf.org
-
-Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
-spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
-increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
-freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
-array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
-($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
-status with the IRS.
-
-The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
-charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
-States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
-considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
-with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
-where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND
-DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular
-state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
-have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
-against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
-approach us with offers to donate.
-
-International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
-any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
-outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
-
-Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
-methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
-ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To
-donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works.
-
-Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm concept of a library of electronic works that could be
-freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and
-distributed Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of
-volunteer support.
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
-editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in
-the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not
-necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper
-edition.
-
-Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search
-facility: www.gutenberg.org
-
-This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
-including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
-subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
-
-
-
-</pre>
-
- </body>
-</html>